Factory Workshop Manual
Make
Chevrolet
Model
Astro Van 2wd
Engine and year
V6-4.3L VIN X (2002)
Please navigate through the PDF using the options
provided by OnlyManuals.com on the sidebar.
This manual was submitted by
Anonymous
Date
1st January 2018
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Accessory Delay Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 12
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 13
Accessory Delay Module: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 14
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 15
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 16
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 17
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 18
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 19
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 20
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 21
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 22
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 23
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 24
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 25
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 26
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 27
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 28
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 29
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 30
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 31
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 32
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 33
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 34
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 35
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 36
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 37
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 38
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 39
Accessory Delay Module: Description and Operation
RETAINED ACCESSORY POWER (RAP) POWER MODE
RAP is a vehicle power mode that permits the operation of selected customer convenience items
after the ignition switch is turned OFF. These selected items will remain in operation until a
passenger compartment door is opened or until the RAP function timer reaches its shut-off limit.
The body control module monitors the ignition switch position, battery condition and passenger
compartment door status to determine whether RAP should be initiated. If the ignition switch
transitions from RUN/ON to OFF, the battery level is within the acceptable range and the
passenger compartment doors are closed, the body control module closes the RAP relay.
This provides power for the following: ^
Sunroof
^ Power windows
^ Power door locks
^ Radio
^ Rear radio
^ OnStar
The BCM turns OFF the RAP function and opens the RAP relay when one of the following
conditions are met: ^
The BCM senses the opening of any door or the liftgate.
^ The BCM detects a decrease in battery capacity below a prescribed limit.
^ The BCM receives a message from its internal timer indicating the end of the RAP period after 20
minutes.
^ The transition from OFF to RUN/ON or ACC of the ignition switch.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Accessory Delay Module: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Diagnostic Starting Point
Begin the system diagnosis with the Diagnostic System Check - Accessory Delay Module. The
Diagnostic System Check will provide the following information:
^ The identification of the control module which commands the system
^ The ability of the control module to communicate through the serial data circuit
^ The identification of any stored DTCs and their status
The use of the Diagnostic System Check will identify the correct procedure for diagnosing the
system and where the procedure is located.
Diagnostic System Check
TEST DESCRIPTION
Steps 1-5
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. Lack of communication
may be due to a partial malfunction of the class 2 serial data circuit or due to a total malfunction of
the class 2 serial data
circuit. The specified procedure will determine the particular condition.
4. This step is checking for DTCs in the BCM. 5. This step is checking for RAP specific DTCs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview >
Page 42
Accessory Delay Module: Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes
With Scan Tool
PROCEDURE
Use a Tech II or equivalent Scan tool to clear Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) from the PCM
memory. When clearing DTCs, follow the instructions supplied by the Scan tool manufacturer.
NOTES: ^
Do not clear the DTCs unless directed to do so by the service information provided for each
diagnostic procedure. All of the diagnostic data that was saved along with the DTC (freeze frame
data and/or malfunction history records) which may be helpful for some diagnostic procedures will
be erased from the memory when the DTCs are cleared.
^ Interrupting PCM battery voltage to clear DTCs is NOT recommended.
Without Scan Tool
PROCEDURE
Use a Tech II or equivalent Scan tool to clear Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) from the PCM
memory. When clearing DTCs, follow the instructions supplied by the Scan tool manufacturer.
NOTES: ^
Do not clear the DTCs unless directed to do so by the service information provided for each
diagnostic procedure. All of the diagnostic data that was saved along with the DTC (freeze frame
data and/or malfunction history records) which may be helpful for some diagnostic procedures will
be erased from the memory when the DTCs are cleared.
^ Interrupting PCM battery voltage to clear DTCs is NOT recommended.
With Scan Tool
PROCEDURE
A Tech II or equivalent Scan tool must be used to retrieve Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) from
the PCM memory. DTCs can no longer be retrieved at the data link connector. This also eliminates
the PCM function of flashing Code 12. Follow the instructions supplied by the Scan tool
manufacturer in order to access and read either current and/or history DTCs.
Without Scan Tool
A Tech II or equivalent scan tool must be used to retrieve Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) from
the PCM memory. DTCs can no longer be retrieved at the data link connector. This also eliminates
the PCM function of flashing Code 12. Follow the instructions supplied by the scan tool
manufacturer in order to access and read either current and/or history DTCs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview >
Page 43
Accessory Delay Module: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
A Symptoms
IMPORTANT PRELIMINARY CHECKS BEFORE STARTING
1. Perform the Diagnostic System Check - Accessory Delay Module before using the Symptom
Tables in order to verify that all of the following are
true: ^
There are no DTCs set.
^ The control module(s) can communicate via the serial data link. See: Initial Inspection and
Diagnostic Overview/Diagnostic System Check
2. Review the system operation in order to familiarize yourself with the system functions. Refer to
Retained Accessory Power (RAP) Description and
Operation.
VISUAL/PHYSICAL INSPECTION ^
Inspect for aftermarket devices which could affect the operation of the Retained Accessory Power
system. Refer to Checking Aftermarket Accessories in Diagnostic Aids.
^ Inspect the easily accessible or visible system components for obvious damage or conditions
which could cause the symptom.
INTERMITTENT Faulty electrical connections or wiring may be the cause of intermittent conditions.
Refer to Testing for Intermittent and Poor Connections in Diagnostic Aids.
SYMPTOM LIST Refer to a symptom diagnostic procedure from the following list in order to
diagnose the symptom: ^
Retained Accessory Power (RAP) On After Timeout
^ Retained Accessory Power (RAP) Inoperative
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview >
Page 44
Steps 1-10
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview >
Page 45
Steps 1-9
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview >
Page 46
Accessory Delay Module: Scan Tool Testing and Procedures
Scan Tool Data Definitions
MODULE INFORMATION 1
Julian Date of Build: The scan tool displays the date upon which the Body Control Module (BCM)
was manufactured.
Manufacture Enable Counter (MEC): The scan tool displays the actual value for the MEC in the
BCM. This information is for the assembly plant only.
Module Part Number: The scan tool displays the pan number assigned to the BCM that is currently
in the vehicle.
Software Design Suffix: The scan tool displays the version of the software pan number in the BCM.
Software Part Number: The scan tool displays the software identification number (ID) in the BCM.
MODULE INFORMATION 2
Retained Accessory Power (RAP) Calibration Number: The scan tool displays the RAP calibration
part number in the BCM.
Retained Accessory Power (RAP) Suffix: The scan tool displays the RAP identification number in
the BCM.
DATA
Battery Voltage: The scan tool displays the battery system voltage.
Inadvertent Power Timer: The scan tool displays the seconds left before the BCM turns the
inadvertent power relay OFF. The BCM uses this feature to protect the battery against inadvertent
battery rundown caused by components that are part of the courtesy lamp circuit. The inadvertent
power relay is supplied power by the BCM for 2400 seconds / 40 minutes after the ignition is turned
OFF.
RAP Timer: The scan tool displays the seconds left before the BCM turns the RAP relay OFF. The
BCM uses this feature to allow the operation of the radio and the power windows for up to 1198
seconds / 20 minutes after the ignition is turned OFF. After the time has elapsed or the door is
opened the BCM will open the ground circuit for the RAP relay.
INPUT 1
Door Handle Switch: The scan tool displays the position of the door handle. The scan tool displays
ACTIVE when a door handle is raised and INACTIVE with all doors closed and the door handles at
rest.
Drivers Door Jamb Switch: The scan tool displays the position of the drivers door. The scan tool
displays ACTIVE when the drivers door is open.
Ignition 1: The scan tool displays the position of the ignition switch. The scan tool displays ACTIVE
when the ignition switch is in the RUN or CRANK position.
Ignition 3: The scan tool displays the position of the ignition switch. The scan tool displays ACTIVE
when the ignition switch is in the RUN position only.
Ignition Power Mode: The scan tool displays the position of the ignition switch. The scan tool
displays OFF, RUN, CRANK and UNKNOWN. The UNKNOWN display is when the BCM can not
determine the position of the ignition switch.
Key In Ignition: The scan tool displays the position of the ignition key in the ignition switch cylinder.
The scan tool displays YES when the ignition key is completely inserted into the ignition switch
cylinder. The BCM uses this data in controlling the operation of the reminder chime feature.
RAP Relay Feedback: The scan tool displays the state of the RAP relay. The scan tool displays ON
when the BCM activates the RAP relay.
OUTPUTS
RAP Relay: The scan tool displays the commanded state of the RAP relay. The scan tool displays
ON when the BCM allows the RAP relay to go to ground. The BCM will allow operation of the radio
and the power windows with the ignition OFF and the doors closed for up to 1198 seconds,
approximately 20 minutes.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview >
Page 47
Scan Tool Data List
Scan Tool Output Controls
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 05-08-46-004C
> Dec > 10 > OnStar(R) - Number Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned
Emergency Contact Module: Customer Interest OnStar(R) - Number Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 05-08-46-004C
Date: December 23, 2010
Subject: OnStar(R) Phone Number Concerns (Phone Number Incorrect/Assigned to Another
Vehicle/Phone) That Occur During Diagnosis of OnStar(R) System
Models:
2000-2011 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Equipped with OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years up to 2011. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 05-08-46-004B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
During diagnosis of an OnStar(R) concern, the technician may be told that the OnStar(R) phone
number is incorrect or tied to another vehicle and/or phone of some kind. To resolve these
concerns, the Tech 2(R) with software version 22.005 (or higher), has the capability to change the
OnStar(R) phone number.
Service Procedure
1. With the Tech 2(R), build the vehicle to specifications within the Diagnostics area of the Tech
2(R). 2. For vehicles with physical-based diagnostics - under Body, go to the OnStar(R) section.
Then select the Special Functions menu.
For vehicles with functional-based diagnostics - under Body and Accessories, go to the Cellular
Communication section. Select Module Setup and then Vehicle Communication Interface Module.
3. Locate the Program Phone Number prompt and select it. The original phone number will be
displayed on the Tech 2(R) screen. 4. Contact the OnStar(R) team at the GM Technical Assistance
Center (TAC) to obtain a new phone number. 5. Highlight the digits of the phone number one at a
time and enter the new phone number using the number keys on the Tech 2(R). 6. Press the Soft
key at the base of the screen for Done once these numbers have been changed on the screen. 7.
Press the Soft key for Done again. The area code or new phone number has now been
programmed into the phone. 8. Cycle the ignition to Off and open the driver's door. 9. Press the
blue OnStar(R) button to make sure that a normal connection can be made to the OnStar(R) call
center. If applicable, make sure the
Hands-Free Calling (HFC) works properly by making a phone call.
10. If the system is working properly, fax or voicemail a case closing into the OnStar(R) team at
TAC with the results. Dealers in Canada should
submit case closing information through the GM infoNET.
Please follow this diagnostic process thoroughly and complete each step. If the condition exhibited
is resolved WITHOUT completing every step, the remaining steps do not need to be performed. If
the procedure above does not resolve the condition, you must contact TAC for further assistance.
This diagnostic approach was developed specifically for this condition and should not automatically
be used for other vehicles with similar symptoms.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 05-08-46-004C
> Dec > 10 > OnStar(R) - Number Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned > Page 56
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 02-08-46-006C
> Jan > 08 > OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position Reported During Call
Emergency Contact Module: Customer Interest OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position Reported
During Call
Bulletin No.: 02-08-46-006C
Date: January 08, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Incorrect OnStar(R) Global Positioning System (GPS) Location Reported During
OnStar(R) Call
Models: 2000-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2008
HUMMER H2 2006-2008 HUMMER H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
with OnStar(R)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
02-08-46-006B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
A small number of the above-mentioned vehicles may exhibit a condition in which the vehicle
reports an inaccurate location to the OnStar(R) Call Center. This condition can only be identified
via a button press to the OnStar(R) Call Center by the customer. Call Center personnel will be able
to identify this inaccurate location condition. Customers will then be notified through the mail by
OnStar(R) if their vehicle exhibits this condition. Once this condition has been identified OnStar(R)
will instruct the customer to return to the dealership to have this condition corrected.
It is not necessary to reconfigure the vehicle after the following procedure.
In order to correct this condition you must cycle power to the OnStar(R) system. This can be done
by either removing the fuses powering the OnStar(R) system or disconnecting the OnStar(R)
module (VCIM) from the vehicle. As a last resort you can disconnect the vehicle's battery.
The power needs to be removed from the system for approximately 15 minutes.
After completing this procedure the vehicle should be taken to an area with an unobstructed view of
the sky. The vehicle should be kept running for approximately 10 minutes to allow the vehicle to
reacquire the global positioning system (GPS). Then contact the OnStar(R) Call Center via the blue
OnStar(R) button and ask the advisor to verify the GPS position.
If the OnStar(R) advisor still has an inaccurate GPS location refer to the Navigation Systems and
Cellular Communications sub-sections in the Service Manual in order to diagnose and repair the
concern. If the normal diagnostics lead to module replacement you will need to contact Technical
Assistance (TAC) and choose the OnStar(R) prompt. GM OnStar(R) TAC will assist in the
diagnosis and if appropriate order a replacement part. Replacement parts are usually shipped out
within 24 hours and a pre-paid return package label will be included for returning the faulty part. By
returning the faulty part you will avoid a significant non-return core charge.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab US Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Warranty Information (Saab US Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 02-08-46-006C
> Jan > 08 > OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position Reported During Call > Page 61
For vehicles repaired under warranty use, the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 02-08-46-007C
> Nov > 07 > OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands Free Issues
Emergency Contact Module: Customer Interest OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands Free Issues
Bulletin No.: 02-08-46-007C
Date: November 19, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Information on OnStar(R) System - Possible Loss of GPS Signal, Hands-Free Calling
Minutes Expire Prematurely and/or Inability to Add Hands-Free Calling Minutes
Models: 2001-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2008
HUMMER H2 2006-2008 HUMMER H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
with OnStar(R) System (RPO UE1)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2008 model year, warranty information and to provide GPS
signal recovery steps (under Dealer Action heading) to do PRIOR to determining if the VIU/VCIM
needs replacement. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-08-46-007B (Section 08 - Body
& Accessories).
If the vehicle currently has analog-upgradable OnStar(R) hardware, then the customer should be
made aware of the digital upgrade program per the latest version of Service Bulletin #
05-08-46-006. Any analog OnStar system that is not upgraded prior to the end of 2007 will be
deactivated due to the upcoming phase-out of the analog cellular network in the U.S. and Canada.
If the vehicle has recently been upgraded or has had a service replacement unit installed, this
bulletin may not be applicable.
Certain 2001-2008 model year vehicles equipped with OnStar(R) may exhibit a condition with the
Global Positioning System (GPS) that causes inaccuracies in the GPS clock. The GPS system is
internal to the OnStar(R) Vehicle Interface Unit (VIU) or the Vehicle Communication Interface
Module (VCIM). This inaccuracy can result in a symptom where the OnStar(R) Call Center is
unable to obtain an accurate GPS signal, hands-Free Calling minutes expire prematurely and/or
the inability to add Hands-Free calling minutes.
Customer Notification
OnStar(R) will notify the customer by mail with instructions to contact their dealership service
department.
Dealer Action
Not all vehicles will require VIU/VCIM replacement.
The GPS signal in some vehicles may be recoverable. To determine if the signal is recoverable,
simply connect the Tech2(R) and using the GPS information data display option, observe the GPS
date and time. If the date/time stamps are equal to a date approximately 19 years in the future, the
GPS clock has exceeded its capacity and the VIU/VCIM will need to be replaced. If the date/time
stamp is in the past or near future, the GPS clock has simply generated an inaccurate value and
may be recoverable by performing the following power-up reset.
To initiate a power-up reset, battery voltage (batt. +) must be removed from the VIU/VCIM. The
preferred methods, in order, of initiating the reset are outlined below.
Remove the fuse that supplies Battery positive (Batt. +) voltage to the module (refer to the
applicable Service Information schematics for the appropriate fuse).
The next preferred method is to remove the connector to the OnStar(R) unit that Batt + is
contained.
The least preferable method is to remove the negative terminal of the vehicle battery. This will not
only initiate the power-up reset, but it may also result in the loss of radio presets and other stored
personalization information/settings in other modules as well.
After initiating the power-up reset, the GPS data will be set to the defaulted date and time and will
require an acquisition of the GPS signal in order to gain the proper date and time.
Acquiring the GPS signal requires running the vehicle in an open/unobstructed view of the sky.
First, contact OnStar(R) Technical Support by pressing the blue button. Allow the OnStar(R)
Technical Advisor to activate the GPS recovery process. This should take approximately 10
minutes. Continue to
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 02-08-46-007C
> Nov > 07 > OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands Free Issues > Page 66
monitor the Tech2(R) for the current time and date. REMINDER - Keep in mind that the time
displayed on the Tech2(R) is in Greenwich Mean Time (GMT) and the offset is based on the time
zones relationship to GMT.
If replacement of the VIU/VCIM is necessary, you MUST reconfigure the OnStar® system. Failure
to reconfigure the system will result in an additional customer visit for repair. OnStar® VIU,
Generations 2 and 3, will require the technician to press the blue OnStar® button to reconfigure the
vehicle with an OnStar® advisor.
OnStar(R) VCIM, Generations 4-7 will require the technician to reconfigure the vehicle with the use
of the TIS2WEB and SPS applications (pass thru only), along with the Tech2(R).
The configuration and set-up procedure is a two-step process that must be completed step-by-step
without interruption or delay in between each step. This procedure enables an automated activation
without a button press by the technician to the OnStar(R) Call Center. Following this procedure, it
may take up to 24 hours for all OnStar(R) services to be fully activated.
How to Order Parts
If the OnStar(R) GPS date/time stamp is non-recoverable and the unit needs to be replaced,
dealers in the U.S. should contact Autocraft Electronics select the catalog item that contains this
bulletin number. Canadian dealers should contact MASS Electronics.
Dealers DO NOT need to call the GM Technical Assistance Center (TAC) for replacement
approval. Autocraft Electronics and MASS Electronics will be responsible for verifying that the
subject vehicle is a candidate for a replacement VIU/VCIM.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 02-08-46-007C
> Nov > 07 > OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands Free Issues > Page 67
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Emergency Contact Module: > 05-08-46-004C > Dec > 10 > OnStar(R) - Number Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Number
Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 05-08-46-004C
Date: December 23, 2010
Subject: OnStar(R) Phone Number Concerns (Phone Number Incorrect/Assigned to Another
Vehicle/Phone) That Occur During Diagnosis of OnStar(R) System
Models:
2000-2011 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Equipped with OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years up to 2011. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 05-08-46-004B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
During diagnosis of an OnStar(R) concern, the technician may be told that the OnStar(R) phone
number is incorrect or tied to another vehicle and/or phone of some kind. To resolve these
concerns, the Tech 2(R) with software version 22.005 (or higher), has the capability to change the
OnStar(R) phone number.
Service Procedure
1. With the Tech 2(R), build the vehicle to specifications within the Diagnostics area of the Tech
2(R). 2. For vehicles with physical-based diagnostics - under Body, go to the OnStar(R) section.
Then select the Special Functions menu.
For vehicles with functional-based diagnostics - under Body and Accessories, go to the Cellular
Communication section. Select Module Setup and then Vehicle Communication Interface Module.
3. Locate the Program Phone Number prompt and select it. The original phone number will be
displayed on the Tech 2(R) screen. 4. Contact the OnStar(R) team at the GM Technical Assistance
Center (TAC) to obtain a new phone number. 5. Highlight the digits of the phone number one at a
time and enter the new phone number using the number keys on the Tech 2(R). 6. Press the Soft
key at the base of the screen for Done once these numbers have been changed on the screen. 7.
Press the Soft key for Done again. The area code or new phone number has now been
programmed into the phone. 8. Cycle the ignition to Off and open the driver's door. 9. Press the
blue OnStar(R) button to make sure that a normal connection can be made to the OnStar(R) call
center. If applicable, make sure the
Hands-Free Calling (HFC) works properly by making a phone call.
10. If the system is working properly, fax or voicemail a case closing into the OnStar(R) team at
TAC with the results. Dealers in Canada should
submit case closing information through the GM infoNET.
Please follow this diagnostic process thoroughly and complete each step. If the condition exhibited
is resolved WITHOUT completing every step, the remaining steps do not need to be performed. If
the procedure above does not resolve the condition, you must contact TAC for further assistance.
This diagnostic approach was developed specifically for this condition and should not automatically
be used for other vehicles with similar symptoms.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Emergency Contact Module: > 05-08-46-004C > Dec > 10 > OnStar(R) - Number Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned > Page 73
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Emergency Contact Module: > 02-08-44-007D > May > 09 > OnStar(R) - Negative Impact of Cloth/Vinyl Roofs
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Negative Impact of
Cloth/Vinyl Roofs
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 02-08-44-007D
Date: May 12, 2009
Subject: Negative Impact of Dealer-Installed Cloth/Vinyl Roofs on XM Radio and/or OnStar(R)
Systems
Models:
2002-2009 Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2009
HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X with XM Radio (RPO U2K) and/or OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................................................. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to
include the 2009 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-08-44-007C (Section
08 - Body and Accessories).
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................
Dealers should not install a cloth or vinyl roof on vehicles that have been ordered with the XM radio
option (RPO U2K) and/or OnStar(R) (RPO UE1). The performance of these systems may be
negatively impacted by the installation of the cloth/vinyl roof. Additionally, water leaks may result
from installing a cloth or vinyl roof on vehicles with roof-mounted antenna systems. Relocating the
antenna to another spot on the vehicle exterior, in order to install a cloth or vinyl roof, is not advised
either. The performance of the OnStar(R) and XM Radio antennas has been optimized for their
current locations. Relocating the antennas may result in a performance degradation.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Emergency Contact Module: > 08-08-46-004 > Aug > 08 > OnStar(R) - Aftermarket Device Interference Information
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Aftermarket Device
Interference Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-08-46-004
Date: August 14, 2008
Subject: Information on Aftermarket Device Interference with OnStar(R) Diagnostic Services
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Car and Truck (including Saturn) 2009 and Prior HUMMER
H2, H3 Models 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
with OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
This bulletin is being issued to provide dealer service personnel with information regarding
aftermarket devices connected to the Diagnostic Link Connector (DLC) and the impact to
OnStar(R) diagnostic probes and Vehicle Diagnostic e-mails.
Certain aftermarket devices, when connected to the Diagnostic Link Connector, such as, but not
limited to, Scan Tools, Trip Computers, Fuel Economy Analyzers and Insurance Tracking Devices,
interfere with OnStar's ability to perform a diagnostic probe when requested (via a blue button call)
by a subscriber. These devices also prohibit the ability to gather diagnostic and tire pressure data
for a subscriber's scheduled OnStar(R) Vehicle Diagnostic (OVD) e-mail.
These aftermarket devices utilize the Vehicles serial data bus to perform data requests and/or
information gathering. When these devices are requesting data, OnStar(R) is designed not to
interfere with any data request being made by these devices as required by OBD II regulations.
The OnStar(R) advisor is unable to definitively detect the presence of these devices and will only
be able to inform the caller or requester of the unsuccessful or incomplete probe and may in some
cases refer the subscriber/requester to take the vehicle to a dealer for diagnosis of the concern.
When performing a diagnostic check for an unsuccessful or incomplete OnStar(R) diagnostic
probe, or for concerns regarding completeness of the OnStar(R) Vehicle Diagnostic (OVD) e-mail,
verify that an aftermarket device was not present at the time of the requested probe. Regarding the
OVD e-mail, if an aftermarket device is interfering (including a Scan Tool of any type), the e-mail
will consistently display a "yellow" indication in diagnostics section for all vehicle systems except
the OnStar(R) System and Tire Pressure data (not available on all vehicles) will not be displayed
(i.e. section is collapsed). Successful diagnostic probes and complete OVD e-mails will resume
following the removal or disconnecting of the off-board device.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Emergency Contact Module: > 00-08-46-004C > Jan > 08 > OnStar(R) - Re-establishing OnStar(R) Communications
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Re-establishing OnStar(R)
Communications
Bulletin No.: 00-08-46-004C
Date: January 17, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Re-establishing Communications with OnStar(R) Center After Battery Disconnect
Models: 2000-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn and Saab)
with Digital OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-08-46-004B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
When servicing any of the above models and a battery cable is disconnected or power to the
OnStar(R) Vehicle Communication Interface Module (VCIM) is interrupted for any reason the
following procedure must be performed to verify proper Global Positioning System (GPS) function.
Never swap OnStar(R) Vehicle Communication Interface Modules (VCIM) from other vehicles.
Transfer of OnStar(R) modules from other vehicles should not be done. Each OnStar(R) module
has a unique identification number. The VCIM has a specific Station Identification (STID). This
identification number is used by the National Cellular Telephone Network and OnStar(R) systems
and is stored in General Motors Vehicle History files by VIN.
After completing ALL repairs to the vehicle you must perform the following procedure:
Move the vehicle into an open area of the service lot.
Sit in the vehicle with the engine running and the radio turned on for five minutes.
Press the OnStar(R) button in the vehicle.
When the OnStar(R) advisor answers ask the advisor to verify the current location of the vehicle.
If the vehicle location is different than the location the OnStar(R) advisor gives contact GM
Technical Assistance (TAC) and choose the OnStar(R) prompt. GM OnStar(R) TAC will assist in
the diagnosis of a failed VCIM and, if appropriate, order a replacement part. Replacement parts are
usually shipped out within 24 hours, and a pre-paid return package label will be included for
returning the faulty part. By returning the faulty part, you will avoid a non-return core charge.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Emergency Contact Module: > 02-08-46-006C > Jan > 08 > OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position Reported During Call
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position
Reported During Call
Bulletin No.: 02-08-46-006C
Date: January 08, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Incorrect OnStar(R) Global Positioning System (GPS) Location Reported During
OnStar(R) Call
Models: 2000-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2008
HUMMER H2 2006-2008 HUMMER H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
with OnStar(R)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
02-08-46-006B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
A small number of the above-mentioned vehicles may exhibit a condition in which the vehicle
reports an inaccurate location to the OnStar(R) Call Center. This condition can only be identified
via a button press to the OnStar(R) Call Center by the customer. Call Center personnel will be able
to identify this inaccurate location condition. Customers will then be notified through the mail by
OnStar(R) if their vehicle exhibits this condition. Once this condition has been identified OnStar(R)
will instruct the customer to return to the dealership to have this condition corrected.
It is not necessary to reconfigure the vehicle after the following procedure.
In order to correct this condition you must cycle power to the OnStar(R) system. This can be done
by either removing the fuses powering the OnStar(R) system or disconnecting the OnStar(R)
module (VCIM) from the vehicle. As a last resort you can disconnect the vehicle's battery.
The power needs to be removed from the system for approximately 15 minutes.
After completing this procedure the vehicle should be taken to an area with an unobstructed view of
the sky. The vehicle should be kept running for approximately 10 minutes to allow the vehicle to
reacquire the global positioning system (GPS). Then contact the OnStar(R) Call Center via the blue
OnStar(R) button and ask the advisor to verify the GPS position.
If the OnStar(R) advisor still has an inaccurate GPS location refer to the Navigation Systems and
Cellular Communications sub-sections in the Service Manual in order to diagnose and repair the
concern. If the normal diagnostics lead to module replacement you will need to contact Technical
Assistance (TAC) and choose the OnStar(R) prompt. GM OnStar(R) TAC will assist in the
diagnosis and if appropriate order a replacement part. Replacement parts are usually shipped out
within 24 hours and a pre-paid return package label will be included for returning the faulty part. By
returning the faulty part you will avoid a significant non-return core charge.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab US Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Warranty Information (Saab US Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Emergency Contact Module: > 02-08-46-006C > Jan > 08 > OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position Reported During Call >
Page 90
For vehicles repaired under warranty use, the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Emergency Contact Module: > 02-08-46-007C > Nov > 07 > OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands Free Issues
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands
Free Issues
Bulletin No.: 02-08-46-007C
Date: November 19, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Information on OnStar(R) System - Possible Loss of GPS Signal, Hands-Free Calling
Minutes Expire Prematurely and/or Inability to Add Hands-Free Calling Minutes
Models: 2001-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2008
HUMMER H2 2006-2008 HUMMER H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
with OnStar(R) System (RPO UE1)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2008 model year, warranty information and to provide GPS
signal recovery steps (under Dealer Action heading) to do PRIOR to determining if the VIU/VCIM
needs replacement. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-08-46-007B (Section 08 - Body
& Accessories).
If the vehicle currently has analog-upgradable OnStar(R) hardware, then the customer should be
made aware of the digital upgrade program per the latest version of Service Bulletin #
05-08-46-006. Any analog OnStar system that is not upgraded prior to the end of 2007 will be
deactivated due to the upcoming phase-out of the analog cellular network in the U.S. and Canada.
If the vehicle has recently been upgraded or has had a service replacement unit installed, this
bulletin may not be applicable.
Certain 2001-2008 model year vehicles equipped with OnStar(R) may exhibit a condition with the
Global Positioning System (GPS) that causes inaccuracies in the GPS clock. The GPS system is
internal to the OnStar(R) Vehicle Interface Unit (VIU) or the Vehicle Communication Interface
Module (VCIM). This inaccuracy can result in a symptom where the OnStar(R) Call Center is
unable to obtain an accurate GPS signal, hands-Free Calling minutes expire prematurely and/or
the inability to add Hands-Free calling minutes.
Customer Notification
OnStar(R) will notify the customer by mail with instructions to contact their dealership service
department.
Dealer Action
Not all vehicles will require VIU/VCIM replacement.
The GPS signal in some vehicles may be recoverable. To determine if the signal is recoverable,
simply connect the Tech2(R) and using the GPS information data display option, observe the GPS
date and time. If the date/time stamps are equal to a date approximately 19 years in the future, the
GPS clock has exceeded its capacity and the VIU/VCIM will need to be replaced. If the date/time
stamp is in the past or near future, the GPS clock has simply generated an inaccurate value and
may be recoverable by performing the following power-up reset.
To initiate a power-up reset, battery voltage (batt. +) must be removed from the VIU/VCIM. The
preferred methods, in order, of initiating the reset are outlined below.
Remove the fuse that supplies Battery positive (Batt. +) voltage to the module (refer to the
applicable Service Information schematics for the appropriate fuse).
The next preferred method is to remove the connector to the OnStar(R) unit that Batt + is
contained.
The least preferable method is to remove the negative terminal of the vehicle battery. This will not
only initiate the power-up reset, but it may also result in the loss of radio presets and other stored
personalization information/settings in other modules as well.
After initiating the power-up reset, the GPS data will be set to the defaulted date and time and will
require an acquisition of the GPS signal in order to gain the proper date and time.
Acquiring the GPS signal requires running the vehicle in an open/unobstructed view of the sky.
First, contact OnStar(R) Technical Support by pressing the blue button. Allow the OnStar(R)
Technical Advisor to activate the GPS recovery process. This should take approximately 10
minutes. Continue to
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Emergency Contact Module: > 02-08-46-007C > Nov > 07 > OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands Free Issues > Page 95
monitor the Tech2(R) for the current time and date. REMINDER - Keep in mind that the time
displayed on the Tech2(R) is in Greenwich Mean Time (GMT) and the offset is based on the time
zones relationship to GMT.
If replacement of the VIU/VCIM is necessary, you MUST reconfigure the OnStar® system. Failure
to reconfigure the system will result in an additional customer visit for repair. OnStar® VIU,
Generations 2 and 3, will require the technician to press the blue OnStar® button to reconfigure the
vehicle with an OnStar® advisor.
OnStar(R) VCIM, Generations 4-7 will require the technician to reconfigure the vehicle with the use
of the TIS2WEB and SPS applications (pass thru only), along with the Tech2(R).
The configuration and set-up procedure is a two-step process that must be completed step-by-step
without interruption or delay in between each step. This procedure enables an automated activation
without a button press by the technician to the OnStar(R) Call Center. Following this procedure, it
may take up to 24 hours for all OnStar(R) services to be fully activated.
How to Order Parts
If the OnStar(R) GPS date/time stamp is non-recoverable and the unit needs to be replaced,
dealers in the U.S. should contact Autocraft Electronics select the catalog item that contains this
bulletin number. Canadian dealers should contact MASS Electronics.
Dealers DO NOT need to call the GM Technical Assistance Center (TAC) for replacement
approval. Autocraft Electronics and MASS Electronics will be responsible for verifying that the
subject vehicle is a candidate for a replacement VIU/VCIM.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Emergency Contact Module: > 02-08-46-007C > Nov > 07 > OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands Free Issues > Page 96
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for
Emergency Contact Module: > 02-08-44-007D > May > 09 > OnStar(R) - Negative Impact of Cloth/Vinyl Roofs
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Negative Impact of
Cloth/Vinyl Roofs
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 02-08-44-007D
Date: May 12, 2009
Subject: Negative Impact of Dealer-Installed Cloth/Vinyl Roofs on XM Radio and/or OnStar(R)
Systems
Models:
2002-2009 Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2009
HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X with XM Radio (RPO U2K) and/or OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................................................. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to
include the 2009 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-08-44-007C (Section
08 - Body and Accessories).
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................
Dealers should not install a cloth or vinyl roof on vehicles that have been ordered with the XM radio
option (RPO U2K) and/or OnStar(R) (RPO UE1). The performance of these systems may be
negatively impacted by the installation of the cloth/vinyl roof. Additionally, water leaks may result
from installing a cloth or vinyl roof on vehicles with roof-mounted antenna systems. Relocating the
antenna to another spot on the vehicle exterior, in order to install a cloth or vinyl roof, is not advised
either. The performance of the OnStar(R) and XM Radio antennas has been optimized for their
current locations. Relocating the antennas may result in a performance degradation.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for
Emergency Contact Module: > 08-08-46-004 > Aug > 08 > OnStar(R) - Aftermarket Device Interference Information
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Aftermarket Device
Interference Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-08-46-004
Date: August 14, 2008
Subject: Information on Aftermarket Device Interference with OnStar(R) Diagnostic Services
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Car and Truck (including Saturn) 2009 and Prior HUMMER
H2, H3 Models 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
with OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
This bulletin is being issued to provide dealer service personnel with information regarding
aftermarket devices connected to the Diagnostic Link Connector (DLC) and the impact to
OnStar(R) diagnostic probes and Vehicle Diagnostic e-mails.
Certain aftermarket devices, when connected to the Diagnostic Link Connector, such as, but not
limited to, Scan Tools, Trip Computers, Fuel Economy Analyzers and Insurance Tracking Devices,
interfere with OnStar's ability to perform a diagnostic probe when requested (via a blue button call)
by a subscriber. These devices also prohibit the ability to gather diagnostic and tire pressure data
for a subscriber's scheduled OnStar(R) Vehicle Diagnostic (OVD) e-mail.
These aftermarket devices utilize the Vehicles serial data bus to perform data requests and/or
information gathering. When these devices are requesting data, OnStar(R) is designed not to
interfere with any data request being made by these devices as required by OBD II regulations.
The OnStar(R) advisor is unable to definitively detect the presence of these devices and will only
be able to inform the caller or requester of the unsuccessful or incomplete probe and may in some
cases refer the subscriber/requester to take the vehicle to a dealer for diagnosis of the concern.
When performing a diagnostic check for an unsuccessful or incomplete OnStar(R) diagnostic
probe, or for concerns regarding completeness of the OnStar(R) Vehicle Diagnostic (OVD) e-mail,
verify that an aftermarket device was not present at the time of the requested probe. Regarding the
OVD e-mail, if an aftermarket device is interfering (including a Scan Tool of any type), the e-mail
will consistently display a "yellow" indication in diagnostics section for all vehicle systems except
the OnStar(R) System and Tire Pressure data (not available on all vehicles) will not be displayed
(i.e. section is collapsed). Successful diagnostic probes and complete OVD e-mails will resume
following the removal or disconnecting of the off-board device.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for
Emergency Contact Module: > 00-08-46-004C > Jan > 08 > OnStar(R) - Re-establishing OnStar(R) Communications
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Re-establishing OnStar(R)
Communications
Bulletin No.: 00-08-46-004C
Date: January 17, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Re-establishing Communications with OnStar(R) Center After Battery Disconnect
Models: 2000-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn and Saab)
with Digital OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-08-46-004B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
When servicing any of the above models and a battery cable is disconnected or power to the
OnStar(R) Vehicle Communication Interface Module (VCIM) is interrupted for any reason the
following procedure must be performed to verify proper Global Positioning System (GPS) function.
Never swap OnStar(R) Vehicle Communication Interface Modules (VCIM) from other vehicles.
Transfer of OnStar(R) modules from other vehicles should not be done. Each OnStar(R) module
has a unique identification number. The VCIM has a specific Station Identification (STID). This
identification number is used by the National Cellular Telephone Network and OnStar(R) systems
and is stored in General Motors Vehicle History files by VIN.
After completing ALL repairs to the vehicle you must perform the following procedure:
Move the vehicle into an open area of the service lot.
Sit in the vehicle with the engine running and the radio turned on for five minutes.
Press the OnStar(R) button in the vehicle.
When the OnStar(R) advisor answers ask the advisor to verify the current location of the vehicle.
If the vehicle location is different than the location the OnStar(R) advisor gives contact GM
Technical Assistance (TAC) and choose the OnStar(R) prompt. GM OnStar(R) TAC will assist in
the diagnosis of a failed VCIM and, if appropriate, order a replacement part. Replacement parts are
usually shipped out within 24 hours, and a pre-paid return package label will be included for
returning the faulty part. By returning the faulty part, you will avoid a non-return core charge.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D >
Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules
Relay Module: Customer Interest Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-06-03-004D
Date: December 08, 2010
Subject: Intermittent No Crank/No Start, No Module Communication, MIL, Warning Lights, Vehicle
Messages or DTCs Set by Various Control Modules - Diagnosing and Repairing Fretting Corrosion
(Disconnect Affected Connector and Apply Dielectric Lubricant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Attention:
This repair can be applied to ANY electrical connection including, but not limited to: lighting, body
electrical, in-line connections, powertrain control sensors, etc. DO NOT over apply lubricant to the
point where it prevents the full engagement of sealed connectors. A light coating on the terminal
surfaces is sufficient to correct the condition.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Attention statement and add the 2011
model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-03-004C (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions:
- An intermittent no crank/no start
- Intermittent malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illumination
- Intermittent service lamp illumination
- Intermittent service message(s) being displayed
The technician may determine that he is unable to duplicate the intermittent condition.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a buildup of nonconductive insulating oxidized debris known as
fretting corrosion, occurring between two electrical contact surfaces of the connection or connector.
This may be caused by any of the following conditions:
- Vibration
- Thermal cycling
- Poor connection/terminal retention
- Micro motion
- A connector, component or wiring harness not properly secured resulting in movement
On low current signal circuits this condition may cause high resistance, resulting in intermittent
connections.
On high current power circuits this condition may cause permanent increases in the resistance and
may cause a device to become inoperative.
Representative List of Control Modules and Components
The following is only a representative list of control modules and components that may be affected
by this connection or connector condition and DOES NOT include every possible module or
component for every vehicle.
- Blower Control Module
- Body Control Module (BCM)
- Communication Interface Module (CIM)
- Cooling Fan Control Module
- Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)
- Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module (EBTCM)
- Electronic Suspension Control (ESC) Module
- Engine Control Module (ECM)
- Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) Control Module
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D >
Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 118
- HVAC Actuator
- Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM)
- Any AIR BAG module
- Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner
- Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner
- An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set:
B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023
- Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
- Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Correction
Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions:
- The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated.
- The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can
no longer be duplicated.
Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above.
1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any
existing history or current DTCs from all of the
control modules (refer to SI).
‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the
connector(s) of the control module/component
which may be causing the condition (refer to SI).
‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control
module/component which may be causing the
condition (refer to SI).
2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component
Connector End Views and Component Locator
documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the
condition.
Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the
actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or
identified without the use of a magnifying glass.
Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown,
as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush
that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin.
3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side
and the harness side of the affected connector(s).
4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present.
5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information:
- DTC Diagnostic Procedure
- Circuit/System Description
- Conditions for Running the DTC
- Conditions for Setting the DTC
- Diagnostic Aids
- Circuit/System Verification
‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated,
then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI).
Repair Order Documentation
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D >
Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 119
Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so
may result in a chargeback.
- Customer vehicle condition.
- Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or
Service Message.
- Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set.
- After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated?
‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector
name and number on the repair order.
- If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and
additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID
Number MUST be written on the repair order.
Parts Information
Alternate Distributor For All of North America
Note
NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada),
specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D >
Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 120
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table
above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Relay Module: >
09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules
Relay Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control
Modules
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-06-03-004D
Date: December 08, 2010
Subject: Intermittent No Crank/No Start, No Module Communication, MIL, Warning Lights, Vehicle
Messages or DTCs Set by Various Control Modules - Diagnosing and Repairing Fretting Corrosion
(Disconnect Affected Connector and Apply Dielectric Lubricant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Attention:
This repair can be applied to ANY electrical connection including, but not limited to: lighting, body
electrical, in-line connections, powertrain control sensors, etc. DO NOT over apply lubricant to the
point where it prevents the full engagement of sealed connectors. A light coating on the terminal
surfaces is sufficient to correct the condition.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Attention statement and add the 2011
model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-03-004C (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions:
- An intermittent no crank/no start
- Intermittent malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illumination
- Intermittent service lamp illumination
- Intermittent service message(s) being displayed
The technician may determine that he is unable to duplicate the intermittent condition.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a buildup of nonconductive insulating oxidized debris known as
fretting corrosion, occurring between two electrical contact surfaces of the connection or connector.
This may be caused by any of the following conditions:
- Vibration
- Thermal cycling
- Poor connection/terminal retention
- Micro motion
- A connector, component or wiring harness not properly secured resulting in movement
On low current signal circuits this condition may cause high resistance, resulting in intermittent
connections.
On high current power circuits this condition may cause permanent increases in the resistance and
may cause a device to become inoperative.
Representative List of Control Modules and Components
The following is only a representative list of control modules and components that may be affected
by this connection or connector condition and DOES NOT include every possible module or
component for every vehicle.
- Blower Control Module
- Body Control Module (BCM)
- Communication Interface Module (CIM)
- Cooling Fan Control Module
- Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)
- Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module (EBTCM)
- Electronic Suspension Control (ESC) Module
- Engine Control Module (ECM)
- Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) Control Module
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Relay Module: >
09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 126
- HVAC Actuator
- Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM)
- Any AIR BAG module
- Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner
- Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner
- An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set:
B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023
- Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
- Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Correction
Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions:
- The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated.
- The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can
no longer be duplicated.
Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above.
1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any
existing history or current DTCs from all of the
control modules (refer to SI).
‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the
connector(s) of the control module/component
which may be causing the condition (refer to SI).
‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control
module/component which may be causing the
condition (refer to SI).
2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component
Connector End Views and Component Locator
documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the
condition.
Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the
actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or
identified without the use of a magnifying glass.
Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown,
as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush
that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin.
3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side
and the harness side of the affected connector(s).
4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present.
5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information:
- DTC Diagnostic Procedure
- Circuit/System Description
- Conditions for Running the DTC
- Conditions for Setting the DTC
- Diagnostic Aids
- Circuit/System Verification
‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated,
then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI).
Repair Order Documentation
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Relay Module: >
09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 127
Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so
may result in a chargeback.
- Customer vehicle condition.
- Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or
Service Message.
- Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set.
- After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated?
‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector
name and number on the repair order.
- If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and
additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID
Number MUST be written on the repair order.
Parts Information
Alternate Distributor For All of North America
Note
NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada),
specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Relay Module: >
09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 128
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table
above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 133
Door Lock Relay
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Specifications
Electronic Brake Control Module: Specifications
Brake Pressure Modulator Bleeder Valves 80 inch lbs.
EBCM to BPMV 39 inch lbs.
Front Brake Lines to BPMV 18 ft. lbs.
Rear Brake Line to BPMV 18 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Specifications > Page 138
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Specifications > Page 139
Electronic Brake Control Module: Diagrams
Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM) C1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Specifications > Page 140
Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM) C2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Specifications > Page 141
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair
Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM) Replacement
Removal Procedure
Important: After installation, calibrate the new EBCM to the tire size that is appropriate to the
vehicle.
1. Remove the fuel pipe shield (3) from the frame bracket (2) by removing the 2 nuts (4).
Important: Thoroughly wash all contaminants from around the EHCU (1). The area around the
EHCU must be free from loose dirt to prevent contamination of disassembled ABS components.
2. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the EBCM.
3. Remove the 4 T-25 Tort mounting screws (1) that fasten the EBCM (2) to the BPMV (5). 4.
Remove the EBCM (2) from the BPMV (5). Removal may require a light amount of force.
Important: Do not use a tool to pry the EBCM or the BPMV. Excessive force will damage the
EBCM.
5. Clean the BPMV to EBCM mounting surfaces with a clean cloth.
Installation Procedure
Important: Do not reuse the old mounting screws (1). Always install new mounting screws with the
new EBCM.
Important: Do not use RTV or any other type of sealant on the EBCM gasket or mating surfaces.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Specifications > Page 142
1. Install EBCM (2) on to the BPMV (5).
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the 4 new T-25 Torx screws (1) in the EBCM (2).
^ Tighten the 4 T-25 Torx screws to 5 Nm (39 inch lbs.) in an X-pattern.
3. Connect the electrical connectors to the EBCM. 4. Secure the module (1) to the frame bracket
(3) and fuel pipe shield (2) with the two nuts (4). 5. Revise the tire calibration using the Scan Tool
Tire Size Calibration function. 6. Return to Diagnostic System Check - ABS on. See: Brakes and
Traction Control/Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview/Diagnostic System Check
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams
Cruise Control Module (CCM)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 147
Cruise Control Module: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the cruise control cable. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector. 3. Remove the cruise
control module bolts. 4. Remove the cruise control module.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the cruise control module.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the cruise control module bolts.
Tighten Tighten the cruise control module bolts to 12 N.m (106 lb in).
3. Connect the electrical connector.
IMPORTANT: The cruise control cable does not require mechanical adjusting after the
replacement. The cruise control module internally adjusts the cable.
4. Install the cruise control cable. 5. Perform the functional check.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Blower Motor Relay: Service and Repair
BLOWER MOTOR RELAY REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: The blower motor relay that is used on the M/L van is an integral part of the blower
motor resistor and can not be serviced separately from the resistor.
1. Remove the air cleaner. 2. Remove the windshield washers and the coolant reservoir. 3.
Disconnect the electrical connectors. 4. Remove the screws from the blower motor resistor
assembly. 5. Remove the blower motor resistor assembly (4).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the blower motor resistor assembly (4).
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice
2. Install the screws to the blower motor resistor assembly.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Install the windshield washers and the coolant reservoir. 4. Connect the electrical connectors. 5.
Install the air cleaner.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 155
Compressor Clutch Relay: Service and Repair
COMPRESSOR RELAY REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the cover from the underhood convenience center. 2. Remove the compressor relay
(2).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the compressor relay (2). 2. Install the cover to the underhood convenience center.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair
Audible Warning Device Control Module: Service and Repair
MULTIFUNCTION ALARM MODULE REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the multifunction alarm assembly from the convenience center located under the left
side of the instrument panel. 2. Release the single tab connector on the top of the assembly. 3. Pull
out the single tab connector.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the multifunction alarm assembly to the convenience center. 2. Align the retaining tab. 3.
Press the tab in place.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Relay > Component Information > Service and Repair
Daytime Running Lamp Relay: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the left side of the knee bolster. 2. Remove the cover (4) from the block to expose the
DRL daytime running lights relay. 3. Remove the relay from the block.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the relay to the block. 2. Install the cover (4) to the block for the DRL daytime running
lights relay. 3. Install the left side of the knee bolster.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Parking Lamp Relay: Locations
Convenience Center (Front View)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Parking Lamp Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 175
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 176
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 177
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 178
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 179
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 180
Parking Lamp Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 181
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 182
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 183
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 184
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 185
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 186
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 187
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 188
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 189
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 190
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 191
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 192
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 193
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 194
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 195
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 196
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 197
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 198
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 199
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 200
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 201
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 202
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 203
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 204
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 205
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Relay Block #1
Relay Box: Locations Relay Block #1
Relay Block # 1 Under left side of dash on data link connector bracket facing rear of vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Relay Block #1 > Page 211
Relay Box: Locations Relay Block #2
Relay Block # 2 Under left side of dash on data link connector bracket facing front of vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Relay Block #1 > Page 212
Fuse Block - Underhood
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Relay Block #1
Relay Block No. 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Relay Block #1 > Page 215
Relay Block No. 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Relay Block #1 > Page 216
Relay Box: Application and ID Underhood Fuse-Relay Center (Front View)
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Relay Block #1 > Page 217
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) Part 2 Of 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Relay Block #1 > Page 218
Relay Box: Application and ID Underhood Fuse-Relay Center (Rear View)
Fuse Block - Underhood (Rear View) Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Relay Block #1 > Page 219
Fuse Block - Underhood (Rear View) Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Body Control
Module (BCM) C1
Body Control Module C1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Body Control
Module (BCM) C1 > Page 226
Body Control Module C2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Body Control
Module (BCM) C1 > Page 227
Body Control Module C3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 228
Body Control Module: Description and Operation
The BCM contains the logic of the theft deterrent system. The BCM provides the battery positive
voltage to operate the Passlock(TM) Sensor. The BCM also measures the voltage of the security
sensor signal circuit. The voltage measured will indicate whether the Passlock(TM) Sensor has
been activated and whether the resistance value from the sensor is a valid value or the tamper
value. If voltage measured is in the valid range, the BCM compares this voltage, voltage code, to a
previously learned voltage code. If the voltage codes match, the BCM sends a class 2 message
containing a password to the PCM. If the voltage codes do not match, or the voltage is in the
Tamper range, or there is a circuit fault, the BCM will not send the correct password to the PCM,
and the vehicle will not start.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures
Body Control Module: Procedures
IMPORTANT: If any module is replaced, programming the module with the proper RPO
configurations must be done prior to performing the Passlock Learn procedure.
1. The BCM must be programmed with the proper RPO configurations. The BCM stores the
information regarding the vehicle options. If the BCM is
not properly configured with the correct RPO codes the BCM will not control the features properly.
Ensure that the following conditions exist in order to prepare for BCM programming: ^
The battery is fully charged.
^ The ignition switch is in the RUN position.
^ The DLC is accessible.
^ All disconnected modules and devices are reconnected before programming.
2. Follow the SPS instructions on the Techline Terminal and scan tool to program the BCM. 3. If
the BCM fails to accept the program, perform the following steps:
^ Inspect all BCM connections.
^ Verify that the SPS Techline Terminal and scan tool have the latest software version.
Passlock Learn Procedures Refer to the Theft Deterrent sub-system for the appropriate learn
procedure.
IMPORTANT: After programming, perform the following to avoid future misdiagnosis: 1. Turn the
ignition OFF for 10 seconds. 2. Connect the scan tool to the data link connector. 3. Turn the ignition
ON with the engine OFF. 4. Use the scan tool in order to retrieve History DTCs from all modules. 5.
Clear all history DTCs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 231
Body Control Module: Removal and Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Replacing the body control module (BCM) may be necessary when you service the body control
system.
IMPORTANT: The ignition switch should be in the OFF position when connecting or disconnecting
the connectors to the BCM. Always disconnect the Brown BCM connector FIRST and connect the
Brown BCM connector LAST. The BCM can set DTC(s) with the ignition switch in the OFF position.
The BCM has battery run down protection for the courtesy lamp circuit. The BCM battery run down
protection can not detect shorts on inputs or other circuits which it does not control. The scan tool
can be used to put the BCM to sleep in order to check for current draws on circuits which are not
controlled by the BCM or controlled by the battery run down protection system. If an excessive
current draw is detected, refer to Battery Electrical Drain/Parasitic Load Test (w/ BCM) in Starting
and Charging.
1. Remove the radio from the vehicle. 2. Remove the heater control.
Pull the heater control (2) out and down in order to gain access to the body control module.
3. Push upward on the bracket retainer slightly and pull the body control module (2) from the
bracket (1) at an angle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 232
4. Disconnect the electrical connectors (2) from the body control module (1). 5. Remove the body
control module from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the body control module (2) to the vehicle. 2. Install the body control module to the bracket
(1) at an angle under the wide hook retainer, with the label facing away from the bracket. 3. Apply
pressure on the center of the body control module in order to move the module toward the
mounting bracket base. Snap the module into
place.
4. Ensure that the module is fully seated. Ensure that both snap retainers are holding the module.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 233
5. Connect the electrical connectors (2) to the body control module (1).
6. Install the heater control (2). 7. Install the radio to the vehicle. 8. Use the following components
in order to program the body control module with the proper calibrations:
^ The Techline Terminal
^ The Scan Tool
9. Perform the body control module programing. Refer to Body Control Module (BCM)
Programming/RPO Configuration. See: Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning
10. Clear the diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory
Usage
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-06-04-054B
Date: November 18, 2010
Subject: Info - Non-GM Parts and Accessories (Aftermarket)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years and update to the new U.S. Fixed
Operation Manager (FOM) and Canada Warranty Manager (WM) names. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 04-06-04-054A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
The recent rise and expansion of companies selling non-GM parts and accessories has made it
necessary to issue this reminder to dealers regarding GM's policy on the use and installation of
these aftermarket components.
When a dealer is performing a repair under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty, they are required to
use only genuine GM or GM-approved parts and accessories. This applies to all warranty repairs,
special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM. Parts and accessories advertised as being "the
same" as parts manufactured by GM, but not sold through GM, do not qualify for use in warranty
repairs, special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM.
During a warranty repair, if a GM original equipment part is not available through GM Customer
Care and Aftersales (GM CC&A;), ACDelco(R) distributors, other GM dealers or approved sources,
the dealer is to obtain comparable, non-GM parts and clearly indicate, in detail, on the repair order
the circumstances surrounding why non-GM parts were used. The dealer must give customers
written notice, prior to the sale or service, that such parts or accessories are not marketed or
warranted by General Motors.
It should also be noted that dealers modifying new vehicles and installing equipment, parts and
accessories obtained from sources not authorized by GM are responsible for complying with the
National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act. Certain non-approved parts or assemblies, installed
by the dealer or its agent not authorized by GM, may result in a change to the vehicle's design
characteristics and may affect the vehicle's ability to conform to federal law. Dealers must fully
understand that non-GM approved parts may not have been validated, tested or certified for use.
This puts the dealer at risk for potential liability in the event of a part or vehicle failure. If a GM part
failure occurs as the result of the installation or use of a non-GM approved part, the warranty will
not be honored.
A good example of non-authorized modification of vehicles is the result of an ever increasing
supply of aftermarket devices available to the customer, which claim to increase the horsepower
and torque of the Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines. These include the addition of, but are not limited to
one or more of the following modifications:
- Propane injection
- Nitrous oxide injection
- Additional modules (black boxes) that connect to the vehicle wiring systems
- Revised engine calibrations downloaded for the engine control module
- Calibration modules which connect to the vehicle diagnostic connector
- Modification to the engine turbocharger waste gate
Although the installation of these devices, or modification of vehicle components, can increase
engine horsepower and torque, they may also negatively affect the engine emissions, reliability
and/or durability. In addition, other powertrain components, such as transmissions, universal joints,
drive shafts, and front/rear axle components, can be stressed beyond design safety limits by the
installation of these devices.
General Motors does not support or endorse the use of devices or modifications that, when
installed, increase the engine horsepower and torque. It is because of these unknown stresses,
and the potential to alter reliability, durability and emissions performance, that GM has adopted a
policy that prevents any UNAUTHORIZED dealer warranty claim submissions to any remaining
warranty coverage, to the powertrain and driveline components whenever the presence of a
non-GM (aftermarket) calibration is confirmed - even if the non-GM control module calibration is
subsequently removed. Refer to the latest version of Bulletin 09-06-04-026 (V8 Gas Engines) or
06-06-01-007 (Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines) for more information on dealer requirements for
calibration verification.
These same policies apply as they relate to the use of non-GM accessories. Damage or failure
from the use or installation of a non-GM accessory will not be covered under warranty. Failure
resulting from the alteration or modification of the vehicle, including the cutting, welding or
disconnecting of the vehicle's original equipment parts and components will void the warranty.
Additionally, dealers will NOT be reimbursed or compensated by GM in the event of any legal
inquiry at either the local, state or federal level that
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 238
results from the alteration or modification of a vehicle using non-GM approved parts or accessories.
Dealers should be especially cautious of accessory companies that claim the installation of their
product will not void the factory warranty. Many times these companies have even given direction
on how to quickly disassemble the accessory in an attempt to preclude the manufacturer from
finding out that is has been installed.
Any suspect repairs should be reviewed by the Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), and in Canada
by the Warranty Manager (WM) for appropriate repair direction. If it is decided that a goodwill repair
is to be made on the vehicle, even with the installation of such non-GM approved components, the
customer is to be made aware of General Motors position on this issue and is to sign the
appropriate goodwill documentation required by General Motors.
It is imperative for dealers to understand that by installing such devices, they are jeopardizing not
only the warranty coverage, but also the performance and reliability of the customer's vehicle.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 239
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 242
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 243
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 244
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 245
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 246
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 247
Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 248
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 249
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 250
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 251
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 252
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 253
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 254
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 255
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 256
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 257
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 258
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 259
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 260
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 261
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 262
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 263
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 264
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 265
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 266
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 267
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 268
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 269
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 270
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 271
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 272
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 273
Engine Control Module: Connector Views
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) C1 Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 274
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) C1 Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 275
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) C2 Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 276
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) C2 Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> General Information
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation General Information
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is designed to maintain exhaust emission levels while
maintaining excellent driveability and fuel efficiency. The PCM controls the following operations:
^ The fuel control
^ The Ignition Control (IC)
^ The Knock Sensor (KS) system
^ The automatic transmission shift functions
^ The manual transmission
^ The cruise control enable, if so equipped
^ The generator
^ The Evaporative Emissions (EVAP) purge
^ The A/C clutch control, if so equipped
^ The Secondary Air Injection (AIR), if so equipped
^ The Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR)
The PCM controls all ignition system functions, and constantly corrects the basic spark timing. The
PCM monitors information from various sensor inputs that include the following:
^ The Throttle Position (TP) sensor
^ The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
^ The Mass Airflow (MAF) Sensor
^ The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor
^ The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
^ The transmission gear position or range information sensors
^ The engine Knock Sensors (KS)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> General Information > Page 279
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the meaning of voltage
(volts), current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens in a circuit
with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring diagram.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> General Information > Page 280
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation Engine Controls Information
The driveability and emissions information describes the function and operation of the Powertrain
Control Module (PCM).
The computers and control systems information contains the following:
^ Component locations
^ Wiring diagrams
^ PCM terminal end view and terminal definitions
^ Powertrain On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) System Check
^ Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) tables
The Component System includes the following items:
^ Component and circuit description
^ On-vehicle service for each sub-system
^ Functional checks and diagnostic tables
The DTCs also contain diagnostic support information containing circuit diagrams, circuit or system
information, and helpful diagnostic information.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> General Information > Page 281
Typical Drive Cycle
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> General Information > Page 282
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation
General Information
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is designed to maintain exhaust emission levels while
maintaining excellent driveability and fuel efficiency. The PCM controls the following operations:
^ The fuel control
^ The Ignition Control (IC)
^ The Knock Sensor (KS) system
^ The automatic transmission shift functions
^ The manual transmission
^ The cruise control enable, if so equipped
^ The generator
^ The Evaporative Emissions (EVAP) purge
^ The A/C clutch control, if so equipped
^ The Secondary Air Injection (AIR), if so equipped
^ The Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR)
The PCM controls all ignition system functions, and constantly corrects the basic spark timing. The
PCM monitors information from various sensor inputs that include the following:
^ The Throttle Position (TP) sensor
^ The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
^ The Mass Airflow (MAF) Sensor
^ The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor
^ The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
^ The transmission gear position or range information sensors
^ The engine Knock Sensors (KS)
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the meaning of voltage
(volts), current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens in a circuit
with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring diagram.
Engine Controls Information
The driveability and emissions information describes the function and operation of the Powertrain
Control Module (PCM).
The computers and control systems information contains the following:
^ Component locations
^ Wiring diagrams
^ PCM terminal end view and terminal definitions
^ Powertrain On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) System Check
^ Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) tables
The Component System includes the following items:
^ Component and circuit description
^ On-vehicle service for each sub-system
^ Functional checks and diagnostic tables
The DTCs also contain diagnostic support information containing circuit diagrams, circuit or system
information, and helpful diagnostic information.
Typical Drive Cycle
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> General Information > Page 283
Primary System Based Diagnostics
There are primary system-based diagnostics which evaluate the system operation and their effect
on vehicle emissions. The primary system-based diagnostics are listed, with a brief description of
the diagnostic functionality.
Heated Oxygen Sensors
The main function of the pre-catalyst Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) is to provide the (PCM) with
exhaust stream information in order to maintain proper fueling to hold emissions within acceptable
levels. These oxygen sensors are always located between the exhaust manifold and the catalytic
converter. After the sensor reaches the operating temperature, the sensor generates a voltage
inversely proportional to the amount of oxygen present in the exhaust gases.
The PCM uses the signal voltage from the fuel control heated oxygen sensors in a Closed Loop in
order to adjust the fuel injector pulse width. While in a Closed Loop, the PCM can adjust fuel
delivery in order to maintain an air to fuel ratio which allows the best combination of emission
control and driveability.
If the oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal are damaged, replace the entire oxygen
sensor assembly. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, the connector, or the terminals. In order for
the sensor to function properly, the sensor must have a clean air reference provided to it. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor wires. Any attempt to repair the wires,
connectors, or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference. Any attempt to repair
the wires, connectors, or terminals could degrade oxygen sensor performance.
Catalyst Monitor Diagnostic Operation
The catalyst monitor diagnostic measures oxygen storage capacity of the catalyst converter. In
order to do this, the heated sensors are installed before and after the 3-Way Catalyst (TWC).
Voltage variations between the sensors allow the PCM to determine the catalyst emission
performance.
As a catalyst becomes less effective in promoting chemical reactions, the catalysts capacity to
store and release oxygen generally degrades. The catalyst monitor diagnostic is based on a
correlation between conversion efficiency and oxygen storage capacity.
A good catalyst, e.g. 95 degrees hydrocarbon conversion efficiency, shows a relatively flat output
voltage on the post-catalyst Heated Oxygen Sensor ( HO2S). A degraded catalyst, 65 percent
hydrocarbon conversion, shows a greatly increased activity in output voltage from the post catalyst
HO2S.
The post-catalyst HO2S is used to measure the oxygen storage and release capacity of the
catalyst. A high oxygen storage capacity indicates a good catalyst. Low oxygen storage capacity
indicates a failing catalyst. The (TWC) and the HO2S must be at operating temperature in order to
achieve correct oxygen sensor voltages like those shown in the post-catalyst HO2S outputs
graphic.
The catalyst monitor diagnostic is sensitive to the following conditions:
^ Exhaust leaks
^ HO2S contamination
^ Alternative fuels
Exhaust system leaks may cause the following:
^ Prevent a degraded catalyst from failing the diagnostic
^ Cause a false failure for a normally functioning catalyst
^ Prevent the diagnostic from running
Some of the contaminants that may be encountered are phosphorus, lead, silica, and sulfur. The
presence of these contaminants prevent the TWC diagnostic from functioning properly.
Catalyst Monitor Heated Oxygen Sensors
In order to control emissions of Hydrocarbons (HC), Carbon Monoxide (CO), and Oxides of
Nitrogen (NOx), the system uses a 3-way catalytic converter. The catalyst promotes a chemical
reaction which oxidizes the HC and CO present in the exhaust gas, converting the HC and CO into
harmless water vapor and carbon dioxide. The catalyst also converts NOx to nitrogen. Catalyst
monitor HO2S, post-catalyst HO2S, are always located downstream of the catalytic converter.
The PCM has the ability to monitor this process using the post catalyst heated oxygen sensors.
The pre-sensors produce an output signal which indicates the amount of oxygen present in the
exhaust gas entering the 3-way catalytic converter. The post sensor produces an output signal
which indicates the oxygen storage capacity of the catalyst. This in turn indicates the catalysts
ability to convert exhaust gases efficiently. If the catalyst is operating efficiently, the pre-HO2S
signal is far more active than that produced by the post-HO2S.
In addition to catalyst monitoring, the post-HO2S has a limited role in controlling fuel delivery. If the
post-HO2S signal indicates a high or low oxygen content for an extended period of time while in a
Closed Loop, the PCM adjusts the fuel delivery slightly in order to compensate.
Comprehensive Component Monitor Diagnostic
Comprehensive component monitoring diagnostics are required to monitor emissions-related input
and output powertrain components.
Fuel Trim System Operation
The fuel trim system monitors the averages of short-term and long-term fuel trim values. If these
fuel trim values stay at their limits for a calibrated period of time, a malfunction is indicated. The fuel
trim diagnostic compares the average of short and long-term fuel trim values. If either value is
within the thresholds, a pass is recorded. If either value is outside the thresholds, a rich or lean fuel
trim DTC will set.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> General Information > Page 284
Misfire Monitor Diagnostic Operation
The misfire monitor diagnostic is based on crankshaft rotational velocity, aka reference period,
variations. The PCM determines crankshaft rotational velocity using the Crankshaft Position (CKP)
Sensor and Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor. When a cylinder misfires, the crankshaft slows down
momentarily. By monitoring the crankshaft and camshaft position sensor signals, the PCM can
calculate when a misfire occurs.
For a non-catalyst damaging misfire, the diagnostic is required to monitor a misfire present for
between 1,000 - 3,200 engine revolutions.
For catalyst damage misfire, the diagnostic responds to the misfire within 200 engine revolutions.
Rough roads may cause false misfire detection. A rough road applies sudden torque variations to
the drive wheels and drivetrain. This torque can intermittently decrease the crankshaft rotational
velocity. The Antilock Braking (ABS) System detects uneven speed between the vehicles wheels
and sends data via the serial data bus to the PCM to disable the misfire monitor until the rough
road is no longer detected.
On automatic transmission equipped vehicles, the Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) disables
whenever a misfire is detected. Disabling the TCC isolates the engine from the rest of the drive line
and minimizes the effect of the drive wheel inputs on crankshaft rotation.
When the TCC has disabled as a result of misfire detection, the TCC is re-enabled after
approximately 3,200 engine revolutions if no misfire is detected. The TCC remains disabled
whenever the misfire is detected, with or without a DTC set. This allows the misfire diagnostic to
reevaluate the system.
Whenever a cylinder misfires, the misfire diagnostic counts the misfire and notes the crankshaft
position at the time the misfire occurred.
A current and a history misfire counter is maintained for each cylinder. The misfire current
counters, Misfire Cur #1 - 8, indicate the number of firing events out of the last 200 cylinder firing
events which were misfires. The misfire current counters displays real time data without a misfire
DTC stored. The misfire history counters, Misfire Hist #1 - 8. indicate the total number of cylinder
firing events which were misfires. The misfire history counters display 0 until the misfire diagnostic
has failed and a DTC P0300 is set. Once the misfire DTC sets, the misfire history counters will be
updated every 200 cylinder firing events. The Misfire counters graphic illustrates how these misfire
counters are maintained.
When crankshaft rotation is erratic, the PCM detects a misfire condition. Because of this erratic
condition, the data that is collected by the diagnostic can
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> General Information > Page 285
sometimes incorrectly identify which cylinder is misfiring. The Misfire Counters graphic shows there
are misfires counted from more than one cylinder. Cylinder #1 has the majority of counted misfires.
In this case, the misfire counters would identify cylinder #1 as the misfiring cylinder. The misfires in
the other counters were just background noise caused by the erratic rotation of the crankshaft. If
the number of accumulated misfires is sufficient for the diagnostic to identify a true misfire, the
diagnostic will set DTC P0300 - Misfire Detected. The illustration depicts an accumulation in the
history buffers.
If two cylinders in sequential firing order are both misfiring, the first misfiring cylinder will
accumulate misfires in its buffer, but the second misfiring cylinder will not. This is because the PCM
compares a misfiring cylinder with the cylinder 90 degrees prior to it in the firing order. Therefore
the PCM would be comparing crankshaft speed of the second misfiring cylinder to an already
suspect cylinder. The PCM however, will be able to detect both misfiring cylinders after the engine
exceeds 2,000 RPM. This is because the PCM then starts to compare misfires to the opposing
cylinder rather than the previous cylinder in the firing order.
Use Techline equipment to monitor the misfire counter data on applicable vehicles, knowing which
specific cylinders misfire can lead to the root cause. Using the information in the misfire counters
identifies which cylinders are misfiring. If the counters indicate cylinders number 1 and 4 misfired,
look for a circuit or component common to both cylinders.
The misfire diagnostic may indicate a fault due to a temporary fault not necessarily caused by a
vehicle emission system malfunction. Examples include the following items:
^ Contaminated fuel
^ Running out of fuel
^ Fuel fouled spark plugs
^ Basic engine fault
Oxygen Sensor Diagnosis
Diagnose the fuel control heated oxygen sensors for the following conditions:
^ Heater performance, time to activity on cold start
^ Slow response
^ Response time, time to switch R/L or L/R
^ Inactive signal, output steady at bias voltage - approximately 450 mV
^ Signal fixed high
^ Signal fixed low
Diagnose the catalyst monitor heated oxygen sensors for the following functions:
^ Heater performance, time to activity on cold start
^ Signal fixed low during steady state conditions
^ Inactive sensor
PCM Function
The PCM supplies a buffered voltage to various sensors and switches. The PCM controls most
components with electronic switches which complete a ground circuit when turned ON.
PCM Service Precautions
The PCM is designed to withstand normal current draws associated with vehicle operations. Avoid
overloading any circuit. When testing for opens or shorts, do not ground any of the PCM circuits
unless instructed. When testing for opens or shorts, do not apply voltage to any of the PCM circuits
unless instructed. Only test these circuits with a DMM while the PCM connectors remain
connected.
Three-Way Catalyst Oxygen Storage Capacity
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> General Information > Page 286
Three-Way Catalyst Storage Capacity
The PCM must monitor the 3-Way Catalyst System (TWC) for efficiency. In order to accomplish
this, the PCM monitors the pre-catalyst and post-catalyst oxygen sensors. When the TWC is
operating properly, the post-catalyst (2) oxygen sensor shows significantly less activity than the
pre-catalyst (1) oxygen sensor. The TWC stores oxygen during the normal reduction and oxidation
process. The TWC releases oxygen during its normal reduction and oxidation process. The PCM
calculates the oxygen storage capacity using the difference between the pre-catalyst and
post-catalyst oxygen sensor voltage levels.
Misfire Monitor Diagnostic Tests
Whenever the sensor activity of the post-catalyst (2) oxygen sensor nears the sensor activity of the
pre-catalyst (1) oxygen sensor, the catalysts efficiency is degraded.
Aftermarket HO2S characteristics may be different from the original equipment manufacturer
sensor. This may lead to a false pass or a false fail of the catalyst monitor diagnostic. Similarly, if
an aftermarket catalyst does not contain the same amount of precious metal content as the original
pan, the correlation between oxygen storage and conversion efficiency may be altered enough to
set a false DTC.
Torque Management
Torque management is a function of the PCM that reduces engine power under certain conditions.
Torque management is performed for the following reasons:
1. To prevent over-stressing the powertrain and driveline components 2. To prevent damage to the
vehicle during certain abusive maneuvers 3. To reduce engine speed when the IAC is out of the
normal operating range
The PCM monitors the following sensors and engine parameters in order to calculate engine output
torque:
^ The air/fuel ratio
^ The Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor
^ The Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) sensor
^ The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor
^ The spark advance
^ The engine speed
^ The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor
^ The A/C clutch status
The PCM monitors the torque converter status, the transmission gear ratio, and the engine speed
in order to determine if torque reduction is required. The PCM retards the spark as appropriate to
reduce engine torque output if torque reduction is required. The PCM also shuts OFF the fuel to
certain injectors in order to reduce the engine power in the case of an abusive maneuver.
The following are instances when engine power reduction is likely to be experienced:
^ During transmission upshifts and downshifts
^ During heavy acceleration from a standing start
^ When the clutch pedal is released too quick under a heavy load (6.0L only)
^ When one set of drive axles loses traction while the other set of drive axles are not moving (4WD
only and in 4WD low)
^ If the IAC is out of the normal operating range, except 6.0L
^ When the driver is performing harsh or abusive maneuvers such as shifting into gear at high
throttle angles or shifting the transmission from reverse to drive to create a rocking motion
The driver is unlikely to notice the torque management actions in the first 2 instances. The engine
power output is moderate at full throttle in the other cases.
The PCM calculates the amount of spark retard necessary to reduce the engine power by the
desired amount. The PCM disables the fuel injectors for
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> General Information > Page 287
cylinders 1, 4, 6, and 7 in the case of an abusive maneuver.
Powertrain Control Module
Powertrain Control Module
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is located in the engine compartment. The PCM is the
control center of the vehicle. It controls the following:
^ The fuel metering system
^ The transmission shifting
^ The ignition timing
^ The on-board diagnostics for powertrain functions
The PCM constantly monitors the information from various sensors and controls the systems that
affect vehicle performance and emissions. The PCM also performs the diagnostic functions for
those systems. The PCM can recognize operational problems and alert the driver through the
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) when a malfunction has occurred. When a malfunction is
detected, the PCM stores a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) which helps to identify problem areas.
This is done to aid the technician in making repairs
The PCM supplies either 5.0 or 12.0 volts to power various sensors and switches. This is done
through resistances in the PCM. The resistance is so high in value that a test lamp does not
illuminate when connected to the circuit. In some cases, even an ordinary shop voltmeter does not
give an accurate reading because the voltmeters resistance is too low. Therefore, a DMM with a
minimum of 10 megaohms input impedance is required to ensure accurate voltage readings.
The PCM controls output circuits such as the fuel injectors, the Idle Air Control (IAC), the cooling
fan relays, etc. by controlling the ground or the power feed circuit through transistors or a device
called an output driver module.
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) contains the remainder of the logic of the theft deterrent
system. If a class 2 message containing a valid password is received from the BCM, the PCM will
continue to allow the fuel injectors to operate. The PCM will allow the fuel injectors to operate until
it decides there is no valid password coming from the BCM. If the PCM does not receive a class 2
message, or receives a class 2 message with an incorrect password, the engine will crank and will
not run or will start and stall immediately.
Input Components
The PCM monitors the input components for circuit continuity and out-of-range values. This
includes performance checking. Performance checking refers to indicating a fault when the signal
from a sensor does not seem reasonable, such as a Throttle Position (TP) sensor that indicates
high throttle position at low engine loads or MAP voltage. The input components may include, but
are not limited to, the following sensors:
^ The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
^ Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
^ Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor
^ Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
^ Knock Sensor (KS)
^ Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
^ Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
^ Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor
^ Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
In addition to the circuit continuity and rationality check, the ECT sensor is monitored for its ability
to achieve a steady state temperature to enable Closed Loop fuel control.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> General Information > Page 288
Output Components
Diagnose the output components for the proper response to PCM commands. Components where
functional monitoring is not feasible will be monitored for circuit continuity and out-of-range values if
applicable.
Output components to be monitored include, but are not limited to, the following circuits:
^ The Idle Air Control (IAC) motor
^ The EVAP system
^ The electronic transmission controls
^ The A/C relay, if so equipped
^ The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) output
^ The Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) control
^ The cruise control enable, if so equipped
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Additional Information
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Additional Information
The Service Programming System (SPS) allows a technician to program a control module through
the Data Link Connector (DLC). The information transfer circuit that is used at the DLC is the same
serial data circuit used by the scan tool for retrieving Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs), displaying
data, clearing DTCs, etc. This procedure offers the ability to install software/calibrations matched to
a particular vehicle.
Most control modules have 2 types of memory. The software/calibrations reside in the flash
memory. The two types of memory are listed below:
^ Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EEPROM) This type of memory allows
selected portions of memory to be programmed while other portions remain unchanged. Certain
learned values reside in the EEPROM, such as: ^
The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
^ The crankshaft variation learned position
^ The software/calibrations identification numbers
^ The control module security information
^ Flash Read Only Memory - Rash Memory Flash memory has increased memory storage
capacity. During programming, all information within this type of memory is erased, and then
replaced with entirely new information.
Service Programming Methods The 4 methods of programming a control module and the proper
tools for each method are as follows: ^
Remote Programming: The Tech 2 or other scan tool, Techline Terminal or a personal computer equipped with General
Motors Corporation authorized programming software - The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an
interface between the vehicle and the Techline Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is installed in the vehicle
^ Pass Thru Programming: The Tech 2 or other scan tool Techline Terminal or a personal computer equipped with General
Motors Corporation authorized programming software - The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an
interface between the vehicle and the Techline Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is installed in the vehicle.
^ Off-Board Remote Programming, vehicle NOT available: The Tech 2 or other scan tool, Off-board Programming Adapter (OBPA), Techline Terminal or a
personal computer equipped with General Motors Corporation authorized programming software The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an interface between the vehicle and the Techline
Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is NOT installed in a vehicle
^ Off-Board Pass Thru Programming The Tech 2 or other scan tool, off-board programming adapter (OBPA), Techline Terminal or a
personal computer equipped with General Motors Corporation authorized programming software The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an interface between the vehicle and the Techline
Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is NOT installed in a vehicle
Before Programming a Control Module
IMPORTANT: DO NOT program an existing control module with the identical software/calibration
package. This procedure is not a short cut to correct a driveability condition. This is an ineffective
repair. A control module should only be programmed when the following occurs: ^
When a service procedure instructs you to replace the control module. The service part control
module does not contain operating software or calibrations.
^ General Motors Corporation releases an updated software/calibration package.
Ensure that the following conditions are met before programming a control module: ^
Vehicle system voltage: There are no charging system concerns. All charging system concerns must be repaired before
programming a control module.
- The battery voltage is greater than 12 volts but less than 16 volts. The battery must be fully
charged before programming the control module.
- A battery charger is NOT connected to the vehicles battery. Incorrect system voltage or voltage
fluctuations from a battery charger may cause programming failure or control module damage.
- Turn OFF or disable any system that may put a load on the vehicles battery. Turn OFF or disable
systems such as: ^
Daytime Running Lights (DRL). Applying the parking brake, on most vehicles, disables the DRL
system.
^ Heating, Ventilation, And Air Conditioning (HVAC) systems
^ Engine cooling fans, etc.
^ The ignition switch is in the proper position. The scan tool prompts you to turn ON the ignition,
with the engine OFF. DO NOT change the position of the ignition switch during the programming
procedure unless instructed to do so.
^ All tool connections are secure: The RS-232 cable
- The connection at the DLC
- The voltage supply circuits
- The OBPA
^ DO NOT disturb the tool harnesses while programming. If an interruption occurs during the
programming procedure, programming failure or
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Additional Information > Page 291
control module damage may occur.
^ If you are performing the pass-through programming procedure using a notebook computer
without the power cord, ensure that the internal battery is fully charged.
After Programming A Control Module The powertrain may operate slightly different after a control
module software/calibration update. Operating the powertrain through various driving conditions
allows the control module to re-learn certain values. The control module must re-learn the following
after a software/calibration update: ^
Fuel trim correction
^ Idle Air Control (IAC) learned position
^ Automatic transmission shift adapts
Other learned values only re-learn by performing a service procedure.
If a control module is replaced the following service procedures may need to be performed: ^
The crankshaft variation learn procedure
^ The engine oil life reset procedure
^ The idle learn procedure
^ The inspection/maintenance complete system set procedure
^ The vehicle theft deterrent password learn procedure
^ The Throttle Position (TP) sensor learn procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Additional Information > Page 292
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Programming
(Off-board)
BEFORE PROGRAMMING A CONTROL MODULE
IMPORTANT: ^
DO NOT program a control module unless you are directed by a service procedure or you are
directed by a General Motors Corporation service bulletin. Programming a control module at any
other time will not permanently correct a customer's concern.
^ The Off-Board Programming is used in situations where a control module must be programmed
without having the vehicle present. The Off-Board Programming Adapter must be used to perform
the Off-Board Programming procedure. The adapter allows the control module to power up and
allows the Tech 2 to communicate with the control module.
^ DO NOT disturb the tool harnesses while programming. If an interruption occurs during the
programming procedure, programming failure or control module damage may occur.
Ensure that all connections are secure at the following locations: ^
The Off-Board Programming Adapter
^ The Tech 2
^ The control module
^ The Techline terminal
OFF-BOARD PROGRAMMING
1. Obtain the VIN of the vehicle for which the control module is being programmed. 2. With the
Techline terminal, select Service Programming. 3. Select Tech 2, Reprogram ECU, and Off-Board
Programming Adapter as the electronic control unit (ECU) location. 4. Connect the control module,
Off-Board Programming Adapter, and the Tech 2 as described on the Techline terminal. Ensure
you use the correct
harness connector from the Off-Board Programming Adapter kit.
5. With the Tech 2, select Service Programming Request Information function. The Tech 2
communicates with the control module and receives the
access code.
6. With the Tech 2, exit the Service Programming Request Information. 7. Disconnect the Tech 2
from the Off-Board Programming Adapter. 8. Connect the Tech 2 to the Techline terminal. 9. Turn
ON the Tech 2.
10. With the Techline terminal, enter the VIN of the vehicle that will be receiving the control module.
11. The Techline terminal will display the message, attaching to database. 12. Identify what type of
programming that you are performing. 13. Select the appropriate calibration file. 14. Ensure all
connections are secure. 15. The Techline terminal displays a summary screen that summarizes
your selections. After confirming you choices, the Techline terminal
automatically loads the calibration files to the Tech 2.
16. After the download is complete, turn OFF the Tech 2. 17. Disconnect the Tech 2 from the
Techline terminal. 18. Connect the Tech 2 to the Off-Board Programming Adapter. 19. With the
Tech 2, select Service Programming.
IMPORTANT: DO NOT turn OFF the Off-Board Programming Adapter if the programming
procedure is interrupted or unsuccessful. Ensure the control module and the Off-Board
Programming Adapter connections are secure and the Techline operating software is up to date.
Attempt to reprogram the control module. If the control module cannot be programmed, replace the
control module.
20. With the Tech 2, select Program. 21. After the download is complete, exit Service
Programming. 22. Turn OFF the Off-Board Programming Adapter.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Additional Information > Page 293
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Programming
(On-Board)
BEFORE PROGRAMMING A CONTROL MODULE
IMPORTANT: DO NOT program a control module unless you are directed by a service procedure
or you are directed by a General Motors Corporation service bulletin. Programming a control
module at any other time will not permanently correct a customers concern.
Ensure the following conditions are met before programming a control module: ^
Vehicle system voltage There is no charging system concern. All charging system concerns must be repaired before
programming a control module.
- Battery voltage is greater than 12 volts but less than 16 volts. The battery must be charged before
programming the control module if the battery voltage is low.
- A battery charger is NOT connected to the vehicle's battery. Incorrect system voltage or voltage
fluctuations from a battery charger, may cause programming failure or control module damage.
- Turn OFF or disable any system that may put a load on the vehicle's battery. ^
Twilight sentinel
^ Interior lights
^ Daytime running lights (DRL) - Applying the parking brake, on most vehicles, disables the DRL
system.
^ HVAC systems
^ Engine cooling fans etc.
^ The ignition switch is in the proper position. The scan tool prompts you to turn ON the ignition,
with the engine OFF. DO NOT change the position of the ignition switch during the programming
procedure, unless instructed to do so.
^ All tool connections are secure. RS-232
- The connection at the data link connector (DLC) is secure.
- Voltage supply circuits
^ DO NOT disturb the tool harnesses while programming. If an interruption occurs during the
programming procedure, programming failure or control module damage may occur.
REMOTE PROGRAMMING
1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Install the Tech 2 to the DLC. 3. Turn ON the ignition, with the engine
OFF. 4. Turn OFF all vehicle accessories. 5. With the Tech 2, select Service Programming. 6.
Identify vehicle information as requested by the Tech 2. 7. Select the type of module you are
programming. 8. Select the type of programming to be performed. 9. Verify the displayed VIN with
the vehicle VIN. If the displayed VIN does not match the actual VIN, write down the actual VIN and
correct the
VIN at the Techline terminal.
10. When complete, Exit Service Programming. 11. Turn OFF the Tech 2 and disconnect the Tech
2 from the vehicle. 12. Turn OFF the ignition. 13. Connect the Tech 2 to the Techline terminal. 14.
Select Service Programming. 15. Select Tech 2 as the tool you are using. 16. Select the type of
programming to be performed. 17. Verify the displayed VIN with the vehicle VIN. Correct the VIN
as necessary. 18. Select the type of module you are programming. 19. Identify what type of
programming that you are performing.
^ Normal - This type of programming is for updating an existing calibration or programming a new
controller.
^ Vehicle configuration index (VCI) - This selection is used if the vehicle VIN is unavailable or not
recognized by the Techline terminal. Observe, you will need to contact the Techline Customer
Support center to use this option.
^ Reconfigure - This is to reconfigure a vehicle, such as tire size and axle ratio changes.
20. Select the appropriate calibration file. 21. Ensure all connections are secure. 22. Select Reprog
to initiate the download of the new calibration to the Tech 2. 23. After the download is complete,
turn OFF the Tech 2. 24. Disconnect the Tech 2 from the Techline terminal. 25. Install the Tech 2
to the data link connector (DLC). 26. Turn ON the Tech 2. 27. Turn ON the ignition, with the engine
OFF. 28. Select Service Programming.
IMPORTANT: DO NOT turn OFF the ignition if the programming procedure is interrupted or
unsuccessful. Ensure that all the PCM and DLC
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Additional Information > Page 294
connections are secure and the Techline operating software is up to date. Attempt to reprogram the
control module. If the control module cannot be programmed, replace the control module.
29. Select Program. 30. After the download is complete, EXIT Service Programming. 31. Turn OFF
the ignition for 30 seconds. 32. Turn OFF the Tech 2. 33. If a control module is replaced the
following service procedures must be performed:
^ The Crankshaft Variation Learn Procedure
^ The Engine Oil Life Reset Procedure
^ The Idle Learn Procedure
^ The Inspection/Maintenance Complete System Set Procedure
^ The Vehicle Theft Deterrent Password Learn Procedure
^ The TP Sensor Learn Procedure
PROGRAMMING VERIFICATION
1. With a scan tool, clear the DTCs. 2. Attempt to start the engine. 3. Repeat the Service
Programming procedure if the engine does not start or operates poorly. Perform the following
procedures before programming
the PCM: ^
Ensure the control module and DLC connections are OK.
^ Ensure the Techline operating software is up to date.
^ Ensure the calibration part number is correct for the vehicle.
4. Attempt to program the control module. If the control module still cannot be programmed
properly, replace the control module. You must program
the replacement control module.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Additional Information > Page 295
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Replacement
Service of the powertrain control module (PCM) should normally consist of either replacement of
the PCM or electrically erasable programmable read only memory (EEPROM) programming. If the
diagnostic procedures call for the PCM to be replaced, the PCM should be inspected first to see if
the correct part is being used. If the correct part is being used, remove the faulty PCM and install
the new service PCM.
IMPORTANT:
^ To prevent internal PCM damage, the ignition must be OFF when disconnecting or reconnecting
power to the PCM. For example, when working with a battery cable, PCM pigtail, PCM fuse, or
jumper cables.
^ Remove any debris from the PCM connector surfaces before servicing the PCM. Inspect the
PCM module connector gaskets when diagnosing or replacing the PCM. Ensure that the gaskets
are installed correctly. The gaskets prevent contaminant intrusion into the PCM.
^ The replacement PCM must be programmed.
Removal Procedure
NOTE: ^
Refer to PCM and ESD Notice in Service Precautions.
^ In order to prevent internal damage to the PCM, the ignition must be OFF when disconnecting or
reconnecting the PCM connector.
1. Disconnect the PCM harness connectors (4). 2. Release the spring latch (3) from the PCM (1).
3. Lift the PCM from the PCM mounting tray (2). 4. Remove the PCM (1) from the engine
compartment.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Additional Information > Page 296
1. Install the PCM (1) to the PCM mounting tray (2). 2. Secure the spring latch (3) to the PCM (1).
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Connect the PCM connectors (4) to the PCM (1).
Tighten Tighten the PCM connector end fasteners to 8 N.m (71 lb in).
4. If a new PCM is being installed, program the PCM. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming
and Relearning
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Additional Information > Page 297
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Service Programming System (SPS)
The Service Programming System (SPS) allows a technician to program a control module through
the Data Link Connector (DLC). The information transfer circuit that is used at the DLC is the same
serial data circuit used by the scan tool for retrieving Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs), displaying
data, clearing DTCs, etc. This procedure offers the ability to install software/calibrations matched to
a particular vehicle.
Most control modules have 2 types of memory. The software/calibrations reside in the flash
memory. The two types of memory are listed below:
^ Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EEPROM) This type of memory allows
selected portions of memory to be programmed while other portions remain unchanged. Certain
learned values reside in the EEPROM, such as: ^
The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
^ The crankshaft variation learned position
^ The software/calibrations identification numbers
^ The control module security information
^ Flash Read Only Memory - Rash Memory Flash memory has increased memory storage
capacity. During programming, all information within this type of memory is erased, and then
replaced with entirely new information.
Service Programming Methods The 4 methods of programming a control module and the proper
tools for each method are as follows: ^
Remote Programming: The Tech 2 or other scan tool, Techline Terminal or a personal computer equipped with General
Motors Corporation authorized programming software - The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an
interface between the vehicle and the Techline Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is installed in the vehicle
^ Pass Thru Programming: The Tech 2 or other scan tool Techline Terminal or a personal computer equipped with General
Motors Corporation authorized programming software - The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an
interface between the vehicle and the Techline Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is installed in the vehicle.
^ Off-Board Remote Programming, vehicle NOT available: The Tech 2 or other scan tool, Off-board Programming Adapter (OBPA), Techline Terminal or a
personal computer equipped with General Motors Corporation authorized programming software The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an interface between the vehicle and the Techline
Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is NOT installed in a vehicle
^ Off-Board Pass Thru Programming The Tech 2 or other scan tool, off-board programming adapter (OBPA), Techline Terminal or a
personal computer equipped with General Motors Corporation authorized programming software The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an interface between the vehicle and the Techline
Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is NOT installed in a vehicle
Before Programming a Control Module
IMPORTANT: DO NOT program an existing control module with the identical software/calibration
package. This procedure is not a short cut to correct a driveability condition. This is an ineffective
repair. A control module should only be programmed when the following occurs: ^
When a service procedure instructs you to replace the control module. The service part control
module does not contain operating software or calibrations.
^ General Motors Corporation releases an updated software/calibration package.
Ensure that the following conditions are met before programming a control module: ^
Vehicle system voltage: There are no charging system concerns. All charging system concerns must be repaired before
programming a control module.
- The battery voltage is greater than 12 volts but less than 16 volts. The battery must be fully
charged before programming the control module.
- A battery charger is NOT connected to the vehicles battery. Incorrect system voltage or voltage
fluctuations from a battery charger may cause programming failure or control module damage.
- Turn OFF or disable any system that may put a load on the vehicles battery. Turn OFF or disable
systems such as: ^
Daytime Running Lights (DRL). Applying the parking brake, on most vehicles, disables the DRL
system.
^ Heating, Ventilation, And Air Conditioning (HVAC) systems
^ Engine cooling fans, etc.
^ The ignition switch is in the proper position. The scan tool prompts you to turn ON the ignition,
with the engine OFF. DO NOT change the position of the ignition switch during the programming
procedure unless instructed to do so.
^ All tool connections are secure: The RS-232 cable
- The connection at the DLC
- The voltage supply circuits
- The OBPA
^ DO NOT disturb the tool harnesses while programming. If an interruption occurs during the
programming procedure, programming failure or
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Additional Information > Page 298
control module damage may occur.
^ If you are performing the pass-through programming procedure using a notebook computer
without the power cord, ensure that the internal battery is fully charged.
After Programming A Control Module The powertrain may operate slightly different after a control
module software/calibration update. Operating the powertrain through various driving conditions
allows the control module to re-learn certain values. The control module must re-learn the following
after a software/calibration update: ^
Fuel trim correction
^ Idle Air Control (IAC) learned position
^ Automatic transmission shift adapts
Other learned values only re-learn by performing a service procedure.
If a control module is replaced the following service procedures may need to be performed: ^
The crankshaft variation learn procedure
^ The engine oil life reset procedure
^ The idle learn procedure
^ The inspection/maintenance complete system set procedure
^ The vehicle theft deterrent password learn procedure
^ The Throttle Position (TP) sensor learn procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Fuel Pump Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 305
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 306
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 307
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 308
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 309
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 310
Fuel Pump Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 311
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 312
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 313
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 314
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 315
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 316
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 317
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 318
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 319
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 320
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 321
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 322
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 323
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 324
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 325
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 326
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 327
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 328
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 329
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 330
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 331
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 332
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 333
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 334
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 335
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page
341
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 342
Ignition Control Module (ICM)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 343
Ignition Control Module: Description and Operation
IGNITION CONTROL MODULE (ICM) AND IGNITION COILS
The ICM is connected to the PCM by an Ignition Control (IC) circuit. The ICM also has a ground
circuit and shares an ignition 1 voltage supply with the ignition coil. The coil driver in the ICM
controls current through the ignition coil based on signal pulses from the PCM. There is no back-up
or by-pass function in the ICM.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 344
Ignition Control Module: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector (3). 3. Remove the screws (4)
holding the ignition control module (2) and the heat sink (1) to the bracket. 4. Remove the ignition
control module and the heat sink.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the ignition control module (2) and the heat sink (1) on the bracket with the screws (4).
Tighten Tighten the screws to 3.5 N.m (31 lb in).
2. Reconnect the electrical connectors (3). 3. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 349
Inflatable Restraint Sensing And Diagnostic Module (SDM)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 350
Air Bag Control Module: Service Precautions
CAUTION:
^ Proper operation of the Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) sensing system requires that any
repairs to the vehicle structure return the vehicle structure to the original production configuration.
Not properly repairing the vehicle structure could cause non-deployment of the air bag(s) in a
frontal collision or deployment of the air bag(s) for conditions less severe than intended.
^ Be careful when you handle a sensing and diagnostic module (SDM). Do not strike or jolt the
SDM. Before applying power to the SDM: ^
Remove any dirt, grease, etc. from the mounting surface
^ Position the SDM horizontally on the mounting surface
^ Point the arrow on the SDM toward the front of the vehicle
^ Tighten all of the SDM fasteners and SDM bracket fasteners to the specified torque value
Failure to follow the correct procedure could cause air bag deployment, personal injury, or
unnecessary SIR system repairs.
^ If any water enters the vehicle's interior up to the level of the carpet or higher and soaks the
carpet, the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) and the SDM harness connector may need to be
replaced. The SDM could be activated when powered, which could cause deployment of the air
bag(s) and result in personal injury. Before attempting these procedures, the SIR system must be
disabled. Refer to Disabling the SIR System. With the ignition OFF, inspect the SDM mounting
area, including the carpet. If any significant soaking or evidence of significant soaking is detected,
you must perform the following tasks: 1. Remove all water. 2. Repair the water damage. 3. Replace
the SDM harness connector. 4. Replace the SDM. Failure to follow these tasks could result in
possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded SIR system repairs.
^ Proper operation of the Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) sensing system requires that any
repairs to the vehicle structure return the vehicle structure to the original production configuration.
Not properly repairing the vehicle structure could cause non-deployment of the side impact air
bag(s) in a side impact collision or deployment of the side impact air bag(s) for conditions less
severe than Intended.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 351
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation
INFLATABLE RESTRAINT SENSING AND DIAGNOSTIC MODULE (SDM)
The Sensing And Diagnostic Module (SDM) is a microprocessor and the control center for the SIR
system. The SDM contains internal sensors along with several external sensors, if equipped,
mounted at various locations on the vehicle. In the event of a collision, the SDM performs
calculations using the signals received from the internal and external sensors. The SDM compares
the results of the calculations to values stored in memory. When these calculations exceed the
stored value, the SDM will cause current to flow through the appropriate deployment loops to
deploy the air bags. The SDM records the SIR system status when a deployment occurs and turns
the AIR BAG indicator ON. The SDM performs continuous diagnostic monitoring of the SIR system
electrical components and circuitry when the ignition is turned ON. If the SDM detects a
malfunction, a DTC will be stored and the SDM will command the AIR BAG indicator ON. In the
event that ignition 1 voltage is lost during a collision, the SDM maintains a 23-volt loop reserve (23
VLR) for deployment of the air bags. It is important to note, when disabling the SIR system for
servicing or rescue operations to allow the 23 VLR to dissipate, which could take up to 1 minute.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 352
Air Bag Control Module: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Air Bag Systems / Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 353
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair
INFLATABLE RESTRAINT SENSING AND DIAGNOSTIC MODULE REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: ^
Be careful when you handle a sensing and diagnostic module (SDM). Do not strike or jolt the SDM.
Before applying power to the SDM: ^
Remove any dirt, grease, etc. from the mounting surface
^ Position the SDM horizontally on the mounting surface
^ Point the arrow on the SDM toward the front of the vehicle
^ Tighten all of the SDM fasteners and SDM bracket fasteners to the specified torque value
Failure to follow the correct procedure could cause air bag deployment, personal injury, or
unnecessary SIR system repairs.
^ If any water enters the vehicle's interior up to the level of the carpet or higher and soaks the
carpet, the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) and the SDM harness connector may need to be
replaced. The SDM could be activated when powered, which could cause deployment of the air
bag(s) and result in personal injury. Before attempting these procedures, the SIR system must be
disabled. Refer to Disabling the SIR System. With the ignition OFF, inspect the SDM mounting
area, including the carpet. If any significant soaking or evidence of significant soaking is detected,
you must perform the following tasks: 1. Remove all water. 2. Repair the water damage. 3. Replace
the SDM harness connector. 4. Replace the SDM. Failure to follow these tasks could result in
possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded SIR system repairs.
^ Refer to SIR Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disable the SIR system. Refer to Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming. 2. Remove the drivers seat.
3. Remove the carpet retaining sill trim molding. 4. Fold back the carpet to access the inflatable
restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM). 5. Remove the connector position assurance
(CPA) (1) from the inflatable restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) wiring harness
connector
(2).
6. Push down the flex lock button (3) and slide the connector locking cover (4) to the open position.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 354
7. Disconnect the SDM wiring harness connector (2) from the SDM (4). 8. Remove the SDM
mounting fasteners (1). 9. Remove the SDM (4) from the vehicle (5).
IMPORTANT: The following repair procedures should only be used in the event that the inflatable
restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) mounting studs and/or fasteners are damaged to
the extent that the SDM may no longer be properly mounted.
10. Repair the fasteners using the following procedure:
10.1. Remove the stripped nut and discard the nut. 10.2. Drill out the weld spots to the weld stud
from the floor pan side, then remove and discard the stud. 10.3. Condition the floor panel attaching
surface where the new stud is to be installed. 10.4. Install new weld stud GM P/N 115115602 and
clamp the weld stud. 10.5. Migweld the stud at the drilled holes form above or below the floor pan,
as required. 10.6. Apply body sealer around any exposed openings. 10.7. Install a new fastener
GM P/N 11515933.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the SDM (4) to the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the SDM mounting fasteners (1).
Tighten Tighten fasteners to 12 N.m (106 lb in).
3. Connect the SDM wiring harness connector (2) to the SDM (4).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 355
4. Push down the flex lock button (3) and slide the connector locking cover (4) to the close position.
5. Install the connector position assurance (CPA) (1) to the inflatable restraint sensing and
diagnostic module (SDM) wiring harness connector (2). 6. Position the carpet to cover the inflatable
restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM). 7. Install the carpet retaining sill trim molding. 8.
Install the driver seat. 9. Enable the SIR system. Refer to Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Monitor Receiver / Transponder > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Tire Monitor System - TPM Sensor Information
Tire Pressure Monitor Receiver / Transponder: Technical Service Bulletins Tire Monitor System TPM Sensor Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-03-16-003
Date: May 12, 2008
Subject: Warranty Reduction - Transfer of Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensors to
Replacement Wheels and Allowable TPM Sensor Replacements
Models: 2000-2009 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2009
HUMMER H2 2006-2009 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7x
with On-Wheel TPM Sensors
TPM Sensor / Wheel Warranty Reviews
During the last warranty review period it was noted that wheels being returned under the GM New
Vehicle Warranty were being shipped back to General Motors with the TPM sensor still attached to
the wheel. Return rates ran as high as 60% with the TPM sensors still attached. Operational TPM
sensors should not be returned to GM and are to be transferred to replacement wheels if they
become necessary.
Important:
Operational TPM Sensors that are returned under warranty to General Motors will be charged back
to the dealer.Sensors have a 10 year /150,000 mile (240,000 km) battery life, and should be
transferred if one or more wheels are replaced.
TPM Valve Stem / Grommet (0-ring) Replacement
When the TPM sensors are transferred to new wheels you should replace the component used to
seal the TPM sensor stem to the wheel. On sensors with an aluminum stem and visible nut on the
outside of the wheel a replacement grommet (0-ring) should be used to assure a proper seal. The
sensor retaining nut (except Aveo) should be tightened to 7 N.m (62 lb in) for all vehicles except
Pontiac Vibe (4.0 N.m (35.4 lb in)).
Important:
^ DO NOT overtorque the retaining nut.
Notice:
^ Factory installed TPM Sensors come with plastic aluminum or nickel-plated brass stem caps.
These caps should not be changed. Chrome plated steel caps may cause corrosion of aluminum
valve stems due to incompatibility of the metals.
On current style sensors the entire rubber stem is replaceable. The service interval on the revised
TPM sensor with replaceable stem is the same as for any other traditional valve stem. Replace the
stem at the time of tire replacement sensor transfer or whenever air seepage is suspected at the
valve stem. When replacing the valve stem tighten the screw to 1.3 N.m (11.5 lb in).
For either style of TPM sensor see the service parts guide for the correct GM part numbers to order
and use.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Control
Module > Component Information > Diagrams
Power Window Control Module: Diagrams
Rear Window Wiper/Washer Module
Windshield Wiper Motor And Module
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Locations
Wiper Control Module: Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 374
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Lock Cylinder Switch > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Audio - Inadvertent Steering
Wheel Button Activation
Remote Switch: Technical Service Bulletins Audio - Inadvertent Steering Wheel Button Activation
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-08-44-028
Date: August 28, 2008
Subject: Information On Inadvertent Steering Wheel Control (SWC) Button Press Causing Radio
Anomalies
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2009 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 Models 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
All Vehicles with Steering Wheel Controls
This bulletin is being issued to provide a recommendation for vehicles with a customer concern of
the radio station tuning changing by itself, volume changing by itself, radio changing by itself, or
radio muting or going silent when driving and turning the steering wheel.
The switches on the right hand side of the steering wheel are easily pressed and may inadvertently
be pressed when turning the steering wheel.
These concerns may be affected by the location of the steering wheel controls.
Recommendation
Do Not Replace The Radio
1. Please determine that the switch controls on the steering wheel are functioning correctly.
2. Ask the customer if their hand was in close proximity to the steering wheel controls when the
condition happened. Explain to the customer that bumping the controls would have caused this
undesired action. Explain to the customer the proper use and function of the steering wheel
controls.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
Power Door Lock Switch: Diagrams
Door Lock Switch - Driver
Door Lock Switch - Front Passenger
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 388
Power Door Lock Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the armrest screws and the armrest YC5. 2. Remove the window handle, if equipped. 3.
Pull out on the escutcheon in order to remove the lock lever escutcheon. Start with the front edge
of the escutcheon. 4. Remove the upper corner trim using the following method:
4.1. Pull the upper corner trim at the top edge.
4.2. Pivot the upper corner trim down in order to clear the tab at the trim panel, YC6 and YC7.
5. Remove the caps that cover the screws for the assist handle. 6. Remove the screws that retain
the assist handle to the door. 7. Remove the screw at the front edge of the accessory switch mount
plate. 8. Remove the plate from the trim panel. 9. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the
switches on the plate, as needed.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Connect the electrical connectors to the switches on the accessory switch mounting plate, as
needed. 2. Install the plate to the trim panel.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the screw at the front edge of the accessory switch mount plate.
Tighten Tighten the screws at the front edge of the accessory switch mount plate to 5 N.m (44 lb
in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 389
4. Install the assist handle and screws to the door.
Tighten Tighten the assist handle screws to 5 N.m (44 lb in).
5. Install the caps that cover the screws on the assist handle. 6. Insert the tab in the slot on the
door trim panel.
Seat the fastener into the door at the top, YC6 and YC7 in order to install the upper corner trim.
7. Snap the lock lever escutcheon into place in order to install the lock lever escutcheon. Start at
the rear edge of the escutcheon. 8. Install the window handle, if equipped. 9. Install the armrest
and armrest screws, YC5.
Tighten Tighten the armrest screws to 5 N.m (44 lb in).
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article or any of the images therein, refer to the
RPO Code List found at Vehicle/Application See: Application and ID
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 393
Seat Adjuster Switch - Driver
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 394
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding the diagnosis of this component and the system that it is a part of,
please refer to Seats Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 395
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair
Seat Switch Replacement - Power
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the screws that retain the power seat switch to the seat.
2. Disconnect the electrical connector from the power seat switch. 3. Remove the power seat
switch.
Installation Procedure
1. Connect the power seat switch electrical connector. 2. Install the power seat switch.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 396
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the screws that retain the power seat switch to the seat.
Tighten the power seat switch retaining screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
02-05-25-006B > Jan > 06 > Brakes - Low Speed (Below 5 MPH) ABS Activation
Wheel Speed Sensor: Customer Interest Brakes - Low Speed (Below 5 MPH) ABS Activation
Bulletin No.: 02-05-25-006B
Date: January 05, 2006
TECHNICAL
Subject: Antilock Brake (ABS) Activation At Low Speeds (Clean Wheel Speed Sensor Mounting
Surface)
Models: 1999-2000 Cadillac Escalade 1995-1999 Chevrolet Silverado (Old Style) 1995-2000
Chevrolet Suburban, Tahoe (Old Style) 1995-2003 Chevrolet Astro Van, Blazer, S10 1995-1999
GMC Sierra (Old Style) 1995-2000 GMC Yukon, Yukon XL (Old Style) 1995-2001 GMC Envoy,
Jimmy 1995-2003 GMC Safari Van, Sonoma 1995-2001 Oldsmobile Bravada
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to update the correction and warranty information. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 02-05-25-006A (Section 05 - Brakes).
Condition
Some customers may comment on ABS activation at low speeds, usually below 8 km/h (5 mph).
Upon investigation, the technician will find no DTCs set.
Cause
The cause of this condition may be an increased air gap between the wheel speed sensor and the
hub reluctor ring due to rust and debris built up on the sensor mounting surface.
Correction
Measure AC voltage and clean wheel speed sensor mounting surfaces.
1. Raise the vehicle on a hoist.
2. Disconnect both the front wheel speed sensor harness connectors.
3. Place a DVM across the terminals of each sensor connector.
4. Rotate the wheel with hand speed and measure the ACmV's. The reading should be at least 350
ACmV's.
5. If the reading is between 200 and 350 ACmV's, remove the wheel, caliper and rotor in order to
gain access to the speed sensor.
6. Remove the wheel speed sensor and plug the hole to prevent debris from falling into the hub
during service.
7. Clean the wheel speed sensor mounting surface using a wire brush, sand paper, emery cloth,
ScotchBrite(TM) or other suitable material. Be sure to thoroughly clean the wheel speed sensor
surface. There should be no rust or corrosion.
8. Check the sensor head to determine if it has been warped/distorted due to the corrosion build up
or other causes. Check the mounting surface on the sensor head for flatness by placing it on the
edge of a metal machinists scale or other suitable straight edge to measure the flatness. Check the
sensor for flatness in multiple (minimum 3) positions/directions. If the sensor head is distorted,
replace the sensor.
9. Apply (spray) two thin coats of the specified rust penetrating lubricant (corrosion inhibitor) to the
complete sensor mounting surface on the bearing hub. Allow to dry for 3-5 minutes between coats.
Use ONLY Rust Penetrating Lubricant, P/N 89022217 (Canadian P/N 89022218).
10. When the corrosion inhibitor is dry to the touch (about 10 minutes), apply a thin layer of bearing
grease to the hub surface and sensor 0-ring prior to sensor installation. Use ONLY Wheel Bearing
Lubricant, P/N 01051344 (Canadian P/N 993037).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
02-05-25-006B > Jan > 06 > Brakes - Low Speed (Below 5 MPH) ABS Activation > Page 406
11. Install either the original sensor or a new one in the hub and secure the sensor. Ensure that the
sensor is seated flush against the hub.
12. Install the rotor, the caliper and the wheel.
13. Place the DVM across the sensor terminals and recheck the voltage while rotating the wheel by
hand. The voltage should now read at least 350 ACmV's.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed
Sensor: > 02-05-25-006B > Jan > 06 > Brakes - Low Speed (Below 5 MPH) ABS Activation
Wheel Speed Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Low Speed (Below 5 MPH) ABS
Activation
Bulletin No.: 02-05-25-006B
Date: January 05, 2006
TECHNICAL
Subject: Antilock Brake (ABS) Activation At Low Speeds (Clean Wheel Speed Sensor Mounting
Surface)
Models: 1999-2000 Cadillac Escalade 1995-1999 Chevrolet Silverado (Old Style) 1995-2000
Chevrolet Suburban, Tahoe (Old Style) 1995-2003 Chevrolet Astro Van, Blazer, S10 1995-1999
GMC Sierra (Old Style) 1995-2000 GMC Yukon, Yukon XL (Old Style) 1995-2001 GMC Envoy,
Jimmy 1995-2003 GMC Safari Van, Sonoma 1995-2001 Oldsmobile Bravada
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to update the correction and warranty information. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 02-05-25-006A (Section 05 - Brakes).
Condition
Some customers may comment on ABS activation at low speeds, usually below 8 km/h (5 mph).
Upon investigation, the technician will find no DTCs set.
Cause
The cause of this condition may be an increased air gap between the wheel speed sensor and the
hub reluctor ring due to rust and debris built up on the sensor mounting surface.
Correction
Measure AC voltage and clean wheel speed sensor mounting surfaces.
1. Raise the vehicle on a hoist.
2. Disconnect both the front wheel speed sensor harness connectors.
3. Place a DVM across the terminals of each sensor connector.
4. Rotate the wheel with hand speed and measure the ACmV's. The reading should be at least 350
ACmV's.
5. If the reading is between 200 and 350 ACmV's, remove the wheel, caliper and rotor in order to
gain access to the speed sensor.
6. Remove the wheel speed sensor and plug the hole to prevent debris from falling into the hub
during service.
7. Clean the wheel speed sensor mounting surface using a wire brush, sand paper, emery cloth,
ScotchBrite(TM) or other suitable material. Be sure to thoroughly clean the wheel speed sensor
surface. There should be no rust or corrosion.
8. Check the sensor head to determine if it has been warped/distorted due to the corrosion build up
or other causes. Check the mounting surface on the sensor head for flatness by placing it on the
edge of a metal machinists scale or other suitable straight edge to measure the flatness. Check the
sensor for flatness in multiple (minimum 3) positions/directions. If the sensor head is distorted,
replace the sensor.
9. Apply (spray) two thin coats of the specified rust penetrating lubricant (corrosion inhibitor) to the
complete sensor mounting surface on the bearing hub. Allow to dry for 3-5 minutes between coats.
Use ONLY Rust Penetrating Lubricant, P/N 89022217 (Canadian P/N 89022218).
10. When the corrosion inhibitor is dry to the touch (about 10 minutes), apply a thin layer of bearing
grease to the hub surface and sensor 0-ring prior to sensor installation. Use ONLY Wheel Bearing
Lubricant, P/N 01051344 (Canadian P/N 993037).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed
Sensor: > 02-05-25-006B > Jan > 06 > Brakes - Low Speed (Below 5 MPH) ABS Activation > Page 412
11. Install either the original sensor or a new one in the hub and secure the sensor. Ensure that the
sensor is seated flush against the hub.
12. Install the rotor, the caliper and the wheel.
13. Place the DVM across the sensor terminals and recheck the voltage while rotating the wheel by
hand. The voltage should now read at least 350 ACmV's.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 413
Wheel Speed Sensor: Specifications
Front Wheel Speed Sensor Mounting Bolt 12 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 414
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 415
Wheel Speed Sensor: Diagrams
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 416
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
Wheel Speed Sensor Replacement (RWD)
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. 2. Remove the tire and wheel. 3. Remove the brake caliper (1). 4. Remove the
hub and rotor assembly (3). 5. Remove the wheel speed sensor cable electrical connector (2). 6.
Remove the wheel speed sensor harness clip rivets using a 3/16 inch drill bit. 7. Remove the clips
from the wheel speed sensor wire. Save the clips for the replacement sensor. 8. Remove the wheel
speed sensor mounting bolts and nut. 9. Remove the 2 splash shield mounting bolts (7).
10. Remove the wheel speed sensor and the splash shield assembly (6). 11. Remove the splash
shield gasket. 12. Clean the gasket and knuckle (8) surfaces thoroughly with a dry cloth.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the splash shield gasket. 2. Install the wheel speed sensor splash shield (6).
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the 2 11 mm splash shield mounting bolts.
^ Tighten the splash shield mounting bolts to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
4. Install the wheel speed sensor mounting bolts and nut.
^ Tighten the speed sensor mounting bolts to 26 Nm (19 ft. lbs.).
5. Install the harness clips to the wheel speed sensor wire. Locate the clips at the paint dots on the
wire. 6. Install the harness clips with 3/16 inch rivets. 7. Connect the wheel speed sensor electrical
connector (2).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 417
8. Install the hub and rotor (3). 9. Install the brake caliper (1).
10. Install the tire and wheel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 15 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 423
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 424
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 425
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 426
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Drain the cooling system. 2. Remove the engine cover.
3. Remove the coolant temperature sensor electrical connector from the electrical harness at the
intake manifold. 4. Remove the coolant temperature sensor electrical connector from the intake
manifold bracket. 5. Remove the coolant temperature sensor from the cylinder head.
Installation Procedure
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the coolant temperature sensor to the cylinder head.
Tighten the sensor to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
2. Snap the coolant temperature sensor electrical connector to the intake manifold bracket. 3.
Connect the coolant temperature sensor electrical connector to the wiring harness at the intake
manifold. 4. Install the engine cover. 5. Fill the cooling system with coolant.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams
Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications
Oil Pressure Sensor: Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure Gage Sensor
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 22 ft. lbs.
Engine Oil Pressure Gage Sensor Fitting (Plus Required Angle)
Torque..................................................................................................................................................
............................................................... 11 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 438
Oil Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
Engine Oil Pressure Sensor and/or Switch Replacement
Tools Required J41712 Oil Pressure Switch Socket
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Disconnect the engine oil pressure sensor gage electrical
connector. 3. Hold the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting with a wrench.
4. Remove the engine oil pressure gage sensor using J41712.
Important: Note the alignment of the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting prior to removal.
5. Remove the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting, if necessary.
Installation Procedure
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting, if removed.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 439
1.1. Tighten the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.).
Important: Do not loosen the sensor fitting. Do not tighten the sensor fitting more than one turn to
align.
1.2. Tighten the sensor fitting until properly aligned.
2. Install the engine oil pressure gage sensor. 3. Hold the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting
with a wrench to prevent from turning.
Using J41712 tighten the engine oil pressure gage sensor to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
4. Install the engine oil pressure gage sensor electrical connector. 5. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Specifications
Ambient Air Temperature Sensor Resistance
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Specifications > Page 444
Ambient Air Temperature Sensor (DIC)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Specifications > Page 445
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Service and Repair
AMBIENT AIR TEMPERATURE GAGE SENSOR REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the radiator grille from the vehicle. 2. Remove the outside air temperature sensor from
the center support bracket by sliding the sensor upward. 3. Disconnect the temperature sensor
electrical connector.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Connect the temperature sensor electrical connector. 2. Install the temperature sensor by sliding
the sensor downward. 3. Install the radiator grille to the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 449
Blower Motor Switch: Diagrams
Blower Motor Switch - A/C Auxiliary - HVAC Systems - Manual
Blower Motor Switch - Heater Auxiliary Part 1 - HVAC Systems - Manual
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 450
Blower Motor Switch - Heater Auxiliary Part 2 - HVAC Systems - Manual
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Blower Motor Switch Replacement - Auxiliary Air Conditioning
Blower Motor Switch: Service and Repair Blower Motor Switch Replacement - Auxiliary Air
Conditioning
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Set the parking brake, turn the ignition key to the ON position and move the gear selector to 1st
gear position. 2. Lower the tilt steering column to the lowest position. 3. Pull the instrument panel
cluster trim plate rearward by grasping it around the edges until the retainers release from the
instrument panel.
4. Remove the auxiliary A/C blower motor switch (2) from the instrument panel cluster trim plate (3)
by releasing the tabs located on the sides of
each switch.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Blower Motor Switch Replacement - Auxiliary Air Conditioning > Page 453
1. Install the auxiliary A/C blower motor switch (2) to the instrument panel cluster trim plate (3) by
engaging the tabs located on the sides of each
switch.
2. Install the instrument panel cluster trim plate by aligning the retainers to the opening in the
instrument panel and push in place until fully seated. 3. Move gear selector into PARK position,
turn the ignition to the OFF position and release the park brake.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Blower Motor Switch Replacement - Auxiliary Air Conditioning > Page 454
Blower Motor Switch: Service and Repair Blower Motor Switch Replacement - Heater Auxiliary
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Set the parking brake, turn the ignition key to the ON position and move the gear selector to 1st
gear position. 2. Lower the tilt steering column to the lowest position. 3. Pull the instrument panel
cluster trim plate rearward by grasping it around the edges until the retainers release from the
instrument panel.
4. Remove the auxiliary heat blower motor switch (1) from the instrument panel cluster trim plate
(3) by releasing the tabs located on the sides of
each switch.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Blower Motor Switch Replacement - Auxiliary Air Conditioning > Page 455
1. Install the auxiliary heat blower motor switch (1) to the instrument panel cluster trim plate (3) by
engaging the tabs located on the sides of each
switch.
2. Install the instrument panel cluster trim plate by aligning the retainers to the opening in the
instrument panel and push in place until fully seated. 3. Move gear selector into PARK position,
turn the ignition to the OFF position and release the park brake.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
A/C High Pressure Switch - HVAC Systems - Manual
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 460
High Pressure Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) HIGH PRESSURE SWITCH REPLACEMENT
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 5403 Snap Ring Pliers
^ J 9553-01 O-Ring Remover
^ J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Recover the refrigerant the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery
and Recharging. 3. Clean the control A/C high pressure switch area before removing the snap ring.
4. Disconnect the electrical connector from the A/C high pressure switch (2) in the rear head of the
compressor. 5. Remove the A/C high pressure switch snap ring using a pair of 90 degree angle
pliers or J 5403. 6. Remove the A/C high pressure switch (2) from the compressor. 7. Remove the
old O-ring seal from the A/C high pressure switch cavity using the J 9553-01. 8. Inspect the A/C
high pressure switch cavity and the O-ring groove in the rear head for dirt or foreign material. Clean
the components as necessary.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: If you reinstall an existing control switch in the compressor, use a new O-ring and a
new retainer ring. An O-ring and a retainer ring is included in a new switch kit.
1. Lubricate the new O-ring using new 525 viscosity refrigerant oil. 2. Install the new O-ring into the
groove in the switch cavity. 3. Lubricate the control switch housing using new 525 viscosity
refrigerant oil. 4. Install the switch (2) into the switch cavity until the switch bottoms in the cavity. 5.
Install the A/C high pressure switch snap ring using a pair of 90 degree angle pliers or J 5403.
Ensure that the high point of the curved sides is
adjacent to the switch housing. Ensure that the snap ring is properly seated in the switch cavity
retaining groove.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 461
6. Evacuate and recharge the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 7. Leak test
the fitting(s) of the repaired or reinstalled components using the J 39400-A. 8. Install the engine
cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 465
A/C Low Pressure Switch - HVAC Systems - Manual
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 466
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) LOW PRESSURE SWITCH REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the electrical connector from the A/C low pressure switch. 2. Remove the A/C low
pressure switch (2) from the accumulator (3).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Lightly coat the NEW O-ring seal with mineral base 525 viscosity refrigerant oil. 2. Install the
NEW O-ring seal to the switch.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the A/C low pressure switch (1) to the accumulator (3).
Tighten Tighten the switch to 6 N.m (53 lb in).
4. Connect the electrical connector to the A/C low pressure switch.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams
Headlamp And Panel Dimmer Switch
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Door Switch: Service and Repair Front
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Loosen the nut on the door jamb switch. 2. Gently pull the switch away from the body. 3.
Disconnect the door jamb switch from the electrical connector(s). 4. Tape the wiring to the body in
order to prevent the wiring from entering the hole in the door pillar. 5. Remove the door jamb switch
from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the door jamb switch to the vehicle. 2. Connect the electrical connector(s) to the door
jamb switch.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Tighten the nut on the door jamb switch.
Tighten Tighten the door jamb switch nut to 3 N.m (27 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 475
Door Switch: Service and Repair Rear
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Loosen the nut on the door jamb switch. 2. Gently pull the switch away from the body. 3.
Disconnect the door jamb switch from the electrical connectors. 4. Tape the wiring to the body in
order to prevent the wiring from entering the hole in the door pillar. 5. Remove the door jamb switch
from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the door jamb switch to the vehicle. 2. Connect the electrical connectors to the door jamb
switch.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Tighten the nut on the door jamb switch.
Tighten Tighten the door jamb switch nut to 3 N.m (27 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Specifications
Fuel Gauge Sender: Specifications
Fuel Level Specifications
The values in the table are approximate values based on information obtained from properly
operating vehicles. Actual results may vary slightly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 479
Fuel Pump And Sender Assembly
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 480
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor
The fuel level sensor consists of a float, a wire float arm, and a ceramic resistor card. The position
of the float arm indicates the fuel level. The fuel level sensor contains a variable resistor which
changes resistance in correspondence with the amount of fuel in the fuel tank. The Powertrain
Control Module ( PCM) sends the fuel level information via the class 2 circuit to the Instrument
Panel Cluster (IPC). This information is used for the IPC fuel gauge and the low fuel warning
indicator, if applicable. The PCM also monitors the fuel level input for various diagnostics.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 481
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the fuel sender assembly. 2. Disconnect the fuel pump electrical connector (5). 3.
Remove the fuel level sensor electrical connector retaining clip (6). 4. Disconnect the fuel level
sensor electrical connector (7) from under the fuel sender cover. 5. Remove the fuel level sensor
retaining clip (4). 6. Squeeze the locking tangs and remove the fuel level sensor (3).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the fuel level sensor (3). 2. Install the fuel level sensor retaining clip (4). 3. Connect the
fuel level sensor electrical connector (7). 4. Connect the fuel level sensor electrical connector
retaining clip (6). 5. Connect the fuel pump electrical connector (5). 6. Install the fuel sender
assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Ambient Light Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 488
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 489
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 490
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 491
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 492
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 493
Ambient Light Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 494
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 495
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 496
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 497
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 498
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 499
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 500
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 501
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 502
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 503
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 504
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 505
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 506
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 507
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 508
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 509
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 510
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 511
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 512
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 513
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 514
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 515
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 516
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 517
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 518
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 519
Ambient Light Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 520
Ambient Light Sensor: Electrical Diagrams
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Lighting and Horns Diagrams.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 521
Ambient Light Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to Lighting
and Horns Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 522
Ambient Light Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Lift upward on the center defogger grille located in center of the dash to expose the DRL photo
sensor (1) retainer. 2. Turn the DRL photo sensor counterclockwise 1/4 turn in order to remove. 3.
Disconnect the electrical connection from the DRL photo sensor (1).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Connect the electrical connection to the DRL photo sensor (1). 2. Insert the DRL photo sensor
(1) and turn counterclockwise 1/4 turn in order to seat. 3. Install the defogger grille located in the
center of the dash by push downward.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 526
Stop Lamp Switch
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 527
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
Stop Lamp Switch Replacement
Removal Procedure
Caution: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the retainer (3) from the brake pedal pin. 3.
Unsnap the switch (2) and pushrod (4) from the brake pedal (1) pin.
4. Disconnect the electrical connector.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 528
1. Connect the electrical connector.
2. Install the switch (2) and pushrod (4) onto the brake pedal (1) pin. 3. Install the retainer (3) onto
the brake pedal (1) pin. 4. Connect the battery negative cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Dome Lamp Switch
> Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Door Switch: Service and Repair Front
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Loosen the nut on the door jamb switch. 2. Gently pull the switch away from the body. 3.
Disconnect the door jamb switch from the electrical connector(s). 4. Tape the wiring to the body in
order to prevent the wiring from entering the hole in the door pillar. 5. Remove the door jamb switch
from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the door jamb switch to the vehicle. 2. Connect the electrical connector(s) to the door
jamb switch.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Tighten the nut on the door jamb switch.
Tighten Tighten the door jamb switch nut to 3 N.m (27 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 536
Door Switch: Service and Repair Rear
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Loosen the nut on the door jamb switch. 2. Gently pull the switch away from the body. 3.
Disconnect the door jamb switch from the electrical connectors. 4. Tape the wiring to the body in
order to prevent the wiring from entering the hole in the door pillar. 5. Remove the door jamb switch
from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the door jamb switch to the vehicle. 2. Connect the electrical connectors to the door jamb
switch.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Tighten the nut on the door jamb switch.
Tighten Tighten the door jamb switch nut to 3 N.m (27 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement
Technical Service Bulletin # 05013A Date: 050526
Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement
Bulletin No.: 05013A
Date: May 26, 2005
SAFETY
Subject: 05013A - Multifunction Switch Contacts
Models: 2001-2002 Chevrolet Astro 2001-2002 GMC Safari
Supercede:
THE INSPECTION IN STEP 35 OF THE PROCEDURE "REPLACING THE HAZARD WARNING
FLASHER SWITCH" HAS BEEN REVISED AND PART NUMBER 15174447 HAS BEEN
ELIMINATED. PLEASE REVIEW THIS NEW INFORMATION IMMEDIATELY. DISCARD ALL
COPIES OF BULLETIN 05013 ISSUED APRIL 2005.
Condition
General Motors has decided that a defect, which relates to motor vehicle safety, exists in certain
2001-2002 Chevrolet Astro and GMC Safari vehicles. On some of these vehicles, the stop lamps
and rear hazard lamps may become inoperative. The usage factors that increase the possibility of
this condition occurring include frequency and length of brake applications, frequency of trailer
towing with brake applications, and exposure to high ambient temperatures. The center high
mounted stop lamp and turn signal lamp functionality are not affected. The loss of stop lamps
and/or rear hazard lamps could fail to warn a following driver that the vehicle is braking and/or is
stopped and could lead to a vehicle accident.
Correction
Dealers are to inspect and replace the hazard warning flasher switch, if necessary. In a small
number of vehicles, the multifunction switch will require replacement.
Vehicles Involved
Involved are certain 2001-2002 Chevrolet Astro and GMC Safari vehicles built within the VIN
breakpoints shown.
Important:
Dealers should confirm vehicle eligibility through GMVIS (GM Vehicle Inquiry System) before
beginning recall repairs. [Not all vehicles within the above breakpoints may be involved.]
For US & Canada
For dealers with involved vehicles, a Campaign Initiation Detail Report containing the complete
Vehicle Identification Number, customer name and address data has been prepared and will be
loaded to the GM DealerWorld (U.S.), GMinfoNet (Canada) Recall Information website. Dealers
that have no involved vehicles currently assigned will not have a report available in GM
DealerWorld/GMinfoNet.
For Export
For dealers with involved vehicles, a Campaign Initiation Detail Report containing the complete
Vehicle Identification Number, customer name and address data has been prepared, and is being
furnished to involved dealers. Dealers that have no involved vehicles currently assigned will not
receive a report with the recall bulletin.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 545
The Campaign Initiation Detail Report may contain customer names and addresses obtained from
Motor Vehicle Registration Records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any
purpose other than follow-up necessary to complete this recall is a violation of law in several
states/provinces/countries. Accordingly, you are urged to limit the use of this report to the follow-up
necessary to complete this recall.
Parts Information
Parts required to complete this recall are to be obtained from General Motors Service Parts
Operations (GMSPO). Please refer to your "involved vehicles listing" before ordering parts. Normal
orders should be placed on a DRO=Daily Replenishment Order. In an emergency situation, parts
should be ordered on a CSO = Customer Special Order.
Customer Reimbursement - For US
All customer requests for reimbursement for previous repairs for the recall condition will be handled
by the Customer Assistance Center, not by dealers.
A General Motors Product Recall Customer Reimbursement Procedure Form is shown in this
bulletin.
Important:
Refer to the GM Service Policies and Procedures Manual, section 6.1.12, for specific procedures
regarding customer reimbursement and the form.
Customer Reimbursement - For Canada & Export
Customer requests for reimbursement of previously paid repairs to correct the condition addressed
in this bulletin are to be submitted by April 30, 2006.
All reasonable customer paid receipts should be considered for reimbursement. The amount to be
reimbursed will be limited to the amount the repair would have cost if completed by an authorized
General Motors dealer.
When a customer requests reimbursement, they must provide the following:
^ Proof of ownership at time of repair.
^ Original paid receipt confirming the amount of repair expense(s) that were not reimbursed, a
description of the repair, and the person or entity performing the repair.
Claims for customer reimbursement on previously paid repairs are to be submitted as required by
WINS.
Important:
Refer to the GM Service Policies and Procedures Manual, section 1.6.2, for specific procedures
regarding customer reimbursement verification.
Courtesy Transportation
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 546
The General Motors Courtesy Transportation Program is intended to minimize customer
inconvenience when a vehicle requires a repair that is covered by the New Vehicle Limited
Warranty. The availability of courtesy transportation to customers whose vehicles are within the
warranty coverage period and involved in a product recall is very important in maintaining customer
satisfaction. Dealers are to ensure that these customers understand that shuttle service or some
other form of courtesy transportation is available and will be provided at no charge. Dealers should
refer to the General Motors Service Policies and Procedures Manual for courtesy transportation
guidelines.
Claim Information
Submit a Product Recall Claim with the information shown.
Refer to the General Motors WINS Claims Processing Manual for details on Product Recall Claim
Submission.
Customer Notification - For US and Canada
General Motors will notify customers of this recall on their vehicle (see copy of customer letter
shown in this bulletin).
Customer Notification - For Export
Letters will be sent to known owners of record located within areas covered by the US National
Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act. For owners outside these areas, dealers should notify
customers using the sample letter.
Dealer Recall Responsibility - For US and Export (US States, Territories, and Possessions)
The US National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act provides that each vehicle which is subject to
a recall of this type must be adequately repaired within a reasonable time after the customer has
tendered it for repair. A failure to repair within sixty days after tender of a vehicle is prima facie
evidence
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 547
of failure to repair within a reasonable time. If the condition is not adequately repaired within a
reasonable time, the customer may be entitled to an identical or reasonably equivalent vehicle at
no charge or to a refund of the purchase price less a reasonable allowance for depreciation. To
avoid having to provide these burdensome remedies, every effort must be made to promptly
schedule an appointment with each customer and to repair their vehicle as soon as possible. In the
recall notification letters, customers are told how to contact the US National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration if the recall is not completed within a reasonable time.
Dealer Recall Responsibility - All
All unsold new vehicles in dealers, possession and subject to this recall MUST be held and
inspected/repaired per the service procedure of this recall bulletin BEFORE customers take
possession of these vehicles.
Dealers are to service all vehicles subject to this recall at no charge to customers, regardless of
mileage, age of vehicle, or ownership, from this time forward.
Customers who have recently purchased vehicles sold from your vehicle inventory, and for which
there is no customer information indicated on the dealer listing, are to be contacted by the dealer.
Arrangements are to be made to make the required correction according to the instructions
contained in this bulletin. A copy of the customer letter is shown in this bulletin for your use in
contacting customers. Recall follow-up cards should not be used for this purpose, since the
customer may not as yet have received the notification letter.
In summary, whenever a vehicle subject to this recall enters your vehicle inventory, or is in your
dealership for service in the future, please take the steps necessary to be sure the recall correction
has been made before selling or releasing the vehicle.
GENERAL MOTORS PRODUCT RECALL CUSTOMER REIMBURSEMENT PROCEDURE
If you have paid to have this recall condition corrected prior to receiving this notification, you may
be eligible to receive reimbursement.
Requests for reimbursement may include parts, labor, fees and taxes. Reimbursement may be
limited to the amount the repair would have cost if completed by an authorized General Motors
dealer.
Your claim will be acted upon within 60 days of receipt.
If your claim is:
^ Approved, you will receive a check from General Motors.
^ Denied, you will receive a letter from General Motors with the reason(s) for the denial, or
^ Incomplete, you will receive a letter from General Motors identifying the documentation that is
needed to complete the claim and offered the opportunity to resubmit the claim when the missing
documentation is available.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 548
Please follow the instructions on the Claim Form shown to file a claim for reimbursement. If you
have questions about this reimbursement procedure, please call the toll-free telephone number
provided on the form. If you need assistance with any other concern, please contact the
appropriate Customer Assistance Center at the number also shown. The Customer Assistance
Center hours of operation are from 8:00 AM - 11:00 PM eastern standard time Monday through
Friday.
Disclaimer
Service Procedure
The following procedure describes how to inspect and replace the hazard warning flasher switch,
OR inspect and replace the multifunction (turn signal, headlamp dimmer, and windshield
wiper/washer) switch assembly. The part that you replace will be determined during the inspection
portion of this procedure. Do NOT replace any parts until after performing the inspection procedure.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 549
Inspection Procedure
1. From inside the vehicle, depress the hazard warning flasher switch located on the top of the
steering column.
2. Depress the hazard warning flasher switch again.
^ If the hazard warning flasher switch did not stick in either the up or down position, proceed to the
section titled "Replacing the Hazard Warning Flasher Switch." Do not order any replacement parts
until instructed to in the additional inspection procedure included in that section.
^ If the hazard warning flasher switch is sticking in either the up or down position, replace the
multifunction switch. Proceed to the section titled "Replacing the Multifunction Switch."
Replacing the Hazard Warning Flasher Switch
This procedure describes how to replace ONLY the hazard warning flasher switch assembly. The
procedure includes information on how to remove the original switch, where to apply the lubricant
on the new switch, and how to install the new switch.
DO NOT use this procedure if the inspection above indicates that the multifunction switch requires
replacement. Contained in this procedure are unique steps to address features or options such as
cruise control, standard or tilt column, and a column mounted automatic transmission lever.
Tools Required
^ J 1859-A Steering Wheel Puller
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
2. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
3. Remove the SIR fuse from the fuse block.
4. Remove the screws attaching the driver's side knee bolster trim panel underneath the I/P and
reposition the panel out of the way.
5. Locate the driver's side yellow 2-way air bag electrical connector at the base of the steering
column and remove the connector position assurance (CPA) from the connector.
6. Disconnect the yellow 2-way electrical connector.
7. If equipped, remove the tilt steering column lever.
Important:
Some of the illustrations included in this procedure show the steering column removed from the
vehicle. Those illustrations are for reference purposes only. DO NOT remove the steering column
from the vehicle to perform this repair procedure.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the RUN position to unlock the steering wheel.
9. Turn the steering wheel 90 degrees so that the side of the SIR module is at the 12 o'clock
position in order to gain access to the holes behind the
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 550
steering wheel.
10. Insert a flat-bladed tool into the access hole and push the leaf spring in order to release the
notched pin that retains the inflator module.
11. Turn the steering wheel 180 degrees in order to gain access to the remaining access hole.
12. Insert a screwdriver into the remaining hole and push the leaf spring in order to release the
notched pin that retains the inflator module.
13. Tilt the top of the inflator module rearward to gain access to the SIR wiring.
14. Disconnect the SIR lead wire from the clip on the inflator module.
15. Disconnect the SIR lead wire from the clip on the steering wheel.
16. Disconnect the CPA retainer.
17. Disconnect the electrical connector.
Caution:
When you are carrying an undeployed inflator module:
^ Do not carry the inflator module by the wires or connector on the inflator module.
^ Make sure the bag opening points away from you.
^ When you are storing an undeployed inflator module, make sure the bag opening points away
from the surface on which the inflator module rests. Provide free space for the air bag to expand in
case of an accidental deployment. Otherwise, personal injury may result.
18. Set the SIR module aside.
19. Remove the horn plunger from the steering column by pressing inward to the stop and rotate
the horn plunger 90 degrees.
20. Remove the steering wheel retaining nut.
21. Install the J 1859-A, Steering Wheel Puller, to the steering wheel.
22. Remove the steering wheel using the J 1859-A.
23. Remove the J 1859-A from the steering wheel.
24. Remove the tilt lever.
25. Remove the screws attaching the lower steering column cover to the steering column.
26. Remove the lower steering column trim cover from the upper steering column trim cover.
26.1 Tilt the lower steering column trim cover down.
26.2 Slide the lower steering column trim cover backward in order to disengage the locking tabs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 551
27. Remove the upper steering column trim cover mounting screws (1).
28. Lift the upper steering column trim cover to gain access to the lock cylinder access hole.
29. Using a bent tip awl, insert the tip into the ignition lock cylinder access hole.
30. Turn the ignition lock cylinder to the START position.
31. Using the bent tip awl, push down on the ignition lock cylinder retaining pin.
32. Release the ignition lock cylinder to the RUN position.
33. Remove the ignition lock cylinder from the lock module by pulling the ignition lock cylinder away
from the steering column.
34. Remove the upper column cover.
Important:
The illustration above is for the purpose of identifying the barcode only. The actual location of the
barcode on the switch may differ.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 552
35. Inspect the part number (1) on the multifunction switch at the location shown in the illustration.
36. If the part number is 26084051, 26084052, 26096834, 26096835, 26102157 or 26102158, no
repair is required. Proceed to the section titled "Reassemble Vehicle."
^ If there is NO part number or barcode on the switch, no repair is required. Proceed to the section
titled "Reassemble Vehicle."
^ If the part number or barcode on the switch is 26091775 or 26091776, proceed to the next step
and replace the hazard warning flasher switch using part number 15177379.
Important:
Carefully review the above illustration to determine the exact location to insert the screwdriver in
the next step.
37. Insert a small, pocket-sized, flat bladed screwdriver (2) into the small space between the
hazard warning flasher switch housing (1) and the multifunction switch (3).
38. Carefully tilt the screwdriver handle towards the instrument cluster. This will cause the blade of
the screwdriver to pry open the space between the hazard warning flasher switch housing and the
multifunction switch.
39. While the space is pried open, pull the hazard warning flasher switch out of the multifunction
switch. Discard the hazard warning flasher switch.
Note:
Do not touch the three triangle-shaped electrical contacts (1) on the side of the switch when
removing the protective packaging, handling, or applying grease to the new hazard warning flasher
switch in the next steps.
40. Remove the rubber band and protective plastic wrapping from the new hazard warning flasher
switch.
Important:
The electrical contacts on the new hazard warning flasher switch require a special lubricant, which
is included in the kit. Only apply this special lubricant as instructed in the next step. DO NOT use
any other type of grease or lubricant.
41. Open the container of special grease included in the kit and apply it to the surfaces of the three
triangle-shaped electrical contacts (1) on the side of the new hazard warning flasher switch. When
properly applied, the surfaces of the three triangle-shaped electrical contacts must be completely
covered and there should be no grease left in the container. DO NOT put any grease in the
opening that contains the small metal return spring.
42. Insert the hazard warning flasher switch into the opening of the multifunction switch and press
down until it locks into place.
43. Remove any excess grease that may appear around the base of the hazard warning flasher
switch. Proceed to the next section "Reassemble Vehicle."
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 553
Reassemble Vehicle
1. Install the upper steering column cover.
2. Insert the ignition lock cylinder through the upper shroud.
3. Install the ignition lock cylinder to the lock module by doing the following:
3.1. Align the positioning slot and locking tab slot on the lock module assembly to the positioning
tab and locking tab on the ignition lock cylinder.
3.2. Push the ignition lock cylinder into the lock module assembly until the locking tab locks against
the lock module.
4. Install the upper steering column cover screws.
Tighten
Tighten the screws to 1.5 N.m (13 lb in).
Important:
The shift lever seal must be seated in the covers.
5. Install the lower steering column trim cover to the upper steering column trim cover.
5.1. Match the tab slots on the lower steering column trim cover with the locking tabs on the upper
steering column trim cover.
5.2. Tilt the lower steering column trim cover up.
5.3. Slide the lower steering column trim cover forward until the locking tabs snap into the tab slots.
6. Install the lower steering column cover screws.
Tighten
Tighten the screws to 3.5 N.m (31 lb in).
7. Install the tilt lever.
8. Install the steering wheel to the steering shaft.
9. Install the steering wheel retaining nut.
Tighten
Tighten the steering wheel retaining nut to 41 N.m (30 lb ft).
10. Install the horn plunger to the steering column.
11. Position the SIR module near the steering wheel.
12. Connect the SIR electrical connector.
13. Connect the CPA retainer to the SIR connector.
14. Connect the SIR lead wire to the clip on the steering wheel.
15. Connect the SIR lead wire to the clip on the inflator module.
Important:
Verify that the wiring is not exposed or trapped between the inflatable restraint steering wheel
module and the steering wheel.
16. Press the inflator module into the steering wheel firmly enough that the module engages and
latches the notched pins in the leaf springs.
17. Rotate the steering wheel back into the straight position.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 554
18. Connect the I/P module yellow 2-way connector located under the I/P extension.
19. Install the CPA to the I/P module yellow 2-way connector located under the I/P extension.
20. Connect the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector located at the base of the steering
column.
21. Install the CPA to the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector located at the base of the
steering column.
22. Position the knee bolster trim panel to the I/P and install the attaching screws.
Tighten
Tighten the screws to 1.9 N.m (17 lb in).
23. Install the SIR fuse and install the fuse block cover.
24. Be sure that the ignition is in the OFF position.
25. Connect the negative battery.
Replacing the Multifunction Switch
This procedure describes how to replace ONLY the multifunction switch assembly. The new
multifunction switch assembly will come complete with a new hazard warning flasher switch already
installed.
DO NOT use this procedure if the results of the inspection procedure indicate that only the hazard
warning flasher switch requires replacement.
Contained in this procedure are unique steps to address features or options such as cruise control,
standard or tilt column, and a column-mounted automatic transmission lever.
Tools Required
^ J 1859-A Steering Wheel Puller
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
2. Disconnect the negative battery.
3. Remove the SIR fuse from the fuse block.
4. Remove the screws attaching the driver's side knee bolster trim panel underneath the I/P and
reposition the panel out of the way.
5. Locate the driver's side yellow 2-way air bag electrical connector at the base of the steering
column and remove the connector position assurance (CPA) from the connector.
6. Disconnect the yellow 2-way electrical connector.
7. If equipped, remove the tilt steering column lever.
Important:
Some of the illustrations included in this procedure show the steering column removed from the
vehicle. Those illustrations are for reference
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 555
purposes only. DO NOT remove the steering column from the vehicle to perform this repair
procedure.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the RUN position to unlock the steering wheel.
9. Turn the steering wheel 90 degrees so that the side of the SIR module is at the 12 o'clock
position in order to gain access to the holes behind the steering wheel.
10. Insert a flat-bladed tool into the access hole and push the leaf spring in order to release the
notched pin that retains the inflator module.
11. Turn the steering wheel 180 degrees in order to gain access to the remaining access hole.
12. Insert a screwdriver into the remaining hole and push the leaf spring in order to release the
notched pin that retains the inflator module.
13. Tilt the top of the inflator module rearward to gain access to the SIR wiring.
14. Disconnect the SIR lead wire from the clip on the inflator module.
15. Disconnect the SIR lead wire from the clip on the steering wheel.
16. Disconnect the CPA retainer.
17. Disconnect the electrical connector.
Caution:
When you are carrying an undeployed inflator module:
^ Do not carry the inflator module by the wires or connector on the inflator module.
^ Make sure the bag opening points away from you.
^ When you are storing an undeployed inflator module, make sure the bag opening points away
from the surface on which the inflator module rests. Provide free space for the air bag to expand in
case of an accidental deployment. Otherwise, personal injury may result.
18. Set the SIR module aside.
19. Remove the horn plunger from the steering column by pressing inward to the stop and rotate
the horn plunger 90 degrees.
20. Remove the steering wheel retaining nut.
21. Install the J 1859-A, Steering Wheel Puller, to the steering wheel.
22. Remove the steering wheel using the J 1859-A.
23. Remove the J 1859-A from the steering wheel.
24. Remove the tilt lever.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 556
25. Remove the screws attaching the lower steering column cover to the steering column.
26. Remove the lower steering column trim cover from the upper steering column trim cover.
27. Tilt the lower steering column trim cover down.
27.1 Slide the lower steering column trim cover backward in order to disengage the locking tabs.
28. Remove the upper steering column trim cover mounting screws (1).
29. Lift the upper steering column trim cover to gain access to the lock cylinder access hole.
30. Using a bent tip awl, insert the tip into the ignition lock cylinder access hole.
31. Turn the ignition lock cylinder to the START position.
32. Using the bent tip awl, push down on the ignition lock cylinder retaining pin.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 557
33. Release the ignition lock cylinder to the RUN position.
34. Remove the ignition lock cylinder from the lock module by pulling the ignition lock cylinder away
from the steering column.
35. Remove the upper column cover.
36. Disconnect the steering column electrical connectors.
37. Disconnect the multifunction switch connectors from the steering column electrical connector.
38. Remove the steering column wiring harness from the wiring harness strap.
39. Remove the wire harness straps from the steering column wire harness.
40. Remove the multifunction switch mounting screws.
41. Remove the multifunction switch.
Important:
The multifunction switch electrical contact must rest on the canceling cam assembly.
42. Install the new multifunction switch as follows:
42.1 Use a small blade screwdriver in order to compress the electrical contact.
42.2 Move the multifunction switch into position.
43. Install the multifunction switch mounting screws.
Tighten
Tighten the multifunction switch mounting screws to 6 N.m (53 lb in).
44. Connect the multifunction switch electrical connectors to the steering column electrical
connector.
45. Connect the steering column electrical connector to the I/P wire harness.
46. Install the wire harness straps to the steering column wire harness.
47. Install the steering column wire harness to the wiring harness strap.
48. Install the upper steering column cover.
49. Insert the ignition lock cylinder through the upper shroud.
50. Install the ignition lock cylinder to the lock module by doing the following:
50.1 Align the positioning slot and locking tab slot on the lock module assembly to the positioning
tab and locking tab on the ignition lock
cylinder.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 558
50.2 Push the ignition lock cylinder into the lock module assembly until the locking tab locks
against the lock module.
51. Install the upper steering column cover screws.
Tighten
Tighten the screws to 1.5 N.m (13 lb in).
Important:
The shift lever seal must be seated in the covers.
52. Install the lower steering column trim cover to the upper steering column trim cover.
52.1 Match the tab slots on the lower steering column trim cover with the locking tabs on the upper
steering column trim cover.
52.3 Tilt the lower steering column trim cover up.
52.3 Slide the lower steering column trim cover forward until the locking tabs snap into the tab
slots.
53. Install the lower steering column cover screws.
Tighten
Tighten the screws to 3.5 N.m (31 lb in).
54. Install the tilt lever.
55. Install the steering wheel to the steering shaft.
56. Install the steering wheel retaining nut.
Tighten
Tighten the steering wheel retaining nut to 41 N.m (30 lb ft).
57. Install the horn plunger to the steering column.
58. Position the SIR module near the steering wheel.
59. Connect the SIR electrical connector.
60. Connect the CPA retainer to the SIR connector.
61. Connect the SIR lead wire to the clip on the steering wheel.
62. Connect the SIR lead wire to the clip on the inflator module.
Important:
Verify that the wiring in not exposed or trapped between the inflatable restraint steering wheel
module and the steering wheel.
63. Press the inflator module into the steering wheel firmly enough that the module engages and
latches the notched pins in the leaf springs.
64. Rotate the steering wheel back into the straight position.
65. Connect the I/P module yellow 2-way connector located under the I/P extension.
66. Install the CPA to the I/P module yellow 2-way connector located under the I/P extension.
67. Connect the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector located at the base of the steering
column.
68. Install the CPA to the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector located at the base of the
steering column.
69. Position the knee bolster trim panel to the I/P and install the attaching screws.
Tighten
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 559
Tighten the screws to 1.9 N.m (17 lb in).
70. Install the SIR fuse and install the fuse block cover.
71. Be sure that the ignition is in the OFF position.
72. Connect the negative battery cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 560
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > NHTSA05V099000
> Mar > 05 > Recall 05V099000: Brake/Hazard Lamp Failure
Hazard Warning Switch: Recalls Recall 05V099000: Brake/Hazard Lamp Failure
MAKE/MODELS: MODEL/BUILD YEARS: Chevrolet/Astro 2001-2002 GMC/Safari 2001-2002
MANUFACTURER: General Motors Corp. NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 05V099000 RECALL
DATE: March 09, 2005
COMPONENT: Exterior Lighting: Brake Lights: Switch
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 77055
SUMMARY: On certain minivans, the multifunction switch may develop an open circuit condition in
the stop lamp or hazard lamp circuit that results in the stop lamps and hazard lamps being
inoperative.
CONSEQUENCE: The loss of stop lamps and rear hazard lamps could fail to warn a following
driver that the vehicle is braking and/or is stopped and could lead to a vehicle crash.
REMEDY: Dealers will replace the hazard warning flasher switch and apply special grease to the
contacts at the time of installation of the module. The repair would be used in vehicles in which the
hazard slider button is still movable. If a vehicle has a hazard slider button that is not movable
(frozen), the entire multifunction switch will be replaced. The manufacturer has not yet provided an
owner notification schedule. Owners should contact Chevrolet at 1-800-630-2438 or GMC at
1-866-996-9463.
NOTES: GM recall No. 05013. Customers can also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Auto Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch:
> 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement
Technical Service Bulletin # 05013A Date: 050526
Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement
Bulletin No.: 05013A
Date: May 26, 2005
SAFETY
Subject: 05013A - Multifunction Switch Contacts
Models: 2001-2002 Chevrolet Astro 2001-2002 GMC Safari
Supercede:
THE INSPECTION IN STEP 35 OF THE PROCEDURE "REPLACING THE HAZARD WARNING
FLASHER SWITCH" HAS BEEN REVISED AND PART NUMBER 15174447 HAS BEEN
ELIMINATED. PLEASE REVIEW THIS NEW INFORMATION IMMEDIATELY. DISCARD ALL
COPIES OF BULLETIN 05013 ISSUED APRIL 2005.
Condition
General Motors has decided that a defect, which relates to motor vehicle safety, exists in certain
2001-2002 Chevrolet Astro and GMC Safari vehicles. On some of these vehicles, the stop lamps
and rear hazard lamps may become inoperative. The usage factors that increase the possibility of
this condition occurring include frequency and length of brake applications, frequency of trailer
towing with brake applications, and exposure to high ambient temperatures. The center high
mounted stop lamp and turn signal lamp functionality are not affected. The loss of stop lamps
and/or rear hazard lamps could fail to warn a following driver that the vehicle is braking and/or is
stopped and could lead to a vehicle accident.
Correction
Dealers are to inspect and replace the hazard warning flasher switch, if necessary. In a small
number of vehicles, the multifunction switch will require replacement.
Vehicles Involved
Involved are certain 2001-2002 Chevrolet Astro and GMC Safari vehicles built within the VIN
breakpoints shown.
Important:
Dealers should confirm vehicle eligibility through GMVIS (GM Vehicle Inquiry System) before
beginning recall repairs. [Not all vehicles within the above breakpoints may be involved.]
For US & Canada
For dealers with involved vehicles, a Campaign Initiation Detail Report containing the complete
Vehicle Identification Number, customer name and address data has been prepared and will be
loaded to the GM DealerWorld (U.S.), GMinfoNet (Canada) Recall Information website. Dealers
that have no involved vehicles currently assigned will not have a report available in GM
DealerWorld/GMinfoNet.
For Export
For dealers with involved vehicles, a Campaign Initiation Detail Report containing the complete
Vehicle Identification Number, customer name and address data has been prepared, and is being
furnished to involved dealers. Dealers that have no involved vehicles currently assigned will not
receive a report with the recall bulletin.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch:
> 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 570
The Campaign Initiation Detail Report may contain customer names and addresses obtained from
Motor Vehicle Registration Records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any
purpose other than follow-up necessary to complete this recall is a violation of law in several
states/provinces/countries. Accordingly, you are urged to limit the use of this report to the follow-up
necessary to complete this recall.
Parts Information
Parts required to complete this recall are to be obtained from General Motors Service Parts
Operations (GMSPO). Please refer to your "involved vehicles listing" before ordering parts. Normal
orders should be placed on a DRO=Daily Replenishment Order. In an emergency situation, parts
should be ordered on a CSO = Customer Special Order.
Customer Reimbursement - For US
All customer requests for reimbursement for previous repairs for the recall condition will be handled
by the Customer Assistance Center, not by dealers.
A General Motors Product Recall Customer Reimbursement Procedure Form is shown in this
bulletin.
Important:
Refer to the GM Service Policies and Procedures Manual, section 6.1.12, for specific procedures
regarding customer reimbursement and the form.
Customer Reimbursement - For Canada & Export
Customer requests for reimbursement of previously paid repairs to correct the condition addressed
in this bulletin are to be submitted by April 30, 2006.
All reasonable customer paid receipts should be considered for reimbursement. The amount to be
reimbursed will be limited to the amount the repair would have cost if completed by an authorized
General Motors dealer.
When a customer requests reimbursement, they must provide the following:
^ Proof of ownership at time of repair.
^ Original paid receipt confirming the amount of repair expense(s) that were not reimbursed, a
description of the repair, and the person or entity performing the repair.
Claims for customer reimbursement on previously paid repairs are to be submitted as required by
WINS.
Important:
Refer to the GM Service Policies and Procedures Manual, section 1.6.2, for specific procedures
regarding customer reimbursement verification.
Courtesy Transportation
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch:
> 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 571
The General Motors Courtesy Transportation Program is intended to minimize customer
inconvenience when a vehicle requires a repair that is covered by the New Vehicle Limited
Warranty. The availability of courtesy transportation to customers whose vehicles are within the
warranty coverage period and involved in a product recall is very important in maintaining customer
satisfaction. Dealers are to ensure that these customers understand that shuttle service or some
other form of courtesy transportation is available and will be provided at no charge. Dealers should
refer to the General Motors Service Policies and Procedures Manual for courtesy transportation
guidelines.
Claim Information
Submit a Product Recall Claim with the information shown.
Refer to the General Motors WINS Claims Processing Manual for details on Product Recall Claim
Submission.
Customer Notification - For US and Canada
General Motors will notify customers of this recall on their vehicle (see copy of customer letter
shown in this bulletin).
Customer Notification - For Export
Letters will be sent to known owners of record located within areas covered by the US National
Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act. For owners outside these areas, dealers should notify
customers using the sample letter.
Dealer Recall Responsibility - For US and Export (US States, Territories, and Possessions)
The US National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act provides that each vehicle which is subject to
a recall of this type must be adequately repaired within a reasonable time after the customer has
tendered it for repair. A failure to repair within sixty days after tender of a vehicle is prima facie
evidence
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch:
> 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 572
of failure to repair within a reasonable time. If the condition is not adequately repaired within a
reasonable time, the customer may be entitled to an identical or reasonably equivalent vehicle at
no charge or to a refund of the purchase price less a reasonable allowance for depreciation. To
avoid having to provide these burdensome remedies, every effort must be made to promptly
schedule an appointment with each customer and to repair their vehicle as soon as possible. In the
recall notification letters, customers are told how to contact the US National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration if the recall is not completed within a reasonable time.
Dealer Recall Responsibility - All
All unsold new vehicles in dealers, possession and subject to this recall MUST be held and
inspected/repaired per the service procedure of this recall bulletin BEFORE customers take
possession of these vehicles.
Dealers are to service all vehicles subject to this recall at no charge to customers, regardless of
mileage, age of vehicle, or ownership, from this time forward.
Customers who have recently purchased vehicles sold from your vehicle inventory, and for which
there is no customer information indicated on the dealer listing, are to be contacted by the dealer.
Arrangements are to be made to make the required correction according to the instructions
contained in this bulletin. A copy of the customer letter is shown in this bulletin for your use in
contacting customers. Recall follow-up cards should not be used for this purpose, since the
customer may not as yet have received the notification letter.
In summary, whenever a vehicle subject to this recall enters your vehicle inventory, or is in your
dealership for service in the future, please take the steps necessary to be sure the recall correction
has been made before selling or releasing the vehicle.
GENERAL MOTORS PRODUCT RECALL CUSTOMER REIMBURSEMENT PROCEDURE
If you have paid to have this recall condition corrected prior to receiving this notification, you may
be eligible to receive reimbursement.
Requests for reimbursement may include parts, labor, fees and taxes. Reimbursement may be
limited to the amount the repair would have cost if completed by an authorized General Motors
dealer.
Your claim will be acted upon within 60 days of receipt.
If your claim is:
^ Approved, you will receive a check from General Motors.
^ Denied, you will receive a letter from General Motors with the reason(s) for the denial, or
^ Incomplete, you will receive a letter from General Motors identifying the documentation that is
needed to complete the claim and offered the opportunity to resubmit the claim when the missing
documentation is available.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch:
> 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 573
Please follow the instructions on the Claim Form shown to file a claim for reimbursement. If you
have questions about this reimbursement procedure, please call the toll-free telephone number
provided on the form. If you need assistance with any other concern, please contact the
appropriate Customer Assistance Center at the number also shown. The Customer Assistance
Center hours of operation are from 8:00 AM - 11:00 PM eastern standard time Monday through
Friday.
Disclaimer
Service Procedure
The following procedure describes how to inspect and replace the hazard warning flasher switch,
OR inspect and replace the multifunction (turn signal, headlamp dimmer, and windshield
wiper/washer) switch assembly. The part that you replace will be determined during the inspection
portion of this procedure. Do NOT replace any parts until after performing the inspection procedure.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch:
> 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 574
Inspection Procedure
1. From inside the vehicle, depress the hazard warning flasher switch located on the top of the
steering column.
2. Depress the hazard warning flasher switch again.
^ If the hazard warning flasher switch did not stick in either the up or down position, proceed to the
section titled "Replacing the Hazard Warning Flasher Switch." Do not order any replacement parts
until instructed to in the additional inspection procedure included in that section.
^ If the hazard warning flasher switch is sticking in either the up or down position, replace the
multifunction switch. Proceed to the section titled "Replacing the Multifunction Switch."
Replacing the Hazard Warning Flasher Switch
This procedure describes how to replace ONLY the hazard warning flasher switch assembly. The
procedure includes information on how to remove the original switch, where to apply the lubricant
on the new switch, and how to install the new switch.
DO NOT use this procedure if the inspection above indicates that the multifunction switch requires
replacement. Contained in this procedure are unique steps to address features or options such as
cruise control, standard or tilt column, and a column mounted automatic transmission lever.
Tools Required
^ J 1859-A Steering Wheel Puller
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
2. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
3. Remove the SIR fuse from the fuse block.
4. Remove the screws attaching the driver's side knee bolster trim panel underneath the I/P and
reposition the panel out of the way.
5. Locate the driver's side yellow 2-way air bag electrical connector at the base of the steering
column and remove the connector position assurance (CPA) from the connector.
6. Disconnect the yellow 2-way electrical connector.
7. If equipped, remove the tilt steering column lever.
Important:
Some of the illustrations included in this procedure show the steering column removed from the
vehicle. Those illustrations are for reference purposes only. DO NOT remove the steering column
from the vehicle to perform this repair procedure.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the RUN position to unlock the steering wheel.
9. Turn the steering wheel 90 degrees so that the side of the SIR module is at the 12 o'clock
position in order to gain access to the holes behind the
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch:
> 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 575
steering wheel.
10. Insert a flat-bladed tool into the access hole and push the leaf spring in order to release the
notched pin that retains the inflator module.
11. Turn the steering wheel 180 degrees in order to gain access to the remaining access hole.
12. Insert a screwdriver into the remaining hole and push the leaf spring in order to release the
notched pin that retains the inflator module.
13. Tilt the top of the inflator module rearward to gain access to the SIR wiring.
14. Disconnect the SIR lead wire from the clip on the inflator module.
15. Disconnect the SIR lead wire from the clip on the steering wheel.
16. Disconnect the CPA retainer.
17. Disconnect the electrical connector.
Caution:
When you are carrying an undeployed inflator module:
^ Do not carry the inflator module by the wires or connector on the inflator module.
^ Make sure the bag opening points away from you.
^ When you are storing an undeployed inflator module, make sure the bag opening points away
from the surface on which the inflator module rests. Provide free space for the air bag to expand in
case of an accidental deployment. Otherwise, personal injury may result.
18. Set the SIR module aside.
19. Remove the horn plunger from the steering column by pressing inward to the stop and rotate
the horn plunger 90 degrees.
20. Remove the steering wheel retaining nut.
21. Install the J 1859-A, Steering Wheel Puller, to the steering wheel.
22. Remove the steering wheel using the J 1859-A.
23. Remove the J 1859-A from the steering wheel.
24. Remove the tilt lever.
25. Remove the screws attaching the lower steering column cover to the steering column.
26. Remove the lower steering column trim cover from the upper steering column trim cover.
26.1 Tilt the lower steering column trim cover down.
26.2 Slide the lower steering column trim cover backward in order to disengage the locking tabs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch:
> 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 576
27. Remove the upper steering column trim cover mounting screws (1).
28. Lift the upper steering column trim cover to gain access to the lock cylinder access hole.
29. Using a bent tip awl, insert the tip into the ignition lock cylinder access hole.
30. Turn the ignition lock cylinder to the START position.
31. Using the bent tip awl, push down on the ignition lock cylinder retaining pin.
32. Release the ignition lock cylinder to the RUN position.
33. Remove the ignition lock cylinder from the lock module by pulling the ignition lock cylinder away
from the steering column.
34. Remove the upper column cover.
Important:
The illustration above is for the purpose of identifying the barcode only. The actual location of the
barcode on the switch may differ.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch:
> 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 577
35. Inspect the part number (1) on the multifunction switch at the location shown in the illustration.
36. If the part number is 26084051, 26084052, 26096834, 26096835, 26102157 or 26102158, no
repair is required. Proceed to the section titled "Reassemble Vehicle."
^ If there is NO part number or barcode on the switch, no repair is required. Proceed to the section
titled "Reassemble Vehicle."
^ If the part number or barcode on the switch is 26091775 or 26091776, proceed to the next step
and replace the hazard warning flasher switch using part number 15177379.
Important:
Carefully review the above illustration to determine the exact location to insert the screwdriver in
the next step.
37. Insert a small, pocket-sized, flat bladed screwdriver (2) into the small space between the
hazard warning flasher switch housing (1) and the multifunction switch (3).
38. Carefully tilt the screwdriver handle towards the instrument cluster. This will cause the blade of
the screwdriver to pry open the space between the hazard warning flasher switch housing and the
multifunction switch.
39. While the space is pried open, pull the hazard warning flasher switch out of the multifunction
switch. Discard the hazard warning flasher switch.
Note:
Do not touch the three triangle-shaped electrical contacts (1) on the side of the switch when
removing the protective packaging, handling, or applying grease to the new hazard warning flasher
switch in the next steps.
40. Remove the rubber band and protective plastic wrapping from the new hazard warning flasher
switch.
Important:
The electrical contacts on the new hazard warning flasher switch require a special lubricant, which
is included in the kit. Only apply this special lubricant as instructed in the next step. DO NOT use
any other type of grease or lubricant.
41. Open the container of special grease included in the kit and apply it to the surfaces of the three
triangle-shaped electrical contacts (1) on the side of the new hazard warning flasher switch. When
properly applied, the surfaces of the three triangle-shaped electrical contacts must be completely
covered and there should be no grease left in the container. DO NOT put any grease in the
opening that contains the small metal return spring.
42. Insert the hazard warning flasher switch into the opening of the multifunction switch and press
down until it locks into place.
43. Remove any excess grease that may appear around the base of the hazard warning flasher
switch. Proceed to the next section "Reassemble Vehicle."
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch:
> 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 578
Reassemble Vehicle
1. Install the upper steering column cover.
2. Insert the ignition lock cylinder through the upper shroud.
3. Install the ignition lock cylinder to the lock module by doing the following:
3.1. Align the positioning slot and locking tab slot on the lock module assembly to the positioning
tab and locking tab on the ignition lock cylinder.
3.2. Push the ignition lock cylinder into the lock module assembly until the locking tab locks against
the lock module.
4. Install the upper steering column cover screws.
Tighten
Tighten the screws to 1.5 N.m (13 lb in).
Important:
The shift lever seal must be seated in the covers.
5. Install the lower steering column trim cover to the upper steering column trim cover.
5.1. Match the tab slots on the lower steering column trim cover with the locking tabs on the upper
steering column trim cover.
5.2. Tilt the lower steering column trim cover up.
5.3. Slide the lower steering column trim cover forward until the locking tabs snap into the tab slots.
6. Install the lower steering column cover screws.
Tighten
Tighten the screws to 3.5 N.m (31 lb in).
7. Install the tilt lever.
8. Install the steering wheel to the steering shaft.
9. Install the steering wheel retaining nut.
Tighten
Tighten the steering wheel retaining nut to 41 N.m (30 lb ft).
10. Install the horn plunger to the steering column.
11. Position the SIR module near the steering wheel.
12. Connect the SIR electrical connector.
13. Connect the CPA retainer to the SIR connector.
14. Connect the SIR lead wire to the clip on the steering wheel.
15. Connect the SIR lead wire to the clip on the inflator module.
Important:
Verify that the wiring is not exposed or trapped between the inflatable restraint steering wheel
module and the steering wheel.
16. Press the inflator module into the steering wheel firmly enough that the module engages and
latches the notched pins in the leaf springs.
17. Rotate the steering wheel back into the straight position.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch:
> 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 579
18. Connect the I/P module yellow 2-way connector located under the I/P extension.
19. Install the CPA to the I/P module yellow 2-way connector located under the I/P extension.
20. Connect the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector located at the base of the steering
column.
21. Install the CPA to the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector located at the base of the
steering column.
22. Position the knee bolster trim panel to the I/P and install the attaching screws.
Tighten
Tighten the screws to 1.9 N.m (17 lb in).
23. Install the SIR fuse and install the fuse block cover.
24. Be sure that the ignition is in the OFF position.
25. Connect the negative battery.
Replacing the Multifunction Switch
This procedure describes how to replace ONLY the multifunction switch assembly. The new
multifunction switch assembly will come complete with a new hazard warning flasher switch already
installed.
DO NOT use this procedure if the results of the inspection procedure indicate that only the hazard
warning flasher switch requires replacement.
Contained in this procedure are unique steps to address features or options such as cruise control,
standard or tilt column, and a column-mounted automatic transmission lever.
Tools Required
^ J 1859-A Steering Wheel Puller
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
2. Disconnect the negative battery.
3. Remove the SIR fuse from the fuse block.
4. Remove the screws attaching the driver's side knee bolster trim panel underneath the I/P and
reposition the panel out of the way.
5. Locate the driver's side yellow 2-way air bag electrical connector at the base of the steering
column and remove the connector position assurance (CPA) from the connector.
6. Disconnect the yellow 2-way electrical connector.
7. If equipped, remove the tilt steering column lever.
Important:
Some of the illustrations included in this procedure show the steering column removed from the
vehicle. Those illustrations are for reference
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch:
> 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 580
purposes only. DO NOT remove the steering column from the vehicle to perform this repair
procedure.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the RUN position to unlock the steering wheel.
9. Turn the steering wheel 90 degrees so that the side of the SIR module is at the 12 o'clock
position in order to gain access to the holes behind the steering wheel.
10. Insert a flat-bladed tool into the access hole and push the leaf spring in order to release the
notched pin that retains the inflator module.
11. Turn the steering wheel 180 degrees in order to gain access to the remaining access hole.
12. Insert a screwdriver into the remaining hole and push the leaf spring in order to release the
notched pin that retains the inflator module.
13. Tilt the top of the inflator module rearward to gain access to the SIR wiring.
14. Disconnect the SIR lead wire from the clip on the inflator module.
15. Disconnect the SIR lead wire from the clip on the steering wheel.
16. Disconnect the CPA retainer.
17. Disconnect the electrical connector.
Caution:
When you are carrying an undeployed inflator module:
^ Do not carry the inflator module by the wires or connector on the inflator module.
^ Make sure the bag opening points away from you.
^ When you are storing an undeployed inflator module, make sure the bag opening points away
from the surface on which the inflator module rests. Provide free space for the air bag to expand in
case of an accidental deployment. Otherwise, personal injury may result.
18. Set the SIR module aside.
19. Remove the horn plunger from the steering column by pressing inward to the stop and rotate
the horn plunger 90 degrees.
20. Remove the steering wheel retaining nut.
21. Install the J 1859-A, Steering Wheel Puller, to the steering wheel.
22. Remove the steering wheel using the J 1859-A.
23. Remove the J 1859-A from the steering wheel.
24. Remove the tilt lever.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch:
> 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 581
25. Remove the screws attaching the lower steering column cover to the steering column.
26. Remove the lower steering column trim cover from the upper steering column trim cover.
27. Tilt the lower steering column trim cover down.
27.1 Slide the lower steering column trim cover backward in order to disengage the locking tabs.
28. Remove the upper steering column trim cover mounting screws (1).
29. Lift the upper steering column trim cover to gain access to the lock cylinder access hole.
30. Using a bent tip awl, insert the tip into the ignition lock cylinder access hole.
31. Turn the ignition lock cylinder to the START position.
32. Using the bent tip awl, push down on the ignition lock cylinder retaining pin.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch:
> 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 582
33. Release the ignition lock cylinder to the RUN position.
34. Remove the ignition lock cylinder from the lock module by pulling the ignition lock cylinder away
from the steering column.
35. Remove the upper column cover.
36. Disconnect the steering column electrical connectors.
37. Disconnect the multifunction switch connectors from the steering column electrical connector.
38. Remove the steering column wiring harness from the wiring harness strap.
39. Remove the wire harness straps from the steering column wire harness.
40. Remove the multifunction switch mounting screws.
41. Remove the multifunction switch.
Important:
The multifunction switch electrical contact must rest on the canceling cam assembly.
42. Install the new multifunction switch as follows:
42.1 Use a small blade screwdriver in order to compress the electrical contact.
42.2 Move the multifunction switch into position.
43. Install the multifunction switch mounting screws.
Tighten
Tighten the multifunction switch mounting screws to 6 N.m (53 lb in).
44. Connect the multifunction switch electrical connectors to the steering column electrical
connector.
45. Connect the steering column electrical connector to the I/P wire harness.
46. Install the wire harness straps to the steering column wire harness.
47. Install the steering column wire harness to the wiring harness strap.
48. Install the upper steering column cover.
49. Insert the ignition lock cylinder through the upper shroud.
50. Install the ignition lock cylinder to the lock module by doing the following:
50.1 Align the positioning slot and locking tab slot on the lock module assembly to the positioning
tab and locking tab on the ignition lock
cylinder.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch:
> 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 583
50.2 Push the ignition lock cylinder into the lock module assembly until the locking tab locks
against the lock module.
51. Install the upper steering column cover screws.
Tighten
Tighten the screws to 1.5 N.m (13 lb in).
Important:
The shift lever seal must be seated in the covers.
52. Install the lower steering column trim cover to the upper steering column trim cover.
52.1 Match the tab slots on the lower steering column trim cover with the locking tabs on the upper
steering column trim cover.
52.3 Tilt the lower steering column trim cover up.
52.3 Slide the lower steering column trim cover forward until the locking tabs snap into the tab
slots.
53. Install the lower steering column cover screws.
Tighten
Tighten the screws to 3.5 N.m (31 lb in).
54. Install the tilt lever.
55. Install the steering wheel to the steering shaft.
56. Install the steering wheel retaining nut.
Tighten
Tighten the steering wheel retaining nut to 41 N.m (30 lb ft).
57. Install the horn plunger to the steering column.
58. Position the SIR module near the steering wheel.
59. Connect the SIR electrical connector.
60. Connect the CPA retainer to the SIR connector.
61. Connect the SIR lead wire to the clip on the steering wheel.
62. Connect the SIR lead wire to the clip on the inflator module.
Important:
Verify that the wiring in not exposed or trapped between the inflatable restraint steering wheel
module and the steering wheel.
63. Press the inflator module into the steering wheel firmly enough that the module engages and
latches the notched pins in the leaf springs.
64. Rotate the steering wheel back into the straight position.
65. Connect the I/P module yellow 2-way connector located under the I/P extension.
66. Install the CPA to the I/P module yellow 2-way connector located under the I/P extension.
67. Connect the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector located at the base of the steering
column.
68. Install the CPA to the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector located at the base of the
steering column.
69. Position the knee bolster trim panel to the I/P and install the attaching screws.
Tighten
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch:
> 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 584
Tighten the screws to 1.9 N.m (17 lb in).
70. Install the SIR fuse and install the fuse block cover.
71. Be sure that the ignition is in the OFF position.
72. Connect the negative battery cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch:
> 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 585
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch:
> NHTSA05V099000 > Mar > 05 > Recall 05V099000: Brake/Hazard Lamp Failure
Hazard Warning Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 05V099000: Brake/Hazard Lamp
Failure
MAKE/MODELS: MODEL/BUILD YEARS: Chevrolet/Astro 2001-2002 GMC/Safari 2001-2002
MANUFACTURER: General Motors Corp. NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 05V099000 RECALL
DATE: March 09, 2005
COMPONENT: Exterior Lighting: Brake Lights: Switch
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 77055
SUMMARY: On certain minivans, the multifunction switch may develop an open circuit condition in
the stop lamp or hazard lamp circuit that results in the stop lamps and hazard lamps being
inoperative.
CONSEQUENCE: The loss of stop lamps and rear hazard lamps could fail to warn a following
driver that the vehicle is braking and/or is stopped and could lead to a vehicle crash.
REMEDY: Dealers will replace the hazard warning flasher switch and apply special grease to the
contacts at the time of installation of the module. The repair would be used in vehicles in which the
hazard slider button is still movable. If a vehicle has a hazard slider button that is not movable
(frozen), the entire multifunction switch will be replaced. The manufacturer has not yet provided an
owner notification schedule. Owners should contact Chevrolet at 1-800-630-2438 or GMC at
1-866-996-9463.
NOTES: GM recall No. 05013. Customers can also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Auto Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 593
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the instrument panel cluster trim plate. 3.
Remove the switch from the plate by using the following procedure:
3.1. Release the retaining tabs on the sides of the switch. 3.2. Pull the switch out of the plate. 3.3.
Disconnect the electrical connector(s) at the back of the headlamp switch.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Connect the electrical connector(s) to the back of the switch. 2. Install the headlamp switch to
the plate by snapping the switch into place. 3. Install the instrument panel cluster trim plate. 4.
Connect the battery negative cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 604
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 605
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 606
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 607
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 608
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 609
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 610
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 611
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 612
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 613
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 614
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 615
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 616
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 617
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 618
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 619
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 620
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 621
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 622
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 623
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 624
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 625
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 626
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 627
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 628
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 629
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 630
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 631
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 632
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 633
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 634
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 635
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 636
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 637
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Disconnect the MAF sensor harness connector.
3. Release the air cleaner cover retainer clips.
NOTE: ^
Handle the MAF sensor carefully.
^ Do not drop the MAF sensor in order to prevent damage to the MAF sensor.
^ Do not damage the screen located on the air inlet end of the MAF.
^ Do not touch the sensing elements.
^ Do not allow solvents and lubricants to come in contact with the sensing elements.
^ Use a small amount of a soap based solution in order to aid in the installation.
4. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct from the MAF sensor by loosening the hose clamp.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 638
5. Disconnect the air cleaner cover from the front of the MAF sensor by loosening the hose clamp.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Point the flow arrows on the MAF sensor away from the air cleaner.
1. Attach the MAF sensor to the air cleaner cover by tightening the hose clamp.
Tighten Tighten the clamp to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
2. Attach the air cleaner outlet duct to the MAF sensor by tightening the hose clamp.
Tighten Tighten the clamp to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 639
3. Install the air cleaner cover by fastening the air cleaner cover retainer clips.
4. Connect the MAF sensor harness connector.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 645
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 646
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 647
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 648
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 649
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 650
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 651
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 652
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 653
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 654
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 655
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 656
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 657
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 658
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 659
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 660
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 661
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 662
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 663
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 664
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 665
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 666
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 667
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 668
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 669
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 670
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 671
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 672
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 673
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 674
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 675
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 676
Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 677
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
The CMP sensor is a hall-effect sensor located in the ignition distributor base, and uses the same
type of circuits as the CKP sensor. The CMP sensor signal is a digital ON/OFF pulse, output once
per revolution of the camshaft. The CMP sensor information is used by the PCM to determine the
position of the valve train relative to the CKP.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 678
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 679
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Disconnect the spark plug wires and ignition coil wire from the
distributor.
3. Disconnect the camshaft position (CMP) sensor harness connector from the distributor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 680
4. Remove the distributor cap screws.
5. Remove the distributor cap.
6. Remove the rotor screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 681
7. Remove the rotor.
8. Align the square slot in the reluctor wheel with the CMP sensor.
9. Remove the CMP screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 682
10. Remove the CMP sensor.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: Do not use the old cap, CMP sensor, and rotor screws. Use the replacement screws
that have been coated with a thread locking compound.
1. Insert the CMP sensor through the reluctor wheel slot.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install new CMP mounting screws.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 2.2 N.m (19 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 683
3. Install the rotor onto the reluctor wheel.
4. Install new rotor screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 684
5. Install the distributor cap.
6. Install new distributor cap screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2.4 N.m (21 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 685
7. Connect the CMP sensor harness connector.
8. Connect the spark plug wires and ignition coil wire. 9. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 15 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 689
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 690
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 691
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 692
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Drain the cooling system. 2. Remove the engine cover.
3. Remove the coolant temperature sensor electrical connector from the electrical harness at the
intake manifold. 4. Remove the coolant temperature sensor electrical connector from the intake
manifold bracket. 5. Remove the coolant temperature sensor from the cylinder head.
Installation Procedure
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the coolant temperature sensor to the cylinder head.
Tighten the sensor to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
2. Snap the coolant temperature sensor electrical connector to the intake manifold bracket. 3.
Connect the coolant temperature sensor electrical connector to the wiring harness at the intake
manifold. 4. Install the engine cover. 5. Fill the cooling system with coolant.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft Position Sensor: > 02-06-04-059 > Dec > 02 > Engine Controls - Engine Runs
Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Customer Interest Engine Controls - Engine Runs Rough/MIL
ON/DTC's Set
File In Section: 06 - Engine/Propulsion System
Bulletin No.: 02-06-04-059
Date: December, 2002
TECHNICAL
Subject: Engine Runs Rough, Service Engine Soon Light On, DTC's P0300 or P0335 Set (Shim
Crankshaft Sensor)
Models: 2002-03 Chevrolet Astro, Blazer, Express, Silverado and S-10 Truck Models 2002-03
GMC Jimmy, Safari, Savana, Sierra and Sonoma Truck Models with 4.3L V-6 Engine (VINs W, X RPOs L35, LU3)
Condition
Some owners may comment on a rough running condition or a Service Engine Soon (SES) light
being illuminated. Upon investigation, the technician may find a DTC code P0300 or P0335.
Cause
The crankshaft sensor may be contacting the reluctor wheel.
Correction
Remove the crankshaft sensor. Refer to the Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement procedure in
the Engine Controls-4.3L sub-section of the Service Manual. After removing the sensor, inspect the
end of it for witness marks that would indicate contact with the crankshaft. If contact with the
reluctor ring is indicated, then inspect the front cover for cracking or other signs of alignment
concerns. If the inspection indicates that the cover is causing mis-alignments, replace the cover. If
replacing the cover, then the 0.5 mm shim is not needed.
If the inspection of the front cover indicates that the cover is not the cause of mis-alignments, then
the sensor should be shimmed. Add one shim between the sensor and the front cover. If the
concern still exists, then add the second shim. Unless the sensor has been rubbed through the
casing or deformed by contact with the crankshaft, it should not be replaced.
In either case, the crankshaft relearn procedure should be performed after any repairs.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft Position Sensor: > 02-06-04-059 > Dec > 02 > Engine Controls - Engine Runs
Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set > Page 701
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Position Sensor: > 02-06-04-059 > Dec > 02 > Engine Controls Engine Runs Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set
Crankshaft Position Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Engine Runs
Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set
File In Section: 06 - Engine/Propulsion System
Bulletin No.: 02-06-04-059
Date: December, 2002
TECHNICAL
Subject: Engine Runs Rough, Service Engine Soon Light On, DTC's P0300 or P0335 Set (Shim
Crankshaft Sensor)
Models: 2002-03 Chevrolet Astro, Blazer, Express, Silverado and S-10 Truck Models 2002-03
GMC Jimmy, Safari, Savana, Sierra and Sonoma Truck Models with 4.3L V-6 Engine (VINs W, X RPOs L35, LU3)
Condition
Some owners may comment on a rough running condition or a Service Engine Soon (SES) light
being illuminated. Upon investigation, the technician may find a DTC code P0300 or P0335.
Cause
The crankshaft sensor may be contacting the reluctor wheel.
Correction
Remove the crankshaft sensor. Refer to the Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement procedure in
the Engine Controls-4.3L sub-section of the Service Manual. After removing the sensor, inspect the
end of it for witness marks that would indicate contact with the crankshaft. If contact with the
reluctor ring is indicated, then inspect the front cover for cracking or other signs of alignment
concerns. If the inspection indicates that the cover is causing mis-alignments, replace the cover. If
replacing the cover, then the 0.5 mm shim is not needed.
If the inspection of the front cover indicates that the cover is not the cause of mis-alignments, then
the sensor should be shimmed. Add one shim between the sensor and the front cover. If the
concern still exists, then add the second shim. Unless the sensor has been rubbed through the
casing or deformed by contact with the crankshaft, it should not be replaced.
In either case, the crankshaft relearn procedure should be performed after any repairs.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Position Sensor: > 02-06-04-059 > Dec > 02 > Engine Controls Engine Runs Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set > Page 707
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 708
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 711
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 712
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 713
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 714
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 715
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 716
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 717
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 718
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 719
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 720
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 721
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 722
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 723
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 724
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 725
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 726
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 727
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 728
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 729
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 730
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 731
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 732
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 733
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 734
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 735
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 736
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 737
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 738
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 739
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 740
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 741
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 742
Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
743
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
The CKP sensor is a three wire sensor based on the magneto resistive principle. A magneto
resistive sensor uses two magnetic pickups between a permanent magnet. As an element such as
a reluctor wheel passes the magnets the resulting change in the magnetic field is used by the
sensor electronics to produce a digital output pulse. The PCM supplies a 12-volt, low reference,
and signal circuit to the CKP sensor. The sensor returns a digital ON/OFF pulse 3 times per
crankshaft revolution for the V6 engine, 4 times for the V8 engine. The CKP sensor reads the
crankshaft mounted reluctor wheel to identify pairs of cylinders at top dead center (TDC).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
744
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
CKP System Variation Learn Procedure
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair CKP System Variation Learn Procedure
IMPORTANT: For additional diagnostic information, refer to DTC P1336.
1. Install a scan tool. 2. With a scan tool, monitor the powertrain control module (PCM) for
diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs). If other DTCs are set, except DTC P1336,
refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List for the applicable DTC that set.
3. With a scan tool, select the crankshaft position (CKP) variation learn procedure. 4. Observe the
fuel cut-OFF for the engine that you are performing the learn procedure on. 5. The scan tool
instructs you to perform the following:
^ Block the drive wheels.
^ Apply the vehicles parking brake.
^ Cycle the ignition from OFF to ON.
^ Apply and hold the brake pedal.
^ Start and idle the engine.
^ Turn OFF the A/C.
^ Place the vehicles transmission in Park (A/T) or Neutral (M/T).
^ The scan tool monitors certain component signals to determine if all the conditions are met to
continue with the procedure. The scan tool only displays the condition that inhibits the procedure.
The scan tool monitors the following components: CKP sensor activity - If there is a CKP sensor condition, refer to the applicable DTCs that set.
- Camshaft position (CMP) sensor activity - If there is a CMP sensor condition, refer to the
applicable DTCs that set.
- Engine coolant temperature (ECT) - If the ECT is not warm enough, idle the engine until the ECT
reaches the correct temperature.
6. With the scan tool, enable the CKP system variation learn procedure.
IMPORTANT: While the learn procedure is in progress, release the throttle immediately when the
engine starts to decelerate. The engine control is returned to the operator and the engine responds
to throttle position (TP) after the learn procedure is complete.
7. Slowly increase the engine speed to the RPM that you observed. 8. Immediately release the
throttle when fuel cut-OFF is reached. 9. The scan tool displays Learn Status: Learned this ignition.
If the scan tool does NOT display this message and no additional DTCs set, refer to
Symptoms - Engine. If a DTC set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List for the applicable
DTC that set.
10. Turn OFF the ignition for 30 seconds after the learn procedure is completed successfully.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
CKP System Variation Learn Procedure > Page 747
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: The CKP System Variation Learn Procedure will need to be performed whenever the
crankshaft position (CKP) sensor is removed or replaced. Refer to CKP System Variation Learn
Procedure.
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. If the vehicle is equipped with the
underbody shield package, then remove the steering linkage shield mounting bolts.
3. Remove the steering linkage shield.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
CKP System Variation Learn Procedure > Page 748
4. Disconnect the CKP sensor harness connector.
5. Remove the CKP sensor mounting bolt.
6. Remove the CKP sensor.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
CKP System Variation Learn Procedure > Page 749
IMPORTANT: ^
When installing the CKP sensor, make sure the sensor is fully seated before tightening the
mounting bolt. A poorly seated CKP sensor may perform erratically and may set false DTCs.
^ Do not reuse the original O-ring.
1. Replace the CKP sensor O-ring. 2. Lubricate the O-ring with clean engine oil before installing the
CKP sensor.
IMPORTANT: Make sure the CKP sensor mounting surface is clear and free of burrs.
3. Install the CKP sensor.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the CKP sensor mounting bolt.
Tighten Tighten the CKP sensor mounting bolt to 9 N.m (80 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
CKP System Variation Learn Procedure > Page 750
5. Connect the CKP sensor harness connector.
6. Install the steering linkage shield.
7. Install the steering linkage shield mounting bolts.
Tighten
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
CKP System Variation Learn Procedure > Page 751
Tighten the bolts to 33 N.m (24 lb ft).
8. Lower the Vehicle. 9. Perform the CKP System Variation Learn Procedure. See: Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor
The fuel level sensor consists of a float, a wire float arm, and a ceramic resistor card. The position
of the float arm indicates the fuel level. The fuel level sensor contains a variable resistor which
changes resistance in correspondence with the amount of fuel in the fuel tank. The Powertrain
Control Module ( PCM) sends the fuel level information via the class 2 circuit to the Instrument
Panel Cluster (IPC). This information is used for the IPC fuel gauge and the low fuel warning
indicator, if applicable. The PCM also monitors the fuel level input for various diagnostics.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 755
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the fuel sender assembly. 2. Disconnect the fuel pump electrical connector (5). 3.
Remove the fuel level sensor electrical connector retaining clip (6). 4. Disconnect the fuel level
sensor electrical connector (7) from under the fuel sender cover. 5. Remove the fuel level sensor
retaining clip (4). 6. Squeeze the locking tangs and remove the fuel level sensor (3).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the fuel level sensor (3). 2. Install the fuel level sensor retaining clip (4). 3. Connect the
fuel level sensor electrical connector (7). 4. Connect the fuel level sensor electrical connector
retaining clip (6). 5. Connect the fuel pump electrical connector (5). 6. Install the fuel sender
assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams
Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
759
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
The Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor measures the difference between the pressure or vacuum in
the fuel tank and outside air pressure. The control module provides a 5-volt reference and a ground
to the FTP sensor. The FTP sensor provides a signal voltage back to the control module that can
vary between 0.1 - 4.9 volts. As FTP increases, FTP sensor voltage decreases, high pressure =
low voltage. As FTP decreases, FTP voltage increases, low pressure or vacuum = high voltage.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
760
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
761
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the fuel tank. 2. Remove the fuel tank pressure sensor (1) from the modular fuel sender
(2).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the fuel tank pressure sensor (1) to the modular fuel sender (2). 2. Install the fuel tank.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
765
Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
766
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
767
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE (IAT) SENSOR REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect the intake air temperature (IAT) sensor
harness connector.
3. Remove the IAT sensor from the air cleaner outlet duct by pulling the sensor upward.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
768
1. Install the IAT sensor in the air cleaner outlet duct.
2. Connect the IAT sensor harness connector. 3. Connect the negative battery cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Knock Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 774
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 775
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 776
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 777
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 778
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 779
Knock Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 780
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 781
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 782
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 783
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 784
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 785
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 786
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 787
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 788
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 789
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 790
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 791
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 792
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 793
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 794
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 795
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 796
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 797
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 798
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 799
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 800
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 801
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 802
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 803
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 804
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 805
Knock Sensor (KS)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 806
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
The Knock Sensor (KS) system enables the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to control the
ignition timing advance for the best possible performance while protecting the engine from
potentially damaging levels of detonation. The sensors in the KS system are used by the PCM as
microphones to listen for abnormal engine noise that may indicate pre-ignition/detonation.
SENSOR DESCRIPTION
There are 2 types of KS currently being used: ^
The broadband single wire sensor
^ The flat response 2-wire sensor
Both sensors use piezo-electric crystal technology to produce and send signals to the PCM. The
amplitude and frequency of this signal will vary constantly depending on the vibration level within
the engine. Flat response and broadband KS signals are processed differently by the PCM. The
major differences are outlined below: ^
All broadband sensors use a single wire circuit. Some types of controllers will output a bias voltage
on the KS signal wire. The bias voltage creates a voltage drop the PCM monitors and uses to help
diagnose KS faults. The KS noise signal rides along this bias voltage, and due to the constantly
fluctuating frequency and amplitude of the signal, will always be outside the bias voltage
parameters. Another way to use the KS signals is for the PCM to learn the average normal noise
output from the KS. The PCM uses this noise channel, and KS signal that rides along the noise
channel, in much the same way as the bias voltage type does. Both systems will constantly monitor
the KS system for a signal that is not present or falls within the noise channel.
^ The flat response KS uses a 2-wire circuit. The KS signal rides within a noise channel which is
learned and output by the PCM. This noise channel is based upon the normal noise input from the
KS and is known as background noise. As engine speed and load change, the noise channel upper
and lower parameters will change to accommodate the KS signal, keeping the signal within the
channel. If there is knock, the signal will range outside the noise channel and the PCM will reduce
spark advance until the knock is reduced. These sensors are monitored in much the same way as
the broadband sensors, except that an abnormal signal will stay outside of the noise channel or will
not be present.
KS diagnostics can be calibrated to detect faults with the KS diagnostic inside the PCM, the KS
wiring, the sensor output, or constant knocking from an outside influence such as a loose or
damaged component. In order to determine which cylinders are knocking, the PCM uses KS signal
information when the cylinders are near Top Dead Center (TDC) of the firing stroke.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 807
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 808
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the engine cover. 3. Disconnect the knock
sensor harness connector (3). 4. Remove the knock sensor bolt (1) and knock sensor (2).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the knock sensor (2) and the knock sensor bolt (1).
Tighten Tighten the sender to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
2. Connect the knock sensor harness connector (3). 3. Install the engine cover. 4. Connect the
negative battery cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 812
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 813
Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 814
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 815
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair
MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE (MAP) SENSOR REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Other than checking for a worn grommet and loose electrical connectors, the only service possible
is a unit replacement if the diagnosis shows a malfunctioning manifold absolute pressure (MAP)
sensor.
1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Remove the engine cover. 3. Disconnect the MAP sensor harness
connector.
NOTE: Do not rotate or pry on the MAP sensor when removing. Damage to the MAP sensor or the
intake manifold may result.
4. Remove the MAP sensor by pulling straight up with a slight rocking motion. 5. Remove the MAP
sensor grommet. 6. Discard the MAP sensor grommet.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 816
1. Install the new MAP sensor grommet on the MAP sensor. 2. Install the MAP sensor.
3. Connect the MAP sensor harness connector. 4. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Oil Pressure Sensor: Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure Gage Sensor
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 22 ft. lbs.
Engine Oil Pressure Gage Sensor Fitting (Plus Required Angle)
Torque..................................................................................................................................................
............................................................... 11 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 820
Oil Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
Engine Oil Pressure Sensor and/or Switch Replacement
Tools Required J41712 Oil Pressure Switch Socket
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Disconnect the engine oil pressure sensor gage electrical
connector. 3. Hold the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting with a wrench.
4. Remove the engine oil pressure gage sensor using J41712.
Important: Note the alignment of the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting prior to removal.
5. Remove the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting, if necessary.
Installation Procedure
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting, if removed.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 821
1.1. Tighten the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.).
Important: Do not loosen the sensor fitting. Do not tighten the sensor fitting more than one turn to
align.
1.2. Tighten the sensor fitting until properly aligned.
2. Install the engine oil pressure gage sensor. 3. Hold the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting
with a wrench to prevent from turning.
Using J41712 tighten the engine oil pressure gage sensor to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
4. Install the engine oil pressure gage sensor electrical connector. 5. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Oxygen Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 827
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 828
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 829
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 830
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 831
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 832
Oxygen Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 833
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 834
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 835
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 836
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 837
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 838
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 839
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 840
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 841
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 842
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 843
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 844
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 845
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 846
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 847
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 848
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 849
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 850
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 851
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 852
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 853
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 854
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 855
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 856
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 857
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 858
Oxygen Sensor: Connector Views
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 1 Sensor 1
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 1 Sensor 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 859
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 2 Sensor 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Heated Oxygen Sensors
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation Heated Oxygen Sensors
The main function of the pre-catalyst Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) is to provide the (PCM) with
exhaust stream information in order to maintain proper fueling to hold emissions within acceptable
levels. These oxygen sensors are always located between the exhaust manifold and the catalytic
converter. After the sensor reaches the operating temperature, the sensor generates a voltage
inversely proportional to the amount of oxygen present in the exhaust gases.
The PCM uses the signal voltage from the fuel control heated oxygen sensors in a Closed Loop in
order to adjust the fuel injector pulse width. While in a Closed Loop, the PCM can adjust fuel
delivery in order to maintain an air to fuel ratio which allows the best combination of emission
control and driveability.
If the oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal are damaged, replace the entire oxygen
sensor assembly. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, the connector, or the terminals. In order for
the sensor to function properly, the sensor must have a clean air reference provided to it. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor wires. Any attempt to repair the wires,
connectors, or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference. Any attempt to repair
the wires, connectors, or terminals could degrade oxygen sensor performance.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Heated Oxygen Sensors > Page 862
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation Oxygen Sensor Diagnosis
Diagnose the fuel control heated oxygen sensors for the following conditions:
^ Heater performance, time to activity on cold start
^ Slow response
^ Response time, time to switch R/L or L/R
^ Inactive signal, output steady at bias voltage - approximately 450 mV
^ Signal fixed high
^ Signal fixed low
Diagnose the catalyst monitor heated oxygen sensors for the following functions:
^ Heater performance, time to activity on cold start
^ Signal fixed low during steady state conditions
^ Inactive sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 863
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor 1
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor
1
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39194-B Oxygen Sensor Wrench
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Vehicle Lifting Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Raise the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Disconnect the connector (1) for the HO2S.
NOTE: Refer to Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Remove the HO2S (2) using a J 39194-B.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: A special anti-seize compound is used on the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S)
threads. The compound consists of liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite tends to burn
away, but the glass beads remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New, or service
replacement sensors already have the compound applied to the threads. If the sensor is removed
from an engine and if for any reason the sensor is to be reinstalled, the threads must have
anti-seize compound applied before the reinstallation.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor 1 > Page 866
1. Coat the threads of the oxygen sensor with anti-seize compound GM P/N 5613695, if necessary.
NOTE: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the HO2S (2) using a J 39194-B.
Tighten Tighten the sensor to 42 N.m (31 lb ft).
3. Connect the HO2S harness connector (1). 4. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor 1 > Page 867
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor
2
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39194-B Oxygen Sensor Wrench
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Vehicle Lifting Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Raise the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Disconnect the connector (3) for the HO2S.
NOTE: Refer to Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Remove the HO2S (4) using a J 39194-B.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: A special anti-seize compound is used on the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S)
threads. The compound consists of liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite tends to burn
away, but the glass beads remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New, or service
replacement sensors already have the compound applied to the threads. If the sensor is removed
from an engine and if for any reason the sensor is to be reinstalled, the threads must have
anti-seize compound applied before the reinstallation.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor 1 > Page 868
1. Coat the threads of the oxygen sensor with anti-seize compound GM P/N 5613695, if necessary.
NOTE: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the HO2S (4) using a J 39194-B.
Tighten Tighten the sensor to 42 N.m (31 lb ft).
3. Connect the HO2S harness connector (3). 4. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor 1 > Page 869
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 2 Sensor
1
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39194-B Oxygen Sensor Wrench
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Vehicle Lifting Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Raise the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Disconnect the connector (2) for the HO2S.
NOTE: Refer to Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Remove the HO2S (1) using a J 39194-B.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: A special anti-seize compound is used on the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S)
threads. The compound consists of liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite tends to burn
away, but the glass beads remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New, or service
replacement sensors already have the compound applied to the threads. If the sensor is removed
from an engine and if for any reason the sensor is to be reinstalled, the threads must have
anti-seize compound applied before the reinstallation.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor 1 > Page 870
1. Coat the threads of the oxygen sensor with anti-seize compound GM P/N 5813695, if necessary.
NOTE: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the HO2S (1) using a J 39194-B.
Tighten Tighten the sensor to 42 N.m (31 lb ft).
3. Connect the HO2S harness connector (2). 4. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 876
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 877
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 878
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 879
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 880
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 881
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 882
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 883
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 884
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 885
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 886
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 887
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 888
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 889
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 890
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 891
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 892
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 893
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 894
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 895
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 896
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 897
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 898
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 899
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 900
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 901
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 902
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 903
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 904
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 905
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 906
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 907
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 908
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 909
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Disconnect the throttle position (TP) sensor harness connector.
3. Remove the mounting bolts from the TP sensor.
NOTE: The TP sensor is an electrical component. Do not soak the TP sensor in any liquid cleaner
or solvent, as damage may result.
4. Remove the TP sensor and gasket from the throttle body assembly.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 910
1. With the throttle valve closed, install the TP sensor on the throttle shaft.
Rotate the TP sensor counterclockwise in order to align the mounting holes.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the TP sensor mounting bolts.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Connect the TP sensor harness connector. 4. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Park/Neutral Position Switch Screw
................................................................................................................................................... 3 Nm
(27 inch lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 914
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams
Automatic Transmission Related Connector End Views
Transmission Range Switch Connector, Wiring Harness Side
Tow/Haul Switch Connector, Column Wiring Harness Side
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 915
Park/Neutral Position Switch (C1)
Park/Neutral Position Switch (C2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 916
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Adjustments
Park/Neutral Position Switch Adjustment
Important: ^
The following procedure is for vehicles that have not had the switch removed or replaced. If the
switch has been removed or replaced, refer to Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement for the
proper adjustment procedure.
^ Apply the parking brake.
^ The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) positions only.
^ Check the switch for proper operation. If adjustment is required, proceed as follows:
1. Place the transmission range selector in the N (Neutral) position. 2. With an assistant in the
drivers seat, raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 3. Loosen the park/neutral position switch
mounting bolts. 4. With the vehicle in the N (Neutral) position, rotate the switch while the assistant
attempts to start the engine. 5. Following a successful start, turn the engine off.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
6. Tighten the bolts securing the switch to the transmission.
Tighten the bolts to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Check the switch for proper operation. The engine must start in the P
(Park) or N (Neutral) positions only. 9. Replace the park/neutral position switch if proper operation
can not be achieved.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 917
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement
^ Tools Required J 41364-A Neutral Position Adjustment Tool
Removal Procedure
1. Apply the parking brake. 2. Shift the transmission into neutral. 3. Raise the vehicle. Refer to
Vehicle Lifting.
4. Remove the nut securing the transmission control lever to the manual shaft. 5. Remove the
transmission control lever from the manual shaft. 6. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the
switch. 7. Remove the bolts securing the park/neutral position switch to the transmission. 8.
Remove the park/neutral position switch from the manual shaft. If the park/neutral position switch
did not slide off the manual shaft, file the outer
edge of the manual shaft in order to remove any burrs.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the switch to the transmission manual shaft by aligning the switch hub flats with the
manual shaft flats.
2. Slide the switch onto the transmission manual shaft until the switch mounting bracket contacts
the mounting bosses on the transmission.
Important: If a new switch is being installed, the switch will come with a positive assurance bracket.
The positive assurance bracket aligns the new switch in it proper position for installation and the
use of neutral position adjustment tool will not be necessary.
3. Install the switch to the transmission with two bolts finger tight.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 918
4. Position the tool J 41364-A onto the park/neutral position switch. Ensure that the two slots on the
switch where the manual shaft is inserted are
lined up with the lower two tabs on the tool.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
5. Rotate the tool until the upper locator pin on the tool is lined up with the slot on the top of the
switch.
Tighten the bolts securing the switch to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
6. Remove the J 41364-A from the switch. If installing a new switch, remove the positive assurance
bracket at this time. 7. Connect the electrical connectors to the switch.
8. Install the transmission control lever to the manual shaft with the nut.
Tighten the control lever nut to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
9. Lower the vehicle.
10. Check the switch for proper operation. The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral)
positions only. If proper operation of the switch can
not be obtained, replace the switch.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 924
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 925
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 926
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 927
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 928
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 929
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 930
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 931
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 932
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 933
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 934
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 935
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 936
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 937
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 938
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 939
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 940
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 941
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 942
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 943
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 944
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 945
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 946
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 947
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 948
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 949
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 950
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 951
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 952
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 953
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 954
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 955
Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 962
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 963
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 964
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 965
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 966
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 967
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 968
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 969
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 970
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 971
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 972
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 973
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 974
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 975
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 976
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 977
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 978
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 979
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 980
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 981
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 982
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 983
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 984
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 985
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 986
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 987
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 988
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 989
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 990
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 991
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 992
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 993
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 994
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 995
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Disconnect the MAF sensor harness connector.
3. Release the air cleaner cover retainer clips.
NOTE: ^
Handle the MAF sensor carefully.
^ Do not drop the MAF sensor in order to prevent damage to the MAF sensor.
^ Do not damage the screen located on the air inlet end of the MAF.
^ Do not touch the sensing elements.
^ Do not allow solvents and lubricants to come in contact with the sensing elements.
^ Use a small amount of a soap based solution in order to aid in the installation.
4. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct from the MAF sensor by loosening the hose clamp.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 996
5. Disconnect the air cleaner cover from the front of the MAF sensor by loosening the hose clamp.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Point the flow arrows on the MAF sensor away from the air cleaner.
1. Attach the MAF sensor to the air cleaner cover by tightening the hose clamp.
Tighten Tighten the clamp to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
2. Attach the air cleaner outlet duct to the MAF sensor by tightening the hose clamp.
Tighten Tighten the clamp to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 997
3. Install the air cleaner cover by fastening the air cleaner cover retainer clips.
4. Connect the MAF sensor harness connector.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1003
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1004
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1005
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1006
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1007
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1008
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1009
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1010
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1011
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1012
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1013
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1014
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1015
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1016
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1017
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1018
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1019
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1020
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1021
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1022
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1023
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1024
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1025
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1026
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1027
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1028
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1029
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1030
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1031
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1032
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1033
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1034
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1035
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1036
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Disconnect the throttle position (TP) sensor harness connector.
3. Remove the mounting bolts from the TP sensor.
NOTE: The TP sensor is an electrical component. Do not soak the TP sensor in any liquid cleaner
or solvent, as damage may result.
4. Remove the TP sensor and gasket from the throttle body assembly.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1037
1. With the throttle valve closed, install the TP sensor on the throttle shaft.
Rotate the TP sensor counterclockwise in order to align the mounting holes.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the TP sensor mounting bolts.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Connect the TP sensor harness connector. 4. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1044
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1045
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1046
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1047
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1048
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1049
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1050
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1051
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1052
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1053
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1054
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1055
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1056
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1057
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1058
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1059
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1060
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1061
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1062
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1063
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1064
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1065
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1066
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1067
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1068
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1069
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1070
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1071
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1072
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1073
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1074
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1075
Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1076
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
The CMP sensor is a hall-effect sensor located in the ignition distributor base, and uses the same
type of circuits as the CKP sensor. The CMP sensor signal is a digital ON/OFF pulse, output once
per revolution of the camshaft. The CMP sensor information is used by the PCM to determine the
position of the valve train relative to the CKP.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1077
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1078
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Disconnect the spark plug wires and ignition coil wire from the
distributor.
3. Disconnect the camshaft position (CMP) sensor harness connector from the distributor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1079
4. Remove the distributor cap screws.
5. Remove the distributor cap.
6. Remove the rotor screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1080
7. Remove the rotor.
8. Align the square slot in the reluctor wheel with the CMP sensor.
9. Remove the CMP screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1081
10. Remove the CMP sensor.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: Do not use the old cap, CMP sensor, and rotor screws. Use the replacement screws
that have been coated with a thread locking compound.
1. Insert the CMP sensor through the reluctor wheel slot.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install new CMP mounting screws.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 2.2 N.m (19 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1082
3. Install the rotor onto the reluctor wheel.
4. Install new rotor screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1083
5. Install the distributor cap.
6. Install new distributor cap screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2.4 N.m (21 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1084
7. Connect the CMP sensor harness connector.
8. Connect the spark plug wires and ignition coil wire. 9. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Crankshaft Position Sensor: > 02-06-04-059 > Dec > 02 > Engine Controls - Engine Runs Rough/MIL
ON/DTC's Set
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Customer Interest Engine Controls - Engine Runs Rough/MIL
ON/DTC's Set
File In Section: 06 - Engine/Propulsion System
Bulletin No.: 02-06-04-059
Date: December, 2002
TECHNICAL
Subject: Engine Runs Rough, Service Engine Soon Light On, DTC's P0300 or P0335 Set (Shim
Crankshaft Sensor)
Models: 2002-03 Chevrolet Astro, Blazer, Express, Silverado and S-10 Truck Models 2002-03
GMC Jimmy, Safari, Savana, Sierra and Sonoma Truck Models with 4.3L V-6 Engine (VINs W, X RPOs L35, LU3)
Condition
Some owners may comment on a rough running condition or a Service Engine Soon (SES) light
being illuminated. Upon investigation, the technician may find a DTC code P0300 or P0335.
Cause
The crankshaft sensor may be contacting the reluctor wheel.
Correction
Remove the crankshaft sensor. Refer to the Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement procedure in
the Engine Controls-4.3L sub-section of the Service Manual. After removing the sensor, inspect the
end of it for witness marks that would indicate contact with the crankshaft. If contact with the
reluctor ring is indicated, then inspect the front cover for cracking or other signs of alignment
concerns. If the inspection indicates that the cover is causing mis-alignments, replace the cover. If
replacing the cover, then the 0.5 mm shim is not needed.
If the inspection of the front cover indicates that the cover is not the cause of mis-alignments, then
the sensor should be shimmed. Add one shim between the sensor and the front cover. If the
concern still exists, then add the second shim. Unless the sensor has been rubbed through the
casing or deformed by contact with the crankshaft, it should not be replaced.
In either case, the crankshaft relearn procedure should be performed after any repairs.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Crankshaft Position Sensor: > 02-06-04-059 > Dec > 02 > Engine Controls - Engine Runs Rough/MIL
ON/DTC's Set > Page 1093
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Position Sensor: > 02-06-04-059 > Dec > 02 > Engine Controls - Engine Runs
Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set
Crankshaft Position Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Engine Runs
Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set
File In Section: 06 - Engine/Propulsion System
Bulletin No.: 02-06-04-059
Date: December, 2002
TECHNICAL
Subject: Engine Runs Rough, Service Engine Soon Light On, DTC's P0300 or P0335 Set (Shim
Crankshaft Sensor)
Models: 2002-03 Chevrolet Astro, Blazer, Express, Silverado and S-10 Truck Models 2002-03
GMC Jimmy, Safari, Savana, Sierra and Sonoma Truck Models with 4.3L V-6 Engine (VINs W, X RPOs L35, LU3)
Condition
Some owners may comment on a rough running condition or a Service Engine Soon (SES) light
being illuminated. Upon investigation, the technician may find a DTC code P0300 or P0335.
Cause
The crankshaft sensor may be contacting the reluctor wheel.
Correction
Remove the crankshaft sensor. Refer to the Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement procedure in
the Engine Controls-4.3L sub-section of the Service Manual. After removing the sensor, inspect the
end of it for witness marks that would indicate contact with the crankshaft. If contact with the
reluctor ring is indicated, then inspect the front cover for cracking or other signs of alignment
concerns. If the inspection indicates that the cover is causing mis-alignments, replace the cover. If
replacing the cover, then the 0.5 mm shim is not needed.
If the inspection of the front cover indicates that the cover is not the cause of mis-alignments, then
the sensor should be shimmed. Add one shim between the sensor and the front cover. If the
concern still exists, then add the second shim. Unless the sensor has been rubbed through the
casing or deformed by contact with the crankshaft, it should not be replaced.
In either case, the crankshaft relearn procedure should be performed after any repairs.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Position Sensor: > 02-06-04-059 > Dec > 02 > Engine Controls - Engine Runs
Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set > Page 1099
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
1100
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1103
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1104
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1105
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1106
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1107
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1108
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1109
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1110
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1111
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1112
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1113
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1114
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1115
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1116
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1117
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1118
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1119
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1120
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1121
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1122
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1123
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1124
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1125
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1126
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1127
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1128
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1129
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1130
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1131
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1132
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1133
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1134
Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1135
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
The CKP sensor is a three wire sensor based on the magneto resistive principle. A magneto
resistive sensor uses two magnetic pickups between a permanent magnet. As an element such as
a reluctor wheel passes the magnets the resulting change in the magnetic field is used by the
sensor electronics to produce a digital output pulse. The PCM supplies a 12-volt, low reference,
and signal circuit to the CKP sensor. The sensor returns a digital ON/OFF pulse 3 times per
crankshaft revolution for the V6 engine, 4 times for the V8 engine. The CKP sensor reads the
crankshaft mounted reluctor wheel to identify pairs of cylinders at top dead center (TDC).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1136
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > CKP System
Variation Learn Procedure
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair CKP System Variation Learn Procedure
IMPORTANT: For additional diagnostic information, refer to DTC P1336.
1. Install a scan tool. 2. With a scan tool, monitor the powertrain control module (PCM) for
diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs). If other DTCs are set, except DTC P1336,
refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List for the applicable DTC that set.
3. With a scan tool, select the crankshaft position (CKP) variation learn procedure. 4. Observe the
fuel cut-OFF for the engine that you are performing the learn procedure on. 5. The scan tool
instructs you to perform the following:
^ Block the drive wheels.
^ Apply the vehicles parking brake.
^ Cycle the ignition from OFF to ON.
^ Apply and hold the brake pedal.
^ Start and idle the engine.
^ Turn OFF the A/C.
^ Place the vehicles transmission in Park (A/T) or Neutral (M/T).
^ The scan tool monitors certain component signals to determine if all the conditions are met to
continue with the procedure. The scan tool only displays the condition that inhibits the procedure.
The scan tool monitors the following components: CKP sensor activity - If there is a CKP sensor condition, refer to the applicable DTCs that set.
- Camshaft position (CMP) sensor activity - If there is a CMP sensor condition, refer to the
applicable DTCs that set.
- Engine coolant temperature (ECT) - If the ECT is not warm enough, idle the engine until the ECT
reaches the correct temperature.
6. With the scan tool, enable the CKP system variation learn procedure.
IMPORTANT: While the learn procedure is in progress, release the throttle immediately when the
engine starts to decelerate. The engine control is returned to the operator and the engine responds
to throttle position (TP) after the learn procedure is complete.
7. Slowly increase the engine speed to the RPM that you observed. 8. Immediately release the
throttle when fuel cut-OFF is reached. 9. The scan tool displays Learn Status: Learned this ignition.
If the scan tool does NOT display this message and no additional DTCs set, refer to
Symptoms - Engine. If a DTC set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List for the applicable
DTC that set.
10. Turn OFF the ignition for 30 seconds after the learn procedure is completed successfully.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > CKP System
Variation Learn Procedure > Page 1139
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: The CKP System Variation Learn Procedure will need to be performed whenever the
crankshaft position (CKP) sensor is removed or replaced. Refer to CKP System Variation Learn
Procedure.
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. If the vehicle is equipped with the
underbody shield package, then remove the steering linkage shield mounting bolts.
3. Remove the steering linkage shield.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > CKP System
Variation Learn Procedure > Page 1140
4. Disconnect the CKP sensor harness connector.
5. Remove the CKP sensor mounting bolt.
6. Remove the CKP sensor.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > CKP System
Variation Learn Procedure > Page 1141
IMPORTANT: ^
When installing the CKP sensor, make sure the sensor is fully seated before tightening the
mounting bolt. A poorly seated CKP sensor may perform erratically and may set false DTCs.
^ Do not reuse the original O-ring.
1. Replace the CKP sensor O-ring. 2. Lubricate the O-ring with clean engine oil before installing the
CKP sensor.
IMPORTANT: Make sure the CKP sensor mounting surface is clear and free of burrs.
3. Install the CKP sensor.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the CKP sensor mounting bolt.
Tighten Tighten the CKP sensor mounting bolt to 9 N.m (80 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > CKP System
Variation Learn Procedure > Page 1142
5. Connect the CKP sensor harness connector.
6. Install the steering linkage shield.
7. Install the steering linkage shield mounting bolts.
Tighten
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > CKP System
Variation Learn Procedure > Page 1143
Tighten the bolts to 33 N.m (24 lb ft).
8. Lower the Vehicle. 9. Perform the CKP System Variation Learn Procedure. See: Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Ignition Lock Cylinder - Revised Replacement Procedure
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Technical Service Bulletins Ignition Lock Cylinder - Revised
Replacement Procedure
File In Section: 02 - Steering
Bulletin No.: 02-02-35-001
Date: January, 2002
SERVICE MANUAL UPDATE
Subject: Revised Ignition Lock Cylinder Replacement
Models: 1998-2002 Chevrolet and GMC C/K, S/T, M/L and G Model Vehicles 1999-2000 Cadillac
Escalade 2002 Cadillac Escalade 1998-2002 Oldsmobile Bravada
This bulletin is being issued to revise the Ignition Lock Cylinder Replacement procedure in the
Steering Wheel and Column - Standard or Steering Wheel and Column - Tilt sub-sections of the
Service Manual. Please replace the current information in the Service Manual with the following
information.
The following information has been updated within SI2000. If you are using a paper version of this
Service Manual, please make a reference to this bulletin on the affected page.
The above mentioned Service Manuals omitted information regarding performing the Passlock
Relearn or Autolearn procedure after an ignition lock cylinder has been replaced. If you have
replaced the ignition lock cylinder, refer to the following procedures:
For 1998-2000 model year vehicles, refer to Passlock Reprogramming in the Theft Deterrent
subsection.
For 2001-2002 model year vehicles, refer to Programming Theft Deterrent System Components in
the Theft Deterrent subsection.
DISCLAIMER
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Knock Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1154
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1155
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1156
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1157
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1158
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1159
Knock Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1160
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1161
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1162
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1163
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1164
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1165
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1166
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1167
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1168
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1169
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1170
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1171
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1172
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1173
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1174
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1175
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1176
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1177
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1178
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1179
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1180
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1181
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1182
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1183
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1184
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1185
Knock Sensor (KS)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1186
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
The Knock Sensor (KS) system enables the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to control the
ignition timing advance for the best possible performance while protecting the engine from
potentially damaging levels of detonation. The sensors in the KS system are used by the PCM as
microphones to listen for abnormal engine noise that may indicate pre-ignition/detonation.
SENSOR DESCRIPTION
There are 2 types of KS currently being used: ^
The broadband single wire sensor
^ The flat response 2-wire sensor
Both sensors use piezo-electric crystal technology to produce and send signals to the PCM. The
amplitude and frequency of this signal will vary constantly depending on the vibration level within
the engine. Flat response and broadband KS signals are processed differently by the PCM. The
major differences are outlined below: ^
All broadband sensors use a single wire circuit. Some types of controllers will output a bias voltage
on the KS signal wire. The bias voltage creates a voltage drop the PCM monitors and uses to help
diagnose KS faults. The KS noise signal rides along this bias voltage, and due to the constantly
fluctuating frequency and amplitude of the signal, will always be outside the bias voltage
parameters. Another way to use the KS signals is for the PCM to learn the average normal noise
output from the KS. The PCM uses this noise channel, and KS signal that rides along the noise
channel, in much the same way as the bias voltage type does. Both systems will constantly monitor
the KS system for a signal that is not present or falls within the noise channel.
^ The flat response KS uses a 2-wire circuit. The KS signal rides within a noise channel which is
learned and output by the PCM. This noise channel is based upon the normal noise input from the
KS and is known as background noise. As engine speed and load change, the noise channel upper
and lower parameters will change to accommodate the KS signal, keeping the signal within the
channel. If there is knock, the signal will range outside the noise channel and the PCM will reduce
spark advance until the knock is reduced. These sensors are monitored in much the same way as
the broadband sensors, except that an abnormal signal will stay outside of the noise channel or will
not be present.
KS diagnostics can be calibrated to detect faults with the KS diagnostic inside the PCM, the KS
wiring, the sensor output, or constant knocking from an outside influence such as a loose or
damaged component. In order to determine which cylinders are knocking, the PCM uses KS signal
information when the cylinders are near Top Dead Center (TDC) of the firing stroke.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1187
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1188
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the engine cover. 3. Disconnect the knock
sensor harness connector (3). 4. Remove the knock sensor bolt (1) and knock sensor (2).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the knock sensor (2) and the knock sensor bolt (1).
Tighten Tighten the sender to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
2. Connect the knock sensor harness connector (3). 3. Install the engine cover. 4. Connect the
negative battery cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1193
Inflatable Restraint Front End Discriminating Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1194
Impact Sensor: Service Precautions
CAUTION: Be careful when you handle a sensor. Do not strike or jolt a sensor. Before applying
power to a sensor:
^ Remove any dirt, grease, etc. from the mounting surface.
^ Position the sensor horizontally on the mounting surface.
^ Point the arrow on the sensor toward the front of the vehicle.
^ Tighten all of the sensor fasteners and sensor bracket fasteners to the specified torque value.
Failure to follow the correct procedure could cause air bag deployment, personal injury, or
unnecessary SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1195
Impact Sensor: Description and Operation
INFLATABLE RESTRAINT FRONT END DISCRIMINATING SENSOR
The front end discriminating sensor is equipped on some vehicles to supplement SIR system
performance. The discriminating sensor is an electro-mechanical sensor and is not part of the
deployment loops, but instead provides an input to the SDM. The SDM uses the input from the
discriminating sensor to assist in determining the severity of a frontal collision further supporting air
bag deployment. If the SDM determines a deployment is warranted, the SDM will cause current to
flow through the deployment loops deploying the frontal air bags.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1196
Impact Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Air Bag Systems / Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Inflatable Restraint Front End Discriminating Sensor Replacement
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Inflatable Restraint Front End Discriminating Sensor
Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Disable the SIR system. Refer to Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming. 2. Disconnect the mass air
flow (MAF) and the intake air temperature (IAT) sensors harness connectors. 3. Loosen the clamp.
4. Remove the air tube from the throttle body air intake cover. 5. Remove the bolts. 6. Remove the
upper radiator shroud. 7. Remove the fan and clutch assembly. 8. Remove the lower radiator
shroud. 9. Disconnect the inflatable restraint front end discriminating sensor harness connector
located at the top of the cradle (1).
10. Remove the bolts (2). 11. Remove the inflatable restraint front end discriminating sensor (3)
from the cradle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Be careful when you handle a sensor. Do not strike or jolt a sensor. Before applying
power to a sensor: ^
Remove any dirt, grease, etc. from the mounting surface.
^ Position the sensor horizontally on the mounting surface.
^ Point the arrow on the sensor toward the front of the vehicle.
^ Tighten all of the sensor fasteners and sensor bracket fasteners to the specified torque value.
Failure to follow the correct procedure could cause air bag deployment, personal injury, or
unnecessary SIR system repairs.
1. Install the inflatable restraint front end discriminating sensor to the top of the cradle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the inflatable restraint front end discriminating sensor mounting fasteners (2).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Inflatable Restraint Front End Discriminating Sensor Replacement > Page
1199
Tighten Tighten fastener to 6.5 N.m (58 lb in).
IMPORTANT: The following procedures should be utilized in the event that sensor mounting holes
or fasteners are damaged to the extent that the sensor may no longer be properly mounted.
3. Perform the following steps in order to complete the first fastener repair;
3.1. Remove and discard the improperly installed rivet.
3.2. Reattach sensor with new rivet (GM P/N 15715058) or equivalent.
4. Perform the following steps, if needed, in order to complete a second fastener repair:
4.1. Remove the improperly installed rivet.
4.2. Enlarge the mounting holes in the lower radiator support to 9.0 mm (0.35 in).
4.3. Insert and properly seat rivnut (GM P/N 15699834) or equivalent.
4.4. Install sensor with screw GM P/N 11515664, or equivalent.
Tighten Tighten fasteners to 6.5 N.m (58 lb in).
5. Connect the inflatable restraint front end discriminating sensor harness connector to the sensor.
6. Install the lower radiator shroud. 7. Install the fan and clutch assembly. 8. Install the upper
radiator shroud. 9. Install the air box with MAF sensor to the upper radiator shroud.
10. Connect the air tube to the throttle body air intake cover with the clamp. 11. Connect the MAF
and IAT sensors harness connectors. 12. Enable the SIR system. Refer to Air Bag(s) Arming and
Disarming.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Inflatable Restraint Front End Discriminating Sensor Replacement > Page
1200
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module
Replacement
INFLATABLE RESTRAINT SENSING AND DIAGNOSTIC MODULE REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: ^
Be careful when you handle a sensing and diagnostic module (SDM). Do not strike or jolt the SDM.
Before applying power to the SDM: ^
Remove any dirt, grease, etc. from the mounting surface
^ Position the SDM horizontally on the mounting surface
^ Point the arrow on the SDM toward the front of the vehicle
^ Tighten all of the SDM fasteners and SDM bracket fasteners to the specified torque value
Failure to follow the correct procedure could cause air bag deployment, personal injury, or
unnecessary SIR system repairs.
^ If any water enters the vehicle's interior up to the level of the carpet or higher and soaks the
carpet, the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) and the SDM harness connector may need to be
replaced. The SDM could be activated when powered, which could cause deployment of the air
bag(s) and result in personal injury. Before attempting these procedures, the SIR system must be
disabled. Refer to Disabling the SIR System. With the ignition OFF, inspect the SDM mounting
area, including the carpet. If any significant soaking or evidence of significant soaking is detected,
you must perform the following tasks: 1. Remove all water. 2. Repair the water damage. 3. Replace
the SDM harness connector. 4. Replace the SDM. Failure to follow these tasks could result in
possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded SIR system repairs.
^ Refer to SIR Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disable the SIR system. Refer to Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming. 2. Remove the drivers seat.
3. Remove the carpet retaining sill trim molding. 4. Fold back the carpet to access the inflatable
restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM). 5. Remove the connector position assurance
(CPA) (1) from the inflatable restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) wiring harness
connector
(2).
6. Push down the flex lock button (3) and slide the connector locking cover (4) to the open position.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Inflatable Restraint Front End Discriminating Sensor Replacement > Page
1201
7. Disconnect the SDM wiring harness connector (2) from the SDM (4). 8. Remove the SDM
mounting fasteners (1). 9. Remove the SDM (4) from the vehicle (5).
IMPORTANT: The following repair procedures should only be used in the event that the inflatable
restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) mounting studs and/or fasteners are damaged to
the extent that the SDM may no longer be properly mounted.
10. Repair the fasteners using the following procedure:
10.1. Remove the stripped nut and discard the nut. 10.2. Drill out the weld spots to the weld stud
from the floor pan side, then remove and discard the stud. 10.3. Condition the floor panel attaching
surface where the new stud is to be installed. 10.4. Install new weld stud GM P/N 115115602 and
clamp the weld stud. 10.5. Migweld the stud at the drilled holes form above or below the floor pan,
as required. 10.6. Apply body sealer around any exposed openings. 10.7. Install a new fastener
GM P/N 11515933.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the SDM (4) to the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the SDM mounting fasteners (1).
Tighten Tighten fasteners to 12 N.m (106 lb in).
3. Connect the SDM wiring harness connector (2) to the SDM (4).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Inflatable Restraint Front End Discriminating Sensor Replacement > Page
1202
4. Push down the flex lock button (3) and slide the connector locking cover (4) to the close position.
5. Install the connector position assurance (CPA) (1) to the inflatable restraint sensing and
diagnostic module (SDM) wiring harness connector (2). 6. Position the carpet to cover the inflatable
restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM). 7. Install the carpet retaining sill trim molding. 8.
Install the driver seat. 9. Enable the SIR system. Refer to Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Inflatable Restraint Front End Discriminating Sensor Replacement > Page
1203
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair SIR Sensor Replacement Guidelines
The SIR sensor replacement policy requires replacing sensors in the area of collision damage. The
area of collision damage is defined as the portion of the vehicle which is crushed, bent, or
damaged due to a collision.
^ Replace the sensor even if the air bags have not deployed.
^ Replace the sensor even if it appears to be undamaged.
Sensor damage which is not visible, such as slight bending of the mounting bracket or cuts in the
wire insulation, can cause improper operation of the SIR sensing system. Do not try to determine
whether the sensor is undamaged, replace the sensor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1207
Seat Belt Buckle Switch
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Passenger Presence System Information
Seat Occupant Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Passenger Presence System
Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 06-08-50-009F
Date: December 23, 2010
Subject: Information on Passenger Presence Sensing System (PPS or PSS) Concerns With
Custom Upholstery, Accessory Seat Heaters or Other Comfort Enhancing Devices
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Equipped with Passenger Presence Sensing
System
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 06-08-50-009E (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Concerns About Safety and Alterations to the Front Passenger Seat
Important ON A GM VEHICLE EQUIPPED WITH A PASSENGER SENSING SYSTEM, USE THE
SEAT COVERS AND OTHER SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT AS RELEASED BY GM FOR THAT
VEHICLE. DO NOT ALTER THE SEAT COVERS OR SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT. ANY
ALTERATIONS TO SEAT COVERS OR GM ACCESSORIES DEFEATS THE INTENDED DESIGN
OF THE SYSTEM. GM WILL NOT BE LIABLE FOR ANY PROBLEMS CAUSED BY USE OF
SUCH IMPROPER SEAT ALTERATIONS, INCLUDING ANY WARRANTY REPAIRS INCURRED.
The front passenger seat in many GM vehicles is equipped with a passenger sensing system that
will turn off the right front passenger's frontal airbag under certain conditions, such as when an
infant or child seat is present. In some vehicles, the passenger sensing system will also turn off the
right front passenger's seat mounted side impact airbag. For the system to function properly,
sensors are used in the seat to detect the presence of a properly-seated occupant. The passenger
sensing system may not operate properly if the original seat trim is replaced (1) by non-GM covers,
upholstery or trim, or (2) by GM covers, upholstery or trim designed for a different vehicle or (3) by
GM covers, upholstery or trim that has been altered by a trim shop, or (4) if any object, such as an
aftermarket seat heater or a comfort enhancing pad or device is installed under the seat fabric or
between the occupant and the seat fabric.
Aftermarket Seat Heaters, Custom Upholstery, and Comfort Enhancing Pads or Devices
Important ON A GM VEHICLE EQUIPPED WITH A PASSENGER SENSING SYSTEM, USE ONLY
SEAT COVERS AND OTHER SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT RELEASED AS GM
ACCESSORIES FOR THAT VEHICLE. DO NOT USE ANY OTHER TYPE OF SEAT COVERS OR
SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT, OR GM ACCESSORIES RELEASED FOR OTHER VEHICLE
APPLICATIONS. GM WILL NOT BE LIABLE FOR ANY PROBLEMS CAUSED BY USE OF SUCH
IMPROPER SEAT ACCESSORIES, INCLUDING ANY WARRANTY REPAIRS MADE
NECESSARY BY SUCH USE.
Many types of aftermarket accessories are available to customers, upfitting shops, and dealers.
Some of these devices sit on top of, or are Velcro(R) strapped to the seat while others such as seat
heaters are installed under the seat fabric. Additionally, seat covers made of leather or other
materials may have different padding thickness installed that could prevent the Passenger Sensing
System from functioning properly. Never alter the vehicle seats. Never add pads or other devices to
the seat cushion, as this may interfere with the operation of the Passenger Sensing System and
either prevent proper deployment of the passenger airbag or prevent proper suppression of the
passenger air bag.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition Lock Cylinder - Revised
Replacement Procedure
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Technical Service Bulletins Ignition Lock Cylinder - Revised
Replacement Procedure
File In Section: 02 - Steering
Bulletin No.: 02-02-35-001
Date: January, 2002
SERVICE MANUAL UPDATE
Subject: Revised Ignition Lock Cylinder Replacement
Models: 1998-2002 Chevrolet and GMC C/K, S/T, M/L and G Model Vehicles 1999-2000 Cadillac
Escalade 2002 Cadillac Escalade 1998-2002 Oldsmobile Bravada
This bulletin is being issued to revise the Ignition Lock Cylinder Replacement procedure in the
Steering Wheel and Column - Standard or Steering Wheel and Column - Tilt sub-sections of the
Service Manual. Please replace the current information in the Service Manual with the following
information.
The following information has been updated within SI2000. If you are using a paper version of this
Service Manual, please make a reference to this bulletin on the affected page.
The above mentioned Service Manuals omitted information regarding performing the Passlock
Relearn or Autolearn procedure after an ignition lock cylinder has been replaced. If you have
replaced the ignition lock cylinder, refer to the following procedures:
For 1998-2000 model year vehicles, refer to Passlock Reprogramming in the Theft Deterrent
subsection.
For 2001-2002 model year vehicles, refer to Programming Theft Deterrent System Components in
the Theft Deterrent subsection.
DISCLAIMER
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Tire Monitor
System - TPM Sensor Information
Tire Pressure Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Tire Monitor System - TPM Sensor Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-03-16-003
Date: May 12, 2008
Subject: Warranty Reduction - Transfer of Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensors to
Replacement Wheels and Allowable TPM Sensor Replacements
Models: 2000-2009 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2009
HUMMER H2 2006-2009 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7x
with On-Wheel TPM Sensors
TPM Sensor / Wheel Warranty Reviews
During the last warranty review period it was noted that wheels being returned under the GM New
Vehicle Warranty were being shipped back to General Motors with the TPM sensor still attached to
the wheel. Return rates ran as high as 60% with the TPM sensors still attached. Operational TPM
sensors should not be returned to GM and are to be transferred to replacement wheels if they
become necessary.
Important:
Operational TPM Sensors that are returned under warranty to General Motors will be charged back
to the dealer.Sensors have a 10 year /150,000 mile (240,000 km) battery life, and should be
transferred if one or more wheels are replaced.
TPM Valve Stem / Grommet (0-ring) Replacement
When the TPM sensors are transferred to new wheels you should replace the component used to
seal the TPM sensor stem to the wheel. On sensors with an aluminum stem and visible nut on the
outside of the wheel a replacement grommet (0-ring) should be used to assure a proper seal. The
sensor retaining nut (except Aveo) should be tightened to 7 N.m (62 lb in) for all vehicles except
Pontiac Vibe (4.0 N.m (35.4 lb in)).
Important:
^ DO NOT overtorque the retaining nut.
Notice:
^ Factory installed TPM Sensors come with plastic aluminum or nickel-plated brass stem caps.
These caps should not be changed. Chrome plated steel caps may cause corrosion of aluminum
valve stems due to incompatibility of the metals.
On current style sensors the entire rubber stem is replaceable. The service interval on the revised
TPM sensor with replaceable stem is the same as for any other traditional valve stem. Replace the
stem at the time of tire replacement sensor transfer or whenever air seepage is suspected at the
valve stem. When replacing the valve stem tighten the screw to 1.3 N.m (11.5 lb in).
For either style of TPM sensor see the service parts guide for the correct GM part numbers to order
and use.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Transmission Mode Switch: Testing and Inspection
Tow/Haul Switch/Indicator Always On or Inoperative
Circuit Description
Tow/haul mode enables the operator to achieve enhanced shift performance when towing or
hauling a load. When tow/haul mode is selected, the tow/haul switch input signal to the Body
Control Module (BCM) is momentarily toggled to zero volts. This signals the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) to extend the length of time between upshifts and increase transmission line
pressure. Cycling the tow/haul switch again disables tow/haul mode and returns the transmission to
a normal shift pattern.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1229
Test Description
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. This step tests for a faulty
tow/haul switch. 3. This step tests for voltage input from the BCM to the tow/haul switch.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Park/Neutral Position Switch Screw
................................................................................................................................................... 3 Nm
(27 inch lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1233
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams
Automatic Transmission Related Connector End Views
Transmission Range Switch Connector, Wiring Harness Side
Tow/Haul Switch Connector, Column Wiring Harness Side
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1234
Park/Neutral Position Switch (C1)
Park/Neutral Position Switch (C2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1235
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Adjustments
Park/Neutral Position Switch Adjustment
Important: ^
The following procedure is for vehicles that have not had the switch removed or replaced. If the
switch has been removed or replaced, refer to Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement for the
proper adjustment procedure.
^ Apply the parking brake.
^ The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) positions only.
^ Check the switch for proper operation. If adjustment is required, proceed as follows:
1. Place the transmission range selector in the N (Neutral) position. 2. With an assistant in the
drivers seat, raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 3. Loosen the park/neutral position switch
mounting bolts. 4. With the vehicle in the N (Neutral) position, rotate the switch while the assistant
attempts to start the engine. 5. Following a successful start, turn the engine off.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
6. Tighten the bolts securing the switch to the transmission.
Tighten the bolts to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Check the switch for proper operation. The engine must start in the P
(Park) or N (Neutral) positions only. 9. Replace the park/neutral position switch if proper operation
can not be achieved.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1236
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement
^ Tools Required J 41364-A Neutral Position Adjustment Tool
Removal Procedure
1. Apply the parking brake. 2. Shift the transmission into neutral. 3. Raise the vehicle. Refer to
Vehicle Lifting.
4. Remove the nut securing the transmission control lever to the manual shaft. 5. Remove the
transmission control lever from the manual shaft. 6. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the
switch. 7. Remove the bolts securing the park/neutral position switch to the transmission. 8.
Remove the park/neutral position switch from the manual shaft. If the park/neutral position switch
did not slide off the manual shaft, file the outer
edge of the manual shaft in order to remove any burrs.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the switch to the transmission manual shaft by aligning the switch hub flats with the
manual shaft flats.
2. Slide the switch onto the transmission manual shaft until the switch mounting bracket contacts
the mounting bosses on the transmission.
Important: If a new switch is being installed, the switch will come with a positive assurance bracket.
The positive assurance bracket aligns the new switch in it proper position for installation and the
use of neutral position adjustment tool will not be necessary.
3. Install the switch to the transmission with two bolts finger tight.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1237
4. Position the tool J 41364-A onto the park/neutral position switch. Ensure that the two slots on the
switch where the manual shaft is inserted are
lined up with the lower two tabs on the tool.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
5. Rotate the tool until the upper locator pin on the tool is lined up with the slot on the top of the
switch.
Tighten the bolts securing the switch to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
6. Remove the J 41364-A from the switch. If installing a new switch, remove the positive assurance
bracket at this time. 7. Connect the electrical connectors to the switch.
8. Install the transmission control lever to the manual shaft with the nut.
Tighten the control lever nut to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
9. Lower the vehicle.
10. Check the switch for proper operation. The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral)
positions only. If proper operation of the switch can
not be obtained, replace the switch.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Speed Sensor: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Speed Sensor Retainer Bolt
............................................................................................................................................ 10.5 13.5 Nm (7.7 - 10 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1241
VSS Assembly Connector, Wiring Harness Side
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1242
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) Replacement
^ Tools Required J 38417 Speed Sensor Remover
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting.
2. Remove the harness connector. 3. Remove the bolt. 4. Place a drain pan under the vehicle. 5.
Remove the vehicle speed sensor using J 38417. 6. Remove the O-ring seal.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the new speed sensor and O-ring seal using J 38417 2. Coat the seal with a thin film of
transmission fluid.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the bolt.
Tighten the bolt to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
4. Install the harness connector. 5. Lower the vehicle. 6. Refill the fluid as required.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Specifications
Transmission Fluid Temperature (TFT) Sensor Specifications
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Power Window Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1251
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1252
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1253
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1254
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1255
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1256
Power Window Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1257
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1258
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1259
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1260
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1261
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1262
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1263
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1264
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1265
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1266
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1267
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1268
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1269
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1270
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1271
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1272
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1273
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1274
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1275
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1276
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1277
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1278
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1279
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1280
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1281
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1282
Power Window Switch: Connector Views
Window Master Switch - Driver C1
Window Switch - Front Passenger C1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1283
Window Master Switch - Driver C2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1284
Window Switch - Front Passenger C2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
Rear Window Wiper Washer Switch
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications
Alignment: Technical Service Bulletins Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
Bulletin No.: 05-03-07-009C
Date: December 09, 2010
Subject: Wheel Alignment Specifications, Requirements and Recommendations for GM Vehicles
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being extensively revised to provide technicians and warranty
administrators with an all inclusive guide for wheel alignments. PLEASE FAMILIARIZE YOURSELF
WITH THESE UPDATES BEFORE PERFORMING YOUR NEXT GM WHEEL ALIGNMENT
SERVICE. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-07-009B (Section 03 - Suspension).
Purpose
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide retail, wholesale and fleet personnel with General Motors'
warranty service requirements and recommendations for customer concerns related to wheel
alignment. For your convenience, this bulletin updates and centralizes all of GM's Standard Wheel
Alignment Service Procedures, Policy Guidelines and bulletins on wheel alignment warranty
service.
Important PLEASE FAMILIARIZE YOURSELF WITH THESE UPDATES BEFORE PERFORMING
YOUR NEXT GM WHEEL ALIGNMENT SERVICE.
The following five (5) key steps are a summary of this bulletin and are REQUIRED in completing a
successful wheel alignment service.
1. Verify the vehicle is in an Original Equipment condition for curb weight, tires, wheels, suspension
and steering configurations. Vehicles
modified in any of these areas are not covered for wheel alignment warranty.
2. Review the customer concern relative to "Normal Operation" definitions. 3. Verify that vehicle is
within the "Mileage Policy" range. 4. Document wheel alignment warranty claims appropriately for
labor operations E2000 and E2020.
The following information must be documented or attached to the repair order:
- Customer concern in detail
- What corrected the customer concern?
- If a wheel alignment is performed:
- Consult SI for proper specifications.
- Document the "Before" AND "After" wheel alignment measurements/settings.
- Completed "Wheel Alignment Repair Order Questionnaire" (form attached to this bulletin)
5. Use the proper wheel alignment equipment (preferred with print-out capability), process and the
appropriate calibration maintenance schedules.
Important If it is determined that a wheel alignment is necessary under warranty, use the proper
labor code for the repair. E2000 for Steering Wheel Angle and/or Front Toe set or E2020 for Wheel
Alignment Check/Adjust includes Caster, Camber and Toe set (Wheel alignment labor time for
other component repairs is to be charged to the component that causes a wheel alignment
operation.).
The following flowchart is to help summarize the information detailed in this bulletin and should be
used whenever a wheel alignment is performed.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications > Page 1297
Verify Original Equipment Condition of the Vehicle
- Verify that Original Equipment Tires and Wheels or Official GM Accessory Tires and Wheels are
on the vehicle.
- Verify that aftermarket suspension "Lift" or "Lowering" Kits or other suspension alterations have
NOT been done to the vehicle.
- Check for accidental damage to the vehicle; for example, severe pothole or curb impacts, collision
damage that may have affected the wheel alignment of the vehicle; e.g., engine cradles,
suspension control arms, axles, wheels, wheel covers, tires may show evidence of damage/impact.
- Check to be sure vehicle has seen "Normal Use" rather than abuse; e.g., very aggressive driving
may show up by looking at the tires and condition of the vehicle.
- Check for other additional equipment items that may significantly affect vehicle mass such as
large tool boxes, campers, snow plow packages (without the snowplow RPO), etc., especially in
trucks and cutaway/incomplete vehicles. Significant additional mass can affect trim height and
wheel alignment of the vehicle and may necessitate a customer pay wheel alignment when placed
semi-permanently in the vehicle (Upfitter instructions are to realign the vehicle after placement of
these types of items. (This typically applies to trucks and incomplete vehicles that can be upfit with
equipment such as the above.)
Customer Concerns, "Normal Operation" Conditions and "Mileage Policy"
Possible Concerns
The following are typical conditions that may require wheel alignment warranty service:
1. Lead/Pull: defined as "at a constant highway speed on a typical straight road, the amount of
effort required at the steering wheel to maintain the
vehicle's straight heading."
Important Please evaluate for the condition with hands-on the steering wheel. Follow the "Vehicle
Leads/Pulls" diagnostic tree located in SI to determine the cause of a lead/pull concern. Lead/Pull
concerns can be due to road crown or road slope, tires, wheel alignment or even in rare
circumstances a steering gear issue. Lead/pull concerns due to road crown are considered
"Normal Operation" and are NOT a warrantable condition -- the customer should be advised that
this is "Normal Operation."
Important Some customers may comment on a "Lead/Pull" when they hold the steering wheel in a
level condition. If so, this is more likely a "steering wheel angle" concern because the customer is
"steering" the vehicle to obtain a "level" steering wheel.
2. Steering wheel angle to the left or right (counter-clockwise or clockwise, respectively): Defined
as the steering wheel angle (clocking)
deviation from "level" while maintaining a straight heading on a typical straight road.
3. Irregular or Premature tire wear: Slight to very slight "feathering" or "edge" wear on the
shoulders of tires is NOT considered unusual and
should even out with a tire rotation; if the customer is concerned about a "feathering" condition of
the tires, the customer could be advised to rotate the tires earlier than the next scheduled
mileage/maintenance interval (but no later than the next interval). Be sure to understand the
customer's driving habits as this will also heavily influence the tire wear performance; tire wear from
aggressive or abusive driving habits is NOT a warrantable condition.
Important Slight or mild feathering, cupping, edge or heel/toe wear of tire tread shoulders is
"normal" and can show up very early in a tire/vehicle service mileage; in fact, some new tires can
show evidence of feathering from the factory. These issues do NOT affect the overall performance
and tread life of the tire. Dealer personnel should always check the customer's maintenance
records to ensure that tire inflation pressure is being maintained to placard and that the tires are
being rotated (modified-X pattern) at the proper mileage intervals. Wheel alignments are NOT to be
performed for the types of "Normal" Tire Feathering shown in Figures 1-4 below.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications > Page 1298
Figure 1: Full Tread View - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear on the Shoulder/Adjacent/Center
Ribs
Figure 2: Tire Shoulder View Example 1 - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear on the Shoulder
Figure 3: Tire Shoulder View Example 2 - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear
Figure 4: Detail Side View of Tire Shoulder Area - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear
Important When a wheel alignment is deemed necessary for tire wear, be sure to document on the
repair order, in as much detail as possible, the severity and type of tire wear (e.g., severe center
wear or severe inside or outside shoulder wear) and the position of the tire on the vehicle (RF, LF,
LR, RR). Please note the customer's concern with the wear such as, noise, appearance, wear life,
etc. A field product report with pictures of the tire wear condition is recommended. Refer to
Corporate Bulletin Number 02-00-89-002J and #07-00-89-036C.
4. Other repairs that affect wheel alignment; e.g., certain component replacement such as
suspension control arm replacement, engine cradle
adjustment/replace, steering gear replacement, steering tie rod replace, suspension strut/shock,
steering knuckle, etc. may require a wheel alignment.
Important If other components or repairs are identified as affecting the wheel alignment, policy calls
for the wheel alignment labor time to be charged to the replaced/repaired component's labor
operation time rather than the wheel alignment labor operations.
Important Vibration type customer concerns are generally NOT due to wheel alignment except in
the rare cases; e.g., extreme diagonal wear across the tread. In general, wheel alignments are
NOT to be performed as an investigation/correction for vibration concerns.
"Normal Operation" Conditions
Vehicle Lead/Pull Due to Road Crown or Slope:
As part of "Normal Operation," vehicles will follow side-to-side or left to right road crown or slope.
Be sure to verify from the customer the types of roads they are driving as they may not recognize
the influence of road crown on vehicle lead/pull and steering wheel angle. If a vehicle requires
significant steering effort to prevent it from "climbing" the road crown there may be an issue to be
looked into further.
Important
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications > Page 1299
A wheel alignment will generally NOT correct vehicles that follow the road crown since this is within
"Normal Operation."
Mileage Policy
The following mileage policy applies for E2020 and E2000 labor operations: Note
Wheel Alignment is NOT covered under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty for Express and Savana
Cutaway vehicles as these vehicles require Upfitters to set the wheel alignment after completing
the vehicles.
- 0-800 km (0-500 mi): E2000/E2020 claims ONLY allowed with Call Center Authorization. Due to
the tie down during shipping, the vehicle's suspension requires some time to reach normal
operating position. For this reason, new vehicles are generally NOT to be aligned until they have
accumulated at least 800 km (500 mi). A field product report should accompany any claim within
this mileage range.
- 801-12,000 km (501-7,500 mi):
- If a vehicle came from the factory with incorrect alignment settings, any resulting off-angle
steering wheel, lead/pull characteristics or the rare occurrence of excessive tire wear would be
apparent early in the life of the vehicle. The following policy applies:
- Vehicles 100% Factory Set/Measured for Caster/Camber/Toe - Escalade/ESV/EXT,
Tahoe/Suburban, Yukon/XL/Denali, Silverado/Sierra, Express/Savana, Corvette and
Colorado/Canyon: E2000/E2020 Claims: Call Center Authorization Required
- All Vehicles NOT 100% Factory Set/Measured for Caster/Camber/Toe as noted above:
E2000/E2020 Claims: Dealer Service Manager Authorization Required
- 12,001 km and beyond (7,501 miles and beyond): During this period, customers are responsible
for the wheel alignment expense or dealers may provide on a case-by case basis a one-time
customer enthusiasm claim up to 16,000 km (10,000 mi). In the event that a defective component
required the use of the subject labor operations, the identified defective component labor operation
will include the appropriate labor time for a wheel alignment as an add condition to the component
repair.
Important Only one wheel alignment labor operation claim (E2000 or E2020) may be used per VIN.
Warranty Documentation Requirements
When a wheel alignment service has been deemed necessary, the following items will need to be
clearly documented on/with the repair order:
- Customer concern in detail
- What corrected the customer concern?
- If a wheel alignment is performed:
- Consult SI for proper specifications.
- Document the "Before" AND "After" wheel alignment measurements/settings.
- Completed "Wheel Alignment Repair Order Questionnaire" (form attached to this bulletin)
1. Document the customer concern in as much detail as possible on the repair order and in the
warranty administration system. Preferred examples:
- Steering wheel is off angle in the counterclockwise direction by approximately x degrees or
clocking position.
- Vehicle lead/pulls to the right at approximately x-y mph. Vehicle will climb the road crown. Severe,
Moderate or Slight.
- RF and LF tires are wearing on the outside shoulders with severe feathering.
Important In the event of a lead/pull or steering wheel angle concern, please note the direction of
lead/pull (left or right) or direction of steering wheel angle (clockwise or counterclockwise) on the
repair order and within the warranty claim verbatim.
Important In the event of a tire wear concern, please note the position on the vehicle and where the
wear is occurring on the tire; i.e., the RF tire is wearing on the inside shoulder.
2. Document the technician's findings on cause and correction of the issue. Examples:
- Reset LF toe from 0.45 degrees to 0.10 degrees and RF toe from -0.25 degrees to 0.10 degrees
to correct the steering wheel angle from 5 degrees counterclockwise to 0 degrees.
- Reset LF camber from 0.25 degrees to -0.05 degrees to correct the cross-camber condition of
+0.30 degrees to 0.00 degrees on the vehicle.
- Front Sum toe was found to be 0.50 degrees, reset to 0.20 degrees.
3. Print-out the "Before" and "After" wheel alignment measurements/settings and attach them to the
Repair Order or if print-out capability is not
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications > Page 1300
available, measurements may also be clearly and legibly handwritten into the Wheel Alignment
Repair Order Questionnaire attached to this bulletin.
4. Attach the Wheel Alignment Repair Order Questionnaire below along with the print-out of
"Before" and "After" wheel alignment measurements to
the Repair Order and retain for use by GM.
Wheel Alignment Equipment and Process
Wheel alignments must be performed with a quality machine that will give accurate results when
performing checks. "External Reference" (image-based camera technology) is preferred. Please
refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 05-00-89-029B: General Motors Dealership Critical Equipment
Requirements and Recommendations.
Requirements:
- Computerized four wheel alignment system.
- Computer capable of printing before and after alignment reports.
- Computer capable of time and date stamp printout.
- Racking system must have jacking capability
- Racking system must be capable of level to 1.6 mm (1/16 in)
- Appropriate wheel stops and safety certification
- Built-in turn plates and slip plates
- Wheel clamps capable of attaching to 20" or larger wheels
- Racking capable of accepting any GM passenger car or light duty truck
- Operator properly trained and ASE-certified (U.S. only) in wheel alignment
Recommendations:
Racking should have front and rear jacking capability.
Equipment Maintenance and Calibration:
Alignment machines must be regularly calibrated in order to give correct information. Most
manufacturers recommend the following:
- Alignment machines with "internal reference" sensors should be checked (and calibrated, if
necessary) every six months.
- Alignment machines with "external reference" (image-based camera technology) should be
checked (and calibrated, if necessary) once a year.
- Racks must be kept level to within 1.6 mm (1/16 in).
- If any instrument that is part of the alignment machine is dropped or damaged in some way,
check the calibration immediately.
Check with the manufacturer of your specific equipment for their recommended service/calibration
schedule.
Wheel Alignment Process
When performing wheel alignment measurement and/or adjustment, the following steps should be
taken:
Preliminary Steps:
1. Verify that the vehicle has a full tank of fuel (compensate as necessary). 2. Inspect the wheels
and the tires for damage. 3. Inspect the tires for the proper inflation and irregular tire wear. 4.
Inspect the wheel bearings for excessive play. 5. Inspect all suspension and steering parts for
looseness, wear, or damage. 6. Inspect the steering wheel for excessive drag or poor return due to
stiff or rusted linkage or suspension components. 7. Inspect the vehicle trim height. 8. Compensate
for frame angle on targeted vehicles (refer to Wheel Alignment Specifications in SI).
Satisfactory vehicle operation may occur over a wide range of alignment angles. However, if the
wheel alignment angles are not within the range of specifications, adjust the wheel alignment to the
specifications. Refer to Wheel Alignment Specifications in SI. Give consideration to excess loads,
such as tool boxes, sample cases, etc. Follow the wheel alignment equipment manufacturer's
instructions.
Measure/Adjust:
Important Prior to making any adjustments to wheel alignment on a vehicle, technicians must verify
that the wheel alignment specifications loaded into their wheel alignment machine are up-to-date
by comparing these to the wheel alignment specifications for the appropriate model and model year
in SI. Using incorrect and/or outdated specifications may result in unnecessary adjustments,
irregular and/or premature tire wear and repeat customer concerns
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications > Page 1301
Important When performing adjustments to vehicles requiring a 4-wheel alignment, set the rear
wheel alignment angles first in order to obtain proper front wheel alignment angles.
Perform the following steps in order to measure the front and rear alignment angles:
1. Install the alignment equipment according to the manufacturer's instructions. 2. Jounce the front
and the rear bumpers 3 times prior to checking the wheel alignment. 3. Measure the alignment
angles and record the readings.
If necessary, adjust the wheel alignment to vehicle specification and record the before and after
measurements. Refer to Wheel Alignment Specifications in SI.
Important Technicians must refer to SI for the correct wheel alignment specifications. SI is the only
source of GM wheel alignment specifications that is kept up-to-date throughout the year.
Test drive vehicle to ensure proper repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications > Page 1302
Frame Angle Measurement (Express / Savana Only) ........
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications > Page 1303
What corrected the customer concern and was the repair verified?
Please Explain: .............
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Wheel Alignment
Specifications
Alignment: Specifications
Camber Service Allowed -0.40 to + 1.60
Service Preferred 0.6
Cross Camber (L-R) Service Allowed -0.5 to +0.5
Service Preferred 0
Caster-Left Wheel Service Allowed 2.0 to 4.0
Service Preferred 3.0
Caster-Right Wheel Service Allowed 2.50 to 4.50
Service Preferred 3.5
Cross Caster (L-R) Service Allowed -1 to 0
Service Preferred -0.5
Steering Wheel Angle Service Allowed -6.0 to +4.0
Service Preferred -1.0
Toe (Total) Service Allowed 0.20 to 0.20
Service Preferred 0
Z Trim Height Service Allowed 2.86 to 3.34 in
Service Preferred 3.10 in
D Trim Height Service Allowed 5.31 to 5.71 in
Service Preferred 5.50 in
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Wheel Alignment
Specifications > Page 1306
Alignment: Specifications
Z Trim Height RWD Service Allowed 2.86 to 3.34 in
Service Preferred 3.10 in
AWD Service Allowed 5.16 to 5.64 in
Service Preferred 5.40 in
D Trim Height ALL Service Allowed 5.31 to 5.71 in
Service Preferred 5.50 in
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 1307
Alignment: Description and Operation
Caster Description
Caster is the tilting of the uppermost point of the steering axis either forward or backward, when
viewed from the side of the vehicle. A backward tilt is positive (+) and a forward tilt is negative (-).
Caster influences directional control of the steering but does not affect the tire wear and is not
adjustable on this vehicle. Caster is affected by the vehicle height, therefore it is important to keep
the body at its designed height. Overloading the vehicle or a weak or sagging rear spring will affect
caster. When the rear of the vehicle is lower than its designated trim height, the front suspension
moves to a more positive caster. If the rear of the vehicle is higher than its designated trim height,
the front suspension moves to a less positive caster. With too little positive caster, steering may be
touchy at high speed and wheel returnability may be diminished when coming out of a turn. If one
wheel has more positive caster than the other, that wheel will pull toward the center of the vehicle.
This condition will cause the vehicle to pull or lead to the side with the least amount of positive
caster.
Camber Description
Camber is the tilting of the wheels from the vertical when viewed from the front of the vehicle.
When the wheels tilt outward at the top, the camber is positive (+). When the wheel tilts inward at
the top, the camber is negative (-). The amount of tilt is measured in degrees from the vertical.
Camber settings influence the directional control and the tire wear. Too much positive camber will
result in premature wear on the outside of the tire and cause excessive wear on the suspension
parts. Too much negative camber will result in premature wear on the inside of the tire and cause
excessive wear on the suspension parts. Unequal side-to-side camber of 1 degree or more will
cause the vehicle to pull or lead to the side with the most positive camber.
Toe Description
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 1308
Toe is a measurement of how much the front and/or rear wheels are turned in or out from a
straight-ahead position. When the wheels are turned in, toe is positive (+). When the wheels are
turned out, toe is negative (-). The actual amount of toe is normally only a fraction of a degree. The
purpose of toe is to ensure that the wheels roll parallel. Toe also offsets the small deflections of the
wheel support system that occur when the vehicle is rolling forward. In other words, with the vehicle
standing still and the wheels set with toe-in, the wheels tend to roll parallel on the road when the
vehicle is moving. Improper toe adjustment will cause premature tire wear and cause steering
instability.
Setback Description
Setback applies to both the front and the rear wheels. Setback is the amount that one wheel may
be aligned behind the other wheel. Setback may be the result of a road hazard or a collision. The
first clue is a caster difference from side-to-side of more than 1 degree.
Thrust Angles Description
The front wheels aim or steer the vehicle. The rear wheels control tracking. This tracking action
relates to the thrust angle (3). The thrust angle is the path that the rear wheels take. Ideally, the
thrust angle is geometrically aligned with the body centerline (2). In the illustration, toe-in is shown
on the left rear wheel, moving the thrust line (1) off center. The resulting deviation from the
centerline is the thrust angle.
Lead/Pull Description
Lead/pull is the deviation of the vehicle from a straight path, on a level road, without hand pressure
on the steering wheel. Lead/pull is usually caused by the following factors: Tire construction
- Uneven brake adjustment
- Wheel alignment
The way in which a tire is built may produce lead/pull. The rear tires will not cause lead.
Memory Steer Description
Memory steer is when the vehicle wants to lead or pull in the direction the driver previously turned
the vehicle. Additionally, after turning in the opposite direction, the vehicle will want to lead or pull in
that direction.
Wander Description
Wander is the undesired drifting or deviation of a vehicle to either side from a straight path with
hand pressure on the steering wheel. Wander is a symptom of the vehicle's sensitivity to external
disturbances, such as road crown and crosswind, and accentuated by poor on-center steering feel.
Scrub Radius Description
Ideally, the scrub radius is as small as possible. Normally, the SAI angle and the centerline of the
tire and the wheel intersect below the road surface,
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 1309
causing a positive scrub radius. With struts, the SAI angle is much larger than the long arm/short
arm type of suspension. This allows the SAI angle to intersect the camber angle above the road
surface, forming a negative scrub radius. The smaller the scrub radius, the better the directional
stability. Installing aftermarket wheels that have additional offset will dramatically increase the
scrub radius. The newly installed wheels may cause the centerline of the tires to move further away
from the spindle. This will increase the scrub radius. A large amount of scrub radius can cause
severe shimmy after hitting a bump. Four-wheel drive vehicles with large tires use a steering
damper to compensate for an increased scrub radius. Scrub radius is not directly measurable by
the conventional methods. Scrub radius is projected geometrically by engineers during the design
phase of the suspension.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Trim Height
Inspection
Alignment: Service and Repair Trim Height Inspection
Trim Height Inspection Procedure
Trim Height Measurements
Trim height is a predetermined measurement relating to vehicle ride height. Incorrect trim heights
can cause bottoming out over bumps, damage to the suspension components and symptoms
similar to wheel alignment problems. Check the trim heights when diagnosing suspension concerns
and before checking the wheel alignment. Perform the following before measuring the trim heights:
1. Set the tire pressures to the pressure shown on the certification label. 2. Check the fuel level.
Add additional weight if necessary to simulate a full tank. 3. Make sure the rear compartment is
empty except for the spare tire. 4. Make sure the vehicle is on a level surface, such as an
alignment rack. 5. Close the doors. 6. Close the hood. 7. All dimensions are measured vertical to
the ground. Trim heights should be within 13 mm (0.5 inch) to be considered correct.
Z Height Measurement
The Z height dimension measurement determines the proper ride height for the front end of the
vehicle. Vehicles equipped with torsion bars use an adjusting arm in order to adjust the Z height
dimension. Vehicles without torsion bars have no adjustment and could require replacement of
suspension components.
1. Lift the front bumper of the vehicle up about 38 mm (1.5 inch). 2. Gently remove your hands. Let
the vehicle settle. 3. Repeat this operation for a total of 3 times. 4. Measure from the pivot bolt
center line (3) down to the lower corner (5) of the lower ball joint (1) in order to obtain the Z height
measurement (4). 5. Push the front bumper of the vehicle down about 38 mm (1.5 inch). 6. Gently
remove your hands. 7. Allow the vehicle to settle into position. 8. Repeat the jouncing operation 2
more times for a total of 3 times. 9. Measure the Z dimension.
10. The true Z height dimension number is the average of the high and the low measurements.
Z Height Adjustment
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Trim Height
Inspection > Page 1312
1. For vehicles equipped with a torsion bar suspension, turn the bolt (1) that contacts the torsion
arm as needed. One revolution of the bolt (1) into
the nut, increases the Z height by approximately 6.0 mm (0.2 inch).
2. For vehicles without torsion bars replace damaged or worn components as necessary.
D Height Measurement
The D height dimension measurement determines the proper rear end ride height. There is no
adjustment procedure. Repair may require replacement of suspension components.
1. With the vehicle on a flat surface, lift upward on the rear bumper 38 mm (1.5 inch). 2. Gently
remove your hands. Allow the vehicle to settle into position. 3. Repeat the jouncing operation 2
more times for a total of 3 times.
4. Measure the D height by measuring the distance between the bumper bracket and the top of the
rear axle tube. 5. Push the rear bumper downward to 38 mm (1.5 inch). 6. Gently remove your
hands. Allow the vehicle to settle into position. 7. Repeat the jouncing operation 2 more times for a
total of 3 times. 8. Measure the D height dimension. 9. The true D height dimension number is the
average of the high and the low measurements.
10. If these measurements are out of specifications, inspect for the following conditions:
- Sagging front suspension.
- Worn rear suspension components, such as leaf spring bushings.
- Improper tire inflation.
- Improper weight distribution.
- Collision damage.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Trim Height
Inspection > Page 1313
Alignment: Service and Repair Measuring Wheel Alignment
Measuring Wheel Alignment
Steering and vibration complaints are not always the result of improper alignment. One possible
cause is wheel and tire imbalance. Another possibility is tire lead due to worn or improperly
manufactured tires. Lead is the vehicle deviation from a straight path on a level road without
pressure on the steering wheel. Refer to Radial Tire Lead/Pull Correction in order to determine if
the vehicle has a tire lead problem. Before performing any adjustment affecting wheel alignment,
perform the following inspections and adjustments in order to ensure correct alignment readings: Inspect the tires for the proper inflation and irregular tire wear.
- Inspect the runout of the wheels and the tires.
- Inspect the wheel bearings for backlash and excessive play.
- Inspect the ball joints and tie rod ends for looseness or wear.
- Inspect the control arms and stabilizer shaft for looseness or wear.
- Inspect the steering gear for looseness at the frame.
- Inspect the struts/shock absorbers for wear, leaks, and any noticeable noises.
- Inspect the vehicle trim height.
- Inspect the steering wheel for excessive drag or poor return due to stiff or rusted linkage or
suspension components.
- Inspect the fuel level. The fuel tank should be full or the vehicle should have a compensating load
added.
Give consideration to excess loads, such as tool boxes, sample cases, etc. If normally carried in
the vehicle, these items should remain in the vehicle during alignment adjustments. Give
consideration also to the condition of the equipment being used for the alignment. Follow the
equipment manufacturer's instructions. Satisfactory vehicle operation may occur over a wide range
of alignment settings. However, if the setting exceeds the service allowable specifications, correct
the alignment to the service preferred specifications. Perform the following steps in order to
measure the front and rear alignment angles:
1. Install the alignment equipment according to the manufacturer's instructions. 2. Jounce the front
and the rear bumpers 3 times prior to checking the wheel alignment. 3. Measure the alignment
angles and record the readings.
Important: When performing adjustments to vehicles requiring a 4-wheel alignment, set the rear
wheel alignment angles first in order to obtain proper front alignment angles.
4. Adjust alignment angles to vehicle specification, if necessary.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Trim Height
Inspection > Page 1314
Alignment: Service and Repair Front Wheel Alignment
Front Caster and Camber Adjustment
Front Caster and Camber Adjustment
The caster and the camber adjustments are made by inserting shims between the upper control
arm shaft and the frame bracket. The shims may be added, subtracted, or transferred in order to
change the readings.
Important: Before adjusting the caster and the camber angles, jounce the front bumper 3 times to allow the
vehicle to return to the normal height.
- Measure and adjust the caster and the camber with the vehicle at curb height. The front
suspension Z dimension and the rear suspension D dimension are indicated in Trim Heights.
- When checking the left and the right side caster and camber, it must be equal within 1.0 degree.
- When setting the left and the right side caster and camber, it must be equal within 0.50 degree.
- The caster and the camber set is relative to the ground.
1. Loosen the upper control arm shaft to frame nuts (1).
Important: A normal shim pack will leave at least 24/~ threads of the bolt exposed beyond the nut. The
maximum shim pack cannot be thicker than 21.3 mm (0.84 inch).
- The difference between the front shim packs and the rear shim packs must not exceed 10 mm
(0.40 inch). If these requirements cannot be met, check for damaged control arms and damaged
related parts.
2. If the caster is not within specifications, adjust the caster by transferring the front shims to the
rear, or the rear shims to the front. The transfer of
the one shim from the rear bolt to the front bolt will decrease the positive caster.
3. If the camber is not within specification, adjust the camber by changing the shims at both the
front and the rear of the shaft. Add or subtract the
shims (2) as required. Adding an equal number of shims at both the front and rear of the cross
shaft will decrease positive camber.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Tighten the nut on the thinner shim pack first.
- Tighten the nuts to 110 Nm (81 ft. lbs.). Tightening the nut on the thinner shim pack first improves
the shaft to frame clamping force and torque retention.
5. Check the toe-in after changing the caster or the camber.
Front Wheel Toe Adjustment
Front Toe Adjustment
The toe-in can be increased or decreased by changing the length of the tie rods. A threaded sleeve
is provided for this purpose. When the tie rods are mounted ahead of the steering knuckle, the tie
rods must be modified as follows: Decreased in length in order to increase the toe-in. Increased in length in order to decrease the
toe-in.
Important: When checking and setting the toe-in, the left and right side to be set separately and the steering
wheel must be held straight ahead position within 4 - 6 degrees. Before adjusting the toe-in, jounce
the front bumper 3 times to allow the vehicle to return to the normal height.
- Adjust the toe-in with the vehicle at curb height. The front suspension Z dimension and the rear
suspension D dimension are indicated in Trim Heights.
- For an accurate toe-in reading, do not push or pull on the tires during the alignment process.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Trim Height
Inspection > Page 1315
1. Set the steering wheel in the straight ahead position. 2. Loosen the clamp bolts at each end of
the steering tie rod adjustable sleeves.
Important: The tie rod adjuster often becomes rusted in service.
3. If the torque needed to rotate the adjuster tube exceeds 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.), perform the
following steps:
3.1. Remove the adjuster tube clamp nuts and the bolts. Discard the nuts and the bolts.
3.2. Apply the penetrating oil between the adjuster tube and the tie rod threads.
3.3. Rotate the adjuster tube until the tube moves freely.
3.4. Install the new bolts and the nuts with the correct part number. The nut must be towards the
front of the vehicle.
4. Rotate the inner and the outer tie rod sockets rearward to the limit of the ball stud travel.
5. Turn the tie rod adjusting sleeves to set the toe-in to specifications.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Important: Before tightening the adjuster tube nuts, do the following: Check the number of threads on each tie rod within the adjuster tube. The tie rod threads within the
adjuster tube must be equal to within 3 threads.
- Check the relationship of the adjuster tube to the clamp. The adjuster tube slot and the clamp
opening must not be in the same position. The position of the adjuster tube clamp must not exceed
30 degrees in either direction.
- The adjuster tube clamp must be on the inside of the adjuster tube dimple.
6. Tighten the adjuster tube clamp nuts.
- Tighten the adjuster tube clamp nuts to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). The clamp ends may touch when the
nuts are tightened to specification.
7. Rotate the tie rod sockets to the centered position.
Ensure that the outer socket is square with the stud.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > Fuel Pressure
Test Port > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System
Information > Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Information not supplied by the manufacturer.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air
Cleaner Restriction Indicator > Component Information > Description and Operation
Air Cleaner Restriction Indicator: Description and Operation
The air cleaner restriction indicator is located on the intake duct between the air cleaner assembly
and the Mass Air Flow/Intake Air Temperature ( MAF/IAT) sensor.
If the area inside of the clear section is green, no air filter service is required. If the area inside the
clear section is orange and Change Air Filter appears, replace the air filter.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air Filter Element: >
04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: Customer Interest Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air Filter Element: >
04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 1336
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 1342
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1343
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER ELEMENT REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the air cleaner cover by releasing the retainer clips. 2. Remove the air cleaner element.
3. Clear out any debris in the air cleaner tub.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Insert the air cleaner element into the air cleaner tub. 2. Install the air cleaner cover. 3. Fasten
the air cleaner cover retainer clips.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure
Release > System Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 34730-1A Fuel Pressure Gage
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Gasoline/Gasoline Vapors Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Remove the engine cover.
CAUTION: Refer to Fuel Gage Leak Caution in Service Precautions.
NOTE: Clean all of the following areas before performing any disconnections in order to avoid
possible contamination in the system: ^
The fuel pipe connections
^ The hose connections
^ The areas surrounding the connections
2. Install the J 34730-1A to the fuel pressure service connection. 3. Turn ON the ignition.
CAUTION: Refer to Fuel Storage Caution in Service Precautions.
4. Place the bleed hose of the fuel pressure gage into an approved gasoline container. 5. Open the
bleed valve on the fuel pressure gage in order to bleed the air from the fuel pressure gage. 6.
Command the fuel pump ON with a scan tool. 7. Close the bleed valve on the fuel pressure gage.
8. Inspect for fuel leaks.
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure
Release > System Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal > Page 1349
1. Place the fuel pressure gage bleed hose into an approved container and open the bleed valve to
bleed OFF fuel system pressure. 2. Place a shop towel under the J 34730-1A to catch any
remaining fuel spillage. 3. Remove the J 34730-1A from the fuel pressure connection. 4. Drain any
fuel remaining in the fuel pressure gage into an approved container. 5. Inspect for leaks using the
following procedure:
5.1. Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF for 2 seconds.
5.2. Turn OFF the ignition for 10 seconds.
5.3. Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
5.4. Inspect for fuel leaks.
6. Install the cap on the fuel pressure connection. 7. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure
Release > System Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal > Page 1350
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair Fuel System Pressure Relief
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 34730-1A Fuel Pressure Gage
CAUTION: Remove the fuel tank cap and relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing the fuel
system in order to reduce the risk of personal injury. After you relieve the fuel system pressure, a
small amount of fuel may be released when servicing the fuel lines, the fuel injection pump, or the
connections. In order to reduce the risk of personal injury, cover the fuel system components with a
shop towel before disconnection. This will catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an
approved container when the disconnection is complete.
1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Disconnect the negative battery cable in order to avoid possible fuel
discharge if an accidental attempt is made to start the engine. 3. Remove the engine cover. 4.
Connect the J 34730-1A or the equivalent to the fuel pressure connection. 5. Wrap a shop towel
around the fitting while connecting the gage in order to avoid spillage. 6. Install the bleed hose of
the gage into an approved container. 7. Open the valve on the gage in order to bleed the system
pressure. The fuel connections are now safe for servicing. 8. Drain any fuel remaining in the gage
into an approved container.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Spark Plug Wire Inspection
Ignition Cable: Service and Repair Spark Plug Wire Inspection
Spark plug wire integrity is vital for proper engine operation. A thorough inspection will be
necessary to accurately identify conditions that may affect engine operation. Inspect for the
following conditions:
1. Correct routing of the spark plug wires - Incorrect routing may cause cross-firing. 2. Any signs of
cracks or splits in the wires. 3. Inspect each boot for the following conditions:
^ Tearing
^ Piercing
^ Arcing
^ Carbon tracking
^ Corroded terminal
If corrosion, carbon tracking or arcing are indicated on a spark plug wire boot or on a terminal,
replace the wire and the component connected to the wire.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Spark Plug Wire Inspection > Page 1355
Ignition Cable: Service and Repair Spark Plug Wire Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the spark plug wire at each spark plug.
^ Twist the boots 1/2 turn before removing the boots.
^ Pull only on the boot or use a tool designed for this purpose in order to remove the wire from
each spark plug.
2. Disconnect the spark plug wire from the distributor.
^ Twist each spark plug boot 1/2 turn.
^ Pull only on the boot or use a tool designed for this purpose in order to remove the wires from the
distributor.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: If the boot to wire movement has occurred, the boot will give a false visual impression of
being fully seated. Ensure that the boots have been properly assembled by pushing sideways on
the installed boots. Failure to properly seat the terminal onto the spark plug will lead to wire core
erosion and result in an engine misfire or crossfire condition, and possible internal damage to the
engine.
1. Install the spark plug wires at the distributor. 2. Install the spark plug wire to each spark plug. 3.
Inspect the wires for proper installation:
3.1. Push sideways on each boot in order to inspect the seating.
3.2. Reinstall any loose boot.
3.3. Wire routings must be kept intact during service and followed exactly when wires have been
disconnected or when replacement of the wires is necessary. Failure to route the wires properly
can lead to radio ignition noise and crossfiring of the plugs, or shorting of the leads to the ground.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Spark Plug Wire Inspection > Page 1356
3.4. Any time the spark plug wires or boots are installed on the spark plugs, new dielectric grease
needs to be applied inside the boot.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Distributor: > 03-06-04-041A > Jan > 05 >
Ignition System - SES Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300
Distributor: Customer Interest Ignition System - SES Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300
Bulletin No.: 03-06-04-041A
Date: January 28, 2005
TECHNICAL
Subject: Poor Engine Performance - Misfire, Rough Idle, Stalls, Engine Cranks but Does Not Run,
Service Engine Soon/Check Engine Light Illuminated, DTC P0300 Set (Inspect Distributor Ignition
(DI) System Components and Replace As Necessary)
Models: 2001-2003 Chevrolet Astro, Blazer, Express, S-10 2001-2003 GMC Jimmy, Safari,
Savana, Sonoma 2001 Oldsmobile Bravada
with 4.3L, 5.0L or 5.7L Gas Engine (VINs W, X, M, R - RPOs L35, LU3, L30, L31)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to delete a model and add information to subject and inspection of
distributor vent screens. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 03-06-04-041 (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on poor engine performance and the Service Engine Soon/Check
Engine light being illuminated. Upon investigation, the technician may find DTC P0300 set.
Cause
This condition may be due to high levels of internal corrosion in the distributor, causing misfire,
rough idle, stall and Engine Cranks But Does Not Run. This corrosion is attributed to a lack of
airflow internal to the cap caused by the vent screens being clogged with debris.
Correction
Remove the vent screens and inspect the internal components of the Distributor Ignition System
using the procedure listed below. If the distributor base has to be replaced, the vent screens will
also have to be removed on the new distributor. If there is evidence of this internal corrosion,
replace the affected component. Refer to the appropriate procedure in the Engine Controls
sub-section of the applicable Service Manual.
Important:
All of these inspections can be done on-vehicle.
1. Inspect the distributor cap. You may notice a white residue on the cap walls. For higher mileage
occurrences, the interior of the cap may have changed to medium brown in color
2. Inspect the distributor rotor. You may notice the presence of black streaks on the plastic surface.
More typical evidence would be visible green spots on the copper surface of the rotor segment.
3. Inspect the distributor base. You may notice high levels of surface rust on the distributor shaft or
surface contamination on the sensor hold down screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Distributor: > 03-06-04-041A > Jan > 05 >
Ignition System - SES Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300 > Page 1365
4. Inspect the distributor vent screens (1). If the vent screens are present, remove them by using a
plastic-handled, long blade awl or pick (2). Insert into the airflow vent screens and pop them out.
Refer to the figure for removal procedure. If the vent screens have been removed from the base of
the distributor, then check the airflow inlets for being clogged with debris.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Distributor: > 03-06-04-041A > Jan > 05 >
Ignition System - SES Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300 > Page 1366
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Distributor: > 03-06-04-041A >
Jan > 05 > Ignition System - SES Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300
Distributor: All Technical Service Bulletins Ignition System - SES Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300
Bulletin No.: 03-06-04-041A
Date: January 28, 2005
TECHNICAL
Subject: Poor Engine Performance - Misfire, Rough Idle, Stalls, Engine Cranks but Does Not Run,
Service Engine Soon/Check Engine Light Illuminated, DTC P0300 Set (Inspect Distributor Ignition
(DI) System Components and Replace As Necessary)
Models: 2001-2003 Chevrolet Astro, Blazer, Express, S-10 2001-2003 GMC Jimmy, Safari,
Savana, Sonoma 2001 Oldsmobile Bravada
with 4.3L, 5.0L or 5.7L Gas Engine (VINs W, X, M, R - RPOs L35, LU3, L30, L31)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to delete a model and add information to subject and inspection of
distributor vent screens. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 03-06-04-041 (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on poor engine performance and the Service Engine Soon/Check
Engine light being illuminated. Upon investigation, the technician may find DTC P0300 set.
Cause
This condition may be due to high levels of internal corrosion in the distributor, causing misfire,
rough idle, stall and Engine Cranks But Does Not Run. This corrosion is attributed to a lack of
airflow internal to the cap caused by the vent screens being clogged with debris.
Correction
Remove the vent screens and inspect the internal components of the Distributor Ignition System
using the procedure listed below. If the distributor base has to be replaced, the vent screens will
also have to be removed on the new distributor. If there is evidence of this internal corrosion,
replace the affected component. Refer to the appropriate procedure in the Engine Controls
sub-section of the applicable Service Manual.
Important:
All of these inspections can be done on-vehicle.
1. Inspect the distributor cap. You may notice a white residue on the cap walls. For higher mileage
occurrences, the interior of the cap may have changed to medium brown in color
2. Inspect the distributor rotor. You may notice the presence of black streaks on the plastic surface.
More typical evidence would be visible green spots on the copper surface of the rotor segment.
3. Inspect the distributor base. You may notice high levels of surface rust on the distributor shaft or
surface contamination on the sensor hold down screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Distributor: > 03-06-04-041A >
Jan > 05 > Ignition System - SES Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300 > Page 1372
4. Inspect the distributor vent screens (1). If the vent screens are present, remove them by using a
plastic-handled, long blade awl or pick (2). Insert into the airflow vent screens and pop them out.
Refer to the figure for removal procedure. If the vent screens have been removed from the base of
the distributor, then check the airflow inlets for being clogged with debris.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Distributor: > 03-06-04-041A >
Jan > 05 > Ignition System - SES Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300 > Page 1373
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul
Distributor: Service and Repair Distributor Overhaul
DISASSEMBLY PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover.
NOTE: The ignition system distributor driven gear and rotor may be installed in multiple positions.
In order to avoid mistakes, mark the distributor on the following components in order to ensure the
same mounting position upon reassembly: ^
The distributor driven gear
^ The distributor shaft
^ The rotor holes
Installing the driven gear 180 degrees out of alignment, or locating the rotor in the wrong holes, will
cause a no-start condition. Premature engine wear or damage may result.
2. Align white paint mark on the bottom stem of the distributor, and the pre-drilled indent hole in the
bottom of the gear (2). 3. With the gear in this position, the rotor segment should be positioned as
shown for a V6 engine (1). If not, replace the distributor.
4. Remove the 2 screws from the rotor. 5. Remove the rotor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 1376
6. Note the locating holes that the rotor was removed from:
^ The rotor screw holes (1)
^ The rotor locator pin holes (2)
7. Line up the square-cut hole in the vane wheel with the CMP sensor.
8. Remove the 2 screws that hold the camshaft position (CMP) sensor. 9. Discard the screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 1377
10. Remove the CMP sensor. 11. Note the dimple located below the roll pin hole on one side of the
gear. The dimple will be used to properly orient the gear onto the shaft during
reassembly.
CAUTION: Refer to Safety Glasses Caution in Service Precautions.
12. Support the distributor drive gear in a V-block or similar fixture. 13. Drive out the roll pin with a
suitable punch.
14. Remove the driven gear from the distributor shaft. 15. Remove the round washer. 16. Remove
the tang washer. 17. Remove the shim washer (1).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 1378
18. Remove the old oil seal.
ASSEMBLY PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: Installing the driven gear 180 degrees out of alignment, or locating the rotor in the
wrong holes, will cause a no-start condition. Premature engine wear or damage may result.
1. Line up the square-cut hole in the vane wheel for the camshaft position (CMP) sensor.
2. Insert the sensor into the housing.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 1379
3. Install two new screws for the camshaft position (CMP) sensor.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2.2 N.m (19 lb in).
4. Identity the correct rotor mounting position:
^ At the rotor screw holes (1)
^ At the rotor locator pin holes (2)
5. Install the distributor rotor according to the index marks. 6. Install two rotor hold down screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 1.9 N.m (17 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 1380
7. Install the shim washer (1) on the bottom of the distributor shaft. 8. Install the tang washer. 9.
Install the round washer.
10. Install the driven gear according to the index marks.
11. Align the rotor segment as shown for a V6 engine (1) or V8 engine (2). 12. Install the gear and
align white paint mark on the bottom stem of the distributor, and the pre-drilled indent hole in the
bottom of the gear (3). 13. Check to see if the driven gear is installed incorrectly. On an incorrectly
installed driven gear, the dimple will be approximately 180 degrees
opposite the rotor segment when the gear is installed in the distributor.
CAUTION: Refer to Safety Glasses Caution in Service Precautions.
14. Support the distributor drive gear in a V-block or similar fixture. 15. Install the roll pin with a
suitable punch and hammer in order to hold the driven gear in the correct position.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 1381
16. Install the new oil seal under the mounting flange of the distributor base. 17. Install the
distributor. 18. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 1382
Distributor: Service and Repair Distributor Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
NOTE: There are two procedures available to install the distributor.
Use Installation Procedure 1 when the crankshaft has NOT been rotated from the original position.
Use Installation Procedure 2 when any of the following components are removed: ^
The intake manifold
^ The cylinder head
^ The camshaft
^ The timing chain or sprockets
^ The complete engine
If the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) turns on and DTC P1345 sets after installing the distributor,
this indicates an incorrectly installed distributor.
Engine damage or distributor damage may occur. Use Procedure 2 in order to install the distributor.
1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Remove the engine cover. 3. Remove air cleaner assembly. 4. Remove
the air intake resonator assembly. 5. Remove the spark plug wires from the distributor cap.
^ Twist each spark plug 1/2 turn.
^ Pull only on the wire boot in order to remove the wire from the distributor cap.
6. Remove the electrical connector from the base of the distributor.
7. Remove the 2 screws that retain the distributor cap to the housing. 8. Discard the screws. 9.
Remove the distributor cap from the housing.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 1383
10. Use a grease pencil in order to mark the position of the rotor in relation to the distributor
housing (1). 11. Mark the distributor housing and the intake manifold with the grease pencil.
12. As the distributor is being removed from the engine, watch the rotor move in a
counter-clockwise direction about 42 degrees. This will appear as
slightly more than one clock position.
13. Note the position of the rotor segment. 14. Place a second mark on the base of the distributor
(2).
This will aid in achieving the proper rotor alignment during the distributor installation.
15. Remove the mounting clamp hold-down bolt. 16. Remove the distributor.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 1384
1. If installing a new distributor assembly, place 2 marks on the new distributor housing in the same
location as the marks on the original housing. 2. Remove the new distributor cap, if necessary. 3.
Align the rotor with the second mark (2).
4. Guide the distributor into the engine. 5. Align the hole in the distributor hold-down base over the
mounting hole in the intake manifold.
6. As the distributor is being installed, observe the rotor moving in a clockwise direction about 42
degrees. 7. Once the distributor is completely seated, the rotor segment should be aligned with the
mark on the distributor base (1).
^ If the rotor segment is not aligned with the mark, the driven gear teeth and the camshaft have
meshed one or more teeth out of alignment.
^ In order to correct this condition, remove and reinstall the distributor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 1385
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
8. Install the distributor mounting clamp bolt.
Tighten Tighten the bolt to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
9. Install the distributor cap.
10. Install the new distributor cap screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2.4 N.m (21 lb in).
11. Install the electrical connector to the distributor. 12. Install the spark plug wires to the distributor
cap.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 1386
13. Install the ignition coil wire. Note the correct orientation of the wire boot.
IMPORTANT: If the malfunction indicator lamp illuminates after installing the distributor and DTC
P1345 is set, the distributor has been installed incorrectly.
14. Refer to Installation Procedure 2 if the malfunction indicator lamp illuminates after installing the
distributor. 15. Install the engine cover.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 2
IMPORTANT: Rotate the number 1 cylinder to top dead center (TDC) of the compression stroke.
The engine front cover has 2 alignment tabs and the crankshaft balancer has 2 alignment marks
spaced 90 degrees apart which are used for positioning the number 1 piston at TDC. With the
piston on the compression stroke and at TDC, the crankshaft balancer alignment mark (1) must
align with the engine front cover tab (2) and the crankshaft balancer alignment mark (4) must align
with the engine front cover tab (3).
1. Rotate the crankshaft balancer clockwise until the alignment marks on the crankshaft balancer
are aligned with the tabs on the engine front cover
and the number 1 piston is at TDC of the compression stroke.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 1387
2. Align the white paint mark on the bottom stem of the distributor and the pre-drilled indent hole in
the bottom of the gear (3).
NOTE: The ignition system distributor driven gear and rotor may be installed in multiple positions.
In order to avoid mistakes, mark the distributor on the following components in order to ensure the
same mounting position upon reassembly: ^
The distributor driven gear
^ The distributor shaft
^ The rotor holes
Installing the driven gear 180 degrees out of alignment, or locating the rotor in the wrong holes, will
cause a no-start condition. Premature engine wear or damage may result.
3. With the gear in this position, the rotor segment should be positioned as shown for a V6 engine
(1).
^ The alignment will not be exact.
^ If the driven gear is installed incorrectly, the dimple Will be approximately 180 degrees opposite
of the rotor segment when installed in the distributor.
4. Use a long screw driver in order to align the oil pump drive shaft to the drive tab of the
distributor. 5. Guide the distributor into the engine.
Ensure the flat portion of the distributor housing is facing toward the front of the engine.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 1388
6. Once the distributor is fully seated, the rotor segment should be aligned with the pointer cast into
the distributor base.
If the rotor segment does not come within a few degrees of the pointer, repeat the procedure in
order to achieve the proper alignment.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
7. Install the distributor mounting clamp bolt.
Tighten Tighten the bolt to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 1389
8. Install the distributor cap. 9. Install the new distributor cap screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2.4 N.m (21 lb in).
10. Install the electrical connector to the distributor. 11. Install the spark plug wires to the distributor
cap.
12. Install the ignition coil wire. Note the correct orientation of the wire boot.
IMPORTANT: If the malfunction indicator lamp illuminates after installing the distributor and DTC
P1345 is set, the distributor has been installed incorrectly.
13. Repeat Installation Procedure 2 if the malfunction indicator lamp illuminates after installing the
distributor. 14. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 1390
Distributor: Service and Repair Distributor Inspection
1. Remove the engine cover.
IMPORTANT: Discoloration of the cap and some whitish build up around the cap terminals is
normal. Yellowing of the rotor cap, darkening and some carbon build up under the rotor segment is
normal. Replacement of the cap and the rotor is not necessary unless there is a driveability
concern.
2. Inspect the cap for cracks, tiny holes or carbon tracks between the cap terminal traces.
Diagnose the carbon tracks using the following procedure:
2.1. Remove the cap.
2.2. Place 1 lead from the DMM on a cap terminal.
2.3. Use the other lead in order to probe all other terminals and the center carbon ball.
2.4. Move the base lead to the next terminal. Probe all other leads.
2.5. Continue this procedure until you test all the secondary terminals.
2.6. If there are any non-infinite readings, replace the cap.
3. Inspect the cap for excess build-up of corrosion on the terminals. Scrape clean the terminals.
Replace the cap if the corrosion is excessive. Some
buildup is normal.
4. Inspect the rotor segment for excess wear. Replace the rotor if excess looseness in the rotor
segment is present. 5. Inspect the shaft for shaft-to-bushing looseness:
5.1. Inspect the housing for cracks or damage.
5.2. Insert the shaft in the housing.
5.3. If the shaft wobbles, replace the housing assembly.
6. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Specifications
Spark Plug: Specifications Ignition System Specifications
Ignition System Specifications
Spark Plug Torque 15 N.m
Spark Plug Gap 1.52 mm
Spark Plug Type R41-932 [AC plug type]
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1394
Spark Plug: Application and ID
Spark Plug ...........................................................................................................................................
............................................ R41-932 (AC plug type)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Spark Plug Inspection
Spark Plug: Service and Repair Spark Plug Inspection
SPARK PLUG USAGE
1. Ensure that the correct spark plug is installed. An incorrect spark plug causes driveability
conditions. Refer to Ignition System Specifications for
the correct spark plug.
2. Ensure that the spark plug has the correct heat range. An incorrect heat range causes the
following conditions:
^ Spark plug fouling - Colder plug
^ Pre-ignition causing spark plug and/or engine damage - Hotter plug
SPARK PLUG INSPECTION
1. Inspect the terminal post (1) for damage.
^ Inspect for a bent or broken terminal post (1).
^ Test for a loose terminal post (1) by twisting and pulling the post. The terminal post (1) should
NOT move.
2. Inspect the insulator (2) for flashover or carbon tracking, soot. This is caused by the electrical
charge traveling across the insulator (2) between the
terminal post (1) and ground. Inspect for the following conditions: ^
Inspect the spark plug boot for damage.
^ Inspect the spark plug recess area of the cylinder head for moisture, such as oil, coolant, or
water. A spark plug boot that is saturated causes arcing to ground.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Spark Plug Inspection > Page 1397
3. Inspect the insulator (2) for cracks. All or part of the electrical charge may arc through the crack
instead of the electrodes (3, 4).
4. Inspect for evidence of improper arcing.
^ Measure the gap between the center electrode (4) and the side electrode (3) terminals. An
excessively wide electrode gap can prevent correct spark plug operation.
^ Inspect for the correct spark plug torque. Refer to Ignition System Specifications. Insufficient
torque can prevent correct spark plug operation. An over torqued spark plug, causes the insulator
(2) to crack.
^ Inspect for signs of tracking that occurred near the insulator tip instead of the center electrode (4).
^ Inspect for a broken or worn side electrode (3).
^ Inspect for a broken, worn, or loose center electrode (4) by shaking the spark plug. A rattling sound indicates internal damage.
- A loose center electrode (4) reduces the spark intensity.
^ Inspect for bridged electrodes (3, 4). Deposits on the electrodes (3, 4) reduce or eliminates the
gap.
^ Inspect for worn or missing platinum pads on the electrodes (3, 4), if equipped.
^ Inspect for excessive fouling.
5. Inspect the spark plug recess area of the cylinder head for debris. Dirty or damaged threads can
cause the spark plug not to seat correctly during
installation.
SPARK PLUG VISUAL INSPECTION
1. Normal operation - Brown to grayish-tan with small amounts of white powdery deposits are
normal combustion by-products from fuels with
additives.
2. Carbon Fouled - Dry, fluffy black carbon, or soot caused by the following conditions:
^ Rich fuel mixtures Leaking fuel injectors
- Excessive fuel pressure
- Restricted air filter element
- Incorrect combustion
^ Reduced ignition system voltage output
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Spark Plug Inspection > Page 1398
- Weak coils
- Worn ignition wires
- Incorrect spark plug gap
^ Excessive idling or slow speeds under light loads can keep spark plug temperatures so low that
normal combustion deposits may not burn off.
3. Deposit Fouling - Oil, coolant, or additives that include substances such as silicone, very white
coating, reduces the spark intensity. Most powdery
deposits will not effect spark intensity unless they form into a glazing over the electrode.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Spark Plug Inspection > Page 1399
Spark Plug: Service and Repair Spark Plug Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the spark plug wires. 2. Loosen each spark plug 1 or 2 turns. 3. Brush or air blast away
any dirt from around the spark plugs. 4. Remove the spark plugs 1 at a time. Place each plug in a
tray marked with the corresponding cylinder numbers.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Properly position each spark plug washer. 2. Inspect each spark plug gap. Adjust each plug as
needed
Specification Spark plug gap: 1.524 mm (0.060 in).
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Hand start the spark plugs in the corresponding cylinders. 4. Tighten the spark plugs.
Tighten ^
For used heads tighten the spark plugs to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
^ For new aluminum heads tighten the spark plugs to 20 N.m (15 lb ft).
^ For new iron heads tighten the spark plugs to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
5. Install the spark plug wires.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check > System
Information > System Diagnosis
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
Normal
The compression builds up quickly and evenly to the specified compression.
Leaking
The compression is low on the first compression stroke. The compression builds up with the
following strokes, but does not reach the specified compression.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine
- Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics
Drive Belt: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-06-01-008A
Date: July 27, 2009
Subject: Diagnosing Accessory Drive Belt / Serpentine Belt Noise and Availability and Use of
Kent-Moore EN-49228 Laser Alignment Tool - Drive Belt
Models:
2010 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 Vehicles 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add a model year and update the Tool Information.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 08-06-01-008 (Section 06 - Engine).
Background
Several aftermarket companies offer laser alignment tools for accessory drive systems that can be
very helpful in eliminating drive belt noise as a result of misaligned pulleys. Typically pricing ranges
from $160 - $200.
EN-49228 Laser Alignment Tool - Drive Belt
The GM Tool program has now made available a competitive, simple to use and time-saving laser
tool to assist in achieving precise alignment of the drive belt pulleys. This optional tool removes the
guesswork from proper pulley alignment and may serve to reduce comebacks from:
- Drive Belt Noise
- Accelerated Drive Belt Wear
- Drive Belt Slippage
Instructions
The instructions below are specific only to the truck Gen IV V-8 family of engines. These
instructions are only for illustrative purposes to show how the tool may be used. Universal
instructions are included in the box with the Laser Alignment Tool - Drive Belt.
Caution
- Do not look directly into the beam projected from the laser.
- Use caution when shining the laser on highly polished or reflective surfaces. Laser safety glasses
help reduce laser beam glare in many circumstances.
- Always use laser safety glasses when using the laser. Laser safety glasses are not designed to
protect eyes from direct laser exposure.
1. Observe and mark the serpentine belt orientation.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine
- Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics > Page 1407
2. Remove the serpentine belt from the accessory drive system.
3. Install the tool onto the power steering pulley. Position the legs of the tool into the outer grooves
of the pulley, farthest from the front of the
engine.
4. Install the retaining cord around the pulley and to the legs of the tool.
5. Put on the laser safety glasses provided with the tool. 6. Depress the switch on the rear of the
tool to activate the light beam. 7. Rotate the power steering pulley as required to project the light
beam onto the crankshaft balancer pulley grooves. 8. Inspect for proper power steering pulley
alignment.
- If the laser beam projects onto the second rib or raised area (1), the pulleys are aligned properly.
- If the laser beam projects more than one-quarter rib 0.9 mm (0.035 in) mis-alignment, adjust the
position of the power steering pulley as required.
- Refer to SI for Power Steering Pulley Removal and Installation procedures.
9. Install the serpentine belt to the accessory drive system in the original orientation.
10. Operate the vehicle and verify that the belt noise concern is no longer present.
Tool Information
Please visit the GM service tool website for pricing information or to place your order for this tool.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine
- Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics > Page 1408
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine
- Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics > Page 1409
Drive Belt: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Serpentine Drive Belt Wear Information
Bulletin No.: 04-06-01-013
Date: April 29, 2004
INFORMATION
Subject: Information on Serpentine Belt Wear
Models: 2004 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks 2003-2004 and Prior HUMMER H2
All current GM vehicles designed and manufactured in North America were assembled with
serpentine belts that are made with an EPDM material and should last the life of the vehicle. It is
extremely rare to observe any cracks in EPDM belts and it is not expected that they will require
maintenance before 10 years or 240,000 km (150,000 mi) of use.
Older style belts, which were manufactured with a chloroprene compound, may exhibit cracks
depending on age. However, the onset of cracking typically signals that the belt is only about
halfway through its usable life.
A good rule of thumb for chloroprene-based belts is that if cracks are observed 3 mm (1/8 in) apart,
ALL AROUND THE BELT, the belt may be reaching the end of its serviceable life and should be
considered a candidate for changing. Small cracks spaced at greater intervals should not be
considered as indicative that the belt needs changing.
Any belt that exhibits chunking should be replaced.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Belt
Chirping
Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection Drive Belt Chirping
Drive Belt Chirping Diagnosis
Diagnostic Aids
The symptom may be intermittent due to moisture on the drive belt(s) or the pulleys. It may be
necessary to spray a small amount of water on the drive belt(s) in order to duplicate the customers
concern. If spraying water on the drive belt(s) duplicates the symptom, cleaning the belt pulleys
may be the probable solution. A loose or incorrect installation of a body component, a suspension
component, or other items of the vehicle may cause the chirping noise.
Test Description
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. The noise may not be
engine related. This step verifies that the engine is making the noise. If the engine is not making
the noise do not proceed
further with this table.
3. The noise may be an internal engine noise. Removing the drive belt and operating the engine
verifies the noise is related to the drive belt. When
removing the drive belt(s) the water pump may not be operating and cause the engine to overheat.
Also DTCs may set if the engine is operating with the drive belt removed.
4. Inspect all drive belt pulleys for pilling. Pilling is the small balls or strings in the drive belt
grooves. Pilling occurs from the accumulation of
rubber dust.
6. Misalignment of the pulleys may be caused from incorrect mounting of the accessory drive
component, incorrect installation of the accessory drive
component pulley, or the pulley bent inward or outward from a previous repair. Test for an
incorrectly aligned pulley. Use a straight edge in the pulley grooves across two or three pulleys. If a
misaligned pulley is found, refer to that accessory drive component for the correct installation
procedure.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Belt
Chirping > Page 1412
10. Inspection of the fasteners eliminates the installment of incorrect: bolts, nuts, spacers, or
washers. 12. Inspecting the pulleys for being bent should include inspecting for a dent or other
damage to the pulleys that would prevent the drive belt from not
seating correctly in all of the pulley grooves or on the smooth surface of a pulley when the back
side of the belt is used to drive the pulley.
14. Replacing the drive belt when it is not damaged, or if there is no excessive pilling will be a
temporary repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Belt
Chirping > Page 1413
Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection Drive Belt Excessive Wear
Drive Belt Excessive Wear Diagnosis
Diagnostic Aids
Excessive wear on a drive belt(s) is usually caused by an incorrect installation or the wrong drive
belt for the application. Minor misalignment of the drive belt pulleys will not cause excessive wear,
but will probably cause the drive belt(s) to make a noise or to fall off. Excessive misalignment of the
drive belt pulleys will cause excessive wear but may also make the drive belt(s) fall off.
Test Description
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. The inspection is to verify
the drive belt(s) is correctly installed on all of the drive belt pulleys. Wear on the drive belt(s) may
be caused by
mix-positioning the drive belt(s) by one groove on a pulley.
3. The installation of a drive belt that is two wide or two narrow will cause wear on the drive belt.
The drive belt ribs should match all of the grooves
on all of the pulleys.
4. This inspection is to verify the drive belt(s) is not contacting any parts of the engine or body while
the engine is operating. There should be
sufficient clearance when the drive belt accessory drive components load varies. The drive belt(s)
should not come in contact with an engine or a body component when snapping the throttle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Belt
Chirping > Page 1414
Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection Drive Belt Falls Off
Drive Belt Falls Off Diagnosis
Diagnostic Aids
If the drive belt(s) repeatedly falls off the drive belt pulleys, this is because of pulley misalignment.
An extra load that is quickly applied on released by an accessory drive component may cause the
drive belt to fall off the pulleys. Verify the accessory drive components operate correctly. If the drive
belt(s) is the incorrect length, the drive belt tensioner may not keep the correct tension on the drive
belt.
Test Description
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. This inspection is to verify
the condition of the drive belt. Damage may of occurred to the drive belt when the drive belt fell off.
The drive belt
may of been damaged, which caused the drive belt to fall off. Inspect the belt for cuts, tears,
sections of ribs missing, or damaged belt plys.
4. Misalignment of the pulleys may be caused from incorrect mounting of the accessory drive
component, incorrect installation of the accessory drive
component pulley, or the pulley bent inward or outward from a previous repair. Test for an
incorrectly aligned pulley using a straight edge in the pulley grooves across two or three pulleys. If
an incorrectly aligned pulley is found refer to that accessory drive component for the correct
installation procedure of that pulley.
5. Inspecting the pulleys for being bent should include inspecting for a dent or other damage to the
pulleys that would prevent the drive belt from not
seating correctly in all of the pulley grooves or on the smooth surface of a pulley when the back
side of the belt is used to drive the pulley.
6. Accessory drive component brackets that are bent or cracked will let the drive belt fall off. 7.
Inspecting of the fasteners can eliminate the possibility that a wrong bolt, nut, spacer, or washer
was installed. Missing, loose, or the wrong
fasteners may cause pulley misalignment from the bracket moving under load. Over tightening of
the fasteners may cause misalignment of the accessory component bracket.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Belt
Chirping > Page 1415
Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection Drive Belt Rumbling
Drive Belt Rumbling Diagnosis
Diagnostic Aids
Vibration from the engine operating may cause a body component or another part of the vehicle to
make rumbling noise. The drive belt(s) may have a condition that can not be seen or felt.
Sometimes replacing the drive belt may be the only repair for the symptom. If replacing the drive
belt(s), completing the diagnostic table, and the noise is only heard when the drive belt(s) is
installed, there might be an accessory drive component with a failure. Varying the load on the
different accessory drive components may aid in identifying which component is causing the
rumbling noise.
Test Description
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. This test is to verify that
the symptom is present during diagnosing. Other vehicle components may cause a similar
symptom. 3. This test is to verify that the drive belt(s) is causing the rumbling noise. Rumbling
noise may be confused with an internal engine noise due to the
similarity in the description. Remove only one drive belt at a time if the vehicle has multiple drive
belts. When removing the drive belt the water pump may not be operating and the engine may
overheat. Also DTCs may set when the engine is operating with the drive belt removed.
4. Inspecting the drive belts) is to ensure that it is not causing the noise. Small cracks across the
ribs of the drive belt will not cause the noise. Belt
separation is identified by the plys of the belt separating and may be seen at the edge of the belt
our felt as a lump in the belt.
5. Small amounts of pilling is normal condition and acceptable. When the pilling is severe the drive
belt does not have a smooth surface for correct
operation.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Belt
Chirping > Page 1416
Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection
Drive Belt Chirping
Drive Belt Chirping Diagnosis
Diagnostic Aids
The symptom may be intermittent due to moisture on the drive belt(s) or the pulleys. It may be
necessary to spray a small amount of water on the drive belt(s) in order to duplicate the customers
concern. If spraying water on the drive belt(s) duplicates the symptom, cleaning the belt pulleys
may be the probable solution. A loose or incorrect installation of a body component, a suspension
component, or other items of the vehicle may cause the chirping noise.
Test Description
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. The noise may not be
engine related. This step verifies that the engine is making the noise. If the engine is not making
the noise do not proceed
further with this table.
3. The noise may be an internal engine noise. Removing the drive belt and operating the engine
verifies the noise is related to the drive belt. When
removing the drive belt(s) the water pump may not be operating and cause the engine to overheat.
Also DTCs may set if the engine is operating with the drive belt removed.
4. Inspect all drive belt pulleys for pilling. Pilling is the small balls or strings in the drive belt
grooves. Pilling occurs from the accumulation of
rubber dust.
6. Misalignment of the pulleys may be caused from incorrect mounting of the accessory drive
component, incorrect installation of the accessory drive
component pulley, or the pulley bent inward or outward from a previous repair. Test for an
incorrectly aligned pulley. Use a straight edge in the pulley grooves across two or three pulleys. If a
misaligned pulley is found, refer to that accessory drive component for the correct installation
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Belt
Chirping > Page 1417
procedure.
10. Inspection of the fasteners eliminates the installment of incorrect: bolts, nuts, spacers, or
washers. 12. Inspecting the pulleys for being bent should include inspecting for a dent or other
damage to the pulleys that would prevent the drive belt from not
seating correctly in all of the pulley grooves or on the smooth surface of a pulley when the back
side of the belt is used to drive the pulley.
14. Replacing the drive belt when it is not damaged, or if there is no excessive pilling will be a
temporary repair.
Drive Belt Excessive Wear
Drive Belt Excessive Wear Diagnosis
Diagnostic Aids
Excessive wear on a drive belt(s) is usually caused by an incorrect installation or the wrong drive
belt for the application. Minor misalignment of the drive belt pulleys will not cause excessive wear,
but will probably cause the drive belt(s) to make a noise or to fall off. Excessive misalignment of the
drive belt pulleys will cause excessive wear but may also make the drive belt(s) fall off.
Test Description
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. The inspection is to verify
the drive belt(s) is correctly installed on all of the drive belt pulleys. Wear on the drive belt(s) may
be caused by
mix-positioning the drive belt(s) by one groove on a pulley.
3. The installation of a drive belt that is two wide or two narrow will cause wear on the drive belt.
The drive belt ribs should match all of the grooves
on all of the pulleys.
4. This inspection is to verify the drive belt(s) is not contacting any parts of the engine or body while
the engine is operating. There should be
sufficient clearance when the drive belt accessory drive components load varies. The drive belt(s)
should not come in contact with an engine or a body component when snapping the throttle.
Drive Belt Falls Off
Drive Belt Falls Off Diagnosis
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Belt
Chirping > Page 1418
Diagnostic Aids
If the drive belt(s) repeatedly falls off the drive belt pulleys, this is because of pulley misalignment.
An extra load that is quickly applied on released by an accessory drive component may cause the
drive belt to fall off the pulleys. Verify the accessory drive components operate correctly. If the drive
belt(s) is the incorrect length, the drive belt tensioner may not keep the correct tension on the drive
belt.
Test Description
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. This inspection is to verify
the condition of the drive belt. Damage may of occurred to the drive belt when the drive belt fell off.
The drive belt
may of been damaged, which caused the drive belt to fall off. Inspect the belt for cuts, tears,
sections of ribs missing, or damaged belt plys.
4. Misalignment of the pulleys may be caused from incorrect mounting of the accessory drive
component, incorrect installation of the accessory drive
component pulley, or the pulley bent inward or outward from a previous repair. Test for an
incorrectly aligned pulley using a straight edge in the pulley grooves across two or three pulleys. If
an incorrectly aligned pulley is found refer to that accessory drive component for the correct
installation procedure of that pulley.
5. Inspecting the pulleys for being bent should include inspecting for a dent or other damage to the
pulleys that would prevent the drive belt from not
seating correctly in all of the pulley grooves or on the smooth surface of a pulley when the back
side of the belt is used to drive the pulley.
6. Accessory drive component brackets that are bent or cracked will let the drive belt fall off. 7.
Inspecting of the fasteners can eliminate the possibility that a wrong bolt, nut, spacer, or washer
was installed. Missing, loose, or the wrong
fasteners may cause pulley misalignment from the bracket moving under load. Over tightening of
the fasteners may cause misalignment of the accessory component bracket.
Drive Belt Rumbling
Drive Belt Rumbling Diagnosis
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Belt
Chirping > Page 1419
Diagnostic Aids
Vibration from the engine operating may cause a body component or another part of the vehicle to
make rumbling noise. The drive belt(s) may have a condition that can not be seen or felt.
Sometimes replacing the drive belt may be the only repair for the symptom. If replacing the drive
belt(s), completing the diagnostic table, and the noise is only heard when the drive belt(s) is
installed, there might be an accessory drive component with a failure. Varying the load on the
different accessory drive components may aid in identifying which component is causing the
rumbling noise.
Test Description
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. This test is to verify that
the symptom is present during diagnosing. Other vehicle components may cause a similar
symptom. 3. This test is to verify that the drive belt(s) is causing the rumbling noise. Rumbling
noise may be confused with an internal engine noise due to the
similarity in the description. Remove only one drive belt at a time if the vehicle has multiple drive
belts. When removing the drive belt the water pump may not be operating and the engine may
overheat. Also DTCs may set when the engine is operating with the drive belt removed.
4. Inspecting the drive belts) is to ensure that it is not causing the noise. Small cracks across the
ribs of the drive belt will not cause the noise. Belt
separation is identified by the plys of the belt separating and may be seen at the edge of the belt
our felt as a lump in the belt.
5. Small amounts of pilling is normal condition and acceptable. When the pilling is severe the drive
belt does not have a smooth surface for correct
operation.
Drive Belt Squeal
Drive Belt Squeal Diagnosis
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Belt
Chirping > Page 1420
Diagnostic Aids
A loose or incorrect installation of a body component, a suspension component, or other items of
the vehicle may cause the squeal noise. If the noise is intermittent verify the accessory drive
components by varying their loads. Ensure the accessory components are operated to their
maximum capacity. An overcharged A/C system or power steering system with: a pinched hose, an
incorrect fluid, or a failed generator are suggested items to inspect.
Test Description
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. The noise may not be
engine related. This step is to verify that the engine is making the noise. If the engine is not making
the noise do not proceed
further with this table.
3. The noise may be an internal engine noise. Removing the drive belt and operating the engine
verifies the noise is related to the drive belt or an
accessory drive component. If the drive belt is removed, the water pump may not operate. Without
the water pump the engine may overheat. DTCs may set when the engine is operating with the
drive belt removed.
4. This test verifies that an accessory drive component does not have a seized bearing. Remove
the belt and test the bearings for smooth turning in the
accessory drive components. Test the accessory drive components with the engine operating, vary
the load on the components to verify that the components operate correctly.
5. This test is to verify that the drive belt tensioner operates correctly. If the drive belt tensioner is
not operating correctly, correct belt tension may
not be achieved to keep the drive belt from slipping which could cause a squeal noise.
6. This test is to verify that the drive belt(s) is not too long, which would prevent the drive belt
tensioner from working correctly. Also if an incorrect
length drive belt was installed, it may not be routed correctly and may be turning an accessory
drive component in the wrong direction.
7. Misalignment of the pulleys may be caused from incorrect mounting of the accessory drive
component, incorrect installation of the accessory drive
component pulley, or the pulley bent inward or outward from a previous repair. Test for a pulley that
is incorrectly aligned using a straight edge in the pulley grooves across two or three pulleys. If an
incorrectly aligned pulley is found refer to that accessory drive component for the correct
installation procedure for that pulley.
8. This test is to verify that the pulleys are the correct diameter or width. Using a known good
vehicle compare the pulley sizes.
Drive Belt Vibration
Drive Belt Vibration Diagnosis
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Belt
Chirping > Page 1421
Diagnostic Aids
The accessory drive components can have an affect on engine vibration. Such as but not limited to
the A/C system over charged, the power steering system restricted or the incorrect fluid, or an extra
load on the generator. To help identify an intermittent or an improper condition, vary the loads on
the accessory drive components.
Test Description
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. This test is to verify that
the symptom is present during diagnosing. Other vehicle components may cause a similar
symptom such as the exhaust
system, or the drivetrain.
3. This test is to verify that the drive belt(s) or accessory drive components may be causing the
vibration. When removing the drive belt the water
pump may not be operating and the engine may overheat. Also DTCs may set when the engine is
operating with the drive belt removed.
4. The drive belt(s) may cause a vibration. While the drive belt(s) is removed this is the best time to
inspect the condition of the belt. 6. Inspecting of the fasteners can eliminate the possibility that a
wrong bolt, nut, spacer, or washer was installed. 8. This step should only be performed if the fan is
driven by the drive belt. Inspect the engine cooling fan for bent, twisted, loose, or cracked blades.
Inspect the fan clutch for smoothness, ease of turning. Inspect for a bent fan shaft or bent mounting
flange.
9. This step should only be performed if the water pump is driven by the drive belt. Inspect the
water pump shaft for being bent. Also inspect the
water pump bearings for smoothness and excessive play. Compare the water pump with a known
good water pump.
10. Accessory drive component brackets that are bent, cracked, or loose may put extra strain on
that accessory component causing it to vibrate.
Drive Belt Whine
Drive Belt Whine Diagnosis
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Belt
Chirping > Page 1422
Diagnostic Aids
The drive belt(s) will not cause the whine noise. If the whine noise is intermittent, verify the
accessory drive components by varying their loads making sure they are operated to their
maximum capacity. Such items but not limited to may be an A/C system overcharged, the power
steering system restricted or the wrong fluid, or the generator failing.
Test Description
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 3. This test is to verify that
the noise is being caused by the drive belt(s) or the accessory drive components. When removing
the drive belt the water
pump may not be operating and the engine may overheat. DTCs may set if the engine is operating
with the drive belt removed.
4. The inspection should include checking the drive belt tensioner and the drive belt idler pulley
bearings. The drive belt(s) may have to be installed
and the accessory drive components operated separately by varying their loads. Refer to the
suspected accessory drive component for the correct inspection and replacement procedure.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1423
Drive Belt: Service and Repair
Drive Belt Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the air cleaner assembly. 2. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct from the throttle body.
3. Install a 3/8 inch drive wrench on the drive belt tensioner arm and rotate the arm
counterclockwise. 4. Remove the drive belt.
5. Slowly release the tension on the drive belt tensioner arm.
Installation Procedure
1. Route the belt over all the pulleys except the tensioner arm. 2. Observe drive belt routing for
vehicles without air conditioning.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1424
3. Observe drive belt routing for vehicles with air conditioning.
4. Install a 3/8 inch drive wrench on the drive belt tensioner arm and rotate the arm counter
clockwise. 5. Install the drive belt over the drive belt tensioner pulley. 6. Slowly release the tension
on the tensioner arm.
7. Inspect for the drive belt being properly installed on the pulleys.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1425
8. Avoid mix-positioning the drive belt by one or more grooves.
9. Confirm for the proper drive belt size and the correct drive belt routing by observing the location
of the fix pointer and the index marks on the
drive belt tensioner. With a new drive belt installed, the fix pointer should align within the
indentation on the drive belt tensioner.
10. With a used drive belt installed, the fix pointer should not align past the index mark. 11. Install
the air cleaner outlet duct. 12. Install the air cleaner assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Cleaner Restriction Indicator >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Air Cleaner Restriction Indicator: Description and Operation
The air cleaner restriction indicator is located on the intake duct between the air cleaner assembly
and the Mass Air Flow/Intake Air Temperature ( MAF/IAT) sensor.
If the area inside of the clear section is green, no air filter service is required. If the area inside the
clear section is orange and Change Air Filter appears, replace the air filter.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air Filter Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: Customer Interest Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air Filter Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 1439
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine,
A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine,
A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 1445
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1446
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER ELEMENT REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the air cleaner cover by releasing the retainer clips. 2. Remove the air cleaner element.
3. Clear out any debris in the air cleaner tub.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Insert the air cleaner element into the air cleaner tub. 2. Install the air cleaner cover. 3. Fasten
the air cleaner cover retainer clips.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair
Fluid Filter - A/T: Service and Repair
Automatic Transmission Fluid/Filter Replacement
Removal Procedure
Caution: When the transmission is at operating temperatures, take necessary precautions when
removing the drain plug, to avoid being burned by draining fluid.
1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting.
2. Place a drain pan under the transmission oil pan. 3. Remove the oil pan drain plug, if equipped.
4. If necessary, remove the bolts and position aside the range selector cable bracket for clearance
while lowering the pan. It is not necessary to
remove the cable from the lever or bracket.
5. Remove the oil pan bolts from the front and sides of the pan only. 6. Loosen the rear oil pan
bolts approximately 4 turns. 7. Lightly tap the oil pan with a rubber mallet in order to loosen the pan
to allow the fluid to drain.
8. Remove the remaining oil pan bolts.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Page 1450
9. Remove the oil pan and the gasket.
10. Grasp firmly while pulling down with a twisting motion in order to remove the filter. 11. Remove
the filter seal. The filter seal may be stuck in the pump; if necessary, carefully use pliers or another
suitable tool to remove the seal. 12. Discard the seal. 13. Inspect the fluid color.
14. Inspect the filter. Pry the metal crimping away from the top of the filter and pull apart. The filter
may contain the following evidence for root cause
diagnosis: ^
Clutch material
^ Bronze slivers indicating bushing wear
^ Steel particles
15. Clean the transmission case and the oil pan gasket surfaces with solvent, and air dry. You must
remove all traces of the old gasket material.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Page 1451
1. Coat the new filter seal with automatic transmission fluid.
2. Install the new filter seal into the transmission case. Tap the seal into place using a suitable size
socket. 3. Install the new filter into the case.
4. Install the oil pan and a new gasket.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
5. Install the oil pan bolts.
Tighten the oil pan to transmission case bolts alternately and evenly to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
6. If previously removed, install the range selector cable bracket and bolts.
Tighten the bolts to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
7. Apply a small amount of sealant GM P/N 12346004 to the threads of the oil pan drain plug, if
equipped. 8. Install the oil pan drain plug, if equipped.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Page 1452
Tighten the oil pan drain plug to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
9. Lower the vehicle.
10. Fill the transmission to the proper level with DEXRON III transmission fluid. 11. Check the
COLD fluid level reading for initial fill only. 12. Inspect the oil pan gasket for leaks.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure Release > System Information >
Service and Repair > Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 34730-1A Fuel Pressure Gage
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Gasoline/Gasoline Vapors Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Remove the engine cover.
CAUTION: Refer to Fuel Gage Leak Caution in Service Precautions.
NOTE: Clean all of the following areas before performing any disconnections in order to avoid
possible contamination in the system: ^
The fuel pipe connections
^ The hose connections
^ The areas surrounding the connections
2. Install the J 34730-1A to the fuel pressure service connection. 3. Turn ON the ignition.
CAUTION: Refer to Fuel Storage Caution in Service Precautions.
4. Place the bleed hose of the fuel pressure gage into an approved gasoline container. 5. Open the
bleed valve on the fuel pressure gage in order to bleed the air from the fuel pressure gage. 6.
Command the fuel pump ON with a scan tool. 7. Close the bleed valve on the fuel pressure gage.
8. Inspect for fuel leaks.
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure Release > System Information >
Service and Repair > Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal > Page 1458
1. Place the fuel pressure gage bleed hose into an approved container and open the bleed valve to
bleed OFF fuel system pressure. 2. Place a shop towel under the J 34730-1A to catch any
remaining fuel spillage. 3. Remove the J 34730-1A from the fuel pressure connection. 4. Drain any
fuel remaining in the fuel pressure gage into an approved container. 5. Inspect for leaks using the
following procedure:
5.1. Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF for 2 seconds.
5.2. Turn OFF the ignition for 10 seconds.
5.3. Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
5.4. Inspect for fuel leaks.
6. Install the cap on the fuel pressure connection. 7. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure Release > System Information >
Service and Repair > Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal > Page 1459
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair Fuel System Pressure Relief
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 34730-1A Fuel Pressure Gage
CAUTION: Remove the fuel tank cap and relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing the fuel
system in order to reduce the risk of personal injury. After you relieve the fuel system pressure, a
small amount of fuel may be released when servicing the fuel lines, the fuel injection pump, or the
connections. In order to reduce the risk of personal injury, cover the fuel system components with a
shop towel before disconnection. This will catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an
approved container when the disconnection is complete.
1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Disconnect the negative battery cable in order to avoid possible fuel
discharge if an accidental attempt is made to start the engine. 3. Remove the engine cover. 4.
Connect the J 34730-1A or the equivalent to the fuel pressure connection. 5. Wrap a shop towel
around the fitting while connecting the gage in order to avoid spillage. 6. Install the bleed hose of
the gage into an approved container. 7. Open the valve on the gage in order to bleed the system
pressure. The fuel connections are now safe for servicing. 8. Drain any fuel remaining in the gage
into an approved container.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Pump Pickup Filter > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Fuel Pump Pickup Filter: Description and Operation
FUEL STRAINER
The fuel strainer attaches to the lower end of the fuel sender. The fuel strainer is made of woven
plastic. The functions of the fuel strainer are to filter contaminants and to wick fuel. The fuel strainer
is self-cleaning and normally requires no maintenance. Fuel stoppage at this point indicates that
the fuel tank contains an abnormal amount of sediment or water.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Pump Pickup Filter > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 1463
Fuel Pump Pickup Filter: Service and Repair
FUEL STRAINER REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the fuel sender assembly. 2. Note the position of the fuel strainer (2) on the fuel sender.
3. Support the fuel sender assembly with one hand and grasp the strainer (2) with the other hand.
4. Pull the strainer off the fuel sender. Discard the strainer after inspection. 5. Inspect the strainer.
Replace a contaminated strainer and clean the fuel tank.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install a new fuel strainer (2) in the same position as noted during disassembly. Push the strainer
on the bottom of the fuel sender until the strainer
is fully seated.
2. Install the fuel sender assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine - Noise/Damage Oil Filter Application Importance
Oil Filter: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Noise/Damage Oil Filter Application Importance
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 07-06-01-016B
Date: July 27, 2009
Subject: Information on Internal Engine Noise or Damage After Oil Filter Replacement
Models:
2010 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3
2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being updated to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 07-06-01-016A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
Important Engine damage that is the result of an incorrect or improperly installed engine oil filter is
not a warrantable claim. The best way to avoid oil filter quality concerns is to purchase ACDelco(R)
oil filters directly from GMSPO.
Oil filter misapplication may cause abnormal engine noise or internal damage. Always utilize the
most recent parts information to ensure the correct part number filter is installed when replacing oil
filters. Do not rely on physical dimensions alone. Counterfeit copies of name brand parts have been
discovered in some aftermarket parts systems. Always ensure the parts you install are from a
trusted source. Improper oil filter installation may result in catastrophic engine damage.
Refer to the appropriate Service Information (SI) installation instructions when replacing any oil
filter and pay particular attention to procedures for proper cartridge filter element alignment. If the
diagnostics in SI (Engine Mechanical) lead to the oil filter as the cause of the internal engine noise
or damage, dealers should submit a field product report. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
02-00-89-002I (Information for Dealers on How to Submit a Field Product Report).
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Oil Filter Bypass Valve Replacement
Oil Filter: Service and Repair Oil Filter Bypass Valve Replacement
Oil Filter Bypass Valve Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Position a suitable container to catch the engine oil.
3. Remove the oil filter. 4. Remove the oil filter adapter. 5. Using a suitable prying tool remove the
oil filter bypass valve. 6. Clean and inspect valve bore for damage.
Installation Procedure
Caution: Refer to Safety Glasses Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Install a NEW oil filter bypass valve using the following procedure:
1.1. Use a brass drift that is the same diameter as the outside diameter of the oil filter bypass
valve.
1.2. Install the oil filter bypass valve into the oil gallery bore until slightly below flush with the
surface of the engine block.
1.3. Using a pointed punch, stake the engine block area around the oil filter bypass valve. Stake in
3 locations 120 degrees apart.
2. Install the oil filter adapter. 3. Install the oil filter. 4. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Oil Filter Bypass Valve Replacement > Page 1470
Oil Filter: Service and Repair Draining Fluids and Oil Filter Removal
Draining Fluids and Oil Filter Removal
1. Remove the oil pan drain plug and allow the engine oil to drain into a suitable container.
2. Remove the oil filter (if applicable). 3. Discard the oil filter (if applicable).
4. Remove both the engine block coolant drain hole plugs and allow the coolant to drain into a
suitable container.
Engine Flywheel Removal
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Oil Filter Bypass Valve Replacement > Page 1471
1. Remove the engine flywheel bolts. 2. Remove the engine flywheel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60)
Refrigerant Filter: Service and Repair Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60)
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
IMPORTANT: The A/C refrigerant filter, ACDelco P/N 15-1697 must be installed to the A/C
evaporator tube between the condenser and evaporator. The installation of this A/C refrigerant filter
eliminates the need for flushing.
1. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Remove the air cleaner. 3. Remove the upper radiator shroud. 4. Remove the grille. 5. Remove the
evaporator tube (1) from the vehicle. 6. Measure 40 mm (1.5 in) from the bend on the evaporator
tube (1) near the high side access port.. 7. Measure 50.8 mm (2 in) from the mark on the
evaporator tube (1) from the previous step.
IMPORTANT: Do not allow metal burrs to enter the evaporator tube (1) during cutting or when
removing the burrs.
8. Using a tubing cutter, cut the marked section of the evaporator tube (1). 9. Remove the burrs
from the evaporator tube (1).
10. Remove the nuts (4), the ferrules (3), and the O-rings (2) from the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
IMPORTANT: DO NOT install the O-rings (2) in this step.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 1476
11. Push the nuts (4) and ferrules (3) over each of the evaporator tube halves. 12. Install the
ferrules (3) with the small end toward the nut (4).
13. Install the A/C refrigerant filter (6) to the evaporator tube (1) with the flow arrow pointing
towards the evaporator.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
14. While holding the evaporator tube in the A/C refrigerant filter (1) tighten the nuts (4) to the A/C
refrigerant filter (1).
Tighten Tighten the nuts to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
15. Remove the nuts (4) from the A/C refrigerant filter (1). 16. Coat the O-rings (2) with 525
viscosity refrigerant oil. 17. Install the O-rings (2) to the evaporator tube. 18. Install the nuts (4) to
the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
Tighten Tighten the nuts to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 1477
19. Install the evaporator tube (1) to the vehicle. 20. Recharge the A/C system. Refer to Refrigerant
Recovery and Recharging. 21. Leak test the fitting(s) of the repaired or reinstalled component
using the J 39400-A. 22. Install the upper radiator shroud. 23. Install the grille. 24. Install the air
cleaner.
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article/images refer to the RPO Code List found
at Vehicle/Application ID. See: Application and ID/RPO Codes
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 1478
Refrigerant Filter: Service and Repair Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C69)
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
IMPORTANT: The A/C refrigerant filter, ACDelco P/N 15-1697 must be installed to the A/C
evaporator tube between the condenser and evaporator. The installation of this A/C refrigerant filter
eliminates the need for flushing.
1. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Remove the air cleaner. 3. Remove the upper radiator shroud. 4. Remove the grille. 5. Remove the
evaporator tube (1) from the vehicle. 6. Measure 40 mm (1.5 in) from the bend on the evaporator
tube (1) near the high side access port. 7. Measure 50.8 mm (2 in) from the mark on the evaporator
tube (1) from the previous step.
IMPORTANT: Do not allow metal burrs to enter the evaporator tube (1) during cutting or when
removing the burrs.
8. Using a tubing cutter, cut the marked section of the evaporator tube (1). 9. Remove the burrs
from the evaporator tube (1).
10. Remove the nuts (4), the ferrules (3), and the O-rings (2) from the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
IMPORTANT: DO NOT install the O-rings (2) in this step.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 1479
11. Push the nuts (4) and ferrules (3) over each of the evaporator tube halves. 12. Install the
ferrules (3) with the small end toward the nut (4).
13. Install the A/C refrigerant filter (6) to the evaporator tube (1) with the flow arrow pointing
towards the evaporator.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
14. While holding the evaporator tube in the A/C refrigerant filter (1), tighten the nuts (4) to the A/C
refrigerant filter (1).
Tighten Tighten the nuts to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
15. Remove the nuts (4) from the A/C refrigerant filter (1). 16. Coat the O-rings (2) with 525
viscosity refrigerant oil. 17. Install the O-rings (2) to the evaporator tube. 18. Install the nuts (4) to
the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
Tighten Tighten the nuts to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 1480
19. Install the evaporator tube (1) to the vehicle. 20. Recharge the A/C system. Refer to Refrigerant
Recovery and Recharging. 21. Leak test the fitting(s) of the repaired or reinstalled component
using the J 39400-A. 22. Install the upper radiator shroud. 23. Install the grille. 24. Install the air
cleaner.
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article/images refer to the RPO Code List found
at Vehicle/Application ID. See: Application and ID/RPO Codes
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 1481
Refrigerant Filter: Service and Repair Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Replacement (C60)
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Remove the air cleaner. 3. Remove the upper radiator shroud. 4. Remove the grille. 5. Remove the
evaporator tube (1) from the vehicle.
IMPORTANT: The ruts (4) and ferrules (3) will remain on the evaporator tube. Do not try to remove.
6. Remove the nuts (4) from the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 1482
7. Remove the A/C refrigerant filter from the evaporator tube (1).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the new O-rings (2) to the evaporator tube.
2. Install the A/C refrigerant filter to the evaporator tube (1) with the flow arrow pointing towards the
evaporator.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 1483
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the nuts (4) to the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
Tighten Tighten the nuts to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
4. Install the evaporator tube. 5. Recharge the A/C system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and
Recharging. 6. Leak test the fitting(s) of the repaired or reinstalled component using the J 39400-A.
7. Install the grille. 8. Install the upper radiator shroud. 9. Install the air cleaner.
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article/images refer to the RPO Code List found
at Vehicle/Application ID. See: Application and ID/RPO Codes
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 1484
Refrigerant Filter: Service and Repair Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Replacement (C69)
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Remove the air cleaner. 3. Remove the upper radiator shroud. 4. Remove the grille. 5. Remove the
evaporator tube (1) from the vehicle.
IMPORTANT: The nuts (4) and ferrules (3) will remain on the evaporator tube. Do not try to
remove.
6. Remove the nuts (4) from the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 1485
7. Remove the A/C refrigerant filter (6) from the evaporator tube (1).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the new O-rings (2) to the evaporator tube.
2. Install the A/C refrigerant filter (6) to the evaporator tube (1) with the flow arrow pointing towards
the evaporator.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 1486
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the nuts (4) to the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
Tighten Tighten the nuts to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
4. Install the evaporator tube. 5. Recharge the A/C system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and
Recharging. 6. Leak test the fitting(s) of the repaired or reinstalled component using the J 39400-A.
7. Install the grille. 8. Install the upper radiator shroud. 9. Install the air cleaner.
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article/images refer to the RPO Code List found
at Vehicle/Application ID. See: Application and ID/RPO Codes
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 1487
Refrigerant Filter: Service and Repair
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60)
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
IMPORTANT: The A/C refrigerant filter, ACDelco P/N 15-1697 must be installed to the A/C
evaporator tube between the condenser and evaporator. The installation of this A/C refrigerant filter
eliminates the need for flushing.
1. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Remove the air cleaner. 3. Remove the upper radiator shroud. 4. Remove the grille. 5. Remove the
evaporator tube (1) from the vehicle. 6. Measure 40 mm (1.5 in) from the bend on the evaporator
tube (1) near the high side access port.. 7. Measure 50.8 mm (2 in) from the mark on the
evaporator tube (1) from the previous step.
IMPORTANT: Do not allow metal burrs to enter the evaporator tube (1) during cutting or when
removing the burrs.
8. Using a tubing cutter, cut the marked section of the evaporator tube (1). 9. Remove the burrs
from the evaporator tube (1).
10. Remove the nuts (4), the ferrules (3), and the O-rings (2) from the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 1488
IMPORTANT: DO NOT install the O-rings (2) in this step.
11. Push the nuts (4) and ferrules (3) over each of the evaporator tube halves. 12. Install the
ferrules (3) with the small end toward the nut (4).
13. Install the A/C refrigerant filter (6) to the evaporator tube (1) with the flow arrow pointing
towards the evaporator.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
14. While holding the evaporator tube in the A/C refrigerant filter (1) tighten the nuts (4) to the A/C
refrigerant filter (1).
Tighten Tighten the nuts to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
15. Remove the nuts (4) from the A/C refrigerant filter (1). 16. Coat the O-rings (2) with 525
viscosity refrigerant oil. 17. Install the O-rings (2) to the evaporator tube. 18. Install the nuts (4) to
the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
Tighten Tighten the nuts to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 1489
19. Install the evaporator tube (1) to the vehicle. 20. Recharge the A/C system. Refer to Refrigerant
Recovery and Recharging. 21. Leak test the fitting(s) of the repaired or reinstalled component
using the J 39400-A. 22. Install the upper radiator shroud. 23. Install the grille. 24. Install the air
cleaner.
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article/images refer to the RPO Code List found
at Vehicle/Application ID. See: Application and ID/RPO Codes
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C69)
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
IMPORTANT: The A/C refrigerant filter, ACDelco P/N 15-1697 must be installed to the A/C
evaporator tube between the condenser and evaporator. The installation of this A/C refrigerant filter
eliminates the need for flushing.
1. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Remove the air cleaner. 3. Remove the upper radiator shroud. 4. Remove the grille. 5. Remove the
evaporator tube (1) from the vehicle. 6. Measure 40 mm (1.5 in) from the bend on the evaporator
tube (1) near the high side access port. 7. Measure 50.8 mm (2 in) from the mark on the evaporator
tube (1) from the previous step.
IMPORTANT: Do not allow metal burrs to enter the evaporator tube (1) during cutting or when
removing the burrs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 1490
8. Using a tubing cutter, cut the marked section of the evaporator tube (1). 9. Remove the burrs
from the evaporator tube (1).
10. Remove the nuts (4), the ferrules (3), and the O-rings (2) from the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
IMPORTANT: DO NOT install the O-rings (2) in this step.
11. Push the nuts (4) and ferrules (3) over each of the evaporator tube halves. 12. Install the
ferrules (3) with the small end toward the nut (4).
13. Install the A/C refrigerant filter (6) to the evaporator tube (1) with the flow arrow pointing
towards the evaporator.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 1491
14. While holding the evaporator tube in the A/C refrigerant filter (1), tighten the nuts (4) to the A/C
refrigerant filter (1).
Tighten Tighten the nuts to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
15. Remove the nuts (4) from the A/C refrigerant filter (1). 16. Coat the O-rings (2) with 525
viscosity refrigerant oil. 17. Install the O-rings (2) to the evaporator tube. 18. Install the nuts (4) to
the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
Tighten Tighten the nuts to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
19. Install the evaporator tube (1) to the vehicle. 20. Recharge the A/C system. Refer to Refrigerant
Recovery and Recharging. 21. Leak test the fitting(s) of the repaired or reinstalled component
using the J 39400-A. 22. Install the upper radiator shroud. 23. Install the grille. 24. Install the air
cleaner.
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article/images refer to the RPO Code List found
at Vehicle/Application ID. See: Application and ID/RPO Codes
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Replacement (C60)
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 1492
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Remove the air cleaner. 3. Remove the upper radiator shroud. 4. Remove the grille. 5. Remove the
evaporator tube (1) from the vehicle.
IMPORTANT: The ruts (4) and ferrules (3) will remain on the evaporator tube. Do not try to remove.
6. Remove the nuts (4) from the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 1493
7. Remove the A/C refrigerant filter from the evaporator tube (1).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the new O-rings (2) to the evaporator tube.
2. Install the A/C refrigerant filter to the evaporator tube (1) with the flow arrow pointing towards the
evaporator.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 1494
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the nuts (4) to the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
Tighten Tighten the nuts to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
4. Install the evaporator tube. 5. Recharge the A/C system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and
Recharging. 6. Leak test the fitting(s) of the repaired or reinstalled component using the J 39400-A.
7. Install the grille. 8. Install the upper radiator shroud. 9. Install the air cleaner.
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article/images refer to the RPO Code List found
at Vehicle/Application ID. See: Application and ID/RPO Codes
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Replacement (C69)
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 1495
1. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Remove the air cleaner. 3. Remove the upper radiator shroud. 4. Remove the grille. 5. Remove the
evaporator tube (1) from the vehicle.
IMPORTANT: The nuts (4) and ferrules (3) will remain on the evaporator tube. Do not try to
remove.
6. Remove the nuts (4) from the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 1496
7. Remove the A/C refrigerant filter (6) from the evaporator tube (1).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the new O-rings (2) to the evaporator tube.
2. Install the A/C refrigerant filter (6) to the evaporator tube (1) with the flow arrow pointing towards
the evaporator.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 1497
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the nuts (4) to the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
Tighten Tighten the nuts to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
4. Install the evaporator tube. 5. Recharge the A/C system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and
Recharging. 6. Leak test the fitting(s) of the repaired or reinstalled component using the J 39400-A.
7. Install the grille. 8. Install the upper radiator shroud. 9. Install the air cleaner.
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article/images refer to the RPO Code List found
at Vehicle/Application ID. See: Application and ID/RPO Codes
Suction Screen Installation
TOOL REQUIRED
J 44551 Suction Screen Installation/ Removal Kit
IMPORTANT: Suction screens are intended to be installed in the suction hose after a major
compressor failure.
The suction screens are available in 3 different sizes.
1. Insert the J 44551-5 sizing tool into the suction hose to select the correct size suction screen.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 1498
2. Insert the suction screen into the compressor end of the suction hose. 3. Install the correct
mandrel to the J 44551-5. 4. Install the J 44551-5 screen installation tool over the end of the
suction hose and the suction screen.
IMPORTANT: Correct placement of the J 44551-5 is critical.
5. Tighten the forcing screw of the J 44551-5. The suction screen is fully installed when the screen
is flush with the end of the suction hose fitting. 6. Remove the J 44551-5 suction screen tool from
the suction hose.
IMPORTANT: After major compressor failure a A/C refrigerant filter should also be installed.
7. Install an A/C refrigerant filter. 8. Install the J 44551-1 Suction Screen Notification label.
Suction Screen Replacement
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42220 Universal Leak Detection Lamp
^ J 44551 Suction Screen Kit
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Recover the refrigerant from the A/C system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Remove the Engine cover. 3. Remove the A/C compressor hose assembly bolt. 4. Separate the
A/C compressor hose assembly from the A/C compressor.
IMPORTANT: The suction screens are available in 3 different sizes.
5. Select the proper size removal tool from the J 44551. 6. Remove the suction screen using the J
44551-31 suction screen removal tool.
^ Thread the forcing screw into the suction screen.
^ Tighten the nut on the forcing screw to remove the suction screen.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Insert the J 44551-6 sizing tool into the suction hose to select the correct size suction screen. 2.
Insert the suction screen into the suction hose. 3. Install the J 44551-3 mandrel to the J 44551-5. 4.
Install the J 44551-5 suction screen installation tool over the end of the suction hose and the
suction screen.
IMPORTANT: Correct placement of the J 44551-5 is critical.
5. Tighten the forcing screw of the J 44551-5. The suction screen is fully installed when the screen
is flush with the end of the suction hose. 6. Remove the J 44551-5 suction screen tool from the
suction hose. 7. Replace the seal washers. 8. Install the A/C compressor hose assembly to the A/C
compressor.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
9. Install the A/C compressor hose assembly bolt.
Tighten Tighten the bolt to (25 lb ft).
10. Evacuate and recharge the A/C system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 11.
Leak test the fittings of the component using the J 42220. 12. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Coolant Line/Hose > Component Information > Specifications
Coolant Line/Hose: Specifications
Oil Cooler Pipe Bracket Bolt to Oil Pan
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ 89 inch lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Pipe Replacement - Auxiliary Front
Heater Hose: Service and Repair Heater Pipe Replacement - Auxiliary Front
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Drain the engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System in Cooling System. 2.
Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 3. Remove the front pipes (5) from the
rear pipes. 4. Remove the bolts (3) that retain the front pipes (5) to the body. 5. Remove the clips
(4) that retain the front pipes (5) to the body. 6. Remove the auxiliary heater front pipes (5) from the
heater hoses (1). 7. Remove the auxiliary heater front pipes (5).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the auxiliary heater front pipes (5). 2. Connect the auxiliary heater front pipes (5) to the
heater hoses (1). 3. Install the front pipe retaining clips (4) that retains the front pipes (5) to the
body.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the bolts (3) that retain the front pipes (5) to the body.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
5. Connect the auxiliary heater front pipes (5) to the rear pipes. 6. Fill the cooling system with
engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System in Cooling System.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Pipe Replacement - Auxiliary Front > Page 1507
7. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Pipe Replacement - Auxiliary Front > Page 1508
Heater Hose: Service and Repair Heater Pipe Replacement - Auxiliary Rear
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Drain the engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System in Cooling System. 2.
Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 3. Disconnect the auxiliary heater rear
pipes from the heater core inlet and outlet tubes. 4. Disconnect the auxiliary heater rear pipes from
the front pipes. 5. Remove the pipe retainers from the body. 6. Remove the auxiliary heater rear
pipes.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the auxiliary heater rear pipes. 2. Install the pipe retainers to the body. 3. Connect the
auxiliary heater rear pipes to the front pipes. 4. Connect the rear pipes to the auxiliary heater core
inlet and outlet tubes. 5. Refill the cooling system with engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling
Cooling System in Cooling System. 6. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Pipe Replacement - Auxiliary Front > Page 1509
Heater Hose: Service and Repair Heater Hose Replacement - Inlet
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 38185 Hose Clamp Pliers
^ J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the air cleaner. 2. Drain the engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling
System in Cooling System. 3. Remove the windshield washers and the coolant reservoir from the
vehicle. 4. Remove the heater hose support bolt (5) from the clamp (4). 5. Remove the clamp from
the heater hose. 6. Disconnect the inlet (3) hose from the heater core. 7. Disconnect the inlet (3)
hose from the water valve.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Connect the inlet (3) hose to the water valve. 2. Connect the inlet (3) hose to the heating core. 3.
Install the clamp to the heater hose.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the heater hose support bolt (5) to the heater hose clamp (4).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Pipe Replacement - Auxiliary Front > Page 1510
Tighten Tighten the bolt to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
5. Use the J 38185 6. Install the windshield washers and the coolant reservoir. 7. Fill the cooling
system. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System in Cooling System. 8. Leak test the fittings
component using the J 39400-A 9. Install the air cleaner.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Pipe Replacement - Auxiliary Front > Page 1511
Heater Hose: Service and Repair Heater Hose Replacement - Outlet
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 38185 Hose Clamp Pliers
^ J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the air cleaner. 2. Drain the engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling
System in Cooling System. 3. Remove the windshield washers and the coolant reservoir from the
vehicle. 4. Remove the heater hose support bolt (5) from the clamp (4). 5. Remove the clamp from
the heater hose. 6. Disconnect the outlet (2) hoses from the heater core. 7. Disconnect the outlet
(2) hoses from the water valve.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Connect the outlet (2) hose to the water valve. 2. Connect the outlet (2) hose to the heating core.
3. Install the clamp to the heater hose.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the heater hose support bolt (5) to the heater hose clamp (4).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Pipe Replacement - Auxiliary Front > Page 1512
Tighten Tighten the bolt to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
5. Use the J 38185 6. Install the windshield washers and the coolant reservoir. 7. Fill the cooling
system. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System in Cooling System. 8. Leak test the fitting
component using the J 39400-A 9. Install the air cleaner.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the IAT sensor. 2. Disconnect the MAF sensor. 3. Remove the air cleaner. 4.
Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 5.
Remove the grille. 6. Remove the engine cover. 7. Remove the compressor hose assembly bolt (2)
from the compressor. 8. Remove the old sealing washers from the compressor.
9. Remove the hose clamp bracket nut (3) from the engine stud.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 1517
10. Remove the compressor hose assembly nut (6) from the condenser. 11. Remove the
compressor hose assembly nut (1) from the accumulator. 12. Remove the bolt from the
transmission filler tube to the oil indicator tube. 13. Remove transmission filler tube from the throttle
cable bracket. 14. Remove the compressor hose assembly from the vehicle. 15. Cap or plug all
open connections on the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Uncap or unplug all open connections. 2. Install the compressor hose assembly to the vehicle. 3.
Install transmission filler tube to the throttle cable bracket.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the bolt to the transmission filler tube to the oil indicator tube.
Tighten Tighten the bolt to the oil indicator tube to 12 N.m (106 lb in).
5. Install the compressor hose assembly nut (1) to the accumulator.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 48 N.m (35 lb ft).
6. Install the compressor hose assembly nut (6) to the condenser.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 28 N.m (21 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 1518
7. Install the hose clamp bracket nut (3) to the engine stud.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 5 N.m (44 lb in).
8. Install the compressor hose assembly seals. 9. Install the sealing washers.
10. Install the compressor hose assembly bolt to the compressor.
Tighten Tighten the bolt to 34 N.m (25 lb ft).
11. Install the engine cover. 12. Install the grille. 13. Evacuate and recharge the system. Refer to
Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 14. Leak test the fittings of the component using the J
39400-A. 15. Install the air cleaner. 16. Connect the IAT sensor. 17. Connect the MAF sensor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 1519
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Accumulator Tube Replacement - Auxiliary Side
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 3. Remove the auxiliary
evaporator outlet side tube (3) from the rear tube. 4. Remove the O-ring seal.
5. Remove the auxiliary evaporator outlet side tube from the compressor hose assembly. 6.
Remove the O-ring seal.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 1520
7. Remove the bolts (1) that retain the clips on the outlet side tube (3) to the body. 8. Remove the
auxiliary evaporator side tube (3) from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the auxiliary evaporator outlet side tube (3) to the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Caution and Notices.
2. Install the bolts (1) that retain the clips on the outlet side tube (3) to the body.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
3. Install the new O-ring seal. Coat the O-ring seal with 525 viscosity refrigerant oil.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 1521
4. Install the auxiliary evaporator outlet side tube to the compressor hose assembly.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 47.5 N.m (35 lb ft).
5. Install the new O-ring seal.
6. Install the auxiliary evaporator outlet underside body tube (3) to the auxiliary evaporator rear
tube.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 47.5 N.m (35 lb ft).
7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Evacuate and recharge the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and
Recharging. 9. Leak test the fittings of the component using the J 39400-A.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 1522
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Compressor/Condenser Hose Replacement - Auxiliary
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the IAT sensor. 2. Disconnect the MAF sensor. 3. Remove the air cleaner. 4.
Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 5.
Remove the grille. 6. Remove the engine cover. 7. Raise vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the
Vehicle. 8. Disconnect the auxiliary evaporator lines nut from the compressor hose assembly. 9.
Lower vehicle.
10. Remove the nut that attaches the compressor hose assembly bracket to the engine.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 1523
11. Remove the hose clamp bracket nut (3) from the engine stud.
12. Remove the compressor hose assembly bolt from the compressor. 13. Remove the sealing
washers from the compressor.
14. Remove the compressor hose assembly nut (6) from the condenser. 15. Remove the
compressor hose assembly nut (1) from the accumulator. 16. Remove the compressor hose
assembly from the vehicle. 17. Cap or plug all open connections.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 1524
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Uncap or unplug all open connections. 2. Install the compressor hose assembly to the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the compressor hose assembly nut (1) to the accumulator.
Tighten Tighten the compressor hose assembly nut (1) to the accumulator to 48 N.m (35 lb ft).
4. Install the compressor hose assembly nut (6) to the condenser.
Tighten Tighten the compressor hose assembly nut to the condenser to 28 N.m (21 lb ft).
5. Install new seal washers to the compressor. 6. Install the compressor hose assembly bolt to the
compressor.
Tighten Tighten the bolt to 34 N.m (25 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 1525
7. Install the hose clamp bracket nut (3) to the engine stud.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 5 N.m (44 lb in).
8. Install the nut that attaches the compressor hose assembly bracket to the engine.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 5 N.m (44 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 1526
9. Raise the vehicle.
10. Connect the auxiliary evaporator hose nut to the compressor hose assembly.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 28 N.m (21 lb ft).
11. Lower the vehicle. 12. Install the engine cover. 13. Install the grille. 14. Evacuate and recharge
the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 15. Leak test the fittings of the
component using the J 39400-A. 16. Install the air cleaner. 17. Connect the IAT sensor. 18.
Connect the MAF sensor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 1527
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Evaporator Tube Replacement
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the air cleaner. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant
Recovery and Recharging. 3. Remove the evaporator tube (2) from the evaporator. 4. Remove the
O-ring seal. 5. Remove the grille. 6. Remove the evaporator tube (2) from the condenser (4). 7.
Remove the O-ring seal. 8. Remove the evaporator tube from the auxiliary A/C evaporator
underbody front tube assembly (if equipped).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the NEW O-ring seal. 2. Install the evaporator tube (2) to the condenser (4).
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Caution and Notices.
3. Tighten the evaporator tube nut (3) to the condenser (4).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 1528
Tighten Tighten the nut to 28 N.m (20 lb ft).
4. Install the grille. 5. Install the new O-ring seal. 6. Install the evaporator tube to the evaporator.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 28 N.m (20 lb ft).
7. Install the evaporator tube to the auxiliary A/C evaporator underbody front tube assembly (if
equipped).
Tighten Tighten the evaporator tube nut to the auxiliary A/C evaporator to 28 N.m (20 lb ft).
8. Evacuate and recharge the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 9. Leak test
the fittings of the component using the J 39400-A.
10. Install the air cleaner.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 1529
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the IAT sensor. 2. Disconnect the MAF sensor. 3. Remove the air cleaner. 4.
Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 5.
Remove the grille. 6. Remove the engine cover. 7. Remove the compressor hose assembly bolt (2)
from the compressor. 8. Remove the old sealing washers from the compressor.
9. Remove the hose clamp bracket nut (3) from the engine stud.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 1530
10. Remove the compressor hose assembly nut (6) from the condenser. 11. Remove the
compressor hose assembly nut (1) from the accumulator. 12. Remove the bolt from the
transmission filler tube to the oil indicator tube. 13. Remove transmission filler tube from the throttle
cable bracket. 14. Remove the compressor hose assembly from the vehicle. 15. Cap or plug all
open connections on the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Uncap or unplug all open connections. 2. Install the compressor hose assembly to the vehicle. 3.
Install transmission filler tube to the throttle cable bracket.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the bolt to the transmission filler tube to the oil indicator tube.
Tighten Tighten the bolt to the oil indicator tube to 12 N.m (106 lb in).
5. Install the compressor hose assembly nut (1) to the accumulator.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 48 N.m (35 lb ft).
6. Install the compressor hose assembly nut (6) to the condenser.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 28 N.m (21 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 1531
7. Install the hose clamp bracket nut (3) to the engine stud.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 5 N.m (44 lb in).
8. Install the compressor hose assembly seals. 9. Install the sealing washers.
10. Install the compressor hose assembly bolt to the compressor.
Tighten Tighten the bolt to 34 N.m (25 lb ft).
11. Install the engine cover. 12. Install the grille. 13. Evacuate and recharge the system. Refer to
Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 14. Leak test the fittings of the component using the J
39400-A. 15. Install the air cleaner. 16. Connect the IAT sensor. 17. Connect the MAF sensor.
Accumulator Tube Replacement - Auxiliary Side
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 1532
1. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 3. Remove the auxiliary
evaporator outlet side tube (3) from the rear tube. 4. Remove the O-ring seal.
5. Remove the auxiliary evaporator outlet side tube from the compressor hose assembly. 6.
Remove the O-ring seal.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 1533
7. Remove the bolts (1) that retain the clips on the outlet side tube (3) to the body. 8. Remove the
auxiliary evaporator side tube (3) from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the auxiliary evaporator outlet side tube (3) to the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Caution and Notices.
2. Install the bolts (1) that retain the clips on the outlet side tube (3) to the body.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
3. Install the new O-ring seal. Coat the O-ring seal with 525 viscosity refrigerant oil.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 1534
4. Install the auxiliary evaporator outlet side tube to the compressor hose assembly.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 47.5 N.m (35 lb ft).
5. Install the new O-ring seal.
6. Install the auxiliary evaporator outlet underside body tube (3) to the auxiliary evaporator rear
tube.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 47.5 N.m (35 lb ft).
7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Evacuate and recharge the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and
Recharging. 9. Leak test the fittings of the component using the J 39400-A.
Compressor/Condenser Hose Replacement - Auxiliary
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 1535
1. Disconnect the IAT sensor. 2. Disconnect the MAF sensor. 3. Remove the air cleaner. 4.
Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 5.
Remove the grille. 6. Remove the engine cover. 7. Raise vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the
Vehicle. 8. Disconnect the auxiliary evaporator lines nut from the compressor hose assembly. 9.
Lower vehicle.
10. Remove the nut that attaches the compressor hose assembly bracket to the engine.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 1536
11. Remove the hose clamp bracket nut (3) from the engine stud.
12. Remove the compressor hose assembly bolt from the compressor. 13. Remove the sealing
washers from the compressor.
14. Remove the compressor hose assembly nut (6) from the condenser. 15. Remove the
compressor hose assembly nut (1) from the accumulator. 16. Remove the compressor hose
assembly from the vehicle. 17. Cap or plug all open connections.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 1537
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Uncap or unplug all open connections. 2. Install the compressor hose assembly to the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the compressor hose assembly nut (1) to the accumulator.
Tighten Tighten the compressor hose assembly nut (1) to the accumulator to 48 N.m (35 lb ft).
4. Install the compressor hose assembly nut (6) to the condenser.
Tighten Tighten the compressor hose assembly nut to the condenser to 28 N.m (21 lb ft).
5. Install new seal washers to the compressor. 6. Install the compressor hose assembly bolt to the
compressor.
Tighten Tighten the bolt to 34 N.m (25 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 1538
7. Install the hose clamp bracket nut (3) to the engine stud.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 5 N.m (44 lb in).
8. Install the nut that attaches the compressor hose assembly bracket to the engine.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 5 N.m (44 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 1539
9. Raise the vehicle.
10. Connect the auxiliary evaporator hose nut to the compressor hose assembly.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 28 N.m (21 lb ft).
11. Lower the vehicle. 12. Install the engine cover. 13. Install the grille. 14. Evacuate and recharge
the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 15. Leak test the fittings of the
component using the J 39400-A. 16. Install the air cleaner. 17. Connect the IAT sensor. 18.
Connect the MAF sensor.
Evaporator Tube Replacement
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the air cleaner. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant
Recovery and Recharging. 3. Remove the evaporator tube (2) from the evaporator. 4. Remove the
O-ring seal. 5. Remove the grille.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 1540
6. Remove the evaporator tube (2) from the condenser (4). 7. Remove the O-ring seal. 8. Remove
the evaporator tube from the auxiliary A/C evaporator underbody front tube assembly (if equipped).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the NEW O-ring seal. 2. Install the evaporator tube (2) to the condenser (4).
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Caution and Notices.
3. Tighten the evaporator tube nut (3) to the condenser (4).
Tighten Tighten the nut to 28 N.m (20 lb ft).
4. Install the grille. 5. Install the new O-ring seal. 6. Install the evaporator tube to the evaporator.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 28 N.m (20 lb ft).
7. Install the evaporator tube to the auxiliary A/C evaporator underbody front tube assembly (if
equipped).
Tighten Tighten the evaporator tube nut to the auxiliary A/C evaporator to 28 N.m (20 lb ft).
8. Evacuate and recharge the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 9. Leak test
the fittings of the component using the J 39400-A.
10. Install the air cleaner.
Evaporator Tube Replacement - Auxiliary Front
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 1541
1. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 3. Remove the auxiliary
evaporator front inlet tube from the evaporator inlet tube (2) at the accumulator. 4. Remove the
O-ring seal. 5. Remove the bolts (3) that retain the clips on the auxiliary evaporator front inlet tube
(2) to the body. 6. Remove the auxiliary evaporator front inlet tube (2) from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the auxiliary evaporator front inlet tube (2) to the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Caution and Notices.
2. Install the bolts that retain the clips on the auxiliary evaporator front inlet tube (2) to the body.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
3. Install the new O-ring seal. 4. Install the auxiliary evaporator front inlet tube (2) to the auxiliary
evaporator side inlet tube.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 27 N.m (20 lb ft).
5. Lower the vehicle. 6. Evacuate and recharge the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and
Recharging. 7. Leak test the fittings of the component using the J 39400-A.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 1542
Evaporator Tube Replacement - Auxiliary Rear
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 3. Remove the auxiliary
evaporator rear outlet tube from the auxiliary evaporator outlet side tubes. 4. Remove the auxiliary
evaporator rear inlet tube from the auxiliary evaporator inlet side tubes. 5. Remove the bolts that
retain the clips on the tubes to the body. 6. Remove the nut that retains the tube to the auxiliary
evaporator module.
7. Remove the tube from the auxiliary evaporator module. 8. Remove the seal washers
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 1543
1. Install the seal washers. 2. Install the tube to the auxiliary evaporator module.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Caution and Notices.
3. Install the nut that retains the tube to the auxiliary evaporator module.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
4. Install the bolts that retain the clips on the tubes to the body.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
5. Install the auxiliary evaporator rear tube inlet tube to the auxiliary evaporator inlet side tube.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 27 N.m (20 lb ft).
6. Install the auxiliary evaporator rear tube outlet tube to the auxiliary evaporator outlet side tube.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 47.5 N.m (35 lb ft).
7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Evacuate and recharge the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and
Recharging.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 1544
9. Leak test the fitting(s) of the repaired or reinstalled component using the J 39400-A.
Evaporator Tube Replacement - Auxiliary Side
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 3. Remove the auxiliary
evaporator side inlet tube from the auxiliary evaporator rear tube (3). 4. Remove the O-ring seal.
5. Remove the auxiliary evaporator side inlet tube from the auxiliary evaporator front tube (2). 6.
Remove the O-ring seal.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 1545
7. Remove the bolts (1) that retain the clips on the auxiliary side inlet tube (3) to the body. 8.
Remove the auxiliary evaporator side inlet tube (3) from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the auxiliary evaporator side inlet tube (3) to the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Caution and Notices.
2. Install the bolts that retain the clips on the auxiliary evaporator side inlet tube (3) to the body.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
3. Install the new O-ring seal.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 1546
4. Install the auxiliary evaporator side inlet tube to the auxiliary evaporator front inlet tube (2).
Tighten Tighten the nut to 27 N.m (20 lb ft).
5. Install the new O-ring seal. Coat the O-ring seal with 525 viscosity refrigerant oil.
6. Install the auxiliary evaporator side inlet tube (3) to the auxiliary evaporator rear tube.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 27 N.m (20 lb ft).
7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Evacuate and recharge the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and
Recharging. 9. Leak test the fittings of the component using the J 39400-A.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 03-02-32-047 > Oct > 03 > Steering - Whistle Noise
When Driving Straight
Power Steering Line/Hose: Customer Interest Steering - Whistle Noise When Driving Straight
Bulletin No.: 03-02-32-047
Date: October 23, 2003
TECHNICAL
Subject:
Whistle Noise from Front of Vehicle (Install Power Steering Hose Adapter)
Models: 2002-2003 Chevrolet Astro Van Models 2002-2003 GMC Safari Van Models
Condition
Some customers may comment on a whistle noise from the front of the vehicle, but noise will quit
when turning the steering wheel.
Cause
Interaction with the fluid flow through the pressure port and the poppet valve at the power steering
(PS) gear box may cause this condition.
Correction
Install an adapter and 0-ring to the PS gear box high pressure inlet using the following procedure.
1. Remove the return line from the PS gear box in order to gain access to the high pressure line.
2. Remove the high pressure line from the PS gear box.
3. Install the adapter and 0-ring to the PS gear box high pressure inlet.
Tighten Tighten to 27.5 N.m (21 lb ft).
4. Install the high pressure line and 0-ring to the adapter.
Tighten Tighten to 27.5 N.m (21 lb ft).
5. Install the return line and 0-ring to the PS gear box.
Tighten Tighten to 27.5 N.m (21 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 03-02-32-047 > Oct > 03 > Steering - Whistle Noise
When Driving Straight > Page 1555
6. Bleed the PS system.
7. Clean the area with brake cleaner.
8. Inspect for leaks.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 03-02-32-047 > Oct > 03 > Steering Whistle Noise When Driving Straight
Power Steering Line/Hose: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering - Whistle Noise When Driving
Straight
Bulletin No.: 03-02-32-047
Date: October 23, 2003
TECHNICAL
Subject:
Whistle Noise from Front of Vehicle (Install Power Steering Hose Adapter)
Models: 2002-2003 Chevrolet Astro Van Models 2002-2003 GMC Safari Van Models
Condition
Some customers may comment on a whistle noise from the front of the vehicle, but noise will quit
when turning the steering wheel.
Cause
Interaction with the fluid flow through the pressure port and the poppet valve at the power steering
(PS) gear box may cause this condition.
Correction
Install an adapter and 0-ring to the PS gear box high pressure inlet using the following procedure.
1. Remove the return line from the PS gear box in order to gain access to the high pressure line.
2. Remove the high pressure line from the PS gear box.
3. Install the adapter and 0-ring to the PS gear box high pressure inlet.
Tighten Tighten to 27.5 N.m (21 lb ft).
4. Install the high pressure line and 0-ring to the adapter.
Tighten Tighten to 27.5 N.m (21 lb ft).
5. Install the return line and 0-ring to the PS gear box.
Tighten Tighten to 27.5 N.m (21 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 03-02-32-047 > Oct > 03 > Steering Whistle Noise When Driving Straight > Page 1561
6. Bleed the PS system.
7. Clean the area with brake cleaner.
8. Inspect for leaks.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 1562
Power Steering Line/Hose: Specifications
Power Steering Hose Fittings 20 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > P/S Cooler Pipe/Hose Replacement
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair P/S Cooler Pipe/Hose Replacement
Power Steering Cooler Pipe/Hose Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Disconnect the power steering cooler hose from the steering pump. 2. Raise the vehicle. Refer
to Vehicle Lifting. 3. Install a drain pan under the vehicle. 4. Disconnect the power steering cooler
pipe hose from the steering gear.
5. Remove the power steering cooler pipe (2) from the air baffle (3). 6. Remove the power steering
cooler pipe from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > P/S Cooler Pipe/Hose Replacement > Page 1565
1. Install the power steering cooler pipe to the vehicle. 2. Install the power steering cooler pipe (2)
to the air baffle (3).
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Connect the power steering cooler pipe to the steering gear.
- Tighten the power steering cooler pipe to the steering gear to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.).
4. Lower the vehicle. 5. Connect the power steering cooler hose to the steering pump. 6. Bleed the
power steering system.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > P/S Cooler Pipe/Hose Replacement > Page 1566
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Power Brake Booster Inlet Hose Replacement
Power Brake Booster Inlet Hose Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Disconnect the hydraulic brake booster
inlet hose from the of the power steering pump. 3. Lower the vehicle.
4. Disconnect the hydraulic brake booster inlet hose from the hydraulic brake booster. 5. Remove
the hydraulic brake booster inlet hose from vehicle.
Installation Procedure
Notice: Do not start the engine with any power steering hose disconnected, or damage to the
components could occur.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > P/S Cooler Pipe/Hose Replacement > Page 1567
1. Install the hydraulic brake booster inlet hose to vehicle. 2. Connect the hydraulic brake booster
inlet hose to the hydraulic brake booster. 3. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Connect the hydraulic brake booster inlet hose to the power steering pump.
- Tighten the hydraulic brake booster inlet hose to the power steering pump to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.).
5. Bleed the system.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > P/S Cooler Pipe/Hose Replacement > Page 1568
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Power Brake Booster Outlet Hose Replacement
Power Brake Booster Outlet Hose Replacement
Removal Procedure
Important: Note the position of all the tie-straps, power steering hoses and the hose insulators for
proper re-installation.
1. Remove the power brake booster outlet hose tie-straps. 2. Place a drain pan under the vehicle.
3. Disconnect the power steering cooler hose from the power steering gear. 4. Disconnect the
hydraulic brake booster outlet hose from the steering gear. 5. Disconnect the hydraulic brake
booster outlet hose from the hydraulic brake booster.
6. Remove the hydraulic brake booster outlet hose from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
Notice: Do not start the engine with any power steering hose disconnected, or damage to the
components could occur.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > P/S Cooler Pipe/Hose Replacement > Page 1569
1. Install the hydraulic brake booster outlet hose to the vehicle.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Connect the hydraulic brake booster outlet hose to the hydraulic brake booster.
- Tighten the hydraulic brake booster outlet hose to the hydraulic brake booster to 27 Nm (20 ft.
lbs.).
3. Connect the hydraulic brake booster outlet hose to the power steering gear.
- Tighten the hydraulic brake booster outlet hose to the power steering gear to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.).
4. Remove the drain pan. 5. Install the hydraulic brake booster outlet hose tie straps. 6. Bleed the
system.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Radiator Hose > Component Information > Specifications
Radiator Hose: Specifications
Upper Radiator Hose Support Bracket Nut to Exhaust Manifold Stud
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 27 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Radiator Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Radiator Hose Replacement - Inlet
Radiator Hose: Service and Repair Radiator Hose Replacement - Inlet
Radiator Hose Replacement - Inlet
Removal Procedure
1. Drain the coolant from the radiator to a level below the hose being removed. 2. Remove the air
cleaner assembly.
3. Reposition the radiator hose clamp. 4. Remove the inlet hose from the radiator. 5. Reposition the
clamp from the thermostat housing. 6. Remove the inlet hose from the thermostat housing
Installation Procedure
1. Install the inlet hose to the thermostat housing. 2. Reposition the clamp to the thermostat
housing. 3. Install the inlet hose to the radiator. 4. Reposition the clamp to the radiator. 5. Install the
air cleaner assembly. 6. Fill the coolant to the proper level.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Radiator Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Radiator Hose Replacement - Inlet > Page 1575
Radiator Hose: Service and Repair Radiator Hose Replacement - Outlet
Radiator Hose Replacement - Outlet
Removal Procedure
1. Drain the engine coolant. 2. Remove the air cleaner assembly. 3. Reposition the radiator hose
clamp. 4. Remove the outlet hose from the radiator. 5. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to
Vehicle Lifting. 6. Reposition the outlet hose clamp from the water pump.
7. Remove the outlet hose from the water pump.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the outlet hose to the water pump. 2. Reposition the outlet hose clamp to the water pump.
3. Lower the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 4. Install the outlet hose to radiator. 5. Reposition the
radiator hose clamp.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Radiator Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Radiator Hose Replacement - Inlet > Page 1576
6. Install the air cleaner assembly. 7. Fill the engine coolant.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Specifications
Brake Fluid: Specifications
Type Delco Supreme 11 or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Cooling System - DEX-COOL(R) Coolant Leak Detection Dye
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System - DEX-COOL(R) Coolant Leak Detection Dye
Bulletin No.: 05-06-02-002B
Date: January 18, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: DEX-COOL(R) Coolant - New Leak Detection Dye J 46366 - Replaces J 29545-6
Models: 1996-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light/Medium Duty Trucks* (including Saturn)
1997-2008 Isuzu T-Series Medium Duty Tilt Cab Models Built in Janesville and Flint 1999-2008
Isuzu N-Series Medium Duty Commercial Models with 5.7L or 6.0L Gas Engine
2003-2008 HUMMER H2 2006-2008 HUMMER H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
*EXCLUDING 2006 and Prior Chevrolet Aveo, Epica, Optra, Vivant and Pontiac Matiz, Wave
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to include additional model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 05-06-02-002A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
Leak detection dye P/N 12378563 (J 29545-6) (in Canada P/N 88900915) may cause
DEX-COOL(R) coolant to appear green in a black vessel making it appear to be conventional
(green) coolant. This may cause a technician to add conventional coolant to a low DEX-COOL(R)
system thus contaminating it. The green DEX-COOL(R) appearance is caused by the color of the
leak detection dye which alters the color of the DEX-COOL(R) coolant.
A new leak detection dye P/N 89022219 (J 46366) (in Canada P/N 89022220) has been released
that does not alter the appearance of the DEX-COOL(R) coolant. When adding the new leak
detection dye the color of the DEX-COOL(R) coolant will not change. For detecting leaks on any
system that uses DEX-COOL(R) leak detection dye P/N 89022219 (in Canada P/N 89022220)
should be used. The new leak detection dye can be used with both conventional and
DEX-COOL(R) coolant.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Cooling System - DEX-COOL(R) Coolant Leak Detection Dye > Page 1585
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information
Bulletin No.: 00-06-02-006D
Date: August 15, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Engine Coolant Recycling and Warranty Information
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2007 and Prior
HUMMER Vehicles 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Attention:
Please address this bulletin to the Warranty Claims Administrator and the Service Manager.
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to adjust the title and Include Warranty Information. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 00-06-02-006C (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
Coolant Reimbursement Policy
General Motors supports the use of recycled engine coolant for warranty repairs/service, providing
a GM approved engine coolant recycling system is used. Recycled coolant will be reimbursed at
the GMSPO dealer price for new coolant plus the appropriate mark-up. When coolant replacement
is required during a warranty repair, it is crucial that only the relative amount of engine coolant
concentrate be charged, not the total diluted volume. In other words: if you are using two gallons of
pre-diluted (50:50) recycled engine coolant to service a vehicle, you may request reimbursement
for one gallon of GM Goodwrench engine coolant concentrate at the dealer price plus the
appropriate warranty parts handling allowance.
Licensed Approved DEX-COOL(R) Providers
Important:
USE OF NON-APPROVED VIRGIN OR RECYCLED DEX-COOL(R) OR DEVIATIONS IN THE
FORM OF ALTERNATE CHEMICALS OR ALTERATION OF EQUIPMENT, WILL VOID THE GM
ENDORSEMENT, MAY DEGRADE COOLANT SYSTEM INTEGRITY AND PLACE THE
COOLING SYSTEM WARRANTY UNDER JEOPARDY.
Shown in Table 1 are the only current licensed and approved providers of DEX-COOL(R). Products
that are advertised as "COMPATIBLE" or "RECOMMENDED" for use with DEX-COOL(R) have not
been tested or approved by General Motors. Non-approved coolants may degrade the
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Cooling System - DEX-COOL(R) Coolant Leak Detection Dye > Page 1586
coolant system integrity and will no longer be considered a 5 yr/150,000 mile (240,000 km) coolant.
Coolant Removal Services/Recycling
The tables include all coolant recycling processes currently approved by GM. Also included is a
primary phone number and demographic information. Used DEX-COOL(R) can be combined with
used conventional coolant (green) for recycling. Depending on the recycling service and/or
equipment, it is then designated as a conventional 2 yr/30,000 mile (50,000 km) coolant or
DEX-COOL(R) 5 yr/150,000 mile (240,000 km) coolant. Recycled coolants as designated in this
bulletin may be used during the vehicle(s) warranty period.
DEX-COOL(R) Recycling
The DEX-COOL(R) recycling service listed in Table 2 has been approved for recycling waste
engine coolants (DEX-COOL) or conventional) to DEX-COOL(R) with 5 yr/150,000 mile (240,000
km) usability. Recycling Fluid Technologies is the only licensed provider of Recycled
DEX-COOL(R) meeting GM6277M specifications and utilizes GM approved inhibitor packages.
This is currently a limited program being monitored by GM Service Operations which will be
expanded as demand increases.
Conventional (Green) Recycling
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Cooling System - DEX-COOL(R) Coolant Leak Detection Dye > Page 1587
Processes shown in the Table 3 are capable of recycling waste engine coolants (DEX-COOL(R) or
conventional) to a conventional (green) coolant. Recycling conventional coolant can be
accomplished at your facility by a technician using approved EQUIPMENT (listed by model number
in Table 3), or by an approved coolant recycling SERVICE which may recycle the coolant at your
facility or at an offsite operation. Refer to the table for GM approved coolant recyclers in either of
these two categories. Should you decide to recycle the coolant yourself, strict adherence to the
operating procedures is imperative. Use ONLY the inhibitor chemicals supplied by the respective
(GM approved) recycling equipment manufacturer.
Sealing Tablets
Cooling System Sealing Tablets (Seal Tabs) should not be used as a regular maintenance item
after servicing an engine cooling system. Discoloration of coolant can occur if too many seal tabs
have been inserted into the cooling system. This can occur if seal tabs are repeatedly used over
the service life of a vehicle. Where appropriate, seal tabs may be used if diagnostics fail to repair a
small leak in the cooling system. When a condition appears in which seal tabs may be
recommended, a specific bulletin will be released describing their proper usage.
Water Quality
The integrity of the coolant is dependent upon the quality of DEX-COOL(R) and water.
DEX-COOL(R) is a product that has enhanced protection capability as well as an extended service
interval. These enhanced properties may be jeopardized by combining DEX-COOL(R) with poor
quality water. If you suspect the water in your area of being poor quality, it is recommended you
use distilled or de-ionized water with DEX-COOL(R).
"Pink" DEX-COOL(R)
DEX-COOL(R) is orange in color to distinguish it from other coolants. Due to inconsistencies in the
mixing of the dyes used with DEX-COOL(R), some batches may appear pink after time. The color
shift from orange to pink does not affect the integrity of the coolant, and still maintains the 5
yr/150,000 mile (240,000 km) service interval.
Back Service
Only use DEX-COOL(R) if the vehicle was originally equipped with DEX-COOL(R).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Cooling System - DEX-COOL(R) Coolant Leak Detection Dye > Page 1588
Contamination
Mixing conventional green coolant with DEX-COOL(R) will degrade the service interval from 5
yrs./150,000 miles (240,000 km) to 2 yrs./30,000 miles (50,000 km) if left in the contaminated
condition. If contamination occurs, the cooling system must be flushed twice immediately and
re-filled with a 50/50 mixture of DEX-COOL(R) and clean water in order to preserve the enhanced
properties and extended service interval of DEX-COOL(R).
After 5 years/150,000 miles (240,000 km)
After 5 yrs/150,000 miles (240,000 km), the coolant should be changed, preferably using a coolant
exchanger. If the vehicle was originally equipped with DEX-COOL(R) and has not had problems
with contamination from non-DEX-COOL(R) coolants, then the service interval remains the same,
and the coolant does not need to be changed for another 5 yrs/150,000 miles (240,000 km)
Equipment (Coolant Exchangers)
The preferred method of performing coolant replacement is to use a coolant exchanger. A coolant
exchanger can replace virtually all of the old coolant with new coolant. Coolant exchangers can be
used to perform coolant replacement without spillage, and facilitate easy waste collection. They
can also be used to lower the coolant level in a vehicle to allow for less messy servicing of cooling
system components. It is recommended that you use a coolant exchanger with a vacuum feature
facilitates removing trapped air from the cooling system. This is a substantial time savings over
repeatedly thermo cycling the vehicle and topping-off the radiator. The vacuum feature also allows
venting of a hot system to relieve system pressure. Approved coolant exchangers are available
through the GMDE (General Motors Dealer Equipment) program.
For refilling a cooling system that has been partially or fully drained for repairs other than coolant
replacement, the Vac-N-Fill Coolant Refill Tool (GE-47716) is recommended to facilitate removal of
trapped air from the cooling system during refill.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Coolant: Capacity Specifications
Coolant Capacity
w/ C36 (Rear Heater) ..........................................................................................................................
.................................................................. 16.5 qts. w/o C36 (Rear Heater) .......................................
................................................................................................................................................... 13.5
qts.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1591
Coolant: Fluid Type Specifications
Coolant
Type .................................................................................................... Use only GM Goodwrench(R)
Dex-Cool(R) in a 50/50 mixture with clean water.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-037E
Date: April 07, 2011
Subject: Release of DEXRON(R)-VI Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF)
Models:
2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2003-2008 HUMMER H2 2006-2008
HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saturn Relay 2005 and Prior Saturn L-Series 2005-2007 Saturn ION
2005-2008 Saturn VUE with 4T45-E 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X Except 2008 and Prior Chevrolet Aveo,
Equinox Except 2006 and Prior Chevrolet Epica Except 2007 and Prior Chevrolet Optra Except
2008 and Prior Pontiac Torrent, Vibe, Wave Except 2003-2005 Saturn ION with CVT or AF23 Only
Except 1991-2002 Saturn S-Series Except 2008 and Prior Saturn VUE with CVT, AF33 or 5AT
(MJ7/MJ8) Transmission Only Except 2008 Saturn Astra
Attention:
DEXRON(R)-VI Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF) is the only approved fluid for warranty repairs
for General Motors transmissions/transaxles requiring DEXRON(R)-III and/or prior DEXRON(R)
transmission fluids.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-037D (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
MANUAL TRANSMISSIONS / TRANSFER CASES and POWER STEERING
The content of this bulletin does not apply to manual transmissions or transfer cases. Any vehicle
that previously required DEXRON(R)-III for a manual transmission or transfer case should now use
P/N 88861800. This fluid is labeled Manual Transmission and Transfer Case Fluid. Some manual
transmissions and transfer cases require a different fluid. Appropriate references should be
checked when servicing any of these components.
Power Steering Systems should now use P/N 9985010 labeled Power Steering Fluid.
Consult the Parts Catalog, Owner's Manual, or Service Information (SI) for fluid recommendations.
Some of our customers and/or General Motors dealerships/Saturn Retailers may have some
concerns with DEXRON(R)-VI and DEXRON(R)-III Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF) and
transmission warranty claims. DEXRON(R)-VI is the only approved fluid for warranty repairs for
General Motors transmissions/transaxles requiring DEXRON(R)-III and/or prior DEXRON(R)
transmission fluids (except as noted above). Please remember that the clean oil reservoirs of the
J-45096 - Flushing and Flow Tester machine should be purged of DEXRON(R)-III and filled with
DEXRON(R)-VI for testing, flushing or filling General Motors transmissions/transaxles (except as
noted above).
DEXRON(R)-VI can be used in any proportion in past model vehicles equipped with an automatic
transmission/transaxle in place of DEXRON(R)-III (i.e. topping off the fluid in the event of a repair
or fluid change). DEXRON(R)-VI is also compatible with any former version of DEXRON(R) for use
in automatic transmissions/transaxles.
DEXRON(R)-VI ATF
General Motors Powertrain has upgraded to DEXRON(R)-VI ATF with the start of 2006 vehicle
production.
Current and prior automatic transmission models that had used DEXRON(R)-III must now only use
DEXRON(R)-VI.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information > Page 1596
All 2006 and future model transmissions that use DEXRON(R)-VI are to be serviced ONLY with
DEXRON(R)-VI fluid.
DEXRON(R)-VI is an improvement over DEXRON(R)-III in the following areas:
* These ATF change intervals remain the same as DEXRON(R)-III for the time being.
2006-2008 Transmission Fill and Cooler Flushing
Some new applications of the 6L80 six speed transmission will require the use of the J 45096 Flushing and Flow Tester to accomplish transmission fluid fill. The clean oil reservoir of the
machine should be purged of DEXRON(R)-III and filled with DEXRON(R)-VI.
Parts Information
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information > Page 1597
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Water Or Coolant Contamination Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-07-30-035B
Date: November 01, 2010
Subject: Information on Water or Ethylene Glycol in Transmission Fluid
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks with Automatic Transmission
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 08-07-30-035A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Water or ethylene glycol in automatic transmission fluid (ATF) is harmful to internal transmission
components and will have a negative effect on reliability and durability of these parts. Water or
ethylene glycol in ATF will also change the friction of the clutches, frequently resulting in shudder
during engagement or gear changes, especially during torque converter clutch engagement.
Indications of water in the ATF may include:
- ATF blowing out of the transmission vent tube.
- ATF may appear cloudy or, in cases of extreme contamination, have the appearance of a
strawberry milkshake.
- Visible water in the oil pan.
- A milky white substance inside the pan area.
- Spacer plate gaskets that appear to be glued to the valve body face or case.
- Spacer plate gaskets that appear to be swollen or wrinkled in areas where they are not
compressed.
- Rust on internal transmission iron/steel components.
If water in the ATF has been found and the source of the water entry has not been identified, or if a
leaking in-radiator transmission oil cooler is suspected (with no evidence of cross-contamination in
the coolant recovery reservoir), a simple and quick test kit is available that detects the presence of
ethylene glycol in ATF. The "Gly-Tek" test kit, available from the Nelco Company, should be
obtained and the ATF tested to make an accurate decision on the need for radiator replacement.
This can help to prevent customer comebacks if the in-radiator transmission oil cooler is leaking
and reduce repair expenses by avoiding radiator replacement if the cooler is not leaking. These
test kits can be obtained from:
Nelco Company
Test kits can be ordered by phone or through the website listed above. Orders are shipped
standard delivery time but can be shipped on a next day delivery basis for an extra charge. One
test kit will complete 10 individual fluid sample tests. For vehicles repaired under warranty, the cost
of the complete test kit plus shipping charges should be divided by 10 and submitted on the
warranty claim as a net item.
The transmission should be repaired or replaced based on the normal cost comparison procedure.
Important If water or coolant is found in the transmission, the following components MUST be
replaced.
- Replace all of the rubber-type seals.
- Replace all of the composition-faced clutch plates and/or bands.
- Replace all of the nylon parts.
- Replace the torque converter.
- Thoroughly clean and rebuild the transmission, using new gaskets and oil filter.
Important The following steps must be completed when repairing or replacing.
Flush and flow check the transmission oil cooler using J 45096. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
02-07-30-052F- Automatic Transmission Oil Cooler Flush and Flow Test Essential Tool J 45096
TransFlow.
- Thoroughly inspect the engine cooling system and hoses and clean/repair as necessary.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information > Page 1598
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information > Page 1599
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Oil Cooler Flushing/Flow Check Procedures
File In Section: 07 - Transmission/Transaxle
Bulletin No.: 99-07-30-017A
Date: February, 2003
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Oil Cooler Flushing and Flow Check Procedures
Models: 2003 and Prior GM Light Duty Trucks 2003 HUMMER H2 with Allison(R) Automatic
Transmission (RPO M74)
This bulletin revises bulletin 99-07-30-017 to reflect the release of the new Transflow(R) J 45096
Transmission Cooling System Service Tool. The Transflow(R) Transmission Cooling System
Service Tool is to be used for all vehicles. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 99-07-30-017
(Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle). Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 02-07-30-052.
Important:
If you were sent here by the instruction booklet for the J 45096 TransFlow(R) machine, note that
the table has been moved to Corporate Bulletin Number 02-07-30-052.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications
Transmission Fluid Pan Removal ........................................................................................................
............................................................................................. 4.7L (5.0 Qt) Overhaul ...........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... 10.6L (11.0 Qt)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1602
Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Transmission Fluid Type
Type .....................................................................................................................................................
...................................... DEXRON III or Equivalent
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1603
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair
Automatic Transmission Fluid/Filter Replacement
Removal Procedure
Caution: When the transmission is at operating temperatures, take necessary precautions when
removing the drain plug, to avoid being burned by draining fluid.
1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting.
2. Place a drain pan under the transmission oil pan. 3. Remove the oil pan drain plug, if equipped.
4. If necessary, remove the bolts and position aside the range selector cable bracket for clearance
while lowering the pan. It is not necessary to
remove the cable from the lever or bracket.
5. Remove the oil pan bolts from the front and sides of the pan only. 6. Loosen the rear oil pan
bolts approximately 4 turns. 7. Lightly tap the oil pan with a rubber mallet in order to loosen the pan
to allow the fluid to drain.
8. Remove the remaining oil pan bolts.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1604
9. Remove the oil pan and the gasket.
10. Grasp firmly while pulling down with a twisting motion in order to remove the filter. 11. Remove
the filter seal. The filter seal may be stuck in the pump; if necessary, carefully use pliers or another
suitable tool to remove the seal. 12. Discard the seal. 13. Inspect the fluid color.
14. Inspect the filter. Pry the metal crimping away from the top of the filter and pull apart. The filter
may contain the following evidence for root cause
diagnosis: ^
Clutch material
^ Bronze slivers indicating bushing wear
^ Steel particles
15. Clean the transmission case and the oil pan gasket surfaces with solvent, and air dry. You must
remove all traces of the old gasket material.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1605
1. Coat the new filter seal with automatic transmission fluid.
2. Install the new filter seal into the transmission case. Tap the seal into place using a suitable size
socket. 3. Install the new filter into the case.
4. Install the oil pan and a new gasket.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
5. Install the oil pan bolts.
Tighten the oil pan to transmission case bolts alternately and evenly to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
6. If previously removed, install the range selector cable bracket and bolts.
Tighten the bolts to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
7. Apply a small amount of sealant GM P/N 12346004 to the threads of the oil pan drain plug, if
equipped. 8. Install the oil pan drain plug, if equipped.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1606
Tighten the oil pan drain plug to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
9. Lower the vehicle.
10. Fill the transmission to the proper level with DEXRON III transmission fluid. 11. Check the
COLD fluid level reading for initial fill only. 12. Inspect the oil pan gasket for leaks.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Differential > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications
Fluid - Differential: Capacity Specifications
Rear Differential
Differential Oil Capacity
Capacity ...............................................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 3.5 Pints
Front Differential
Differential Oil Capacity
Front ....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 1.2L (2.6 Pints)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Differential > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications > Page 1611
Fluid - Differential: Fluid Type Specifications
Differential Fluid Type
Front Grade .........................................................................................................................................
.................................................................................... GL-5 Viscosity ................................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
..... 80W-90 Rear Grade ......................................................................................................................
................................................................................................. Synthetic Viscosity .............................
..............................................................................................................................................................
........................ 75W-90
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Differential > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Lubricant Level Check
Fluid - Differential: Service and Repair Lubricant Level Check
Lubricant Level Check
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Make sure the vehicle is level. 3. Inspect the rear
axle for leaks. Repair as necessary. 4. Clean the area around the rear axle fill plug.
5. Remove the rear axle fill plug. 6. Inspect the lubricant level.
Specification The lubricant level should be between 0 - 10 mm (0 - 0.4 inch) below the fill plug
opening.
7. If the level is low, add lubricant until the level is even with the bottom edge of the fill plug
opening. Use the proper fluid.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
8. Install the rear axle fill plug.
Tighten the rear axle fill plug to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
9. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Differential > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Lubricant Level Check > Page 1614
Fluid - Differential: Service and Repair Lubricant Change
Lubricant Change Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting.
2. Remove the rear axle fill plug.
3. Remove the rear axle housing cover and the rear axle housing cover gasket. 4. Drain the
lubricant into a suitable container. 5. Inspect the drain plug for excessive metal particle
accumulation. This accumulation is symptomatic of extreme wear. 6. Clean the drain plug.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the new rear axle housing cover gasket and the rear axle housing cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Differential > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Lubricant Level Check > Page 1615
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the rear axle housing cover bolts.
Tighten the rear axle housing cover bolts to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
3. Fill the rear axle. Use the proper fluid.
4. Install the rear axle fill plug.
Tighten the rear axle fill plug to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
5. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Engine - GM dexos 1 and dexos 2(R) Oil Specifications
Engine Oil: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - GM dexos 1 and dexos 2(R) Oil Specifications
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 11-00-90-001
Date: March 14, 2011
Subject: Global Information for GM dexos1(TM) and GM dexos2(TM) Engine Oil Specifications for
Spark Ignited and Diesel Engines, Available Licensed Brands, and Service Fill for Adding or
Complete Oil Change
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Excluding All Vehicles Equipped with
Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines
GM dexos 1(TM) Information Center Website
Refer to the following General Motors website for dexos 1(TM) information about the different
licensed brands that are currently available: http://www.gmdexos.com
GM dexos 1(TM) Engine Oil Trademark and Icons
The dexos(TM) specification and trademarks are exclusive to General Motors, LLC.
Only those oils displaying the dexos‹›(TM) trademark and icon on the front label meet the
demanding performance requirements and stringent quality standards set forth in the dexos‹›(TM)
specification.
Look on the front label for any of the logos shown above to identify an authorized, licensed dexos
1(TM) engine oil.
GM dexos 1(TM) Engine Oil Specification
Important General Motors dexos 1(TM) engine oil specification replaces the previous General
Motors specifications GM6094M, GM4718M and GM-LL-A-025 for most GM gasoline engines. The
oil specified for use in GM passenger cars and trucks, PRIOR to the 2011 model year remains
acceptable for those previous vehicles. However, dexos 1(TM) is backward compatible and can be
used in those older vehicles.
In North America, starting with the 2011 model year, GM introduced dexos 1(TM) certified engine
oil as a factory fill and service fill for gasoline engines. The reasons for the new engine oil
specification are as follows:
- To meet environmental goals such as increasing fuel efficiency and reducing engine emissions.
- To promote long engine life.
- To minimize the number of engine oil changes in order to help meet the goal of lessening the
industry's overall dependence on crude oil.
dexos 1(TM) is a GM-developed engine oil specification that has been designed to provide the
following benefits:
- Further improve fuel economy, to meet future corporate average fuel economy (CAFE)
requirements and fuel economy retention by allowing the oil to maintain its fuel economy benefits
throughout the life of the oil.
- More robust formulations for added engine protection and aeration performance.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Engine - GM dexos 1 and dexos 2(R) Oil Specifications > Page 1620
- Support the GM Oil Life System, thereby minimizing the replacement of engine oil, before its life
has been depleted.
- Reduce the duplication of requirements for a large number of internal GM engine oil
specifications.
International Lubricants Standardization and Approval Committee (ILSAC)
GF-5 Standard
In addition to GM dexos 1(TM), a new International Lubricants Standardization and Approval
Committee (ILSAC) standard called GF-5, was introduced in October 2010.
- There will be a corresponding API category, called: SN Resource Conserving. The current GF-4
standard was put in place in 2004 and will become obsolete in October 2011. Similar to dexos
1(TM), the GF-5 standard will use a new fuel economy test, Sequence VID, which demands a
statistically significant increase in fuel economy versus the Sequence VIB test that was used for
GF-4.
- It is expected that all dexos 1(TM) approved oils will be capable of meeting the GF-5 standard.
However, not all GF-5 engine oils will be capable of meeting the dexos 1(TM) specification.
- Like dexos(TM), the new ILSAC GF-5 standard will call for more sophisticated additives. The API
will begin licensing marketers during October 2010, to produce and distribute GF-5 certified
products, which are expected to include SAE 0W-20, 0W-30, 5W-20, 5W-30 and 10W-30 oils.
Corporate Average Fuel Economy (CAFE) Requirements Effect on Fuel Economy
Since CAFE standards were first introduced in 1974, the fuel economy of cars has more than
doubled, while the fuel economy of light trucks has increased by more than 50 percent. Proposed
CAFE standards call for a continuation of increased fuel economy in new cars and trucks. To meet
these future requirements, all aspects of vehicle operation are being looked at more critically than
ever before.
New technology being introduced in GM vehicles designed to increase vehicle efficiency and fuel
economy include direct injection, cam phasing, turbocharging and active fuel management (AFM).
The demands of these new technologies on engine oil also are taken into consideration when
determining new oil specifications. AFM for example can help to achieve improved fuel economy.
However alternately deactivating and activating the cylinders by not allowing the intake and
exhaust valves to open contributes to additional stress on the engine oil.
Another industry trend for meeting tough fuel economy mandates has been a shift toward lower
viscosity oils.
dexos 1(TM) will eventually be offered in several viscosity grades in accordance with engine needs:
SAE 0W-20, 5W-20, 0W-30 and 5W-30.
Using the right viscosity grade oil is critical for proper engine performance. Always refer to the
Maintenance section of a vehicle Owner Manual for the proper viscosity grade for the engine being
serviced.
GM Oil Life System in Conjunction With dexos (TM) Supports Extended Oil Change Intervals
To help conserve oil while maintaining engine protection, many GM vehicles are equipped with the
GM Oil Life System. This system can provide oil change intervals that exceed the traditional 3,000
mile (4,830 km) recommendation.
The dexos (TM) specification, with its requirements for improved oil robustness, compliments the
GM Oil Life System by supporting extended oil change intervals over the lifetime of a vehicle.
If all GM customers with GM Oil Life System equipped vehicles would use the system as intended,
GM estimates that more than 100 million gallons of oil could be saved annually.
GM dexos 2(TM) Information Center Website
Refer to the following General Motors website for dexos 2(TM) information about the different
licensed brands that are currently available: http://www.gmdexos.com
GM dexos 2(TM) Engine Oil Trademark and Icons
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Engine - GM dexos 1 and dexos 2(R) Oil Specifications > Page 1621
The dexos (TM) specification and trademarks are exclusive to General Motors, LLC.
Only those oils displaying the dexos (TM) trademark and icon on the front label meet the
demanding performance requirements and stringent quality standards set forth in the dexos
(TM)specification.
Look on the front label for any of the logos shown above to identify an authorized, licensed dexos
2(TM) engine oil.
GM dexos 2(TM) Engine Oil Specification
- dexos 2(TM) is approved and recommended by GM for use in Europe starting in model year 2010
vehicles, regardless of where the vehicle was manufactured.
- dexos 2(TM) is the recommended service fill oil for European gasoline engines.
Important The Duramax(TM) diesel engine is the exception and requires lubricants meeting
specification CJ-4.
- dexos 2(TM) is the recommended service fill oil for European light-duty diesel engines and
replaces GM-LL-B-025 and GM-LL-A-025.
- dexos 2(TM) protects diesel engines from harmful soot deposits and is designed with limits on
certain chemical components to prolong catalyst life and protect expensive emission reduction
systems. It is a robust oil, resisting degradation between oil changes and maintaining optimum
performance longer.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Engine Oil: Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil ............................................................................................................................................
............................................................. 4.2L (4.5 Qt)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1624
Engine Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Engine Oil
API Classification .................................................................................................................................
........................................ Look for Starburst Symbol Viscosity ...........................................................
..........................................................................................................................................................
5W-30
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1625
Engine Oil: Service and Repair
Engine Oil and Oil Filter Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle and support with safety stands. Refer to Vehicle Lifting.
2. Remove the oil pan drain plug and drain the engine oil in a suitable container.
3. Remove the engine oil filter. 4. Inspect to ensure the engine oil filter gasket is removed.
Installation Procedure
1. Lubricate the engine oil filter gasket with clean engine oil.
2. Install the engine oil filter.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1626
3. Follow the tightening instructions on the oil filter.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the drain plug to the oil pan.
Tighten the oil pan plug to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
5. Remove the safety stands and lower the vehicle. 6. Fill the engine with the proper capacity and
quality of engine oil. 7. Operate the engine, check for leaks and oil pressure. 8. Check the oil level
and add as required.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Specifications
Power Steering Fluid: Specifications
Power Steering System GM Power Steering Fluid (GM Part No. 1052884 - 1 pint, 1050017 - 1
quart, or equivalent).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recycling/Equipment
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recycling/Equipment
Bulletin No.: 08-01-38-001
Date: January 25, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Information On New GE-48800 CoolTech Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2008 and
Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
Attention:
This bulletin is being issued to announce the release of GM approved Air Conditioning (A/C)
Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging Equipment that meets the new Society of Automotive
Engineers (SAE) J2788 Refrigerant Recovery Standards. The ACR2000 (J-43600) cannot be
manufactured in its current state after December 2007 and will be superseded by GE-48800.
The new J2788 standard does not require that GM Dealers replace their ACR2000 units.
ACR2000's currently in use are very capable of servicing today's refrigerant systems when used
correctly and can continue to be used. Details regarding the new SAE J2788 standard are outlined
in GM Bulletin 07-01-38-004.
Effective February 1 2008, new A/C Refrigerant Recovery/Recharging equipment (P/N GE-48800)
will be released as a required replacement for the previously essential ACR2000 (J-43600). This
equipment is SAE J2788 compliant and meets GM requirements for A/C Refrigerant System
Repairs on all General Motors vehicles, including Hybrid systems with Polyolester (POE)
refrigerant oil. This equipment will not be shipped as an essential tool to GM Dealerships.
In addition, this equipment is Hybrid compliant and designed to prevent oil cross contamination
when servicing Hybrid vehicles with Electric A/C Compressors that use POE refrigerant oil.
The ACR2000 (J-43600) will need to be retrofitted with a J-43600-50 (Hose - ACR2000 Oil Flush
Loop) to be able to perform Hybrid A/C service work. All Hybrid dealers will receive the J-43600-50,
with installation instructions, as a component of the Hybrid essential tool package. Dealerships that
do not sell Hybrids, but may need to service Hybrids, can obtain J-43600-50 from SPX Kent Moore.
Refer to GM Bulletin 08-01-39-001 for the ACR2000 Hose Flush procedure.
The High Voltage (HV) electric A/C compressor used on Two Mode Hybrid vehicles uses a
Polyolester (POE) refrigerant oil instead of a Polyalkylene Glycol (PAG) synthetic refrigerant oil.
This is due to the better electrical resistance of the POE oil and its ability to provide HV isolation.
Failure to flush the hoses before adding refrigerant to a Hybrid vehicle with an electric A/C
compressor may result in an unacceptable amount of PAG oil entering the refrigerant system. It
may cause a Battery Energy Control Module Hybrid Battery Voltage System Isolation Lost
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC P1AE7) to be set. Additionally, the A/C system warranty will be
voided.
Warranty Submission Requirements
The Electronically Generated Repair Data (snapshot summary) and printer functions have been
eliminated from the GE-48800. The VGA display and temperature probes were eliminated to
reduce equipment costs. As a result, effective immediately the 18 digit "Snapshot/Charge
Summary" code is no longer required for Air Conditioning (A/C) refrigerant system repairs that are
submitted for warranty reimbursement. The charge summary data from before and after system
repairs will continue to required, but documented on the repair order only. Both high and low
pressures and the recovery and charge amounts should be noted during the repair and entered on
the repair order. If using ACR2000 (J-43600), the "Snapshot/Charge Summary" printouts should
continue to be attached to the shops copy of the repair order.
The labor codes that are affected by this requirement are D3000 through D4500.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recycling/Equipment > Page 1634
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Contaminated R134A Refrigerant
Bulletin No.: 06-01-39-007
Date: July 25, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Contaminated R134a Refrigerant Found on Market for Automotive Air-Conditioning
Systems
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2007 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2007 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Attention:
This bulletin should be directed to the Service Manager as well as the Parts Manager.
Commercially Available Contaminated R134a Refrigerant
Impurities have been found in new commercially available containers of R134a. High levels of
contaminates may cause decreased performance, and be detrimental to some air-conditioning
components. Accompanying these contaminates has been high levels of moisture.
Tip:
Excessive moisture may cause system concerns such as orifice tube freeze-up and reduced
performance.
Industry Reaction: New Industry Purity Standards
Due to the potential availability of these lower quality refrigerants, the Society of Automotive
Engineers (SAE), and the Air Conditioning and Refrigeration Industry (ARI) are in the process of
instituting reliable standards that will be carried on the labels of future R134a refrigerant containers.
This identifying symbol will be your assurance of a product that conforms to the minimum standard
for OEM Automotive Air-Conditioning use.
How Can You Protect Yourself Today?
It is recommended to use GM or ACDelco(R) sourced refrigerants for all A/C repair work. These
refrigerants meet General Motors own internal standards for quality and purity, insuring that your
completed repairs are as good as the way it left the factory.
Parts Information
The part numbers shown are available through GMSPO or ACDelco(R). The nearest ACDelco(R)
distributor in your area can be found by calling 1-800-223-3526 (U.S. Only).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recycling/Equipment > Page 1635
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Refrigerant: Capacity Specifications
Air Conditioning Refrigerant ................................................................................................................
....................................................... 2.0 lb. (0.91 kg.) Air Conditioning Refrigerant with Rear A/C
.............................................................................................................................................. 3.0 lb.
(1.36 kg.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1638
Refrigerant: Fluid Type Specifications
Type R-134a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1639
Refrigerant: Service Precautions
CAUTION:
^ Avoid breathing the A/C Refrigerant 134a (R-134a) and the lubricant vapor or the mist. Exposure
may irritate the eyes, nose, and throat. Work in a well ventilated area. In order to remove R-134a
from the A/C system, use service equipment that is certified to meet the requirements of SAE J
2210 (R-134a recycling equipment). If an accidental system discharge occurs, ventilate the work
area before continuing service. Additional health and safety information may be obtained from the
refrigerant and lubricant manufacturers.
^ For personal protection, goggles and gloves should be worn and a clean cloth wrapped around
fittings, valves, and connections when doing work that includes opening the refrigerant system. If
R-134a comes in contact with any part of the body severe frostbite and personal injury can result.
The exposed area should be flushed immediately with cold water and prompt medical help should
be obtained.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1640
Refrigerant: Service and Repair
REFRIGERANT RECOVERY AND RECHARGING
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 43600 ACR 2000 Air Conditioning Service Center
^ J 45037 A/C Oil Injector
CAUTION:
^ Avoid breathing the A/C Refrigerant 134a (R-134a) and the lubricant vapor or the mist. Exposure
may irritate the eyes, nose, and throat. Work in a well ventilated area. In order to remove R-134a
from the A/C system, use service equipment that is certified to meet the requirements of SAE J
2210 (R-134a recycling equipment). If an accidental system discharge occurs, ventilate the work
area before continuing service. Additional health and safety information may be obtained from the
refrigerant and lubricant manufacturers.
^ For personal protection, goggles and gloves should be worn and a clean cloth wrapped around
fittings, valves, and connections when doing work that includes opening the refrigerant system. If
R-134a comes in contact with any part of the body severe frostbite and personal injury can result.
The exposed area should be flushed immediately with cold water and prompt medical help should
be obtained.
NOTE:
^ R-134a is the only approved refrigerant for use in this vehicle. The use of any other refrigerant
may result in poor system performance or component failure.
^ To avoid system damage use only R-134a dedicated tools when servicing the A/C system.
^ Use only Polyalkylene Glycol Synthetic Refrigerant Oil (PAG) for internal circulation through the
R-134a A/C system and only 525 viscosity mineral oil on fitting threads and O-rings. If lubricants
other than those specified are used, compressor failure and/or fitting seizure may result.
^ R-12 refrigerant and R-134a refrigerant must never be mixed, even in the smallest of amounts, as
they are incompatible with each other. If the refrigerants are mixed, compressor failure is likely to
occur. Refer to the manufacturer instructions included with the service equipment before servicing.
The J 43600 is a complete air conditioning service center for R-134a. The ACR 2000 recovers,
recycles, evacuates and recharges A/C refrigerant quickly, accurately and automatically. The unit
has a display screen that contains the function controls and displays prompts that will lead the
technician through the recover, recycle, evacuate and recharge operations. R-134a is recovered
into and charged out of an internal storage vessel. The ACR 2000 automatically replenishes this
vessel from an external source tank in order to maintain a constant 5.45-6.82 kg (12-15 lbs) of A/C
refrigerant.
The ACR 2000 has a built in A/C refrigerant identifier that will test for contamination, prior to
recovery and will notify the technician if there are foreign gases present in the A/C system. If
foreign gases are present, the ACR 2000 will not recover the refrigerant from the A/C system.
The ACR 2000 also features automatic air purge, single pass recycling and an automatic oil drain.
Refer to the J 43600 ACR 2000 for operation and setup instruction. Always recharge the A/C
System with the proper amount of R-134a. Refer to Refrigerant System Capacities for the correct
amount.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > A/C - New PAG Oil
Refrigerant Oil: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - New PAG Oil
Bulletin No.: 02-01-39-004B
Date: November 16, 2005
INFORMATION
Subject: New PAG Oil Released
Models: 2006 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2006 HUMMER
H2 2006 HUMMER H3 2005-2006 Saab 9-7X
Built With R-134a Refrigeration System
All Air Conditioning Compressor Types (Excluding R4 and A6 Type Compressors)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to change the PAG oil part number used for R4 and A6 compressors
with R-134a refrigerant systems. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-01-39-004A
(Section 01 - HVAC).
All General Motors vehicles built with R-134a refrigerant systems shall now be serviced with GM
Universal PAG Oil (excluding vehicles equipped with an R4 or A6 compressor).
R4 and A6 compressors with R-134a refrigerant systems shall use PAG OIL, GM P/N 12356151
(A/C Delco part number 15-118) (in Canada, use P/N 10953486).
Important:
The PAG oil referenced in this bulletin is formulated with specific additive packages that meet
General Motors specifications and use of another oil may void the A/C systems warranty.
Use this new PAG oil when servicing the A/C system on the vehicles listed above. Oil packaged in
an 8 oz tube should be installed using A/C Oil Injector, J 45037. Refer to the HVAC Section of
Service Information for detailed information on Oil Balancing and Capacities.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications
Refrigerant System Capacities - Heating, Ventilation And Air Conditioning
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications > Page 1647
Refrigerant Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
PAG (Polyalkaline Glycol) synthetic refrigerant oil (GM part number 12345923) or equivalent. For
Canada use GM P/N 10953486.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Page
1648
Refrigerant Oil: Service and Repair
A/C REFRIGERANT SYSTEM OIL CHARGE REPLENISHING
If oil was removed from the A/C system during the recovery process or due to component
replacement, the oil must be replenished. Oil can be injected into a charged system using J 45037.
For the proper quantities of oil to add to the A/C refrigerant system, refer to Refrigerant System
Capacities.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Specifications
Brake Bleeding: Specifications
Brake System Pressure Bleed Initial Pressure Adjustment Setting (Leak Testing the Hydraulic
Brake System) 10 psi
Pressure Bleed Procedure Setting 35 psi
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > ABS
Automated Bleed Procedure
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair ABS Automated Bleed Procedure
ABS Automated Bleed Procedure
Two Person Procedure
Important: ^
Use the 2-person bleed procedure under the following conditions: Installing a new Electro-Hydraulic Control Unit (EHCU) or new Brake Pressure Modulator Valve
(BPMV).
- Air is trapped in the valve body
^ Do not drive the vehicle until the brake pedal feels firm.
^ Do not reuse brake fluid that is used during bleeding.
^ Use the vacuum, the pressure and the gravity bleeding procedures only for base brake bleeding.
1. Raise the vehicle in order to access the system bleed screws. 2. Bleed the system at the right
rear wheel first. 3. Install a clear hose on the bleed screw. 4. Immerse the opposite end of the hose
into a container partially filled with clean DOT 3 brake fluid. 5. Open the bleed screw 1/2 to one full
turn. 6. Slowly depress the brake pedal. While the pedal is depressed to its full extent, tighten the
bleed screw. 7. Release the brake pedal and wait 10-15 seconds for the master cylinder pistons to
return to the home position. 8. Repeat the previous steps for the remaining wheels. The brake fluid
that is present at each bleed screw should be clean and free of air. 9. This procedure may use
more than a pint of fluid per wheel. Check the master cylinder fluid level every four to six strokes of
the brake pedal in
order to avoid running the system dry.
10. Press the brake pedal firmly and run the Scan Tool Automated Bleed Procedure. Release the
brake pedal between each test. 11. Bleed all four wheels again using Steps 3-9. This will remove
the remaining air from the brake system. 12. Evaluate the feel of the brake pedal before attempting
to drive the vehicle. 13. Bleed the system as many times as necessary in order to obtain the
appropriate feel of the pedal.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > ABS
Automated Bleed Procedure > Page 1654
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Hydraulic Brake System Bleeding (Manual)
Hydraulic Brake System Bleeding (Manual)
Notice: When adding fluid to the brake master cylinder reservoir, use only Delco Supreme 11, GM
P/N 12377967, or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container. The use
of any type of fluid other than the recommended type of brake fluid, may cause contamination
which could result in damage to the internal rubber seals and/or rubber linings of hydraulic brake
system components.
Notice: Refer to Brake Fluid Effects on Paint and Electrical Components Notice in Service
Precautions.
1. Place a clean shop cloth beneath the brake master cylinder to prevent brake fluid spills. 2. With
the ignition OFF and the brakes cool, apply the brakes 3-5 times, or until the brake pedal becomes
firm, in order to deplete the brake booster
power reserve.
3. If you have performed a brake master cylinder bench bleeding on this vehicle, or if you
disconnected the brake pipes from the master cylinder, you
must perform the following steps: 3.1.
Ensure that the brake master cylinder reservoir is full to the maximum-fill level. If necessary add
Delco Supreme 11, GM P/N 12377967 (Canadian P/N 992667) or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid
from a clean, sealed brake fluid container. Clean the outside of the reservoir on and around the
reservoir cap prior to removing the cap and diaphragm, if cap removal is necessary.
3.2. With the rear brake pipe installed securely to the master cylinder, loosen and separate the
front brake pipe from the front port of the brake master cylinder.
3.3. Allow a small amount of brake fluid to gravity bleed from the open port of the master cylinder.
3.4. Reconnect the brake pipe to the master cylinder port and tighten securely.
3.5. Have an assistant slowly depress the brake pedal fully and maintain steady pressure on the
pedal.
3.6. Loosen the same brake pipe to purge air from the open port of the master cylinder.
3.7. Tighten the brake pipe, then have the assistant slowly release the brake pedal.
3.8. Wait 15 seconds, then repeat steps 3.3-3.7 until all air is purged from the same port of the
master cylinder.
3.9. With the front brake pipe installed securely to the master cylinder, after all air has been purged
from the front port of the master cylinder, loosen and separate the rear brake pipe from the master
cylinder; then repeat steps 3.3-3.8.
3.10. After completing the final master cylinder port bleeding procedure, ensure that both of the
brake pipe-to-master cylinder fittings are properly tightened.
4. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with Delco Supreme 11, GM P/N 12377967 (Canadian
P/N 992667) or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from
a clean, sealed brake fluid container. Ensure that the brake master cylinder reservoir remains at
least half-full during this bleeding procedure. Add fluid as needed to maintain the proper level.
Clean the outside of the reservoir on and around the reservoir cap prior to removing the cap and
diaphragm, when cap removal is necessary.
5. Install a proper box-end wrench onto the RIGHT REAR wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve,
then install a transparent hose over the end of the
bleeder valve.
6. Submerge the open end of the transparent hose into a transparent container partially filled with
Delco Supreme 11, GM PIN 12377967 (Canadian
P/N 992667) or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container.
7. Have an assistant slowly depress the brake pedal fully and maintain pedal position. 8. Loosen
the bleeder valve to purge air from the wheel hydraulic circuit. 9. Tighten the bleeder valve, then
have the assistant slowly release the brake pedal.
10. Wait 15 seconds, then repeat steps 7-9 until all air is purged from the same wheel hydraulic
circuit. 11. With the right rear wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve tightened securely, after all air
has been purged from the right rear hydraulic circuit;
install a proper box-end wrench onto the LEFT REAR wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve, install a
transparent hose over the end of the bleeder valve, then repeat steps 6-10.
12. With the left rear wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve tightened securely, after all air has been
purged from the left rear hydraulic circuit; install a
proper box-end wrench onto the RIGHT FRONT wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve, install a
transparent hose over the end of the bleeder valve, then repeat steps 6-10.
13. With the right front wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve tightened securely, after all air has
been purged from the right front hydraulic circuit;
install a proper box-end wrench onto the LEFT FRONT wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve, install
a transparent hose over the end of the bleeder valve, then repeat steps 6-10.
14. After completing the final wheel hydraulic circuit bleeding procedure, ensure that each of the 4
wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valves are properly
tightened.
15. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir to the maximum-fill level with Delco Supreme 11, GM
P/N 12377967 (Canadian P/N 992667) or
equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container.
16. Slowly depress and release the brake pedal. Observe the feel of the brake pedal. 17. If the
brake pedal feels spongy, repeat the bleeding procedure again. If the brake pedal still feels spongy
after repeating the bleeding procedure,
perform the following steps: 17.1.
Inspect the brake system for external leaks.
17.2. Pressure bleed the hydraulic brake system in order to purge any air that may still be trapped
in the system.
18. Turn the ignition key ON, with the engine OFF. Check to see if the brake system warning lamp
remains illuminated. 19. If the brake system warning lamp remains illuminated, the hydraulic brake
pressure differential switch plunger may have be forced out of position
during the bleeding procedure and may need to be reset. Perform the following steps to reset the
switch. 19.1.
Install a proper box-end wrench onto the RIGHT REAR wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve, then
install a transparent hose over the end of the bleeder valve.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > ABS
Automated Bleed Procedure > Page 1655
19.2. Submerge the open end of the transparent hose into a transparent container partially filled
with Delco Supreme 11, GM P/N 12377967 (Canadian P/N 992667) or equivalent DOT-3 brake
fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container.
19.3. With the ignition key still ON, with the engine OFF, loosen the bleeder valve.
19.4. Have an assistant slowly depress the brake pedal until the brake system warning lamp turns
OFF and maintain pedal position while you tighten the bleeder valve.
19.5. Have the assistant slowly release the brake pedal.
20. If the brake system warning lamp continues to remain illuminated, DO NOT allow the vehicle to
be driven until it is diagnosed and repaired. Refer
to Symptoms - Hydraulic Brakes. See: Brakes and Traction Control/Hydraulic System/Testing and
Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > ABS
Automated Bleed Procedure > Page 1656
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Hydraulic Brake System Bleeding (Pressure)
Hydraulic Brake System Bleeding (Pressure)
^ Tools Required J 29532 Diaphragm Type Brake Pressure Bleeder, or equivalent
- J 29567 Brake Pressure Bleeder Adapter
- J 39177 Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool, or equivalent
- J 41618 Brake Bleeder Adapter Set
Notice: When adding fluid to the brake master cylinder reservoir, use only Delco Supreme 11, GM
P/N 12377967, or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container. The use
of any type of fluid other than the recommended type of brake fluid, may cause contamination
which could result in damage to the internal rubber seals and/or rubber linings of hydraulic brake
system components.
Notice: Refer to Brake Fluid Effects on Paint and Electrical Components Notice in Service
Precautions.
1. Place a clean shop cloth beneath the brake master cylinder to prevent brake fluid spills. 2. With
the ignition OFF and the brakes cool, apply the brakes 3-5 times, or until the brake pedal becomes
firm, in order to deplete the brake booster
power reserve.
3. If you have performed a brake master cylinder bench bleeding on this vehicle, or if you
disconnected the brake pipes from the master cylinder, you
must perform the following steps: 3.1.
Ensure that the brake master cylinder reservoir is full to the maximum-fill level. If necessary add
Delco Supreme 11, (GM P/N 12377967) or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed
brake fluid container. Clean the outside of the reservoir on and around the reservoir cap prior to
removing the cap and diaphragm, if cap removal is necessary.
3.2. With the rear brake pipe installed securely to the master cylinder, loosen and separate the
front brake pipe from the front port of the brake master cylinder.
3.3. Allow a small amount of brake fluid to gravity bleed from the open port of the master cylinder.
3.4. Reconnect the brake pipe to the master cylinder port and tighten securely.
3.5. Have an assistant slowly depress the brake pedal fully and maintain steady pressure on the
pedal.
3.6. Loosen the same brake pipe to purge air from the open port of the master cylinder.
3.7. Tighten the brake pipe, then have the assistant slowly release the brake pedal.
3.8. Wait 15 seconds, then repeat steps 3.3-3.7 until all air is purged from the same port of the
master cylinder.
3.9. With the front brake pipe installed securely to the master cylinder, (after all air has been
purged from the front port of the master cylinder), loosen and separate the rear brake pipe from the
master cylinder, then repeat steps 3.3-3.8.
3.10. After completing the final master cylinder port bleeding procedure, ensure that both of the
brake pipe-to-master cylinder fittings are properly tightened.
4. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir to the maximum-fill level with Delco Supreme 11, (GM
P/N 12377967) or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid
from a clean, sealed brake fluid container. Clean the outside of the reservoir on and around the
reservoir cap prior to removing the cap and diaphragm.
5. Remove the cap from the metering valve end of the combination valve, then install the J 39177,
or equivalent to the metering valve. 6. Using the J 39177, depress the shaft of the metering valve to
maintain the proper flow of brake fluid to the front wheel hydraulic circuit during the
pressure bleeding procedure.
7. Assemble the J41613 to the J29567. 8. Install the J41618 and J29567to the brake master
cylinder reservoir. 9. Check the brake fluid level in the J 29532, or equivalent. Add Delco Supreme
11, (GM P/N 12377967) or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a
clean, sealed brake fluid container as necessary to bring the level to approximately the half-full
point.
10. Connect the J29532, or equivalent, to the J 29567. 11. Charge the J 29532, or equivalent, air
tank to 175 - 205 kPa (25 - 30 psi). 12. Open the J29532, or equivalent, fluid tank valve to allow
pressurized brake fluid to enter the brake system. 13. Wait approximately 30 seconds, then inspect
the entire hydraulic brake system in order to ensure that there are no existing external brake fluid
leaks. Any brake fluid leaks identified require repair prior to completing this procedure.
14. Install a proper box-end wrench onto the RIGHT REAR wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve,
then install a transparent hose over the end of the
bleeder valve.
15. Submerge the open end of the transparent hose into a transparent container partially filled with
Delco Supreme 11, (GM P/N 12377967) or
equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container.
16. Loosen the bleeder valve to purge air from the wheel hydraulic circuit. Allow fluid to flow until air
bubbles stop flowing from the bleeder, then
tighten the bleeder valve.
17. With the right rear wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve tightened securely, (after all air has
been purged from the right rear hydraulic circuit),
install a proper box-end wrench onto the LEFT REAR wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve, install a
transparent hose over the end of the bleeder valve, then repeat steps 15-16.
18. With the left rear wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve tightened securely, (after all air has been
purged from the left rear hydraulic circuit), install
a proper box-end wrench onto the RIGHT FRONT wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve, install a
transparent hose over the end of the bleeder valve, then repeat steps 15-16.
19. With the right front wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve tightened securely, (after all air has
been purged from the right front hydraulic circuit),
install a proper box-end wrench onto the LEFT FRONT wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve, install
a transparent hose over the end of the bleeder
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > ABS
Automated Bleed Procedure > Page 1657
valve, then repeat steps 15-16.
20. After completing the final wheel hydraulic circuit bleeding procedure, ensure that each of the 4
wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valves are properly
tightened.
21. Close the J 29532, or equivalent, fluid tank valve, then disconnect the J 29532, or equivalent,
from the J 29567. 22. Remove the J 41618 and J29567 from the brake master cylinder reservoir.
23. Remove the J 39177, or equivalent from the metering valve, then install the cap to the metering
valve end of the combination valve. 24. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir to the maximum-fill
level with Delco Supreme 11, (GM P/N 12377967) or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid
from a clean, sealed brake fluid container.
25. Slowly depress and release the brake pedal. Observe the feel of the brake pedal. 26. If the
brake pedal feels spongy perform the following steps:
26.1. Inspect the brake system for external leaks.
26.2. Using a scan tool, perform the antilock brake system automated bleeding procedure to
remove any air that may have been trapped in the BPMV.
27. Turn the ignition key ON, with the engine OFF. Check to see if the brake system warning lamp
remains illuminated. 28. If the brake system warning lamp remains illuminated, DO NOT allow the
vehicle to be driven until it is diagnosed and repaired. Refer to
Symptoms - Hydraulic Brakes. See: Brakes and Traction Control/Hydraulic System/Testing and
Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > ABS
Automated Bleed Procedure > Page 1658
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Master Cylinder Bench Bleeding
Master Cylinder Bench Bleeding
Notice: When adding fluid to the brake master cylinder reservoir, use only Delco Supreme 11, GM
P/N 12377967, or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container. The use
of any type of fluid other than the recommended type of brake fluid, may cause contamination
which could result in damage to the internal rubber seals and/or rubber linings of hydraulic brake
system components.
1. Secure the mounting flange of the brake master cylinder in a bench vise so that the rear of the
primary piston is accessible. 2. Remove the master cylinder reservoir cap and diaphragm. 3. Install
suitable fittings to the master cylinder ports that match the type of flare seat required and also
provide for hose attachment. 4. Install transparent hoses to the fittings installed to the master
cylinder ports, then route the hoses into the master cylinder reservoir. 5. Fill the master cylinder
reservoir to at least the halfway point with Delco Supreme 11, GM P/N 12377967, or equivalent
DOT-3 brake fluid from a
clean, sealed brake fluid container.
6. Ensure that the ends of the transparent hoses running into the master cylinder reservoir are fully
submerged in the brake fluid. 7. Using a smooth, round-ended tool, depress and release the
primary piston as far as it will travel, a depth of about 25 mm (1 in), several times.
Observe the flow of fluid coming from the ports. As air is bled from the primary and secondary
pistons, the effort required to depress the primary piston will increase and the amount of travel will
decrease.
8. Continue to depress and release the primary piston until fluid flows freely from the ports with no
evidence of air bubbles. 9. Remove the transparent hoses from the master cylinder reservoir.
10. Install the master cylinder reservoir cap and diaphragm. 11. Remove the fittings with the
transparent hoses from the master cylinder ports. Wrap the master cylinder with a clean shop cloth
to prevent brake
fluid spills.
12. Remove the master cylinder from the vise.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and
Repair > Disabling
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Disabling
IMPORTANT: Refer to SIR Service Precautions before disabling the SIR system.
1. Turn the steering wheel until the vehicle's wheels are pointing straight ahead. 2. Turn OFF the
ignition. 3. Remove the key from the ignition.
IMPORTANT: With the AIR BAG Fuse removed and the ignition ON, the AIR BAG indicator
illuminates. This is normal operation and does not indicate an SIR system malfunction.
4. Remove the AIR BAG Fuse from the IP fuse block. 5. Remove the sound insulator, if equipped.
6. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) from the steering wheel module yellow 2-way
connector (1) located at the base of the steering
column.
7. Disconnect the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector (1) located at the base of the
steering column.
8. Remove the instrument panel extension. 9. Remove the CPA (2) from the IP module yellow
2-way connector (1) located under the instrument panel extension.
10. Disconnect the IP module yellow 2-way connector (1) located under the instrument panel
extension.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and
Repair > Disabling > Page 1663
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Enabling
1. Remove the key from the ignition. 2. Connect the IP module yellow 2-way connector (1) located
under the instrument panel extension. 3. Install the connector position assurance (CPA) (2) to the
IP module yellow 2-way connector (1) located under the instrument panel extension. 4. Install the
instrument panel extension.
5. Connect the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector (1) located at the base of the
steering column. 6. Install the CPA to the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector (1)
located at the base of the steering column. 7. Install the sound insulator, if equipped. 8. Install the
AIR BAG Fuse to the IP fuse block. 9. Staying well away from the air bags, turn ON the ignition,
with the engine OFF.
9.1. The AIR BAG indicator will flash 7 times.
9.2. The AIR BAG indicator will then turn OFF.
10. Perform Diagnostic System Check - SIR if the AIR BAG indicator does not operate as
described.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical - Aftermarket Fuse Warning
Fuse: Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Aftermarket Fuse Warning
Bulletin No.: 07-08-45-002
Date: September 05, 2007
ADVANCED SERVICE INFORMATION
Subject: Service Alert: Concerns With Aftermarket Fuses in GM Vehicles
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2008 and
Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2008 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Concerns with Harbor Freight Tools "Storehouse" Branded Blade Type Fuses
General Motors has become aware of a fuse recall by Harbor Freight Tools/Storehouse for a
variety of aftermarket fuses. In two cases, these fuses have not provided protection for the wiring
system of the vehicles they were customer installed in.
Upon testing the 15 amp version, it was found that the fuse still would not "open" when shorted
directly across the battery terminals.
How to Identify These Fuses
Packed in a 120 piece set, the fuse has a translucent, hard plastic, blue body with the amperage
stamped into the top. There are no white painted numbers on the fuse to indicate amperage. There
are no identifying marks on the fuse to tell who is making it. The fuses are known to be distributed
by Harbor Freight Tools but there may be other marketers, and packaging of this style of fuse. It
would be prudent to replace these fuses if found in a customers vehicle. Likewise, if wiring
overheating is found you should check the fuse panel for the presence of this style of fuse.
All GM dealers should use genuine GM fuses on the vehicles they service. You should also
encourage the use of GM fuses to your customers to assure they are getting the required electrical
system protection. GM has no knowledge of any concerns with other aftermarket fuses. If
additional information becomes available, this bulletin will be updated.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Fuse Block - I/P
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Fuse Block - I/P > Page 1671
Fuse Block - Underhood
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application
and ID > Fuse Block I/P (Front View)
Fuse: Application and ID Fuse Block I/P (Front View)
Fuse Block I/P (Front View) Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application
and ID > Fuse Block I/P (Front View) > Page 1674
Fuse Block I/P (Front View) Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application
and ID > Fuse Block I/P (Front View) > Page 1675
Fuse: Application and ID Fuse Block I/P (Rear View)
Fuse Block - I/P (Rear View) Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application
and ID > Fuse Block I/P (Front View) > Page 1676
Fuse Block - I/P (Rear View) Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application
and ID > Fuse Block I/P (Front View) > Page 1677
Fuse: Application and ID Fuse Block - Underhood (Front View)
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application
and ID > Fuse Block I/P (Front View) > Page 1678
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) Part 2 Of 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application
and ID > Fuse Block I/P (Front View) > Page 1679
Fuse: Application and ID Fuse Block - Underhood (Rear View)
Fuse Block - Underhood (Rear View) Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application
and ID > Fuse Block I/P (Front View) > Page 1680
Fuse Block - Underhood (Rear View) Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Instrument Panel (I/P) Fuse Block
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Instrument Panel (I/P) Fuse Block > Page 1685
Fuse Block - Underhood
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Page 1686
Fuse Block: Diagrams
Convenience Center C1
Convenience Center C3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Page 1687
Convenience Center C4
Convenience Center C5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Page 1688
Convenience Center C6
Convenience Center C8
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Page 1689
Convenience Center C9
Convenience Center C10
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block - Underhood (Front View)
Fuse Block: Application and ID Fuse Block - Underhood (Front View)
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block - Underhood (Front View) > Page 1692
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) Part 2 Of 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block - Underhood (Front View) > Page 1693
Fuse Block: Application and ID Fuse Block - Underhood (Rear View)
Fuse Block - Underhood (Rear View) Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block - Underhood (Front View) > Page 1694
Fuse Block - Underhood (Rear View) Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block - Underhood (Front View) > Page 1695
Fuse Block: Application and ID Fuse Block I/P (Front View)
Fuse Block I/P (Front View) Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block - Underhood (Front View) > Page 1696
Fuse Block I/P (Front View) Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block - Underhood (Front View) > Page 1697
Fuse Block: Application and ID Fuse Block I/P (Rear View)
Fuse Block - I/P (Rear View) Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block - Underhood (Front View) > Page 1698
Fuse Block - I/P (Rear View) Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Relay Replacement (Within an Electrical Center)
Fuse Block: Service and Repair Relay Replacement (Within an Electrical Center)
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 43244 Relay Puller Pliers
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the electrical center cover. 2. Locate the relay.
IMPORTANT: ^
Always note the orientation of the relay.
^ Make sure the electrical center is secure, as not to put added stress on the wires or terminals.
3. Using the J 43244 (1) position the tool on opposing corners of the relay (2).
NOTE: Use J 43244 to pull the relay straight out from the electrical center terminals. The use of
pliers or a flat bladed tool could damage the electrical center.
4. Remove the relay (2) from the electrical center.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Relay Replacement (Within an Electrical Center) > Page 1701
1. Install the relay (2) in the same position as removed. 2. Install the electrical center cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Relay Replacement (Within an Electrical Center) > Page 1702
Fuse Block: Service and Repair Relay Replacement (Attached to Wire Harness)
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Locate the relay. Refer to the Master Electrical Component List to locate the relay in the vehicle.
2. Remove any fasteners which hold the relay in place. 3. Remove any Connector Position
Assurance (CPA) devices or secondary locks.
IMPORTANT: Use care when removing a relay in a wiring harness when the relay is secured by
fasteners or tape.
4. Separate the relay (1) from the wire harness connector (2).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Connect the relay (1) to the wire harness connector (2). 2. Install any Connector Position
Assurance (CPA) devices or secondary locks. 3. Install the relay using any fasteners or tape that
originally held the relay in place.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Relay Block #1
Relay Box: Locations Relay Block #1
Relay Block # 1 Under left side of dash on data link connector bracket facing rear of vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Relay Block #1 > Page 1707
Relay Box: Locations Relay Block #2
Relay Block # 2 Under left side of dash on data link connector bracket facing front of vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Relay Block #1 > Page 1708
Fuse Block - Underhood
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Relay Block #1
Relay Block No. 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Relay Block #1 > Page 1711
Relay Block No. 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Relay Block #1 > Page 1712
Relay Box: Application and ID Underhood Fuse-Relay Center (Front View)
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Relay Block #1 > Page 1713
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) Part 2 Of 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Relay Block #1 > Page 1714
Relay Box: Application and ID Underhood Fuse-Relay Center (Rear View)
Fuse Block - Underhood (Rear View) Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Relay Block #1 > Page 1715
Fuse Block - Underhood (Rear View) Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Always On
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Testing and Inspection Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Always On
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Battery positive voltage is supplied directly to the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL). The powertrain
control module (PCM) turns the MIL ON by grounding the MIL control circuit.
MIL OPERATION
The MIL is located on the instrument panel.
MIL FUNCTION
^ The MIL informs the driver that a malfunction has occurred and the vehicle should be taken in for
service as soon as possible.
^ The MIL illuminates during a bulb test and a system test.
^ A DTC will be stored if a MIL is requested by the diagnostic test.
MIL ILLUMINATION
^ The MIL will illuminate with ignition switch ON and the engine not running.
^ The MIL will turn OFF when the engine is started.
^ The MIL will remain ON if the self-diagnostic system has detected a malfunction.
^ The MIL may turn OFF if the malfunction is not present.
^ If the MIL is illuminated and the engine stalls, the MIL will remain illuminated as long as the
ignition switch is ON.
^ If the MIL is not illuminated and the engine stalls, the MIL will not illuminate until the ignition
switch is cycled OFF, then ON.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS
If the problem is intermittent, refer to Intermittent Conditions. See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Initial Inspection and
Diagnostic Overview/Diagnostic Strategies/Intermittent Conditions
TEST DESCRIPTION
Steps 1-6
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. This step determines if the
condition is with the MIL control circuit or the PCM.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Always On > Page 1721
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Testing and Inspection Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Inoperative
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Battery positive voltage is supplied directly to the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL). The powertrain
control module (PCM) turns the MIL ON by grounding the MIL control circuit. There should be a
steady MIL with the ignition ON and the engine OFF.
MIL OPERATION
The MIL is located on the instrument panel.
MIL FUNCTION
^ The MIL informs the driver that a malfunction has occurred and the vehicle should be taken in for
service as soon as possible.
^ The MIL illuminates during a bulb test and a system test.
^ A DTC will be stored if a MIL is requested by the diagnostic test.
MIL ILLUMINATION
^ The MIL will illuminate with ignition switch ON and the engine not running.
^ The MIL will turn OFF when the engine is started.
^ The MIL will remain ON if the self-diagnostic system has detected a malfunction.
^ The MIL may turn OFF if the malfunction is not present.
^ If the MIL is illuminated and the engine stalls, the MIL will remain illuminated as long as the
ignition switch is ON.
^ If the MIL is not illuminated and the engine stalls, the MIL will not illuminate until the ignition
switch is cycled OFF, then ON.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS
If the problem is intermittent, refer to Intermittent Conditions. See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Initial Inspection and
Diagnostic Overview/Diagnostic Strategies/Intermittent Conditions
TEST DESCRIPTION
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Always On > Page 1722
Steps 1-14
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 3. This step determines if the
condition is with the MIL control circuit or the PCM. 4. This step determines if a voltage is
constantly being applied to the control circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Oil Change Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Oil Change Reminder Lamp: Service and Repair
This vehicle does not use the GM Oil Life System, and does not have an oil life indicator to reset.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Service
Precautions
Vehicle Lifting: Service Precautions
CAUTION:
To avoid any vehicle damage, serious personal injury or death when major components are
removed from the vehicle and the vehicle is supported by a hoist, support the vehicle with jack
stands at the opposite end from which the components are being removed.
To avoid any vehicle damage, serious personal injury or death, always use the jackstands to
support the vehicle when lifting the vehicle with a jack.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Page 1730
Vehicle Lifting: Service and Repair
Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle
Caution: To avoid any vehicle damage, serious personal injury or death when major components
are removed from the vehicle and the vehicle is supported by a hoist, support the vehicle with jack
stands at the opposite end from which the components are being removed.
Caution: To avoid any vehicle damage, serious personal injury or death, always use the jackstands
to support the vehicle when lifting the vehicle with a jack.
Notice: Perform the following steps before beginning any vehicle lifting or jacking procedure:
* Remove or secure all of the vehicle's contents in order to avoid any shifting or any movement that
may occur during the vehicle lifting or jacking procedure.
* The lifting equipment or the jacking equipment weight rating must meet or exceed the weight of
the vehicle and any vehicle contents.
* The lifting equipment or the jacking equipment must meet the operational standards of the lifting
equipment or jacking equipment's manufacturer.
* Perform the vehicle lifting or jacking procedure on a clean, hard, dry, level surface.
* Perform the vehicle lifting or jacking procedure only at the identified lift points. DO NOT allow the
lifting equipment or jacking equipment to contact any other vehicle components.
Failure to perform the previous steps could result in damage to the lifting equipment or the jacking
equipment, the vehicle, and/or the vehicle's contents.
Use only the prescribed lift points when elevating the vehicle.
Vehicle Lifting Points
1 - Lower Control Arm; Inboard of the Lower Ball Joint 1 - Lower Control Arm; Inboard of the Lower
Ball Joint 2 - Frame; at Second Crossmember 2 - Frame; at Second Crossmember 3 - Rear Spring;
at Forward Spring Hanger 3 - Rear Spring; at Forward Spring Hanger 4 - Axle; Inboard of Shock
Absorber Hanger 4 - Axle; Inboard of Shock Absorber Hanger 5 - Differential; at Center 6 - Front
Suspension Crossmember; Center 1 - Lower Control Arm; Inboard of the Lower Ball Joint 1 - Lower
Control Arm; Inboard of the Lower Ball Joint 2 - Frame; at Second Crossmember 2 - Frame; at
Second Crossmember
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Page 1731
3 - Rear Spring; at Forward Spring Hanger 3 - Rear Spring; at Forward Spring Hanger 4 - Axle;
Inboard of Shock Absorber Hanger 4 - Axle; Inboard of Shock Absorber Hanger 5 - Differential; at
Center 6 - Front Suspension Crossmember; Center
The jack and hoist lift points for the front of the vehicle are located between the front body mounts
and the transmission crossmember. The jack and hoist lift points for the rear of the vehicle are
located at the front hangers for the rear springs.
The front end lift points for the floor jack are at the following locations:
* Beneath the lower control arms, inboard from the shock absorber mounts
* Beneath the center of the front crossmember
The rear end lift points for the floor jack are at the following locations:
* Beneath the axle housing, inboard from the shock absorber mounts
* Beneath the axle differential
Whenever the vehicle is lifted using a jack or a floor jack, observe the following precautions:
* Chock the wheels at the end of the vehicle opposite the end being lifted
* Use jack stands for support. Place jack stands at the any of the following locations:
- Beneath the frame
- Beneath the front suspension crossmember
- Beneath the axle
When removing major components from the vehicle while the vehicle is on a hoist, chain the
vehicle frame to the hoist pads in order to prevent tip-off.
Jacking and Lifting Notice: When jacking or lifting a vehicle, do not allow the lift pads to contact any
of the following parts:
* The catalytic converter
* The brake lines
* The brake cables
* The fuel lines
* The accelerator cables
* The transmission shift cables
Lift pad contact may damage the parts. Lift pad contact may cause unsatisfactory vehicle
performance.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Relays and Modules - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Monitor Receiver / Transponder > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Tire Monitor System - TPM
Sensor Information
Tire Pressure Monitor Receiver / Transponder: Technical Service Bulletins Tire Monitor System TPM Sensor Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-03-16-003
Date: May 12, 2008
Subject: Warranty Reduction - Transfer of Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensors to
Replacement Wheels and Allowable TPM Sensor Replacements
Models: 2000-2009 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2009
HUMMER H2 2006-2009 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7x
with On-Wheel TPM Sensors
TPM Sensor / Wheel Warranty Reviews
During the last warranty review period it was noted that wheels being returned under the GM New
Vehicle Warranty were being shipped back to General Motors with the TPM sensor still attached to
the wheel. Return rates ran as high as 60% with the TPM sensors still attached. Operational TPM
sensors should not be returned to GM and are to be transferred to replacement wheels if they
become necessary.
Important:
Operational TPM Sensors that are returned under warranty to General Motors will be charged back
to the dealer.Sensors have a 10 year /150,000 mile (240,000 km) battery life, and should be
transferred if one or more wheels are replaced.
TPM Valve Stem / Grommet (0-ring) Replacement
When the TPM sensors are transferred to new wheels you should replace the component used to
seal the TPM sensor stem to the wheel. On sensors with an aluminum stem and visible nut on the
outside of the wheel a replacement grommet (0-ring) should be used to assure a proper seal. The
sensor retaining nut (except Aveo) should be tightened to 7 N.m (62 lb in) for all vehicles except
Pontiac Vibe (4.0 N.m (35.4 lb in)).
Important:
^ DO NOT overtorque the retaining nut.
Notice:
^ Factory installed TPM Sensors come with plastic aluminum or nickel-plated brass stem caps.
These caps should not be changed. Chrome plated steel caps may cause corrosion of aluminum
valve stems due to incompatibility of the metals.
On current style sensors the entire rubber stem is replaceable. The service interval on the revised
TPM sensor with replaceable stem is the same as for any other traditional valve stem. Replace the
stem at the time of tire replacement sensor transfer or whenever air seepage is suspected at the
valve stem. When replacing the valve stem tighten the screw to 1.3 N.m (11.5 lb in).
For either style of TPM sensor see the service parts guide for the correct GM part numbers to order
and use.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Tire Monitor System - TPM Sensor Information
Tire Pressure Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Tire Monitor System - TPM Sensor Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-03-16-003
Date: May 12, 2008
Subject: Warranty Reduction - Transfer of Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensors to
Replacement Wheels and Allowable TPM Sensor Replacements
Models: 2000-2009 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2009
HUMMER H2 2006-2009 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7x
with On-Wheel TPM Sensors
TPM Sensor / Wheel Warranty Reviews
During the last warranty review period it was noted that wheels being returned under the GM New
Vehicle Warranty were being shipped back to General Motors with the TPM sensor still attached to
the wheel. Return rates ran as high as 60% with the TPM sensors still attached. Operational TPM
sensors should not be returned to GM and are to be transferred to replacement wheels if they
become necessary.
Important:
Operational TPM Sensors that are returned under warranty to General Motors will be charged back
to the dealer.Sensors have a 10 year /150,000 mile (240,000 km) battery life, and should be
transferred if one or more wheels are replaced.
TPM Valve Stem / Grommet (0-ring) Replacement
When the TPM sensors are transferred to new wheels you should replace the component used to
seal the TPM sensor stem to the wheel. On sensors with an aluminum stem and visible nut on the
outside of the wheel a replacement grommet (0-ring) should be used to assure a proper seal. The
sensor retaining nut (except Aveo) should be tightened to 7 N.m (62 lb in) for all vehicles except
Pontiac Vibe (4.0 N.m (35.4 lb in)).
Important:
^ DO NOT overtorque the retaining nut.
Notice:
^ Factory installed TPM Sensors come with plastic aluminum or nickel-plated brass stem caps.
These caps should not be changed. Chrome plated steel caps may cause corrosion of aluminum
valve stems due to incompatibility of the metals.
On current style sensors the entire rubber stem is replaceable. The service interval on the revised
TPM sensor with replaceable stem is the same as for any other traditional valve stem. Replace the
stem at the time of tire replacement sensor transfer or whenever air seepage is suspected at the
valve stem. When replacing the valve stem tighten the screw to 1.3 N.m (11.5 lb in).
For either style of TPM sensor see the service parts guide for the correct GM part numbers to order
and use.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Monitor
Receiver / Transponder > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Tire Monitor System - TPM Sensor
Information
Tire Pressure Monitor Receiver / Transponder: Technical Service Bulletins Tire Monitor System TPM Sensor Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-03-16-003
Date: May 12, 2008
Subject: Warranty Reduction - Transfer of Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensors to
Replacement Wheels and Allowable TPM Sensor Replacements
Models: 2000-2009 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2009
HUMMER H2 2006-2009 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7x
with On-Wheel TPM Sensors
TPM Sensor / Wheel Warranty Reviews
During the last warranty review period it was noted that wheels being returned under the GM New
Vehicle Warranty were being shipped back to General Motors with the TPM sensor still attached to
the wheel. Return rates ran as high as 60% with the TPM sensors still attached. Operational TPM
sensors should not be returned to GM and are to be transferred to replacement wheels if they
become necessary.
Important:
Operational TPM Sensors that are returned under warranty to General Motors will be charged back
to the dealer.Sensors have a 10 year /150,000 mile (240,000 km) battery life, and should be
transferred if one or more wheels are replaced.
TPM Valve Stem / Grommet (0-ring) Replacement
When the TPM sensors are transferred to new wheels you should replace the component used to
seal the TPM sensor stem to the wheel. On sensors with an aluminum stem and visible nut on the
outside of the wheel a replacement grommet (0-ring) should be used to assure a proper seal. The
sensor retaining nut (except Aveo) should be tightened to 7 N.m (62 lb in) for all vehicles except
Pontiac Vibe (4.0 N.m (35.4 lb in)).
Important:
^ DO NOT overtorque the retaining nut.
Notice:
^ Factory installed TPM Sensors come with plastic aluminum or nickel-plated brass stem caps.
These caps should not be changed. Chrome plated steel caps may cause corrosion of aluminum
valve stems due to incompatibility of the metals.
On current style sensors the entire rubber stem is replaceable. The service interval on the revised
TPM sensor with replaceable stem is the same as for any other traditional valve stem. Replace the
stem at the time of tire replacement sensor transfer or whenever air seepage is suspected at the
valve stem. When replacing the valve stem tighten the screw to 1.3 N.m (11.5 lb in).
For either style of TPM sensor see the service parts guide for the correct GM part numbers to order
and use.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Tire Monitor System - TPM Sensor Information
Tire Pressure Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Tire Monitor System - TPM Sensor Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-03-16-003
Date: May 12, 2008
Subject: Warranty Reduction - Transfer of Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensors to
Replacement Wheels and Allowable TPM Sensor Replacements
Models: 2000-2009 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2009
HUMMER H2 2006-2009 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7x
with On-Wheel TPM Sensors
TPM Sensor / Wheel Warranty Reviews
During the last warranty review period it was noted that wheels being returned under the GM New
Vehicle Warranty were being shipped back to General Motors with the TPM sensor still attached to
the wheel. Return rates ran as high as 60% with the TPM sensors still attached. Operational TPM
sensors should not be returned to GM and are to be transferred to replacement wheels if they
become necessary.
Important:
Operational TPM Sensors that are returned under warranty to General Motors will be charged back
to the dealer.Sensors have a 10 year /150,000 mile (240,000 km) battery life, and should be
transferred if one or more wheels are replaced.
TPM Valve Stem / Grommet (0-ring) Replacement
When the TPM sensors are transferred to new wheels you should replace the component used to
seal the TPM sensor stem to the wheel. On sensors with an aluminum stem and visible nut on the
outside of the wheel a replacement grommet (0-ring) should be used to assure a proper seal. The
sensor retaining nut (except Aveo) should be tightened to 7 N.m (62 lb in) for all vehicles except
Pontiac Vibe (4.0 N.m (35.4 lb in)).
Important:
^ DO NOT overtorque the retaining nut.
Notice:
^ Factory installed TPM Sensors come with plastic aluminum or nickel-plated brass stem caps.
These caps should not be changed. Chrome plated steel caps may cause corrosion of aluminum
valve stems due to incompatibility of the metals.
On current style sensors the entire rubber stem is replaceable. The service interval on the revised
TPM sensor with replaceable stem is the same as for any other traditional valve stem. Replace the
stem at the time of tire replacement sensor transfer or whenever air seepage is suspected at the
valve stem. When replacing the valve stem tighten the screw to 1.3 N.m (11.5 lb in).
For either style of TPM sensor see the service parts guide for the correct GM part numbers to order
and use.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Spare Tire > Component Information >
Specifications
Spare Tire: Specifications
Spare Tire Carrier Mounting Bolts 11 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Spare Tire > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 1755
Spare Tire: Service and Repair
Tire Hoist and Shaft Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the spare tire from the tire carrier. 2. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to
Vehicle Lifting. 3. Remove the pin and retainer from the shaft. 4. Remove the shaft from the hoist.
5. Remove the hoist mounting bolts. 6. Remove the hoist from the rear crossmember.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the hoist to the rear crossmember.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the hoist mounting bolts and nuts.
^ Tighten the hoist mounting bolts and nuts to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.).
3. Install the shaft to the hoist. 4. Install the pin and retainer to the shaft. 5. Lower the vehicle. 6.
Install the spare tire to the carrier.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV)
Wheels: Customer Interest Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV)
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-03-10-006F
Date: May 04, 2010
Subject: Information on Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009
and Prior Saab 9-7X 2000-2005 Saturn L Series 2003-2007 Saturn ION
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to considerably expand the available information on
Radial Force Variation (RFV) and should be reviewed in whole. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-03-10-006E (Section 03 - Suspension).
Important
- Before measuring tires on equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700, the vehicle MUST be driven
a minimum of 16 km (10 mi) to ensure removal of any flat-spotting. Refer to Corporate Bulletin
Number 03-03-10-007E - Tire/Wheel Characteristics of GM Original Equipment Tires.
- Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 MUST be calibrated prior to measuring tire/wheel
assemblies for each vehicle.
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide guidance to GM dealers when using tire force variation
measurement equipment, such as the Hunter GSP9700. This type of equipment can be a valuable
tool in diagnosing vehicle ride concerns. The most common ride concern involving tire radial force
variation is highway speed shake on smooth roads.
Tire related smooth road highway speed shake can be caused by three conditions: imbalance, out
of round and tire force variation. These three conditions are not necessarily related. All three
conditions must be addressed.
Imbalance is normally addressed first, because it is the simpler of the three to correct. Off-vehicle,
two plane dynamic wheel balancers are readily available and can accurately correct any
imbalance. Balancer calibration and maintenance, proper attachment of the wheel to the balancer,
and proper balance weights, are all factors required for a quality balance. However, a perfectly
balanced tire/wheel assembly can still be "oval shaped" and cause a vibration.
Before balancing, perform the following procedures.
Tire and Wheel Diagnosis
1. Set the tire pressure to the placard values. 2. With the vehicle raised, ensure the wheels are
centered on the hub by loosening all wheel nuts and hand-tightening all nuts first by hand while
shaking the wheel, then torque to specifications using a torque wrench, NOT a torque stick.
3. Visually inspect the tires and the wheels. Inspect for evidence of the following conditions and
correct as necessary:
- Missing balance weights
- Bent rim flange
- Irregular tire wear
- Incomplete bead seating
- Tire irregularities (including pressure settings)
- Mud/ice build-up in wheel
- Stones in the tire tread
- Remove any aftermarket wheels and/or tires and restore vehicle to original condition prior to
diagnosing a smooth road shake condition.
4. Road test the vehicle using the Electronic Vibration Analyzer (EVA) essential tool. Drive for a
sufficient distance on a known, smooth road
surface to duplicate the condition. Determine if the vehicle is sensitive to brake apply. If the brakes
are applied lightly and the pulsation felt in the steering wheel increases, refer to the Brakes section
of the service manual that deals with brake-induced pulsation. If you can start to hear the vibration
as a low boom noise (in addition to feeling it), but cannot see it, the vehicle likely has a first order
(one pulse per propshaft revolution) driveline vibration. Driveline first order vibrations are high
enough in frequency that most humans can start to hear them at highway speeds, but are too high
to be able to be easily seen. These issues can be caused by driveline imbalance or misalignment.
If the vehicle exhibits this low boom and the booming pulses in-and-out on a regular basis (like a
throbbing), chances are good that the vehicle could have driveline vibration. This type
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV) > Page 1764
of vibration is normally felt more in the "seat of the pants" than the steering wheel.
5. Next, record the Hertz (Hz) reading as displayed by the EVA onto the tire data worksheet found
at the end of this bulletin. This should be done
after a tire break-in period of at least 16 km (10 mi) at 72 km/h (45 mph) or greater, in order to
eliminate any possible tire flat-spotting. This reading confirms what the vehicle vibration frequency
is prior to vehicle service and documents the amount of improvement occurring as the result of the
various steps taken to repair. Completing the Steering Wheel Shake Worksheet below is required.
A copy of the completed worksheet must be saved with the R.O. and a copy included with any
parts returned to the Warranty Parts Center for analysis. A reading of 35 to 50 Hz typically
indicates a first order propshaft vibration. If this is the situation, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
08-07-30-044D. Generally, a reading between 10 and 20 Hz indicates a tire/wheel vibration and if
this is the reading obtained, continue using this bulletin. If the tire 1st order vibration goes away
and stays away during this evaluation, the cause is likely tire flat-spotting. Tire flat-spotting vibration
may come and go at any speed over 72 km/h (45 mph) during the first 10 minutes of operation, if
vibration continues after 10 minutes of driving at speeds greater than 72 km/h (45 mph), tire
flat-spotting can be ruled out as the cause for vibration.
6. If flat-spotting is the cause, provide the explanation that this has occurred due to the vehicle
being parked for long periods of time and that the
nature of the tire is to take a set. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 03-03-10-007E: Information
on Tire/Wheel Characteristics (Vibration, Balance, Shake, Flat Spotting) of GM Original Equipment
Tires.
7. If the road test indicates a shake/vibration exists, check the imbalance of each tire/wheel
assembly on a known, calibrated, off-car dynamic
balancer.Make sure the mounting surface of the wheel and the surface of the balancer are
absolutely clean and free of debris. Be sure to chose the proper cone/collet for the wheel, and
always use the pilot bore for centering. Never center the wheel using the hub-cap bore since it is
not a precision machined surface. If any assembly calls for more than 1/4 ounce on either rim
flange, remove all balance weights and rebalance to as close to zero as possible. If you can see
the vibration (along with feeling it) in the steering wheel (driving straight without your hands on the
wheel), it is very likely to be a tire/wheel first order (one pulse per revolution) disturbance. First
order disturbances can be caused by imbalance as well as non-uniformities in tires, wheels or
hubs. This first order frequency is too low for a human to hear, but if the amplitude is high enough,
it can be seen.
If a vibration or shake still exists after balancing, any out of round conditions, of the wheel, and
force variation conditions of the tire, must be addressed. Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700
can address both (it is also a wheel balancer).
Tire radial force vibration (RFV) can be defined as the amount of stiffness variation the tire will
produce in one revolution under a constant load. Radial force variation is what the vehicle feels
because the load (weight) of the vehicle is always on the tires. Although free runout of tires (not
under load) is not always a good indicator of a smooth ride, it is critical that total tire/wheel
assembly runout be within specification.
Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 loads the tire, similar to on the vehicle, and measures
radial force variation of the tire/wheel assembly. Note that the wheel is affecting the tire's RFV
measurement at this point. To isolate the wheel, its runout must be measured. This can be easily
done on the Hunter, without the need to set up dial indicators. If the wheel meets the runout
specification, the tire's RFV can then be addressed.
After measuring the tire/wheel assembly under load, and the wheel alone, the machine then
calculates (predicts) the radial force variation of the tire. However, because this is a prediction that
can include mounting inaccuracies, and the load wheel is much smaller in diameter than used in
tire production, this type of service equipment should NOT be used to audit new tires. Rather, it
should be used as a service diagnostic tool to minimize radial force variation of the tire/wheel
assembly.
Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 does an excellent job of measuring wheel runout, and of
finding the low point of the wheel (for runout) and the high point of the tire (for radial force
variation). This allows the tire to be matched mounted to the wheel for lowest tire/wheel assembly
force variation.
The machine will simplify this process into easy steps. The following assembly radial force variation
numbers should be used as a guide:
When measuring RFV and match mounting tires perform the following steps.
Measuring Wheel Runout and Assembly Radial Force Variation
Important The completed worksheet at the end of this bulletin must be attached to the hard copy of
the repair order.
- Measure radial force variation and radial runout.
- If a road force/balancing machine is used, record the radial force variation (RFV) on the
worksheet at the end of this bulletin. It may be of benefit to have the lowest RFV assembly to the
front left corner. If the machine is not available and the EVA data suggests there is an issue, swap
the tire and wheel assemblies from the front to the back. Re-check on the EVA and if the problem
still exists, test another vehicle to find tires that do not exhibit the same frequency and swap those
tires onto the subject vehicle.
- If a runout/balancing machine is used, record the radial runout of the tire/wheel assemblies on the
worksheet at the end of this bulletin. If one or more of the tire/wheel assemblies are more than.040
in (1.02 mm), match mount the tire to the wheel to get below.040 in (1.02 mm). For sensitive
customers, readings of 0.030 inch (0.76 mm) or less are preferable, it may also be of benefit to
have the lowest runout assembly to the front left corner. If the machine is not available and the
EVA data suggests there is an issue, swap the tire and wheel assemblies from the front to the
back. Re-check on the EVA and if the problem still exists, test another vehicle to find tires that do
not exhibit the same frequency and swap those tires
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV) > Page 1765
onto the subject vehicle.
- After match mounting, the tire/wheel assembly must be rebalanced.
If match mounting tires to in-spec wheels produces assembly values higher than these, tire
replacement may be necessary. Replacing tires at lower values will probably mean good tires are
being condemned. Because tires can sometimes become temporarily flat-spotted, which will affect
force variation, it is important that the vehicle be driven at least 16 km (10 mi) prior to measuring.
Tire pressure must also be adjusted to the usage pressure on the vehicle's tire placard prior to
measuring.
Most GM vehicles will tolerate radial force variation up to these levels. However, some vehicles are
more sensitive, and may require lower levels. Also, there are other tire parameters that equipment
such as the Hunter GSP9700 cannot measure that may be a factor. In such cases, TAC should be
contacted for further instructions.
Important
- When mounting a GM wheel to a wheel balancer/force variation machine, always use the wheel's
center pilot hole. This is the primary centering mechanism on all GM wheels; the bolt holes are
secondary. Usually a back cone method to the machine should be used. For added accuracy and
repeatability, a flange plate should be used to clamp the wheel onto the cone and machine. This
system is offered by all balancer manufacturers in GM's dealer program.
- Any type of service equipment that removes tread rubber by grinding, buffing or truing is NOT
recommended, and may void the tire warranty. However, tires may have been ground by the tire
company as part of their tire manufacturing process. This is a legitimate procedure.
Steering Wheel Shake Worksheet
When diagnosing vibration concerns, use the following worksheet in conjunction with the
appropriate Vibration Analysis-Road testing procedure in the Vibration Correction sub-section in SI.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV) > Page 1766
Refer to the appropriate section of SI for specifications and repair procedures that are related to the
vibration concern.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 05-03-10-003F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels
Wheels: Customer Interest Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 05-03-10-003F
Date: April 27, 2010
Subject: Low Tire Pressure, Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels (Repair with Adhesive Sealant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X with Cast Aluminum Wheels
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years and the bulletin reference
information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-10-003E (Section 03 - Suspension).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a low tire pressure condition.
Diagnosis of the low tire pressure condition indicates an air leak through the cast aluminum wheel.
Cause
Porosity in the cast aluminum wheel may be the cause.
Notice
This bulletin specifically addresses issues related to the wheel casting that may result in an air
leak. For issues related to corrosion of the wheel in service, please refer to Corporate Bulletin
Number 08-03-10-006C - Tire Slowly Goes Flat, Tire Air Loss, Low Tire Pressure Warning Light
Illuminated, Aluminum Wheel Bead Seat Corrosion (Clean and Resurface Wheel Bead Seat).
Correction
1. Remove the tire and wheel assembly from the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate service
procedure in SI. 2. Locate the leaking area by inflating the tire to 276 kPa (40 psi) and dipping the
tire/wheel assembly in a water bath, or use a spray bottle with soap
and water to locate the specific leak location.
Important
- If the porosity leak is located in the bead area of the aluminum rim (where the tire meets the rim),
the wheel should be replaced.
- If two or more leaks are located on one wheel, the wheel should be replaced.
3. If air bubbles are observed, mark the location.
- If the leak location is on the tire/rubber area, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 04-03-10-001F Tire Puncture Repair Procedures for All Cars and Light Duty Trucks.
- If the leak is located on the aluminum wheel area, continue with the next step.
4. Inscribe a mark on the tire at the valve stem in order to indicate the orientation of the tire to the
wheel. 5. Dismount the tire from the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. 6. Remove
the tire pressure sensor. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor removal procedure in SI. 7. Scuff the
INSIDE rim surface at the leak area with #80 grit paper and clean the area with general purpose
cleaner, such as 3M(R) General Purpose
Adhesive Cleaner, P/N 08984, or equivalent.
8. Apply a 3 mm (0.12 in) thick layer of Silicone - Adhesive/Sealant, P/N 12378478 (in Canada, use
88900041), or equivalent, to the leak area. 9. Allow for the adhesive/sealant to dry.
Notice Caution must be used when mounting the tire so as not to damage the sealer. Damaging
the repair area may result in an air leak.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 05-03-10-003F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels >
Page 1771
10. Align the inscribed mark on the tire with the valve stem on the wheel. 11. Reinstall the Tire
Pressure Sensor. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor installation procedure in SI. 12. Mount the tire on
the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. 13. Pressurize the tire to 276 kPa (40 psi) and
inspect for leaks. 14. Adjust tire pressure to meet the placard specification. 15. Balance the
tire/wheel assembly. Refer to Tire and Wheel Assembly Balancing - Off-Vehicle. 16. Install the tire
and wheel assembly onto the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate service procedure in SI.
Parts Information
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
Important The Silicone - Adhesive/Sealant comes in a case quantity of six. ONLY charge warranty
one tube of adhesive/sealant per wheel repair.
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
One leak repair per wheel.
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 08-03-10-006C > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Tire Slowly Goes Flat/Warning Light ON
Wheels: Customer Interest Tires/Wheels - Tire Slowly Goes Flat/Warning Light ON
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 08-03-10-006C
Date: April 27, 2010
Subject: Tire Slowly Goes Flat, Tire Air Loss, Low Tire Pressure Warning Light Illuminated,
Aluminum Wheel Bead Seat Corrosion (Clean and Resurface Wheel Bead Seat)
Models:
2000-2011 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2009 HUMMER H2
2006-2010 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 08-03-10-006B (Section 03 - Suspension).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a tire that slowly loses air pressure over a period of days or
weeks.
Cause
Abrasive elements in the environment may intrude between the tire and wheel at the bead seat.
There is always some relative motion between the tire and wheel (when the vehicle is driven) and
this motion may cause the abrasive particles to wear the wheel and tire materials. As the wear
continues, there may also be intrusion at the tire/wheel interface by corrosive media from the
environment. Eventually a path for air develops and a 'slow' leak may ensue. This corrosion may
appear on the inboard or outboard bead seating surface of the wheel. This corrosion will not be
visible until the tire is dismounted from the wheel.
Notice
This bulletin specifically addresses issues related to wheel bead seat corrosion that may result in
an air leak. For issues related to porosity of the wheel casting that may result in an air leak, please
refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-10-006F - Low Tire Pressure, Leaking Cast Aluminum
Wheels (Repair with Adhesive Sealant)
Correction
In most cases, this type of air loss can be corrected by following the procedure below.
Important DO NOT replace a wheel for slow air loss unless you have evaluated and/or tried to
repair the wheel with the procedure below.
Notice
The repair is no longer advised or applicable for chromed aluminum wheels.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly for diagnosis. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and
Installation in SI. 2. After a water dunk tank leak test, if you determine the source of the air leak to
be around the bead seat of the wheel, dismount the tire to examine
the bead seat. Shown below is a typical area of bead seat corrosion.Typical Location of Bead Seat
Corrosion
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 08-03-10-006C > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Tire Slowly Goes Flat/Warning Light ON >
Page 1776
Important Other forms of slow air leaks are possible. If the body of the tire, valve stem and wheel
flange show no signs of air seepage, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-10-003D for
additional information on possible wheel porosity issues.
3. Bead seat corrosion is identified by what appears like blistering of the wheel finish, causing a
rough or uneven surface that is difficult for the tire to
maintain a proper seal on. Below is a close-up photo of bead seat corrosion on an aluminum wheel
that was sufficient to cause slow air loss. Close-Up of Bead Seat Corrosion
4. If corrosion is found on the wheel bead seat, measure the affected area as shown below.
- For vehicles with 32,186 km (20,000 mi) or less, the total allowable combined linear area of
repairable corrosion is 100 mm (4 in) or less. If the total area(s) of corrosion exceed these
dimensions, the wheel should be replaced.
- For vehicles that have exceeded 32,186 km (20,000 mi), the total allowable combined linear area
of repairable corrosion is 200 mm (8 in) or less. If the total area(s) of corrosion exceed these
dimensions, the wheel should be replaced.
5. In order to correct the wheel leak, use a clean-up (fine cut) sanding disc or biscuit to remove the
corrosion and any flaking paint. You should
remove the corrosion back far enough until you reach material that is stable and firmly bonded to
the wheel. Try to taper the edge of any flaking paint as best you can in order to avoid sharp edges
that may increase the chance of a leak reoccurring. The photo below shows an acceptable repaired
surface.
Notice Corrosion that extends up the lip of the wheel, where after the clean-up process it would be
visible with the tire mounted, is only acceptable on the inboard flange. The inboard flange is not
visible with the wheel assembly in the mounted position. If any loose coatings or corrosion extend
to the visible surfaces on the FACE of the wheel, that wheel must be replaced.
Important Remove ONLY the material required to eliminate the corrosion from the bead seating
surface. DO NOT remove excessive amounts of material. ALWAYS keep the sealing surface as
smooth and level as possible.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 08-03-10-006C > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Tire Slowly Goes Flat/Warning Light ON >
Page 1777
Acceptably Prepared (Cleaned-Up) Wheel Surface
6. Once the corrosion has been eliminated, you should coat the repaired area with a commercially
available tire sealant such as Patch Brand Bead
Sealant or equivalent. Commercially available bead sealants are black rubber-like coatings that will
permanently fill and seal the resurfaced bead seat. At 21°C (70°F) ambient temperature, this
sealant will set-up sufficiently for tire mounting in about 10 minutes.Coated and Sealed Bead Seat
7. Remount the tire and install the repaired wheel and tire assembly. Refer to Tire and Wheel
Removal and Installation in SI.
Parts Information
Patch Brand Bead Sealer is available from Myers Tires at 1-800-998-9897 or on the web at
www.myerstiresupply.com. The one-quart size can of sealer will repair about 20 wheels.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 08-03-10-006C > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Tire Slowly Goes Flat/Warning Light ON >
Page 1778
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Chrome Wheel Staining/Pitting/Corrosion
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-03-10-002F
Date: April 21, 2011
Subject: Chemical Staining, Pitting, Corrosion and/or Spotted Appearance of Chromed Aluminum
Wheels
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years, suggest additional restorative
products and add additional corrosion information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
00-03-10-002E (Section 03 - Suspension). Important You may give a copy of this bulletin to the
customer.
What is Chemical Staining of Chrome Wheels? Figure 1
Chemical staining in most cases results from acid based cleaners (refer to Figure 1 for an
example). These stains are frequently milky, black, or greenish in appearance. They result from
using cleaning solutions that contain acids on chrome wheels. Soap and water is usually sufficient
to clean wheels.
If the customer insists on using a wheel cleaner they should only use one that specifically states
that it is safe for chromed wheels and does not contain anything in the following list. (Dealers
should also survey any products they use during prep or normal cleaning of stock units for these
chemicals.)
- Ammonium Bifluoride (fluoride source for dissolution of chrome)
- Hydrofluoric Acid (directly dissolves chrome)
- Hydrochloric Acid (directly dissolves chrome)
- Sodium Dodecylbenzenesulfonic Acid
- Sulfamic Acid
- Phosphoric Acid
- Hydroxyacetic Acid
Notice
Many wheel cleaner instructions advise to take care to avoid contact with painted surfaces. Most
customers think of painted surfaces as the fenders, quarter panels and other exterior sheet metal.
Many vehicles have painted brake calipers. Acidic wheel cleaners may craze, crack, or discolor the
paint on the brake calipers. Damage from wheel cleaners is not covered under the vehicle new car
warranty. Soap and water applied with a soft brush is usually all that is required to clean the
calipers.
Whenever any wheel cleaner is used, it must be THOROUGHLY rinsed off of the wheel with clean,
clear water. Special care must be taken to rinse under the hub cap, balance weights, wheel nuts,
lug nut caps, between the wheel cladding and off the back side of the wheel. Wheels returned to
the Warranty Parts Center (WPC) that exhibit damage from wheel cleaners most often have the
damage around and under the wheel weight where the cleaner was incompletely flushed away.
Notice
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion > Page 1784
Do not use cleaning solutions that contain hydrofluoric, oxalic and most other acids on chrome
wheels (or any wheels).
If the customer is unsure of the chemical make-up of a particular wheel cleaner, it should be
avoided.
For wheels showing signs of milky staining from acidic cleaners, refer to Customer Assistance and
Instructions below.
Warranty of Stained Chrome Wheels
Stained wheels are not warrantable. Most acid based cleaners will permanently stain chrome
wheels. Follow-up with dealers has confirmed that such cleaners were used on wheels that were
returned to the Warranty Parts Center (WPC). Any stained wheels received by the WPC will be
charged back to the dealership. To assist the customer, refer to Customer Assistance and
Instructions below.
Pitting or Spotted Appearance of Chrome Wheels Figure 2
A second type or staining or finish disturbance may result from road chemicals, such as calcium
chloride used for dust control of unpaved roads. The staining will look like small pitting (refer to
Figure 2). This staining will usually be on the leading edges of each wheel spoke, but may be
uniformly distributed. If a vehicle must be operated under such conditions, the chrome wheels
should be washed with mild soap and water and thoroughly rinsed as soon as conveniently
possible.
Important Road chemicals, such as calcium chloride used for dust control of unpaved roads, can
also stain chrome wheels. The staining will look like small pitting. This staining will usually be on
the leading edges of each wheel spoke. This is explained by the vehicle traveling in the forward
direction while being splashed by the road chemical. If a vehicle must be operated under such
conditions, the chrome wheels should be washed with mild soap and water and thoroughly rinsed
as soon as conveniently possible.
Warranty of Pitted or Spotted Chrome Wheels
Wheels returned with pitting or spotting as a result of road chemicals may be replaced one time.
Damage resulting from contact with these applied road chemicals is corrosive to the wheels finish
and may cause damage if the wheels are not kept clean.
Important Notify the customer that this is a one time replacement. Please stress to the customer
the vital importance of keeping the wheels clean if they are operating the vehicle in an area that
applies calcium chloride or other dust controlling chemicals! "GM of Canada" dealers require prior
approval by the District Manager - Customer Care and Service Process (DM-CCSP).
"Stardust" Corrosion of Chrome Wheels Figure 3
A third type of finish disturbance results from prolonged exposure to brake dust and resultant
penetration of brake dust through the chrome. As brakes are applied hot particles of brake material
are thrown off and tend to be forced through the leading edge of the wheel spoke windows by
airflow. These
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion > Page 1785
hot particles embed themselves in the chrome layer and create a small pit. If the material is allowed
to sit on the wheel while it is exposed to moisture or salt, it will corrode the wheel beneath the
chrome leaving a pit or small blister in the chrome.
Heavy brake dust build-up should be removed from wheels by using GM Chrome Cleaner and
Polish, P/N 1050173 (in Canada use 10953013). For moderate cleaning, light brake dust build-up
or water spots use GM Swirl Remover Polish, P/N 12377965 (in Canada, use Meguiars
Plast-X(TM) Clear Plastic Cleaner and Polish #G12310C**). After cleaning, the wheel should be
waxed using GM Cleaner Wax, P/N 12377966 (in Canada, use Meguiars Cleaner Wax
#M0616C**), which will help protect the wheel from brake dust and reduce adhesion of any brake
dust that gets on the wheel surface. For general maintenance cleaning, PEEK Metal Polish† may
be used. It will clean and shine the chrome and leave behind a wax coating that may help protect
the finish.
Warranty of Stardust Corroded Chrome Wheels
Wheels returned with pitting or spotting as a result of neglect and brake dust build-up may be
replaced one time.
Important Notify the customer that this is a one time replacement. Please stress to the customer
the vital importance of keeping the wheels clean and free of prolonged exposure to brake dust
build-up. "GM of Canada" dealers require prior approval by the District Manager - Customer Care
and Service Process (DM-CCSP).
Customer Assistance and Instructions
GM has looked for ways customers may improve the appearance of wheels damaged by acidic
cleaners. The following product and procedure has been found to dramatically improve the
appearance of stained wheels. For wheels that have milky stains caused by acidic cleaners try the
following:
Notice
THE 3M CHROME AND METAL POLISH REQUIRED FOR THIS PROCEDURE IS AN
EXTREMELY AGGRESSIVE POLISH/CLEANER. THE WHEELS MUST BE CLEANED BEFORE
APPLICATION TO AVOID SCRATCHING THE WHEEL SURFACE. THIS PRODUCT WILL
REDUCE THE THICKNESS OF THE CHROME PLATING ON THE WHEEL AND IF USED
INCORRECTLY OR EXCESSIVELY MAY REMOVE THE CHROME PLATING ALL TOGETHER,
EXPOSING A LESS BRIGHT AND BRASSY COLORED SUB-LAYER. FOLLOW INSTRUCTIONS
EXACTLY.
1. Wash the wheels with vigorously with soap and water. This step will clean and may reduce
wheel staining. Flood all areas of the wheel with water
to rinse.
2. Dry the wheels completely.
Notice Begin with a small section of the wheel and with light pressure buff off polish and examine
results. ONLY apply and rub with sufficient force and time to remove enough staining that you are
satisfied with the results. Some wheels may be stained to the extent that you may only achieve a
50% improvement while others may be able to be restored to the original lustre. IN ALL CASES,
only apply until the results are satisfactory.
3. Apply 3M Chrome and Metal Polish #39527* with a clean terry cloth towel. As you apply the
polish, the staining will be diminished. 4. When dry, buff off the polish with a clean portion of the
towel. 5. Repeat application of the 3M Chrome and Metal Polish until satisfied with the results. If
continued applications fail to improve the appearance
further discontinue use.
This procedure will improve the appearance of the wheels and may, with repeated applications,
restore the finish dramatically. For wheels that exhibit spotting from road chemicals the above
procedure may marginally improve the condition but will not restore the finish or remove the pitting.
In this type of staining the wheel finish has actually been removed in spots and no manner of
cleaning will restore the finish.
†*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or
assume any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may
be available from other sources.
Parts Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion > Page 1786
*This product is currently available from 3M. To obtain information for your local retail location
please call 3M at 1-888-364-3577.
**This product is currently available from Meguiars (Canada). To obtain information for your local
retail location please call Meguiars at 1-800-347-5700 or at www.meguiarscanada.com.
^ This product is currently available from Tri-Peek International. To obtain information for your local
retail location please call Tri-Peek at
1-877-615-4272 or at www.tripeek.com.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 99-08-51-007E > Mar > 11 > Wheels/Tires - Refinishing Aluminum
Wheels
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Refinishing Aluminum Wheels
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 99-08-51-007E
Date: March 17, 2011
Subject: Refinishing Aluminum Wheels
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add additional model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 99-08-51-007D (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
This bulletin updates General Motor's position on refinishing aluminum wheels. GM does not
endorse any repairs that involve welding, bending, straightening or re-machining. Only cosmetic
refinishing of the wheel's coatings, using recommended procedures, is allowed.
Evaluating Damage
In evaluating damage, it is the GM Dealer's responsibility to inspect the wheel for corrosion,
scrapes, gouges, etc. The Dealer must insure that such damage is not deeper than what can be
sanded or polished off. The wheel must be inspected for cracks. If cracks are found, discard the
wheel. Any wheels with bent rim flanges must not be repaired or refinished. Wheels that have been
refinished by an outside company must be returned to the same vehicle. The Dealer must record
the wheel ID stamp or the cast date on the wheel in order to assure this requirement. Refer to
Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company later in this bulletin.
Aluminum Wheel Refinishing Recommendations
- Chrome-plated aluminum wheels Re-plating these wheels is not recommended.
- Polished aluminum wheels These wheels have a polyester or acrylic clearcoat on them. If the
clearcoat is damaged, refinishing is possible. However, the required refinishing process cannot be
performed in the dealer environment. Refer to Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company later
in this bulletin.
- Painted aluminum wheels These wheels are painted using a primer, color coat, and clearcoat
procedure. If the paint is damaged, refinishing is possible. As with polished wheels, all original
coatings must be removed first. Media blasting is recommended. Refer to GM Aluminum
Refinishing Bulletin #53-17-03A for the re-painting of this type of wheel.
- Bright, machined aluminum wheels These wheels have a polyester or acrylic clearcoat on them.
In some cases, the recessed "pocket" areas of the wheel may be painted. Surface refinishing is
possible. The wheel must be totally stripped by media blasting or other suitable means. The wheel
should be resurfaced by using a sanding process rather than a machining process. This allows the
least amount of material to be removed.
Important Do not use any re-machining process that removes aluminum. This could affect the
dimensions and function of the wheel.
Painting is an option to re-clearcoating polished and bright machined aluminum wheels. Paint will
better mask any surface imperfections and is somewhat more durable than clearcoat alone. GM
recommends using Corsican SILVER WAEQ9283 for a fine "aluminum-like" look or Sparkle
SILVER WA9967 for a very bright look. As an option, the body color may also be used. When using
any of the painting options, it is recommended that all four wheels be refinished in order to maintain
color uniformity. Refer to GM Aluminum Refinishing Bulletin #53-17-03A for specific procedures
and product recommendations.
Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company
Important Some outside companies are offering wheel refinishing services. Such refinished wheels
will be permanently marked by the refinisher and are warranted by the refinisher. Any process that
re-machines or otherwise re-manufactures the wheel should not be used.
A refinisher's responsibility includes inspecting for cracks using the Zyglo system or the equivalent.
Any cracked wheels must not be refinished. No welding, hammering or reforming of any kind is
allowed. The wheel ID must be recorded and follow the wheel throughout the process in order to
assure that the same wheel is returned. A plastic media blast may be used for clean up of the
wheel. Hand and/or lathe sanding of the machined surface and the wheel window is allowed.
Material removal, though, must be kept to a minimum. Re-machining of the wheel is not allowed.
Paint and/or clear coat must not be present on the following surfaces: the nut chamfers, the wheel
mounting surfaces and the wheel pilot hole. The refinisher must permanently ID stamp the wheel
and warrant the painted/clearcoated surfaces for a minimum of one year or the remainder of the
new vehicle warranty, whichever is
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 99-08-51-007E > Mar > 11 > Wheels/Tires - Refinishing Aluminum
Wheels > Page 1791
longer.
Important Whenever a wheel is refinished, the mounting surface and the wheel nut contact
surfaces must not be painted or clearcoated. Coating these surfaces could affect the wheel nut
torque.
When re-mounting a tire on an aluminum wheel, coated balance weights must be used in order to
reduce the chance of future cosmetic damage.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 06-03-10-010A > Jun > 10 > Wheels - Changing
Procedures/Precautions
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Changing Procedures/Precautions
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 06-03-10-010A
Date: June 09, 2010
Subject: Information on Proper Wheel Changing Procedures and Cautions
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER Models 2005-2009 Saab
9-7X 2005-2009 Saturn Vehicles
Attention:
Complete wheel changing instructions for each vehicle line can be found under Tire and Wheel
Removal and Installation in Service Information (SI). This bulletin is intended to quickly review and
reinforce simple but vital procedures to reduce the possibility of achieving low torque during wheel
installation. Always refer to SI for wheel lug nut torque specifications and complete jacking
instructions for safe wheel changing.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to include the 2011 model year and update the available
special tool list. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 06-03-10-010 (Section 03 Suspension).
Frequency of Wheel Changes - Marketplace Driven
Just a few years ago, the increasing longevity of tires along with greater resistance to punctures
had greatly reduced the number of times wheels were removed to basically required tire rotation
intervals. Today with the booming business in accessory wheels/special application tires (such as
winter tires), consumers are having tire/wheel assemblies removed - replaced - or installed more
than ever. With this increased activity, it opens up more of a chance for error on the part of the
technician. This bulletin will review a few of the common concerns and mistakes to make yourself
aware of.
Proper Servicing Starts With the Right Tools
The following tools have been made available to assist in proper wheel and tire removal and
installation.
- J 41013 Rotor Resurfacing Kit (or equivalent)
- J 42450-A Wheel Hub Resurfacing Kit (or equivalent)
Corroded Surfaces
One area of concern is corrosion on the mating surfaces of the wheel to the hub on the vehicle.
Excessive corrosion, dirt, rust or debris built up on these surfaces can mimic a properly tightened
wheel in the service stall. Once the vehicle is driven, the debris may loosen, grind up or be washed
away from water splash. This action may result in clearance at the mating surface of the wheel and
an under-torqued condition.
Caution
Before installing a wheel, remove any buildup on the wheel mounting surface and brake drum or
brake disc mounting surface. Installing wheels with poor metal-to-metal contact at the mounting
surfaces can cause wheel nuts to loosen. This may cause a wheel to come off when the vehicle is
moving, possibly resulting in a loss of control or personal injury.
Whenever you remove the tire/wheel assemblies, you must inspect the mating surfaces. If
corrosion is found, you should remove the debris with a die grinder equipped with a fine sanding
pad, wire brush or cleaning disc. Just remove enough material to assure a clean, smooth mating
surface.
The J 41013 (or equivalent) can be used to clean the following surfaces:
- The hub mounting surface
- The brake rotor mounting surface
- The wheel mounting surface
Use the J 42450-A (or equivalent) to clean around the base of the studs and the hub.
Lubricants, Grease and Fluids
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 06-03-10-010A > Jun > 10 > Wheels - Changing
Procedures/Precautions > Page 1796
Some customers may use penetrating oils, grease or other lubricants on wheel studs to aid in
removal or installation. Always use a suitable cleaner/solvent to remove these lubricants prior to
installing the wheel and tire assemblies. Lubricants left on the wheel studs may cause improper
readings of wheel nut torque. Always install wheels to clean, dry wheel studs ONLY.
Notice
Lubricants left on the wheel studs or vertical mounting surfaces between the wheel and the rotor or
drum may cause the wheel to work itself loose after the vehicle is driven. Always install wheels to
clean, dry wheel studs and surfaces ONLY. Beginning with 2011 model year vehicles, put a light
coating of grease, GM P/N 1051344 (in Canada, P/N 9930370), on the inner surface of the wheel
pilot hole to prevent wheel seizure to the axle or bearing hub.
Wheel Stud and Lug Nut Damage
Always inspect the wheel studs and lug nuts for signs of damage from crossthreading or abuse.
You should never have to force wheel nuts down the stud. Lug nuts that are damaged may not
retain properly, yet give the impression of fully tightening. Always inspect and replace any
component suspected of damage.
Tip
Always start wheel nuts by hand! Be certain that all wheel nut threads have been engaged
BEFORE tightening the nut.
Important If the vehicle has directional tread tires, verify the directional arrow on the outboard side
of the tire is pointing in the direction of forward rotation.
Wheel Nut Tightening and Torque
Improper wheel nut tightening can lead to brake pulsation and rotor damage. In order to avoid
additional brake repairs, evenly tighten the wheel nuts to the proper torque specification as shown
for each vehicle in SI. Always observe the proper wheel nut tightening sequence as shown below in
order to avoid trapping the wheel on the wheel stud threads or clamping the wheel slightly off
center resulting in vibration.
The Most Important Service You Provide
While the above information is well known, and wheel removal so common, technicians run the risk
of becoming complacent on this very important
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 06-03-10-010A > Jun > 10 > Wheels - Changing
Procedures/Precautions > Page 1797
service operation. A simple distraction or time constraint that rushes the job may result in personal
injury if the greatest of care is not exercised. Make it a habit to double check your work and to
always side with caution when installing wheels.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force
Variation (RFV)
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV)
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-03-10-006F
Date: May 04, 2010
Subject: Information on Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009
and Prior Saab 9-7X 2000-2005 Saturn L Series 2003-2007 Saturn ION
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to considerably expand the available information on
Radial Force Variation (RFV) and should be reviewed in whole. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-03-10-006E (Section 03 - Suspension).
Important
- Before measuring tires on equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700, the vehicle MUST be driven
a minimum of 16 km (10 mi) to ensure removal of any flat-spotting. Refer to Corporate Bulletin
Number 03-03-10-007E - Tire/Wheel Characteristics of GM Original Equipment Tires.
- Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 MUST be calibrated prior to measuring tire/wheel
assemblies for each vehicle.
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide guidance to GM dealers when using tire force variation
measurement equipment, such as the Hunter GSP9700. This type of equipment can be a valuable
tool in diagnosing vehicle ride concerns. The most common ride concern involving tire radial force
variation is highway speed shake on smooth roads.
Tire related smooth road highway speed shake can be caused by three conditions: imbalance, out
of round and tire force variation. These three conditions are not necessarily related. All three
conditions must be addressed.
Imbalance is normally addressed first, because it is the simpler of the three to correct. Off-vehicle,
two plane dynamic wheel balancers are readily available and can accurately correct any
imbalance. Balancer calibration and maintenance, proper attachment of the wheel to the balancer,
and proper balance weights, are all factors required for a quality balance. However, a perfectly
balanced tire/wheel assembly can still be "oval shaped" and cause a vibration.
Before balancing, perform the following procedures.
Tire and Wheel Diagnosis
1. Set the tire pressure to the placard values. 2. With the vehicle raised, ensure the wheels are
centered on the hub by loosening all wheel nuts and hand-tightening all nuts first by hand while
shaking the wheel, then torque to specifications using a torque wrench, NOT a torque stick.
3. Visually inspect the tires and the wheels. Inspect for evidence of the following conditions and
correct as necessary:
- Missing balance weights
- Bent rim flange
- Irregular tire wear
- Incomplete bead seating
- Tire irregularities (including pressure settings)
- Mud/ice build-up in wheel
- Stones in the tire tread
- Remove any aftermarket wheels and/or tires and restore vehicle to original condition prior to
diagnosing a smooth road shake condition.
4. Road test the vehicle using the Electronic Vibration Analyzer (EVA) essential tool. Drive for a
sufficient distance on a known, smooth road
surface to duplicate the condition. Determine if the vehicle is sensitive to brake apply. If the brakes
are applied lightly and the pulsation felt in the steering wheel increases, refer to the Brakes section
of the service manual that deals with brake-induced pulsation. If you can start to hear the vibration
as a low boom noise (in addition to feeling it), but cannot see it, the vehicle likely has a first order
(one pulse per propshaft revolution) driveline vibration. Driveline first order vibrations are high
enough in frequency that most humans can start to hear them at highway speeds, but are too high
to be able to be easily seen. These issues can be caused by driveline imbalance or misalignment.
If the vehicle exhibits this low boom and the booming pulses in-and-out on a regular basis (like a
throbbing), chances are good that the vehicle could have driveline vibration. This type
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force
Variation (RFV) > Page 1802
of vibration is normally felt more in the "seat of the pants" than the steering wheel.
5. Next, record the Hertz (Hz) reading as displayed by the EVA onto the tire data worksheet found
at the end of this bulletin. This should be done
after a tire break-in period of at least 16 km (10 mi) at 72 km/h (45 mph) or greater, in order to
eliminate any possible tire flat-spotting. This reading confirms what the vehicle vibration frequency
is prior to vehicle service and documents the amount of improvement occurring as the result of the
various steps taken to repair. Completing the Steering Wheel Shake Worksheet below is required.
A copy of the completed worksheet must be saved with the R.O. and a copy included with any
parts returned to the Warranty Parts Center for analysis. A reading of 35 to 50 Hz typically
indicates a first order propshaft vibration. If this is the situation, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
08-07-30-044D. Generally, a reading between 10 and 20 Hz indicates a tire/wheel vibration and if
this is the reading obtained, continue using this bulletin. If the tire 1st order vibration goes away
and stays away during this evaluation, the cause is likely tire flat-spotting. Tire flat-spotting vibration
may come and go at any speed over 72 km/h (45 mph) during the first 10 minutes of operation, if
vibration continues after 10 minutes of driving at speeds greater than 72 km/h (45 mph), tire
flat-spotting can be ruled out as the cause for vibration.
6. If flat-spotting is the cause, provide the explanation that this has occurred due to the vehicle
being parked for long periods of time and that the
nature of the tire is to take a set. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 03-03-10-007E: Information
on Tire/Wheel Characteristics (Vibration, Balance, Shake, Flat Spotting) of GM Original Equipment
Tires.
7. If the road test indicates a shake/vibration exists, check the imbalance of each tire/wheel
assembly on a known, calibrated, off-car dynamic
balancer.Make sure the mounting surface of the wheel and the surface of the balancer are
absolutely clean and free of debris. Be sure to chose the proper cone/collet for the wheel, and
always use the pilot bore for centering. Never center the wheel using the hub-cap bore since it is
not a precision machined surface. If any assembly calls for more than 1/4 ounce on either rim
flange, remove all balance weights and rebalance to as close to zero as possible. If you can see
the vibration (along with feeling it) in the steering wheel (driving straight without your hands on the
wheel), it is very likely to be a tire/wheel first order (one pulse per revolution) disturbance. First
order disturbances can be caused by imbalance as well as non-uniformities in tires, wheels or
hubs. This first order frequency is too low for a human to hear, but if the amplitude is high enough,
it can be seen.
If a vibration or shake still exists after balancing, any out of round conditions, of the wheel, and
force variation conditions of the tire, must be addressed. Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700
can address both (it is also a wheel balancer).
Tire radial force vibration (RFV) can be defined as the amount of stiffness variation the tire will
produce in one revolution under a constant load. Radial force variation is what the vehicle feels
because the load (weight) of the vehicle is always on the tires. Although free runout of tires (not
under load) is not always a good indicator of a smooth ride, it is critical that total tire/wheel
assembly runout be within specification.
Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 loads the tire, similar to on the vehicle, and measures
radial force variation of the tire/wheel assembly. Note that the wheel is affecting the tire's RFV
measurement at this point. To isolate the wheel, its runout must be measured. This can be easily
done on the Hunter, without the need to set up dial indicators. If the wheel meets the runout
specification, the tire's RFV can then be addressed.
After measuring the tire/wheel assembly under load, and the wheel alone, the machine then
calculates (predicts) the radial force variation of the tire. However, because this is a prediction that
can include mounting inaccuracies, and the load wheel is much smaller in diameter than used in
tire production, this type of service equipment should NOT be used to audit new tires. Rather, it
should be used as a service diagnostic tool to minimize radial force variation of the tire/wheel
assembly.
Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 does an excellent job of measuring wheel runout, and of
finding the low point of the wheel (for runout) and the high point of the tire (for radial force
variation). This allows the tire to be matched mounted to the wheel for lowest tire/wheel assembly
force variation.
The machine will simplify this process into easy steps. The following assembly radial force variation
numbers should be used as a guide:
When measuring RFV and match mounting tires perform the following steps.
Measuring Wheel Runout and Assembly Radial Force Variation
Important The completed worksheet at the end of this bulletin must be attached to the hard copy of
the repair order.
- Measure radial force variation and radial runout.
- If a road force/balancing machine is used, record the radial force variation (RFV) on the
worksheet at the end of this bulletin. It may be of benefit to have the lowest RFV assembly to the
front left corner. If the machine is not available and the EVA data suggests there is an issue, swap
the tire and wheel assemblies from the front to the back. Re-check on the EVA and if the problem
still exists, test another vehicle to find tires that do not exhibit the same frequency and swap those
tires onto the subject vehicle.
- If a runout/balancing machine is used, record the radial runout of the tire/wheel assemblies on the
worksheet at the end of this bulletin. If one or more of the tire/wheel assemblies are more than.040
in (1.02 mm), match mount the tire to the wheel to get below.040 in (1.02 mm). For sensitive
customers, readings of 0.030 inch (0.76 mm) or less are preferable, it may also be of benefit to
have the lowest runout assembly to the front left corner. If the machine is not available and the
EVA data suggests there is an issue, swap the tire and wheel assemblies from the front to the
back. Re-check on the EVA and if the problem still exists, test another vehicle to find tires that do
not exhibit the same frequency and swap those tires
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force
Variation (RFV) > Page 1803
onto the subject vehicle.
- After match mounting, the tire/wheel assembly must be rebalanced.
If match mounting tires to in-spec wheels produces assembly values higher than these, tire
replacement may be necessary. Replacing tires at lower values will probably mean good tires are
being condemned. Because tires can sometimes become temporarily flat-spotted, which will affect
force variation, it is important that the vehicle be driven at least 16 km (10 mi) prior to measuring.
Tire pressure must also be adjusted to the usage pressure on the vehicle's tire placard prior to
measuring.
Most GM vehicles will tolerate radial force variation up to these levels. However, some vehicles are
more sensitive, and may require lower levels. Also, there are other tire parameters that equipment
such as the Hunter GSP9700 cannot measure that may be a factor. In such cases, TAC should be
contacted for further instructions.
Important
- When mounting a GM wheel to a wheel balancer/force variation machine, always use the wheel's
center pilot hole. This is the primary centering mechanism on all GM wheels; the bolt holes are
secondary. Usually a back cone method to the machine should be used. For added accuracy and
repeatability, a flange plate should be used to clamp the wheel onto the cone and machine. This
system is offered by all balancer manufacturers in GM's dealer program.
- Any type of service equipment that removes tread rubber by grinding, buffing or truing is NOT
recommended, and may void the tire warranty. However, tires may have been ground by the tire
company as part of their tire manufacturing process. This is a legitimate procedure.
Steering Wheel Shake Worksheet
When diagnosing vibration concerns, use the following worksheet in conjunction with the
appropriate Vibration Analysis-Road testing procedure in the Vibration Correction sub-section in SI.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force
Variation (RFV) > Page 1804
Refer to the appropriate section of SI for specifications and repair procedures that are related to the
vibration concern.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 05-03-10-003F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast
Aluminum Wheels
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 05-03-10-003F
Date: April 27, 2010
Subject: Low Tire Pressure, Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels (Repair with Adhesive Sealant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X with Cast Aluminum Wheels
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years and the bulletin reference
information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-10-003E (Section 03 - Suspension).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a low tire pressure condition.
Diagnosis of the low tire pressure condition indicates an air leak through the cast aluminum wheel.
Cause
Porosity in the cast aluminum wheel may be the cause.
Notice
This bulletin specifically addresses issues related to the wheel casting that may result in an air
leak. For issues related to corrosion of the wheel in service, please refer to Corporate Bulletin
Number 08-03-10-006C - Tire Slowly Goes Flat, Tire Air Loss, Low Tire Pressure Warning Light
Illuminated, Aluminum Wheel Bead Seat Corrosion (Clean and Resurface Wheel Bead Seat).
Correction
1. Remove the tire and wheel assembly from the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate service
procedure in SI. 2. Locate the leaking area by inflating the tire to 276 kPa (40 psi) and dipping the
tire/wheel assembly in a water bath, or use a spray bottle with soap
and water to locate the specific leak location.
Important
- If the porosity leak is located in the bead area of the aluminum rim (where the tire meets the rim),
the wheel should be replaced.
- If two or more leaks are located on one wheel, the wheel should be replaced.
3. If air bubbles are observed, mark the location.
- If the leak location is on the tire/rubber area, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 04-03-10-001F Tire Puncture Repair Procedures for All Cars and Light Duty Trucks.
- If the leak is located on the aluminum wheel area, continue with the next step.
4. Inscribe a mark on the tire at the valve stem in order to indicate the orientation of the tire to the
wheel. 5. Dismount the tire from the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. 6. Remove
the tire pressure sensor. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor removal procedure in SI. 7. Scuff the
INSIDE rim surface at the leak area with #80 grit paper and clean the area with general purpose
cleaner, such as 3M(R) General Purpose
Adhesive Cleaner, P/N 08984, or equivalent.
8. Apply a 3 mm (0.12 in) thick layer of Silicone - Adhesive/Sealant, P/N 12378478 (in Canada, use
88900041), or equivalent, to the leak area. 9. Allow for the adhesive/sealant to dry.
Notice Caution must be used when mounting the tire so as not to damage the sealer. Damaging
the repair area may result in an air leak.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 05-03-10-003F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast
Aluminum Wheels > Page 1809
10. Align the inscribed mark on the tire with the valve stem on the wheel. 11. Reinstall the Tire
Pressure Sensor. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor installation procedure in SI. 12. Mount the tire on
the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. 13. Pressurize the tire to 276 kPa (40 psi) and
inspect for leaks. 14. Adjust tire pressure to meet the placard specification. 15. Balance the
tire/wheel assembly. Refer to Tire and Wheel Assembly Balancing - Off-Vehicle. 16. Install the tire
and wheel assembly onto the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate service procedure in SI.
Parts Information
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
Important The Silicone - Adhesive/Sealant comes in a case quantity of six. ONLY charge warranty
one tube of adhesive/sealant per wheel repair.
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
One leak repair per wheel.
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 08-03-10-006C > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Tire Slowly Goes
Flat/Warning Light ON
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Tires/Wheels - Tire Slowly Goes Flat/Warning Light ON
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 08-03-10-006C
Date: April 27, 2010
Subject: Tire Slowly Goes Flat, Tire Air Loss, Low Tire Pressure Warning Light Illuminated,
Aluminum Wheel Bead Seat Corrosion (Clean and Resurface Wheel Bead Seat)
Models:
2000-2011 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2009 HUMMER H2
2006-2010 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 08-03-10-006B (Section 03 - Suspension).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a tire that slowly loses air pressure over a period of days or
weeks.
Cause
Abrasive elements in the environment may intrude between the tire and wheel at the bead seat.
There is always some relative motion between the tire and wheel (when the vehicle is driven) and
this motion may cause the abrasive particles to wear the wheel and tire materials. As the wear
continues, there may also be intrusion at the tire/wheel interface by corrosive media from the
environment. Eventually a path for air develops and a 'slow' leak may ensue. This corrosion may
appear on the inboard or outboard bead seating surface of the wheel. This corrosion will not be
visible until the tire is dismounted from the wheel.
Notice
This bulletin specifically addresses issues related to wheel bead seat corrosion that may result in
an air leak. For issues related to porosity of the wheel casting that may result in an air leak, please
refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-10-006F - Low Tire Pressure, Leaking Cast Aluminum
Wheels (Repair with Adhesive Sealant)
Correction
In most cases, this type of air loss can be corrected by following the procedure below.
Important DO NOT replace a wheel for slow air loss unless you have evaluated and/or tried to
repair the wheel with the procedure below.
Notice
The repair is no longer advised or applicable for chromed aluminum wheels.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly for diagnosis. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and
Installation in SI. 2. After a water dunk tank leak test, if you determine the source of the air leak to
be around the bead seat of the wheel, dismount the tire to examine
the bead seat. Shown below is a typical area of bead seat corrosion.Typical Location of Bead Seat
Corrosion
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 08-03-10-006C > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Tire Slowly Goes
Flat/Warning Light ON > Page 1814
Important Other forms of slow air leaks are possible. If the body of the tire, valve stem and wheel
flange show no signs of air seepage, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-10-003D for
additional information on possible wheel porosity issues.
3. Bead seat corrosion is identified by what appears like blistering of the wheel finish, causing a
rough or uneven surface that is difficult for the tire to
maintain a proper seal on. Below is a close-up photo of bead seat corrosion on an aluminum wheel
that was sufficient to cause slow air loss. Close-Up of Bead Seat Corrosion
4. If corrosion is found on the wheel bead seat, measure the affected area as shown below.
- For vehicles with 32,186 km (20,000 mi) or less, the total allowable combined linear area of
repairable corrosion is 100 mm (4 in) or less. If the total area(s) of corrosion exceed these
dimensions, the wheel should be replaced.
- For vehicles that have exceeded 32,186 km (20,000 mi), the total allowable combined linear area
of repairable corrosion is 200 mm (8 in) or less. If the total area(s) of corrosion exceed these
dimensions, the wheel should be replaced.
5. In order to correct the wheel leak, use a clean-up (fine cut) sanding disc or biscuit to remove the
corrosion and any flaking paint. You should
remove the corrosion back far enough until you reach material that is stable and firmly bonded to
the wheel. Try to taper the edge of any flaking paint as best you can in order to avoid sharp edges
that may increase the chance of a leak reoccurring. The photo below shows an acceptable repaired
surface.
Notice Corrosion that extends up the lip of the wheel, where after the clean-up process it would be
visible with the tire mounted, is only acceptable on the inboard flange. The inboard flange is not
visible with the wheel assembly in the mounted position. If any loose coatings or corrosion extend
to the visible surfaces on the FACE of the wheel, that wheel must be replaced.
Important Remove ONLY the material required to eliminate the corrosion from the bead seating
surface. DO NOT remove excessive amounts of material. ALWAYS keep the sealing surface as
smooth and level as possible.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 08-03-10-006C > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Tire Slowly Goes
Flat/Warning Light ON > Page 1815
Acceptably Prepared (Cleaned-Up) Wheel Surface
6. Once the corrosion has been eliminated, you should coat the repaired area with a commercially
available tire sealant such as Patch Brand Bead
Sealant or equivalent. Commercially available bead sealants are black rubber-like coatings that will
permanently fill and seal the resurfaced bead seat. At 21°C (70°F) ambient temperature, this
sealant will set-up sufficiently for tire mounting in about 10 minutes.Coated and Sealed Bead Seat
7. Remount the tire and install the repaired wheel and tire assembly. Refer to Tire and Wheel
Removal and Installation in SI.
Parts Information
Patch Brand Bead Sealer is available from Myers Tires at 1-800-998-9897 or on the web at
www.myerstiresupply.com. The one-quart size can of sealer will repair about 20 wheels.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 08-03-10-006C > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Tire Slowly Goes
Flat/Warning Light ON > Page 1816
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 04-03-10-012B > Feb > 08 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel Brake Dust
Accumulation/Pitting
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Chrome Wheel Brake Dust Accumulation/Pitting
Bulletin No.: 04-03-10-012B
Date: February 01, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Pitting and Brake Dust on Chrome wheels
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2008 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
04-03-10-012A (Section 03 - Suspension).
Analysis of Returned Wheels
Chrome wheels returned under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty for pitting concerns have
recently been evaluated. This condition is usually most severe in the vent (or window) area of the
front wheels. This "pitting" may actually be brake dust that has been allowed to accumulate on the
wheel. The longer this accumulation builds up, the more difficult it is to remove.
Cleaning the Wheels
In all cases, the returned wheels could be cleaned to their original condition using GM Vehicle Care
Cleaner Wax, P/N 12377966 (in Canada, P/N 10952905). When using this product, you should
confine your treatment to the areas of the wheel that show evidence of the brake dust build-up.
This product is only for use on chromed steel or chromed aluminum wheels.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
Wheel replacement for this condition is NOT applicable under the terms of the New Vehicle Limited
Warranty.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Chrome Wheel Staining/Pitting/Corrosion
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-03-10-002F
Date: April 21, 2011
Subject: Chemical Staining, Pitting, Corrosion and/or Spotted Appearance of Chromed Aluminum
Wheels
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years, suggest additional restorative
products and add additional corrosion information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
00-03-10-002E (Section 03 - Suspension). Important You may give a copy of this bulletin to the
customer.
What is Chemical Staining of Chrome Wheels? Figure 1
Chemical staining in most cases results from acid based cleaners (refer to Figure 1 for an
example). These stains are frequently milky, black, or greenish in appearance. They result from
using cleaning solutions that contain acids on chrome wheels. Soap and water is usually sufficient
to clean wheels.
If the customer insists on using a wheel cleaner they should only use one that specifically states
that it is safe for chromed wheels and does not contain anything in the following list. (Dealers
should also survey any products they use during prep or normal cleaning of stock units for these
chemicals.)
- Ammonium Bifluoride (fluoride source for dissolution of chrome)
- Hydrofluoric Acid (directly dissolves chrome)
- Hydrochloric Acid (directly dissolves chrome)
- Sodium Dodecylbenzenesulfonic Acid
- Sulfamic Acid
- Phosphoric Acid
- Hydroxyacetic Acid
Notice
Many wheel cleaner instructions advise to take care to avoid contact with painted surfaces. Most
customers think of painted surfaces as the fenders, quarter panels and other exterior sheet metal.
Many vehicles have painted brake calipers. Acidic wheel cleaners may craze, crack, or discolor the
paint on the brake calipers. Damage from wheel cleaners is not covered under the vehicle new car
warranty. Soap and water applied with a soft brush is usually all that is required to clean the
calipers.
Whenever any wheel cleaner is used, it must be THOROUGHLY rinsed off of the wheel with clean,
clear water. Special care must be taken to rinse under the hub cap, balance weights, wheel nuts,
lug nut caps, between the wheel cladding and off the back side of the wheel. Wheels returned to
the Warranty Parts Center (WPC) that exhibit damage from wheel cleaners most often have the
damage around and under the wheel weight where the cleaner was incompletely flushed away.
Notice
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion > Page 1826
Do not use cleaning solutions that contain hydrofluoric, oxalic and most other acids on chrome
wheels (or any wheels).
If the customer is unsure of the chemical make-up of a particular wheel cleaner, it should be
avoided.
For wheels showing signs of milky staining from acidic cleaners, refer to Customer Assistance and
Instructions below.
Warranty of Stained Chrome Wheels
Stained wheels are not warrantable. Most acid based cleaners will permanently stain chrome
wheels. Follow-up with dealers has confirmed that such cleaners were used on wheels that were
returned to the Warranty Parts Center (WPC). Any stained wheels received by the WPC will be
charged back to the dealership. To assist the customer, refer to Customer Assistance and
Instructions below.
Pitting or Spotted Appearance of Chrome Wheels Figure 2
A second type or staining or finish disturbance may result from road chemicals, such as calcium
chloride used for dust control of unpaved roads. The staining will look like small pitting (refer to
Figure 2). This staining will usually be on the leading edges of each wheel spoke, but may be
uniformly distributed. If a vehicle must be operated under such conditions, the chrome wheels
should be washed with mild soap and water and thoroughly rinsed as soon as conveniently
possible.
Important Road chemicals, such as calcium chloride used for dust control of unpaved roads, can
also stain chrome wheels. The staining will look like small pitting. This staining will usually be on
the leading edges of each wheel spoke. This is explained by the vehicle traveling in the forward
direction while being splashed by the road chemical. If a vehicle must be operated under such
conditions, the chrome wheels should be washed with mild soap and water and thoroughly rinsed
as soon as conveniently possible.
Warranty of Pitted or Spotted Chrome Wheels
Wheels returned with pitting or spotting as a result of road chemicals may be replaced one time.
Damage resulting from contact with these applied road chemicals is corrosive to the wheels finish
and may cause damage if the wheels are not kept clean.
Important Notify the customer that this is a one time replacement. Please stress to the customer
the vital importance of keeping the wheels clean if they are operating the vehicle in an area that
applies calcium chloride or other dust controlling chemicals! "GM of Canada" dealers require prior
approval by the District Manager - Customer Care and Service Process (DM-CCSP).
"Stardust" Corrosion of Chrome Wheels Figure 3
A third type of finish disturbance results from prolonged exposure to brake dust and resultant
penetration of brake dust through the chrome. As brakes are applied hot particles of brake material
are thrown off and tend to be forced through the leading edge of the wheel spoke windows by
airflow. These
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion > Page 1827
hot particles embed themselves in the chrome layer and create a small pit. If the material is allowed
to sit on the wheel while it is exposed to moisture or salt, it will corrode the wheel beneath the
chrome leaving a pit or small blister in the chrome.
Heavy brake dust build-up should be removed from wheels by using GM Chrome Cleaner and
Polish, P/N 1050173 (in Canada use 10953013). For moderate cleaning, light brake dust build-up
or water spots use GM Swirl Remover Polish, P/N 12377965 (in Canada, use Meguiars
Plast-X(TM) Clear Plastic Cleaner and Polish #G12310C**). After cleaning, the wheel should be
waxed using GM Cleaner Wax, P/N 12377966 (in Canada, use Meguiars Cleaner Wax
#M0616C**), which will help protect the wheel from brake dust and reduce adhesion of any brake
dust that gets on the wheel surface. For general maintenance cleaning, PEEK Metal Polish† may
be used. It will clean and shine the chrome and leave behind a wax coating that may help protect
the finish.
Warranty of Stardust Corroded Chrome Wheels
Wheels returned with pitting or spotting as a result of neglect and brake dust build-up may be
replaced one time.
Important Notify the customer that this is a one time replacement. Please stress to the customer
the vital importance of keeping the wheels clean and free of prolonged exposure to brake dust
build-up. "GM of Canada" dealers require prior approval by the District Manager - Customer Care
and Service Process (DM-CCSP).
Customer Assistance and Instructions
GM has looked for ways customers may improve the appearance of wheels damaged by acidic
cleaners. The following product and procedure has been found to dramatically improve the
appearance of stained wheels. For wheels that have milky stains caused by acidic cleaners try the
following:
Notice
THE 3M CHROME AND METAL POLISH REQUIRED FOR THIS PROCEDURE IS AN
EXTREMELY AGGRESSIVE POLISH/CLEANER. THE WHEELS MUST BE CLEANED BEFORE
APPLICATION TO AVOID SCRATCHING THE WHEEL SURFACE. THIS PRODUCT WILL
REDUCE THE THICKNESS OF THE CHROME PLATING ON THE WHEEL AND IF USED
INCORRECTLY OR EXCESSIVELY MAY REMOVE THE CHROME PLATING ALL TOGETHER,
EXPOSING A LESS BRIGHT AND BRASSY COLORED SUB-LAYER. FOLLOW INSTRUCTIONS
EXACTLY.
1. Wash the wheels with vigorously with soap and water. This step will clean and may reduce
wheel staining. Flood all areas of the wheel with water
to rinse.
2. Dry the wheels completely.
Notice Begin with a small section of the wheel and with light pressure buff off polish and examine
results. ONLY apply and rub with sufficient force and time to remove enough staining that you are
satisfied with the results. Some wheels may be stained to the extent that you may only achieve a
50% improvement while others may be able to be restored to the original lustre. IN ALL CASES,
only apply until the results are satisfactory.
3. Apply 3M Chrome and Metal Polish #39527* with a clean terry cloth towel. As you apply the
polish, the staining will be diminished. 4. When dry, buff off the polish with a clean portion of the
towel. 5. Repeat application of the 3M Chrome and Metal Polish until satisfied with the results. If
continued applications fail to improve the appearance
further discontinue use.
This procedure will improve the appearance of the wheels and may, with repeated applications,
restore the finish dramatically. For wheels that exhibit spotting from road chemicals the above
procedure may marginally improve the condition but will not restore the finish or remove the pitting.
In this type of staining the wheel finish has actually been removed in spots and no manner of
cleaning will restore the finish.
†*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or
assume any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may
be available from other sources.
Parts Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion > Page 1828
*This product is currently available from 3M. To obtain information for your local retail location
please call 3M at 1-888-364-3577.
**This product is currently available from Meguiars (Canada). To obtain information for your local
retail location please call Meguiars at 1-800-347-5700 or at www.meguiarscanada.com.
^ This product is currently available from Tri-Peek International. To obtain information for your local
retail location please call Tri-Peek at
1-877-615-4272 or at www.tripeek.com.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 99-08-51-007E > Mar > 11 > Wheels/Tires - Refinishing Aluminum
Wheels
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Refinishing Aluminum Wheels
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 99-08-51-007E
Date: March 17, 2011
Subject: Refinishing Aluminum Wheels
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add additional model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 99-08-51-007D (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
This bulletin updates General Motor's position on refinishing aluminum wheels. GM does not
endorse any repairs that involve welding, bending, straightening or re-machining. Only cosmetic
refinishing of the wheel's coatings, using recommended procedures, is allowed.
Evaluating Damage
In evaluating damage, it is the GM Dealer's responsibility to inspect the wheel for corrosion,
scrapes, gouges, etc. The Dealer must insure that such damage is not deeper than what can be
sanded or polished off. The wheel must be inspected for cracks. If cracks are found, discard the
wheel. Any wheels with bent rim flanges must not be repaired or refinished. Wheels that have been
refinished by an outside company must be returned to the same vehicle. The Dealer must record
the wheel ID stamp or the cast date on the wheel in order to assure this requirement. Refer to
Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company later in this bulletin.
Aluminum Wheel Refinishing Recommendations
- Chrome-plated aluminum wheels Re-plating these wheels is not recommended.
- Polished aluminum wheels These wheels have a polyester or acrylic clearcoat on them. If the
clearcoat is damaged, refinishing is possible. However, the required refinishing process cannot be
performed in the dealer environment. Refer to Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company later
in this bulletin.
- Painted aluminum wheels These wheels are painted using a primer, color coat, and clearcoat
procedure. If the paint is damaged, refinishing is possible. As with polished wheels, all original
coatings must be removed first. Media blasting is recommended. Refer to GM Aluminum
Refinishing Bulletin #53-17-03A for the re-painting of this type of wheel.
- Bright, machined aluminum wheels These wheels have a polyester or acrylic clearcoat on them.
In some cases, the recessed "pocket" areas of the wheel may be painted. Surface refinishing is
possible. The wheel must be totally stripped by media blasting or other suitable means. The wheel
should be resurfaced by using a sanding process rather than a machining process. This allows the
least amount of material to be removed.
Important Do not use any re-machining process that removes aluminum. This could affect the
dimensions and function of the wheel.
Painting is an option to re-clearcoating polished and bright machined aluminum wheels. Paint will
better mask any surface imperfections and is somewhat more durable than clearcoat alone. GM
recommends using Corsican SILVER WAEQ9283 for a fine "aluminum-like" look or Sparkle
SILVER WA9967 for a very bright look. As an option, the body color may also be used. When using
any of the painting options, it is recommended that all four wheels be refinished in order to maintain
color uniformity. Refer to GM Aluminum Refinishing Bulletin #53-17-03A for specific procedures
and product recommendations.
Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company
Important Some outside companies are offering wheel refinishing services. Such refinished wheels
will be permanently marked by the refinisher and are warranted by the refinisher. Any process that
re-machines or otherwise re-manufactures the wheel should not be used.
A refinisher's responsibility includes inspecting for cracks using the Zyglo system or the equivalent.
Any cracked wheels must not be refinished. No welding, hammering or reforming of any kind is
allowed. The wheel ID must be recorded and follow the wheel throughout the process in order to
assure that the same wheel is returned. A plastic media blast may be used for clean up of the
wheel. Hand and/or lathe sanding of the machined surface and the wheel window is allowed.
Material removal, though, must be kept to a minimum. Re-machining of the wheel is not allowed.
Paint and/or clear coat must not be present on the following surfaces: the nut chamfers, the wheel
mounting surfaces and the wheel pilot hole. The refinisher must permanently ID stamp the wheel
and warrant the painted/clearcoated surfaces for a minimum of one year or the remainder of the
new vehicle warranty, whichever is
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 99-08-51-007E > Mar > 11 > Wheels/Tires - Refinishing Aluminum
Wheels > Page 1833
longer.
Important Whenever a wheel is refinished, the mounting surface and the wheel nut contact
surfaces must not be painted or clearcoated. Coating these surfaces could affect the wheel nut
torque.
When re-mounting a tire on an aluminum wheel, coated balance weights must be used in order to
reduce the chance of future cosmetic damage.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 06-03-10-010A > Jun > 10 > Wheels - Changing
Procedures/Precautions
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Changing Procedures/Precautions
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 06-03-10-010A
Date: June 09, 2010
Subject: Information on Proper Wheel Changing Procedures and Cautions
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER Models 2005-2009 Saab
9-7X 2005-2009 Saturn Vehicles
Attention:
Complete wheel changing instructions for each vehicle line can be found under Tire and Wheel
Removal and Installation in Service Information (SI). This bulletin is intended to quickly review and
reinforce simple but vital procedures to reduce the possibility of achieving low torque during wheel
installation. Always refer to SI for wheel lug nut torque specifications and complete jacking
instructions for safe wheel changing.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to include the 2011 model year and update the available
special tool list. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 06-03-10-010 (Section 03 Suspension).
Frequency of Wheel Changes - Marketplace Driven
Just a few years ago, the increasing longevity of tires along with greater resistance to punctures
had greatly reduced the number of times wheels were removed to basically required tire rotation
intervals. Today with the booming business in accessory wheels/special application tires (such as
winter tires), consumers are having tire/wheel assemblies removed - replaced - or installed more
than ever. With this increased activity, it opens up more of a chance for error on the part of the
technician. This bulletin will review a few of the common concerns and mistakes to make yourself
aware of.
Proper Servicing Starts With the Right Tools
The following tools have been made available to assist in proper wheel and tire removal and
installation.
- J 41013 Rotor Resurfacing Kit (or equivalent)
- J 42450-A Wheel Hub Resurfacing Kit (or equivalent)
Corroded Surfaces
One area of concern is corrosion on the mating surfaces of the wheel to the hub on the vehicle.
Excessive corrosion, dirt, rust or debris built up on these surfaces can mimic a properly tightened
wheel in the service stall. Once the vehicle is driven, the debris may loosen, grind up or be washed
away from water splash. This action may result in clearance at the mating surface of the wheel and
an under-torqued condition.
Caution
Before installing a wheel, remove any buildup on the wheel mounting surface and brake drum or
brake disc mounting surface. Installing wheels with poor metal-to-metal contact at the mounting
surfaces can cause wheel nuts to loosen. This may cause a wheel to come off when the vehicle is
moving, possibly resulting in a loss of control or personal injury.
Whenever you remove the tire/wheel assemblies, you must inspect the mating surfaces. If
corrosion is found, you should remove the debris with a die grinder equipped with a fine sanding
pad, wire brush or cleaning disc. Just remove enough material to assure a clean, smooth mating
surface.
The J 41013 (or equivalent) can be used to clean the following surfaces:
- The hub mounting surface
- The brake rotor mounting surface
- The wheel mounting surface
Use the J 42450-A (or equivalent) to clean around the base of the studs and the hub.
Lubricants, Grease and Fluids
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 06-03-10-010A > Jun > 10 > Wheels - Changing
Procedures/Precautions > Page 1838
Some customers may use penetrating oils, grease or other lubricants on wheel studs to aid in
removal or installation. Always use a suitable cleaner/solvent to remove these lubricants prior to
installing the wheel and tire assemblies. Lubricants left on the wheel studs may cause improper
readings of wheel nut torque. Always install wheels to clean, dry wheel studs ONLY.
Notice
Lubricants left on the wheel studs or vertical mounting surfaces between the wheel and the rotor or
drum may cause the wheel to work itself loose after the vehicle is driven. Always install wheels to
clean, dry wheel studs and surfaces ONLY. Beginning with 2011 model year vehicles, put a light
coating of grease, GM P/N 1051344 (in Canada, P/N 9930370), on the inner surface of the wheel
pilot hole to prevent wheel seizure to the axle or bearing hub.
Wheel Stud and Lug Nut Damage
Always inspect the wheel studs and lug nuts for signs of damage from crossthreading or abuse.
You should never have to force wheel nuts down the stud. Lug nuts that are damaged may not
retain properly, yet give the impression of fully tightening. Always inspect and replace any
component suspected of damage.
Tip
Always start wheel nuts by hand! Be certain that all wheel nut threads have been engaged
BEFORE tightening the nut.
Important If the vehicle has directional tread tires, verify the directional arrow on the outboard side
of the tire is pointing in the direction of forward rotation.
Wheel Nut Tightening and Torque
Improper wheel nut tightening can lead to brake pulsation and rotor damage. In order to avoid
additional brake repairs, evenly tighten the wheel nuts to the proper torque specification as shown
for each vehicle in SI. Always observe the proper wheel nut tightening sequence as shown below in
order to avoid trapping the wheel on the wheel stud threads or clamping the wheel slightly off
center resulting in vibration.
The Most Important Service You Provide
While the above information is well known, and wheel removal so common, technicians run the risk
of becoming complacent on this very important
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 06-03-10-010A > Jun > 10 > Wheels - Changing
Procedures/Precautions > Page 1839
service operation. A simple distraction or time constraint that rushes the job may result in personal
injury if the greatest of care is not exercised. Make it a habit to double check your work and to
always side with caution when installing wheels.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 04-03-10-012B > Feb > 08 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel Brake Dust
Accumulation/Pitting
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Chrome Wheel Brake Dust Accumulation/Pitting
Bulletin No.: 04-03-10-012B
Date: February 01, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Pitting and Brake Dust on Chrome wheels
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2008 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
04-03-10-012A (Section 03 - Suspension).
Analysis of Returned Wheels
Chrome wheels returned under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty for pitting concerns have
recently been evaluated. This condition is usually most severe in the vent (or window) area of the
front wheels. This "pitting" may actually be brake dust that has been allowed to accumulate on the
wheel. The longer this accumulation builds up, the more difficult it is to remove.
Cleaning the Wheels
In all cases, the returned wheels could be cleaned to their original condition using GM Vehicle Care
Cleaner Wax, P/N 12377966 (in Canada, P/N 10952905). When using this product, you should
confine your treatment to the areas of the wheel that show evidence of the brake dust build-up.
This product is only for use on chromed steel or chromed aluminum wheels.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
Wheel replacement for this condition is NOT applicable under the terms of the New Vehicle Limited
Warranty.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1844
Wheels: Testing and Inspection
Wheel Mounting Surface Check
Replace any wheels that are bent or dented, or have excessive lateral or radial runout. Wheels with
runout greater than specified may cause objectionable vibrations.
1. Use a straight edge 200 - 229 mm (09 inch) long. Place the straight edge on the wheel inboard
mounting surface. Try to rock the straightedge up
and down within the mounting surface.
2. Repeat this procedure on at least 3-4 different positions on the inboard mounting surface.
^ The outer ring of the mounting surface normally is raised above everything inside the mounting
surface.
^ The mounting surface will be raised above the outer ring if the wheel mounting surface has been
bent on a tire changer.
^ If you can rock the straight edge, the mounting surface is bent and you must replace the wheel.
3. Inspect the mounting wheel/nut holes for damage caused from over-torquing the wheel/nuts.
Inspect for collapsed wheel/nut bosses. Inspect for
cracked wheel bosses.
Notice: The use of non-GM original equipment wheels may cause: ^
Damage to the wheel bearing, the wheel fasteners and the wheel
^ Tire damage caused by the modified clearance to the adjacent vehicle components
^ Adverse vehicle steering stability caused by the modified scrub radius
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1845
^ Damage to the vehicle caused by the modified ground clearance
^ Speedometer and odometer inaccuracy
Important: ^
Replacement wheels must be equivalent to the original equipment wheels in the following ways: The load capacity
- The wheel diameter
- The rim width
- The wheel offset
- The mounting configuration
^ A wheel of the incorrect size or type may affect the following conditions: Wheel and hub-bearing life
- Brake cooling
- Speedometer/odometer calibration
- Vehicle ground clearance
- Tire clearance to the body and the chassis
4. Replace the wheel if the wheel is bent. 5. Replace the wheel if the wheel/nut boss area is
cracked. Identify steel wheels with a 2 or 3-letter code stamped into the rim near the valve stem.
Aluminum wheels have the code, the part number, and the manufacturer identification cast into the
back side of the wheel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Aluminum Wheel Porosity Repair
Wheels: Service and Repair Aluminum Wheel Porosity Repair
Aluminum Wheel Porosity Repair
1. Remove the tire and wheel. 2. Inflate the tire to the manufactures specified pressure as stated
on the tire. 3. Submerge the tire/wheel into a water bath in order to locate the leak. 4. Inscribe a
mark on the wheel in order to indicate the leak areas. 5. Inscribe a mark on the tire at the valve
stem in order to indicate the orientation of the tire to the wheel. 6. Remove the tire from the wheel.
Important: Do not damage the exterior surface of the wheel.
7. Use number 80 grit sandpaper to scuff the inside of the rim surface at the leak area. 8. Use
general purpose cleaner such as EMS, P/N 08984 or equivalent, to clean the leak area. 9. Apply 3
mm (0.12 inch) thick layer of adhesive/sealant, GM P/N 12378478 (Canadian P/N 88900041) or
equivalent, to the leak area.
10. Allow for the adhesive/sealant to dry. 11. Align the inscribed mark on the tire with the valve
stem on the wheel. 12. Install the tire to the wheel. 13. Inflate the tire to the manufactures specified
pressure as stated on the tire. 14. Submerge the tire/wheel into a water bath in order ensure the
leak is sealed. 15. Balance the tire and wheel. 16. Install the tire and wheel. 17. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Aluminum Wheel Porosity Repair > Page 1848
Wheels: Service and Repair Aluminum Wheel Refinishing
Aluminum Wheel Refinishing
Finish Damage Evaluation Procedure
Important: ^
If the wheels are chrome-plated, do not re-plate or refinish the wheels.
^ If the wheels are polished aluminum, do not refinish the wheels in the dealer environment. Utilize
a refinisher that meets manufacturer guidelines.
1. Inspect the wheels for damage from uncoated wheel balance weights or from automatic car
wash facilities. 2. Inspect the wheels for the following conditions:
^ Corrosion
^ Scrape
^ Gouges
3. Verify the damage is not deeper than what sanding can remove. 4. Inspect the wheels for
cracks. If a wheel has cracks, discard the wheel. 5. Inspect the wheels for bent rim flanges. If a rim
flange is bent, discard the wheel.
Refinishing Procedure
Caution: To avoid serious personal injury when applying any two part component paint system,
follow the specific precautions provided by the paint manufacturer. Failure to follow these
precautions may cause lung irritation and allergic respiratory reaction.
1. Remove the tire and wheel assembly from the vehicle. 2. Remove the balance weights from the
wheel. 3. Remove the tire from the wheel. 4. Use a suitable cleaner in order to remove the
following contaminants from the wheel:
^ Lubricants
^ Wax
^ Dirt
Important: ^
Do not re-machine the wheel.
^ Do not use chemicals in order to strip the paint from the wheel.
5. Use plastic media blasting in order to remove the paint from the wheel. 6. If the wheel had a
machined aluminum finish, spin the wheel and use sand paper in order to restore the circular
machined appearance.
Important: The wheel mounting surface and the wheel nut contact surface must remain free of
paint.
7. Mask the wheel mounting surface and the wheel nut contact surface. 8. Follow the paint
manufacturer's instructions for painting the wheel. 9. Unmask the wheel.
10. Install a new valve stem.
Important: Use new coated balance weights in order to balance the wheel.
11. Install the tire to the wheel. 12. Use a suitable cleaner in order to remove the following
contaminants from the wheel mounting surface:
^ Corrosion
^ Overspray
^ Dirt
13. Install the tire and wheel assembly to the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Specifications
Wheel Bearing: Specifications
"Information not supplied by the manufacturer"
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed
Wheel Bearing: Testing and Inspection Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed
Wheel Bearings Diagnosis (Sealed)
- Tools Required J 8001 Dial Indicator
The following procedure describes how to inspect the wheel bearing/hub for excessive looseness.
If you are inspecting the wheel bearing/hub for excessive runout, refer to Tire and Wheel Assembly
Runout Measurement - On-Vehicle.
Important: If you are inspecting the FRONT wheel bearing/hub, support the front of the vehicle by
the lower control arms in order to load the lower ball joint.
1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Mount and secure the J 8001 to a
stand. 3. Ensure that the J 8001 contacts the vertical surface of the wheel as close as possible to
the top wheel stud. 4. Push and pull on the TOP of the tire. 5. Inspect the total movement indicated
by the J 8001. 6. If the measurement exceeds 0.127 mm (0.005 inch), replace the wheel
bearing/hub.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed > Page 1854
Wheel Bearing: Testing and Inspection Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Tapered
Wheel Bearings Diagnosis (Tapered)
Tapered Roller Bearing Diagnosis
The following procedure describes how to inspect the wheel bearing for excessive looseness. If
excessive wheel bearing looseness is present, adjust the wheel bearings. If excessive looseness is
still present after adjustment, inspect the wheel bearings. Consider the following factors when
diagnosing the wheel bearing condition: General condition of the following parts during disassembly and inspection: Wheel bearings
- Races
- Seals
- Lubricant
- Steering Knuckle
- Classify the failure of the wheel bearing with the aid of the illustrations.
- Determine the cause of the wheel bearing failure.
- Replace the damaged parts.
Abrasive Roller Wear
The pattern on the races and the rollers is caused by fine abrasives. 1. Clean all of the parts and
the housings. 2. Check the seals and the bearings. 3. Replace leaky seals, rough, or noisy
bearings.
Abrasive Step Wear
The pattern on the roller ends is caused by fine abrasives. 1. Clean all of the parts and the
housings. 2. Check the seals and the bearings. 3. Replace leaky seals, rough, or noisy bearings.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed > Page 1855
Galling
The metal smears on the roller ends are due to overheating, lubricant failure, or lubricant overload.
1. Check the seals. 2. Check for proper lubrication. 3. Clean all of the parts and the housings. 4.
Replace the bearing.
Etching
The bearing surfaces appear gray or grayish black in color, with related etching away of material
usually at roller spacing. 1. Check the seals. 2. Check for proper lubrication. 3. Clean all of the
parts and the housings. 4. Replace the bearings.
Bent Cage
When a cage is damaged due to improper handling or improper tool usage. Replace the bearing.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed > Page 1856
Bent Cage
The cage may be damaged due to improper handling or improper tool usage. Replace the bearing.
Cage Wear
The wear around the outside diameter of the cage and the roller pockets is caused by abrasive
material or inefficient lubrication. 1. Check the seals. 2. Clean all the parts and the housings. 3.
Replace the bearings.
Indentations
The surface depressions on the race and the rollers are caused by hard particles of foreign matter.
1. Check the seals. 2. Clean all the parts and the housings. 3. Replace the bearings.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed > Page 1857
Frettage
The corrosion caused by small relative movement of parts with no lubrication. 1. Check the seals.
2. Check for proper lubrication. 3. Clean all the parts and the housings. 4. Replace the bearings.
Smears
The smearing of the metal is due to slippage. Slippage can be caused by the following factors: Poor fits
- Lubrication
- Overheating
- Overloads
- Handling damage
If this condition occurs, perform the following: 1. Check the seals. 2. Check for proper fit. 3. Check
for proper lubrication. 4. Clean all the parts and the housings. 5. Replace the bearings.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed > Page 1858
Stain Discoloration
The discoloration on the bearings is caused by incorrect lubrication or moisture and ranges in color
from light brown to black. Reuse the bearing if you can remove the stains with light polishing and
there is no evidence of overheating. If this condition occurs, perform the following: 1. Check the
seals. 2. Clean all the parts and the housings. 3. Replace the bearings, if necessary.
Heat Discoloration
The heat discoloration on the bearings ranges from faint yellow to dark blue and results from
overload or an incorrect lubricant. Excessive heat causes softening of the races or the rollers. In
order to check for loss of temper on the races and the rollers, perform a file test. A file drawn over a
tempered part will grab and cut the metal and fail the file test. A file drawn over a hard part will glide
with no metal cutting. If overheating damage is indicated, perform the following: 1. Check the seals.
2. Clean all the parts and the housings. 3. Replace the bearings.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed > Page 1859
Misalignment
The outer race is misaligned due to a foreign object. 1. Clean all the parts and the housings. 2.
Ensure the races are properly seated. 3. Replace the bearing.
Cracked Inner Race
The race is cracked due to improper fit, cocking, or poor bearing seats. 1. Clean all the parts and
the housings. 2. Ensure the races are properly seated. 3. Replace the bearing.
Fatigue Spalling
The surface is flaked with metal due to bearing fatigue. 1. Clean all the parts and the housings. 2.
Replace the bearing.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed > Page 1860
Brinelling
The surface indentations in the race way are caused by the rollers under impact loading or from
vibration while the bearing is not rotating. 1. Clean all the parts and the housings. 2. Replace the
bearing.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 1861
Wheel Bearing: Adjustments
Front Wheel Bearing Adjustment
Important: ^
Adjust the front wheel bearings correctly in order to ensure the front suspension functions properly.
^ The bearings must be a slip fit on the spindle.
^ Lubricate the bearings in order to ensure the bearings will creep.
^ The spindle nut must have a free-running fit on the spindle threads.
1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle with safety stands. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the
wheel cover. 3. Remove the dust cap from the wheel hub.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Remove the cotter pin.
^ Tighten the wheel hub nut to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.), while turning the wheel forward by hand. This will
seat the bearings.
Important: Do not back the nut off more than 1/2 flat.
5. Adjust the nut to a finger tight position by hand. Then, back the nut off until the hole in the
spindle aligns with a slot in the nut. 6. Install a new cotter pin.
6.1. Make sure the cotter pin ends do not interfere with the cap. Bend the ends of the cotter pin
against the nut. Cut off any extra pin length.
6.2. Measure the endplay. Proper endplay is 0.0 - 0.13 mm (0.001 - 0.005 inch).
7. Install the dust cap to the wheel hub. 8. Install the wheel cover. 9. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 1862
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair
"For information regarding this component please refer to wheel hub service and repair"
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
wheel hub nut 12 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Fastener: > 01-03-10-009A > Jul > 04 > Wheels - Plastic Wheel Nut Covers
Loose/Missing
Wheel Fastener: Customer Interest Wheels - Plastic Wheel Nut Covers Loose/Missing
Bulletin No.: 01-03-10-009A
Date: July 27, 2004
TECHNICAL
Subject: Plastic Wheel Nut Covers Missing and/or Loose (Replace Missing Covers and Add
Sealant to All Covers)
Models: 2005 and All Prior Passenger Cars (Except All Cadillac Models and Pontiac GTO)
with Plastic Wheel Nut Covers
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add additional models years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 01-03-10-009.
Condition
Some customers may comment that the plastic wheel nut covers are missing and/or loose.
Correction
Important:
^ DO NOT USE a silicone-based adhesive.
^ Do not apply the *permatex(R) around the threads in a circular pattern.
^ Apply a single bead across the threads approximately 10 mm (0.4 in) in length, 5 mm (0.2 in) in
height and 5 mm (0.2 in) in width.
Replace any missing plastic wheel nut covers with the appropriate covers and apply Permatex(R) #
2 Form A Gasket Sealant(R) to the threads of all the plastic wheel nut covers. Tighten finger tight
plus a 1/4 turn with a hand wrench.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such material.
General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any responsibility for the
products from this firm or for any other such items which may be available from other sources.
Permatex(R) # 2 Form A Gasket Sealant(R) part numbers (available at your local parts supplier)
^ P/N 80009 (2A/2AR) - 44 ml (1.5 oz) tube boxed
^ P/N 80015 (2AR) - 44 ml (1.5 oz) tube carded
^ P/N 80010 (2B/2BR) - 89 ml (3 oz) tube boxed
^ P/N 80016 (2BR) - 89 ml (3 oz) tube carded
^ P/N 80011 (2C) - 325 ml (11 oz) tube boxed
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Fastener: > 01-03-10-009A > Jul > 04 > Wheels - Plastic Wheel Nut Covers
Loose/Missing > Page 1875
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Fastener: > 01-03-10-009A > Jul > 04 > Wheels - Plastic Wheel
Nut Covers Loose/Missing
Wheel Fastener: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Plastic Wheel Nut Covers Loose/Missing
Bulletin No.: 01-03-10-009A
Date: July 27, 2004
TECHNICAL
Subject: Plastic Wheel Nut Covers Missing and/or Loose (Replace Missing Covers and Add
Sealant to All Covers)
Models: 2005 and All Prior Passenger Cars (Except All Cadillac Models and Pontiac GTO)
with Plastic Wheel Nut Covers
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add additional models years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 01-03-10-009.
Condition
Some customers may comment that the plastic wheel nut covers are missing and/or loose.
Correction
Important:
^ DO NOT USE a silicone-based adhesive.
^ Do not apply the *permatex(R) around the threads in a circular pattern.
^ Apply a single bead across the threads approximately 10 mm (0.4 in) in length, 5 mm (0.2 in) in
height and 5 mm (0.2 in) in width.
Replace any missing plastic wheel nut covers with the appropriate covers and apply Permatex(R) #
2 Form A Gasket Sealant(R) to the threads of all the plastic wheel nut covers. Tighten finger tight
plus a 1/4 turn with a hand wrench.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such material.
General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any responsibility for the
products from this firm or for any other such items which may be available from other sources.
Permatex(R) # 2 Form A Gasket Sealant(R) part numbers (available at your local parts supplier)
^ P/N 80009 (2A/2AR) - 44 ml (1.5 oz) tube boxed
^ P/N 80015 (2AR) - 44 ml (1.5 oz) tube carded
^ P/N 80010 (2B/2BR) - 89 ml (3 oz) tube boxed
^ P/N 80016 (2BR) - 89 ml (3 oz) tube carded
^ P/N 80011 (2C) - 325 ml (11 oz) tube boxed
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Fastener: > 01-03-10-009A > Jul > 04 > Wheels - Plastic Wheel
Nut Covers Loose/Missing > Page 1881
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 1882
Wheel Fastener: Specifications
Wheel nuts 100 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front
Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair Front
Wheel Stud Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the rotor. 2. Remove the wheel stud.
^ Press the stud out using an arbor press.
^ Do not damage the wheel mounting surface on the wheel hub flange.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the stud into the hole in the wheel hub.
1.1. Start the serrated stud into the hole in the wheel hub by tapping lightly with a hammer.
1.2. The stud must be square with the wheel hub before pressing on the arbor press.
2. Install the rotor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front > Page 1885
Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair Rear
Wheel Stud Replacement (Rear Drum Brakes)
^ Tools Required J 43631 Ball Joint Separator
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the tire and the wheel. 3. Remove the
brake drum.
4. Remove the wheel stud from the axle flange using J 43631.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front > Page 1886
1. Start the new stud into the axle flange hole by pressing firmly with your hand. 2. Install a washer
and thread the lug nut on the wheel stud with the flat side of the lug nut to the vehicle. 3. Tighten
the lug nut in order to draw the wheel stud into the rear of the flange. 4. Remove the lug nut and
washers from the wheel stud.
5. Install the brake drum. 6. Install the tire and the wheel. 7. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Page 1887
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Jump Starting > System Information > Service Precautions
Jump Starting: Service Precautions
CAUTION: Batteries produce explosive gases. Batteries contain corrosive acid. Batteries supply
levels of electrical current high enough to cause burns. Therefore, in order to reduce the risk of
personal injury while working near a battery, observe the following guidelines:
^ Always shield your eyes.
^ Avoid leaning over the battery whenever possible.
^ Do not expose the battery to open flames or sparks.
^ Do not allow battery acid to contact the eyes or the skin. Flush any contacted areas with water immediately and thoroughly.
- Get medical help.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Jump Starting > System Information > Service Precautions > Page 1891
Jump Starting: Service and Repair
JUMP STARTING IN CASE OF EMERGENCY
CAUTION: Batteries produce explosive gases. Batteries contain corrosive acid. Batteries supply
levels of electrical current high enough to cause burns. Therefore, in order to reduce the risk of
personal injury while working near a battery, observe the following guidelines:
^ Always shield your eyes.
^ Avoid leaning over the battery whenever possible.
^ Do not expose the battery to open flames or sparks.
^ Do not allow battery acid to contact the eyes or the skin. Flush any contacted areas with water immediately and thoroughly.
- Get medical help.
NOTE: This vehicle has a 12 volt, negative ground electrical system. Make sure the vehicle or
equipment being used to jump start the engine is also 12 volt, negative ground. Use of any other
type of system will damage the vehicle's electrical components.
This vehicle has a 12 volt positive, negative ground electrical system. Do not try to jump start a
vehicle if you are unsure of the other vehicle's positive voltage or ground position. The booster
battery and the discharged battery should be treated carefully when using jumper cables.
1. Position the vehicle with the booster battery so that the jumper cables will comfortably reach the
battery of the other vehicle.
^ Do not let the 2 vehicles touch.
^ Make sure that the jumper cables do not have loose clamps or missing insulation.
2. Perform the following steps on both vehicles:
2.1. Place the automatic transmission in PARK.
2.2. Block the wheels.
2.3. Set the parking brake.
2.4. Turn off all electrical loads that are not needed. Leave the hazard flashers ON.
2.5. Turn OFF the ignition switch.
IMPORTANT: Some vehicles have a battery remote positive stud. ALWAYS use the battery remote
positive stud in order to give or to receive a jump start.
3. Attach the end of one jumper cable to the positive terminal of the discharged battery. 4. Attach
the other end of the first cable to the positive terminal of the booster battery. 5. Attach one end of
the remaining jumper cable to the negative terminal of the booster battery.
NOTE: Do not connect the negative charger lead to the housings of other vehicle electrical
accessories or equipment. The action of the battery charger may damage such equipment.
6. Make the final connection of the negative jumper cable to the block or suitable bracket
connected directly to the block, away from the battery. 7. Start the engine of the vehicle that is
providing the jump start and turn off all electrical accessories. Raise the engine RPM to
approximately 1,500
RPM.
8. Crank the engine of the vehicle with the weak battery.
If the engine does not crank or cranks too slowly, perform the following steps: 8.1.
Turn the ignition OFF.
8.2. Allow the booster vehicle engine to run at approximately 1,500 RPM for 5 minutes.
8.3. Attempt to start the engine of the vehicle with the discharged battery.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Jump Starting > System Information > Service Precautions > Page 1892
9. Reverse the steps exactly when removing the jumper cables. The negative battery cable must
first be disconnected from the engine that was jump
started.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Service Precautions
Vehicle Lifting: Service Precautions
CAUTION:
To avoid any vehicle damage, serious personal injury or death when major components are
removed from the vehicle and the vehicle is supported by a hoist, support the vehicle with jack
stands at the opposite end from which the components are being removed.
To avoid any vehicle damage, serious personal injury or death, always use the jackstands to
support the vehicle when lifting the vehicle with a jack.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Service Precautions > Page
1896
Vehicle Lifting: Service and Repair
Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle
Caution: To avoid any vehicle damage, serious personal injury or death when major components
are removed from the vehicle and the vehicle is supported by a hoist, support the vehicle with jack
stands at the opposite end from which the components are being removed.
Caution: To avoid any vehicle damage, serious personal injury or death, always use the jackstands
to support the vehicle when lifting the vehicle with a jack.
Notice: Perform the following steps before beginning any vehicle lifting or jacking procedure:
* Remove or secure all of the vehicle's contents in order to avoid any shifting or any movement that
may occur during the vehicle lifting or jacking procedure.
* The lifting equipment or the jacking equipment weight rating must meet or exceed the weight of
the vehicle and any vehicle contents.
* The lifting equipment or the jacking equipment must meet the operational standards of the lifting
equipment or jacking equipment's manufacturer.
* Perform the vehicle lifting or jacking procedure on a clean, hard, dry, level surface.
* Perform the vehicle lifting or jacking procedure only at the identified lift points. DO NOT allow the
lifting equipment or jacking equipment to contact any other vehicle components.
Failure to perform the previous steps could result in damage to the lifting equipment or the jacking
equipment, the vehicle, and/or the vehicle's contents.
Use only the prescribed lift points when elevating the vehicle.
Vehicle Lifting Points
1 - Lower Control Arm; Inboard of the Lower Ball Joint 1 - Lower Control Arm; Inboard of the Lower
Ball Joint 2 - Frame; at Second Crossmember 2 - Frame; at Second Crossmember 3 - Rear Spring;
at Forward Spring Hanger 3 - Rear Spring; at Forward Spring Hanger 4 - Axle; Inboard of Shock
Absorber Hanger 4 - Axle; Inboard of Shock Absorber Hanger 5 - Differential; at Center 6 - Front
Suspension Crossmember; Center 1 - Lower Control Arm; Inboard of the Lower Ball Joint 1 - Lower
Control Arm; Inboard of the Lower Ball Joint 2 - Frame; at Second Crossmember 2 - Frame; at
Second Crossmember
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Service Precautions > Page
1897
3 - Rear Spring; at Forward Spring Hanger 3 - Rear Spring; at Forward Spring Hanger 4 - Axle;
Inboard of Shock Absorber Hanger 4 - Axle; Inboard of Shock Absorber Hanger 5 - Differential; at
Center 6 - Front Suspension Crossmember; Center
The jack and hoist lift points for the front of the vehicle are located between the front body mounts
and the transmission crossmember. The jack and hoist lift points for the rear of the vehicle are
located at the front hangers for the rear springs.
The front end lift points for the floor jack are at the following locations:
* Beneath the lower control arms, inboard from the shock absorber mounts
* Beneath the center of the front crossmember
The rear end lift points for the floor jack are at the following locations:
* Beneath the axle housing, inboard from the shock absorber mounts
* Beneath the axle differential
Whenever the vehicle is lifted using a jack or a floor jack, observe the following precautions:
* Chock the wheels at the end of the vehicle opposite the end being lifted
* Use jack stands for support. Place jack stands at the any of the following locations:
- Beneath the frame
- Beneath the front suspension crossmember
- Beneath the axle
When removing major components from the vehicle while the vehicle is on a hoist, chain the
vehicle frame to the hoist pads in order to prevent tip-off.
Jacking and Lifting Notice: When jacking or lifting a vehicle, do not allow the lift pads to contact any
of the following parts:
* The catalytic converter
* The brake lines
* The brake cables
* The fuel lines
* The accelerator cables
* The transmission shift cables
Lift pad contact may damage the parts. Lift pad contact may cause unsatisfactory vehicle
performance.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Access Cover, Engine > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures
Access Cover: Procedures
Engine Cover
ENGINE COVER
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the instrument panel extension. Refer to "Instrument Panel Extension". 2. Remove the
floor air outlet duct. Refer to "Air Outlet - Center Floor".
3. Remove the bolts from the brackets:
^ Loosen the bolt.
^ Rotate the bracket out of the way.
4. Remove the latches.
5. Remove the screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Access Cover, Engine > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1904
6. Remove the engine cover.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the engine cover. 2. Install the screws to the engine cover. Do not fully tighten the screws.
3. Install the latch screws.
Tighten Tighten the latch screws to 4 Nm (35 lb in).
4. Install the engine cover bolts to the brackets.
Tighten Tighten the engine cove bolt to 25 Nm (18 lb ft).
5. Insert the floor air outlet duct. 6. Insert the instrument panel extension.
Instrument Panel (IP) Extension
INSTRUMENT PANEL (I/P) EXTENSION REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the caps that cover the extension screws. 2. Remove the screws from the extension. 3.
Remove the nuts at the bottom of the extension.
4. Pull toward the rear of the vehicle in order to remove the extension from the instrument panel. 5.
Disconnect the electrical connectors.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Connect the electrical connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Access Cover, Engine > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1905
2. Install the extension to the instrument panel:
2.1. Align the retainers.
2.2. Press the extension into place until the retainers are seated.
3. Install the nuts that retain the extension to the floor.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Tighten Tighten the nuts that retain the extension to the floor to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
4. Install the retaining screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
5. Install the extension screw covers.
Air Outlet - Center Floor
AIR OUTLET REPLACEMENT - CENTER FLOOR
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the IP extension. Refer to "Instrument Panel (I/P) Extension". 2. Remove the floor air
outlet duct from the air distributor. 3. Remove the bucket seats. Refer to "Seat Replacement Bucket". 4. Remove the front section of the carpet, if equipped. Refer to "MAT/Carpet
Replacement".
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Access Cover, Engine > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1906
5. Remove the retaining nuts from the floor outlet duct, if equipped. 6. Remove the floor air outlet
from the ducts to the rear seat, if equipped.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the floor air outlet to the ducts to the rear seat, if equipped.
2. Install the retaining nuts to the floor outlet duct, if equipped.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Access Cover, Engine > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1907
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Tighten Tighten the nuts to 2 Nm (18 lb in).
3. Install the front section of the carpet, if equipped. 4. Install the bucket seats. 5. Install the floor air
outlet duct from the air distributor. 6. Install the IP extension.
Engine Cover Guide Assembly
ENGINE COVER GUIDE ASSEMBLY
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the engine cover. Refer to Engine Cover Replacement. 2. Remove the bolts that retain
the engine cover guide assembly to the vehicle. 3. Remove the engine cover guide assembly from
the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the engine cover guide assembly. 2. Install the bolts that retain the engine cover guide
assembly to the vehicle.
Tighten Tighten the bolts that retain the engine cover guide to 8.5 Nm (75 lb in).
3. Install the engine cover.
MAT/Carpet Replacement
MAT/CARPET REPLACEMENT - FRONT FLOOR
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the seats and the risers. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket. 2. Remove the engine
cover, if required. Refer to Engine Cover Replacement. 3. Remove the trim plates from the front
door openings. Refer to Carpet Retainer Replacement. 4. Remove the cowl side panel trim. Refer
to Trim Panel Replacement - Cowl Side.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Access Cover, Engine > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1908
5. Remove the throttle pedal guard. 6. Remove the screws from the center floor air duct. 7.
Remove the center floor air duct. 8. Remove the front side door lock pillar garnish molding, if
required. Refer to Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar. 9. Remove the carpet/mat from
the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
CAUTION: In order to avoid personal injury or vehicle damage when you repair or replace the
carpet, use the same thickness and material size as the original installation. Always return the
carpet to the original location.
1. Install the carpet/mat to the vehicle. 2. Install the center floor air duct.
NOTICE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the screws to the center floor air duct.
TIGHTEN
Screws to 2 Nm (18 lb. in.).
4. Install the front side door lock pillar garnish molding, if required. Refer to Garnish Molding
Replacement - LF Lock Pillar. 5. Install the trim plates to the front door openings. Refer to Carpet
Retainer Replacement. 6. Install the cowl side panel trim. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Cowl
Side. 7. Install the engine cover, if required. Refer to Engine Cover Replacement. 8. Install the
seats and the risers. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket in Seats.
Seat Replacement - Bucket
SEAT REPLACEMENT - BUCKET
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the seat belt from the side of the seat belt guide.
2. Remove the nuts that retain the seat to the floor. 3. Disconnect the electrical connector from the
power seat if equipped. 4. Remove the seat and the riser from the vehicle. 5. Remove the seat belt
guide from the seat riser.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Access Cover, Engine > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1909
6. Remove the bolts that retain the seat to the riser. 7. Remove the power seat from the seat risers
if equipped. 8. Remove the manual seat adjuster wire from the seat tracks. 9. Remove the seat
riser spacer nuts and bolts from the seat tracks.
10. Remove the seat riser spacer from the seat risers.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the seat riser spacer to the seat risers. 2. Install the seat riser spacer nuts and bolts to the
seat tracks.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Tighten Tighten the seat riser spacer nuts and bolts to the seat tracks to 30 Nm (22 lb ft).
3. Install the manual seat adjuster wire to the seat tracks. 4. Install the power seat to the seat risers
if equipped. 5. Install the seat belt guide to the seat riser.
6. Install the nuts that retain the seat to the risers.
Tighten Tighten the nuts that retain the seat to the riser to 43 Nm (32 lb ft).
7. Install the seat and the seat riser in the vehicle. 8. Connect the electrical connector to the power
seat if equipped.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Access Cover, Engine > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1910
9. Install the nuts that retain the seat to the floor.
Tighten Tighten the nuts that retain the seat to the floor to 43 Nm (32 lb ft).
10. Install the seat belt to the side of the seat belt guide.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Access Cover, Engine > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1911
Access Cover: Removal and Replacement
Engine Cover Replacement
Engine Cover Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the instrument panel extension. Refer to IP Extension Replacement (See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard /
Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/IP Extension Replacement) in Instrument Panel, Gages and
Console.
2. Remove the floor air outlet duct. Refer to Air Outlet Replacement - Center Floor in Heating,
Ventilation and Air Conditioning. 3. Remove the bolts from the brackets:
1. Loosen the bolt. 2. Rotate the bracket out of the way.
4. Remove the latches.
5. Remove the screws.
6. Remove the engine cover.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Access Cover, Engine > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1912
1. Install the engine cover.
2. Install the screws to the engine cover.
Do not fully tighten the screws.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the latch screws.
Tighten the latch screws to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
4. Install the engine cover bolts to the brackets.
Tighten the engine cover bolt to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
5. Insert the floor air outlet duct. Refer to IP Extension Replacement (See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument
Panel/Service and Repair/IP Extension Replacement) in Instrument Panel, Gages and Console.
6. Insert the instrument panel extension. Refer to Air Outlet Replacement - Center Floor in Heating,
Ventilation and Air Conditioning.
Engine Cover Guide Replacement
Engine Cover Guide Replacement
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Access Cover, Engine > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1913
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the engine cover. Refer to Engine Cover Replacement (See: Engine Cover
Replacement) .
2. Remove the bolts that retain the engine cover guide assembly to the vehicle. 3. Remove the
engine cover guide assembly.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the engine cover guide assembly.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the bolts that retain the engine cover guide assembly to the vehicle.
Tighten the bolts that retain the engine cover guide to 8.5 N.m (75 lb in).
3. Install the engine cover. Refer to Engine Cover Replacement (See: Engine Cover Replacement)
.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Compression Check > System Information >
System Diagnosis
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
Normal
The compression builds up quickly and evenly to the specified compression.
Leaking
The compression is low on the first compression stroke. The compression builds up with the
following strokes, but does not reach the specified compression.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft
Gear/Sprocket > Component Information > Specifications
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Specifications
Camshaft Sprocket Bolt
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 18 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft
Gear/Sprocket > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1921
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Service and Repair
Timing Chain and Sprockets Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the engine front cover.
2. Remove the crankshaft position sensor reluctor ring.
Notice: In order to rotate the engine install a bolt with the same threads as the crankshaft, but do
not use the crankshaft balancer bolt or a bolt longer than 1 inch, in the crankshaft. Failing to do so
will cause damage to the bolt threads and the crankshaft threaded hole when removing the bolt.
3. Install a 7/16-20 x 1 inch bolt into the end of the crankshaft.
Notice: Align the timing marks before removing the timing chain. If it is necessary to turn either the
camshaft or the crankshaft with the timing chain removed, loosen or remove the valve rocker arms.
Turning either the crankshaft or camshaft with the timing chain removed may cause the pistons to
contact the valves, resulting in damage.
4. Rotate the crankshaft until:
4.1. The timing marks on both sprockets line up.
4.2. The number four cylinder is at Top Dead Center (TDC) of the compression stroke.
5. Remove the timing chain and sprockets. 6. Clean and inspect the timing chain and sprockets.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the timing chain and the sprockets. 2. Remove the bolt from the crankshaft.
Notice: Do not reuse the engine front cover. Oil leaks may result.
3. Install the engine front cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Specifications
Camshaft: Specifications
Camshaft
End Play
........................................................................................................................................................
0.0254 - 0.2286 mm (0.0010 - 0.0090 inch) Journal Diameter
........................................................................................................................................... 47.440 47.490 mm (1.8677 - 1.8696 inch) Journal Diameter Out-of-Round
.......................................................................................................... 0.025 mm - Maximum (0.0010
inch - Maximum) Lobe Lift - Exhaust
................................................................................................................................................... 7.20 7.30 mm (0.283 - 0.287 inch) Lobe Lift - Intake
...................................................................................................................................................... 6.97
- 7.07 mm (0.274 - 0.278 inch) Runout ................................................................................................
......................................................................................... 0.065 mm (0.0026 inch) Retainer Bolt
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 106 inch lbs.
Sprocket Bolt
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 18 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1925
Camshaft: Service and Repair
Camshaft Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Remove the air cleaner assembly. 3. Remove the radiator. 4.
Remove the A/C condenser. 5. Remove the radiator grille. 6. Remove the valve lifters. 7. Remove
the timing chain and the camshaft sprocket.
8. Remove the balance shaft drive gear. 9. Remove the camshaft.
10. Clean and inspect the camshaft and the bearings.
Installation Procedure
Important: Whenever a new camshaft is installed, do the following procedures: Change the engine oil.
- Change the engine oil filter.
- Add GM Engine Oil Supplement GM P/N 1052367 or the equivalent to the engine oil.
1. Install the camshaft into the engine block. 2. Install the balance shaft drive gear. 3. Install the
timing chain and camshaft sprocket. 4. Install the valve lifters. 5. Install the A/C condenser. 6.
Install the radiator grille. 7. Install the radiator. 8. Fill the engine cooling system. 9. Recharge the air
conditioning system.
10. Install the air cleaner assembly. 11. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Specifications
Lifter / Lash Adjuster: Specifications
Valve Lifter
Valve Lifter ...........................................................................................................................................
......................................... Hydraulic Roller Type Valve Lift
Exhaust ................................................................................................................................................
................................ 10.879 mm (0.4280 inch)
Valve Lift
Intake ...................................................................................................................................................
................................ 10.527 mm (0.4140 inch)
Pushrod Guide Bolt
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 12 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1929
Lifter / Lash Adjuster: Service and Repair
Valve Lifter Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the lower intake manifold. 2. Remove the valve rocker arms and the valve push rods. 3.
Remove the valve lifters. 4. Use a cleaning solvent and a shop towel to clean any varnish from the
valve lifter bores. 5. Inspect the valve lifter bores for excessive wear or scoring. Replace the engine
block if there is excessive wear or deep scoring. 6. Inspect the camshaft for wear or damage. If the
wear is questionable remove the camshaft and inspect. 7. Clean and inspect the valve lifters and
the valve pushrod guide.
Installation Procedure
Important: It is normal for NEW lifters to make a slight ticking noise when the engine is first started.
Increasing the engine RPMs slightly to raise oil pressure should stop the noise.
1. Install the valve lifters. 2. Install the valve rocker arms and push rods. 3. Install the lower intake
manifold.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Push Rod >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Push Rod: Service and Repair
Valve Rocker Arm and Push Rod Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the valve rocker arm cover. 2. Remove the valve rocker arm and the valve pushrod. 3.
Clean and inspect the valve rocker arm and the valve pushrod.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the valve rocker arm and the valve pushrod. 2. Install the valve rocker arm cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Specifications
Rocker Arm Assembly: Specifications
Rocker Arm
Rocker Arm ..........................................................................................................................................
................................................. Roller Pivot Type Rocker Arm Ratio ..................................................
.................................................................................................................................................... 1.5:1
Rocker Arm Bolt
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 22 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1936
Rocker Arm Assembly: Service and Repair
Valve Rocker Arm and Push Rod Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the valve rocker arm cover. 2. Remove the valve rocker arm and the valve pushrod. 3.
Clean and inspect the valve rocker arm and the valve pushrod.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the valve rocker arm and the valve pushrod. 2. Install the valve rocker arm cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Balance Shaft >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - Balance Shaft Rattling Noises (Cancellation)
Balance Shaft: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Balance Shaft Rattling Noises (Cancellation)
Bulletin No.: 00-06-01-023C
Date: August 30, 2006
TECHNICAL
Subject: Engine/Balance Shaft "Rattle" Noise
Models: 1992-2003 Chevrolet and GMC C/K, S/T, M/L, G and P Models 1992-2001 Oldsmobile
Bravada
with 4.3 L V6 Engine (VINs W, X - RPOs L35, LF6, LU3)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to cancel this bulletin. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
00-06-01-023B (Section 06 -- Engine/Propulsion System).
Technicians should refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 03-06-01-024C for information on
engine/balance shaft "rattle" noise concerns.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Balance Shaft >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1942
Balance Shaft: Specifications
Balance Shaft Driven Gear Bolt
Torque:
First Pass .............................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 15 ft. lbs. Final Pass .................................................................
................................................................................................................................... 35 degrees
Balance Shaft Retainer Bolt ................................................................................................................
............................................................ 106 inch lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Balance Shaft >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1943
Balance Shaft: Service and Repair
Balance Shaft Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the radiator. 2. Remove the A/C condenser, if equipped. 3. Remove the valve lifter
pushrod guide. 4. Remove the camshaft timing chain and sprockets.
Important: The balance shaft and the front bearing are serviced only as a package. Do not remove
the bearing from the balance shaft.
5. Remove the balance shaft. 6. Clean and inspect the balance shaft.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the balance shaft. 2. Install the camshaft timing chain and the camshaft sprocket. 3. Install
the crankshaft position reluctor ring and the engine front cover. 4. Install the valve lifter pushrod
guide. 5. Install the A/C condenser, if equipped. 6. Install the radiator.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Balance Shaft Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications
Balance Shaft Bearing: Specifications
Balance Shaft Bearing
Rear Bearing Journal Clearance
.......................................................................................................................... 0.050 - 0.088 mm
(0.0020-0.0035 inch) Rear Bearing Journal Diameter
....................................................................................................................... 38.085 - 38.100 mm
(1.4994 - 1.500 inch)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Balance Shaft Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 1947
Balance Shaft Bearing: Service and Repair
Balance Shaft Bearing and/or Bushing Replacement
Removal Procedure
Important: The balance shaft and the front bearing are serviced only as a package. Do not remove
the bearing from the balance shaft.
1. Remove the balance shaft. 2. Remove the balance shaft rear bearing.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the balance shaft rear bearing. 2. Install the balance shaft.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod
Bearing > Component Information > Specifications
Connecting Rod Bearing: Specifications
Connecting Rod Bearing
Clearance
Production
.....................................................................................................................................................
0.038 - 0.078 mm (0.0015-0.0031 inch) Service
.........................................................................................................................................................
0.025 - 0.063 mm (0.0010 - 0.0025 inch)
Journal Diameter
.......................................................................................................................................... 57.116 57.148 mm (2.2487 - 2.2497 inch) Journal Out-of-Round
Production ......................................................................................................................................
0.007 mm - Maximum (0.0002 inch - Maximum) Service
............................................................................................................................................ 0.025 mm
- Maximum (0.0010 inch - Maximum)
Journal Taper
Production ................................................................................................................................
0.00508 mm - Maximum (0.00030 inch - Maximum) Service
............................................................................................................................................ 0.025 mm
- Maximum (0.0010 inch - Maximum)
Side Clearance
...........................................................................................................................................................
0.15 - 0.44 mm (0.006 - 0.017 inch)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod,
Engine > Component Information > Specifications
Connecting Rod: Specifications
Connecting Rod
Bearing Clearance
Production
.....................................................................................................................................................
0.038 - 0.078 mm (0.0015-0.0031 inch) Service
.........................................................................................................................................................
0.025 - 0.063 mm (0.0010 - 0.0025 inch)
Journal Diameter
.......................................................................................................................................... 57.116 57.148 mm (2.2487 - 2.2497 inch) Journal Out-of-Round
Production ......................................................................................................................................
0.007 mm - Maximum (0.0002 inch - Maximum) Service
............................................................................................................................................ 0.025 mm
- Maximum (0.0010 inch - Maximum)
Journal Taper
Production ................................................................................................................................
0.00508 mm - Maximum (0.00030 inch - Maximum) Service
............................................................................................................................................ 0.025 mm
- Maximum (0.0010 inch - Maximum)
Connecting Rod Side Clearance
................................................................................................................................ 0.15 - 0.44 mm
(0.006 - 0.017 inch)
Connecting Rod Nut
Torque:
First Pass .............................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 20 ft. lbs. Final Pass .................................................................
................................................................................................................................... 70 degrees
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Coolant Drain Plug,
Cylinder Block > Component Information > Specifications
Coolant Drain Plug: Specifications
Engine Block Coolant Drain Hole Plug
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 15 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main
Bearing > Component Information > Specifications
Crankshaft Main Bearing: Specifications
Crankshaft
Bearing Clearance - Journal #1-Production
.......................................................................................................... 0.02 - 0.508 mm
(0.0008-0.0020 inch) Bearing Clearance - Journal #2, #3, and #4-Production
.................................................................................... 0.028 - 0.058 mm (0.0011 - 0.0023 inch)
Bearing Clearance - Journal #1-Service
............................................................................................................ 0.0254 - 0.05 mm (0.0010 0.0020 inch) Bearing Clearance - Journal #2 #3 and #4-Service
........................................................................................... 0.025 - 0.063 mm (0.0010 - 0.0250 inch)
End Play ..............................................................................................................................................
.................... 0.050 - 0.20 mm (0.002 - 0.008 inch) Journal Diameter - Journal #1
....................................................................................................................... 62.199 - 62.217 mm
(2.4488 - 2.4495 inch) Journal Diameter - Journal #2 and #3
........................................................................................................... 62.191 - 62.215 mm (2.4485 2.4494 inch) Journal Diameter - Journal #4
....................................................................................................................... 62.179 - 62.203 mm
(2.4480 - 2.4489 inch) Journal Out-of-Round
Production ......................................................................................................................................
0.005 mm - Maximum (0.0002 inch - Maximum) Service
............................................................................................................................................ 0.025 mm
- Maximum (0.0010 inch - Maximum)
Journal Taper - Production
................................................................................................................... 0.007 mm - Maximum
(0.0003 inch - Maximum) Runout
.................................................................................................................................................. 0.025
mm - Maximum (0.0010 inch - Maximum)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Crankshaft: Specifications
Crankshaft Bearing Cap Bolt (Preferred Method)
Torque:
First Pass .............................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 15 ft. lbs. Final Pass .................................................................
................................................................................................................................... 73 degrees
Crankshaft Bearing Cap Bolt (Optional Strategy)
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 77 ft. lbs.
Crankshaft
Bearing Clearance - Journal #1-Production
.......................................................................................................... 0.02 - 0.508 mm
(0.0008-0.0020 inch) Bearing Clearance - Journal #2, #3, and #4-Production
.................................................................................... 0.028 - 0.058 mm (0.0011 - 0.0023 inch)
Bearing Clearance - Journal #1-Service
............................................................................................................ 0.0254 - 0.05 mm (0.0010 0.0020 inch) Bearing Clearance - Journal #2 #3 and #4-Service
........................................................................................... 0.025 - 0.063 mm (0.0010 - 0.0250 inch)
End Play ..............................................................................................................................................
.................... 0.050 - 0.20 mm (0.002 - 0.008 inch) Journal Diameter - Journal #1
....................................................................................................................... 62.199 - 62.217 mm
(2.4488 - 2.4495 inch) Journal Diameter - Journal #2 and #3
........................................................................................................... 62.191 - 62.215 mm (2.4485 2.4494 inch) Journal Diameter - Journal #4
....................................................................................................................... 62.179 - 62.203 mm
(2.4480 - 2.4489 inch) Journal Out-of-Round
Production ......................................................................................................................................
0.005 mm - Maximum (0.0002 inch - Maximum) Service
............................................................................................................................................ 0.025 mm
- Maximum (0.0010 inch - Maximum)
Journal Taper - Production
................................................................................................................... 0.007 mm - Maximum
(0.0003 inch - Maximum) Runout
.................................................................................................................................................. 0.025
mm - Maximum (0.0010 inch - Maximum)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Engine Block Heater >
Component Information > Specifications
Engine Block Heater: Specifications
Engine Coolant Heater Bolt/Screw
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ 18 inch lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Engine Block Heater >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1966
Engine Block Heater: Service and Repair
Coolant Heater Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Drain the engine coolant.
2. If not originally equipped with an engine coolant heater, remove the coolant jacket plug by using
the following procedure:
2.1. Carefully tap the coolant jacket plug near the outer edge. This causes the plug to rotate in the
hole. Do not score the machined surface of the hole.
2.2. Grasp the plug with pliers and pull the plug out.
3. Remove the cord from the engine coolant heater. 4. Loosen the bolt. 5. Remove the engine
coolant heater. 6. Clean the core plug hole. Remove any of the following conditions:
- Burrs
- Compound
- Paint
- Rough spots
Installation Procedure
1. Apply a coating of lubricant to the O-ring seal and the cleaned surface of the plug opening in the
block. Use a water spray resistant,
high-temperature grease lubricant (GM P/N 9985164 or equivalent).
Notice: The block heater element must not touch the engine block inner wall in the installed
position or damage to the engine block and the block heater could result.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Engine Block Heater >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1967
2. Install the engine block heater into the engine block. Position the heater element 90 degrees
perpendicular (1) to the crankshaft centerline.
3. Push the engine coolant heater into the block until the outer edge is flush with the engine block
surface.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Tighten the bolt until both locking wings draw tight against the inner wall of the engine block.
Tighten the bolt to 1.9 Nm (17 inch lbs.).
Notice: The heater cord must not touch the engine, hot pipes, manifold, or any moving parts. Route
the cord to the left front of the engine compartment securing with tie straps as necessary to prevent
damage.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Engine Block Heater >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1968
5. Install the heater cord to the coolant heater. Route and secure the heater cord through the
engine as shown.
6. Route and secure the heater cord across the engine cowl as shown.
7. Route and secure the heater cord to the VCM wiring harness. 8. Fill the reservoir with engine
coolant.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Engine Block Heater >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1969
9. Inspect the system for leaks.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Expansion/Freeze
Plug > Component Information > Specifications
Expansion/Freeze Plug: Specifications
Engine Block Left Rear Oil Gallery Plug
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 22 ft. lbs.
Engine Block Left Side Oil Gallery Plug
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 15 ft. lbs.
Engine Block Oil Gallery Plug
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 15 ft. lbs.
Engine Block Right Rear Oil Gallery Plug
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 15 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications
Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley: Specifications
Crankshaft Balancer Bolt
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 70 ft. lbs.
Crankshaft Pulley Bolt
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 43 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1976
Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley: Service and Repair
Crankshaft Balancer Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the fan shroud assembly.
2. Remove the drive belt. 3. Remove the crankshaft balancer. 4. Clean and inspect all parts.
Installation Procedure
1. Apply a small amount of grease to the crankshaft front cover oil seal sealing surface if reusing
the seal. 2. Install the crankshaft balancer. 3. Install the drive belt. 4. Install the fan shroud
assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Piston: Specifications
Piston
Piston Bore Clearance
Production
................................................................................................................................................... 0.018
- 0.061 mm (0.0007 - 0.0024 inch) Service
............................................................................................................................................ 0.075 mm
- Maximum (0.0029 inch - Maximum)
Piston Pin
Clearance in Piston
Production
................................................................................................................................................... 0.013
- 0.023 mm (0.0005 - 0.0009 inch) Service
............................................................................................................................................ 0.025 mm
- Maximum (0.0010 inch - Maximum)
Diameter
........................................................................................................................................................
23.545 - 23.548 mm (0.9270 - 0.9271 inch) Fit in Connecting Rod
.......................................................................................... 0.012 - 0.048 mm - Interference (0.0005 0.0019 inch - Interference)
Piston Rings- End Gap Measured in Cylinder Bore
Compression Ring Gap
Production-Top Groove
...................................................................................................................................... 0.25 - 0.40
mm (0.010 - 0.016 inch) Production-2nd Groove
....................................................................................................................................... 0.38 - 0.58
mm (0.015 - 0.023 inch) Service-Top Groove
............................................................................................................................................ 0.25 0.50 mm (0.010 - 0.020 inch) Service-2nd Groove
............................................................................................................................................ 0.38 0.80 mm (0.015 - 0.031 inch)
Piston Compression Ring Groove Clearance
Production-Top
........................................................................................................................................... 0.030 0.070 mm (0.0012 - 0.0027 inch) 2nd Groove
.................................................................................................................................................. 0.040
- 0.080 mm (0 0015 - 0.0031 inch) Service
.........................................................................................................................................................
0.030 - 0.085 mm (0.0012 - 0.0033 inch)
Piston Oil Ring Gap
Production
...........................................................................................................................................................
0.25 - 0.76 mm (0.010 - 0.029 inch) Service
.........................................................................................................................................................
0.005 - 0.090 mm (0.0002 - 0.0035 inch)
Piston Oil Ring Groove Clearance Production
................................................................................................................................................... 0.046
- 0.196 mm (0.0018 - 0.0077 inch) Service
.........................................................................................................................................................
0.046 - 0.200 mm (0.0018 - 0.0079 inch)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Pin, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Piston Pin: Specifications
Piston Pin
Clearance in Piston Production
................................................................................................................................................... 0.013
- 0.023 mm (0.0005 - 0.0009 inch) Service
............................................................................................................................................ 0.025 mm
- Maximum (0.0010 inch - Maximum)
Diameter
........................................................................................................................................................
23.545 - 23.548 mm (0.9270 - 0.9271 inch) Fit in Connecting Rod
.......................................................................................... 0.012 - 0.048 mm - Interference (0.0005 0.0019 inch - Interference)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Ring, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Piston Ring: Specifications
Piston Rings- End Gap Measured in Cylinder Bore
Compression Ring Gap
Production-Top Groove
...................................................................................................................................... 0.25 - 0.40
mm (0.010 - 0.016 inch) Production-2nd Groove
....................................................................................................................................... 0.38 - 0.58
mm (0.015 - 0.023 inch) Service-Top Groove
............................................................................................................................................ 0.25 0.50 mm (0.010 - 0.020 inch) Service-2nd Groove
............................................................................................................................................ 0.38 0.80 mm (0.015 - 0.031 inch)
Compression Ring Groove Clearance
Production-Top
........................................................................................................................................... 0.030 0.070 mm (0.0012 - 0.0027 inch) Production 2nd Groove
............................................................................................................................... 0.040 - 0.080 mm
(0 0015 - 0.0031 inch) Service
.........................................................................................................................................................
0.030 - 0.085 mm (0.0012 - 0.0033 inch)
Oil Ring Gap
Production
...........................................................................................................................................................
0.25 - 0.76 mm (0.010 - 0.029 inch) Service
.........................................................................................................................................................
0.005 - 0.090 mm (0.0002 - 0.0035 inch)
Oil Ring Groove Clearance
Production
................................................................................................................................................... 0.046
- 0.196 mm (0.0018 - 0.0077 inch) Service
.........................................................................................................................................................
0.046 - 0.200 mm (0.0018 - 0.0079 inch)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Fuel Pressure Release
> System Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 34730-1A Fuel Pressure Gage
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Gasoline/Gasoline Vapors Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Remove the engine cover.
CAUTION: Refer to Fuel Gage Leak Caution in Service Precautions.
NOTE: Clean all of the following areas before performing any disconnections in order to avoid
possible contamination in the system: ^
The fuel pipe connections
^ The hose connections
^ The areas surrounding the connections
2. Install the J 34730-1A to the fuel pressure service connection. 3. Turn ON the ignition.
CAUTION: Refer to Fuel Storage Caution in Service Precautions.
4. Place the bleed hose of the fuel pressure gage into an approved gasoline container. 5. Open the
bleed valve on the fuel pressure gage in order to bleed the air from the fuel pressure gage. 6.
Command the fuel pump ON with a scan tool. 7. Close the bleed valve on the fuel pressure gage.
8. Inspect for fuel leaks.
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Fuel Pressure Release
> System Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal > Page 1991
1. Place the fuel pressure gage bleed hose into an approved container and open the bleed valve to
bleed OFF fuel system pressure. 2. Place a shop towel under the J 34730-1A to catch any
remaining fuel spillage. 3. Remove the J 34730-1A from the fuel pressure connection. 4. Drain any
fuel remaining in the fuel pressure gage into an approved container. 5. Inspect for leaks using the
following procedure:
5.1. Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF for 2 seconds.
5.2. Turn OFF the ignition for 10 seconds.
5.3. Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
5.4. Inspect for fuel leaks.
6. Install the cap on the fuel pressure connection. 7. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Fuel Pressure Release
> System Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal > Page 1992
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair Fuel System Pressure Relief
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 34730-1A Fuel Pressure Gage
CAUTION: Remove the fuel tank cap and relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing the fuel
system in order to reduce the risk of personal injury. After you relieve the fuel system pressure, a
small amount of fuel may be released when servicing the fuel lines, the fuel injection pump, or the
connections. In order to reduce the risk of personal injury, cover the fuel system components with a
shop towel before disconnection. This will catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an
approved container when the disconnection is complete.
1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Disconnect the negative battery cable in order to avoid possible fuel
discharge if an accidental attempt is made to start the engine. 3. Remove the engine cover. 4.
Connect the J 34730-1A or the equivalent to the fuel pressure connection. 5. Wrap a shop towel
around the fitting while connecting the gage in order to avoid spillage. 6. Install the bleed hose of
the gage into an approved container. 7. Open the valve on the gage in order to bleed the system
pressure. The fuel connections are now safe for servicing. 8. Drain any fuel remaining in the gage
into an approved container.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly
> Component Information > Specifications
Rocker Arm Assembly: Specifications
Rocker Arm
Rocker Arm ..........................................................................................................................................
................................................. Roller Pivot Type Rocker Arm Ratio ..................................................
.................................................................................................................................................... 1.5:1
Rocker Arm Bolt
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 22 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 1996
Rocker Arm Assembly: Service and Repair
Valve Rocker Arm and Push Rod Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the valve rocker arm cover. 2. Remove the valve rocker arm and the valve pushrod. 3.
Clean and inspect the valve rocker arm and the valve pushrod.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the valve rocker arm and the valve pushrod. 2. Install the valve rocker arm cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Valve Rocker Arm Cover Replacement (Left)
Valve Cover: Service and Repair Valve Rocker Arm Cover Replacement (Left)
Valve Rocker Arm Cover Replacement - Left
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the engine cover.
2. Remove the oil filler tube and bolt
3. Disconnect the Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor electrical connector.
4. Remove the PCV valve hose assembly from the intake manifold and the valve rocker arm cover.
5. Remove the rear spark plug wire retainer from the support. 6. Remove the valve rocker arm
cover. 7. Clean all sealing surfaces and the valve rocker arm cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Valve Rocker Arm Cover Replacement (Left) > Page 2001
Installation Procedure
1. Install the valve rocker arm cover and bolts.
2. Install the PCV valve hose assembly to the intake manifold and in the valve rocker arm cover. 3.
Install the rear spark plug wire retainer to the support
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the oil filler tube and bolt.
Tighten the bolt to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
5. Connect the ECT sensor electrical connector. 6. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Valve Rocker Arm Cover Replacement (Left) > Page 2002
Valve Cover: Service and Repair Valve Rocker Arm Cover Replacement (Right)
Valve Rocker Arm Cover Replacement - Right
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Disconnect the spark plug wires for the right side of the engine
from the distributor cap.
3. Remove the PCV tube from the valve rocker arm cover and the air cleaner outlet duct.
4. Remove the engine wiring harness bracket from the EVAP canister purge solenoid valve stud. 5.
Move the engine wiring harness aside. 6. Remove the right valve rocker arm cover. 7. Clean all
sealing surfaces and the valve rocker arm cover.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Valve Rocker Arm Cover Replacement (Left) > Page 2003
1. Install the right valve rocker arm cover and bolts.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the engine wiring harness bracket and nut to EVAP canister purge solenoid valve stud.
Tighten the engine wiring harness bracket nut to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs.).
3. Install the PCV hose in the valve rocker arm cover and the air cleaner outlet duct. 4. Connect the
spark plug wires to the distributor cap. 5. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Guide >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Valve Guide: > 1539013 > Jul > 04 > Engine SES Lamp ON/Misfire DTC' Set Towing Uphill
Valve Guide: Customer Interest Engine - SES Lamp ON/Misfire DTC' Set Towing Uphill
Subject: SES Light and P0300 When Towing, Cruising Uphill or on hard Acceleration - kw 4.3, 5.0,
5.7 accelerate cruise cylinderhead DTC L30, L31, L35, LF6, LU3, P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303,
P0304, P0305, P0306, P0307 P0308 # PIP3081 - (07/23/2004)
Models:
The following diagnosis might be helpful if the vehicle exhibits the symptom described in the PI.
Condition/Concern:
The vehicle may exhibit a SES Light due to a P0300 and misfire. If the misfire is related to the
information below, it will typically happen while cruising uphill, pulling a trailer or on hard
acceleration and then stop misfiring shortly after returning to an idle. Typically, cylinders 3, 4, 5 or 6
will be the ones to experience this.
Recommendation/Instructions:
If the P0300 SI diagnostics did not isolate a concern, the following may help:
Remove the valve cover, valve springs and valve seals on the effected cylinder or cylinders. A
small wire tie or rubber bands can be placed in the valve stem keeper groove to prevent the valve
from falling into the cylinder. Rotate the valve while moving it up and down in the guide to see if it
binds. If a binding valve is found, remove both cylinder heads and use either of the following
methods to increase the stem to guide clearance:
^ Send the head out to a machine shop and advise them to increase the valve stem to guide
clearance to 0.002 inch per guide.
^ Hone the guide with a 9 mm hone, such as Snap On BCG249, until a clearance of 0.002 inch is
obtained. This will usually take about 4 strokes of the hone.
Reassemble the cylinder heads using new valve seals.
Please follow this diagnosis process thoroughly and complete each step. If the condition exhibited
is resolved without completing every step, the remaining steps do not need to be performed. If
these steps do not resolve the condition, please contact GM TAC for further diagnostic assistance.
Models Affected
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Guide >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Valve Guide: > 1539013 > Jul >
04 > Engine - SES Lamp ON/Misfire DTC' Set Towing Uphill
Valve Guide: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - SES Lamp ON/Misfire DTC' Set Towing
Uphill
Subject: SES Light and P0300 When Towing, Cruising Uphill or on hard Acceleration - kw 4.3, 5.0,
5.7 accelerate cruise cylinderhead DTC L30, L31, L35, LF6, LU3, P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303,
P0304, P0305, P0306, P0307 P0308 # PIP3081 - (07/23/2004)
Models:
The following diagnosis might be helpful if the vehicle exhibits the symptom described in the PI.
Condition/Concern:
The vehicle may exhibit a SES Light due to a P0300 and misfire. If the misfire is related to the
information below, it will typically happen while cruising uphill, pulling a trailer or on hard
acceleration and then stop misfiring shortly after returning to an idle. Typically, cylinders 3, 4, 5 or 6
will be the ones to experience this.
Recommendation/Instructions:
If the P0300 SI diagnostics did not isolate a concern, the following may help:
Remove the valve cover, valve springs and valve seals on the effected cylinder or cylinders. A
small wire tie or rubber bands can be placed in the valve stem keeper groove to prevent the valve
from falling into the cylinder. Rotate the valve while moving it up and down in the guide to see if it
binds. If a binding valve is found, remove both cylinder heads and use either of the following
methods to increase the stem to guide clearance:
^ Send the head out to a machine shop and advise them to increase the valve stem to guide
clearance to 0.002 inch per guide.
^ Hone the guide with a 9 mm hone, such as Snap On BCG249, until a clearance of 0.002 inch is
obtained. This will usually take about 4 strokes of the hone.
Reassemble the cylinder heads using new valve seals.
Please follow this diagnosis process thoroughly and complete each step. If the condition exhibited
is resolved without completing every step, the remaining steps do not need to be performed. If
these steps do not resolve the condition, please contact GM TAC for further diagnostic assistance.
Models Affected
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Seat >
Component Information > Specifications
Valve Seat: Specifications
Valve Seat
Angle ...................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................. 46 degrees Runout
...................................................................................................................................................... 0.05
mm - Maximum (0.002 inch - Maximum) Seat Width - Exhaust
............................................................................................................................................. 1.651 2.489 mm (0.065 - 0.098 inch) Seat Width - Intake
................................................................................................................................................ 1.016 1.651 mm (0.040 - 0.065 inch)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Specifications
Valve Spring: Specifications
Valve Spring
Free Length .........................................................................................................................................
............................................... 51.3 mm (2.02 inch) Installed Height
Exhaust
............................................................................................................................................................
42.92 - 43.43 mm (1.670 - 1.700 inch) Intake .....................................................................................
.......................................................................... 42.92 - 43.43 mm (1.670 - 1.700 inch)
Spring Pressure
Closed ...........................................................................................................................................
338 - 374 N at 43.2 mm (76 - 84 lbs. at 1.70 inch) Open
.......................................................................................................................................... 832 - 903 N
at 32.3 mm (187 - 203 lbs. at 1.27 inch)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2023
Valve Spring: Service and Repair
Valve Stem Oil Seal and Valve Spring Replacement
Tools Required J22794 Spark Plug Port Adapter
- J38606 Valve Spring Compressor
- J5892-D Valve Spring Compressor
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the valve rocker arm cover. 2. Remove the required valve rocker arms. 3. Remove the
required spark plugs.
4. Install the J22794 into the spark plug hole. 5. Connect a shop air supply hose and apply
compressed air in order to hold the valves in place.
6. Remove a bolt from a valve rocker arm. 7. Install a flat washer on the bolt. 8. Install the bolt in
the valve rocker arm bolt hole for the valve spring requiring removal.
Caution: Compressed valve springs have high tension against the valve spring compressor. Valve
springs that are not properly compressed by or released from the valve spring compressor can be
ejected from the valve spring compressor with intense force. Use care when compressing or
releasing the valve spring with the valve spring compressor and when removing or installing the
valve stem keys. Failing to use care may cause personal injury.
9. Use the J5892-D in order to compress the valve spring.
9.1. Hook the slotted end of J5892-D under the washer on the valve rocker arm bolt.
9.2. Apply steady pressure on the valve spring cap until the valve keys are accessible.
Notice: Completely engage the J38606 jaws on the valve spring. The J38606 may slip off and
scratch the valve spring. Replace the valve spring if the valve spring becomes scratch.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2024
10. Use J38606 when J5892-D will not fit.
11. Remove the valve keys (1). 12. Carefully release the valve spring tension. 13. Remove the
J5892-D or J38606 14. Remove the valve spring cap (2) and valve spring (3). 15. Remove the
valve stem oil seal (4).
Installation Procedure
1. Install the valve seals (4). 2. Install the valve spring (3). 3. Install the valve spring cap (2) on the
valve stem.
Caution: Compressed valve springs have high tension against the valve spring compressor. Valve
springs that are not properly compressed
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2025
by or released from the valve spring compressor can be ejected from the valve spring compressor
with intense force. Use care when compressing or releasing the valve spring with the valve spring
compressor and when removing or installing the valve stem keys. Failing to use care may cause
personal injury.
4. To press the valve spring (3) use the J5892-D.
Notice: Completely engage the J38606 jaws on the valve spring. The J38606 may slip off and
scratch the valve spring. Replace the valve spring if the valve spring becomes scratch.
5. Use the J38606 if the clearance does not permit use of the J5892-D. 6. Install the valve stem
keys. Use grease in order to hold the valve stem keys in place.
7. Carefully release the valve spring pressure, making sure the valve stem keys stay in place.
Notice: The valve stem keys must correctly seat in the valve spring cap. Engine damage may occur
by not installing properly.
8. Remove the J5892-D or the J38606.
8.1. Look to ensure that the valve stem keys seat properly in the upper groove of the valve stem.
8.2. Tap the end of the valve stem with a plastic faced hammer in to seat the valve stem keys, if
necessary.
9. Remove the J22794.
10. Install the spark plugs. 11. Install the valve rocker arms to the cylinder head. 12. Install the
valve rocker arm cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Valve: > 1539013 > Jul > 04 > Engine - SES
Lamp ON/Misfire DTC' Set Towing Uphill
Valve: Customer Interest Engine - SES Lamp ON/Misfire DTC' Set Towing Uphill
Subject: SES Light and P0300 When Towing, Cruising Uphill or on hard Acceleration - kw 4.3, 5.0,
5.7 accelerate cruise cylinderhead DTC L30, L31, L35, LF6, LU3, P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303,
P0304, P0305, P0306, P0307 P0308 # PIP3081 - (07/23/2004)
Models:
The following diagnosis might be helpful if the vehicle exhibits the symptom described in the PI.
Condition/Concern:
The vehicle may exhibit a SES Light due to a P0300 and misfire. If the misfire is related to the
information below, it will typically happen while cruising uphill, pulling a trailer or on hard
acceleration and then stop misfiring shortly after returning to an idle. Typically, cylinders 3, 4, 5 or 6
will be the ones to experience this.
Recommendation/Instructions:
If the P0300 SI diagnostics did not isolate a concern, the following may help:
Remove the valve cover, valve springs and valve seals on the effected cylinder or cylinders. A
small wire tie or rubber bands can be placed in the valve stem keeper groove to prevent the valve
from falling into the cylinder. Rotate the valve while moving it up and down in the guide to see if it
binds. If a binding valve is found, remove both cylinder heads and use either of the following
methods to increase the stem to guide clearance:
^ Send the head out to a machine shop and advise them to increase the valve stem to guide
clearance to 0.002 inch per guide.
^ Hone the guide with a 9 mm hone, such as Snap On BCG249, until a clearance of 0.002 inch is
obtained. This will usually take about 4 strokes of the hone.
Reassemble the cylinder heads using new valve seals.
Please follow this diagnosis process thoroughly and complete each step. If the condition exhibited
is resolved without completing every step, the remaining steps do not need to be performed. If
these steps do not resolve the condition, please contact GM TAC for further diagnostic assistance.
Models Affected
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Valve: > 1539013 > Jul > 04 >
Engine - SES Lamp ON/Misfire DTC' Set Towing Uphill
Valve: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - SES Lamp ON/Misfire DTC' Set Towing Uphill
Subject: SES Light and P0300 When Towing, Cruising Uphill or on hard Acceleration - kw 4.3, 5.0,
5.7 accelerate cruise cylinderhead DTC L30, L31, L35, LF6, LU3, P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303,
P0304, P0305, P0306, P0307 P0308 # PIP3081 - (07/23/2004)
Models:
The following diagnosis might be helpful if the vehicle exhibits the symptom described in the PI.
Condition/Concern:
The vehicle may exhibit a SES Light due to a P0300 and misfire. If the misfire is related to the
information below, it will typically happen while cruising uphill, pulling a trailer or on hard
acceleration and then stop misfiring shortly after returning to an idle. Typically, cylinders 3, 4, 5 or 6
will be the ones to experience this.
Recommendation/Instructions:
If the P0300 SI diagnostics did not isolate a concern, the following may help:
Remove the valve cover, valve springs and valve seals on the effected cylinder or cylinders. A
small wire tie or rubber bands can be placed in the valve stem keeper groove to prevent the valve
from falling into the cylinder. Rotate the valve while moving it up and down in the guide to see if it
binds. If a binding valve is found, remove both cylinder heads and use either of the following
methods to increase the stem to guide clearance:
^ Send the head out to a machine shop and advise them to increase the valve stem to guide
clearance to 0.002 inch per guide.
^ Hone the guide with a 9 mm hone, such as Snap On BCG249, until a clearance of 0.002 inch is
obtained. This will usually take about 4 strokes of the hone.
Reassemble the cylinder heads using new valve seals.
Please follow this diagnosis process thoroughly and complete each step. If the condition exhibited
is resolved without completing every step, the remaining steps do not need to be performed. If
these steps do not resolve the condition, please contact GM TAC for further diagnostic assistance.
Models Affected
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2039
Valve: Specifications
Valve System
Valve Face Angle.................................................................................................................................
.............................................................. 45 degrees Valve Head
............................................................................................................................................ 0.79 mm Minimum (1 0.031 inch - Minimum) Valve Lash ..................................................................................
................................................................................................ Net Lash-No Adjustment Valve Lift Exhaust ................................................................................................................................................
................... 10.879 mm (0.4280 inch) Valve Lift - Intake ....................................................................
.................................................................................................. 10.527 mm (0.4140 inch) Valve Lifter
..............................................................................................................................................................
...................... Hydraulic Roller Type Rocker Arm ...............................................................................
............................................................................................................ Roller Pivot Type Rocker Arm
Ratio ....................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 1.5:1 Valve Seat Angle .....................................................................
......................................................................................................................... 46 degrees Valve
Seat Runout ....................................................................................................................................
0.05 mm - Maximum (0.002 inch - Maximum) Valve Seat Width
Exhaust
............................................................................................................................................................
1.651 - 2.489 mm (0.065 - 0.098 inch) Intake .....................................................................................
.......................................................................... 1.016 - 1.651 mm (0.040 - 0.065 inch)
Valve Spring Free Length ....................................................................................................................
.............................................. 51.3 mm (2.02 inch) Valve Spring Installed Height
Exhaust
............................................................................................................................................................
42.92 - 43.43 mm (1.670 - 1.700 inch) Intake .....................................................................................
.......................................................................... 42.92 - 43.43 mm (1.670 - 1.700 inch)
Valve Spring Pressure
Closed ...........................................................................................................................................
338 - 374 N at 43.2 mm (76 - 84 lbs. at 1.70 inch) Open
.......................................................................................................................................... 832 - 903 N
at 32.3 mm (187 - 203 lbs. at 1.27 inch)
Valve Stem Clearance - Exhaust
Production
................................................................................................................................................... 0.025
- 0.069 mm (0.0010 - 0.0027 inch) Service
.........................................................................................................................................................
0.025 - 0.094 mm (0.0010 - 0.0037 inch)
Valve Stem Clearance - Intake
Production
................................................................................................................................................... 0.025
- 0.069 mm (0.0010 - 0.0027 inch) Service
.........................................................................................................................................................
0.025 - 0.094 mm (0.0010 - 0.0037 inch)
Valve Stem Oil Seal installed Height
......................................................................................................................... 1 - 2 mm (0.03937 -
0.07874 inch) (Measured from the Top of the Large Diameter Valve Guide Bevel to the Bottom of
the Valve Stem Oil Seal)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics
Drive Belt: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-06-01-008A
Date: July 27, 2009
Subject: Diagnosing Accessory Drive Belt / Serpentine Belt Noise and Availability and Use of
Kent-Moore EN-49228 Laser Alignment Tool - Drive Belt
Models:
2010 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 Vehicles 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add a model year and update the Tool Information.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 08-06-01-008 (Section 06 - Engine).
Background
Several aftermarket companies offer laser alignment tools for accessory drive systems that can be
very helpful in eliminating drive belt noise as a result of misaligned pulleys. Typically pricing ranges
from $160 - $200.
EN-49228 Laser Alignment Tool - Drive Belt
The GM Tool program has now made available a competitive, simple to use and time-saving laser
tool to assist in achieving precise alignment of the drive belt pulleys. This optional tool removes the
guesswork from proper pulley alignment and may serve to reduce comebacks from:
- Drive Belt Noise
- Accelerated Drive Belt Wear
- Drive Belt Slippage
Instructions
The instructions below are specific only to the truck Gen IV V-8 family of engines. These
instructions are only for illustrative purposes to show how the tool may be used. Universal
instructions are included in the box with the Laser Alignment Tool - Drive Belt.
Caution
- Do not look directly into the beam projected from the laser.
- Use caution when shining the laser on highly polished or reflective surfaces. Laser safety glasses
help reduce laser beam glare in many circumstances.
- Always use laser safety glasses when using the laser. Laser safety glasses are not designed to
protect eyes from direct laser exposure.
1. Observe and mark the serpentine belt orientation.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics > Page
2045
2. Remove the serpentine belt from the accessory drive system.
3. Install the tool onto the power steering pulley. Position the legs of the tool into the outer grooves
of the pulley, farthest from the front of the
engine.
4. Install the retaining cord around the pulley and to the legs of the tool.
5. Put on the laser safety glasses provided with the tool. 6. Depress the switch on the rear of the
tool to activate the light beam. 7. Rotate the power steering pulley as required to project the light
beam onto the crankshaft balancer pulley grooves. 8. Inspect for proper power steering pulley
alignment.
- If the laser beam projects onto the second rib or raised area (1), the pulleys are aligned properly.
- If the laser beam projects more than one-quarter rib 0.9 mm (0.035 in) mis-alignment, adjust the
position of the power steering pulley as required.
- Refer to SI for Power Steering Pulley Removal and Installation procedures.
9. Install the serpentine belt to the accessory drive system in the original orientation.
10. Operate the vehicle and verify that the belt noise concern is no longer present.
Tool Information
Please visit the GM service tool website for pricing information or to place your order for this tool.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics > Page
2046
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics > Page
2047
Drive Belt: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Serpentine Drive Belt Wear Information
Bulletin No.: 04-06-01-013
Date: April 29, 2004
INFORMATION
Subject: Information on Serpentine Belt Wear
Models: 2004 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks 2003-2004 and Prior HUMMER H2
All current GM vehicles designed and manufactured in North America were assembled with
serpentine belts that are made with an EPDM material and should last the life of the vehicle. It is
extremely rare to observe any cracks in EPDM belts and it is not expected that they will require
maintenance before 10 years or 240,000 km (150,000 mi) of use.
Older style belts, which were manufactured with a chloroprene compound, may exhibit cracks
depending on age. However, the onset of cracking typically signals that the belt is only about
halfway through its usable life.
A good rule of thumb for chloroprene-based belts is that if cracks are observed 3 mm (1/8 in) apart,
ALL AROUND THE BELT, the belt may be reaching the end of its serviceable life and should be
considered a candidate for changing. Small cracks spaced at greater intervals should not be
considered as indicative that the belt needs changing.
Any belt that exhibits chunking should be replaced.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Belt Chirping
Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection Drive Belt Chirping
Drive Belt Chirping Diagnosis
Diagnostic Aids
The symptom may be intermittent due to moisture on the drive belt(s) or the pulleys. It may be
necessary to spray a small amount of water on the drive belt(s) in order to duplicate the customers
concern. If spraying water on the drive belt(s) duplicates the symptom, cleaning the belt pulleys
may be the probable solution. A loose or incorrect installation of a body component, a suspension
component, or other items of the vehicle may cause the chirping noise.
Test Description
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. The noise may not be
engine related. This step verifies that the engine is making the noise. If the engine is not making
the noise do not proceed
further with this table.
3. The noise may be an internal engine noise. Removing the drive belt and operating the engine
verifies the noise is related to the drive belt. When
removing the drive belt(s) the water pump may not be operating and cause the engine to overheat.
Also DTCs may set if the engine is operating with the drive belt removed.
4. Inspect all drive belt pulleys for pilling. Pilling is the small balls or strings in the drive belt
grooves. Pilling occurs from the accumulation of
rubber dust.
6. Misalignment of the pulleys may be caused from incorrect mounting of the accessory drive
component, incorrect installation of the accessory drive
component pulley, or the pulley bent inward or outward from a previous repair. Test for an
incorrectly aligned pulley. Use a straight edge in the pulley grooves across two or three pulleys. If a
misaligned pulley is found, refer to that accessory drive component for the correct installation
procedure.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Belt Chirping > Page 2050
10. Inspection of the fasteners eliminates the installment of incorrect: bolts, nuts, spacers, or
washers. 12. Inspecting the pulleys for being bent should include inspecting for a dent or other
damage to the pulleys that would prevent the drive belt from not
seating correctly in all of the pulley grooves or on the smooth surface of a pulley when the back
side of the belt is used to drive the pulley.
14. Replacing the drive belt when it is not damaged, or if there is no excessive pilling will be a
temporary repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Belt Chirping > Page 2051
Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection Drive Belt Excessive Wear
Drive Belt Excessive Wear Diagnosis
Diagnostic Aids
Excessive wear on a drive belt(s) is usually caused by an incorrect installation or the wrong drive
belt for the application. Minor misalignment of the drive belt pulleys will not cause excessive wear,
but will probably cause the drive belt(s) to make a noise or to fall off. Excessive misalignment of the
drive belt pulleys will cause excessive wear but may also make the drive belt(s) fall off.
Test Description
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. The inspection is to verify
the drive belt(s) is correctly installed on all of the drive belt pulleys. Wear on the drive belt(s) may
be caused by
mix-positioning the drive belt(s) by one groove on a pulley.
3. The installation of a drive belt that is two wide or two narrow will cause wear on the drive belt.
The drive belt ribs should match all of the grooves
on all of the pulleys.
4. This inspection is to verify the drive belt(s) is not contacting any parts of the engine or body while
the engine is operating. There should be
sufficient clearance when the drive belt accessory drive components load varies. The drive belt(s)
should not come in contact with an engine or a body component when snapping the throttle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Belt Chirping > Page 2052
Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection Drive Belt Falls Off
Drive Belt Falls Off Diagnosis
Diagnostic Aids
If the drive belt(s) repeatedly falls off the drive belt pulleys, this is because of pulley misalignment.
An extra load that is quickly applied on released by an accessory drive component may cause the
drive belt to fall off the pulleys. Verify the accessory drive components operate correctly. If the drive
belt(s) is the incorrect length, the drive belt tensioner may not keep the correct tension on the drive
belt.
Test Description
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. This inspection is to verify
the condition of the drive belt. Damage may of occurred to the drive belt when the drive belt fell off.
The drive belt
may of been damaged, which caused the drive belt to fall off. Inspect the belt for cuts, tears,
sections of ribs missing, or damaged belt plys.
4. Misalignment of the pulleys may be caused from incorrect mounting of the accessory drive
component, incorrect installation of the accessory drive
component pulley, or the pulley bent inward or outward from a previous repair. Test for an
incorrectly aligned pulley using a straight edge in the pulley grooves across two or three pulleys. If
an incorrectly aligned pulley is found refer to that accessory drive component for the correct
installation procedure of that pulley.
5. Inspecting the pulleys for being bent should include inspecting for a dent or other damage to the
pulleys that would prevent the drive belt from not
seating correctly in all of the pulley grooves or on the smooth surface of a pulley when the back
side of the belt is used to drive the pulley.
6. Accessory drive component brackets that are bent or cracked will let the drive belt fall off. 7.
Inspecting of the fasteners can eliminate the possibility that a wrong bolt, nut, spacer, or washer
was installed. Missing, loose, or the wrong
fasteners may cause pulley misalignment from the bracket moving under load. Over tightening of
the fasteners may cause misalignment of the accessory component bracket.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Belt Chirping > Page 2053
Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection Drive Belt Rumbling
Drive Belt Rumbling Diagnosis
Diagnostic Aids
Vibration from the engine operating may cause a body component or another part of the vehicle to
make rumbling noise. The drive belt(s) may have a condition that can not be seen or felt.
Sometimes replacing the drive belt may be the only repair for the symptom. If replacing the drive
belt(s), completing the diagnostic table, and the noise is only heard when the drive belt(s) is
installed, there might be an accessory drive component with a failure. Varying the load on the
different accessory drive components may aid in identifying which component is causing the
rumbling noise.
Test Description
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. This test is to verify that
the symptom is present during diagnosing. Other vehicle components may cause a similar
symptom. 3. This test is to verify that the drive belt(s) is causing the rumbling noise. Rumbling
noise may be confused with an internal engine noise due to the
similarity in the description. Remove only one drive belt at a time if the vehicle has multiple drive
belts. When removing the drive belt the water pump may not be operating and the engine may
overheat. Also DTCs may set when the engine is operating with the drive belt removed.
4. Inspecting the drive belts) is to ensure that it is not causing the noise. Small cracks across the
ribs of the drive belt will not cause the noise. Belt
separation is identified by the plys of the belt separating and may be seen at the edge of the belt
our felt as a lump in the belt.
5. Small amounts of pilling is normal condition and acceptable. When the pilling is severe the drive
belt does not have a smooth surface for correct
operation.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Belt Chirping > Page 2054
Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection
Drive Belt Chirping
Drive Belt Chirping Diagnosis
Diagnostic Aids
The symptom may be intermittent due to moisture on the drive belt(s) or the pulleys. It may be
necessary to spray a small amount of water on the drive belt(s) in order to duplicate the customers
concern. If spraying water on the drive belt(s) duplicates the symptom, cleaning the belt pulleys
may be the probable solution. A loose or incorrect installation of a body component, a suspension
component, or other items of the vehicle may cause the chirping noise.
Test Description
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. The noise may not be
engine related. This step verifies that the engine is making the noise. If the engine is not making
the noise do not proceed
further with this table.
3. The noise may be an internal engine noise. Removing the drive belt and operating the engine
verifies the noise is related to the drive belt. When
removing the drive belt(s) the water pump may not be operating and cause the engine to overheat.
Also DTCs may set if the engine is operating with the drive belt removed.
4. Inspect all drive belt pulleys for pilling. Pilling is the small balls or strings in the drive belt
grooves. Pilling occurs from the accumulation of
rubber dust.
6. Misalignment of the pulleys may be caused from incorrect mounting of the accessory drive
component, incorrect installation of the accessory drive
component pulley, or the pulley bent inward or outward from a previous repair. Test for an
incorrectly aligned pulley. Use a straight edge in the pulley grooves across two or three pulleys. If a
misaligned pulley is found, refer to that accessory drive component for the correct installation
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Belt Chirping > Page 2055
procedure.
10. Inspection of the fasteners eliminates the installment of incorrect: bolts, nuts, spacers, or
washers. 12. Inspecting the pulleys for being bent should include inspecting for a dent or other
damage to the pulleys that would prevent the drive belt from not
seating correctly in all of the pulley grooves or on the smooth surface of a pulley when the back
side of the belt is used to drive the pulley.
14. Replacing the drive belt when it is not damaged, or if there is no excessive pilling will be a
temporary repair.
Drive Belt Excessive Wear
Drive Belt Excessive Wear Diagnosis
Diagnostic Aids
Excessive wear on a drive belt(s) is usually caused by an incorrect installation or the wrong drive
belt for the application. Minor misalignment of the drive belt pulleys will not cause excessive wear,
but will probably cause the drive belt(s) to make a noise or to fall off. Excessive misalignment of the
drive belt pulleys will cause excessive wear but may also make the drive belt(s) fall off.
Test Description
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. The inspection is to verify
the drive belt(s) is correctly installed on all of the drive belt pulleys. Wear on the drive belt(s) may
be caused by
mix-positioning the drive belt(s) by one groove on a pulley.
3. The installation of a drive belt that is two wide or two narrow will cause wear on the drive belt.
The drive belt ribs should match all of the grooves
on all of the pulleys.
4. This inspection is to verify the drive belt(s) is not contacting any parts of the engine or body while
the engine is operating. There should be
sufficient clearance when the drive belt accessory drive components load varies. The drive belt(s)
should not come in contact with an engine or a body component when snapping the throttle.
Drive Belt Falls Off
Drive Belt Falls Off Diagnosis
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Belt Chirping > Page 2056
Diagnostic Aids
If the drive belt(s) repeatedly falls off the drive belt pulleys, this is because of pulley misalignment.
An extra load that is quickly applied on released by an accessory drive component may cause the
drive belt to fall off the pulleys. Verify the accessory drive components operate correctly. If the drive
belt(s) is the incorrect length, the drive belt tensioner may not keep the correct tension on the drive
belt.
Test Description
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. This inspection is to verify
the condition of the drive belt. Damage may of occurred to the drive belt when the drive belt fell off.
The drive belt
may of been damaged, which caused the drive belt to fall off. Inspect the belt for cuts, tears,
sections of ribs missing, or damaged belt plys.
4. Misalignment of the pulleys may be caused from incorrect mounting of the accessory drive
component, incorrect installation of the accessory drive
component pulley, or the pulley bent inward or outward from a previous repair. Test for an
incorrectly aligned pulley using a straight edge in the pulley grooves across two or three pulleys. If
an incorrectly aligned pulley is found refer to that accessory drive component for the correct
installation procedure of that pulley.
5. Inspecting the pulleys for being bent should include inspecting for a dent or other damage to the
pulleys that would prevent the drive belt from not
seating correctly in all of the pulley grooves or on the smooth surface of a pulley when the back
side of the belt is used to drive the pulley.
6. Accessory drive component brackets that are bent or cracked will let the drive belt fall off. 7.
Inspecting of the fasteners can eliminate the possibility that a wrong bolt, nut, spacer, or washer
was installed. Missing, loose, or the wrong
fasteners may cause pulley misalignment from the bracket moving under load. Over tightening of
the fasteners may cause misalignment of the accessory component bracket.
Drive Belt Rumbling
Drive Belt Rumbling Diagnosis
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Belt Chirping > Page 2057
Diagnostic Aids
Vibration from the engine operating may cause a body component or another part of the vehicle to
make rumbling noise. The drive belt(s) may have a condition that can not be seen or felt.
Sometimes replacing the drive belt may be the only repair for the symptom. If replacing the drive
belt(s), completing the diagnostic table, and the noise is only heard when the drive belt(s) is
installed, there might be an accessory drive component with a failure. Varying the load on the
different accessory drive components may aid in identifying which component is causing the
rumbling noise.
Test Description
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. This test is to verify that
the symptom is present during diagnosing. Other vehicle components may cause a similar
symptom. 3. This test is to verify that the drive belt(s) is causing the rumbling noise. Rumbling
noise may be confused with an internal engine noise due to the
similarity in the description. Remove only one drive belt at a time if the vehicle has multiple drive
belts. When removing the drive belt the water pump may not be operating and the engine may
overheat. Also DTCs may set when the engine is operating with the drive belt removed.
4. Inspecting the drive belts) is to ensure that it is not causing the noise. Small cracks across the
ribs of the drive belt will not cause the noise. Belt
separation is identified by the plys of the belt separating and may be seen at the edge of the belt
our felt as a lump in the belt.
5. Small amounts of pilling is normal condition and acceptable. When the pilling is severe the drive
belt does not have a smooth surface for correct
operation.
Drive Belt Squeal
Drive Belt Squeal Diagnosis
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Belt Chirping > Page 2058
Diagnostic Aids
A loose or incorrect installation of a body component, a suspension component, or other items of
the vehicle may cause the squeal noise. If the noise is intermittent verify the accessory drive
components by varying their loads. Ensure the accessory components are operated to their
maximum capacity. An overcharged A/C system or power steering system with: a pinched hose, an
incorrect fluid, or a failed generator are suggested items to inspect.
Test Description
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. The noise may not be
engine related. This step is to verify that the engine is making the noise. If the engine is not making
the noise do not proceed
further with this table.
3. The noise may be an internal engine noise. Removing the drive belt and operating the engine
verifies the noise is related to the drive belt or an
accessory drive component. If the drive belt is removed, the water pump may not operate. Without
the water pump the engine may overheat. DTCs may set when the engine is operating with the
drive belt removed.
4. This test verifies that an accessory drive component does not have a seized bearing. Remove
the belt and test the bearings for smooth turning in the
accessory drive components. Test the accessory drive components with the engine operating, vary
the load on the components to verify that the components operate correctly.
5. This test is to verify that the drive belt tensioner operates correctly. If the drive belt tensioner is
not operating correctly, correct belt tension may
not be achieved to keep the drive belt from slipping which could cause a squeal noise.
6. This test is to verify that the drive belt(s) is not too long, which would prevent the drive belt
tensioner from working correctly. Also if an incorrect
length drive belt was installed, it may not be routed correctly and may be turning an accessory
drive component in the wrong direction.
7. Misalignment of the pulleys may be caused from incorrect mounting of the accessory drive
component, incorrect installation of the accessory drive
component pulley, or the pulley bent inward or outward from a previous repair. Test for a pulley that
is incorrectly aligned using a straight edge in the pulley grooves across two or three pulleys. If an
incorrectly aligned pulley is found refer to that accessory drive component for the correct
installation procedure for that pulley.
8. This test is to verify that the pulleys are the correct diameter or width. Using a known good
vehicle compare the pulley sizes.
Drive Belt Vibration
Drive Belt Vibration Diagnosis
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Belt Chirping > Page 2059
Diagnostic Aids
The accessory drive components can have an affect on engine vibration. Such as but not limited to
the A/C system over charged, the power steering system restricted or the incorrect fluid, or an extra
load on the generator. To help identify an intermittent or an improper condition, vary the loads on
the accessory drive components.
Test Description
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. This test is to verify that
the symptom is present during diagnosing. Other vehicle components may cause a similar
symptom such as the exhaust
system, or the drivetrain.
3. This test is to verify that the drive belt(s) or accessory drive components may be causing the
vibration. When removing the drive belt the water
pump may not be operating and the engine may overheat. Also DTCs may set when the engine is
operating with the drive belt removed.
4. The drive belt(s) may cause a vibration. While the drive belt(s) is removed this is the best time to
inspect the condition of the belt. 6. Inspecting of the fasteners can eliminate the possibility that a
wrong bolt, nut, spacer, or washer was installed. 8. This step should only be performed if the fan is
driven by the drive belt. Inspect the engine cooling fan for bent, twisted, loose, or cracked blades.
Inspect the fan clutch for smoothness, ease of turning. Inspect for a bent fan shaft or bent mounting
flange.
9. This step should only be performed if the water pump is driven by the drive belt. Inspect the
water pump shaft for being bent. Also inspect the
water pump bearings for smoothness and excessive play. Compare the water pump with a known
good water pump.
10. Accessory drive component brackets that are bent, cracked, or loose may put extra strain on
that accessory component causing it to vibrate.
Drive Belt Whine
Drive Belt Whine Diagnosis
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Belt Chirping > Page 2060
Diagnostic Aids
The drive belt(s) will not cause the whine noise. If the whine noise is intermittent, verify the
accessory drive components by varying their loads making sure they are operated to their
maximum capacity. Such items but not limited to may be an A/C system overcharged, the power
steering system restricted or the wrong fluid, or the generator failing.
Test Description
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 3. This test is to verify that
the noise is being caused by the drive belt(s) or the accessory drive components. When removing
the drive belt the water
pump may not be operating and the engine may overheat. DTCs may set if the engine is operating
with the drive belt removed.
4. The inspection should include checking the drive belt tensioner and the drive belt idler pulley
bearings. The drive belt(s) may have to be installed
and the accessory drive components operated separately by varying their loads. Refer to the
suspected accessory drive component for the correct inspection and replacement procedure.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2061
Drive Belt: Service and Repair
Drive Belt Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the air cleaner assembly. 2. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct from the throttle body.
3. Install a 3/8 inch drive wrench on the drive belt tensioner arm and rotate the arm
counterclockwise. 4. Remove the drive belt.
5. Slowly release the tension on the drive belt tensioner arm.
Installation Procedure
1. Route the belt over all the pulleys except the tensioner arm. 2. Observe drive belt routing for
vehicles without air conditioning.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2062
3. Observe drive belt routing for vehicles with air conditioning.
4. Install a 3/8 inch drive wrench on the drive belt tensioner arm and rotate the arm counter
clockwise. 5. Install the drive belt over the drive belt tensioner pulley. 6. Slowly release the tension
on the tensioner arm.
7. Inspect for the drive belt being properly installed on the pulleys.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2063
8. Avoid mix-positioning the drive belt by one or more grooves.
9. Confirm for the proper drive belt size and the correct drive belt routing by observing the location
of the fix pointer and the index marks on the
drive belt tensioner. With a new drive belt installed, the fix pointer should align within the
indentation on the drive belt tensioner.
10. With a used drive belt installed, the fix pointer should not align past the index mark. 11. Install
the air cleaner outlet duct. 12. Install the air cleaner assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt Tensioner > Component Information > Specifications
Drive Belt Tensioner: Specifications
Drive Belt Tensioner Bolt
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 37 ft. lbs.
Engine Wiring Harness Bracket Bolt to Generator and Drive Belt Tensioner Bracket
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 18 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt Tensioner > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2067
Drive Belt Tensioner: Testing and Inspection
Drive Belt Tensioner Diagnosis
Notice: Allowing the drive belt tensioner to snap into the free position may result in damage to the
tensioner.
Important: When the engine is operating the belt tensioner arm will move. Do not replace the belt
tensioner because of movement in the belt tensioner arm.
1. Remove the drive belt. 2. Position a 3/8 inch drive wrench on the drive belt tensioner arm and
rotate the arm counterclockwise 3. Move the drive belt tensioner through its full travel.
- The movement should feel smooth.
- There should be no binding.
- The tensioner should return freely.
4. If any binding is observed, replace the drive belt tensioner. 5. Install the drive belt.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt Tensioner > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2068
Drive Belt Tensioner: Service and Repair
Drive Belt Tensioner Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the drive belt.
2. Remove the bolt. 3. Remove the drive belt tensioner.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the drive belt tensioner assembly.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the attaching bolt.
Tighten the tensioner assembly bolt to 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs.).
3. Install the drive belt.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Accessory Bracket > Component Information > Specifications
Engine Accessory Bracket: Specifications
Engine Accessory Bracket
Engine Lift Bracket Bolt (Special Tool J41427)
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 11 ft. lbs.
Engine Lift Front Bracket Stud
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 26 ft. lbs.
Engine Mount Bracket Bolt to Engine
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 47 ft. lbs.
Engine Mount Bracket to Frame Bolt (AWD)
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 35 ft. lbs.
Engine Mount Bracket to Frame Nut (AWD)
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 31 ft. lbs.
Engine Mount Frame Bracket Through-bolt
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 50 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Specifications
Engine Mount: Specifications
Engine Mount
Bolt to Frame (AWD)
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 44 ft. lbs.
Bolt to Frame (AWD)
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 35 ft. lbs.
Nut to Frame (RWD)
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 31 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2075
Engine Mount: Testing and Inspection
Engine Mount Inspection
Notice: Broken or deteriorated mounts can cause misalignment and destruction of certain drive
train components. When a single mount breaks, the remaining mounts are subjected to abnormally
high stresses.
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting.
2. Inspect for loose or missing bolts at the following locations:
- The engine mount bracket to the engine
- The engine mount to the engine bracket through-bolts
- The engine mount to frame bracket bolts
3. Replace loose or missing bolts.
Notice: When raising or supporting the engine for any reason, do not use a jack under the oil pan,
any sheet metal, or the crankshaft pulley. Lifting the engine in an unapproved manner may cause
component damage.
4. In order to access the square tab on the left side of the engine remove the oil filter adapter. 5. In
order to access the square tab on the right side of the engine remove the starter.
6. Using a jack on the square tab at the rear of the engine block (left side shown) raise the engine
in order to complete the following tasks:
- Remove weight from the engine mount.
- Place a slight tension on the rubber cushion.
- Observe the engine mount while raising the engine.
7. Replace the engine mount if the following conditions exist:
- Heat check cracks cover the hard rubber surface.
- The rubber cushion is separated from the metal plate of the engine mount.
- There is a split through the rubber cushion.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2076
8. Replace the starter, if removed. 9. Replace the oil filter adapter, if removed.
10. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Mount Replacement - Left
Engine Mount: Service and Repair Engine Mount Replacement - Left
Engine Mount Replacement - Left
Removal Procedure
Notice: Refer to Engine Mounting Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable. 2. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 3. Remove
the oil filter adapter.
4. Remove the engine mount through-bolt and nut for the side being replaced.
Notice: Refer to Engine Lifting Notice in Service Precautions.
5. Using a jack on the square tab (left side shown) at the rear of the engine block, raise the engine
only enough to remove the engine mount.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Mount Replacement - Left > Page 2079
6. Remove the bolts for the engine mount bracket to the engine.
Access the upper two bolts for the right engine mount bracket through the fender wheelhouse.
7. Remove the engine mount bracket.
8. For AWD vehicle remove the bolts for the engine mount to the frame (left side shown). 9.
Remove the engine mount.
10. For a RWD vehicle left side remove the bolts and the nuts for the engine mount to the frame
bracket (left side shown). 11. If necessary, remove the left side engine mount frame bracket from
the frame.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Mount Replacement - Left > Page 2080
1. For AWD vehicle install the engine mount to the frame (left side shown).
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the AWD vehicle engine mount to the frame bolts.
Tighten the AWD vehicle engine mount to frame bolts to 59 Nm (44 ft. lbs.).
3. If removed, install the RWD vehicle left side bolts, nuts and engine mount frame bracket to the
frame.
- Tighten the engine mount frame bracket bolts to 47 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
- Tighten the engine mount frame bracket nuts to 42 Nm (31 ft. lbs.).
4. Install the RWD vehicle left side engine mount, the bolts, and the nuts to the frame bracket.
- Tighten the engine mount to frame bolts to 47 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
- Tighten the engine mount to frame nuts to 42 Nm (31 ft. lbs.).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Mount Replacement - Left > Page 2081
5. Install the engine mount bracket to the engine. 6. Install the engine mount bracket bolts.
Tighten the engine mount bracket bolts to 64 Nm (47 ft. lbs.).
7. Lower the engine.
8. Install the engine mount through-bolt and the nut.
Tighten the engine mount through-bolt nuts to 68 Nm (50 ft. lbs.).
9. Install the oil filter adapter.
10. Lower the vehicle. 11. Connect the battery negative cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Mount Replacement - Left > Page 2082
Engine Mount: Service and Repair Engine Mount Replacement - Right
Engine Mount Replacement - Right
Removal Procedure
Notice: Refer to Engine Mounting Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable. 2. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 3. Remove
the right front tire. 4. Remove the right fender wheelhouse extension. 5. Remove the starter.
6. Remove the engine mount through-bolt and nut.
Notice: Refer to Engine Lifting Notice in Service Precautions.
7. Using a jack on the square tab (left side shown) at the rear of the engine block, raise the engine
only enough to remove the engine mount.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Mount Replacement - Left > Page 2083
8. Remove the bolts for the engine mount bracket to the engine.
Access the upper two bolts for the right engine mount bracket through the fender wheelhouse.
9. Remove the engine mount bracket.
10. For AWD vehicle remove the bolts for the engine mount to the frame (left side shown). 11.
Remove the engine mount.
12. For a RWD vehicle right side remove the bolts and the nuts for the engine mount to the frame.
Installation Procedure
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Mount Replacement - Left > Page 2084
1. Install the AWD vehicle engine mount to the frame bolts.
Tighten the AWD vehicle engine mount to frame bolts to 59 Nm (44 ft. lbs.).
2. Install the RWD vehicle right side engine mount, the bolts, and the nuts to the frame.
- Tighten the engine mount to frame bolts to 47 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
- Tighten the engine mount to frame nuts to 42 Nm (31 ft. lbs.).
3. Install the engine mount bracket to the engine. 4. Install the engine mount bracket bolts.
Tighten the engine mount bracket bolts to 64 Nm (47 ft. lbs.).
5. Lower the engine.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Mount Replacement - Left > Page 2085
6. Install the engine mount through bolt and the nut.
Tighten the engine mount through-bolt nuts to 68 Nm (50 ft. lbs.).
7. Install the starter. 8. Install the right fender wheelhouse extension. 9. Install the right front tire.
10. Lower the vehicle. 11. Connect the battery negative cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Idler Pulley > Component Information > Specifications
Idler Pulley: Specifications
Belt Idler Pulley Bolt
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 37 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Idler Pulley > Component Information > Service and Repair > Drive Belt Idler Pulley Replacement - Right
Idler Pulley: Service and Repair Drive Belt Idler Pulley Replacement - Right
Drive Belt Idler Pulley Replacement - Right
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the drive belt.
2. Remove the drive belt idler pulley bolt. 3. Remove the drive belt idler pulley from the generator
mounting bracket.
Installation Procedure
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the drive belt idler pulley and bolt to the generator mounting bracket.
Tighten the bolt to 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs.).
2. Install the drive belt.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Idler Pulley > Component Information > Service and Repair > Drive Belt Idler Pulley Replacement - Right > Page 2091
Idler Pulley: Service and Repair Drive Belt Idler Pulley Replacement - Without Air Conditioning
Drive Belt Idler Pulley Replacement - without Air Conditioning
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the drive belt.
2. Remove the drive belt idler pulley bolt. 3. Remove the drive belt idler pulley from the power
steering pump mounting bracket.
Installation Procedure
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the drive belt idler pulley and bolt to the power steering pump mounting bracket.
Tighten the bolt to 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs.).
2. Install the drive belt.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Pressure >
Component Information > Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure: Specifications
Oil Pressure
Minimum - at Normal Operating Temperature
................................................................................................................... 42 kPa (6 psig) at 1,000
RPM Minimum - at Normal Operating Temperature
............................................................................................................... 125 kPa (18 psig) at 2,000
RPM Minimum - at Normal Operating Temperature
................................................................................................................ 166 kPa (24 psig)at 4,000
RPM
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Pressure >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2096
Engine Oil Pressure: Testing and Inspection
Oil Pressure Diagnosis and Testing
1. With the vehicle on a level surface, allow adequate drain down time, 2-3 minutes, and measure
for a low engine oil level. Add the recommended
grade engine oil, and fill the crankcase until the oil level measures FULL on the oil level indicator.
2. Operate the engine and verify low or no oil pressure on the vehicle oil pressure gage or the oil
indicator light. Listen for a noisy valve train or a
knocking noise.
3. Inspect for the following:
- Engine oil diluted by moisture or unburned fuel mixtures
- Improper engine oil viscosity for the expected temperature
- Incorrect or faulty oil pressure gage sensor
- Incorrect or faulty oil pressure gage
- Plugged oil filter
- Malfunctioning oil filter bypass valve
4. Remove the oil pressure gage sensor or another engine block oil gallery plug. 5. Install an oil
pressure gage. 6. Start the engine and then allow the engine to reach normal operation
temperature. 7. Measure the engine oil pressure at the following RPM:
Specification 7.1.
42 kPa (6 psig, minimum, at 1,000 RPM
7.2. 125 kPa (18 psig, minimum, at 2,000 RPM
7.3. 166 kPa (24 psig, minimum, at 4,000 RPM
8. If the engine oil pressure is below minimum specifications, inspect the engine for one or more of
the following:
- Oil pump worn or dirty
- Malfunctioning oil pump pressure relief valve
- Oil pump screen loose, plugged, or damaged
- Excessive bearing clearance
- Cracked, porous or restricted oil galleries
- Engine block oil gallery plugs missing or incorrectly installed
- Broken valve lifters
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Dip Stick - Dip
Stick Tube > Component Information > Specifications
Engine Oil Dip Stick - Dip Stick Tube: Specifications
Dip Stick Tube
Fill Tube Bolt
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 18 ft. lbs.
Oil Level Indicator Tube Bolt
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 106 inch lbs.
Oil Level Indicator Tube Bolt to Transmission Fluid Fill Tube
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 106 inch lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Dip Stick - Dip
Stick Tube > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2100
Engine Oil Dip Stick - Dip Stick Tube: Service and Repair
Oil Level Indicator and Tube Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Remove the oil level indicator.
3. Remove the bolt holding the oil level indicator tube to the transmission fluid fill tube.
4. Remove the upper half of the oil level indicator tube from the lower half. 5. Clean the old sealer
from the tubes.
6. Remove the oil level indicator tube bolt. 7. Remove the oil level indicator tube from the engine
using a twisting motion. 8. Clean the old sealer from the oil level indicator tube and the engine
block.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Dip Stick - Dip
Stick Tube > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2101
Installation Procedure
1. Install the lower half of the oil level indicator tube to the engine. 2. Apply sealer, GM P/N
12346004 or equivalent, on the upper oil level indicator tube to the area where the tube fits into the
lower half.
3. Install the oil level indicator tube upper half to the lower half.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Secure the engine oil level indicator tube to the transmission fluid fill tube with the bolt.
Tighten the bolt to 12 Nm (106 inch lbs.).
5. Install the oil level indicator. 6. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - GM dexos 1 and dexos 2(R) Oil Specifications
Engine Oil: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - GM dexos 1 and dexos 2(R) Oil Specifications
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 11-00-90-001
Date: March 14, 2011
Subject: Global Information for GM dexos1(TM) and GM dexos2(TM) Engine Oil Specifications for
Spark Ignited and Diesel Engines, Available Licensed Brands, and Service Fill for Adding or
Complete Oil Change
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Excluding All Vehicles Equipped with
Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines
GM dexos 1(TM) Information Center Website
Refer to the following General Motors website for dexos 1(TM) information about the different
licensed brands that are currently available: http://www.gmdexos.com
GM dexos 1(TM) Engine Oil Trademark and Icons
The dexos(TM) specification and trademarks are exclusive to General Motors, LLC.
Only those oils displaying the dexos‹›(TM) trademark and icon on the front label meet the
demanding performance requirements and stringent quality standards set forth in the dexos‹›(TM)
specification.
Look on the front label for any of the logos shown above to identify an authorized, licensed dexos
1(TM) engine oil.
GM dexos 1(TM) Engine Oil Specification
Important General Motors dexos 1(TM) engine oil specification replaces the previous General
Motors specifications GM6094M, GM4718M and GM-LL-A-025 for most GM gasoline engines. The
oil specified for use in GM passenger cars and trucks, PRIOR to the 2011 model year remains
acceptable for those previous vehicles. However, dexos 1(TM) is backward compatible and can be
used in those older vehicles.
In North America, starting with the 2011 model year, GM introduced dexos 1(TM) certified engine
oil as a factory fill and service fill for gasoline engines. The reasons for the new engine oil
specification are as follows:
- To meet environmental goals such as increasing fuel efficiency and reducing engine emissions.
- To promote long engine life.
- To minimize the number of engine oil changes in order to help meet the goal of lessening the
industry's overall dependence on crude oil.
dexos 1(TM) is a GM-developed engine oil specification that has been designed to provide the
following benefits:
- Further improve fuel economy, to meet future corporate average fuel economy (CAFE)
requirements and fuel economy retention by allowing the oil to maintain its fuel economy benefits
throughout the life of the oil.
- More robust formulations for added engine protection and aeration performance.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - GM dexos 1 and dexos 2(R) Oil Specifications > Page 2106
- Support the GM Oil Life System, thereby minimizing the replacement of engine oil, before its life
has been depleted.
- Reduce the duplication of requirements for a large number of internal GM engine oil
specifications.
International Lubricants Standardization and Approval Committee (ILSAC)
GF-5 Standard
In addition to GM dexos 1(TM), a new International Lubricants Standardization and Approval
Committee (ILSAC) standard called GF-5, was introduced in October 2010.
- There will be a corresponding API category, called: SN Resource Conserving. The current GF-4
standard was put in place in 2004 and will become obsolete in October 2011. Similar to dexos
1(TM), the GF-5 standard will use a new fuel economy test, Sequence VID, which demands a
statistically significant increase in fuel economy versus the Sequence VIB test that was used for
GF-4.
- It is expected that all dexos 1(TM) approved oils will be capable of meeting the GF-5 standard.
However, not all GF-5 engine oils will be capable of meeting the dexos 1(TM) specification.
- Like dexos(TM), the new ILSAC GF-5 standard will call for more sophisticated additives. The API
will begin licensing marketers during October 2010, to produce and distribute GF-5 certified
products, which are expected to include SAE 0W-20, 0W-30, 5W-20, 5W-30 and 10W-30 oils.
Corporate Average Fuel Economy (CAFE) Requirements Effect on Fuel Economy
Since CAFE standards were first introduced in 1974, the fuel economy of cars has more than
doubled, while the fuel economy of light trucks has increased by more than 50 percent. Proposed
CAFE standards call for a continuation of increased fuel economy in new cars and trucks. To meet
these future requirements, all aspects of vehicle operation are being looked at more critically than
ever before.
New technology being introduced in GM vehicles designed to increase vehicle efficiency and fuel
economy include direct injection, cam phasing, turbocharging and active fuel management (AFM).
The demands of these new technologies on engine oil also are taken into consideration when
determining new oil specifications. AFM for example can help to achieve improved fuel economy.
However alternately deactivating and activating the cylinders by not allowing the intake and
exhaust valves to open contributes to additional stress on the engine oil.
Another industry trend for meeting tough fuel economy mandates has been a shift toward lower
viscosity oils.
dexos 1(TM) will eventually be offered in several viscosity grades in accordance with engine needs:
SAE 0W-20, 5W-20, 0W-30 and 5W-30.
Using the right viscosity grade oil is critical for proper engine performance. Always refer to the
Maintenance section of a vehicle Owner Manual for the proper viscosity grade for the engine being
serviced.
GM Oil Life System in Conjunction With dexos (TM) Supports Extended Oil Change Intervals
To help conserve oil while maintaining engine protection, many GM vehicles are equipped with the
GM Oil Life System. This system can provide oil change intervals that exceed the traditional 3,000
mile (4,830 km) recommendation.
The dexos (TM) specification, with its requirements for improved oil robustness, compliments the
GM Oil Life System by supporting extended oil change intervals over the lifetime of a vehicle.
If all GM customers with GM Oil Life System equipped vehicles would use the system as intended,
GM estimates that more than 100 million gallons of oil could be saved annually.
GM dexos 2(TM) Information Center Website
Refer to the following General Motors website for dexos 2(TM) information about the different
licensed brands that are currently available: http://www.gmdexos.com
GM dexos 2(TM) Engine Oil Trademark and Icons
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - GM dexos 1 and dexos 2(R) Oil Specifications > Page 2107
The dexos (TM) specification and trademarks are exclusive to General Motors, LLC.
Only those oils displaying the dexos (TM) trademark and icon on the front label meet the
demanding performance requirements and stringent quality standards set forth in the dexos
(TM)specification.
Look on the front label for any of the logos shown above to identify an authorized, licensed dexos
2(TM) engine oil.
GM dexos 2(TM) Engine Oil Specification
- dexos 2(TM) is approved and recommended by GM for use in Europe starting in model year 2010
vehicles, regardless of where the vehicle was manufactured.
- dexos 2(TM) is the recommended service fill oil for European gasoline engines.
Important The Duramax(TM) diesel engine is the exception and requires lubricants meeting
specification CJ-4.
- dexos 2(TM) is the recommended service fill oil for European light-duty diesel engines and
replaces GM-LL-B-025 and GM-LL-A-025.
- dexos 2(TM) protects diesel engines from harmful soot deposits and is designed with limits on
certain chemical components to prolong catalyst life and protect expensive emission reduction
systems. It is a robust oil, resisting degradation between oil changes and maintaining optimum
performance longer.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil: Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil ............................................................................................................................................
............................................................. 4.2L (4.5 Qt)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 2110
Engine Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Engine Oil
API Classification .................................................................................................................................
........................................ Look for Starburst Symbol Viscosity ...........................................................
..........................................................................................................................................................
5W-30
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2111
Engine Oil: Service and Repair
Engine Oil and Oil Filter Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle and support with safety stands. Refer to Vehicle Lifting.
2. Remove the oil pan drain plug and drain the engine oil in a suitable container.
3. Remove the engine oil filter. 4. Inspect to ensure the engine oil filter gasket is removed.
Installation Procedure
1. Lubricate the engine oil filter gasket with clean engine oil.
2. Install the engine oil filter.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2112
3. Follow the tightening instructions on the oil filter.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the drain plug to the oil pan.
Tighten the oil pan plug to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
5. Remove the safety stands and lower the vehicle. 6. Fill the engine with the proper capacity and
quality of engine oil. 7. Operate the engine, check for leaks and oil pressure. 8. Check the oil level
and add as required.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - Noise/Damage Oil Filter Application Importance
Oil Filter: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Noise/Damage Oil Filter Application Importance
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 07-06-01-016B
Date: July 27, 2009
Subject: Information on Internal Engine Noise or Damage After Oil Filter Replacement
Models:
2010 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3
2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being updated to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 07-06-01-016A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
Important Engine damage that is the result of an incorrect or improperly installed engine oil filter is
not a warrantable claim. The best way to avoid oil filter quality concerns is to purchase ACDelco(R)
oil filters directly from GMSPO.
Oil filter misapplication may cause abnormal engine noise or internal damage. Always utilize the
most recent parts information to ensure the correct part number filter is installed when replacing oil
filters. Do not rely on physical dimensions alone. Counterfeit copies of name brand parts have been
discovered in some aftermarket parts systems. Always ensure the parts you install are from a
trusted source. Improper oil filter installation may result in catastrophic engine damage.
Refer to the appropriate Service Information (SI) installation instructions when replacing any oil
filter and pay particular attention to procedures for proper cartridge filter element alignment. If the
diagnostics in SI (Engine Mechanical) lead to the oil filter as the cause of the internal engine noise
or damage, dealers should submit a field product report. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
02-00-89-002I (Information for Dealers on How to Submit a Field Product Report).
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Oil Filter Bypass Valve Replacement
Oil Filter: Service and Repair Oil Filter Bypass Valve Replacement
Oil Filter Bypass Valve Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Position a suitable container to catch the engine oil.
3. Remove the oil filter. 4. Remove the oil filter adapter. 5. Using a suitable prying tool remove the
oil filter bypass valve. 6. Clean and inspect valve bore for damage.
Installation Procedure
Caution: Refer to Safety Glasses Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Install a NEW oil filter bypass valve using the following procedure:
1.1. Use a brass drift that is the same diameter as the outside diameter of the oil filter bypass
valve.
1.2. Install the oil filter bypass valve into the oil gallery bore until slightly below flush with the
surface of the engine block.
1.3. Using a pointed punch, stake the engine block area around the oil filter bypass valve. Stake in
3 locations 120 degrees apart.
2. Install the oil filter adapter. 3. Install the oil filter. 4. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Oil Filter Bypass Valve Replacement > Page 2119
Oil Filter: Service and Repair Draining Fluids and Oil Filter Removal
Draining Fluids and Oil Filter Removal
1. Remove the oil pan drain plug and allow the engine oil to drain into a suitable container.
2. Remove the oil filter (if applicable). 3. Discard the oil filter (if applicable).
4. Remove both the engine block coolant drain hole plugs and allow the coolant to drain into a
suitable container.
Engine Flywheel Removal
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Oil Filter Bypass Valve Replacement > Page 2120
1. Remove the engine flywheel bolts. 2. Remove the engine flywheel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter Adapter >
Component Information > Specifications
Oil Filter Adapter: Specifications
Oil Filter Adapter Bolt
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 15 ft. lbs.
Oil Filter Fitting
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 41 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter Adapter >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2124
Oil Filter Adapter: Service and Repair
Oil Filter Adapter Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting.
2. Position a suitable container to catch the engine oil. 3. Remove the oil filter. 4. Disconnect the
engine oil cooler pipes from the oil filter adapter. 5. Remove the oil filter adapter.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the oil filter adapter with a NEW gasket. 2. Install the engine oil cooler pipes to the oil filter
adapter. 3. Install the oil filter. 4. Lower the vehicle. 5. Operate the vehicle and check for leaks. 6.
Check the oil level and add as required.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Line, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Oil Line: Specifications
Oil Cooler Line
Oil Cooler Line Clip Bolt
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
........................................ 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
Engine Oil Cooler Lines to Oil Filter Adapter Assembly Bolt
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
........................................... 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Line, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2128
Oil Line: Service and Repair
Engine Oil Cooler Hose/Pipe Replacement
Removal Procedure
Caution: In order to avoid being burned, do not service the engine walls it is still hot Service the
engine when it is cool.
1. Place a drain pan under the oil filter adapter.
2. Disconnect the oil cooler lines from the oil filter adapter assembly.
3. Remove the oil cooler line to engine clip bolt. 4. Remove the oil cooler lines from the engine clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Line, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2129
5. Disconnect the oil cooler lines from the radiator connector fitting by doing the following:
- Use a small pick-type tool or a screwdriver to release one of the open ends of the retaining clip
from the connector fitting.
- Disconnect the retaining clip from the connector fitting.
- Discard the clips.
6. Remove the engine oil cooler lines. 7. Clean all of the components with a suitable solvent. Dry
the components with compressed air. 8. Inspect the following for damage or distortion:
- The connector fittings
- The connectors
- The engine oil cooler lines
Installation Procedure
Important: Inspect the cooler line for a damaged or missing plastic cap. If the plastic cap is
damaged or missing, replace it with a new plastic cap.
1. Install the engine oil cooler lines. 2. Install the new retaining clips into the radiator connector
fittings.
2.1. Using your thumb and forefinger, insert a new retaining clip into one of the three recesses in
the connector fitting (1).
2.2. With one end of the retaining clip engaged in the connector fitting slot, use your thumb to
rotate the retaining clip around the connector fitting (2).
2.3. Snap the clip into place in the connector fitting (3).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Line, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2130
3. Connect the engine oil cooler lines to the connector fittings.
- Verify that a click is heard or felt.
- Pull back sharply on the cooler lines in order to assure that the line fastens into the connector
fittings.
4. Connect the engine oil cooler lines to the engine clip.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
5. Install the engine clip bolt.
Tighten the engine clip bolt to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
6. Install the engine oil cooler lines to the oil filter adapter assembly.
Tighten the oil cooler lines to oil filter adapter assembly bolt to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
7. Start the engine. Check the oil cooler lines for leaks.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Oil Pan: Specifications
Oil Pan Bolt and Nut
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 18 ft. lbs.
Oil Pan Drain Plug
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 18 ft. lbs.
Oil Pan Alignment at Rear of Engine Block
Maximum .............................................................................................................................................
.............................................. 0.3 mm (0.011 inch)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2134
Oil Pan: Service and Repair
Oil Pan Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the oil level indicator. 3. Raise the vehicle.
Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 4. Remove the oil pan drain plug and drain the engine oil into a suitable
container. 5. Remove the oil filter.
6. Remove the bolt holding the oil cooler pipes bracket to the oil pan. 7. Remove the oil filter
adapter.
8. Remove the bolt holding the bracket for the starter wiring harness and the transmission cooler
pipes. 9. Remove the Crankcase Position sensor wiring harness from the retainer.
10. Remove the starter.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2135
11. Remove the transmission cover.
12. Remove the access plugs for the oil pan rear nuts.
13. Remove the transmission to oil pan bolts. 14. Remove the oil pan from the engine. 15. Clean all
sealing surfaces on the engine and the oil pan.
Installation Procedure
Notice: Any time the transmission and the engine oil pan are off of the engine at the same time,
install the transmission before the oil pan. This is to allow for the proper oil pan alignment. Failure
to achieve the correct oil pan alignment can result in transmission failure.
1. Install the oil pan to the engine.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2136
2. Install the transmission to oil pan bolts and nuts.
Tighten the bolts to 47 Nm (34 ft. lbs.).
3. Install the access plugs for the oil pan rear nuts.
4. Install the transmission cover.
Tighten the bolts to 12 Nm (106 inch lbs.).
5. Install the starter motor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2137
6. Install the bolt holding the bracket for the starter wiring harness and the transmission cooler
pipes.
Tighten the bolts to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
7. Install the CKP sensor wiring harness in the retainer. 8. Install the oil filter adapter.
9. Install the oil cooler pipes bracket bolt.
Tighten the bolts to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
10. Install the oil filter.
11. Install the oil pan drain plug.
Tighten the oil pan drain plug to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Fill the crankcase with engine oil. 14. Connect the battery negative
cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Gauge >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Pressure Gauge: Description and Operation
ENGINE OIL PRESSURE GAGE
The IPC displays the engine oil pressure as determined by the PCM. The IPC receives a class 2
message from the PCM indicating the engine oil pressure. The engine oil pressure gage defaults to
0 kPa (0 psi) or below if:
^ The PCM detects a malfunction in the engine oil pressure sensor circuit.
^ The IPC detects a loss of class 2 communications with the PCM.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams
Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications
Oil Pressure Sensor: Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure Gage Sensor
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 22 ft. lbs.
Engine Oil Pressure Gage Sensor Fitting (Plus Required Angle)
Torque..................................................................................................................................................
............................................................... 11 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2147
Oil Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
Engine Oil Pressure Sensor and/or Switch Replacement
Tools Required J41712 Oil Pressure Switch Socket
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Disconnect the engine oil pressure sensor gage electrical
connector. 3. Hold the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting with a wrench.
4. Remove the engine oil pressure gage sensor using J41712.
Important: Note the alignment of the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting prior to removal.
5. Remove the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting, if necessary.
Installation Procedure
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting, if removed.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2148
1.1. Tighten the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.).
Important: Do not loosen the sensor fitting. Do not tighten the sensor fitting more than one turn to
align.
1.2. Tighten the sensor fitting until properly aligned.
2. Install the engine oil pressure gage sensor. 3. Hold the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting
with a wrench to prevent from turning.
Using J41712 tighten the engine oil pressure gage sensor to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
4. Install the engine oil pressure gage sensor electrical connector. 5. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pump Cover >
Component Information > Specifications
Oil Pump Cover: Specifications
Oil Pump Cover Bolt
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 106 inch lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pump, Engine > Engine
Oil Pressure > Component Information > Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure: Specifications
Oil Pressure
Minimum - at Normal Operating Temperature
................................................................................................................... 42 kPa (6 psig) at 1,000
RPM Minimum - at Normal Operating Temperature
............................................................................................................... 125 kPa (18 psig) at 2,000
RPM Minimum - at Normal Operating Temperature
................................................................................................................ 166 kPa (24 psig)at 4,000
RPM
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pump, Engine > Engine
Oil Pressure > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2156
Engine Oil Pressure: Testing and Inspection
Oil Pressure Diagnosis and Testing
1. With the vehicle on a level surface, allow adequate drain down time, 2-3 minutes, and measure
for a low engine oil level. Add the recommended
grade engine oil, and fill the crankcase until the oil level measures FULL on the oil level indicator.
2. Operate the engine and verify low or no oil pressure on the vehicle oil pressure gage or the oil
indicator light. Listen for a noisy valve train or a
knocking noise.
3. Inspect for the following:
- Engine oil diluted by moisture or unburned fuel mixtures
- Improper engine oil viscosity for the expected temperature
- Incorrect or faulty oil pressure gage sensor
- Incorrect or faulty oil pressure gage
- Plugged oil filter
- Malfunctioning oil filter bypass valve
4. Remove the oil pressure gage sensor or another engine block oil gallery plug. 5. Install an oil
pressure gage. 6. Start the engine and then allow the engine to reach normal operation
temperature. 7. Measure the engine oil pressure at the following RPM:
Specification 7.1.
42 kPa (6 psig, minimum, at 1,000 RPM
7.2. 125 kPa (18 psig, minimum, at 2,000 RPM
7.3. 166 kPa (24 psig, minimum, at 4,000 RPM
8. If the engine oil pressure is below minimum specifications, inspect the engine for one or more of
the following:
- Oil pump worn or dirty
- Malfunctioning oil pump pressure relief valve
- Oil pump screen loose, plugged, or damaged
- Excessive bearing clearance
- Cracked, porous or restricted oil galleries
- Engine block oil gallery plugs missing or incorrectly installed
- Broken valve lifters
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - Intake Manifold Inspection/Replacement
Intake Manifold: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Intake Manifold Inspection/Replacement
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-06-01-026C
Date: February 03, 2010
Subject: Intake Manifold Inspection/Replacement After Severe Internal Engine Damage
Models:
2010 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3
2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to include additional model years. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 00-06-01-026B (Section 06 - Engine).
When replacing an engine due to internal damage, extreme care should be taken when transferring
the intake manifold to the new Goodwrench service engine long block. Internal damage may result
in the potential discharge of internal engine component debris in the intake manifold via broken
pistons and/or bent, broken, or missing intake valves. After removing the intake manifold from the
engine, the technician should carefully inspect all of the cylinder head intake ports to see if the
valve heads are still present and not bent. Usually when the valve heads are missing or sufficiently
bent, internal engine component debris will be present to varying degrees in the intake port of the
cylinder head. If this debris is present in any of the cylinder head intake ports, the intake manifold
should be replaced. This replacement is required due to the complex inlet runner and plenum
configuration of most of the intake manifolds, making thorough and complete component cleaning
difficult and nearly impossible to verify complete removal of debris. Re-installation of an intake
manifold removed from an engine with deposits of internal engine component debris may result in
the ingestion of any remaining debris into the new Goodwrench service engine. This may cause
damage or potential failure of the new service engine.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2161
Intake Manifold: Specifications
Accelerator Control Cable Bracket Stud to Intake Manifold
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ 53 inch lbs.
Air Conditioning (A/C) Hose Bracket Nut to Intake Manifold
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ 44 inch lbs.
Engine Wiring Harness Bracket Nut to Intake Manifold
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 106 inch lbs.
Lower Intake Manifold Bolt
Torque:
First Pass .............................................................................................................................................
....................................................... 27 inch lbs. Second Pass ............................................................
................................................................................................................................. 106 inch lbs.
Final Pass ............................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 11 ft. lbs.
Upper Intake Manifold Stud
Torque:
First Pass .............................................................................................................................................
....................................................... 44 inch lbs. Final Pass .................................................................
.................................................................................................................................. 80 inch lbs.
Intake Manifold Surface Flatness
................................................................................................................. 0.10 mm - Maximum (0.004
inch - Maximum)
Tightening Sequence
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Intake Manifold Replacement - Lower
Intake Manifold: Service and Repair Intake Manifold Replacement - Lower
Intake Manifold Replacement - Lower
Removal Procedure
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the engine cover. 3. Drain the cooling system.
4. Remove the air cleaner assembly. 5. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct from the throttle body
assembly. 6. Disconnect the accelerator control cable from the throttle shaft and the accelerator
control cable bracket. 7. Perform this step if the vehicle is equipped with a cruise control.
Disconnect the cruise control cable from the throttle shaft, and from the
accelerator control cable bracket.
8. Disconnect PCV valve hose assembly from the intake manifold and the valve rocker arm cover.
9. Remove the nut holding the A/C hose bracket to the intake manifold stud, if equipped.
10. Remove the nut holding the engine wiring harness bracket to the intake manifold stud.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Intake Manifold Replacement - Lower > Page 2164
11. Disconnect the following electrical connectors:
- The A/C compressor clutch, if equipped (1)
- The A/C high pressure cutoff switch, if equipped (5)
- The Throttle Position (TP) sensor (2)
- The Idle Air Control (IAC) motor (3)
- The fuel meter body assembly connector (4)
12. Disconnect the following electrical connectors:
- The Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) sensor (4)
- The EVAP canister purge solenoid valve (1)
13. Remove the ground wire (2) from the stud at the water outlet.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Intake Manifold Replacement - Lower > Page 2165
14. Remove the nut, and remove the engine wiring harness bracket from the stud, at the EVAP
canister purge solenoid valve. 15. Move and secure the engine wire harness out of the way. 16.
Remove the EVAP canister purge valve. 17. Remove the radiator inlet hose at the water outlet. 18.
Remove the heater hose from the intake manifold.
19. Remove the water pump inlet hose from the intake manifold.
20. Disconnect the vacuum hose from the intake manifold.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Intake Manifold Replacement - Lower > Page 2166
21. Remove the bolt holding the transmission fluid filler tube to the accelerator control cable
bracket.
22. Remove the accelerator control cable bracket from the throttle body and the intake manifold.
23. Remove the distributor. 24. Disconnect the fuel supply, and disconnect the return pipes, at the
rear of the intake manifold. 25. Remove the Ignition Control Module (ICM).
26. In order to remove the front intake manifold bolt, perform the following steps:
26.1. Remove the drive belt.
26.2. Remove the A/C compressor side brace.
26.3. Loosen the nut for the power steering pump rear bracket.
26.4. Remove the oil filler tube bracket bolt and the oil filler tube.
26.5. Remove the bolts and the nut for the power steering pump mounting bracket.
26.6. Leave the A/C compressor, if equipped, and the power steering pump on the bracket.
26.7. Slide the power steering pump bracket forward to access the bolt at the front of the intake
manifold.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Intake Manifold Replacement - Lower > Page 2167
27. Remove the lower intake manifold. 28. Clean all sealing surfaces and the intake manifold. 29. If
the intake manifold requires replacement, refer to Intake Manifold.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the lower intake manifold.
2. Reposition the power steering pump mounting bracket.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the power steering pump mounting bracket three bolts and the nut.
Tighten the power steering pump mounting bracket bolts and the nut and the power steering pump
rear bracket nut to 41 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
4. Install A/C compressor side brace and bolts.
4.1. Tighten the A/C compressor side brace bolt to 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs.).
4.2. Tighten the side brace bolt to the generator bracket to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
5. Install the oil filler tube and bolt.
Tighten the oil filler tube bolt to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
6. Install the drive belt. 7. Install the EVAP canister purge valve. 8. Install the fuel supply and return
pipes to the rear of the intake manifold.
Important: In order to install the distributor for the correct engine timing, position the engine to
number one cylinder top dead center.
9. Remove the spark plug for number one cylinder.
10. Rotate the crankshaft until number one cylinder is in the compression stroke. 11. Align the 2
reference marks on the crankshaft balancer (1, 4) with the 2 alignment marks (2, 3) on the front
cover. 12. Install the spark plug. 13. Install the distributor. 14. Install the ICM.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Intake Manifold Replacement - Lower > Page 2168
15. Install the accelerator control cable bracket, studs, and nuts to the intake manifold and the
throttle body.
Tighten the accelerator control cable bracket nuts and studs to 12 Nm (106 inch lbs.).
16. Install the vacuum hose to the intake manifold.
17. Install the transmission fluid fill tube and bolt to the accelerator control cable bracket.
Tighten the transmission fluid fill tube bolt 6 Nm (53 inch lbs.).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Intake Manifold Replacement - Lower > Page 2169
18. Install the water pump inlet hose to the intake manifold. 19. Install the heater hoses. 20. Install
the radiator inlet hose to the water outlet.
21. Position the engine wiring harness. 22. Connect the following electrical connectors:
- The A/C compressor clutch, if equipped (1)
- The A/C high pressure cutoff switch, if equipped (5)
- The Throttle Position (TP) sensor (2)
- The Idle Air Control (IAC) motor (3)
- The fuel meter body assembly connector (4)
23. Connect the following electrical connectors:
- The Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) sensor (4)
- The EVAP canister purge solenoid valve (1)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Intake Manifold Replacement - Lower > Page 2170
24. Install the ground wire (2) and the nut to the water outlet stud. 25. Tighten the ground wire nut
to 19 Nm (14 ft. lbs.).
26. Install the nut and the engine wiring harness bracket to the stud for the EVAP canister purge
valve.
Tighten the engine wiring harness bracket nut to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs.).
27. Install the nut and the engine wiring harness bracket to the intake manifold stud.
Tighten the engine wiring harness bracket nut to 12 Nm (106 inch lbs.).
28. Install the nut and the A/C hose bracket to the intake manifold stud, if equipped.
Tighten the A/C hose bracket nut to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs.).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Intake Manifold Replacement - Lower > Page 2171
29. Install the PCV valve hose assembly to the intake manifold and the valve rocker arm cover. 30.
Install the cruise control cable, if equipped to the throttle shaft and the accelerator control cable
bracket. 31. Install the accelerator control cable to the throttle shaft and the accelerator control
cable bracket. 32. Refill the cooling system. 33. Install air cleaner outlet duct to the throttle body.
34. Install the air cleaner assembly. 35. Connect the battery negative cable. 36. Install the engine
cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Intake Manifold Replacement - Lower > Page 2172
Intake Manifold: Service and Repair Upper Intake Manifold Replacement
Intake Manifold Replacement - Upper
Removal Procedure
Important: You do not have to remove the upper intake manifold in order to remove the lower
intake manifold.
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct from the throttle body. 3.
Disconnect the accelerator control cable from the throttle shaft and the accelerator control cable
bracket. 4. Disconnect the cruise control cable, if equipped from the throttle shaft and the
accelerator control cable bracket.
5. Remove the PCV valve hose assembly from the intake manifold and the valve rocker arm cover.
6. Remove the nut holding the A/C hose bracket, if equipped to the intake manifold stud. 7.
Remove the A/C hose bracket from the stud. 8. Remove the nut holding the engine wiring harness
bracket to the intake manifold stud. 9. Remove the engine wiring harness bracket from the stud.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Intake Manifold Replacement - Lower > Page 2173
10. Disconnect the following electrical connectors:
- The A/C compressor clutch, if equipped (1)
- The A/C high pressure cutoff switch, if equipped (5)
- The throttle position (TP) sensor (2)
- The idle air control (IAC) motor (3)
- The fuel meter body assembly connector (4)
11. Disconnect the following electrical connectors:
- The Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) sensor (4)
- The EVAP canister purge solenoid valve (1)
12. Remove the engine wiring harness bracket from the stud at the EVAP canister purge solenoid
valve. 13. Move and secure the engine wiring harness out of the way. 14. Remove the EVAP
canister purge valve.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Intake Manifold Replacement - Lower > Page 2174
15. Disconnect the vacuum hose from the intake manifold.
16. Remove the bolt holding the transmission fluid filler tube to the accelerator control cable
bracket.
17. Remove the accelerator control cable bracket from the throttle body and the intake manifold.
18. Remove the fuel lines from the fuel meter body assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Intake Manifold Replacement - Lower > Page 2175
19. Remove the studs for the upper intake manifold. 20. Remove the upper intake manifold.
21. Remove the upper intake manifold gasket from the groove. 22. Discard the gasket.
23. Remove the seal from the fuel meter body assembly. 24. Discard the seal.
Important: Do not immerse the assembled upper intake manifold in cleaning solvent.
25. Clean all sealing surfaces and the inside of the upper intake manifold with a shop towel and
cleaning solvent. 26. Inspect the upper intake manifold for the following:
- Cracks or other damage to the exterior
- Cracking or damage to the gasket grooves
- Loose or damaged bolt hole thread inserts
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Intake Manifold Replacement - Lower > Page 2176
27. If replacing the upper intake manifold, turn and remove the PCV valve cover from the upper
intake manifold. 28. Remove and discard the seal. 29. Remove the throttle body if replacing the
upper intake manifold. 30. Remove the MAP sensor if replacing the upper intake manifold.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the throttle body, if removed. 2. Install the MAP sensor, if removed.
3. Install the PCV valve cover, if removed, using the following procedure:
3.1. Install a NEW seal (O-ring) on the PCV valve cover.
3.2. Lubricate the seal with clean engine oil.
3.3. Install the PCV valve cover in the upper intake manifold.
3.4. Turn and lock the PCV valve cover in position.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Intake Manifold Replacement - Lower > Page 2177
4. Install a NEW seal on the fuel meter body assembly. 5. Lubricate the seal with clean engine oil.
6. Install a NEW upper intake manifold to lower intake manifold gasket in the groove of the upper
intake manifold.
7. Install the upper intake manifold onto the lower intake manifold. 8. If reusing the fasteners, apply
threadlock GM P/N 12345382 or equivalent to the threads of the upper intake manifold attaching
bolts.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
9. Install the upper intake manifold attaching studs.
9.1. Tighten the upper intake manifold attaching studs on the first pass to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs.).
9.2. Tighten the upper intake manifold attaching studs on the final pass to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.).
10. Install the fuel lines to the fuel meter body assembly. 11. Install the EVAP canister purge valve.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Intake Manifold Replacement - Lower > Page 2178
12. Install the accelerator control cable bracket, studs, and nuts to the intake manifold and the
throttle body.
Tighten the accelerator control cable bracket nuts and studs to 12 Nm (106 inch lbs.).
13. Connect the vacuum hose to the intake manifold.
14. Install the transmission fluid fill tube and bolt to the accelerator control cable bracket.
Tighten the transmission fluid fill tube bolt 6 Nm (53 inch lbs.).
15. Position the engine wiring harness.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Intake Manifold Replacement - Lower > Page 2179
16. Connect the following electrical connectors:
- The A/C compressor clutch, if equipped (1)
- The A/C high pressure cutoff switch, if equipped (5)
- The Throttle Position (TP) sensor (2)
- The Idle Air Control (IAC) motor (3)
- The fuel meter body assembly connector (4)
17. Connect the following electrical connectors:
- The Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) sensor (4)
- The EVAP canister purge solenoid valve (1)
18. Install the engine wiring harness bracket and nut to the intake manifold stud.
Tighten the engine wiring harness bracket nut to 12 Nm (106 inch lbs.).
19. Install the A/C hose bracket and nut, if equipped to the intake manifold stud.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Intake Manifold Replacement - Lower > Page 2180
Tighten the A/C hose bracket nut to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs.).
20. Install the engine wiring harness bracket and the nut onto the stud at the EVAP canister purge
solenoid valve.
Tighten the engine wiring harness bracket nut to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs.).
21. Connect the PCV valve hose assembly to the intake manifold and the valve rocker arm cover.
22. Install the cruise control cable, if equipped to the throttle shaft and the accelerator control cable
bracket. 23. Install the accelerator control cable to the throttle shaft and the accelerator control
cable bracket. 24. Install the air cleaner outlet duct to the throttle body assembly. 25. Install the
engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Gauge > Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Pressure Gauge: Description and Operation
ENGINE OIL PRESSURE GAGE
The IPC displays the engine oil pressure as determined by the PCM. The IPC receives a class 2
message from the PCM indicating the engine oil pressure. The engine oil pressure gage defaults to
0 kPa (0 psi) or below if:
^ The PCM detects a malfunction in the engine oil pressure sensor circuit.
^ The IPC detects a loss of class 2 communications with the PCM.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Specifications
Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal: Specifications
Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal
Rear Oil Seal Housing Bolt and Nut
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 106 inch lbs.
Rear Oil Seal Housing Retainer Stud
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
...................................................... 53 inch lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Replacement
Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal: Service and Repair Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Replacement
Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Replacement
Tools Required J35621-B Rear Main Seal Installer
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the transmission assembly. 2. Remove the engine flywheel.
3. Remove the crankshaft rear oil seal from the crankshaft rear oil seal housing.
Insert a suitable tool into the access notches and then carefully pry the crankshaft rear oil seal from
the crankshaft rear oil seal housing.
4. Discard the crankshaft rear oil seal. 5. Clean off any dirt or rust in the area.
Installation Procedure
1. Apply a small amount (2 to 3 drops) of clean engine oil to the bore of the crankshaft rear oil seal
housing. 2. Apply a small amount (2 to 3 drops) of clean engine oil to the outside diameter of the
engine flywheel pilot flange. 3. Apply a small amount (1 drop) of clean engine oil to the outside
diameter of the flywheel locator pin. 4. Apply a small amount (2 to 3 drops) of clean engine oil to
the crankshaft seal surface.
5. Inspect the J35621-B flange for imperfections that may damage the crankshaft rear oil seal.
Minor imperfections may be removed with a fine grade emery cloth.
Important: DO NOT allow oil or any other lubricants to contact the seal lip surface of the crankshaft
rear oil seal.
6. Remove the sleeve from the crankshaft rear oil seal. 7. Apply a small amount (2 to 3 drops) of
clean engine oil to the outside diameter of the crankshaft rear oil seal. 8. Install the crankshaft rear
oil seal onto the J35621-B. 9. Install the J35621-B onto the rear of the crankshaft and hand tighten
the tool bolts until snug.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Replacement > Page 2191
Notice: Proper alignment of the crankshaft rear oil seal is critical. Install the crankshaft rear oil seal
near to flush and square to the crankshaft rear oil seal housing. Failing to do so may cause the
crankshaft rear oil seal or the crankshaft rear oil seal installation tool to fail.
10. Install the crankshaft rear oil seal onto the crankshaft and into the crankshaft rear oil seal
housing.
10.1. Turn the J35621-B wing nut clockwise until the crankshaft rear oil seal is installed near to
flush and square to the crankshaft rear oil seal
housing. Increased resistance will be felt when the crankshaft rear oil seal has reached the bottom
of the crankshaft rear oil seal housing bore.
10.2. Turn the J35621-B wing nut counterclockwise to release the J35621-B from the crankshaft
rear oil seal.
11. Remove the J35621-B from the crankshaft. 12. Wipe off any excess engine oil with a clean rag.
13. Install the engine flywheel. 14. Install the transmission assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Replacement > Page 2192
Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal: Service and Repair Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Housing Replacement
Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Housing Replacement
Removal Procedure
Important: Do not remove the crankshaft rear oil seal housing if only replacing the crankshaft rear
oil seal.
1. Remove the oil pan. 2. Remove the transmission assembly. 3. Remove the engine flywheel.
4. Remove the bolts and the nut holding the crankshaft rear oil seal housing to the engine. 5.
Remove the crankshaft rear oil seal housing.
6. Remove and discard the crankshaft rear oil seal housing gasket. 7. Clean all the sealing
surfaces. 8. Inspect and replace the crankshaft rear oil seal housing for warping, cracks, wear, or
damage.
Installation Procedure
Important: When installing a NEW crankshaft rear oil seal housing the crankshaft rear oil seal will
come with the housing. If reusing the housing and then installing a NEW seal follow the instructions
for installing the housing and than
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Replacement > Page 2193
1. Install a NEW crankshaft rear oil seal housing gasket.
2. Install the NEW crankshaft rear oil seal housing with the oil seal to the engine block using the
following procedure.
Important: Do not oil or grease the seal lip or the crankshaft seal area.
2.1. Leave the sleeve in the crankshaft rear oil seal and use the sleeve as a guide to ease the seal
lip over the end of the crankshaft.
2.2. Push the crankshaft rear oil seal housing fully onto the crankshaft until the crankshaft rear oil
seal housing is against the crankshaft rear oil seal gasket and the engine.
2.3. Remove the sleeve.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the bolts and the nut to the crankshaft rear oil seal housing.
Tighten the crankshaft rear oil seal housing bolts and nut to 12 Nm (106 inch lbs.).
4. Install the engine flywheel.
Notice: Any time the transmission and the engine oil pan are off of the engine at the same time,
install the transmission before the oil pan. This is to allow for the proper oil pan alignment. Failure
to achieve the correct oil pan alignment can result in transmission failure.
5. Install the transmission assembly. 6. Install the oil pan.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft
Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair
Front Crankshaft Seal: Service and Repair
Crankshaft Front Oil Seal Replacement
Tools Required J35468 Crankshaft Aligner/Seal Installer
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the crankshaft balancer.
2. Use a suitable prying tool to remove the crankshaft front oil seal. 3. Inspect the engine front
cover seal bore for damage. 4. Inspect the crankshaft balancer seal area.
Installation Procedure
1. Lubricate the exterior of the crankshaft front oil seal with clean engine oil.
2. Use the J35468 with a hammer in order to install the crankshaft front oil seal. 3. Inspect to
ensure the crankshaft front oil seal is flush and square to the engine front cover. 4. Install the
crankshaft balancer.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 1539013 > Jul > 04 > Engine - SES Lamp
ON/Misfire DTC' Set Towing Uphill
Valve Guide Seal: Customer Interest Engine - SES Lamp ON/Misfire DTC' Set Towing Uphill
Subject: SES Light and P0300 When Towing, Cruising Uphill or on hard Acceleration - kw 4.3, 5.0,
5.7 accelerate cruise cylinderhead DTC L30, L31, L35, LF6, LU3, P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303,
P0304, P0305, P0306, P0307 P0308 # PIP3081 - (07/23/2004)
Models:
The following diagnosis might be helpful if the vehicle exhibits the symptom described in the PI.
Condition/Concern:
The vehicle may exhibit a SES Light due to a P0300 and misfire. If the misfire is related to the
information below, it will typically happen while cruising uphill, pulling a trailer or on hard
acceleration and then stop misfiring shortly after returning to an idle. Typically, cylinders 3, 4, 5 or 6
will be the ones to experience this.
Recommendation/Instructions:
If the P0300 SI diagnostics did not isolate a concern, the following may help:
Remove the valve cover, valve springs and valve seals on the effected cylinder or cylinders. A
small wire tie or rubber bands can be placed in the valve stem keeper groove to prevent the valve
from falling into the cylinder. Rotate the valve while moving it up and down in the guide to see if it
binds. If a binding valve is found, remove both cylinder heads and use either of the following
methods to increase the stem to guide clearance:
^ Send the head out to a machine shop and advise them to increase the valve stem to guide
clearance to 0.002 inch per guide.
^ Hone the guide with a 9 mm hone, such as Snap On BCG249, until a clearance of 0.002 inch is
obtained. This will usually take about 4 strokes of the hone.
Reassemble the cylinder heads using new valve seals.
Please follow this diagnosis process thoroughly and complete each step. If the condition exhibited
is resolved without completing every step, the remaining steps do not need to be performed. If
these steps do not resolve the condition, please contact GM TAC for further diagnostic assistance.
Models Affected
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 1539013 > Jul > 04 > Engine SES Lamp ON/Misfire DTC' Set Towing Uphill
Valve Guide Seal: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - SES Lamp ON/Misfire DTC' Set Towing
Uphill
Subject: SES Light and P0300 When Towing, Cruising Uphill or on hard Acceleration - kw 4.3, 5.0,
5.7 accelerate cruise cylinderhead DTC L30, L31, L35, LF6, LU3, P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303,
P0304, P0305, P0306, P0307 P0308 # PIP3081 - (07/23/2004)
Models:
The following diagnosis might be helpful if the vehicle exhibits the symptom described in the PI.
Condition/Concern:
The vehicle may exhibit a SES Light due to a P0300 and misfire. If the misfire is related to the
information below, it will typically happen while cruising uphill, pulling a trailer or on hard
acceleration and then stop misfiring shortly after returning to an idle. Typically, cylinders 3, 4, 5 or 6
will be the ones to experience this.
Recommendation/Instructions:
If the P0300 SI diagnostics did not isolate a concern, the following may help:
Remove the valve cover, valve springs and valve seals on the effected cylinder or cylinders. A
small wire tie or rubber bands can be placed in the valve stem keeper groove to prevent the valve
from falling into the cylinder. Rotate the valve while moving it up and down in the guide to see if it
binds. If a binding valve is found, remove both cylinder heads and use either of the following
methods to increase the stem to guide clearance:
^ Send the head out to a machine shop and advise them to increase the valve stem to guide
clearance to 0.002 inch per guide.
^ Hone the guide with a 9 mm hone, such as Snap On BCG249, until a clearance of 0.002 inch is
obtained. This will usually take about 4 strokes of the hone.
Reassemble the cylinder heads using new valve seals.
Please follow this diagnosis process thoroughly and complete each step. If the condition exhibited
is resolved without completing every step, the remaining steps do not need to be performed. If
these steps do not resolve the condition, please contact GM TAC for further diagnostic assistance.
Models Affected
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Guide Seal: > 01-07-30-036H >
Jan > 09 > A/T Control - DTC P0756 Diagnostic Tips
Valve Body: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T Control - DTC P0756 Diagnostic Tips
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 01-07-30-036H
Date: January 29, 2009
Subject: Diagnostic Tips for Automatic Transmission DTC P0756, Second, Third, Fourth Gear Start
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
with 4L60-E, 4L65-E or 4L70E Automatic Transmission (RPOs M30, M32 or M70)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2009 model year and add details regarding spacer plates.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 01-07-30-036G (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Some dealership technicians may have difficulty diagnosing DTC P0756, 2-3 Shift Valve
Performance on 4L60-E, 4L65-E or 4L70E automatic transmissions. As detailed in the Service
Manual, when the PCM detects a 4-3-3-4 shift pattern, DTC P0756 will set. Some customers may
also describe a condition of a second, third or fourth gear start that may have the same causes but
has not set this DTC yet. Below are some tips when diagnosing this DTC:
^ This is a performance code. This means that a mechanical malfunction exists.
^ This code is not set by electrical issues such as a damaged wiring harness or poor electrical
connections. Electrical problems would cause a DTC P0758, P0787 or P0788 to set.
^ The most likely cause is chips/debris plugging the filtered AFL oil at orifice # 29 on the top of the
spacer plate (48). This is a very small hole and is easily plugged by a small amount of debris. It is
important to remove the spacer plate and inspect orifice # 29 and the immediate area for the
presence of chips/debris. Also, the transmission case passage directly above this orifice and the
valve body passage directly below should be inspected and cleaned of any chips/debris. For 2003
and newer vehicles the spacer plate should be replaced. The service replacement spacer plate is a
bonded style with gaskets and solenoid filter screens bonded to the spacer plate. These screens
can help to prevent plugging of orifice # 29 caused by small debris or chips.
^ This code could be set if the 2-3 shift valve (368) were stuck or hung-up in its bore. Inspect the
2-3 shift valve (368) and the 2-3 shuttle valve (369) for free movement or damage and clean the
valves, the bore and the valve body passages.
^ This code could be set by a 2-3 shift solenoid (367b) if it were cracked, broken or leaking. Refer
to Shift Solenoid Leak Test in the appropriate Service Manual for the leak test procedure. Based on
parts return findings, a damaged or leaking shift solenoid is the least likely cause of this condition.
Simply replacing a shift solenoid will not correct this condition unless the solenoid has been found
to be cracked, broken or leaking.
It is important to also refer to the appropriate Service Manual or Service Information (SI) for further
possible causes of this condition.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Guide Seal: > 07-07-30-024 >
Sep > 07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning
Valve Body: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning
Bulletin No.: 07-07-30-024
Date: September 27, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Information on 4L60-E M30 Rear Wheel Drive Automatic Transmission Valve Body
Reconditioning, DTC P0741, P0756, P0894, Harsh 1-2 Shift
Models
The following new service information outlined in this bulletin will aid technicians in providing easy
to follow valve body reconditioning instructions and new illustrations to simplify reassembly of the
valve body. This service bulletin will also provide additional service information documents that are
related to the 4L60-E transmission.
Related Service Documents
DTC P0741 - Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) System - Stuck Off. Refer to Service Bulletin
04-07-30-041.
DTC P0756 - 2-3 Shift Solenoid Valve Performance - No First or Second Gear. Refer to Service
Bulletin 01-07-30-036F.
DTC P0894 - Transmission Component Slipping. Refer to Service Bulletin 06-07-30-007.
Harsh 1-2 Shift. Refer to Bulletin PIP3170E.
If valve body cleaning is not required, Do Not disassemble the bores unless it is necessary to verify
movement of valves.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Guide Seal: > 07-07-30-024 >
Sep > 07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 2219
Inspection Procedure
Using the exploded views in this bulletin, inspect each bore for freedom of valve(s) movement and
evidence of debris. Pay particular attention to those valves related to the customer's concern.
Verify movement of the valves in their normal installed position. Valves may become restricted
during removal or installation. This is normal due to small tolerances between the valves and
bores.
If a valve is restricted and cannot be corrected by cleaning the valve and bore, then replace the
valve body. Describe the restricted valve on the repair order.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Guide Seal: > 07-07-30-024 >
Sep > 07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 2220
Valve Body Spring and Bore Plug Chart (inch)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Guide Seal: > 07-07-30-024 >
Sep > 07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 2221
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Guide Seal: > 07-07-30-024 >
Sep > 07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 2222
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Guide Seal: > 07-07-30-024 >
Sep > 07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 2223
Left Side Control Valve Body Assembly
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Guide Seal: > 07-07-30-024 >
Sep > 07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 2224
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Guide Seal: > 07-07-30-024 >
Sep > 07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 2225
Right Side Control Valve Body Assembly
Be sure all solenoids are installed with the electrical connectors facing the non-machined (cast)
side of the valve body; otherwise the solenoids will bind against the transmission case as the valve
body bolts are tightened and damage may occur.
Disassembly/Reassembly
If a valve is restricted by a metal burr from machining that bore, remove the valve and burr, then
inspect movement in the valve's normal position. If no
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Guide Seal: > 07-07-30-024 >
Sep > 07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 2226
other debris or restrictions are found, then reassemble the valve body and install in the
transmission.
If the valve body has been contaminated with debris from another transmission component failure,
then disassemble all bores for complete cleaning of all valve body components. If possible, keep
individual bore parts separated for ease of reassembly. Use the illustrations in this bulletin for a
positive identification and location of individual parts:
Using GM Brake Clean, or equivalent, in a safe and clean environment (clean aluminum pan),
clean the valve body and dry it with compressed air. Use appropriate eye protection.
Clean individual valve body components with GM Brake Clean, or equivalent. Coat each valve with
clean ATF and reassemble in each bore. Check each valve for free movement during assembly of
each bore.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Guide Seal: > 01-07-30-038D >
Sep > 06 > A/T - Poor Performance/MIL ON/DTC P0757
Valve Body: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Poor Performance/MIL ON/DTC P0757
Bulletin No.: 01-07-30-038D
Date: September 12, 2006
TECHNICAL
Subject: Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) P0757 Set, Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Illuminated,
Poor Performance of Transmission, Transmission Slipping (Clean Transmission Valve Body and
Case Oil Passages of Debris)
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2003-2007 HUMMER H2
2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
with 4L60-E/4L65-E/4L70-E Automatic Transmission (RPOs M30/M32/M70)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2007 model year and the 4L70-E transmission. Also,
information has been added to Condition, Cause and Correction.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 01-07-30-038C (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Condition
Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions:
An illuminated MIL where DTC P0757 is found as a history code in the PCM or TCM.
No 3rd and 4th gear.
The transmission does not shift correctly.
The transmission feels like it shifts to Neutral or a loss of drive occurs.
The vehicle free wheels above 48 km/h (30 mph). High RPM needed to overcome the free
wheeling.
Cause
This condition may be caused by any of the following:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Guide Seal: > 01-07-30-038D >
Sep > 06 > A/T - Poor Performance/MIL ON/DTC P0757 > Page 2231
Chips or debris plugging the bleed orifice of the 2-3 shift solenoid (367). This will cause the
transmission to stay in 2nd gear when 3rd gear is commanded and return to 1st gear when 4th
gear is commanded.
A 2-3 shift valve (368) or 2-3 shuttle valve (369) that is stuck, restricted and/or hung-up in its bore.
This condition may also be an indication of a damaged 2-4 band or 3-4 clutches. This clutch
damage may generate debris causing the 2-3 shift valve line-up to stick in the valve body bore and
set DTC P0757.
Correction
Inspect the condition of the transmission fluid for signs of overheat or a burnt odor. If either is
noted, the transmission should be disassembled for further investigation and repaired as needed.
Inspect the inside of the oil pan for signs of clutch friction material. A small amount of friction
material in the bottom of the pan is normal. If a large amount of clutch material is noted in the fluid
or bottom pan, the transmission should be disassembled for further investigation and repaired as
needed.
Inspect and clean the 2-3 shift valve (368), the 2-3 shuttle valve (369) and the valve bore of
debris/metal chips.
Inspect and clean the 2-3 shift solenoid (367B) opening of debris/metal chips. While inspecting the
2-3 shift solenoid (367B), look for a screen over the solenoid opening. If the solenoid DOES NOT
have a screen, replace the solenoid. All current GMSPO stock shift solenoids have a screen over
the solenoid opening.
If clutch debris is found, it is also very important to inspect the pressure control (PC) solenoid valve
fluid screens. Clean or replace the PC solenoid as necessary. It is also important to flush and flow
check the transmission oil cooler using J 45096. Refer to SI "Automatic Transmission Oil Cooler
Flushing and Flow Test" for the procedure.
Refer to the appropriate Service Manual for additional diagnostic information and service
procedures.
Warranty Information
For repairs performed under warranty, use the applicable published labor code and information.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Guide Seal: > 01-07-30-030B >
Oct > 05 > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E Harsh 1-2 Upshift Diagnosis
Valve Body: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E Harsh 1-2 Upshift Diagnosis
Bulletin No.: 01-07-30-030B
Date: October 18, 2005
INFORMATION
Subject: 4L60-E/4L65-E Automatic Transmission Diagnostic Information on Harsh 1-2 Upshift
Models: 2001-2006 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2003-2006 HUMMER H2 2006
HUMMER H3 2005-2006 Saab 9-7X
with 4L60-E or 4L65-E Automatic Transmission
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years and models. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 01-07-30-030A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The following four conditions have been found to cause the majority of consistent, harsh 1-2 shift
comments.
^ Chips/Sediment/Debris/Contamination found in the valve body, 1-2 accumulator valve (371) bore,
may cause the 1-2 accumulator valve to stick or hang-up.
^ Chips/Sediment/Debris/Contamination found in the valve body, 4-3 sequence valve (383) bore,
may cause the 4-3 sequence valve to stick or hang-up.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Guide Seal: > 01-07-30-030B >
Oct > 05 > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E Harsh 1-2 Upshift Diagnosis > Page 2236
A cracked 1-2 accumulator piston (56) that is allowing fluid to leak by.
Mislocated/Missing valve body-to-spacer plate check balls (61).
When attempting to correct a consistent harsh 1-2 shift, the four conditions listed above should be
inspected as possible causes. It is important to also refer to the appropriate Service Manual for
further possible causes of this condition.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Guide Seal: > 01-07-30-030B >
Oct > 05 > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E Harsh 1-2 Upshift Diagnosis > Page 2237
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Guide Seal: > 01-07-30-030B >
Oct > 05 > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E Harsh 1-2 Upshift Diagnosis > Page 2238
This diagnostic table should be used when addressing a harsh 1-2 shift concern.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Guide Seal: > 07-07-30-024 >
Sep > 07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 2248
Inspection Procedure
Using the exploded views in this bulletin, inspect each bore for freedom of valve(s) movement and
evidence of debris. Pay particular attention to those valves related to the customer's concern.
Verify movement of the valves in their normal installed position. Valves may become restricted
during removal or installation. This is normal due to small tolerances between the valves and
bores.
If a valve is restricted and cannot be corrected by cleaning the valve and bore, then replace the
valve body. Describe the restricted valve on the repair order.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Guide Seal: > 07-07-30-024 >
Sep > 07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 2249
Valve Body Spring and Bore Plug Chart (inch)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Guide Seal: > 07-07-30-024 >
Sep > 07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 2250
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Guide Seal: > 07-07-30-024 >
Sep > 07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 2251
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Guide Seal: > 07-07-30-024 >
Sep > 07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 2252
Left Side Control Valve Body Assembly
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Guide Seal: > 07-07-30-024 >
Sep > 07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 2253
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Guide Seal: > 07-07-30-024 >
Sep > 07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 2254
Right Side Control Valve Body Assembly
Be sure all solenoids are installed with the electrical connectors facing the non-machined (cast)
side of the valve body; otherwise the solenoids will bind against the transmission case as the valve
body bolts are tightened and damage may occur.
Disassembly/Reassembly
If a valve is restricted by a metal burr from machining that bore, remove the valve and burr, then
inspect movement in the valve's normal position. If no
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Guide Seal: > 07-07-30-024 >
Sep > 07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 2255
other debris or restrictions are found, then reassemble the valve body and install in the
transmission.
If the valve body has been contaminated with debris from another transmission component failure,
then disassemble all bores for complete cleaning of all valve body components. If possible, keep
individual bore parts separated for ease of reassembly. Use the illustrations in this bulletin for a
positive identification and location of individual parts:
Using GM Brake Clean, or equivalent, in a safe and clean environment (clean aluminum pan),
clean the valve body and dry it with compressed air. Use appropriate eye protection.
Clean individual valve body components with GM Brake Clean, or equivalent. Coat each valve with
clean ATF and reassemble in each bore. Check each valve for free movement during assembly of
each bore.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Guide Seal: > 01-07-30-038D >
Sep > 06 > A/T - Poor Performance/MIL ON/DTC P0757 > Page 2260
Chips or debris plugging the bleed orifice of the 2-3 shift solenoid (367). This will cause the
transmission to stay in 2nd gear when 3rd gear is commanded and return to 1st gear when 4th
gear is commanded.
A 2-3 shift valve (368) or 2-3 shuttle valve (369) that is stuck, restricted and/or hung-up in its bore.
This condition may also be an indication of a damaged 2-4 band or 3-4 clutches. This clutch
damage may generate debris causing the 2-3 shift valve line-up to stick in the valve body bore and
set DTC P0757.
Correction
Inspect the condition of the transmission fluid for signs of overheat or a burnt odor. If either is
noted, the transmission should be disassembled for further investigation and repaired as needed.
Inspect the inside of the oil pan for signs of clutch friction material. A small amount of friction
material in the bottom of the pan is normal. If a large amount of clutch material is noted in the fluid
or bottom pan, the transmission should be disassembled for further investigation and repaired as
needed.
Inspect and clean the 2-3 shift valve (368), the 2-3 shuttle valve (369) and the valve bore of
debris/metal chips.
Inspect and clean the 2-3 shift solenoid (367B) opening of debris/metal chips. While inspecting the
2-3 shift solenoid (367B), look for a screen over the solenoid opening. If the solenoid DOES NOT
have a screen, replace the solenoid. All current GMSPO stock shift solenoids have a screen over
the solenoid opening.
If clutch debris is found, it is also very important to inspect the pressure control (PC) solenoid valve
fluid screens. Clean or replace the PC solenoid as necessary. It is also important to flush and flow
check the transmission oil cooler using J 45096. Refer to SI "Automatic Transmission Oil Cooler
Flushing and Flow Test" for the procedure.
Refer to the appropriate Service Manual for additional diagnostic information and service
procedures.
Warranty Information
For repairs performed under warranty, use the applicable published labor code and information.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Guide Seal: > 01-07-30-030B >
Oct > 05 > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E Harsh 1-2 Upshift Diagnosis > Page 2265
A cracked 1-2 accumulator piston (56) that is allowing fluid to leak by.
Mislocated/Missing valve body-to-spacer plate check balls (61).
When attempting to correct a consistent harsh 1-2 shift, the four conditions listed above should be
inspected as possible causes. It is important to also refer to the appropriate Service Manual for
further possible causes of this condition.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Guide Seal: > 01-07-30-030B >
Oct > 05 > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E Harsh 1-2 Upshift Diagnosis > Page 2266
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Guide Seal: > 01-07-30-030B >
Oct > 05 > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E Harsh 1-2 Upshift Diagnosis > Page 2267
This diagnostic table should be used when addressing a harsh 1-2 shift concern.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2268
Valve Guide Seal: Specifications
Valve Stem
Clearance - Intake
Production
................................................................................................................................................... 0.025
- 0.069 mm (0.0010 - 0.0027 inch) Service
.........................................................................................................................................................
0.025 - 0.094 mm (0.0010 - 0.0037 inch)
Clearance - Exhaust
Production
................................................................................................................................................... 0.025
- 0.069 mm (0.0010 - 0.0027 inch) Service
.........................................................................................................................................................
0.025 - 0.094 mm (0.0010 - 0.0037 inch)
Oil Seal Installed Height
............................................................................................................................................. 1 - 2 mm
(0.03937 - 0.07874 inch) (Measured from the Top of the Large Diameter Valve Guide Bevel to the
Bottom of the Valve Stem Oil Seal)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2269
Valve Guide Seal: Service and Repair
Valve Stem Oil Seal and Valve Spring Replacement
Tools Required J22794 Spark Plug Port Adapter
- J38606 Valve Spring Compressor
- J5892-D Valve Spring Compressor
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the valve rocker arm cover. 2. Remove the required valve rocker arms. 3. Remove the
required spark plugs.
4. Install the J22794 into the spark plug hole. 5. Connect a shop air supply hose and apply
compressed air in order to hold the valves in place.
6. Remove a bolt from a valve rocker arm. 7. Install a flat washer on the bolt. 8. Install the bolt in
the valve rocker arm bolt hole for the valve spring requiring removal.
Caution: Compressed valve springs have high tension against the valve spring compressor. Valve
springs that are not properly compressed by or released from the valve spring compressor can be
ejected from the valve spring compressor with intense force. Use care when compressing or
releasing the valve spring with the valve spring compressor and when removing or installing the
valve stem keys. Failing to use care may cause personal injury.
9. Use the J5892-D in order to compress the valve spring.
9.1. Hook the slotted end of J5892-D under the washer on the valve rocker arm bolt.
9.2. Apply steady pressure on the valve spring cap until the valve keys are accessible.
Notice: Completely engage the J38606 jaws on the valve spring. The J38606 may slip off and
scratch the valve spring. Replace the valve spring if the valve spring becomes scratch.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2270
10. Use J38606 when J5892-D will not fit.
11. Remove the valve keys (1). 12. Carefully release the valve spring tension. 13. Remove the
J5892-D or J38606 14. Remove the valve spring cap (2) and valve spring (3). 15. Remove the
valve stem oil seal (4).
Installation Procedure
1. Install the valve seals (4). 2. Install the valve spring (3). 3. Install the valve spring cap (2) on the
valve stem.
Caution: Compressed valve springs have high tension against the valve spring compressor. Valve
springs that are not properly compressed
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2271
by or released from the valve spring compressor can be ejected from the valve spring compressor
with intense force. Use care when compressing or releasing the valve spring with the valve spring
compressor and when removing or installing the valve stem keys. Failing to use care may cause
personal injury.
4. To press the valve spring (3) use the J5892-D.
Notice: Completely engage the J38606 jaws on the valve spring. The J38606 may slip off and
scratch the valve spring. Replace the valve spring if the valve spring becomes scratch.
5. Use the J38606 if the clearance does not permit use of the J5892-D. 6. Install the valve stem
keys. Use grease in order to hold the valve stem keys in place.
7. Carefully release the valve spring pressure, making sure the valve stem keys stay in place.
Notice: The valve stem keys must correctly seat in the valve spring cap. Engine damage may occur
by not installing properly.
8. Remove the J5892-D or the J38606.
8.1. Look to ensure that the valve stem keys seat properly in the upper groove of the valve stem.
8.2. Tap the end of the valve stem with a plastic faced hammer in to seat the valve stem keys, if
necessary.
9. Remove the J22794.
10. Install the spark plugs. 11. Install the valve rocker arms to the cylinder head. 12. Install the
valve rocker arm cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sender > Component Information > Diagrams
Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Oil Pressure Sensor: Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure Gage Sensor
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 22 ft. lbs.
Engine Oil Pressure Gage Sensor Fitting (Plus Required Angle)
Torque..................................................................................................................................................
............................................................... 11 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2279
Oil Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
Engine Oil Pressure Sensor and/or Switch Replacement
Tools Required J41712 Oil Pressure Switch Socket
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Disconnect the engine oil pressure sensor gage electrical
connector. 3. Hold the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting with a wrench.
4. Remove the engine oil pressure gage sensor using J41712.
Important: Note the alignment of the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting prior to removal.
5. Remove the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting, if necessary.
Installation Procedure
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting, if removed.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2280
1.1. Tighten the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.).
Important: Do not loosen the sensor fitting. Do not tighten the sensor fitting more than one turn to
align.
1.2. Tighten the sensor fitting until properly aligned.
2. Install the engine oil pressure gage sensor. 3. Hold the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting
with a wrench to prevent from turning.
Using J41712 tighten the engine oil pressure gage sensor to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
4. Install the engine oil pressure gage sensor electrical connector. 5. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Balance Shaft >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - Balance Shaft Rattling Noises (Cancellation)
Balance Shaft: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Balance Shaft Rattling Noises (Cancellation)
Bulletin No.: 00-06-01-023C
Date: August 30, 2006
TECHNICAL
Subject: Engine/Balance Shaft "Rattle" Noise
Models: 1992-2003 Chevrolet and GMC C/K, S/T, M/L, G and P Models 1992-2001 Oldsmobile
Bravada
with 4.3 L V6 Engine (VINs W, X - RPOs L35, LF6, LU3)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to cancel this bulletin. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
00-06-01-023B (Section 06 -- Engine/Propulsion System).
Technicians should refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 03-06-01-024C for information on
engine/balance shaft "rattle" noise concerns.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Balance Shaft >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2286
Balance Shaft: Specifications
Balance Shaft Driven Gear Bolt
Torque:
First Pass .............................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 15 ft. lbs. Final Pass .................................................................
................................................................................................................................... 35 degrees
Balance Shaft Retainer Bolt ................................................................................................................
............................................................ 106 inch lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Balance Shaft >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2287
Balance Shaft: Service and Repair
Balance Shaft Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the radiator. 2. Remove the A/C condenser, if equipped. 3. Remove the valve lifter
pushrod guide. 4. Remove the camshaft timing chain and sprockets.
Important: The balance shaft and the front bearing are serviced only as a package. Do not remove
the bearing from the balance shaft.
5. Remove the balance shaft. 6. Clean and inspect the balance shaft.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the balance shaft. 2. Install the camshaft timing chain and the camshaft sprocket. 3. Install
the crankshaft position reluctor ring and the engine front cover. 4. Install the valve lifter pushrod
guide. 5. Install the A/C condenser, if equipped. 6. Install the radiator.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Balance Shaft Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications
Balance Shaft Bearing: Specifications
Balance Shaft Bearing
Rear Bearing Journal Clearance
.......................................................................................................................... 0.050 - 0.088 mm
(0.0020-0.0035 inch) Rear Bearing Journal Diameter
....................................................................................................................... 38.085 - 38.100 mm
(1.4994 - 1.500 inch)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Balance Shaft Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2291
Balance Shaft Bearing: Service and Repair
Balance Shaft Bearing and/or Bushing Replacement
Removal Procedure
Important: The balance shaft and the front bearing are serviced only as a package. Do not remove
the bearing from the balance shaft.
1. Remove the balance shaft. 2. Remove the balance shaft rear bearing.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the balance shaft rear bearing. 2. Install the balance shaft.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Camshaft Gear/Sprocket >
Component Information > Specifications
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Specifications
Camshaft Sprocket Bolt
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 18 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Camshaft Gear/Sprocket >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2295
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Service and Repair
Timing Chain and Sprockets Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the engine front cover.
2. Remove the crankshaft position sensor reluctor ring.
Notice: In order to rotate the engine install a bolt with the same threads as the crankshaft, but do
not use the crankshaft balancer bolt or a bolt longer than 1 inch, in the crankshaft. Failing to do so
will cause damage to the bolt threads and the crankshaft threaded hole when removing the bolt.
3. Install a 7/16-20 x 1 inch bolt into the end of the crankshaft.
Notice: Align the timing marks before removing the timing chain. If it is necessary to turn either the
camshaft or the crankshaft with the timing chain removed, loosen or remove the valve rocker arms.
Turning either the crankshaft or camshaft with the timing chain removed may cause the pistons to
contact the valves, resulting in damage.
4. Rotate the crankshaft until:
4.1. The timing marks on both sprockets line up.
4.2. The number four cylinder is at Top Dead Center (TDC) of the compression stroke.
5. Remove the timing chain and sprockets. 6. Clean and inspect the timing chain and sprockets.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the timing chain and the sprockets. 2. Remove the bolt from the crankshaft.
Notice: Do not reuse the engine front cover. Oil leaks may result.
3. Install the engine front cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Timing Chain: Service and Repair
Timing Chain and Sprockets Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the engine front cover.
2. Remove the crankshaft position sensor reluctor ring.
Notice: In order to rotate the engine install a bolt with the same threads as the crankshaft, but do
not use the crankshaft balancer bolt or a bolt longer than 1 inch, in the crankshaft. Failing to do so
will cause damage to the bolt threads and the crankshaft threaded hole when removing the bolt.
3. Install a 7/16-20 x 1 inch bolt into the end of the crankshaft.
Notice: Align the timing marks before removing the timing chain. If it is necessary to turn either the
camshaft or the crankshaft with the timing chain removed, loosen or remove the valve rocker arms.
Turning either the crankshaft or camshaft with the timing chain removed may cause the pistons to
contact the valves, resulting in damage.
4. Rotate the crankshaft until:
4.1. The timing marks on both sprockets line up.
4.2. The number four cylinder is at Top Dead Center (TDC) of the compression stroke.
5. Remove the timing chain and sprockets. 6. Clean and inspect the timing chain and sprockets.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the timing chain and the sprockets. 2. Remove the bolt from the crankshaft.
Notice: Do not reuse the engine front cover. Oil leaks may result.
3. Install the engine front cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Timing Chain Tensioner: > 03-06-01-024C >
Aug > 06 > Engine - Engine Rattle at 1,800-2,200 RPM's
Timing Chain Tensioner: Customer Interest Engine - Engine Rattle at 1,800-2,200 RPM's
Bulletin No.: 03-06-01-024C
Date: August 30, 2006
TECHNICAL
Subject: Rattle Noise In Engine (Install Timing Tensioner Kit)
Models: 1996-2003 Chevrolet Astro, Blazer, Express, S-10, Silverado and P Models 1996-2003
GMC Jimmy, Safari, Savana, Sierra, Sonoma 1996-2001 Oldsmobile Bravada
with 4.3L V6 Engine (VINs W, X - RPOs L35, LF6, LU3)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add additional models. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
03-06-01-024B (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a rattle-type noise coming from the engine at approximately
1800 to 2200 RPMs.
Cause
The spark, rattle-type noise may be caused by torsional vibration of the balance shaft.
Correction
If detonation noise is present, perform detonation/spark knock diagnostics first.
Install a new tensioner assembly kit using the procedure below.
Remove the engine front cover. Refer to SI for engine front cover removal procedure.
Remove the crankshaft sensor reluctor ring and line up the timing marks on the crank gear and
cam shaft gear.
Remove the camshaft gear and chain. For model years 1996-1998, remove the crankshaft
sprocket using J 5825-A.
Pull the shipping pin and discard. Remove the nylon timing chain tensioner blade from the timing
chain tensioner bracket.
Position the bracket on the front of the engine. The upper two attaching holes of the bracket will
line up with the center two engine front cover bolt holes. The lower bracket holes will line up with
the engine front cover alignment holes.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Timing Chain Tensioner: > 03-06-01-024C >
Aug > 06 > Engine - Engine Rattle at 1,800-2,200 RPM's > Page 2307
Use a hammer and the J 46165 Pin Driver to install the dowel pins through the two lower holes in
the bracket and into the engine block. Make sure that the bracket is held firmly in place before
proceeding.
For model years 1996-1998, install a roller-type timing chain set. Install the crankshaft sprocket
using the J 5590 Crankshaft Gear Installer. Install the timing chain around the crankshaft sprocket
and position the timing chain to the driver's side of the engine.
Install the nylon timing chain tensioner guide onto the timing chain tensioner bracket pin and
position the top of the guide under the tab at the top of the bracket.
Install the camshaft sprocket into the chain and then to the camshaft. Install the bolts finger-tight.
Make sure the timing marks are aligned, then tighten the camshaft sprocket bolt.
Tighten
Tighten the bolt to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
Install the crankshaft reluctor ring.
Install the engine front cover and place a washer under the two center cover bolts that extend
through the tensioner bracket. These washers are required to maintain the proper crush on the
engine front cover seal.
Tighten
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Timing Chain Tensioner: > 03-06-01-024C >
Aug > 06 > Engine - Engine Rattle at 1,800-2,200 RPM's > Page 2308
Tighten the bolts to 12 N.m (106 lb in).
Parts Information
Warranty Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Timing Chain Tensioner: > 03-06-01-024C >
Aug > 06 > Engine - Engine Rattle at 1,800-2,200 RPM's > Page 2309
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Timing Chain Tensioner: >
03-06-01-024C > Aug > 06 > Engine - Engine Rattle at 1,800-2,200 RPM's
Timing Chain Tensioner: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Engine Rattle at 1,800-2,200
RPM's
Bulletin No.: 03-06-01-024C
Date: August 30, 2006
TECHNICAL
Subject: Rattle Noise In Engine (Install Timing Tensioner Kit)
Models: 1996-2003 Chevrolet Astro, Blazer, Express, S-10, Silverado and P Models 1996-2003
GMC Jimmy, Safari, Savana, Sierra, Sonoma 1996-2001 Oldsmobile Bravada
with 4.3L V6 Engine (VINs W, X - RPOs L35, LF6, LU3)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add additional models. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
03-06-01-024B (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a rattle-type noise coming from the engine at approximately
1800 to 2200 RPMs.
Cause
The spark, rattle-type noise may be caused by torsional vibration of the balance shaft.
Correction
If detonation noise is present, perform detonation/spark knock diagnostics first.
Install a new tensioner assembly kit using the procedure below.
Remove the engine front cover. Refer to SI for engine front cover removal procedure.
Remove the crankshaft sensor reluctor ring and line up the timing marks on the crank gear and
cam shaft gear.
Remove the camshaft gear and chain. For model years 1996-1998, remove the crankshaft
sprocket using J 5825-A.
Pull the shipping pin and discard. Remove the nylon timing chain tensioner blade from the timing
chain tensioner bracket.
Position the bracket on the front of the engine. The upper two attaching holes of the bracket will
line up with the center two engine front cover bolt holes. The lower bracket holes will line up with
the engine front cover alignment holes.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Timing Chain Tensioner: >
03-06-01-024C > Aug > 06 > Engine - Engine Rattle at 1,800-2,200 RPM's > Page 2315
Use a hammer and the J 46165 Pin Driver to install the dowel pins through the two lower holes in
the bracket and into the engine block. Make sure that the bracket is held firmly in place before
proceeding.
For model years 1996-1998, install a roller-type timing chain set. Install the crankshaft sprocket
using the J 5590 Crankshaft Gear Installer. Install the timing chain around the crankshaft sprocket
and position the timing chain to the driver's side of the engine.
Install the nylon timing chain tensioner guide onto the timing chain tensioner bracket pin and
position the top of the guide under the tab at the top of the bracket.
Install the camshaft sprocket into the chain and then to the camshaft. Install the bolts finger-tight.
Make sure the timing marks are aligned, then tighten the camshaft sprocket bolt.
Tighten
Tighten the bolt to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
Install the crankshaft reluctor ring.
Install the engine front cover and place a washer under the two center cover bolts that extend
through the tensioner bracket. These washers are required to maintain the proper crush on the
engine front cover seal.
Tighten
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Timing Chain Tensioner: >
03-06-01-024C > Aug > 06 > Engine - Engine Rattle at 1,800-2,200 RPM's > Page 2316
Tighten the bolts to 12 N.m (106 lb in).
Parts Information
Warranty Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Timing Chain Tensioner: >
03-06-01-024C > Aug > 06 > Engine - Engine Rattle at 1,800-2,200 RPM's > Page 2317
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications
Timing Cover: Specifications
Engine Front Cover Bolt
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 106 inch lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2321
Timing Cover: Service and Repair
Engine Front Cover Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the engine oil pan. 2. Remove the crankshaft balancer. 3. Remove the water pump. 4.
Remove the Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor.
Notice: Do not reuse the engine front cover. Oil leaks may result.
5. Remove the engine front cover. 6. Discard the engine front cover. 7. Clean all sealing surfaces.
Installation Procedure
Notice: Do not reuse the engine front cover. Oil leaks may result.
1. Install the engine front cover. 2. Install the engine oil pan.
Important: Do not reuse the original seal (O-ring) when installing the crankshaft position sensor to
the engine front cover. Erratic engine operation may result.
3. Install the CKP sensor. 4. Install the water pump. 5. Install the crankshaft balancer.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > Fuel Pressure Test Port > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle
Speed > System Information > Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Information not supplied by the manufacturer.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Air Cleaner Restriction Indicator > Component Information > Description and Operation
Air Cleaner Restriction Indicator: Description and Operation
The air cleaner restriction indicator is located on the intake duct between the air cleaner assembly
and the Mass Air Flow/Intake Air Temperature ( MAF/IAT) sensor.
If the area inside of the clear section is green, no air filter service is required. If the area inside the
clear section is orange and Change Air Filter appears, replace the air filter.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air
Filter Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: Customer Interest Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air
Filter Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 2342
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Air Filter Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Air Filter Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page
2348
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2349
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER ELEMENT REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the air cleaner cover by releasing the retainer clips. 2. Remove the air cleaner element.
3. Clear out any debris in the air cleaner tub.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Insert the air cleaner element into the air cleaner tub. 2. Install the air cleaner cover. 3. Fasten
the air cleaner cover retainer clips.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Filter > Fuel Pressure Release > System Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 34730-1A Fuel Pressure Gage
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Gasoline/Gasoline Vapors Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Remove the engine cover.
CAUTION: Refer to Fuel Gage Leak Caution in Service Precautions.
NOTE: Clean all of the following areas before performing any disconnections in order to avoid
possible contamination in the system: ^
The fuel pipe connections
^ The hose connections
^ The areas surrounding the connections
2. Install the J 34730-1A to the fuel pressure service connection. 3. Turn ON the ignition.
CAUTION: Refer to Fuel Storage Caution in Service Precautions.
4. Place the bleed hose of the fuel pressure gage into an approved gasoline container. 5. Open the
bleed valve on the fuel pressure gage in order to bleed the air from the fuel pressure gage. 6.
Command the fuel pump ON with a scan tool. 7. Close the bleed valve on the fuel pressure gage.
8. Inspect for fuel leaks.
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Filter > Fuel Pressure Release > System Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal
> Page 2355
1. Place the fuel pressure gage bleed hose into an approved container and open the bleed valve to
bleed OFF fuel system pressure. 2. Place a shop towel under the J 34730-1A to catch any
remaining fuel spillage. 3. Remove the J 34730-1A from the fuel pressure connection. 4. Drain any
fuel remaining in the fuel pressure gage into an approved container. 5. Inspect for leaks using the
following procedure:
5.1. Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF for 2 seconds.
5.2. Turn OFF the ignition for 10 seconds.
5.3. Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
5.4. Inspect for fuel leaks.
6. Install the cap on the fuel pressure connection. 7. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Filter > Fuel Pressure Release > System Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal
> Page 2356
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair Fuel System Pressure Relief
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 34730-1A Fuel Pressure Gage
CAUTION: Remove the fuel tank cap and relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing the fuel
system in order to reduce the risk of personal injury. After you relieve the fuel system pressure, a
small amount of fuel may be released when servicing the fuel lines, the fuel injection pump, or the
connections. In order to reduce the risk of personal injury, cover the fuel system components with a
shop towel before disconnection. This will catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an
approved container when the disconnection is complete.
1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Disconnect the negative battery cable in order to avoid possible fuel
discharge if an accidental attempt is made to start the engine. 3. Remove the engine cover. 4.
Connect the J 34730-1A or the equivalent to the fuel pressure connection. 5. Wrap a shop towel
around the fitting while connecting the gage in order to avoid spillage. 6. Install the bleed hose of
the gage into an approved container. 7. Open the valve on the gage in order to bleed the system
pressure. The fuel connections are now safe for servicing. 8. Drain any fuel remaining in the gage
into an approved container.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Ignition Cable > Component Information > Service and Repair > Spark Plug Wire Inspection
Ignition Cable: Service and Repair Spark Plug Wire Inspection
Spark plug wire integrity is vital for proper engine operation. A thorough inspection will be
necessary to accurately identify conditions that may affect engine operation. Inspect for the
following conditions:
1. Correct routing of the spark plug wires - Incorrect routing may cause cross-firing. 2. Any signs of
cracks or splits in the wires. 3. Inspect each boot for the following conditions:
^ Tearing
^ Piercing
^ Arcing
^ Carbon tracking
^ Corroded terminal
If corrosion, carbon tracking or arcing are indicated on a spark plug wire boot or on a terminal,
replace the wire and the component connected to the wire.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Ignition Cable > Component Information > Service and Repair > Spark Plug Wire Inspection > Page 2361
Ignition Cable: Service and Repair Spark Plug Wire Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the spark plug wire at each spark plug.
^ Twist the boots 1/2 turn before removing the boots.
^ Pull only on the boot or use a tool designed for this purpose in order to remove the wire from
each spark plug.
2. Disconnect the spark plug wire from the distributor.
^ Twist each spark plug boot 1/2 turn.
^ Pull only on the boot or use a tool designed for this purpose in order to remove the wires from the
distributor.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: If the boot to wire movement has occurred, the boot will give a false visual impression of
being fully seated. Ensure that the boots have been properly assembled by pushing sideways on
the installed boots. Failure to properly seat the terminal onto the spark plug will lead to wire core
erosion and result in an engine misfire or crossfire condition, and possible internal damage to the
engine.
1. Install the spark plug wires at the distributor. 2. Install the spark plug wire to each spark plug. 3.
Inspect the wires for proper installation:
3.1. Push sideways on each boot in order to inspect the seating.
3.2. Reinstall any loose boot.
3.3. Wire routings must be kept intact during service and followed exactly when wires have been
disconnected or when replacement of the wires is necessary. Failure to route the wires properly
can lead to radio ignition noise and crossfiring of the plugs, or shorting of the leads to the ground.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Ignition Cable > Component Information > Service and Repair > Spark Plug Wire Inspection > Page 2362
3.4. Any time the spark plug wires or boots are installed on the spark plugs, new dielectric grease
needs to be applied inside the boot.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Distributor: >
03-06-04-041A > Jan > 05 > Ignition System - SES Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300
Distributor: Customer Interest Ignition System - SES Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300
Bulletin No.: 03-06-04-041A
Date: January 28, 2005
TECHNICAL
Subject: Poor Engine Performance - Misfire, Rough Idle, Stalls, Engine Cranks but Does Not Run,
Service Engine Soon/Check Engine Light Illuminated, DTC P0300 Set (Inspect Distributor Ignition
(DI) System Components and Replace As Necessary)
Models: 2001-2003 Chevrolet Astro, Blazer, Express, S-10 2001-2003 GMC Jimmy, Safari,
Savana, Sonoma 2001 Oldsmobile Bravada
with 4.3L, 5.0L or 5.7L Gas Engine (VINs W, X, M, R - RPOs L35, LU3, L30, L31)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to delete a model and add information to subject and inspection of
distributor vent screens. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 03-06-04-041 (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on poor engine performance and the Service Engine Soon/Check
Engine light being illuminated. Upon investigation, the technician may find DTC P0300 set.
Cause
This condition may be due to high levels of internal corrosion in the distributor, causing misfire,
rough idle, stall and Engine Cranks But Does Not Run. This corrosion is attributed to a lack of
airflow internal to the cap caused by the vent screens being clogged with debris.
Correction
Remove the vent screens and inspect the internal components of the Distributor Ignition System
using the procedure listed below. If the distributor base has to be replaced, the vent screens will
also have to be removed on the new distributor. If there is evidence of this internal corrosion,
replace the affected component. Refer to the appropriate procedure in the Engine Controls
sub-section of the applicable Service Manual.
Important:
All of these inspections can be done on-vehicle.
1. Inspect the distributor cap. You may notice a white residue on the cap walls. For higher mileage
occurrences, the interior of the cap may have changed to medium brown in color
2. Inspect the distributor rotor. You may notice the presence of black streaks on the plastic surface.
More typical evidence would be visible green spots on the copper surface of the rotor segment.
3. Inspect the distributor base. You may notice high levels of surface rust on the distributor shaft or
surface contamination on the sensor hold down screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Distributor: >
03-06-04-041A > Jan > 05 > Ignition System - SES Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300 > Page 2371
4. Inspect the distributor vent screens (1). If the vent screens are present, remove them by using a
plastic-handled, long blade awl or pick (2). Insert into the airflow vent screens and pop them out.
Refer to the figure for removal procedure. If the vent screens have been removed from the base of
the distributor, then check the airflow inlets for being clogged with debris.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Distributor: >
03-06-04-041A > Jan > 05 > Ignition System - SES Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300 > Page 2372
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Distributor: >
03-06-04-041A > Jan > 05 > Ignition System - SES Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300
Distributor: All Technical Service Bulletins Ignition System - SES Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300
Bulletin No.: 03-06-04-041A
Date: January 28, 2005
TECHNICAL
Subject: Poor Engine Performance - Misfire, Rough Idle, Stalls, Engine Cranks but Does Not Run,
Service Engine Soon/Check Engine Light Illuminated, DTC P0300 Set (Inspect Distributor Ignition
(DI) System Components and Replace As Necessary)
Models: 2001-2003 Chevrolet Astro, Blazer, Express, S-10 2001-2003 GMC Jimmy, Safari,
Savana, Sonoma 2001 Oldsmobile Bravada
with 4.3L, 5.0L or 5.7L Gas Engine (VINs W, X, M, R - RPOs L35, LU3, L30, L31)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to delete a model and add information to subject and inspection of
distributor vent screens. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 03-06-04-041 (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on poor engine performance and the Service Engine Soon/Check
Engine light being illuminated. Upon investigation, the technician may find DTC P0300 set.
Cause
This condition may be due to high levels of internal corrosion in the distributor, causing misfire,
rough idle, stall and Engine Cranks But Does Not Run. This corrosion is attributed to a lack of
airflow internal to the cap caused by the vent screens being clogged with debris.
Correction
Remove the vent screens and inspect the internal components of the Distributor Ignition System
using the procedure listed below. If the distributor base has to be replaced, the vent screens will
also have to be removed on the new distributor. If there is evidence of this internal corrosion,
replace the affected component. Refer to the appropriate procedure in the Engine Controls
sub-section of the applicable Service Manual.
Important:
All of these inspections can be done on-vehicle.
1. Inspect the distributor cap. You may notice a white residue on the cap walls. For higher mileage
occurrences, the interior of the cap may have changed to medium brown in color
2. Inspect the distributor rotor. You may notice the presence of black streaks on the plastic surface.
More typical evidence would be visible green spots on the copper surface of the rotor segment.
3. Inspect the distributor base. You may notice high levels of surface rust on the distributor shaft or
surface contamination on the sensor hold down screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Distributor: >
03-06-04-041A > Jan > 05 > Ignition System - SES Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300 > Page 2378
4. Inspect the distributor vent screens (1). If the vent screens are present, remove them by using a
plastic-handled, long blade awl or pick (2). Insert into the airflow vent screens and pop them out.
Refer to the figure for removal procedure. If the vent screens have been removed from the base of
the distributor, then check the airflow inlets for being clogged with debris.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Distributor: >
03-06-04-041A > Jan > 05 > Ignition System - SES Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300 > Page 2379
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul
Distributor: Service and Repair Distributor Overhaul
DISASSEMBLY PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover.
NOTE: The ignition system distributor driven gear and rotor may be installed in multiple positions.
In order to avoid mistakes, mark the distributor on the following components in order to ensure the
same mounting position upon reassembly: ^
The distributor driven gear
^ The distributor shaft
^ The rotor holes
Installing the driven gear 180 degrees out of alignment, or locating the rotor in the wrong holes, will
cause a no-start condition. Premature engine wear or damage may result.
2. Align white paint mark on the bottom stem of the distributor, and the pre-drilled indent hole in the
bottom of the gear (2). 3. With the gear in this position, the rotor segment should be positioned as
shown for a V6 engine (1). If not, replace the distributor.
4. Remove the 2 screws from the rotor. 5. Remove the rotor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 2382
6. Note the locating holes that the rotor was removed from:
^ The rotor screw holes (1)
^ The rotor locator pin holes (2)
7. Line up the square-cut hole in the vane wheel with the CMP sensor.
8. Remove the 2 screws that hold the camshaft position (CMP) sensor. 9. Discard the screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 2383
10. Remove the CMP sensor. 11. Note the dimple located below the roll pin hole on one side of the
gear. The dimple will be used to properly orient the gear onto the shaft during
reassembly.
CAUTION: Refer to Safety Glasses Caution in Service Precautions.
12. Support the distributor drive gear in a V-block or similar fixture. 13. Drive out the roll pin with a
suitable punch.
14. Remove the driven gear from the distributor shaft. 15. Remove the round washer. 16. Remove
the tang washer. 17. Remove the shim washer (1).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 2384
18. Remove the old oil seal.
ASSEMBLY PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: Installing the driven gear 180 degrees out of alignment, or locating the rotor in the
wrong holes, will cause a no-start condition. Premature engine wear or damage may result.
1. Line up the square-cut hole in the vane wheel for the camshaft position (CMP) sensor.
2. Insert the sensor into the housing.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 2385
3. Install two new screws for the camshaft position (CMP) sensor.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2.2 N.m (19 lb in).
4. Identity the correct rotor mounting position:
^ At the rotor screw holes (1)
^ At the rotor locator pin holes (2)
5. Install the distributor rotor according to the index marks. 6. Install two rotor hold down screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 1.9 N.m (17 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 2386
7. Install the shim washer (1) on the bottom of the distributor shaft. 8. Install the tang washer. 9.
Install the round washer.
10. Install the driven gear according to the index marks.
11. Align the rotor segment as shown for a V6 engine (1) or V8 engine (2). 12. Install the gear and
align white paint mark on the bottom stem of the distributor, and the pre-drilled indent hole in the
bottom of the gear (3). 13. Check to see if the driven gear is installed incorrectly. On an incorrectly
installed driven gear, the dimple will be approximately 180 degrees
opposite the rotor segment when the gear is installed in the distributor.
CAUTION: Refer to Safety Glasses Caution in Service Precautions.
14. Support the distributor drive gear in a V-block or similar fixture. 15. Install the roll pin with a
suitable punch and hammer in order to hold the driven gear in the correct position.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 2387
16. Install the new oil seal under the mounting flange of the distributor base. 17. Install the
distributor. 18. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 2388
Distributor: Service and Repair Distributor Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
NOTE: There are two procedures available to install the distributor.
Use Installation Procedure 1 when the crankshaft has NOT been rotated from the original position.
Use Installation Procedure 2 when any of the following components are removed: ^
The intake manifold
^ The cylinder head
^ The camshaft
^ The timing chain or sprockets
^ The complete engine
If the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) turns on and DTC P1345 sets after installing the distributor,
this indicates an incorrectly installed distributor.
Engine damage or distributor damage may occur. Use Procedure 2 in order to install the distributor.
1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Remove the engine cover. 3. Remove air cleaner assembly. 4. Remove
the air intake resonator assembly. 5. Remove the spark plug wires from the distributor cap.
^ Twist each spark plug 1/2 turn.
^ Pull only on the wire boot in order to remove the wire from the distributor cap.
6. Remove the electrical connector from the base of the distributor.
7. Remove the 2 screws that retain the distributor cap to the housing. 8. Discard the screws. 9.
Remove the distributor cap from the housing.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 2389
10. Use a grease pencil in order to mark the position of the rotor in relation to the distributor
housing (1). 11. Mark the distributor housing and the intake manifold with the grease pencil.
12. As the distributor is being removed from the engine, watch the rotor move in a
counter-clockwise direction about 42 degrees. This will appear as
slightly more than one clock position.
13. Note the position of the rotor segment. 14. Place a second mark on the base of the distributor
(2).
This will aid in achieving the proper rotor alignment during the distributor installation.
15. Remove the mounting clamp hold-down bolt. 16. Remove the distributor.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 2390
1. If installing a new distributor assembly, place 2 marks on the new distributor housing in the same
location as the marks on the original housing. 2. Remove the new distributor cap, if necessary. 3.
Align the rotor with the second mark (2).
4. Guide the distributor into the engine. 5. Align the hole in the distributor hold-down base over the
mounting hole in the intake manifold.
6. As the distributor is being installed, observe the rotor moving in a clockwise direction about 42
degrees. 7. Once the distributor is completely seated, the rotor segment should be aligned with the
mark on the distributor base (1).
^ If the rotor segment is not aligned with the mark, the driven gear teeth and the camshaft have
meshed one or more teeth out of alignment.
^ In order to correct this condition, remove and reinstall the distributor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 2391
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
8. Install the distributor mounting clamp bolt.
Tighten Tighten the bolt to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
9. Install the distributor cap.
10. Install the new distributor cap screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2.4 N.m (21 lb in).
11. Install the electrical connector to the distributor. 12. Install the spark plug wires to the distributor
cap.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 2392
13. Install the ignition coil wire. Note the correct orientation of the wire boot.
IMPORTANT: If the malfunction indicator lamp illuminates after installing the distributor and DTC
P1345 is set, the distributor has been installed incorrectly.
14. Refer to Installation Procedure 2 if the malfunction indicator lamp illuminates after installing the
distributor. 15. Install the engine cover.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 2
IMPORTANT: Rotate the number 1 cylinder to top dead center (TDC) of the compression stroke.
The engine front cover has 2 alignment tabs and the crankshaft balancer has 2 alignment marks
spaced 90 degrees apart which are used for positioning the number 1 piston at TDC. With the
piston on the compression stroke and at TDC, the crankshaft balancer alignment mark (1) must
align with the engine front cover tab (2) and the crankshaft balancer alignment mark (4) must align
with the engine front cover tab (3).
1. Rotate the crankshaft balancer clockwise until the alignment marks on the crankshaft balancer
are aligned with the tabs on the engine front cover
and the number 1 piston is at TDC of the compression stroke.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 2393
2. Align the white paint mark on the bottom stem of the distributor and the pre-drilled indent hole in
the bottom of the gear (3).
NOTE: The ignition system distributor driven gear and rotor may be installed in multiple positions.
In order to avoid mistakes, mark the distributor on the following components in order to ensure the
same mounting position upon reassembly: ^
The distributor driven gear
^ The distributor shaft
^ The rotor holes
Installing the driven gear 180 degrees out of alignment, or locating the rotor in the wrong holes, will
cause a no-start condition. Premature engine wear or damage may result.
3. With the gear in this position, the rotor segment should be positioned as shown for a V6 engine
(1).
^ The alignment will not be exact.
^ If the driven gear is installed incorrectly, the dimple Will be approximately 180 degrees opposite
of the rotor segment when installed in the distributor.
4. Use a long screw driver in order to align the oil pump drive shaft to the drive tab of the
distributor. 5. Guide the distributor into the engine.
Ensure the flat portion of the distributor housing is facing toward the front of the engine.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 2394
6. Once the distributor is fully seated, the rotor segment should be aligned with the pointer cast into
the distributor base.
If the rotor segment does not come within a few degrees of the pointer, repeat the procedure in
order to achieve the proper alignment.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
7. Install the distributor mounting clamp bolt.
Tighten Tighten the bolt to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 2395
8. Install the distributor cap. 9. Install the new distributor cap screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2.4 N.m (21 lb in).
10. Install the electrical connector to the distributor. 11. Install the spark plug wires to the distributor
cap.
12. Install the ignition coil wire. Note the correct orientation of the wire boot.
IMPORTANT: If the malfunction indicator lamp illuminates after installing the distributor and DTC
P1345 is set, the distributor has been installed incorrectly.
13. Repeat Installation Procedure 2 if the malfunction indicator lamp illuminates after installing the
distributor. 14. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 2396
Distributor: Service and Repair Distributor Inspection
1. Remove the engine cover.
IMPORTANT: Discoloration of the cap and some whitish build up around the cap terminals is
normal. Yellowing of the rotor cap, darkening and some carbon build up under the rotor segment is
normal. Replacement of the cap and the rotor is not necessary unless there is a driveability
concern.
2. Inspect the cap for cracks, tiny holes or carbon tracks between the cap terminal traces.
Diagnose the carbon tracks using the following procedure:
2.1. Remove the cap.
2.2. Place 1 lead from the DMM on a cap terminal.
2.3. Use the other lead in order to probe all other terminals and the center carbon ball.
2.4. Move the base lead to the next terminal. Probe all other leads.
2.5. Continue this procedure until you test all the secondary terminals.
2.6. If there are any non-infinite readings, replace the cap.
3. Inspect the cap for excess build-up of corrosion on the terminals. Scrape clean the terminals.
Replace the cap if the corrosion is excessive. Some
buildup is normal.
4. Inspect the rotor segment for excess wear. Replace the rotor if excess looseness in the rotor
segment is present. 5. Inspect the shaft for shaft-to-bushing looseness:
5.1. Inspect the housing for cracks or damage.
5.2. Insert the shaft in the housing.
5.3. If the shaft wobbles, replace the housing assembly.
6. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Spark Plug > Component Information > Specifications
Spark Plug: Specifications Ignition System Specifications
Ignition System Specifications
Spark Plug Torque 15 N.m
Spark Plug Gap 1.52 mm
Spark Plug Type R41-932 [AC plug type]
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Spark Plug > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2400
Spark Plug: Application and ID
Spark Plug ...........................................................................................................................................
............................................ R41-932 (AC plug type)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Spark Plug > Component Information > Service and Repair > Spark Plug Inspection
Spark Plug: Service and Repair Spark Plug Inspection
SPARK PLUG USAGE
1. Ensure that the correct spark plug is installed. An incorrect spark plug causes driveability
conditions. Refer to Ignition System Specifications for
the correct spark plug.
2. Ensure that the spark plug has the correct heat range. An incorrect heat range causes the
following conditions:
^ Spark plug fouling - Colder plug
^ Pre-ignition causing spark plug and/or engine damage - Hotter plug
SPARK PLUG INSPECTION
1. Inspect the terminal post (1) for damage.
^ Inspect for a bent or broken terminal post (1).
^ Test for a loose terminal post (1) by twisting and pulling the post. The terminal post (1) should
NOT move.
2. Inspect the insulator (2) for flashover or carbon tracking, soot. This is caused by the electrical
charge traveling across the insulator (2) between the
terminal post (1) and ground. Inspect for the following conditions: ^
Inspect the spark plug boot for damage.
^ Inspect the spark plug recess area of the cylinder head for moisture, such as oil, coolant, or
water. A spark plug boot that is saturated causes arcing to ground.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Spark Plug > Component Information > Service and Repair > Spark Plug Inspection > Page 2403
3. Inspect the insulator (2) for cracks. All or part of the electrical charge may arc through the crack
instead of the electrodes (3, 4).
4. Inspect for evidence of improper arcing.
^ Measure the gap between the center electrode (4) and the side electrode (3) terminals. An
excessively wide electrode gap can prevent correct spark plug operation.
^ Inspect for the correct spark plug torque. Refer to Ignition System Specifications. Insufficient
torque can prevent correct spark plug operation. An over torqued spark plug, causes the insulator
(2) to crack.
^ Inspect for signs of tracking that occurred near the insulator tip instead of the center electrode (4).
^ Inspect for a broken or worn side electrode (3).
^ Inspect for a broken, worn, or loose center electrode (4) by shaking the spark plug. A rattling sound indicates internal damage.
- A loose center electrode (4) reduces the spark intensity.
^ Inspect for bridged electrodes (3, 4). Deposits on the electrodes (3, 4) reduce or eliminates the
gap.
^ Inspect for worn or missing platinum pads on the electrodes (3, 4), if equipped.
^ Inspect for excessive fouling.
5. Inspect the spark plug recess area of the cylinder head for debris. Dirty or damaged threads can
cause the spark plug not to seat correctly during
installation.
SPARK PLUG VISUAL INSPECTION
1. Normal operation - Brown to grayish-tan with small amounts of white powdery deposits are
normal combustion by-products from fuels with
additives.
2. Carbon Fouled - Dry, fluffy black carbon, or soot caused by the following conditions:
^ Rich fuel mixtures Leaking fuel injectors
- Excessive fuel pressure
- Restricted air filter element
- Incorrect combustion
^ Reduced ignition system voltage output
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Spark Plug > Component Information > Service and Repair > Spark Plug Inspection > Page 2404
- Weak coils
- Worn ignition wires
- Incorrect spark plug gap
^ Excessive idling or slow speeds under light loads can keep spark plug temperatures so low that
normal combustion deposits may not burn off.
3. Deposit Fouling - Oil, coolant, or additives that include substances such as silicone, very white
coating, reduces the spark intensity. Most powdery
deposits will not effect spark intensity unless they form into a glazing over the electrode.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Spark Plug > Component Information > Service and Repair > Spark Plug Inspection > Page 2405
Spark Plug: Service and Repair Spark Plug Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the spark plug wires. 2. Loosen each spark plug 1 or 2 turns. 3. Brush or air blast away
any dirt from around the spark plugs. 4. Remove the spark plugs 1 at a time. Place each plug in a
tray marked with the corresponding cylinder numbers.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Properly position each spark plug washer. 2. Inspect each spark plug gap. Adjust each plug as
needed
Specification Spark plug gap: 1.524 mm (0.060 in).
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Hand start the spark plugs in the corresponding cylinders. 4. Tighten the spark plugs.
Tighten ^
For used heads tighten the spark plugs to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
^ For new aluminum heads tighten the spark plugs to 20 N.m (15 lb ft).
^ For new iron heads tighten the spark plugs to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
5. Install the spark plug wires.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Compression Check > System Information > System Diagnosis
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
Normal
The compression builds up quickly and evenly to the specified compression.
Leaking
The compression is low on the first compression stroke. The compression builds up with the
following strokes, but does not reach the specified compression.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications
Water Pump: Specifications
Water Pump Bolt
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 33 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2412
Water Pump: Service and Repair
Water Pump Replacement
Removal Procedure
Caution: In order to avoid being burned, do not service the engine while it is still hot. Service the
engine when it is cool.
1. Drain the coolant from the radiator. 2. Remove the air cleaner assembly. 3. Remove the Mass
Air Flow (MAP) sensor. 4. Remove the upper fan shroud. 5. Remove the drive belt. 6. Remove the
fan and fan blade clutch assembly.
7. Remove the coolant pump pulley bolts and the pulley.
8. Disconnect the coolant bypass hose and clamps. 9. Disconnect the radiator outlet hose from the
coolant pump.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2413
10. Remove the four coolant pump bolts. 11. Remove the coolant pump. 12. Remove the gaskets.
Important: Make sure all of the gasket mating surfaces are free of burrs or other imperfections.
13. Inspect all of the parts. Replace the parts as necessary.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the coolant pump gaskets. 2. Install the coolant pump.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the four bolts retaining the coolant pump.
Tighten the bolts to 45 Nm (33 ft. lbs.).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2414
4. Connect the coolant bypass hose and clamps. 5. Connect the radiator outlet hose to the coolant
pump.
6. Install the coolant pump pulley and the bolts.
Tighten the coolant pump pulley bolts to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
7. Install the fan and fan blade clutch assembly. 8. Install the drive belt. 9. Install the upper fan
shroud and the bolts.
10. Install the Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor. 11. Install the air cleaner assembly. 12. Refill the
radiator with coolant. 13. Start engine. After engine reaches normal operating temperature, check
for coolant leaks.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System - DEX-COOL(R) Coolant Leak Detection Dye
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System - DEX-COOL(R) Coolant Leak Detection Dye
Bulletin No.: 05-06-02-002B
Date: January 18, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: DEX-COOL(R) Coolant - New Leak Detection Dye J 46366 - Replaces J 29545-6
Models: 1996-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light/Medium Duty Trucks* (including Saturn)
1997-2008 Isuzu T-Series Medium Duty Tilt Cab Models Built in Janesville and Flint 1999-2008
Isuzu N-Series Medium Duty Commercial Models with 5.7L or 6.0L Gas Engine
2003-2008 HUMMER H2 2006-2008 HUMMER H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
*EXCLUDING 2006 and Prior Chevrolet Aveo, Epica, Optra, Vivant and Pontiac Matiz, Wave
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to include additional model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 05-06-02-002A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
Leak detection dye P/N 12378563 (J 29545-6) (in Canada P/N 88900915) may cause
DEX-COOL(R) coolant to appear green in a black vessel making it appear to be conventional
(green) coolant. This may cause a technician to add conventional coolant to a low DEX-COOL(R)
system thus contaminating it. The green DEX-COOL(R) appearance is caused by the color of the
leak detection dye which alters the color of the DEX-COOL(R) coolant.
A new leak detection dye P/N 89022219 (J 46366) (in Canada P/N 89022220) has been released
that does not alter the appearance of the DEX-COOL(R) coolant. When adding the new leak
detection dye the color of the DEX-COOL(R) coolant will not change. For detecting leaks on any
system that uses DEX-COOL(R) leak detection dye P/N 89022219 (in Canada P/N 89022220)
should be used. The new leak detection dye can be used with both conventional and
DEX-COOL(R) coolant.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System - DEX-COOL(R) Coolant Leak Detection Dye > Page 2420
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information
Bulletin No.: 00-06-02-006D
Date: August 15, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Engine Coolant Recycling and Warranty Information
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2007 and Prior
HUMMER Vehicles 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Attention:
Please address this bulletin to the Warranty Claims Administrator and the Service Manager.
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to adjust the title and Include Warranty Information. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 00-06-02-006C (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
Coolant Reimbursement Policy
General Motors supports the use of recycled engine coolant for warranty repairs/service, providing
a GM approved engine coolant recycling system is used. Recycled coolant will be reimbursed at
the GMSPO dealer price for new coolant plus the appropriate mark-up. When coolant replacement
is required during a warranty repair, it is crucial that only the relative amount of engine coolant
concentrate be charged, not the total diluted volume. In other words: if you are using two gallons of
pre-diluted (50:50) recycled engine coolant to service a vehicle, you may request reimbursement
for one gallon of GM Goodwrench engine coolant concentrate at the dealer price plus the
appropriate warranty parts handling allowance.
Licensed Approved DEX-COOL(R) Providers
Important:
USE OF NON-APPROVED VIRGIN OR RECYCLED DEX-COOL(R) OR DEVIATIONS IN THE
FORM OF ALTERNATE CHEMICALS OR ALTERATION OF EQUIPMENT, WILL VOID THE GM
ENDORSEMENT, MAY DEGRADE COOLANT SYSTEM INTEGRITY AND PLACE THE
COOLING SYSTEM WARRANTY UNDER JEOPARDY.
Shown in Table 1 are the only current licensed and approved providers of DEX-COOL(R). Products
that are advertised as "COMPATIBLE" or "RECOMMENDED" for use with DEX-COOL(R) have not
been tested or approved by General Motors. Non-approved coolants may degrade the
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System - DEX-COOL(R) Coolant Leak Detection Dye > Page 2421
coolant system integrity and will no longer be considered a 5 yr/150,000 mile (240,000 km) coolant.
Coolant Removal Services/Recycling
The tables include all coolant recycling processes currently approved by GM. Also included is a
primary phone number and demographic information. Used DEX-COOL(R) can be combined with
used conventional coolant (green) for recycling. Depending on the recycling service and/or
equipment, it is then designated as a conventional 2 yr/30,000 mile (50,000 km) coolant or
DEX-COOL(R) 5 yr/150,000 mile (240,000 km) coolant. Recycled coolants as designated in this
bulletin may be used during the vehicle(s) warranty period.
DEX-COOL(R) Recycling
The DEX-COOL(R) recycling service listed in Table 2 has been approved for recycling waste
engine coolants (DEX-COOL) or conventional) to DEX-COOL(R) with 5 yr/150,000 mile (240,000
km) usability. Recycling Fluid Technologies is the only licensed provider of Recycled
DEX-COOL(R) meeting GM6277M specifications and utilizes GM approved inhibitor packages.
This is currently a limited program being monitored by GM Service Operations which will be
expanded as demand increases.
Conventional (Green) Recycling
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System - DEX-COOL(R) Coolant Leak Detection Dye > Page 2422
Processes shown in the Table 3 are capable of recycling waste engine coolants (DEX-COOL(R) or
conventional) to a conventional (green) coolant. Recycling conventional coolant can be
accomplished at your facility by a technician using approved EQUIPMENT (listed by model number
in Table 3), or by an approved coolant recycling SERVICE which may recycle the coolant at your
facility or at an offsite operation. Refer to the table for GM approved coolant recyclers in either of
these two categories. Should you decide to recycle the coolant yourself, strict adherence to the
operating procedures is imperative. Use ONLY the inhibitor chemicals supplied by the respective
(GM approved) recycling equipment manufacturer.
Sealing Tablets
Cooling System Sealing Tablets (Seal Tabs) should not be used as a regular maintenance item
after servicing an engine cooling system. Discoloration of coolant can occur if too many seal tabs
have been inserted into the cooling system. This can occur if seal tabs are repeatedly used over
the service life of a vehicle. Where appropriate, seal tabs may be used if diagnostics fail to repair a
small leak in the cooling system. When a condition appears in which seal tabs may be
recommended, a specific bulletin will be released describing their proper usage.
Water Quality
The integrity of the coolant is dependent upon the quality of DEX-COOL(R) and water.
DEX-COOL(R) is a product that has enhanced protection capability as well as an extended service
interval. These enhanced properties may be jeopardized by combining DEX-COOL(R) with poor
quality water. If you suspect the water in your area of being poor quality, it is recommended you
use distilled or de-ionized water with DEX-COOL(R).
"Pink" DEX-COOL(R)
DEX-COOL(R) is orange in color to distinguish it from other coolants. Due to inconsistencies in the
mixing of the dyes used with DEX-COOL(R), some batches may appear pink after time. The color
shift from orange to pink does not affect the integrity of the coolant, and still maintains the 5
yr/150,000 mile (240,000 km) service interval.
Back Service
Only use DEX-COOL(R) if the vehicle was originally equipped with DEX-COOL(R).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System - DEX-COOL(R) Coolant Leak Detection Dye > Page 2423
Contamination
Mixing conventional green coolant with DEX-COOL(R) will degrade the service interval from 5
yrs./150,000 miles (240,000 km) to 2 yrs./30,000 miles (50,000 km) if left in the contaminated
condition. If contamination occurs, the cooling system must be flushed twice immediately and
re-filled with a 50/50 mixture of DEX-COOL(R) and clean water in order to preserve the enhanced
properties and extended service interval of DEX-COOL(R).
After 5 years/150,000 miles (240,000 km)
After 5 yrs/150,000 miles (240,000 km), the coolant should be changed, preferably using a coolant
exchanger. If the vehicle was originally equipped with DEX-COOL(R) and has not had problems
with contamination from non-DEX-COOL(R) coolants, then the service interval remains the same,
and the coolant does not need to be changed for another 5 yrs/150,000 miles (240,000 km)
Equipment (Coolant Exchangers)
The preferred method of performing coolant replacement is to use a coolant exchanger. A coolant
exchanger can replace virtually all of the old coolant with new coolant. Coolant exchangers can be
used to perform coolant replacement without spillage, and facilitate easy waste collection. They
can also be used to lower the coolant level in a vehicle to allow for less messy servicing of cooling
system components. It is recommended that you use a coolant exchanger with a vacuum feature
facilitates removing trapped air from the cooling system. This is a substantial time savings over
repeatedly thermo cycling the vehicle and topping-off the radiator. The vacuum feature also allows
venting of a hot system to relieve system pressure. Approved coolant exchangers are available
through the GMDE (General Motors Dealer Equipment) program.
For refilling a cooling system that has been partially or fully drained for repairs other than coolant
replacement, the Vac-N-Fill Coolant Refill Tool (GE-47716) is recommended to facilitate removal of
trapped air from the cooling system during refill.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Coolant: Capacity Specifications
Coolant Capacity
w/ C36 (Rear Heater) ..........................................................................................................................
.................................................................. 16.5 qts. w/o C36 (Rear Heater) .......................................
................................................................................................................................................... 13.5
qts.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 2426
Coolant: Fluid Type Specifications
Coolant
Type .................................................................................................... Use only GM Goodwrench(R)
Dex-Cool(R) in a 50/50 mixture with clean water.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Drain Plug, Cylinder Block >
Component Information > Specifications
Coolant Drain Plug: Specifications
Engine Block Coolant Drain Hole Plug
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 15 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Line/Hose > Component
Information > Specifications
Coolant Line/Hose: Specifications
Oil Cooler Pipe Bracket Bolt to Oil Pan
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ 89 inch lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Outlet > Component Information
> Specifications
Coolant Outlet: Specifications
Water Outlet Stud
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 18 ft. lbs.
Coolant Outlet Bolt/Stud
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................. 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Reservoir > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Coolant Reservoir: Service and Repair
Coolant Recovery Reservoir Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Disconnect the coolant recovery reservoir hose from the from the radiator filler neck.
2. Remove the two reservoir retainers.
3. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the washer pumps. 4. Disconnect the washer hose(s)
from the washer pump(s)
5. Remove the coolant recovery reservoir/windshield washer assembly. 6. Drain the coolant in the
reservoir.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Reservoir > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 2439
Installation Procedure
1. Connect the electrical connector(s) to the washer pump(s) 2. Connect the washer hose(s) to the
washer pump(s).
3. Install the coolant recovery reservoir.
4. Install the retainers. 5. Install the coolant recovery reservoir hose. 6. Refill the coolant recovery
reservoir with coolant to the proper level. Use the proper fluid.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Blade >
Component Information > Specifications
Fan Blade: Specifications
Cooling Fan Blade to Fan Clutch Bolts
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................. 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Clutch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Intermittent Downshift/Slip/Cycling Diagnosis
Fan Clutch: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Intermittent Downshift/Slip/Cycling Diagnosis
File In Section: 07 Transmission/Transaxle
Bulletin No.: 99-07-30-016B
Date: October, 2002
INFORMATION
Subject: Diagnostic Information For Intermittent Transmission Downshift, Slip, Busy/cycling TCC or
Noisy Cooling Fan
Models: 1999-2000 Cadillac Escalade 2002-2003 Cadillac Escalade, Escalade EXT 1988-2003
Chevrolet Astro, Blazer, S-10, Silverado, Suburban 1989-2003 Chevrolet/Geo Tracker 1995-2003
Chevrolet Tahoe 1996-2003 Chevrolet Express 1988-1994 GMC S-15 1988-1999 GMC Suburban
1988-2003 GMC Safari, Sierra 1995-2003 GMC Sonoma, Yukon, Yukon XL 1996-2003 GMC
Savana 1999-2001 GMC Envoy 1991-2001 Oldsmobile Bravada 2003 HUMMER H2 with Air
Conditioning
This bulletin is being revised to change the Model information and text. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 99-07-30-016A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle)
Some customers may comment that at times the transmission seems to slip, or that there is a loud
roar from the engine with slow acceleration. This condition is most noticeable after the vehicle has
sat idle for 12 or more hours, or on hot days when the A/C is on and the vehicle moves slowly with
traffic.
Typical comments from customers may include the following conditions:
^ Intermittent slipping
^ Intermittent downshift followed by an upshift, both with no apparent reason
^ Busyness or cycling of the TCC (torque converter clutch) at steady throttle conditions and on a
level roadway
^ Noisy cooling fan
The type of concern described above requires further definition. The customer should be asked the
following questions:
^ Is the situation more pronounced with higher vehicle loads such as when pulling a trailer?
^ Do warmer ambient temperatures make the situation more pronounced?
^ When the condition occurred, did you have the A/C on, and were you driving in stop and go city
traffic?
^ Does the condition exhibit itself on the first start-up after sitting more than eight hours?
If the customer indicates that these conditions apply, and your observation confirms that the vehicle
is operating properly, provide the customer with the vehicle operating description included at the
end of this bulletin. Further action may not be necessary. A service procedure follows if further
definition is required.
Diagnostic Aids
Cooling fan operation or the resulting sound varies. The cooling fan clutch may be described as a
continuously variable clutch. If the vehicle engine is running, the fan blade is always turning unless
the fan clutch is non-functional. The speed of the fan in relation to engine speed is temperature
dependent.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Clutch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Intermittent Downshift/Slip/Cycling Diagnosis > Page 2448
Maximum fan speed (air flow and related fan noise) through the engine compartment is
experienced under two conditions.
1. When the vehicle sits in an unused condition for several hours, the viscous fluid within the
thermostatic fan clutch assembly migrates and fully engages the clutch of the fan. After a short
drive, the viscous fluid will migrate to the storage area in the fan clutch and the fan clutch will slip,
reducing the noise (roar of the fan). This is normal thermostatic fan clutch operation.
2. When the engine is running, and the air being drawn by the fan or pushed through the radiator
from the vehicle movement reaches a high enough temperature, the fan clutch will fully engage the
fan clutch, drawing additional air through the radiator to lower the engine coolant temperature and
A/C refrigerant temperature. When the cooling fan clutch fully engages, fan noise increases (for
example; this is the same as switching an electric household fan from low to high speed). Some
customers have interpreted this sound increase to be an increase in the engine RPM due to
transmission downshift, transmission slipping, or TCC cycling. As the engine coolant temperature
decreases, the fan clutch will begin to slip, lowering the actual speed of the fan blade and the
resultant sound.
Service Procedure
When diagnosing an intermittent transmission downshift, slip, or busy/cycling TCC, follow these
steps:
1. Verify the transmission fluid level and the fluid condition. Refer to the Automatic Transmission
sub-section of the appropriate Service Manual.
2. Test drive the vehicle under the conditions described by the customer (ambient temperature,
engine coolant temperature, trailering, etc.). It may be necessary to partially restrict airflow to the
radiator in order to raise the engine coolant temperature to match the customer's conditions.
3. Monitor the engine RPM and the engine coolant temperature using a scan tool.
4. Listen for an actual increase in the engine RPM. Use either the vehicle tachometer (if equipped),
the Tech 2 RPM or transmission slip speed as an indicator, rather than just the sound.
If the engine RPM display on the tachometer or the Tech 2 increases, verify the scan tool RPM and
coolant temperature readings. If the noise increase is due to the engagement of the fan, the engine
RPM will not increase and the engine coolant temperature will begin to decrease after the fan
engages. As the fan runs, the engine coolant temperature will drop and the fan will disengage,
reducing noise levels. The engine RPM will not decrease. This cycle will repeat as the engine
coolant temperature rises again.
If the above procedure shows the condition to be cooling fan-related, no further action is
necessary. The vehicle should be returned to the customer and the condition explained.
If the above procedure shows the condition to be other than cooling fan-related, refer to the
Automatic Transmission sub-section of the appropriate Service Manual for transmission diagnosis
information.
The following information regarding the operation of the engine cooling fan should be photocopied
and given to the customer.
Intermittent Transmission Downshift
All light duty trucks are equipped with a thermostatic engine cooling fan. This fan is designed to
provide greater fuel efficiency and quieter operation than a standard fan. These benefits are
possible through the addition of a thermostatic clutch to the fan drive. When the engine is cool (it
the engine has been run in the last few hours), the clutch allows the fan to "slip" or turn at a speed
slower than the engine. By turning at a slower speed, the fan uses less horsepower, which saves
fuel, and is quieter. When the engine temperature reaches a preset temperature or if the engine
has not been run for several hours, the fan "engages" and turns at the same speed as the engine.
"Engagement" of the fan provides increased airflow through the radiator to cool the engine. As the
airflow increases, fan operation becomes clearly audible.
This increase in noise can easily be mistaken for an increase in engine RPM and may be
incorrectly blamed on the automatic transmission. When operating an unloaded vehicle in cooler
ambient temperatures, the thermostatic clutch usually won't fully engage. However, if the vehicle is
pulling a trailer, is heavily loaded or is operated at high ambient temperatures, the thermostatic fan
clutch may cycle on and off as the engine coolant temperature rises and falls.
The sound of fan operation under the conditions described above is a sign that the cooling system
on your vehicle is working correctly. Replacement or modification of the cooling system or the
transmission parts will not change or reduce the noise level. Attempts to reduce this noise may
cause you, the customer, to believe that your vehicle is not reliable and will inconvenience you by
causing your vehicle to be out of service.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Clutch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Intermittent Downshift/Slip/Cycling Diagnosis > Page 2449
DISCLAIMER
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Clutch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2450
Fan Clutch: Specifications
Cooling Fan Clutch to Water Pump Bolts
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................. 56 Nm (41 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine Compartment Fan > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Engine Compartment Fan: Service and Repair
Fan Replacement
Tools Required J41240 Fan Clutch Wrench
Removal Procedure
Caution: To help avoid personal injury or damage to the vehicle, a bent, cracked, or damaged fan
blade or housing should always be replaced.
1. Remove the upper fan shroud.
2. Remove the fan clutch using the J41240. 3. Remove the fan and fan blade clutch assembly from
the vehicle. 4. Remove the four bolts retaining the fan blade to the fan blade clutch. 5. Remove the
fan from the fan blade clutch.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the fan to the fan blade clutch.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the four bolts retaining the fan blade to the clutch.
Tighten the bolts to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
3. Install the fan blade clutch assembly using the J41240.
Tighten the fan blade clutch assembly to 56 Nm (41 ft. lbs.).
4. Install the upper fan shroud.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 15 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Specifications > Page
2458
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Specifications > Page
2459
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Specifications > Page
2460
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Specifications > Page
2461
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Drain the cooling system. 2. Remove the engine cover.
3. Remove the coolant temperature sensor electrical connector from the electrical harness at the
intake manifold. 4. Remove the coolant temperature sensor electrical connector from the intake
manifold bracket. 5. Remove the coolant temperature sensor from the cylinder head.
Installation Procedure
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the coolant temperature sensor to the cylinder head.
Tighten the sensor to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
2. Snap the coolant temperature sensor electrical connector to the intake manifold bracket. 3.
Connect the coolant temperature sensor electrical connector to the wiring harness at the intake
manifold. 4. Install the engine cover. 5. Fill the cooling system with coolant.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Fan Shroud > Component Information >
Specifications
Fan Shroud: Specifications
Upper Fan Shroud Bolts
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................. 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Fan Shroud > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Fan Shroud Replacement - Upper
Fan Shroud: Service and Repair Fan Shroud Replacement - Upper
Fan Shroud Replacement - Upper
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the air cleaner assembly.
2. Remove the upper fan shroud bolts. 3. Remove the upper fan shroud.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the upper fan shroud.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the upper shroud bolts.
Tighten the bolts to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.).
3. Install the air cleaner assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Fan Shroud > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Fan Shroud Replacement - Upper > Page 2467
Fan Shroud: Service and Repair Fan Shroud Replacement - Lower
Fan Shroud Replacement - Lower
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the air cleaner assembly.
2. Remove the upper fan shroud bolts. 3. Remove the upper fan shroud.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the upper fan shroud.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the upper shroud bolts.
Tighten the bolts to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.).
3. Install the air cleaner assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Control Valve > Component
Information > Diagrams
Coolant Bypass Valve Solenoid - HVAC Systems - Manual
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Control Valve > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Hot Water Bypass Valve Replacement (Front)
Heater Control Valve: Service and Repair Hot Water Bypass Valve Replacement (Front)
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38185 Hose Clamp Pliers
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the air cleaner. 2. Remove the upper fan shroud. 3. Drain the engine coolant. Refer to
Draining and Filling Cooling System 4. Remove the heater inlet pipe (5) and the outlet pipe (6) from
the bypass valves (4). 5. Remove the bolt (3) that retains the valve (4) to the heater assembly. 6.
Remove the bypass valve (4) from the heater assembly.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the bypass valve (4) to the heater assembly.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice
2. Install the bolt (3) that retains the valve (4) to the heater assembly.
Tighten Tighten the bolt to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Control Valve > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Hot Water Bypass Valve Replacement (Front) > Page 2473
3. Install the heater inlet pipe (5) and the outlet pipe (6) to the bypass valves. 4. Refill the cooling
system. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System 5. Install the upper fan shroud. 6. Install the
air cleaner.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Control Valve > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Hot Water Bypass Valve Replacement (Front) > Page 2474
Heater Control Valve: Service and Repair Hot Water Bypass Valve Replacement (Rear)
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38185 Hose Clamp Pliers
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the air cleaner. 2. Remove the upper fan shroud. 3. Drain the engine coolant. Refer to
Draining and Filling Cooling System 4. Disconnect the electrical connector from the valve. 5.
Disconnect the vacuum hose from the valve. 6. Remove the hose clamps from the outlet pipe (8)
and from the inlet pipe (4). 7. Remove the bolt (3) that retains the valve to the heater assembly. 8.
Remove the bypass valve (5) from the heater assembly. 9. Remove the heater hoses from the
engine to the hot water bypass valve.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the heater hoses to the engine to the hot water bypass valve. 2. Install the bypass valve
(5) to the heater assembly.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice.
3. Install the bolt (3) that retains the valve (5) to the heater assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Control Valve > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Hot Water Bypass Valve Replacement (Front) > Page 2475
Tighten Tighten the bolt to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
4. Install the heater inlet pipe (4) and the outlet pipe to the bypass valves. 5. Connect the vacuum
hose to the valve. 6. Connect the electrical connector to the valve. 7. Refill the cooling system.
Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System 8. Install the upper fan shroud. 9. Install the air
cleaner.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators
Heater Core: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 05-06-02-001A
Date: July 16, 2008
Subject: Information On Aluminum Heater Core and/or Radiator Replacement
Models: 2005 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2005
HUMMER H2
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to update the Warranty Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 05-06-02-001 (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
Important:
2004-05 Chevrolet Aveo (Pontiac Wave, Canada Only) does not use DEX-COOL(R). Refer to the
flushing procedure explained later in this bulletin.
The following information should be utilized when servicing aluminum heater core and/or radiators
on repeat visits. A replacement may be necessary because erosion, corrosion, or insufficient
inhibitor levels may cause damage to the heater core, radiator or water pump. A coolant check
should be performed whenever a heater core, radiator, or water pump is replaced. The following
procedures/ inspections should be done to verify proper coolant effectiveness.
Caution:
To avoid being burned, do not remove the radiator cap or surge tank cap while the engine is hot.
The cooling system will release scalding fluid and steam under pressure if the radiator cap or surge
tank cap is removed while the engine and radiator are still hot.
Important:
If the vehicle's coolant is low, drained out, or the customer has repeatedly added coolant or water
to the system, then the system should be completely flushed using the procedure explained later in
this bulletin.
Technician Diagnosis
^ Verify coolant concentration. A 50% coolant/water solution ensures proper freeze and corrosion
protection. Inhibitor levels cannot be easily measured in the field, but can be indirectly done by the
measurement of coolant concentration. This must be done by using a Refractometer J 23688
(Fahrenheit scale) or J 26568 (centigrade scale), or equivalent, coolant tester. The Refractometer
uses a minimal amount of coolant that can be taken from the coolant recovery reservoir, radiator or
the engine block. Inexpensive gravity float testers (floating balls) will not completely analyze the
coolant concentration fully and should not be used. The concentration levels should be between
50% and 65% coolant concentrate. This mixture will have a freeze point protection of -34 degrees
Fahrenheit (-37 degrees Celsius). If the concentration is below 50%, the cooling system must be
flushed.
^ Inspect the coolant flow restrictor if the vehicle is equipped with one. Refer to Service Information
(SI) and/or the appropriate Service Manual for component location and condition for operation.
^ Verify that no electrolysis is present in the cooling system. This electrolysis test can be performed
before or after the system has been repaired. Use a digital voltmeter set to 12 volts. Attach one test
lead to the negative battery post and insert the other test lead into the radiator coolant, making sure
the lead does not touch the filler neck or core. Any voltage reading over 0.3 volts indicates that
stray current is finding its way into the coolant. Electrolysis is often an intermittent condition that
occurs when a device or accessory that is mounted to the radiator is energized. This type of current
could be caused from a poorly grounded cooling fan or some other accessory and can be verified
by watching the volt meter and turning on and off various accessories or engage the starter motor.
Before using one of the following flush procedures, the coolant recovery reservoir must be
removed, drained, cleaned and reinstalled before refilling the system.
Notice:
^ Using coolant other than DEX‐COOL(R) may cause premature engine, heater core or
radiator corrosion. In addition, the engine coolant may require changing sooner, at 30,000 miles
(50,000 km) or 24 months, whichever occurs first. Any repairs would not be covered by your
warranty. Always use DEX‐COOL(R) (silicate free) coolant in your vehicle.
^ If you use an improper coolant mixture, your engine could overheat and be badly damaged. The
repair cost would not be covered by your warranty. Too much water in the mixture can freeze and
crack the engine, radiator, heater core and other parts.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators > Page 2480
Flushing Procedures using DEX-COOL(R)
Important:
The following procedure recommends refilling the system with DEX-COOL(R), P/N 12346290 (in
Canada, use P/N 10953464), GM specification 6277M. This coolant is orange in color and has a
service interval of 5 years or 240,000 km (150,000 mi). However, when used on vehicles built prior
to the introduction of DEX-COOL(R), maintenance intervals will remain the same as specified in the
Owner's Manual.
^ If available, use the approved cooling system flush and fill machine (available through the GM
Dealer Equipment Program) following the manufacturer's operating instructions.
^ If approved cooling system flush and fill machine is not available, drain the coolant and dispose of
properly following the draining procedures in the appropriate Service Manual. Refill the system
using clear, drinkable water and run the vehicle until the thermostat opens. Repeat and run the
vehicle three (3) times to totally remove the old coolant or until the drained coolant is almost clear.
Once the system is completely flushed, refill the cooling system to a 50%-60% concentration with
DEX‐COOL(R), P/N 12346290 (in Canada, use P/N 10953464), GM specification 6277M,
following the refill procedures in the appropriate Service Manual.
If a Service Manual is not available, fill half the capacity of the system with 100% DEX-COOL(R),
P/N 12346290 (in Canada, use P/N 10953464), GM specification 6277M. Then slowly add clear,
drinkable water (preferably distilled) to the system until the level of the coolant mixture has reached
the base of the radiator neck. Wait two (2) minutes and reverify the coolant level. If necessary, add
clean water to restore the coolant to the appropriate level.
Once the system is refilled, reverify the coolant concentration using a Refractometer J 23688
(Fahrenheit scale) or J 26568 (centigrade scale) coolant tester, or equivalent. The concentration
levels should be between 50% and 65%.
Flushing Procedures using Conventional Silicated (Green Colored) Coolant
Important:
2004-2005 Chevrolet Aveo (Pontiac Wave, Canada Only) does not use DEX‐COOL(R).
The Aveo and Wave are filled with conventional, silicated engine coolant that is blue in color.
Silicated coolants are typically green in color and are required to be drained, flushed and refilled
every 30,000 miles (48,000 km). The Aveo and Wave are to be serviced with conventional, silicated
coolant. Use P/N 12378560 (1 gal) (in Canada, use P/N 88862159 (1 L). Refer to the Owner's
Manual or Service Information (SI) for further information on OEM coolant.
Important:
Do not mix the OEM orange colored DEX-COOL(R) coolant with green colored coolant when
adding coolant to the system or when servicing the vehicle's cooling system. Mixing the orange and
green colored coolants will produce a brown coolant which may be a customer dissatisfier and will
not extend the service interval to that of DEX-COOL(R). Conventional silicated coolants offered by
GM Service and Parts Operations are green in color.
^ If available, use the approved cooling system flush and fill machine (available through the GM
Dealer Equipment Program) following the manufacturer's operating instructions.
^ If approved cooling systems flush and fill machine is not available, drain coolant and dispose of
properly following the draining procedures in appropriate Service Manual. Refill the system using
clear, drinkable water and run vehicle until thermostat opens. Repeat and run vehicle three (3)
times to totally remove old coolant or until drained coolant is almost clear. Once the system is
completely flushed, refill the cooling system to a 50%-60% concentration with a good quality
ethylene glycol base engine coolant, P/N 12378560, 1 gal (in Canada, use P/N 88862159 1 L),
conforming to GM specification 1825M, or recycled coolant conforming to GM specification 1825M,
following the refill procedures in the appropriate Service Manual.
If a Service Manual is not available, fill half the capacity of the system with 100% good quality
ethylene glycol base (green colored) engine coolant, P/N 12378560 1 gal., (in Canada, use P/N
88862159 1 L) conforming to GM specification 1825M. Then slowly add clear, drinkable water
(preferably distilled) to system until the level of the coolant mixture has reached the base of the
radiator neck. Wait two (2) minutes and recheck coolant level. If necessary, add clean water to
restore coolant to the appropriate level.
Once the system is refilled, recheck the coolant concentration using a Refractometer J 23688
(Fahrenheit scale) or J 26568 (centigrade scale) coolant tester, or equivalent. Concentration levels
should be between 50% and 65%.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators > Page 2481
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Case/Cover Replacement
Heater Core: Service and Repair Heater Case/Cover Replacement
HEATER CASE REPLACEMENT (C60)
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Drain the engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System in Cooling System. 2.
Recover the refrigerant. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 3. Remove the heater
hoses from the heater core. 4. Remove the evaporator case from the vehicle.
5. Remove the heater case retaining nuts (2) from the engine compartment. 6. Roll out the
instrument panel. Refer to IP Carrier Replacement in Instrument Panel, Gages and Console. 7.
Disconnect the electrical connectors. 8. Disconnect the vacuum lines. 9. Remove the heater case
(5) from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Case/Cover Replacement > Page 2484
1. Install the heater case (5) to the vehicle. 2. Connect the vacuum lines. 3. Connect the electrical
connectors. 4. Roll the instrument panel upward. Refer to IP Carrier Replacement in Instrument
Panel, Gages and Console.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
5. Install the heater case retaining nuts (2) to the engine compartment.
Tighten Tighten the nuts to 6 N.m (53 lb in).
6. Install the evaporator casing to the vehicle.
7. Connect the heater hoses from the heater core. 8. Evacuate and recharge the A/C system. Refer
to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 9. Fill the engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling
Cooling System in Cooling System.
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article/images refer to the RPO Code List found
at Vehicle/Application ID. See: Application and ID/RPO Codes
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Case/Cover Replacement > Page 2485
Heater Core: Service and Repair Heater Core Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Drain the engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System in Cooling System. 2.
Remove the heater hoses. 3. Remove the screws (9) that retain the cover to the heater case
assembly. 4. Remove the straps (8) that retain the heater core to the heater case assembly. 5.
Remove the heater core (7) from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the heater core to the vehicle. 2. Install the straps that retain the heater core to the heater
case assembly.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the screws that retain the heater core to the heater case assembly.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
4. Install the heater hoses. 5. Refill the cooling system. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling
System in Cooling System.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Case/Cover Replacement > Page 2486
Heater Core: Service and Repair Heater Core Replacement - Auxiliary
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Drain the engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System in Cooling System. 2.
Remove the body side front lower trim panel. 3. Remove the clamps from the auxiliary heater
pipes. 4. Disconnect the auxiliary heater pipes from the auxiliary heater module. 5. Remove the
screws and the band clamp from the right side of the heater core. 6. Remove the screw and the
band clamp from the left side of the heater core.
IMPORTANT: Before removing the auxiliary heater module from the vehicle, be sure to place a
protective cover on the floor in order to prevent coolant from leaking onto the carpet.
7. Remove the heater core from the heater core case. 8. Remove the seals from the heater core.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the seals to the heater core. 2. Install the heater core into the heater core case.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the screw and the band clamp to the left side of the heater core.
Tighten Tighten the screws and the band clamp to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
4. Install the screws and the band clamp to the right side of the heater core.
Tighten Tighten the screw and the band clamp to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Case/Cover Replacement > Page 2487
5. Connect the auxiliary heater pipes from the auxiliary heater module. 6. Install the clamps to the
auxiliary heater pipes. 7. Install the body side front lower trim panel. 8. Refill the system with engine
coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System in Cooling System.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Pipe Replacement - Auxiliary Front
Heater Hose: Service and Repair Heater Pipe Replacement - Auxiliary Front
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Drain the engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System in Cooling System. 2.
Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 3. Remove the front pipes (5) from the
rear pipes. 4. Remove the bolts (3) that retain the front pipes (5) to the body. 5. Remove the clips
(4) that retain the front pipes (5) to the body. 6. Remove the auxiliary heater front pipes (5) from the
heater hoses (1). 7. Remove the auxiliary heater front pipes (5).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the auxiliary heater front pipes (5). 2. Connect the auxiliary heater front pipes (5) to the
heater hoses (1). 3. Install the front pipe retaining clips (4) that retains the front pipes (5) to the
body.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the bolts (3) that retain the front pipes (5) to the body.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
5. Connect the auxiliary heater front pipes (5) to the rear pipes. 6. Fill the cooling system with
engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System in Cooling System.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Pipe Replacement - Auxiliary Front > Page 2492
7. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Pipe Replacement - Auxiliary Front > Page 2493
Heater Hose: Service and Repair Heater Pipe Replacement - Auxiliary Rear
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Drain the engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System in Cooling System. 2.
Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 3. Disconnect the auxiliary heater rear
pipes from the heater core inlet and outlet tubes. 4. Disconnect the auxiliary heater rear pipes from
the front pipes. 5. Remove the pipe retainers from the body. 6. Remove the auxiliary heater rear
pipes.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the auxiliary heater rear pipes. 2. Install the pipe retainers to the body. 3. Connect the
auxiliary heater rear pipes to the front pipes. 4. Connect the rear pipes to the auxiliary heater core
inlet and outlet tubes. 5. Refill the cooling system with engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling
Cooling System in Cooling System. 6. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Pipe Replacement - Auxiliary Front > Page 2494
Heater Hose: Service and Repair Heater Hose Replacement - Inlet
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 38185 Hose Clamp Pliers
^ J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the air cleaner. 2. Drain the engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling
System in Cooling System. 3. Remove the windshield washers and the coolant reservoir from the
vehicle. 4. Remove the heater hose support bolt (5) from the clamp (4). 5. Remove the clamp from
the heater hose. 6. Disconnect the inlet (3) hose from the heater core. 7. Disconnect the inlet (3)
hose from the water valve.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Connect the inlet (3) hose to the water valve. 2. Connect the inlet (3) hose to the heating core. 3.
Install the clamp to the heater hose.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the heater hose support bolt (5) to the heater hose clamp (4).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Pipe Replacement - Auxiliary Front > Page 2495
Tighten Tighten the bolt to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
5. Use the J 38185 6. Install the windshield washers and the coolant reservoir. 7. Fill the cooling
system. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System in Cooling System. 8. Leak test the fittings
component using the J 39400-A 9. Install the air cleaner.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Pipe Replacement - Auxiliary Front > Page 2496
Heater Hose: Service and Repair Heater Hose Replacement - Outlet
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 38185 Hose Clamp Pliers
^ J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the air cleaner. 2. Drain the engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling
System in Cooling System. 3. Remove the windshield washers and the coolant reservoir from the
vehicle. 4. Remove the heater hose support bolt (5) from the clamp (4). 5. Remove the clamp from
the heater hose. 6. Disconnect the outlet (2) hoses from the heater core. 7. Disconnect the outlet
(2) hoses from the water valve.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Connect the outlet (2) hose to the water valve. 2. Connect the outlet (2) hose to the heating core.
3. Install the clamp to the heater hose.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the heater hose support bolt (5) to the heater hose clamp (4).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Pipe Replacement - Auxiliary Front > Page 2497
Tighten Tighten the bolt to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
5. Use the J 38185 6. Install the windshield washers and the coolant reservoir. 7. Fill the cooling
system. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System in Cooling System. 8. Leak test the fitting
component using the J 39400-A 9. Install the air cleaner.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Temperature Gauge: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2503
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2504
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2505
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2506
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2507
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2508
Temperature Gauge: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2509
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2510
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2511
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2512
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2513
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2514
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2515
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2516
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2517
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2518
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2519
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2520
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2521
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2522
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2523
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2524
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2525
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2526
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2527
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2528
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2529
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2530
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2531
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2532
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2533
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2534
Temperature Gauge: Electrical Diagrams
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators Diagrams.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2535
Temperature Gauge: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Radiator Drain Plug >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Radiator Drain Plug: Service and Repair
Drain Cock Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Drain the coolant from the radiator.
2. Remove the radiator drain stem and seal. The seal usually comes out attached to the stem. 3.
Remove the body of the drain cock. Use your fingers or needle nose pliers to disengage the locking
tangs from the side tank. 4. Clean the drain.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the drain cock body. Ensure that the body is fully seated in the side tank and that the
locking tangs are engaged. 2. Install the seal on the drain cock stem. 3. Install the drain cock. Turn
the stem clockwise to lock. 4. Refill the coolant to the proper level.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Hose > Component Information
> Specifications
Radiator Hose: Specifications
Upper Radiator Hose Support Bracket Nut to Exhaust Manifold Stud
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 27 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Hose > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Radiator Hose Replacement - Inlet
Radiator Hose: Service and Repair Radiator Hose Replacement - Inlet
Radiator Hose Replacement - Inlet
Removal Procedure
1. Drain the coolant from the radiator to a level below the hose being removed. 2. Remove the air
cleaner assembly.
3. Reposition the radiator hose clamp. 4. Remove the inlet hose from the radiator. 5. Reposition the
clamp from the thermostat housing. 6. Remove the inlet hose from the thermostat housing
Installation Procedure
1. Install the inlet hose to the thermostat housing. 2. Reposition the clamp to the thermostat
housing. 3. Install the inlet hose to the radiator. 4. Reposition the clamp to the radiator. 5. Install the
air cleaner assembly. 6. Fill the coolant to the proper level.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Hose > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Radiator Hose Replacement - Inlet > Page 2545
Radiator Hose: Service and Repair Radiator Hose Replacement - Outlet
Radiator Hose Replacement - Outlet
Removal Procedure
1. Drain the engine coolant. 2. Remove the air cleaner assembly. 3. Reposition the radiator hose
clamp. 4. Remove the outlet hose from the radiator. 5. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to
Vehicle Lifting. 6. Reposition the outlet hose clamp from the water pump.
7. Remove the outlet hose from the water pump.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the outlet hose to the water pump. 2. Reposition the outlet hose clamp to the water pump.
3. Lower the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 4. Install the outlet hose to radiator. 5. Reposition the
radiator hose clamp.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Hose > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Radiator Hose Replacement - Inlet > Page 2546
6. Install the air cleaner assembly. 7. Fill the engine coolant.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 15 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2552
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2553
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2554
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2555
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Drain the cooling system. 2. Remove the engine cover.
3. Remove the coolant temperature sensor electrical connector from the electrical harness at the
intake manifold. 4. Remove the coolant temperature sensor electrical connector from the intake
manifold bracket. 5. Remove the coolant temperature sensor from the cylinder head.
Installation Procedure
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the coolant temperature sensor to the cylinder head.
Tighten the sensor to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
2. Snap the coolant temperature sensor electrical connector to the intake manifold bracket. 3.
Connect the coolant temperature sensor electrical connector to the wiring harness at the intake
manifold. 4. Install the engine cover. 5. Fill the cooling system with coolant.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Temperature Gauge: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2560
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2561
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2562
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2563
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2564
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2565
Temperature Gauge: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2566
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2567
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2568
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2569
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2570
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2571
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2572
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2573
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2574
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2575
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2576
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2577
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2578
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2579
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2580
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2581
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2582
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2583
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2584
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2585
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2586
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2587
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2588
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2589
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2590
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2591
Temperature Gauge: Electrical Diagrams
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators Diagrams.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 2592
Temperature Gauge: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Thermostat: Service and Repair
Thermostat Replacement
Removal Procedure
Caution: In order to avoid being burned, do not service the engine while it is still hot. Service the
engine when it is cool.
1. Drain the coolant to a level below the thermostat. 2. Remove the air cleaner assembly. 3.
Disconnect the ground lead from the coolant outlet.
4. Remove the Bolt/Stud and the bolt on the coolant outlet. 5. Remove the coolant outlet. 6.
Remove the thermostat. 7. Clean all of the parts and the sealing surfaces.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the thermostat. 2. Install the coolant outlet.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the bolt and the Bolt/Stud.
Tighten the bolt and the Bolt/Stud to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
4. Install the ground lead to the Bolt/Stud. 5. Install the air cleaner assembly. 6. Refill the coolant. 7.
Start the engine. After the engine reaches normal operating temperature, check for coolant leaks.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications
Water Pump: Specifications
Water Pump Bolt
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 33 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2599
Water Pump: Service and Repair
Water Pump Replacement
Removal Procedure
Caution: In order to avoid being burned, do not service the engine while it is still hot. Service the
engine when it is cool.
1. Drain the coolant from the radiator. 2. Remove the air cleaner assembly. 3. Remove the Mass
Air Flow (MAP) sensor. 4. Remove the upper fan shroud. 5. Remove the drive belt. 6. Remove the
fan and fan blade clutch assembly.
7. Remove the coolant pump pulley bolts and the pulley.
8. Disconnect the coolant bypass hose and clamps. 9. Disconnect the radiator outlet hose from the
coolant pump.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2600
10. Remove the four coolant pump bolts. 11. Remove the coolant pump. 12. Remove the gaskets.
Important: Make sure all of the gasket mating surfaces are free of burrs or other imperfections.
13. Inspect all of the parts. Replace the parts as necessary.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the coolant pump gaskets. 2. Install the coolant pump.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the four bolts retaining the coolant pump.
Tighten the bolts to 45 Nm (33 ft. lbs.).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2601
4. Connect the coolant bypass hose and clamps. 5. Connect the radiator outlet hose to the coolant
pump.
6. Install the coolant pump pulley and the bolts.
Tighten the coolant pump pulley bolts to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
7. Install the fan and fan blade clutch assembly. 8. Install the drive belt. 9. Install the upper fan
shroud and the bolts.
10. Install the Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor. 11. Install the air cleaner assembly. 12. Refill the
radiator with coolant. 13. Start engine. After engine reaches normal operating temperature, check
for coolant leaks.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Specifications
Catalytic Converter: Specifications
Catalytic Converter-to-Muffler Nuts
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................. 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2606
Catalytic Converter: Service and Repair
Catalytic Converter Replacement (RWD)
Removal Procedure
Caution: Always wear protective goggles and gloves when removing exhaust parts as falling rust
and sharp edges from worn exhaust components could result in serious personal injury.
Caution: In order to avoid being burned, do not service the exhaust system while it is still hot.
Service the system when it is cool. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion may make removing
exhaust components difficult. Applying a penetrating oil on the threads of the bolts may assist in
the removal of these components.
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Support the catalytic converter assembly.
3. Remove the 3 oxygen sensor electrical connections and clips.
4. Remove the nuts from the muffler flange bolts.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2607
5. Remove the nuts from the exhaust manifold studs (right side). 6. Disconnect the collars from the
exhaust manifold studs (right side).
7. Remove the nuts from the exhaust manifold studs (left side). 8. Disconnect the collars from the
exhaust manifold studs (left side).
9. Remove the catalytic converter assembly from the muffler assembly.
10. Remove the catalytic converter assembly from the exhaust manifolds. 11. Lower the front of the
catalytic converter assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2608
12. Remove the catalytic converter assembly from the hanger.
Notice: Do not damage the oxygen sensors when removing the catalytic converter.
13. Remove the catalytic converter assembly from the vehicle by rotating the assembly over the
rear of the transmission crossmember. 14. Remove the 3 oxygen sensors.
Installation Procedure
When installing exhaust components, inspect the exhaust system for proper alignment. Misaligned
components commonly cause rattles, noise and vibrations in the exhaust system. During system
alignment, leave all of the bolts or nuts loose, until all of the parts are properly aligned. After
properly aligning the parts, tighten the bolts or nuts from the front to the rear. In order to maintain
the alignment of the exhaust system, replace any damaged exhaust system hangers, hanger
brackets, and clamps.
Important: Replacement of exhaust system parts must be OEM standard to ensure that the vehicle operates
as designed.
- When exhaust system service requires removing and replacing an oxygen sensor, refer to the
applicable service procedure.
- Always use new nuts when installing the exhaust pipe to the exhaust manifold.
- Before installing the new nuts, clean the exhaust manifold stud threads with a wire brush.
1. Install the 3 oxygen sensors to the catalytic converter assembly. 2. Install the catalytic converter
assembly to the hanger.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2609
3. Install the collars on the catalytic converter assembly to the exhaust manifold studs (left side). 4.
Loosely install the nuts onto the exhaust manifold studs (left side).
5. Install the collars on the catalytic converter assembly to the exhaust manifold studs (right side).
6. Loosely install the nuts onto the exhaust manifold studs (right side).
7. Connect the catalytic converter assembly and the gasket to the muffler assembly. 8. Loosely
install the nuts.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2610
9. Tighten the exhaust manifold nuts in proper sequence (1-6).
- Tighten the catalytic converter assembly-to-exhaust manifold nuts to 53 Nm (39 ft. lbs.).
- Tighten the catalytic converter assembly-to-muffler assembly nuts to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
10. Install the three oxygen sensor electrical connections and clips. 11. Remove the support from
the catalytic converter assembly. 12. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component
Information > Specifications
Exhaust Manifold: Specifications
Exhaust Manifold Bolt/Stud
Torque:
First Pass .............................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 11 ft. lbs. Final Pass .................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... 22 ft. lbs.
Exhaust Manifold
Surface Flatness:
Flange to Flange .................................................................................................................................
0.25 mm - Maximum (0.010 inch - Maximum) Individual Flange
................................................................................................................................ 0.05 mm Maximum (0.002 inch - Maximum)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Exhaust Manifold Replacement - Left
Exhaust Manifold: Service and Repair Exhaust Manifold Replacement - Left
Exhaust Manifold Replacement - Left
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the engine cover.
2. Disconnect the Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor. 3. Raise the vehicle. Refer to
Vehicle Lifting. 4. Remove the left front tire.
5. Remove the left fender wheelhouse extension. 6. Remove the catalytic converter assembly. 7.
Remove the spark plug wires from the spark plugs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Exhaust Manifold Replacement - Left > Page 2616
8. Remove the spark plug wire support bolts. 9. Remove the spark plug wire support with the spark
plug wires.
10. Remove the front 4 exhaust manifold bolts through the wheelhouse. 11. Remove the 2 rear
exhaust manifold bolts through the engine cover opening. 12. Remove the exhaust manifold,
gaskets and the spark plug wire shields from underneath the vehicle. 13. Clean all gasket surfaces.
Installation Procedure
Important: To assist in installing the exhaust manifold to the engine, the tabs on a NEW exhaust
manifold gasket will hold the gasket and the bolts in place.
1. Sub-assemble the NEW gaskets, the spark plug wire shields, and the bolts to the exhaust
manifold.
2. Ensure that the exhaust manifold bolts are held in place by the tabs on the exhaust manifold
gaskets. 3. Install the exhaust manifold.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Exhaust Manifold Replacement - Left > Page 2617
- Tighten the 2 rear exhaust manifold bolts through the engine cover opening.
- Tighten the front 4 exhaust manifold bolts through the wheelhouse.
4. Install the spark plug wires to the spark plugs.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
5. Install the spark plug wire support and bolts.
Tighten the spark plug wire support bolts to 12 Nm (106 inch lbs.).
6. Install the catalytic converter assembly.
7. Install the fender wheelhouse extension. 8. Install the left front tire. 9. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Exhaust Manifold Replacement - Left > Page 2618
10. Connect the ECT sensor electrical connector. 11. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Exhaust Manifold Replacement - Left > Page 2619
Exhaust Manifold: Service and Repair Exhaust Manifold Replacement - Right
Exhaust Manifold Replacement - Right
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the right front tire.
3. Remove the right fender wheelhouse extension. 4. Disconnect the spark plug wires from the
spark plugs. 5. Remove the catalytic converter assembly.
6. Remove the exhaust manifold bolts through the wheelhouse. 7. Remove the exhaust manifold
with the exhaust manifold gaskets and the spark plug wire shields from the engine. 8. Clean all
gasket surfaces.
Installation Procedure
Important: To assist in installing the exhaust manifold to the engine, the tabs on a NEW exhaust
manifold gasket will hold the gasket and the bolts in place.
1. Sub-assemble the NEW gaskets, the spark plug wire shields, and the bolts to the exhaust
manifold.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Exhaust Manifold Replacement - Left > Page 2620
2. Ensure that the exhaust manifold bolts are held in place by the tabs on the exhaust manifold
gaskets. 3. Install the exhaust manifold. 4. Install the catalytic converter assembly. 5. Install the
spark plug wires.
6. Install the fender wheelhouse extension. 7. Install the front tire. 8. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information
> Specifications
Exhaust Pipe: Specifications
Exhaust Pipe
Exhaust Pipe-to-Manifold Nuts
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
........................................... 53 Nm (39 ft. lbs.)
Exhaust Pipe-to-Manifold Studs
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
........................................... 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe/Muffler Hanger >
Component Information > Specifications
Exhaust Pipe/Muffler Hanger: Specifications
Muffler Hanger
Hanger-to-Frame Nuts
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
........................................... 45 Nm (33 ft. lbs.)
Hanger-to-Transfer Case Bolts (A4WD)
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
........................................... 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.)
Hanger-to-Transmission Bolts (RWD)
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
........................................... 45 Nm (33 ft. lbs.)
Hanger-to-Frame Bolts
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
........................................... 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Muffler: Service and Repair
Muffler Replacement
Removal Procedure
Caution: Always wear protective goggles and gloves when removing exhaust parts as falling rust
and sharp edges from worn exhaust components could result in serious personal injury.
Caution: In order to avoid being burned, do not service the exhaust system while it is still hot
Service the system when it is cool. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion may make removing
exhaust components difficult. Applying a penetrating oil on the threads of the bolts may assist in
the removal of these components.
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Support the muffler assembly.
3. Remove the 3 nuts connecting the muffler assembly to the catalytic converter assembly.
4. To aid in the removal of the muffler assembly, lubricate the rubber hangers with rubber lubricant
GM P/N 12345884.
Remove the muffler assembly from the front hanger.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 2630
5. Remove muffler assembly from the rear hanger.
6. Remove the muffler assembly from the tailpipe hanger. 7. Remove the muffler assembly from
the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
When installing exhaust components, inspect the exhaust system for proper alignment. Misaligned
components commonly cause rattles, noise and vibrations in the exhaust system. During system
alignment, leave all of the bolts or nuts loose, until all of the parts are properly aligned. After
properly aligning the parts, tighten the bolts or nuts from the front to the rear. In order to maintain
the alignment of the exhaust system, replace any damaged exhaust system hangers, hanger
brackets, and clamps.
Important: Replacement of exhaust system parts must be OEM standard to ensure that the vehicle operates
as designed.
- Replace the tailpipe when replacing the muffler.
- Always use new nuts when installing the exhaust pipe to the exhaust manifold.
- Before installing the new nuts, clean the exhaust manifold stud threads with a wire brush.
1. To aid in the installation of the muffler assembly, lubricate the rubber hangers with rubber
lubricant GM PIN 12345884.
Install the muffler assembly into the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 2631
2. Connect the muffler assembly to the tailpipe hanger.
3. Connect the muffler assembly to the rear hanger.
4. Connect muffler assembly to the front hanger.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 2632
5. Install the 3 nuts to connect the muffler assembly to the catalytic converter assembly.
Tighten the nuts to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Body Control
Module (BCM) C1
Body Control Module C1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Body Control
Module (BCM) C1 > Page 2640
Body Control Module C2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Body Control
Module (BCM) C1 > Page 2641
Body Control Module C3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2642
Body Control Module: Description and Operation
The BCM contains the logic of the theft deterrent system. The BCM provides the battery positive
voltage to operate the Passlock(TM) Sensor. The BCM also measures the voltage of the security
sensor signal circuit. The voltage measured will indicate whether the Passlock(TM) Sensor has
been activated and whether the resistance value from the sensor is a valid value or the tamper
value. If voltage measured is in the valid range, the BCM compares this voltage, voltage code, to a
previously learned voltage code. If the voltage codes match, the BCM sends a class 2 message
containing a password to the PCM. If the voltage codes do not match, or the voltage is in the
Tamper range, or there is a circuit fault, the BCM will not send the correct password to the PCM,
and the vehicle will not start.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures
Body Control Module: Procedures
IMPORTANT: If any module is replaced, programming the module with the proper RPO
configurations must be done prior to performing the Passlock Learn procedure.
1. The BCM must be programmed with the proper RPO configurations. The BCM stores the
information regarding the vehicle options. If the BCM is
not properly configured with the correct RPO codes the BCM will not control the features properly.
Ensure that the following conditions exist in order to prepare for BCM programming: ^
The battery is fully charged.
^ The ignition switch is in the RUN position.
^ The DLC is accessible.
^ All disconnected modules and devices are reconnected before programming.
2. Follow the SPS instructions on the Techline Terminal and scan tool to program the BCM. 3. If
the BCM fails to accept the program, perform the following steps:
^ Inspect all BCM connections.
^ Verify that the SPS Techline Terminal and scan tool have the latest software version.
Passlock Learn Procedures Refer to the Theft Deterrent sub-system for the appropriate learn
procedure.
IMPORTANT: After programming, perform the following to avoid future misdiagnosis: 1. Turn the
ignition OFF for 10 seconds. 2. Connect the scan tool to the data link connector. 3. Turn the ignition
ON with the engine OFF. 4. Use the scan tool in order to retrieve History DTCs from all modules. 5.
Clear all history DTCs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 2645
Body Control Module: Removal and Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Replacing the body control module (BCM) may be necessary when you service the body control
system.
IMPORTANT: The ignition switch should be in the OFF position when connecting or disconnecting
the connectors to the BCM. Always disconnect the Brown BCM connector FIRST and connect the
Brown BCM connector LAST. The BCM can set DTC(s) with the ignition switch in the OFF position.
The BCM has battery run down protection for the courtesy lamp circuit. The BCM battery run down
protection can not detect shorts on inputs or other circuits which it does not control. The scan tool
can be used to put the BCM to sleep in order to check for current draws on circuits which are not
controlled by the BCM or controlled by the battery run down protection system. If an excessive
current draw is detected, refer to Battery Electrical Drain/Parasitic Load Test (w/ BCM) in Starting
and Charging.
1. Remove the radio from the vehicle. 2. Remove the heater control.
Pull the heater control (2) out and down in order to gain access to the body control module.
3. Push upward on the bracket retainer slightly and pull the body control module (2) from the
bracket (1) at an angle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 2646
4. Disconnect the electrical connectors (2) from the body control module (1). 5. Remove the body
control module from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the body control module (2) to the vehicle. 2. Install the body control module to the bracket
(1) at an angle under the wide hook retainer, with the label facing away from the bracket. 3. Apply
pressure on the center of the body control module in order to move the module toward the
mounting bracket base. Snap the module into
place.
4. Ensure that the module is fully seated. Ensure that both snap retainers are holding the module.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 2647
5. Connect the electrical connectors (2) to the body control module (1).
6. Install the heater control (2). 7. Install the radio to the vehicle. 8. Use the following components
in order to program the body control module with the proper calibrations:
^ The Techline Terminal
^ The Scan Tool
9. Perform the body control module programing. Refer to Body Control Module (BCM)
Programming/RPO Configuration. See: Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning
10. Clear the diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory
Usage
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-06-04-054B
Date: November 18, 2010
Subject: Info - Non-GM Parts and Accessories (Aftermarket)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years and update to the new U.S. Fixed
Operation Manager (FOM) and Canada Warranty Manager (WM) names. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 04-06-04-054A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
The recent rise and expansion of companies selling non-GM parts and accessories has made it
necessary to issue this reminder to dealers regarding GM's policy on the use and installation of
these aftermarket components.
When a dealer is performing a repair under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty, they are required to
use only genuine GM or GM-approved parts and accessories. This applies to all warranty repairs,
special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM. Parts and accessories advertised as being "the
same" as parts manufactured by GM, but not sold through GM, do not qualify for use in warranty
repairs, special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM.
During a warranty repair, if a GM original equipment part is not available through GM Customer
Care and Aftersales (GM CC&A;), ACDelco(R) distributors, other GM dealers or approved sources,
the dealer is to obtain comparable, non-GM parts and clearly indicate, in detail, on the repair order
the circumstances surrounding why non-GM parts were used. The dealer must give customers
written notice, prior to the sale or service, that such parts or accessories are not marketed or
warranted by General Motors.
It should also be noted that dealers modifying new vehicles and installing equipment, parts and
accessories obtained from sources not authorized by GM are responsible for complying with the
National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act. Certain non-approved parts or assemblies, installed
by the dealer or its agent not authorized by GM, may result in a change to the vehicle's design
characteristics and may affect the vehicle's ability to conform to federal law. Dealers must fully
understand that non-GM approved parts may not have been validated, tested or certified for use.
This puts the dealer at risk for potential liability in the event of a part or vehicle failure. If a GM part
failure occurs as the result of the installation or use of a non-GM approved part, the warranty will
not be honored.
A good example of non-authorized modification of vehicles is the result of an ever increasing
supply of aftermarket devices available to the customer, which claim to increase the horsepower
and torque of the Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines. These include the addition of, but are not limited to
one or more of the following modifications:
- Propane injection
- Nitrous oxide injection
- Additional modules (black boxes) that connect to the vehicle wiring systems
- Revised engine calibrations downloaded for the engine control module
- Calibration modules which connect to the vehicle diagnostic connector
- Modification to the engine turbocharger waste gate
Although the installation of these devices, or modification of vehicle components, can increase
engine horsepower and torque, they may also negatively affect the engine emissions, reliability
and/or durability. In addition, other powertrain components, such as transmissions, universal joints,
drive shafts, and front/rear axle components, can be stressed beyond design safety limits by the
installation of these devices.
General Motors does not support or endorse the use of devices or modifications that, when
installed, increase the engine horsepower and torque. It is because of these unknown stresses,
and the potential to alter reliability, durability and emissions performance, that GM has adopted a
policy that prevents any UNAUTHORIZED dealer warranty claim submissions to any remaining
warranty coverage, to the powertrain and driveline components whenever the presence of a
non-GM (aftermarket) calibration is confirmed - even if the non-GM control module calibration is
subsequently removed. Refer to the latest version of Bulletin 09-06-04-026 (V8 Gas Engines) or
06-06-01-007 (Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines) for more information on dealer requirements for
calibration verification.
These same policies apply as they relate to the use of non-GM accessories. Damage or failure
from the use or installation of a non-GM accessory will not be covered under warranty. Failure
resulting from the alteration or modification of the vehicle, including the cutting, welding or
disconnecting of the vehicle's original equipment parts and components will void the warranty.
Additionally, dealers will NOT be reimbursed or compensated by GM in the event of any legal
inquiry at either the local, state or federal level that
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 2652
results from the alteration or modification of a vehicle using non-GM approved parts or accessories.
Dealers should be especially cautious of accessory companies that claim the installation of their
product will not void the factory warranty. Many times these companies have even given direction
on how to quickly disassemble the accessory in an attempt to preclude the manufacturer from
finding out that is has been installed.
Any suspect repairs should be reviewed by the Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), and in Canada
by the Warranty Manager (WM) for appropriate repair direction. If it is decided that a goodwill repair
is to be made on the vehicle, even with the installation of such non-GM approved components, the
customer is to be made aware of General Motors position on this issue and is to sign the
appropriate goodwill documentation required by General Motors.
It is imperative for dealers to understand that by installing such devices, they are jeopardizing not
only the warranty coverage, but also the performance and reliability of the customer's vehicle.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 2653
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2656
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2657
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2658
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2659
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2660
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2661
Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2662
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2663
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2664
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2665
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2666
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2667
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2668
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2669
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2670
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2671
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2672
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2673
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2674
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2675
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2676
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2677
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2678
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2679
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2680
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2681
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2682
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2683
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2684
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2685
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2686
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2687
Engine Control Module: Connector Views
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) C1 Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2688
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) C1 Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2689
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) C2 Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2690
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) C2 Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> General Information
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation General Information
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is designed to maintain exhaust emission levels while
maintaining excellent driveability and fuel efficiency. The PCM controls the following operations:
^ The fuel control
^ The Ignition Control (IC)
^ The Knock Sensor (KS) system
^ The automatic transmission shift functions
^ The manual transmission
^ The cruise control enable, if so equipped
^ The generator
^ The Evaporative Emissions (EVAP) purge
^ The A/C clutch control, if so equipped
^ The Secondary Air Injection (AIR), if so equipped
^ The Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR)
The PCM controls all ignition system functions, and constantly corrects the basic spark timing. The
PCM monitors information from various sensor inputs that include the following:
^ The Throttle Position (TP) sensor
^ The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
^ The Mass Airflow (MAF) Sensor
^ The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor
^ The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
^ The transmission gear position or range information sensors
^ The engine Knock Sensors (KS)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> General Information > Page 2693
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the meaning of voltage
(volts), current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens in a circuit
with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring diagram.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> General Information > Page 2694
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation Engine Controls Information
The driveability and emissions information describes the function and operation of the Powertrain
Control Module (PCM).
The computers and control systems information contains the following:
^ Component locations
^ Wiring diagrams
^ PCM terminal end view and terminal definitions
^ Powertrain On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) System Check
^ Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) tables
The Component System includes the following items:
^ Component and circuit description
^ On-vehicle service for each sub-system
^ Functional checks and diagnostic tables
The DTCs also contain diagnostic support information containing circuit diagrams, circuit or system
information, and helpful diagnostic information.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> General Information > Page 2695
Typical Drive Cycle
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> General Information > Page 2696
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation
General Information
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is designed to maintain exhaust emission levels while
maintaining excellent driveability and fuel efficiency. The PCM controls the following operations:
^ The fuel control
^ The Ignition Control (IC)
^ The Knock Sensor (KS) system
^ The automatic transmission shift functions
^ The manual transmission
^ The cruise control enable, if so equipped
^ The generator
^ The Evaporative Emissions (EVAP) purge
^ The A/C clutch control, if so equipped
^ The Secondary Air Injection (AIR), if so equipped
^ The Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR)
The PCM controls all ignition system functions, and constantly corrects the basic spark timing. The
PCM monitors information from various sensor inputs that include the following:
^ The Throttle Position (TP) sensor
^ The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
^ The Mass Airflow (MAF) Sensor
^ The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor
^ The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
^ The transmission gear position or range information sensors
^ The engine Knock Sensors (KS)
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the meaning of voltage
(volts), current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens in a circuit
with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring diagram.
Engine Controls Information
The driveability and emissions information describes the function and operation of the Powertrain
Control Module (PCM).
The computers and control systems information contains the following:
^ Component locations
^ Wiring diagrams
^ PCM terminal end view and terminal definitions
^ Powertrain On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) System Check
^ Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) tables
The Component System includes the following items:
^ Component and circuit description
^ On-vehicle service for each sub-system
^ Functional checks and diagnostic tables
The DTCs also contain diagnostic support information containing circuit diagrams, circuit or system
information, and helpful diagnostic information.
Typical Drive Cycle
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> General Information > Page 2697
Primary System Based Diagnostics
There are primary system-based diagnostics which evaluate the system operation and their effect
on vehicle emissions. The primary system-based diagnostics are listed, with a brief description of
the diagnostic functionality.
Heated Oxygen Sensors
The main function of the pre-catalyst Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) is to provide the (PCM) with
exhaust stream information in order to maintain proper fueling to hold emissions within acceptable
levels. These oxygen sensors are always located between the exhaust manifold and the catalytic
converter. After the sensor reaches the operating temperature, the sensor generates a voltage
inversely proportional to the amount of oxygen present in the exhaust gases.
The PCM uses the signal voltage from the fuel control heated oxygen sensors in a Closed Loop in
order to adjust the fuel injector pulse width. While in a Closed Loop, the PCM can adjust fuel
delivery in order to maintain an air to fuel ratio which allows the best combination of emission
control and driveability.
If the oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal are damaged, replace the entire oxygen
sensor assembly. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, the connector, or the terminals. In order for
the sensor to function properly, the sensor must have a clean air reference provided to it. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor wires. Any attempt to repair the wires,
connectors, or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference. Any attempt to repair
the wires, connectors, or terminals could degrade oxygen sensor performance.
Catalyst Monitor Diagnostic Operation
The catalyst monitor diagnostic measures oxygen storage capacity of the catalyst converter. In
order to do this, the heated sensors are installed before and after the 3-Way Catalyst (TWC).
Voltage variations between the sensors allow the PCM to determine the catalyst emission
performance.
As a catalyst becomes less effective in promoting chemical reactions, the catalysts capacity to
store and release oxygen generally degrades. The catalyst monitor diagnostic is based on a
correlation between conversion efficiency and oxygen storage capacity.
A good catalyst, e.g. 95 degrees hydrocarbon conversion efficiency, shows a relatively flat output
voltage on the post-catalyst Heated Oxygen Sensor ( HO2S). A degraded catalyst, 65 percent
hydrocarbon conversion, shows a greatly increased activity in output voltage from the post catalyst
HO2S.
The post-catalyst HO2S is used to measure the oxygen storage and release capacity of the
catalyst. A high oxygen storage capacity indicates a good catalyst. Low oxygen storage capacity
indicates a failing catalyst. The (TWC) and the HO2S must be at operating temperature in order to
achieve correct oxygen sensor voltages like those shown in the post-catalyst HO2S outputs
graphic.
The catalyst monitor diagnostic is sensitive to the following conditions:
^ Exhaust leaks
^ HO2S contamination
^ Alternative fuels
Exhaust system leaks may cause the following:
^ Prevent a degraded catalyst from failing the diagnostic
^ Cause a false failure for a normally functioning catalyst
^ Prevent the diagnostic from running
Some of the contaminants that may be encountered are phosphorus, lead, silica, and sulfur. The
presence of these contaminants prevent the TWC diagnostic from functioning properly.
Catalyst Monitor Heated Oxygen Sensors
In order to control emissions of Hydrocarbons (HC), Carbon Monoxide (CO), and Oxides of
Nitrogen (NOx), the system uses a 3-way catalytic converter. The catalyst promotes a chemical
reaction which oxidizes the HC and CO present in the exhaust gas, converting the HC and CO into
harmless water vapor and carbon dioxide. The catalyst also converts NOx to nitrogen. Catalyst
monitor HO2S, post-catalyst HO2S, are always located downstream of the catalytic converter.
The PCM has the ability to monitor this process using the post catalyst heated oxygen sensors.
The pre-sensors produce an output signal which indicates the amount of oxygen present in the
exhaust gas entering the 3-way catalytic converter. The post sensor produces an output signal
which indicates the oxygen storage capacity of the catalyst. This in turn indicates the catalysts
ability to convert exhaust gases efficiently. If the catalyst is operating efficiently, the pre-HO2S
signal is far more active than that produced by the post-HO2S.
In addition to catalyst monitoring, the post-HO2S has a limited role in controlling fuel delivery. If the
post-HO2S signal indicates a high or low oxygen content for an extended period of time while in a
Closed Loop, the PCM adjusts the fuel delivery slightly in order to compensate.
Comprehensive Component Monitor Diagnostic
Comprehensive component monitoring diagnostics are required to monitor emissions-related input
and output powertrain components.
Fuel Trim System Operation
The fuel trim system monitors the averages of short-term and long-term fuel trim values. If these
fuel trim values stay at their limits for a calibrated period of time, a malfunction is indicated. The fuel
trim diagnostic compares the average of short and long-term fuel trim values. If either value is
within the thresholds, a pass is recorded. If either value is outside the thresholds, a rich or lean fuel
trim DTC will set.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> General Information > Page 2698
Misfire Monitor Diagnostic Operation
The misfire monitor diagnostic is based on crankshaft rotational velocity, aka reference period,
variations. The PCM determines crankshaft rotational velocity using the Crankshaft Position (CKP)
Sensor and Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor. When a cylinder misfires, the crankshaft slows down
momentarily. By monitoring the crankshaft and camshaft position sensor signals, the PCM can
calculate when a misfire occurs.
For a non-catalyst damaging misfire, the diagnostic is required to monitor a misfire present for
between 1,000 - 3,200 engine revolutions.
For catalyst damage misfire, the diagnostic responds to the misfire within 200 engine revolutions.
Rough roads may cause false misfire detection. A rough road applies sudden torque variations to
the drive wheels and drivetrain. This torque can intermittently decrease the crankshaft rotational
velocity. The Antilock Braking (ABS) System detects uneven speed between the vehicles wheels
and sends data via the serial data bus to the PCM to disable the misfire monitor until the rough
road is no longer detected.
On automatic transmission equipped vehicles, the Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) disables
whenever a misfire is detected. Disabling the TCC isolates the engine from the rest of the drive line
and minimizes the effect of the drive wheel inputs on crankshaft rotation.
When the TCC has disabled as a result of misfire detection, the TCC is re-enabled after
approximately 3,200 engine revolutions if no misfire is detected. The TCC remains disabled
whenever the misfire is detected, with or without a DTC set. This allows the misfire diagnostic to
reevaluate the system.
Whenever a cylinder misfires, the misfire diagnostic counts the misfire and notes the crankshaft
position at the time the misfire occurred.
A current and a history misfire counter is maintained for each cylinder. The misfire current
counters, Misfire Cur #1 - 8, indicate the number of firing events out of the last 200 cylinder firing
events which were misfires. The misfire current counters displays real time data without a misfire
DTC stored. The misfire history counters, Misfire Hist #1 - 8. indicate the total number of cylinder
firing events which were misfires. The misfire history counters display 0 until the misfire diagnostic
has failed and a DTC P0300 is set. Once the misfire DTC sets, the misfire history counters will be
updated every 200 cylinder firing events. The Misfire counters graphic illustrates how these misfire
counters are maintained.
When crankshaft rotation is erratic, the PCM detects a misfire condition. Because of this erratic
condition, the data that is collected by the diagnostic can
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> General Information > Page 2699
sometimes incorrectly identify which cylinder is misfiring. The Misfire Counters graphic shows there
are misfires counted from more than one cylinder. Cylinder #1 has the majority of counted misfires.
In this case, the misfire counters would identify cylinder #1 as the misfiring cylinder. The misfires in
the other counters were just background noise caused by the erratic rotation of the crankshaft. If
the number of accumulated misfires is sufficient for the diagnostic to identify a true misfire, the
diagnostic will set DTC P0300 - Misfire Detected. The illustration depicts an accumulation in the
history buffers.
If two cylinders in sequential firing order are both misfiring, the first misfiring cylinder will
accumulate misfires in its buffer, but the second misfiring cylinder will not. This is because the PCM
compares a misfiring cylinder with the cylinder 90 degrees prior to it in the firing order. Therefore
the PCM would be comparing crankshaft speed of the second misfiring cylinder to an already
suspect cylinder. The PCM however, will be able to detect both misfiring cylinders after the engine
exceeds 2,000 RPM. This is because the PCM then starts to compare misfires to the opposing
cylinder rather than the previous cylinder in the firing order.
Use Techline equipment to monitor the misfire counter data on applicable vehicles, knowing which
specific cylinders misfire can lead to the root cause. Using the information in the misfire counters
identifies which cylinders are misfiring. If the counters indicate cylinders number 1 and 4 misfired,
look for a circuit or component common to both cylinders.
The misfire diagnostic may indicate a fault due to a temporary fault not necessarily caused by a
vehicle emission system malfunction. Examples include the following items:
^ Contaminated fuel
^ Running out of fuel
^ Fuel fouled spark plugs
^ Basic engine fault
Oxygen Sensor Diagnosis
Diagnose the fuel control heated oxygen sensors for the following conditions:
^ Heater performance, time to activity on cold start
^ Slow response
^ Response time, time to switch R/L or L/R
^ Inactive signal, output steady at bias voltage - approximately 450 mV
^ Signal fixed high
^ Signal fixed low
Diagnose the catalyst monitor heated oxygen sensors for the following functions:
^ Heater performance, time to activity on cold start
^ Signal fixed low during steady state conditions
^ Inactive sensor
PCM Function
The PCM supplies a buffered voltage to various sensors and switches. The PCM controls most
components with electronic switches which complete a ground circuit when turned ON.
PCM Service Precautions
The PCM is designed to withstand normal current draws associated with vehicle operations. Avoid
overloading any circuit. When testing for opens or shorts, do not ground any of the PCM circuits
unless instructed. When testing for opens or shorts, do not apply voltage to any of the PCM circuits
unless instructed. Only test these circuits with a DMM while the PCM connectors remain
connected.
Three-Way Catalyst Oxygen Storage Capacity
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> General Information > Page 2700
Three-Way Catalyst Storage Capacity
The PCM must monitor the 3-Way Catalyst System (TWC) for efficiency. In order to accomplish
this, the PCM monitors the pre-catalyst and post-catalyst oxygen sensors. When the TWC is
operating properly, the post-catalyst (2) oxygen sensor shows significantly less activity than the
pre-catalyst (1) oxygen sensor. The TWC stores oxygen during the normal reduction and oxidation
process. The TWC releases oxygen during its normal reduction and oxidation process. The PCM
calculates the oxygen storage capacity using the difference between the pre-catalyst and
post-catalyst oxygen sensor voltage levels.
Misfire Monitor Diagnostic Tests
Whenever the sensor activity of the post-catalyst (2) oxygen sensor nears the sensor activity of the
pre-catalyst (1) oxygen sensor, the catalysts efficiency is degraded.
Aftermarket HO2S characteristics may be different from the original equipment manufacturer
sensor. This may lead to a false pass or a false fail of the catalyst monitor diagnostic. Similarly, if
an aftermarket catalyst does not contain the same amount of precious metal content as the original
pan, the correlation between oxygen storage and conversion efficiency may be altered enough to
set a false DTC.
Torque Management
Torque management is a function of the PCM that reduces engine power under certain conditions.
Torque management is performed for the following reasons:
1. To prevent over-stressing the powertrain and driveline components 2. To prevent damage to the
vehicle during certain abusive maneuvers 3. To reduce engine speed when the IAC is out of the
normal operating range
The PCM monitors the following sensors and engine parameters in order to calculate engine output
torque:
^ The air/fuel ratio
^ The Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor
^ The Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) sensor
^ The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor
^ The spark advance
^ The engine speed
^ The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor
^ The A/C clutch status
The PCM monitors the torque converter status, the transmission gear ratio, and the engine speed
in order to determine if torque reduction is required. The PCM retards the spark as appropriate to
reduce engine torque output if torque reduction is required. The PCM also shuts OFF the fuel to
certain injectors in order to reduce the engine power in the case of an abusive maneuver.
The following are instances when engine power reduction is likely to be experienced:
^ During transmission upshifts and downshifts
^ During heavy acceleration from a standing start
^ When the clutch pedal is released too quick under a heavy load (6.0L only)
^ When one set of drive axles loses traction while the other set of drive axles are not moving (4WD
only and in 4WD low)
^ If the IAC is out of the normal operating range, except 6.0L
^ When the driver is performing harsh or abusive maneuvers such as shifting into gear at high
throttle angles or shifting the transmission from reverse to drive to create a rocking motion
The driver is unlikely to notice the torque management actions in the first 2 instances. The engine
power output is moderate at full throttle in the other cases.
The PCM calculates the amount of spark retard necessary to reduce the engine power by the
desired amount. The PCM disables the fuel injectors for
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> General Information > Page 2701
cylinders 1, 4, 6, and 7 in the case of an abusive maneuver.
Powertrain Control Module
Powertrain Control Module
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is located in the engine compartment. The PCM is the
control center of the vehicle. It controls the following:
^ The fuel metering system
^ The transmission shifting
^ The ignition timing
^ The on-board diagnostics for powertrain functions
The PCM constantly monitors the information from various sensors and controls the systems that
affect vehicle performance and emissions. The PCM also performs the diagnostic functions for
those systems. The PCM can recognize operational problems and alert the driver through the
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) when a malfunction has occurred. When a malfunction is
detected, the PCM stores a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) which helps to identify problem areas.
This is done to aid the technician in making repairs
The PCM supplies either 5.0 or 12.0 volts to power various sensors and switches. This is done
through resistances in the PCM. The resistance is so high in value that a test lamp does not
illuminate when connected to the circuit. In some cases, even an ordinary shop voltmeter does not
give an accurate reading because the voltmeters resistance is too low. Therefore, a DMM with a
minimum of 10 megaohms input impedance is required to ensure accurate voltage readings.
The PCM controls output circuits such as the fuel injectors, the Idle Air Control (IAC), the cooling
fan relays, etc. by controlling the ground or the power feed circuit through transistors or a device
called an output driver module.
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) contains the remainder of the logic of the theft deterrent
system. If a class 2 message containing a valid password is received from the BCM, the PCM will
continue to allow the fuel injectors to operate. The PCM will allow the fuel injectors to operate until
it decides there is no valid password coming from the BCM. If the PCM does not receive a class 2
message, or receives a class 2 message with an incorrect password, the engine will crank and will
not run or will start and stall immediately.
Input Components
The PCM monitors the input components for circuit continuity and out-of-range values. This
includes performance checking. Performance checking refers to indicating a fault when the signal
from a sensor does not seem reasonable, such as a Throttle Position (TP) sensor that indicates
high throttle position at low engine loads or MAP voltage. The input components may include, but
are not limited to, the following sensors:
^ The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
^ Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
^ Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor
^ Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
^ Knock Sensor (KS)
^ Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
^ Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
^ Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor
^ Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
In addition to the circuit continuity and rationality check, the ECT sensor is monitored for its ability
to achieve a steady state temperature to enable Closed Loop fuel control.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> General Information > Page 2702
Output Components
Diagnose the output components for the proper response to PCM commands. Components where
functional monitoring is not feasible will be monitored for circuit continuity and out-of-range values if
applicable.
Output components to be monitored include, but are not limited to, the following circuits:
^ The Idle Air Control (IAC) motor
^ The EVAP system
^ The electronic transmission controls
^ The A/C relay, if so equipped
^ The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) output
^ The Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) control
^ The cruise control enable, if so equipped
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Additional Information
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Additional Information
The Service Programming System (SPS) allows a technician to program a control module through
the Data Link Connector (DLC). The information transfer circuit that is used at the DLC is the same
serial data circuit used by the scan tool for retrieving Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs), displaying
data, clearing DTCs, etc. This procedure offers the ability to install software/calibrations matched to
a particular vehicle.
Most control modules have 2 types of memory. The software/calibrations reside in the flash
memory. The two types of memory are listed below:
^ Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EEPROM) This type of memory allows
selected portions of memory to be programmed while other portions remain unchanged. Certain
learned values reside in the EEPROM, such as: ^
The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
^ The crankshaft variation learned position
^ The software/calibrations identification numbers
^ The control module security information
^ Flash Read Only Memory - Rash Memory Flash memory has increased memory storage
capacity. During programming, all information within this type of memory is erased, and then
replaced with entirely new information.
Service Programming Methods The 4 methods of programming a control module and the proper
tools for each method are as follows: ^
Remote Programming: The Tech 2 or other scan tool, Techline Terminal or a personal computer equipped with General
Motors Corporation authorized programming software - The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an
interface between the vehicle and the Techline Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is installed in the vehicle
^ Pass Thru Programming: The Tech 2 or other scan tool Techline Terminal or a personal computer equipped with General
Motors Corporation authorized programming software - The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an
interface between the vehicle and the Techline Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is installed in the vehicle.
^ Off-Board Remote Programming, vehicle NOT available: The Tech 2 or other scan tool, Off-board Programming Adapter (OBPA), Techline Terminal or a
personal computer equipped with General Motors Corporation authorized programming software The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an interface between the vehicle and the Techline
Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is NOT installed in a vehicle
^ Off-Board Pass Thru Programming The Tech 2 or other scan tool, off-board programming adapter (OBPA), Techline Terminal or a
personal computer equipped with General Motors Corporation authorized programming software The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an interface between the vehicle and the Techline
Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is NOT installed in a vehicle
Before Programming a Control Module
IMPORTANT: DO NOT program an existing control module with the identical software/calibration
package. This procedure is not a short cut to correct a driveability condition. This is an ineffective
repair. A control module should only be programmed when the following occurs: ^
When a service procedure instructs you to replace the control module. The service part control
module does not contain operating software or calibrations.
^ General Motors Corporation releases an updated software/calibration package.
Ensure that the following conditions are met before programming a control module: ^
Vehicle system voltage: There are no charging system concerns. All charging system concerns must be repaired before
programming a control module.
- The battery voltage is greater than 12 volts but less than 16 volts. The battery must be fully
charged before programming the control module.
- A battery charger is NOT connected to the vehicles battery. Incorrect system voltage or voltage
fluctuations from a battery charger may cause programming failure or control module damage.
- Turn OFF or disable any system that may put a load on the vehicles battery. Turn OFF or disable
systems such as: ^
Daytime Running Lights (DRL). Applying the parking brake, on most vehicles, disables the DRL
system.
^ Heating, Ventilation, And Air Conditioning (HVAC) systems
^ Engine cooling fans, etc.
^ The ignition switch is in the proper position. The scan tool prompts you to turn ON the ignition,
with the engine OFF. DO NOT change the position of the ignition switch during the programming
procedure unless instructed to do so.
^ All tool connections are secure: The RS-232 cable
- The connection at the DLC
- The voltage supply circuits
- The OBPA
^ DO NOT disturb the tool harnesses while programming. If an interruption occurs during the
programming procedure, programming failure or
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Additional Information > Page 2705
control module damage may occur.
^ If you are performing the pass-through programming procedure using a notebook computer
without the power cord, ensure that the internal battery is fully charged.
After Programming A Control Module The powertrain may operate slightly different after a control
module software/calibration update. Operating the powertrain through various driving conditions
allows the control module to re-learn certain values. The control module must re-learn the following
after a software/calibration update: ^
Fuel trim correction
^ Idle Air Control (IAC) learned position
^ Automatic transmission shift adapts
Other learned values only re-learn by performing a service procedure.
If a control module is replaced the following service procedures may need to be performed: ^
The crankshaft variation learn procedure
^ The engine oil life reset procedure
^ The idle learn procedure
^ The inspection/maintenance complete system set procedure
^ The vehicle theft deterrent password learn procedure
^ The Throttle Position (TP) sensor learn procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Additional Information > Page 2706
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Programming
(Off-board)
BEFORE PROGRAMMING A CONTROL MODULE
IMPORTANT: ^
DO NOT program a control module unless you are directed by a service procedure or you are
directed by a General Motors Corporation service bulletin. Programming a control module at any
other time will not permanently correct a customer's concern.
^ The Off-Board Programming is used in situations where a control module must be programmed
without having the vehicle present. The Off-Board Programming Adapter must be used to perform
the Off-Board Programming procedure. The adapter allows the control module to power up and
allows the Tech 2 to communicate with the control module.
^ DO NOT disturb the tool harnesses while programming. If an interruption occurs during the
programming procedure, programming failure or control module damage may occur.
Ensure that all connections are secure at the following locations: ^
The Off-Board Programming Adapter
^ The Tech 2
^ The control module
^ The Techline terminal
OFF-BOARD PROGRAMMING
1. Obtain the VIN of the vehicle for which the control module is being programmed. 2. With the
Techline terminal, select Service Programming. 3. Select Tech 2, Reprogram ECU, and Off-Board
Programming Adapter as the electronic control unit (ECU) location. 4. Connect the control module,
Off-Board Programming Adapter, and the Tech 2 as described on the Techline terminal. Ensure
you use the correct
harness connector from the Off-Board Programming Adapter kit.
5. With the Tech 2, select Service Programming Request Information function. The Tech 2
communicates with the control module and receives the
access code.
6. With the Tech 2, exit the Service Programming Request Information. 7. Disconnect the Tech 2
from the Off-Board Programming Adapter. 8. Connect the Tech 2 to the Techline terminal. 9. Turn
ON the Tech 2.
10. With the Techline terminal, enter the VIN of the vehicle that will be receiving the control module.
11. The Techline terminal will display the message, attaching to database. 12. Identify what type of
programming that you are performing. 13. Select the appropriate calibration file. 14. Ensure all
connections are secure. 15. The Techline terminal displays a summary screen that summarizes
your selections. After confirming you choices, the Techline terminal
automatically loads the calibration files to the Tech 2.
16. After the download is complete, turn OFF the Tech 2. 17. Disconnect the Tech 2 from the
Techline terminal. 18. Connect the Tech 2 to the Off-Board Programming Adapter. 19. With the
Tech 2, select Service Programming.
IMPORTANT: DO NOT turn OFF the Off-Board Programming Adapter if the programming
procedure is interrupted or unsuccessful. Ensure the control module and the Off-Board
Programming Adapter connections are secure and the Techline operating software is up to date.
Attempt to reprogram the control module. If the control module cannot be programmed, replace the
control module.
20. With the Tech 2, select Program. 21. After the download is complete, exit Service
Programming. 22. Turn OFF the Off-Board Programming Adapter.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Additional Information > Page 2707
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Programming
(On-Board)
BEFORE PROGRAMMING A CONTROL MODULE
IMPORTANT: DO NOT program a control module unless you are directed by a service procedure
or you are directed by a General Motors Corporation service bulletin. Programming a control
module at any other time will not permanently correct a customers concern.
Ensure the following conditions are met before programming a control module: ^
Vehicle system voltage There is no charging system concern. All charging system concerns must be repaired before
programming a control module.
- Battery voltage is greater than 12 volts but less than 16 volts. The battery must be charged before
programming the control module if the battery voltage is low.
- A battery charger is NOT connected to the vehicle's battery. Incorrect system voltage or voltage
fluctuations from a battery charger, may cause programming failure or control module damage.
- Turn OFF or disable any system that may put a load on the vehicle's battery. ^
Twilight sentinel
^ Interior lights
^ Daytime running lights (DRL) - Applying the parking brake, on most vehicles, disables the DRL
system.
^ HVAC systems
^ Engine cooling fans etc.
^ The ignition switch is in the proper position. The scan tool prompts you to turn ON the ignition,
with the engine OFF. DO NOT change the position of the ignition switch during the programming
procedure, unless instructed to do so.
^ All tool connections are secure. RS-232
- The connection at the data link connector (DLC) is secure.
- Voltage supply circuits
^ DO NOT disturb the tool harnesses while programming. If an interruption occurs during the
programming procedure, programming failure or control module damage may occur.
REMOTE PROGRAMMING
1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Install the Tech 2 to the DLC. 3. Turn ON the ignition, with the engine
OFF. 4. Turn OFF all vehicle accessories. 5. With the Tech 2, select Service Programming. 6.
Identify vehicle information as requested by the Tech 2. 7. Select the type of module you are
programming. 8. Select the type of programming to be performed. 9. Verify the displayed VIN with
the vehicle VIN. If the displayed VIN does not match the actual VIN, write down the actual VIN and
correct the
VIN at the Techline terminal.
10. When complete, Exit Service Programming. 11. Turn OFF the Tech 2 and disconnect the Tech
2 from the vehicle. 12. Turn OFF the ignition. 13. Connect the Tech 2 to the Techline terminal. 14.
Select Service Programming. 15. Select Tech 2 as the tool you are using. 16. Select the type of
programming to be performed. 17. Verify the displayed VIN with the vehicle VIN. Correct the VIN
as necessary. 18. Select the type of module you are programming. 19. Identify what type of
programming that you are performing.
^ Normal - This type of programming is for updating an existing calibration or programming a new
controller.
^ Vehicle configuration index (VCI) - This selection is used if the vehicle VIN is unavailable or not
recognized by the Techline terminal. Observe, you will need to contact the Techline Customer
Support center to use this option.
^ Reconfigure - This is to reconfigure a vehicle, such as tire size and axle ratio changes.
20. Select the appropriate calibration file. 21. Ensure all connections are secure. 22. Select Reprog
to initiate the download of the new calibration to the Tech 2. 23. After the download is complete,
turn OFF the Tech 2. 24. Disconnect the Tech 2 from the Techline terminal. 25. Install the Tech 2
to the data link connector (DLC). 26. Turn ON the Tech 2. 27. Turn ON the ignition, with the engine
OFF. 28. Select Service Programming.
IMPORTANT: DO NOT turn OFF the ignition if the programming procedure is interrupted or
unsuccessful. Ensure that all the PCM and DLC
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Additional Information > Page 2708
connections are secure and the Techline operating software is up to date. Attempt to reprogram the
control module. If the control module cannot be programmed, replace the control module.
29. Select Program. 30. After the download is complete, EXIT Service Programming. 31. Turn OFF
the ignition for 30 seconds. 32. Turn OFF the Tech 2. 33. If a control module is replaced the
following service procedures must be performed:
^ The Crankshaft Variation Learn Procedure
^ The Engine Oil Life Reset Procedure
^ The Idle Learn Procedure
^ The Inspection/Maintenance Complete System Set Procedure
^ The Vehicle Theft Deterrent Password Learn Procedure
^ The TP Sensor Learn Procedure
PROGRAMMING VERIFICATION
1. With a scan tool, clear the DTCs. 2. Attempt to start the engine. 3. Repeat the Service
Programming procedure if the engine does not start or operates poorly. Perform the following
procedures before programming
the PCM: ^
Ensure the control module and DLC connections are OK.
^ Ensure the Techline operating software is up to date.
^ Ensure the calibration part number is correct for the vehicle.
4. Attempt to program the control module. If the control module still cannot be programmed
properly, replace the control module. You must program
the replacement control module.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Additional Information > Page 2709
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Replacement
Service of the powertrain control module (PCM) should normally consist of either replacement of
the PCM or electrically erasable programmable read only memory (EEPROM) programming. If the
diagnostic procedures call for the PCM to be replaced, the PCM should be inspected first to see if
the correct part is being used. If the correct part is being used, remove the faulty PCM and install
the new service PCM.
IMPORTANT:
^ To prevent internal PCM damage, the ignition must be OFF when disconnecting or reconnecting
power to the PCM. For example, when working with a battery cable, PCM pigtail, PCM fuse, or
jumper cables.
^ Remove any debris from the PCM connector surfaces before servicing the PCM. Inspect the
PCM module connector gaskets when diagnosing or replacing the PCM. Ensure that the gaskets
are installed correctly. The gaskets prevent contaminant intrusion into the PCM.
^ The replacement PCM must be programmed.
Removal Procedure
NOTE: ^
Refer to PCM and ESD Notice in Service Precautions.
^ In order to prevent internal damage to the PCM, the ignition must be OFF when disconnecting or
reconnecting the PCM connector.
1. Disconnect the PCM harness connectors (4). 2. Release the spring latch (3) from the PCM (1).
3. Lift the PCM from the PCM mounting tray (2). 4. Remove the PCM (1) from the engine
compartment.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Additional Information > Page 2710
1. Install the PCM (1) to the PCM mounting tray (2). 2. Secure the spring latch (3) to the PCM (1).
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Connect the PCM connectors (4) to the PCM (1).
Tighten Tighten the PCM connector end fasteners to 8 N.m (71 lb in).
4. If a new PCM is being installed, program the PCM. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming
and Relearning
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Additional Information > Page 2711
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Service Programming System (SPS)
The Service Programming System (SPS) allows a technician to program a control module through
the Data Link Connector (DLC). The information transfer circuit that is used at the DLC is the same
serial data circuit used by the scan tool for retrieving Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs), displaying
data, clearing DTCs, etc. This procedure offers the ability to install software/calibrations matched to
a particular vehicle.
Most control modules have 2 types of memory. The software/calibrations reside in the flash
memory. The two types of memory are listed below:
^ Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EEPROM) This type of memory allows
selected portions of memory to be programmed while other portions remain unchanged. Certain
learned values reside in the EEPROM, such as: ^
The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
^ The crankshaft variation learned position
^ The software/calibrations identification numbers
^ The control module security information
^ Flash Read Only Memory - Rash Memory Flash memory has increased memory storage
capacity. During programming, all information within this type of memory is erased, and then
replaced with entirely new information.
Service Programming Methods The 4 methods of programming a control module and the proper
tools for each method are as follows: ^
Remote Programming: The Tech 2 or other scan tool, Techline Terminal or a personal computer equipped with General
Motors Corporation authorized programming software - The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an
interface between the vehicle and the Techline Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is installed in the vehicle
^ Pass Thru Programming: The Tech 2 or other scan tool Techline Terminal or a personal computer equipped with General
Motors Corporation authorized programming software - The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an
interface between the vehicle and the Techline Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is installed in the vehicle.
^ Off-Board Remote Programming, vehicle NOT available: The Tech 2 or other scan tool, Off-board Programming Adapter (OBPA), Techline Terminal or a
personal computer equipped with General Motors Corporation authorized programming software The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an interface between the vehicle and the Techline
Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is NOT installed in a vehicle
^ Off-Board Pass Thru Programming The Tech 2 or other scan tool, off-board programming adapter (OBPA), Techline Terminal or a
personal computer equipped with General Motors Corporation authorized programming software The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an interface between the vehicle and the Techline
Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is NOT installed in a vehicle
Before Programming a Control Module
IMPORTANT: DO NOT program an existing control module with the identical software/calibration
package. This procedure is not a short cut to correct a driveability condition. This is an ineffective
repair. A control module should only be programmed when the following occurs: ^
When a service procedure instructs you to replace the control module. The service part control
module does not contain operating software or calibrations.
^ General Motors Corporation releases an updated software/calibration package.
Ensure that the following conditions are met before programming a control module: ^
Vehicle system voltage: There are no charging system concerns. All charging system concerns must be repaired before
programming a control module.
- The battery voltage is greater than 12 volts but less than 16 volts. The battery must be fully
charged before programming the control module.
- A battery charger is NOT connected to the vehicles battery. Incorrect system voltage or voltage
fluctuations from a battery charger may cause programming failure or control module damage.
- Turn OFF or disable any system that may put a load on the vehicles battery. Turn OFF or disable
systems such as: ^
Daytime Running Lights (DRL). Applying the parking brake, on most vehicles, disables the DRL
system.
^ Heating, Ventilation, And Air Conditioning (HVAC) systems
^ Engine cooling fans, etc.
^ The ignition switch is in the proper position. The scan tool prompts you to turn ON the ignition,
with the engine OFF. DO NOT change the position of the ignition switch during the programming
procedure unless instructed to do so.
^ All tool connections are secure: The RS-232 cable
- The connection at the DLC
- The voltage supply circuits
- The OBPA
^ DO NOT disturb the tool harnesses while programming. If an interruption occurs during the
programming procedure, programming failure or
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Additional Information > Page 2712
control module damage may occur.
^ If you are performing the pass-through programming procedure using a notebook computer
without the power cord, ensure that the internal battery is fully charged.
After Programming A Control Module The powertrain may operate slightly different after a control
module software/calibration update. Operating the powertrain through various driving conditions
allows the control module to re-learn certain values. The control module must re-learn the following
after a software/calibration update: ^
Fuel trim correction
^ Idle Air Control (IAC) learned position
^ Automatic transmission shift adapts
Other learned values only re-learn by performing a service procedure.
If a control module is replaced the following service procedures may need to be performed: ^
The crankshaft variation learn procedure
^ The engine oil life reset procedure
^ The idle learn procedure
^ The inspection/maintenance complete system set procedure
^ The vehicle theft deterrent password learn procedure
^ The Throttle Position (TP) sensor learn procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Fuel Pump Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2719
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2720
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2721
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2722
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2723
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2724
Fuel Pump Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2725
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2726
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2727
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2728
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2729
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2730
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2731
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2732
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2733
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2734
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2735
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2736
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2737
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2738
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2739
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2740
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2741
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2742
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2743
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2744
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2745
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2746
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2747
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2748
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2749
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page
2755
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 2756
Ignition Control Module (ICM)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 2757
Ignition Control Module: Description and Operation
IGNITION CONTROL MODULE (ICM) AND IGNITION COILS
The ICM is connected to the PCM by an Ignition Control (IC) circuit. The ICM also has a ground
circuit and shares an ignition 1 voltage supply with the ignition coil. The coil driver in the ICM
controls current through the ignition coil based on signal pulses from the PCM. There is no back-up
or by-pass function in the ICM.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 2758
Ignition Control Module: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector (3). 3. Remove the screws (4)
holding the ignition control module (2) and the heat sink (1) to the bracket. 4. Remove the ignition
control module and the heat sink.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the ignition control module (2) and the heat sink (1) on the bracket with the screws (4).
Tighten Tighten the screws to 3.5 N.m (31 lb in).
2. Reconnect the electrical connectors (3). 3. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2766
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2767
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2768
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2769
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2770
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2771
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2772
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2773
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2774
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2775
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2776
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2777
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2778
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2779
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2780
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2781
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2782
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2783
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2784
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2785
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2786
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2787
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2788
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2789
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2790
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2791
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2792
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2793
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2794
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2795
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2796
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2797
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2798
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2799
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Disconnect the MAF sensor harness connector.
3. Release the air cleaner cover retainer clips.
NOTE: ^
Handle the MAF sensor carefully.
^ Do not drop the MAF sensor in order to prevent damage to the MAF sensor.
^ Do not damage the screen located on the air inlet end of the MAF.
^ Do not touch the sensing elements.
^ Do not allow solvents and lubricants to come in contact with the sensing elements.
^ Use a small amount of a soap based solution in order to aid in the installation.
4. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct from the MAF sensor by loosening the hose clamp.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2800
5. Disconnect the air cleaner cover from the front of the MAF sensor by loosening the hose clamp.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Point the flow arrows on the MAF sensor away from the air cleaner.
1. Attach the MAF sensor to the air cleaner cover by tightening the hose clamp.
Tighten Tighten the clamp to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
2. Attach the air cleaner outlet duct to the MAF sensor by tightening the hose clamp.
Tighten Tighten the clamp to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2801
3. Install the air cleaner cover by fastening the air cleaner cover retainer clips.
4. Connect the MAF sensor harness connector.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2807
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2808
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2809
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2810
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2811
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2812
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2813
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2814
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2815
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2816
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2817
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2818
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2819
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2820
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2821
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2822
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2823
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2824
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2825
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2826
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2827
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2828
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2829
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2830
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2831
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2832
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2833
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2834
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2835
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2836
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2837
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2838
Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
2839
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
The CMP sensor is a hall-effect sensor located in the ignition distributor base, and uses the same
type of circuits as the CKP sensor. The CMP sensor signal is a digital ON/OFF pulse, output once
per revolution of the camshaft. The CMP sensor information is used by the PCM to determine the
position of the valve train relative to the CKP.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
2840
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
2841
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Disconnect the spark plug wires and ignition coil wire from the
distributor.
3. Disconnect the camshaft position (CMP) sensor harness connector from the distributor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
2842
4. Remove the distributor cap screws.
5. Remove the distributor cap.
6. Remove the rotor screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
2843
7. Remove the rotor.
8. Align the square slot in the reluctor wheel with the CMP sensor.
9. Remove the CMP screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
2844
10. Remove the CMP sensor.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: Do not use the old cap, CMP sensor, and rotor screws. Use the replacement screws
that have been coated with a thread locking compound.
1. Insert the CMP sensor through the reluctor wheel slot.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install new CMP mounting screws.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 2.2 N.m (19 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
2845
3. Install the rotor onto the reluctor wheel.
4. Install new rotor screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
2846
5. Install the distributor cap.
6. Install new distributor cap screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2.4 N.m (21 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
2847
7. Connect the CMP sensor harness connector.
8. Connect the spark plug wires and ignition coil wire. 9. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 15 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2851
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2852
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2853
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2854
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Drain the cooling system. 2. Remove the engine cover.
3. Remove the coolant temperature sensor electrical connector from the electrical harness at the
intake manifold. 4. Remove the coolant temperature sensor electrical connector from the intake
manifold bracket. 5. Remove the coolant temperature sensor from the cylinder head.
Installation Procedure
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the coolant temperature sensor to the cylinder head.
Tighten the sensor to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
2. Snap the coolant temperature sensor electrical connector to the intake manifold bracket. 3.
Connect the coolant temperature sensor electrical connector to the wiring harness at the intake
manifold. 4. Install the engine cover. 5. Fill the cooling system with coolant.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft Position Sensor: > 02-06-04-059 > Dec > 02 > Engine Controls - Engine Runs
Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Customer Interest Engine Controls - Engine Runs Rough/MIL
ON/DTC's Set
File In Section: 06 - Engine/Propulsion System
Bulletin No.: 02-06-04-059
Date: December, 2002
TECHNICAL
Subject: Engine Runs Rough, Service Engine Soon Light On, DTC's P0300 or P0335 Set (Shim
Crankshaft Sensor)
Models: 2002-03 Chevrolet Astro, Blazer, Express, Silverado and S-10 Truck Models 2002-03
GMC Jimmy, Safari, Savana, Sierra and Sonoma Truck Models with 4.3L V-6 Engine (VINs W, X RPOs L35, LU3)
Condition
Some owners may comment on a rough running condition or a Service Engine Soon (SES) light
being illuminated. Upon investigation, the technician may find a DTC code P0300 or P0335.
Cause
The crankshaft sensor may be contacting the reluctor wheel.
Correction
Remove the crankshaft sensor. Refer to the Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement procedure in
the Engine Controls-4.3L sub-section of the Service Manual. After removing the sensor, inspect the
end of it for witness marks that would indicate contact with the crankshaft. If contact with the
reluctor ring is indicated, then inspect the front cover for cracking or other signs of alignment
concerns. If the inspection indicates that the cover is causing mis-alignments, replace the cover. If
replacing the cover, then the 0.5 mm shim is not needed.
If the inspection of the front cover indicates that the cover is not the cause of mis-alignments, then
the sensor should be shimmed. Add one shim between the sensor and the front cover. If the
concern still exists, then add the second shim. Unless the sensor has been rubbed through the
casing or deformed by contact with the crankshaft, it should not be replaced.
In either case, the crankshaft relearn procedure should be performed after any repairs.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft Position Sensor: > 02-06-04-059 > Dec > 02 > Engine Controls - Engine Runs
Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set > Page 2863
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Position Sensor: > 02-06-04-059 > Dec > 02 > Engine Controls Engine Runs Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set
Crankshaft Position Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Engine Runs
Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set
File In Section: 06 - Engine/Propulsion System
Bulletin No.: 02-06-04-059
Date: December, 2002
TECHNICAL
Subject: Engine Runs Rough, Service Engine Soon Light On, DTC's P0300 or P0335 Set (Shim
Crankshaft Sensor)
Models: 2002-03 Chevrolet Astro, Blazer, Express, Silverado and S-10 Truck Models 2002-03
GMC Jimmy, Safari, Savana, Sierra and Sonoma Truck Models with 4.3L V-6 Engine (VINs W, X RPOs L35, LU3)
Condition
Some owners may comment on a rough running condition or a Service Engine Soon (SES) light
being illuminated. Upon investigation, the technician may find a DTC code P0300 or P0335.
Cause
The crankshaft sensor may be contacting the reluctor wheel.
Correction
Remove the crankshaft sensor. Refer to the Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement procedure in
the Engine Controls-4.3L sub-section of the Service Manual. After removing the sensor, inspect the
end of it for witness marks that would indicate contact with the crankshaft. If contact with the
reluctor ring is indicated, then inspect the front cover for cracking or other signs of alignment
concerns. If the inspection indicates that the cover is causing mis-alignments, replace the cover. If
replacing the cover, then the 0.5 mm shim is not needed.
If the inspection of the front cover indicates that the cover is not the cause of mis-alignments, then
the sensor should be shimmed. Add one shim between the sensor and the front cover. If the
concern still exists, then add the second shim. Unless the sensor has been rubbed through the
casing or deformed by contact with the crankshaft, it should not be replaced.
In either case, the crankshaft relearn procedure should be performed after any repairs.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Position Sensor: > 02-06-04-059 > Dec > 02 > Engine Controls Engine Runs Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set > Page 2869
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 2870
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2873
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2874
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2875
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2876
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2877
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2878
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2879
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2880
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2881
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2882
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2883
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2884
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2885
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2886
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2887
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2888
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2889
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2890
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2891
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2892
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2893
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2894
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2895
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2896
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2897
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2898
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2899
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2900
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2901
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2902
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2903
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2904
Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
2905
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
The CKP sensor is a three wire sensor based on the magneto resistive principle. A magneto
resistive sensor uses two magnetic pickups between a permanent magnet. As an element such as
a reluctor wheel passes the magnets the resulting change in the magnetic field is used by the
sensor electronics to produce a digital output pulse. The PCM supplies a 12-volt, low reference,
and signal circuit to the CKP sensor. The sensor returns a digital ON/OFF pulse 3 times per
crankshaft revolution for the V6 engine, 4 times for the V8 engine. The CKP sensor reads the
crankshaft mounted reluctor wheel to identify pairs of cylinders at top dead center (TDC).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
2906
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
CKP System Variation Learn Procedure
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair CKP System Variation Learn Procedure
IMPORTANT: For additional diagnostic information, refer to DTC P1336.
1. Install a scan tool. 2. With a scan tool, monitor the powertrain control module (PCM) for
diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs). If other DTCs are set, except DTC P1336,
refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List for the applicable DTC that set.
3. With a scan tool, select the crankshaft position (CKP) variation learn procedure. 4. Observe the
fuel cut-OFF for the engine that you are performing the learn procedure on. 5. The scan tool
instructs you to perform the following:
^ Block the drive wheels.
^ Apply the vehicles parking brake.
^ Cycle the ignition from OFF to ON.
^ Apply and hold the brake pedal.
^ Start and idle the engine.
^ Turn OFF the A/C.
^ Place the vehicles transmission in Park (A/T) or Neutral (M/T).
^ The scan tool monitors certain component signals to determine if all the conditions are met to
continue with the procedure. The scan tool only displays the condition that inhibits the procedure.
The scan tool monitors the following components: CKP sensor activity - If there is a CKP sensor condition, refer to the applicable DTCs that set.
- Camshaft position (CMP) sensor activity - If there is a CMP sensor condition, refer to the
applicable DTCs that set.
- Engine coolant temperature (ECT) - If the ECT is not warm enough, idle the engine until the ECT
reaches the correct temperature.
6. With the scan tool, enable the CKP system variation learn procedure.
IMPORTANT: While the learn procedure is in progress, release the throttle immediately when the
engine starts to decelerate. The engine control is returned to the operator and the engine responds
to throttle position (TP) after the learn procedure is complete.
7. Slowly increase the engine speed to the RPM that you observed. 8. Immediately release the
throttle when fuel cut-OFF is reached. 9. The scan tool displays Learn Status: Learned this ignition.
If the scan tool does NOT display this message and no additional DTCs set, refer to
Symptoms - Engine. If a DTC set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List for the applicable
DTC that set.
10. Turn OFF the ignition for 30 seconds after the learn procedure is completed successfully.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
CKP System Variation Learn Procedure > Page 2909
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: The CKP System Variation Learn Procedure will need to be performed whenever the
crankshaft position (CKP) sensor is removed or replaced. Refer to CKP System Variation Learn
Procedure.
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. If the vehicle is equipped with the
underbody shield package, then remove the steering linkage shield mounting bolts.
3. Remove the steering linkage shield.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
CKP System Variation Learn Procedure > Page 2910
4. Disconnect the CKP sensor harness connector.
5. Remove the CKP sensor mounting bolt.
6. Remove the CKP sensor.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
CKP System Variation Learn Procedure > Page 2911
IMPORTANT: ^
When installing the CKP sensor, make sure the sensor is fully seated before tightening the
mounting bolt. A poorly seated CKP sensor may perform erratically and may set false DTCs.
^ Do not reuse the original O-ring.
1. Replace the CKP sensor O-ring. 2. Lubricate the O-ring with clean engine oil before installing the
CKP sensor.
IMPORTANT: Make sure the CKP sensor mounting surface is clear and free of burrs.
3. Install the CKP sensor.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the CKP sensor mounting bolt.
Tighten Tighten the CKP sensor mounting bolt to 9 N.m (80 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
CKP System Variation Learn Procedure > Page 2912
5. Connect the CKP sensor harness connector.
6. Install the steering linkage shield.
7. Install the steering linkage shield mounting bolts.
Tighten
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
CKP System Variation Learn Procedure > Page 2913
Tighten the bolts to 33 N.m (24 lb ft).
8. Lower the Vehicle. 9. Perform the CKP System Variation Learn Procedure. See: Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor
The fuel level sensor consists of a float, a wire float arm, and a ceramic resistor card. The position
of the float arm indicates the fuel level. The fuel level sensor contains a variable resistor which
changes resistance in correspondence with the amount of fuel in the fuel tank. The Powertrain
Control Module ( PCM) sends the fuel level information via the class 2 circuit to the Instrument
Panel Cluster (IPC). This information is used for the IPC fuel gauge and the low fuel warning
indicator, if applicable. The PCM also monitors the fuel level input for various diagnostics.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 2917
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the fuel sender assembly. 2. Disconnect the fuel pump electrical connector (5). 3.
Remove the fuel level sensor electrical connector retaining clip (6). 4. Disconnect the fuel level
sensor electrical connector (7) from under the fuel sender cover. 5. Remove the fuel level sensor
retaining clip (4). 6. Squeeze the locking tangs and remove the fuel level sensor (3).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the fuel level sensor (3). 2. Install the fuel level sensor retaining clip (4). 3. Connect the
fuel level sensor electrical connector (7). 4. Connect the fuel level sensor electrical connector
retaining clip (6). 5. Connect the fuel pump electrical connector (5). 6. Install the fuel sender
assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams
Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
2921
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
The Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor measures the difference between the pressure or vacuum in
the fuel tank and outside air pressure. The control module provides a 5-volt reference and a ground
to the FTP sensor. The FTP sensor provides a signal voltage back to the control module that can
vary between 0.1 - 4.9 volts. As FTP increases, FTP sensor voltage decreases, high pressure =
low voltage. As FTP decreases, FTP voltage increases, low pressure or vacuum = high voltage.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
2922
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
2923
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the fuel tank. 2. Remove the fuel tank pressure sensor (1) from the modular fuel sender
(2).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the fuel tank pressure sensor (1) to the modular fuel sender (2). 2. Install the fuel tank.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2927
Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2928
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2929
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE (IAT) SENSOR REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect the intake air temperature (IAT) sensor
harness connector.
3. Remove the IAT sensor from the air cleaner outlet duct by pulling the sensor upward.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2930
1. Install the IAT sensor in the air cleaner outlet duct.
2. Connect the IAT sensor harness connector. 3. Connect the negative battery cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Knock Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2936
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2937
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2938
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2939
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2940
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2941
Knock Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2942
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2943
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2944
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2945
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2946
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2947
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2948
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2949
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2950
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2951
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2952
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2953
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2954
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2955
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2956
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2957
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2958
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2959
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2960
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2961
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2962
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2963
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2964
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2965
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2966
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2967
Knock Sensor (KS)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2968
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
The Knock Sensor (KS) system enables the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to control the
ignition timing advance for the best possible performance while protecting the engine from
potentially damaging levels of detonation. The sensors in the KS system are used by the PCM as
microphones to listen for abnormal engine noise that may indicate pre-ignition/detonation.
SENSOR DESCRIPTION
There are 2 types of KS currently being used: ^
The broadband single wire sensor
^ The flat response 2-wire sensor
Both sensors use piezo-electric crystal technology to produce and send signals to the PCM. The
amplitude and frequency of this signal will vary constantly depending on the vibration level within
the engine. Flat response and broadband KS signals are processed differently by the PCM. The
major differences are outlined below: ^
All broadband sensors use a single wire circuit. Some types of controllers will output a bias voltage
on the KS signal wire. The bias voltage creates a voltage drop the PCM monitors and uses to help
diagnose KS faults. The KS noise signal rides along this bias voltage, and due to the constantly
fluctuating frequency and amplitude of the signal, will always be outside the bias voltage
parameters. Another way to use the KS signals is for the PCM to learn the average normal noise
output from the KS. The PCM uses this noise channel, and KS signal that rides along the noise
channel, in much the same way as the bias voltage type does. Both systems will constantly monitor
the KS system for a signal that is not present or falls within the noise channel.
^ The flat response KS uses a 2-wire circuit. The KS signal rides within a noise channel which is
learned and output by the PCM. This noise channel is based upon the normal noise input from the
KS and is known as background noise. As engine speed and load change, the noise channel upper
and lower parameters will change to accommodate the KS signal, keeping the signal within the
channel. If there is knock, the signal will range outside the noise channel and the PCM will reduce
spark advance until the knock is reduced. These sensors are monitored in much the same way as
the broadband sensors, except that an abnormal signal will stay outside of the noise channel or will
not be present.
KS diagnostics can be calibrated to detect faults with the KS diagnostic inside the PCM, the KS
wiring, the sensor output, or constant knocking from an outside influence such as a loose or
damaged component. In order to determine which cylinders are knocking, the PCM uses KS signal
information when the cylinders are near Top Dead Center (TDC) of the firing stroke.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2969
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2970
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the engine cover. 3. Disconnect the knock
sensor harness connector (3). 4. Remove the knock sensor bolt (1) and knock sensor (2).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the knock sensor (2) and the knock sensor bolt (1).
Tighten Tighten the sender to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
2. Connect the knock sensor harness connector (3). 3. Install the engine cover. 4. Connect the
negative battery cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2974
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2975
Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2976
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2977
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair
MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE (MAP) SENSOR REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Other than checking for a worn grommet and loose electrical connectors, the only service possible
is a unit replacement if the diagnosis shows a malfunctioning manifold absolute pressure (MAP)
sensor.
1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Remove the engine cover. 3. Disconnect the MAP sensor harness
connector.
NOTE: Do not rotate or pry on the MAP sensor when removing. Damage to the MAP sensor or the
intake manifold may result.
4. Remove the MAP sensor by pulling straight up with a slight rocking motion. 5. Remove the MAP
sensor grommet. 6. Discard the MAP sensor grommet.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2978
1. Install the new MAP sensor grommet on the MAP sensor. 2. Install the MAP sensor.
3. Connect the MAP sensor harness connector. 4. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Oil Pressure Sensor: Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure Gage Sensor
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 22 ft. lbs.
Engine Oil Pressure Gage Sensor Fitting (Plus Required Angle)
Torque..................................................................................................................................................
............................................................... 11 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2982
Oil Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
Engine Oil Pressure Sensor and/or Switch Replacement
Tools Required J41712 Oil Pressure Switch Socket
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Disconnect the engine oil pressure sensor gage electrical
connector. 3. Hold the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting with a wrench.
4. Remove the engine oil pressure gage sensor using J41712.
Important: Note the alignment of the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting prior to removal.
5. Remove the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting, if necessary.
Installation Procedure
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting, if removed.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2983
1.1. Tighten the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.).
Important: Do not loosen the sensor fitting. Do not tighten the sensor fitting more than one turn to
align.
1.2. Tighten the sensor fitting until properly aligned.
2. Install the engine oil pressure gage sensor. 3. Hold the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting
with a wrench to prevent from turning.
Using J41712 tighten the engine oil pressure gage sensor to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
4. Install the engine oil pressure gage sensor electrical connector. 5. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Oxygen Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2989
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2990
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2991
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2992
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2993
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2994
Oxygen Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2995
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2996
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2997
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2998
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2999
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3000
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3001
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3002
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3003
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3004
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3005
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3006
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3007
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3008
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3009
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3010
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3011
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3012
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3013
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3014
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3015
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3016
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3017
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3018
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3019
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3020
Oxygen Sensor: Connector Views
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 1 Sensor 1
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 1 Sensor 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3021
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 2 Sensor 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Heated Oxygen Sensors
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation Heated Oxygen Sensors
The main function of the pre-catalyst Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) is to provide the (PCM) with
exhaust stream information in order to maintain proper fueling to hold emissions within acceptable
levels. These oxygen sensors are always located between the exhaust manifold and the catalytic
converter. After the sensor reaches the operating temperature, the sensor generates a voltage
inversely proportional to the amount of oxygen present in the exhaust gases.
The PCM uses the signal voltage from the fuel control heated oxygen sensors in a Closed Loop in
order to adjust the fuel injector pulse width. While in a Closed Loop, the PCM can adjust fuel
delivery in order to maintain an air to fuel ratio which allows the best combination of emission
control and driveability.
If the oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal are damaged, replace the entire oxygen
sensor assembly. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, the connector, or the terminals. In order for
the sensor to function properly, the sensor must have a clean air reference provided to it. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor wires. Any attempt to repair the wires,
connectors, or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference. Any attempt to repair
the wires, connectors, or terminals could degrade oxygen sensor performance.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Heated Oxygen Sensors > Page 3024
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation Oxygen Sensor Diagnosis
Diagnose the fuel control heated oxygen sensors for the following conditions:
^ Heater performance, time to activity on cold start
^ Slow response
^ Response time, time to switch R/L or L/R
^ Inactive signal, output steady at bias voltage - approximately 450 mV
^ Signal fixed high
^ Signal fixed low
Diagnose the catalyst monitor heated oxygen sensors for the following functions:
^ Heater performance, time to activity on cold start
^ Signal fixed low during steady state conditions
^ Inactive sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 3025
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor 1
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor
1
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39194-B Oxygen Sensor Wrench
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Vehicle Lifting Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Raise the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Disconnect the connector (1) for the HO2S.
NOTE: Refer to Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Remove the HO2S (2) using a J 39194-B.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: A special anti-seize compound is used on the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S)
threads. The compound consists of liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite tends to burn
away, but the glass beads remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New, or service
replacement sensors already have the compound applied to the threads. If the sensor is removed
from an engine and if for any reason the sensor is to be reinstalled, the threads must have
anti-seize compound applied before the reinstallation.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor 1 > Page 3028
1. Coat the threads of the oxygen sensor with anti-seize compound GM P/N 5613695, if necessary.
NOTE: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the HO2S (2) using a J 39194-B.
Tighten Tighten the sensor to 42 N.m (31 lb ft).
3. Connect the HO2S harness connector (1). 4. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor 1 > Page 3029
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor
2
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39194-B Oxygen Sensor Wrench
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Vehicle Lifting Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Raise the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Disconnect the connector (3) for the HO2S.
NOTE: Refer to Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Remove the HO2S (4) using a J 39194-B.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: A special anti-seize compound is used on the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S)
threads. The compound consists of liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite tends to burn
away, but the glass beads remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New, or service
replacement sensors already have the compound applied to the threads. If the sensor is removed
from an engine and if for any reason the sensor is to be reinstalled, the threads must have
anti-seize compound applied before the reinstallation.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor 1 > Page 3030
1. Coat the threads of the oxygen sensor with anti-seize compound GM P/N 5613695, if necessary.
NOTE: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the HO2S (4) using a J 39194-B.
Tighten Tighten the sensor to 42 N.m (31 lb ft).
3. Connect the HO2S harness connector (3). 4. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor 1 > Page 3031
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 2 Sensor
1
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39194-B Oxygen Sensor Wrench
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Vehicle Lifting Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Raise the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Disconnect the connector (2) for the HO2S.
NOTE: Refer to Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Remove the HO2S (1) using a J 39194-B.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: A special anti-seize compound is used on the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S)
threads. The compound consists of liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite tends to burn
away, but the glass beads remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New, or service
replacement sensors already have the compound applied to the threads. If the sensor is removed
from an engine and if for any reason the sensor is to be reinstalled, the threads must have
anti-seize compound applied before the reinstallation.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor 1 > Page 3032
1. Coat the threads of the oxygen sensor with anti-seize compound GM P/N 5813695, if necessary.
NOTE: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the HO2S (1) using a J 39194-B.
Tighten Tighten the sensor to 42 N.m (31 lb ft).
3. Connect the HO2S harness connector (2). 4. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3038
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3039
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3040
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3041
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3042
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3043
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3044
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3045
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3046
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3047
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3048
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3049
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3050
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3051
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3052
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3053
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3054
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3055
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3056
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3057
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3058
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3059
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3060
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3061
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3062
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3063
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3064
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3065
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3066
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3067
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3068
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3069
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3070
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3071
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Disconnect the throttle position (TP) sensor harness connector.
3. Remove the mounting bolts from the TP sensor.
NOTE: The TP sensor is an electrical component. Do not soak the TP sensor in any liquid cleaner
or solvent, as damage may result.
4. Remove the TP sensor and gasket from the throttle body assembly.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3072
1. With the throttle valve closed, install the TP sensor on the throttle shaft.
Rotate the TP sensor counterclockwise in order to align the mounting holes.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the TP sensor mounting bolts.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Connect the TP sensor harness connector. 4. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Park/Neutral Position Switch Screw
................................................................................................................................................... 3 Nm
(27 inch lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3076
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams
Automatic Transmission Related Connector End Views
Transmission Range Switch Connector, Wiring Harness Side
Tow/Haul Switch Connector, Column Wiring Harness Side
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3077
Park/Neutral Position Switch (C1)
Park/Neutral Position Switch (C2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3078
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Adjustments
Park/Neutral Position Switch Adjustment
Important: ^
The following procedure is for vehicles that have not had the switch removed or replaced. If the
switch has been removed or replaced, refer to Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement for the
proper adjustment procedure.
^ Apply the parking brake.
^ The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) positions only.
^ Check the switch for proper operation. If adjustment is required, proceed as follows:
1. Place the transmission range selector in the N (Neutral) position. 2. With an assistant in the
drivers seat, raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 3. Loosen the park/neutral position switch
mounting bolts. 4. With the vehicle in the N (Neutral) position, rotate the switch while the assistant
attempts to start the engine. 5. Following a successful start, turn the engine off.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
6. Tighten the bolts securing the switch to the transmission.
Tighten the bolts to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Check the switch for proper operation. The engine must start in the P
(Park) or N (Neutral) positions only. 9. Replace the park/neutral position switch if proper operation
can not be achieved.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3079
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement
^ Tools Required J 41364-A Neutral Position Adjustment Tool
Removal Procedure
1. Apply the parking brake. 2. Shift the transmission into neutral. 3. Raise the vehicle. Refer to
Vehicle Lifting.
4. Remove the nut securing the transmission control lever to the manual shaft. 5. Remove the
transmission control lever from the manual shaft. 6. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the
switch. 7. Remove the bolts securing the park/neutral position switch to the transmission. 8.
Remove the park/neutral position switch from the manual shaft. If the park/neutral position switch
did not slide off the manual shaft, file the outer
edge of the manual shaft in order to remove any burrs.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the switch to the transmission manual shaft by aligning the switch hub flats with the
manual shaft flats.
2. Slide the switch onto the transmission manual shaft until the switch mounting bracket contacts
the mounting bosses on the transmission.
Important: If a new switch is being installed, the switch will come with a positive assurance bracket.
The positive assurance bracket aligns the new switch in it proper position for installation and the
use of neutral position adjustment tool will not be necessary.
3. Install the switch to the transmission with two bolts finger tight.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3080
4. Position the tool J 41364-A onto the park/neutral position switch. Ensure that the two slots on the
switch where the manual shaft is inserted are
lined up with the lower two tabs on the tool.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
5. Rotate the tool until the upper locator pin on the tool is lined up with the slot on the top of the
switch.
Tighten the bolts securing the switch to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
6. Remove the J 41364-A from the switch. If installing a new switch, remove the positive assurance
bracket at this time. 7. Connect the electrical connectors to the switch.
8. Install the transmission control lever to the manual shaft with the nut.
Tighten the control lever nut to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
9. Lower the vehicle.
10. Check the switch for proper operation. The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral)
positions only. If proper operation of the switch can
not be obtained, replace the switch.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3086
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3087
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3088
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3089
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3090
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3091
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3092
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3093
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3094
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3095
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3096
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3097
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3098
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3099
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3100
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3101
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3102
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3103
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3104
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3105
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3106
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3107
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3108
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3109
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3110
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3111
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3112
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3113
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3114
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3115
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3116
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3117
Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3124
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3125
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3126
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3127
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3128
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3129
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3130
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3131
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3132
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3133
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3134
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3135
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3136
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3137
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3138
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3139
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3140
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3141
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3142
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3143
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3144
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3145
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3146
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3147
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3148
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3149
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3150
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3151
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3152
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3153
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3154
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3155
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3156
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3157
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Disconnect the MAF sensor harness connector.
3. Release the air cleaner cover retainer clips.
NOTE: ^
Handle the MAF sensor carefully.
^ Do not drop the MAF sensor in order to prevent damage to the MAF sensor.
^ Do not damage the screen located on the air inlet end of the MAF.
^ Do not touch the sensing elements.
^ Do not allow solvents and lubricants to come in contact with the sensing elements.
^ Use a small amount of a soap based solution in order to aid in the installation.
4. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct from the MAF sensor by loosening the hose clamp.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3158
5. Disconnect the air cleaner cover from the front of the MAF sensor by loosening the hose clamp.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Point the flow arrows on the MAF sensor away from the air cleaner.
1. Attach the MAF sensor to the air cleaner cover by tightening the hose clamp.
Tighten Tighten the clamp to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
2. Attach the air cleaner outlet duct to the MAF sensor by tightening the hose clamp.
Tighten Tighten the clamp to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3159
3. Install the air cleaner cover by fastening the air cleaner cover retainer clips.
4. Connect the MAF sensor harness connector.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3165
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3166
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3167
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3168
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3169
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3170
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3171
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3172
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3173
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3174
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3175
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3176
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3177
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3178
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3179
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3180
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3181
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3182
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3183
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3184
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3185
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3186
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3187
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3188
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3189
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3190
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3191
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3192
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3193
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3194
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3195
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3196
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3197
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3198
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Disconnect the throttle position (TP) sensor harness connector.
3. Remove the mounting bolts from the TP sensor.
NOTE: The TP sensor is an electrical component. Do not soak the TP sensor in any liquid cleaner
or solvent, as damage may result.
4. Remove the TP sensor and gasket from the throttle body assembly.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3199
1. With the throttle valve closed, install the TP sensor on the throttle shaft.
Rotate the TP sensor counterclockwise in order to align the mounting holes.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the TP sensor mounting bolts.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Connect the TP sensor harness connector. 4. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3206
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3207
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3208
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3209
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3210
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3211
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3212
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3213
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3214
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3215
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3216
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3217
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3218
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3219
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3220
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3221
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3222
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3223
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3224
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3225
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3226
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3227
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3228
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3229
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3230
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3231
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3232
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3233
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3234
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3235
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3236
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3237
Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3238
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
The CMP sensor is a hall-effect sensor located in the ignition distributor base, and uses the same
type of circuits as the CKP sensor. The CMP sensor signal is a digital ON/OFF pulse, output once
per revolution of the camshaft. The CMP sensor information is used by the PCM to determine the
position of the valve train relative to the CKP.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3239
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3240
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Disconnect the spark plug wires and ignition coil wire from the
distributor.
3. Disconnect the camshaft position (CMP) sensor harness connector from the distributor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3241
4. Remove the distributor cap screws.
5. Remove the distributor cap.
6. Remove the rotor screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3242
7. Remove the rotor.
8. Align the square slot in the reluctor wheel with the CMP sensor.
9. Remove the CMP screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3243
10. Remove the CMP sensor.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: Do not use the old cap, CMP sensor, and rotor screws. Use the replacement screws
that have been coated with a thread locking compound.
1. Insert the CMP sensor through the reluctor wheel slot.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install new CMP mounting screws.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 2.2 N.m (19 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3244
3. Install the rotor onto the reluctor wheel.
4. Install new rotor screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3245
5. Install the distributor cap.
6. Install new distributor cap screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2.4 N.m (21 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3246
7. Connect the CMP sensor harness connector.
8. Connect the spark plug wires and ignition coil wire. 9. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Crankshaft Position Sensor: > 02-06-04-059 > Dec > 02 > Engine Controls - Engine Runs Rough/MIL
ON/DTC's Set
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Customer Interest Engine Controls - Engine Runs Rough/MIL
ON/DTC's Set
File In Section: 06 - Engine/Propulsion System
Bulletin No.: 02-06-04-059
Date: December, 2002
TECHNICAL
Subject: Engine Runs Rough, Service Engine Soon Light On, DTC's P0300 or P0335 Set (Shim
Crankshaft Sensor)
Models: 2002-03 Chevrolet Astro, Blazer, Express, Silverado and S-10 Truck Models 2002-03
GMC Jimmy, Safari, Savana, Sierra and Sonoma Truck Models with 4.3L V-6 Engine (VINs W, X RPOs L35, LU3)
Condition
Some owners may comment on a rough running condition or a Service Engine Soon (SES) light
being illuminated. Upon investigation, the technician may find a DTC code P0300 or P0335.
Cause
The crankshaft sensor may be contacting the reluctor wheel.
Correction
Remove the crankshaft sensor. Refer to the Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement procedure in
the Engine Controls-4.3L sub-section of the Service Manual. After removing the sensor, inspect the
end of it for witness marks that would indicate contact with the crankshaft. If contact with the
reluctor ring is indicated, then inspect the front cover for cracking or other signs of alignment
concerns. If the inspection indicates that the cover is causing mis-alignments, replace the cover. If
replacing the cover, then the 0.5 mm shim is not needed.
If the inspection of the front cover indicates that the cover is not the cause of mis-alignments, then
the sensor should be shimmed. Add one shim between the sensor and the front cover. If the
concern still exists, then add the second shim. Unless the sensor has been rubbed through the
casing or deformed by contact with the crankshaft, it should not be replaced.
In either case, the crankshaft relearn procedure should be performed after any repairs.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Crankshaft Position Sensor: > 02-06-04-059 > Dec > 02 > Engine Controls - Engine Runs Rough/MIL
ON/DTC's Set > Page 3255
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Position Sensor: > 02-06-04-059 > Dec > 02 > Engine Controls - Engine Runs
Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set
Crankshaft Position Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Engine Runs
Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set
File In Section: 06 - Engine/Propulsion System
Bulletin No.: 02-06-04-059
Date: December, 2002
TECHNICAL
Subject: Engine Runs Rough, Service Engine Soon Light On, DTC's P0300 or P0335 Set (Shim
Crankshaft Sensor)
Models: 2002-03 Chevrolet Astro, Blazer, Express, Silverado and S-10 Truck Models 2002-03
GMC Jimmy, Safari, Savana, Sierra and Sonoma Truck Models with 4.3L V-6 Engine (VINs W, X RPOs L35, LU3)
Condition
Some owners may comment on a rough running condition or a Service Engine Soon (SES) light
being illuminated. Upon investigation, the technician may find a DTC code P0300 or P0335.
Cause
The crankshaft sensor may be contacting the reluctor wheel.
Correction
Remove the crankshaft sensor. Refer to the Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement procedure in
the Engine Controls-4.3L sub-section of the Service Manual. After removing the sensor, inspect the
end of it for witness marks that would indicate contact with the crankshaft. If contact with the
reluctor ring is indicated, then inspect the front cover for cracking or other signs of alignment
concerns. If the inspection indicates that the cover is causing mis-alignments, replace the cover. If
replacing the cover, then the 0.5 mm shim is not needed.
If the inspection of the front cover indicates that the cover is not the cause of mis-alignments, then
the sensor should be shimmed. Add one shim between the sensor and the front cover. If the
concern still exists, then add the second shim. Unless the sensor has been rubbed through the
casing or deformed by contact with the crankshaft, it should not be replaced.
In either case, the crankshaft relearn procedure should be performed after any repairs.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Position Sensor: > 02-06-04-059 > Dec > 02 > Engine Controls - Engine Runs
Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set > Page 3261
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
3262
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3265
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3266
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3267
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3268
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3269
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3270
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3271
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3272
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3273
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3274
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3275
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3276
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3277
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3278
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3279
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3280
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3281
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3282
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3283
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3284
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3285
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3286
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3287
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3288
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3289
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3290
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3291
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3292
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3293
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3294
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3295
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3296
Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3297
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
The CKP sensor is a three wire sensor based on the magneto resistive principle. A magneto
resistive sensor uses two magnetic pickups between a permanent magnet. As an element such as
a reluctor wheel passes the magnets the resulting change in the magnetic field is used by the
sensor electronics to produce a digital output pulse. The PCM supplies a 12-volt, low reference,
and signal circuit to the CKP sensor. The sensor returns a digital ON/OFF pulse 3 times per
crankshaft revolution for the V6 engine, 4 times for the V8 engine. The CKP sensor reads the
crankshaft mounted reluctor wheel to identify pairs of cylinders at top dead center (TDC).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3298
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > CKP System
Variation Learn Procedure
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair CKP System Variation Learn Procedure
IMPORTANT: For additional diagnostic information, refer to DTC P1336.
1. Install a scan tool. 2. With a scan tool, monitor the powertrain control module (PCM) for
diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs). If other DTCs are set, except DTC P1336,
refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List for the applicable DTC that set.
3. With a scan tool, select the crankshaft position (CKP) variation learn procedure. 4. Observe the
fuel cut-OFF for the engine that you are performing the learn procedure on. 5. The scan tool
instructs you to perform the following:
^ Block the drive wheels.
^ Apply the vehicles parking brake.
^ Cycle the ignition from OFF to ON.
^ Apply and hold the brake pedal.
^ Start and idle the engine.
^ Turn OFF the A/C.
^ Place the vehicles transmission in Park (A/T) or Neutral (M/T).
^ The scan tool monitors certain component signals to determine if all the conditions are met to
continue with the procedure. The scan tool only displays the condition that inhibits the procedure.
The scan tool monitors the following components: CKP sensor activity - If there is a CKP sensor condition, refer to the applicable DTCs that set.
- Camshaft position (CMP) sensor activity - If there is a CMP sensor condition, refer to the
applicable DTCs that set.
- Engine coolant temperature (ECT) - If the ECT is not warm enough, idle the engine until the ECT
reaches the correct temperature.
6. With the scan tool, enable the CKP system variation learn procedure.
IMPORTANT: While the learn procedure is in progress, release the throttle immediately when the
engine starts to decelerate. The engine control is returned to the operator and the engine responds
to throttle position (TP) after the learn procedure is complete.
7. Slowly increase the engine speed to the RPM that you observed. 8. Immediately release the
throttle when fuel cut-OFF is reached. 9. The scan tool displays Learn Status: Learned this ignition.
If the scan tool does NOT display this message and no additional DTCs set, refer to
Symptoms - Engine. If a DTC set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List for the applicable
DTC that set.
10. Turn OFF the ignition for 30 seconds after the learn procedure is completed successfully.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > CKP System
Variation Learn Procedure > Page 3301
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: The CKP System Variation Learn Procedure will need to be performed whenever the
crankshaft position (CKP) sensor is removed or replaced. Refer to CKP System Variation Learn
Procedure.
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. If the vehicle is equipped with the
underbody shield package, then remove the steering linkage shield mounting bolts.
3. Remove the steering linkage shield.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > CKP System
Variation Learn Procedure > Page 3302
4. Disconnect the CKP sensor harness connector.
5. Remove the CKP sensor mounting bolt.
6. Remove the CKP sensor.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > CKP System
Variation Learn Procedure > Page 3303
IMPORTANT: ^
When installing the CKP sensor, make sure the sensor is fully seated before tightening the
mounting bolt. A poorly seated CKP sensor may perform erratically and may set false DTCs.
^ Do not reuse the original O-ring.
1. Replace the CKP sensor O-ring. 2. Lubricate the O-ring with clean engine oil before installing the
CKP sensor.
IMPORTANT: Make sure the CKP sensor mounting surface is clear and free of burrs.
3. Install the CKP sensor.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the CKP sensor mounting bolt.
Tighten Tighten the CKP sensor mounting bolt to 9 N.m (80 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > CKP System
Variation Learn Procedure > Page 3304
5. Connect the CKP sensor harness connector.
6. Install the steering linkage shield.
7. Install the steering linkage shield mounting bolts.
Tighten
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > CKP System
Variation Learn Procedure > Page 3305
Tighten the bolts to 33 N.m (24 lb ft).
8. Lower the Vehicle. 9. Perform the CKP System Variation Learn Procedure. See: Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Ignition Lock Cylinder - Revised Replacement Procedure
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Technical Service Bulletins Ignition Lock Cylinder - Revised
Replacement Procedure
File In Section: 02 - Steering
Bulletin No.: 02-02-35-001
Date: January, 2002
SERVICE MANUAL UPDATE
Subject: Revised Ignition Lock Cylinder Replacement
Models: 1998-2002 Chevrolet and GMC C/K, S/T, M/L and G Model Vehicles 1999-2000 Cadillac
Escalade 2002 Cadillac Escalade 1998-2002 Oldsmobile Bravada
This bulletin is being issued to revise the Ignition Lock Cylinder Replacement procedure in the
Steering Wheel and Column - Standard or Steering Wheel and Column - Tilt sub-sections of the
Service Manual. Please replace the current information in the Service Manual with the following
information.
The following information has been updated within SI2000. If you are using a paper version of this
Service Manual, please make a reference to this bulletin on the affected page.
The above mentioned Service Manuals omitted information regarding performing the Passlock
Relearn or Autolearn procedure after an ignition lock cylinder has been replaced. If you have
replaced the ignition lock cylinder, refer to the following procedures:
For 1998-2000 model year vehicles, refer to Passlock Reprogramming in the Theft Deterrent
subsection.
For 2001-2002 model year vehicles, refer to Programming Theft Deterrent System Components in
the Theft Deterrent subsection.
DISCLAIMER
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Knock Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3316
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3317
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3318
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3319
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3320
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3321
Knock Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3322
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3323
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3324
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3325
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3326
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3327
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3328
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3329
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3330
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3331
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3332
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3333
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3334
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3335
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3336
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3337
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3338
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3339
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3340
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3341
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3342
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3343
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3344
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3345
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3346
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3347
Knock Sensor (KS)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3348
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
The Knock Sensor (KS) system enables the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to control the
ignition timing advance for the best possible performance while protecting the engine from
potentially damaging levels of detonation. The sensors in the KS system are used by the PCM as
microphones to listen for abnormal engine noise that may indicate pre-ignition/detonation.
SENSOR DESCRIPTION
There are 2 types of KS currently being used: ^
The broadband single wire sensor
^ The flat response 2-wire sensor
Both sensors use piezo-electric crystal technology to produce and send signals to the PCM. The
amplitude and frequency of this signal will vary constantly depending on the vibration level within
the engine. Flat response and broadband KS signals are processed differently by the PCM. The
major differences are outlined below: ^
All broadband sensors use a single wire circuit. Some types of controllers will output a bias voltage
on the KS signal wire. The bias voltage creates a voltage drop the PCM monitors and uses to help
diagnose KS faults. The KS noise signal rides along this bias voltage, and due to the constantly
fluctuating frequency and amplitude of the signal, will always be outside the bias voltage
parameters. Another way to use the KS signals is for the PCM to learn the average normal noise
output from the KS. The PCM uses this noise channel, and KS signal that rides along the noise
channel, in much the same way as the bias voltage type does. Both systems will constantly monitor
the KS system for a signal that is not present or falls within the noise channel.
^ The flat response KS uses a 2-wire circuit. The KS signal rides within a noise channel which is
learned and output by the PCM. This noise channel is based upon the normal noise input from the
KS and is known as background noise. As engine speed and load change, the noise channel upper
and lower parameters will change to accommodate the KS signal, keeping the signal within the
channel. If there is knock, the signal will range outside the noise channel and the PCM will reduce
spark advance until the knock is reduced. These sensors are monitored in much the same way as
the broadband sensors, except that an abnormal signal will stay outside of the noise channel or will
not be present.
KS diagnostics can be calibrated to detect faults with the KS diagnostic inside the PCM, the KS
wiring, the sensor output, or constant knocking from an outside influence such as a loose or
damaged component. In order to determine which cylinders are knocking, the PCM uses KS signal
information when the cylinders are near Top Dead Center (TDC) of the firing stroke.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3349
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3350
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the engine cover. 3. Disconnect the knock
sensor harness connector (3). 4. Remove the knock sensor bolt (1) and knock sensor (2).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the knock sensor (2) and the knock sensor bolt (1).
Tighten Tighten the sender to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
2. Connect the knock sensor harness connector (3). 3. Install the engine cover. 4. Connect the
negative battery cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure >
Fuel Pressure Test Port > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed >
System Information > Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Information not supplied by the manufacturer.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner
Housing > Air Cleaner Restriction Indicator > Component Information > Description and Operation
Air Cleaner Restriction Indicator: Description and Operation
The air cleaner restriction indicator is located on the intake duct between the air cleaner assembly
and the Mass Air Flow/Intake Air Temperature ( MAF/IAT) sensor.
If the area inside of the clear section is green, no air filter service is required. If the area inside the
clear section is orange and Change Air Filter appears, replace the air filter.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner
Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air Filter
Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: Customer Interest Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner
Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air Filter
Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 3371
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner
Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air
Filter Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner
Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air
Filter Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 3377
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner
Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3378
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER ELEMENT REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the air cleaner cover by releasing the retainer clips. 2. Remove the air cleaner element.
3. Clear out any debris in the air cleaner tub.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Insert the air cleaner element into the air cleaner tub. 2. Install the air cleaner cover. 3. Fasten
the air cleaner cover retainer clips.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel
Pressure Release > System Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 34730-1A Fuel Pressure Gage
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Gasoline/Gasoline Vapors Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Remove the engine cover.
CAUTION: Refer to Fuel Gage Leak Caution in Service Precautions.
NOTE: Clean all of the following areas before performing any disconnections in order to avoid
possible contamination in the system: ^
The fuel pipe connections
^ The hose connections
^ The areas surrounding the connections
2. Install the J 34730-1A to the fuel pressure service connection. 3. Turn ON the ignition.
CAUTION: Refer to Fuel Storage Caution in Service Precautions.
4. Place the bleed hose of the fuel pressure gage into an approved gasoline container. 5. Open the
bleed valve on the fuel pressure gage in order to bleed the air from the fuel pressure gage. 6.
Command the fuel pump ON with a scan tool. 7. Close the bleed valve on the fuel pressure gage.
8. Inspect for fuel leaks.
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel
Pressure Release > System Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal > Page 3384
1. Place the fuel pressure gage bleed hose into an approved container and open the bleed valve to
bleed OFF fuel system pressure. 2. Place a shop towel under the J 34730-1A to catch any
remaining fuel spillage. 3. Remove the J 34730-1A from the fuel pressure connection. 4. Drain any
fuel remaining in the fuel pressure gage into an approved container. 5. Inspect for leaks using the
following procedure:
5.1. Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF for 2 seconds.
5.2. Turn OFF the ignition for 10 seconds.
5.3. Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
5.4. Inspect for fuel leaks.
6. Install the cap on the fuel pressure connection. 7. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel
Pressure Release > System Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal > Page 3385
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair Fuel System Pressure Relief
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 34730-1A Fuel Pressure Gage
CAUTION: Remove the fuel tank cap and relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing the fuel
system in order to reduce the risk of personal injury. After you relieve the fuel system pressure, a
small amount of fuel may be released when servicing the fuel lines, the fuel injection pump, or the
connections. In order to reduce the risk of personal injury, cover the fuel system components with a
shop towel before disconnection. This will catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an
approved container when the disconnection is complete.
1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Disconnect the negative battery cable in order to avoid possible fuel
discharge if an accidental attempt is made to start the engine. 3. Remove the engine cover. 4.
Connect the J 34730-1A or the equivalent to the fuel pressure connection. 5. Wrap a shop towel
around the fitting while connecting the gage in order to avoid spillage. 6. Install the bleed hose of
the gage into an approved container. 7. Open the valve on the gage in order to bleed the system
pressure. The fuel connections are now safe for servicing. 8. Drain any fuel remaining in the gage
into an approved container.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Spark Plug Wire Inspection
Ignition Cable: Service and Repair Spark Plug Wire Inspection
Spark plug wire integrity is vital for proper engine operation. A thorough inspection will be
necessary to accurately identify conditions that may affect engine operation. Inspect for the
following conditions:
1. Correct routing of the spark plug wires - Incorrect routing may cause cross-firing. 2. Any signs of
cracks or splits in the wires. 3. Inspect each boot for the following conditions:
^ Tearing
^ Piercing
^ Arcing
^ Carbon tracking
^ Corroded terminal
If corrosion, carbon tracking or arcing are indicated on a spark plug wire boot or on a terminal,
replace the wire and the component connected to the wire.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Spark Plug Wire Inspection > Page 3390
Ignition Cable: Service and Repair Spark Plug Wire Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the spark plug wire at each spark plug.
^ Twist the boots 1/2 turn before removing the boots.
^ Pull only on the boot or use a tool designed for this purpose in order to remove the wire from
each spark plug.
2. Disconnect the spark plug wire from the distributor.
^ Twist each spark plug boot 1/2 turn.
^ Pull only on the boot or use a tool designed for this purpose in order to remove the wires from the
distributor.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: If the boot to wire movement has occurred, the boot will give a false visual impression of
being fully seated. Ensure that the boots have been properly assembled by pushing sideways on
the installed boots. Failure to properly seat the terminal onto the spark plug will lead to wire core
erosion and result in an engine misfire or crossfire condition, and possible internal damage to the
engine.
1. Install the spark plug wires at the distributor. 2. Install the spark plug wire to each spark plug. 3.
Inspect the wires for proper installation:
3.1. Push sideways on each boot in order to inspect the seating.
3.2. Reinstall any loose boot.
3.3. Wire routings must be kept intact during service and followed exactly when wires have been
disconnected or when replacement of the wires is necessary. Failure to route the wires properly
can lead to radio ignition noise and crossfiring of the plugs, or shorting of the leads to the ground.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Spark Plug Wire Inspection > Page 3391
3.4. Any time the spark plug wires or boots are installed on the spark plugs, new dielectric grease
needs to be applied inside the boot.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Distributor: > 03-06-04-041A > Jan > 05 >
Ignition System - SES Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300
Distributor: Customer Interest Ignition System - SES Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300
Bulletin No.: 03-06-04-041A
Date: January 28, 2005
TECHNICAL
Subject: Poor Engine Performance - Misfire, Rough Idle, Stalls, Engine Cranks but Does Not Run,
Service Engine Soon/Check Engine Light Illuminated, DTC P0300 Set (Inspect Distributor Ignition
(DI) System Components and Replace As Necessary)
Models: 2001-2003 Chevrolet Astro, Blazer, Express, S-10 2001-2003 GMC Jimmy, Safari,
Savana, Sonoma 2001 Oldsmobile Bravada
with 4.3L, 5.0L or 5.7L Gas Engine (VINs W, X, M, R - RPOs L35, LU3, L30, L31)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to delete a model and add information to subject and inspection of
distributor vent screens. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 03-06-04-041 (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on poor engine performance and the Service Engine Soon/Check
Engine light being illuminated. Upon investigation, the technician may find DTC P0300 set.
Cause
This condition may be due to high levels of internal corrosion in the distributor, causing misfire,
rough idle, stall and Engine Cranks But Does Not Run. This corrosion is attributed to a lack of
airflow internal to the cap caused by the vent screens being clogged with debris.
Correction
Remove the vent screens and inspect the internal components of the Distributor Ignition System
using the procedure listed below. If the distributor base has to be replaced, the vent screens will
also have to be removed on the new distributor. If there is evidence of this internal corrosion,
replace the affected component. Refer to the appropriate procedure in the Engine Controls
sub-section of the applicable Service Manual.
Important:
All of these inspections can be done on-vehicle.
1. Inspect the distributor cap. You may notice a white residue on the cap walls. For higher mileage
occurrences, the interior of the cap may have changed to medium brown in color
2. Inspect the distributor rotor. You may notice the presence of black streaks on the plastic surface.
More typical evidence would be visible green spots on the copper surface of the rotor segment.
3. Inspect the distributor base. You may notice high levels of surface rust on the distributor shaft or
surface contamination on the sensor hold down screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Distributor: > 03-06-04-041A > Jan > 05 >
Ignition System - SES Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300 > Page 3400
4. Inspect the distributor vent screens (1). If the vent screens are present, remove them by using a
plastic-handled, long blade awl or pick (2). Insert into the airflow vent screens and pop them out.
Refer to the figure for removal procedure. If the vent screens have been removed from the base of
the distributor, then check the airflow inlets for being clogged with debris.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Distributor: > 03-06-04-041A > Jan > 05 >
Ignition System - SES Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300 > Page 3401
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Distributor: > 03-06-04-041A >
Jan > 05 > Ignition System - SES Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300
Distributor: All Technical Service Bulletins Ignition System - SES Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300
Bulletin No.: 03-06-04-041A
Date: January 28, 2005
TECHNICAL
Subject: Poor Engine Performance - Misfire, Rough Idle, Stalls, Engine Cranks but Does Not Run,
Service Engine Soon/Check Engine Light Illuminated, DTC P0300 Set (Inspect Distributor Ignition
(DI) System Components and Replace As Necessary)
Models: 2001-2003 Chevrolet Astro, Blazer, Express, S-10 2001-2003 GMC Jimmy, Safari,
Savana, Sonoma 2001 Oldsmobile Bravada
with 4.3L, 5.0L or 5.7L Gas Engine (VINs W, X, M, R - RPOs L35, LU3, L30, L31)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to delete a model and add information to subject and inspection of
distributor vent screens. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 03-06-04-041 (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on poor engine performance and the Service Engine Soon/Check
Engine light being illuminated. Upon investigation, the technician may find DTC P0300 set.
Cause
This condition may be due to high levels of internal corrosion in the distributor, causing misfire,
rough idle, stall and Engine Cranks But Does Not Run. This corrosion is attributed to a lack of
airflow internal to the cap caused by the vent screens being clogged with debris.
Correction
Remove the vent screens and inspect the internal components of the Distributor Ignition System
using the procedure listed below. If the distributor base has to be replaced, the vent screens will
also have to be removed on the new distributor. If there is evidence of this internal corrosion,
replace the affected component. Refer to the appropriate procedure in the Engine Controls
sub-section of the applicable Service Manual.
Important:
All of these inspections can be done on-vehicle.
1. Inspect the distributor cap. You may notice a white residue on the cap walls. For higher mileage
occurrences, the interior of the cap may have changed to medium brown in color
2. Inspect the distributor rotor. You may notice the presence of black streaks on the plastic surface.
More typical evidence would be visible green spots on the copper surface of the rotor segment.
3. Inspect the distributor base. You may notice high levels of surface rust on the distributor shaft or
surface contamination on the sensor hold down screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Distributor: > 03-06-04-041A >
Jan > 05 > Ignition System - SES Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300 > Page 3407
4. Inspect the distributor vent screens (1). If the vent screens are present, remove them by using a
plastic-handled, long blade awl or pick (2). Insert into the airflow vent screens and pop them out.
Refer to the figure for removal procedure. If the vent screens have been removed from the base of
the distributor, then check the airflow inlets for being clogged with debris.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Distributor: > 03-06-04-041A >
Jan > 05 > Ignition System - SES Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300 > Page 3408
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul
Distributor: Service and Repair Distributor Overhaul
DISASSEMBLY PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover.
NOTE: The ignition system distributor driven gear and rotor may be installed in multiple positions.
In order to avoid mistakes, mark the distributor on the following components in order to ensure the
same mounting position upon reassembly: ^
The distributor driven gear
^ The distributor shaft
^ The rotor holes
Installing the driven gear 180 degrees out of alignment, or locating the rotor in the wrong holes, will
cause a no-start condition. Premature engine wear or damage may result.
2. Align white paint mark on the bottom stem of the distributor, and the pre-drilled indent hole in the
bottom of the gear (2). 3. With the gear in this position, the rotor segment should be positioned as
shown for a V6 engine (1). If not, replace the distributor.
4. Remove the 2 screws from the rotor. 5. Remove the rotor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 3411
6. Note the locating holes that the rotor was removed from:
^ The rotor screw holes (1)
^ The rotor locator pin holes (2)
7. Line up the square-cut hole in the vane wheel with the CMP sensor.
8. Remove the 2 screws that hold the camshaft position (CMP) sensor. 9. Discard the screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 3412
10. Remove the CMP sensor. 11. Note the dimple located below the roll pin hole on one side of the
gear. The dimple will be used to properly orient the gear onto the shaft during
reassembly.
CAUTION: Refer to Safety Glasses Caution in Service Precautions.
12. Support the distributor drive gear in a V-block or similar fixture. 13. Drive out the roll pin with a
suitable punch.
14. Remove the driven gear from the distributor shaft. 15. Remove the round washer. 16. Remove
the tang washer. 17. Remove the shim washer (1).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 3413
18. Remove the old oil seal.
ASSEMBLY PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: Installing the driven gear 180 degrees out of alignment, or locating the rotor in the
wrong holes, will cause a no-start condition. Premature engine wear or damage may result.
1. Line up the square-cut hole in the vane wheel for the camshaft position (CMP) sensor.
2. Insert the sensor into the housing.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 3414
3. Install two new screws for the camshaft position (CMP) sensor.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2.2 N.m (19 lb in).
4. Identity the correct rotor mounting position:
^ At the rotor screw holes (1)
^ At the rotor locator pin holes (2)
5. Install the distributor rotor according to the index marks. 6. Install two rotor hold down screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 1.9 N.m (17 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 3415
7. Install the shim washer (1) on the bottom of the distributor shaft. 8. Install the tang washer. 9.
Install the round washer.
10. Install the driven gear according to the index marks.
11. Align the rotor segment as shown for a V6 engine (1) or V8 engine (2). 12. Install the gear and
align white paint mark on the bottom stem of the distributor, and the pre-drilled indent hole in the
bottom of the gear (3). 13. Check to see if the driven gear is installed incorrectly. On an incorrectly
installed driven gear, the dimple will be approximately 180 degrees
opposite the rotor segment when the gear is installed in the distributor.
CAUTION: Refer to Safety Glasses Caution in Service Precautions.
14. Support the distributor drive gear in a V-block or similar fixture. 15. Install the roll pin with a
suitable punch and hammer in order to hold the driven gear in the correct position.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 3416
16. Install the new oil seal under the mounting flange of the distributor base. 17. Install the
distributor. 18. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 3417
Distributor: Service and Repair Distributor Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
NOTE: There are two procedures available to install the distributor.
Use Installation Procedure 1 when the crankshaft has NOT been rotated from the original position.
Use Installation Procedure 2 when any of the following components are removed: ^
The intake manifold
^ The cylinder head
^ The camshaft
^ The timing chain or sprockets
^ The complete engine
If the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) turns on and DTC P1345 sets after installing the distributor,
this indicates an incorrectly installed distributor.
Engine damage or distributor damage may occur. Use Procedure 2 in order to install the distributor.
1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Remove the engine cover. 3. Remove air cleaner assembly. 4. Remove
the air intake resonator assembly. 5. Remove the spark plug wires from the distributor cap.
^ Twist each spark plug 1/2 turn.
^ Pull only on the wire boot in order to remove the wire from the distributor cap.
6. Remove the electrical connector from the base of the distributor.
7. Remove the 2 screws that retain the distributor cap to the housing. 8. Discard the screws. 9.
Remove the distributor cap from the housing.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 3418
10. Use a grease pencil in order to mark the position of the rotor in relation to the distributor
housing (1). 11. Mark the distributor housing and the intake manifold with the grease pencil.
12. As the distributor is being removed from the engine, watch the rotor move in a
counter-clockwise direction about 42 degrees. This will appear as
slightly more than one clock position.
13. Note the position of the rotor segment. 14. Place a second mark on the base of the distributor
(2).
This will aid in achieving the proper rotor alignment during the distributor installation.
15. Remove the mounting clamp hold-down bolt. 16. Remove the distributor.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 3419
1. If installing a new distributor assembly, place 2 marks on the new distributor housing in the same
location as the marks on the original housing. 2. Remove the new distributor cap, if necessary. 3.
Align the rotor with the second mark (2).
4. Guide the distributor into the engine. 5. Align the hole in the distributor hold-down base over the
mounting hole in the intake manifold.
6. As the distributor is being installed, observe the rotor moving in a clockwise direction about 42
degrees. 7. Once the distributor is completely seated, the rotor segment should be aligned with the
mark on the distributor base (1).
^ If the rotor segment is not aligned with the mark, the driven gear teeth and the camshaft have
meshed one or more teeth out of alignment.
^ In order to correct this condition, remove and reinstall the distributor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 3420
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
8. Install the distributor mounting clamp bolt.
Tighten Tighten the bolt to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
9. Install the distributor cap.
10. Install the new distributor cap screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2.4 N.m (21 lb in).
11. Install the electrical connector to the distributor. 12. Install the spark plug wires to the distributor
cap.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 3421
13. Install the ignition coil wire. Note the correct orientation of the wire boot.
IMPORTANT: If the malfunction indicator lamp illuminates after installing the distributor and DTC
P1345 is set, the distributor has been installed incorrectly.
14. Refer to Installation Procedure 2 if the malfunction indicator lamp illuminates after installing the
distributor. 15. Install the engine cover.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 2
IMPORTANT: Rotate the number 1 cylinder to top dead center (TDC) of the compression stroke.
The engine front cover has 2 alignment tabs and the crankshaft balancer has 2 alignment marks
spaced 90 degrees apart which are used for positioning the number 1 piston at TDC. With the
piston on the compression stroke and at TDC, the crankshaft balancer alignment mark (1) must
align with the engine front cover tab (2) and the crankshaft balancer alignment mark (4) must align
with the engine front cover tab (3).
1. Rotate the crankshaft balancer clockwise until the alignment marks on the crankshaft balancer
are aligned with the tabs on the engine front cover
and the number 1 piston is at TDC of the compression stroke.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 3422
2. Align the white paint mark on the bottom stem of the distributor and the pre-drilled indent hole in
the bottom of the gear (3).
NOTE: The ignition system distributor driven gear and rotor may be installed in multiple positions.
In order to avoid mistakes, mark the distributor on the following components in order to ensure the
same mounting position upon reassembly: ^
The distributor driven gear
^ The distributor shaft
^ The rotor holes
Installing the driven gear 180 degrees out of alignment, or locating the rotor in the wrong holes, will
cause a no-start condition. Premature engine wear or damage may result.
3. With the gear in this position, the rotor segment should be positioned as shown for a V6 engine
(1).
^ The alignment will not be exact.
^ If the driven gear is installed incorrectly, the dimple Will be approximately 180 degrees opposite
of the rotor segment when installed in the distributor.
4. Use a long screw driver in order to align the oil pump drive shaft to the drive tab of the
distributor. 5. Guide the distributor into the engine.
Ensure the flat portion of the distributor housing is facing toward the front of the engine.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 3423
6. Once the distributor is fully seated, the rotor segment should be aligned with the pointer cast into
the distributor base.
If the rotor segment does not come within a few degrees of the pointer, repeat the procedure in
order to achieve the proper alignment.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
7. Install the distributor mounting clamp bolt.
Tighten Tighten the bolt to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 3424
8. Install the distributor cap. 9. Install the new distributor cap screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2.4 N.m (21 lb in).
10. Install the electrical connector to the distributor. 11. Install the spark plug wires to the distributor
cap.
12. Install the ignition coil wire. Note the correct orientation of the wire boot.
IMPORTANT: If the malfunction indicator lamp illuminates after installing the distributor and DTC
P1345 is set, the distributor has been installed incorrectly.
13. Repeat Installation Procedure 2 if the malfunction indicator lamp illuminates after installing the
distributor. 14. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 3425
Distributor: Service and Repair Distributor Inspection
1. Remove the engine cover.
IMPORTANT: Discoloration of the cap and some whitish build up around the cap terminals is
normal. Yellowing of the rotor cap, darkening and some carbon build up under the rotor segment is
normal. Replacement of the cap and the rotor is not necessary unless there is a driveability
concern.
2. Inspect the cap for cracks, tiny holes or carbon tracks between the cap terminal traces.
Diagnose the carbon tracks using the following procedure:
2.1. Remove the cap.
2.2. Place 1 lead from the DMM on a cap terminal.
2.3. Use the other lead in order to probe all other terminals and the center carbon ball.
2.4. Move the base lead to the next terminal. Probe all other leads.
2.5. Continue this procedure until you test all the secondary terminals.
2.6. If there are any non-infinite readings, replace the cap.
3. Inspect the cap for excess build-up of corrosion on the terminals. Scrape clean the terminals.
Replace the cap if the corrosion is excessive. Some
buildup is normal.
4. Inspect the rotor segment for excess wear. Replace the rotor if excess looseness in the rotor
segment is present. 5. Inspect the shaft for shaft-to-bushing looseness:
5.1. Inspect the housing for cracks or damage.
5.2. Insert the shaft in the housing.
5.3. If the shaft wobbles, replace the housing assembly.
6. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Specifications
Spark Plug: Specifications Ignition System Specifications
Ignition System Specifications
Spark Plug Torque 15 N.m
Spark Plug Gap 1.52 mm
Spark Plug Type R41-932 [AC plug type]
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3429
Spark Plug: Application and ID
Spark Plug ...........................................................................................................................................
............................................ R41-932 (AC plug type)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Spark Plug Inspection
Spark Plug: Service and Repair Spark Plug Inspection
SPARK PLUG USAGE
1. Ensure that the correct spark plug is installed. An incorrect spark plug causes driveability
conditions. Refer to Ignition System Specifications for
the correct spark plug.
2. Ensure that the spark plug has the correct heat range. An incorrect heat range causes the
following conditions:
^ Spark plug fouling - Colder plug
^ Pre-ignition causing spark plug and/or engine damage - Hotter plug
SPARK PLUG INSPECTION
1. Inspect the terminal post (1) for damage.
^ Inspect for a bent or broken terminal post (1).
^ Test for a loose terminal post (1) by twisting and pulling the post. The terminal post (1) should
NOT move.
2. Inspect the insulator (2) for flashover or carbon tracking, soot. This is caused by the electrical
charge traveling across the insulator (2) between the
terminal post (1) and ground. Inspect for the following conditions: ^
Inspect the spark plug boot for damage.
^ Inspect the spark plug recess area of the cylinder head for moisture, such as oil, coolant, or
water. A spark plug boot that is saturated causes arcing to ground.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Spark Plug Inspection > Page 3432
3. Inspect the insulator (2) for cracks. All or part of the electrical charge may arc through the crack
instead of the electrodes (3, 4).
4. Inspect for evidence of improper arcing.
^ Measure the gap between the center electrode (4) and the side electrode (3) terminals. An
excessively wide electrode gap can prevent correct spark plug operation.
^ Inspect for the correct spark plug torque. Refer to Ignition System Specifications. Insufficient
torque can prevent correct spark plug operation. An over torqued spark plug, causes the insulator
(2) to crack.
^ Inspect for signs of tracking that occurred near the insulator tip instead of the center electrode (4).
^ Inspect for a broken or worn side electrode (3).
^ Inspect for a broken, worn, or loose center electrode (4) by shaking the spark plug. A rattling sound indicates internal damage.
- A loose center electrode (4) reduces the spark intensity.
^ Inspect for bridged electrodes (3, 4). Deposits on the electrodes (3, 4) reduce or eliminates the
gap.
^ Inspect for worn or missing platinum pads on the electrodes (3, 4), if equipped.
^ Inspect for excessive fouling.
5. Inspect the spark plug recess area of the cylinder head for debris. Dirty or damaged threads can
cause the spark plug not to seat correctly during
installation.
SPARK PLUG VISUAL INSPECTION
1. Normal operation - Brown to grayish-tan with small amounts of white powdery deposits are
normal combustion by-products from fuels with
additives.
2. Carbon Fouled - Dry, fluffy black carbon, or soot caused by the following conditions:
^ Rich fuel mixtures Leaking fuel injectors
- Excessive fuel pressure
- Restricted air filter element
- Incorrect combustion
^ Reduced ignition system voltage output
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Spark Plug Inspection > Page 3433
- Weak coils
- Worn ignition wires
- Incorrect spark plug gap
^ Excessive idling or slow speeds under light loads can keep spark plug temperatures so low that
normal combustion deposits may not burn off.
3. Deposit Fouling - Oil, coolant, or additives that include substances such as silicone, very white
coating, reduces the spark intensity. Most powdery
deposits will not effect spark intensity unless they form into a glazing over the electrode.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Spark Plug Inspection > Page 3434
Spark Plug: Service and Repair Spark Plug Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the spark plug wires. 2. Loosen each spark plug 1 or 2 turns. 3. Brush or air blast away
any dirt from around the spark plugs. 4. Remove the spark plugs 1 at a time. Place each plug in a
tray marked with the corresponding cylinder numbers.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Properly position each spark plug washer. 2. Inspect each spark plug gap. Adjust each plug as
needed
Specification Spark plug gap: 1.524 mm (0.060 in).
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Hand start the spark plugs in the corresponding cylinders. 4. Tighten the spark plugs.
Tighten ^
For used heads tighten the spark plugs to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
^ For new aluminum heads tighten the spark plugs to 20 N.m (15 lb ft).
^ For new iron heads tighten the spark plugs to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
5. Install the spark plug wires.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression
Check > System Information > System Diagnosis
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
Normal
The compression builds up quickly and evenly to the specified compression.
Leaking
The compression is low on the first compression stroke. The compression builds up with the
following strokes, but does not reach the specified compression.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3444
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3445
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3446
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3447
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3448
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3449
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3450
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3451
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3452
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3453
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3454
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3455
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3456
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3457
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3458
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3459
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3460
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3461
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3462
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3463
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3464
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3465
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3466
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3467
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3468
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3469
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3470
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3471
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3472
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3473
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3474
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3475
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3476
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3477
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Disconnect the MAF sensor harness connector.
3. Release the air cleaner cover retainer clips.
NOTE: ^
Handle the MAF sensor carefully.
^ Do not drop the MAF sensor in order to prevent damage to the MAF sensor.
^ Do not damage the screen located on the air inlet end of the MAF.
^ Do not touch the sensing elements.
^ Do not allow solvents and lubricants to come in contact with the sensing elements.
^ Use a small amount of a soap based solution in order to aid in the installation.
4. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct from the MAF sensor by loosening the hose clamp.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3478
5. Disconnect the air cleaner cover from the front of the MAF sensor by loosening the hose clamp.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Point the flow arrows on the MAF sensor away from the air cleaner.
1. Attach the MAF sensor to the air cleaner cover by tightening the hose clamp.
Tighten Tighten the clamp to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
2. Attach the air cleaner outlet duct to the MAF sensor by tightening the hose clamp.
Tighten Tighten the clamp to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3479
3. Install the air cleaner cover by fastening the air cleaner cover retainer clips.
4. Connect the MAF sensor harness connector.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3483
Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3484
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3485
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE (IAT) SENSOR REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect the intake air temperature (IAT) sensor
harness connector.
3. Remove the IAT sensor from the air cleaner outlet duct by pulling the sensor upward.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3486
1. Install the IAT sensor in the air cleaner outlet duct.
2. Connect the IAT sensor harness connector. 3. Connect the negative battery cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Body Control Module (BCM) C1
Body Control Module C1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Body Control Module (BCM) C1 > Page 3491
Body Control Module C2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Body Control Module (BCM) C1 > Page 3492
Body Control Module C3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3493
Body Control Module: Description and Operation
The BCM contains the logic of the theft deterrent system. The BCM provides the battery positive
voltage to operate the Passlock(TM) Sensor. The BCM also measures the voltage of the security
sensor signal circuit. The voltage measured will indicate whether the Passlock(TM) Sensor has
been activated and whether the resistance value from the sensor is a valid value or the tamper
value. If voltage measured is in the valid range, the BCM compares this voltage, voltage code, to a
previously learned voltage code. If the voltage codes match, the BCM sends a class 2 message
containing a password to the PCM. If the voltage codes do not match, or the voltage is in the
Tamper range, or there is a circuit fault, the BCM will not send the correct password to the PCM,
and the vehicle will not start.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Body Control Module: Procedures
IMPORTANT: If any module is replaced, programming the module with the proper RPO
configurations must be done prior to performing the Passlock Learn procedure.
1. The BCM must be programmed with the proper RPO configurations. The BCM stores the
information regarding the vehicle options. If the BCM is
not properly configured with the correct RPO codes the BCM will not control the features properly.
Ensure that the following conditions exist in order to prepare for BCM programming: ^
The battery is fully charged.
^ The ignition switch is in the RUN position.
^ The DLC is accessible.
^ All disconnected modules and devices are reconnected before programming.
2. Follow the SPS instructions on the Techline Terminal and scan tool to program the BCM. 3. If
the BCM fails to accept the program, perform the following steps:
^ Inspect all BCM connections.
^ Verify that the SPS Techline Terminal and scan tool have the latest software version.
Passlock Learn Procedures Refer to the Theft Deterrent sub-system for the appropriate learn
procedure.
IMPORTANT: After programming, perform the following to avoid future misdiagnosis: 1. Turn the
ignition OFF for 10 seconds. 2. Connect the scan tool to the data link connector. 3. Turn the ignition
ON with the engine OFF. 4. Use the scan tool in order to retrieve History DTCs from all modules. 5.
Clear all history DTCs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 3496
Body Control Module: Removal and Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Replacing the body control module (BCM) may be necessary when you service the body control
system.
IMPORTANT: The ignition switch should be in the OFF position when connecting or disconnecting
the connectors to the BCM. Always disconnect the Brown BCM connector FIRST and connect the
Brown BCM connector LAST. The BCM can set DTC(s) with the ignition switch in the OFF position.
The BCM has battery run down protection for the courtesy lamp circuit. The BCM battery run down
protection can not detect shorts on inputs or other circuits which it does not control. The scan tool
can be used to put the BCM to sleep in order to check for current draws on circuits which are not
controlled by the BCM or controlled by the battery run down protection system. If an excessive
current draw is detected, refer to Battery Electrical Drain/Parasitic Load Test (w/ BCM) in Starting
and Charging.
1. Remove the radio from the vehicle. 2. Remove the heater control.
Pull the heater control (2) out and down in order to gain access to the body control module.
3. Push upward on the bracket retainer slightly and pull the body control module (2) from the
bracket (1) at an angle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 3497
4. Disconnect the electrical connectors (2) from the body control module (1). 5. Remove the body
control module from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the body control module (2) to the vehicle. 2. Install the body control module to the bracket
(1) at an angle under the wide hook retainer, with the label facing away from the bracket. 3. Apply
pressure on the center of the body control module in order to move the module toward the
mounting bracket base. Snap the module into
place.
4. Ensure that the module is fully seated. Ensure that both snap retainers are holding the module.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 3498
5. Connect the electrical connectors (2) to the body control module (1).
6. Install the heater control (2). 7. Install the radio to the vehicle. 8. Use the following components
in order to program the body control module with the proper calibrations:
^ The Techline Terminal
^ The Scan Tool
9. Perform the body control module programing. Refer to Body Control Module (BCM)
Programming/RPO Configuration. See: Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning
10. Clear the diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3504
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3505
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3506
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3507
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3508
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3509
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3510
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3511
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3512
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3513
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3514
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3515
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3516
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3517
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3518
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3519
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3520
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3521
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3522
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3523
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3524
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3525
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3526
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3527
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3528
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3529
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3530
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3531
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3532
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3533
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3534
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3535
Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3536
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
The CMP sensor is a hall-effect sensor located in the ignition distributor base, and uses the same
type of circuits as the CKP sensor. The CMP sensor signal is a digital ON/OFF pulse, output once
per revolution of the camshaft. The CMP sensor information is used by the PCM to determine the
position of the valve train relative to the CKP.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3537
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3538
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Disconnect the spark plug wires and ignition coil wire from the
distributor.
3. Disconnect the camshaft position (CMP) sensor harness connector from the distributor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3539
4. Remove the distributor cap screws.
5. Remove the distributor cap.
6. Remove the rotor screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3540
7. Remove the rotor.
8. Align the square slot in the reluctor wheel with the CMP sensor.
9. Remove the CMP screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3541
10. Remove the CMP sensor.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: Do not use the old cap, CMP sensor, and rotor screws. Use the replacement screws
that have been coated with a thread locking compound.
1. Insert the CMP sensor through the reluctor wheel slot.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install new CMP mounting screws.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 2.2 N.m (19 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3542
3. Install the rotor onto the reluctor wheel.
4. Install new rotor screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3543
5. Install the distributor cap.
6. Install new distributor cap screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2.4 N.m (21 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3544
7. Connect the CMP sensor harness connector.
8. Connect the spark plug wires and ignition coil wire. 9. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 15 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3548
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3549
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3550
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3551
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Drain the cooling system. 2. Remove the engine cover.
3. Remove the coolant temperature sensor electrical connector from the electrical harness at the
intake manifold. 4. Remove the coolant temperature sensor electrical connector from the intake
manifold bracket. 5. Remove the coolant temperature sensor from the cylinder head.
Installation Procedure
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the coolant temperature sensor to the cylinder head.
Tighten the sensor to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
2. Snap the coolant temperature sensor electrical connector to the intake manifold bracket. 3.
Connect the coolant temperature sensor electrical connector to the wiring harness at the intake
manifold. 4. Install the engine cover. 5. Fill the cooling system with coolant.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft Position Sensor: > 02-06-04-059 >
Dec > 02 > Engine Controls - Engine Runs Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Customer Interest Engine Controls - Engine Runs Rough/MIL
ON/DTC's Set
File In Section: 06 - Engine/Propulsion System
Bulletin No.: 02-06-04-059
Date: December, 2002
TECHNICAL
Subject: Engine Runs Rough, Service Engine Soon Light On, DTC's P0300 or P0335 Set (Shim
Crankshaft Sensor)
Models: 2002-03 Chevrolet Astro, Blazer, Express, Silverado and S-10 Truck Models 2002-03
GMC Jimmy, Safari, Savana, Sierra and Sonoma Truck Models with 4.3L V-6 Engine (VINs W, X RPOs L35, LU3)
Condition
Some owners may comment on a rough running condition or a Service Engine Soon (SES) light
being illuminated. Upon investigation, the technician may find a DTC code P0300 or P0335.
Cause
The crankshaft sensor may be contacting the reluctor wheel.
Correction
Remove the crankshaft sensor. Refer to the Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement procedure in
the Engine Controls-4.3L sub-section of the Service Manual. After removing the sensor, inspect the
end of it for witness marks that would indicate contact with the crankshaft. If contact with the
reluctor ring is indicated, then inspect the front cover for cracking or other signs of alignment
concerns. If the inspection indicates that the cover is causing mis-alignments, replace the cover. If
replacing the cover, then the 0.5 mm shim is not needed.
If the inspection of the front cover indicates that the cover is not the cause of mis-alignments, then
the sensor should be shimmed. Add one shim between the sensor and the front cover. If the
concern still exists, then add the second shim. Unless the sensor has been rubbed through the
casing or deformed by contact with the crankshaft, it should not be replaced.
In either case, the crankshaft relearn procedure should be performed after any repairs.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft Position Sensor: > 02-06-04-059 >
Dec > 02 > Engine Controls - Engine Runs Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set > Page 3560
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Position Sensor: >
02-06-04-059 > Dec > 02 > Engine Controls - Engine Runs Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set
Crankshaft Position Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Engine Runs
Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set
File In Section: 06 - Engine/Propulsion System
Bulletin No.: 02-06-04-059
Date: December, 2002
TECHNICAL
Subject: Engine Runs Rough, Service Engine Soon Light On, DTC's P0300 or P0335 Set (Shim
Crankshaft Sensor)
Models: 2002-03 Chevrolet Astro, Blazer, Express, Silverado and S-10 Truck Models 2002-03
GMC Jimmy, Safari, Savana, Sierra and Sonoma Truck Models with 4.3L V-6 Engine (VINs W, X RPOs L35, LU3)
Condition
Some owners may comment on a rough running condition or a Service Engine Soon (SES) light
being illuminated. Upon investigation, the technician may find a DTC code P0300 or P0335.
Cause
The crankshaft sensor may be contacting the reluctor wheel.
Correction
Remove the crankshaft sensor. Refer to the Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement procedure in
the Engine Controls-4.3L sub-section of the Service Manual. After removing the sensor, inspect the
end of it for witness marks that would indicate contact with the crankshaft. If contact with the
reluctor ring is indicated, then inspect the front cover for cracking or other signs of alignment
concerns. If the inspection indicates that the cover is causing mis-alignments, replace the cover. If
replacing the cover, then the 0.5 mm shim is not needed.
If the inspection of the front cover indicates that the cover is not the cause of mis-alignments, then
the sensor should be shimmed. Add one shim between the sensor and the front cover. If the
concern still exists, then add the second shim. Unless the sensor has been rubbed through the
casing or deformed by contact with the crankshaft, it should not be replaced.
In either case, the crankshaft relearn procedure should be performed after any repairs.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Position Sensor: >
02-06-04-059 > Dec > 02 > Engine Controls - Engine Runs Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set > Page 3566
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3567
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3570
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3571
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3572
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3573
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3574
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3575
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3576
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3577
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3578
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3579
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3580
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3581
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3582
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3583
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3584
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3585
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3586
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3587
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3588
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3589
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3590
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3591
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3592
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3593
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3594
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3595
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3596
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3597
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3598
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3599
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3600
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3601
Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3602
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
The CKP sensor is a three wire sensor based on the magneto resistive principle. A magneto
resistive sensor uses two magnetic pickups between a permanent magnet. As an element such as
a reluctor wheel passes the magnets the resulting change in the magnetic field is used by the
sensor electronics to produce a digital output pulse. The PCM supplies a 12-volt, low reference,
and signal circuit to the CKP sensor. The sensor returns a digital ON/OFF pulse 3 times per
crankshaft revolution for the V6 engine, 4 times for the V8 engine. The CKP sensor reads the
crankshaft mounted reluctor wheel to identify pairs of cylinders at top dead center (TDC).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3603
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > CKP System Variation Learn Procedure
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair CKP System Variation Learn Procedure
IMPORTANT: For additional diagnostic information, refer to DTC P1336.
1. Install a scan tool. 2. With a scan tool, monitor the powertrain control module (PCM) for
diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs). If other DTCs are set, except DTC P1336,
refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List for the applicable DTC that set.
3. With a scan tool, select the crankshaft position (CKP) variation learn procedure. 4. Observe the
fuel cut-OFF for the engine that you are performing the learn procedure on. 5. The scan tool
instructs you to perform the following:
^ Block the drive wheels.
^ Apply the vehicles parking brake.
^ Cycle the ignition from OFF to ON.
^ Apply and hold the brake pedal.
^ Start and idle the engine.
^ Turn OFF the A/C.
^ Place the vehicles transmission in Park (A/T) or Neutral (M/T).
^ The scan tool monitors certain component signals to determine if all the conditions are met to
continue with the procedure. The scan tool only displays the condition that inhibits the procedure.
The scan tool monitors the following components: CKP sensor activity - If there is a CKP sensor condition, refer to the applicable DTCs that set.
- Camshaft position (CMP) sensor activity - If there is a CMP sensor condition, refer to the
applicable DTCs that set.
- Engine coolant temperature (ECT) - If the ECT is not warm enough, idle the engine until the ECT
reaches the correct temperature.
6. With the scan tool, enable the CKP system variation learn procedure.
IMPORTANT: While the learn procedure is in progress, release the throttle immediately when the
engine starts to decelerate. The engine control is returned to the operator and the engine responds
to throttle position (TP) after the learn procedure is complete.
7. Slowly increase the engine speed to the RPM that you observed. 8. Immediately release the
throttle when fuel cut-OFF is reached. 9. The scan tool displays Learn Status: Learned this ignition.
If the scan tool does NOT display this message and no additional DTCs set, refer to
Symptoms - Engine. If a DTC set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List for the applicable
DTC that set.
10. Turn OFF the ignition for 30 seconds after the learn procedure is completed successfully.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > CKP System Variation Learn Procedure > Page 3606
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: The CKP System Variation Learn Procedure will need to be performed whenever the
crankshaft position (CKP) sensor is removed or replaced. Refer to CKP System Variation Learn
Procedure.
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. If the vehicle is equipped with the
underbody shield package, then remove the steering linkage shield mounting bolts.
3. Remove the steering linkage shield.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > CKP System Variation Learn Procedure > Page 3607
4. Disconnect the CKP sensor harness connector.
5. Remove the CKP sensor mounting bolt.
6. Remove the CKP sensor.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > CKP System Variation Learn Procedure > Page 3608
IMPORTANT: ^
When installing the CKP sensor, make sure the sensor is fully seated before tightening the
mounting bolt. A poorly seated CKP sensor may perform erratically and may set false DTCs.
^ Do not reuse the original O-ring.
1. Replace the CKP sensor O-ring. 2. Lubricate the O-ring with clean engine oil before installing the
CKP sensor.
IMPORTANT: Make sure the CKP sensor mounting surface is clear and free of burrs.
3. Install the CKP sensor.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the CKP sensor mounting bolt.
Tighten Tighten the CKP sensor mounting bolt to 9 N.m (80 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > CKP System Variation Learn Procedure > Page 3609
5. Connect the CKP sensor harness connector.
6. Install the steering linkage shield.
7. Install the steering linkage shield mounting bolts.
Tighten
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > CKP System Variation Learn Procedure > Page 3610
Tighten the bolts to 33 N.m (24 lb ft).
8. Lower the Vehicle. 9. Perform the CKP System Variation Learn Procedure. See: Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Timing
Ring > Component Information > Service and Repair
Crankshaft Position Timing Ring: Service and Repair
Crankshaft Position (CKP) Reluctor Ring Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the engine front cover.
2. Remove the crankshaft position sensor reluctor ring.
Installation Procedure
Notice: Failure to properly align the crankshaft position sensor reluctor ring may result in
component damage and effect OBD II system performance.
Important: The reluctor ring is shaped like a dish. The dish must face towards the engine front
cover.
1. Install the crankshaft position sensor reluctor ring. 2. Install the engine front cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3617
Data Link Connector (DLC)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory
Usage
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-06-04-054B
Date: November 18, 2010
Subject: Info - Non-GM Parts and Accessories (Aftermarket)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years and update to the new U.S. Fixed
Operation Manager (FOM) and Canada Warranty Manager (WM) names. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 04-06-04-054A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
The recent rise and expansion of companies selling non-GM parts and accessories has made it
necessary to issue this reminder to dealers regarding GM's policy on the use and installation of
these aftermarket components.
When a dealer is performing a repair under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty, they are required to
use only genuine GM or GM-approved parts and accessories. This applies to all warranty repairs,
special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM. Parts and accessories advertised as being "the
same" as parts manufactured by GM, but not sold through GM, do not qualify for use in warranty
repairs, special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM.
During a warranty repair, if a GM original equipment part is not available through GM Customer
Care and Aftersales (GM CC&A;), ACDelco(R) distributors, other GM dealers or approved sources,
the dealer is to obtain comparable, non-GM parts and clearly indicate, in detail, on the repair order
the circumstances surrounding why non-GM parts were used. The dealer must give customers
written notice, prior to the sale or service, that such parts or accessories are not marketed or
warranted by General Motors.
It should also be noted that dealers modifying new vehicles and installing equipment, parts and
accessories obtained from sources not authorized by GM are responsible for complying with the
National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act. Certain non-approved parts or assemblies, installed
by the dealer or its agent not authorized by GM, may result in a change to the vehicle's design
characteristics and may affect the vehicle's ability to conform to federal law. Dealers must fully
understand that non-GM approved parts may not have been validated, tested or certified for use.
This puts the dealer at risk for potential liability in the event of a part or vehicle failure. If a GM part
failure occurs as the result of the installation or use of a non-GM approved part, the warranty will
not be honored.
A good example of non-authorized modification of vehicles is the result of an ever increasing
supply of aftermarket devices available to the customer, which claim to increase the horsepower
and torque of the Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines. These include the addition of, but are not limited to
one or more of the following modifications:
- Propane injection
- Nitrous oxide injection
- Additional modules (black boxes) that connect to the vehicle wiring systems
- Revised engine calibrations downloaded for the engine control module
- Calibration modules which connect to the vehicle diagnostic connector
- Modification to the engine turbocharger waste gate
Although the installation of these devices, or modification of vehicle components, can increase
engine horsepower and torque, they may also negatively affect the engine emissions, reliability
and/or durability. In addition, other powertrain components, such as transmissions, universal joints,
drive shafts, and front/rear axle components, can be stressed beyond design safety limits by the
installation of these devices.
General Motors does not support or endorse the use of devices or modifications that, when
installed, increase the engine horsepower and torque. It is because of these unknown stresses,
and the potential to alter reliability, durability and emissions performance, that GM has adopted a
policy that prevents any UNAUTHORIZED dealer warranty claim submissions to any remaining
warranty coverage, to the powertrain and driveline components whenever the presence of a
non-GM (aftermarket) calibration is confirmed - even if the non-GM control module calibration is
subsequently removed. Refer to the latest version of Bulletin 09-06-04-026 (V8 Gas Engines) or
06-06-01-007 (Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines) for more information on dealer requirements for
calibration verification.
These same policies apply as they relate to the use of non-GM accessories. Damage or failure
from the use or installation of a non-GM accessory will not be covered under warranty. Failure
resulting from the alteration or modification of the vehicle, including the cutting, welding or
disconnecting of the vehicle's original equipment parts and components will void the warranty.
Additionally, dealers will NOT be reimbursed or compensated by GM in the event of any legal
inquiry at either the local, state or federal level that
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 3622
results from the alteration or modification of a vehicle using non-GM approved parts or accessories.
Dealers should be especially cautious of accessory companies that claim the installation of their
product will not void the factory warranty. Many times these companies have even given direction
on how to quickly disassemble the accessory in an attempt to preclude the manufacturer from
finding out that is has been installed.
Any suspect repairs should be reviewed by the Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), and in Canada
by the Warranty Manager (WM) for appropriate repair direction. If it is decided that a goodwill repair
is to be made on the vehicle, even with the installation of such non-GM approved components, the
customer is to be made aware of General Motors position on this issue and is to sign the
appropriate goodwill documentation required by General Motors.
It is imperative for dealers to understand that by installing such devices, they are jeopardizing not
only the warranty coverage, but also the performance and reliability of the customer's vehicle.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3623
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3626
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3627
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3628
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3629
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3630
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3631
Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3632
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3633
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3634
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3635
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3636
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3637
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3638
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3639
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3640
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3641
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3642
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3643
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3644
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3645
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3646
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3647
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3648
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3649
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3650
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3651
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3652
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3653
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3654
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3655
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3656
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3657
Engine Control Module: Connector Views
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) C1 Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3658
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) C1 Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3659
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) C2 Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3660
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) C2 Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > General Information
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation General Information
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is designed to maintain exhaust emission levels while
maintaining excellent driveability and fuel efficiency. The PCM controls the following operations:
^ The fuel control
^ The Ignition Control (IC)
^ The Knock Sensor (KS) system
^ The automatic transmission shift functions
^ The manual transmission
^ The cruise control enable, if so equipped
^ The generator
^ The Evaporative Emissions (EVAP) purge
^ The A/C clutch control, if so equipped
^ The Secondary Air Injection (AIR), if so equipped
^ The Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR)
The PCM controls all ignition system functions, and constantly corrects the basic spark timing. The
PCM monitors information from various sensor inputs that include the following:
^ The Throttle Position (TP) sensor
^ The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
^ The Mass Airflow (MAF) Sensor
^ The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor
^ The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
^ The transmission gear position or range information sensors
^ The engine Knock Sensors (KS)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > General Information > Page 3663
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the meaning of voltage
(volts), current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens in a circuit
with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring diagram.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > General Information > Page 3664
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation Engine Controls Information
The driveability and emissions information describes the function and operation of the Powertrain
Control Module (PCM).
The computers and control systems information contains the following:
^ Component locations
^ Wiring diagrams
^ PCM terminal end view and terminal definitions
^ Powertrain On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) System Check
^ Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) tables
The Component System includes the following items:
^ Component and circuit description
^ On-vehicle service for each sub-system
^ Functional checks and diagnostic tables
The DTCs also contain diagnostic support information containing circuit diagrams, circuit or system
information, and helpful diagnostic information.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > General Information > Page 3665
Typical Drive Cycle
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > General Information > Page 3666
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation
General Information
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is designed to maintain exhaust emission levels while
maintaining excellent driveability and fuel efficiency. The PCM controls the following operations:
^ The fuel control
^ The Ignition Control (IC)
^ The Knock Sensor (KS) system
^ The automatic transmission shift functions
^ The manual transmission
^ The cruise control enable, if so equipped
^ The generator
^ The Evaporative Emissions (EVAP) purge
^ The A/C clutch control, if so equipped
^ The Secondary Air Injection (AIR), if so equipped
^ The Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR)
The PCM controls all ignition system functions, and constantly corrects the basic spark timing. The
PCM monitors information from various sensor inputs that include the following:
^ The Throttle Position (TP) sensor
^ The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
^ The Mass Airflow (MAF) Sensor
^ The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor
^ The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
^ The transmission gear position or range information sensors
^ The engine Knock Sensors (KS)
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the meaning of voltage
(volts), current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens in a circuit
with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring diagram.
Engine Controls Information
The driveability and emissions information describes the function and operation of the Powertrain
Control Module (PCM).
The computers and control systems information contains the following:
^ Component locations
^ Wiring diagrams
^ PCM terminal end view and terminal definitions
^ Powertrain On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) System Check
^ Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) tables
The Component System includes the following items:
^ Component and circuit description
^ On-vehicle service for each sub-system
^ Functional checks and diagnostic tables
The DTCs also contain diagnostic support information containing circuit diagrams, circuit or system
information, and helpful diagnostic information.
Typical Drive Cycle
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > General Information > Page 3667
Primary System Based Diagnostics
There are primary system-based diagnostics which evaluate the system operation and their effect
on vehicle emissions. The primary system-based diagnostics are listed, with a brief description of
the diagnostic functionality.
Heated Oxygen Sensors
The main function of the pre-catalyst Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) is to provide the (PCM) with
exhaust stream information in order to maintain proper fueling to hold emissions within acceptable
levels. These oxygen sensors are always located between the exhaust manifold and the catalytic
converter. After the sensor reaches the operating temperature, the sensor generates a voltage
inversely proportional to the amount of oxygen present in the exhaust gases.
The PCM uses the signal voltage from the fuel control heated oxygen sensors in a Closed Loop in
order to adjust the fuel injector pulse width. While in a Closed Loop, the PCM can adjust fuel
delivery in order to maintain an air to fuel ratio which allows the best combination of emission
control and driveability.
If the oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal are damaged, replace the entire oxygen
sensor assembly. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, the connector, or the terminals. In order for
the sensor to function properly, the sensor must have a clean air reference provided to it. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor wires. Any attempt to repair the wires,
connectors, or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference. Any attempt to repair
the wires, connectors, or terminals could degrade oxygen sensor performance.
Catalyst Monitor Diagnostic Operation
The catalyst monitor diagnostic measures oxygen storage capacity of the catalyst converter. In
order to do this, the heated sensors are installed before and after the 3-Way Catalyst (TWC).
Voltage variations between the sensors allow the PCM to determine the catalyst emission
performance.
As a catalyst becomes less effective in promoting chemical reactions, the catalysts capacity to
store and release oxygen generally degrades. The catalyst monitor diagnostic is based on a
correlation between conversion efficiency and oxygen storage capacity.
A good catalyst, e.g. 95 degrees hydrocarbon conversion efficiency, shows a relatively flat output
voltage on the post-catalyst Heated Oxygen Sensor ( HO2S). A degraded catalyst, 65 percent
hydrocarbon conversion, shows a greatly increased activity in output voltage from the post catalyst
HO2S.
The post-catalyst HO2S is used to measure the oxygen storage and release capacity of the
catalyst. A high oxygen storage capacity indicates a good catalyst. Low oxygen storage capacity
indicates a failing catalyst. The (TWC) and the HO2S must be at operating temperature in order to
achieve correct oxygen sensor voltages like those shown in the post-catalyst HO2S outputs
graphic.
The catalyst monitor diagnostic is sensitive to the following conditions:
^ Exhaust leaks
^ HO2S contamination
^ Alternative fuels
Exhaust system leaks may cause the following:
^ Prevent a degraded catalyst from failing the diagnostic
^ Cause a false failure for a normally functioning catalyst
^ Prevent the diagnostic from running
Some of the contaminants that may be encountered are phosphorus, lead, silica, and sulfur. The
presence of these contaminants prevent the TWC diagnostic from functioning properly.
Catalyst Monitor Heated Oxygen Sensors
In order to control emissions of Hydrocarbons (HC), Carbon Monoxide (CO), and Oxides of
Nitrogen (NOx), the system uses a 3-way catalytic converter. The catalyst promotes a chemical
reaction which oxidizes the HC and CO present in the exhaust gas, converting the HC and CO into
harmless water vapor and carbon dioxide. The catalyst also converts NOx to nitrogen. Catalyst
monitor HO2S, post-catalyst HO2S, are always located downstream of the catalytic converter.
The PCM has the ability to monitor this process using the post catalyst heated oxygen sensors.
The pre-sensors produce an output signal which indicates the amount of oxygen present in the
exhaust gas entering the 3-way catalytic converter. The post sensor produces an output signal
which indicates the oxygen storage capacity of the catalyst. This in turn indicates the catalysts
ability to convert exhaust gases efficiently. If the catalyst is operating efficiently, the pre-HO2S
signal is far more active than that produced by the post-HO2S.
In addition to catalyst monitoring, the post-HO2S has a limited role in controlling fuel delivery. If the
post-HO2S signal indicates a high or low oxygen content for an extended period of time while in a
Closed Loop, the PCM adjusts the fuel delivery slightly in order to compensate.
Comprehensive Component Monitor Diagnostic
Comprehensive component monitoring diagnostics are required to monitor emissions-related input
and output powertrain components.
Fuel Trim System Operation
The fuel trim system monitors the averages of short-term and long-term fuel trim values. If these
fuel trim values stay at their limits for a calibrated period of time, a malfunction is indicated. The fuel
trim diagnostic compares the average of short and long-term fuel trim values. If either value is
within the thresholds, a pass is recorded. If either value is outside the thresholds, a rich or lean fuel
trim DTC will set.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > General Information > Page 3668
Misfire Monitor Diagnostic Operation
The misfire monitor diagnostic is based on crankshaft rotational velocity, aka reference period,
variations. The PCM determines crankshaft rotational velocity using the Crankshaft Position (CKP)
Sensor and Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor. When a cylinder misfires, the crankshaft slows down
momentarily. By monitoring the crankshaft and camshaft position sensor signals, the PCM can
calculate when a misfire occurs.
For a non-catalyst damaging misfire, the diagnostic is required to monitor a misfire present for
between 1,000 - 3,200 engine revolutions.
For catalyst damage misfire, the diagnostic responds to the misfire within 200 engine revolutions.
Rough roads may cause false misfire detection. A rough road applies sudden torque variations to
the drive wheels and drivetrain. This torque can intermittently decrease the crankshaft rotational
velocity. The Antilock Braking (ABS) System detects uneven speed between the vehicles wheels
and sends data via the serial data bus to the PCM to disable the misfire monitor until the rough
road is no longer detected.
On automatic transmission equipped vehicles, the Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) disables
whenever a misfire is detected. Disabling the TCC isolates the engine from the rest of the drive line
and minimizes the effect of the drive wheel inputs on crankshaft rotation.
When the TCC has disabled as a result of misfire detection, the TCC is re-enabled after
approximately 3,200 engine revolutions if no misfire is detected. The TCC remains disabled
whenever the misfire is detected, with or without a DTC set. This allows the misfire diagnostic to
reevaluate the system.
Whenever a cylinder misfires, the misfire diagnostic counts the misfire and notes the crankshaft
position at the time the misfire occurred.
A current and a history misfire counter is maintained for each cylinder. The misfire current
counters, Misfire Cur #1 - 8, indicate the number of firing events out of the last 200 cylinder firing
events which were misfires. The misfire current counters displays real time data without a misfire
DTC stored. The misfire history counters, Misfire Hist #1 - 8. indicate the total number of cylinder
firing events which were misfires. The misfire history counters display 0 until the misfire diagnostic
has failed and a DTC P0300 is set. Once the misfire DTC sets, the misfire history counters will be
updated every 200 cylinder firing events. The Misfire counters graphic illustrates how these misfire
counters are maintained.
When crankshaft rotation is erratic, the PCM detects a misfire condition. Because of this erratic
condition, the data that is collected by the diagnostic can
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > General Information > Page 3669
sometimes incorrectly identify which cylinder is misfiring. The Misfire Counters graphic shows there
are misfires counted from more than one cylinder. Cylinder #1 has the majority of counted misfires.
In this case, the misfire counters would identify cylinder #1 as the misfiring cylinder. The misfires in
the other counters were just background noise caused by the erratic rotation of the crankshaft. If
the number of accumulated misfires is sufficient for the diagnostic to identify a true misfire, the
diagnostic will set DTC P0300 - Misfire Detected. The illustration depicts an accumulation in the
history buffers.
If two cylinders in sequential firing order are both misfiring, the first misfiring cylinder will
accumulate misfires in its buffer, but the second misfiring cylinder will not. This is because the PCM
compares a misfiring cylinder with the cylinder 90 degrees prior to it in the firing order. Therefore
the PCM would be comparing crankshaft speed of the second misfiring cylinder to an already
suspect cylinder. The PCM however, will be able to detect both misfiring cylinders after the engine
exceeds 2,000 RPM. This is because the PCM then starts to compare misfires to the opposing
cylinder rather than the previous cylinder in the firing order.
Use Techline equipment to monitor the misfire counter data on applicable vehicles, knowing which
specific cylinders misfire can lead to the root cause. Using the information in the misfire counters
identifies which cylinders are misfiring. If the counters indicate cylinders number 1 and 4 misfired,
look for a circuit or component common to both cylinders.
The misfire diagnostic may indicate a fault due to a temporary fault not necessarily caused by a
vehicle emission system malfunction. Examples include the following items:
^ Contaminated fuel
^ Running out of fuel
^ Fuel fouled spark plugs
^ Basic engine fault
Oxygen Sensor Diagnosis
Diagnose the fuel control heated oxygen sensors for the following conditions:
^ Heater performance, time to activity on cold start
^ Slow response
^ Response time, time to switch R/L or L/R
^ Inactive signal, output steady at bias voltage - approximately 450 mV
^ Signal fixed high
^ Signal fixed low
Diagnose the catalyst monitor heated oxygen sensors for the following functions:
^ Heater performance, time to activity on cold start
^ Signal fixed low during steady state conditions
^ Inactive sensor
PCM Function
The PCM supplies a buffered voltage to various sensors and switches. The PCM controls most
components with electronic switches which complete a ground circuit when turned ON.
PCM Service Precautions
The PCM is designed to withstand normal current draws associated with vehicle operations. Avoid
overloading any circuit. When testing for opens or shorts, do not ground any of the PCM circuits
unless instructed. When testing for opens or shorts, do not apply voltage to any of the PCM circuits
unless instructed. Only test these circuits with a DMM while the PCM connectors remain
connected.
Three-Way Catalyst Oxygen Storage Capacity
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > General Information > Page 3670
Three-Way Catalyst Storage Capacity
The PCM must monitor the 3-Way Catalyst System (TWC) for efficiency. In order to accomplish
this, the PCM monitors the pre-catalyst and post-catalyst oxygen sensors. When the TWC is
operating properly, the post-catalyst (2) oxygen sensor shows significantly less activity than the
pre-catalyst (1) oxygen sensor. The TWC stores oxygen during the normal reduction and oxidation
process. The TWC releases oxygen during its normal reduction and oxidation process. The PCM
calculates the oxygen storage capacity using the difference between the pre-catalyst and
post-catalyst oxygen sensor voltage levels.
Misfire Monitor Diagnostic Tests
Whenever the sensor activity of the post-catalyst (2) oxygen sensor nears the sensor activity of the
pre-catalyst (1) oxygen sensor, the catalysts efficiency is degraded.
Aftermarket HO2S characteristics may be different from the original equipment manufacturer
sensor. This may lead to a false pass or a false fail of the catalyst monitor diagnostic. Similarly, if
an aftermarket catalyst does not contain the same amount of precious metal content as the original
pan, the correlation between oxygen storage and conversion efficiency may be altered enough to
set a false DTC.
Torque Management
Torque management is a function of the PCM that reduces engine power under certain conditions.
Torque management is performed for the following reasons:
1. To prevent over-stressing the powertrain and driveline components 2. To prevent damage to the
vehicle during certain abusive maneuvers 3. To reduce engine speed when the IAC is out of the
normal operating range
The PCM monitors the following sensors and engine parameters in order to calculate engine output
torque:
^ The air/fuel ratio
^ The Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor
^ The Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) sensor
^ The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor
^ The spark advance
^ The engine speed
^ The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor
^ The A/C clutch status
The PCM monitors the torque converter status, the transmission gear ratio, and the engine speed
in order to determine if torque reduction is required. The PCM retards the spark as appropriate to
reduce engine torque output if torque reduction is required. The PCM also shuts OFF the fuel to
certain injectors in order to reduce the engine power in the case of an abusive maneuver.
The following are instances when engine power reduction is likely to be experienced:
^ During transmission upshifts and downshifts
^ During heavy acceleration from a standing start
^ When the clutch pedal is released too quick under a heavy load (6.0L only)
^ When one set of drive axles loses traction while the other set of drive axles are not moving (4WD
only and in 4WD low)
^ If the IAC is out of the normal operating range, except 6.0L
^ When the driver is performing harsh or abusive maneuvers such as shifting into gear at high
throttle angles or shifting the transmission from reverse to drive to create a rocking motion
The driver is unlikely to notice the torque management actions in the first 2 instances. The engine
power output is moderate at full throttle in the other cases.
The PCM calculates the amount of spark retard necessary to reduce the engine power by the
desired amount. The PCM disables the fuel injectors for
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > General Information > Page 3671
cylinders 1, 4, 6, and 7 in the case of an abusive maneuver.
Powertrain Control Module
Powertrain Control Module
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is located in the engine compartment. The PCM is the
control center of the vehicle. It controls the following:
^ The fuel metering system
^ The transmission shifting
^ The ignition timing
^ The on-board diagnostics for powertrain functions
The PCM constantly monitors the information from various sensors and controls the systems that
affect vehicle performance and emissions. The PCM also performs the diagnostic functions for
those systems. The PCM can recognize operational problems and alert the driver through the
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) when a malfunction has occurred. When a malfunction is
detected, the PCM stores a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) which helps to identify problem areas.
This is done to aid the technician in making repairs
The PCM supplies either 5.0 or 12.0 volts to power various sensors and switches. This is done
through resistances in the PCM. The resistance is so high in value that a test lamp does not
illuminate when connected to the circuit. In some cases, even an ordinary shop voltmeter does not
give an accurate reading because the voltmeters resistance is too low. Therefore, a DMM with a
minimum of 10 megaohms input impedance is required to ensure accurate voltage readings.
The PCM controls output circuits such as the fuel injectors, the Idle Air Control (IAC), the cooling
fan relays, etc. by controlling the ground or the power feed circuit through transistors or a device
called an output driver module.
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) contains the remainder of the logic of the theft deterrent
system. If a class 2 message containing a valid password is received from the BCM, the PCM will
continue to allow the fuel injectors to operate. The PCM will allow the fuel injectors to operate until
it decides there is no valid password coming from the BCM. If the PCM does not receive a class 2
message, or receives a class 2 message with an incorrect password, the engine will crank and will
not run or will start and stall immediately.
Input Components
The PCM monitors the input components for circuit continuity and out-of-range values. This
includes performance checking. Performance checking refers to indicating a fault when the signal
from a sensor does not seem reasonable, such as a Throttle Position (TP) sensor that indicates
high throttle position at low engine loads or MAP voltage. The input components may include, but
are not limited to, the following sensors:
^ The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
^ Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
^ Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor
^ Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
^ Knock Sensor (KS)
^ Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
^ Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
^ Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor
^ Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
In addition to the circuit continuity and rationality check, the ECT sensor is monitored for its ability
to achieve a steady state temperature to enable Closed Loop fuel control.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > General Information > Page 3672
Output Components
Diagnose the output components for the proper response to PCM commands. Components where
functional monitoring is not feasible will be monitored for circuit continuity and out-of-range values if
applicable.
Output components to be monitored include, but are not limited to, the following circuits:
^ The Idle Air Control (IAC) motor
^ The EVAP system
^ The electronic transmission controls
^ The A/C relay, if so equipped
^ The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) output
^ The Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) control
^ The cruise control enable, if so equipped
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Additional Information
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Additional Information
The Service Programming System (SPS) allows a technician to program a control module through
the Data Link Connector (DLC). The information transfer circuit that is used at the DLC is the same
serial data circuit used by the scan tool for retrieving Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs), displaying
data, clearing DTCs, etc. This procedure offers the ability to install software/calibrations matched to
a particular vehicle.
Most control modules have 2 types of memory. The software/calibrations reside in the flash
memory. The two types of memory are listed below:
^ Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EEPROM) This type of memory allows
selected portions of memory to be programmed while other portions remain unchanged. Certain
learned values reside in the EEPROM, such as: ^
The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
^ The crankshaft variation learned position
^ The software/calibrations identification numbers
^ The control module security information
^ Flash Read Only Memory - Rash Memory Flash memory has increased memory storage
capacity. During programming, all information within this type of memory is erased, and then
replaced with entirely new information.
Service Programming Methods The 4 methods of programming a control module and the proper
tools for each method are as follows: ^
Remote Programming: The Tech 2 or other scan tool, Techline Terminal or a personal computer equipped with General
Motors Corporation authorized programming software - The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an
interface between the vehicle and the Techline Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is installed in the vehicle
^ Pass Thru Programming: The Tech 2 or other scan tool Techline Terminal or a personal computer equipped with General
Motors Corporation authorized programming software - The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an
interface between the vehicle and the Techline Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is installed in the vehicle.
^ Off-Board Remote Programming, vehicle NOT available: The Tech 2 or other scan tool, Off-board Programming Adapter (OBPA), Techline Terminal or a
personal computer equipped with General Motors Corporation authorized programming software The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an interface between the vehicle and the Techline
Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is NOT installed in a vehicle
^ Off-Board Pass Thru Programming The Tech 2 or other scan tool, off-board programming adapter (OBPA), Techline Terminal or a
personal computer equipped with General Motors Corporation authorized programming software The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an interface between the vehicle and the Techline
Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is NOT installed in a vehicle
Before Programming a Control Module
IMPORTANT: DO NOT program an existing control module with the identical software/calibration
package. This procedure is not a short cut to correct a driveability condition. This is an ineffective
repair. A control module should only be programmed when the following occurs: ^
When a service procedure instructs you to replace the control module. The service part control
module does not contain operating software or calibrations.
^ General Motors Corporation releases an updated software/calibration package.
Ensure that the following conditions are met before programming a control module: ^
Vehicle system voltage: There are no charging system concerns. All charging system concerns must be repaired before
programming a control module.
- The battery voltage is greater than 12 volts but less than 16 volts. The battery must be fully
charged before programming the control module.
- A battery charger is NOT connected to the vehicles battery. Incorrect system voltage or voltage
fluctuations from a battery charger may cause programming failure or control module damage.
- Turn OFF or disable any system that may put a load on the vehicles battery. Turn OFF or disable
systems such as: ^
Daytime Running Lights (DRL). Applying the parking brake, on most vehicles, disables the DRL
system.
^ Heating, Ventilation, And Air Conditioning (HVAC) systems
^ Engine cooling fans, etc.
^ The ignition switch is in the proper position. The scan tool prompts you to turn ON the ignition,
with the engine OFF. DO NOT change the position of the ignition switch during the programming
procedure unless instructed to do so.
^ All tool connections are secure: The RS-232 cable
- The connection at the DLC
- The voltage supply circuits
- The OBPA
^ DO NOT disturb the tool harnesses while programming. If an interruption occurs during the
programming procedure, programming failure or
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Additional Information > Page 3675
control module damage may occur.
^ If you are performing the pass-through programming procedure using a notebook computer
without the power cord, ensure that the internal battery is fully charged.
After Programming A Control Module The powertrain may operate slightly different after a control
module software/calibration update. Operating the powertrain through various driving conditions
allows the control module to re-learn certain values. The control module must re-learn the following
after a software/calibration update: ^
Fuel trim correction
^ Idle Air Control (IAC) learned position
^ Automatic transmission shift adapts
Other learned values only re-learn by performing a service procedure.
If a control module is replaced the following service procedures may need to be performed: ^
The crankshaft variation learn procedure
^ The engine oil life reset procedure
^ The idle learn procedure
^ The inspection/maintenance complete system set procedure
^ The vehicle theft deterrent password learn procedure
^ The Throttle Position (TP) sensor learn procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Additional Information > Page 3676
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Programming
(Off-board)
BEFORE PROGRAMMING A CONTROL MODULE
IMPORTANT: ^
DO NOT program a control module unless you are directed by a service procedure or you are
directed by a General Motors Corporation service bulletin. Programming a control module at any
other time will not permanently correct a customer's concern.
^ The Off-Board Programming is used in situations where a control module must be programmed
without having the vehicle present. The Off-Board Programming Adapter must be used to perform
the Off-Board Programming procedure. The adapter allows the control module to power up and
allows the Tech 2 to communicate with the control module.
^ DO NOT disturb the tool harnesses while programming. If an interruption occurs during the
programming procedure, programming failure or control module damage may occur.
Ensure that all connections are secure at the following locations: ^
The Off-Board Programming Adapter
^ The Tech 2
^ The control module
^ The Techline terminal
OFF-BOARD PROGRAMMING
1. Obtain the VIN of the vehicle for which the control module is being programmed. 2. With the
Techline terminal, select Service Programming. 3. Select Tech 2, Reprogram ECU, and Off-Board
Programming Adapter as the electronic control unit (ECU) location. 4. Connect the control module,
Off-Board Programming Adapter, and the Tech 2 as described on the Techline terminal. Ensure
you use the correct
harness connector from the Off-Board Programming Adapter kit.
5. With the Tech 2, select Service Programming Request Information function. The Tech 2
communicates with the control module and receives the
access code.
6. With the Tech 2, exit the Service Programming Request Information. 7. Disconnect the Tech 2
from the Off-Board Programming Adapter. 8. Connect the Tech 2 to the Techline terminal. 9. Turn
ON the Tech 2.
10. With the Techline terminal, enter the VIN of the vehicle that will be receiving the control module.
11. The Techline terminal will display the message, attaching to database. 12. Identify what type of
programming that you are performing. 13. Select the appropriate calibration file. 14. Ensure all
connections are secure. 15. The Techline terminal displays a summary screen that summarizes
your selections. After confirming you choices, the Techline terminal
automatically loads the calibration files to the Tech 2.
16. After the download is complete, turn OFF the Tech 2. 17. Disconnect the Tech 2 from the
Techline terminal. 18. Connect the Tech 2 to the Off-Board Programming Adapter. 19. With the
Tech 2, select Service Programming.
IMPORTANT: DO NOT turn OFF the Off-Board Programming Adapter if the programming
procedure is interrupted or unsuccessful. Ensure the control module and the Off-Board
Programming Adapter connections are secure and the Techline operating software is up to date.
Attempt to reprogram the control module. If the control module cannot be programmed, replace the
control module.
20. With the Tech 2, select Program. 21. After the download is complete, exit Service
Programming. 22. Turn OFF the Off-Board Programming Adapter.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Additional Information > Page 3677
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Programming
(On-Board)
BEFORE PROGRAMMING A CONTROL MODULE
IMPORTANT: DO NOT program a control module unless you are directed by a service procedure
or you are directed by a General Motors Corporation service bulletin. Programming a control
module at any other time will not permanently correct a customers concern.
Ensure the following conditions are met before programming a control module: ^
Vehicle system voltage There is no charging system concern. All charging system concerns must be repaired before
programming a control module.
- Battery voltage is greater than 12 volts but less than 16 volts. The battery must be charged before
programming the control module if the battery voltage is low.
- A battery charger is NOT connected to the vehicle's battery. Incorrect system voltage or voltage
fluctuations from a battery charger, may cause programming failure or control module damage.
- Turn OFF or disable any system that may put a load on the vehicle's battery. ^
Twilight sentinel
^ Interior lights
^ Daytime running lights (DRL) - Applying the parking brake, on most vehicles, disables the DRL
system.
^ HVAC systems
^ Engine cooling fans etc.
^ The ignition switch is in the proper position. The scan tool prompts you to turn ON the ignition,
with the engine OFF. DO NOT change the position of the ignition switch during the programming
procedure, unless instructed to do so.
^ All tool connections are secure. RS-232
- The connection at the data link connector (DLC) is secure.
- Voltage supply circuits
^ DO NOT disturb the tool harnesses while programming. If an interruption occurs during the
programming procedure, programming failure or control module damage may occur.
REMOTE PROGRAMMING
1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Install the Tech 2 to the DLC. 3. Turn ON the ignition, with the engine
OFF. 4. Turn OFF all vehicle accessories. 5. With the Tech 2, select Service Programming. 6.
Identify vehicle information as requested by the Tech 2. 7. Select the type of module you are
programming. 8. Select the type of programming to be performed. 9. Verify the displayed VIN with
the vehicle VIN. If the displayed VIN does not match the actual VIN, write down the actual VIN and
correct the
VIN at the Techline terminal.
10. When complete, Exit Service Programming. 11. Turn OFF the Tech 2 and disconnect the Tech
2 from the vehicle. 12. Turn OFF the ignition. 13. Connect the Tech 2 to the Techline terminal. 14.
Select Service Programming. 15. Select Tech 2 as the tool you are using. 16. Select the type of
programming to be performed. 17. Verify the displayed VIN with the vehicle VIN. Correct the VIN
as necessary. 18. Select the type of module you are programming. 19. Identify what type of
programming that you are performing.
^ Normal - This type of programming is for updating an existing calibration or programming a new
controller.
^ Vehicle configuration index (VCI) - This selection is used if the vehicle VIN is unavailable or not
recognized by the Techline terminal. Observe, you will need to contact the Techline Customer
Support center to use this option.
^ Reconfigure - This is to reconfigure a vehicle, such as tire size and axle ratio changes.
20. Select the appropriate calibration file. 21. Ensure all connections are secure. 22. Select Reprog
to initiate the download of the new calibration to the Tech 2. 23. After the download is complete,
turn OFF the Tech 2. 24. Disconnect the Tech 2 from the Techline terminal. 25. Install the Tech 2
to the data link connector (DLC). 26. Turn ON the Tech 2. 27. Turn ON the ignition, with the engine
OFF. 28. Select Service Programming.
IMPORTANT: DO NOT turn OFF the ignition if the programming procedure is interrupted or
unsuccessful. Ensure that all the PCM and DLC
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Additional Information > Page 3678
connections are secure and the Techline operating software is up to date. Attempt to reprogram the
control module. If the control module cannot be programmed, replace the control module.
29. Select Program. 30. After the download is complete, EXIT Service Programming. 31. Turn OFF
the ignition for 30 seconds. 32. Turn OFF the Tech 2. 33. If a control module is replaced the
following service procedures must be performed:
^ The Crankshaft Variation Learn Procedure
^ The Engine Oil Life Reset Procedure
^ The Idle Learn Procedure
^ The Inspection/Maintenance Complete System Set Procedure
^ The Vehicle Theft Deterrent Password Learn Procedure
^ The TP Sensor Learn Procedure
PROGRAMMING VERIFICATION
1. With a scan tool, clear the DTCs. 2. Attempt to start the engine. 3. Repeat the Service
Programming procedure if the engine does not start or operates poorly. Perform the following
procedures before programming
the PCM: ^
Ensure the control module and DLC connections are OK.
^ Ensure the Techline operating software is up to date.
^ Ensure the calibration part number is correct for the vehicle.
4. Attempt to program the control module. If the control module still cannot be programmed
properly, replace the control module. You must program
the replacement control module.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Additional Information > Page 3679
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Replacement
Service of the powertrain control module (PCM) should normally consist of either replacement of
the PCM or electrically erasable programmable read only memory (EEPROM) programming. If the
diagnostic procedures call for the PCM to be replaced, the PCM should be inspected first to see if
the correct part is being used. If the correct part is being used, remove the faulty PCM and install
the new service PCM.
IMPORTANT:
^ To prevent internal PCM damage, the ignition must be OFF when disconnecting or reconnecting
power to the PCM. For example, when working with a battery cable, PCM pigtail, PCM fuse, or
jumper cables.
^ Remove any debris from the PCM connector surfaces before servicing the PCM. Inspect the
PCM module connector gaskets when diagnosing or replacing the PCM. Ensure that the gaskets
are installed correctly. The gaskets prevent contaminant intrusion into the PCM.
^ The replacement PCM must be programmed.
Removal Procedure
NOTE: ^
Refer to PCM and ESD Notice in Service Precautions.
^ In order to prevent internal damage to the PCM, the ignition must be OFF when disconnecting or
reconnecting the PCM connector.
1. Disconnect the PCM harness connectors (4). 2. Release the spring latch (3) from the PCM (1).
3. Lift the PCM from the PCM mounting tray (2). 4. Remove the PCM (1) from the engine
compartment.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Additional Information > Page 3680
1. Install the PCM (1) to the PCM mounting tray (2). 2. Secure the spring latch (3) to the PCM (1).
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Connect the PCM connectors (4) to the PCM (1).
Tighten Tighten the PCM connector end fasteners to 8 N.m (71 lb in).
4. If a new PCM is being installed, program the PCM. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming
and Relearning
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Additional Information > Page 3681
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Service Programming System (SPS)
The Service Programming System (SPS) allows a technician to program a control module through
the Data Link Connector (DLC). The information transfer circuit that is used at the DLC is the same
serial data circuit used by the scan tool for retrieving Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs), displaying
data, clearing DTCs, etc. This procedure offers the ability to install software/calibrations matched to
a particular vehicle.
Most control modules have 2 types of memory. The software/calibrations reside in the flash
memory. The two types of memory are listed below:
^ Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EEPROM) This type of memory allows
selected portions of memory to be programmed while other portions remain unchanged. Certain
learned values reside in the EEPROM, such as: ^
The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
^ The crankshaft variation learned position
^ The software/calibrations identification numbers
^ The control module security information
^ Flash Read Only Memory - Rash Memory Flash memory has increased memory storage
capacity. During programming, all information within this type of memory is erased, and then
replaced with entirely new information.
Service Programming Methods The 4 methods of programming a control module and the proper
tools for each method are as follows: ^
Remote Programming: The Tech 2 or other scan tool, Techline Terminal or a personal computer equipped with General
Motors Corporation authorized programming software - The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an
interface between the vehicle and the Techline Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is installed in the vehicle
^ Pass Thru Programming: The Tech 2 or other scan tool Techline Terminal or a personal computer equipped with General
Motors Corporation authorized programming software - The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an
interface between the vehicle and the Techline Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is installed in the vehicle.
^ Off-Board Remote Programming, vehicle NOT available: The Tech 2 or other scan tool, Off-board Programming Adapter (OBPA), Techline Terminal or a
personal computer equipped with General Motors Corporation authorized programming software The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an interface between the vehicle and the Techline
Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is NOT installed in a vehicle
^ Off-Board Pass Thru Programming The Tech 2 or other scan tool, off-board programming adapter (OBPA), Techline Terminal or a
personal computer equipped with General Motors Corporation authorized programming software The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an interface between the vehicle and the Techline
Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is NOT installed in a vehicle
Before Programming a Control Module
IMPORTANT: DO NOT program an existing control module with the identical software/calibration
package. This procedure is not a short cut to correct a driveability condition. This is an ineffective
repair. A control module should only be programmed when the following occurs: ^
When a service procedure instructs you to replace the control module. The service part control
module does not contain operating software or calibrations.
^ General Motors Corporation releases an updated software/calibration package.
Ensure that the following conditions are met before programming a control module: ^
Vehicle system voltage: There are no charging system concerns. All charging system concerns must be repaired before
programming a control module.
- The battery voltage is greater than 12 volts but less than 16 volts. The battery must be fully
charged before programming the control module.
- A battery charger is NOT connected to the vehicles battery. Incorrect system voltage or voltage
fluctuations from a battery charger may cause programming failure or control module damage.
- Turn OFF or disable any system that may put a load on the vehicles battery. Turn OFF or disable
systems such as: ^
Daytime Running Lights (DRL). Applying the parking brake, on most vehicles, disables the DRL
system.
^ Heating, Ventilation, And Air Conditioning (HVAC) systems
^ Engine cooling fans, etc.
^ The ignition switch is in the proper position. The scan tool prompts you to turn ON the ignition,
with the engine OFF. DO NOT change the position of the ignition switch during the programming
procedure unless instructed to do so.
^ All tool connections are secure: The RS-232 cable
- The connection at the DLC
- The voltage supply circuits
- The OBPA
^ DO NOT disturb the tool harnesses while programming. If an interruption occurs during the
programming procedure, programming failure or
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Additional Information > Page 3682
control module damage may occur.
^ If you are performing the pass-through programming procedure using a notebook computer
without the power cord, ensure that the internal battery is fully charged.
After Programming A Control Module The powertrain may operate slightly different after a control
module software/calibration update. Operating the powertrain through various driving conditions
allows the control module to re-learn certain values. The control module must re-learn the following
after a software/calibration update: ^
Fuel trim correction
^ Idle Air Control (IAC) learned position
^ Automatic transmission shift adapts
Other learned values only re-learn by performing a service procedure.
If a control module is replaced the following service procedures may need to be performed: ^
The crankshaft variation learn procedure
^ The engine oil life reset procedure
^ The idle learn procedure
^ The inspection/maintenance complete system set procedure
^ The vehicle theft deterrent password learn procedure
^ The Throttle Position (TP) sensor learn procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor
The fuel level sensor consists of a float, a wire float arm, and a ceramic resistor card. The position
of the float arm indicates the fuel level. The fuel level sensor contains a variable resistor which
changes resistance in correspondence with the amount of fuel in the fuel tank. The Powertrain
Control Module ( PCM) sends the fuel level information via the class 2 circuit to the Instrument
Panel Cluster (IPC). This information is used for the IPC fuel gauge and the low fuel warning
indicator, if applicable. The PCM also monitors the fuel level input for various diagnostics.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3686
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the fuel sender assembly. 2. Disconnect the fuel pump electrical connector (5). 3.
Remove the fuel level sensor electrical connector retaining clip (6). 4. Disconnect the fuel level
sensor electrical connector (7) from under the fuel sender cover. 5. Remove the fuel level sensor
retaining clip (4). 6. Squeeze the locking tangs and remove the fuel level sensor (3).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the fuel level sensor (3). 2. Install the fuel level sensor retaining clip (4). 3. Connect the
fuel level sensor electrical connector (7). 4. Connect the fuel level sensor electrical connector
retaining clip (6). 5. Connect the fuel pump electrical connector (5). 6. Install the fuel sender
assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Diagrams
Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3690
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
The Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor measures the difference between the pressure or vacuum in
the fuel tank and outside air pressure. The control module provides a 5-volt reference and a ground
to the FTP sensor. The FTP sensor provides a signal voltage back to the control module that can
vary between 0.1 - 4.9 volts. As FTP increases, FTP sensor voltage decreases, high pressure =
low voltage. As FTP decreases, FTP voltage increases, low pressure or vacuum = high voltage.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3691
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3692
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the fuel tank. 2. Remove the fuel tank pressure sensor (1) from the modular fuel sender
(2).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the fuel tank pressure sensor (1) to the modular fuel sender (2). 2. Install the fuel tank.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Locations > Page 3696
Idle Air Control (IAC) Valve
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Locations > Page 3697
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Testing and Inspection
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The engine idle speed is controlled by the idle air control (IAC) valve. The IAC valve is on the
throttle body. The IAC valve pintle moves in and out of an idle air passage bore to control air flow
around the throttle plate. The valve consists of a movable pintle, driven by a gear attached to a two
phase bi-polar permanent magnet electric motor called a stepper motor. The stepper motor is
capable of highly accurate rotation, or of movement, called steps. The stepper motor has two
separate windings that are called coils. Each coil is fed by two circuits from the powertrain control
module (PCM). When the PCM changes polarity of a coil, the stepper motor moves one step. The
PCM uses a predetermined number of counts to determine the IAC pintle position. Observe IAC
counts with a scan tool. The IAC counts will increment up or down as the PCM attempts to change
the IAC valve pintle position. An IAC Reset will occur when the ignition key is turned OFF. First, the
PCM will seat the IAC pintle in the idle air passage bore. Second, the PCM will retract the pintle a
predetermined number of counts to allow for efficient engine start-up. If the engine idle speed is out
of range for a calibrated period of time, an idle speed diagnostic trouble code (DTC) may set.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS
Inspect for the following conditions: ^
A skewed high throttle position (TP) sensor
^ Restricted air intake system
^ Objects blocking the IAC passage or throttle bore
^ The correct positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) valve, properly installed and proper operation of
the PCV valve
^ Proper operation and installation of all air intake components
^ Proper installation and operation of the mass air flow (MAF) sensor, if equipped
^ A tampered with or damaged throttle stop screw
^ A tampered with or damaged throttle plate, throttle shaft, throttle linkage, or cruise control linkage,
if equipped
^ Excessive deposits in the IAC passage or on the IAC pintle
^ Excessive deposits in the throttle bore or on the throttle plate
^ Vacuum leaks
^ Excessive load on engine i.e. transmission, power steering, alternator, etc.
^ A high or unstable idle condition could be caused by a non-IAC system problem that can not be
overcome by the IAC valve. Refer to Symptoms-Computers and Controls Systems. See: Testing
and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
^ A low or unstable idle condition could be caused by a non-IAC system problem that can not be
overcome by the IAC valve. Refer to Symptoms-Computers and Controls Systems. See: Testing
and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
^ If the problem is determined to be intermittent, refer to Intermittent Conditions. See: Testing and
Inspection/Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview/Diagnostic Strategies/Intermittent Conditions
TEST DESCRIPTION
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Locations > Page 3698
Steps 1-6
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Locations > Page 3699
Steps 7-11
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Locations > Page 3700
Steps 12-19
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 5. This test will determine
the ability of the PCM and IAC valve circuits to control the IAC valve. 7. This test will determine the
ability of the PCM to provide the IAC valve circuits with a ground. On a normally operating system,
the test lamp
should not flash while the IAC counts are incrementing.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Locations > Page 3701
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Service and Repair
IDLE AIR CONTROL (IAC) VALVE REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Remove the engine cover. 3. Disconnect the harness connector from
the idle air control (IAC) valve.
4. Remove the IAC valve attaching fasteners.
NOTE: If the IAC valve has been in service: DO NOT push or pull on the IAC valve pintle. The
force required to move the pintle may damage the threads on the worm drive. Also, DO NOT soak
the IAC valve in any liquid cleaner or solvent, as damage may result.
5. Remove the IAC valve assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Locations > Page 3702
6. Remove the O-ring.
CLEANING AND INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1. Clean the IAC valve O-ring sealing surface, the pintle valve seat, and the air passage.
^ Use a carburetor cleaner and a parts cleaning brush in order to remove any carbon deposits.
Follow the instructions on the container.
^ Do not use a cleaner that contains methyl ethyl ketone. MEK is an extremely strong solvent and
not necessary for this type of deposit
^ Shiny spots on the pintle or seat are normal and do not indicate misalignment or a bent pintle
shaft.
^ If the air passage has heavy deposits, remove the throttle body for a complete cleaning.
2. Inspect the IAC valve O-ring for cuts, cracks, or distortion. Replace the O-ring if damaged.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: If you are installing a new IAC valve, replace the valve with an identical part. The
IAC valve pintle shape and diameter are designed for the specific application.
1. Measure the distance between tip of the IAC valve pintle and the mounting flange.
If the distance is more than 28 mm (1.10 in), use finger pressure in order to slowly retract the pintle.
The force required to retract the pintle of a new valve will not cause damage to the valve.
2. Lubricate the IAC valve O-ring with clean engine oil. 3. Install the IAC valve assembly.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Locations > Page 3703
4. Install the attaching fasteners.
Tighten Tighten the IAC valve fasteners to 3 N.m (27 lb in).
5. Connect the IAC harness connector. 6. Install the engine cover. 7. Reset the IAC valve pintle
position.
IAC VALVE RESET PROCEDURE
1. Turn ON the ignition for 5 seconds, leaving the engine OFF. 2. Turn OFF the ignition for 10
seconds. 3. Start the engine. 4. Check for the proper idle speed.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3707
Data Link Connector (DLC)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Data Link Communications
Information Bus: Description and Operation Data Link Communications
DATA LINK COMMUNICATIONS CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION AND OPERATION
The Class 2 serial data link allows specified modules to transmit, receive, or exchange data: ^
Transfer Case Shift Control Module (TCSCM)
^ Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)
^ Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
^ Body Control Module (BCM)
^ Instrument Panel Cluster (IPC)
^ Driver Information Center (DIC)
^ Inflatable Restraint Sensing And Diagnostic Module (SDM)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Modules connected to the class 2 serial data circuit monitor for serial data communications during
normal vehicle operation. Operating information and commands are exchanged among the
modules. In addition to this, Node Alive messages are transmitted by each module on the class 2
serial data circuit about once every 2 seconds. When the module detects the class 2 serial data
circuit shorted, the setting of all other class 2 serial communication DTCs is inhibited and a U1300,
U1301, or a U1305 DTC will set.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Data Link Communications > Page 3710
Information Bus: Description and Operation General Description
DATA LINK COMMUNICATIONS CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION AND OPERATION
The Class 2 serial data link allows specified modules to transmit, receive, or exchange data: ^
Transfer Case Shift Control Module (TCSCM)
^ Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)
^ Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
^ Body Control Module (BCM)
^ Instrument Panel Cluster (IPC)
^ Driver Information Center (DIC)
^ Inflatable Restraint Sensing And Diagnostic Module (SDM)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Modules connected to the class 2 serial data circuit monitor for serial data communications during
normal vehicle operation. Operating information and commands are exchanged among the
modules. In addition to this, Node Alive messages are transmitted by each module on the class 2
serial data circuit about once every 2 seconds. When the module detects the class 2 serial data
circuit shorted, the setting of all other class 2 serial communication DTCs is inhibited and a U1300,
U1301, or a U1305 DTC will set.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Information Bus: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Begin the diagnosis of the Data Link Communications by performing the Diagnostic System Check
for the system in which the customer concern is apparent. The Diagnostic System Check will direct
you to the correct procedure within the Data Link Communications when a communication
malfunction is present.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3713
Information Bus: Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes
With Diagnostic Scan Tool
PROCEDURE
A Tech II or equivalent Scan tool must be used to retrieve Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) from
the PCM memory. DTCs can no longer be retrieved at the data link connector. This also eliminates
the PCM function of flashing Code 12. Follow the instructions supplied by the Scan tool
manufacturer in order to access and read either current and/or history DTCs.
Without Diagnostic Scan Tool
A Tech II or equivalent scan tool must be used to retrieve Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) from
the PCM memory. DTCs can no longer be retrieved at the data link connector. This also eliminates
the PCM function of flashing Code 12. Follow the instructions supplied by the scan tool
manufacturer in order to access and read either current and/or history DTCs.
With Diagnostic Scan Tool
PROCEDURE
Use a Tech II or equivalent Scan tool to clear Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) from the PCM
memory. When clearing DTCs, follow the instructions supplied by the Scan tool manufacturer.
NOTES: ^
Do not clear the DTCs unless directed to do so by the service information provided for each
diagnostic procedure. All of the diagnostic data that was saved along with the DTC (freeze frame
data and/or malfunction history records) which may be helpful for some diagnostic procedures will
be erased from the memory when the DTCs are cleared.
^ Interrupting PCM battery voltage to clear DTCs is NOT recommended.
Without Diagnostic Scan Tool
PROCEDURE
Use a Tech II or equivalent Scan tool to clear Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) from the PCM
memory. When clearing DTCs, follow the instructions supplied by the Scan tool manufacturer.
NOTES: ^
Do not clear the DTCs unless directed to do so by the service information provided for each
diagnostic procedure. All of the diagnostic data that was saved along with the DTC (freeze frame
data and/or malfunction history records) which may be helpful for some diagnostic procedures will
be erased from the memory when the DTCs are cleared.
^ Interrupting PCM battery voltage to clear DTCs is NOT recommended.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3714
Information Bus: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
A Symptoms - Data Link Communications
IMPORTANT: The following steps must be completed before using the symptom tables:
1. Perform the Diagnostic System Check for the subsystem exhibiting the symptoms. The
subsystem diagnostic system check will identity where to
begin diagnosis of the data link communication system.
2. Review the system operation in order to familiarize yourself with the system functions. Refer to
Data Link Communications Description and
Operation.
Visual/Physical Inspection ^
Inspect for aftermarket devices that could affect the operation of the serial data communications
systems. Refer to Checking Aftermarket Accessories in Diagnostic Aids.
^ Inspect the easily accessible systems or visible system components for obvious damage or
conditions that could cause the symptom.
Intermittent Faulty electrical connections or wiring may be the cause of intermittent conditions.
Refer to Diagnostic Aids for Circuit Testing and Wiring Repair procedures.
Symptom List Refer to a symptom diagnostic procedure from the following list in order to diagnose
the symptom: ^
Scan Tool Does Not Power Up
^ Scan Tool Does Not Communicate with Class 2 Device
Scan Tool Does Not Communicate With Class 2 Device
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Modules connected to the class 2 serial data circuit monitor for serial data communications during
normal vehicle operation. Operating information and commands are exchanged among the
modules. Connecting a scan tool to the DLC allows communication with the modules for diagnostic
purposes. DTCs may be set due to this symptom and during this diagnostic procedure. Complete
the diagnostic procedure in order to ensure all the DTCs are diagnosed and cleared from memory.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS
^ The BCM detects that the ignition is ON and sends the appropriate power mode message to the
other modules. Therefore, the BCM must be connected to the DLC for any other module to
communicate with the scan tool.
^ When the class 2 serial data circuit: ^
is shorted to ground
^ is shorted to voltage
The following DTCs may set: ^
U1300
^ U1301
^ U1305
TEST DESCRIPTION
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3715
Steps 1-9
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3716
Steps 10-13
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3717
Steps 14-18
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3718
Steps 19-25
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. A partial loss of
communication in the class 2 serial data circuit uses a different procedure than a total loss of
communication of the class 2 serial
data circuit.
4. The following DTCs may be retrieved with a history status. These DTCs are not the cause of the
present condition.
^ U1300
^ U1301
^ U1305
6. A State of Health DTC with a history status may be present along with a U1000 or U1255 with a
current status. This indicates that the malfunction
occurred when the ignition was on.
10. Normal class 2 serial data communication cannot take place until the power mode master
(PMM) module sends the appropriate power mode
message. If the PMM does not send a wake-up message, other modules on the class 2 serial data
circuit may not communicate.
12. Disconnecting the splice pack(s) and/or class 2 circuits one at a time and attempting to
communicate with any module still connected to the class 2
serial data circuit, will determine whether or not the concern is in the splice pack portion of the
class 2 serial data circuit.
13. Connecting the class 2 serial data circuits to the suspect splice pack one at a time while
attempting to communicate with any module still
connected to the class 2 serial data circuit, will determine which circuit or module on the splice
pack is causing the concern.
14. Splitting the class 2 serial data circuit will help isolate the location of the malfunction. If
communication can be established, the concern is located
in the wiring or one of the modules that is no longer connected to the DLC. If communication
cannot be established, the concern is located in the wiring or one of the modules that is still
connected to the DLC.
22. If there are no current DTCs that begin with the letter "U", the communication concern has been
repaired. 23. The communication concern may have prevented diagnosis of the customer
complaint.
Scan Tool Does Not Power Up
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The data link connector (DLC) is a standardized 16 cavity connector. Connector design and
location is dictated by an industry wide standard, and is required to provide the following: ^
Scan tool power battery positive voltage at terminal 16.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3719
^ Scan tool power ground at terminal 4.
^ Common signal ground at terminal 5.
The scan tool will power up with the ignition off. Some modules however, will not communicate
unless the ignition is on and the power mode master (PMM) module sends the appropriate power
mode message.
TEST DESCRIPTION
Steps 1-4
The number below refers to the step number on the diagnostic table. 4. If the battery positive
voltage and ground circuits of the DLC are functioning properly. The malfunction must be due to
the scan tool.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Knock Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3725
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3726
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3727
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3728
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3729
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3730
Knock Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3731
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3732
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3733
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3734
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3735
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3736
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3737
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3738
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3739
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3740
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3741
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3742
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3743
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3744
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3745
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3746
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3747
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3748
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3749
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3750
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3751
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3752
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3753
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3754
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3755
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3756
Knock Sensor (KS)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3757
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
The Knock Sensor (KS) system enables the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to control the
ignition timing advance for the best possible performance while protecting the engine from
potentially damaging levels of detonation. The sensors in the KS system are used by the PCM as
microphones to listen for abnormal engine noise that may indicate pre-ignition/detonation.
SENSOR DESCRIPTION
There are 2 types of KS currently being used: ^
The broadband single wire sensor
^ The flat response 2-wire sensor
Both sensors use piezo-electric crystal technology to produce and send signals to the PCM. The
amplitude and frequency of this signal will vary constantly depending on the vibration level within
the engine. Flat response and broadband KS signals are processed differently by the PCM. The
major differences are outlined below: ^
All broadband sensors use a single wire circuit. Some types of controllers will output a bias voltage
on the KS signal wire. The bias voltage creates a voltage drop the PCM monitors and uses to help
diagnose KS faults. The KS noise signal rides along this bias voltage, and due to the constantly
fluctuating frequency and amplitude of the signal, will always be outside the bias voltage
parameters. Another way to use the KS signals is for the PCM to learn the average normal noise
output from the KS. The PCM uses this noise channel, and KS signal that rides along the noise
channel, in much the same way as the bias voltage type does. Both systems will constantly monitor
the KS system for a signal that is not present or falls within the noise channel.
^ The flat response KS uses a 2-wire circuit. The KS signal rides within a noise channel which is
learned and output by the PCM. This noise channel is based upon the normal noise input from the
KS and is known as background noise. As engine speed and load change, the noise channel upper
and lower parameters will change to accommodate the KS signal, keeping the signal within the
channel. If there is knock, the signal will range outside the noise channel and the PCM will reduce
spark advance until the knock is reduced. These sensors are monitored in much the same way as
the broadband sensors, except that an abnormal signal will stay outside of the noise channel or will
not be present.
KS diagnostics can be calibrated to detect faults with the KS diagnostic inside the PCM, the KS
wiring, the sensor output, or constant knocking from an outside influence such as a loose or
damaged component. In order to determine which cylinders are knocking, the PCM uses KS signal
information when the cylinders are near Top Dead Center (TDC) of the firing stroke.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3758
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3759
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the engine cover. 3. Disconnect the knock
sensor harness connector (3). 4. Remove the knock sensor bolt (1) and knock sensor (2).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the knock sensor (2) and the knock sensor bolt (1).
Tighten Tighten the sender to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
2. Connect the knock sensor harness connector (3). 3. Install the engine cover. 4. Connect the
negative battery cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Always On
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Testing and Inspection Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Always On
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Battery positive voltage is supplied directly to the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL). The powertrain
control module (PCM) turns the MIL ON by grounding the MIL control circuit.
MIL OPERATION
The MIL is located on the instrument panel.
MIL FUNCTION
^ The MIL informs the driver that a malfunction has occurred and the vehicle should be taken in for
service as soon as possible.
^ The MIL illuminates during a bulb test and a system test.
^ A DTC will be stored if a MIL is requested by the diagnostic test.
MIL ILLUMINATION
^ The MIL will illuminate with ignition switch ON and the engine not running.
^ The MIL will turn OFF when the engine is started.
^ The MIL will remain ON if the self-diagnostic system has detected a malfunction.
^ The MIL may turn OFF if the malfunction is not present.
^ If the MIL is illuminated and the engine stalls, the MIL will remain illuminated as long as the
ignition switch is ON.
^ If the MIL is not illuminated and the engine stalls, the MIL will not illuminate until the ignition
switch is cycled OFF, then ON.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS
If the problem is intermittent, refer to Intermittent Conditions. See: Testing and Inspection/Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview/Diagnostic Strategies/Intermittent Conditions
TEST DESCRIPTION
Steps 1-6
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. This step determines if the
condition is with the MIL control circuit or the PCM.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Always On > Page 3764
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Testing and Inspection Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Inoperative
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Battery positive voltage is supplied directly to the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL). The powertrain
control module (PCM) turns the MIL ON by grounding the MIL control circuit. There should be a
steady MIL with the ignition ON and the engine OFF.
MIL OPERATION
The MIL is located on the instrument panel.
MIL FUNCTION
^ The MIL informs the driver that a malfunction has occurred and the vehicle should be taken in for
service as soon as possible.
^ The MIL illuminates during a bulb test and a system test.
^ A DTC will be stored if a MIL is requested by the diagnostic test.
MIL ILLUMINATION
^ The MIL will illuminate with ignition switch ON and the engine not running.
^ The MIL will turn OFF when the engine is started.
^ The MIL will remain ON if the self-diagnostic system has detected a malfunction.
^ The MIL may turn OFF if the malfunction is not present.
^ If the MIL is illuminated and the engine stalls, the MIL will remain illuminated as long as the
ignition switch is ON.
^ If the MIL is not illuminated and the engine stalls, the MIL will not illuminate until the ignition
switch is cycled OFF, then ON.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS
If the problem is intermittent, refer to Intermittent Conditions. See: Testing and Inspection/Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview/Diagnostic Strategies/Intermittent Conditions
TEST DESCRIPTION
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Always On > Page 3765
Steps 1-14
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 3. This step determines if the
condition is with the MIL control circuit or the PCM. 4. This step determines if a voltage is
constantly being applied to the control circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3769
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3770
Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3771
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3772
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair
MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE (MAP) SENSOR REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Other than checking for a worn grommet and loose electrical connectors, the only service possible
is a unit replacement if the diagnosis shows a malfunctioning manifold absolute pressure (MAP)
sensor.
1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Remove the engine cover. 3. Disconnect the MAP sensor harness
connector.
NOTE: Do not rotate or pry on the MAP sensor when removing. Damage to the MAP sensor or the
intake manifold may result.
4. Remove the MAP sensor by pulling straight up with a slight rocking motion. 5. Remove the MAP
sensor grommet. 6. Discard the MAP sensor grommet.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3773
1. Install the new MAP sensor grommet on the MAP sensor. 2. Install the MAP sensor.
3. Connect the MAP sensor harness connector. 4. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications
Oil Pressure Sensor: Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure Gage Sensor
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 22 ft. lbs.
Engine Oil Pressure Gage Sensor Fitting (Plus Required Angle)
Torque..................................................................................................................................................
............................................................... 11 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3777
Oil Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
Engine Oil Pressure Sensor and/or Switch Replacement
Tools Required J41712 Oil Pressure Switch Socket
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Disconnect the engine oil pressure sensor gage electrical
connector. 3. Hold the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting with a wrench.
4. Remove the engine oil pressure gage sensor using J41712.
Important: Note the alignment of the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting prior to removal.
5. Remove the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting, if necessary.
Installation Procedure
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting, if removed.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3778
1.1. Tighten the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.).
Important: Do not loosen the sensor fitting. Do not tighten the sensor fitting more than one turn to
align.
1.2. Tighten the sensor fitting until properly aligned.
2. Install the engine oil pressure gage sensor. 3. Hold the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting
with a wrench to prevent from turning.
Using J41712 tighten the engine oil pressure gage sensor to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
4. Install the engine oil pressure gage sensor electrical connector. 5. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Oxygen Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3784
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3785
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3786
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3787
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3788
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3789
Oxygen Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3790
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3791
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3792
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3793
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3794
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3795
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3796
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3797
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3798
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3799
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3800
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3801
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3802
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3803
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3804
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3805
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3806
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3807
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3808
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3809
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3810
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3811
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3812
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3813
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3814
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3815
Oxygen Sensor: Connector Views
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 1 Sensor 1
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 1 Sensor 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3816
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 2 Sensor 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Heated Oxygen Sensors
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation Heated Oxygen Sensors
The main function of the pre-catalyst Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) is to provide the (PCM) with
exhaust stream information in order to maintain proper fueling to hold emissions within acceptable
levels. These oxygen sensors are always located between the exhaust manifold and the catalytic
converter. After the sensor reaches the operating temperature, the sensor generates a voltage
inversely proportional to the amount of oxygen present in the exhaust gases.
The PCM uses the signal voltage from the fuel control heated oxygen sensors in a Closed Loop in
order to adjust the fuel injector pulse width. While in a Closed Loop, the PCM can adjust fuel
delivery in order to maintain an air to fuel ratio which allows the best combination of emission
control and driveability.
If the oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal are damaged, replace the entire oxygen
sensor assembly. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, the connector, or the terminals. In order for
the sensor to function properly, the sensor must have a clean air reference provided to it. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor wires. Any attempt to repair the wires,
connectors, or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference. Any attempt to repair
the wires, connectors, or terminals could degrade oxygen sensor performance.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Heated Oxygen Sensors > Page 3819
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation Oxygen Sensor Diagnosis
Diagnose the fuel control heated oxygen sensors for the following conditions:
^ Heater performance, time to activity on cold start
^ Slow response
^ Response time, time to switch R/L or L/R
^ Inactive signal, output steady at bias voltage - approximately 450 mV
^ Signal fixed high
^ Signal fixed low
Diagnose the catalyst monitor heated oxygen sensors for the following functions:
^ Heater performance, time to activity on cold start
^ Signal fixed low during steady state conditions
^ Inactive sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3820
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor 1
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor
1
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39194-B Oxygen Sensor Wrench
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Vehicle Lifting Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Raise the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Disconnect the connector (1) for the HO2S.
NOTE: Refer to Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Remove the HO2S (2) using a J 39194-B.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: A special anti-seize compound is used on the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S)
threads. The compound consists of liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite tends to burn
away, but the glass beads remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New, or service
replacement sensors already have the compound applied to the threads. If the sensor is removed
from an engine and if for any reason the sensor is to be reinstalled, the threads must have
anti-seize compound applied before the reinstallation.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor 1 > Page
3823
1. Coat the threads of the oxygen sensor with anti-seize compound GM P/N 5613695, if necessary.
NOTE: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the HO2S (2) using a J 39194-B.
Tighten Tighten the sensor to 42 N.m (31 lb ft).
3. Connect the HO2S harness connector (1). 4. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor 1 > Page
3824
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor
2
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39194-B Oxygen Sensor Wrench
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Vehicle Lifting Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Raise the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Disconnect the connector (3) for the HO2S.
NOTE: Refer to Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Remove the HO2S (4) using a J 39194-B.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: A special anti-seize compound is used on the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S)
threads. The compound consists of liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite tends to burn
away, but the glass beads remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New, or service
replacement sensors already have the compound applied to the threads. If the sensor is removed
from an engine and if for any reason the sensor is to be reinstalled, the threads must have
anti-seize compound applied before the reinstallation.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor 1 > Page
3825
1. Coat the threads of the oxygen sensor with anti-seize compound GM P/N 5613695, if necessary.
NOTE: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the HO2S (4) using a J 39194-B.
Tighten Tighten the sensor to 42 N.m (31 lb ft).
3. Connect the HO2S harness connector (3). 4. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor 1 > Page
3826
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 2 Sensor
1
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39194-B Oxygen Sensor Wrench
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Vehicle Lifting Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Raise the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Disconnect the connector (2) for the HO2S.
NOTE: Refer to Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Remove the HO2S (1) using a J 39194-B.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: A special anti-seize compound is used on the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S)
threads. The compound consists of liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite tends to burn
away, but the glass beads remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New, or service
replacement sensors already have the compound applied to the threads. If the sensor is removed
from an engine and if for any reason the sensor is to be reinstalled, the threads must have
anti-seize compound applied before the reinstallation.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor 1 > Page
3827
1. Coat the threads of the oxygen sensor with anti-seize compound GM P/N 5813695, if necessary.
NOTE: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the HO2S (1) using a J 39194-B.
Tighten Tighten the sensor to 42 N.m (31 lb ft).
3. Connect the HO2S harness connector (2). 4. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Body Control Module
(BCM) C1
Body Control Module C1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Body Control Module
(BCM) C1 > Page 3833
Body Control Module C2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Body Control Module
(BCM) C1 > Page 3834
Body Control Module C3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3835
Body Control Module: Description and Operation
The BCM contains the logic of the theft deterrent system. The BCM provides the battery positive
voltage to operate the Passlock(TM) Sensor. The BCM also measures the voltage of the security
sensor signal circuit. The voltage measured will indicate whether the Passlock(TM) Sensor has
been activated and whether the resistance value from the sensor is a valid value or the tamper
value. If voltage measured is in the valid range, the BCM compares this voltage, voltage code, to a
previously learned voltage code. If the voltage codes match, the BCM sends a class 2 message
containing a password to the PCM. If the voltage codes do not match, or the voltage is in the
Tamper range, or there is a circuit fault, the BCM will not send the correct password to the PCM,
and the vehicle will not start.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Body Control Module: Procedures
IMPORTANT: If any module is replaced, programming the module with the proper RPO
configurations must be done prior to performing the Passlock Learn procedure.
1. The BCM must be programmed with the proper RPO configurations. The BCM stores the
information regarding the vehicle options. If the BCM is
not properly configured with the correct RPO codes the BCM will not control the features properly.
Ensure that the following conditions exist in order to prepare for BCM programming: ^
The battery is fully charged.
^ The ignition switch is in the RUN position.
^ The DLC is accessible.
^ All disconnected modules and devices are reconnected before programming.
2. Follow the SPS instructions on the Techline Terminal and scan tool to program the BCM. 3. If
the BCM fails to accept the program, perform the following steps:
^ Inspect all BCM connections.
^ Verify that the SPS Techline Terminal and scan tool have the latest software version.
Passlock Learn Procedures Refer to the Theft Deterrent sub-system for the appropriate learn
procedure.
IMPORTANT: After programming, perform the following to avoid future misdiagnosis: 1. Turn the
ignition OFF for 10 seconds. 2. Connect the scan tool to the data link connector. 3. Turn the ignition
ON with the engine OFF. 4. Use the scan tool in order to retrieve History DTCs from all modules. 5.
Clear all history DTCs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 3838
Body Control Module: Removal and Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Replacing the body control module (BCM) may be necessary when you service the body control
system.
IMPORTANT: The ignition switch should be in the OFF position when connecting or disconnecting
the connectors to the BCM. Always disconnect the Brown BCM connector FIRST and connect the
Brown BCM connector LAST. The BCM can set DTC(s) with the ignition switch in the OFF position.
The BCM has battery run down protection for the courtesy lamp circuit. The BCM battery run down
protection can not detect shorts on inputs or other circuits which it does not control. The scan tool
can be used to put the BCM to sleep in order to check for current draws on circuits which are not
controlled by the BCM or controlled by the battery run down protection system. If an excessive
current draw is detected, refer to Battery Electrical Drain/Parasitic Load Test (w/ BCM) in Starting
and Charging.
1. Remove the radio from the vehicle. 2. Remove the heater control.
Pull the heater control (2) out and down in order to gain access to the body control module.
3. Push upward on the bracket retainer slightly and pull the body control module (2) from the
bracket (1) at an angle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 3839
4. Disconnect the electrical connectors (2) from the body control module (1). 5. Remove the body
control module from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the body control module (2) to the vehicle. 2. Install the body control module to the bracket
(1) at an angle under the wide hook retainer, with the label facing away from the bracket. 3. Apply
pressure on the center of the body control module in order to move the module toward the
mounting bracket base. Snap the module into
place.
4. Ensure that the module is fully seated. Ensure that both snap retainers are holding the module.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 3840
5. Connect the electrical connectors (2) to the body control module (1).
6. Install the heater control (2). 7. Install the radio to the vehicle. 8. Use the following components
in order to program the body control module with the proper calibrations:
^ The Techline Terminal
^ The Scan Tool
9. Perform the body control module programing. Refer to Body Control Module (BCM)
Programming/RPO Configuration. See: Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning
10. Clear the diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine
Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory
Usage
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-06-04-054B
Date: November 18, 2010
Subject: Info - Non-GM Parts and Accessories (Aftermarket)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years and update to the new U.S. Fixed
Operation Manager (FOM) and Canada Warranty Manager (WM) names. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 04-06-04-054A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
The recent rise and expansion of companies selling non-GM parts and accessories has made it
necessary to issue this reminder to dealers regarding GM's policy on the use and installation of
these aftermarket components.
When a dealer is performing a repair under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty, they are required to
use only genuine GM or GM-approved parts and accessories. This applies to all warranty repairs,
special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM. Parts and accessories advertised as being "the
same" as parts manufactured by GM, but not sold through GM, do not qualify for use in warranty
repairs, special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM.
During a warranty repair, if a GM original equipment part is not available through GM Customer
Care and Aftersales (GM CC&A;), ACDelco(R) distributors, other GM dealers or approved sources,
the dealer is to obtain comparable, non-GM parts and clearly indicate, in detail, on the repair order
the circumstances surrounding why non-GM parts were used. The dealer must give customers
written notice, prior to the sale or service, that such parts or accessories are not marketed or
warranted by General Motors.
It should also be noted that dealers modifying new vehicles and installing equipment, parts and
accessories obtained from sources not authorized by GM are responsible for complying with the
National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act. Certain non-approved parts or assemblies, installed
by the dealer or its agent not authorized by GM, may result in a change to the vehicle's design
characteristics and may affect the vehicle's ability to conform to federal law. Dealers must fully
understand that non-GM approved parts may not have been validated, tested or certified for use.
This puts the dealer at risk for potential liability in the event of a part or vehicle failure. If a GM part
failure occurs as the result of the installation or use of a non-GM approved part, the warranty will
not be honored.
A good example of non-authorized modification of vehicles is the result of an ever increasing
supply of aftermarket devices available to the customer, which claim to increase the horsepower
and torque of the Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines. These include the addition of, but are not limited to
one or more of the following modifications:
- Propane injection
- Nitrous oxide injection
- Additional modules (black boxes) that connect to the vehicle wiring systems
- Revised engine calibrations downloaded for the engine control module
- Calibration modules which connect to the vehicle diagnostic connector
- Modification to the engine turbocharger waste gate
Although the installation of these devices, or modification of vehicle components, can increase
engine horsepower and torque, they may also negatively affect the engine emissions, reliability
and/or durability. In addition, other powertrain components, such as transmissions, universal joints,
drive shafts, and front/rear axle components, can be stressed beyond design safety limits by the
installation of these devices.
General Motors does not support or endorse the use of devices or modifications that, when
installed, increase the engine horsepower and torque. It is because of these unknown stresses,
and the potential to alter reliability, durability and emissions performance, that GM has adopted a
policy that prevents any UNAUTHORIZED dealer warranty claim submissions to any remaining
warranty coverage, to the powertrain and driveline components whenever the presence of a
non-GM (aftermarket) calibration is confirmed - even if the non-GM control module calibration is
subsequently removed. Refer to the latest version of Bulletin 09-06-04-026 (V8 Gas Engines) or
06-06-01-007 (Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines) for more information on dealer requirements for
calibration verification.
These same policies apply as they relate to the use of non-GM accessories. Damage or failure
from the use or installation of a non-GM accessory will not be covered under warranty. Failure
resulting from the alteration or modification of the vehicle, including the cutting, welding or
disconnecting of the vehicle's original equipment parts and components will void the warranty.
Additionally, dealers will NOT be reimbursed or compensated by GM in the event of any legal
inquiry at either the local, state or federal level that
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine
Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 3845
results from the alteration or modification of a vehicle using non-GM approved parts or accessories.
Dealers should be especially cautious of accessory companies that claim the installation of their
product will not void the factory warranty. Many times these companies have even given direction
on how to quickly disassemble the accessory in an attempt to preclude the manufacturer from
finding out that is has been installed.
Any suspect repairs should be reviewed by the Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), and in Canada
by the Warranty Manager (WM) for appropriate repair direction. If it is decided that a goodwill repair
is to be made on the vehicle, even with the installation of such non-GM approved components, the
customer is to be made aware of General Motors position on this issue and is to sign the
appropriate goodwill documentation required by General Motors.
It is imperative for dealers to understand that by installing such devices, they are jeopardizing not
only the warranty coverage, but also the performance and reliability of the customer's vehicle.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
3846
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3849
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3850
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3851
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3852
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3853
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3854
Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3855
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3856
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3857
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3858
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3859
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3860
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3861
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3862
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3863
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3864
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3865
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3866
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3867
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3868
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3869
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3870
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3871
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3872
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3873
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3874
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3875
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3876
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3877
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3878
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3879
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3880
Engine Control Module: Connector Views
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) C1 Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3881
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) C1 Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3882
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) C2 Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3883
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) C2 Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > General
Information
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation General Information
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is designed to maintain exhaust emission levels while
maintaining excellent driveability and fuel efficiency. The PCM controls the following operations:
^ The fuel control
^ The Ignition Control (IC)
^ The Knock Sensor (KS) system
^ The automatic transmission shift functions
^ The manual transmission
^ The cruise control enable, if so equipped
^ The generator
^ The Evaporative Emissions (EVAP) purge
^ The A/C clutch control, if so equipped
^ The Secondary Air Injection (AIR), if so equipped
^ The Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR)
The PCM controls all ignition system functions, and constantly corrects the basic spark timing. The
PCM monitors information from various sensor inputs that include the following:
^ The Throttle Position (TP) sensor
^ The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
^ The Mass Airflow (MAF) Sensor
^ The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor
^ The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
^ The transmission gear position or range information sensors
^ The engine Knock Sensors (KS)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > General
Information > Page 3886
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the meaning of voltage
(volts), current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens in a circuit
with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring diagram.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > General
Information > Page 3887
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation Engine Controls Information
The driveability and emissions information describes the function and operation of the Powertrain
Control Module (PCM).
The computers and control systems information contains the following:
^ Component locations
^ Wiring diagrams
^ PCM terminal end view and terminal definitions
^ Powertrain On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) System Check
^ Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) tables
The Component System includes the following items:
^ Component and circuit description
^ On-vehicle service for each sub-system
^ Functional checks and diagnostic tables
The DTCs also contain diagnostic support information containing circuit diagrams, circuit or system
information, and helpful diagnostic information.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > General
Information > Page 3888
Typical Drive Cycle
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > General
Information > Page 3889
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation
General Information
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is designed to maintain exhaust emission levels while
maintaining excellent driveability and fuel efficiency. The PCM controls the following operations:
^ The fuel control
^ The Ignition Control (IC)
^ The Knock Sensor (KS) system
^ The automatic transmission shift functions
^ The manual transmission
^ The cruise control enable, if so equipped
^ The generator
^ The Evaporative Emissions (EVAP) purge
^ The A/C clutch control, if so equipped
^ The Secondary Air Injection (AIR), if so equipped
^ The Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR)
The PCM controls all ignition system functions, and constantly corrects the basic spark timing. The
PCM monitors information from various sensor inputs that include the following:
^ The Throttle Position (TP) sensor
^ The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
^ The Mass Airflow (MAF) Sensor
^ The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor
^ The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
^ The transmission gear position or range information sensors
^ The engine Knock Sensors (KS)
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the meaning of voltage
(volts), current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens in a circuit
with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring diagram.
Engine Controls Information
The driveability and emissions information describes the function and operation of the Powertrain
Control Module (PCM).
The computers and control systems information contains the following:
^ Component locations
^ Wiring diagrams
^ PCM terminal end view and terminal definitions
^ Powertrain On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) System Check
^ Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) tables
The Component System includes the following items:
^ Component and circuit description
^ On-vehicle service for each sub-system
^ Functional checks and diagnostic tables
The DTCs also contain diagnostic support information containing circuit diagrams, circuit or system
information, and helpful diagnostic information.
Typical Drive Cycle
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > General
Information > Page 3890
Primary System Based Diagnostics
There are primary system-based diagnostics which evaluate the system operation and their effect
on vehicle emissions. The primary system-based diagnostics are listed, with a brief description of
the diagnostic functionality.
Heated Oxygen Sensors
The main function of the pre-catalyst Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) is to provide the (PCM) with
exhaust stream information in order to maintain proper fueling to hold emissions within acceptable
levels. These oxygen sensors are always located between the exhaust manifold and the catalytic
converter. After the sensor reaches the operating temperature, the sensor generates a voltage
inversely proportional to the amount of oxygen present in the exhaust gases.
The PCM uses the signal voltage from the fuel control heated oxygen sensors in a Closed Loop in
order to adjust the fuel injector pulse width. While in a Closed Loop, the PCM can adjust fuel
delivery in order to maintain an air to fuel ratio which allows the best combination of emission
control and driveability.
If the oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal are damaged, replace the entire oxygen
sensor assembly. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, the connector, or the terminals. In order for
the sensor to function properly, the sensor must have a clean air reference provided to it. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor wires. Any attempt to repair the wires,
connectors, or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference. Any attempt to repair
the wires, connectors, or terminals could degrade oxygen sensor performance.
Catalyst Monitor Diagnostic Operation
The catalyst monitor diagnostic measures oxygen storage capacity of the catalyst converter. In
order to do this, the heated sensors are installed before and after the 3-Way Catalyst (TWC).
Voltage variations between the sensors allow the PCM to determine the catalyst emission
performance.
As a catalyst becomes less effective in promoting chemical reactions, the catalysts capacity to
store and release oxygen generally degrades. The catalyst monitor diagnostic is based on a
correlation between conversion efficiency and oxygen storage capacity.
A good catalyst, e.g. 95 degrees hydrocarbon conversion efficiency, shows a relatively flat output
voltage on the post-catalyst Heated Oxygen Sensor ( HO2S). A degraded catalyst, 65 percent
hydrocarbon conversion, shows a greatly increased activity in output voltage from the post catalyst
HO2S.
The post-catalyst HO2S is used to measure the oxygen storage and release capacity of the
catalyst. A high oxygen storage capacity indicates a good catalyst. Low oxygen storage capacity
indicates a failing catalyst. The (TWC) and the HO2S must be at operating temperature in order to
achieve correct oxygen sensor voltages like those shown in the post-catalyst HO2S outputs
graphic.
The catalyst monitor diagnostic is sensitive to the following conditions:
^ Exhaust leaks
^ HO2S contamination
^ Alternative fuels
Exhaust system leaks may cause the following:
^ Prevent a degraded catalyst from failing the diagnostic
^ Cause a false failure for a normally functioning catalyst
^ Prevent the diagnostic from running
Some of the contaminants that may be encountered are phosphorus, lead, silica, and sulfur. The
presence of these contaminants prevent the TWC diagnostic from functioning properly.
Catalyst Monitor Heated Oxygen Sensors
In order to control emissions of Hydrocarbons (HC), Carbon Monoxide (CO), and Oxides of
Nitrogen (NOx), the system uses a 3-way catalytic converter. The catalyst promotes a chemical
reaction which oxidizes the HC and CO present in the exhaust gas, converting the HC and CO into
harmless water vapor and carbon dioxide. The catalyst also converts NOx to nitrogen. Catalyst
monitor HO2S, post-catalyst HO2S, are always located downstream of the catalytic converter.
The PCM has the ability to monitor this process using the post catalyst heated oxygen sensors.
The pre-sensors produce an output signal which indicates the amount of oxygen present in the
exhaust gas entering the 3-way catalytic converter. The post sensor produces an output signal
which indicates the oxygen storage capacity of the catalyst. This in turn indicates the catalysts
ability to convert exhaust gases efficiently. If the catalyst is operating efficiently, the pre-HO2S
signal is far more active than that produced by the post-HO2S.
In addition to catalyst monitoring, the post-HO2S has a limited role in controlling fuel delivery. If the
post-HO2S signal indicates a high or low oxygen content for an extended period of time while in a
Closed Loop, the PCM adjusts the fuel delivery slightly in order to compensate.
Comprehensive Component Monitor Diagnostic
Comprehensive component monitoring diagnostics are required to monitor emissions-related input
and output powertrain components.
Fuel Trim System Operation
The fuel trim system monitors the averages of short-term and long-term fuel trim values. If these
fuel trim values stay at their limits for a calibrated period of time, a malfunction is indicated. The fuel
trim diagnostic compares the average of short and long-term fuel trim values. If either value is
within the thresholds, a pass is recorded. If either value is outside the thresholds, a rich or lean fuel
trim DTC will set.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > General
Information > Page 3891
Misfire Monitor Diagnostic Operation
The misfire monitor diagnostic is based on crankshaft rotational velocity, aka reference period,
variations. The PCM determines crankshaft rotational velocity using the Crankshaft Position (CKP)
Sensor and Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor. When a cylinder misfires, the crankshaft slows down
momentarily. By monitoring the crankshaft and camshaft position sensor signals, the PCM can
calculate when a misfire occurs.
For a non-catalyst damaging misfire, the diagnostic is required to monitor a misfire present for
between 1,000 - 3,200 engine revolutions.
For catalyst damage misfire, the diagnostic responds to the misfire within 200 engine revolutions.
Rough roads may cause false misfire detection. A rough road applies sudden torque variations to
the drive wheels and drivetrain. This torque can intermittently decrease the crankshaft rotational
velocity. The Antilock Braking (ABS) System detects uneven speed between the vehicles wheels
and sends data via the serial data bus to the PCM to disable the misfire monitor until the rough
road is no longer detected.
On automatic transmission equipped vehicles, the Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) disables
whenever a misfire is detected. Disabling the TCC isolates the engine from the rest of the drive line
and minimizes the effect of the drive wheel inputs on crankshaft rotation.
When the TCC has disabled as a result of misfire detection, the TCC is re-enabled after
approximately 3,200 engine revolutions if no misfire is detected. The TCC remains disabled
whenever the misfire is detected, with or without a DTC set. This allows the misfire diagnostic to
reevaluate the system.
Whenever a cylinder misfires, the misfire diagnostic counts the misfire and notes the crankshaft
position at the time the misfire occurred.
A current and a history misfire counter is maintained for each cylinder. The misfire current
counters, Misfire Cur #1 - 8, indicate the number of firing events out of the last 200 cylinder firing
events which were misfires. The misfire current counters displays real time data without a misfire
DTC stored. The misfire history counters, Misfire Hist #1 - 8. indicate the total number of cylinder
firing events which were misfires. The misfire history counters display 0 until the misfire diagnostic
has failed and a DTC P0300 is set. Once the misfire DTC sets, the misfire history counters will be
updated every 200 cylinder firing events. The Misfire counters graphic illustrates how these misfire
counters are maintained.
When crankshaft rotation is erratic, the PCM detects a misfire condition. Because of this erratic
condition, the data that is collected by the diagnostic can
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > General
Information > Page 3892
sometimes incorrectly identify which cylinder is misfiring. The Misfire Counters graphic shows there
are misfires counted from more than one cylinder. Cylinder #1 has the majority of counted misfires.
In this case, the misfire counters would identify cylinder #1 as the misfiring cylinder. The misfires in
the other counters were just background noise caused by the erratic rotation of the crankshaft. If
the number of accumulated misfires is sufficient for the diagnostic to identify a true misfire, the
diagnostic will set DTC P0300 - Misfire Detected. The illustration depicts an accumulation in the
history buffers.
If two cylinders in sequential firing order are both misfiring, the first misfiring cylinder will
accumulate misfires in its buffer, but the second misfiring cylinder will not. This is because the PCM
compares a misfiring cylinder with the cylinder 90 degrees prior to it in the firing order. Therefore
the PCM would be comparing crankshaft speed of the second misfiring cylinder to an already
suspect cylinder. The PCM however, will be able to detect both misfiring cylinders after the engine
exceeds 2,000 RPM. This is because the PCM then starts to compare misfires to the opposing
cylinder rather than the previous cylinder in the firing order.
Use Techline equipment to monitor the misfire counter data on applicable vehicles, knowing which
specific cylinders misfire can lead to the root cause. Using the information in the misfire counters
identifies which cylinders are misfiring. If the counters indicate cylinders number 1 and 4 misfired,
look for a circuit or component common to both cylinders.
The misfire diagnostic may indicate a fault due to a temporary fault not necessarily caused by a
vehicle emission system malfunction. Examples include the following items:
^ Contaminated fuel
^ Running out of fuel
^ Fuel fouled spark plugs
^ Basic engine fault
Oxygen Sensor Diagnosis
Diagnose the fuel control heated oxygen sensors for the following conditions:
^ Heater performance, time to activity on cold start
^ Slow response
^ Response time, time to switch R/L or L/R
^ Inactive signal, output steady at bias voltage - approximately 450 mV
^ Signal fixed high
^ Signal fixed low
Diagnose the catalyst monitor heated oxygen sensors for the following functions:
^ Heater performance, time to activity on cold start
^ Signal fixed low during steady state conditions
^ Inactive sensor
PCM Function
The PCM supplies a buffered voltage to various sensors and switches. The PCM controls most
components with electronic switches which complete a ground circuit when turned ON.
PCM Service Precautions
The PCM is designed to withstand normal current draws associated with vehicle operations. Avoid
overloading any circuit. When testing for opens or shorts, do not ground any of the PCM circuits
unless instructed. When testing for opens or shorts, do not apply voltage to any of the PCM circuits
unless instructed. Only test these circuits with a DMM while the PCM connectors remain
connected.
Three-Way Catalyst Oxygen Storage Capacity
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > General
Information > Page 3893
Three-Way Catalyst Storage Capacity
The PCM must monitor the 3-Way Catalyst System (TWC) for efficiency. In order to accomplish
this, the PCM monitors the pre-catalyst and post-catalyst oxygen sensors. When the TWC is
operating properly, the post-catalyst (2) oxygen sensor shows significantly less activity than the
pre-catalyst (1) oxygen sensor. The TWC stores oxygen during the normal reduction and oxidation
process. The TWC releases oxygen during its normal reduction and oxidation process. The PCM
calculates the oxygen storage capacity using the difference between the pre-catalyst and
post-catalyst oxygen sensor voltage levels.
Misfire Monitor Diagnostic Tests
Whenever the sensor activity of the post-catalyst (2) oxygen sensor nears the sensor activity of the
pre-catalyst (1) oxygen sensor, the catalysts efficiency is degraded.
Aftermarket HO2S characteristics may be different from the original equipment manufacturer
sensor. This may lead to a false pass or a false fail of the catalyst monitor diagnostic. Similarly, if
an aftermarket catalyst does not contain the same amount of precious metal content as the original
pan, the correlation between oxygen storage and conversion efficiency may be altered enough to
set a false DTC.
Torque Management
Torque management is a function of the PCM that reduces engine power under certain conditions.
Torque management is performed for the following reasons:
1. To prevent over-stressing the powertrain and driveline components 2. To prevent damage to the
vehicle during certain abusive maneuvers 3. To reduce engine speed when the IAC is out of the
normal operating range
The PCM monitors the following sensors and engine parameters in order to calculate engine output
torque:
^ The air/fuel ratio
^ The Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor
^ The Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) sensor
^ The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor
^ The spark advance
^ The engine speed
^ The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor
^ The A/C clutch status
The PCM monitors the torque converter status, the transmission gear ratio, and the engine speed
in order to determine if torque reduction is required. The PCM retards the spark as appropriate to
reduce engine torque output if torque reduction is required. The PCM also shuts OFF the fuel to
certain injectors in order to reduce the engine power in the case of an abusive maneuver.
The following are instances when engine power reduction is likely to be experienced:
^ During transmission upshifts and downshifts
^ During heavy acceleration from a standing start
^ When the clutch pedal is released too quick under a heavy load (6.0L only)
^ When one set of drive axles loses traction while the other set of drive axles are not moving (4WD
only and in 4WD low)
^ If the IAC is out of the normal operating range, except 6.0L
^ When the driver is performing harsh or abusive maneuvers such as shifting into gear at high
throttle angles or shifting the transmission from reverse to drive to create a rocking motion
The driver is unlikely to notice the torque management actions in the first 2 instances. The engine
power output is moderate at full throttle in the other cases.
The PCM calculates the amount of spark retard necessary to reduce the engine power by the
desired amount. The PCM disables the fuel injectors for
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > General
Information > Page 3894
cylinders 1, 4, 6, and 7 in the case of an abusive maneuver.
Powertrain Control Module
Powertrain Control Module
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is located in the engine compartment. The PCM is the
control center of the vehicle. It controls the following:
^ The fuel metering system
^ The transmission shifting
^ The ignition timing
^ The on-board diagnostics for powertrain functions
The PCM constantly monitors the information from various sensors and controls the systems that
affect vehicle performance and emissions. The PCM also performs the diagnostic functions for
those systems. The PCM can recognize operational problems and alert the driver through the
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) when a malfunction has occurred. When a malfunction is
detected, the PCM stores a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) which helps to identify problem areas.
This is done to aid the technician in making repairs
The PCM supplies either 5.0 or 12.0 volts to power various sensors and switches. This is done
through resistances in the PCM. The resistance is so high in value that a test lamp does not
illuminate when connected to the circuit. In some cases, even an ordinary shop voltmeter does not
give an accurate reading because the voltmeters resistance is too low. Therefore, a DMM with a
minimum of 10 megaohms input impedance is required to ensure accurate voltage readings.
The PCM controls output circuits such as the fuel injectors, the Idle Air Control (IAC), the cooling
fan relays, etc. by controlling the ground or the power feed circuit through transistors or a device
called an output driver module.
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) contains the remainder of the logic of the theft deterrent
system. If a class 2 message containing a valid password is received from the BCM, the PCM will
continue to allow the fuel injectors to operate. The PCM will allow the fuel injectors to operate until
it decides there is no valid password coming from the BCM. If the PCM does not receive a class 2
message, or receives a class 2 message with an incorrect password, the engine will crank and will
not run or will start and stall immediately.
Input Components
The PCM monitors the input components for circuit continuity and out-of-range values. This
includes performance checking. Performance checking refers to indicating a fault when the signal
from a sensor does not seem reasonable, such as a Throttle Position (TP) sensor that indicates
high throttle position at low engine loads or MAP voltage. The input components may include, but
are not limited to, the following sensors:
^ The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
^ Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
^ Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor
^ Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
^ Knock Sensor (KS)
^ Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
^ Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
^ Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor
^ Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
In addition to the circuit continuity and rationality check, the ECT sensor is monitored for its ability
to achieve a steady state temperature to enable Closed Loop fuel control.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > General
Information > Page 3895
Output Components
Diagnose the output components for the proper response to PCM commands. Components where
functional monitoring is not feasible will be monitored for circuit continuity and out-of-range values if
applicable.
Output components to be monitored include, but are not limited to, the following circuits:
^ The Idle Air Control (IAC) motor
^ The EVAP system
^ The electronic transmission controls
^ The A/C relay, if so equipped
^ The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) output
^ The Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) control
^ The cruise control enable, if so equipped
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Additional
Information
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Additional Information
The Service Programming System (SPS) allows a technician to program a control module through
the Data Link Connector (DLC). The information transfer circuit that is used at the DLC is the same
serial data circuit used by the scan tool for retrieving Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs), displaying
data, clearing DTCs, etc. This procedure offers the ability to install software/calibrations matched to
a particular vehicle.
Most control modules have 2 types of memory. The software/calibrations reside in the flash
memory. The two types of memory are listed below:
^ Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EEPROM) This type of memory allows
selected portions of memory to be programmed while other portions remain unchanged. Certain
learned values reside in the EEPROM, such as: ^
The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
^ The crankshaft variation learned position
^ The software/calibrations identification numbers
^ The control module security information
^ Flash Read Only Memory - Rash Memory Flash memory has increased memory storage
capacity. During programming, all information within this type of memory is erased, and then
replaced with entirely new information.
Service Programming Methods The 4 methods of programming a control module and the proper
tools for each method are as follows: ^
Remote Programming: The Tech 2 or other scan tool, Techline Terminal or a personal computer equipped with General
Motors Corporation authorized programming software - The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an
interface between the vehicle and the Techline Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is installed in the vehicle
^ Pass Thru Programming: The Tech 2 or other scan tool Techline Terminal or a personal computer equipped with General
Motors Corporation authorized programming software - The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an
interface between the vehicle and the Techline Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is installed in the vehicle.
^ Off-Board Remote Programming, vehicle NOT available: The Tech 2 or other scan tool, Off-board Programming Adapter (OBPA), Techline Terminal or a
personal computer equipped with General Motors Corporation authorized programming software The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an interface between the vehicle and the Techline
Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is NOT installed in a vehicle
^ Off-Board Pass Thru Programming The Tech 2 or other scan tool, off-board programming adapter (OBPA), Techline Terminal or a
personal computer equipped with General Motors Corporation authorized programming software The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an interface between the vehicle and the Techline
Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is NOT installed in a vehicle
Before Programming a Control Module
IMPORTANT: DO NOT program an existing control module with the identical software/calibration
package. This procedure is not a short cut to correct a driveability condition. This is an ineffective
repair. A control module should only be programmed when the following occurs: ^
When a service procedure instructs you to replace the control module. The service part control
module does not contain operating software or calibrations.
^ General Motors Corporation releases an updated software/calibration package.
Ensure that the following conditions are met before programming a control module: ^
Vehicle system voltage: There are no charging system concerns. All charging system concerns must be repaired before
programming a control module.
- The battery voltage is greater than 12 volts but less than 16 volts. The battery must be fully
charged before programming the control module.
- A battery charger is NOT connected to the vehicles battery. Incorrect system voltage or voltage
fluctuations from a battery charger may cause programming failure or control module damage.
- Turn OFF or disable any system that may put a load on the vehicles battery. Turn OFF or disable
systems such as: ^
Daytime Running Lights (DRL). Applying the parking brake, on most vehicles, disables the DRL
system.
^ Heating, Ventilation, And Air Conditioning (HVAC) systems
^ Engine cooling fans, etc.
^ The ignition switch is in the proper position. The scan tool prompts you to turn ON the ignition,
with the engine OFF. DO NOT change the position of the ignition switch during the programming
procedure unless instructed to do so.
^ All tool connections are secure: The RS-232 cable
- The connection at the DLC
- The voltage supply circuits
- The OBPA
^ DO NOT disturb the tool harnesses while programming. If an interruption occurs during the
programming procedure, programming failure or
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Additional
Information > Page 3898
control module damage may occur.
^ If you are performing the pass-through programming procedure using a notebook computer
without the power cord, ensure that the internal battery is fully charged.
After Programming A Control Module The powertrain may operate slightly different after a control
module software/calibration update. Operating the powertrain through various driving conditions
allows the control module to re-learn certain values. The control module must re-learn the following
after a software/calibration update: ^
Fuel trim correction
^ Idle Air Control (IAC) learned position
^ Automatic transmission shift adapts
Other learned values only re-learn by performing a service procedure.
If a control module is replaced the following service procedures may need to be performed: ^
The crankshaft variation learn procedure
^ The engine oil life reset procedure
^ The idle learn procedure
^ The inspection/maintenance complete system set procedure
^ The vehicle theft deterrent password learn procedure
^ The Throttle Position (TP) sensor learn procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Additional
Information > Page 3899
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Programming
(Off-board)
BEFORE PROGRAMMING A CONTROL MODULE
IMPORTANT: ^
DO NOT program a control module unless you are directed by a service procedure or you are
directed by a General Motors Corporation service bulletin. Programming a control module at any
other time will not permanently correct a customer's concern.
^ The Off-Board Programming is used in situations where a control module must be programmed
without having the vehicle present. The Off-Board Programming Adapter must be used to perform
the Off-Board Programming procedure. The adapter allows the control module to power up and
allows the Tech 2 to communicate with the control module.
^ DO NOT disturb the tool harnesses while programming. If an interruption occurs during the
programming procedure, programming failure or control module damage may occur.
Ensure that all connections are secure at the following locations: ^
The Off-Board Programming Adapter
^ The Tech 2
^ The control module
^ The Techline terminal
OFF-BOARD PROGRAMMING
1. Obtain the VIN of the vehicle for which the control module is being programmed. 2. With the
Techline terminal, select Service Programming. 3. Select Tech 2, Reprogram ECU, and Off-Board
Programming Adapter as the electronic control unit (ECU) location. 4. Connect the control module,
Off-Board Programming Adapter, and the Tech 2 as described on the Techline terminal. Ensure
you use the correct
harness connector from the Off-Board Programming Adapter kit.
5. With the Tech 2, select Service Programming Request Information function. The Tech 2
communicates with the control module and receives the
access code.
6. With the Tech 2, exit the Service Programming Request Information. 7. Disconnect the Tech 2
from the Off-Board Programming Adapter. 8. Connect the Tech 2 to the Techline terminal. 9. Turn
ON the Tech 2.
10. With the Techline terminal, enter the VIN of the vehicle that will be receiving the control module.
11. The Techline terminal will display the message, attaching to database. 12. Identify what type of
programming that you are performing. 13. Select the appropriate calibration file. 14. Ensure all
connections are secure. 15. The Techline terminal displays a summary screen that summarizes
your selections. After confirming you choices, the Techline terminal
automatically loads the calibration files to the Tech 2.
16. After the download is complete, turn OFF the Tech 2. 17. Disconnect the Tech 2 from the
Techline terminal. 18. Connect the Tech 2 to the Off-Board Programming Adapter. 19. With the
Tech 2, select Service Programming.
IMPORTANT: DO NOT turn OFF the Off-Board Programming Adapter if the programming
procedure is interrupted or unsuccessful. Ensure the control module and the Off-Board
Programming Adapter connections are secure and the Techline operating software is up to date.
Attempt to reprogram the control module. If the control module cannot be programmed, replace the
control module.
20. With the Tech 2, select Program. 21. After the download is complete, exit Service
Programming. 22. Turn OFF the Off-Board Programming Adapter.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Additional
Information > Page 3900
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Programming
(On-Board)
BEFORE PROGRAMMING A CONTROL MODULE
IMPORTANT: DO NOT program a control module unless you are directed by a service procedure
or you are directed by a General Motors Corporation service bulletin. Programming a control
module at any other time will not permanently correct a customers concern.
Ensure the following conditions are met before programming a control module: ^
Vehicle system voltage There is no charging system concern. All charging system concerns must be repaired before
programming a control module.
- Battery voltage is greater than 12 volts but less than 16 volts. The battery must be charged before
programming the control module if the battery voltage is low.
- A battery charger is NOT connected to the vehicle's battery. Incorrect system voltage or voltage
fluctuations from a battery charger, may cause programming failure or control module damage.
- Turn OFF or disable any system that may put a load on the vehicle's battery. ^
Twilight sentinel
^ Interior lights
^ Daytime running lights (DRL) - Applying the parking brake, on most vehicles, disables the DRL
system.
^ HVAC systems
^ Engine cooling fans etc.
^ The ignition switch is in the proper position. The scan tool prompts you to turn ON the ignition,
with the engine OFF. DO NOT change the position of the ignition switch during the programming
procedure, unless instructed to do so.
^ All tool connections are secure. RS-232
- The connection at the data link connector (DLC) is secure.
- Voltage supply circuits
^ DO NOT disturb the tool harnesses while programming. If an interruption occurs during the
programming procedure, programming failure or control module damage may occur.
REMOTE PROGRAMMING
1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Install the Tech 2 to the DLC. 3. Turn ON the ignition, with the engine
OFF. 4. Turn OFF all vehicle accessories. 5. With the Tech 2, select Service Programming. 6.
Identify vehicle information as requested by the Tech 2. 7. Select the type of module you are
programming. 8. Select the type of programming to be performed. 9. Verify the displayed VIN with
the vehicle VIN. If the displayed VIN does not match the actual VIN, write down the actual VIN and
correct the
VIN at the Techline terminal.
10. When complete, Exit Service Programming. 11. Turn OFF the Tech 2 and disconnect the Tech
2 from the vehicle. 12. Turn OFF the ignition. 13. Connect the Tech 2 to the Techline terminal. 14.
Select Service Programming. 15. Select Tech 2 as the tool you are using. 16. Select the type of
programming to be performed. 17. Verify the displayed VIN with the vehicle VIN. Correct the VIN
as necessary. 18. Select the type of module you are programming. 19. Identify what type of
programming that you are performing.
^ Normal - This type of programming is for updating an existing calibration or programming a new
controller.
^ Vehicle configuration index (VCI) - This selection is used if the vehicle VIN is unavailable or not
recognized by the Techline terminal. Observe, you will need to contact the Techline Customer
Support center to use this option.
^ Reconfigure - This is to reconfigure a vehicle, such as tire size and axle ratio changes.
20. Select the appropriate calibration file. 21. Ensure all connections are secure. 22. Select Reprog
to initiate the download of the new calibration to the Tech 2. 23. After the download is complete,
turn OFF the Tech 2. 24. Disconnect the Tech 2 from the Techline terminal. 25. Install the Tech 2
to the data link connector (DLC). 26. Turn ON the Tech 2. 27. Turn ON the ignition, with the engine
OFF. 28. Select Service Programming.
IMPORTANT: DO NOT turn OFF the ignition if the programming procedure is interrupted or
unsuccessful. Ensure that all the PCM and DLC
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Additional
Information > Page 3901
connections are secure and the Techline operating software is up to date. Attempt to reprogram the
control module. If the control module cannot be programmed, replace the control module.
29. Select Program. 30. After the download is complete, EXIT Service Programming. 31. Turn OFF
the ignition for 30 seconds. 32. Turn OFF the Tech 2. 33. If a control module is replaced the
following service procedures must be performed:
^ The Crankshaft Variation Learn Procedure
^ The Engine Oil Life Reset Procedure
^ The Idle Learn Procedure
^ The Inspection/Maintenance Complete System Set Procedure
^ The Vehicle Theft Deterrent Password Learn Procedure
^ The TP Sensor Learn Procedure
PROGRAMMING VERIFICATION
1. With a scan tool, clear the DTCs. 2. Attempt to start the engine. 3. Repeat the Service
Programming procedure if the engine does not start or operates poorly. Perform the following
procedures before programming
the PCM: ^
Ensure the control module and DLC connections are OK.
^ Ensure the Techline operating software is up to date.
^ Ensure the calibration part number is correct for the vehicle.
4. Attempt to program the control module. If the control module still cannot be programmed
properly, replace the control module. You must program
the replacement control module.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Additional
Information > Page 3902
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Replacement
Service of the powertrain control module (PCM) should normally consist of either replacement of
the PCM or electrically erasable programmable read only memory (EEPROM) programming. If the
diagnostic procedures call for the PCM to be replaced, the PCM should be inspected first to see if
the correct part is being used. If the correct part is being used, remove the faulty PCM and install
the new service PCM.
IMPORTANT:
^ To prevent internal PCM damage, the ignition must be OFF when disconnecting or reconnecting
power to the PCM. For example, when working with a battery cable, PCM pigtail, PCM fuse, or
jumper cables.
^ Remove any debris from the PCM connector surfaces before servicing the PCM. Inspect the
PCM module connector gaskets when diagnosing or replacing the PCM. Ensure that the gaskets
are installed correctly. The gaskets prevent contaminant intrusion into the PCM.
^ The replacement PCM must be programmed.
Removal Procedure
NOTE: ^
Refer to PCM and ESD Notice in Service Precautions.
^ In order to prevent internal damage to the PCM, the ignition must be OFF when disconnecting or
reconnecting the PCM connector.
1. Disconnect the PCM harness connectors (4). 2. Release the spring latch (3) from the PCM (1).
3. Lift the PCM from the PCM mounting tray (2). 4. Remove the PCM (1) from the engine
compartment.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Additional
Information > Page 3903
1. Install the PCM (1) to the PCM mounting tray (2). 2. Secure the spring latch (3) to the PCM (1).
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Connect the PCM connectors (4) to the PCM (1).
Tighten Tighten the PCM connector end fasteners to 8 N.m (71 lb in).
4. If a new PCM is being installed, program the PCM. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming
and Relearning
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Additional
Information > Page 3904
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Service Programming System (SPS)
The Service Programming System (SPS) allows a technician to program a control module through
the Data Link Connector (DLC). The information transfer circuit that is used at the DLC is the same
serial data circuit used by the scan tool for retrieving Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs), displaying
data, clearing DTCs, etc. This procedure offers the ability to install software/calibrations matched to
a particular vehicle.
Most control modules have 2 types of memory. The software/calibrations reside in the flash
memory. The two types of memory are listed below:
^ Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EEPROM) This type of memory allows
selected portions of memory to be programmed while other portions remain unchanged. Certain
learned values reside in the EEPROM, such as: ^
The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
^ The crankshaft variation learned position
^ The software/calibrations identification numbers
^ The control module security information
^ Flash Read Only Memory - Rash Memory Flash memory has increased memory storage
capacity. During programming, all information within this type of memory is erased, and then
replaced with entirely new information.
Service Programming Methods The 4 methods of programming a control module and the proper
tools for each method are as follows: ^
Remote Programming: The Tech 2 or other scan tool, Techline Terminal or a personal computer equipped with General
Motors Corporation authorized programming software - The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an
interface between the vehicle and the Techline Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is installed in the vehicle
^ Pass Thru Programming: The Tech 2 or other scan tool Techline Terminal or a personal computer equipped with General
Motors Corporation authorized programming software - The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an
interface between the vehicle and the Techline Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is installed in the vehicle.
^ Off-Board Remote Programming, vehicle NOT available: The Tech 2 or other scan tool, Off-board Programming Adapter (OBPA), Techline Terminal or a
personal computer equipped with General Motors Corporation authorized programming software The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an interface between the vehicle and the Techline
Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is NOT installed in a vehicle
^ Off-Board Pass Thru Programming The Tech 2 or other scan tool, off-board programming adapter (OBPA), Techline Terminal or a
personal computer equipped with General Motors Corporation authorized programming software The Tech 2 or other scan tool is used as an interface between the vehicle and the Techline
Terminal or a personal computer.
- The control module is NOT installed in a vehicle
Before Programming a Control Module
IMPORTANT: DO NOT program an existing control module with the identical software/calibration
package. This procedure is not a short cut to correct a driveability condition. This is an ineffective
repair. A control module should only be programmed when the following occurs: ^
When a service procedure instructs you to replace the control module. The service part control
module does not contain operating software or calibrations.
^ General Motors Corporation releases an updated software/calibration package.
Ensure that the following conditions are met before programming a control module: ^
Vehicle system voltage: There are no charging system concerns. All charging system concerns must be repaired before
programming a control module.
- The battery voltage is greater than 12 volts but less than 16 volts. The battery must be fully
charged before programming the control module.
- A battery charger is NOT connected to the vehicles battery. Incorrect system voltage or voltage
fluctuations from a battery charger may cause programming failure or control module damage.
- Turn OFF or disable any system that may put a load on the vehicles battery. Turn OFF or disable
systems such as: ^
Daytime Running Lights (DRL). Applying the parking brake, on most vehicles, disables the DRL
system.
^ Heating, Ventilation, And Air Conditioning (HVAC) systems
^ Engine cooling fans, etc.
^ The ignition switch is in the proper position. The scan tool prompts you to turn ON the ignition,
with the engine OFF. DO NOT change the position of the ignition switch during the programming
procedure unless instructed to do so.
^ All tool connections are secure: The RS-232 cable
- The connection at the DLC
- The voltage supply circuits
- The OBPA
^ DO NOT disturb the tool harnesses while programming. If an interruption occurs during the
programming procedure, programming failure or
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Additional
Information > Page 3905
control module damage may occur.
^ If you are performing the pass-through programming procedure using a notebook computer
without the power cord, ensure that the internal battery is fully charged.
After Programming A Control Module The powertrain may operate slightly different after a control
module software/calibration update. Operating the powertrain through various driving conditions
allows the control module to re-learn certain values. The control module must re-learn the following
after a software/calibration update: ^
Fuel trim correction
^ Idle Air Control (IAC) learned position
^ Automatic transmission shift adapts
Other learned values only re-learn by performing a service procedure.
If a control module is replaced the following service procedures may need to be performed: ^
The crankshaft variation learn procedure
^ The engine oil life reset procedure
^ The idle learn procedure
^ The inspection/maintenance complete system set procedure
^ The vehicle theft deterrent password learn procedure
^ The Throttle Position (TP) sensor learn procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3912
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3913
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3914
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3915
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3916
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3917
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3918
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3919
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3920
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3921
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3922
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3923
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3924
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3925
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3926
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3927
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3928
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3929
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3930
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3931
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3932
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3933
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3934
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3935
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3936
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3937
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3938
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3939
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3940
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3941
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3942
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3943
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3944
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3945
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Disconnect the MAF sensor harness connector.
3. Release the air cleaner cover retainer clips.
NOTE: ^
Handle the MAF sensor carefully.
^ Do not drop the MAF sensor in order to prevent damage to the MAF sensor.
^ Do not damage the screen located on the air inlet end of the MAF.
^ Do not touch the sensing elements.
^ Do not allow solvents and lubricants to come in contact with the sensing elements.
^ Use a small amount of a soap based solution in order to aid in the installation.
4. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct from the MAF sensor by loosening the hose clamp.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3946
5. Disconnect the air cleaner cover from the front of the MAF sensor by loosening the hose clamp.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Point the flow arrows on the MAF sensor away from the air cleaner.
1. Attach the MAF sensor to the air cleaner cover by tightening the hose clamp.
Tighten Tighten the clamp to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
2. Attach the air cleaner outlet duct to the MAF sensor by tightening the hose clamp.
Tighten Tighten the clamp to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3947
3. Install the air cleaner cover by fastening the air cleaner cover retainer clips.
4. Connect the MAF sensor harness connector.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3953
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3954
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3955
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3956
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3957
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3958
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3959
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3960
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3961
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3962
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3963
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3964
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3965
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3966
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3967
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3968
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3969
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3970
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3971
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3972
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3973
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3974
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3975
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3976
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3977
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3978
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3979
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3980
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3981
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3982
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3983
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3984
Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3985
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
The CMP sensor is a hall-effect sensor located in the ignition distributor base, and uses the same
type of circuits as the CKP sensor. The CMP sensor signal is a digital ON/OFF pulse, output once
per revolution of the camshaft. The CMP sensor information is used by the PCM to determine the
position of the valve train relative to the CKP.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3986
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3987
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Disconnect the spark plug wires and ignition coil wire from the
distributor.
3. Disconnect the camshaft position (CMP) sensor harness connector from the distributor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3988
4. Remove the distributor cap screws.
5. Remove the distributor cap.
6. Remove the rotor screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3989
7. Remove the rotor.
8. Align the square slot in the reluctor wheel with the CMP sensor.
9. Remove the CMP screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3990
10. Remove the CMP sensor.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: Do not use the old cap, CMP sensor, and rotor screws. Use the replacement screws
that have been coated with a thread locking compound.
1. Insert the CMP sensor through the reluctor wheel slot.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install new CMP mounting screws.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 2.2 N.m (19 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3991
3. Install the rotor onto the reluctor wheel.
4. Install new rotor screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3992
5. Install the distributor cap.
6. Install new distributor cap screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2.4 N.m (21 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3993
7. Connect the CMP sensor harness connector.
8. Connect the spark plug wires and ignition coil wire. 9. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 15 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3997
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3998
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3999
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4000
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Drain the cooling system. 2. Remove the engine cover.
3. Remove the coolant temperature sensor electrical connector from the electrical harness at the
intake manifold. 4. Remove the coolant temperature sensor electrical connector from the intake
manifold bracket. 5. Remove the coolant temperature sensor from the cylinder head.
Installation Procedure
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the coolant temperature sensor to the cylinder head.
Tighten the sensor to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
2. Snap the coolant temperature sensor electrical connector to the intake manifold bracket. 3.
Connect the coolant temperature sensor electrical connector to the wiring harness at the intake
manifold. 4. Install the engine cover. 5. Fill the cooling system with coolant.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Crankshaft Position Sensor: > 02-06-04-059 > Dec > 02 > Engine Controls - Engine Runs Rough/MIL
ON/DTC's Set
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Customer Interest Engine Controls - Engine Runs Rough/MIL
ON/DTC's Set
File In Section: 06 - Engine/Propulsion System
Bulletin No.: 02-06-04-059
Date: December, 2002
TECHNICAL
Subject: Engine Runs Rough, Service Engine Soon Light On, DTC's P0300 or P0335 Set (Shim
Crankshaft Sensor)
Models: 2002-03 Chevrolet Astro, Blazer, Express, Silverado and S-10 Truck Models 2002-03
GMC Jimmy, Safari, Savana, Sierra and Sonoma Truck Models with 4.3L V-6 Engine (VINs W, X RPOs L35, LU3)
Condition
Some owners may comment on a rough running condition or a Service Engine Soon (SES) light
being illuminated. Upon investigation, the technician may find a DTC code P0300 or P0335.
Cause
The crankshaft sensor may be contacting the reluctor wheel.
Correction
Remove the crankshaft sensor. Refer to the Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement procedure in
the Engine Controls-4.3L sub-section of the Service Manual. After removing the sensor, inspect the
end of it for witness marks that would indicate contact with the crankshaft. If contact with the
reluctor ring is indicated, then inspect the front cover for cracking or other signs of alignment
concerns. If the inspection indicates that the cover is causing mis-alignments, replace the cover. If
replacing the cover, then the 0.5 mm shim is not needed.
If the inspection of the front cover indicates that the cover is not the cause of mis-alignments, then
the sensor should be shimmed. Add one shim between the sensor and the front cover. If the
concern still exists, then add the second shim. Unless the sensor has been rubbed through the
casing or deformed by contact with the crankshaft, it should not be replaced.
In either case, the crankshaft relearn procedure should be performed after any repairs.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Crankshaft Position Sensor: > 02-06-04-059 > Dec > 02 > Engine Controls - Engine Runs Rough/MIL
ON/DTC's Set > Page 4009
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Position Sensor: > 02-06-04-059 > Dec > 02 > Engine Controls - Engine Runs
Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set
Crankshaft Position Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Engine Runs
Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set
File In Section: 06 - Engine/Propulsion System
Bulletin No.: 02-06-04-059
Date: December, 2002
TECHNICAL
Subject: Engine Runs Rough, Service Engine Soon Light On, DTC's P0300 or P0335 Set (Shim
Crankshaft Sensor)
Models: 2002-03 Chevrolet Astro, Blazer, Express, Silverado and S-10 Truck Models 2002-03
GMC Jimmy, Safari, Savana, Sierra and Sonoma Truck Models with 4.3L V-6 Engine (VINs W, X RPOs L35, LU3)
Condition
Some owners may comment on a rough running condition or a Service Engine Soon (SES) light
being illuminated. Upon investigation, the technician may find a DTC code P0300 or P0335.
Cause
The crankshaft sensor may be contacting the reluctor wheel.
Correction
Remove the crankshaft sensor. Refer to the Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement procedure in
the Engine Controls-4.3L sub-section of the Service Manual. After removing the sensor, inspect the
end of it for witness marks that would indicate contact with the crankshaft. If contact with the
reluctor ring is indicated, then inspect the front cover for cracking or other signs of alignment
concerns. If the inspection indicates that the cover is causing mis-alignments, replace the cover. If
replacing the cover, then the 0.5 mm shim is not needed.
If the inspection of the front cover indicates that the cover is not the cause of mis-alignments, then
the sensor should be shimmed. Add one shim between the sensor and the front cover. If the
concern still exists, then add the second shim. Unless the sensor has been rubbed through the
casing or deformed by contact with the crankshaft, it should not be replaced.
In either case, the crankshaft relearn procedure should be performed after any repairs.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Position Sensor: > 02-06-04-059 > Dec > 02 > Engine Controls - Engine Runs
Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set > Page 4015
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 4016
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4019
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4020
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4021
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4022
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4023
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4024
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4025
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4026
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4027
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4028
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4029
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4030
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4031
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4032
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4033
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4034
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4035
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4036
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4037
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4038
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4039
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4040
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4041
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4042
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4043
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4044
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4045
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4046
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4047
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4048
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4049
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4050
Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4051
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
The CKP sensor is a three wire sensor based on the magneto resistive principle. A magneto
resistive sensor uses two magnetic pickups between a permanent magnet. As an element such as
a reluctor wheel passes the magnets the resulting change in the magnetic field is used by the
sensor electronics to produce a digital output pulse. The PCM supplies a 12-volt, low reference,
and signal circuit to the CKP sensor. The sensor returns a digital ON/OFF pulse 3 times per
crankshaft revolution for the V6 engine, 4 times for the V8 engine. The CKP sensor reads the
crankshaft mounted reluctor wheel to identify pairs of cylinders at top dead center (TDC).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4052
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > CKP
System Variation Learn Procedure
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair CKP System Variation Learn Procedure
IMPORTANT: For additional diagnostic information, refer to DTC P1336.
1. Install a scan tool. 2. With a scan tool, monitor the powertrain control module (PCM) for
diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs). If other DTCs are set, except DTC P1336,
refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List for the applicable DTC that set.
3. With a scan tool, select the crankshaft position (CKP) variation learn procedure. 4. Observe the
fuel cut-OFF for the engine that you are performing the learn procedure on. 5. The scan tool
instructs you to perform the following:
^ Block the drive wheels.
^ Apply the vehicles parking brake.
^ Cycle the ignition from OFF to ON.
^ Apply and hold the brake pedal.
^ Start and idle the engine.
^ Turn OFF the A/C.
^ Place the vehicles transmission in Park (A/T) or Neutral (M/T).
^ The scan tool monitors certain component signals to determine if all the conditions are met to
continue with the procedure. The scan tool only displays the condition that inhibits the procedure.
The scan tool monitors the following components: CKP sensor activity - If there is a CKP sensor condition, refer to the applicable DTCs that set.
- Camshaft position (CMP) sensor activity - If there is a CMP sensor condition, refer to the
applicable DTCs that set.
- Engine coolant temperature (ECT) - If the ECT is not warm enough, idle the engine until the ECT
reaches the correct temperature.
6. With the scan tool, enable the CKP system variation learn procedure.
IMPORTANT: While the learn procedure is in progress, release the throttle immediately when the
engine starts to decelerate. The engine control is returned to the operator and the engine responds
to throttle position (TP) after the learn procedure is complete.
7. Slowly increase the engine speed to the RPM that you observed. 8. Immediately release the
throttle when fuel cut-OFF is reached. 9. The scan tool displays Learn Status: Learned this ignition.
If the scan tool does NOT display this message and no additional DTCs set, refer to
Symptoms - Engine. If a DTC set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List for the applicable
DTC that set.
10. Turn OFF the ignition for 30 seconds after the learn procedure is completed successfully.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > CKP
System Variation Learn Procedure > Page 4055
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: The CKP System Variation Learn Procedure will need to be performed whenever the
crankshaft position (CKP) sensor is removed or replaced. Refer to CKP System Variation Learn
Procedure.
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. If the vehicle is equipped with the
underbody shield package, then remove the steering linkage shield mounting bolts.
3. Remove the steering linkage shield.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > CKP
System Variation Learn Procedure > Page 4056
4. Disconnect the CKP sensor harness connector.
5. Remove the CKP sensor mounting bolt.
6. Remove the CKP sensor.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > CKP
System Variation Learn Procedure > Page 4057
IMPORTANT: ^
When installing the CKP sensor, make sure the sensor is fully seated before tightening the
mounting bolt. A poorly seated CKP sensor may perform erratically and may set false DTCs.
^ Do not reuse the original O-ring.
1. Replace the CKP sensor O-ring. 2. Lubricate the O-ring with clean engine oil before installing the
CKP sensor.
IMPORTANT: Make sure the CKP sensor mounting surface is clear and free of burrs.
3. Install the CKP sensor.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the CKP sensor mounting bolt.
Tighten Tighten the CKP sensor mounting bolt to 9 N.m (80 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > CKP
System Variation Learn Procedure > Page 4058
5. Connect the CKP sensor harness connector.
6. Install the steering linkage shield.
7. Install the steering linkage shield mounting bolts.
Tighten
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > CKP
System Variation Learn Procedure > Page 4059
Tighten the bolts to 33 N.m (24 lb ft).
8. Lower the Vehicle. 9. Perform the CKP System Variation Learn Procedure. See: Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor
The fuel level sensor consists of a float, a wire float arm, and a ceramic resistor card. The position
of the float arm indicates the fuel level. The fuel level sensor contains a variable resistor which
changes resistance in correspondence with the amount of fuel in the fuel tank. The Powertrain
Control Module ( PCM) sends the fuel level information via the class 2 circuit to the Instrument
Panel Cluster (IPC). This information is used for the IPC fuel gauge and the low fuel warning
indicator, if applicable. The PCM also monitors the fuel level input for various diagnostics.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4063
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the fuel sender assembly. 2. Disconnect the fuel pump electrical connector (5). 3.
Remove the fuel level sensor electrical connector retaining clip (6). 4. Disconnect the fuel level
sensor electrical connector (7) from under the fuel sender cover. 5. Remove the fuel level sensor
retaining clip (4). 6. Squeeze the locking tangs and remove the fuel level sensor (3).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the fuel level sensor (3). 2. Install the fuel level sensor retaining clip (4). 3. Connect the
fuel level sensor electrical connector (7). 4. Connect the fuel level sensor electrical connector
retaining clip (6). 5. Connect the fuel pump electrical connector (5). 6. Install the fuel sender
assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams
Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4067
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
The Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor measures the difference between the pressure or vacuum in
the fuel tank and outside air pressure. The control module provides a 5-volt reference and a ground
to the FTP sensor. The FTP sensor provides a signal voltage back to the control module that can
vary between 0.1 - 4.9 volts. As FTP increases, FTP sensor voltage decreases, high pressure =
low voltage. As FTP decreases, FTP voltage increases, low pressure or vacuum = high voltage.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4068
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4069
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the fuel tank. 2. Remove the fuel tank pressure sensor (1) from the modular fuel sender
(2).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the fuel tank pressure sensor (1) to the modular fuel sender (2). 2. Install the fuel tank.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4073
Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4074
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4075
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE (IAT) SENSOR REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect the intake air temperature (IAT) sensor
harness connector.
3. Remove the IAT sensor from the air cleaner outlet duct by pulling the sensor upward.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4076
1. Install the IAT sensor in the air cleaner outlet duct.
2. Connect the IAT sensor harness connector. 3. Connect the negative battery cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Knock Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4082
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4083
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4084
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4085
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4086
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4087
Knock Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4088
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4089
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4090
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4091
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4092
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4093
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4094
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4095
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4096
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4097
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4098
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4099
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4100
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4101
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4102
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4103
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4104
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4105
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4106
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4107
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4108
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4109
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4110
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4111
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4112
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4113
Knock Sensor (KS)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4114
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
The Knock Sensor (KS) system enables the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to control the
ignition timing advance for the best possible performance while protecting the engine from
potentially damaging levels of detonation. The sensors in the KS system are used by the PCM as
microphones to listen for abnormal engine noise that may indicate pre-ignition/detonation.
SENSOR DESCRIPTION
There are 2 types of KS currently being used: ^
The broadband single wire sensor
^ The flat response 2-wire sensor
Both sensors use piezo-electric crystal technology to produce and send signals to the PCM. The
amplitude and frequency of this signal will vary constantly depending on the vibration level within
the engine. Flat response and broadband KS signals are processed differently by the PCM. The
major differences are outlined below: ^
All broadband sensors use a single wire circuit. Some types of controllers will output a bias voltage
on the KS signal wire. The bias voltage creates a voltage drop the PCM monitors and uses to help
diagnose KS faults. The KS noise signal rides along this bias voltage, and due to the constantly
fluctuating frequency and amplitude of the signal, will always be outside the bias voltage
parameters. Another way to use the KS signals is for the PCM to learn the average normal noise
output from the KS. The PCM uses this noise channel, and KS signal that rides along the noise
channel, in much the same way as the bias voltage type does. Both systems will constantly monitor
the KS system for a signal that is not present or falls within the noise channel.
^ The flat response KS uses a 2-wire circuit. The KS signal rides within a noise channel which is
learned and output by the PCM. This noise channel is based upon the normal noise input from the
KS and is known as background noise. As engine speed and load change, the noise channel upper
and lower parameters will change to accommodate the KS signal, keeping the signal within the
channel. If there is knock, the signal will range outside the noise channel and the PCM will reduce
spark advance until the knock is reduced. These sensors are monitored in much the same way as
the broadband sensors, except that an abnormal signal will stay outside of the noise channel or will
not be present.
KS diagnostics can be calibrated to detect faults with the KS diagnostic inside the PCM, the KS
wiring, the sensor output, or constant knocking from an outside influence such as a loose or
damaged component. In order to determine which cylinders are knocking, the PCM uses KS signal
information when the cylinders are near Top Dead Center (TDC) of the firing stroke.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4115
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4116
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the engine cover. 3. Disconnect the knock
sensor harness connector (3). 4. Remove the knock sensor bolt (1) and knock sensor (2).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the knock sensor (2) and the knock sensor bolt (1).
Tighten Tighten the sender to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
2. Connect the knock sensor harness connector (3). 3. Install the engine cover. 4. Connect the
negative battery cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4120
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4121
Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4122
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4123
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair
MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE (MAP) SENSOR REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Other than checking for a worn grommet and loose electrical connectors, the only service possible
is a unit replacement if the diagnosis shows a malfunctioning manifold absolute pressure (MAP)
sensor.
1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Remove the engine cover. 3. Disconnect the MAP sensor harness
connector.
NOTE: Do not rotate or pry on the MAP sensor when removing. Damage to the MAP sensor or the
intake manifold may result.
4. Remove the MAP sensor by pulling straight up with a slight rocking motion. 5. Remove the MAP
sensor grommet. 6. Discard the MAP sensor grommet.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4124
1. Install the new MAP sensor grommet on the MAP sensor. 2. Install the MAP sensor.
3. Connect the MAP sensor harness connector. 4. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Oil Pressure Sensor: Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure Gage Sensor
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 22 ft. lbs.
Engine Oil Pressure Gage Sensor Fitting (Plus Required Angle)
Torque..................................................................................................................................................
............................................................... 11 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4128
Oil Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
Engine Oil Pressure Sensor and/or Switch Replacement
Tools Required J41712 Oil Pressure Switch Socket
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Disconnect the engine oil pressure sensor gage electrical
connector. 3. Hold the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting with a wrench.
4. Remove the engine oil pressure gage sensor using J41712.
Important: Note the alignment of the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting prior to removal.
5. Remove the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting, if necessary.
Installation Procedure
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting, if removed.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4129
1.1. Tighten the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.).
Important: Do not loosen the sensor fitting. Do not tighten the sensor fitting more than one turn to
align.
1.2. Tighten the sensor fitting until properly aligned.
2. Install the engine oil pressure gage sensor. 3. Hold the engine oil pressure gage sensor fitting
with a wrench to prevent from turning.
Using J41712 tighten the engine oil pressure gage sensor to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
4. Install the engine oil pressure gage sensor electrical connector. 5. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Oxygen Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4135
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4136
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4137
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4138
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4139
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4140
Oxygen Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4141
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4142
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4143
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4144
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4145
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4146
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4147
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4148
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4149
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4150
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4151
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4152
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4153
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4154
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4155
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4156
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4157
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4158
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4159
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4160
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4161
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4162
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4163
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4164
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4165
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4166
Oxygen Sensor: Connector Views
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 1 Sensor 1
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 1 Sensor 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4167
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Bank 2 Sensor 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Heated
Oxygen Sensors
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation Heated Oxygen Sensors
The main function of the pre-catalyst Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) is to provide the (PCM) with
exhaust stream information in order to maintain proper fueling to hold emissions within acceptable
levels. These oxygen sensors are always located between the exhaust manifold and the catalytic
converter. After the sensor reaches the operating temperature, the sensor generates a voltage
inversely proportional to the amount of oxygen present in the exhaust gases.
The PCM uses the signal voltage from the fuel control heated oxygen sensors in a Closed Loop in
order to adjust the fuel injector pulse width. While in a Closed Loop, the PCM can adjust fuel
delivery in order to maintain an air to fuel ratio which allows the best combination of emission
control and driveability.
If the oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal are damaged, replace the entire oxygen
sensor assembly. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, the connector, or the terminals. In order for
the sensor to function properly, the sensor must have a clean air reference provided to it. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor wires. Any attempt to repair the wires,
connectors, or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference. Any attempt to repair
the wires, connectors, or terminals could degrade oxygen sensor performance.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Heated
Oxygen Sensors > Page 4170
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation Oxygen Sensor Diagnosis
Diagnose the fuel control heated oxygen sensors for the following conditions:
^ Heater performance, time to activity on cold start
^ Slow response
^ Response time, time to switch R/L or L/R
^ Inactive signal, output steady at bias voltage - approximately 450 mV
^ Signal fixed high
^ Signal fixed low
Diagnose the catalyst monitor heated oxygen sensors for the following functions:
^ Heater performance, time to activity on cold start
^ Signal fixed low during steady state conditions
^ Inactive sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4171
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor 1
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor
1
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39194-B Oxygen Sensor Wrench
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Vehicle Lifting Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Raise the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Disconnect the connector (1) for the HO2S.
NOTE: Refer to Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Remove the HO2S (2) using a J 39194-B.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: A special anti-seize compound is used on the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S)
threads. The compound consists of liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite tends to burn
away, but the glass beads remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New, or service
replacement sensors already have the compound applied to the threads. If the sensor is removed
from an engine and if for any reason the sensor is to be reinstalled, the threads must have
anti-seize compound applied before the reinstallation.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor 1 > Page 4174
1. Coat the threads of the oxygen sensor with anti-seize compound GM P/N 5613695, if necessary.
NOTE: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the HO2S (2) using a J 39194-B.
Tighten Tighten the sensor to 42 N.m (31 lb ft).
3. Connect the HO2S harness connector (1). 4. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor 1 > Page 4175
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor
2
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39194-B Oxygen Sensor Wrench
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Vehicle Lifting Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Raise the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Disconnect the connector (3) for the HO2S.
NOTE: Refer to Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Remove the HO2S (4) using a J 39194-B.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: A special anti-seize compound is used on the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S)
threads. The compound consists of liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite tends to burn
away, but the glass beads remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New, or service
replacement sensors already have the compound applied to the threads. If the sensor is removed
from an engine and if for any reason the sensor is to be reinstalled, the threads must have
anti-seize compound applied before the reinstallation.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor 1 > Page 4176
1. Coat the threads of the oxygen sensor with anti-seize compound GM P/N 5613695, if necessary.
NOTE: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the HO2S (4) using a J 39194-B.
Tighten Tighten the sensor to 42 N.m (31 lb ft).
3. Connect the HO2S harness connector (3). 4. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor 1 > Page 4177
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 2 Sensor
1
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39194-B Oxygen Sensor Wrench
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Vehicle Lifting Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Raise the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Heated Oxygen and Oxygen Sensor Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Disconnect the connector (2) for the HO2S.
NOTE: Refer to Excessive Force and Oxygen Sensor Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Remove the HO2S (1) using a J 39194-B.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: A special anti-seize compound is used on the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S)
threads. The compound consists of liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite tends to burn
away, but the glass beads remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New, or service
replacement sensors already have the compound applied to the threads. If the sensor is removed
from an engine and if for any reason the sensor is to be reinstalled, the threads must have
anti-seize compound applied before the reinstallation.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) Replacement Bank 1 Sensor 1 > Page 4178
1. Coat the threads of the oxygen sensor with anti-seize compound GM P/N 5813695, if necessary.
NOTE: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the HO2S (1) using a J 39194-B.
Tighten Tighten the sensor to 42 N.m (31 lb ft).
3. Connect the HO2S harness connector (2). 4. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4184
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4185
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4186
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4187
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4188
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4189
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4190
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4191
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4192
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4193
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4194
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4195
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4196
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4197
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4198
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4199
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4200
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4201
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4202
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4203
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4204
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4205
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4206
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4207
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4208
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4209
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4210
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4211
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4212
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4213
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4214
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 4215
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4216
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4217
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Disconnect the throttle position (TP) sensor harness connector.
3. Remove the mounting bolts from the TP sensor.
NOTE: The TP sensor is an electrical component. Do not soak the TP sensor in any liquid cleaner
or solvent, as damage may result.
4. Remove the TP sensor and gasket from the throttle body assembly.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4218
1. With the throttle valve closed, install the TP sensor on the throttle shaft.
Rotate the TP sensor counterclockwise in order to align the mounting holes.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the TP sensor mounting bolts.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Connect the TP sensor harness connector. 4. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Park/Neutral Position Switch Screw
................................................................................................................................................... 3 Nm
(27 inch lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 4222
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams
Automatic Transmission Related Connector End Views
Transmission Range Switch Connector, Wiring Harness Side
Tow/Haul Switch Connector, Column Wiring Harness Side
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 4223
Park/Neutral Position Switch (C1)
Park/Neutral Position Switch (C2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 4224
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Adjustments
Park/Neutral Position Switch Adjustment
Important: ^
The following procedure is for vehicles that have not had the switch removed or replaced. If the
switch has been removed or replaced, refer to Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement for the
proper adjustment procedure.
^ Apply the parking brake.
^ The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) positions only.
^ Check the switch for proper operation. If adjustment is required, proceed as follows:
1. Place the transmission range selector in the N (Neutral) position. 2. With an assistant in the
drivers seat, raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 3. Loosen the park/neutral position switch
mounting bolts. 4. With the vehicle in the N (Neutral) position, rotate the switch while the assistant
attempts to start the engine. 5. Following a successful start, turn the engine off.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
6. Tighten the bolts securing the switch to the transmission.
Tighten the bolts to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Check the switch for proper operation. The engine must start in the P
(Park) or N (Neutral) positions only. 9. Replace the park/neutral position switch if proper operation
can not be achieved.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 4225
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement
^ Tools Required J 41364-A Neutral Position Adjustment Tool
Removal Procedure
1. Apply the parking brake. 2. Shift the transmission into neutral. 3. Raise the vehicle. Refer to
Vehicle Lifting.
4. Remove the nut securing the transmission control lever to the manual shaft. 5. Remove the
transmission control lever from the manual shaft. 6. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the
switch. 7. Remove the bolts securing the park/neutral position switch to the transmission. 8.
Remove the park/neutral position switch from the manual shaft. If the park/neutral position switch
did not slide off the manual shaft, file the outer
edge of the manual shaft in order to remove any burrs.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the switch to the transmission manual shaft by aligning the switch hub flats with the
manual shaft flats.
2. Slide the switch onto the transmission manual shaft until the switch mounting bracket contacts
the mounting bosses on the transmission.
Important: If a new switch is being installed, the switch will come with a positive assurance bracket.
The positive assurance bracket aligns the new switch in it proper position for installation and the
use of neutral position adjustment tool will not be necessary.
3. Install the switch to the transmission with two bolts finger tight.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 4226
4. Position the tool J 41364-A onto the park/neutral position switch. Ensure that the two slots on the
switch where the manual shaft is inserted are
lined up with the lower two tabs on the tool.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
5. Rotate the tool until the upper locator pin on the tool is lined up with the slot on the top of the
switch.
Tighten the bolts securing the switch to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
6. Remove the J 41364-A from the switch. If installing a new switch, remove the positive assurance
bracket at this time. 7. Connect the electrical connectors to the switch.
8. Install the transmission control lever to the manual shaft with the nut.
Tighten the control lever nut to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
9. Lower the vehicle.
10. Check the switch for proper operation. The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral)
positions only. If proper operation of the switch can
not be obtained, replace the switch.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4232
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4233
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4234
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4235
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4236
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4237
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4238
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4239
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4240
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4241
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4242
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4243
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4244
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4245
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4246
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4247
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4248
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4249
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4250
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4251
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4252
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4253
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4254
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4255
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4256
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4257
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4258
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4259
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4260
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4261
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4262
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4263
Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4269
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4270
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4271
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4272
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4273
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4274
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4275
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4276
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4277
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4278
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4279
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4280
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4281
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4282
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4283
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4284
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4285
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4286
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4287
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4288
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4289
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4290
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4291
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4292
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4293
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4294
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4295
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4296
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4297
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4298
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4299
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4300
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4301
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4302
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Disconnect the throttle position (TP) sensor harness connector.
3. Remove the mounting bolts from the TP sensor.
NOTE: The TP sensor is an electrical component. Do not soak the TP sensor in any liquid cleaner
or solvent, as damage may result.
4. Remove the TP sensor and gasket from the throttle body assembly.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4303
1. With the throttle valve closed, install the TP sensor on the throttle shaft.
Rotate the TP sensor counterclockwise in order to align the mounting holes.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the TP sensor mounting bolts.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Connect the TP sensor harness connector. 4. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Park/Neutral Position Switch Screw
................................................................................................................................................... 3 Nm
(27 inch lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4307
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams
Automatic Transmission Related Connector End Views
Transmission Range Switch Connector, Wiring Harness Side
Tow/Haul Switch Connector, Column Wiring Harness Side
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4308
Park/Neutral Position Switch (C1)
Park/Neutral Position Switch (C2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4309
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Adjustments
Park/Neutral Position Switch Adjustment
Important: ^
The following procedure is for vehicles that have not had the switch removed or replaced. If the
switch has been removed or replaced, refer to Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement for the
proper adjustment procedure.
^ Apply the parking brake.
^ The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) positions only.
^ Check the switch for proper operation. If adjustment is required, proceed as follows:
1. Place the transmission range selector in the N (Neutral) position. 2. With an assistant in the
drivers seat, raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 3. Loosen the park/neutral position switch
mounting bolts. 4. With the vehicle in the N (Neutral) position, rotate the switch while the assistant
attempts to start the engine. 5. Following a successful start, turn the engine off.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
6. Tighten the bolts securing the switch to the transmission.
Tighten the bolts to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Check the switch for proper operation. The engine must start in the P
(Park) or N (Neutral) positions only. 9. Replace the park/neutral position switch if proper operation
can not be achieved.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4310
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement
^ Tools Required J 41364-A Neutral Position Adjustment Tool
Removal Procedure
1. Apply the parking brake. 2. Shift the transmission into neutral. 3. Raise the vehicle. Refer to
Vehicle Lifting.
4. Remove the nut securing the transmission control lever to the manual shaft. 5. Remove the
transmission control lever from the manual shaft. 6. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the
switch. 7. Remove the bolts securing the park/neutral position switch to the transmission. 8.
Remove the park/neutral position switch from the manual shaft. If the park/neutral position switch
did not slide off the manual shaft, file the outer
edge of the manual shaft in order to remove any burrs.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the switch to the transmission manual shaft by aligning the switch hub flats with the
manual shaft flats.
2. Slide the switch onto the transmission manual shaft until the switch mounting bracket contacts
the mounting bosses on the transmission.
Important: If a new switch is being installed, the switch will come with a positive assurance bracket.
The positive assurance bracket aligns the new switch in it proper position for installation and the
use of neutral position adjustment tool will not be necessary.
3. Install the switch to the transmission with two bolts finger tight.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4311
4. Position the tool J 41364-A onto the park/neutral position switch. Ensure that the two slots on the
switch where the manual shaft is inserted are
lined up with the lower two tabs on the tool.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
5. Rotate the tool until the upper locator pin on the tool is lined up with the slot on the top of the
switch.
Tighten the bolts securing the switch to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
6. Remove the J 41364-A from the switch. If installing a new switch, remove the positive assurance
bracket at this time. 7. Connect the electrical connectors to the switch.
8. Install the transmission control lever to the manual shaft with the nut.
Tighten the control lever nut to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
9. Lower the vehicle.
10. Check the switch for proper operation. The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral)
positions only. If proper operation of the switch can
not be obtained, replace the switch.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4317
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4318
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4319
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4320
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4321
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4322
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4323
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4324
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4325
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4326
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4327
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4328
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4329
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4330
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4331
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4332
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4333
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4334
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4335
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4336
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4337
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4338
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4339
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4340
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4341
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4342
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4343
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4344
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4345
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4346
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4347
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4348
Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Specifications
Catalytic Converter: Specifications
Catalytic Converter-to-Muffler Nuts
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
................................................. 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4353
Catalytic Converter: Service and Repair
Catalytic Converter Replacement (RWD)
Removal Procedure
Caution: Always wear protective goggles and gloves when removing exhaust parts as falling rust
and sharp edges from worn exhaust components could result in serious personal injury.
Caution: In order to avoid being burned, do not service the exhaust system while it is still hot.
Service the system when it is cool. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion may make removing
exhaust components difficult. Applying a penetrating oil on the threads of the bolts may assist in
the removal of these components.
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Support the catalytic converter assembly.
3. Remove the 3 oxygen sensor electrical connections and clips.
4. Remove the nuts from the muffler flange bolts.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4354
5. Remove the nuts from the exhaust manifold studs (right side). 6. Disconnect the collars from the
exhaust manifold studs (right side).
7. Remove the nuts from the exhaust manifold studs (left side). 8. Disconnect the collars from the
exhaust manifold studs (left side).
9. Remove the catalytic converter assembly from the muffler assembly.
10. Remove the catalytic converter assembly from the exhaust manifolds. 11. Lower the front of the
catalytic converter assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4355
12. Remove the catalytic converter assembly from the hanger.
Notice: Do not damage the oxygen sensors when removing the catalytic converter.
13. Remove the catalytic converter assembly from the vehicle by rotating the assembly over the
rear of the transmission crossmember. 14. Remove the 3 oxygen sensors.
Installation Procedure
When installing exhaust components, inspect the exhaust system for proper alignment. Misaligned
components commonly cause rattles, noise and vibrations in the exhaust system. During system
alignment, leave all of the bolts or nuts loose, until all of the parts are properly aligned. After
properly aligning the parts, tighten the bolts or nuts from the front to the rear. In order to maintain
the alignment of the exhaust system, replace any damaged exhaust system hangers, hanger
brackets, and clamps.
Important: Replacement of exhaust system parts must be OEM standard to ensure that the vehicle operates
as designed.
- When exhaust system service requires removing and replacing an oxygen sensor, refer to the
applicable service procedure.
- Always use new nuts when installing the exhaust pipe to the exhaust manifold.
- Before installing the new nuts, clean the exhaust manifold stud threads with a wire brush.
1. Install the 3 oxygen sensors to the catalytic converter assembly. 2. Install the catalytic converter
assembly to the hanger.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4356
3. Install the collars on the catalytic converter assembly to the exhaust manifold studs (left side). 4.
Loosely install the nuts onto the exhaust manifold studs (left side).
5. Install the collars on the catalytic converter assembly to the exhaust manifold studs (right side).
6. Loosely install the nuts onto the exhaust manifold studs (right side).
7. Connect the catalytic converter assembly and the gasket to the muffler assembly. 8. Loosely
install the nuts.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4357
9. Tighten the exhaust manifold nuts in proper sequence (1-6).
- Tighten the catalytic converter assembly-to-exhaust manifold nuts to 53 Nm (39 ft. lbs.).
- Tighten the catalytic converter assembly-to-muffler assembly nuts to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
10. Install the three oxygen sensor electrical connections and clips. 11. Remove the support from
the catalytic converter assembly. 12. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair
Canister Purge Control Valve: Service and Repair
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) CANISTER PURGE VALVE REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Remove the engine wiring harness bracket from the stud.
3. Disconnect the evaporative emissions (EVAP) canister purge pipe.
4. Disconnect the EVAP canister purge valve harness connector.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4362
5. Remove the EVAP canister purge valve mounting nuts.
6. Remove the EVAP canister purge valve from the intake manifold.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the EVAP canister purge valve to the intake manifold.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4363
2. Install the EVAP canister purge valve mounting nuts.
Tighten Tighten the nuts to 12 N.m (106 lb in).
3. Connect the EVAP canister purge valve harness connector.
4. Connect the EVAP canister purge pipe.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4364
5. Install the engine wiring harness bracket to the stud.
Tighten Tighten the bracket nut to 8 N.m (71 lb in).
6. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Canister Purge Solenoid: Component Locations
Locations View
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4369
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4370
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 4371
Evaporator Emission (EVAP) Canister Purge Solenoid
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 4372
Canister Purge Solenoid: Description and Operation
EVAP VENT VALVE
The EVAP vent valve controls fresh airflow into the EVAP canister. It is a normally open valve. The
control module will command the valve closed during some EVAP tests, allowing the system to be
tested for leaks.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Canister Vent Valve > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Canister Vent Valve > Component Information > Locations > Page 4377
Evaporator Emission (EVAP) Canister Vent Solenoid
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Canister Vent Valve > Component Information > Locations > Page 4378
Canister Vent Valve: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. Remove the evaporative emission
(EVAP) canister vent valve bracket bolt (5) from the vent valve bracket (1). 3. Disconnect the vent
valve harness connector (4) from the vent valve (6). 4. Disconnect the vent pipe (3) from the vent
valve (6). 5. Remove the vent valve. 6. Remove the vent valve from the bracket.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the vent valve on the bracket. 2. Install the EVAP canister vent pipe (3) on the EVAP
canister vent valve (6). 3. Connect the EVAP canister vent valve harness connector (4) to the
EVAP canister vent valve.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the EVAP canister vent valve bracket (1) and the vent valve bracket bolt (5).
Tighten Tighten the retaining bolt to 10 N.m (89 lb in).
5. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emissions Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair > Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Hoses/Pipes
Replacement - Engine
Evaporative Emissions Hose: Service and Repair Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Hoses/Pipes
Replacement - Engine
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: When replacing the evaporative emission (EVAP) pipe, always replace the pipe with
original equipment or parts that meet the GM specifications for this part. The replacement pipe
must have the same type of fittings as the original pipe in order to ensure the integrity of the
connection.
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Clean the pipe connections and the surrounding areas before
disconnecting in order to avoid possible contamination of the EVAP system. 3. Disconnect the
engine compartment EVAP pipe at the EVAP canister purge valve.
4. Disconnect the engine compartment EVAP pipe (1) at the chassis EVAP pipe (2). 5. Remove the
EVAP pipe from the engine. 6. Cap the EVAP canister purge valve and the chassis EVAP pipe in
order to prevent possible EVAP system contamination.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emissions Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair > Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Hoses/Pipes
Replacement - Engine > Page 4383
1. Remove the caps from the EVAP canister purge valve and the chassis EVAP pipe. 2. Install the
EVAP pipe on the engine. 3. Connect the engine compartment EVAP pipe (1) to the chassis EVAP
pipe (2).
4. Connect the engine compartment EVAP pipe at the EVAP canister purge valve. 5. Install the
engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emissions Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair > Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Hoses/Pipes
Replacement - Engine > Page 4384
Evaporative Emissions Hose: Service and Repair EVAP Hoses/Pipes Replacement - Canister/Fuel
Tank
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the fuel tank. 2. Disconnect the EVAP vapor pipe (5) from the EVAP canister (1). 3.
Disconnect the EVAP vapor pipe from the fill limiter vent valve (2). 4. Remove the EVAP vapor
pipe.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Connect the EVAP vapor pipe (5) to the till limiter vent valve (2). 2. Connect the EVAP vapor
pipe to the EVAP canister (1). 3. Install the fuel tank.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emissions Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair > Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Hoses/Pipes
Replacement - Engine > Page 4385
Evaporative Emissions Hose: Service and Repair EVAP Hoses/Pipes Replacement Chassis/Canister
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the fuel tank. 2. Disconnect the rear chassis EVAP purge pipe (3) from the EVAP
canister (1). 3. Remove the rear chassis EVAP purge pipe.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Connect the rear chassis EVAP purge pipe (3) to the EVAP canister (1). 2. Install the fuel tank.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emissions Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair > Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Hoses/Pipes
Replacement - Engine > Page 4386
Evaporative Emissions Hose: Service and Repair EVAP Hoses/Pipes Replacement Engine/Chassis
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Clean all the pipe connections and the surrounding areas before
disconnecting the pipes in order to avoid possible contamination. 3. Disconnect the chassis EVAP
pipe from the engine compartment EVAP purge pipe (9). 4. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and
Jacking the Vehicle. 5. Remove the fuel/EVAP pipes bundle retainer mounting stud (7) from the
cylinder head. 6. Remove the fuel/EVAP pipes bundle retainer mounting stud (6) from the
transmission. 7. Remove the fuel/EVAP pipes bundle retainer mounting fastener (5) from the
crossrail.
8. Disconnect the front chassis EVAP purge pipe from the rear chassis EVAP purge pipe (4). 9.
Note the position of the EVAP pipe for aid in installation.
10. Remove the EVAP pipe from the retaining clips. 11. Remove the EVAP pipe.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT:
^ When replacing the fuel/EVAP pipes, always replace them with original equipment or parts that
meet the GM specifications for those parts. The replacement pipes must have the same type of
fittings as the original pipes in order to ensure the integrity of the connection.
^ Do not use copper or aluminum tubing to replace steel tubing. Only tubing meeting the 124-M
specification or its equivalent is capable of meeting all pressure, corrosion and vibration
characteristics necessary to ensure the durability standard required.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emissions Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair > Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Hoses/Pipes
Replacement - Engine > Page 4387
1. Connect the front chassis EVAP pipe to the rear chassis EVAP purge pipe (4).
2. Install the EVAP pipe into the transmission bracket retainer.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the mounting stud (6).
Tighten Tighten the mounting stud to 33 N.m (24 lb ft).
4. Install the EVAP pipe into the cylinder head retainer. 5. Install the mounting stud (7).
Tighten Tighten the mounting stud to 33 N.m (24 lb ft).
6. Install the EVAP pipe into the crossrail retainer. 7. Install the mounting bolt (5) to the crossrail.
Tighten Tighten the mounting bolt to 11 N.m (97 lb in).
8. Lower the vehicle. 9. Connect the chassis EVAP pipe to the engine compartment EVAP pipe (9).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emissions Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair > Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Hoses/Pipes
Replacement - Engine > Page 4388
10. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative System Service Port > Component Information > Description and Operation
Evaporative System Service Port: Description and Operation
The EVAP service port is located in the EVAP purge pipe between the EVAP purge valve and the
EVAP canister. The service port is identified by a green colored cap.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > Fuel Pressure
Test Port > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Release >
System Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 34730-1A Fuel Pressure Gage
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Gasoline/Gasoline Vapors Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Remove the engine cover.
CAUTION: Refer to Fuel Gage Leak Caution in Service Precautions.
NOTE: Clean all of the following areas before performing any disconnections in order to avoid
possible contamination in the system: ^
The fuel pipe connections
^ The hose connections
^ The areas surrounding the connections
2. Install the J 34730-1A to the fuel pressure service connection. 3. Turn ON the ignition.
CAUTION: Refer to Fuel Storage Caution in Service Precautions.
4. Place the bleed hose of the fuel pressure gage into an approved gasoline container. 5. Open the
bleed valve on the fuel pressure gage in order to bleed the air from the fuel pressure gage. 6.
Command the fuel pump ON with a scan tool. 7. Close the bleed valve on the fuel pressure gage.
8. Inspect for fuel leaks.
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Release >
System Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal > Page 4401
1. Place the fuel pressure gage bleed hose into an approved container and open the bleed valve to
bleed OFF fuel system pressure. 2. Place a shop towel under the J 34730-1A to catch any
remaining fuel spillage. 3. Remove the J 34730-1A from the fuel pressure connection. 4. Drain any
fuel remaining in the fuel pressure gage into an approved container. 5. Inspect for leaks using the
following procedure:
5.1. Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF for 2 seconds.
5.2. Turn OFF the ignition for 10 seconds.
5.3. Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
5.4. Inspect for fuel leaks.
6. Install the cap on the fuel pressure connection. 7. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Release >
System Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal > Page 4402
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair Fuel System Pressure Relief
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 34730-1A Fuel Pressure Gage
CAUTION: Remove the fuel tank cap and relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing the fuel
system in order to reduce the risk of personal injury. After you relieve the fuel system pressure, a
small amount of fuel may be released when servicing the fuel lines, the fuel injection pump, or the
connections. In order to reduce the risk of personal injury, cover the fuel system components with a
shop towel before disconnection. This will catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an
approved container when the disconnection is complete.
1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Disconnect the negative battery cable in order to avoid possible fuel
discharge if an accidental attempt is made to start the engine. 3. Remove the engine cover. 4.
Connect the J 34730-1A or the equivalent to the fuel pressure connection. 5. Wrap a shop towel
around the fitting while connecting the gage in order to avoid spillage. 6. Install the bleed hose of
the gage into an approved container. 7. Open the valve on the gage in order to bleed the system
pressure. The fuel connections are now safe for servicing. 8. Drain any fuel remaining in the gage
into an approved container.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed > System
Information > Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Information not supplied by the manufacturer.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Accelerator Pedal: Service and Repair
ACCELERATOR CONTROLS PEDAL REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Lift upward on the accelerator pedal (3) to relieve tension on the cable (2). 2. Remove the
retainer (1) from the pedal lever (4) hole. 3. Remove cable (2) from the slot in the pedal lever (4). 4.
Remove the accelerator pedal mounting fasteners. 5. Remove the accelerator pedal assembly.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: The accelerator cable is not to be kinked or damaged in any way during installation.
Ensure that the mounting surface between the accelerator pedal assembly and the dash panel is
free of insulation. The carpet and padding in the pedal area must be positioned to lay flat and be
free of wrinkles and bunches. Wire, hoses, cables, and other flexible components should not be
within 13 mm (0.52 in) of the cable or lever, at any point in their travel.
1. Place the accelerator pedal assembly on the mounting surface.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the three mounting bolts.
Tighten Tighten the pedal assembly to 5 N.m (44 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4409
3. Lift upward on the accelerator pedal (3). 4. Insert the cable (2) through the pedal lever slot. 5.
Press the retainer (1) into the lever hole until fully seated.
IMPORTANT: The pedal must operate freely without binding through the full range of pedal
movement.
6. Check the pedal (3) for free movement by pressing down on the pedal.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air
Cleaner Restriction Indicator > Component Information > Description and Operation
Air Cleaner Restriction Indicator: Description and Operation
The air cleaner restriction indicator is located on the intake duct between the air cleaner assembly
and the Mass Air Flow/Intake Air Temperature ( MAF/IAT) sensor.
If the area inside of the clear section is green, no air filter service is required. If the area inside the
clear section is orange and Change Air Filter appears, replace the air filter.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air Filter Element: >
04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: Customer Interest Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air Filter Element: >
04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 4422
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 4428
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4429
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER ELEMENT REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the air cleaner cover by releasing the retainer clips. 2. Remove the air cleaner element.
3. Clear out any debris in the air cleaner tub.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Insert the air cleaner element into the air cleaner tub. 2. Install the air cleaner cover. 3. Fasten
the air cleaner cover retainer clips.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4435
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4436
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4437
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4438
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4439
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4440
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4441
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4442
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4443
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4444
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4445
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4446
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4447
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4448
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4449
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4450
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4451
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4452
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4453
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4454
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4455
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4456
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4457
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4458
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4459
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4460
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4461
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4462
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4463
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4464
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4465
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4466
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4467
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4468
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Disconnect the MAF sensor harness connector.
3. Release the air cleaner cover retainer clips.
NOTE: ^
Handle the MAF sensor carefully.
^ Do not drop the MAF sensor in order to prevent damage to the MAF sensor.
^ Do not damage the screen located on the air inlet end of the MAF.
^ Do not touch the sensing elements.
^ Do not allow solvents and lubricants to come in contact with the sensing elements.
^ Use a small amount of a soap based solution in order to aid in the installation.
4. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct from the MAF sensor by loosening the hose clamp.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4469
5. Disconnect the air cleaner cover from the front of the MAF sensor by loosening the hose clamp.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Point the flow arrows on the MAF sensor away from the air cleaner.
1. Attach the MAF sensor to the air cleaner cover by tightening the hose clamp.
Tighten Tighten the clamp to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
2. Attach the air cleaner outlet duct to the MAF sensor by tightening the hose clamp.
Tighten Tighten the clamp to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4470
3. Install the air cleaner cover by fastening the air cleaner cover retainer clips.
4. Connect the MAF sensor harness connector.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel System - TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline (Canada)
Fuel: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline (Canada)
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 05-06-04-022G
Date: October 27, 2010
Subject: TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Information and Available Brands (Deposits, Fuel
Economy, No Start, Power, Performance, Stall Concerns) - Canada ONLY
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Canada Only)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years and include an additional
gasoline brand as a TOP TIER source. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-06-04-022F
(Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). In the U.S., refer to the latest version of Corporate
Bulletin Number 04-06-04-047I.
A new class of fuel called TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline is appearing at retail stations of some fuel
marketers. This gasoline meets detergency standards developed by six automotive companies. All
vehicles will benefit from using TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline over gasoline containing the "Lowest
Additive Concentration" recommended by the Canadian General Standards Board (CGSB). Those
vehicles that have experienced deposit related concerns may especially benefit from use of TOP
TIER Detergent Gasoline.
Intake valve: 16,093 km (10,000 mi) with TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline
Intake valve: 16,093 km (10,000 mi) with Minimum Additive recommended by the CGSB
Top Tier Fuel Availability
Chevron was the first to offer TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline in Canada. Shell became the first
national gasoline retailer to offer TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline across Canada. Petro-Canada
began offering TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline nationally as of October 1, 2006. Sunoco began
offering TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline in March of 2007. Esso began offering TOP TIER Detergent
Gasoline in May of 2010.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel System - TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline (Canada) > Page 4475
Gasoline Brands That Currently Meet TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Standards
The following gasoline brands meet the TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Standards in all octane
grades :
Chevron Canada (markets in British Columbia and western Alberta)
- Shell Canada (nationally)
- Petro-Canada (nationally)
- Sunoco-Canada (Ontario)
- Esso-Canada (nationally)
What is TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline is a new class of gasoline with enhanced detergency and no
metallic additives. It meets new, voluntary deposit control standards developed by six automotive
companies that exceed the detergent recommendations of Canadian standards and does not
contain metallic additives, which can damage vehicle emission control components.
Where Can TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Be Purchased?
The TOP TIER program began in the U.S. and Canada on May 3, 2004. Some fuel marketers have
already joined and introduced TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline. This is a voluntary program and not
all fuel marketers will offer this product. Once fuel marketers make public announcements, they will
appear on a list of brands that meet the TOP TIER standards.
Who developed TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline standards?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline standards were developed by six automotive companies: BMW,
General Motors, Honda, Toyota, Volkswagen and Audi.
Why was TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline developed?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline was developed to increase the level of detergent additive in
gasoline. In the U.S., government regulations require that all gasoline sold in the U.S. contain a
detergent additive. However, the requirement is minimal and in many cases, is not sufficient to
keep engines clean. In Canada, gasoline standards recommend adherence to U.S. detergency
requirements but do not require it. In fact, many brands of gasoline in Canada do not contain any
detergent additive. In order to meet TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline standards, a higher level of
detergent is needed than what is required or recommended, and no metallic additives are allowed.
Also, TOP TIER was developed to give fuel marketers the opportunity to differentiate their product.
Why did the six automotive companies join together to develop TOP TIER?
All six corporations recognized the benefits to both the vehicle and the consumer. Also, joining
together emphasized that low detergency and the intentional addition of metallic additives is an
issue of concern to several automotive companies.
What are the benefits of TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline will help keep engines cleaner than gasoline containing the "Lowest
Additive Concentration" recommended by Canadian standards. Clean engines help provide optimal
fuel economy and engine performance, and also provide reduced emissions. Also, the use of TOP
TIER Detergent Gasoline will help reduce deposit related concerns.
Who should use TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline?
All vehicles will benefit from using TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline over gasoline containing the
"Lowest Additive Concentration" recommended by Canadian standards. Those vehicles that have
experienced deposit related concerns may especially benefit from use of TOP TIER Detergent
Gasoline. More information on TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline can be found at this website,
http://www.toptiergas.com/.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel System - TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline (Canada) > Page 4476
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel System - TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline (Canada) > Page 4477
Fuel: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - 'TOP TIER' Detergent Gasoline Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-06-04-047I
Date: August 17, 2009
Subject: TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline (Deposits, Fuel Economy, No Start, Power, Performance,
Stall Concerns) - U.S. Only
Models:
2010 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) (U.S. Only) 2003-2010
HUMMER H2 (U.S. Only) 2006-2010 HUMMER H3 (U.S. Only) 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X (U.S. Only)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years and additional sources to the Top Tier
Fuel Retailers list. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-06-04-047H (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System). In Canada, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 05-06-04-022F.
A new class of fuel called TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline is appearing at retail stations of some fuel
marketers. This gasoline meets detergency standards developed by six automotive companies. All
vehicles will benefit from using TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline over gasoline containing the "Lowest
Additive Concentration" set by the EPA. Those vehicles that have experienced deposit related
concerns may especially benefit from the use of TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline.
Intake valve: - 10,000 miles with TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline
Intake valve: - 10,000 miles with Legal Minimum additive
Gasoline Brands That Currently Meet TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Standards
As of August 1, 2009, all grades of the following gasoline brands meet the TOP TIER Detergent
Gasoline Standards:
- Chevron
- Chevron-Canada
- QuikTrip
- Conoco
Phillips 66
- 76
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel System - TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline (Canada) > Page 4478
- Shell
- Shell-Canada
- Entec Stations located in the greater Montgomery, Alabama area.
- MFA Oil Company located throughout Missouri.
- Kwik Trip, Inc. in Minnesota and Wisconsin and Kwik Star convenience stores in Iowa.
The Somerset Refinery, Inc. at Somerset Oil stations in Kentucky.
Aloha Petroleum
- Tri-Par Oil Company
- Turkey Hill Minit Markets
- Texaco
- Petro-Canada
- Sunoco-Canada
- Road Ranger located in Illinois, Indiana, Iowa, Kentucky, Missouri, Ohio and Wisconsin
What is TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline is a new class of gasoline with enhanced detergency. It meets new,
voluntary deposit control standards developed by six automotive companies that exceed the
detergent requirements imposed by the EPA.
Where Can TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Be Purchased?
The TOP TIER program began on May 3, 2004 and many fuel marketers have joined the program
and have introduced TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline. This is a voluntary program and not all fuel
marketers will offer this product. Once fuel marketers make public announcements, they will appear
on a list of brands that meet the TOP TIER standards.
Where Can I find the Latest Information on TOP TIER Fuel and Retailers?
On the web, please visit www.toptiergas.com for additional information and updated retailer lists.
Who developed TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline standards?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline standards were developed by six automotive companies: Audi,
BMW, General Motors, Honda, Toyota and Volkswagen.
Why was TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline developed?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline was developed to increase the level of detergent additive in
gasoline. The EPA requires that all gasoline sold in the U.S. contain a detergent additive. However,
the requirement is minimal and in many cases, is not sufficient to keep engines clean. In order to
meet TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline standards, a higher level of detergent is needed than what is
required by the EPA. Also, TOP TIER was developed to give fuel marketers the opportunity to
differentiate their product.
Why did the six automotive companies join together to develop TOP TIER?
All six corporations recognized the benefits to both the vehicle and the consumer. Also, joining
together emphasized that low detergency is an issue of concern to several automotive companies.
What are the benefits of TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline will help keep engines cleaner than gasoline containing the "Lowest
Additive Concentration" set by the EPA. Clean engines help provide optimal fuel economy and
performance and reduced emissions. Also, use of TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline will help reduce
deposit related concerns.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel System - TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline (Canada) > Page 4479
Fuel: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - E85 Fuel Usage Precautions
Bulletin No.: 05-06-04-035C
Date: July 30, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Usage of E85 Fuels in GM Vehicles
Models: 1997-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2008 HUMMER H2
2006-2008 HUMMER H3 1997-2008 Isuzu NPR Commercial Medium Duty Trucks 2005-2008
Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2008 model year and additional engines with E85
capability. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-06-04-035B (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Customer Interest in E85 Fuel
As the retail price of gasoline increases, some locations in the country are seeing price differentials
between regular gasoline and E85 where E85 is selling for substantially less than regular grade
gasoline. One result of this is that some customers have inquired if they are able to use E85 fuel in
non-E85 compatible vehicles.
Only vehicles designated for use with E85 should use E85 blended fuel.
E85 compatibility is designated for vehicles that are certified to run on up to 85% ethanol and 15%
gasoline. All other gasoline engines are designed to run on fuel that contains no more than 10%
ethanol.
Use of fuel containing greater than 10% ethanol in non-E85 designated vehicles can cause
driveability issues, service engine soon indicators as well as increased fuel system corrosion.
Using E85 Fuels in Non-Compatible Vehicles
General Motors is aware of an increased number of cases where customers have fueled
non-FlexFuel designated vehicles with E85. Fueling non-FlexFuel designated vehicles with E85, or
with fuels where the concentration of ethanol exceeds the ASTM specification of 10%, will result in
one or more of the following conditions:
Lean Driveability concerns such as hesitations, sags and/or possible stalling.
SES lights due to OBD codes.
Fuel Trim codes P0171 and/or P0174.
Misfire codes (P0300).
Various 02 sensor codes.
Disabled traction control or Stability System disabled messages.
Harsh/Firm transmission shifts.
Fuel system and/or engine mechanical component degradation.
Use of fuel containing greater than 10% ethanol in non-E85 designated vehicles can cause
driveability issues, service engine soon indicators as well as increased fuel system corrosion.
If the dealer suspects that a non-FlexFuel designated vehicle brought in for service has been
fueled with E85, the fuel in the vehicle's tank should be checked for alcohol content with tool J
44175. If the alcohol content exceeds 10% the fuel should be drained and the vehicle refilled with
gasoline - preferably one of the Top Tier brands.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel System - TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline (Canada) > Page 4480
Repairs to non-FlexFuel vehicles that have been fueled with E85 are not covered under the terms
of the New Vehicle Warranty.
A complete list of GM's FlexFuel vehicles can be found in this Service Bulletin, or at
www.livegreengoyellow.com.
E85 Compatible Vehicles
The only E85 compatible vehicles produced by General Motors are shown.
Only vehicles that are listed in the E85 Compatible Vehicles section of this bulletin and/or
www.livegreengoyellow.com are E85 compatible.
All other gasoline and diesel engines are NOT E85 compatible.
Use of fuel containing greater than 10% ethanol in non-E85 designated vehicles can cause
driveability issues, service engine soon indicators as well as increased fuel system corrosion.
Repairs to non-FlexFuel vehicles that have been fueled with E85 are not covered under the terms
of the New Vehicle Warranty.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel System - TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline (Canada) > Page 4481
Fuel: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - Top Tier Detergent Gasoline Information
Bulletin No.: 04-06-00-047
Date: June 24, 2004
ADVANCED SERVICE INFORMATION
Subject: Top Tier Detergent Gasoline (Deposits, Fuel Economy, No Start, Power, Performance,
Stall Concerns)
Models: 2005 and Prior All General Motors Passenger Cars and Trucks (U.S. Only)
A new class of gasoline, called Top Tier Detergent Gasoline, will be appearing at retail stations of
some fuel marketers. This gasoline meets detergency standards developed by four automotive
companies. A description of the concept and benefits of Top Tier is provided in the following
question and answer section.
What is Top Tier Detergent Gasoline?
Top Tier Detergent Gasoline is a new class of gasoline with enhanced detergency. It meets new,
voluntary deposit control standards developed by four automotive companies that exceed the
detergent requirements imposed by the EPA.
Who developed Top Tier Detergent Gasoline standards?
Top Tier Detergent Gasoline standards were developed by four automotive companies: BMW,
General Motors, Honda and Toyota.
Why was Top Tier Detergent Gasoline developed?
Top Tier Detergent Gasoline was developed to increase the level of detergent additive in gasoline.
The EPA requires that all gasoline sold in the U.S. contain a detergent additive. However, the
requirement is minimal and in many cases, is not sufficient to keep engines clean. In order to meet
Top Tier Detergent Gasoline standards, a higher level of detergent is needed than what is required
by the EPA. Also, Top Tier was developed to give fuel marketers the opportunity to differentiate
their product.
Why did the four automotive companies join together to develop Top Tier?
All four corporations recognized the benefits to both the vehicle and the consumer. Also, joining
together emphasized that low detergency is an issue of concern to several automotive companies.
What are the benefits of Top Tier Detergent Gasoline?
Top Tier Detergent Gasoline will help keep engines cleaner than gasoline containing the "Lowest
Additive Concentration" set by the EPA. Clean engines help provide optimal fuel economy and
performance and reduced emissions. Also, use of Top Tier Detergent Gasoline will help reduce
deposit related concerns.
Who should use Top Tier Detergent Gasoline?
All vehicles will benefit from using Top Tier Detergent Gasoline over gasoline containing the
"Lowest Additive Concentration" set by the EPA. Those vehicles that have experienced deposit
related concerns may especially benefit from use of Top Tier Detergent Gasoline.
Where can Top Tier Detergent Gasoline be purchased?
The Top Tier program began on May 3, 2004. Some fuel marketers have already joined and are
making plans to introduce Top Tier Detergent Gasoline. This is a voluntary program and not all fuel
marketers will offer this product. Once fuel marketers make public announcements, a list of all fuel
marketers meeting Top Tier standards will be made available. For now, look for the "Top Tier"
designation at the gas pump.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4482
Fuel: Description and Operation
FUEL SYSTEM SPECIFICATIONS
Use regular unleaded gasoline rated at 87 octane or higher. The manufacturer recommends that
the gasoline meet the specifications which have been developed by the American Automobile
Manufacturers Association (AAMA) and endorsed by the Canadian Motor Vehicle Manufacturers
Association for better vehicle performance and engine protection. Gasoline meeting the AAMA
specification may provide improved driveability and emission control system performance
compared to other gasoline. For more information, write to: American Automobile Manufacturer's
Association, 7430 Second Ave., Suite 300, Detroit, MI, 48202.
Be sure the posted octane is at least 87. If the octane is less than 87, you may get a heavy
knocking noise when you drive. Severe knocking may damage your engine.
If you are using fuel rated at 87 octane or higher and you hear heavy knocking, your engine needs
service. Do not worry if you hear a little pinging noise when you are accelerating or driving up a hill.
This is normal and you do not have to buy a higher octane fuel to get rid of pinging. Only the heavy,
constant knock means that you have a problem.
NOTE: Your vehicle was not designed for fuel that contains methanol. Do not use methanol fuel
which can corrode metal parts in your fuel system and also damage plastic and rubber parts. This
kind of damage would not be covered under your warranty.
If your vehicle is certified to meet California emission standards, indicated on the underhood
emission control label, is designed to operate on fuels that meet California specifications. If such
fuels are not available in states adopting California emission standards, your vehicle operates
satisfactorily on fuels meeting federal specifications, but emission control system performance may
be affected. The Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) on your instrument panel may turn ON, and your
vehicle may fail a smog-check test. If this occurs, return to your authorized dealer for diagnosis in
order to determine the cause of failure. If the type of fuel you used caused the condition, repairs
may not be covered by your warranty. Some gasolines that are not reformulated for low emissions
may contain an octane-enhancing additive called Methylcyclopentadienyl Manganese Tricarbonyl
(MMT). Ask your service station operator whether or not the fuel contains MMT.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection > With Special Tool
Fuel: Testing and Inspection With Special Tool
TEST DESCRIPTION
Fuel quality can effect vehicle performance. Gasoline and gasoline blends that are contaminated or
contain excessive amounts of alcohol can effect vehicle driveability, fuel economy, fuel system
components and emissions. Excessive alcohol in the fuel may cause fuel system corrosion,
deterioration of rubber components, and subsequent fuel filter restriction. Some types of alcohol
are more detrimental to fuel system components than others. Ethanol is commonly used in
gasoline, but in concentrations of no more than 10 percent. Some fuels, such as E85, contain a
very high percentage of ethanol. Fuel with more than 10 percent ethanol may cause driveability
conditions in vehicles such as hesitation, lack of power, stalling, or no start. If excessive alcohol in
the fuel is suspected, then use the following procedure to test the fuel quality.
TEST PROCEDURE
1. Turn ON the J 44175 Fuel Composition Tester. 2. Verify that the fuel composition tester is
operational by measuring the AC frequency output with a DMM. Refer to Measuring Frequency in
Diagnostic Aids. A frequency without a fuel sample in the test cell indicates that the tester is
working correctly.
3. Install the fuel pressure gage. Refer to Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal.
IMPORTANT: Bleed the fuel pressure gage a few times in order to obtain an accurate fuel sample
from the vehicle being tested.
4. Close the bleed valve on the fuel pressure gage. 5. Place the bleed hose (1) of the fuel pressure
gage into the 100 ml beaker (2). 6. Command the fuel pump ON with a scan tool. 7. Slowly open
the bleed valve on the fuel pressure gage, until an adequate fuel sample is obtained.
8. If water appears in the fuel sample, clean the fuel system and replace the fuel in the vehicle.
Refer to Fuel System Cleaning.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection > With Special Tool > Page 4485
IMPORTANT: DO NOT allow any substances other than gasoline, ethanol/gasoline blends, air, or
acetone into the test ports of the fuel composition tester. Contaminants in the J 44175 could result
in misdiagnosis.
9. Pour the fuel sample from the beaker (1) into the J 44175, until the level of the fuel is at the top
of each fuel test port (2).
10. Observe the diagnostic LEDs on the fuel composition tester.
If the red fuel diagnostic LED is illuminated, a fuel contamination condition exists. Refer to Fuel
System Cleaning.
11. Measure the output frequency of the fuel composition tester.
Alcohol/Contaminants-in-Fuel Diagnosis (With Special Tool)
12. Subtract 50 from the reading on the DMM to obtain the percentage of alcohol in the fuel
sample. Refer to the examples in the table. 13. If the fuel sample contains more than 10 percent
ethanol, replace the fuel in the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection > With Special Tool > Page 4486
Fuel: Testing and Inspection Without Special Tool
Water contamination in the fuel system may cause driveability conditions such as hesitation,
stalling, no start, or misfires in one or more cylinders. Water may collect near a single fuel injector
at the lowest point in the fuel meter body assembly, and cause a misfire in that cylinder. If the fuel
system is contaminated with water, inspect the fuel system components for rust, or deterioration.
Alcohol concentrations of more than 10 percent in fuel can be detrimental to fuel system
components. Alcohol contamination may cause fuel system corrosion, deterioration of rubber
components, and subsequent fuel filter restriction. Fuel contaminated with alcohol may cause
driveability conditions such as hesitation, lack of power, stalling, or no start. Some types of alcohol
are more detrimental to fuel system components than others.
Alcohol In Fuel Testing Procedure The fuel sample should be drawn from the bottom of the tank so
that any water present in the tank will be detected. The sample should be bright and clear. If
alcohol contamination is suspected then use the following procedure to test the fuel quality. 1.
Using a 100 ml (3.38 oz) specified cylinder with 1 ml (0.034 oz) graduation marks, fill the cylinder
with fuel to the 90 ml (3.04 oz) mark. 2. Add 10 ml (0.34 oz) of water in order to bring the total fluid
volume to 100 ml (3.38 oz) and install a stopper. 3. Shake the cylinder vigorously for 10-15
seconds. 4. Carefully loosen the stopper in order to release the pressure. 5. Re-install the stopper
and shake the cylinder vigorously again for 10-15 seconds. 6. Put the cylinder on a level surface for
approximately 5 minutes in order to allow adequate liquid separation.
If alcohol is present in the fuel, the volume of the lower layer which would now contain both alcohol
and water, will be more than 10 ml (0.34 oz). For example, if the volume of the lower layer is
increased to 15 ml (0.51 oz), this indicates at least 5 percent alcohol in the fuel. The actual amount
of alcohol may be somewhat more because this procedure does not extract all of the alcohol from
the fuel.
Particulate Contaminants In Fuel Testing Procedure The fuel sample should be drawn from the
bottom of the tank so that any water present in the tank will be detected. The sample should be
bright and clear. If the sample appears cloudy, or contaminated with water, as indicated by a water
layer at the bottom of the sample, use the following procedure to diagnose the fuel. 1. Using an
approved fuel container, draw approximately 0.5 liter (0.53 qt) of fuel. 2. Place the cylinder on a
level surface for approximately 5 minutes in order to allow settling of the particulate contamination.
3. Particulate contamination will show up in various shapes and colors. Sand will typically be
identified by a white or light brown crystals. Rubber
will appear as black and irregular particles.
4. Observe the fuel sample. If any physical contaminants or water are present, clean the fuel
system. Refer to Fuel System Cleaning.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection > Page 4487
Fuel: Service and Repair
FUEL SYSTEM CLEANING
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the fuel tank. 2. Remove the fuel sender assembly. 3. Inspect the fuel pump strainer.
Replace a contaminated strainer and inspect the fuel pump. 4. Inspect the fuel pump inlet for dirt
and debris. Replace the fuel pump if you find dirt or debris in the fuel pump inlet.
IMPORTANT: When flushing the fuel tank, handle the fuel and water mixture as a hazardous
material. Handle the fuel and water mixture in accordance with all applicable local, state and
federal laws and regulations.
5. Flush the fuel lank with hot water. 6. Pour the water out of the fuel sender assembly opening. 7.
Rock the fuel tank to be sure that the removal of water from tank is complete. 8. Inspect the in-line
fuel filter for contamination. 9. Replace the fuel filter if the filter is plugged.
IMPORTANT: Only use oil free compressed air to blow out the fuel pipes.
10. Clean the fuel pipes by applying air pressure in the opposite direction of the fuel flow. 11. Install
the fuel sender assembly with a new seal into the fuel tank. 12. Install the fuel tank.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filler Cap > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Filler Cap: Description and Operation
NOTE: If a fuel tank filler cap requires replacement, use only a fuel tank filler cap with the same
features. Failure to use the correct fuel tank filler cap can result in a serious malfunction of the fuel
and EVAP system.
Fuel Filler Cap
The fuel fill pipe has a tethered fuel filler cap. A torque-limiting device prevents the cap from being
over-tightened. To install the cap, turn the cap clockwise until you hear audible clicks. This
indicates that the cap is correctly torqued and fully seated. A fuel filler cap that is not fully seated
may cause a malfunction in the emission system.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure
Release > System Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 34730-1A Fuel Pressure Gage
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Gasoline/Gasoline Vapors Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Remove the engine cover.
CAUTION: Refer to Fuel Gage Leak Caution in Service Precautions.
NOTE: Clean all of the following areas before performing any disconnections in order to avoid
possible contamination in the system: ^
The fuel pipe connections
^ The hose connections
^ The areas surrounding the connections
2. Install the J 34730-1A to the fuel pressure service connection. 3. Turn ON the ignition.
CAUTION: Refer to Fuel Storage Caution in Service Precautions.
4. Place the bleed hose of the fuel pressure gage into an approved gasoline container. 5. Open the
bleed valve on the fuel pressure gage in order to bleed the air from the fuel pressure gage. 6.
Command the fuel pump ON with a scan tool. 7. Close the bleed valve on the fuel pressure gage.
8. Inspect for fuel leaks.
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure
Release > System Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal > Page 4496
1. Place the fuel pressure gage bleed hose into an approved container and open the bleed valve to
bleed OFF fuel system pressure. 2. Place a shop towel under the J 34730-1A to catch any
remaining fuel spillage. 3. Remove the J 34730-1A from the fuel pressure connection. 4. Drain any
fuel remaining in the fuel pressure gage into an approved container. 5. Inspect for leaks using the
following procedure:
5.1. Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF for 2 seconds.
5.2. Turn OFF the ignition for 10 seconds.
5.3. Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
5.4. Inspect for fuel leaks.
6. Install the cap on the fuel pressure connection. 7. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure
Release > System Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pressure Gage Installation and Removal > Page 4497
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair Fuel System Pressure Relief
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 34730-1A Fuel Pressure Gage
CAUTION: Remove the fuel tank cap and relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing the fuel
system in order to reduce the risk of personal injury. After you relieve the fuel system pressure, a
small amount of fuel may be released when servicing the fuel lines, the fuel injection pump, or the
connections. In order to reduce the risk of personal injury, cover the fuel system components with a
shop towel before disconnection. This will catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an
approved container when the disconnection is complete.
1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Disconnect the negative battery cable in order to avoid possible fuel
discharge if an accidental attempt is made to start the engine. 3. Remove the engine cover. 4.
Connect the J 34730-1A or the equivalent to the fuel pressure connection. 5. Wrap a shop towel
around the fitting while connecting the gage in order to avoid spillage. 6. Install the bleed hose of
the gage into an approved container. 7. Open the valve on the gage in order to bleed the system
pressure. The fuel connections are now safe for servicing. 8. Drain any fuel remaining in the gage
into an approved container.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 99066F > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Fuel Injector Sticking Closed
Fuel Injector: Recalls Campaign - Fuel Injector Sticking Closed
File In Section: 06-Engine Emissions
Bulletin No.: 99066F
Date: March, 2003
SPECIAL POLICY
SUBJECT: 99066F - SPECIAL POLICY ADJUSTMENT - SEQUENTIAL CENTRAL PORT FUEL
INJECTION (SCPI) FAILURES IN CALIFORNIA ONLY (YF5 EMISSION EQUIPPED)
MODELS: CERTAIN 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 S/T, M/L, C/K, G, P, W4/NPR
TRUCKS AND 2003 NPR TRUCKS EQUIPPED WITH 4.3L (RPO L35 - VIN CODE W OR RPO
LF6 - VIN CODE X), 5.0L (RPO L30 - VIN CODE M) OR 5.7L (RPO L31 - VIN CODE R) ENGINE
AND CALIFORNIA EMISSION EQUIPPED (RPO YF5)
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2002 and 2003 model years to the SCPI Special Policy on
certain S/T, M/L, C/K, G, P and W4/NPR truck models. Please discard Special Policy Bulletin
Number 99066E, dated February, 2003.
CONDITION
Some customers of 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 model year S/T, M/L, C/K, G, P,
W4/NPR trucks and 2003 NPR trucks, that are registered in California, equipped with 4.3L (RPO
L35 and VIN Code W, or RPO LF6 and VIN Code X), 5.0L (RPO L30 and VIN Code M) or 5.7L
(RPO L31 and VIN Code R) engine, and California emissions (RPO YF5), may experience a
"Service Engine Soon" light, misfire, rough idle or hard start due to a deposit build-up on the
Sequential Central Port Fuel Injector (SCPI) poppet valve(s). The deposit build-up may cause
injector poppets to stick closed. Certain fuels have been found to interact with the SCPI system to
cause the deposits.
SPECIAL POLICY ADJUSTMENT
This special policy covers the SCPI failure condition described above for a period of ten (10) years
or 200,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the date the vehicle was originally placed in service,
regardless of ownership.
The repairs will be made at no charge to the owner. This special policy applies ONLY to repairs
requiring SCPI system servicing, injector cleaning and/or MFI assembly replacement of the SCPI
system. The customer should not be charged for performing a system check when it is determined
that the SCPI system is not the cause of a customer complaint (labor operation T5532 is provided
to submit claims for such system checks). Any additional necessary diagnosis and repairs that are
not related to the SCPI condition are not covered by this special policy. The customer should be
informed that any further service that is not covered by new vehicle warranty will not be covered by
this policy.
VEHICLES INVOLVED
Involved are certain 1996,1997,1998,1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 S/T, M/L, C/K, G, P, W4/NPR and
2003 NPR model vehicles, registered in California, equipped with 4.3L (RPO L35 - VIN Code W, or
RPO LF6 - VIN Code X), 5.0L (RPO L30 - VIN Code M) or 5.7L (RPO L31 - VIN Code R) engine;
and California emissions (RPO YF5). This Special Policy covers all vehicles within these model
years, with these engine and emissions RPO's.
PARTS INFORMATION
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 99066F > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Fuel Injector Sticking Closed >
Page 4506
Parts required to complete this special policy are to be obtained from General Motors Service Parts
Operations (GMSPO). Please refer to your "involved vehicles listing" prior to ordering parts. Normal
orders should be placed on a DRO Daily Replenishment Order. In an emergency, parts should be
ordered on a CSO = Customer Special Order.
IMPORTANT:
Isuzu Parts Ordering: In order to comply with the 10-digit Isuzu part numbering system, Isuzu
dealers must add an "8" to the beginning and a "0" to the end of the listed 8-digit part numbers
when ordering parts through AIPDN.
CUSTOMER NOTIFICATION
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 99066F > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Fuel Injector Sticking Closed >
Page 4507
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 99066F > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Fuel Injector Sticking Closed >
Page 4508
Customers will be notified of this special policy on their vehicles by General Motors (see copy of
typical customer letter included with this bulletin - actual divisional letter may vary slightly).
SERVICE PROCEDURE
System Check: Use strategy-based diagnoses listed in the front of the Driveability and Emissions
section of the service manual. If the SCPI system is operating properly, inform the customer that
the vehicle does not have the condition listed in the owner letter. If poor driveability conditions
persist, inform the customer that any further diagnosis and repairs will be at their expense if the
vehicle is outside the parameters of the new vehicle warranty.
SCPI Injector Cleaning Procedure: If diagnosis leads to sticking poppet nozzles, use the service
procedure from Service Bulletin 00-06-04-003B to clean the SCPI poppet nozzles. Please note that
the service bulletin term for SCPI is Central Sequential Fuel Injection (CSFI), but is referring to the
same fuel system assembly. If the poppet nozzles have previously been cleaned and the sticking
condition has reoccurred, refer to the correction paragraph below.
SCPI Fuel Tank Fill Pipe Assembly for 1997-99 M/L Van and 1999 - some 2000 C/K Truck: with
4.3L, 5.0L, 5.7L engines and built prior to listed VIN/Production dates on Service Bulletin
00-06-04-018: If diagnosis leads to sticking poppet nozzles on these models, use the service
procedure from Service Bulletin 00-06-04-018 to replace the fuel tank fill pipe assembly, if this
procedure has not been performed previously. Previous service procedure can be verified by
checking GMVIS for Labor Operation L1065 on "M/L" trucks with replacement part number
15050573; or Labor Operation L1065 on "C/K" trucks with replacement part numbers 15747585 or
15747588.
Correction: If, after cleaning the SCPI poppet nozzles, the normal service manual diagnosis still
indicates that the SCPI is the cause of the customer complaint, or if the injectors have previously
been cleaned and the vehicle has again experienced sticking poppet nozzles, refer to Service
Bulletin 00-06-04-003B and replace the SCPI fuel assembly with the MFI fuel assembly. Please
note that the service bulletin term for SCPI is Central Sequential Fuel Injection (CSFI), but is
referring to the same fuel system assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 99066F > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Fuel Injector Sticking Closed >
Page 4509
CLAIM INFORMATION
For vehicles repaired under this special policy, submit a claim with the information indicated.
CUSTOMER REIMBURSEMENT
Customer requests for reimbursement are for any previously paid repairs to, or replacement of, the
Sequential Central Port Fuel Injection (SCPI) system. Repairs must have occurred within 10 years
of the date the vehicle was originally placed in service, or 200,000 miles, whichever occurs first.
The requests are to be submitted within two (2) years of the date on which the repair was paid or
within two (2) years of the date of this Special Policy Bulletin, whichever is greater.
When a customer requests reimbursement, they must provide the following:
- Proof of ownership at time of repair.
- Original paid receipt confirming the amount of unreimbursed repair expense(s) (including Service
Contract deductibles), a description of the repair, and the person or entity performing the repair.
Customers from the State of California, must submit requests for reimbursement directly to
(Divisions) per instructions in the owner letter.
If the work was done by someone other than a GM dealership, the amount of reimbursement will
be limited to the amount that the repair would have cost GM to have it completed by a GM
dealership.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough
Idle on Start-Up
Technical Service Bulletin # 00-06-04-003B Date: 030201
Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up
File In Section: 06 - Engine/Propulsion System
Bulletin No.: 00-06-04-003B
Date: February, 2003
TECHNICAL
Subject: Rough Idle After Start, And/Or A Service Engine Soon (SES) Light (Unstick And Clean
Central Sequential Fuel Injection (CSFI) Poppet Valves or Convert to MFI)
Models: 1995-2002 Chevrolet and GMC S/T Models 1996-2002 Chevrolet and GMC C/K, M/L, G, P
Models 1996-2001 Oldsmobile Bravada 1999-2000 Cadillac Escalade with 4.3L, 5.0L or 5.7L
Engine (VINS W, X, M, R - RPOs L35, LF6, L30, L31) Except 2002 VIN X - RPO LU3 Models
This bulletin is being revised to update the Warranty Information. Please discard previous copies of
Corporate Bulletin Number 00-06-04-003B with warranty chart (Section 06 - Engine). This copy is
for Dealers in the state of CALIFORNIA ONLY.
Condition
Some customers may comment on rough idle after start-up, especially if the vehicle has sat
overnight. These symptoms may be intermittent. The Service Engine Soon (SES) light may also be
illuminated. Current misfire or history misfire codes may be detected with the Tech 2 scan tool.
Cause
A deposit build-up on the CSFI poppet valve ball and/or seat may cause the poppet ball to stick
open or closed. In either case, the specific cylinder will be mis-fueled, resulting in a cylinder mis-fire
condition.
Correction
A new injector unsticking and cleaning process has proven to be effective in restoring poppet
valves to an "as new" condition. CSFI injector replacement should NOT be considered as a
correction for this customer concern.
Check the vehicle history to determine if the vehicle is returning for a second fuel system repair for
this condition. If the fuel system has been repaired for this condition previously, then inform the
customer that an alternate fix is available. A new MFI fuel system has been developed that will
back service the CSFI fuel system. The MFI fuel system eliminates the CSFI poppet valve ball and
seat. The CSFI fuel system will need to be replaced as a unit. Refer to Central SFI to MFI
Conversion instructions in this bulletin.
Notice:
Individual CSFI injectors can not be replaced with MFI injectors. The entire CSFI fuel meter body
will need to be replaced. The bracket used to retain the injectors in the fuel meter body is different
between the CSFI and MFI unit. The unit may not seal if you mix injectors. Severe engine damage
could result.
Cleaning the CSFI injectors is the preferred repair. The CSFI unit should not be replaced until
cleaning has been attempted. If the vehicle should return for the same repair, then the CSFI unit
can be replaced with an MFI unit. If the vehicle is out of warranty, the customer should be given the
option of which fix to pursue.
Important:
"GM of Canada" dealers require District Service Manager approval prior to replacing the CSFI unit
with a MFI unit under warranty.
The first step of this process is to use the J 41413 Evap Pressure/Purge Station, in conjunction with
the J 44466-10 pressure regulator/hose assembly, to provide the required high pressure (150 psi)
source to perform the unsticking procedure. The J 39021 fuel injector tester and accessories
provide the means to "energize" the injector. Some later model-year vehicles may utilize the Tech
2(R) to "energize" the injectors.
The second step of this process is to run the engine on a solution of 10% Top Engine Cleaner and
90% gasoline. This will effectively clean any deposits from the ball and seats of the poppets. It is
very important that the engine fuel system is separated from the vehicle fuel system. Top Engine
Cleaner may have detrimental effects on the fuel pump.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough
Idle on Start-Up > Page 4515
Parts Information
Cleaning Procedure Parts
CSFI to MFI Conversion Parts
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
Important:
Some California vehicles may be covered by Special Policy 99066E if built with California
Emissions RPO YF5. If the vehicle is covered by the special policy, then that warranty information
should be used.
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use information contained in Special Policy 99066E.
Information
This procedure should be performed before any attempt to convert the fuel system to MFI.
S/T and C/K Truck
1. Loosen the fuel filler cap to relieve vapor pressure in the fuel tank.
2. Remove the Positive Crankcase Ventilation (PCV) clean air tube from the air inlet tube and set
aside.
3. Remove the bonnet and inlet tube from the throttle body.
4. Remove the brake booster vacuum hose and connector from the intake manifold.
5. Remove the electrical connector from the CSFI fuel metering body.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough
Idle on Start-Up > Page 4516
6. Remove ignition wires 1, 3, 5, and 7 from the distributor cap.
7. Remove the fuel line bolt (4) at the rear of the intake manifold.
8. Relieve the fuel system pressure at the service fitting on the fuel line. Use a shop towel to
contain any fuel that may exit the service fitting.
9. Remove the nuts (1) and clamp (2) from the fuel pipe.
10. Remove the fuel pipes from the metering body. Be careful not to disturb the O-rings, washer,
and spacer in the metering body.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough
Idle on Start-Up > Page 4517
11. Install the J 44466-12 (2) and the J 44466-13 (1) to the metering body and tighten. Make sure
that the fuel pipe 0-rings, washer, and spacers are present and in their proper position.
12. Install the J 44466-11 (4), clamp (2), and J 44466-13 (1) to the fuel pipe and tighten.
13. Obtain the J 41413, close the valve (2) on the tank, and remove the regulator assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough
Idle on Start-Up > Page 4518
14. Install the J 44466-10 (5) to the J 41413 tank (3). The J 44466-10 regulator is preset to 150 psi.
15. Connect the J 44466-10 hose (1) to the J 44466-12 (3).
16. Install the J 39021 Injector/Coil Balance Tester, the J 39021-210 Injector Tester Adapter Box,
and J 39021-301 V6 Fuel Injector Test Adapter (1) or J 39021-302 V8 Fuel Injector Test Adapter to
the metering body electrical connector.
17. Adjust the amperage selector switch on J 39021 to 0.5 amps.
18. Open the valve (2) on the tank (3).
19. Open the valve (4) on the J 44466-10 to pressurize the fuel system. The minimum pressure
required on the gauge (6) is 150 psi. If 150 psi is not obtained, the tank (3) must be refilled prior to
performing this procedure.
20. Close the valve (4) on the J 44466-10.
21. Energize one injector using the J 39021. Observe a pressure drop on the gauge (6) and verity
the injector/poppet valve operation. An injector/poppet that is "stuck" and not operational will have
no pressure drop on the gauge. It an injector remains "stuck", repeat the procedure multiple times
(as required) until the injector is operational.
22. Repeat Steps 19, 20 and 21 for each individual injector to verify that all injector/poppet valve
assemblies are "unstuck" and functional.
23. Shut off pressure valve (2) on the tank (3) of the J 41413.
24. Bleed off the pressure at the J 44466-10.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough
Idle on Start-Up > Page 4519
25. Disconnect and remove the J 44466-10 (5) from the J 44466-12, and the J 41413.
26. Remove the J 39021-301 or J 39021-302, J 39021-210, and J 39021 from the metering body.
27. Install the vehicle electrical connector to the metering body.
28. Install the brake booster vacuum hose and connector to the intake manifold.
29. Install ignition wires 1, 3, 5, and 7 to the distributor cap.
30. Install the air inlet bonnet 10 the throttle body, tighten the wing-nut.
31. Install the PCV fresh air tube to the air inlet tube.
32. Obtain J 35800-A (2). Make sure the valve at the bottom of the canister (3) is closed.
33. Remove the canister top and add 24 ml (0.8 fl. oz.) Top Engine Cleaner, P/N 1050002 (Canada
P/N 992872), to the canister.
34. Fill the remainder of the canister with regular unleaded gasoline and install the canister top.
35. Suspend J 35800-A from a convenient underhood location.
36. Connect the hose from J 35800-A to the service port on the J 44466-12
37. Open the valve (3) at the bottom of J 35800-A.
38. Connect a "shop air" source to the fitting at the top of J 35800-A and adjust the regulator (1) to
75 psi.
39. Start the vehicle. It may be necessary to re-adjust the J 35800-A pressure regulator to maintain
75 psi.
40. Let the vehicle run at idle until the canister is empty and the vehicle stalls.
41. Remove the shop air supply from J 35800-A.
42. Depressurize the J 35800-A.
43. Disconnect the J 35800-A hose from the J 44466-12.
44. Remove the PCV clean air tube from the air inlet tube and set aside.
45. Remove the bonnet from the throttle body, and set aside.
46. Remove ignition wires 1, 3, 5, and 7 from the distributor cap.
47. Remove the brake booster vacuum hose and connector from the intake manifold.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough
Idle on Start-Up > Page 4520
48. Bleed the residual pressure from the J 44466-12.
49. Remove J 44466-13 (1) and J 44466-12 (2) from the metering body.
50. Remove J 44466-13 (1), clamp (2), and J 44466-11 (4), from the fuel pipe (3).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough
Idle on Start-Up > Page 4521
51. Install the fuel pipe (3) to the metering body. Make sure that all of the 0-rings (6 and 8),
washers (7), and spacers (5) are present and in their proper position.
52. Install the clamp (2) and nuts (1).
Tighten
Tighten the nuts to 3 N.m (27 lb in).
53. Apply threadlock, P/N 12345382, or equivalent to the threads of the fuel pipe bolt (4). Install the
bolt.
Tighten
Tighten the fuel pipe bolt to 6 N.m (53 lb in).
54. Install the brake booster vacuum hose and connector to the intake manifold.
55. Install the bonnet and air inlet tube to the throttle body.
56. Install the PCV fresh air tube to the inlet duct.
57. Install ignition wires 1, 3, 5 (7) to the distributor cap.
58. Add one (1) ounce of Port Fuel Injector Cleaner, P/N 12345104 (Canada P/N 10953467), to the
vehicle fuel tank for each gallon of gasoline estimated to be in the tank. Instruct the customer to
add the remainder of the bottle of Port Fuel Injector Cleaner to the vehicle fuel tank at the next
fill-up. Further recommend that Port Fuel Injector Cleaner be added to the fuel tank every 3000
miles (4800 km) particularly if the vehicle is not started and driven every day. Inform the customer
that the Port Fuel Injector Cleaner is not to be used at every fill up but may be reapplied every 3000
miles (4800 km).
59. Tighten the fuel tank filler cap.
60. Start the vehicle and check for fuel leaks.
61. Using the Tech 2(R) scan tool, check for any stored Powertrain DTC codes. Clear codes as
required.
62. Disconnect the Tech 2(R) Scan tool.
63. Advise the customer to change brands of fuel.
M/L, G Van and P Truck
1. Loosen the fuel tank filler cap to relieve fuel tank vapor pressure.
2. Remove the engine cover.
3. Remove ignition wires 1 3, 5, and 7 from the distributor cap.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough
Idle on Start-Up > Page 4522
4. Remove the vacuum brake booster hose and connector from the intake manifold.
5. Remove the fuel pipe bolt (4) at the rear of the intake manifold.
6. Relieve the fuel system pressure at the service fitting on the fuel pipe. Use a shop towel to
contain any fuel that may exit the service fitting.
7. Disconnect the fuel pipes (3) at the rear of intake manifold (1).
8. Remove the nuts (1) and clamp (2) from the fuel pipe.
9. Remove the fuel pipes from the metering body. Be careful not to disturb the 0-rings, washer, and
spacer in the metering body.
10. Remove the electrical connector from metering body.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough
Idle on Start-Up > Page 4523
11. Install J 44466-12 (2) and J 44466-13 (1) to the fuel metering body and tighten. Make sure that
the fuel pipe 0-rings, washer, and spacers are present and in their proper position.
12. Install J 44466-01 (1) to the vehicle fuel lines.
13. Obtain the J 41413, close the valve (2) on the tank, and remove the regulator assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough
Idle on Start-Up > Page 4524
14. Install the J 44466-10 (5) to the J 41413 tank (3). The J 44466-10 regulator is preset to 150 psi.
The minimum pressure required on the gauge (6) is 150 psi. If 150 psi is not obtained, the tank
must be refilled prior to performing this procedure.
15. Connect the J 44466-10 hose to the J 44466-12.
16. Install J 39021 Injector/Coil Balance Tester, the J 39021-210 Injector Tester Adapter Box, and J
39021-301 V6 Fuel Injector Test Adapter or J 39021-302 V8 Fuel Injector Test Adapter to metering
body electrical connector.
17. Adjust the amperage selector switch on J 39021 to 0.5 amps.
18. Open the valve (2) on the tank (3).
19. Open the valve (4) on the J 44466-10 to pressurize the fuel system.
20. Close the valve (4) on the J 44466-10.
21. Energize one injector using the J 39021. Observe a pressure drop on the gauge (6) and verify
the injector/poppet valve operation. An injector/poppet that is "stuck" and not operational will have
no pressure drop on the gauge. If an injector remains "stuck", repeat the procedure multiple times
(as required) until the injector is operational.
22. Repeat steps 19, 20, and 21, for each individual injector to verify that all injector/poppet valve
assemblies are "unstuck" and functional.
23. Shut off the pressure valve (2) on the tank (3) of the J 41413.
24. Bleed off pressure at J 44466-10.
25. Disconnect and remove the J 44466-10 hose from the J 44466-12 and the J 41413.
26. Remove the J 39021-301 or J 39021-210, J 39021-210, and J 39021 from the metering body.
27. Install the vehicle electrical connector to the metering body.
28. Install ignition wires 1, 3, 5, and 7 to the distributor cap.
29. Install the vacuum brake booster hose and connector to the intake manifold.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough
Idle on Start-Up > Page 4525
30. Obtain J 35800-A (2). Make sure the valve (3) at the bottom of the canister is closed.
31. Remove the canister top and add 24 ml (0.8 fl. oz.) Top Engine Cleaner, P/N 1050002 (Canada
P/N 992872), to the canister.
32. Fill the remainder of the canister with regular unleaded gasoline and install the canister top.
33. Suspend the J 35800-A in a convenient location.
34. Connect the hose from the J 35800-A to the service port on the J 44466-12.
35. Open the valve (3) at the bottom of J 35800-A.
36. Connect a "shop air" source to the fitting at the top of J 35800-A and adjust the regulator (1) to
75 psi.
37. Start the vehicle. It may be necessary to re-adjust the J 35800-A pressure regulator to maintain
75 psi.
38. Let the vehicle run at idle until the canister is empty and the vehicle stalls.
39. Remove the shop air supply from J 35800-A.
40. Depressurize the J 35800-A.
41. Disconnect the J 35800-A hose from the J 44466-12.
42. Remove the vacuum brake booster hose and connector from the intake manifold.
43. Remove ignition wires 1, 3, 5, and 7 from the distributor cap.
44. Bleed the residual pressure from J 44466-12.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough
Idle on Start-Up > Page 4526
45. Remove the J 44466-13 (1) and J 44466-12 (2) from the metering body.
46. Remove the J 44466-01 (1) from the vehicle fuel lines.
47. Install the fuel pipe (3) to the metering body. Make sure the all of the 0-rings (6 and 8), washers
(7), and spacers (5) are present and in their proper position.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough
Idle on Start-Up > Page 4527
48. Install the clamp (2) and nuts (1).
Tighten
Tighten the nuts to 3 N.m (27 lb in).
49. Inspect the 0-rings at the fuel pipe-to-vehicle lines (1). Replace as necessary.
Tighten
Tighten the fuel line nuts to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
50. Apply threadlock, P/N 12345382, or equivalent to the threads of the fuel pipe bolt. Install the
bolt.
Tighten
Tighten the fuel pipe bolt to 6 N.m (53 lb in).
51. Install ignition wires 1, 3, 5, and 7 to the distributor cap.
52. Install the vacuum brake booster hose and connector to the intake manifold.
53. Add one (1) ounce of Port Fuel Injector Cleaner, P/N 12345104 (Canada P/N 10953467), to the
vehicle fuel tank for each gallon of gasoline estimated to be in the tank. Instruct the customer to
add the remainder of the bottle of Port Fuel Injector Cleaner to the vehicle fuel tank at the next
fill-up. Further recommend that Port Fuel Injector Cleaner be added to the fuel tank every 3000
miles (4800 km) particularly if the vehicle is not started and driven every day. Inform the customer
that the Port Fuel Injector Cleaner is not to be used at every fill up but may be reapplied every 3000
miles (4800 km).
54. Tighten the fuel tank filler cap.
55. Start the engine and check for fuel leaks.
56. Use the Tech 2(R) Scan Tool to check for any stored Powertrain DTC codes. Clear codes as
required.
57. Disconnect the Tech 2(R) Scan tool.
58. Install the engine cover.
59. Advise customer to change brands of fuel.
Central SFI to MFI Conversion Instructions
This procedure outlines the steps required to replace the existing Central SFI Fuel System with a
new MFI (Multiport Flexible Injection) Fuel System. Be sure to use the appropriate year and model
Service Manual for proper disassembly and re-assembly procedure(s).
Important:
Cleaning the CSFI injectors is the preferred repair. The CSFI unit should not be replaced until
cleaning has been attempted. If the vehicle should
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough
Idle on Start-Up > Page 4528
return for the same repair, then the CSFI unit can be replaced with a MFI unit. If the vehicle is out
of warranty, the customer should be given the option of which fix to pursue.
V6 Engines
1. Remove Upper Intake Manifold plenum and SFI Fuel Meter Body according to Service Manual
Procedures.
2. Remove the Fuel Meter Body bracket and discard. Install the new bracket as shown in Figure 1.
3. Position Fuel Tubes of MFI Fuel Meter Body as shown in Figure 2. Tubes must be oriented away
from the fuel pressure regulator end of the fuel meter body.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough
Idle on Start-Up > Page 4529
Notice:
The number 3 Fuel Tube must be positioned behind the number 1 Fuel Tube to eliminate
interference with the Upper Intake Manifold plenum when installed. See Figure 2.
4. Insert the MFI Fuel Meter Body into the Fuel Meter Body Bracket on the Lower Intake Manifold
being careful not to bind the Fuel Tubes. Make sure that the number three Fuel Tube is routed in
behind number 1 and 5 Fuel Tubes as shown in Figure 2. Push down firmly on the fuel meter body
locking it into the bracket.
Notice:
Use caution when inserting injectors into lower intake manifold to be sure the correct injector is
being placed into the correct hole.
Injectors should not be removed once they have been installed.
Removal of injectors from the intake manifold may cause damage to the retaining lugs on the
injector.
Important:
The Injector holes are numbered on the Lower Intake Manifold. The injectors are numbered on the
side of the Fuel Meter Body.
5. Insert the number 3 injector into the correct Injector hole in the Lower Intake Manifold first. Install
the number 5 injector next and then number 1. This sequence must be followed correctly to prevent
interference of the Fuel Tubes. Injectors 2, 4, and 6 are then installed.
6. Insure that the electrical connectors of the injectors are positioned so that they do not interfere
with each other and are pointing towards the center of the Intake Manifold. If necessary, rotate the
electrical connectors inboard.
Notice:
Lack of lubrication will make installation of the Upper Intake Manifold plenum difficult and may
cause damage to the 0-ring.
7. Lubricate the Fuel Meter Body Upper Manifold 0-ring (orange in color) with clean engine oil.
8. Inspect the Upper Intake Manifold plenum gasket and replace if necessary. Reinstall the Upper
Intake Manifold plenum following the procedures outlined in the Service Manual.
Important:
Lubricate the Fuel Inlet and Return Lines with clean engine oil before inserting them into the Fuel
Meter Body.
Make sure that the Fuel Line Retaining Bracket is properly oriented with the tabs down.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough
Idle on Start-Up > Page 4530
V8 Engines
This procedure outlines the steps required to replace the existing Central SFI Fuel System with a
new MFI (Multipoint Flexible Injection) Fuel System. Be sure to use the appropriate year and model
Service Manual for proper disassembly and re-assembly procedure(s).
1. Remove Upper Intake Manifold plenum and SFI Fuel Meter Body according to Service Manual
Procedures.
2. Remove the Fuel Meter Body bracket and discard. Install the new bracket.
3. Position Fuel Tubes of MFI Fuel Meter Body as shown in Figure 3. Fuel tubes 1, 3, 5, and 7 are
oriented toward the fuel inlet side of the fuel meter body. Fuel tubes 2, 4, 6, and 8 are oriented
toward the fuel pressure regulator side if the fuel meter body.
4. Insert the MFI Fuel Meter Body into the Fuel Meter Body Bracket on the Lower Intake Manifold
being careful not to bind the Fuel Tubes. Push down firmly on the fuel meter body until the tabs
snap into the bracket locking the fuel meter body in place.
5. Orient the fuel tubes to coincide with their corresponding cylinder. The fuel tubes are numbered
on the side of the fuel meter body and the corresponding cylinder number is cast in the intake
manifold.
Notice:
Use caution when inserting injectors into lower intake manifold to be sure the correct injector is
being placed into the correct hole.
Injectors should not be removed once they have been installed.
Removal of injectors from the intake manifold may cause damage to the retaining lugs on the
injector.
Important:
The Injector holes are numbered on the Lower Intake Manifold. The injectors are numbered on the
side of the Fuel Meter Body.
6. Insert the fuel tubes into their corresponding holes in the intake manifold. Install tubes for
cylinders 1, 3, 6 and 8 making sure that the injector electrical connectors are facing in toward the
center of the manifold.
7. Insert fuel tubes for cylinders 2, 4, 5, and 7 in the same manner.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough
Idle on Start-Up > Page 4531
Important:
When installing fuel tubes, it is important that the tubes are oriented properly to provide minimal
interference when installing the upper intake manifold plenum. Intake holes for cylinders 2, 4, 5,
and 7 are closer to the fuel meter body. It is necessary to cross tube 5 over tube 7 and tube 4 over
tube 2 as shown in Figure 4.
Notice:
Lack of lubrication will make installation of the Upper Intake Manifold plenum difficult and may
cause damage to the 0-ring.
8. Lubricate the Fuel Meter Body Upper Manifold 0-ring (blue in color) with clean engine oil.
9. Inspect Upper Intake Manifold Gasket and replace if necessary. Reinstall the Upper Intake
Manifold plenum following the procedures in the Service Manual.
Important:
Lubricate the Fuel Inlet and Return Lines with clean engine oil before inserting them in the of the
Fuel Meter Body.
Make sure that Fuel Line Retaining Bracket is properly oriented with the tabs down.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 04-06-04-051B > Jan > 06 >
Fuel System - Fuel Injector Maintenance Cleaning
Fuel Injector: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Fuel Injector Maintenance Cleaning
Bulletin No.: 04-06-04-051B
Date: January 04, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Maintenance Cleaning of Fuel Injectors
Models: 2006 and Prior All General Motors Passenger Cars and Trucks 2003-2006 HUMMER H2
2006 HUMMER H3
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years and update the name and part
number of GM Fuel System Treatment. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-06-04-051A
(Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
General Motors is aware that some companies are marketing tools, equipment and programs to
support fuel injector cleaning as a preventative maintenance procedure. General Motors does not
endorse, support or acknowledge the need for fuel injector cleaning as a preventative maintenance
procedure. Fuel injector cleaning is approved only when performed as directed by a published GM
driveability or DTC diagnostic service procedure.
Due to variation in fuel quality in different areas of the country, the only preventative maintenance
currently endorsed by GM regarding its gasoline engine fuel systems is the addition of GM Fuel
System Treatment PLUS, P/N 88861011 (for U.S. ACDelco(R), use P/N 88861013) (in Canada,
P/N 88861012), added to a tank of fuel at each oil change. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
03-06-04-030A for proper cleaning instructions.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 99066F > Mar > 03 >
Campaign - Fuel Injector Sticking Closed
Fuel Injector: All Technical Service Bulletins Campaign - Fuel Injector Sticking Closed
File In Section: 06-Engine Emissions
Bulletin No.: 99066F
Date: March, 2003
SPECIAL POLICY
SUBJECT: 99066F - SPECIAL POLICY ADJUSTMENT - SEQUENTIAL CENTRAL PORT FUEL
INJECTION (SCPI) FAILURES IN CALIFORNIA ONLY (YF5 EMISSION EQUIPPED)
MODELS: CERTAIN 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 S/T, M/L, C/K, G, P, W4/NPR
TRUCKS AND 2003 NPR TRUCKS EQUIPPED WITH 4.3L (RPO L35 - VIN CODE W OR RPO
LF6 - VIN CODE X), 5.0L (RPO L30 - VIN CODE M) OR 5.7L (RPO L31 - VIN CODE R) ENGINE
AND CALIFORNIA EMISSION EQUIPPED (RPO YF5)
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2002 and 2003 model years to the SCPI Special Policy on
certain S/T, M/L, C/K, G, P and W4/NPR truck models. Please discard Special Policy Bulletin
Number 99066E, dated February, 2003.
CONDITION
Some customers of 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 model year S/T, M/L, C/K, G, P,
W4/NPR trucks and 2003 NPR trucks, that are registered in California, equipped with 4.3L (RPO
L35 and VIN Code W, or RPO LF6 and VIN Code X), 5.0L (RPO L30 and VIN Code M) or 5.7L
(RPO L31 and VIN Code R) engine, and California emissions (RPO YF5), may experience a
"Service Engine Soon" light, misfire, rough idle or hard start due to a deposit build-up on the
Sequential Central Port Fuel Injector (SCPI) poppet valve(s). The deposit build-up may cause
injector poppets to stick closed. Certain fuels have been found to interact with the SCPI system to
cause the deposits.
SPECIAL POLICY ADJUSTMENT
This special policy covers the SCPI failure condition described above for a period of ten (10) years
or 200,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the date the vehicle was originally placed in service,
regardless of ownership.
The repairs will be made at no charge to the owner. This special policy applies ONLY to repairs
requiring SCPI system servicing, injector cleaning and/or MFI assembly replacement of the SCPI
system. The customer should not be charged for performing a system check when it is determined
that the SCPI system is not the cause of a customer complaint (labor operation T5532 is provided
to submit claims for such system checks). Any additional necessary diagnosis and repairs that are
not related to the SCPI condition are not covered by this special policy. The customer should be
informed that any further service that is not covered by new vehicle warranty will not be covered by
this policy.
VEHICLES INVOLVED
Involved are certain 1996,1997,1998,1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 S/T, M/L, C/K, G, P, W4/NPR and
2003 NPR model vehicles, registered in California, equipped with 4.3L (RPO L35 - VIN Code W, or
RPO LF6 - VIN Code X), 5.0L (RPO L30 - VIN Code M) or 5.7L (RPO L31 - VIN Code R) engine;
and California emissions (RPO YF5). This Special Policy covers all vehicles within these model
years, with these engine and emissions RPO's.
PARTS INFORMATION
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 99066F > Mar > 03 >
Campaign - Fuel Injector Sticking Closed > Page 4541
Parts required to complete this special policy are to be obtained from General Motors Service Parts
Operations (GMSPO). Please refer to your "involved vehicles listing" prior to ordering parts. Normal
orders should be placed on a DRO Daily Replenishment Order. In an emergency, parts should be
ordered on a CSO = Customer Special Order.
IMPORTANT:
Isuzu Parts Ordering: In order to comply with the 10-digit Isuzu part numbering system, Isuzu
dealers must add an "8" to the beginning and a "0" to the end of the listed 8-digit part numbers
when ordering parts through AIPDN.
CUSTOMER NOTIFICATION
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 99066F > Mar > 03 >
Campaign - Fuel Injector Sticking Closed > Page 4542
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 99066F > Mar > 03 >
Campaign - Fuel Injector Sticking Closed > Page 4543
Customers will be notified of this special policy on their vehicles by General Motors (see copy of
typical customer letter included with this bulletin - actual divisional letter may vary slightly).
SERVICE PROCEDURE
System Check: Use strategy-based diagnoses listed in the front of the Driveability and Emissions
section of the service manual. If the SCPI system is operating properly, inform the customer that
the vehicle does not have the condition listed in the owner letter. If poor driveability conditions
persist, inform the customer that any further diagnosis and repairs will be at their expense if the
vehicle is outside the parameters of the new vehicle warranty.
SCPI Injector Cleaning Procedure: If diagnosis leads to sticking poppet nozzles, use the service
procedure from Service Bulletin 00-06-04-003B to clean the SCPI poppet nozzles. Please note that
the service bulletin term for SCPI is Central Sequential Fuel Injection (CSFI), but is referring to the
same fuel system assembly. If the poppet nozzles have previously been cleaned and the sticking
condition has reoccurred, refer to the correction paragraph below.
SCPI Fuel Tank Fill Pipe Assembly for 1997-99 M/L Van and 1999 - some 2000 C/K Truck: with
4.3L, 5.0L, 5.7L engines and built prior to listed VIN/Production dates on Service Bulletin
00-06-04-018: If diagnosis leads to sticking poppet nozzles on these models, use the service
procedure from Service Bulletin 00-06-04-018 to replace the fuel tank fill pipe assembly, if this
procedure has not been performed previously. Previous service procedure can be verified by
checking GMVIS for Labor Operation L1065 on "M/L" trucks with replacement part number
15050573; or Labor Operation L1065 on "C/K" trucks with replacement part numbers 15747585 or
15747588.
Correction: If, after cleaning the SCPI poppet nozzles, the normal service manual diagnosis still
indicates that the SCPI is the cause of the customer complaint, or if the injectors have previously
been cleaned and the vehicle has again experienced sticking poppet nozzles, refer to Service
Bulletin 00-06-04-003B and replace the SCPI fuel assembly with the MFI fuel assembly. Please
note that the service bulletin term for SCPI is Central Sequential Fuel Injection (CSFI), but is
referring to the same fuel system assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 99066F > Mar > 03 >
Campaign - Fuel Injector Sticking Closed > Page 4544
CLAIM INFORMATION
For vehicles repaired under this special policy, submit a claim with the information indicated.
CUSTOMER REIMBURSEMENT
Customer requests for reimbursement are for any previously paid repairs to, or replacement of, the
Sequential Central Port Fuel Injection (SCPI) system. Repairs must have occurred within 10 years
of the date the vehicle was originally placed in service, or 200,000 miles, whichever occurs first.
The requests are to be submitted within two (2) years of the date on which the repair was paid or
within two (2) years of the date of this Special Policy Bulletin, whichever is greater.
When a customer requests reimbursement, they must provide the following:
- Proof of ownership at time of repair.
- Original paid receipt confirming the amount of unreimbursed repair expense(s) (including Service
Contract deductibles), a description of the repair, and the person or entity performing the repair.
Customers from the State of California, must submit requests for reimbursement directly to
(Divisions) per instructions in the owner letter.
If the work was done by someone other than a GM dealership, the amount of reimbursement will
be limited to the amount that the repair would have cost GM to have it completed by a GM
dealership.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 >
Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up
Technical Service Bulletin # 00-06-04-003B Date: 030201
Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up
File In Section: 06 - Engine/Propulsion System
Bulletin No.: 00-06-04-003B
Date: February, 2003
TECHNICAL
Subject: Rough Idle After Start, And/Or A Service Engine Soon (SES) Light (Unstick And Clean
Central Sequential Fuel Injection (CSFI) Poppet Valves or Convert to MFI)
Models: 1995-2002 Chevrolet and GMC S/T Models 1996-2002 Chevrolet and GMC C/K, M/L, G, P
Models 1996-2001 Oldsmobile Bravada 1999-2000 Cadillac Escalade with 4.3L, 5.0L or 5.7L
Engine (VINS W, X, M, R - RPOs L35, LF6, L30, L31) Except 2002 VIN X - RPO LU3 Models
This bulletin is being revised to update the Warranty Information. Please discard previous copies of
Corporate Bulletin Number 00-06-04-003B with warranty chart (Section 06 - Engine). This copy is
for Dealers in the state of CALIFORNIA ONLY.
Condition
Some customers may comment on rough idle after start-up, especially if the vehicle has sat
overnight. These symptoms may be intermittent. The Service Engine Soon (SES) light may also be
illuminated. Current misfire or history misfire codes may be detected with the Tech 2 scan tool.
Cause
A deposit build-up on the CSFI poppet valve ball and/or seat may cause the poppet ball to stick
open or closed. In either case, the specific cylinder will be mis-fueled, resulting in a cylinder mis-fire
condition.
Correction
A new injector unsticking and cleaning process has proven to be effective in restoring poppet
valves to an "as new" condition. CSFI injector replacement should NOT be considered as a
correction for this customer concern.
Check the vehicle history to determine if the vehicle is returning for a second fuel system repair for
this condition. If the fuel system has been repaired for this condition previously, then inform the
customer that an alternate fix is available. A new MFI fuel system has been developed that will
back service the CSFI fuel system. The MFI fuel system eliminates the CSFI poppet valve ball and
seat. The CSFI fuel system will need to be replaced as a unit. Refer to Central SFI to MFI
Conversion instructions in this bulletin.
Notice:
Individual CSFI injectors can not be replaced with MFI injectors. The entire CSFI fuel meter body
will need to be replaced. The bracket used to retain the injectors in the fuel meter body is different
between the CSFI and MFI unit. The unit may not seal if you mix injectors. Severe engine damage
could result.
Cleaning the CSFI injectors is the preferred repair. The CSFI unit should not be replaced until
cleaning has been attempted. If the vehicle should return for the same repair, then the CSFI unit
can be replaced with an MFI unit. If the vehicle is out of warranty, the customer should be given the
option of which fix to pursue.
Important:
"GM of Canada" dealers require District Service Manager approval prior to replacing the CSFI unit
with a MFI unit under warranty.
The first step of this process is to use the J 41413 Evap Pressure/Purge Station, in conjunction with
the J 44466-10 pressure regulator/hose assembly, to provide the required high pressure (150 psi)
source to perform the unsticking procedure. The J 39021 fuel injector tester and accessories
provide the means to "energize" the injector. Some later model-year vehicles may utilize the Tech
2(R) to "energize" the injectors.
The second step of this process is to run the engine on a solution of 10% Top Engine Cleaner and
90% gasoline. This will effectively clean any deposits from the ball and seats of the poppets. It is
very important that the engine fuel system is separated from the vehicle fuel system. Top Engine
Cleaner may have detrimental effects on the fuel pump.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 >
Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4549
Parts Information
Cleaning Procedure Parts
CSFI to MFI Conversion Parts
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
Important:
Some California vehicles may be covered by Special Policy 99066E if built with California
Emissions RPO YF5. If the vehicle is covered by the special policy, then that warranty information
should be used.
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use information contained in Special Policy 99066E.
Information
This procedure should be performed before any attempt to convert the fuel system to MFI.
S/T and C/K Truck
1. Loosen the fuel filler cap to relieve vapor pressure in the fuel tank.
2. Remove the Positive Crankcase Ventilation (PCV) clean air tube from the air inlet tube and set
aside.
3. Remove the bonnet and inlet tube from the throttle body.
4. Remove the brake booster vacuum hose and connector from the intake manifold.
5. Remove the electrical connector from the CSFI fuel metering body.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 >
Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4550
6. Remove ignition wires 1, 3, 5, and 7 from the distributor cap.
7. Remove the fuel line bolt (4) at the rear of the intake manifold.
8. Relieve the fuel system pressure at the service fitting on the fuel line. Use a shop towel to
contain any fuel that may exit the service fitting.
9. Remove the nuts (1) and clamp (2) from the fuel pipe.
10. Remove the fuel pipes from the metering body. Be careful not to disturb the O-rings, washer,
and spacer in the metering body.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 >
Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4551
11. Install the J 44466-12 (2) and the J 44466-13 (1) to the metering body and tighten. Make sure
that the fuel pipe 0-rings, washer, and spacers are present and in their proper position.
12. Install the J 44466-11 (4), clamp (2), and J 44466-13 (1) to the fuel pipe and tighten.
13. Obtain the J 41413, close the valve (2) on the tank, and remove the regulator assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 >
Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4552
14. Install the J 44466-10 (5) to the J 41413 tank (3). The J 44466-10 regulator is preset to 150 psi.
15. Connect the J 44466-10 hose (1) to the J 44466-12 (3).
16. Install the J 39021 Injector/Coil Balance Tester, the J 39021-210 Injector Tester Adapter Box,
and J 39021-301 V6 Fuel Injector Test Adapter (1) or J 39021-302 V8 Fuel Injector Test Adapter to
the metering body electrical connector.
17. Adjust the amperage selector switch on J 39021 to 0.5 amps.
18. Open the valve (2) on the tank (3).
19. Open the valve (4) on the J 44466-10 to pressurize the fuel system. The minimum pressure
required on the gauge (6) is 150 psi. If 150 psi is not obtained, the tank (3) must be refilled prior to
performing this procedure.
20. Close the valve (4) on the J 44466-10.
21. Energize one injector using the J 39021. Observe a pressure drop on the gauge (6) and verity
the injector/poppet valve operation. An injector/poppet that is "stuck" and not operational will have
no pressure drop on the gauge. It an injector remains "stuck", repeat the procedure multiple times
(as required) until the injector is operational.
22. Repeat Steps 19, 20 and 21 for each individual injector to verify that all injector/poppet valve
assemblies are "unstuck" and functional.
23. Shut off pressure valve (2) on the tank (3) of the J 41413.
24. Bleed off the pressure at the J 44466-10.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 >
Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4553
25. Disconnect and remove the J 44466-10 (5) from the J 44466-12, and the J 41413.
26. Remove the J 39021-301 or J 39021-302, J 39021-210, and J 39021 from the metering body.
27. Install the vehicle electrical connector to the metering body.
28. Install the brake booster vacuum hose and connector to the intake manifold.
29. Install ignition wires 1, 3, 5, and 7 to the distributor cap.
30. Install the air inlet bonnet 10 the throttle body, tighten the wing-nut.
31. Install the PCV fresh air tube to the air inlet tube.
32. Obtain J 35800-A (2). Make sure the valve at the bottom of the canister (3) is closed.
33. Remove the canister top and add 24 ml (0.8 fl. oz.) Top Engine Cleaner, P/N 1050002 (Canada
P/N 992872), to the canister.
34. Fill the remainder of the canister with regular unleaded gasoline and install the canister top.
35. Suspend J 35800-A from a convenient underhood location.
36. Connect the hose from J 35800-A to the service port on the J 44466-12
37. Open the valve (3) at the bottom of J 35800-A.
38. Connect a "shop air" source to the fitting at the top of J 35800-A and adjust the regulator (1) to
75 psi.
39. Start the vehicle. It may be necessary to re-adjust the J 35800-A pressure regulator to maintain
75 psi.
40. Let the vehicle run at idle until the canister is empty and the vehicle stalls.
41. Remove the shop air supply from J 35800-A.
42. Depressurize the J 35800-A.
43. Disconnect the J 35800-A hose from the J 44466-12.
44. Remove the PCV clean air tube from the air inlet tube and set aside.
45. Remove the bonnet from the throttle body, and set aside.
46. Remove ignition wires 1, 3, 5, and 7 from the distributor cap.
47. Remove the brake booster vacuum hose and connector from the intake manifold.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 >
Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4554
48. Bleed the residual pressure from the J 44466-12.
49. Remove J 44466-13 (1) and J 44466-12 (2) from the metering body.
50. Remove J 44466-13 (1), clamp (2), and J 44466-11 (4), from the fuel pipe (3).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 >
Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4555
51. Install the fuel pipe (3) to the metering body. Make sure that all of the 0-rings (6 and 8),
washers (7), and spacers (5) are present and in their proper position.
52. Install the clamp (2) and nuts (1).
Tighten
Tighten the nuts to 3 N.m (27 lb in).
53. Apply threadlock, P/N 12345382, or equivalent to the threads of the fuel pipe bolt (4). Install the
bolt.
Tighten
Tighten the fuel pipe bolt to 6 N.m (53 lb in).
54. Install the brake booster vacuum hose and connector to the intake manifold.
55. Install the bonnet and air inlet tube to the throttle body.
56. Install the PCV fresh air tube to the inlet duct.
57. Install ignition wires 1, 3, 5 (7) to the distributor cap.
58. Add one (1) ounce of Port Fuel Injector Cleaner, P/N 12345104 (Canada P/N 10953467), to the
vehicle fuel tank for each gallon of gasoline estimated to be in the tank. Instruct the customer to
add the remainder of the bottle of Port Fuel Injector Cleaner to the vehicle fuel tank at the next
fill-up. Further recommend that Port Fuel Injector Cleaner be added to the fuel tank every 3000
miles (4800 km) particularly if the vehicle is not started and driven every day. Inform the customer
that the Port Fuel Injector Cleaner is not to be used at every fill up but may be reapplied every 3000
miles (4800 km).
59. Tighten the fuel tank filler cap.
60. Start the vehicle and check for fuel leaks.
61. Using the Tech 2(R) scan tool, check for any stored Powertrain DTC codes. Clear codes as
required.
62. Disconnect the Tech 2(R) Scan tool.
63. Advise the customer to change brands of fuel.
M/L, G Van and P Truck
1. Loosen the fuel tank filler cap to relieve fuel tank vapor pressure.
2. Remove the engine cover.
3. Remove ignition wires 1 3, 5, and 7 from the distributor cap.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 >
Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4556
4. Remove the vacuum brake booster hose and connector from the intake manifold.
5. Remove the fuel pipe bolt (4) at the rear of the intake manifold.
6. Relieve the fuel system pressure at the service fitting on the fuel pipe. Use a shop towel to
contain any fuel that may exit the service fitting.
7. Disconnect the fuel pipes (3) at the rear of intake manifold (1).
8. Remove the nuts (1) and clamp (2) from the fuel pipe.
9. Remove the fuel pipes from the metering body. Be careful not to disturb the 0-rings, washer, and
spacer in the metering body.
10. Remove the electrical connector from metering body.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 >
Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4557
11. Install J 44466-12 (2) and J 44466-13 (1) to the fuel metering body and tighten. Make sure that
the fuel pipe 0-rings, washer, and spacers are present and in their proper position.
12. Install J 44466-01 (1) to the vehicle fuel lines.
13. Obtain the J 41413, close the valve (2) on the tank, and remove the regulator assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 >
Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4558
14. Install the J 44466-10 (5) to the J 41413 tank (3). The J 44466-10 regulator is preset to 150 psi.
The minimum pressure required on the gauge (6) is 150 psi. If 150 psi is not obtained, the tank
must be refilled prior to performing this procedure.
15. Connect the J 44466-10 hose to the J 44466-12.
16. Install J 39021 Injector/Coil Balance Tester, the J 39021-210 Injector Tester Adapter Box, and J
39021-301 V6 Fuel Injector Test Adapter or J 39021-302 V8 Fuel Injector Test Adapter to metering
body electrical connector.
17. Adjust the amperage selector switch on J 39021 to 0.5 amps.
18. Open the valve (2) on the tank (3).
19. Open the valve (4) on the J 44466-10 to pressurize the fuel system.
20. Close the valve (4) on the J 44466-10.
21. Energize one injector using the J 39021. Observe a pressure drop on the gauge (6) and verify
the injector/poppet valve operation. An injector/poppet that is "stuck" and not operational will have
no pressure drop on the gauge. If an injector remains "stuck", repeat the procedure multiple times
(as required) until the injector is operational.
22. Repeat steps 19, 20, and 21, for each individual injector to verify that all injector/poppet valve
assemblies are "unstuck" and functional.
23. Shut off the pressure valve (2) on the tank (3) of the J 41413.
24. Bleed off pressure at J 44466-10.
25. Disconnect and remove the J 44466-10 hose from the J 44466-12 and the J 41413.
26. Remove the J 39021-301 or J 39021-210, J 39021-210, and J 39021 from the metering body.
27. Install the vehicle electrical connector to the metering body.
28. Install ignition wires 1, 3, 5, and 7 to the distributor cap.
29. Install the vacuum brake booster hose and connector to the intake manifold.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 >
Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4559
30. Obtain J 35800-A (2). Make sure the valve (3) at the bottom of the canister is closed.
31. Remove the canister top and add 24 ml (0.8 fl. oz.) Top Engine Cleaner, P/N 1050002 (Canada
P/N 992872), to the canister.
32. Fill the remainder of the canister with regular unleaded gasoline and install the canister top.
33. Suspend the J 35800-A in a convenient location.
34. Connect the hose from the J 35800-A to the service port on the J 44466-12.
35. Open the valve (3) at the bottom of J 35800-A.
36. Connect a "shop air" source to the fitting at the top of J 35800-A and adjust the regulator (1) to
75 psi.
37. Start the vehicle. It may be necessary to re-adjust the J 35800-A pressure regulator to maintain
75 psi.
38. Let the vehicle run at idle until the canister is empty and the vehicle stalls.
39. Remove the shop air supply from J 35800-A.
40. Depressurize the J 35800-A.
41. Disconnect the J 35800-A hose from the J 44466-12.
42. Remove the vacuum brake booster hose and connector from the intake manifold.
43. Remove ignition wires 1, 3, 5, and 7 from the distributor cap.
44. Bleed the residual pressure from J 44466-12.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 >
Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4560
45. Remove the J 44466-13 (1) and J 44466-12 (2) from the metering body.
46. Remove the J 44466-01 (1) from the vehicle fuel lines.
47. Install the fuel pipe (3) to the metering body. Make sure the all of the 0-rings (6 and 8), washers
(7), and spacers (5) are present and in their proper position.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 >
Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4561
48. Install the clamp (2) and nuts (1).
Tighten
Tighten the nuts to 3 N.m (27 lb in).
49. Inspect the 0-rings at the fuel pipe-to-vehicle lines (1). Replace as necessary.
Tighten
Tighten the fuel line nuts to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
50. Apply threadlock, P/N 12345382, or equivalent to the threads of the fuel pipe bolt. Install the
bolt.
Tighten
Tighten the fuel pipe bolt to 6 N.m (53 lb in).
51. Install ignition wires 1, 3, 5, and 7 to the distributor cap.
52. Install the vacuum brake booster hose and connector to the intake manifold.
53. Add one (1) ounce of Port Fuel Injector Cleaner, P/N 12345104 (Canada P/N 10953467), to the
vehicle fuel tank for each gallon of gasoline estimated to be in the tank. Instruct the customer to
add the remainder of the bottle of Port Fuel Injector Cleaner to the vehicle fuel tank at the next
fill-up. Further recommend that Port Fuel Injector Cleaner be added to the fuel tank every 3000
miles (4800 km) particularly if the vehicle is not started and driven every day. Inform the customer
that the Port Fuel Injector Cleaner is not to be used at every fill up but may be reapplied every 3000
miles (4800 km).
54. Tighten the fuel tank filler cap.
55. Start the engine and check for fuel leaks.
56. Use the Tech 2(R) Scan Tool to check for any stored Powertrain DTC codes. Clear codes as
required.
57. Disconnect the Tech 2(R) Scan tool.
58. Install the engine cover.
59. Advise customer to change brands of fuel.
Central SFI to MFI Conversion Instructions
This procedure outlines the steps required to replace the existing Central SFI Fuel System with a
new MFI (Multiport Flexible Injection) Fuel System. Be sure to use the appropriate year and model
Service Manual for proper disassembly and re-assembly procedure(s).
Important:
Cleaning the CSFI injectors is the preferred repair. The CSFI unit should not be replaced until
cleaning has been attempted. If the vehicle should
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 >
Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4562
return for the same repair, then the CSFI unit can be replaced with a MFI unit. If the vehicle is out
of warranty, the customer should be given the option of which fix to pursue.
V6 Engines
1. Remove Upper Intake Manifold plenum and SFI Fuel Meter Body according to Service Manual
Procedures.
2. Remove the Fuel Meter Body bracket and discard. Install the new bracket as shown in Figure 1.
3. Position Fuel Tubes of MFI Fuel Meter Body as shown in Figure 2. Tubes must be oriented away
from the fuel pressure regulator end of the fuel meter body.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 >
Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4563
Notice:
The number 3 Fuel Tube must be positioned behind the number 1 Fuel Tube to eliminate
interference with the Upper Intake Manifold plenum when installed. See Figure 2.
4. Insert the MFI Fuel Meter Body into the Fuel Meter Body Bracket on the Lower Intake Manifold
being careful not to bind the Fuel Tubes. Make sure that the number three Fuel Tube is routed in
behind number 1 and 5 Fuel Tubes as shown in Figure 2. Push down firmly on the fuel meter body
locking it into the bracket.
Notice:
Use caution when inserting injectors into lower intake manifold to be sure the correct injector is
being placed into the correct hole.
Injectors should not be removed once they have been installed.
Removal of injectors from the intake manifold may cause damage to the retaining lugs on the
injector.
Important:
The Injector holes are numbered on the Lower Intake Manifold. The injectors are numbered on the
side of the Fuel Meter Body.
5. Insert the number 3 injector into the correct Injector hole in the Lower Intake Manifold first. Install
the number 5 injector next and then number 1. This sequence must be followed correctly to prevent
interference of the Fuel Tubes. Injectors 2, 4, and 6 are then installed.
6. Insure that the electrical connectors of the injectors are positioned so that they do not interfere
with each other and are pointing towards the center of the Intake Manifold. If necessary, rotate the
electrical connectors inboard.
Notice:
Lack of lubrication will make installation of the Upper Intake Manifold plenum difficult and may
cause damage to the 0-ring.
7. Lubricate the Fuel Meter Body Upper Manifold 0-ring (orange in color) with clean engine oil.
8. Inspect the Upper Intake Manifold plenum gasket and replace if necessary. Reinstall the Upper
Intake Manifold plenum following the procedures outlined in the Service Manual.
Important:
Lubricate the Fuel Inlet and Return Lines with clean engine oil before inserting them into the Fuel
Meter Body.
Make sure that the Fuel Line Retaining Bracket is properly oriented with the tabs down.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 >
Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4564
V8 Engines
This procedure outlines the steps required to replace the existing Central SFI Fuel System with a
new MFI (Multipoint Flexible Injection) Fuel System. Be sure to use the appropriate year and model
Service Manual for proper disassembly and re-assembly procedure(s).
1. Remove Upper Intake Manifold plenum and SFI Fuel Meter Body according to Service Manual
Procedures.
2. Remove the Fuel Meter Body bracket and discard. Install the new bracket.
3. Position Fuel Tubes of MFI Fuel Meter Body as shown in Figure 3. Fuel tubes 1, 3, 5, and 7 are
oriented toward the fuel inlet side of the fuel meter body. Fuel tubes 2, 4, 6, and 8 are oriented
toward the fuel pressure regulator side if the fuel meter body.
4. Insert the MFI Fuel Meter Body into the Fuel Meter Body Bracket on the Lower Intake Manifold
being careful not to bind the Fuel Tubes. Push down firmly on the fuel meter body until the tabs
snap into the bracket locking the fuel meter body in place.
5. Orient the fuel tubes to coincide with their corresponding cylinder. The fuel tubes are numbered
on the side of the fuel meter body and the corresponding cylinder number is cast in the intake
manifold.
Notice:
Use caution when inserting injectors into lower intake manifold to be sure the correct injector is
being placed into the correct hole.
Injectors should not be removed once they have been installed.
Removal of injectors from the intake manifold may cause damage to the retaining lugs on the
injector.
Important:
The Injector holes are numbered on the Lower Intake Manifold. The injectors are numbered on the
side of the Fuel Meter Body.
6. Insert the fuel tubes into their corresponding holes in the intake manifold. Install tubes for
cylinders 1, 3, 6 and 8 making sure that the injector electrical connectors are facing in toward the
center of the manifold.
7. Insert fuel tubes for cylinders 2, 4, 5, and 7 in the same manner.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 >
Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4565
Important:
When installing fuel tubes, it is important that the tubes are oriented properly to provide minimal
interference when installing the upper intake manifold plenum. Intake holes for cylinders 2, 4, 5,
and 7 are closer to the fuel meter body. It is necessary to cross tube 5 over tube 7 and tube 4 over
tube 2 as shown in Figure 4.
Notice:
Lack of lubrication will make installation of the Upper Intake Manifold plenum difficult and may
cause damage to the 0-ring.
8. Lubricate the Fuel Meter Body Upper Manifold 0-ring (blue in color) with clean engine oil.
9. Inspect Upper Intake Manifold Gasket and replace if necessary. Reinstall the Upper Intake
Manifold plenum following the procedures in the Service Manual.
Important:
Lubricate the Fuel Inlet and Return Lines with clean engine oil before inserting them in the of the
Fuel Meter Body.
Make sure that Fuel Line Retaining Bracket is properly oriented with the tabs down.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 04-06-04-051B > Jan > 06 > Fuel
System - Fuel Injector Maintenance Cleaning
Fuel Injector: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Fuel Injector Maintenance Cleaning
Bulletin No.: 04-06-04-051B
Date: January 04, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Maintenance Cleaning of Fuel Injectors
Models: 2006 and Prior All General Motors Passenger Cars and Trucks 2003-2006 HUMMER H2
2006 HUMMER H3
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years and update the name and part
number of GM Fuel System Treatment. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-06-04-051A
(Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
General Motors is aware that some companies are marketing tools, equipment and programs to
support fuel injector cleaning as a preventative maintenance procedure. General Motors does not
endorse, support or acknowledge the need for fuel injector cleaning as a preventative maintenance
procedure. Fuel injector cleaning is approved only when performed as directed by a published GM
driveability or DTC diagnostic service procedure.
Due to variation in fuel quality in different areas of the country, the only preventative maintenance
currently endorsed by GM regarding its gasoline engine fuel systems is the addition of GM Fuel
System Treatment PLUS, P/N 88861011 (for U.S. ACDelco(R), use P/N 88861013) (in Canada,
P/N 88861012), added to a tank of fuel at each oil change. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
03-06-04-030A for proper cleaning instructions.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel
System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up
Technical Service Bulletin # 00-06-04-003B Date: 030201
Fuel System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up
File In Section: 06 - Engine/Propulsion System
Bulletin No.: 00-06-04-003B
Date: February, 2003
TECHNICAL
Subject: Rough Idle After Start, And/Or A Service Engine Soon (SES) Light (Unstick And Clean
Central Sequential Fuel Injection (CSFI) Poppet Valves or Convert to MFI)
Models: 1995-2002 Chevrolet and GMC S/T Models 1996-2002 Chevrolet and GMC C/K, M/L, G, P
Models 1996-2001 Oldsmobile Bravada 1999-2000 Cadillac Escalade with 4.3L, 5.0L or 5.7L
Engine (VINS W, X, M, R - RPOs L35, LF6, L30, L31) Except 2002 VIN X - RPO LU3 Models
This bulletin is being revised to update the Warranty Information. Please discard previous copies of
Corporate Bulletin Number 00-06-04-003B with warranty chart (Section 06 - Engine). This copy is
for Dealers in the state of CALIFORNIA ONLY.
Condition
Some customers may comment on rough idle after start-up, especially if the vehicle has sat
overnight. These symptoms may be intermittent. The Service Engine Soon (SES) light may also be
illuminated. Current misfire or history misfire codes may be detected with the Tech 2 scan tool.
Cause
A deposit build-up on the CSFI poppet valve ball and/or seat may cause the poppet ball to stick
open or closed. In either case, the specific cylinder will be mis-fueled, resulting in a cylinder mis-fire
condition.
Correction
A new injector unsticking and cleaning process has proven to be effective in restoring poppet
valves to an "as new" condition. CSFI injector replacement should NOT be considered as a
correction for this customer concern.
Check the vehicle history to determine if the vehicle is returning for a second fuel system repair for
this condition. If the fuel system has been repaired for this condition previously, then inform the
customer that an alternate fix is available. A new MFI fuel system has been developed that will
back service the CSFI fuel system. The MFI fuel system eliminates the CSFI poppet valve ball and
seat. The CSFI fuel system will need to be replaced as a unit. Refer to Central SFI to MFI
Conversion instructions in this bulletin.
Notice:
Individual CSFI injectors can not be replaced with MFI injectors. The entire CSFI fuel meter body
will need to be replaced. The bracket used to retain the injectors in the fuel meter body is different
between the CSFI and MFI unit. The unit may not seal if you mix injectors. Severe engine damage
could result.
Cleaning the CSFI injectors is the preferred repair. The CSFI unit should not be replaced until
cleaning has been attempted. If the vehicle should return for the same repair, then the CSFI unit
can be replaced with an MFI unit. If the vehicle is out of warranty, the customer should be given the
option of which fix to pursue.
Important:
"GM of Canada" dealers require District Service Manager approval prior to replacing the CSFI unit
with a MFI unit under warranty.
The first step of this process is to use the J 41413 Evap Pressure/Purge Station, in conjunction with
the J 44466-10 pressure regulator/hose assembly, to provide the required high pressure (150 psi)
source to perform the unsticking procedure. The J 39021 fuel injector tester and accessories
provide the means to "energize" the injector. Some later model-year vehicles may utilize the Tech
2(R) to "energize" the injectors.
The second step of this process is to run the engine on a solution of 10% Top Engine Cleaner and
90% gasoline. This will effectively clean any deposits from the ball and seats of the poppets. It is
very important that the engine fuel system is separated from the vehicle fuel system. Top Engine
Cleaner may have detrimental effects on the fuel pump.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel
System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4575
Parts Information
Cleaning Procedure Parts
CSFI to MFI Conversion Parts
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
Important:
Some California vehicles may be covered by Special Policy 99066E if built with California
Emissions RPO YF5. If the vehicle is covered by the special policy, then that warranty information
should be used.
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use information contained in Special Policy 99066E.
Information
This procedure should be performed before any attempt to convert the fuel system to MFI.
S/T and C/K Truck
1. Loosen the fuel filler cap to relieve vapor pressure in the fuel tank.
2. Remove the Positive Crankcase Ventilation (PCV) clean air tube from the air inlet tube and set
aside.
3. Remove the bonnet and inlet tube from the throttle body.
4. Remove the brake booster vacuum hose and connector from the intake manifold.
5. Remove the electrical connector from the CSFI fuel metering body.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel
System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4576
6. Remove ignition wires 1, 3, 5, and 7 from the distributor cap.
7. Remove the fuel line bolt (4) at the rear of the intake manifold.
8. Relieve the fuel system pressure at the service fitting on the fuel line. Use a shop towel to
contain any fuel that may exit the service fitting.
9. Remove the nuts (1) and clamp (2) from the fuel pipe.
10. Remove the fuel pipes from the metering body. Be careful not to disturb the O-rings, washer,
and spacer in the metering body.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel
System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4577
11. Install the J 44466-12 (2) and the J 44466-13 (1) to the metering body and tighten. Make sure
that the fuel pipe 0-rings, washer, and spacers are present and in their proper position.
12. Install the J 44466-11 (4), clamp (2), and J 44466-13 (1) to the fuel pipe and tighten.
13. Obtain the J 41413, close the valve (2) on the tank, and remove the regulator assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel
System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4578
14. Install the J 44466-10 (5) to the J 41413 tank (3). The J 44466-10 regulator is preset to 150 psi.
15. Connect the J 44466-10 hose (1) to the J 44466-12 (3).
16. Install the J 39021 Injector/Coil Balance Tester, the J 39021-210 Injector Tester Adapter Box,
and J 39021-301 V6 Fuel Injector Test Adapter (1) or J 39021-302 V8 Fuel Injector Test Adapter to
the metering body electrical connector.
17. Adjust the amperage selector switch on J 39021 to 0.5 amps.
18. Open the valve (2) on the tank (3).
19. Open the valve (4) on the J 44466-10 to pressurize the fuel system. The minimum pressure
required on the gauge (6) is 150 psi. If 150 psi is not obtained, the tank (3) must be refilled prior to
performing this procedure.
20. Close the valve (4) on the J 44466-10.
21. Energize one injector using the J 39021. Observe a pressure drop on the gauge (6) and verity
the injector/poppet valve operation. An injector/poppet that is "stuck" and not operational will have
no pressure drop on the gauge. It an injector remains "stuck", repeat the procedure multiple times
(as required) until the injector is operational.
22. Repeat Steps 19, 20 and 21 for each individual injector to verify that all injector/poppet valve
assemblies are "unstuck" and functional.
23. Shut off pressure valve (2) on the tank (3) of the J 41413.
24. Bleed off the pressure at the J 44466-10.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel
System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4579
25. Disconnect and remove the J 44466-10 (5) from the J 44466-12, and the J 41413.
26. Remove the J 39021-301 or J 39021-302, J 39021-210, and J 39021 from the metering body.
27. Install the vehicle electrical connector to the metering body.
28. Install the brake booster vacuum hose and connector to the intake manifold.
29. Install ignition wires 1, 3, 5, and 7 to the distributor cap.
30. Install the air inlet bonnet 10 the throttle body, tighten the wing-nut.
31. Install the PCV fresh air tube to the air inlet tube.
32. Obtain J 35800-A (2). Make sure the valve at the bottom of the canister (3) is closed.
33. Remove the canister top and add 24 ml (0.8 fl. oz.) Top Engine Cleaner, P/N 1050002 (Canada
P/N 992872), to the canister.
34. Fill the remainder of the canister with regular unleaded gasoline and install the canister top.
35. Suspend J 35800-A from a convenient underhood location.
36. Connect the hose from J 35800-A to the service port on the J 44466-12
37. Open the valve (3) at the bottom of J 35800-A.
38. Connect a "shop air" source to the fitting at the top of J 35800-A and adjust the regulator (1) to
75 psi.
39. Start the vehicle. It may be necessary to re-adjust the J 35800-A pressure regulator to maintain
75 psi.
40. Let the vehicle run at idle until the canister is empty and the vehicle stalls.
41. Remove the shop air supply from J 35800-A.
42. Depressurize the J 35800-A.
43. Disconnect the J 35800-A hose from the J 44466-12.
44. Remove the PCV clean air tube from the air inlet tube and set aside.
45. Remove the bonnet from the throttle body, and set aside.
46. Remove ignition wires 1, 3, 5, and 7 from the distributor cap.
47. Remove the brake booster vacuum hose and connector from the intake manifold.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel
System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4580
48. Bleed the residual pressure from the J 44466-12.
49. Remove J 44466-13 (1) and J 44466-12 (2) from the metering body.
50. Remove J 44466-13 (1), clamp (2), and J 44466-11 (4), from the fuel pipe (3).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel
System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4581
51. Install the fuel pipe (3) to the metering body. Make sure that all of the 0-rings (6 and 8),
washers (7), and spacers (5) are present and in their proper position.
52. Install the clamp (2) and nuts (1).
Tighten
Tighten the nuts to 3 N.m (27 lb in).
53. Apply threadlock, P/N 12345382, or equivalent to the threads of the fuel pipe bolt (4). Install the
bolt.
Tighten
Tighten the fuel pipe bolt to 6 N.m (53 lb in).
54. Install the brake booster vacuum hose and connector to the intake manifold.
55. Install the bonnet and air inlet tube to the throttle body.
56. Install the PCV fresh air tube to the inlet duct.
57. Install ignition wires 1, 3, 5 (7) to the distributor cap.
58. Add one (1) ounce of Port Fuel Injector Cleaner, P/N 12345104 (Canada P/N 10953467), to the
vehicle fuel tank for each gallon of gasoline estimated to be in the tank. Instruct the customer to
add the remainder of the bottle of Port Fuel Injector Cleaner to the vehicle fuel tank at the next
fill-up. Further recommend that Port Fuel Injector Cleaner be added to the fuel tank every 3000
miles (4800 km) particularly if the vehicle is not started and driven every day. Inform the customer
that the Port Fuel Injector Cleaner is not to be used at every fill up but may be reapplied every 3000
miles (4800 km).
59. Tighten the fuel tank filler cap.
60. Start the vehicle and check for fuel leaks.
61. Using the Tech 2(R) scan tool, check for any stored Powertrain DTC codes. Clear codes as
required.
62. Disconnect the Tech 2(R) Scan tool.
63. Advise the customer to change brands of fuel.
M/L, G Van and P Truck
1. Loosen the fuel tank filler cap to relieve fuel tank vapor pressure.
2. Remove the engine cover.
3. Remove ignition wires 1 3, 5, and 7 from the distributor cap.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel
System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4582
4. Remove the vacuum brake booster hose and connector from the intake manifold.
5. Remove the fuel pipe bolt (4) at the rear of the intake manifold.
6. Relieve the fuel system pressure at the service fitting on the fuel pipe. Use a shop towel to
contain any fuel that may exit the service fitting.
7. Disconnect the fuel pipes (3) at the rear of intake manifold (1).
8. Remove the nuts (1) and clamp (2) from the fuel pipe.
9. Remove the fuel pipes from the metering body. Be careful not to disturb the 0-rings, washer, and
spacer in the metering body.
10. Remove the electrical connector from metering body.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel
System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4583
11. Install J 44466-12 (2) and J 44466-13 (1) to the fuel metering body and tighten. Make sure that
the fuel pipe 0-rings, washer, and spacers are present and in their proper position.
12. Install J 44466-01 (1) to the vehicle fuel lines.
13. Obtain the J 41413, close the valve (2) on the tank, and remove the regulator assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel
System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4584
14. Install the J 44466-10 (5) to the J 41413 tank (3). The J 44466-10 regulator is preset to 150 psi.
The minimum pressure required on the gauge (6) is 150 psi. If 150 psi is not obtained, the tank
must be refilled prior to performing this procedure.
15. Connect the J 44466-10 hose to the J 44466-12.
16. Install J 39021 Injector/Coil Balance Tester, the J 39021-210 Injector Tester Adapter Box, and J
39021-301 V6 Fuel Injector Test Adapter or J 39021-302 V8 Fuel Injector Test Adapter to metering
body electrical connector.
17. Adjust the amperage selector switch on J 39021 to 0.5 amps.
18. Open the valve (2) on the tank (3).
19. Open the valve (4) on the J 44466-10 to pressurize the fuel system.
20. Close the valve (4) on the J 44466-10.
21. Energize one injector using the J 39021. Observe a pressure drop on the gauge (6) and verify
the injector/poppet valve operation. An injector/poppet that is "stuck" and not operational will have
no pressure drop on the gauge. If an injector remains "stuck", repeat the procedure multiple times
(as required) until the injector is operational.
22. Repeat steps 19, 20, and 21, for each individual injector to verify that all injector/poppet valve
assemblies are "unstuck" and functional.
23. Shut off the pressure valve (2) on the tank (3) of the J 41413.
24. Bleed off pressure at J 44466-10.
25. Disconnect and remove the J 44466-10 hose from the J 44466-12 and the J 41413.
26. Remove the J 39021-301 or J 39021-210, J 39021-210, and J 39021 from the metering body.
27. Install the vehicle electrical connector to the metering body.
28. Install ignition wires 1, 3, 5, and 7 to the distributor cap.
29. Install the vacuum brake booster hose and connector to the intake manifold.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel
System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4585
30. Obtain J 35800-A (2). Make sure the valve (3) at the bottom of the canister is closed.
31. Remove the canister top and add 24 ml (0.8 fl. oz.) Top Engine Cleaner, P/N 1050002 (Canada
P/N 992872), to the canister.
32. Fill the remainder of the canister with regular unleaded gasoline and install the canister top.
33. Suspend the J 35800-A in a convenient location.
34. Connect the hose from the J 35800-A to the service port on the J 44466-12.
35. Open the valve (3) at the bottom of J 35800-A.
36. Connect a "shop air" source to the fitting at the top of J 35800-A and adjust the regulator (1) to
75 psi.
37. Start the vehicle. It may be necessary to re-adjust the J 35800-A pressure regulator to maintain
75 psi.
38. Let the vehicle run at idle until the canister is empty and the vehicle stalls.
39. Remove the shop air supply from J 35800-A.
40. Depressurize the J 35800-A.
41. Disconnect the J 35800-A hose from the J 44466-12.
42. Remove the vacuum brake booster hose and connector from the intake manifold.
43. Remove ignition wires 1, 3, 5, and 7 from the distributor cap.
44. Bleed the residual pressure from J 44466-12.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel
System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4586
45. Remove the J 44466-13 (1) and J 44466-12 (2) from the metering body.
46. Remove the J 44466-01 (1) from the vehicle fuel lines.
47. Install the fuel pipe (3) to the metering body. Make sure the all of the 0-rings (6 and 8), washers
(7), and spacers (5) are present and in their proper position.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel
System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4587
48. Install the clamp (2) and nuts (1).
Tighten
Tighten the nuts to 3 N.m (27 lb in).
49. Inspect the 0-rings at the fuel pipe-to-vehicle lines (1). Replace as necessary.
Tighten
Tighten the fuel line nuts to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
50. Apply threadlock, P/N 12345382, or equivalent to the threads of the fuel pipe bolt. Install the
bolt.
Tighten
Tighten the fuel pipe bolt to 6 N.m (53 lb in).
51. Install ignition wires 1, 3, 5, and 7 to the distributor cap.
52. Install the vacuum brake booster hose and connector to the intake manifold.
53. Add one (1) ounce of Port Fuel Injector Cleaner, P/N 12345104 (Canada P/N 10953467), to the
vehicle fuel tank for each gallon of gasoline estimated to be in the tank. Instruct the customer to
add the remainder of the bottle of Port Fuel Injector Cleaner to the vehicle fuel tank at the next
fill-up. Further recommend that Port Fuel Injector Cleaner be added to the fuel tank every 3000
miles (4800 km) particularly if the vehicle is not started and driven every day. Inform the customer
that the Port Fuel Injector Cleaner is not to be used at every fill up but may be reapplied every 3000
miles (4800 km).
54. Tighten the fuel tank filler cap.
55. Start the engine and check for fuel leaks.
56. Use the Tech 2(R) Scan Tool to check for any stored Powertrain DTC codes. Clear codes as
required.
57. Disconnect the Tech 2(R) Scan tool.
58. Install the engine cover.
59. Advise customer to change brands of fuel.
Central SFI to MFI Conversion Instructions
This procedure outlines the steps required to replace the existing Central SFI Fuel System with a
new MFI (Multiport Flexible Injection) Fuel System. Be sure to use the appropriate year and model
Service Manual for proper disassembly and re-assembly procedure(s).
Important:
Cleaning the CSFI injectors is the preferred repair. The CSFI unit should not be replaced until
cleaning has been attempted. If the vehicle should
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel
System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4588
return for the same repair, then the CSFI unit can be replaced with a MFI unit. If the vehicle is out
of warranty, the customer should be given the option of which fix to pursue.
V6 Engines
1. Remove Upper Intake Manifold plenum and SFI Fuel Meter Body according to Service Manual
Procedures.
2. Remove the Fuel Meter Body bracket and discard. Install the new bracket as shown in Figure 1.
3. Position Fuel Tubes of MFI Fuel Meter Body as shown in Figure 2. Tubes must be oriented away
from the fuel pressure regulator end of the fuel meter body.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel
System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4589
Notice:
The number 3 Fuel Tube must be positioned behind the number 1 Fuel Tube to eliminate
interference with the Upper Intake Manifold plenum when installed. See Figure 2.
4. Insert the MFI Fuel Meter Body into the Fuel Meter Body Bracket on the Lower Intake Manifold
being careful not to bind the Fuel Tubes. Make sure that the number three Fuel Tube is routed in
behind number 1 and 5 Fuel Tubes as shown in Figure 2. Push down firmly on the fuel meter body
locking it into the bracket.
Notice:
Use caution when inserting injectors into lower intake manifold to be sure the correct injector is
being placed into the correct hole.
Injectors should not be removed once they have been installed.
Removal of injectors from the intake manifold may cause damage to the retaining lugs on the
injector.
Important:
The Injector holes are numbered on the Lower Intake Manifold. The injectors are numbered on the
side of the Fuel Meter Body.
5. Insert the number 3 injector into the correct Injector hole in the Lower Intake Manifold first. Install
the number 5 injector next and then number 1. This sequence must be followed correctly to prevent
interference of the Fuel Tubes. Injectors 2, 4, and 6 are then installed.
6. Insure that the electrical connectors of the injectors are positioned so that they do not interfere
with each other and are pointing towards the center of the Intake Manifold. If necessary, rotate the
electrical connectors inboard.
Notice:
Lack of lubrication will make installation of the Upper Intake Manifold plenum difficult and may
cause damage to the 0-ring.
7. Lubricate the Fuel Meter Body Upper Manifold 0-ring (orange in color) with clean engine oil.
8. Inspect the Upper Intake Manifold plenum gasket and replace if necessary. Reinstall the Upper
Intake Manifold plenum following the procedures outlined in the Service Manual.
Important:
Lubricate the Fuel Inlet and Return Lines with clean engine oil before inserting them into the Fuel
Meter Body.
Make sure that the Fuel Line Retaining Bracket is properly oriented with the tabs down.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel
System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4590
V8 Engines
This procedure outlines the steps required to replace the existing Central SFI Fuel System with a
new MFI (Multipoint Flexible Injection) Fuel System. Be sure to use the appropriate year and model
Service Manual for proper disassembly and re-assembly procedure(s).
1. Remove Upper Intake Manifold plenum and SFI Fuel Meter Body according to Service Manual
Procedures.
2. Remove the Fuel Meter Body bracket and discard. Install the new bracket.
3. Position Fuel Tubes of MFI Fuel Meter Body as shown in Figure 3. Fuel tubes 1, 3, 5, and 7 are
oriented toward the fuel inlet side of the fuel meter body. Fuel tubes 2, 4, 6, and 8 are oriented
toward the fuel pressure regulator side if the fuel meter body.
4. Insert the MFI Fuel Meter Body into the Fuel Meter Body Bracket on the Lower Intake Manifold
being careful not to bind the Fuel Tubes. Push down firmly on the fuel meter body until the tabs
snap into the bracket locking the fuel meter body in place.
5. Orient the fuel tubes to coincide with their corresponding cylinder. The fuel tubes are numbered
on the side of the fuel meter body and the corresponding cylinder number is cast in the intake
manifold.
Notice:
Use caution when inserting injectors into lower intake manifold to be sure the correct injector is
being placed into the correct hole.
Injectors should not be removed once they have been installed.
Removal of injectors from the intake manifold may cause damage to the retaining lugs on the
injector.
Important:
The Injector holes are numbered on the Lower Intake Manifold. The injectors are numbered on the
side of the Fuel Meter Body.
6. Insert the fuel tubes into their corresponding holes in the intake manifold. Install tubes for
cylinders 1, 3, 6 and 8 making sure that the injector electrical connectors are facing in toward the
center of the manifold.
7. Insert fuel tubes for cylinders 2, 4, 5, and 7 in the same manner.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 00-06-04-003B > Feb > 03 > Fuel
System - MIL ON/Rough Idle on Start-Up > Page 4591
Important:
When installing fuel tubes, it is important that the tubes are oriented properly to provide minimal
interference when installing the upper intake manifold plenum. Intake holes for cylinders 2, 4, 5,
and 7 are closer to the fuel meter body. It is necessary to cross tube 5 over tube 7 and tube 4 over
tube 2 as shown in Figure 4.
Notice:
Lack of lubrication will make installation of the Upper Intake Manifold plenum difficult and may
cause damage to the 0-ring.
8. Lubricate the Fuel Meter Body Upper Manifold 0-ring (blue in color) with clean engine oil.
9. Inspect Upper Intake Manifold Gasket and replace if necessary. Reinstall the Upper Intake
Manifold plenum following the procedures in the Service Manual.
Important:
Lubricate the Fuel Inlet and Return Lines with clean engine oil before inserting them in the of the
Fuel Meter Body.
Make sure that Fuel Line Retaining Bracket is properly oriented with the tabs down.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 99066F > Mar > 03 > Campaign Fuel Injector Sticking Closed
Fuel Injector: All Technical Service Bulletins Campaign - Fuel Injector Sticking Closed
File In Section: 06-Engine Emissions
Bulletin No.: 99066F
Date: March, 2003
SPECIAL POLICY
SUBJECT: 99066F - SPECIAL POLICY ADJUSTMENT - SEQUENTIAL CENTRAL PORT FUEL
INJECTION (SCPI) FAILURES IN CALIFORNIA ONLY (YF5 EMISSION EQUIPPED)
MODELS: CERTAIN 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 S/T, M/L, C/K, G, P, W4/NPR
TRUCKS AND 2003 NPR TRUCKS EQUIPPED WITH 4.3L (RPO L35 - VIN CODE W OR RPO
LF6 - VIN CODE X), 5.0L (RPO L30 - VIN CODE M) OR 5.7L (RPO L31 - VIN CODE R) ENGINE
AND CALIFORNIA EMISSION EQUIPPED (RPO YF5)
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2002 and 2003 model years to the SCPI Special Policy on
certain S/T, M/L, C/K, G, P and W4/NPR truck models. Please discard Special Policy Bulletin
Number 99066E, dated February, 2003.
CONDITION
Some customers of 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 model year S/T, M/L, C/K, G, P,
W4/NPR trucks and 2003 NPR trucks, that are registered in California, equipped with 4.3L (RPO
L35 and VIN Code W, or RPO LF6 and VIN Code X), 5.0L (RPO L30 and VIN Code M) or 5.7L
(RPO L31 and VIN Code R) engine, and California emissions (RPO YF5), may experience a
"Service Engine Soon" light, misfire, rough idle or hard start due to a deposit build-up on the
Sequential Central Port Fuel Injector (SCPI) poppet valve(s). The deposit build-up may cause
injector poppets to stick closed. Certain fuels have been found to interact with the SCPI system to
cause the deposits.
SPECIAL POLICY ADJUSTMENT
This special policy covers the SCPI failure condition described above for a period of ten (10) years
or 200,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the date the vehicle was originally placed in service,
regardless of ownership.
The repairs will be made at no charge to the owner. This special policy applies ONLY to repairs
requiring SCPI system servicing, injector cleaning and/or MFI assembly replacement of the SCPI
system. The customer should not be charged for performing a system check when it is determined
that the SCPI system is not the cause of a customer complaint (labor operation T5532 is provided
to submit claims for such system checks). Any additional necessary diagnosis and repairs that are
not related to the SCPI condition are not covered by this special policy. The customer should be
informed that any further service that is not covered by new vehicle warranty will not be covered by
this policy.
VEHICLES INVOLVED
Involved are certain 1996,1997,1998,1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 S/T, M/L, C/K, G, P, W4/NPR and
2003 NPR model vehicles, registered in California, equipped with 4.3L (RPO L35 - VIN Code W, or
RPO LF6 - VIN Code X), 5.0L (RPO L30 - VIN Code M) or 5.7L (RPO L31 - VIN Code R) engine;
and California emissions (RPO YF5). This Special Policy covers all vehicles within these model
years, with these engine and emissions RPO's.
PARTS INFORMATION
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 99066F > Mar > 03 > Campaign Fuel Injector Sticking Closed > Page 4601
Parts required to complete this special policy are to be obtained from General Motors Service Parts
Operations (GMSPO). Please refer to your "involved vehicles listing" prior to ordering parts. Normal
orders should be placed on a DRO Daily Replenishment Order. In an emergency, parts should be
ordered on a CSO = Customer Special Order.
IMPORTANT:
Isuzu Parts Ordering: In order to comply with the 10-digit Isuzu part numbering system, Isuzu
dealers must add an "8" to the beginning and a "0" to the end of the listed 8-digit part numbers
when ordering parts through AIPDN.
CUSTOMER NOTIFICATION
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 99066F > Mar > 03 > Campaign Fuel Injector Sticking Closed > Page 4602
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 99066F > Mar > 03 > Campaign Fuel Injector Sticking Closed > Page 4603
Customers will be notified of this special policy on their vehicles by General Motors (see copy of
typical customer letter included with this bulletin - actual divisional letter may vary slightly).
SERVICE PROCEDURE
System Check: Use strategy-based diagnoses listed in the front of the Driveability and Emissions
section of the service manual. If the SCPI system is operating properly, inform the customer that
the vehicle does not have the condition listed in the owner letter. If poor driveability conditions
persist, inform the customer that any further diagnosis and repairs will be at their expense if the
vehicle is outside the parameters of the new vehicle warranty.
SCPI Injector Cleaning Procedure: If diagnosis leads to sticking poppet nozzles, use the service
procedure from Service Bulletin 00-06-04-003B to clean the SCPI poppet nozzles. Please note that
the service bulletin term for SCPI is Central Sequential Fuel Injection (CSFI), but is referring to the
same fuel system assembly. If the poppet nozzles have previously been cleaned and the sticking
condition has reoccurred, refer to the correction paragraph below.
SCPI Fuel Tank Fill Pipe Assembly for 1997-99 M/L Van and 1999 - some 2000 C/K Truck: with
4.3L, 5.0L, 5.7L engines and built prior to listed VIN/Production dates on Service Bulletin
00-06-04-018: If diagnosis leads to sticking poppet nozzles on these models, use the service
procedure from Service Bulletin 00-06-04-018 to replace the fuel tank fill pipe assembly, if this
procedure has not been performed previously. Previous service procedure can be verified by
checking GMVIS for Labor Operation L1065 on "M/L" trucks with replacement part number
15050573; or Labor Operation L1065 on "C/K" trucks with replacement part numbers 15747585 or
15747588.
Correction: If, after cleaning the SCPI poppet nozzles, the normal service manual diagnosis still
indicates that the SCPI is the cause of the customer complaint, or if the injectors have previously
been cleaned and the vehicle has again experienced sticking poppet nozzles, refer to Service
Bulletin 00-06-04-003B and replace the SCPI fuel assembly with the MFI fuel assembly. Please
note that the service bulletin term for SCPI is Central Sequential Fuel Injection (CSFI), but is
referring to the same fuel system assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Injector: > 99066F > Mar > 03 > Campaign Fuel Injector Sticking Closed > Page 4604
CLAIM INFORMATION
For vehicles repaired under this special policy, submit a claim with the information indicated.
CUSTOMER REIMBURSEMENT
Customer requests for reimbursement are for any previously paid repairs to, or replacement of, the
Sequential Central Port Fuel Injection (SCPI) system. Repairs must have occurred within 10 years
of the date the vehicle was originally placed in service, or 200,000 miles, whichever occurs first.
The requests are to be submitted within two (2) years of the date on which the repair was paid or
within two (2) years of the date of this Special Policy Bulletin, whichever is greater.
When a customer requests reimbursement, they must provide the following:
- Proof of ownership at time of repair.
- Original paid receipt confirming the amount of unreimbursed repair expense(s) (including Service
Contract deductibles), a description of the repair, and the person or entity performing the repair.
Customers from the State of California, must submit requests for reimbursement directly to
(Divisions) per instructions in the owner letter.
If the work was done by someone other than a GM dealership, the amount of reimbursement will
be limited to the amount that the repair would have cost GM to have it completed by a GM
dealership.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Fuel Injector: Electrical Specifications Resistance Ohms
Resistance Ohms ECT between 50 - 90degrees F (10 - 32 degrees C)
Ohms 11.0-14.0
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 4607
Fuel Injector: Pressure, Vacuum and Temperature Specifications Fuel Injector Pressure Drop
Fuel Injector Pressure Drop If the pressure drop value for each injector is within 1.5 psi of the
average drop value the fuel injectors are flowing properly.
Pressure Drop 1.5 psi
Fuel Injector Balance Test Example (Typical)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuel Injector: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4610
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4611
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4612
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4613
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4614
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4615
Fuel Injector: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4616
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4617
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4618
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4619
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4620
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4621
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4622
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4623
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4624
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4625
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4626
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4627
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4628
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4629
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4630
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4631
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4632
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4633
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4634
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4635
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4636
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4637
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4638
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4639
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4640
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4641
Central Sequential Fuel Injection (CSFI)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4642
Fuel Injector: Description and Operation
The Multec 2 fuel injector assembly is a solenoid device, controlled by the PCM, that meters
pressurized fuel to a single engine cylinder. The PCM energizes the high-impedance (12.0 ohms)
injector solenoid to open a normally closed ball valve. This allows fuel to flow into the top of the
injector, past the ball valve, and through a director plate at the injector outlet. The director plate has
four machined holes that control the fuel flow, generating a spray of finely atomized fuel at the
injector tip. Fuel from the injector tip is directed at the intake valve, causing the fuel to become
further atomized and vaporized before entering the combustion chamber. This fine atomization
improves fuel economy and emissions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Fuel Injector Coil Test
Fuel Injector: Testing and Inspection Fuel Injector Coil Test
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The powertrain control module (PCM) enables the appropriate fuel injector on the intake stroke for
each cylinder. A voltage is supplied directly to the fuel injectors. The PCM controls each fuel
injector by grounding the control circuit via a solid state device called a driver. A fuel injector coil
winding resistance that is too high or too low will affect engine driveability. A fuel injector control
circuit DTC may not set, but a misfire may be apparent. The fuel injector coil windings are affected
by temperature. The resistance of the fuel injector coil windings will increase as the temperature of
the fuel injector increases.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS
^ Monitoring the misfire current counters, or misfire graph, may help to isolate the fuel injector that
is causing the condition.
^ Operating the vehicle over a wide temperature range may help isolate the fuel injector that is
causing the condition.
^ Perform the fuel injector coil test within the conditions of the customer's concern. A fuel injector
condition may only be apparent at a certain temperature, or under certain conditions.
^ If the fuel injector coil test does not isolate the condition perform the fuel injector balance test.
Refer to Fuel Injector Balance Test with Special Tool or Fuel Injector Balance Test with Tech 2.
See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and
General Diagnostics
TEST DESCRIPTION
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Fuel Injector Coil Test > Page 4645
Steps 1-7
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 3. This step tests each fuel
injector resistance within a specific temperature range. If any of the fuel injectors display a
resistance outside of the
specified value, replace the fuel injector.
4. This step determines if all of the fuel injectors are within 3 ohms of each other. If the highest
resistance value is within 3 ohms of the lowest
resistance value, then all of the fuel injector coil windings are OK.
5. This step determines which fuel injector is faulty. After subtracting the highest and lowest
resistance values from the average value, replace the
fuel injector that has the greatest resistance difference from the average.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Fuel Injector Coil Test > Page 4646
Fuel Injector: Testing and Inspection Fuel Injector Balance Test With special Tool
CIRCUIT
Fuel Injector Balance Test With Special Tool
Fuel Injector Balance Test Example (Typical)
TEST DESCRIPTION
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Fuel Injector Coil Test > Page 4647
Steps 1-5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Fuel Injector Coil Test > Page 4648
Steps 6-8
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 3. The engine coolant
temperature (ECT) must be below the operating temperature in order to avoid irregular fuel
pressure readings due to hot soak
fuel boiling.
6. If the pressure drop value for each fuel injector is within 10 kPa (1.5 psi) of the average pressure
drop value, the fuel injectors are flowing
properly. Calculate the pressure drop value for each fuel injector by subtracting the second
pressure reading from the first pressure reading. Refer to the Fuel Injector Balance Test Example.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Fuel Injector Coil Test > Page 4649
Fuel Injector: Testing and Inspection Fuel Injector Balance Test with Tech 2
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The scan tool first energizes the fuel pump and then the injectors for a precise amount of time
allowing a measured amount of fuel into the manifold. This causes a drop in system fuel pressure
that can be recorded and used to compare each injector.
TEST DESCRIPTION
Steps 1-5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Fuel Injector Coil Test > Page 4650
Steps 6-8
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 3. The engine coolant
temperature (ECT) must be below the operating temperature in order to avoid irregular fuel
pressure readings due to hot soak
fuel boiling.
4. The fuel pressure should be within the specified range. Refer to Fuel System Diagnosis if the
fuel pressure is not within the specified range. See:
Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics
5. The fuel pressure should reach a steady value. Refer to Fuel System Diagnosis if the fuel
pressure does not stabilize. See: Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics
6. If the pressure drop value for each fuel injector is within 10 kPa (1.5 psi) of the average pressure
drop value, the fuel injectors are flowing
properly. Calculate the pressure drop value for each fuel injector by subtracting the second
pressure reading from the first pressure reading.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Fuel Injector Coil Test > Page 4651
Fuel Injector: Testing and Inspection Fuel Injector Circuit Diagnosis
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The powertrain control module (PCM) enables the appropriate fuel injector on the intake stroke for
each cylinder. A voltage is supplied directly to the fuel injectors. The PCM controls each fuel
injector by grounding the control circuit via a solid state device called a driver.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS
^ Monitoring the fuel injector circuit status with a scan tool, while moving the fuel injector harness,
may help isolate an intermittent condition.
^ Performing the Fuel Injector Coil Test may help isolate an intermittent condition. Refer to Fuel
Injector Coil Test. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests
and General Diagnostics
^ For an intermittent condition refer to Intermittent Conditions. See: Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview/Diagnostic
Strategies/Intermittent Conditions
TEST DESCRIPTION
Steps 1-7
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Fuel Injector Coil Test > Page 4652
Steps 8-12
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 4. This step tests for a short
to ground on the ignition 1 voltage supply circuit of the fuel injector. 5. This step tests for a short to
a PCM ground on the ignition 1 voltage supply circuit of the fuel injector. 6. This step tests for an
open ignition 1 voltage supply circuit between the ECM 1 fuse and the multi-way connector. 7. This
step tests for high resistance between the ECM 1 fuse and the multi-way connector.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 4653
Fuel Injector: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Relieve the fuel system pressure. Refer to Fuel Pressure Relief Procedure. 2. Remove the upper
intake manifold assembly. 3. Remove the fuel meter body assembly (1). 4. Remove the injector
assembly retainer (4) and the injector retainer lock nuts (2).
NOTE: Use care in removing the fuel injectors to prevent damage to the electrical connector
terminals.
The fuel injector is serviced as a complete assembly only.
Also since the injectors are electrical components, these injectors should not be immersed in any
type of liquid solvent or cleaner as damage may occur. Fuel injector cleaning is not recommended.
5. While pulling the injector tube downward, push with a small tip punch down between the injector
terminals until the injector (3) is removed.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: Each injector is calibrated for a specific flow rate. Order the correct injector for the
application being serviced when replacing the fuel injectors.
1. Lubricate the O-ring seals with engine oil on the new fuel injector assembly (3). 2. Install the fuel
injector assembly (3) into the fuel meter body (1).
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 4654
3. Install the injector assembly retainer (4) and the injector retainer lock nuts (2).
Tighten Tighten the injector retainer lock nuts to 3 N.m (27 lb in).
4. Install the fuel meter body assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Line Coupler: Description and Operation
QUICK-CONNECT FITTINGS
Quick-connect fittings provide a simplified means of installing and connecting fuel system
components. The fittings consist of a unique female connector and a compatible male pipe end.
O-rings, located inside the female connector, provide the fuel seal. Integral locking tabs inside the
female connector hold the fittings together.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Quick Connect Fitting(S) Service (Metal Collar)
Fuel Line Coupler: Service and Repair Quick Connect Fitting(S) Service (Metal Collar)
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 37088-A Fuel Line Disconnect Tool Set
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing any fuel system connection. Refer to Fuel
Pressure Relief Procedure. 2. Remove the retainer from the quick-connect fitting.
CAUTION: Wear safety glasses when using compressed air in order to prevent eye injury.
3. Blow dirt out of the fitting using compressed air.
4. Choose the correct tool from J 37088-A tool set for the size of the fitting. Insert the tool into the
female connector, then push inward to release the
locking tabs.
5. Pull the connection apart.
NOTE: If necessary, remove rust or burrs from the fuel pipes with an emery cloth. Use a radial
motion with the fuel pipe end in order to prevent damage to the O-ring sealing surface. Use a clean
shop towel in order to wipe off the male tube ends. Inspect all the connections for dirt and burrs.
Clean or replace the components and assemblies as required.
6. Using a clean shop towel, wipe off the male pipe end. 7. Inspect both ends of the fitting for dirt
and burrs. Clean or replace the components as required.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Quick Connect Fitting(S) Service (Metal Collar) > Page 4660
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Always apply a few drops of clean engine oil to the male pipe ends before connecting
the fuel pipe fittings in order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury. This will ensure proper
reconnection and prevent a possible fuel leak. During normal operation, the O-rings located in the
female connector will swell and may prevent proper reconnection if not lubricated.
1. Apply a few drops of clean engine oil to the male pipe end.
2. Push both sides of the fitting together to cause the retaining tabs to snap into place.
3. Once installed, pull on both sides of the fitting to make sure the connection is secure. 4. Install
the retainer to the quick-connect fitting.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Quick Connect Fitting(S) Service (Metal Collar) > Page 4661
Fuel Line Coupler: Service and Repair Quick Connect Fitting(S) Service (Plastic Collar)
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing any fuel system connection. Refer to the Fuel
Pressure Relief Procedure.
CAUTION: Wear safety glasses when using compressed air in order to prevent eye injury.
2. Using compressed air, blow any dirt out of the quick-connect fitting.
3. Squeeze the plastic retainer release tabs.
4. Pull the connection apart.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Always apply a few drops Of clean engine oil to the male pipe ends before connecting
the fuel pipe fittings in order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury. This will ensure proper
reconnection and prevent a possible fuel leak. During normal operation, the O-rings located In the
female connector will swell and may prevent proper reconnection If not lubricated.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Quick Connect Fitting(S) Service (Metal Collar) > Page 4662
1. Apply a few drops of clean engine oil to the male fuel pipe end.
2. Push both sides of the quick-connect fitting together in order to cause the retaining tabs to snap
into place.
3. Once installed, pull on both sides of the quick-connect fitting in order to make sure the
connection is secure.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Meter Body > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Meter Body: Description and Operation
FUEL METER BODY ASSEMBLY
The fuel meter body assembly attaches to the lower intake manifold. The fuel meter body assembly
performs the following functions:
^ Distributes fuel evenly to the injectors
^ Integrates the fuel pressure regulator into the fuel metering system
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Meter Body > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 4666
Fuel Meter Body: Service and Repair
FUEL METER BODY ASSEMBLY REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
An 8 digit part identification number is on a mylar label affixed to the fuel meter body assembly.
Refer to this number if servicing or part replacement is required.
1. Relieve the fuel system pressure. Refer to Fuel Pressure Relief Procedure. 2. Remove the upper
intake manifold assembly.
NOTE: Do not use any solvent that contains Methyl Ethyl Ketone (MEK). This solvent may damage
fuel system components.
3. Before removal, clean the fuel meter body assembly with a spray type engine cleaner, GM
X-30A, if necessary. Follow the package instructions.
Do not soak fuel meter body assemblies in liquid cleaning solvent.
NOTE: Cover the injector sockets in order to prevent dirt and other contaminants from entering the
open fuel passages.
IMPORTANT: When disconnecting the injectors, remember the sequence in order to ensure
correct injector placement to each cylinder.
4. Squeeze the injector locking tabs together while lining the injector out of the casting socket.
5. Remove the fuel meter body from the bracket by releasing the lock tabs on the bracket.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the MFI fuel meter body into the bracket on the lower intake manifold. Place all of the fuel
tubes in a forward position. Route the number 3
fuel tube behind the numbers 1 and 5 fuel tubes.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Meter Body > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 4667
CAUTION: Verify that the injectors are firmly seated and locked in their casting sockets, in order to
reduce the risk of fire and personal injury. An unlocked or a loose injector could work loose from its
socket and produce a fuel leak. If an injector is loose, replace the retainer.
IMPORTANT: The fuel meter body assembly and the lower intake are numbered to indicate correct
injector order. Ensure that the electrical connectors on the injectors do not interfere with each other
and point towards the center of the intake manifold. Rotate the electrical connectors inboard, if
necessary.
2. Insert the 6 injectors in the following sequence:
2.1. Insert #3 injector into the #3 injector hole.
2.2. Insert #5 injector into the #5 injector hole.
2.3. Insert #1 injector into the #1 injector hole.
2.4. Insert #2 injector into the #2 injector hole.
2.5. Insert #4 injector into the #4 injector hole.
2.6. Insert #6 injector into the #6 injector hole.
3. Install the upper intake manifold assembly. 4. Connect the negative battery cable. 5. Inspect for
leaks using the following procedure:
5.1. Turn ON the ignition for 2 seconds.
5.2. Turn OFF the ignition for 10 seconds.
5.3. Turn ON the ignition.
5.4. Inspect for fuel leaks.
6. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Regulator >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Pressure Regulator: Description and Operation
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR ASSEMBLY
Fuel Pressure Regulator Assembly
The fuel pressure regulator is a diaphragm relief valve. The diaphragm has fuel pressure on one
side and regulator spring pressure and intake manifold vacuum on the other side. The fuel
pressure regulator maintains a constant pressure differential across the fuel injectors under all
operating conditions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Regulator >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4671
Fuel Pressure Regulator: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Relieve the fuel system pressure. Refer to Fuel Pressure Relief Procedure in Computers and
Controls Systems. 2. Remove the upper intake manifold assembly. 3. Remove the fuel pressure
regulator retainer clip (5). 4. Pull and twist the fuel pressure regulator (6) in order to remove the fuel
pressure regulator from the fuel pressure regulator housing using a shop
towel to catch any spilled fuel.
5. Remove the regulator seal lower O-ring (3). 6. Remove the regulator assembly filter (2). 7.
Remove the regulator seal upper O-ring (1). 8. Remove the regulator seal backup ring (7). 9.
Discard the O-rings.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: If the fuel pressure regulator is to be reinstalled, inspect the filter screen for
contamination. If the filter screen is contaminated, replace the regulator.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Regulator >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4672
1. Lubricate the new O-rings with clean engine oil. 2. Install the regulator seal backup ring (7). 3.
Install the regulator seal upper O-ring (1). 4. Install the regulator assembly filter (2). 5. Install the
regulator seal lower O-ring (3). 6. Assemble the regulator (6) with the vacuum tube pointing down
into the regulator retainer clip. 7. Install the fuel pressure regulator retainer clip (5). 8. Install the
upper manifold assembly. 9. Connect the negative battery cable.
10. Inspect for leaks.
10.1. Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF, for 2 seconds. 10.2. Turn OFF the ignition for 10
seconds. 10.3. Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. 10.4. Inspect for fuel leaks.
11. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Test Port >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
Fuel Pressure Test Port > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Locations
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuel Pump Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4686
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4687
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4688
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4689
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4690
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4691
Fuel Pump Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4692
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4693
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4694
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4695
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4696
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4697
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4698
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4699
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4700
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4701
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4702
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4703
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4704
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4705
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4706
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4707
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4708
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4709
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4710
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4711
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4712
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4713
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4714
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4715
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4716
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Pickup Filter >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Pump Pickup Filter: Description and Operation
FUEL STRAINER
The fuel strainer attaches to the lower end of the fuel sender. The fuel strainer is made of woven
plastic. The functions of the fuel strainer are to filter contaminants and to wick fuel. The fuel strainer
is self-cleaning and normally requires no maintenance. Fuel stoppage at this point indicates that
the fuel tank contains an abnormal amount of sediment or water.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Pickup Filter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4720
Fuel Pump Pickup Filter: Service and Repair
FUEL STRAINER REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the fuel sender assembly. 2. Note the position of the fuel strainer (2) on the fuel sender.
3. Support the fuel sender assembly with one hand and grasp the strainer (2) with the other hand.
4. Pull the strainer off the fuel sender. Discard the strainer after inspection. 5. Inspect the strainer.
Replace a contaminated strainer and clean the fuel tank.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install a new fuel strainer (2) in the same position as noted during disassembly. Push the strainer
on the bottom of the fuel sender until the strainer
is fully seated.
2. Install the fuel sender assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Return Line > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Return Line: Description and Operation
FUEL FEED AND RETURN PIPES
The fuel feed pipe carries fuel from the fuel tank to the fuel meter body assembly. The fuel return
pipe carries fuel from the fuel meter body assembly back to the fuel tank. The fuel pipes consist of
2 sections:
^ The rear fuel pipe assemblies are located from the top of the fuel tank to the chassis fuel pipes.
The rear fuel pipes are constructed of nylon.
^ The chassis fuel pipes are located under the vehicle and connect the rear fuel pipes to the fuel
meter body. These pipes are constructed of steel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Hose/Pipes Replacement - Engine Compartment
Fuel Supply Line: Service and Repair Fuel Hose/Pipes Replacement - Engine Compartment
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Relieve the fuel system pressure. Refer to Fuel Pressure Relief Procedure. 2. Remove the air
cleaner outlet resonator. 3. Disconnect the left bank spark plug wires from the distributor. 4.
Disconnect the fuel pipes at the rear of the intake manifold.
5. Remove the injector fuel inlet and outlet pipe retainer nuts. 6. Remove the injector fuel inlet and
the outlet pipe retainer.
7. Remove the rear fuel pipe bracket retaining bolt.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Hose/Pipes Replacement - Engine Compartment > Page 4728
8. Pull straight up on the fuel pipes in order to remove the fuel pipes from the fuel meter body. 9.
Remove the O-ring seals from both ends of the fuel feed and return pipes.
10. Discard the O-ring seals.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Assemble the new O-rings into the inlet and outlet of the fuel meter body.
CAUTION: Refer to Fuel Pipe Fitting Caution in Service Precautions.
2. Apply a few drops of clean engine oil to the male tube ends. 3. Install the fuel feed and return
pipes to the fuel meter body.
4. Install the fuel pipe retainer and the attaching nuts. Once installed, pull on both ends of each
connection in order to make sure they are secure.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Hose/Pipes Replacement - Engine Compartment > Page 4729
5. Install the rear fuel pipe bracket retaining bolt.
Tighten 5.1.
Tighten the rear fuel pipe bracket bolt to 6 N.m (53 lb in).
5.2. Tighten the fuel pipe retainer nuts to 3 N.m (27 lb in).
6. Install the new O-ring seals on the engine fuel feed and the return pipes. 7. Connect the fuel
feed and return pipes to the engine fuel pipes.
Tighten Tighten the fuel pipe fittings to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
8. Connect the negative battery cable. 9. Inspect for fuel leaks.
9.1. Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF, for 2 seconds.
9.2. Turn OFF the ignition for 10 seconds.
9.3. Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
9.4. Inspect for fuel leaks.
10. Connect the left bank spark plug wires to the distributor. 11. Install the air cleaner outlet
resonator. 12. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Hose/Pipes Replacement - Engine Compartment > Page 4730
Fuel Supply Line: Service and Repair Fuel Hose/Pipes Replacement - Chassis (Front)
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Relieve the fuel system pressure. Refer to Fuel Pressure Relief Procedure. 2. Clean all the fuel
pipe connections and the surrounding areas before disconnecting the pipes in order to avoid
possible contamination of the fuel
system.
3. Disconnect the fuel feed and return pipes (8) from the engine compartment fuel pipes. 4. Cap the
engine compartment fuel pipes. 5. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 6.
Remove the fuel pipes retainer mounting stud (7) from the cylinder head. 7. Remove the fuel pipes
retainer mounting stud (6) from the transmission. 8. Remove the fuel pipes retainer mounting
fastener (5) from the crossrail.
9. Disconnect the fuel return pipe (2) at the coupler (3).
10. Disconnect the fuel feed pipe at the fuel filter outlet. 11. Cap the rear fuel pipes. 12. Note the
position of the fuel pipes for aid in installation. 13. Remove the fuel pipes from the retaining clips.
14. Remove the fuel pipes.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: ^
When replacing the fuel pipes, always replace them with original equipment or parts that meet the
GM specifications for those parts. The
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Hose/Pipes Replacement - Engine Compartment > Page 4731
replacement pipes must have the same type of fittings as the original pipes in order to ensure the
integrity of the connection.
^ Do not use copper or aluminum tubing to replace steel tubing. Only tubing meeting the 124-M
specification or its equivalent is capable of meeting all pressure, corrosion and vibration
characteristics necessary to ensure the durability standard required.
1. Remove the caps from the rear fuel pipes.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Connect the chassis fuel feed pipe at the fuel filter outlet.
Tighten Tighten the fuel feed pipe fitting to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
3. Connect the fuel return pipe (2) at the coupler (3).
Tighten Tighten the return pipe fitting to 27 N.m (20 lb ft).
4. Install the fuel pipes into the transmission bracket retainer. 5. Install the mounting stud (6).
Tighten Tighten the mounting stud to 33 N.m (24 lb ft).
6. Install the fuel pipes into the cylinder head retainer. 7. Install the mounting stud (7).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Hose/Pipes Replacement - Engine Compartment > Page 4732
Tighten Tighten the mounting stud to 33 N.m (24 lb ft).
8. Install the fuel pipes into the crossrail retainer. 9. Install the mounting bolt (5) to the crossrail.
Tighten Tighten the mounting bolt to 11 N.m (97 lb in).
10. Lower the vehicle. 11. Remove the caps from the engine compartment fuel pipes. 12. Connect
the fuel feed and return pipes (8) to the engine compartment fuel pipes.
Ensure the O-rings are in place.
Tighten Tighten the fuel feed and return pipe fittings to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
13. Connect the negative battery cable. 14. Inspect for leaks.
14.1. Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF, for 2 seconds. 14.2. Turn OFF the ignition for 10
seconds. 14.3. Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. 14.4. Inspect for fuel leaks.
15. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Hose/Pipes Replacement - Engine Compartment > Page 4733
Fuel Supply Line: Service and Repair Fuel Hose/Pipes Replacement - Chassis (Rear)
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Relieve the fuel system pressure. Refer to Fuel Pressure Relief Procedure. 2. Disconnect the
front fuel pipes (3) from the rear chassis pipes (1). 3. Drain gasoline into an approved container.
4. Disconnect the fuel feed pipe (1) from the fuel filter. 5. Discard the O-ring. 6. Disconnect the fuel
return pipe (2) from the coupler (3). 7. Discard the O-ring.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Hose/Pipes Replacement - Engine Compartment > Page 4734
8. Disconnect the fuel return (5) and the fuel feed (2) pipes from the fuel tank pipes (1). 9. Release
the fuel pipe grommet (4) from the crossrail.
10. Remove the fuel pipe retainer (3) from the crossrail. 11. Release the fuel pipes from the
retainer and the grommet.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Fuel Pipe Fitting Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Install the new O-rings on the engine fuel feed and return pipes. 2. Position the fuel pipes into
the crossrail retainer and the crossrail grommet. 3. Position the new fuel pipes through the
crossrails in the original location. 4. Loosely assemble the fuel feed pipe (1) to the fuel filter. 5.
Loosely assemble the fuel return pipe (2) to the coupler (3).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Hose/Pipes Replacement - Engine Compartment > Page 4735
6. Install the fuel pipe grommet (4) into the crossrail. Lubricate the grommet to aid in the
installation.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
7. Install the fuel pipe retainer to the crossrail.
Tighten ^
Tighten the fuel pipe crossrail retainer to 11 N.m (97 lb in).
^ Tighten the fuel feed pipe to fuel filter fitting to 27 N.m (20 lb ft) using a back-up wrench.
^ Tighten the fuel return pipe to coupler fitting to 27 N.m (20 lb ft) using a back-up wrench.
8. Apply a few drops of clean engine oil to the rear male connector pipe ends. 9. Connect the fuel
return (5) and the fuel feed (2) pipes to the fuel tank pipes (1).
10. Connect the negative battery cable. 11. Inspect for fuel leaks.
11.1. Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF, for 2 seconds. 11.2. Turn OFF the ignition for 10
seconds. 11.3. Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF. 11.4. Inspect for fuel leaks.
12. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Hose/Pipes Replacement - Engine Compartment > Page 4736
Fuel Supply Line: Service and Repair Fuel Hose/Pipes Assembly Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the fuel tank. 2. Remove the fuel pipes (1) from the fuel sender (2).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Fuel Pipe Fitting Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Install fuel pipes (1) to the fuel sender (2). 2. Install the fuel tank.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Fuel Filler Hose: > 99066F > Mar > 03 > Campaign Fuel Injector Sticking Closed
Fuel Filler Hose: Recalls Campaign - Fuel Injector Sticking Closed
File In Section: 06-Engine Emissions
Bulletin No.: 99066F
Date: March, 2003
SPECIAL POLICY
SUBJECT: 99066F - SPECIAL POLICY ADJUSTMENT - SEQUENTIAL CENTRAL PORT FUEL
INJECTION (SCPI) FAILURES IN CALIFORNIA ONLY (YF5 EMISSION EQUIPPED)
MODELS: CERTAIN 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 S/T, M/L, C/K, G, P, W4/NPR
TRUCKS AND 2003 NPR TRUCKS EQUIPPED WITH 4.3L (RPO L35 - VIN CODE W OR RPO
LF6 - VIN CODE X), 5.0L (RPO L30 - VIN CODE M) OR 5.7L (RPO L31 - VIN CODE R) ENGINE
AND CALIFORNIA EMISSION EQUIPPED (RPO YF5)
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2002 and 2003 model years to the SCPI Special Policy on
certain S/T, M/L, C/K, G, P and W4/NPR truck models. Please discard Special Policy Bulletin
Number 99066E, dated February, 2003.
CONDITION
Some customers of 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 model year S/T, M/L, C/K, G, P,
W4/NPR trucks and 2003 NPR trucks, that are registered in California, equipped with 4.3L (RPO
L35 and VIN Code W, or RPO LF6 and VIN Code X), 5.0L (RPO L30 and VIN Code M) or 5.7L
(RPO L31 and VIN Code R) engine, and California emissions (RPO YF5), may experience a
"Service Engine Soon" light, misfire, rough idle or hard start due to a deposit build-up on the
Sequential Central Port Fuel Injector (SCPI) poppet valve(s). The deposit build-up may cause
injector poppets to stick closed. Certain fuels have been found to interact with the SCPI system to
cause the deposits.
SPECIAL POLICY ADJUSTMENT
This special policy covers the SCPI failure condition described above for a period of ten (10) years
or 200,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the date the vehicle was originally placed in service,
regardless of ownership.
The repairs will be made at no charge to the owner. This special policy applies ONLY to repairs
requiring SCPI system servicing, injector cleaning and/or MFI assembly replacement of the SCPI
system. The customer should not be charged for performing a system check when it is determined
that the SCPI system is not the cause of a customer complaint (labor operation T5532 is provided
to submit claims for such system checks). Any additional necessary diagnosis and repairs that are
not related to the SCPI condition are not covered by this special policy. The customer should be
informed that any further service that is not covered by new vehicle warranty will not be covered by
this policy.
VEHICLES INVOLVED
Involved are certain 1996,1997,1998,1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 S/T, M/L, C/K, G, P, W4/NPR and
2003 NPR model vehicles, registered in California, equipped with 4.3L (RPO L35 - VIN Code W, or
RPO LF6 - VIN Code X), 5.0L (RPO L30 - VIN Code M) or 5.7L (RPO L31 - VIN Code R) engine;
and California emissions (RPO YF5). This Special Policy covers all vehicles within these model
years, with these engine and emissions RPO's.
PARTS INFORMATION
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Fuel Filler Hose: > 99066F > Mar > 03 > Campaign Fuel Injector Sticking Closed > Page 4746
Parts required to complete this special policy are to be obtained from General Motors Service Parts
Operations (GMSPO). Please refer to your "involved vehicles listing" prior to ordering parts. Normal
orders should be placed on a DRO Daily Replenishment Order. In an emergency, parts should be
ordered on a CSO = Customer Special Order.
IMPORTANT:
Isuzu Parts Ordering: In order to comply with the 10-digit Isuzu part numbering system, Isuzu
dealers must add an "8" to the beginning and a "0" to the end of the listed 8-digit part numbers
when ordering parts through AIPDN.
CUSTOMER NOTIFICATION
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Fuel Filler Hose: > 99066F > Mar > 03 > Campaign Fuel Injector Sticking Closed > Page 4747
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Fuel Filler Hose: > 99066F > Mar > 03 > Campaign Fuel Injector Sticking Closed > Page 4748
Customers will be notified of this special policy on their vehicles by General Motors (see copy of
typical customer letter included with this bulletin - actual divisional letter may vary slightly).
SERVICE PROCEDURE
System Check: Use strategy-based diagnoses listed in the front of the Driveability and Emissions
section of the service manual. If the SCPI system is operating properly, inform the customer that
the vehicle does not have the condition listed in the owner letter. If poor driveability conditions
persist, inform the customer that any further diagnosis and repairs will be at their expense if the
vehicle is outside the parameters of the new vehicle warranty.
SCPI Injector Cleaning Procedure: If diagnosis leads to sticking poppet nozzles, use the service
procedure from Service Bulletin 00-06-04-003B to clean the SCPI poppet nozzles. Please note that
the service bulletin term for SCPI is Central Sequential Fuel Injection (CSFI), but is referring to the
same fuel system assembly. If the poppet nozzles have previously been cleaned and the sticking
condition has reoccurred, refer to the correction paragraph below.
SCPI Fuel Tank Fill Pipe Assembly for 1997-99 M/L Van and 1999 - some 2000 C/K Truck: with
4.3L, 5.0L, 5.7L engines and built prior to listed VIN/Production dates on Service Bulletin
00-06-04-018: If diagnosis leads to sticking poppet nozzles on these models, use the service
procedure from Service Bulletin 00-06-04-018 to replace the fuel tank fill pipe assembly, if this
procedure has not been performed previously. Previous service procedure can be verified by
checking GMVIS for Labor Operation L1065 on "M/L" trucks with replacement part number
15050573; or Labor Operation L1065 on "C/K" trucks with replacement part numbers 15747585 or
15747588.
Correction: If, after cleaning the SCPI poppet nozzles, the normal service manual diagnosis still
indicates that the SCPI is the cause of the customer complaint, or if the injectors have previously
been cleaned and the vehicle has again experienced sticking poppet nozzles, refer to Service
Bulletin 00-06-04-003B and replace the SCPI fuel assembly with the MFI fuel assembly. Please
note that the service bulletin term for SCPI is Central Sequential Fuel Injection (CSFI), but is
referring to the same fuel system assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Fuel Filler Hose: > 99066F > Mar > 03 > Campaign Fuel Injector Sticking Closed > Page 4749
CLAIM INFORMATION
For vehicles repaired under this special policy, submit a claim with the information indicated.
CUSTOMER REIMBURSEMENT
Customer requests for reimbursement are for any previously paid repairs to, or replacement of, the
Sequential Central Port Fuel Injection (SCPI) system. Repairs must have occurred within 10 years
of the date the vehicle was originally placed in service, or 200,000 miles, whichever occurs first.
The requests are to be submitted within two (2) years of the date on which the repair was paid or
within two (2) years of the date of this Special Policy Bulletin, whichever is greater.
When a customer requests reimbursement, they must provide the following:
- Proof of ownership at time of repair.
- Original paid receipt confirming the amount of unreimbursed repair expense(s) (including Service
Contract deductibles), a description of the repair, and the person or entity performing the repair.
Customers from the State of California, must submit requests for reimbursement directly to
(Divisions) per instructions in the owner letter.
If the work was done by someone other than a GM dealership, the amount of reimbursement will
be limited to the amount that the repair would have cost GM to have it completed by a GM
dealership.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Filler Hose: > 99066F > Mar
> 03 > Campaign - Fuel Injector Sticking Closed
Fuel Filler Hose: All Technical Service Bulletins Campaign - Fuel Injector Sticking Closed
File In Section: 06-Engine Emissions
Bulletin No.: 99066F
Date: March, 2003
SPECIAL POLICY
SUBJECT: 99066F - SPECIAL POLICY ADJUSTMENT - SEQUENTIAL CENTRAL PORT FUEL
INJECTION (SCPI) FAILURES IN CALIFORNIA ONLY (YF5 EMISSION EQUIPPED)
MODELS: CERTAIN 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 S/T, M/L, C/K, G, P, W4/NPR
TRUCKS AND 2003 NPR TRUCKS EQUIPPED WITH 4.3L (RPO L35 - VIN CODE W OR RPO
LF6 - VIN CODE X), 5.0L (RPO L30 - VIN CODE M) OR 5.7L (RPO L31 - VIN CODE R) ENGINE
AND CALIFORNIA EMISSION EQUIPPED (RPO YF5)
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2002 and 2003 model years to the SCPI Special Policy on
certain S/T, M/L, C/K, G, P and W4/NPR truck models. Please discard Special Policy Bulletin
Number 99066E, dated February, 2003.
CONDITION
Some customers of 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 model year S/T, M/L, C/K, G, P,
W4/NPR trucks and 2003 NPR trucks, that are registered in California, equipped with 4.3L (RPO
L35 and VIN Code W, or RPO LF6 and VIN Code X), 5.0L (RPO L30 and VIN Code M) or 5.7L
(RPO L31 and VIN Code R) engine, and California emissions (RPO YF5), may experience a
"Service Engine Soon" light, misfire, rough idle or hard start due to a deposit build-up on the
Sequential Central Port Fuel Injector (SCPI) poppet valve(s). The deposit build-up may cause
injector poppets to stick closed. Certain fuels have been found to interact with the SCPI system to
cause the deposits.
SPECIAL POLICY ADJUSTMENT
This special policy covers the SCPI failure condition described above for a period of ten (10) years
or 200,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the date the vehicle was originally placed in service,
regardless of ownership.
The repairs will be made at no charge to the owner. This special policy applies ONLY to repairs
requiring SCPI system servicing, injector cleaning and/or MFI assembly replacement of the SCPI
system. The customer should not be charged for performing a system check when it is determined
that the SCPI system is not the cause of a customer complaint (labor operation T5532 is provided
to submit claims for such system checks). Any additional necessary diagnosis and repairs that are
not related to the SCPI condition are not covered by this special policy. The customer should be
informed that any further service that is not covered by new vehicle warranty will not be covered by
this policy.
VEHICLES INVOLVED
Involved are certain 1996,1997,1998,1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 S/T, M/L, C/K, G, P, W4/NPR and
2003 NPR model vehicles, registered in California, equipped with 4.3L (RPO L35 - VIN Code W, or
RPO LF6 - VIN Code X), 5.0L (RPO L30 - VIN Code M) or 5.7L (RPO L31 - VIN Code R) engine;
and California emissions (RPO YF5). This Special Policy covers all vehicles within these model
years, with these engine and emissions RPO's.
PARTS INFORMATION
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Filler Hose: > 99066F > Mar
> 03 > Campaign - Fuel Injector Sticking Closed > Page 4755
Parts required to complete this special policy are to be obtained from General Motors Service Parts
Operations (GMSPO). Please refer to your "involved vehicles listing" prior to ordering parts. Normal
orders should be placed on a DRO Daily Replenishment Order. In an emergency, parts should be
ordered on a CSO = Customer Special Order.
IMPORTANT:
Isuzu Parts Ordering: In order to comply with the 10-digit Isuzu part numbering system, Isuzu
dealers must add an "8" to the beginning and a "0" to the end of the listed 8-digit part numbers
when ordering parts through AIPDN.
CUSTOMER NOTIFICATION
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Filler Hose: > 99066F > Mar
> 03 > Campaign - Fuel Injector Sticking Closed > Page 4756
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Filler Hose: > 99066F > Mar
> 03 > Campaign - Fuel Injector Sticking Closed > Page 4757
Customers will be notified of this special policy on their vehicles by General Motors (see copy of
typical customer letter included with this bulletin - actual divisional letter may vary slightly).
SERVICE PROCEDURE
System Check: Use strategy-based diagnoses listed in the front of the Driveability and Emissions
section of the service manual. If the SCPI system is operating properly, inform the customer that
the vehicle does not have the condition listed in the owner letter. If poor driveability conditions
persist, inform the customer that any further diagnosis and repairs will be at their expense if the
vehicle is outside the parameters of the new vehicle warranty.
SCPI Injector Cleaning Procedure: If diagnosis leads to sticking poppet nozzles, use the service
procedure from Service Bulletin 00-06-04-003B to clean the SCPI poppet nozzles. Please note that
the service bulletin term for SCPI is Central Sequential Fuel Injection (CSFI), but is referring to the
same fuel system assembly. If the poppet nozzles have previously been cleaned and the sticking
condition has reoccurred, refer to the correction paragraph below.
SCPI Fuel Tank Fill Pipe Assembly for 1997-99 M/L Van and 1999 - some 2000 C/K Truck: with
4.3L, 5.0L, 5.7L engines and built prior to listed VIN/Production dates on Service Bulletin
00-06-04-018: If diagnosis leads to sticking poppet nozzles on these models, use the service
procedure from Service Bulletin 00-06-04-018 to replace the fuel tank fill pipe assembly, if this
procedure has not been performed previously. Previous service procedure can be verified by
checking GMVIS for Labor Operation L1065 on "M/L" trucks with replacement part number
15050573; or Labor Operation L1065 on "C/K" trucks with replacement part numbers 15747585 or
15747588.
Correction: If, after cleaning the SCPI poppet nozzles, the normal service manual diagnosis still
indicates that the SCPI is the cause of the customer complaint, or if the injectors have previously
been cleaned and the vehicle has again experienced sticking poppet nozzles, refer to Service
Bulletin 00-06-04-003B and replace the SCPI fuel assembly with the MFI fuel assembly. Please
note that the service bulletin term for SCPI is Central Sequential Fuel Injection (CSFI), but is
referring to the same fuel system assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Filler Hose: > 99066F > Mar
> 03 > Campaign - Fuel Injector Sticking Closed > Page 4758
CLAIM INFORMATION
For vehicles repaired under this special policy, submit a claim with the information indicated.
CUSTOMER REIMBURSEMENT
Customer requests for reimbursement are for any previously paid repairs to, or replacement of, the
Sequential Central Port Fuel Injection (SCPI) system. Repairs must have occurred within 10 years
of the date the vehicle was originally placed in service, or 200,000 miles, whichever occurs first.
The requests are to be submitted within two (2) years of the date on which the repair was paid or
within two (2) years of the date of this Special Policy Bulletin, whichever is greater.
When a customer requests reimbursement, they must provide the following:
- Proof of ownership at time of repair.
- Original paid receipt confirming the amount of unreimbursed repair expense(s) (including Service
Contract deductibles), a description of the repair, and the person or entity performing the repair.
Customers from the State of California, must submit requests for reimbursement directly to
(Divisions) per instructions in the owner letter.
If the work was done by someone other than a GM dealership, the amount of reimbursement will
be limited to the amount that the repair would have cost GM to have it completed by a GM
dealership.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4759
Fuel Filler Hose: Description and Operation
FUEL FILL PIPE
The fuel fill pipe has a built-in restrictor and a deflector in order to prevent refueling with leaded
fuel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Filler Tube Replacement
Fuel Filler Hose: Service and Repair Filler Tube Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Drain the fuel tank to a level below that of the fuel tank
filler tube. Refer to Fuel Tank Draining Procedure. 3. Remove the fuel filler tube to the fuel filler
pocket screws (1). 4. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 5. Wipe the fuel
filler tube connection at the fuel tank with a clean cloth and then disconnect the fuel filler tube
clamp (3). 6. Remove the fuel fill tube attaching screw (2) and the fuel filler tube.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the fuel filler tube into the fuel tank.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the fuel filler tube attaching screw (2).
Tighten Tighten the attaching screw to 11.5 N.m (102 lb in).
3. Connect the fuel filler tube hose and clamp (3).
Tighten Tighten the fuel fill hose clamp to 3 N.m (27 lb in).
4. Install the fuel filler tube screws at the fuel filler pocket.
Tighten Tighten the fuel filler tube screws to 1.9 N.m (17 lb in).
5. Connect the negative battery cable. 6. Refill the fuel tank.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Filler Tube Replacement > Page 4762
7. Inspect for fuel leaks.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Filler Tube Replacement > Page 4763
Fuel Filler Hose: Service and Repair Fuel Filler Hose Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the fuel filler tube. 2. Disconnect the fuel fill hose from the fuel fill tube. 3. Remove the
fuel fill hose and the hose clamps (3). 4. Cap the fuel tank opening.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Uncap the fuel tank opening. 2. Install the fuel fill hose and the hose clamps (3) on to the filler
tube. 3. Install the fuel filler tube.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Neck >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Fuel Filler Neck: > 99066F > Mar > 03 > Campaign Fuel Injector Sticking Closed
Fuel Filler Neck: Recalls Campaign - Fuel Injector Sticking Closed
File In Section: 06-Engine Emissions
Bulletin No.: 99066F
Date: March, 2003
SPECIAL POLICY
SUBJECT: 99066F - SPECIAL POLICY ADJUSTMENT - SEQUENTIAL CENTRAL PORT FUEL
INJECTION (SCPI) FAILURES IN CALIFORNIA ONLY (YF5 EMISSION EQUIPPED)
MODELS: CERTAIN 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 S/T, M/L, C/K, G, P, W4/NPR
TRUCKS AND 2003 NPR TRUCKS EQUIPPED WITH 4.3L (RPO L35 - VIN CODE W OR RPO
LF6 - VIN CODE X), 5.0L (RPO L30 - VIN CODE M) OR 5.7L (RPO L31 - VIN CODE R) ENGINE
AND CALIFORNIA EMISSION EQUIPPED (RPO YF5)
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2002 and 2003 model years to the SCPI Special Policy on
certain S/T, M/L, C/K, G, P and W4/NPR truck models. Please discard Special Policy Bulletin
Number 99066E, dated February, 2003.
CONDITION
Some customers of 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 model year S/T, M/L, C/K, G, P,
W4/NPR trucks and 2003 NPR trucks, that are registered in California, equipped with 4.3L (RPO
L35 and VIN Code W, or RPO LF6 and VIN Code X), 5.0L (RPO L30 and VIN Code M) or 5.7L
(RPO L31 and VIN Code R) engine, and California emissions (RPO YF5), may experience a
"Service Engine Soon" light, misfire, rough idle or hard start due to a deposit build-up on the
Sequential Central Port Fuel Injector (SCPI) poppet valve(s). The deposit build-up may cause
injector poppets to stick closed. Certain fuels have been found to interact with the SCPI system to
cause the deposits.
SPECIAL POLICY ADJUSTMENT
This special policy covers the SCPI failure condition described above for a period of ten (10) years
or 200,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the date the vehicle was originally placed in service,
regardless of ownership.
The repairs will be made at no charge to the owner. This special policy applies ONLY to repairs
requiring SCPI system servicing, injector cleaning and/or MFI assembly replacement of the SCPI
system. The customer should not be charged for performing a system check when it is determined
that the SCPI system is not the cause of a customer complaint (labor operation T5532 is provided
to submit claims for such system checks). Any additional necessary diagnosis and repairs that are
not related to the SCPI condition are not covered by this special policy. The customer should be
informed that any further service that is not covered by new vehicle warranty will not be covered by
this policy.
VEHICLES INVOLVED
Involved are certain 1996,1997,1998,1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 S/T, M/L, C/K, G, P, W4/NPR and
2003 NPR model vehicles, registered in California, equipped with 4.3L (RPO L35 - VIN Code W, or
RPO LF6 - VIN Code X), 5.0L (RPO L30 - VIN Code M) or 5.7L (RPO L31 - VIN Code R) engine;
and California emissions (RPO YF5). This Special Policy covers all vehicles within these model
years, with these engine and emissions RPO's.
PARTS INFORMATION
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Neck >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Fuel Filler Neck: > 99066F > Mar > 03 > Campaign Fuel Injector Sticking Closed > Page 4772
Parts required to complete this special policy are to be obtained from General Motors Service Parts
Operations (GMSPO). Please refer to your "involved vehicles listing" prior to ordering parts. Normal
orders should be placed on a DRO Daily Replenishment Order. In an emergency, parts should be
ordered on a CSO = Customer Special Order.
IMPORTANT:
Isuzu Parts Ordering: In order to comply with the 10-digit Isuzu part numbering system, Isuzu
dealers must add an "8" to the beginning and a "0" to the end of the listed 8-digit part numbers
when ordering parts through AIPDN.
CUSTOMER NOTIFICATION
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Neck >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Fuel Filler Neck: > 99066F > Mar > 03 > Campaign Fuel Injector Sticking Closed > Page 4773
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Neck >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Fuel Filler Neck: > 99066F > Mar > 03 > Campaign Fuel Injector Sticking Closed > Page 4774
Customers will be notified of this special policy on their vehicles by General Motors (see copy of
typical customer letter included with this bulletin - actual divisional letter may vary slightly).
SERVICE PROCEDURE
System Check: Use strategy-based diagnoses listed in the front of the Driveability and Emissions
section of the service manual. If the SCPI system is operating properly, inform the customer that
the vehicle does not have the condition listed in the owner letter. If poor driveability conditions
persist, inform the customer that any further diagnosis and repairs will be at their expense if the
vehicle is outside the parameters of the new vehicle warranty.
SCPI Injector Cleaning Procedure: If diagnosis leads to sticking poppet nozzles, use the service
procedure from Service Bulletin 00-06-04-003B to clean the SCPI poppet nozzles. Please note that
the service bulletin term for SCPI is Central Sequential Fuel Injection (CSFI), but is referring to the
same fuel system assembly. If the poppet nozzles have previously been cleaned and the sticking
condition has reoccurred, refer to the correction paragraph below.
SCPI Fuel Tank Fill Pipe Assembly for 1997-99 M/L Van and 1999 - some 2000 C/K Truck: with
4.3L, 5.0L, 5.7L engines and built prior to listed VIN/Production dates on Service Bulletin
00-06-04-018: If diagnosis leads to sticking poppet nozzles on these models, use the service
procedure from Service Bulletin 00-06-04-018 to replace the fuel tank fill pipe assembly, if this
procedure has not been performed previously. Previous service procedure can be verified by
checking GMVIS for Labor Operation L1065 on "M/L" trucks with replacement part number
15050573; or Labor Operation L1065 on "C/K" trucks with replacement part numbers 15747585 or
15747588.
Correction: If, after cleaning the SCPI poppet nozzles, the normal service manual diagnosis still
indicates that the SCPI is the cause of the customer complaint, or if the injectors have previously
been cleaned and the vehicle has again experienced sticking poppet nozzles, refer to Service
Bulletin 00-06-04-003B and replace the SCPI fuel assembly with the MFI fuel assembly. Please
note that the service bulletin term for SCPI is Central Sequential Fuel Injection (CSFI), but is
referring to the same fuel system assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Neck >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Fuel Filler Neck: > 99066F > Mar > 03 > Campaign Fuel Injector Sticking Closed > Page 4775
CLAIM INFORMATION
For vehicles repaired under this special policy, submit a claim with the information indicated.
CUSTOMER REIMBURSEMENT
Customer requests for reimbursement are for any previously paid repairs to, or replacement of, the
Sequential Central Port Fuel Injection (SCPI) system. Repairs must have occurred within 10 years
of the date the vehicle was originally placed in service, or 200,000 miles, whichever occurs first.
The requests are to be submitted within two (2) years of the date on which the repair was paid or
within two (2) years of the date of this Special Policy Bulletin, whichever is greater.
When a customer requests reimbursement, they must provide the following:
- Proof of ownership at time of repair.
- Original paid receipt confirming the amount of unreimbursed repair expense(s) (including Service
Contract deductibles), a description of the repair, and the person or entity performing the repair.
Customers from the State of California, must submit requests for reimbursement directly to
(Divisions) per instructions in the owner letter.
If the work was done by someone other than a GM dealership, the amount of reimbursement will
be limited to the amount that the repair would have cost GM to have it completed by a GM
dealership.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Neck >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Filler Neck: > 99066F > Mar
> 03 > Campaign - Fuel Injector Sticking Closed
Fuel Filler Neck: All Technical Service Bulletins Campaign - Fuel Injector Sticking Closed
File In Section: 06-Engine Emissions
Bulletin No.: 99066F
Date: March, 2003
SPECIAL POLICY
SUBJECT: 99066F - SPECIAL POLICY ADJUSTMENT - SEQUENTIAL CENTRAL PORT FUEL
INJECTION (SCPI) FAILURES IN CALIFORNIA ONLY (YF5 EMISSION EQUIPPED)
MODELS: CERTAIN 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 S/T, M/L, C/K, G, P, W4/NPR
TRUCKS AND 2003 NPR TRUCKS EQUIPPED WITH 4.3L (RPO L35 - VIN CODE W OR RPO
LF6 - VIN CODE X), 5.0L (RPO L30 - VIN CODE M) OR 5.7L (RPO L31 - VIN CODE R) ENGINE
AND CALIFORNIA EMISSION EQUIPPED (RPO YF5)
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2002 and 2003 model years to the SCPI Special Policy on
certain S/T, M/L, C/K, G, P and W4/NPR truck models. Please discard Special Policy Bulletin
Number 99066E, dated February, 2003.
CONDITION
Some customers of 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 model year S/T, M/L, C/K, G, P,
W4/NPR trucks and 2003 NPR trucks, that are registered in California, equipped with 4.3L (RPO
L35 and VIN Code W, or RPO LF6 and VIN Code X), 5.0L (RPO L30 and VIN Code M) or 5.7L
(RPO L31 and VIN Code R) engine, and California emissions (RPO YF5), may experience a
"Service Engine Soon" light, misfire, rough idle or hard start due to a deposit build-up on the
Sequential Central Port Fuel Injector (SCPI) poppet valve(s). The deposit build-up may cause
injector poppets to stick closed. Certain fuels have been found to interact with the SCPI system to
cause the deposits.
SPECIAL POLICY ADJUSTMENT
This special policy covers the SCPI failure condition described above for a period of ten (10) years
or 200,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the date the vehicle was originally placed in service,
regardless of ownership.
The repairs will be made at no charge to the owner. This special policy applies ONLY to repairs
requiring SCPI system servicing, injector cleaning and/or MFI assembly replacement of the SCPI
system. The customer should not be charged for performing a system check when it is determined
that the SCPI system is not the cause of a customer complaint (labor operation T5532 is provided
to submit claims for such system checks). Any additional necessary diagnosis and repairs that are
not related to the SCPI condition are not covered by this special policy. The customer should be
informed that any further service that is not covered by new vehicle warranty will not be covered by
this policy.
VEHICLES INVOLVED
Involved are certain 1996,1997,1998,1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 S/T, M/L, C/K, G, P, W4/NPR and
2003 NPR model vehicles, registered in California, equipped with 4.3L (RPO L35 - VIN Code W, or
RPO LF6 - VIN Code X), 5.0L (RPO L30 - VIN Code M) or 5.7L (RPO L31 - VIN Code R) engine;
and California emissions (RPO YF5). This Special Policy covers all vehicles within these model
years, with these engine and emissions RPO's.
PARTS INFORMATION
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Neck >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Filler Neck: > 99066F > Mar
> 03 > Campaign - Fuel Injector Sticking Closed > Page 4781
Parts required to complete this special policy are to be obtained from General Motors Service Parts
Operations (GMSPO). Please refer to your "involved vehicles listing" prior to ordering parts. Normal
orders should be placed on a DRO Daily Replenishment Order. In an emergency, parts should be
ordered on a CSO = Customer Special Order.
IMPORTANT:
Isuzu Parts Ordering: In order to comply with the 10-digit Isuzu part numbering system, Isuzu
dealers must add an "8" to the beginning and a "0" to the end of the listed 8-digit part numbers
when ordering parts through AIPDN.
CUSTOMER NOTIFICATION
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Neck >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Filler Neck: > 99066F > Mar
> 03 > Campaign - Fuel Injector Sticking Closed > Page 4782
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Neck >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Filler Neck: > 99066F > Mar
> 03 > Campaign - Fuel Injector Sticking Closed > Page 4783
Customers will be notified of this special policy on their vehicles by General Motors (see copy of
typical customer letter included with this bulletin - actual divisional letter may vary slightly).
SERVICE PROCEDURE
System Check: Use strategy-based diagnoses listed in the front of the Driveability and Emissions
section of the service manual. If the SCPI system is operating properly, inform the customer that
the vehicle does not have the condition listed in the owner letter. If poor driveability conditions
persist, inform the customer that any further diagnosis and repairs will be at their expense if the
vehicle is outside the parameters of the new vehicle warranty.
SCPI Injector Cleaning Procedure: If diagnosis leads to sticking poppet nozzles, use the service
procedure from Service Bulletin 00-06-04-003B to clean the SCPI poppet nozzles. Please note that
the service bulletin term for SCPI is Central Sequential Fuel Injection (CSFI), but is referring to the
same fuel system assembly. If the poppet nozzles have previously been cleaned and the sticking
condition has reoccurred, refer to the correction paragraph below.
SCPI Fuel Tank Fill Pipe Assembly for 1997-99 M/L Van and 1999 - some 2000 C/K Truck: with
4.3L, 5.0L, 5.7L engines and built prior to listed VIN/Production dates on Service Bulletin
00-06-04-018: If diagnosis leads to sticking poppet nozzles on these models, use the service
procedure from Service Bulletin 00-06-04-018 to replace the fuel tank fill pipe assembly, if this
procedure has not been performed previously. Previous service procedure can be verified by
checking GMVIS for Labor Operation L1065 on "M/L" trucks with replacement part number
15050573; or Labor Operation L1065 on "C/K" trucks with replacement part numbers 15747585 or
15747588.
Correction: If, after cleaning the SCPI poppet nozzles, the normal service manual diagnosis still
indicates that the SCPI is the cause of the customer complaint, or if the injectors have previously
been cleaned and the vehicle has again experienced sticking poppet nozzles, refer to Service
Bulletin 00-06-04-003B and replace the SCPI fuel assembly with the MFI fuel assembly. Please
note that the service bulletin term for SCPI is Central Sequential Fuel Injection (CSFI), but is
referring to the same fuel system assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Neck >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Filler Neck: > 99066F > Mar
> 03 > Campaign - Fuel Injector Sticking Closed > Page 4784
CLAIM INFORMATION
For vehicles repaired under this special policy, submit a claim with the information indicated.
CUSTOMER REIMBURSEMENT
Customer requests for reimbursement are for any previously paid repairs to, or replacement of, the
Sequential Central Port Fuel Injection (SCPI) system. Repairs must have occurred within 10 years
of the date the vehicle was originally placed in service, or 200,000 miles, whichever occurs first.
The requests are to be submitted within two (2) years of the date on which the repair was paid or
within two (2) years of the date of this Special Policy Bulletin, whichever is greater.
When a customer requests reimbursement, they must provide the following:
- Proof of ownership at time of repair.
- Original paid receipt confirming the amount of unreimbursed repair expense(s) (including Service
Contract deductibles), a description of the repair, and the person or entity performing the repair.
Customers from the State of California, must submit requests for reimbursement directly to
(Divisions) per instructions in the owner letter.
If the work was done by someone other than a GM dealership, the amount of reimbursement will
be limited to the amount that the repair would have cost GM to have it completed by a GM
dealership.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge
Sender > Component Information > Specifications
Fuel Gauge Sender: Specifications
Fuel Level Specifications
The values in the table are approximate values based on information obtained from properly
operating vehicles. Actual results may vary slightly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge
Sender > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4788
Fuel Pump And Sender Assembly
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge
Sender > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4789
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor
The fuel level sensor consists of a float, a wire float arm, and a ceramic resistor card. The position
of the float arm indicates the fuel level. The fuel level sensor contains a variable resistor which
changes resistance in correspondence with the amount of fuel in the fuel tank. The Powertrain
Control Module ( PCM) sends the fuel level information via the class 2 circuit to the Instrument
Panel Cluster (IPC). This information is used for the IPC fuel gauge and the low fuel warning
indicator, if applicable. The PCM also monitors the fuel level input for various diagnostics.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge
Sender > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4790
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the fuel sender assembly. 2. Disconnect the fuel pump electrical connector (5). 3.
Remove the fuel level sensor electrical connector retaining clip (6). 4. Disconnect the fuel level
sensor electrical connector (7) from under the fuel sender cover. 5. Remove the fuel level sensor
retaining clip (4). 6. Squeeze the locking tangs and remove the fuel level sensor (3).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the fuel level sensor (3). 2. Install the fuel level sensor retaining clip (4). 3. Connect the
fuel level sensor electrical connector (7). 4. Connect the fuel level sensor electrical connector
retaining clip (6). 5. Connect the fuel pump electrical connector (5). 6. Install the fuel sender
assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Diagrams
Fuel Pump And Sender Assembly
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4794
Fuel Tank Unit: Description and Operation
FUEL SENDER ASSEMBLY
Fuel Sender Assembly
The fuel sender assembly consists of the following major components:
^ The fuel level sensor (6)
^ The Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) sensor (1)
^ The fuel pump module (2)
^ The fuel strainer (3)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4795
Fuel Tank Unit: Service and Repair
FUEL SENDER ASSEMBLY REPLACEMENT
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39765 Fuel Sender Locknut Wrench
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the fuel tank.
NOTE: Do Not handle the fuel sender assembly by the fuel pipes. The amount of leverage
generated by handling the fuel pipes could damage the joints.
2. Disconnect the fuel sender electrical connectors. 3. Disconnect the fuel and EVAP pipes from
the fuel sender. 4. Remove the fuel sender assembly retaining ring using the J 39765.
CAUTION: Drain the fuel from the fuel sender assembly into an approved container in order to
reduce the risk of fire and personal injury. Never store the fuel in an open container.
5. Remove the fuel sender assembly and the seal. Discard the seal. 6. Clean the fuel sender
sealing surfaces.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
CAUTION: In order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury that may result from a fuel leak,
always replace the fuel sender gasket when reinstalling the fuel sender assembly.
1. Install the new seal on the fuel tank.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4796
IMPORTANT: The fuel pump strainer must be in a horizontal position when the fuel sender is
installed in the tank. When installing the fuel sender assembly, assure that the fuel pump strainer
does not block full travel of the float arm.
2. Install the fuel sender assembly into the fuel tank. 3. Install the fuel sender assembly retaining
ring using the J 39765. 4. Connect the fuel and EVAP pipes to the fuel sender. 5. Connect the fuel
sender electrical connectors. 6. Install the fuel tank.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Locations > Page 4800
Idle Air Control (IAC) Valve
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Locations > Page 4801
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Testing and Inspection
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The engine idle speed is controlled by the idle air control (IAC) valve. The IAC valve is on the
throttle body. The IAC valve pintle moves in and out of an idle air passage bore to control air flow
around the throttle plate. The valve consists of a movable pintle, driven by a gear attached to a two
phase bi-polar permanent magnet electric motor called a stepper motor. The stepper motor is
capable of highly accurate rotation, or of movement, called steps. The stepper motor has two
separate windings that are called coils. Each coil is fed by two circuits from the powertrain control
module (PCM). When the PCM changes polarity of a coil, the stepper motor moves one step. The
PCM uses a predetermined number of counts to determine the IAC pintle position. Observe IAC
counts with a scan tool. The IAC counts will increment up or down as the PCM attempts to change
the IAC valve pintle position. An IAC Reset will occur when the ignition key is turned OFF. First, the
PCM will seat the IAC pintle in the idle air passage bore. Second, the PCM will retract the pintle a
predetermined number of counts to allow for efficient engine start-up. If the engine idle speed is out
of range for a calibrated period of time, an idle speed diagnostic trouble code (DTC) may set.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS
Inspect for the following conditions: ^
A skewed high throttle position (TP) sensor
^ Restricted air intake system
^ Objects blocking the IAC passage or throttle bore
^ The correct positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) valve, properly installed and proper operation of
the PCV valve
^ Proper operation and installation of all air intake components
^ Proper installation and operation of the mass air flow (MAF) sensor, if equipped
^ A tampered with or damaged throttle stop screw
^ A tampered with or damaged throttle plate, throttle shaft, throttle linkage, or cruise control linkage,
if equipped
^ Excessive deposits in the IAC passage or on the IAC pintle
^ Excessive deposits in the throttle bore or on the throttle plate
^ Vacuum leaks
^ Excessive load on engine i.e. transmission, power steering, alternator, etc.
^ A high or unstable idle condition could be caused by a non-IAC system problem that can not be
overcome by the IAC valve. Refer to Symptoms-Computers and Controls Systems. See:
Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
^ A low or unstable idle condition could be caused by a non-IAC system problem that can not be
overcome by the IAC valve. Refer to Symptoms-Computers and Controls Systems. See:
Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
^ If the problem is determined to be intermittent, refer to Intermittent Conditions. See: Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview/Diagnostic
Strategies/Intermittent Conditions
TEST DESCRIPTION
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Locations > Page 4802
Steps 1-6
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Locations > Page 4803
Steps 7-11
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Locations > Page 4804
Steps 12-19
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 5. This test will determine
the ability of the PCM and IAC valve circuits to control the IAC valve. 7. This test will determine the
ability of the PCM to provide the IAC valve circuits with a ground. On a normally operating system,
the test lamp
should not flash while the IAC counts are incrementing.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Locations > Page 4805
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Service and Repair
IDLE AIR CONTROL (IAC) VALVE REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Remove the engine cover. 3. Disconnect the harness connector from
the idle air control (IAC) valve.
4. Remove the IAC valve attaching fasteners.
NOTE: If the IAC valve has been in service: DO NOT push or pull on the IAC valve pintle. The
force required to move the pintle may damage the threads on the worm drive. Also, DO NOT soak
the IAC valve in any liquid cleaner or solvent, as damage may result.
5. Remove the IAC valve assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Locations > Page 4806
6. Remove the O-ring.
CLEANING AND INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1. Clean the IAC valve O-ring sealing surface, the pintle valve seat, and the air passage.
^ Use a carburetor cleaner and a parts cleaning brush in order to remove any carbon deposits.
Follow the instructions on the container.
^ Do not use a cleaner that contains methyl ethyl ketone. MEK is an extremely strong solvent and
not necessary for this type of deposit
^ Shiny spots on the pintle or seat are normal and do not indicate misalignment or a bent pintle
shaft.
^ If the air passage has heavy deposits, remove the throttle body for a complete cleaning.
2. Inspect the IAC valve O-ring for cuts, cracks, or distortion. Replace the O-ring if damaged.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: If you are installing a new IAC valve, replace the valve with an identical part. The
IAC valve pintle shape and diameter are designed for the specific application.
1. Measure the distance between tip of the IAC valve pintle and the mounting flange.
If the distance is more than 28 mm (1.10 in), use finger pressure in order to slowly retract the pintle.
The force required to retract the pintle of a new valve will not cause damage to the valve.
2. Lubricate the IAC valve O-ring with clean engine oil. 3. Install the IAC valve assembly.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Locations > Page 4807
4. Install the attaching fasteners.
Tighten Tighten the IAC valve fasteners to 3 N.m (27 lb in).
5. Connect the IAC harness connector. 6. Install the engine cover. 7. Reset the IAC valve pintle
position.
IAC VALVE RESET PROCEDURE
1. Turn ON the ignition for 5 seconds, leaving the engine OFF. 2. Turn OFF the ignition for 10
seconds. 3. Start the engine. 4. Check for the proper idle speed.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuel Pump Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4814
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4815
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4816
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4817
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4818
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4819
Fuel Pump Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4820
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4821
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4822
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4823
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4824
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4825
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4826
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4827
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4828
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4829
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4830
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4831
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4832
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4833
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4834
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4835
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4836
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4837
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4838
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4839
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4840
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4841
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4842
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4843
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4844
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Resonator, Intake Air >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Resonator: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER OUTLET RESONATOR REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the engine cover. 3. Remove the air cleaner
outlet retaining nut (1). 4. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct (2) from the throttle body assembly.
5. Loosen the air cleaner outlet duct from the MAF/IAT sensor. 6. Remove the air cleaner outlet
duct.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the air cleaner outlet duct to the MAF/IAT sensor.
Tighten
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Resonator, Intake Air >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4848
Tighten the clamp to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
2. Install the air cleaner outlet duct (2) on the throttle body assembly. 3. Tighten the retaining nut
(1).
Tighten Tighten the nut 2 N.m (18 lb in).
4. Install the engine cover. 5. Connect the negative battery cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4855
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4856
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4857
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4858
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4859
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4860
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4861
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4862
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4863
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4864
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4865
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4866
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4867
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4868
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4869
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4870
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4871
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4872
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4873
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4874
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4875
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4876
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4877
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4878
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4879
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4880
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4881
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4882
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4883
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4884
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4885
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4886
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4887
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4888
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Disconnect the MAF sensor harness connector.
3. Release the air cleaner cover retainer clips.
NOTE: ^
Handle the MAF sensor carefully.
^ Do not drop the MAF sensor in order to prevent damage to the MAF sensor.
^ Do not damage the screen located on the air inlet end of the MAF.
^ Do not touch the sensing elements.
^ Do not allow solvents and lubricants to come in contact with the sensing elements.
^ Use a small amount of a soap based solution in order to aid in the installation.
4. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct from the MAF sensor by loosening the hose clamp.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4889
5. Disconnect the air cleaner cover from the front of the MAF sensor by loosening the hose clamp.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Point the flow arrows on the MAF sensor away from the air cleaner.
1. Attach the MAF sensor to the air cleaner cover by tightening the hose clamp.
Tighten Tighten the clamp to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
2. Attach the air cleaner outlet duct to the MAF sensor by tightening the hose clamp.
Tighten Tighten the clamp to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4890
3. Install the air cleaner cover by fastening the air cleaner cover retainer clips.
4. Connect the MAF sensor harness connector.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4896
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4897
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4898
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4899
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4900
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4901
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4902
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4903
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4904
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4905
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4906
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4907
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4908
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4909
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4910
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4911
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4912
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4913
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4914
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4915
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4916
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4917
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4918
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4919
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4920
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4921
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4922
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4923
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4924
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4925
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4926
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4927
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4928
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4929
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Disconnect the throttle position (TP) sensor harness connector.
3. Remove the mounting bolts from the TP sensor.
NOTE: The TP sensor is an electrical component. Do not soak the TP sensor in any liquid cleaner
or solvent, as damage may result.
4. Remove the TP sensor and gasket from the throttle body assembly.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4930
1. With the throttle valve closed, install the TP sensor on the throttle shaft.
Rotate the TP sensor counterclockwise in order to align the mounting holes.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the TP sensor mounting bolts.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Connect the TP sensor harness connector. 4. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Throttle Body Assembly Replacement
Throttle Body: Service and Repair Throttle Body Assembly Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the engine cover. 3. Remove the air cleaner
outlet resonator. 4. Remove the air cleaner outlet resonator adapter stud. 5. Remove the cruise
control cable.
6. Remove the accelerator cable. 7. Remove the stud and nuts retaining the accelerator control
cable bracket and position bracket aside.
8. Disconnect the (IAC) valve harness connector.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Throttle Body Assembly Replacement > Page 4935
9. Disconnect the (TP) sensor harness connector.
10. Remove the throttle body retaining studs.
11. Remove the throttle body assembly. 12. Discard the throttle body seal.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Safety Glasses Caution in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Throttle Body Assembly Replacement > Page 4936
1. Clean the gasket surface on the intake manifold. 2. Install the throttle body assembly with a new
seal.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the throttle body assembly retaining studs.
Tighten Tighten the studs to 9 N.m (80 lb in).
4. Install the air cleaner outlet resonator adapter stud.
Tighten Tighten the studs to 8 N.m (71 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Throttle Body Assembly Replacement > Page 4937
5. Connect the TP sensor harness connector.
6. Connect the IAC valve harness connector. 7. Install the accelerator control cable bracket using
the fasteners.
Tighten Tighten the fasteners to 12 N.m (106 lb in).
IMPORTANT: Ensure the accelerator and the cruise control cables do not hold the throttle open.
8. Install the accelerator cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Throttle Body Assembly Replacement > Page 4938
9. Install the cruise control cable.
10. Install the air cleaner outlet resonator. 11. Install the engine cover. 12. Connect the negative
battery cable.
IMPORTANT: The accelerator pedal should operate freely without binding between full and closed
throttle.
13. Use the following procedure in order to check the accelerator pedal operation.
13.1. Depress the pedal to the floor. 13.2. Release the accelerator pedal.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Throttle Body Assembly Replacement > Page 4939
Throttle Body: Service and Repair Throttle Body Cleaning Procedure
1. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct. 2. Inspect the throttle body bore and the throttle valve plate
for deposits. You must open the throttle valve in order to inspect all of the surfaces.
NOTE: Do not subject a throttle body assembly which contains the following components to an
immersion cleaner or a strong solvent: ^
Throttle position (TP) sensor
^ Idle air control (IAC) valve
^ Sealed throttle shaft bearings
The cleaners will damaged the electric components or sensors.
The cleaners will damage some of these components that contain seals or O-rings.
Solvents can wash away or break down the grease used on non-serviceable throttle shaft bearings.
Never use a wire brush or scraper to clean the throttle body. A wire brush or sharp tools may
damage the throttle body components.
Do not use a cleaner that contains methyl ethyl ketone. This extremely strong solvent may damage
components and is not necessary for this type of cleaning.
3. Clean the throttle body bore and the throttle valve plate using a clean shop towel with GM Top
Engine Cleaner, P/N 1052626 or an equivalent
product.
4. If the deposits are excessive, remove and disassemble the throttle body for cleaning. 5. After
disassembly, clean the throttle body using a parts cleaning brush. DO NOT immerse the throttle
body in any cleaning solvent. 6. If you removed and disassembled the throttle body for cleaning,
assemble and install the throttle body. 7. Install the air cleaner outlet duct.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable/Linkage >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Throttle Cable/Linkage: Service and Repair
ACCELERATOR CONTROLS CABLE REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Remove the air cleaner outlet duct. 3. Remove the accelerator
cable from the throttle lever.
4. Remove the accelerator cable from the engine cable bracket.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable/Linkage >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4943
5. Remove the accelerator cable (1) from the accelerator pedal (3).
6. Remove the accelerator cable assembly from the bulkhead (1).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the accelerator cable to the bulkhead (1).
^ Ensure all locking tabs (3) are expanded to secure cable assembly to dash panel (1).
^ Ensure dash panel insulator does not come in contact with any portion of the cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable/Linkage >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4944
2. Install the accelerator cable (1) to the accelerator pedal (3). Ensure the retainer (2) is securely
seated to the accelerator pedal.
3. Install the accelerator cable to the engine cable bracket.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable/Linkage >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4945
4. Install the accelerator cable to the throttle lever. 5. Install the air cleaner outlet duct. 6. Install the
engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4951
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4952
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4953
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4954
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4955
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4956
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4957
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4958
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4959
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4960
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4961
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4962
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4963
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4964
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4965
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4966
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4967
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4968
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4969
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4970
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4971
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4972
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4973
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4974
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4975
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4976
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4977
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4978
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4979
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4980
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4981
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4982
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4983
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4984
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Disconnect the throttle position (TP) sensor harness connector.
3. Remove the mounting bolts from the TP sensor.
NOTE: The TP sensor is an electrical component. Do not soak the TP sensor in any liquid cleaner
or solvent, as damage may result.
4. Remove the TP sensor and gasket from the throttle body assembly.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4985
1. With the throttle valve closed, install the TP sensor on the throttle shaft.
Rotate the TP sensor counterclockwise in order to align the mounting holes.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the TP sensor mounting bolts.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Connect the TP sensor harness connector. 4. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4992
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4993
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4994
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4995
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4996
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4997
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4998
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4999
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5000
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5001
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5002
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5003
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5004
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5005
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5006
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5007
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5008
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5009
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5010
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5011
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5012
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5013
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5014
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5015
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5016
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5017
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5018
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5019
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5020
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5021
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5022
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5023
Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5024
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
The CMP sensor is a hall-effect sensor located in the ignition distributor base, and uses the same
type of circuits as the CKP sensor. The CMP sensor signal is a digital ON/OFF pulse, output once
per revolution of the camshaft. The CMP sensor information is used by the PCM to determine the
position of the valve train relative to the CKP.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5025
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5026
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Disconnect the spark plug wires and ignition coil wire from the
distributor.
3. Disconnect the camshaft position (CMP) sensor harness connector from the distributor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5027
4. Remove the distributor cap screws.
5. Remove the distributor cap.
6. Remove the rotor screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5028
7. Remove the rotor.
8. Align the square slot in the reluctor wheel with the CMP sensor.
9. Remove the CMP screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5029
10. Remove the CMP sensor.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: Do not use the old cap, CMP sensor, and rotor screws. Use the replacement screws
that have been coated with a thread locking compound.
1. Insert the CMP sensor through the reluctor wheel slot.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install new CMP mounting screws.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 2.2 N.m (19 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5030
3. Install the rotor onto the reluctor wheel.
4. Install new rotor screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5031
5. Install the distributor cap.
6. Install new distributor cap screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2.4 N.m (21 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5032
7. Connect the CMP sensor harness connector.
8. Connect the spark plug wires and ignition coil wire. 9. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft Position Sensor: > 02-06-04-059 > Dec > 02 >
Engine Controls - Engine Runs Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Customer Interest Engine Controls - Engine Runs Rough/MIL
ON/DTC's Set
File In Section: 06 - Engine/Propulsion System
Bulletin No.: 02-06-04-059
Date: December, 2002
TECHNICAL
Subject: Engine Runs Rough, Service Engine Soon Light On, DTC's P0300 or P0335 Set (Shim
Crankshaft Sensor)
Models: 2002-03 Chevrolet Astro, Blazer, Express, Silverado and S-10 Truck Models 2002-03
GMC Jimmy, Safari, Savana, Sierra and Sonoma Truck Models with 4.3L V-6 Engine (VINs W, X RPOs L35, LU3)
Condition
Some owners may comment on a rough running condition or a Service Engine Soon (SES) light
being illuminated. Upon investigation, the technician may find a DTC code P0300 or P0335.
Cause
The crankshaft sensor may be contacting the reluctor wheel.
Correction
Remove the crankshaft sensor. Refer to the Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement procedure in
the Engine Controls-4.3L sub-section of the Service Manual. After removing the sensor, inspect the
end of it for witness marks that would indicate contact with the crankshaft. If contact with the
reluctor ring is indicated, then inspect the front cover for cracking or other signs of alignment
concerns. If the inspection indicates that the cover is causing mis-alignments, replace the cover. If
replacing the cover, then the 0.5 mm shim is not needed.
If the inspection of the front cover indicates that the cover is not the cause of mis-alignments, then
the sensor should be shimmed. Add one shim between the sensor and the front cover. If the
concern still exists, then add the second shim. Unless the sensor has been rubbed through the
casing or deformed by contact with the crankshaft, it should not be replaced.
In either case, the crankshaft relearn procedure should be performed after any repairs.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft Position Sensor: > 02-06-04-059 > Dec > 02 >
Engine Controls - Engine Runs Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set > Page 5041
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Position Sensor: > 02-06-04-059 >
Dec > 02 > Engine Controls - Engine Runs Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set
Crankshaft Position Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Engine Runs
Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set
File In Section: 06 - Engine/Propulsion System
Bulletin No.: 02-06-04-059
Date: December, 2002
TECHNICAL
Subject: Engine Runs Rough, Service Engine Soon Light On, DTC's P0300 or P0335 Set (Shim
Crankshaft Sensor)
Models: 2002-03 Chevrolet Astro, Blazer, Express, Silverado and S-10 Truck Models 2002-03
GMC Jimmy, Safari, Savana, Sierra and Sonoma Truck Models with 4.3L V-6 Engine (VINs W, X RPOs L35, LU3)
Condition
Some owners may comment on a rough running condition or a Service Engine Soon (SES) light
being illuminated. Upon investigation, the technician may find a DTC code P0300 or P0335.
Cause
The crankshaft sensor may be contacting the reluctor wheel.
Correction
Remove the crankshaft sensor. Refer to the Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement procedure in
the Engine Controls-4.3L sub-section of the Service Manual. After removing the sensor, inspect the
end of it for witness marks that would indicate contact with the crankshaft. If contact with the
reluctor ring is indicated, then inspect the front cover for cracking or other signs of alignment
concerns. If the inspection indicates that the cover is causing mis-alignments, replace the cover. If
replacing the cover, then the 0.5 mm shim is not needed.
If the inspection of the front cover indicates that the cover is not the cause of mis-alignments, then
the sensor should be shimmed. Add one shim between the sensor and the front cover. If the
concern still exists, then add the second shim. Unless the sensor has been rubbed through the
casing or deformed by contact with the crankshaft, it should not be replaced.
In either case, the crankshaft relearn procedure should be performed after any repairs.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Position Sensor: > 02-06-04-059 >
Dec > 02 > Engine Controls - Engine Runs Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set > Page 5047
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5048
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5051
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5052
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5053
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5054
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5055
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5056
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5057
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5058
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5059
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5060
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5061
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5062
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5063
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5064
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5065
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5066
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5067
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5068
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5069
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5070
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5071
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5072
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5073
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5074
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5075
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5076
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5077
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5078
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5079
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5080
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5081
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5082
Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5083
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
The CKP sensor is a three wire sensor based on the magneto resistive principle. A magneto
resistive sensor uses two magnetic pickups between a permanent magnet. As an element such as
a reluctor wheel passes the magnets the resulting change in the magnetic field is used by the
sensor electronics to produce a digital output pulse. The PCM supplies a 12-volt, low reference,
and signal circuit to the CKP sensor. The sensor returns a digital ON/OFF pulse 3 times per
crankshaft revolution for the V6 engine, 4 times for the V8 engine. The CKP sensor reads the
crankshaft mounted reluctor wheel to identify pairs of cylinders at top dead center (TDC).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5084
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > CKP System Variation Learn Procedure
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair CKP System Variation Learn Procedure
IMPORTANT: For additional diagnostic information, refer to DTC P1336.
1. Install a scan tool. 2. With a scan tool, monitor the powertrain control module (PCM) for
diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs). If other DTCs are set, except DTC P1336,
refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List for the applicable DTC that set.
3. With a scan tool, select the crankshaft position (CKP) variation learn procedure. 4. Observe the
fuel cut-OFF for the engine that you are performing the learn procedure on. 5. The scan tool
instructs you to perform the following:
^ Block the drive wheels.
^ Apply the vehicles parking brake.
^ Cycle the ignition from OFF to ON.
^ Apply and hold the brake pedal.
^ Start and idle the engine.
^ Turn OFF the A/C.
^ Place the vehicles transmission in Park (A/T) or Neutral (M/T).
^ The scan tool monitors certain component signals to determine if all the conditions are met to
continue with the procedure. The scan tool only displays the condition that inhibits the procedure.
The scan tool monitors the following components: CKP sensor activity - If there is a CKP sensor condition, refer to the applicable DTCs that set.
- Camshaft position (CMP) sensor activity - If there is a CMP sensor condition, refer to the
applicable DTCs that set.
- Engine coolant temperature (ECT) - If the ECT is not warm enough, idle the engine until the ECT
reaches the correct temperature.
6. With the scan tool, enable the CKP system variation learn procedure.
IMPORTANT: While the learn procedure is in progress, release the throttle immediately when the
engine starts to decelerate. The engine control is returned to the operator and the engine responds
to throttle position (TP) after the learn procedure is complete.
7. Slowly increase the engine speed to the RPM that you observed. 8. Immediately release the
throttle when fuel cut-OFF is reached. 9. The scan tool displays Learn Status: Learned this ignition.
If the scan tool does NOT display this message and no additional DTCs set, refer to
Symptoms - Engine. If a DTC set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List for the applicable
DTC that set.
10. Turn OFF the ignition for 30 seconds after the learn procedure is completed successfully.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > CKP System Variation Learn Procedure > Page 5087
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: The CKP System Variation Learn Procedure will need to be performed whenever the
crankshaft position (CKP) sensor is removed or replaced. Refer to CKP System Variation Learn
Procedure.
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. If the vehicle is equipped with the
underbody shield package, then remove the steering linkage shield mounting bolts.
3. Remove the steering linkage shield.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > CKP System Variation Learn Procedure > Page 5088
4. Disconnect the CKP sensor harness connector.
5. Remove the CKP sensor mounting bolt.
6. Remove the CKP sensor.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > CKP System Variation Learn Procedure > Page 5089
IMPORTANT: ^
When installing the CKP sensor, make sure the sensor is fully seated before tightening the
mounting bolt. A poorly seated CKP sensor may perform erratically and may set false DTCs.
^ Do not reuse the original O-ring.
1. Replace the CKP sensor O-ring. 2. Lubricate the O-ring with clean engine oil before installing the
CKP sensor.
IMPORTANT: Make sure the CKP sensor mounting surface is clear and free of burrs.
3. Install the CKP sensor.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the CKP sensor mounting bolt.
Tighten Tighten the CKP sensor mounting bolt to 9 N.m (80 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > CKP System Variation Learn Procedure > Page 5090
5. Connect the CKP sensor harness connector.
6. Install the steering linkage shield.
7. Install the steering linkage shield mounting bolts.
Tighten
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > CKP System Variation Learn Procedure > Page 5091
Tighten the bolts to 33 N.m (24 lb ft).
8. Lower the Vehicle. 9. Perform the CKP System Variation Learn Procedure. See: Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Distributor: > 03-06-04-041A > Jan > 05 > Ignition System - SES
Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300
Distributor: Customer Interest Ignition System - SES Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300
Bulletin No.: 03-06-04-041A
Date: January 28, 2005
TECHNICAL
Subject: Poor Engine Performance - Misfire, Rough Idle, Stalls, Engine Cranks but Does Not Run,
Service Engine Soon/Check Engine Light Illuminated, DTC P0300 Set (Inspect Distributor Ignition
(DI) System Components and Replace As Necessary)
Models: 2001-2003 Chevrolet Astro, Blazer, Express, S-10 2001-2003 GMC Jimmy, Safari,
Savana, Sonoma 2001 Oldsmobile Bravada
with 4.3L, 5.0L or 5.7L Gas Engine (VINs W, X, M, R - RPOs L35, LU3, L30, L31)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to delete a model and add information to subject and inspection of
distributor vent screens. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 03-06-04-041 (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on poor engine performance and the Service Engine Soon/Check
Engine light being illuminated. Upon investigation, the technician may find DTC P0300 set.
Cause
This condition may be due to high levels of internal corrosion in the distributor, causing misfire,
rough idle, stall and Engine Cranks But Does Not Run. This corrosion is attributed to a lack of
airflow internal to the cap caused by the vent screens being clogged with debris.
Correction
Remove the vent screens and inspect the internal components of the Distributor Ignition System
using the procedure listed below. If the distributor base has to be replaced, the vent screens will
also have to be removed on the new distributor. If there is evidence of this internal corrosion,
replace the affected component. Refer to the appropriate procedure in the Engine Controls
sub-section of the applicable Service Manual.
Important:
All of these inspections can be done on-vehicle.
1. Inspect the distributor cap. You may notice a white residue on the cap walls. For higher mileage
occurrences, the interior of the cap may have changed to medium brown in color
2. Inspect the distributor rotor. You may notice the presence of black streaks on the plastic surface.
More typical evidence would be visible green spots on the copper surface of the rotor segment.
3. Inspect the distributor base. You may notice high levels of surface rust on the distributor shaft or
surface contamination on the sensor hold down screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Distributor: > 03-06-04-041A > Jan > 05 > Ignition System - SES
Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300 > Page 5100
4. Inspect the distributor vent screens (1). If the vent screens are present, remove them by using a
plastic-handled, long blade awl or pick (2). Insert into the airflow vent screens and pop them out.
Refer to the figure for removal procedure. If the vent screens have been removed from the base of
the distributor, then check the airflow inlets for being clogged with debris.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Distributor: > 03-06-04-041A > Jan > 05 > Ignition System - SES
Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300 > Page 5101
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Distributor: > 03-06-04-041A > Jan > 05 > Ignition System
- SES Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300
Distributor: All Technical Service Bulletins Ignition System - SES Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300
Bulletin No.: 03-06-04-041A
Date: January 28, 2005
TECHNICAL
Subject: Poor Engine Performance - Misfire, Rough Idle, Stalls, Engine Cranks but Does Not Run,
Service Engine Soon/Check Engine Light Illuminated, DTC P0300 Set (Inspect Distributor Ignition
(DI) System Components and Replace As Necessary)
Models: 2001-2003 Chevrolet Astro, Blazer, Express, S-10 2001-2003 GMC Jimmy, Safari,
Savana, Sonoma 2001 Oldsmobile Bravada
with 4.3L, 5.0L or 5.7L Gas Engine (VINs W, X, M, R - RPOs L35, LU3, L30, L31)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to delete a model and add information to subject and inspection of
distributor vent screens. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 03-06-04-041 (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on poor engine performance and the Service Engine Soon/Check
Engine light being illuminated. Upon investigation, the technician may find DTC P0300 set.
Cause
This condition may be due to high levels of internal corrosion in the distributor, causing misfire,
rough idle, stall and Engine Cranks But Does Not Run. This corrosion is attributed to a lack of
airflow internal to the cap caused by the vent screens being clogged with debris.
Correction
Remove the vent screens and inspect the internal components of the Distributor Ignition System
using the procedure listed below. If the distributor base has to be replaced, the vent screens will
also have to be removed on the new distributor. If there is evidence of this internal corrosion,
replace the affected component. Refer to the appropriate procedure in the Engine Controls
sub-section of the applicable Service Manual.
Important:
All of these inspections can be done on-vehicle.
1. Inspect the distributor cap. You may notice a white residue on the cap walls. For higher mileage
occurrences, the interior of the cap may have changed to medium brown in color
2. Inspect the distributor rotor. You may notice the presence of black streaks on the plastic surface.
More typical evidence would be visible green spots on the copper surface of the rotor segment.
3. Inspect the distributor base. You may notice high levels of surface rust on the distributor shaft or
surface contamination on the sensor hold down screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Distributor: > 03-06-04-041A > Jan > 05 > Ignition System
- SES Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300 > Page 5107
4. Inspect the distributor vent screens (1). If the vent screens are present, remove them by using a
plastic-handled, long blade awl or pick (2). Insert into the airflow vent screens and pop them out.
Refer to the figure for removal procedure. If the vent screens have been removed from the base of
the distributor, then check the airflow inlets for being clogged with debris.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Distributor: > 03-06-04-041A > Jan > 05 > Ignition System
- SES Lamp ON/Misfire/DTC P0300 > Page 5108
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul
Distributor: Service and Repair Distributor Overhaul
DISASSEMBLY PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover.
NOTE: The ignition system distributor driven gear and rotor may be installed in multiple positions.
In order to avoid mistakes, mark the distributor on the following components in order to ensure the
same mounting position upon reassembly: ^
The distributor driven gear
^ The distributor shaft
^ The rotor holes
Installing the driven gear 180 degrees out of alignment, or locating the rotor in the wrong holes, will
cause a no-start condition. Premature engine wear or damage may result.
2. Align white paint mark on the bottom stem of the distributor, and the pre-drilled indent hole in the
bottom of the gear (2). 3. With the gear in this position, the rotor segment should be positioned as
shown for a V6 engine (1). If not, replace the distributor.
4. Remove the 2 screws from the rotor. 5. Remove the rotor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 5111
6. Note the locating holes that the rotor was removed from:
^ The rotor screw holes (1)
^ The rotor locator pin holes (2)
7. Line up the square-cut hole in the vane wheel with the CMP sensor.
8. Remove the 2 screws that hold the camshaft position (CMP) sensor. 9. Discard the screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 5112
10. Remove the CMP sensor. 11. Note the dimple located below the roll pin hole on one side of the
gear. The dimple will be used to properly orient the gear onto the shaft during
reassembly.
CAUTION: Refer to Safety Glasses Caution in Service Precautions.
12. Support the distributor drive gear in a V-block or similar fixture. 13. Drive out the roll pin with a
suitable punch.
14. Remove the driven gear from the distributor shaft. 15. Remove the round washer. 16. Remove
the tang washer. 17. Remove the shim washer (1).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 5113
18. Remove the old oil seal.
ASSEMBLY PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: Installing the driven gear 180 degrees out of alignment, or locating the rotor in the
wrong holes, will cause a no-start condition. Premature engine wear or damage may result.
1. Line up the square-cut hole in the vane wheel for the camshaft position (CMP) sensor.
2. Insert the sensor into the housing.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 5114
3. Install two new screws for the camshaft position (CMP) sensor.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2.2 N.m (19 lb in).
4. Identity the correct rotor mounting position:
^ At the rotor screw holes (1)
^ At the rotor locator pin holes (2)
5. Install the distributor rotor according to the index marks. 6. Install two rotor hold down screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 1.9 N.m (17 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 5115
7. Install the shim washer (1) on the bottom of the distributor shaft. 8. Install the tang washer. 9.
Install the round washer.
10. Install the driven gear according to the index marks.
11. Align the rotor segment as shown for a V6 engine (1) or V8 engine (2). 12. Install the gear and
align white paint mark on the bottom stem of the distributor, and the pre-drilled indent hole in the
bottom of the gear (3). 13. Check to see if the driven gear is installed incorrectly. On an incorrectly
installed driven gear, the dimple will be approximately 180 degrees
opposite the rotor segment when the gear is installed in the distributor.
CAUTION: Refer to Safety Glasses Caution in Service Precautions.
14. Support the distributor drive gear in a V-block or similar fixture. 15. Install the roll pin with a
suitable punch and hammer in order to hold the driven gear in the correct position.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 5116
16. Install the new oil seal under the mounting flange of the distributor base. 17. Install the
distributor. 18. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 5117
Distributor: Service and Repair Distributor Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
NOTE: There are two procedures available to install the distributor.
Use Installation Procedure 1 when the crankshaft has NOT been rotated from the original position.
Use Installation Procedure 2 when any of the following components are removed: ^
The intake manifold
^ The cylinder head
^ The camshaft
^ The timing chain or sprockets
^ The complete engine
If the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) turns on and DTC P1345 sets after installing the distributor,
this indicates an incorrectly installed distributor.
Engine damage or distributor damage may occur. Use Procedure 2 in order to install the distributor.
1. Turn OFF the ignition. 2. Remove the engine cover. 3. Remove air cleaner assembly. 4. Remove
the air intake resonator assembly. 5. Remove the spark plug wires from the distributor cap.
^ Twist each spark plug 1/2 turn.
^ Pull only on the wire boot in order to remove the wire from the distributor cap.
6. Remove the electrical connector from the base of the distributor.
7. Remove the 2 screws that retain the distributor cap to the housing. 8. Discard the screws. 9.
Remove the distributor cap from the housing.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 5118
10. Use a grease pencil in order to mark the position of the rotor in relation to the distributor
housing (1). 11. Mark the distributor housing and the intake manifold with the grease pencil.
12. As the distributor is being removed from the engine, watch the rotor move in a
counter-clockwise direction about 42 degrees. This will appear as
slightly more than one clock position.
13. Note the position of the rotor segment. 14. Place a second mark on the base of the distributor
(2).
This will aid in achieving the proper rotor alignment during the distributor installation.
15. Remove the mounting clamp hold-down bolt. 16. Remove the distributor.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 5119
1. If installing a new distributor assembly, place 2 marks on the new distributor housing in the same
location as the marks on the original housing. 2. Remove the new distributor cap, if necessary. 3.
Align the rotor with the second mark (2).
4. Guide the distributor into the engine. 5. Align the hole in the distributor hold-down base over the
mounting hole in the intake manifold.
6. As the distributor is being installed, observe the rotor moving in a clockwise direction about 42
degrees. 7. Once the distributor is completely seated, the rotor segment should be aligned with the
mark on the distributor base (1).
^ If the rotor segment is not aligned with the mark, the driven gear teeth and the camshaft have
meshed one or more teeth out of alignment.
^ In order to correct this condition, remove and reinstall the distributor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 5120
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
8. Install the distributor mounting clamp bolt.
Tighten Tighten the bolt to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
9. Install the distributor cap.
10. Install the new distributor cap screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2.4 N.m (21 lb in).
11. Install the electrical connector to the distributor. 12. Install the spark plug wires to the distributor
cap.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 5121
13. Install the ignition coil wire. Note the correct orientation of the wire boot.
IMPORTANT: If the malfunction indicator lamp illuminates after installing the distributor and DTC
P1345 is set, the distributor has been installed incorrectly.
14. Refer to Installation Procedure 2 if the malfunction indicator lamp illuminates after installing the
distributor. 15. Install the engine cover.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 2
IMPORTANT: Rotate the number 1 cylinder to top dead center (TDC) of the compression stroke.
The engine front cover has 2 alignment tabs and the crankshaft balancer has 2 alignment marks
spaced 90 degrees apart which are used for positioning the number 1 piston at TDC. With the
piston on the compression stroke and at TDC, the crankshaft balancer alignment mark (1) must
align with the engine front cover tab (2) and the crankshaft balancer alignment mark (4) must align
with the engine front cover tab (3).
1. Rotate the crankshaft balancer clockwise until the alignment marks on the crankshaft balancer
are aligned with the tabs on the engine front cover
and the number 1 piston is at TDC of the compression stroke.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 5122
2. Align the white paint mark on the bottom stem of the distributor and the pre-drilled indent hole in
the bottom of the gear (3).
NOTE: The ignition system distributor driven gear and rotor may be installed in multiple positions.
In order to avoid mistakes, mark the distributor on the following components in order to ensure the
same mounting position upon reassembly: ^
The distributor driven gear
^ The distributor shaft
^ The rotor holes
Installing the driven gear 180 degrees out of alignment, or locating the rotor in the wrong holes, will
cause a no-start condition. Premature engine wear or damage may result.
3. With the gear in this position, the rotor segment should be positioned as shown for a V6 engine
(1).
^ The alignment will not be exact.
^ If the driven gear is installed incorrectly, the dimple Will be approximately 180 degrees opposite
of the rotor segment when installed in the distributor.
4. Use a long screw driver in order to align the oil pump drive shaft to the drive tab of the
distributor. 5. Guide the distributor into the engine.
Ensure the flat portion of the distributor housing is facing toward the front of the engine.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 5123
6. Once the distributor is fully seated, the rotor segment should be aligned with the pointer cast into
the distributor base.
If the rotor segment does not come within a few degrees of the pointer, repeat the procedure in
order to achieve the proper alignment.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
7. Install the distributor mounting clamp bolt.
Tighten Tighten the bolt to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 5124
8. Install the distributor cap. 9. Install the new distributor cap screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2.4 N.m (21 lb in).
10. Install the electrical connector to the distributor. 11. Install the spark plug wires to the distributor
cap.
12. Install the ignition coil wire. Note the correct orientation of the wire boot.
IMPORTANT: If the malfunction indicator lamp illuminates after installing the distributor and DTC
P1345 is set, the distributor has been installed incorrectly.
13. Repeat Installation Procedure 2 if the malfunction indicator lamp illuminates after installing the
distributor. 14. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Distributor Overhaul > Page 5125
Distributor: Service and Repair Distributor Inspection
1. Remove the engine cover.
IMPORTANT: Discoloration of the cap and some whitish build up around the cap terminals is
normal. Yellowing of the rotor cap, darkening and some carbon build up under the rotor segment is
normal. Replacement of the cap and the rotor is not necessary unless there is a driveability
concern.
2. Inspect the cap for cracks, tiny holes or carbon tracks between the cap terminal traces.
Diagnose the carbon tracks using the following procedure:
2.1. Remove the cap.
2.2. Place 1 lead from the DMM on a cap terminal.
2.3. Use the other lead in order to probe all other terminals and the center carbon ball.
2.4. Move the base lead to the next terminal. Probe all other leads.
2.5. Continue this procedure until you test all the secondary terminals.
2.6. If there are any non-infinite readings, replace the cap.
3. Inspect the cap for excess build-up of corrosion on the terminals. Scrape clean the terminals.
Replace the cap if the corrosion is excessive. Some
buildup is normal.
4. Inspect the rotor segment for excess wear. Replace the rotor if excess looseness in the rotor
segment is present. 5. Inspect the shaft for shaft-to-bushing looseness:
5.1. Inspect the housing for cracks or damage.
5.2. Insert the shaft in the housing.
5.3. If the shaft wobbles, replace the housing assembly.
6. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Spark Plug Wire Inspection
Ignition Cable: Service and Repair Spark Plug Wire Inspection
Spark plug wire integrity is vital for proper engine operation. A thorough inspection will be
necessary to accurately identify conditions that may affect engine operation. Inspect for the
following conditions:
1. Correct routing of the spark plug wires - Incorrect routing may cause cross-firing. 2. Any signs of
cracks or splits in the wires. 3. Inspect each boot for the following conditions:
^ Tearing
^ Piercing
^ Arcing
^ Carbon tracking
^ Corroded terminal
If corrosion, carbon tracking or arcing are indicated on a spark plug wire boot or on a terminal,
replace the wire and the component connected to the wire.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Spark Plug Wire Inspection > Page 5130
Ignition Cable: Service and Repair Spark Plug Wire Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the spark plug wire at each spark plug.
^ Twist the boots 1/2 turn before removing the boots.
^ Pull only on the boot or use a tool designed for this purpose in order to remove the wire from
each spark plug.
2. Disconnect the spark plug wire from the distributor.
^ Twist each spark plug boot 1/2 turn.
^ Pull only on the boot or use a tool designed for this purpose in order to remove the wires from the
distributor.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: If the boot to wire movement has occurred, the boot will give a false visual impression of
being fully seated. Ensure that the boots have been properly assembled by pushing sideways on
the installed boots. Failure to properly seat the terminal onto the spark plug will lead to wire core
erosion and result in an engine misfire or crossfire condition, and possible internal damage to the
engine.
1. Install the spark plug wires at the distributor. 2. Install the spark plug wire to each spark plug. 3.
Inspect the wires for proper installation:
3.1. Push sideways on each boot in order to inspect the seating.
3.2. Reinstall any loose boot.
3.3. Wire routings must be kept intact during service and followed exactly when wires have been
disconnected or when replacement of the wires is necessary. Failure to route the wires properly
can lead to radio ignition noise and crossfiring of the plugs, or shorting of the leads to the ground.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Spark Plug Wire Inspection > Page 5131
3.4. Any time the spark plug wires or boots are installed on the spark plugs, new dielectric grease
needs to be applied inside the boot.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Locations
Ignition Coil: Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5135
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5136
Ignition Coil
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5137
Ignition Coil: Description and Operation
IGNITION CONTROL MODULE (ICM) AND IGNITION COILS
The ICM is connected to the PCM by an Ignition Control (IC) circuit. The ICM also has a ground
circuit and shares an ignition 1 voltage supply with the ignition coil. The coil driver in the ICM
controls current through the ignition coil based on signal pulses from the PCM. There is no back-up
or by-pass function in the ICM.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5138
Ignition Coil: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Disconnect the electrical connectors. 3. Remove the ignition coil
wire to the distributor. 4. Remove the studs holding the bracket and the ignition coil to the intake
manifold. 5. Remove the bracket and the ignition coil. 6. Drill and punch out the two rivets holding
the ignition coil to the bracket. 7. Remove the ignition coil from the bracket.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: A replacement ignition coil kit comes with 2 screws in order to attach the ignition coil
to the bracket.
1. Install the ignition coil to the bracket with the 2 screws.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the ignition coil and the bracket to the intake manifold with studs.
Tighten Tighten the studs to 11 N.m (97 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5139
3. Install the ignition coil wire.
The wire must not touch anything like the dip stick. Rubbing will make a ground or short after time
of use.
4. Install the electrical connectors. 5. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 5144
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5145
Ignition Control Module (ICM)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5146
Ignition Control Module: Description and Operation
IGNITION CONTROL MODULE (ICM) AND IGNITION COILS
The ICM is connected to the PCM by an Ignition Control (IC) circuit. The ICM also has a ground
circuit and shares an ignition 1 voltage supply with the ignition coil. The coil driver in the ICM
controls current through the ignition coil based on signal pulses from the PCM. There is no back-up
or by-pass function in the ICM.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5147
Ignition Control Module: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector (3). 3. Remove the screws (4)
holding the ignition control module (2) and the heat sink (1) to the bracket. 4. Remove the ignition
control module and the heat sink.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the ignition control module (2) and the heat sink (1) on the bracket with the screws (4).
Tighten Tighten the screws to 3.5 N.m (31 lb in).
2. Reconnect the electrical connectors (3). 3. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Knock Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5153
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5154
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5155
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5156
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5157
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5158
Knock Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5159
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5160
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5161
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5162
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5163
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5164
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5165
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5166
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5167
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5168
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5169
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5170
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5171
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5172
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5173
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5174
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5175
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5176
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5177
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5178
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5179
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5180
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5181
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5182
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5183
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5184
Knock Sensor (KS)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 5185
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
The Knock Sensor (KS) system enables the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to control the
ignition timing advance for the best possible performance while protecting the engine from
potentially damaging levels of detonation. The sensors in the KS system are used by the PCM as
microphones to listen for abnormal engine noise that may indicate pre-ignition/detonation.
SENSOR DESCRIPTION
There are 2 types of KS currently being used: ^
The broadband single wire sensor
^ The flat response 2-wire sensor
Both sensors use piezo-electric crystal technology to produce and send signals to the PCM. The
amplitude and frequency of this signal will vary constantly depending on the vibration level within
the engine. Flat response and broadband KS signals are processed differently by the PCM. The
major differences are outlined below: ^
All broadband sensors use a single wire circuit. Some types of controllers will output a bias voltage
on the KS signal wire. The bias voltage creates a voltage drop the PCM monitors and uses to help
diagnose KS faults. The KS noise signal rides along this bias voltage, and due to the constantly
fluctuating frequency and amplitude of the signal, will always be outside the bias voltage
parameters. Another way to use the KS signals is for the PCM to learn the average normal noise
output from the KS. The PCM uses this noise channel, and KS signal that rides along the noise
channel, in much the same way as the bias voltage type does. Both systems will constantly monitor
the KS system for a signal that is not present or falls within the noise channel.
^ The flat response KS uses a 2-wire circuit. The KS signal rides within a noise channel which is
learned and output by the PCM. This noise channel is based upon the normal noise input from the
KS and is known as background noise. As engine speed and load change, the noise channel upper
and lower parameters will change to accommodate the KS signal, keeping the signal within the
channel. If there is knock, the signal will range outside the noise channel and the PCM will reduce
spark advance until the knock is reduced. These sensors are monitored in much the same way as
the broadband sensors, except that an abnormal signal will stay outside of the noise channel or will
not be present.
KS diagnostics can be calibrated to detect faults with the KS diagnostic inside the PCM, the KS
wiring, the sensor output, or constant knocking from an outside influence such as a loose or
damaged component. In order to determine which cylinders are knocking, the PCM uses KS signal
information when the cylinders are near Top Dead Center (TDC) of the firing stroke.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 5186
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 5187
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the engine cover. 3. Disconnect the knock
sensor harness connector (3). 4. Remove the knock sensor bolt (1) and knock sensor (2).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the knock sensor (2) and the knock sensor bolt (1).
Tighten Tighten the sender to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
2. Connect the knock sensor harness connector (3). 3. Install the engine cover. 4. Connect the
negative battery cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System >
Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System >
Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 5193
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System >
Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 5194
Ignition Control Module (ICM)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System >
Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 5195
Ignition Control Module: Description and Operation
IGNITION CONTROL MODULE (ICM) AND IGNITION COILS
The ICM is connected to the PCM by an Ignition Control (IC) circuit. The ICM also has a ground
circuit and shares an ignition 1 voltage supply with the ignition coil. The coil driver in the ICM
controls current through the ignition coil based on signal pulses from the PCM. There is no back-up
or by-pass function in the ICM.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System >
Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 5196
Ignition Control Module: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector (3). 3. Remove the screws (4)
holding the ignition control module (2) and the heat sink (1) to the bracket. 4. Remove the ignition
control module and the heat sink.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the ignition control module (2) and the heat sink (1) on the bracket with the screws (4).
Tighten Tighten the screws to 3.5 N.m (31 lb in).
2. Reconnect the electrical connectors (3). 3. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5203
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5204
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5205
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5206
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5207
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5208
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5209
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5210
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5211
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5212
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5213
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5214
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5215
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5216
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5217
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5218
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5219
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5220
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5221
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5222
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5223
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5224
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5225
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5226
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5227
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5228
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5229
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5230
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5231
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5232
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5233
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5234
Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5235
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
The CMP sensor is a hall-effect sensor located in the ignition distributor base, and uses the same
type of circuits as the CKP sensor. The CMP sensor signal is a digital ON/OFF pulse, output once
per revolution of the camshaft. The CMP sensor information is used by the PCM to determine the
position of the valve train relative to the CKP.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5236
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5237
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Disconnect the spark plug wires and ignition coil wire from the
distributor.
3. Disconnect the camshaft position (CMP) sensor harness connector from the distributor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5238
4. Remove the distributor cap screws.
5. Remove the distributor cap.
6. Remove the rotor screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5239
7. Remove the rotor.
8. Align the square slot in the reluctor wheel with the CMP sensor.
9. Remove the CMP screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5240
10. Remove the CMP sensor.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: Do not use the old cap, CMP sensor, and rotor screws. Use the replacement screws
that have been coated with a thread locking compound.
1. Insert the CMP sensor through the reluctor wheel slot.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install new CMP mounting screws.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 2.2 N.m (19 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5241
3. Install the rotor onto the reluctor wheel.
4. Install new rotor screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5242
5. Install the distributor cap.
6. Install new distributor cap screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2.4 N.m (21 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5243
7. Connect the CMP sensor harness connector.
8. Connect the spark plug wires and ignition coil wire. 9. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft
Position Sensor: > 02-06-04-059 > Dec > 02 > Engine Controls - Engine Runs Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Customer Interest Engine Controls - Engine Runs Rough/MIL
ON/DTC's Set
File In Section: 06 - Engine/Propulsion System
Bulletin No.: 02-06-04-059
Date: December, 2002
TECHNICAL
Subject: Engine Runs Rough, Service Engine Soon Light On, DTC's P0300 or P0335 Set (Shim
Crankshaft Sensor)
Models: 2002-03 Chevrolet Astro, Blazer, Express, Silverado and S-10 Truck Models 2002-03
GMC Jimmy, Safari, Savana, Sierra and Sonoma Truck Models with 4.3L V-6 Engine (VINs W, X RPOs L35, LU3)
Condition
Some owners may comment on a rough running condition or a Service Engine Soon (SES) light
being illuminated. Upon investigation, the technician may find a DTC code P0300 or P0335.
Cause
The crankshaft sensor may be contacting the reluctor wheel.
Correction
Remove the crankshaft sensor. Refer to the Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement procedure in
the Engine Controls-4.3L sub-section of the Service Manual. After removing the sensor, inspect the
end of it for witness marks that would indicate contact with the crankshaft. If contact with the
reluctor ring is indicated, then inspect the front cover for cracking or other signs of alignment
concerns. If the inspection indicates that the cover is causing mis-alignments, replace the cover. If
replacing the cover, then the 0.5 mm shim is not needed.
If the inspection of the front cover indicates that the cover is not the cause of mis-alignments, then
the sensor should be shimmed. Add one shim between the sensor and the front cover. If the
concern still exists, then add the second shim. Unless the sensor has been rubbed through the
casing or deformed by contact with the crankshaft, it should not be replaced.
In either case, the crankshaft relearn procedure should be performed after any repairs.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft
Position Sensor: > 02-06-04-059 > Dec > 02 > Engine Controls - Engine Runs Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set > Page 5252
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Crankshaft Position Sensor: > 02-06-04-059 > Dec > 02 > Engine Controls - Engine Runs Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set
Crankshaft Position Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Engine Runs
Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set
File In Section: 06 - Engine/Propulsion System
Bulletin No.: 02-06-04-059
Date: December, 2002
TECHNICAL
Subject: Engine Runs Rough, Service Engine Soon Light On, DTC's P0300 or P0335 Set (Shim
Crankshaft Sensor)
Models: 2002-03 Chevrolet Astro, Blazer, Express, Silverado and S-10 Truck Models 2002-03
GMC Jimmy, Safari, Savana, Sierra and Sonoma Truck Models with 4.3L V-6 Engine (VINs W, X RPOs L35, LU3)
Condition
Some owners may comment on a rough running condition or a Service Engine Soon (SES) light
being illuminated. Upon investigation, the technician may find a DTC code P0300 or P0335.
Cause
The crankshaft sensor may be contacting the reluctor wheel.
Correction
Remove the crankshaft sensor. Refer to the Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement procedure in
the Engine Controls-4.3L sub-section of the Service Manual. After removing the sensor, inspect the
end of it for witness marks that would indicate contact with the crankshaft. If contact with the
reluctor ring is indicated, then inspect the front cover for cracking or other signs of alignment
concerns. If the inspection indicates that the cover is causing mis-alignments, replace the cover. If
replacing the cover, then the 0.5 mm shim is not needed.
If the inspection of the front cover indicates that the cover is not the cause of mis-alignments, then
the sensor should be shimmed. Add one shim between the sensor and the front cover. If the
concern still exists, then add the second shim. Unless the sensor has been rubbed through the
casing or deformed by contact with the crankshaft, it should not be replaced.
In either case, the crankshaft relearn procedure should be performed after any repairs.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Crankshaft Position Sensor: > 02-06-04-059 > Dec > 02 > Engine Controls - Engine Runs Rough/MIL ON/DTC's Set > Page
5258
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5259
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5262
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5263
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5264
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5265
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5266
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5267
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5268
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5269
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5270
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5271
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5272
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5273
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5274
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5275
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5276
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5277
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5278
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5279
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5280
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5281
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5282
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5283
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5284
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5285
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5286
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5287
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5288
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5289
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5290
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5291
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5292
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5293
Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5294
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
The CKP sensor is a three wire sensor based on the magneto resistive principle. A magneto
resistive sensor uses two magnetic pickups between a permanent magnet. As an element such as
a reluctor wheel passes the magnets the resulting change in the magnetic field is used by the
sensor electronics to produce a digital output pulse. The PCM supplies a 12-volt, low reference,
and signal circuit to the CKP sensor. The sensor returns a digital ON/OFF pulse 3 times per
crankshaft revolution for the V6 engine, 4 times for the V8 engine. The CKP sensor reads the
crankshaft mounted reluctor wheel to identify pairs of cylinders at top dead center (TDC).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5295
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > CKP System Variation Learn Procedure
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair CKP System Variation Learn Procedure
IMPORTANT: For additional diagnostic information, refer to DTC P1336.
1. Install a scan tool. 2. With a scan tool, monitor the powertrain control module (PCM) for
diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs). If other DTCs are set, except DTC P1336,
refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List for the applicable DTC that set.
3. With a scan tool, select the crankshaft position (CKP) variation learn procedure. 4. Observe the
fuel cut-OFF for the engine that you are performing the learn procedure on. 5. The scan tool
instructs you to perform the following:
^ Block the drive wheels.
^ Apply the vehicles parking brake.
^ Cycle the ignition from OFF to ON.
^ Apply and hold the brake pedal.
^ Start and idle the engine.
^ Turn OFF the A/C.
^ Place the vehicles transmission in Park (A/T) or Neutral (M/T).
^ The scan tool monitors certain component signals to determine if all the conditions are met to
continue with the procedure. The scan tool only displays the condition that inhibits the procedure.
The scan tool monitors the following components: CKP sensor activity - If there is a CKP sensor condition, refer to the applicable DTCs that set.
- Camshaft position (CMP) sensor activity - If there is a CMP sensor condition, refer to the
applicable DTCs that set.
- Engine coolant temperature (ECT) - If the ECT is not warm enough, idle the engine until the ECT
reaches the correct temperature.
6. With the scan tool, enable the CKP system variation learn procedure.
IMPORTANT: While the learn procedure is in progress, release the throttle immediately when the
engine starts to decelerate. The engine control is returned to the operator and the engine responds
to throttle position (TP) after the learn procedure is complete.
7. Slowly increase the engine speed to the RPM that you observed. 8. Immediately release the
throttle when fuel cut-OFF is reached. 9. The scan tool displays Learn Status: Learned this ignition.
If the scan tool does NOT display this message and no additional DTCs set, refer to
Symptoms - Engine. If a DTC set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List for the applicable
DTC that set.
10. Turn OFF the ignition for 30 seconds after the learn procedure is completed successfully.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > CKP System Variation Learn Procedure >
Page 5298
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: The CKP System Variation Learn Procedure will need to be performed whenever the
crankshaft position (CKP) sensor is removed or replaced. Refer to CKP System Variation Learn
Procedure.
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 2. If the vehicle is equipped with the
underbody shield package, then remove the steering linkage shield mounting bolts.
3. Remove the steering linkage shield.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > CKP System Variation Learn Procedure >
Page 5299
4. Disconnect the CKP sensor harness connector.
5. Remove the CKP sensor mounting bolt.
6. Remove the CKP sensor.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > CKP System Variation Learn Procedure >
Page 5300
IMPORTANT: ^
When installing the CKP sensor, make sure the sensor is fully seated before tightening the
mounting bolt. A poorly seated CKP sensor may perform erratically and may set false DTCs.
^ Do not reuse the original O-ring.
1. Replace the CKP sensor O-ring. 2. Lubricate the O-ring with clean engine oil before installing the
CKP sensor.
IMPORTANT: Make sure the CKP sensor mounting surface is clear and free of burrs.
3. Install the CKP sensor.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the CKP sensor mounting bolt.
Tighten Tighten the CKP sensor mounting bolt to 9 N.m (80 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > CKP System Variation Learn Procedure >
Page 5301
5. Connect the CKP sensor harness connector.
6. Install the steering linkage shield.
7. Install the steering linkage shield mounting bolts.
Tighten
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > CKP System Variation Learn Procedure >
Page 5302
Tighten the bolts to 33 N.m (24 lb ft).
8. Lower the Vehicle. 9. Perform the CKP System Variation Learn Procedure. See: Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition Lock
Cylinder - Revised Replacement Procedure
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Technical Service Bulletins Ignition Lock Cylinder - Revised
Replacement Procedure
File In Section: 02 - Steering
Bulletin No.: 02-02-35-001
Date: January, 2002
SERVICE MANUAL UPDATE
Subject: Revised Ignition Lock Cylinder Replacement
Models: 1998-2002 Chevrolet and GMC C/K, S/T, M/L and G Model Vehicles 1999-2000 Cadillac
Escalade 2002 Cadillac Escalade 1998-2002 Oldsmobile Bravada
This bulletin is being issued to revise the Ignition Lock Cylinder Replacement procedure in the
Steering Wheel and Column - Standard or Steering Wheel and Column - Tilt sub-sections of the
Service Manual. Please replace the current information in the Service Manual with the following
information.
The following information has been updated within SI2000. If you are using a paper version of this
Service Manual, please make a reference to this bulletin on the affected page.
The above mentioned Service Manuals omitted information regarding performing the Passlock
Relearn or Autolearn procedure after an ignition lock cylinder has been replaced. If you have
replaced the ignition lock cylinder, refer to the following procedures:
For 1998-2000 model year vehicles, refer to Passlock Reprogramming in the Theft Deterrent
subsection.
For 2001-2002 model year vehicles, refer to Programming Theft Deterrent System Components in
the Theft Deterrent subsection.
DISCLAIMER
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Knock Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5313
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5314
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5315
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5316
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5317
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5318
Knock Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5319
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5320
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5321
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5322
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5323
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5324
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5325
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5326
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5327
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5328
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5329
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5330
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5331
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5332
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5333
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5334
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5335
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5336
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5337
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5338
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5339
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5340
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5341
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5342
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5343
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5344
Knock Sensor (KS)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5345
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
The Knock Sensor (KS) system enables the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to control the
ignition timing advance for the best possible performance while protecting the engine from
potentially damaging levels of detonation. The sensors in the KS system are used by the PCM as
microphones to listen for abnormal engine noise that may indicate pre-ignition/detonation.
SENSOR DESCRIPTION
There are 2 types of KS currently being used: ^
The broadband single wire sensor
^ The flat response 2-wire sensor
Both sensors use piezo-electric crystal technology to produce and send signals to the PCM. The
amplitude and frequency of this signal will vary constantly depending on the vibration level within
the engine. Flat response and broadband KS signals are processed differently by the PCM. The
major differences are outlined below: ^
All broadband sensors use a single wire circuit. Some types of controllers will output a bias voltage
on the KS signal wire. The bias voltage creates a voltage drop the PCM monitors and uses to help
diagnose KS faults. The KS noise signal rides along this bias voltage, and due to the constantly
fluctuating frequency and amplitude of the signal, will always be outside the bias voltage
parameters. Another way to use the KS signals is for the PCM to learn the average normal noise
output from the KS. The PCM uses this noise channel, and KS signal that rides along the noise
channel, in much the same way as the bias voltage type does. Both systems will constantly monitor
the KS system for a signal that is not present or falls within the noise channel.
^ The flat response KS uses a 2-wire circuit. The KS signal rides within a noise channel which is
learned and output by the PCM. This noise channel is based upon the normal noise input from the
KS and is known as background noise. As engine speed and load change, the noise channel upper
and lower parameters will change to accommodate the KS signal, keeping the signal within the
channel. If there is knock, the signal will range outside the noise channel and the PCM will reduce
spark advance until the knock is reduced. These sensors are monitored in much the same way as
the broadband sensors, except that an abnormal signal will stay outside of the noise channel or will
not be present.
KS diagnostics can be calibrated to detect faults with the KS diagnostic inside the PCM, the KS
wiring, the sensor output, or constant knocking from an outside influence such as a loose or
damaged component. In order to determine which cylinders are knocking, the PCM uses KS signal
information when the cylinders are near Top Dead Center (TDC) of the firing stroke.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5346
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Computers and Control Systems Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5347
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the engine cover. 3. Disconnect the knock
sensor harness connector (3). 4. Remove the knock sensor bolt (1) and knock sensor (2).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the knock sensor (2) and the knock sensor bolt (1).
Tighten Tighten the sender to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
2. Connect the knock sensor harness connector (3). 3. Install the engine cover. 4. Connect the
negative battery cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information >
Specifications
Spark Plug: Specifications Ignition System Specifications
Ignition System Specifications
Spark Plug Torque 15 N.m
Spark Plug Gap 1.52 mm
Spark Plug Type R41-932 [AC plug type]
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5351
Spark Plug: Application and ID
Spark Plug ...........................................................................................................................................
............................................ R41-932 (AC plug type)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Spark Plug Inspection
Spark Plug: Service and Repair Spark Plug Inspection
SPARK PLUG USAGE
1. Ensure that the correct spark plug is installed. An incorrect spark plug causes driveability
conditions. Refer to Ignition System Specifications for
the correct spark plug.
2. Ensure that the spark plug has the correct heat range. An incorrect heat range causes the
following conditions:
^ Spark plug fouling - Colder plug
^ Pre-ignition causing spark plug and/or engine damage - Hotter plug
SPARK PLUG INSPECTION
1. Inspect the terminal post (1) for damage.
^ Inspect for a bent or broken terminal post (1).
^ Test for a loose terminal post (1) by twisting and pulling the post. The terminal post (1) should
NOT move.
2. Inspect the insulator (2) for flashover or carbon tracking, soot. This is caused by the electrical
charge traveling across the insulator (2) between the
terminal post (1) and ground. Inspect for the following conditions: ^
Inspect the spark plug boot for damage.
^ Inspect the spark plug recess area of the cylinder head for moisture, such as oil, coolant, or
water. A spark plug boot that is saturated causes arcing to ground.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Spark Plug Inspection > Page 5354
3. Inspect the insulator (2) for cracks. All or part of the electrical charge may arc through the crack
instead of the electrodes (3, 4).
4. Inspect for evidence of improper arcing.
^ Measure the gap between the center electrode (4) and the side electrode (3) terminals. An
excessively wide electrode gap can prevent correct spark plug operation.
^ Inspect for the correct spark plug torque. Refer to Ignition System Specifications. Insufficient
torque can prevent correct spark plug operation. An over torqued spark plug, causes the insulator
(2) to crack.
^ Inspect for signs of tracking that occurred near the insulator tip instead of the center electrode (4).
^ Inspect for a broken or worn side electrode (3).
^ Inspect for a broken, worn, or loose center electrode (4) by shaking the spark plug. A rattling sound indicates internal damage.
- A loose center electrode (4) reduces the spark intensity.
^ Inspect for bridged electrodes (3, 4). Deposits on the electrodes (3, 4) reduce or eliminates the
gap.
^ Inspect for worn or missing platinum pads on the electrodes (3, 4), if equipped.
^ Inspect for excessive fouling.
5. Inspect the spark plug recess area of the cylinder head for debris. Dirty or damaged threads can
cause the spark plug not to seat correctly during
installation.
SPARK PLUG VISUAL INSPECTION
1. Normal operation - Brown to grayish-tan with small amounts of white powdery deposits are
normal combustion by-products from fuels with
additives.
2. Carbon Fouled - Dry, fluffy black carbon, or soot caused by the following conditions:
^ Rich fuel mixtures Leaking fuel injectors
- Excessive fuel pressure
- Restricted air filter element
- Incorrect combustion
^ Reduced ignition system voltage output
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Spark Plug Inspection > Page 5355
- Weak coils
- Worn ignition wires
- Incorrect spark plug gap
^ Excessive idling or slow speeds under light loads can keep spark plug temperatures so low that
normal combustion deposits may not burn off.
3. Deposit Fouling - Oil, coolant, or additives that include substances such as silicone, very white
coating, reduces the spark intensity. Most powdery
deposits will not effect spark intensity unless they form into a glazing over the electrode.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Spark Plug Inspection > Page 5356
Spark Plug: Service and Repair Spark Plug Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the spark plug wires. 2. Loosen each spark plug 1 or 2 turns. 3. Brush or air blast away
any dirt from around the spark plugs. 4. Remove the spark plugs 1 at a time. Place each plug in a
tray marked with the corresponding cylinder numbers.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Properly position each spark plug washer. 2. Inspect each spark plug gap. Adjust each plug as
needed
Specification Spark plug gap: 1.524 mm (0.060 in).
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Hand start the spark plugs in the corresponding cylinders. 4. Tighten the spark plugs.
Tighten ^
For used heads tighten the spark plugs to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
^ For new aluminum heads tighten the spark plugs to 20 N.m (15 lb ft).
^ For new iron heads tighten the spark plugs to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
5. Install the spark plug wires.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair
Pressure Regulator Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the transmission oil pan and
filter.
3. Compress the reverse boost valve sleeve into the bore of the oil pump to release tension on the
reverse boost valve retaining ring. 4. Remove the reverse boost valve retaining ring, then slowly
release tension on the reverse boost valve sleeve.
5. Remove the reverse boost valve sleeve (5) and the reverse boost valve (4). 6. Remove the
pressure regulator isolator spring (3) and the pressure regulator valve spring (2). 7. Remove the
pressure regulator valve (1).
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 5363
1. Install the pressure regulator valve (1). 2. Install the pressure regulator isolator spring (3) and the
pressure regulator valve spring (2). 3. Install the reverse boost valve (4) in the reverse boost valve
sleeve (5). 4. Install the reverse boost valve (4) and sleeve (5) in the oil pump cover.
5. Compress the reverse boost valve sleeve into the bore of the oil pump to expose the retaining
ring slot. 6. Install the reverse boost valve retaining ring, then slowly release tension on the reverse
boost valve sleeve. 7. Install the transmission oil filter and pan. 8. Lower the vehicle. 9. Fill the
transmission to the proper level with DEXRON III transmission fluid.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Service and Repair
Automatic Transmission Shift Lock Actuator Replacement
Removal Procedure
Caution: Refer to SIR Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disable the SIR system. 2. Remove the lower steering column trim cover.
3. Disconnect the automatic transmission shift lock control actuator electrical connector. 4. Place
the shift lever clevis into the neutral position. 5. Use a small screwdriver to pry the automatic
transmission shift lock control actuator from the steering column jacket assembly. 6. Remove the
automatic transmission shift lock control actuator from the steering column.
Installation Procedure
1. Firmly install the automatic transmission shift lock control actuator onto the steering column
jacket assembly. 2. Connect the automatic transmission shift lock control actuator electrical
connector.
3. Adjust the automatic transmission shift lock control actuator (with the shift lever clevis in the
neutral position) in the following way:
3.1. Pull out the tab (1) on the adjuster block side (2) of the automatic transmission shift lock
control actuator.
3.2. Press on the adjuster block (2) to disengage the adjuster teeth. Slide the adjuster block (2) as
far away from the actuator as possible.
3.3. Lock the adjuster block in place by pushing inward on the tab (1).
4. Inspect the automatic transmission shift lock control actuator for the following items:
4.1. The automatic transmission shift lock control actuator must lock the shift lever clevis when the
shift lever clevis is put into the PARK position.
4.2. Turn the ignition to the ON position and depress the brake pedal in order to move the gear shift
lever out of the PARK position. The actuator will be energized.
4.3. Readjust the automatic transmission shift lock control actuator if needed.
5. Install the lower steering column trim cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Page 5367
6. Enable the SIR system.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair
Control and Shift Solenoids Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the transmission oil pan and filter.
Important: Do not remove the valve body for the following procedures. Removal of the 1-2
accumulator is necessary only if servicing the pressure control solenoid.
2. Remove the 1-2 accumulator if necessary.
3. Disconnect the internal wiring harness electrical connectors from the following components:
^ Transmission fluid pressure switch (1)
^ 1-2 shift control solenoid (2)
^ 2-3 shift control solenoid (3)
^ Pressure control solenoid (4)
^ TCC PWM solenoid (5)
^ 3-2 control solenoid (6)
4. Remove the pressure control solenoid retainer.
5. Remove the pressure control solenoid.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 5371
6. Remove the 1-2 and 2-3 shift solenoid retainers. 7. Remove the 1-2 and 2-3 shift solenoids.
8. Remove the 3-2 control solenoid retainer. 9. Remove the 3-2 control solenoid.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the 3-2 control solenoid. 2. Install the 3-2 control solenoid retainer.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 5372
3. Install the 1-2 and 2-3 shift solenoids. 4. Install the 1-2 and 2-3 shift solenoid retainers.
5. Install the pressure control solenoid. Ensure that the electrical tabs are facing outboard.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
6. Install the pressure control solenoid retainer and retaining bolt.
Tighten the pressure control solenoid retaining bolt to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
7. Connect the internal wiring harness electrical connectors to the following components:
^ Transmission fluid pressure switch (1)
^ 1-2 shift control solenoid (2)
^ 2-3 shift control solenoid (3)
^ Pressure control solenoid (4)
^ TCC PWM solenoid (5)
^ 3-2 control solenoid (6)
8. Install the 1-2 accumulator.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 5373
9. Install the transmission oil pan and filter.
10. Fill the transmission to the proper level with DEXRON III transmission fluid.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
TCC Solenoid Assembly to Case Bolt
................................................................................................................................ 8.0 - 14.0 Nm (6 10 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5377
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Service and Repair
Torque Converter Clutch Pulse Width Modulation (TCC PWM) Solenoid, TCC Solenoid, and Wiring
Harness
^ Tools Required J 28458 Seal Protector Retainer Installer
Removal Procedure
1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the transmission oil pan and
the filter.
3. Disconnect the transmission harness 20-way connector from the transmission internal harness
pass-through connector. Depress both tabs on the
connector and pull straight up; do not pry the connector.
Important: Removal of the valve body is not necessary for the following procedure.
4. Remove the 1-2 accumulator assembly. Do not remove the spacer plate.
5. Disconnect the internal wiring harness electrical connectors from the following components:
^ Transmission fluid pressure switch (1)
^ 1-2 shift control solenoid (2)
^ 2-3 shift control solenoid (3)
^ Pressure control solenoid (4)
^ TCC PWM solenoid (5)
^ 3-2 control solenoid (6)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5378
6. Remove the TCC PWM solenoid retainer. 7. Remove the TCC PWM solenoid in order to access
one of the TCC solenoid retaining bolts. 8. Remove the pressure control solenoid retainer.
9. Remove the pressure control solenoid.
10. Remove the TCC solenoid retaining bolts and the valve body bolts which retain the internal
wiring harness.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5379
11. Using J 28458, release the pass-through electrical connector from the transmission case.
11.1. Use the small end of the J 28458 over the top of the connector.
11.2. Twist in order to release the four tabs retaining the connector.
11.3. Pull the harness connector down through the transmission case.
12. Remove the TCC solenoid (with O-ring seal) and wiring harness assembly from the
transmission case.
13. Inspect the TCC solenoid and wiring harness assembly for the following defects:
^ Damage
^ Cracked connectors
^ Exposed wires
^ Loose pins
Installation Procedure
1. Install the wiring harness and TCC solenoid assembly with a new O-ring seal to the
transmission. 2. Install the pass-through electrical connector to the transmission case.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5380
3. Install the valve body bolts which retain the internal wiring harness and install the TCC solenoid
retaining bolts.
^ Tighten the control valve body retaining bolts to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
^ Tighten the TCC solenoid retaining bolts to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
4. Install the pressure control solenoid. Ensure that the electrical tabs are facing outboard. 5. Install
the pressure control solenoid retainer and retaining bolt.
Tighten the pressure control solenoid retaining bolt to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
6. Install the TCC PWM solenoid to the control valve body. 7. Install the TCC PWM solenoid
retainer.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5381
8. Connect the internal wiring harness electrical connectors to the following components:
^ Transmission fluid pressure switch (1)
^ 1-2 shift control solenoid (2)
^ 2-3 shift control solenoid (3)
^ Pressure control solenoid (4)
^ TCC PWM solenoid (5)
^ 3-2 control solenoid (6)
9. Install the 1-2 accumulator.
10. Connect the transmission harness 20-way connector to the transmission pass-through
connector. Align the arrows on each half of the connector and
insert straight down.
11. Install the transmission oil pan and filter. 12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Fill the transmission to the
proper level with DEXRON III transmission fluid.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection
Transmission Mode Switch: Testing and Inspection
Tow/Haul Switch/Indicator Always On or Inoperative
Circuit Description
Tow/haul mode enables the operator to achieve enhanced shift performance when towing or
hauling a load. When tow/haul mode is selected, the tow/haul switch input signal to the Body
Control Module (BCM) is momentarily toggled to zero volts. This signals the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) to extend the length of time between upshifts and increase transmission line
pressure. Cycling the tow/haul switch again disables tow/haul mode and returns the transmission to
a normal shift pattern.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Page 5387
Test Description
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. This step tests for a faulty
tow/haul switch. 3. This step tests for voltage input from the BCM to the tow/haul switch.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Park/Neutral Position Switch Screw
................................................................................................................................................... 3 Nm
(27 inch lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5391
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams
Automatic Transmission Related Connector End Views
Transmission Range Switch Connector, Wiring Harness Side
Tow/Haul Switch Connector, Column Wiring Harness Side
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5392
Park/Neutral Position Switch (C1)
Park/Neutral Position Switch (C2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5393
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Adjustments
Park/Neutral Position Switch Adjustment
Important: ^
The following procedure is for vehicles that have not had the switch removed or replaced. If the
switch has been removed or replaced, refer to Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement for the
proper adjustment procedure.
^ Apply the parking brake.
^ The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) positions only.
^ Check the switch for proper operation. If adjustment is required, proceed as follows:
1. Place the transmission range selector in the N (Neutral) position. 2. With an assistant in the
drivers seat, raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 3. Loosen the park/neutral position switch
mounting bolts. 4. With the vehicle in the N (Neutral) position, rotate the switch while the assistant
attempts to start the engine. 5. Following a successful start, turn the engine off.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
6. Tighten the bolts securing the switch to the transmission.
Tighten the bolts to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Check the switch for proper operation. The engine must start in the P
(Park) or N (Neutral) positions only. 9. Replace the park/neutral position switch if proper operation
can not be achieved.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5394
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement
^ Tools Required J 41364-A Neutral Position Adjustment Tool
Removal Procedure
1. Apply the parking brake. 2. Shift the transmission into neutral. 3. Raise the vehicle. Refer to
Vehicle Lifting.
4. Remove the nut securing the transmission control lever to the manual shaft. 5. Remove the
transmission control lever from the manual shaft. 6. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the
switch. 7. Remove the bolts securing the park/neutral position switch to the transmission. 8.
Remove the park/neutral position switch from the manual shaft. If the park/neutral position switch
did not slide off the manual shaft, file the outer
edge of the manual shaft in order to remove any burrs.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the switch to the transmission manual shaft by aligning the switch hub flats with the
manual shaft flats.
2. Slide the switch onto the transmission manual shaft until the switch mounting bracket contacts
the mounting bosses on the transmission.
Important: If a new switch is being installed, the switch will come with a positive assurance bracket.
The positive assurance bracket aligns the new switch in it proper position for installation and the
use of neutral position adjustment tool will not be necessary.
3. Install the switch to the transmission with two bolts finger tight.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5395
4. Position the tool J 41364-A onto the park/neutral position switch. Ensure that the two slots on the
switch where the manual shaft is inserted are
lined up with the lower two tabs on the tool.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
5. Rotate the tool until the upper locator pin on the tool is lined up with the slot on the top of the
switch.
Tighten the bolts securing the switch to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
6. Remove the J 41364-A from the switch. If installing a new switch, remove the positive assurance
bracket at this time. 7. Connect the electrical connectors to the switch.
8. Install the transmission control lever to the manual shaft with the nut.
Tighten the control lever nut to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
9. Lower the vehicle.
10. Check the switch for proper operation. The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral)
positions only. If proper operation of the switch can
not be obtained, replace the switch.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications
Transmission Speed Sensor: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Speed Sensor Retainer Bolt
............................................................................................................................................ 10.5 13.5 Nm (7.7 - 10 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5399
VSS Assembly Connector, Wiring Harness Side
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5400
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) Replacement
^ Tools Required J 38417 Speed Sensor Remover
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting.
2. Remove the harness connector. 3. Remove the bolt. 4. Place a drain pan under the vehicle. 5.
Remove the vehicle speed sensor using J 38417. 6. Remove the O-ring seal.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the new speed sensor and O-ring seal using J 38417 2. Coat the seal with a thin film of
transmission fluid.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the bolt.
Tighten the bolt to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
4. Install the harness connector. 5. Lower the vehicle. 6. Refill the fluid as required.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Specifications
Transmission Fluid Temperature (TFT) Sensor Specifications
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > PCM/BCM Replacement - DTC's B001/B1271/B1780 Set
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Technical Service Bulletins PCM/BCM Replacement DTC's B001/B1271/B1780 Set
File In Section: 06 - Engine/Propulsion System
Bulletin No.: 99-06-03-010A
Date: June, 2001
INFORMATION
Subject: DTCs B1001, B1271 or B1780 Set When Replacing/Reprogramming Other Modules
Models: 1999-2002 All Passenger Cars and Trucks With Class 2 Serial Data Communication
Between Modules
This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
99-06-03-010 (Section 06 - Engine/propulsion System).
Class 2 Serial Data Communication allows control modules (i.e. the Powertrain Control Module
(PCM), the Body Control Module (BCM), the Dash Integration Module (DIM), the Instrument Panel
Cluster (IPC), the radio, the Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) Controller, and the
Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM) to exchange information. This information may be
operational information or identification information. Among the identification information
exchanged and compared within these modules is the Vehicle Identification Number (VIN).
Typically, the PCM broadcasts a portion of the VIN, while another module broadcasts another
portion of the VIN. This information is compared by the SDM in order to ensure installation is in the
correct vehicle. When the broadcast VIN does not match the VIN stored within the SDM, the
following actions occur:
^ DTC B1001 Option Configuration Error is set and deployment of the airbags is inhibited.
^ The VIN information is also used by the radio in order to prevent theft. When the broadcast VIN
does not match the VIN stored within the radio, a DTC B1271 ora DTC B1780 Theft Locked is set
and the radio is inoperative.
This situation may occur when a vehicle is being repaired. When a PCM or a body control type
module is replaced, the VIN information must be programmed into the replaced (new) control
module. A module which has had VIN information entered into it (for example, one taken from
another vehicle) cannot be reprogrammed. VIN information can only be entered into new modules.
The ignition must be ON in order to program the control module. Since the VIN information is
broadcast when the ignition goes to ON from any other ignition switch position, DTCs may be set in
the SDM and/or the radio. Therefore, always follow the specified control module replacement
procedures.
1. After completing the repair, turn OFF the ignition for at least 30 seconds.
2. Turn ON the ignition and check for DTCs using a scan tool.
If DTCs B1001, B1271, or B178C are present with a history status, DO NOT REPLACE THE SDM
OR THE RADIO.
3. Clear the DTCs from all modules using the scan tool. The SDM and/or the radio should then
operate properly.
4. Ensure the proper operation of the SDM by turning OFF the ignition and then turning ON the
ignition. The air bag warning indicator should flash seven times and then go OFF.
Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 99-09-41-001 for additional information regarding proper
reprogramming of the new/replaced module.
Clearing codes from the other modules is part of the replacement and reprogramming procedure
for the replaced module. The repair is not complete unless all codes have been cleared from all
modules.
DO NOT SUBMIT CLAIMS FOR OTHER MODULE REPLACEMENTS OR REPROGRAMMING.
DISCLAIMER
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair
Pressure Regulator Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the transmission oil pan and
filter.
3. Compress the reverse boost valve sleeve into the bore of the oil pump to release tension on the
reverse boost valve retaining ring. 4. Remove the reverse boost valve retaining ring, then slowly
release tension on the reverse boost valve sleeve.
5. Remove the reverse boost valve sleeve (5) and the reverse boost valve (4). 6. Remove the
pressure regulator isolator spring (3) and the pressure regulator valve spring (2). 7. Remove the
pressure regulator valve (1).
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page
5414
1. Install the pressure regulator valve (1). 2. Install the pressure regulator isolator spring (3) and the
pressure regulator valve spring (2). 3. Install the reverse boost valve (4) in the reverse boost valve
sleeve (5). 4. Install the reverse boost valve (4) and sleeve (5) in the oil pump cover.
5. Compress the reverse boost valve sleeve into the bore of the oil pump to expose the retaining
ring slot. 6. Install the reverse boost valve retaining ring, then slowly release tension on the reverse
boost valve sleeve. 7. Install the transmission oil filter and pan. 8. Lower the vehicle. 9. Fill the
transmission to the proper level with DEXRON III transmission fluid.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Service and Repair
Automatic Transmission Shift Lock Actuator Replacement
Removal Procedure
Caution: Refer to SIR Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disable the SIR system. 2. Remove the lower steering column trim cover.
3. Disconnect the automatic transmission shift lock control actuator electrical connector. 4. Place
the shift lever clevis into the neutral position. 5. Use a small screwdriver to pry the automatic
transmission shift lock control actuator from the steering column jacket assembly. 6. Remove the
automatic transmission shift lock control actuator from the steering column.
Installation Procedure
1. Firmly install the automatic transmission shift lock control actuator onto the steering column
jacket assembly. 2. Connect the automatic transmission shift lock control actuator electrical
connector.
3. Adjust the automatic transmission shift lock control actuator (with the shift lever clevis in the
neutral position) in the following way:
3.1. Pull out the tab (1) on the adjuster block side (2) of the automatic transmission shift lock
control actuator.
3.2. Press on the adjuster block (2) to disengage the adjuster teeth. Slide the adjuster block (2) as
far away from the actuator as possible.
3.3. Lock the adjuster block in place by pushing inward on the tab (1).
4. Inspect the automatic transmission shift lock control actuator for the following items:
4.1. The automatic transmission shift lock control actuator must lock the shift lever clevis when the
shift lever clevis is put into the PARK position.
4.2. Turn the ignition to the ON position and depress the brake pedal in order to move the gear shift
lever out of the PARK position. The actuator will be energized.
4.3. Readjust the automatic transmission shift lock control actuator if needed.
5. Install the lower steering column trim cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5418
6. Enable the SIR system.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair
Control and Shift Solenoids Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the transmission oil pan and filter.
Important: Do not remove the valve body for the following procedures. Removal of the 1-2
accumulator is necessary only if servicing the pressure control solenoid.
2. Remove the 1-2 accumulator if necessary.
3. Disconnect the internal wiring harness electrical connectors from the following components:
^ Transmission fluid pressure switch (1)
^ 1-2 shift control solenoid (2)
^ 2-3 shift control solenoid (3)
^ Pressure control solenoid (4)
^ TCC PWM solenoid (5)
^ 3-2 control solenoid (6)
4. Remove the pressure control solenoid retainer.
5. Remove the pressure control solenoid.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5422
6. Remove the 1-2 and 2-3 shift solenoid retainers. 7. Remove the 1-2 and 2-3 shift solenoids.
8. Remove the 3-2 control solenoid retainer. 9. Remove the 3-2 control solenoid.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the 3-2 control solenoid. 2. Install the 3-2 control solenoid retainer.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5423
3. Install the 1-2 and 2-3 shift solenoids. 4. Install the 1-2 and 2-3 shift solenoid retainers.
5. Install the pressure control solenoid. Ensure that the electrical tabs are facing outboard.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
6. Install the pressure control solenoid retainer and retaining bolt.
Tighten the pressure control solenoid retaining bolt to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
7. Connect the internal wiring harness electrical connectors to the following components:
^ Transmission fluid pressure switch (1)
^ 1-2 shift control solenoid (2)
^ 2-3 shift control solenoid (3)
^ Pressure control solenoid (4)
^ TCC PWM solenoid (5)
^ 3-2 control solenoid (6)
8. Install the 1-2 accumulator.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5424
9. Install the transmission oil pan and filter.
10. Fill the transmission to the proper level with DEXRON III transmission fluid.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
TCC Solenoid Assembly to Case Bolt
................................................................................................................................ 8.0 - 14.0 Nm (6 10 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page
5428
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Service and Repair
Torque Converter Clutch Pulse Width Modulation (TCC PWM) Solenoid, TCC Solenoid, and Wiring
Harness
^ Tools Required J 28458 Seal Protector Retainer Installer
Removal Procedure
1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the transmission oil pan and
the filter.
3. Disconnect the transmission harness 20-way connector from the transmission internal harness
pass-through connector. Depress both tabs on the
connector and pull straight up; do not pry the connector.
Important: Removal of the valve body is not necessary for the following procedure.
4. Remove the 1-2 accumulator assembly. Do not remove the spacer plate.
5. Disconnect the internal wiring harness electrical connectors from the following components:
^ Transmission fluid pressure switch (1)
^ 1-2 shift control solenoid (2)
^ 2-3 shift control solenoid (3)
^ Pressure control solenoid (4)
^ TCC PWM solenoid (5)
^ 3-2 control solenoid (6)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page
5429
6. Remove the TCC PWM solenoid retainer. 7. Remove the TCC PWM solenoid in order to access
one of the TCC solenoid retaining bolts. 8. Remove the pressure control solenoid retainer.
9. Remove the pressure control solenoid.
10. Remove the TCC solenoid retaining bolts and the valve body bolts which retain the internal
wiring harness.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page
5430
11. Using J 28458, release the pass-through electrical connector from the transmission case.
11.1. Use the small end of the J 28458 over the top of the connector.
11.2. Twist in order to release the four tabs retaining the connector.
11.3. Pull the harness connector down through the transmission case.
12. Remove the TCC solenoid (with O-ring seal) and wiring harness assembly from the
transmission case.
13. Inspect the TCC solenoid and wiring harness assembly for the following defects:
^ Damage
^ Cracked connectors
^ Exposed wires
^ Loose pins
Installation Procedure
1. Install the wiring harness and TCC solenoid assembly with a new O-ring seal to the
transmission. 2. Install the pass-through electrical connector to the transmission case.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page
5431
3. Install the valve body bolts which retain the internal wiring harness and install the TCC solenoid
retaining bolts.
^ Tighten the control valve body retaining bolts to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
^ Tighten the TCC solenoid retaining bolts to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
4. Install the pressure control solenoid. Ensure that the electrical tabs are facing outboard. 5. Install
the pressure control solenoid retainer and retaining bolt.
Tighten the pressure control solenoid retaining bolt to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
6. Install the TCC PWM solenoid to the control valve body. 7. Install the TCC PWM solenoid
retainer.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page
5432
8. Connect the internal wiring harness electrical connectors to the following components:
^ Transmission fluid pressure switch (1)
^ 1-2 shift control solenoid (2)
^ 2-3 shift control solenoid (3)
^ Pressure control solenoid (4)
^ TCC PWM solenoid (5)
^ 3-2 control solenoid (6)
9. Install the 1-2 accumulator.
10. Connect the transmission harness 20-way connector to the transmission pass-through
connector. Align the arrows on each half of the connector and
insert straight down.
11. Install the transmission oil pan and filter. 12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Fill the transmission to the
proper level with DEXRON III transmission fluid.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair
Pressure Regulator Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the transmission oil pan and
filter.
3. Compress the reverse boost valve sleeve into the bore of the oil pump to release tension on the
reverse boost valve retaining ring. 4. Remove the reverse boost valve retaining ring, then slowly
release tension on the reverse boost valve sleeve.
5. Remove the reverse boost valve sleeve (5) and the reverse boost valve (4). 6. Remove the
pressure regulator isolator spring (3) and the pressure regulator valve spring (2). 7. Remove the
pressure regulator valve (1).
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5438
1. Install the pressure regulator valve (1). 2. Install the pressure regulator isolator spring (3) and the
pressure regulator valve spring (2). 3. Install the reverse boost valve (4) in the reverse boost valve
sleeve (5). 4. Install the reverse boost valve (4) and sleeve (5) in the oil pump cover.
5. Compress the reverse boost valve sleeve into the bore of the oil pump to expose the retaining
ring slot. 6. Install the reverse boost valve retaining ring, then slowly release tension on the reverse
boost valve sleeve. 7. Install the transmission oil filter and pan. 8. Lower the vehicle. 9. Fill the
transmission to the proper level with DEXRON III transmission fluid.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Service and Repair
Automatic Transmission Shift Lock Actuator Replacement
Removal Procedure
Caution: Refer to SIR Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disable the SIR system. 2. Remove the lower steering column trim cover.
3. Disconnect the automatic transmission shift lock control actuator electrical connector. 4. Place
the shift lever clevis into the neutral position. 5. Use a small screwdriver to pry the automatic
transmission shift lock control actuator from the steering column jacket assembly. 6. Remove the
automatic transmission shift lock control actuator from the steering column.
Installation Procedure
1. Firmly install the automatic transmission shift lock control actuator onto the steering column
jacket assembly. 2. Connect the automatic transmission shift lock control actuator electrical
connector.
3. Adjust the automatic transmission shift lock control actuator (with the shift lever clevis in the
neutral position) in the following way:
3.1. Pull out the tab (1) on the adjuster block side (2) of the automatic transmission shift lock
control actuator.
3.2. Press on the adjuster block (2) to disengage the adjuster teeth. Slide the adjuster block (2) as
far away from the actuator as possible.
3.3. Lock the adjuster block in place by pushing inward on the tab (1).
4. Inspect the automatic transmission shift lock control actuator for the following items:
4.1. The automatic transmission shift lock control actuator must lock the shift lever clevis when the
shift lever clevis is put into the PARK position.
4.2. Turn the ignition to the ON position and depress the brake pedal in order to move the gear shift
lever out of the PARK position. The actuator will be energized.
4.3. Readjust the automatic transmission shift lock control actuator if needed.
5. Install the lower steering column trim cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5442
6. Enable the SIR system.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair
Control and Shift Solenoids Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the transmission oil pan and filter.
Important: Do not remove the valve body for the following procedures. Removal of the 1-2
accumulator is necessary only if servicing the pressure control solenoid.
2. Remove the 1-2 accumulator if necessary.
3. Disconnect the internal wiring harness electrical connectors from the following components:
^ Transmission fluid pressure switch (1)
^ 1-2 shift control solenoid (2)
^ 2-3 shift control solenoid (3)
^ Pressure control solenoid (4)
^ TCC PWM solenoid (5)
^ 3-2 control solenoid (6)
4. Remove the pressure control solenoid retainer.
5. Remove the pressure control solenoid.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5446
6. Remove the 1-2 and 2-3 shift solenoid retainers. 7. Remove the 1-2 and 2-3 shift solenoids.
8. Remove the 3-2 control solenoid retainer. 9. Remove the 3-2 control solenoid.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the 3-2 control solenoid. 2. Install the 3-2 control solenoid retainer.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5447
3. Install the 1-2 and 2-3 shift solenoids. 4. Install the 1-2 and 2-3 shift solenoid retainers.
5. Install the pressure control solenoid. Ensure that the electrical tabs are facing outboard.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
6. Install the pressure control solenoid retainer and retaining bolt.
Tighten the pressure control solenoid retaining bolt to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
7. Connect the internal wiring harness electrical connectors to the following components:
^ Transmission fluid pressure switch (1)
^ 1-2 shift control solenoid (2)
^ 2-3 shift control solenoid (3)
^ Pressure control solenoid (4)
^ TCC PWM solenoid (5)
^ 3-2 control solenoid (6)
8. Install the 1-2 accumulator.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5448
9. Install the transmission oil pan and filter.
10. Fill the transmission to the proper level with DEXRON III transmission fluid.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
TCC Solenoid Assembly to Case Bolt
................................................................................................................................ 8.0 - 14.0 Nm (6 10 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5452
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Service and Repair
Torque Converter Clutch Pulse Width Modulation (TCC PWM) Solenoid, TCC Solenoid, and Wiring
Harness
^ Tools Required J 28458 Seal Protector Retainer Installer
Removal Procedure
1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the transmission oil pan and
the filter.
3. Disconnect the transmission harness 20-way connector from the transmission internal harness
pass-through connector. Depress both tabs on the
connector and pull straight up; do not pry the connector.
Important: Removal of the valve body is not necessary for the following procedure.
4. Remove the 1-2 accumulator assembly. Do not remove the spacer plate.
5. Disconnect the internal wiring harness electrical connectors from the following components:
^ Transmission fluid pressure switch (1)
^ 1-2 shift control solenoid (2)
^ 2-3 shift control solenoid (3)
^ Pressure control solenoid (4)
^ TCC PWM solenoid (5)
^ 3-2 control solenoid (6)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5453
6. Remove the TCC PWM solenoid retainer. 7. Remove the TCC PWM solenoid in order to access
one of the TCC solenoid retaining bolts. 8. Remove the pressure control solenoid retainer.
9. Remove the pressure control solenoid.
10. Remove the TCC solenoid retaining bolts and the valve body bolts which retain the internal
wiring harness.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5454
11. Using J 28458, release the pass-through electrical connector from the transmission case.
11.1. Use the small end of the J 28458 over the top of the connector.
11.2. Twist in order to release the four tabs retaining the connector.
11.3. Pull the harness connector down through the transmission case.
12. Remove the TCC solenoid (with O-ring seal) and wiring harness assembly from the
transmission case.
13. Inspect the TCC solenoid and wiring harness assembly for the following defects:
^ Damage
^ Cracked connectors
^ Exposed wires
^ Loose pins
Installation Procedure
1. Install the wiring harness and TCC solenoid assembly with a new O-ring seal to the
transmission. 2. Install the pass-through electrical connector to the transmission case.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5455
3. Install the valve body bolts which retain the internal wiring harness and install the TCC solenoid
retaining bolts.
^ Tighten the control valve body retaining bolts to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
^ Tighten the TCC solenoid retaining bolts to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
4. Install the pressure control solenoid. Ensure that the electrical tabs are facing outboard. 5. Install
the pressure control solenoid retainer and retaining bolt.
Tighten the pressure control solenoid retaining bolt to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
6. Install the TCC PWM solenoid to the control valve body. 7. Install the TCC PWM solenoid
retainer.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5456
8. Connect the internal wiring harness electrical connectors to the following components:
^ Transmission fluid pressure switch (1)
^ 1-2 shift control solenoid (2)
^ 2-3 shift control solenoid (3)
^ Pressure control solenoid (4)
^ TCC PWM solenoid (5)
^ 3-2 control solenoid (6)
9. Install the 1-2 accumulator.
10. Connect the transmission harness 20-way connector to the transmission pass-through
connector. Align the arrows on each half of the connector and
insert straight down.
11. Install the transmission oil pan and filter. 12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Fill the transmission to the
proper level with DEXRON III transmission fluid.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E Harsh 1-2 Upshift Diagnosis
Accumulator: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E Harsh 1-2 Upshift Diagnosis
Bulletin No.: 01-07-30-030B
Date: October 18, 2005
INFORMATION
Subject: 4L60-E/4L65-E Automatic Transmission Diagnostic Information on Harsh 1-2 Upshift
Models: 2001-2006 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2003-2006 HUMMER H2 2006
HUMMER H3 2005-2006 Saab 9-7X
with 4L60-E or 4L65-E Automatic Transmission
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years and models. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 01-07-30-030A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The following four conditions have been found to cause the majority of consistent, harsh 1-2 shift
comments.
^ Chips/Sediment/Debris/Contamination found in the valve body, 1-2 accumulator valve (371) bore,
may cause the 1-2 accumulator valve to stick or hang-up.
^ Chips/Sediment/Debris/Contamination found in the valve body, 4-3 sequence valve (383) bore,
may cause the 4-3 sequence valve to stick or hang-up.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E Harsh 1-2 Upshift Diagnosis > Page 5461
A cracked 1-2 accumulator piston (56) that is allowing fluid to leak by.
Mislocated/Missing valve body-to-spacer plate check balls (61).
When attempting to correct a consistent harsh 1-2 shift, the four conditions listed above should be
inspected as possible causes. It is important to also refer to the appropriate Service Manual for
further possible causes of this condition.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E Harsh 1-2 Upshift Diagnosis > Page 5462
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E Harsh 1-2 Upshift Diagnosis > Page 5463
This diagnostic table should be used when addressing a harsh 1-2 shift concern.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5464
Accumulator: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Forward Accumulator Cover to Valve Body Bolt
............................................................................................................... 8.0 - 14.0 Nm (6 - 10 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5465
Accumulator: Service and Repair
Accumulator Assembly, Spacer Plate, and Gaskets
^ Tools Required J 25025-B Pump and Valve Body Alignment Pin Set
- J 36850 Transjel Lubricant
Removal Procedure
1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the transmission oil pan and
filter.
Important: The 1-2 accumulator can be removed without removing the control valve assembly.
3. Remove the control valve body.
4. Remove the accumulator cover retaining bolts. 5. Remove the 1-2 accumulator cover assembly.
6. Disassemble the 1-2 accumulator.
6.1. Blow compressed air into the 1-2 accumulator cover, as shown, to remove the 1-2 accumulator
piston.
6.2. Remove the 1-2 accumulator inner and outer springs.
7. Inspect the 1-2 accumulator inner and outer springs for cracks.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5466
8. Remove the 1-2 accumulator piston seal (1) from the 1-2 accumulator piston. 9. Inspect the 1-2
accumulator piston for the following defects:
^ Porosity
^ Cracks
^ Scoring
^ Nicks and scratches
10. Inspect the 1-2 accumulator cover for the following defects:
^ Porosity
^ Cracks
^ Scoring
^ Nicks and scratches
11. Remove the spacer plate support retaining bolts.
Important: Use care not to drop the following items that will be removed along with the spacer
plate: ^
The number 1 checkball
^ The 3-4 accumulator spring
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5467
^ The 3-4 accumulator pin
12. Remove the spacer plate support.
13. Remove the spacer plate to valve body gasket, the spacer plate and the spacer plate to
transmission case gasket.
14. Remove the 3-4 accumulator piston (2). 15. Inspect the 3-4 accumulator spring for cracks.
16. Remove the 3-4 accumulator piston seal (1) from the 3-4 accumulator piston. 17. Inspect the
3-4 accumulator piston for the following defects:
^ Porosity
^ Cracks
^ Scoring
^ Nicks and scratches
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5468
Installation Procedure
1. Install a new 3-4 accumulator piston seal (1) to the 3-4 accumulator piston.
2. Install the 3-4 accumulator pin (1) into the transmission case and retain the pin with J 36850.
3. Install the 3-4 accumulator piston (2) onto the pin (1) in the transmission case. Ensure that the
3-4 accumulator piston legs face away from the
transmission case.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5469
4. Install the J 25025-B (2, 3) to the transmission case. 5. Install the spacer plate to transmission
case gasket and the spacer plate to valve body gasket to the spacer plate; use J 36850 in order to
retain the
gaskets to the spacer plate. ^
The case gasket is identified by a C. Be sure to place the case gasket on the transmission case
side of the spacer plate.
^ The valve body gasket is identified by a V. Be sure to place the valve body gasket on the valve
body side of the spacer plate.
6. Ensure that the solenoid screens (1, 2) are in place on the spacer plate. 7. Place the checkball
(3) on the spacer plate in the location shown. 8. Place the 3-4 accumulator spring (4) on the spacer
plate. 9. Install the spacer plate and related components to the transmission.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
10. Install the spacer plate support and the spacer plate support retaining bolts.
Tighten the spacer plate support retaining bolts to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5470
11. After installing the spacer plate support (2), look through the hole in the spacer plate to ensure
that the checkball (1) has remained in the proper
location.
12. Install a new 1-2 accumulator piston seal (1) to the 1-2 accumulator piston.
13. Install the 1-2 accumulator inner and outer springs to the 1-2 accumulator cover. 14. Install the
1-2 accumulator piston onto the pin in the 1-2 accumulator cover. Ensure that the piston legs face
the accumulator cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5471
15. Install the 1-2 accumulator cover and the accumulator cover retaining bolts.
Tighten the accumulator cover retaining bolts to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
16. Remove the J 25025-B from the transmission case. 17. Install the control valve body. 18. Install
the transmission oil pan and filter. 19. Lower the vehicle. 20. Fill the transmission to the proper
level with DEXRON III transmission fluid.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Band Apply Servo, A/T
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Band Apply Servo: > 04-07-30-028A > Jan
> 06 > A/T - 4T65-E Fluid Leaks From Reverse Servo Cover
Band Apply Servo: Customer Interest A/T - 4T65-E Fluid Leaks From Reverse Servo Cover
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-028A
Date: January 12, 2006
TECHNICAL
Subject: 4T65-E Automatic Transmission Fluid Leak From Reverse Servo Cover (Replace Reverse
Servo Cover Seal)
Models: 2005 and Prior Cars and Light Duty Trucks
with Automatic Transmission 4T65-E (RPOs MN3, MN7, M15, M76)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to announce an improved reverse servo cover seal is available from
GMSPO and to advise technicians that it is no longer necessary to replace the reverse servo cover
when replacing the seal. The 2005 model year vehicles are also being added. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 04-07-30-028 (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a fluid leak under the vehicle. A transmission fluid leak may be
noted during the Pre-delivery Inspection (PDI).
Cause
A possible cause of a transmission fluid leak usually only during cold ambient temperatures below
-6.7°C (20°F) may be the reverse servo cover seal. The reverse servo cover seal may shrink in
cold ambient temperatures causing a transmission fluid leak.
Correction
Follow the diagnosis and repair procedure below to correct this condition.
1. Diagnose the source of the fluid leak.
2. If the source of the transmission fluid leak is the reverse servo cover, replace the reverse servo
cover seal with P/N 24235894. Refer to Reverse Servo Replacement in the appropriate Service
Manual.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Band Apply Servo, A/T
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Band Apply Servo: > 04-07-30-028A > Jan
> 06 > A/T - 4T65-E Fluid Leaks From Reverse Servo Cover > Page 5480
3. Clean the area around and below the cover.
4. Inspect the transmission fluid level. Refer to Transmission Fluid Checking Procedure in the
appropriate Service Manual.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Band Apply Servo, A/T
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Band Apply Servo: >
04-07-30-028A > Jan > 06 > A/T - 4T65-E Fluid Leaks From Reverse Servo Cover
Band Apply Servo: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 4T65-E Fluid Leaks From Reverse Servo
Cover
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-028A
Date: January 12, 2006
TECHNICAL
Subject: 4T65-E Automatic Transmission Fluid Leak From Reverse Servo Cover (Replace Reverse
Servo Cover Seal)
Models: 2005 and Prior Cars and Light Duty Trucks
with Automatic Transmission 4T65-E (RPOs MN3, MN7, M15, M76)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to announce an improved reverse servo cover seal is available from
GMSPO and to advise technicians that it is no longer necessary to replace the reverse servo cover
when replacing the seal. The 2005 model year vehicles are also being added. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 04-07-30-028 (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a fluid leak under the vehicle. A transmission fluid leak may be
noted during the Pre-delivery Inspection (PDI).
Cause
A possible cause of a transmission fluid leak usually only during cold ambient temperatures below
-6.7°C (20°F) may be the reverse servo cover seal. The reverse servo cover seal may shrink in
cold ambient temperatures causing a transmission fluid leak.
Correction
Follow the diagnosis and repair procedure below to correct this condition.
1. Diagnose the source of the fluid leak.
2. If the source of the transmission fluid leak is the reverse servo cover, replace the reverse servo
cover seal with P/N 24235894. Refer to Reverse Servo Replacement in the appropriate Service
Manual.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Band Apply Servo, A/T
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Band Apply Servo: >
04-07-30-028A > Jan > 06 > A/T - 4T65-E Fluid Leaks From Reverse Servo Cover > Page 5486
3. Clean the area around and below the cover.
4. Inspect the transmission fluid level. Refer to Transmission Fluid Checking Procedure in the
appropriate Service Manual.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Band Apply Servo, A/T
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5487
Band Apply Servo: Service and Repair
2-4 Servo
^ Tools Required J 29714-A Servo Cover Depressor
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the transmission heat shield. 3. Place a
drain pan under the vehicle. 4. Remove the oil pan bolt below and to the left of the 2-4 servo cover.
5. Install the J 29714-A to the oil pan rail. 6. Tighten the bolt on the J 29714-A in order to compress
the servo cover.
7. Remove the servo cover retaining ring. 8. Loosen the bolt on the J 29714-A to release tension
on the servo cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Band Apply Servo, A/T
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5488
9. Remove the servo cover and O-ring seal. If the cover is hung up on the seal, use a pick (2) to
pull and stretch the seal (1) out of the groove. Cut
and remove the O-ring seal before removing the cover.
10. Remove the 2-4 servo assembly from the transmission. 11. Inspect the 4th apply piston, the 2-4
servo converter, 2nd apply piston, and the piston inner housing for the following defects:
^ Cracks
^ Scoring
^ Burrs and nicks
Installation Procedure
1. Install the new seals on the pistons and the servo cover. 2. Lubricate the seals with clean
transmission fluid.
3. Install the 2-4 servo assembly into the 2-4 servo bore. 4. Install the servo cover and O-ring seal.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Band Apply Servo, A/T
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5489
5. Install the J 29714-A.
6. Tighten the bolt on the J 29714-A in order to compress the servo cover. 7. Install the servo cover
retaining ring. 8. Remove the J 29714-A from the oil pan flange.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
9. Install the oil pan bolt.
Tighten the oil pan bolt to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
10. Install the transmission heat shield. 11. Remove the drain pan. 12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Fill
the transmission to the proper level with DEXRON III transmission fluid.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Case, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Cracked Case Diagnosis
Case: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Cracked Case Diagnosis
Bulletin No.: 02-07-30-024B
Date: August 18, 2005
INFORMATION
Subject: Diagnosis of Cracked or Broken Transmission Case
Models: 2006 and Prior Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2006 and Prior HUMMER H2 2006 HUMMER
H3 2005-2006 Saab 9-7X
with 4L60/4L60-E/4L65-E or 4L80-E/4L85-E or Allison(R) Series 1000 Automatic Transmission
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 02-07-30-024A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Diagnosing the cause of a cracked or broken transmission case requires additional diagnosis and
repair or a repeat failure will occur.
A cracked or broken transmission case is most often the result of abnormal external torsional
forces acting on the transmission case. If none of the conditions listed below are apparent, an
internal transmission component inspection may be required. Repairs of this type may be the result
of external damage or abuse for which General Motors is not responsible. They are not the result of
defects in materials or workmanship. If in doubt, contact your General Motors Service
Representative.
The following items should be considered:
^ It is important to inspect the vehicle for signs of an out of line condition, impact damage or foreign
material to the following components:
- The transmission
- The engine mounts
- The transmission rear mount and crossmember
- Vehicle frame damage that alters the front to rear alignment of the driveshaft
- The driveshafts (both front and rear)
- The wheels (caked with mud, concrete, etc.)
- The tires (roundness, lack of cupping, excessive balance weights)
- The transfer case (if the vehicle is 4WD)
^ A worn or damaged driveshaft U-Joint has shown to be a frequent cause of transmission case
cracking, especially on vehicles that see extended periods of highway driving. Always inspect the
U-joint condition when diagnosing this condition.
^ For driveshaft damage or imbalance, Inspect the driveshafts (both front and rear) for dents,
straightness/runout or signs of missing balance weights. Also, inspect for foreign material such as
undercoat sprayed on the driveshaft.
^ The driveshaft working angles may be excessive or non-canceling, especially if the vehicle
carrying height has been altered (lifted or lowered) or if the frame has been extended or modified.
^ Damaged or worn upper or lower rear control arms or bushings.
^ A rear axle that is not seated in the rear spring properly (leaf spring vehicles).
^ Broken rear springs and or worn leaf spring bushings.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Case, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Cracked Case Diagnosis > Page 5494
In some cases, the customer may not comment about a vibration but it is important to test drive the
vehicle while using the electronic vibration analysis tool in an attempt to locate the cause of the
torsional vibration. Refer to the Vibration Diagnosis and Correction sub-section of the appropriate
Service Manual for more details on diagnosing and correcting vibrations.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Case, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Cracked Case Diagnosis > Page 5495
Case: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E New Pump/Seal/Case/Service
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-023
Date: May 12, 2004
INFORMATION
Subject: Oil Pump Assembly Seal and Transmission Case Change
Models: 2002-2004 Cars and Light Duty Trucks with 4L60-E or 4L65-E Automatic Transmissions
(RPOs M30, M32 or M33)
An improved oil pump to case seal design has been made to the 4L60-E/4L65-E transmission. The
new design affects the oil pump, the oil pump seal, the transmission pan bolts and the transmission
case. The complete design was implemented in three phases.
The first phase, beginning in September 2002, relocated the machining of the oil pump 0-ring seal
groove in the pump body. The 0-ring seal groove moved 1.6 mm (0.62 in) inward on the pump body
in order to place the sealing surface deeper into the case bore. The relocated pump body groove
can be identified by measuring the groove location. Pump bodies that measure 2.3 mm (0.09 in)
from the machined surface to the groove opening have the relocated 0-ring seal groove. Pump
bodies that measure 3.9 mm (0.15 in) are prior to September 2002 design.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Case, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Cracked Case Diagnosis > Page 5496
The first phase also machined a case chamfer leading into the pump bore (2). The chamfer is
designed to help eliminate possible 0-ring seal damage during pump installation.
Phase two modified the case casting and the chamfer into the pump bore. The casting change left
additional material in the surrounding pump bore to allow deeper bore machining in order to create
the necessary sealing surface for a new pump seal design. The leading surface into the pump bore
was also machined with a modified chamfer (1).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Case, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Cracked Case Diagnosis > Page 5497
Phase three will eliminate the oil pump body 0-ring seal groove and the 0-ring seal. Beginning
March 2004, a new stamped carrier molded rubber seal (2) will be used to seal the pump assembly
to the transmission case.
The pump sealing surface is now the outer diameter of the pump and the inner diameter (1) of the
transmission case bore. Unlike the current 0-ring seal, which is installed on the oil pump body, the
new seal is installed after the pump assembly is properly positioned and torqued in place. Seating
the seal is accomplished when the torque converter housing is installed, which presses the seal (3)
into position between the pump and the case bore (1).
As a result of the modified casting and the deeper pump bore machining, the area between the oil
pan mounting surface and the pump bore has decreased. Because of the reduced material in this
area (1) it is necessary to use the shorter oil pan attaching bolts (2). Early pan bolts (3), before
November 2002, should not be used with the modified case design, since they are 1.0 mm (0.39 in)
longer and could deform the chamfer surface (4).
Service Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Case, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Cracked Case Diagnosis > Page 5498
When Servicing transmissions with the new seal design, use the following precautions:
^ The outer diameter of the pump assembly and case bore must be clean and free of burrs or
raised surfaces. Be aware of sharp edges that could damage the seal during installation.
^ The seal should be clean and dry before installation. It does not require lubrication for installation.
^ The seal should be inspected prior to installation for obvious damage.
^ It is preferable to hand-start the seal positioning the seal evenly around the case bore before
installing the torque converter housing.
^ The seal can be easily removed by prying it out, typical of a pressed-on seal.
^ The seal may be reused, however a thorough inspection must be performed. Inspect the seal for
the following conditions:
^ Distortion of the metal carrier or separation from the rubber seal.
^ A cut, deformed, or damaged seal.
^ Refer to the appropriate unit repair information in SI for seal removal and installation procedures.
Parts Interchangeability Information
In order to properly service the different designs, it is necessary to correctly identify and select
corresponding parts for each level. This table provides a summary of the part usage for the
different design levels.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Case, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Cracked Case Diagnosis > Page 5499
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Case, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5500
Case: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Accumulator Cover to Case Bolt
........................................................................................................................................ 8.0 - 14.0
Nm (6 - 10 ft. lbs.) Case Extension to Case Bolt
........................................................................................................................................... 42.0 - 48.0
Nm (31 - 35 ft. lbs.) Case Extension to Case Bolt (4WD Shipping)
............................................................................................................ 11.2 - 22.6 Nm (8.3 - 16.7 ft.
lbs.) Converter Housing to Case Screw
.................................................................................................................................... 65.0 - 75.0 Nm
(48 - 55 ft. lbs.) Oil Passage Cover to Case Bolt
............................................................................................................................................. 8 - 14.0
Nm (6 - 10 ft. lbs.) Park Brake Bracket to Case Bolt
..................................................................................................................................... 27.0 - 34.0 Nm
(20 - 25 ft. lbs.) Plate to Case Bolt (Shipping)
.......................................................................................................................................... 27.0 - 34.0
Nm (20 - 25 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Case, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5501
Case: Service and Repair
Heat Shield Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting.
2. Remove the two bolts securing the transmission heat shield to the transmission. 3. Remove the
transmission heat shield from the transmission.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the transmission heat shield to the transmission.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the two bolts securing the transmission heat shield to the transmission.
Tighten the bolts to 17 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
3. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Channel Plate, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 01-07-30-032E > Sep > 08 > A/T - 4T65E Fluid
Leaking From A/T Vent
Channel Plate: Customer Interest A/T - 4T65E Fluid Leaking From A/T Vent
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 01-07-30-032E
Date: September 29, 2008
Subject: Transmission Oil Leaking From Transmission Vent (Replace Transmission Case Cover
(Channel Plate) Gasket)
Models: 1997-2009 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn)
with Hydra-Matic 4T65-E Automatic Transmission (RPOs MN3, MN7, M15, M76)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2008 and 2009 model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 01-07-30-032D (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a transmission oil leak.
Cause
This condition may be caused by an improperly torqued channel plate gasket.
Correction
To correct this condition, replace the case cover (channel plate) gaskets (429 and 430). Refer to
Unit Repair publication in SI of the appropriate vehicle being serviced.
Visual inspection of the upper gasket (1) will reveal damage at the referenced area.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Channel Plate, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 01-07-30-032E > Sep > 08 > A/T - 4T65E Fluid
Leaking From A/T Vent > Page 5510
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Channel Plate, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Channel Plate: > 01-07-30-036H
> Jan > 09 > A/T Control - DTC P0756 Diagnostic Tips
Channel Plate: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T Control - DTC P0756 Diagnostic Tips
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 01-07-30-036H
Date: January 29, 2009
Subject: Diagnostic Tips for Automatic Transmission DTC P0756, Second, Third, Fourth Gear Start
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
with 4L60-E, 4L65-E or 4L70E Automatic Transmission (RPOs M30, M32 or M70)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2009 model year and add details regarding spacer plates.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 01-07-30-036G (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Some dealership technicians may have difficulty diagnosing DTC P0756, 2-3 Shift Valve
Performance on 4L60-E, 4L65-E or 4L70E automatic transmissions. As detailed in the Service
Manual, when the PCM detects a 4-3-3-4 shift pattern, DTC P0756 will set. Some customers may
also describe a condition of a second, third or fourth gear start that may have the same causes but
has not set this DTC yet. Below are some tips when diagnosing this DTC:
^ This is a performance code. This means that a mechanical malfunction exists.
^ This code is not set by electrical issues such as a damaged wiring harness or poor electrical
connections. Electrical problems would cause a DTC P0758, P0787 or P0788 to set.
^ The most likely cause is chips/debris plugging the filtered AFL oil at orifice # 29 on the top of the
spacer plate (48). This is a very small hole and is easily plugged by a small amount of debris. It is
important to remove the spacer plate and inspect orifice # 29 and the immediate area for the
presence of chips/debris. Also, the transmission case passage directly above this orifice and the
valve body passage directly below should be inspected and cleaned of any chips/debris. For 2003
and newer vehicles the spacer plate should be replaced. The service replacement spacer plate is a
bonded style with gaskets and solenoid filter screens bonded to the spacer plate. These screens
can help to prevent plugging of orifice # 29 caused by small debris or chips.
^ This code could be set if the 2-3 shift valve (368) were stuck or hung-up in its bore. Inspect the
2-3 shift valve (368) and the 2-3 shuttle valve (369) for free movement or damage and clean the
valves, the bore and the valve body passages.
^ This code could be set by a 2-3 shift solenoid (367b) if it were cracked, broken or leaking. Refer
to Shift Solenoid Leak Test in the appropriate Service Manual for the leak test procedure. Based on
parts return findings, a damaged or leaking shift solenoid is the least likely cause of this condition.
Simply replacing a shift solenoid will not correct this condition unless the solenoid has been found
to be cracked, broken or leaking.
It is important to also refer to the appropriate Service Manual or Service Information (SI) for further
possible causes of this condition.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Channel Plate, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Channel Plate: > 01-07-30-032E
> Sep > 08 > A/T - 4T65E Fluid Leaking From A/T Vent
Channel Plate: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 4T65E Fluid Leaking From A/T Vent
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 01-07-30-032E
Date: September 29, 2008
Subject: Transmission Oil Leaking From Transmission Vent (Replace Transmission Case Cover
(Channel Plate) Gasket)
Models: 1997-2009 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn)
with Hydra-Matic 4T65-E Automatic Transmission (RPOs MN3, MN7, M15, M76)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2008 and 2009 model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 01-07-30-032D (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a transmission oil leak.
Cause
This condition may be caused by an improperly torqued channel plate gasket.
Correction
To correct this condition, replace the case cover (channel plate) gaskets (429 and 430). Refer to
Unit Repair publication in SI of the appropriate vehicle being serviced.
Visual inspection of the upper gasket (1) will reveal damage at the referenced area.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Channel Plate, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Channel Plate: > 01-07-30-032E
> Sep > 08 > A/T - 4T65E Fluid Leaking From A/T Vent > Page 5520
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Channel Plate, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Channel Plate: > 01-07-30-036H >
Jan > 09 > A/T Control - DTC P0756 Diagnostic Tips
Channel Plate: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T Control - DTC P0756 Diagnostic Tips
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 01-07-30-036H
Date: January 29, 2009
Subject: Diagnostic Tips for Automatic Transmission DTC P0756, Second, Third, Fourth Gear Start
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
with 4L60-E, 4L65-E or 4L70E Automatic Transmission (RPOs M30, M32 or M70)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2009 model year and add details regarding spacer plates.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 01-07-30-036G (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Some dealership technicians may have difficulty diagnosing DTC P0756, 2-3 Shift Valve
Performance on 4L60-E, 4L65-E or 4L70E automatic transmissions. As detailed in the Service
Manual, when the PCM detects a 4-3-3-4 shift pattern, DTC P0756 will set. Some customers may
also describe a condition of a second, third or fourth gear start that may have the same causes but
has not set this DTC yet. Below are some tips when diagnosing this DTC:
^ This is a performance code. This means that a mechanical malfunction exists.
^ This code is not set by electrical issues such as a damaged wiring harness or poor electrical
connections. Electrical problems would cause a DTC P0758, P0787 or P0788 to set.
^ The most likely cause is chips/debris plugging the filtered AFL oil at orifice # 29 on the top of the
spacer plate (48). This is a very small hole and is easily plugged by a small amount of debris. It is
important to remove the spacer plate and inspect orifice # 29 and the immediate area for the
presence of chips/debris. Also, the transmission case passage directly above this orifice and the
valve body passage directly below should be inspected and cleaned of any chips/debris. For 2003
and newer vehicles the spacer plate should be replaced. The service replacement spacer plate is a
bonded style with gaskets and solenoid filter screens bonded to the spacer plate. These screens
can help to prevent plugging of orifice # 29 caused by small debris or chips.
^ This code could be set if the 2-3 shift valve (368) were stuck or hung-up in its bore. Inspect the
2-3 shift valve (368) and the 2-3 shuttle valve (369) for free movement or damage and clean the
valves, the bore and the valve body passages.
^ This code could be set by a 2-3 shift solenoid (367b) if it were cracked, broken or leaking. Refer
to Shift Solenoid Leak Test in the appropriate Service Manual for the leak test procedure. Based on
parts return findings, a damaged or leaking shift solenoid is the least likely cause of this condition.
Simply replacing a shift solenoid will not correct this condition unless the solenoid has been found
to be cracked, broken or leaking.
It is important to also refer to the appropriate Service Manual or Service Information (SI) for further
possible causes of this condition.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Clutch: > 08-07-30-027 > Jun > 08 > A/T - No
Movement in Drive or 3rd Gear
Clutch: Customer Interest A/T - No Movement in Drive or 3rd Gear
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 08-07-30-027
Date: June 04, 2008
Subject: No Movement When Transmission is Shifted to Drive or Third - Normal Operation When
Shifted to Second, First or Reverse (Replace Forward Sprag Assembly)
Models: 1982 - 2005 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2006 - 2007 Buick Rainier 2006
Cadillac Escalade, Escalade ESV, Escalade EXT 2006 Chevrolet SSR 2006 - 2008 Chevrolet
Avalanche, Colorado, Express, Silverado Classic, Silverado, Suburban, Tahoe, TrailBlazer 2006
GMC Yukon Denali, Yukon Denali XL 2006 - 2008 GMC Canyon, Envoy, Savana, Sierra Classic,
Sierra, Yukon, Yukon XL 2006 Pontiac GTO 2006 - 2007 HUMMER H2 2006 - 2008 HUMMER H3
2006 - 2008 Saab 9-7X
with 4L60, 4L60E, 4L65E or 4L70E Automatic Transmission (RPOs MD8, M30, M32, M33 or M70)
Condition
Some customers may comment that the vehicle has no movement when the transmission is shifted
to DRIVE or THIRD position, but there is normal operation when it is shifted to SECOND, FIRST or
REVERSE position.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a damaged forward sprag assembly (642).
Correction
When inspecting the sprag, it is important to test the sprag for proper operation by holding the outer
race (644) with one hand while rotating the input sun gear (640) with the other hand. The sun gear
should rotate only in the counterclockwise direction with the input sun gear facing upward. If the
sprag rotates in both directions or will not rotate in either direction, the sprag elements should be
inspected by removing one of the sprag assembly retaining rings (643). Refer to SI Unit Repair
section for forward clutch sprag disassembly procedures.
If the sprag is found to be damaged, make repairs to the transmission as necessary. A new forward
roller clutch sprag assembly is now available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Clutch: > 08-07-30-027 > Jun > 08 > A/T - No
Movement in Drive or 3rd Gear > Page 5534
If clutch debris is found, it is also very important to inspect the Pressure Control (PC) solenoid
valve (377) fluid screens. Clean or replace the PC solenoid (377) as necessary. It is also important
to flush and flow check the transmission oil cooler using J45096. Refer to SI Automatic
Transmission Oil Cooler Flushing and Flow Test for the procedure.
The notches above each sprag must point up as shown when assembled into the outer race.
Bearing Assembly, Input Sun Gear
Snap Ring, Overrun Clutch Hub Retaining
Hub, Overrun Clutch
Wear Plate, Sprag Assembly
Retainer and Race Assembly, Sprag
Forward Sprag Assembly
Retainer Rings, Sprag Assembly
Outer Race, Forward Clutch
Washer, Thrust (Input Carrier to Race)
The following information applies when this sprag is used in 1982-86 transmissions.
The new design sprag can be used on models 1982 through 1986, by replacing the entire
assembly (637 - 644). Individual components are NOT
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Clutch: > 08-07-30-027 > Jun > 08 > A/T - No
Movement in Drive or 3rd Gear > Page 5535
interchangeable.
Important:
The wear plate (640) and input thrust washer (660) are not required with the new sprag. Use of the
thrust washer and wear plate with the new sprag assembly will cause a misbuild (correct end play
cannot be obtained).
Parts Information
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Clutch: > 08-07-30-009B > May > 08 > A/T 4T80E, Slips in Gear/L/H Axle Seal Leaks
Clutch: Customer Interest A/T - 4T80E, Slips in Gear/L/H Axle Seal Leaks
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 08-07-30-009B
Date: May 01, 2008
Subject: HYDRA-MATIC(R) Front Wheel Drive 4T80-E (MH1) Left Front Axle Seal Leak,
Transmission Slips in Gear (Replace Third Clutch Housing with Revised Service Part)
Models: 2001-2008 GM Passenger Cars
with HYDRA-MATIC(R) Front Wheel Drive 4T80-E Automatic Transmission (RPO - MH1)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being updated to revise the Warranty Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 08-07-30-009A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a transmission oil leak and/or that the transmission slips in
gear.
Cause
An oil leak may be caused by bushing wear in the third clutch housing, causing excessive fluid
build-up at axe sea.
Correction
Important:
DO NOT replace the transmission for above concerns.
Replace the third clutch housing with service P/N 8682114, which has revised bushing material to
extend life and reduce left front axle seal leaks. Refer to Automatic/Transaxle - 4T80-E
Transmission Off-Vehicle Repair Instructions for the replacement of the third clutch housing in SI.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Clutch: > 08-07-30-027 > Jun >
08 > A/T - No Movement in Drive or 3rd Gear
Clutch: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - No Movement in Drive or 3rd Gear
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 08-07-30-027
Date: June 04, 2008
Subject: No Movement When Transmission is Shifted to Drive or Third - Normal Operation When
Shifted to Second, First or Reverse (Replace Forward Sprag Assembly)
Models: 1982 - 2005 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2006 - 2007 Buick Rainier 2006
Cadillac Escalade, Escalade ESV, Escalade EXT 2006 Chevrolet SSR 2006 - 2008 Chevrolet
Avalanche, Colorado, Express, Silverado Classic, Silverado, Suburban, Tahoe, TrailBlazer 2006
GMC Yukon Denali, Yukon Denali XL 2006 - 2008 GMC Canyon, Envoy, Savana, Sierra Classic,
Sierra, Yukon, Yukon XL 2006 Pontiac GTO 2006 - 2007 HUMMER H2 2006 - 2008 HUMMER H3
2006 - 2008 Saab 9-7X
with 4L60, 4L60E, 4L65E or 4L70E Automatic Transmission (RPOs MD8, M30, M32, M33 or M70)
Condition
Some customers may comment that the vehicle has no movement when the transmission is shifted
to DRIVE or THIRD position, but there is normal operation when it is shifted to SECOND, FIRST or
REVERSE position.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a damaged forward sprag assembly (642).
Correction
When inspecting the sprag, it is important to test the sprag for proper operation by holding the outer
race (644) with one hand while rotating the input sun gear (640) with the other hand. The sun gear
should rotate only in the counterclockwise direction with the input sun gear facing upward. If the
sprag rotates in both directions or will not rotate in either direction, the sprag elements should be
inspected by removing one of the sprag assembly retaining rings (643). Refer to SI Unit Repair
section for forward clutch sprag disassembly procedures.
If the sprag is found to be damaged, make repairs to the transmission as necessary. A new forward
roller clutch sprag assembly is now available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Clutch: > 08-07-30-027 > Jun >
08 > A/T - No Movement in Drive or 3rd Gear > Page 5545
If clutch debris is found, it is also very important to inspect the Pressure Control (PC) solenoid
valve (377) fluid screens. Clean or replace the PC solenoid (377) as necessary. It is also important
to flush and flow check the transmission oil cooler using J45096. Refer to SI Automatic
Transmission Oil Cooler Flushing and Flow Test for the procedure.
The notches above each sprag must point up as shown when assembled into the outer race.
Bearing Assembly, Input Sun Gear
Snap Ring, Overrun Clutch Hub Retaining
Hub, Overrun Clutch
Wear Plate, Sprag Assembly
Retainer and Race Assembly, Sprag
Forward Sprag Assembly
Retainer Rings, Sprag Assembly
Outer Race, Forward Clutch
Washer, Thrust (Input Carrier to Race)
The following information applies when this sprag is used in 1982-86 transmissions.
The new design sprag can be used on models 1982 through 1986, by replacing the entire
assembly (637 - 644). Individual components are NOT
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Clutch: > 08-07-30-027 > Jun >
08 > A/T - No Movement in Drive or 3rd Gear > Page 5546
interchangeable.
Important:
The wear plate (640) and input thrust washer (660) are not required with the new sprag. Use of the
thrust washer and wear plate with the new sprag assembly will cause a misbuild (correct end play
cannot be obtained).
Parts Information
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Clutch: > 08-07-30-009B > May >
08 > A/T - 4T80E, Slips in Gear/L/H Axle Seal Leaks
Clutch: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 4T80E, Slips in Gear/L/H Axle Seal Leaks
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 08-07-30-009B
Date: May 01, 2008
Subject: HYDRA-MATIC(R) Front Wheel Drive 4T80-E (MH1) Left Front Axle Seal Leak,
Transmission Slips in Gear (Replace Third Clutch Housing with Revised Service Part)
Models: 2001-2008 GM Passenger Cars
with HYDRA-MATIC(R) Front Wheel Drive 4T80-E Automatic Transmission (RPO - MH1)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being updated to revise the Warranty Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 08-07-30-009A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a transmission oil leak and/or that the transmission slips in
gear.
Cause
An oil leak may be caused by bushing wear in the third clutch housing, causing excessive fluid
build-up at axe sea.
Correction
Important:
DO NOT replace the transmission for above concerns.
Replace the third clutch housing with service P/N 8682114, which has revised bushing material to
extend life and reduce left front axle seal leaks. Refer to Automatic/Transaxle - 4T80-E
Transmission Off-Vehicle Repair Instructions for the replacement of the third clutch housing in SI.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Automatic
Transmission Dipstick - Dipstick Tube > Component Information > Specifications
Automatic Transmission Dipstick - Dipstick Tube: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Oil Level Indicator Bolt .........................................................................................................................
.............................................. 47 Nm (35 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Automatic
Transmission Dipstick - Dipstick Tube > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5554
Automatic Transmission Dipstick - Dipstick Tube: Service and Repair
Filler Tube and Seal Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the transmission fluid level indicator from the fluid fill tube.
2. Remove the bolt securing the transmission fluid fill tube bracket to the engine. 3. Raise the
vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 4. Remove the bolt securing the transmission fluid fill tube bracket
to the transmission. 5. Place a drain pan under the vehicle. 6. Remove the transmission fluid fill
tube from the transmission. 7. Remove the transmission fill tube seal.
Installation Procedure
1. Install a new oil level indicator tube seal into the transmission case. 2. Install the oil level
indicator tube into the seal.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the bolt securing the oil level indicator tube bracket to the transmission.
Tighten the bolt to 47 Nm (53 inch lbs.).
4. Remove the drain pan from under the vehicle. 5. Lower the vehicle. 6. Install the bolt securing
the oil level indicator tube bracket to the engine.
Tighten the bolt to 6 Nm (53 inch lbs.).
7. Fill the transmission with DEXRON III transmission fluid.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Extension Housing, A/T
> Component Information > Service and Repair
Extension Housing: Service and Repair
Transmission Extension Housing Assembly Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Support the transmission with
a transmission jack. 3. Place a drain pan under the vehicle. 4. Remove the propeller shaft. 5.
Remove the transmission mount.
6. Remove the case extension bolts (1). 7. Remove the case extension (2). 8. Remove and discard
the case extension 0 ring seal (3).
Installation Procedure
1. Install a new case extension O ring seal (3). 2. Install the case extension (2).
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the case extension bolts (1).
Tighten the case extension bolts (1) to 45 Nm (33 ft. lbs.).
4. Install the transmission mount. 5. Install the propeller shaft. 6. Remove the drain pan and the
transmission jack. 7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Fill the transmission to the proper level with DEXRON III
transmission fluid.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-037E
Date: April 07, 2011
Subject: Release of DEXRON(R)-VI Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF)
Models:
2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2003-2008 HUMMER H2 2006-2008
HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saturn Relay 2005 and Prior Saturn L-Series 2005-2007 Saturn ION
2005-2008 Saturn VUE with 4T45-E 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X Except 2008 and Prior Chevrolet Aveo,
Equinox Except 2006 and Prior Chevrolet Epica Except 2007 and Prior Chevrolet Optra Except
2008 and Prior Pontiac Torrent, Vibe, Wave Except 2003-2005 Saturn ION with CVT or AF23 Only
Except 1991-2002 Saturn S-Series Except 2008 and Prior Saturn VUE with CVT, AF33 or 5AT
(MJ7/MJ8) Transmission Only Except 2008 Saturn Astra
Attention:
DEXRON(R)-VI Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF) is the only approved fluid for warranty repairs
for General Motors transmissions/transaxles requiring DEXRON(R)-III and/or prior DEXRON(R)
transmission fluids.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-037D (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
MANUAL TRANSMISSIONS / TRANSFER CASES and POWER STEERING
The content of this bulletin does not apply to manual transmissions or transfer cases. Any vehicle
that previously required DEXRON(R)-III for a manual transmission or transfer case should now use
P/N 88861800. This fluid is labeled Manual Transmission and Transfer Case Fluid. Some manual
transmissions and transfer cases require a different fluid. Appropriate references should be
checked when servicing any of these components.
Power Steering Systems should now use P/N 9985010 labeled Power Steering Fluid.
Consult the Parts Catalog, Owner's Manual, or Service Information (SI) for fluid recommendations.
Some of our customers and/or General Motors dealerships/Saturn Retailers may have some
concerns with DEXRON(R)-VI and DEXRON(R)-III Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF) and
transmission warranty claims. DEXRON(R)-VI is the only approved fluid for warranty repairs for
General Motors transmissions/transaxles requiring DEXRON(R)-III and/or prior DEXRON(R)
transmission fluids (except as noted above). Please remember that the clean oil reservoirs of the
J-45096 - Flushing and Flow Tester machine should be purged of DEXRON(R)-III and filled with
DEXRON(R)-VI for testing, flushing or filling General Motors transmissions/transaxles (except as
noted above).
DEXRON(R)-VI can be used in any proportion in past model vehicles equipped with an automatic
transmission/transaxle in place of DEXRON(R)-III (i.e. topping off the fluid in the event of a repair
or fluid change). DEXRON(R)-VI is also compatible with any former version of DEXRON(R) for use
in automatic transmissions/transaxles.
DEXRON(R)-VI ATF
General Motors Powertrain has upgraded to DEXRON(R)-VI ATF with the start of 2006 vehicle
production.
Current and prior automatic transmission models that had used DEXRON(R)-III must now only use
DEXRON(R)-VI.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information > Page 5562
All 2006 and future model transmissions that use DEXRON(R)-VI are to be serviced ONLY with
DEXRON(R)-VI fluid.
DEXRON(R)-VI is an improvement over DEXRON(R)-III in the following areas:
* These ATF change intervals remain the same as DEXRON(R)-III for the time being.
2006-2008 Transmission Fill and Cooler Flushing
Some new applications of the 6L80 six speed transmission will require the use of the J 45096 Flushing and Flow Tester to accomplish transmission fluid fill. The clean oil reservoir of the
machine should be purged of DEXRON(R)-III and filled with DEXRON(R)-VI.
Parts Information
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information > Page 5563
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Water Or Coolant Contamination Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-07-30-035B
Date: November 01, 2010
Subject: Information on Water or Ethylene Glycol in Transmission Fluid
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks with Automatic Transmission
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 08-07-30-035A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Water or ethylene glycol in automatic transmission fluid (ATF) is harmful to internal transmission
components and will have a negative effect on reliability and durability of these parts. Water or
ethylene glycol in ATF will also change the friction of the clutches, frequently resulting in shudder
during engagement or gear changes, especially during torque converter clutch engagement.
Indications of water in the ATF may include:
- ATF blowing out of the transmission vent tube.
- ATF may appear cloudy or, in cases of extreme contamination, have the appearance of a
strawberry milkshake.
- Visible water in the oil pan.
- A milky white substance inside the pan area.
- Spacer plate gaskets that appear to be glued to the valve body face or case.
- Spacer plate gaskets that appear to be swollen or wrinkled in areas where they are not
compressed.
- Rust on internal transmission iron/steel components.
If water in the ATF has been found and the source of the water entry has not been identified, or if a
leaking in-radiator transmission oil cooler is suspected (with no evidence of cross-contamination in
the coolant recovery reservoir), a simple and quick test kit is available that detects the presence of
ethylene glycol in ATF. The "Gly-Tek" test kit, available from the Nelco Company, should be
obtained and the ATF tested to make an accurate decision on the need for radiator replacement.
This can help to prevent customer comebacks if the in-radiator transmission oil cooler is leaking
and reduce repair expenses by avoiding radiator replacement if the cooler is not leaking. These
test kits can be obtained from:
Nelco Company
Test kits can be ordered by phone or through the website listed above. Orders are shipped
standard delivery time but can be shipped on a next day delivery basis for an extra charge. One
test kit will complete 10 individual fluid sample tests. For vehicles repaired under warranty, the cost
of the complete test kit plus shipping charges should be divided by 10 and submitted on the
warranty claim as a net item.
The transmission should be repaired or replaced based on the normal cost comparison procedure.
Important If water or coolant is found in the transmission, the following components MUST be
replaced.
- Replace all of the rubber-type seals.
- Replace all of the composition-faced clutch plates and/or bands.
- Replace all of the nylon parts.
- Replace the torque converter.
- Thoroughly clean and rebuild the transmission, using new gaskets and oil filter.
Important The following steps must be completed when repairing or replacing.
Flush and flow check the transmission oil cooler using J 45096. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
02-07-30-052F- Automatic Transmission Oil Cooler Flush and Flow Test Essential Tool J 45096
TransFlow.
- Thoroughly inspect the engine cooling system and hoses and clean/repair as necessary.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information > Page 5564
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information > Page 5565
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Oil Cooler Flushing/Flow Check Procedures
File In Section: 07 - Transmission/Transaxle
Bulletin No.: 99-07-30-017A
Date: February, 2003
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Oil Cooler Flushing and Flow Check Procedures
Models: 2003 and Prior GM Light Duty Trucks 2003 HUMMER H2 with Allison(R) Automatic
Transmission (RPO M74)
This bulletin revises bulletin 99-07-30-017 to reflect the release of the new Transflow(R) J 45096
Transmission Cooling System Service Tool. The Transflow(R) Transmission Cooling System
Service Tool is to be used for all vehicles. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 99-07-30-017
(Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle). Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 02-07-30-052.
Important:
If you were sent here by the instruction booklet for the J 45096 TransFlow(R) machine, note that
the table has been moved to Corporate Bulletin Number 02-07-30-052.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications
Transmission Fluid Pan Removal ........................................................................................................
............................................................................................. 4.7L (5.0 Qt) Overhaul ...........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... 10.6L (11.0 Qt)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 5568
Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Transmission Fluid Type
Type .....................................................................................................................................................
...................................... DEXRON III or Equivalent
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 5569
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair
Automatic Transmission Fluid/Filter Replacement
Removal Procedure
Caution: When the transmission is at operating temperatures, take necessary precautions when
removing the drain plug, to avoid being burned by draining fluid.
1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting.
2. Place a drain pan under the transmission oil pan. 3. Remove the oil pan drain plug, if equipped.
4. If necessary, remove the bolts and position aside the range selector cable bracket for clearance
while lowering the pan. It is not necessary to
remove the cable from the lever or bracket.
5. Remove the oil pan bolts from the front and sides of the pan only. 6. Loosen the rear oil pan
bolts approximately 4 turns. 7. Lightly tap the oil pan with a rubber mallet in order to loosen the pan
to allow the fluid to drain.
8. Remove the remaining oil pan bolts.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 5570
9. Remove the oil pan and the gasket.
10. Grasp firmly while pulling down with a twisting motion in order to remove the filter. 11. Remove
the filter seal. The filter seal may be stuck in the pump; if necessary, carefully use pliers or another
suitable tool to remove the seal. 12. Discard the seal. 13. Inspect the fluid color.
14. Inspect the filter. Pry the metal crimping away from the top of the filter and pull apart. The filter
may contain the following evidence for root cause
diagnosis: ^
Clutch material
^ Bronze slivers indicating bushing wear
^ Steel particles
15. Clean the transmission case and the oil pan gasket surfaces with solvent, and air dry. You must
remove all traces of the old gasket material.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 5571
1. Coat the new filter seal with automatic transmission fluid.
2. Install the new filter seal into the transmission case. Tap the seal into place using a suitable size
socket. 3. Install the new filter into the case.
4. Install the oil pan and a new gasket.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
5. Install the oil pan bolts.
Tighten the oil pan to transmission case bolts alternately and evenly to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
6. If previously removed, install the range selector cable bracket and bolts.
Tighten the bolts to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
7. Apply a small amount of sealant GM P/N 12346004 to the threads of the oil pan drain plug, if
equipped. 8. Install the oil pan drain plug, if equipped.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 5572
Tighten the oil pan drain plug to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
9. Lower the vehicle.
10. Fill the transmission to the proper level with DEXRON III transmission fluid. 11. Check the
COLD fluid level reading for initial fill only. 12. Inspect the oil pan gasket for leaks.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Fluid Filter - A/T: Service and Repair
Automatic Transmission Fluid/Filter Replacement
Removal Procedure
Caution: When the transmission is at operating temperatures, take necessary precautions when
removing the drain plug, to avoid being burned by draining fluid.
1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting.
2. Place a drain pan under the transmission oil pan. 3. Remove the oil pan drain plug, if equipped.
4. If necessary, remove the bolts and position aside the range selector cable bracket for clearance
while lowering the pan. It is not necessary to
remove the cable from the lever or bracket.
5. Remove the oil pan bolts from the front and sides of the pan only. 6. Loosen the rear oil pan
bolts approximately 4 turns. 7. Lightly tap the oil pan with a rubber mallet in order to loosen the pan
to allow the fluid to drain.
8. Remove the remaining oil pan bolts.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5576
9. Remove the oil pan and the gasket.
10. Grasp firmly while pulling down with a twisting motion in order to remove the filter. 11. Remove
the filter seal. The filter seal may be stuck in the pump; if necessary, carefully use pliers or another
suitable tool to remove the seal. 12. Discard the seal. 13. Inspect the fluid color.
14. Inspect the filter. Pry the metal crimping away from the top of the filter and pull apart. The filter
may contain the following evidence for root cause
diagnosis: ^
Clutch material
^ Bronze slivers indicating bushing wear
^ Steel particles
15. Clean the transmission case and the oil pan gasket surfaces with solvent, and air dry. You must
remove all traces of the old gasket material.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5577
1. Coat the new filter seal with automatic transmission fluid.
2. Install the new filter seal into the transmission case. Tap the seal into place using a suitable size
socket. 3. Install the new filter into the case.
4. Install the oil pan and a new gasket.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
5. Install the oil pan bolts.
Tighten the oil pan to transmission case bolts alternately and evenly to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
6. If previously removed, install the range selector cable bracket and bolts.
Tighten the bolts to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
7. Apply a small amount of sealant GM P/N 12346004 to the threads of the oil pan drain plug, if
equipped. 8. Install the oil pan drain plug, if equipped.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5578
Tighten the oil pan drain plug to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
9. Lower the vehicle.
10. Fill the transmission to the proper level with DEXRON III transmission fluid. 11. Check the
COLD fluid level reading for initial fill only. 12. Inspect the oil pan gasket for leaks.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Revised Converter Check Valve/Cooler Line Fitting
Fluid Line/Hose: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Revised Converter Check Valve/Cooler Line
Fitting
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-017B
Date: November 25, 2008
Subject: Information on 4T65-E MN7, M15, M76, MN3 Automatic Transmission Case, Cooler
Fitting and Torque Converter Drain Back Check Ball Change
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks
with one of the HYDRA-MATIC(R) Automatic Transmissions shown above.
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to update the Parts Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-017A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Effective with Julian date 4019 (January 19, 2004), the 4T65E transaxle cases and cooler fittings
have changed and are not interchangeable with past models. The technician may find that when
replacing the inlet or outlet transmission cooler lines, the new lines cannot be connected to the
transmission.
A change to the transmission cooler line fittings was implemented in production on February 1,
2004. The cooler line fittings were changed to a design with a longer lead in pilot (1). The cooler
line fittings with the longer lead in pilot will not fit on models built before February 1, 2004.
The longer lead in pilot fittings (1) (9/16-18 UNF) have replaced the shorter lead in pilot fittings (2)
(3/8-18 NPSF w/check ball & 1/4-18 NPSF).
If the transmission cooler lines will not connect, then replace them with the following cooler line
fittings as appropriate with the older, shorter lead in pilot design:
^ For vehicles built prior to February 1, 2004, use Transmission Fluid Cooler Inlet Hose, P/N
20793004.
^ For vehicles built after February 1, 2004, use Transmission Fluid Cooler Inlet Hose, second
design P/N 15264588.
^ For vehicles built prior to February 1, 2004, use Transmission Fluid Cooler Outlet Hose, P/N
20793005.
^ For vehicles built after February 1, 2004, use Transmission Fluid Cooler Outlet Hose, second
design P/N 15264589.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Revised Converter Check Valve/Cooler Line Fitting > Page
5583
The torque specification has changed for the fittings to case. The torque has changed from 38 Nm
(28 lb ft) to 32 Nm (23 lb ft).
Tighten
Tighten the new cooler fittings to 32 Nm (23 lb ft).
The converter drain back check ball (420C) has been removed from the cooler line fitting and is
now located in the channel plate.
If you get a concern of no movement in the morning or after sitting for several hours, the cooler
check ball should be inspected.
The best way to determine where the check ball is located is to look at the cooler line fittings. The
old fittings are different sizes (3/8-18 NPSF & 1/4-18 NPSF) and would contain the cooler check
ball. The new fittings are the same size as each other (9/16-18 UNF) and do not have a cooler
check ball.
Parts Information
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Revised Converter Check Valve/Cooler Line Fitting > Page
5584
Fluid Line/Hose: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Cooler Line Fitting Applications
Bulletin No.: 08-07-30-004
Date: January 31, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: 4L60-E, 4L65-E, 4L70-E HYDRA-MATIC(R) Automatic Transmission (RPOs M30, M70
M32, M33, MK2 MD6)
Oil Cooler Fitting Change
Models: 1997-2008 GM Light Duty Trucks (Including Saab)
with 4L60-E, 4L65-E, 4L70-E HYDRA-MATIC(R) Automatic Transmission (RPOs M30, M70, M3,
M33, MK2, MD6)
Aluminum cooler line fittings - These new fittings (2) cannot be used on earlier cases because the
threaded hole is not the same size. Old style fittings (1) will continue to be available through SPO
parts.
Service cases will be the new case and fittings. The old cases with the old thread design will not be
maintained for service. The connection on the hose side will accept both the short snout and the
newer longer snout cooler hose assemblies.
The fittings (1) have a new torque specification of 20 N.m (14 lb ft). They also have one inner and
one outer "0" ring that are not serviced separately.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Revised Converter Check Valve/Cooler Line Fitting > Page
5585
The new thread size 9/16-1a UNF-2A (1) was implemented on 11-29-07 or Julian date 333.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5586
Fluid Line/Hose: Service and Repair
Transmission Fluid Cooler Hose/Pipe Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting.
2. Remove the oil cooler lines from the radiator and transmission.
Important: Perform the following procedures when removing the retaining ring and cooler line from
the quick connect fitting on the radiator and transmission.
3. Pull the plastic cap back from the quick connect fitting and down along the cooler line about two
inches.
4. Using a bent-tip screwdriver, pull on one of the open ends of the retaining ring in order to rotate
the retaining ring around the quick connect fitting
until the retaining ring is out of position and can be completely removed.
5. Remove the retaining ring from the quick connect fitting. 6. Discard the retaining ring.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5587
7. Pull the cooler line straight out from the quick connect fitting. 8. Remove the retaining ring
(E-clips) securing the cooler line to the quick connect in order to remove the remaining cooler lines
from the remaining
quick connect fittings.
9. Remove the cooler lines from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the transmission oil cooler line to the vehicle.
Important: ^
Do not reuse any of the existing oil lines or oil line fittings if there is any excessive corrosion.
^ Do not reuse any of the existing retaining rings that were removed from the existing quick
connect fittings. All retaining rings being installed must be new.
^ Ensure the following procedures are performed when installing the new retaining rings onto the
fittings.
2. Install a new retaining ring (E-clip) into the quick connect fitting using the following procedure:
3. Hook one of the open ends of the retaining ring in one of the slots in the quick connect fitting.
4. Rotate the retaining ring around the fitting until the retaining ring is positioned with all three ears
through the three slots on the fitting.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5588
5. Do not install the new retaining ring onto the fitting by pushing the retaining ring.
6. Ensure that the three retaining ring ears are seen from inside the fitting and that the retaining
ring moves freely in the fitting slots. 7. Install the new retaining ring (E-clip) into the remaining quick
connect fittings.
Notice: Ensure that the cooler line being installed has a plastic cap on each end that connects to a
quick connect fitting. If no plastic cap exists, or the plastic cap is damaged, obtain a new plastic cap
and position on to the cooler line prior to the cooler line installation.
8. Install the cooler lines to the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5589
9. Install the cooler line into the quick connect fitting.
10. Insert the cooler line end into the quick connect fitting until a click is either heard or felt.
11. Do not use the plastic cap on the cooler line in order to install the cooler line into the fitting. 12.
Pull back sharply on the cooler line in order to ensure that the cooler line is fastened into the quick
connect fitting.
13. Position (snap) the plastic cap onto the fitting. Do not manually depress the retaining ring when
installing the plastic cap onto the quick connect
fitting.
14. Ensure that the plastic cap is fully seated against the fitting.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5590
15. Ensure that no gap is present between the cap and the fitting.
16. Ensure that the yellow identification band on the tube is hidden within the quick connect fitting.
17. A hidden yellow identification band indicates proper joint seating.
18. Install the remaining oil cooler line ends into the transmission and radiator.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Fluid Pan: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Oil Pan to Transmission Case Bolt
................................................................................................................................................... 11
Nm (97 inch lbs.) Transmission Oil Pan to Case Bolt
..................................................................................................................................... 9.5 - 13.8 Nm
(7 - 10 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E New Pump/Seal/Case/Service
Fluid Pump: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E New Pump/Seal/Case/Service
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-023
Date: May 12, 2004
INFORMATION
Subject: Oil Pump Assembly Seal and Transmission Case Change
Models: 2002-2004 Cars and Light Duty Trucks with 4L60-E or 4L65-E Automatic Transmissions
(RPOs M30, M32 or M33)
An improved oil pump to case seal design has been made to the 4L60-E/4L65-E transmission. The
new design affects the oil pump, the oil pump seal, the transmission pan bolts and the transmission
case. The complete design was implemented in three phases.
The first phase, beginning in September 2002, relocated the machining of the oil pump 0-ring seal
groove in the pump body. The 0-ring seal groove moved 1.6 mm (0.62 in) inward on the pump body
in order to place the sealing surface deeper into the case bore. The relocated pump body groove
can be identified by measuring the groove location. Pump bodies that measure 2.3 mm (0.09 in)
from the machined surface to the groove opening have the relocated 0-ring seal groove. Pump
bodies that measure 3.9 mm (0.15 in) are prior to September 2002 design.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E New Pump/Seal/Case/Service > Page 5598
The first phase also machined a case chamfer leading into the pump bore (2). The chamfer is
designed to help eliminate possible 0-ring seal damage during pump installation.
Phase two modified the case casting and the chamfer into the pump bore. The casting change left
additional material in the surrounding pump bore to allow deeper bore machining in order to create
the necessary sealing surface for a new pump seal design. The leading surface into the pump bore
was also machined with a modified chamfer (1).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E New Pump/Seal/Case/Service > Page 5599
Phase three will eliminate the oil pump body 0-ring seal groove and the 0-ring seal. Beginning
March 2004, a new stamped carrier molded rubber seal (2) will be used to seal the pump assembly
to the transmission case.
The pump sealing surface is now the outer diameter of the pump and the inner diameter (1) of the
transmission case bore. Unlike the current 0-ring seal, which is installed on the oil pump body, the
new seal is installed after the pump assembly is properly positioned and torqued in place. Seating
the seal is accomplished when the torque converter housing is installed, which presses the seal (3)
into position between the pump and the case bore (1).
As a result of the modified casting and the deeper pump bore machining, the area between the oil
pan mounting surface and the pump bore has decreased. Because of the reduced material in this
area (1) it is necessary to use the shorter oil pan attaching bolts (2). Early pan bolts (3), before
November 2002, should not be used with the modified case design, since they are 1.0 mm (0.39 in)
longer and could deform the chamfer surface (4).
Service Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E New Pump/Seal/Case/Service > Page 5600
When Servicing transmissions with the new seal design, use the following precautions:
^ The outer diameter of the pump assembly and case bore must be clean and free of burrs or
raised surfaces. Be aware of sharp edges that could damage the seal during installation.
^ The seal should be clean and dry before installation. It does not require lubrication for installation.
^ The seal should be inspected prior to installation for obvious damage.
^ It is preferable to hand-start the seal positioning the seal evenly around the case bore before
installing the torque converter housing.
^ The seal can be easily removed by prying it out, typical of a pressed-on seal.
^ The seal may be reused, however a thorough inspection must be performed. Inspect the seal for
the following conditions:
^ Distortion of the metal carrier or separation from the rubber seal.
^ A cut, deformed, or damaged seal.
^ Refer to the appropriate unit repair information in SI for seal removal and installation procedures.
Parts Interchangeability Information
In order to properly service the different designs, it is necessary to correctly identify and select
corresponding parts for each level. This table provides a summary of the part usage for the
different design levels.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E New Pump/Seal/Case/Service > Page 5601
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E New Pump/Seal/Case/Service > Page 5602
Fluid Pump: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 4L65E, 4L60E, 4L60, 200-4R Oil Pump Spring
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-006
Date: February 11, 2004
INFORMATION
Subject: 4L65-E, 4L60-E, 4L60 and 200-4R Automatic Transmission Oil Pump Spring First and
Second Design Identification
Models: 2004 and Prior Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2003-2004 HUMMER H2
with 4L65-E, 4L60-E, 4L60 or 200-4R Automatic Transmission
The purpose of this bulletin is to identify the oil pump spring usage for the two different pump
designs. Manufacturing of the first design oil pump springs ended December 15, 2003.
Manufacturing of the second design oil pump spring began December 16, 2003
The first design oil pump springs (206) and (207) DO NOT have any identification markings. The
first design springs (206) and (207) use an inner and outer spring, two springs.
The second design oil pump spring (245) is identified with tapered ends on the spring (245) as
shown above. The second design spring (245) is a single spring.
When servicing either (first design or second design) oil pump body, use the new single oil pump
spring (245) with tapered ends.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E New Pump/Seal/Case/Service > Page 5603
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E New Pump/Seal/Case/Service > Page 5604
Fluid Pump: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 4L60-E Oil Pump Identification
Bulletin No.: 03-07-30-056
Date: November 05, 2003
INFORMATION
Subject: 4L60-E Automatic Transmission Oil Pump First And Second Design Identification
Models: 1997-2002 Chevrolet Camaro 1997-2002 Pontiac Firebird 2002-2004 Cadillac Escalade,
Escalade EXT 1997-1999 Chevrolet C/K Full Size Pickup 1997-2004 Chevrolet Astro, Blazer,
Corvette, Express, S-10, Suburban 1999-2004 Chevrolet Silverado 2000-2004 Chevrolet Tahoe
2002-2004 Chevrolet Avalanche, TrailBlazer 2004 Chevrolet Colorado, SSR 1997-1999 GMC
Suburban 1997-2001 GMC Jimmy 1997-2004 GMC Envoy, Safari, Savana, Sierra, Sonoma
1999-2004 GMC Denali 2000-2004 GMC Yukon, Yukon XL 2004 GMC Canyon 1997-2004
Oldsmobile Bravada 2003-2004 HUMMER H2 with 4L60-E Automatic Transmission (RPOs M30,
M32, M33)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E New Pump/Seal/Case/Service > Page 5605
The purpose of this bulletin is to identify the correct oil pump rotor (212) and slide (203) usage for
the two different transmission oil pump designs.
Manufacturing of the first design oil pump rotor (212) and slide (203) ended November 30, 2000.
Manufacturing of the second design oil pump rotor (212) and slide (203) began December 1, 2000.
Important:
It is critical that the first and second design oil pump rotors and slides do not become intermixed.
Do not use first design pump components with second design pump components. If the pump
components from either design are intermixed, pump efficiency will be affected resulting in less
than optimal pump performance.
The first design oil pump rotor (212) and slide (203) DO NOT have any identification markings.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E New Pump/Seal/Case/Service > Page 5606
The second design oil pump rotor (212) and slide (203) are identified with dimples (circular
depression) as shown above.
The rotor (212) has two dimples adjacent to the rotor drive tangs (1).
The slide (203) has one dimple located on the spring tab (2).
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5607
Fluid Pump: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Pump Assembly to Case Bolt
.......................................................................................................................................... 26.0 - 32.0
Nm (19 - 24 ft. lbs.) Pump Cover to Pump Body Bolt
..................................................................................................................................... 20.0 - 27.0 Nm
(15 - 20 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Output Shaft, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 2-3 Upshift or 3-2 Downshift Clunk Noise
Output Shaft: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 2-3 Upshift or 3-2 Downshift Clunk Noise
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 01-07-30-042F
Date: February 05, 2010
Subject: Information on 2-3 Upshift or 3-2 Downshift Clunk Noise
Models:
2010 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3
2005-2009 Saab 9-7X with 4L60-E, 4L65-E or 4L70-E Automatic Transmission (RPOs M30, M32,
M70)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2010 model year and 4L70E transmission.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 01-07-30-042E (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Important For 2005 model year fullsize utilities and pickups, refer to Corporate Bulletin
05-07-30-012.
Some vehicles may exhibit a clunk noise that can be heard on a 2-3 upshift or a 3-2 downshift.
During a 2-3 upshift, the 2-4 band is released and the 3-4 clutch is applied. The timing of this shift
can cause a momentary torque reversal of the output shaft that results in a clunk noise. This same
torque reversal can also occur on a 3-2 downshift when the 3-4 clutch is released and the 2-4 band
applied. This condition may be worse on a 4-wheel drive vehicle due to the additional tolerances in
the transfer case.
This is a normal condition. No repairs should be attempted.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair
Pressure Regulator Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the transmission oil pan and
filter.
3. Compress the reverse boost valve sleeve into the bore of the oil pump to release tension on the
reverse boost valve retaining ring. 4. Remove the reverse boost valve retaining ring, then slowly
release tension on the reverse boost valve sleeve.
5. Remove the reverse boost valve sleeve (5) and the reverse boost valve (4). 6. Remove the
pressure regulator isolator spring (3) and the pressure regulator valve spring (2). 7. Remove the
pressure regulator valve (1).
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5615
1. Install the pressure regulator valve (1). 2. Install the pressure regulator isolator spring (3) and the
pressure regulator valve spring (2). 3. Install the reverse boost valve (4) in the reverse boost valve
sleeve (5). 4. Install the reverse boost valve (4) and sleeve (5) in the oil pump cover.
5. Compress the reverse boost valve sleeve into the bore of the oil pump to expose the retaining
ring slot. 6. Install the reverse boost valve retaining ring, then slowly release tension on the reverse
boost valve sleeve. 7. Install the transmission oil filter and pan. 8. Lower the vehicle. 9. Fill the
transmission to the proper level with DEXRON III transmission fluid.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T
> System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 01-07-30-032E > Sep > 08 > A/T - 4T65E Fluid
Leaking From A/T Vent
Seals and Gaskets: Customer Interest A/T - 4T65E Fluid Leaking From A/T Vent
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 01-07-30-032E
Date: September 29, 2008
Subject: Transmission Oil Leaking From Transmission Vent (Replace Transmission Case Cover
(Channel Plate) Gasket)
Models: 1997-2009 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn)
with Hydra-Matic 4T65-E Automatic Transmission (RPOs MN3, MN7, M15, M76)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2008 and 2009 model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 01-07-30-032D (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a transmission oil leak.
Cause
This condition may be caused by an improperly torqued channel plate gasket.
Correction
To correct this condition, replace the case cover (channel plate) gaskets (429 and 430). Refer to
Unit Repair publication in SI of the appropriate vehicle being serviced.
Visual inspection of the upper gasket (1) will reveal damage at the referenced area.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T
> System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 01-07-30-032E > Sep > 08 > A/T - 4T65E Fluid
Leaking From A/T Vent > Page 5624
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T
> System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: >
01-07-30-032E > Sep > 08 > A/T - 4T65E Fluid Leaking From A/T Vent
Seals and Gaskets: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 4T65E Fluid Leaking From A/T Vent
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 01-07-30-032E
Date: September 29, 2008
Subject: Transmission Oil Leaking From Transmission Vent (Replace Transmission Case Cover
(Channel Plate) Gasket)
Models: 1997-2009 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn)
with Hydra-Matic 4T65-E Automatic Transmission (RPOs MN3, MN7, M15, M76)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2008 and 2009 model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 01-07-30-032D (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a transmission oil leak.
Cause
This condition may be caused by an improperly torqued channel plate gasket.
Correction
To correct this condition, replace the case cover (channel plate) gaskets (429 and 430). Refer to
Unit Repair publication in SI of the appropriate vehicle being serviced.
Visual inspection of the upper gasket (1) will reveal damage at the referenced area.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T
> System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: >
01-07-30-032E > Sep > 08 > A/T - 4T65E Fluid Leaking From A/T Vent > Page 5630
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T
> System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 04-07-30-023
> May > 04 > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E New Pump/Seal/Case/Service
Seals and Gaskets: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E New
Pump/Seal/Case/Service
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-023
Date: May 12, 2004
INFORMATION
Subject: Oil Pump Assembly Seal and Transmission Case Change
Models: 2002-2004 Cars and Light Duty Trucks with 4L60-E or 4L65-E Automatic Transmissions
(RPOs M30, M32 or M33)
An improved oil pump to case seal design has been made to the 4L60-E/4L65-E transmission. The
new design affects the oil pump, the oil pump seal, the transmission pan bolts and the transmission
case. The complete design was implemented in three phases.
The first phase, beginning in September 2002, relocated the machining of the oil pump 0-ring seal
groove in the pump body. The 0-ring seal groove moved 1.6 mm (0.62 in) inward on the pump body
in order to place the sealing surface deeper into the case bore. The relocated pump body groove
can be identified by measuring the groove location. Pump bodies that measure 2.3 mm (0.09 in)
from the machined surface to the groove opening have the relocated 0-ring seal groove. Pump
bodies that measure 3.9 mm (0.15 in) are prior to September 2002 design.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T
> System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 04-07-30-023
> May > 04 > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E New Pump/Seal/Case/Service > Page 5635
The first phase also machined a case chamfer leading into the pump bore (2). The chamfer is
designed to help eliminate possible 0-ring seal damage during pump installation.
Phase two modified the case casting and the chamfer into the pump bore. The casting change left
additional material in the surrounding pump bore to allow deeper bore machining in order to create
the necessary sealing surface for a new pump seal design. The leading surface into the pump bore
was also machined with a modified chamfer (1).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T
> System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 04-07-30-023
> May > 04 > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E New Pump/Seal/Case/Service > Page 5636
Phase three will eliminate the oil pump body 0-ring seal groove and the 0-ring seal. Beginning
March 2004, a new stamped carrier molded rubber seal (2) will be used to seal the pump assembly
to the transmission case.
The pump sealing surface is now the outer diameter of the pump and the inner diameter (1) of the
transmission case bore. Unlike the current 0-ring seal, which is installed on the oil pump body, the
new seal is installed after the pump assembly is properly positioned and torqued in place. Seating
the seal is accomplished when the torque converter housing is installed, which presses the seal (3)
into position between the pump and the case bore (1).
As a result of the modified casting and the deeper pump bore machining, the area between the oil
pan mounting surface and the pump bore has decreased. Because of the reduced material in this
area (1) it is necessary to use the shorter oil pan attaching bolts (2). Early pan bolts (3), before
November 2002, should not be used with the modified case design, since they are 1.0 mm (0.39 in)
longer and could deform the chamfer surface (4).
Service Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T
> System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 04-07-30-023
> May > 04 > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E New Pump/Seal/Case/Service > Page 5637
When Servicing transmissions with the new seal design, use the following precautions:
^ The outer diameter of the pump assembly and case bore must be clean and free of burrs or
raised surfaces. Be aware of sharp edges that could damage the seal during installation.
^ The seal should be clean and dry before installation. It does not require lubrication for installation.
^ The seal should be inspected prior to installation for obvious damage.
^ It is preferable to hand-start the seal positioning the seal evenly around the case bore before
installing the torque converter housing.
^ The seal can be easily removed by prying it out, typical of a pressed-on seal.
^ The seal may be reused, however a thorough inspection must be performed. Inspect the seal for
the following conditions:
^ Distortion of the metal carrier or separation from the rubber seal.
^ A cut, deformed, or damaged seal.
^ Refer to the appropriate unit repair information in SI for seal removal and installation procedures.
Parts Interchangeability Information
In order to properly service the different designs, it is necessary to correctly identify and select
corresponding parts for each level. This table provides a summary of the part usage for the
different design levels.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T
> System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 04-07-30-023
> May > 04 > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E New Pump/Seal/Case/Service > Page 5638
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T
> System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 04-07-30-023 >
May > 04 > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E New Pump/Seal/Case/Service
Seals and Gaskets: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E New
Pump/Seal/Case/Service
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-023
Date: May 12, 2004
INFORMATION
Subject: Oil Pump Assembly Seal and Transmission Case Change
Models: 2002-2004 Cars and Light Duty Trucks with 4L60-E or 4L65-E Automatic Transmissions
(RPOs M30, M32 or M33)
An improved oil pump to case seal design has been made to the 4L60-E/4L65-E transmission. The
new design affects the oil pump, the oil pump seal, the transmission pan bolts and the transmission
case. The complete design was implemented in three phases.
The first phase, beginning in September 2002, relocated the machining of the oil pump 0-ring seal
groove in the pump body. The 0-ring seal groove moved 1.6 mm (0.62 in) inward on the pump body
in order to place the sealing surface deeper into the case bore. The relocated pump body groove
can be identified by measuring the groove location. Pump bodies that measure 2.3 mm (0.09 in)
from the machined surface to the groove opening have the relocated 0-ring seal groove. Pump
bodies that measure 3.9 mm (0.15 in) are prior to September 2002 design.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T
> System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 04-07-30-023 >
May > 04 > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E New Pump/Seal/Case/Service > Page 5644
The first phase also machined a case chamfer leading into the pump bore (2). The chamfer is
designed to help eliminate possible 0-ring seal damage during pump installation.
Phase two modified the case casting and the chamfer into the pump bore. The casting change left
additional material in the surrounding pump bore to allow deeper bore machining in order to create
the necessary sealing surface for a new pump seal design. The leading surface into the pump bore
was also machined with a modified chamfer (1).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T
> System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 04-07-30-023 >
May > 04 > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E New Pump/Seal/Case/Service > Page 5645
Phase three will eliminate the oil pump body 0-ring seal groove and the 0-ring seal. Beginning
March 2004, a new stamped carrier molded rubber seal (2) will be used to seal the pump assembly
to the transmission case.
The pump sealing surface is now the outer diameter of the pump and the inner diameter (1) of the
transmission case bore. Unlike the current 0-ring seal, which is installed on the oil pump body, the
new seal is installed after the pump assembly is properly positioned and torqued in place. Seating
the seal is accomplished when the torque converter housing is installed, which presses the seal (3)
into position between the pump and the case bore (1).
As a result of the modified casting and the deeper pump bore machining, the area between the oil
pan mounting surface and the pump bore has decreased. Because of the reduced material in this
area (1) it is necessary to use the shorter oil pan attaching bolts (2). Early pan bolts (3), before
November 2002, should not be used with the modified case design, since they are 1.0 mm (0.39 in)
longer and could deform the chamfer surface (4).
Service Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T
> System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 04-07-30-023 >
May > 04 > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E New Pump/Seal/Case/Service > Page 5646
When Servicing transmissions with the new seal design, use the following precautions:
^ The outer diameter of the pump assembly and case bore must be clean and free of burrs or
raised surfaces. Be aware of sharp edges that could damage the seal during installation.
^ The seal should be clean and dry before installation. It does not require lubrication for installation.
^ The seal should be inspected prior to installation for obvious damage.
^ It is preferable to hand-start the seal positioning the seal evenly around the case bore before
installing the torque converter housing.
^ The seal can be easily removed by prying it out, typical of a pressed-on seal.
^ The seal may be reused, however a thorough inspection must be performed. Inspect the seal for
the following conditions:
^ Distortion of the metal carrier or separation from the rubber seal.
^ A cut, deformed, or damaged seal.
^ Refer to the appropriate unit repair information in SI for seal removal and installation procedures.
Parts Interchangeability Information
In order to properly service the different designs, it is necessary to correctly identify and select
corresponding parts for each level. This table provides a summary of the part usage for the
different design levels.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T
> System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 04-07-30-023 >
May > 04 > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E New Pump/Seal/Case/Service > Page 5647
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T
> System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page 5648
Seals and Gaskets: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 01-07-30-032E Date: 080929
A/T - 4T65E Fluid Leaking From A/T Vent
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 01-07-30-032E
Date: September 29, 2008
Subject: Transmission Oil Leaking From Transmission Vent (Replace Transmission Case Cover
(Channel Plate) Gasket)
Models: 1997-2009 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn)
with Hydra-Matic 4T65-E Automatic Transmission (RPOs MN3, MN7, M15, M76)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2008 and 2009 model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 01-07-30-032D (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a transmission oil leak.
Cause
This condition may be caused by an improperly torqued channel plate gasket.
Correction
To correct this condition, replace the case cover (channel plate) gaskets (429 and 430). Refer to
Unit Repair publication in SI of the appropriate vehicle being serviced.
Visual inspection of the upper gasket (1) will reveal damage at the referenced area.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T
> System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page 5649
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Technical Service Bulletin # 01-07-30-032E Date: 080929
A/T - 4T65E Fluid Leaking From A/T Vent
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 01-07-30-032E
Date: September 29, 2008
Subject: Transmission Oil Leaking From Transmission Vent (Replace Transmission Case Cover
(Channel Plate) Gasket)
Models: 1997-2009 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn)
with Hydra-Matic 4T65-E Automatic Transmission (RPOs MN3, MN7, M15, M76)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2008 and 2009 model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 01-07-30-032D (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a transmission oil leak.
Cause
This condition may be caused by an improperly torqued channel plate gasket.
Correction
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T
> System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page 5650
To correct this condition, replace the case cover (channel plate) gaskets (429 and 430). Refer to
Unit Repair publication in SI of the appropriate vehicle being serviced.
Visual inspection of the upper gasket (1) will reveal damage at the referenced area.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T
> System Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Extension Housing Rear Oil Seal Replacement
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Transmission Extension Housing Rear Oil Seal
Replacement
Transmission Extension Housing Rear Oil Seal Replacement
^ Tools Required J 21426 Extension Housing Seal Installer
- J 36850 Transmission Assembly Lubricant
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Place a drain pan under the vehicle. 3. Remove the
propeller shaft.
4. Remove the case extension housing rear oil seal. Use a flat bladed tool and carefully pry the
seal from the housing. 5. Inspect the case extension housing for damage. Replace the extension
housing if necessary.
Installation Procedure
1. Lubricate the inside diameter of the new seal with J 36850.
2. Use the J 21426 with a soft faced mallet to install the seal. 3. Install the seal to the extension
housing. 4. Install the propeller shaft. 5. Remove the drain pan and lower the vehicle. 6. Fill the
transmission to the proper level with DEXRON III transmission fluid.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T
> System Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Extension Housing Rear Oil Seal Replacement > Page 5653
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Manual Shift Shaft Seal Replacement
Manual Shift Shaft Seal Replacement
^ Tools Required J 43911 Selector Shaft Seal Remover
- J 43909 Selector Shaft Seal Installer
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the Park/Neutral Position (PNP) Switch.
3. Be sure that the jackscrew for J 43911 is backed off and will not interfere with installation of the
removal tool. Slide the seal remover tool over the
selector shaft (2) with the threaded end of the tool towards the seal.
4. Rotate the removal tool so that the threads on the end of the tool engage the steel shell (1) of
the seal. Use a wrench to be sure that the removal tool
is firmly attached to the seal shell.
5. Rotate the jackscrew in the clockwise direction to remove the seal from the bore. Discard the
seal that was removed.
Installation Procedure
1. Carefully slide a new selector shaft seal (1) over the selector shaft (2) with the wide face of the
steel case facing outward. Position the seal so that
it is starting to enter the seal bore.
2. Obtain J 43909 and remove the inner sleeve so that the tool will slide over the selector shaft. 3.
Slide the J 43909 into position so that the end of the tool contacts the seal being installed. Use a
mallet to strike the J 43909 and drive the new seal
into the seal bore until it is seated at the bottom of the bore.
4. Install the PNP Switch. 5. Lower the vehicle. 6. Fill the transmission to the proper level with
DEXRON III transmission fluid.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Transmission Mode Switch: Testing and Inspection
Tow/Haul Switch/Indicator Always On or Inoperative
Circuit Description
Tow/haul mode enables the operator to achieve enhanced shift performance when towing or
hauling a load. When tow/haul mode is selected, the tow/haul switch input signal to the Body
Control Module (BCM) is momentarily toggled to zero volts. This signals the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) to extend the length of time between upshifts and increase transmission line
pressure. Cycling the tow/haul switch again disables tow/haul mode and returns the transmission to
a normal shift pattern.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 5658
Test Description
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. This step tests for a faulty
tow/haul switch. 3. This step tests for voltage input from the BCM to the tow/haul switch.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Park/Neutral Position Switch Screw
................................................................................................................................................... 3 Nm
(27 inch lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5662
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams
Automatic Transmission Related Connector End Views
Transmission Range Switch Connector, Wiring Harness Side
Tow/Haul Switch Connector, Column Wiring Harness Side
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5663
Park/Neutral Position Switch (C1)
Park/Neutral Position Switch (C2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5664
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Adjustments
Park/Neutral Position Switch Adjustment
Important: ^
The following procedure is for vehicles that have not had the switch removed or replaced. If the
switch has been removed or replaced, refer to Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement for the
proper adjustment procedure.
^ Apply the parking brake.
^ The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) positions only.
^ Check the switch for proper operation. If adjustment is required, proceed as follows:
1. Place the transmission range selector in the N (Neutral) position. 2. With an assistant in the
drivers seat, raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 3. Loosen the park/neutral position switch
mounting bolts. 4. With the vehicle in the N (Neutral) position, rotate the switch while the assistant
attempts to start the engine. 5. Following a successful start, turn the engine off.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
6. Tighten the bolts securing the switch to the transmission.
Tighten the bolts to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Check the switch for proper operation. The engine must start in the P
(Park) or N (Neutral) positions only. 9. Replace the park/neutral position switch if proper operation
can not be achieved.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5665
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement
^ Tools Required J 41364-A Neutral Position Adjustment Tool
Removal Procedure
1. Apply the parking brake. 2. Shift the transmission into neutral. 3. Raise the vehicle. Refer to
Vehicle Lifting.
4. Remove the nut securing the transmission control lever to the manual shaft. 5. Remove the
transmission control lever from the manual shaft. 6. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the
switch. 7. Remove the bolts securing the park/neutral position switch to the transmission. 8.
Remove the park/neutral position switch from the manual shaft. If the park/neutral position switch
did not slide off the manual shaft, file the outer
edge of the manual shaft in order to remove any burrs.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the switch to the transmission manual shaft by aligning the switch hub flats with the
manual shaft flats.
2. Slide the switch onto the transmission manual shaft until the switch mounting bracket contacts
the mounting bosses on the transmission.
Important: If a new switch is being installed, the switch will come with a positive assurance bracket.
The positive assurance bracket aligns the new switch in it proper position for installation and the
use of neutral position adjustment tool will not be necessary.
3. Install the switch to the transmission with two bolts finger tight.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5666
4. Position the tool J 41364-A onto the park/neutral position switch. Ensure that the two slots on the
switch where the manual shaft is inserted are
lined up with the lower two tabs on the tool.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
5. Rotate the tool until the upper locator pin on the tool is lined up with the slot on the top of the
switch.
Tighten the bolts securing the switch to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
6. Remove the J 41364-A from the switch. If installing a new switch, remove the positive assurance
bracket at this time. 7. Connect the electrical connectors to the switch.
8. Install the transmission control lever to the manual shaft with the nut.
Tighten the control lever nut to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
9. Lower the vehicle.
10. Check the switch for proper operation. The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral)
positions only. If proper operation of the switch can
not be obtained, replace the switch.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Speed Sensor: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Speed Sensor Retainer Bolt
............................................................................................................................................ 10.5 13.5 Nm (7.7 - 10 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5670
VSS Assembly Connector, Wiring Harness Side
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5671
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) Replacement
^ Tools Required J 38417 Speed Sensor Remover
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting.
2. Remove the harness connector. 3. Remove the bolt. 4. Place a drain pan under the vehicle. 5.
Remove the vehicle speed sensor using J 38417. 6. Remove the O-ring seal.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the new speed sensor and O-ring seal using J 38417 2. Coat the seal with a thin film of
transmission fluid.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the bolt.
Tighten the bolt to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
4. Install the harness connector. 5. Lower the vehicle. 6. Refill the fluid as required.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Specifications
Transmission Fluid Temperature (TFT) Sensor Specifications
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T >
Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Service and Repair
Automatic Transmission Shift Lock Actuator Replacement
Removal Procedure
Caution: Refer to SIR Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disable the SIR system. 2. Remove the lower steering column trim cover.
3. Disconnect the automatic transmission shift lock control actuator electrical connector. 4. Place
the shift lever clevis into the neutral position. 5. Use a small screwdriver to pry the automatic
transmission shift lock control actuator from the steering column jacket assembly. 6. Remove the
automatic transmission shift lock control actuator from the steering column.
Installation Procedure
1. Firmly install the automatic transmission shift lock control actuator onto the steering column
jacket assembly. 2. Connect the automatic transmission shift lock control actuator electrical
connector.
3. Adjust the automatic transmission shift lock control actuator (with the shift lever clevis in the
neutral position) in the following way:
3.1. Pull out the tab (1) on the adjuster block side (2) of the automatic transmission shift lock
control actuator.
3.2. Press on the adjuster block (2) to disengage the adjuster teeth. Slide the adjuster block (2) as
far away from the actuator as possible.
3.3. Lock the adjuster block in place by pushing inward on the tab (1).
4. Inspect the automatic transmission shift lock control actuator for the following items:
4.1. The automatic transmission shift lock control actuator must lock the shift lever clevis when the
shift lever clevis is put into the PARK position.
4.2. Turn the ignition to the ON position and depress the brake pedal in order to move the gear shift
lever out of the PARK position. The actuator will be energized.
4.3. Readjust the automatic transmission shift lock control actuator if needed.
5. Install the lower steering column trim cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T >
Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5679
6. Enable the SIR system.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair
Control and Shift Solenoids Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the transmission oil pan and filter.
Important: Do not remove the valve body for the following procedures. Removal of the 1-2
accumulator is necessary only if servicing the pressure control solenoid.
2. Remove the 1-2 accumulator if necessary.
3. Disconnect the internal wiring harness electrical connectors from the following components:
^ Transmission fluid pressure switch (1)
^ 1-2 shift control solenoid (2)
^ 2-3 shift control solenoid (3)
^ Pressure control solenoid (4)
^ TCC PWM solenoid (5)
^ 3-2 control solenoid (6)
4. Remove the pressure control solenoid retainer.
5. Remove the pressure control solenoid.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5683
6. Remove the 1-2 and 2-3 shift solenoid retainers. 7. Remove the 1-2 and 2-3 shift solenoids.
8. Remove the 3-2 control solenoid retainer. 9. Remove the 3-2 control solenoid.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the 3-2 control solenoid. 2. Install the 3-2 control solenoid retainer.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5684
3. Install the 1-2 and 2-3 shift solenoids. 4. Install the 1-2 and 2-3 shift solenoid retainers.
5. Install the pressure control solenoid. Ensure that the electrical tabs are facing outboard.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
6. Install the pressure control solenoid retainer and retaining bolt.
Tighten the pressure control solenoid retaining bolt to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
7. Connect the internal wiring harness electrical connectors to the following components:
^ Transmission fluid pressure switch (1)
^ 1-2 shift control solenoid (2)
^ 2-3 shift control solenoid (3)
^ Pressure control solenoid (4)
^ TCC PWM solenoid (5)
^ 3-2 control solenoid (6)
8. Install the 1-2 accumulator.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5685
9. Install the transmission oil pan and filter.
10. Fill the transmission to the proper level with DEXRON III transmission fluid.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T >
Shift Cable, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Slipping/Missed Shifts Diagnostic Tips
Shift Cable: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Slipping/Missed Shifts Diagnostic Tips
File In Section: 07 - Transmission/Transaxle
Bulletin No.: 01-07-30-043
Date: December, 2001
INFORMATION
Subject: Diagnostic Tips for Slipping or Missing Second, Third and/or Fourth Gear
Models: 2001-2002 Chevrolet Camaro, Corvette 2001-2002 Pontiac Firebird 2001-2002 Chevrolet
and GMC C/K Pickup and Utility Models (Silverado, Sierra, Suburban, Tahoe, Yukon, Yukon XL)
2001-2002 Chevrolet and GMC G-Van Models (Express, Savana) 2001-2002 Chevrolet and GMC
M/L-Van Models (Astro, Safari) 2001-2002 Chevrolet and GMC S/T Pickup and Utility Models (S10,
Sonoma, Blazer, Jimmy) 2002 Chevrolet and GMC S/T Utility Models (New Style) (TrailBlazer,
Envoy) 2002 Cadillac Escalade 2001-2002 Oldsmobile Bravada
Recently, a study was completed to determine the causes of slipping/missing 2nd, 3rd or 4th gear
in the 4L60/4L65-E transmission family. This study was conducted using transmissions which were
determined by dealership technicians as having a slipping/missing shift. The transmissions used
were from vehicles with less than 19,000 km (12,000 mi) and the slipping/missing shift condition
was verified during a test drive by dealership personnel before the transmission was removed from
the vehicle. Eight items were found to cause the majority of the slipping/missing shift concerns.
These eight items are listed below in the order of frequency that they were found.
^ Chips in the servo feed oil passage, orifice # 7 in the spacer plate.
^ Cut forward clutch piston inner seal.
^ Cut 3/4 clutch piston outer seal.
^ Input housing orifice cup plug blown out.
^ Input housing cracked or broken.
^ Mislocated valve body to spacer plate check ball(s).
^ Case damaged at the 2nd clutch apply piston pin bore causing the pin to drag/stick in the bore.
^ Input housing air bleed orifice cup plug with a check ball that does not seal.
In addition to the above items, a misadjusted shift cable has been found to cause these types of
concerns. When attempting to correct a slipping/missing second, third or fourth gear, the items
listed above should be inspected as possible causes. It is also important to reference the
appropriate Service Information for additional possible causes of these concerns.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T >
Shift Cable, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5691
Shift Cable: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Shift Cable Grommet Screw
............................................................................................................................................................
1.7 Nm (15 inch lbs.) Shift Control Cable Attachment
...........................................................................................................................................................
20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T >
Shift Cable, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5692
Shift Cable: Adjustments
Automatic Transmission Range Selector Cable Adjustment
Adjustment Procedure
1. Ensure that the transmission range selector cable is not restricted. 2. Block the drive wheels.
3. Place the steering column shift lever in the NEUTRAL position. 4. Raise the vehicle. Refer to
Vehicle Lifting. 5. Ensure that the transmission is in the mechanical neutral position. 6. Disconnect
the transmission range selector cable from the transmission range selector lever ball stud. 7.
Rotate the transmission range selector lever clockwise until it reaches the full clockwise stop
position. 8. Move the range selector lever counterclockwise two detents.
9. Release the locking tab located on the range selector cable.
10. Ensure that the tab remains positioned OUT. 11. Pull the cable end completely forward and
release it. (When the cable is pulled completely forward and released, the adjustment spring will
position the cable to its most rearward position.)
12. Connect the end of the range selector cable to the transmission range selector lever stud ball.
13. Press the locking tab IN in order to retain the adjustment. 14. Lower the vehicle. 15. Check for
proper operation of the range selector cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T >
Shift Cable, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5693
Shift Cable: Service and Repair
Automatic Transmission Range Selector Cable Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Block the drive wheels and place the vehicle in the neutral position. 2. Remove the drivers side
knee bolster. 3. Remove the bottom half of the steering column trim cover. 4. Remove the range
selector cable end from the steering column shift controller ball stud.
5. Remove the clip that secures the range selector cable to the steering column bracket. 6.
Remove the range selector cable from the steering column bracket. 7. Raise the vehicle. Refer to
Vehicle Lifting. 8. Remove the range selector cable end from the transmission range selector lever
stud ball.
9. Remove the clip from the bracket that secures the range selector cable to the transmission.
10. Remove the range selector cable from the bracket. 11. Remove the three range selector cable
clips from the body. 12. Remove the grommet from the hole in the floor panel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T >
Shift Cable, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5694
13. If the vehicle is equipped with a transfer case, remove the bolt and washer securing the clip
and the range selector cable to the transfer case. 14. Remove the range selector cable from the
vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Feed the steering column end of the range selector cable through the grommet hole in the floor
panel. 2. Lower the vehicle. 3. Connect the range selector cable end to the steering column shift
controller stud ball. 4. Install the range selector cable to the steering column bracket.
5. Install the clip that secures the range selector cable to the steering column bracket. 6. Raise the
vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T >
Shift Cable, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5695
7. Install the range selector cable to the transmission bracket.
^ Do not depress the adjustment locking tab located on the range selector cable. Ensure that the
tab remains positioned OUT.
^ Do not install the range selector cable end to the transmission shift lever stud ball at this time.
8. Ensure that the transmission is in the mechanical neutral position.
^ Rotate the transmission range selector lever clockwise until it reaches the full clockwise stop
position.
^ Move the range selector lever counterclockwise two detents.
9. Position the range selector cable to assume a natural routing. The range selector cable must be
free to move 20.0 mm (0.80 inch) axially during
the adjustment under adjustment spring loads.
10. Pull the range selector cable end completely forward and release it. (When the cable is pulled
completely forward and released, the adjustment
spring will position the cable to its most rearward position.)
Notice: Do not pull the shift lever ball stud forward of the transmission shift lever ball stud during
installation. Pulling the shift cable end forward of the transmission shift lever ball stud before
installing the shift cable end to the transmission shift lever ball stud will result in a poor adjustment.
11. Connect the end of the range selector cable to the transmission range selector lever stud ball.
12. Press the locking tab IN in order to retain the adjustment and to secure the cable to the
transmission bracket.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T >
Shift Cable, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5696
13. If the vehicle is equipped with a transfer case, install the bolt and washer securing clip and the
cable to the transfer case.
14. Install the grommet to the hole in the floor panel. 15. Install the three range selector cable clips
to the body. 16. Lower the vehicle. 17. Check for proper operation of the range selector cable. 18.
Install the lower half of the steering column trim cover. 19. Install the drivers side knee bolster. 20.
Remove the wheel blocks.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sun Gear > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sun Gear: > 00-07-30-022D > Jun > 08 > A/T - 4L60/65E,
No Reverse/2nd or 4th Gear
Sun Gear: Customer Interest A/T - 4L60/65E, No Reverse/2nd or 4th Gear
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 00-07-30-022D
Date: June 10, 2008
Subject: No Reverse, Second Gear or Fourth Gear (Replace Reaction Sun Shell with More Robust
Heat Treated Parts)
Models: 1993 - 2005 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2003 - 2005 HUMMER H2
with 4L60/65-E Automatic Transmission (RPOs M30 or M32)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add 2005 model year to the parts information. Please
discard Corporate Bulletin Number 00-07-30-022C (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a no reverse, no second or no fourth gear condition. First and
third gears will operate properly.
Cause
The reaction sun gear (673) may not hold inside the reaction sun shell (670).
Correction
Important:
There are FOUR distinct groups of vehicles and repair procedures involved. Vehicles built in the
2001 model year and prior that make use of a reaction shaft to shell thrust washer:
^ The sun shell can be identified by four square holes used to retain the thrust washer. Use
reaction sun shell P/N 24228345, reaction carrier to shell thrust washer (699B) P/N 8642202 and
reaction sun gear shell thrust washer (674) P/N 8642331er (674) P/N 8642331along with the
appropriate seals and washers listed below.
^ Vehicles built in the 2001 model year and prior that have had previous service to the reaction sun
shell: It is possible that some 2001 and prior model year vehicles have had previous service to the
reaction sun shell. At the time of service, these vehicles may have been updated with a Reaction
Sun Shell Kit (Refer to Service Bulletin 020730003) without four square holes to retain the thrust
washer. If it is found in a 2001 model year and prior vehicles that the reaction sun shell DOES NOT
have four square holes to retain the thrust washer, these vehicles must be serviced with P/Ns
24229825 (674), 24217328 and 8642331 along with the appropriate seals and washers listed
below.
^ Vehicles built in the 2001 model year and later that make use of a reaction shaft to shell thrust
bearing: The sun shell can be identified by no holes to retain the thrust washer. Use reaction sun
shell, P/N 24229825, reaction carrier shaft to shell thrust bearing (669A), P/N 24217328 and
reaction sun gear shell thrust washer (674), P/N 8642331 along with the appropriate seals and
washers listed below.
^ Vehicles built from November, 2001 through June, 2002: These vehicles should have the reaction
carrier shaft replaced when the sun shell is replaced. Use shell kit P/N 24229853, which contains a
sun shell (670), a reaction carrier shaft (666), a reaction carrier shaft to shell thrust bearing (669A)
and a reaction sun gear shell thrust washer (674). The appropriate seals and washers listed below
should also be used.
When servicing the transmission as a result of this condition, the transmission oil cooler and lines
MUST be flushed. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 02-07-30-052.
Follow the service procedure below for diagnosis and correction of the no reverse, no second, no
forth condition.
Important:
If metallic debris is found on the transmission magnet, the transmission must be completely
disassembled and cleaned. Metallic debris is defined as broken parts and pieces of internal
transmission components. This should not be confused with typical "normal" fine particles found on
all transmission magnets. Failure to properly clean the transmission case and internal components
may lead to additional repeat repairs.
1. Remove the transmission oil pan and inspect the magnet in the bottom of the pan for metal
debris. Refer to SI Document ID # 825141.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sun Gear > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sun Gear: > 00-07-30-022D > Jun > 08 > A/T - 4L60/65E,
No Reverse/2nd or 4th Gear > Page 5705
2. Remove the transmission from the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate SI document.
Important:
^ Inspect all the transmission components for damage or wear. Replace all damaged or worn
components. The parts shown above should be sufficient to correct this concern.
^ This condition does not normally require replacement of the transmission completely.
Components such as clutches, valve body, pump and torque converters will NOT require
replacement to correct this condition.
Disassemble the transmission and replace the appropriate parts listed below. Refer to the Unit
Repair Manual - Repair Instructions.
3. Reinstall the transmission in the vehicle. Refer to appropriate service information.
When servicing the transmission as a result of this condition, the transmission oil cooler and lines
MUST be flushed. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 02-07-30-052.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sun Gear > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sun Gear: > 00-07-30-022D > Jun > 08 > A/T - 4L60/65E,
No Reverse/2nd or 4th Gear > Page 5706
Parts Information
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sun Gear > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sun Gear: > 00-07-30-022D > Jun > 08 > A/T
- 4L60/65E, No Reverse/2nd or 4th Gear
Sun Gear: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 4L60/65E, No Reverse/2nd or 4th Gear
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 00-07-30-022D
Date: June 10, 2008
Subject: No Reverse, Second Gear or Fourth Gear (Replace Reaction Sun Shell with More Robust
Heat Treated Parts)
Models: 1993 - 2005 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2003 - 2005 HUMMER H2
with 4L60/65-E Automatic Transmission (RPOs M30 or M32)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add 2005 model year to the parts information. Please
discard Corporate Bulletin Number 00-07-30-022C (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a no reverse, no second or no fourth gear condition. First and
third gears will operate properly.
Cause
The reaction sun gear (673) may not hold inside the reaction sun shell (670).
Correction
Important:
There are FOUR distinct groups of vehicles and repair procedures involved. Vehicles built in the
2001 model year and prior that make use of a reaction shaft to shell thrust washer:
^ The sun shell can be identified by four square holes used to retain the thrust washer. Use
reaction sun shell P/N 24228345, reaction carrier to shell thrust washer (699B) P/N 8642202 and
reaction sun gear shell thrust washer (674) P/N 8642331er (674) P/N 8642331along with the
appropriate seals and washers listed below.
^ Vehicles built in the 2001 model year and prior that have had previous service to the reaction sun
shell: It is possible that some 2001 and prior model year vehicles have had previous service to the
reaction sun shell. At the time of service, these vehicles may have been updated with a Reaction
Sun Shell Kit (Refer to Service Bulletin 020730003) without four square holes to retain the thrust
washer. If it is found in a 2001 model year and prior vehicles that the reaction sun shell DOES NOT
have four square holes to retain the thrust washer, these vehicles must be serviced with P/Ns
24229825 (674), 24217328 and 8642331 along with the appropriate seals and washers listed
below.
^ Vehicles built in the 2001 model year and later that make use of a reaction shaft to shell thrust
bearing: The sun shell can be identified by no holes to retain the thrust washer. Use reaction sun
shell, P/N 24229825, reaction carrier shaft to shell thrust bearing (669A), P/N 24217328 and
reaction sun gear shell thrust washer (674), P/N 8642331 along with the appropriate seals and
washers listed below.
^ Vehicles built from November, 2001 through June, 2002: These vehicles should have the reaction
carrier shaft replaced when the sun shell is replaced. Use shell kit P/N 24229853, which contains a
sun shell (670), a reaction carrier shaft (666), a reaction carrier shaft to shell thrust bearing (669A)
and a reaction sun gear shell thrust washer (674). The appropriate seals and washers listed below
should also be used.
When servicing the transmission as a result of this condition, the transmission oil cooler and lines
MUST be flushed. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 02-07-30-052.
Follow the service procedure below for diagnosis and correction of the no reverse, no second, no
forth condition.
Important:
If metallic debris is found on the transmission magnet, the transmission must be completely
disassembled and cleaned. Metallic debris is defined as broken parts and pieces of internal
transmission components. This should not be confused with typical "normal" fine particles found on
all transmission magnets. Failure to properly clean the transmission case and internal components
may lead to additional repeat repairs.
1. Remove the transmission oil pan and inspect the magnet in the bottom of the pan for metal
debris. Refer to SI Document ID # 825141.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sun Gear > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sun Gear: > 00-07-30-022D > Jun > 08 > A/T
- 4L60/65E, No Reverse/2nd or 4th Gear > Page 5712
2. Remove the transmission from the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate SI document.
Important:
^ Inspect all the transmission components for damage or wear. Replace all damaged or worn
components. The parts shown above should be sufficient to correct this concern.
^ This condition does not normally require replacement of the transmission completely.
Components such as clutches, valve body, pump and torque converters will NOT require
replacement to correct this condition.
Disassemble the transmission and replace the appropriate parts listed below. Refer to the Unit
Repair Manual - Repair Instructions.
3. Reinstall the transmission in the vehicle. Refer to appropriate service information.
When servicing the transmission as a result of this condition, the transmission oil cooler and lines
MUST be flushed. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 02-07-30-052.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sun Gear > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sun Gear: > 00-07-30-022D > Jun > 08 > A/T
- 4L60/65E, No Reverse/2nd or 4th Gear > Page 5713
Parts Information
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Torque Converter Replacement Information
Torque Converter: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Torque Converter Replacement Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 01-07-30-010C
Date: May 12, 2008
Subject: Automatic Transmission/Transaxle Torque Converter Replacement
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009
and Prior Saturn Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Except VTi Equipped Vehicles (RPO M16 and M75)
2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
with ALL Automatic Transmissions and Transaxles
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2007-2009 model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 01-07-30-010B (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The purpose of this bulletin is to help technicians determine when a torque converter should be
replaced. Below is a list of general guidelines to follow.
The converter should NOT be replaced if the following apply:
^ DTC P0742 - TCC stuck on is set. This code is almost always the result of a controls condition
(i.e. stuck TCC solenoid/valve). Experience has shown that this code rarely indicates a mechanical
concern within the torque converter.
^ The fluid has an odor or is discolored but no evidence of metal contamination.
^ Fine metal particles (traces of metal flakes/gray color to fluid ) are found in the converter. This is
not harmful to the torque converter.
^ The vehicle has been exposed to high mileage.
^ A small amount of wear appears on the hub where the oil pump drive gear mates to the converter
(RWD only). A certain amount of such wear is normal for both the hub and oil pump gear. Neither
the converter nor the front pump assembly should be replaced.
The torque converter should be replaced under any of the following conditions:
^ The vehicle has TCC shudder and/or no TCC apply. First complete all electrical and hydraulic
diagnosis and check for proper engine operation. The converter clutch may be damaged. Also the
converter bushing and/or internal 0-ring may be damaged.
^ Evidence of damage to the oil pump assembly pump shaft turbine shaft drive sprocket support
and bearing or metal chips/debris in the converter.
^ Metal chips/debris are found in the converter or when flushing the cooler and the cooler lines.
^ External leaks in the hub weld area lug weld or closure weld.
^ Converter pilot is broken damaged or fits poorly into the crankshaft.
^ The converter hub is scored or damaged.
^ The transmission oil is contaminated with engine coolant engine oil or water.
^ If excessive end play is found after measuring the converter for proper end play (refer to Service
Manual).
^ If metal chips/debris are found in the fluid filter or on the magnet and no internal parts in the unit
are worn or damaged. This indicates that the material came from the converter.
^ The converter has an unbalanced condition that results in a vibration that cannot be corrected by
following Converter Vibration Procedures.
^ Blue converter or dark circular ring between lugs. This condition will also require a complete
cleaning of the cooler and a check for adequate flow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Torque Converter Replacement Information > Page 5718
through the cooler.
^ Converter bearing noise determined by noise from the bell housing area in Drive or Reverse at
idle. The noise is gone in Neutral and Park.
^ If silicon from the viscous clutch is found in the lower pan (4T80-E ONLY).
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5719
Torque Converter: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Plate to Converter Bolt (Shipping)
.................................................................................................................................. 27.0 - 34.0 Nm
(20 - 25 ft. lbs.)
Torque Converter End Play Specifications
245 mm (9.65 inch)
........................................................................................................................................................ 0.0
- 0.38 mm (0.0 - 0.015 inch) 258 mm (10.16 inch)
.................................................................................................................................................. 0.1 0.50 mm (0.004 - 0.020 inch) 298 mm (11.73 inch)
.................................................................................................................................................. 0.1 0.48 mm (0.004 - 0.019 inch) 300 mm (11.81 inch)
.................................................................................................................................................... 0.1 0.5 mm (0.004 - 0.020 inch)
Transmission General Specifications
Torque Converter Size, Diameter of Torque Converter Turbine;
245 mm, 258 mm, 298 mm, 300 mm
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter
Check Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Revised Converter Check Valve/Cooler Line
Fitting
Torque Converter Check Valve: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Revised Converter Check
Valve/Cooler Line Fitting
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-017B
Date: November 25, 2008
Subject: Information on 4T65-E MN7, M15, M76, MN3 Automatic Transmission Case, Cooler
Fitting and Torque Converter Drain Back Check Ball Change
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks
with one of the HYDRA-MATIC(R) Automatic Transmissions shown above.
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to update the Parts Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-017A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Effective with Julian date 4019 (January 19, 2004), the 4T65E transaxle cases and cooler fittings
have changed and are not interchangeable with past models. The technician may find that when
replacing the inlet or outlet transmission cooler lines, the new lines cannot be connected to the
transmission.
A change to the transmission cooler line fittings was implemented in production on February 1,
2004. The cooler line fittings were changed to a design with a longer lead in pilot (1). The cooler
line fittings with the longer lead in pilot will not fit on models built before February 1, 2004.
The longer lead in pilot fittings (1) (9/16-18 UNF) have replaced the shorter lead in pilot fittings (2)
(3/8-18 NPSF w/check ball & 1/4-18 NPSF).
If the transmission cooler lines will not connect, then replace them with the following cooler line
fittings as appropriate with the older, shorter lead in pilot design:
^ For vehicles built prior to February 1, 2004, use Transmission Fluid Cooler Inlet Hose, P/N
20793004.
^ For vehicles built after February 1, 2004, use Transmission Fluid Cooler Inlet Hose, second
design P/N 15264588.
^ For vehicles built prior to February 1, 2004, use Transmission Fluid Cooler Outlet Hose, P/N
20793005.
^ For vehicles built after February 1, 2004, use Transmission Fluid Cooler Outlet Hose, second
design P/N 15264589.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter
Check Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Revised Converter Check Valve/Cooler Line
Fitting > Page 5724
The torque specification has changed for the fittings to case. The torque has changed from 38 Nm
(28 lb ft) to 32 Nm (23 lb ft).
Tighten
Tighten the new cooler fittings to 32 Nm (23 lb ft).
The converter drain back check ball (420C) has been removed from the cooler line fitting and is
now located in the channel plate.
If you get a concern of no movement in the morning or after sitting for several hours, the cooler
check ball should be inspected.
The best way to determine where the check ball is located is to look at the cooler line fittings. The
old fittings are different sizes (3/8-18 NPSF & 1/4-18 NPSF) and would contain the cooler check
ball. The new fittings are the same size as each other (9/16-18 UNF) and do not have a cooler
check ball.
Parts Information
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter
Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
TCC Solenoid Assembly to Case Bolt
................................................................................................................................ 8.0 - 14.0 Nm (6 10 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter
Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5728
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Service and Repair
Torque Converter Clutch Pulse Width Modulation (TCC PWM) Solenoid, TCC Solenoid, and Wiring
Harness
^ Tools Required J 28458 Seal Protector Retainer Installer
Removal Procedure
1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the transmission oil pan and
the filter.
3. Disconnect the transmission harness 20-way connector from the transmission internal harness
pass-through connector. Depress both tabs on the
connector and pull straight up; do not pry the connector.
Important: Removal of the valve body is not necessary for the following procedure.
4. Remove the 1-2 accumulator assembly. Do not remove the spacer plate.
5. Disconnect the internal wiring harness electrical connectors from the following components:
^ Transmission fluid pressure switch (1)
^ 1-2 shift control solenoid (2)
^ 2-3 shift control solenoid (3)
^ Pressure control solenoid (4)
^ TCC PWM solenoid (5)
^ 3-2 control solenoid (6)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter
Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5729
6. Remove the TCC PWM solenoid retainer. 7. Remove the TCC PWM solenoid in order to access
one of the TCC solenoid retaining bolts. 8. Remove the pressure control solenoid retainer.
9. Remove the pressure control solenoid.
10. Remove the TCC solenoid retaining bolts and the valve body bolts which retain the internal
wiring harness.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter
Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5730
11. Using J 28458, release the pass-through electrical connector from the transmission case.
11.1. Use the small end of the J 28458 over the top of the connector.
11.2. Twist in order to release the four tabs retaining the connector.
11.3. Pull the harness connector down through the transmission case.
12. Remove the TCC solenoid (with O-ring seal) and wiring harness assembly from the
transmission case.
13. Inspect the TCC solenoid and wiring harness assembly for the following defects:
^ Damage
^ Cracked connectors
^ Exposed wires
^ Loose pins
Installation Procedure
1. Install the wiring harness and TCC solenoid assembly with a new O-ring seal to the
transmission. 2. Install the pass-through electrical connector to the transmission case.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter
Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5731
3. Install the valve body bolts which retain the internal wiring harness and install the TCC solenoid
retaining bolts.
^ Tighten the control valve body retaining bolts to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
^ Tighten the TCC solenoid retaining bolts to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
4. Install the pressure control solenoid. Ensure that the electrical tabs are facing outboard. 5. Install
the pressure control solenoid retainer and retaining bolt.
Tighten the pressure control solenoid retaining bolt to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
6. Install the TCC PWM solenoid to the control valve body. 7. Install the TCC PWM solenoid
retainer.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter
Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5732
8. Connect the internal wiring harness electrical connectors to the following components:
^ Transmission fluid pressure switch (1)
^ 1-2 shift control solenoid (2)
^ 2-3 shift control solenoid (3)
^ Pressure control solenoid (4)
^ TCC PWM solenoid (5)
^ 3-2 control solenoid (6)
9. Install the 1-2 accumulator.
10. Connect the transmission harness 20-way connector to the transmission pass-through
connector. Align the arrows on each half of the connector and
insert straight down.
11. Install the transmission oil pan and filter. 12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Fill the transmission to the
proper level with DEXRON III transmission fluid.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter
Cover > Component Information > Specifications
Torque Converter Cover: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Converter Cover Bolt ...........................................................................................................................
............................................ 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler,
A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Fluid Oil Cooler Flush
Transmission Cooler: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Fluid Oil Cooler Flush
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 02-07-30-052G
Date: March 02, 2011
Subject: Automatic Transmission Oil Cooler Flush and Flow Test Essential Tool J 45096
TransFlow(R)
Models:
2011 and Prior Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2003-2010 HUMMER H2 2006-2010
HUMMER H3 with Automatic Transmission/Transaxle including Allison(R) Transmissions
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 02-07-30-052F (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Important All labor operations that include removal of the transmission from the vehicle include
labor time to flush the transmission oil cooler system.
The J 45096 transmission oil cooling system flush and flow test tool replaces current tool J
35944-A. J 45096 is a self-contained unit utilizing a 12-volt flow meter, shop air supply and
DEXRON(R) VI automatic transmission fluid (ATF). In the flush mode, transmission fluid is cycled
through the transmission oil cooling system. High-pressure air is automatically injected into the fluid
stream adding agitation to the ATF oil to enhance the removal of contaminated ATF oil and debris.
In the flow mode, an electronic flow meter is used to measure the flow capability of the ATF oil
cooling system. A digital display indicates the ATF oil flow rate in gallons per minute (GPM) along
with the amount of ATF oil in the supply vessel, supply vessel ATF oil temperature, machine cycles
and the operating mode. The supply oil vessel has 30 L (32 qt) capacity and the waste oil vessel
has 32 L (34 qt) capacity. The waste oil vessel is constructed of a translucent composite material
that allows the user to easily identify the oil level. The waste oil vessel can accommodate vacuum
evacuation and gravity draining. In the code mode, a random, encrypted code is generated that can
be used for verification of flow test results.
Current essential cooler line adapters are used to connect the J 45096 to the automatic
transmission oil cooler lines that allows J 45096 to adapt to General Motors passenger cars and
light duty trucks, current and past models (except the Pontiac Vibe, Wave and Chevrolet Aveo).
The tool may be adapted for use on the Pontiac Vibe, Wave and Chevrolet Aveo by dealership
personnel with a barbed hose connector and rubber hose obtained locally. The
Vibe's/Wave's/Aveo's transmission has a transmission oil requirement which is slightly different
than DEXRON(R) VI ATF. However, flushing the cooler with DEXRON(R) VI automatic
transmission fluid is an acceptable service procedure. Very little fluid remains in the cooler after the
flush procedure and the residual DEXRON(R) VI ATF in the cooler is compatible with the
Vibe's/Wave's/Aveo's transmission fluid.
Notice
Insufficient oil flow through the ATF oil cooling system will cause premature transmission failure.
The required minimum ATF oil flow rate reading is directly related to the supply oil temperature.
Refer to the flow rate reference chart for the oil flow rate specification based on the temperature of
the ATF in the supply vessel.
Helpful Hints for Maintaining the Temperature at or above 18°C (65°F)
Important
- The temperature of the supply vessel oil must be 18°C (65°F) or greater for J 45096 to operate. It
is recommended to store the J 45096 in an area of the dealership where the room temperature
remains at or above 18°C (65°F) when not in use.
- Do not attempt to increase the fluid temperature in the Transflow(R) machine with an engine oil
dipstick, or any other immersion type heater. The Transflow(R) machine has a check valve in the
supply reservoir. Inserting a heater will damage the check valve and the subsequent repair
expense would be the dealer's responsibility.
- A heater blanket, P/N J-45096-10, is available for the Transflow(R) transmission cooling system
flushing tool. This heater fastens around the Transflow(R) internal supply vessel and runs on 110
volts AC. The heater will warm the ATF in the supply vessel to at least 18°C (65° F) and has a
thermostat to hold a constant temperature.
Store the Transmission Cooling System Service Tool, J 45096, Transflow(R) machine in a room
where the temperature is maintained at or above 18°C (65°F).
Keep the ATF level in the reservoir low when the Transmission Cooling System Service Tool, J
45096, Transflow(R), is not in use. Store several gallons of oil in an area where the temperature is
maintained at or above 18°C (65°F). Fill the reservoir of the J 45096 as needed before using the
machine on
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler,
A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Fluid Oil Cooler Flush > Page 5740
each repair.
With the ATF in a tightly sealed container, place the container in a tub of hot water for a period of
time. Then pour the ATF into the reservoir. This method works best with a low fluid level in the
reservoir.
Place the Transflow(R) machine in the direct sunlight with the cabinet door open to expose the
reservoir to the rays of the warm sun.
Flush / Flow Test Procedure
Important All labor operations that include removal of the transmission from the vehicle and require
the transmission oil pan or transmission side cover to be removed include labor time to flush the
transmission oil cooler system.
Refer to SI for Automatic Transmission Oil Cooler Flushing and Flow Test J 45096 for the
appropriate procedure.
Important The J 45096 can be used to flush the transmission oil cooler system on an Allison
equipped vehicle, but the flow meter should not be utilized. Refer to SI for Automatic Transmission
Oil Cooler Flushing and Flow Test J 45096 for the appropriate flow check procedure.
Machine Displays
After completion of the flush and flow test, the following information is to be recorded on the repair
order. This information is displayed on the Transmission Cooling System Service Tool, J 45096,
Transflow(R) machine when the dial is in the code position.
- Tested flow rate (displayed in Gallons Per Minute (GPM)
- Temperature (displayed is degrees Fahrenheit)
- Cycle number (a number)
- Seven digit Alpha/Numeric flow code (i.e. A10DFB2)
Warranty Information
Important All labor operations that include removal of the transmission from the vehicle include
labor time to flush the transmission oil cooler system.
Performing a transmission oil cooling system flush and flow test will use between 4.7-7.5 L (5-8 qts)
of DEXRON(R)VI transmission fluid. The amount
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler,
A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Fluid Oil Cooler Flush > Page 5741
of transmission fluid (ATF), (DEXRON(R)VI) (fluid) that is to be charged for the flush portion of the
repair should not exceed the allowable charge for 7.5 L (2 gal) of fluid. This expense should be
shown in the Parts Section of the warranty claim document.
The Seven digit Alpha/Numeric flow code, i.e. A10DFB2, "MUST" be written on the job card and
placed in the comments section of the warranty claim. Any repair that requires the technician to
contact the Product Quality Center (PQC) must also include the seven digit flow code. The agent
will request the seven digit flow code and add the information to the PQC case prior to providing
authorization for the warranty claim.
The Seven digit Alpha/Numeric flow code, i.e. A10DFB2, "MUST" be written on the job card,
entered in the warranty claim labor operation Flush Code additional field (when available) and
placed in the comments section of the warranty claim. Any repair that requires the technician to
contact the Product Quality Center (PQC) must also include the seven digit flow code. The agent
will request the seven digit flow code and add the information to the PQC case prior to providing
authorization for the warranty claim.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler,
A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Fluid Oil Cooler Flush > Page 5742
Transmission Cooler: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Water Or Coolant Contamination
Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-07-30-035B
Date: November 01, 2010
Subject: Information on Water or Ethylene Glycol in Transmission Fluid
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks with Automatic Transmission
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 08-07-30-035A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Water or ethylene glycol in automatic transmission fluid (ATF) is harmful to internal transmission
components and will have a negative effect on reliability and durability of these parts. Water or
ethylene glycol in ATF will also change the friction of the clutches, frequently resulting in shudder
during engagement or gear changes, especially during torque converter clutch engagement.
Indications of water in the ATF may include:
- ATF blowing out of the transmission vent tube.
- ATF may appear cloudy or, in cases of extreme contamination, have the appearance of a
strawberry milkshake.
- Visible water in the oil pan.
- A milky white substance inside the pan area.
- Spacer plate gaskets that appear to be glued to the valve body face or case.
- Spacer plate gaskets that appear to be swollen or wrinkled in areas where they are not
compressed.
- Rust on internal transmission iron/steel components.
If water in the ATF has been found and the source of the water entry has not been identified, or if a
leaking in-radiator transmission oil cooler is suspected (with no evidence of cross-contamination in
the coolant recovery reservoir), a simple and quick test kit is available that detects the presence of
ethylene glycol in ATF. The "Gly-Tek" test kit, available from the Nelco Company, should be
obtained and the ATF tested to make an accurate decision on the need for radiator replacement.
This can help to prevent customer comebacks if the in-radiator transmission oil cooler is leaking
and reduce repair expenses by avoiding radiator replacement if the cooler is not leaking. These
test kits can be obtained from:
Nelco Company
Test kits can be ordered by phone or through the website listed above. Orders are shipped
standard delivery time but can be shipped on a next day delivery basis for an extra charge. One
test kit will complete 10 individual fluid sample tests. For vehicles repaired under warranty, the cost
of the complete test kit plus shipping charges should be divided by 10 and submitted on the
warranty claim as a net item.
The transmission should be repaired or replaced based on the normal cost comparison procedure.
Important If water or coolant is found in the transmission, the following components MUST be
replaced.
- Replace all of the rubber-type seals.
- Replace all of the composition-faced clutch plates and/or bands.
- Replace all of the nylon parts.
- Replace the torque converter.
- Thoroughly clean and rebuild the transmission, using new gaskets and oil filter.
Important The following steps must be completed when repairing or replacing.
Flush and flow check the transmission oil cooler using J 45096. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
02-07-30-052F- Automatic Transmission Oil Cooler Flush and Flow Test Essential Tool J 45096
TransFlow.
- Thoroughly inspect the engine cooling system and hoses and clean/repair as necessary.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler,
A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Fluid Oil Cooler Flush > Page 5743
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler,
A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Fluid Oil Cooler Flush > Page 5744
Transmission Cooler: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Oil Cooler Flushing Frequently Asked
Questions
File In Section: 07 - Transmission/Transaxle
Bulletin No.: 03-07-30-027
Date: June, 2003
INFORMATION
Subject: Most Frequently Asked Questions and Answers for J 45096 TransFlow Transmission Oil
Cooling System Flushing Machine
Models: 2004 and Prior Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks with Automatic
Transmission/Transaxle
2004 and Prior HUMMER H2
This bulletin is issued to help answer the most frequently asked questions and concerns about
essential tool J 45096.
Q: Why doesn't the machine work below 18°C (65°F)?
A: The flow characteristics of ATF at temperatures below 18°C (65°F) does not provide accurate
flow test results with the electronics used in the J
45096.
Q: Why didn't the unit come with a tank heater?
A: The vast majority of dealerships do not require a heater to keep the ATF above 18°C (65°F). As
a result, the heater was deleted as a cost-savings
measure. A tank heater, J 45096-10, is currently available from Kent-Moore if your dealership
requires it. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 03-07-30-002A for suggestions on warming the ATF
without using a heater blanket.
Q: Why does the machine fail new oil coolers?
A: Several reasons have been found. The most likely reason is the air pressure at the air hose
connected to the J 45096 is less than 586 kPa (85 psi).
Other reasons include a twisted hose inside the J 45096 at the bulkhead as a result of the nut
turning when the waste or supply hose was installed, the internal pressure regulator was
improperly set at the factory or a problem with the cooler lines on the vehicle. Perform the J 45096
self-test as described on pages 9 and 10 of the Operation Manual. If a problem is still detected,
refer to Troubleshooting on page 19 of the Operation Manual. If a problem still persists, contact
Kent-Moore Customer Service at 1-800-345-2233.
Q: What is the difference between steel and aluminum oil coolers?
A: The aluminum oil cooler tube is slightly thinner in construction than the steel oil cooler tube,
which affects the oil flow rate. The fitting that is
protruding out of the radiator tank easily identifies the aluminum oil cooler. Refer to the Quick
Reference card provided with the J 45096 in order to identify the proper flow rate for the aluminum
oil cooler.
Q: Why can't I use TransFlow for Allison transmission cooling Systems?
A: Validation of TransFlow is currently under development for light duty trucks equipped with the
Allison automatic transmission. TransFlow is based
on the existing MINIMUM flow rate specification through the transmission oil cooling system. The
Allison transmission oil cooling system only has MAXIMUM oil flow rates specified and J 45096
does not have the capability to test the transmission oil cooling system at the maximum oil flow rate
specification.
Q: Why doesn't GM publish a specification for auxiliary transmission oil coolers?
A: The auxiliary oil cooler used with GM vehicles does not contain an internal turbulator plate like
the radiator tank oil cooler does. Therefore, there is
no internal restriction that would affect the flow rate through the oil cooling system so a
specification for auxiliary oil cooler is not required. Keep in mind, kinks and damage to the auxiliary
cooler and lines can affect the flow rate through the system.
Q: Why did GM drop the labor time for transmission repairs?
A: The labor for flushing and flow testing the transmission oil cooling system is included with the
R&R; labor of the "K" labor operations that require
transmission removal. The time required to use the J 45096 to perform the flush and flow test is
much less than that of the J 35944-A. The warranty labor savings allowed GM to provide the J
45096 at no cost to dealerships.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler,
A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Fluid Oil Cooler Flush > Page 5745
Q: Why didn't the machine come with the adapters to hook up to the car?
A: The J 45096 was designed to use the previously released essential cooler line adapters for the J
35944-A. All adapters are listed on page 17 of the
Operation Manual and can be ordered from Kent-Moore at 1-800-345-2233.
Q: How do I connect the J 45096 to a Catera, Prizm or a Vibe?
A: These vehicles, along with many other models, only require barbed fittings to connect to the
rubber cooler hose. These fittings are commercially
available and already found in many shops.
Q: Why didn't I receive an Operation Manual with the machine?
A: The Operation Manual was packaged in the upper portion of the shipping carton. If the shipping
carton was lifted off the base without opening the
top of the carton, the Operation Manual could have been discarded with the carton. Replacement
Operation Manual packages can be obtained from Kent-Moore Customer Service at
1-800-345-2233.
Q: Why can't I re-use the transmission fluid I use for flushing?
A: The very fine metal and clutch material debris from the transmission failure in the ATF causes
failures with the hall effect speed sensors that are used
to measure the flow rate. To avoid costly repairs, expensive filters, regular maintenance and
problems caused by a partially restricted filter, the filter was not included.
Q: What do I do if I need service on my machine?
A: Call Kent-Moore Customer Service at 1-800-345-2233. The J 45096 has a one-year warranty.
Q: Can I flush and flow engine oil coolers?
A: The engine oil cooler flow rates, the appropriate adapters and an acceptable procedure are
currently under development.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler,
A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Fluid Oil Cooler Flush > Page 5746
Transmission Cooler: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Oil Cooler Flushing/Flow Check Procedures
File In Section: 07 - Transmission/Transaxle
Bulletin No.: 99-07-30-017A
Date: February, 2003
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Oil Cooler Flushing and Flow Check Procedures
Models: 2003 and Prior GM Light Duty Trucks 2003 HUMMER H2 with Allison(R) Automatic
Transmission (RPO M74)
This bulletin revises bulletin 99-07-30-017 to reflect the release of the new Transflow(R) J 45096
Transmission Cooling System Service Tool. The Transflow(R) Transmission Cooling System
Service Tool is to be used for all vehicles. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 99-07-30-017
(Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle). Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 02-07-30-052.
Important:
If you were sent here by the instruction booklet for the J 45096 TransFlow(R) machine, note that
the table has been moved to Corporate Bulletin Number 02-07-30-052.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode
Switch, A/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Transmission Mode Switch: Testing and Inspection
Tow/Haul Switch/Indicator Always On or Inoperative
Circuit Description
Tow/haul mode enables the operator to achieve enhanced shift performance when towing or
hauling a load. When tow/haul mode is selected, the tow/haul switch input signal to the Body
Control Module (BCM) is momentarily toggled to zero volts. This signals the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) to extend the length of time between upshifts and increase transmission line
pressure. Cycling the tow/haul switch again disables tow/haul mode and returns the transmission to
a normal shift pattern.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode
Switch, A/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 5750
Test Description
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. This step tests for a faulty
tow/haul switch. 3. This step tests for voltage input from the BCM to the tow/haul switch.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mount,
A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Mount: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Trans Mount to Transmission Bolt
...................................................................................................................................................... 25
Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mount,
A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5754
Transmission Mount: Service and Repair
Transmission Mount Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Support the transmission with
a transmission jack.
3. Remove the two nuts securing the transmission mount to the transmission support. 4. Raise the
transmission just enough to remove the weight off of the mount.
5. Remove the bolts (1) from the transmission mount. 6. Raise the transmission just enough to
remove the mount from between the transmission and the support. 7. Remove the transmission
mount from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the transmission mount to the vehicle.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mount,
A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5755
2. Install the bolts (1) that retain the transmission mount to the transmission (2WD), or transfer
case adapter (AWD).
For vehicles equipped with AWD, tighten the bolts to 47 Nm (35 ft. lbs.). For vehicles equipped with
2WD, tighten the bolts to 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs.).
3. Lower the transmission.
4. Install the two nuts securing the transmission mount to the transmission support.
Tighten the nuts to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
5. Remove the transmission jack. 6. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Park/Neutral Position Switch Screw
................................................................................................................................................... 3 Nm
(27 inch lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5759
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams
Automatic Transmission Related Connector End Views
Transmission Range Switch Connector, Wiring Harness Side
Tow/Haul Switch Connector, Column Wiring Harness Side
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5760
Park/Neutral Position Switch (C1)
Park/Neutral Position Switch (C2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5761
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Adjustments
Park/Neutral Position Switch Adjustment
Important: ^
The following procedure is for vehicles that have not had the switch removed or replaced. If the
switch has been removed or replaced, refer to Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement for the
proper adjustment procedure.
^ Apply the parking brake.
^ The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) positions only.
^ Check the switch for proper operation. If adjustment is required, proceed as follows:
1. Place the transmission range selector in the N (Neutral) position. 2. With an assistant in the
drivers seat, raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 3. Loosen the park/neutral position switch
mounting bolts. 4. With the vehicle in the N (Neutral) position, rotate the switch while the assistant
attempts to start the engine. 5. Following a successful start, turn the engine off.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
6. Tighten the bolts securing the switch to the transmission.
Tighten the bolts to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Check the switch for proper operation. The engine must start in the P
(Park) or N (Neutral) positions only. 9. Replace the park/neutral position switch if proper operation
can not be achieved.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5762
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement
^ Tools Required J 41364-A Neutral Position Adjustment Tool
Removal Procedure
1. Apply the parking brake. 2. Shift the transmission into neutral. 3. Raise the vehicle. Refer to
Vehicle Lifting.
4. Remove the nut securing the transmission control lever to the manual shaft. 5. Remove the
transmission control lever from the manual shaft. 6. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the
switch. 7. Remove the bolts securing the park/neutral position switch to the transmission. 8.
Remove the park/neutral position switch from the manual shaft. If the park/neutral position switch
did not slide off the manual shaft, file the outer
edge of the manual shaft in order to remove any burrs.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the switch to the transmission manual shaft by aligning the switch hub flats with the
manual shaft flats.
2. Slide the switch onto the transmission manual shaft until the switch mounting bracket contacts
the mounting bosses on the transmission.
Important: If a new switch is being installed, the switch will come with a positive assurance bracket.
The positive assurance bracket aligns the new switch in it proper position for installation and the
use of neutral position adjustment tool will not be necessary.
3. Install the switch to the transmission with two bolts finger tight.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5763
4. Position the tool J 41364-A onto the park/neutral position switch. Ensure that the two slots on the
switch where the manual shaft is inserted are
lined up with the lower two tabs on the tool.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
5. Rotate the tool until the upper locator pin on the tool is lined up with the slot on the top of the
switch.
Tighten the bolts securing the switch to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
6. Remove the J 41364-A from the switch. If installing a new switch, remove the positive assurance
bracket at this time. 7. Connect the electrical connectors to the switch.
8. Install the transmission control lever to the manual shaft with the nut.
Tighten the control lever nut to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
9. Lower the vehicle.
10. Check the switch for proper operation. The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral)
positions only. If proper operation of the switch can
not be obtained, replace the switch.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Speed Sensor: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Speed Sensor Retainer Bolt
............................................................................................................................................ 10.5 13.5 Nm (7.7 - 10 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5767
VSS Assembly Connector, Wiring Harness Side
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5768
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) Replacement
^ Tools Required J 38417 Speed Sensor Remover
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting.
2. Remove the harness connector. 3. Remove the bolt. 4. Place a drain pan under the vehicle. 5.
Remove the vehicle speed sensor using J 38417. 6. Remove the O-ring seal.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the new speed sensor and O-ring seal using J 38417 2. Coat the seal with a thin film of
transmission fluid.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the bolt.
Tighten the bolt to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
4. Install the harness connector. 5. Lower the vehicle. 6. Refill the fluid as required.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission
Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Specifications
Transmission Fluid Temperature (TFT) Sensor Specifications
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 01-07-30-038D > Sep > 06 > A/T - Poor
Performance/MIL ON/DTC P0757
Valve Body: Customer Interest A/T - Poor Performance/MIL ON/DTC P0757
Bulletin No.: 01-07-30-038D
Date: September 12, 2006
TECHNICAL
Subject: Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) P0757 Set, Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Illuminated,
Poor Performance of Transmission, Transmission Slipping (Clean Transmission Valve Body and
Case Oil Passages of Debris)
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2003-2007 HUMMER H2
2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
with 4L60-E/4L65-E/4L70-E Automatic Transmission (RPOs M30/M32/M70)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2007 model year and the 4L70-E transmission. Also,
information has been added to Condition, Cause and Correction.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 01-07-30-038C (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Condition
Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions:
An illuminated MIL where DTC P0757 is found as a history code in the PCM or TCM.
No 3rd and 4th gear.
The transmission does not shift correctly.
The transmission feels like it shifts to Neutral or a loss of drive occurs.
The vehicle free wheels above 48 km/h (30 mph). High RPM needed to overcome the free
wheeling.
Cause
This condition may be caused by any of the following:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 01-07-30-038D > Sep > 06 > A/T - Poor
Performance/MIL ON/DTC P0757 > Page 5780
Chips or debris plugging the bleed orifice of the 2-3 shift solenoid (367). This will cause the
transmission to stay in 2nd gear when 3rd gear is commanded and return to 1st gear when 4th
gear is commanded.
A 2-3 shift valve (368) or 2-3 shuttle valve (369) that is stuck, restricted and/or hung-up in its bore.
This condition may also be an indication of a damaged 2-4 band or 3-4 clutches. This clutch
damage may generate debris causing the 2-3 shift valve line-up to stick in the valve body bore and
set DTC P0757.
Correction
Inspect the condition of the transmission fluid for signs of overheat or a burnt odor. If either is
noted, the transmission should be disassembled for further investigation and repaired as needed.
Inspect the inside of the oil pan for signs of clutch friction material. A small amount of friction
material in the bottom of the pan is normal. If a large amount of clutch material is noted in the fluid
or bottom pan, the transmission should be disassembled for further investigation and repaired as
needed.
Inspect and clean the 2-3 shift valve (368), the 2-3 shuttle valve (369) and the valve bore of
debris/metal chips.
Inspect and clean the 2-3 shift solenoid (367B) opening of debris/metal chips. While inspecting the
2-3 shift solenoid (367B), look for a screen over the solenoid opening. If the solenoid DOES NOT
have a screen, replace the solenoid. All current GMSPO stock shift solenoids have a screen over
the solenoid opening.
If clutch debris is found, it is also very important to inspect the pressure control (PC) solenoid valve
fluid screens. Clean or replace the PC solenoid as necessary. It is also important to flush and flow
check the transmission oil cooler using J 45096. Refer to SI "Automatic Transmission Oil Cooler
Flushing and Flow Test" for the procedure.
Refer to the appropriate Service Manual for additional diagnostic information and service
procedures.
Warranty Information
For repairs performed under warranty, use the applicable published labor code and information.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 01-07-30-036H >
Jan > 09 > A/T Control - DTC P0756 Diagnostic Tips
Valve Body: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T Control - DTC P0756 Diagnostic Tips
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 01-07-30-036H
Date: January 29, 2009
Subject: Diagnostic Tips for Automatic Transmission DTC P0756, Second, Third, Fourth Gear Start
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
with 4L60-E, 4L65-E or 4L70E Automatic Transmission (RPOs M30, M32 or M70)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2009 model year and add details regarding spacer plates.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 01-07-30-036G (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Some dealership technicians may have difficulty diagnosing DTC P0756, 2-3 Shift Valve
Performance on 4L60-E, 4L65-E or 4L70E automatic transmissions. As detailed in the Service
Manual, when the PCM detects a 4-3-3-4 shift pattern, DTC P0756 will set. Some customers may
also describe a condition of a second, third or fourth gear start that may have the same causes but
has not set this DTC yet. Below are some tips when diagnosing this DTC:
^ This is a performance code. This means that a mechanical malfunction exists.
^ This code is not set by electrical issues such as a damaged wiring harness or poor electrical
connections. Electrical problems would cause a DTC P0758, P0787 or P0788 to set.
^ The most likely cause is chips/debris plugging the filtered AFL oil at orifice # 29 on the top of the
spacer plate (48). This is a very small hole and is easily plugged by a small amount of debris. It is
important to remove the spacer plate and inspect orifice # 29 and the immediate area for the
presence of chips/debris. Also, the transmission case passage directly above this orifice and the
valve body passage directly below should be inspected and cleaned of any chips/debris. For 2003
and newer vehicles the spacer plate should be replaced. The service replacement spacer plate is a
bonded style with gaskets and solenoid filter screens bonded to the spacer plate. These screens
can help to prevent plugging of orifice # 29 caused by small debris or chips.
^ This code could be set if the 2-3 shift valve (368) were stuck or hung-up in its bore. Inspect the
2-3 shift valve (368) and the 2-3 shuttle valve (369) for free movement or damage and clean the
valves, the bore and the valve body passages.
^ This code could be set by a 2-3 shift solenoid (367b) if it were cracked, broken or leaking. Refer
to Shift Solenoid Leak Test in the appropriate Service Manual for the leak test procedure. Based on
parts return findings, a damaged or leaking shift solenoid is the least likely cause of this condition.
Simply replacing a shift solenoid will not correct this condition unless the solenoid has been found
to be cracked, broken or leaking.
It is important to also refer to the appropriate Service Manual or Service Information (SI) for further
possible causes of this condition.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 07-07-30-024 >
Sep > 07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning
Valve Body: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning
Bulletin No.: 07-07-30-024
Date: September 27, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Information on 4L60-E M30 Rear Wheel Drive Automatic Transmission Valve Body
Reconditioning, DTC P0741, P0756, P0894, Harsh 1-2 Shift
Models
The following new service information outlined in this bulletin will aid technicians in providing easy
to follow valve body reconditioning instructions and new illustrations to simplify reassembly of the
valve body. This service bulletin will also provide additional service information documents that are
related to the 4L60-E transmission.
Related Service Documents
DTC P0741 - Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) System - Stuck Off. Refer to Service Bulletin
04-07-30-041.
DTC P0756 - 2-3 Shift Solenoid Valve Performance - No First or Second Gear. Refer to Service
Bulletin 01-07-30-036F.
DTC P0894 - Transmission Component Slipping. Refer to Service Bulletin 06-07-30-007.
Harsh 1-2 Shift. Refer to Bulletin PIP3170E.
If valve body cleaning is not required, Do Not disassemble the bores unless it is necessary to verify
movement of valves.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 07-07-30-024 >
Sep > 07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 5790
Inspection Procedure
Using the exploded views in this bulletin, inspect each bore for freedom of valve(s) movement and
evidence of debris. Pay particular attention to those valves related to the customer's concern.
Verify movement of the valves in their normal installed position. Valves may become restricted
during removal or installation. This is normal due to small tolerances between the valves and
bores.
If a valve is restricted and cannot be corrected by cleaning the valve and bore, then replace the
valve body. Describe the restricted valve on the repair order.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 07-07-30-024 >
Sep > 07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 5791
Valve Body Spring and Bore Plug Chart (inch)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 07-07-30-024 >
Sep > 07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 5792
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 07-07-30-024 >
Sep > 07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 5793
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 07-07-30-024 >
Sep > 07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 5794
Left Side Control Valve Body Assembly
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 07-07-30-024 >
Sep > 07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 5795
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 07-07-30-024 >
Sep > 07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 5796
Right Side Control Valve Body Assembly
Be sure all solenoids are installed with the electrical connectors facing the non-machined (cast)
side of the valve body; otherwise the solenoids will bind against the transmission case as the valve
body bolts are tightened and damage may occur.
Disassembly/Reassembly
If a valve is restricted by a metal burr from machining that bore, remove the valve and burr, then
inspect movement in the valve's normal position. If no
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 07-07-30-024 >
Sep > 07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 5797
other debris or restrictions are found, then reassemble the valve body and install in the
transmission.
If the valve body has been contaminated with debris from another transmission component failure,
then disassemble all bores for complete cleaning of all valve body components. If possible, keep
individual bore parts separated for ease of reassembly. Use the illustrations in this bulletin for a
positive identification and location of individual parts:
Using GM Brake Clean, or equivalent, in a safe and clean environment (clean aluminum pan),
clean the valve body and dry it with compressed air. Use appropriate eye protection.
Clean individual valve body components with GM Brake Clean, or equivalent. Coat each valve with
clean ATF and reassemble in each bore. Check each valve for free movement during assembly of
each bore.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 01-07-30-038D >
Sep > 06 > A/T - Poor Performance/MIL ON/DTC P0757
Valve Body: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Poor Performance/MIL ON/DTC P0757
Bulletin No.: 01-07-30-038D
Date: September 12, 2006
TECHNICAL
Subject: Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) P0757 Set, Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Illuminated,
Poor Performance of Transmission, Transmission Slipping (Clean Transmission Valve Body and
Case Oil Passages of Debris)
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2003-2007 HUMMER H2
2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
with 4L60-E/4L65-E/4L70-E Automatic Transmission (RPOs M30/M32/M70)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2007 model year and the 4L70-E transmission. Also,
information has been added to Condition, Cause and Correction.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 01-07-30-038C (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Condition
Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions:
An illuminated MIL where DTC P0757 is found as a history code in the PCM or TCM.
No 3rd and 4th gear.
The transmission does not shift correctly.
The transmission feels like it shifts to Neutral or a loss of drive occurs.
The vehicle free wheels above 48 km/h (30 mph). High RPM needed to overcome the free
wheeling.
Cause
This condition may be caused by any of the following:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 01-07-30-038D >
Sep > 06 > A/T - Poor Performance/MIL ON/DTC P0757 > Page 5802
Chips or debris plugging the bleed orifice of the 2-3 shift solenoid (367). This will cause the
transmission to stay in 2nd gear when 3rd gear is commanded and return to 1st gear when 4th
gear is commanded.
A 2-3 shift valve (368) or 2-3 shuttle valve (369) that is stuck, restricted and/or hung-up in its bore.
This condition may also be an indication of a damaged 2-4 band or 3-4 clutches. This clutch
damage may generate debris causing the 2-3 shift valve line-up to stick in the valve body bore and
set DTC P0757.
Correction
Inspect the condition of the transmission fluid for signs of overheat or a burnt odor. If either is
noted, the transmission should be disassembled for further investigation and repaired as needed.
Inspect the inside of the oil pan for signs of clutch friction material. A small amount of friction
material in the bottom of the pan is normal. If a large amount of clutch material is noted in the fluid
or bottom pan, the transmission should be disassembled for further investigation and repaired as
needed.
Inspect and clean the 2-3 shift valve (368), the 2-3 shuttle valve (369) and the valve bore of
debris/metal chips.
Inspect and clean the 2-3 shift solenoid (367B) opening of debris/metal chips. While inspecting the
2-3 shift solenoid (367B), look for a screen over the solenoid opening. If the solenoid DOES NOT
have a screen, replace the solenoid. All current GMSPO stock shift solenoids have a screen over
the solenoid opening.
If clutch debris is found, it is also very important to inspect the pressure control (PC) solenoid valve
fluid screens. Clean or replace the PC solenoid as necessary. It is also important to flush and flow
check the transmission oil cooler using J 45096. Refer to SI "Automatic Transmission Oil Cooler
Flushing and Flow Test" for the procedure.
Refer to the appropriate Service Manual for additional diagnostic information and service
procedures.
Warranty Information
For repairs performed under warranty, use the applicable published labor code and information.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 01-07-30-030B >
Oct > 05 > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E Harsh 1-2 Upshift Diagnosis
Valve Body: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E Harsh 1-2 Upshift Diagnosis
Bulletin No.: 01-07-30-030B
Date: October 18, 2005
INFORMATION
Subject: 4L60-E/4L65-E Automatic Transmission Diagnostic Information on Harsh 1-2 Upshift
Models: 2001-2006 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2003-2006 HUMMER H2 2006
HUMMER H3 2005-2006 Saab 9-7X
with 4L60-E or 4L65-E Automatic Transmission
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years and models. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 01-07-30-030A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The following four conditions have been found to cause the majority of consistent, harsh 1-2 shift
comments.
^ Chips/Sediment/Debris/Contamination found in the valve body, 1-2 accumulator valve (371) bore,
may cause the 1-2 accumulator valve to stick or hang-up.
^ Chips/Sediment/Debris/Contamination found in the valve body, 4-3 sequence valve (383) bore,
may cause the 4-3 sequence valve to stick or hang-up.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 01-07-30-030B >
Oct > 05 > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E Harsh 1-2 Upshift Diagnosis > Page 5807
A cracked 1-2 accumulator piston (56) that is allowing fluid to leak by.
Mislocated/Missing valve body-to-spacer plate check balls (61).
When attempting to correct a consistent harsh 1-2 shift, the four conditions listed above should be
inspected as possible causes. It is important to also refer to the appropriate Service Manual for
further possible causes of this condition.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 01-07-30-030B >
Oct > 05 > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E Harsh 1-2 Upshift Diagnosis > Page 5808
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 01-07-30-030B >
Oct > 05 > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E Harsh 1-2 Upshift Diagnosis > Page 5809
This diagnostic table should be used when addressing a harsh 1-2 shift concern.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 01-07-30-036H > Jan >
09 > A/T Control - DTC P0756 Diagnostic Tips
Valve Body: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T Control - DTC P0756 Diagnostic Tips
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 01-07-30-036H
Date: January 29, 2009
Subject: Diagnostic Tips for Automatic Transmission DTC P0756, Second, Third, Fourth Gear Start
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
with 4L60-E, 4L65-E or 4L70E Automatic Transmission (RPOs M30, M32 or M70)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2009 model year and add details regarding spacer plates.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 01-07-30-036G (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Some dealership technicians may have difficulty diagnosing DTC P0756, 2-3 Shift Valve
Performance on 4L60-E, 4L65-E or 4L70E automatic transmissions. As detailed in the Service
Manual, when the PCM detects a 4-3-3-4 shift pattern, DTC P0756 will set. Some customers may
also describe a condition of a second, third or fourth gear start that may have the same causes but
has not set this DTC yet. Below are some tips when diagnosing this DTC:
^ This is a performance code. This means that a mechanical malfunction exists.
^ This code is not set by electrical issues such as a damaged wiring harness or poor electrical
connections. Electrical problems would cause a DTC P0758, P0787 or P0788 to set.
^ The most likely cause is chips/debris plugging the filtered AFL oil at orifice # 29 on the top of the
spacer plate (48). This is a very small hole and is easily plugged by a small amount of debris. It is
important to remove the spacer plate and inspect orifice # 29 and the immediate area for the
presence of chips/debris. Also, the transmission case passage directly above this orifice and the
valve body passage directly below should be inspected and cleaned of any chips/debris. For 2003
and newer vehicles the spacer plate should be replaced. The service replacement spacer plate is a
bonded style with gaskets and solenoid filter screens bonded to the spacer plate. These screens
can help to prevent plugging of orifice # 29 caused by small debris or chips.
^ This code could be set if the 2-3 shift valve (368) were stuck or hung-up in its bore. Inspect the
2-3 shift valve (368) and the 2-3 shuttle valve (369) for free movement or damage and clean the
valves, the bore and the valve body passages.
^ This code could be set by a 2-3 shift solenoid (367b) if it were cracked, broken or leaking. Refer
to Shift Solenoid Leak Test in the appropriate Service Manual for the leak test procedure. Based on
parts return findings, a damaged or leaking shift solenoid is the least likely cause of this condition.
Simply replacing a shift solenoid will not correct this condition unless the solenoid has been found
to be cracked, broken or leaking.
It is important to also refer to the appropriate Service Manual or Service Information (SI) for further
possible causes of this condition.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 07-07-30-024 > Sep >
07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning
Valve Body: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning
Bulletin No.: 07-07-30-024
Date: September 27, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Information on 4L60-E M30 Rear Wheel Drive Automatic Transmission Valve Body
Reconditioning, DTC P0741, P0756, P0894, Harsh 1-2 Shift
Models
The following new service information outlined in this bulletin will aid technicians in providing easy
to follow valve body reconditioning instructions and new illustrations to simplify reassembly of the
valve body. This service bulletin will also provide additional service information documents that are
related to the 4L60-E transmission.
Related Service Documents
DTC P0741 - Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) System - Stuck Off. Refer to Service Bulletin
04-07-30-041.
DTC P0756 - 2-3 Shift Solenoid Valve Performance - No First or Second Gear. Refer to Service
Bulletin 01-07-30-036F.
DTC P0894 - Transmission Component Slipping. Refer to Service Bulletin 06-07-30-007.
Harsh 1-2 Shift. Refer to Bulletin PIP3170E.
If valve body cleaning is not required, Do Not disassemble the bores unless it is necessary to verify
movement of valves.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 07-07-30-024 > Sep >
07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 5819
Inspection Procedure
Using the exploded views in this bulletin, inspect each bore for freedom of valve(s) movement and
evidence of debris. Pay particular attention to those valves related to the customer's concern.
Verify movement of the valves in their normal installed position. Valves may become restricted
during removal or installation. This is normal due to small tolerances between the valves and
bores.
If a valve is restricted and cannot be corrected by cleaning the valve and bore, then replace the
valve body. Describe the restricted valve on the repair order.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 07-07-30-024 > Sep >
07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 5820
Valve Body Spring and Bore Plug Chart (inch)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 07-07-30-024 > Sep >
07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 5821
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 07-07-30-024 > Sep >
07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 5822
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 07-07-30-024 > Sep >
07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 5823
Left Side Control Valve Body Assembly
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 07-07-30-024 > Sep >
07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 5824
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 07-07-30-024 > Sep >
07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 5825
Right Side Control Valve Body Assembly
Be sure all solenoids are installed with the electrical connectors facing the non-machined (cast)
side of the valve body; otherwise the solenoids will bind against the transmission case as the valve
body bolts are tightened and damage may occur.
Disassembly/Reassembly
If a valve is restricted by a metal burr from machining that bore, remove the valve and burr, then
inspect movement in the valve's normal position. If no
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 07-07-30-024 > Sep >
07 > A/T - Valve Body Reconditioning > Page 5826
other debris or restrictions are found, then reassemble the valve body and install in the
transmission.
If the valve body has been contaminated with debris from another transmission component failure,
then disassemble all bores for complete cleaning of all valve body components. If possible, keep
individual bore parts separated for ease of reassembly. Use the illustrations in this bulletin for a
positive identification and location of individual parts:
Using GM Brake Clean, or equivalent, in a safe and clean environment (clean aluminum pan),
clean the valve body and dry it with compressed air. Use appropriate eye protection.
Clean individual valve body components with GM Brake Clean, or equivalent. Coat each valve with
clean ATF and reassemble in each bore. Check each valve for free movement during assembly of
each bore.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 01-07-30-030B > Oct >
05 > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E Harsh 1-2 Upshift Diagnosis
Valve Body: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E Harsh 1-2 Upshift Diagnosis
Bulletin No.: 01-07-30-030B
Date: October 18, 2005
INFORMATION
Subject: 4L60-E/4L65-E Automatic Transmission Diagnostic Information on Harsh 1-2 Upshift
Models: 2001-2006 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2003-2006 HUMMER H2 2006
HUMMER H3 2005-2006 Saab 9-7X
with 4L60-E or 4L65-E Automatic Transmission
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years and models. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 01-07-30-030A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The following four conditions have been found to cause the majority of consistent, harsh 1-2 shift
comments.
^ Chips/Sediment/Debris/Contamination found in the valve body, 1-2 accumulator valve (371) bore,
may cause the 1-2 accumulator valve to stick or hang-up.
^ Chips/Sediment/Debris/Contamination found in the valve body, 4-3 sequence valve (383) bore,
may cause the 4-3 sequence valve to stick or hang-up.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 01-07-30-030B > Oct >
05 > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E Harsh 1-2 Upshift Diagnosis > Page 5831
A cracked 1-2 accumulator piston (56) that is allowing fluid to leak by.
Mislocated/Missing valve body-to-spacer plate check balls (61).
When attempting to correct a consistent harsh 1-2 shift, the four conditions listed above should be
inspected as possible causes. It is important to also refer to the appropriate Service Manual for
further possible causes of this condition.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 01-07-30-030B > Oct >
05 > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E Harsh 1-2 Upshift Diagnosis > Page 5832
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 01-07-30-030B > Oct >
05 > A/T - 4L60-E/4L65-E Harsh 1-2 Upshift Diagnosis > Page 5833
This diagnostic table should be used when addressing a harsh 1-2 shift concern.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5834
Valve Body: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Valve Body to Case Bolt
..................................................................................................................................................... 8.0 14.0 Nm (6 - 10 ft. lbs.) Transmission Fluid Pressure Manual Valve Position Switch to Valve Body
Bolt ............................................................... 8.0 - 14.0 Nm (6 - 10 ft. lbs.) Pressure Control
Solenoid Bracket to Valve Body Bolt
..................................................................................................... 8.0 - 14.0 Nm (6 - 10 ft. lbs.)
Detent Spring to Valve Body Bolt
.................................................................................................................................. 20.0 - 27.0 Nm
(15 - 20 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5835
Valve Body: Service and Repair
Valve Body and Pressure Switch Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Ensure that removal of the valve body is necessary before proceeding.
Important: The following components can be serviced without removing the valve body from the
transmission: ^
The torque converter clutch solenoid (1)
^ The pressure control solenoid (2)
^ The internal wiring harness (3)
^ The 2-3 shift solenoid (4)
^ The 1-2 shift solenoid (5)
^ The transmission fluid pressure manual valve position switch (6)
^ The 3-2 shift solenoid (7)
^ The Torque Converter Clutch Pulse Width Modulation (TCC PWM) solenoid (8)
2. Remove the fluid level indicator. 3. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 4. Remove the oil
pan, gasket, and filter.
5. Disconnect the internal wiring harness electrical connectors from the following components:
^ The transmission fluid pressure manual valve position switch (1)
^ The 1-2 shift solenoid (2)
^ The 2-3 shift solenoid (3)
^ The pressure control solenoid (4)
^ The TCC PWM solenoid (5)
^ The 3-2 shift solenoid (6)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5836
6. Remove the fluid indicator stop bracket bolt (2). 7. Remove the fluid indicator bracket (1).
8. Remove the TCC PWM solenoid retainer (2) with a small screwdriver. Rotate the solenoid (1) in
the bore, if necessary, until the flat part of the
retainer (2) is visible.
9. Remove the TCC PWM solenoid (1) in order to access the TCC solenoid retaining bolts.
10. Remove the TCC solenoid retaining bolts.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5837
11. Remove the TCC solenoid (with O-ring seal) and wiring harness from the control valve body.
12. Reposition the harness to the side of the transmission case.
13. Remove the control valve body bolts which retain the transmission fluid pressure switch to the
control valve body. 14. Remove the transmission fluid pressure switch.
15. Inspect the transmission fluid pressure switch for damage or debris.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5838
16. Remove the manual detent spring retaining bolt. 17. Remove the manual detent spring. 18.
Inspect the manual detent spring for cracks or damage.
Important: Keep the control valve body level when lowering it from the vehicle. This will prevent the
loss of checkballs located in the control valve body passages.
19. Remove the remaining control valve body bolts.
20. Carefully begin to lower the control valve body down from the transmission case while
simultaneously disconnecting the manual valve link.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the checkballs (1 - 7) in the valve body.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5839
2. Install the control valve body to the transmission case while simultaneously connecting the
manual valve link to the manual valve.
3. Verify that the manual valve link (3) is installed properly to the inside detent lever (1) and the
manual valve (2).
4. Install one bolt (M6 X 1.0 X 47.5) hand tight in the center (1) of the valve body to hold it in place.
Important: When installing bolts throughout this procedure, be sure to use the correct bolt size and
length in the correct location as specified.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5840
5. Do not install the transmission fluid indicator stop bracket and bolt at this time. Install but do not
tighten the control valve body bolts which retain
only the valve body directly. Each numbered bolt location corresponds to a specific bolt size and
length, as indicated by the following: ^
M6 X 1.0 X 65.0 (1)
^ M6 X 1.0 X 54.4 (2)
^ M6 X 1.0 X 47.5 (3)
^ M6 X 1.0 X 35.0 (4)
^ M8 X 1.0 X 20.0 (5)
^ M6 X 1.0 X 12.0 (6)
^ M6 X 1.0 X 18.0 (7)
6. Install the manual detent spring.
7. Install but do not tighten the manual detent spring retaining bolt. 8. Install the transmission fluid
pressure switch.
9. Install but do not tighten the control valve body bolts which retain the transmission fluid pressure
switch to the control valve body.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5841
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions. Torque valve body bolts in a spiral pattern
starting from the center. If the bolts are torqued at random, valve bores may be distorted and inhibit
valve operation.
10. Tighten the control valve body bolts in a spiral pattern starting from the center, as indicated by
the arrows.
Tighten the control valve body bolts (in sequence) to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
11. Ensure that the manual detent spring is aligned properly with the detent lever.
Tighten the manual detent spring bolt to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
12. Install the TCC solenoid with a new O-ring seal to the valve body.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5842
13. Install the TCC solenoid bolts.
Tighten the TCC solenoid retaining bolts to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
14. Install the internal wiring harness to the valve body. The internal wiring harness has a tab (1) on
the edge of the conduit.
15. Place the tab between the valve body and the pressure switch in the location shown (2). Press
the harness into position on the valve body bolt
bosses (1, 3).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5843
16. Install the TCC PWM solenoid (1) to the control valve body. 17. Install the TCC PWM solenoid
retainer (2).
18. Install the transmission fluid indicator stop bracket (1) and bolt (2).
Tighten the transmission fluid indicator stop bracket bolt to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
19. Connect the internal wiring harness electrical connectors to the following components:
^ The transmission fluid pressure manual valve position switch (1)
^ The 1-2 shift solenoid (2)
^ The 2-3 shift solenoid (3)
^ The pressure control solenoid (4)
^ The TCC PWM solenoid (5)
^ The 3-2 shift solenoid (6)
20. Install the transmission oil pan and filter. 21. Lower the vehicle. 22. Fill the transmission to the
proper level with DEXRON III transmission fluid.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > System Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > M/T - Hydraulic Clutch Bleeding Procedure Improvement
Clutch Hydraulic System: Technical Service Bulletins M/T - Hydraulic Clutch Bleeding Procedure
Improvement
Bulletin No.: 01-07-31-002B
Date: November 01, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Improved Bleeding Procedure for Hydraulic Clutch Release System
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2007 and
Prior Chevrolet and GMC 6-7F T-Series Medium Duty Tilt Cab Models 2007 and Prior Isuzu
F-Series Medium Duty Tilt Cab Models 2006-2007 HUMMER H3
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
01-07-31-002A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle). This bulletin is being issued to inform
dealers of an improved procedure to aid in the ease of bleeding the clutch hydraulic system for the
above listed vehicles. This procedure can be used anytime air is introduced into the hydraulic
system. Following this procedure may also reduce the number of unnecessary parts replaced for
low clutch pedal reserve and high shift effort.
Verify that all the lines and fittings are dry and secure.
Clean the dirt and grease from the reservoir cap in order to ensure that no foreign substances enter
the system.
Remove the reservoir cap.
Fill the reservoir to the proper level with the required fluid.
Attach the J 43485 (Adapter) to the J 35555 (Mity Vac), or equivalent.
Brake fluid will deteriorate the rubber on J 43485. Use a clean shop cloth to wipe away the fluid
after each use.
Place and hold the adapter on the reservoir filler neck to ensure a tight fit. In some cases, the
adapter will fit into the reservoir opening.
Apply a vacuum of 51-68 kPa (15-20 hg) and remove the adapter.
Refill the reservoir to the proper level.
Repeat Steps 6 and 7.
If needed, refill the reservoir and continue to pull a vacuum until no more bubbles can be seen in
the reservoir or until the fluid level no longer drops.
The vehicle will move if started in gear before the Actuator Cylinder is refilled and operational. Start
the vehicle the first time in neutral to help prevent personal injury from vehicle movement and see if
the transmission will shift easily into gear.
Pump the clutch pedal until firm (to refill actuator cylinder).
Add additional fluid if needed.
Test drive vehicle to ensure proper operation.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT > Shift
Interlock, CVT > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Shift Lock Control Feature Function
Shift Interlock: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Shift Lock Control Feature Function
Bulletin No.: 03-07-30-043A
Date: May 25, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Information Regarding Automatic Transmission Shift Lock Control Function
Models: 2007 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2007 and Prior HUMMER
H2, H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
with Automatic Transmission
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 03-07-30-043 (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle). This bulletin is being issued to better
explain how the Automatic Transmission Shift Lock Control (formerly known as Brake Transmission
Shift Interlock (BTSI)) feature is intended to operate. Revised wording regarding the shift lock
control system began appearing in the Owner Manuals beginning with the 2004 model year.
The shift lock control feature was intended to prevent drivers from shifting out of Park with the
vehicle running without the brakes applied. However, if the ignition switch is in the Accessory
(ACC) position, it may be possible on some vehicles to move the shift lever out of Park WITHOUT
first activating the brake.
The shift lock control system is ONLY active when the ignition switch is in the RUN or ON position.
This means that when the ignition switch is in the RUN or ON position, the shift lever cannot be
moved out of the Park position without activating the brake.
Some owners may feel that the shift lock control system prevents an unattended child from moving
the vehicle. Please stress to owners, as stated in the Owner Manual, that children should NEVER
be left unattended in a vehicle, even if the ignition key has been removed from the vehicle.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Differential Cover: Service and Repair
Rear Axle Housing Cover and Gasket Replacement Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Clean the rear axle cover area.
3. Remove the rear axle cover bolts. Place a container under the axle housing in order to retrieve
the lubricant. 4. Remove the rear axle cover from the axle housing. Pry the rear axle cover loose. 5.
Drain the lubricant from the axle housing.
6. Remove the fill plug. 7. Clean the gasket surfaces on the axle housing and the rear axle cover.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the new gasket.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 5858
2. Install the rear axle cover.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the rear axle cover bolts.
Tighten the bolts to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.) in a crosswise pattern.
4. Add axle lubricant to the axle housing. Use the proper fluid.
5. Install the fill plug.
Tighten the fill plug to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
6. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Axle Housing >
Component Information > Specifications
Differential Axle Housing: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Differential Housing Cover Bolts
........................................................................................................................................................ 30
Nm (22 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Axle Housing >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 5862
Differential Axle Housing: Service and Repair
Rear Axle Housing Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Drain the axle lubricant. 3. Remove the rear axle
assembly. 4. Remove the brake drums. 5. Remove the rear axle cover housing and gasket. 6.
Remove the axle shafts. 7. Remove the brake backing plates. 8. Remove the differential. 9.
Remove the drive pinion.
10. Remove the drive pinion shaft yoke and the seal.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the drive pinion. 2. Install the differential case. 3. Adjust the side bearing preload. 4. Adjust
the backlash. 5. Perform a gear tooth contact pattern check. 6. Install the brake backing plates. 7.
Install the axle shafts. 8. Install the rear axle housing cover and gasket. 9. Install the brake drums.
10. Install the rear axle. 11. Fill the axle with lubricant. 12. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Fill Plug, Differential > Component
Information > Specifications
Fill Plug: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Fill Plug ................................................................................................................................................
............................................... 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Fluid - Differential > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Fluid - Differential: Capacity Specifications
Rear Differential
Differential Oil Capacity
Capacity ...............................................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 3.5 Pints
Front Differential
Differential Oil Capacity
Front ....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 1.2L (2.6 Pints)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Fluid - Differential > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 5870
Fluid - Differential: Fluid Type Specifications
Differential Fluid Type
Front Grade .........................................................................................................................................
.................................................................................... GL-5 Viscosity ................................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
..... 80W-90 Rear Grade ......................................................................................................................
................................................................................................. Synthetic Viscosity .............................
..............................................................................................................................................................
........................ 75W-90
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Fluid - Differential > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Lubricant Level Check
Fluid - Differential: Service and Repair Lubricant Level Check
Lubricant Level Check
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Make sure the vehicle is level. 3. Inspect the rear
axle for leaks. Repair as necessary. 4. Clean the area around the rear axle fill plug.
5. Remove the rear axle fill plug. 6. Inspect the lubricant level.
Specification The lubricant level should be between 0 - 10 mm (0 - 0.4 inch) below the fill plug
opening.
7. If the level is low, add lubricant until the level is even with the bottom edge of the fill plug
opening. Use the proper fluid.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
8. Install the rear axle fill plug.
Tighten the rear axle fill plug to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
9. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Fluid - Differential > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Lubricant Level Check > Page 5873
Fluid - Differential: Service and Repair Lubricant Change
Lubricant Change Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting.
2. Remove the rear axle fill plug.
3. Remove the rear axle housing cover and the rear axle housing cover gasket. 4. Drain the
lubricant into a suitable container. 5. Inspect the drain plug for excessive metal particle
accumulation. This accumulation is symptomatic of extreme wear. 6. Clean the drain plug.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the new rear axle housing cover gasket and the rear axle housing cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Fluid - Differential > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Lubricant Level Check > Page 5874
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the rear axle housing cover bolts.
Tighten the rear axle housing cover bolts to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
3. Fill the rear axle. Use the proper fluid.
4. Install the rear axle fill plug.
Tighten the rear axle fill plug to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
5. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Bearing, Differential >
Component Information > Specifications
Pinion Bearing: Specifications
Pinion Bearing and Differential Bearing Preload
Pinion and Differential Case Bearing Preload, New Bearings
......................................................................................... 3.4 - 6.2 Nm (30 - 55 inch lbs.) Pinion and
Differential Case Bearing Preload, Used Bearings
........................................................................................ 2.8 - 5.6 Nm (25 - 50 inch lbs.) Pinion
Bearing Preload, New Bearings
........................................................................................................................... 1.7 - 3.4 Nm (15 - 30
inch lbs.) Pinion Bearing Preload, Used Bearings
........................................................................................................................... 1.1 - 2.8 Nm (10 - 25
inch lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Ring Gear, Differential > Component
Information > Specifications
Ring Gear: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Ring Gear Bolts ...................................................................................................................................
.............................................. 120 Nm (89 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential >
System Information > Service and Repair
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair
Rear Oil Seal and/or Bearing Replacement
^ Tools Required J 8092 Driver Handle
- J 23771 Axle Shaft Seal Installer
- J 34794 Bearing Installer
- J 23689 Axle Shaft Bearing Remover
- J 2619-01 Slide Hammer
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the tire and wheel assembly. 3. Remove
the rear axle housing cover. 4. Remove the axle shaft.
5. Remove the axle shaft seal and the bearing from the axle housing using the J 23689 (1) and the
J 2619-01 (2).
Installation Procedure
1. Install the axle shaft bearing using the J 34794 (1) and the J 8092 (2). Drive the axle shaft
bearing into the axle housing until the tool bottoms
against the tube.
2. Install the axle shaft seal using the J 23771. Drive the tool into the bore until the axle shaft seal
bottoms flush with the tube.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential >
System Information > Service and Repair > Page 5884
3. Install the axle shaft. 4. Install the rear axle housing cover. 5. Install the tire and wheel assembly.
6. Fill the rear axle. Use the proper fluid. 7. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Vibration Damper, Differential >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Vibration Damper: > 00-03-09-001A > Jul > 03
> Drivetrain - Booming Noise at Highway Speeds
Vibration Damper: Customer Interest Drivetrain - Booming Noise at Highway Speeds
Bulletin No.: 00-03-09-001A
Date: July 29, 2003
TECHNICAL
Subject: Rolling Boom Noise Inside Vehicle (Install Pinion Nose Damper and/or New Rear Leaf
Spring Dampers)
Models: 1995-2004 Chevrolet Astro Van Models 1995-2004 GMC Safari Van Models
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
00-03-09-001 (Section 03 - Suspension).
Condition
Some owners may comment about a "boom" noise inside the vehicle while driving at speeds
ranging between 97-105 km/h (60-65 mph). This condition is most noticeable from behind the
driver's seat.
Cause
The condition may result from an engine-firing harmonic, which becomes noticeable at torque
converter clutch (TCC) lock-up.
Correction
A new rear leaf spring damper kit (one per spring) has been developed, to be used in conjunction
with a pinion nose damper tuned to 86 Hertz (Hz), to reduce the resultant noise level.
AFFECTED VEHICLES MAY REQUIRE THE INSTALLATION OF THE PINION NOSE DAMPER,
THE SPRING DAMPERS, OR BOTH. THE INSTALLATION OF EITHER OF THESE DAMPERS IS
AT THE DISCRETION OF THE TECHNICIAN FOR BEST RESULTS. Use the following
procedures and the appropriate part number listed below.
Important:
Installation of these dampers will not totally eliminate the boom noise. The boom noise may only be
reduced to a more acceptable level. There may be other boom noises, such as body or exhaust,
associated with the vehicle and this fix may either diminish or enhance the noise. These other
noises should be addressed prior to the correction for the TCC boom dampener being installed.
Pinion Nose Damper Installation Procedure
Use Damper Kit, Rr. Axle Vib., P/N 15006567, for this procedure.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Vibration Damper, Differential >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Vibration Damper: > 00-03-09-001A > Jul > 03
> Drivetrain - Booming Noise at Highway Speeds > Page 5893
1. Place the template (1), P/N 15005879, on the bottom surface of the triangular flanged portion of
the rear axle.
2. Mark the hole locations.
3. Using a pin punch (1), mark the center location of the holes.
4. Drill a 11 mm (0.44 in) diameter hole in two places.
5. Clean out the holes, including the top and bottom surface of the axle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Vibration Damper, Differential >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Vibration Damper: > 00-03-09-001A > Jul > 03
> Drivetrain - Booming Noise at Highway Speeds > Page 5894
6. Install the rear axle pinion nose damper (1), P/N 15005880.
7. Install the rear axle pinion nose damper washers (2), P/N 15614758, and the nuts (3), P/N
11516072.
Tighten
Tighten each nut to 37-53 N.m (27-39 lb ft).
8. Rotate the driveshaft in order to verify that there is no contact between the driveshaft and the
pinion nose damper.
9. Test drive the vehicle. Inspect for contact between the driveshaft and the damper.
Rear Leaf Spring Damper Installation Procedure
Use Damper Kit, Rear Spring Vib., P/N 15042486, for this procedure.
1. Raise the vehicle. Support the rear axle. Refer to the General Information subsection of the
appropriate Service Manual for lifting and jacking information.
2. Remove the leaf spring. Refer to the Rear Suspension subsection of the appropriate Service
Manual for leaf spring replacement procedures.
3. Locate the rear spring clip closest to the shackle. This clip maintains the alignment of the rear
spring plates # 1 and # 2.
Note:
Do not damage the top surfaces of the # 1 and # 2 spring plates. Damage may cause premature
spring breakage.
4. Insert a wood wedge, no metal or sharp objects, between rear spring plates # 1 and # 2, located
forward of the clip. Allow enough clearance to work around. This should maximize the gap between
spring plates # 1 and # 2.
5. Grind off or, using an 11 mm (0.44 in) drill bit, drill out the rivet head holding the clip to the # 2
spring plate.
6. Remove the clip and the plastic clip liner from the spring assembly. Discard the spring clip only.
7. Knock out any remaining rivet residue from spring plate # 2.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Vibration Damper, Differential >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Vibration Damper: > 00-03-09-001A > Jul > 03
> Drivetrain - Booming Noise at Highway Speeds > Page 5895
8. Insert the stud bolt (2), P/N 15042491, from the top of spring plate # 2 (3) so that the bolt head
sits into the hole's counter sink.
9. Place the spring clip (1), P/N 15042492, over the stud so that the clip is in a similar position as
the original clip removed previously. Do not close the clip at this time.
10. Install the damper (8), P/N 15042487, onto the stud. Install the damper completely onto the
stud so that the clip is securely trapped between the # 2 spring plate (bottom) and the damper inner
sleeve.
Tighten
Tighten the damper to 30 N.m (22 lb ft) while holding the stud.
11. Install the jam nut (6), P/N 11508189, onto the stud until the nut is against the inner sleeve of
the damper.
Tighten
Tighten the nut to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
Note:
Do not break the clip liner or damage the top surface of the # 1 spring plate.
12. Install the plastic clip liner in the same orientation as when removed. The bolt head may stick
up above the top surface of the spring plate.
13. Remove the wood wedge.
14. Using a press or a vise, close the clip to the same position as the removed clip. The maximum
width of the installed clip is 91.5 mm (3.6 in) and the maximum height is 46.5 mm (1.8 in). This
ensures proper clearance to the body rails.
15. Install the leaf spring onto the vehicle. Refer to the Rear Suspension subsection of the
appropriate Service Manual for leaf spring replacement procedures.
16. Repeat steps 2-15 for the other spring.
Parts Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Vibration Damper, Differential >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Vibration Damper: > 00-03-09-001A > Jul > 03
> Drivetrain - Booming Noise at Highway Speeds > Page 5896
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Vibration Damper, Differential >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Vibration Damper: >
00-03-09-001A > Jul > 03 > Drivetrain - Booming Noise at Highway Speeds
Vibration Damper: All Technical Service Bulletins Drivetrain - Booming Noise at Highway Speeds
Bulletin No.: 00-03-09-001A
Date: July 29, 2003
TECHNICAL
Subject: Rolling Boom Noise Inside Vehicle (Install Pinion Nose Damper and/or New Rear Leaf
Spring Dampers)
Models: 1995-2004 Chevrolet Astro Van Models 1995-2004 GMC Safari Van Models
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
00-03-09-001 (Section 03 - Suspension).
Condition
Some owners may comment about a "boom" noise inside the vehicle while driving at speeds
ranging between 97-105 km/h (60-65 mph). This condition is most noticeable from behind the
driver's seat.
Cause
The condition may result from an engine-firing harmonic, which becomes noticeable at torque
converter clutch (TCC) lock-up.
Correction
A new rear leaf spring damper kit (one per spring) has been developed, to be used in conjunction
with a pinion nose damper tuned to 86 Hertz (Hz), to reduce the resultant noise level.
AFFECTED VEHICLES MAY REQUIRE THE INSTALLATION OF THE PINION NOSE DAMPER,
THE SPRING DAMPERS, OR BOTH. THE INSTALLATION OF EITHER OF THESE DAMPERS IS
AT THE DISCRETION OF THE TECHNICIAN FOR BEST RESULTS. Use the following
procedures and the appropriate part number listed below.
Important:
Installation of these dampers will not totally eliminate the boom noise. The boom noise may only be
reduced to a more acceptable level. There may be other boom noises, such as body or exhaust,
associated with the vehicle and this fix may either diminish or enhance the noise. These other
noises should be addressed prior to the correction for the TCC boom dampener being installed.
Pinion Nose Damper Installation Procedure
Use Damper Kit, Rr. Axle Vib., P/N 15006567, for this procedure.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Vibration Damper, Differential >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Vibration Damper: >
00-03-09-001A > Jul > 03 > Drivetrain - Booming Noise at Highway Speeds > Page 5902
1. Place the template (1), P/N 15005879, on the bottom surface of the triangular flanged portion of
the rear axle.
2. Mark the hole locations.
3. Using a pin punch (1), mark the center location of the holes.
4. Drill a 11 mm (0.44 in) diameter hole in two places.
5. Clean out the holes, including the top and bottom surface of the axle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Vibration Damper, Differential >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Vibration Damper: >
00-03-09-001A > Jul > 03 > Drivetrain - Booming Noise at Highway Speeds > Page 5903
6. Install the rear axle pinion nose damper (1), P/N 15005880.
7. Install the rear axle pinion nose damper washers (2), P/N 15614758, and the nuts (3), P/N
11516072.
Tighten
Tighten each nut to 37-53 N.m (27-39 lb ft).
8. Rotate the driveshaft in order to verify that there is no contact between the driveshaft and the
pinion nose damper.
9. Test drive the vehicle. Inspect for contact between the driveshaft and the damper.
Rear Leaf Spring Damper Installation Procedure
Use Damper Kit, Rear Spring Vib., P/N 15042486, for this procedure.
1. Raise the vehicle. Support the rear axle. Refer to the General Information subsection of the
appropriate Service Manual for lifting and jacking information.
2. Remove the leaf spring. Refer to the Rear Suspension subsection of the appropriate Service
Manual for leaf spring replacement procedures.
3. Locate the rear spring clip closest to the shackle. This clip maintains the alignment of the rear
spring plates # 1 and # 2.
Note:
Do not damage the top surfaces of the # 1 and # 2 spring plates. Damage may cause premature
spring breakage.
4. Insert a wood wedge, no metal or sharp objects, between rear spring plates # 1 and # 2, located
forward of the clip. Allow enough clearance to work around. This should maximize the gap between
spring plates # 1 and # 2.
5. Grind off or, using an 11 mm (0.44 in) drill bit, drill out the rivet head holding the clip to the # 2
spring plate.
6. Remove the clip and the plastic clip liner from the spring assembly. Discard the spring clip only.
7. Knock out any remaining rivet residue from spring plate # 2.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Vibration Damper, Differential >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Vibration Damper: >
00-03-09-001A > Jul > 03 > Drivetrain - Booming Noise at Highway Speeds > Page 5904
8. Insert the stud bolt (2), P/N 15042491, from the top of spring plate # 2 (3) so that the bolt head
sits into the hole's counter sink.
9. Place the spring clip (1), P/N 15042492, over the stud so that the clip is in a similar position as
the original clip removed previously. Do not close the clip at this time.
10. Install the damper (8), P/N 15042487, onto the stud. Install the damper completely onto the
stud so that the clip is securely trapped between the # 2 spring plate (bottom) and the damper inner
sleeve.
Tighten
Tighten the damper to 30 N.m (22 lb ft) while holding the stud.
11. Install the jam nut (6), P/N 11508189, onto the stud until the nut is against the inner sleeve of
the damper.
Tighten
Tighten the nut to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
Note:
Do not break the clip liner or damage the top surface of the # 1 spring plate.
12. Install the plastic clip liner in the same orientation as when removed. The bolt head may stick
up above the top surface of the spring plate.
13. Remove the wood wedge.
14. Using a press or a vise, close the clip to the same position as the removed clip. The maximum
width of the installed clip is 91.5 mm (3.6 in) and the maximum height is 46.5 mm (1.8 in). This
ensures proper clearance to the body rails.
15. Install the leaf spring onto the vehicle. Refer to the Rear Suspension subsection of the
appropriate Service Manual for leaf spring replacement procedures.
16. Repeat steps 2-15 for the other spring.
Parts Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Vibration Damper, Differential >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Vibration Damper: >
00-03-09-001A > Jul > 03 > Drivetrain - Booming Noise at Highway Speeds > Page 5905
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Axle Shaft Assembly: Service and Repair
Rear Axle Shaft Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the tire and wheel assembly. 3. Remove
the brake drums. 4. Remove the rear cover and the gasket.
5. Remove the pinion shaft locking bolt.
6. On axles without a locking differential, remove the pinion shaft.
7. On axles with a locking differential, remove the shaft part way. Rotate the case until the pinion
shaft touches the housing.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5910
8. On axles with a locking differential, use a screwdriver, or a similar tool, in order to enter the
differential case and rotate the lock (1) until the lock
aligns with the thrust block (2).
9. Push the flange of the axle shaft (1) toward the differential.
10. Remove the C-lock (4) from the button end of the axle shaft (1).
Important: When removing the axle shaft, do not rotate the shaft. Rotating the shaft will misalign
the gears. Misaligning the gears will make the assembly difficult.
11. Remove the axle shaft (1) from the housing (5).
Installation Procedure
Important: Carefully insert the axle shaft in order to not damage the seal.
1. Install the axle shaft (1) into the rear axle housing (5).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5911
2. Slide the axle shaft (1) into place allowing the splines to engage the differential side gear. 3. On
axles without a locking differential, place the lock (4) on the button end of the axle shaft (1). 4. On
axles with a locking differential, keep the pinion shaft partially withdrawn.
5. On axles with a locking differential, place the C-lock (1) on the axle shaft (3) so that the ends are
flush with the thrust block (2). 6. Pull the shaft flange outward in order to seat the lock in the
differential gear. 7. Align the hole in the pinion shaft with the bolt hole in the differential case.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
8. Install the new pinion shaft locking bolt.
Tighten the pinion shaft locking bolt to 25 Nm (19 ft. lbs.).
9. Install the rear cover and the gasket.
10. Install the brake drums. 11. install the tire and wheel assembly. 12. Fill the rear axle. Use the
proper fluid. 13. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seals and Gaskets: > 08-07-30-009B >
May > 08 > A/T - 4T80E, Slips in Gear/L/H Axle Seal Leaks
Seals and Gaskets: Customer Interest A/T - 4T80E, Slips in Gear/L/H Axle Seal Leaks
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 08-07-30-009B
Date: May 01, 2008
Subject: HYDRA-MATIC(R) Front Wheel Drive 4T80-E (MH1) Left Front Axle Seal Leak,
Transmission Slips in Gear (Replace Third Clutch Housing with Revised Service Part)
Models: 2001-2008 GM Passenger Cars
with HYDRA-MATIC(R) Front Wheel Drive 4T80-E Automatic Transmission (RPO - MH1)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being updated to revise the Warranty Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 08-07-30-009A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a transmission oil leak and/or that the transmission slips in
gear.
Cause
An oil leak may be caused by bushing wear in the third clutch housing, causing excessive fluid
build-up at axe sea.
Correction
Important:
DO NOT replace the transmission for above concerns.
Replace the third clutch housing with service P/N 8682114, which has revised bushing material to
extend life and reduce left front axle seal leaks. Refer to Automatic/Transaxle - 4T80-E
Transmission Off-Vehicle Repair Instructions for the replacement of the third clutch housing in SI.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: >
08-07-30-009B > May > 08 > A/T - 4T80E, Slips in Gear/L/H Axle Seal Leaks
Seals and Gaskets: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 4T80E, Slips in Gear/L/H Axle Seal Leaks
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 08-07-30-009B
Date: May 01, 2008
Subject: HYDRA-MATIC(R) Front Wheel Drive 4T80-E (MH1) Left Front Axle Seal Leak,
Transmission Slips in Gear (Replace Third Clutch Housing with Revised Service Part)
Models: 2001-2008 GM Passenger Cars
with HYDRA-MATIC(R) Front Wheel Drive 4T80-E Automatic Transmission (RPO - MH1)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being updated to revise the Warranty Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 08-07-30-009A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a transmission oil leak and/or that the transmission slips in
gear.
Cause
An oil leak may be caused by bushing wear in the third clutch housing, causing excessive fluid
build-up at axe sea.
Correction
Important:
DO NOT replace the transmission for above concerns.
Replace the third clutch housing with service P/N 8682114, which has revised bushing material to
extend life and reduce left front axle seal leaks. Refer to Automatic/Transaxle - 4T80-E
Transmission Off-Vehicle Repair Instructions for the replacement of the third clutch housing in SI.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page
5925
Seals and Gaskets: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 08-07-30-009B Date: 080501
A/T - 4T80E, Slips in Gear/L/H Axle Seal Leaks
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 08-07-30-009B
Date: May 01, 2008
Subject: HYDRA-MATIC(R) Front Wheel Drive 4T80-E (MH1) Left Front Axle Seal Leak,
Transmission Slips in Gear (Replace Third Clutch Housing with Revised Service Part)
Models: 2001-2008 GM Passenger Cars
with HYDRA-MATIC(R) Front Wheel Drive 4T80-E Automatic Transmission (RPO - MH1)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being updated to revise the Warranty Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 08-07-30-009A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a transmission oil leak and/or that the transmission slips in
gear.
Cause
An oil leak may be caused by bushing wear in the third clutch housing, causing excessive fluid
build-up at axe sea.
Correction
Important:
DO NOT replace the transmission for above concerns.
Replace the third clutch housing with service P/N 8682114, which has revised bushing material to
extend life and reduce left front axle seal leaks. Refer to Automatic/Transaxle - 4T80-E
Transmission Off-Vehicle Repair Instructions for the replacement of the third clutch housing in SI.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Technical Service Bulletin # 08-07-30-009B Date: 080501
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page
5926
A/T - 4T80E, Slips in Gear/L/H Axle Seal Leaks
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 08-07-30-009B
Date: May 01, 2008
Subject: HYDRA-MATIC(R) Front Wheel Drive 4T80-E (MH1) Left Front Axle Seal Leak,
Transmission Slips in Gear (Replace Third Clutch Housing with Revised Service Part)
Models: 2001-2008 GM Passenger Cars
with HYDRA-MATIC(R) Front Wheel Drive 4T80-E Automatic Transmission (RPO - MH1)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being updated to revise the Warranty Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 08-07-30-009A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a transmission oil leak and/or that the transmission slips in
gear.
Cause
An oil leak may be caused by bushing wear in the third clutch housing, causing excessive fluid
build-up at axe sea.
Correction
Important:
DO NOT replace the transmission for above concerns.
Replace the third clutch housing with service P/N 8682114, which has revised bushing material to
extend life and reduce left front axle seal leaks. Refer to Automatic/Transaxle - 4T80-E
Transmission Off-Vehicle Repair Instructions for the replacement of the third clutch housing in SI.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Technical Service Bulletin # 08-07-30-009B Date: 080501
A/T - 4T80E, Slips in Gear/L/H Axle Seal Leaks
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 08-07-30-009B
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page
5927
Date: May 01, 2008
Subject: HYDRA-MATIC(R) Front Wheel Drive 4T80-E (MH1) Left Front Axle Seal Leak,
Transmission Slips in Gear (Replace Third Clutch Housing with Revised Service Part)
Models: 2001-2008 GM Passenger Cars
with HYDRA-MATIC(R) Front Wheel Drive 4T80-E Automatic Transmission (RPO - MH1)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being updated to revise the Warranty Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 08-07-30-009A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a transmission oil leak and/or that the transmission slips in
gear.
Cause
An oil leak may be caused by bushing wear in the third clutch housing, causing excessive fluid
build-up at axe sea.
Correction
Important:
DO NOT replace the transmission for above concerns.
Replace the third clutch housing with service P/N 8682114, which has revised bushing material to
extend life and reduce left front axle seal leaks. Refer to Automatic/Transaxle - 4T80-E
Transmission Off-Vehicle Repair Instructions for the replacement of the third clutch housing in SI.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications
Wheel Bearing: Specifications
"Information not supplied by the manufacturer"
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed
Wheel Bearing: Testing and Inspection Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed
Wheel Bearings Diagnosis (Sealed)
- Tools Required J 8001 Dial Indicator
The following procedure describes how to inspect the wheel bearing/hub for excessive looseness.
If you are inspecting the wheel bearing/hub for excessive runout, refer to Tire and Wheel Assembly
Runout Measurement - On-Vehicle.
Important: If you are inspecting the FRONT wheel bearing/hub, support the front of the vehicle by
the lower control arms in order to load the lower ball joint.
1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Mount and secure the J 8001 to a
stand. 3. Ensure that the J 8001 contacts the vertical surface of the wheel as close as possible to
the top wheel stud. 4. Push and pull on the TOP of the tire. 5. Inspect the total movement indicated
by the J 8001. 6. If the measurement exceeds 0.127 mm (0.005 inch), replace the wheel
bearing/hub.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed > Page 5933
Wheel Bearing: Testing and Inspection Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Tapered
Wheel Bearings Diagnosis (Tapered)
Tapered Roller Bearing Diagnosis
The following procedure describes how to inspect the wheel bearing for excessive looseness. If
excessive wheel bearing looseness is present, adjust the wheel bearings. If excessive looseness is
still present after adjustment, inspect the wheel bearings. Consider the following factors when
diagnosing the wheel bearing condition: General condition of the following parts during disassembly and inspection: Wheel bearings
- Races
- Seals
- Lubricant
- Steering Knuckle
- Classify the failure of the wheel bearing with the aid of the illustrations.
- Determine the cause of the wheel bearing failure.
- Replace the damaged parts.
Abrasive Roller Wear
The pattern on the races and the rollers is caused by fine abrasives. 1. Clean all of the parts and
the housings. 2. Check the seals and the bearings. 3. Replace leaky seals, rough, or noisy
bearings.
Abrasive Step Wear
The pattern on the roller ends is caused by fine abrasives. 1. Clean all of the parts and the
housings. 2. Check the seals and the bearings. 3. Replace leaky seals, rough, or noisy bearings.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed > Page 5934
Galling
The metal smears on the roller ends are due to overheating, lubricant failure, or lubricant overload.
1. Check the seals. 2. Check for proper lubrication. 3. Clean all of the parts and the housings. 4.
Replace the bearing.
Etching
The bearing surfaces appear gray or grayish black in color, with related etching away of material
usually at roller spacing. 1. Check the seals. 2. Check for proper lubrication. 3. Clean all of the
parts and the housings. 4. Replace the bearings.
Bent Cage
When a cage is damaged due to improper handling or improper tool usage. Replace the bearing.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed > Page 5935
Bent Cage
The cage may be damaged due to improper handling or improper tool usage. Replace the bearing.
Cage Wear
The wear around the outside diameter of the cage and the roller pockets is caused by abrasive
material or inefficient lubrication. 1. Check the seals. 2. Clean all the parts and the housings. 3.
Replace the bearings.
Indentations
The surface depressions on the race and the rollers are caused by hard particles of foreign matter.
1. Check the seals. 2. Clean all the parts and the housings. 3. Replace the bearings.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed > Page 5936
Frettage
The corrosion caused by small relative movement of parts with no lubrication. 1. Check the seals.
2. Check for proper lubrication. 3. Clean all the parts and the housings. 4. Replace the bearings.
Smears
The smearing of the metal is due to slippage. Slippage can be caused by the following factors: Poor fits
- Lubrication
- Overheating
- Overloads
- Handling damage
If this condition occurs, perform the following: 1. Check the seals. 2. Check for proper fit. 3. Check
for proper lubrication. 4. Clean all the parts and the housings. 5. Replace the bearings.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed > Page 5937
Stain Discoloration
The discoloration on the bearings is caused by incorrect lubrication or moisture and ranges in color
from light brown to black. Reuse the bearing if you can remove the stains with light polishing and
there is no evidence of overheating. If this condition occurs, perform the following: 1. Check the
seals. 2. Clean all the parts and the housings. 3. Replace the bearings, if necessary.
Heat Discoloration
The heat discoloration on the bearings ranges from faint yellow to dark blue and results from
overload or an incorrect lubricant. Excessive heat causes softening of the races or the rollers. In
order to check for loss of temper on the races and the rollers, perform a file test. A file drawn over a
tempered part will grab and cut the metal and fail the file test. A file drawn over a hard part will glide
with no metal cutting. If overheating damage is indicated, perform the following: 1. Check the seals.
2. Clean all the parts and the housings. 3. Replace the bearings.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed > Page 5938
Misalignment
The outer race is misaligned due to a foreign object. 1. Clean all the parts and the housings. 2.
Ensure the races are properly seated. 3. Replace the bearing.
Cracked Inner Race
The race is cracked due to improper fit, cocking, or poor bearing seats. 1. Clean all the parts and
the housings. 2. Ensure the races are properly seated. 3. Replace the bearing.
Fatigue Spalling
The surface is flaked with metal due to bearing fatigue. 1. Clean all the parts and the housings. 2.
Replace the bearing.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed > Page 5939
Brinelling
The surface indentations in the race way are caused by the rollers under impact loading or from
vibration while the bearing is not rotating. 1. Clean all the parts and the housings. 2. Replace the
bearing.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 5940
Wheel Bearing: Adjustments
Front Wheel Bearing Adjustment
Important: ^
Adjust the front wheel bearings correctly in order to ensure the front suspension functions properly.
^ The bearings must be a slip fit on the spindle.
^ Lubricate the bearings in order to ensure the bearings will creep.
^ The spindle nut must have a free-running fit on the spindle threads.
1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle with safety stands. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the
wheel cover. 3. Remove the dust cap from the wheel hub.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Remove the cotter pin.
^ Tighten the wheel hub nut to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.), while turning the wheel forward by hand. This will
seat the bearings.
Important: Do not back the nut off more than 1/2 flat.
5. Adjust the nut to a finger tight position by hand. Then, back the nut off until the hole in the
spindle aligns with a slot in the nut. 6. Install a new cotter pin.
6.1. Make sure the cotter pin ends do not interfere with the cap. Bend the ends of the cotter pin
against the nut. Cut off any extra pin length.
6.2. Measure the endplay. Proper endplay is 0.0 - 0.13 mm (0.001 - 0.005 inch).
7. Install the dust cap to the wheel hub. 8. Install the wheel cover. 9. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 5941
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair
"For information regarding this component please refer to wheel hub service and repair"
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut >
Component Information > Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
wheel hub nut 12 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Specifications
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5950
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Description and Operation
Propeller Shaft Description and Operation
The Propeller Shaft is a tube with universal joints at both ends which do not require periodic
maintenance, that transmit power from the transfer case or transmission output shaft to the
differential.
Front Propeller Shaft Description The front propeller shaft transmits rotating force from the transfer
case to the front differential when the transfer case is engaged. The front propeller shaft connects
to the transfer case using a splined slip joint.
One Piece Propeller Shaft Description A one piece propeller shaft uses a splined slip joint to
connect the driveline to the transmission or transfer case.
Universal Joint Description The universal joint is connected to the propeller shaft. The universal
consist of 4 caps with needle bearings and grease seals mounted on the trunnions of a cross or
spider. These bearings and caps are greased at the factory and no periodic maintenance is
required. There are 2 universal joints used in a one piece propeller shaft. The bearings and caps
are pressed into the yokes and held in place with snap rings, except for 2 bearings on some
models which are strapped onto the pinion flange of the differential. Universal joints are designed
to handle the effects of various loads and rear axle windup conditions during acceleration and
braking. The universal joint operates efficiently and safely within the designed angle variations.
When the design angles are exceeded, the operational life of the joint decreases.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Diagnostic Starting Point - Propeller Shaft
Begin the system diagnosis by reviewing the system Description and Operation. Reviewing the
Description and Operation information will help you determine the correct symptom diagnostic
procedure when a malfunction exists. Reviewing the Description and Operation information will
also help you determine if the condition described by the customer is normal operation. Refer to
Symptoms - Propeller Shaft order to identify the correct procedure for diagnosing the system and
where the procedure is located. See: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/- Symptoms Propeller Shaft
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 5953
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
- Symptoms - Propeller Shaft
Symptoms - Propeller Shaft
Before beginning diagnosis, review the system description and operation in order to familiarize
yourself with the system function.
Classifying the Symptom Propeller Shaft symptoms can usually be classified into the following
categories: ^
Leaks
^ Noises
^ Vibrations
Leak and noise related symptoms are diagnosed within the Propeller Shaft section. For vibration
related symptoms, refer to Diagnostic Starting Point Vibration Diagnosis and Correction.
Visual/Physical Inspection ^
Inspect the system for aftermarket devices which could affect the operation of the Propeller Shaft.
^ Inspect the easily accessible or visible system components for obvious damage or conditions
which could cause the symptom.
Symptom List Refer to a symptom diagnostic procedure from the following list in order to diagnose
the symptom: ^
Leak at Front Slip Yoke See: Leak at Front Slip Yoke
^ Universal Joint Noise See: Universal Joint Noise
^ Ping, Snap, or Click Noise See: Ping, Snap, or Click Noise
^ Knock or Clunk Noise See: Knock or Clunk Noise
^ Scraping Noise See: Scraping Noise
^ Squeak Noise See: Squeak Noise
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 5954
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 5955
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Service and Repair
Propeller Shaft Replacement - Rear
Removal Procedure
Important: The driveline components in this vehicle are factory system-balanced. System balance
provides a smoother running driveline operation. Observe the position of all the driveline
components. Accurately mark the relationship of the components before removal. These
components include the propeller shafts, the drive axles, the pinion flanges, and the output shafts.
All components must be reassembled in the exact relationship to each other as they were before
removal. Follow the specifications, the torque values, and any measurements made prior to
disassembly in order to maintain the factory system balance.
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Accurately reference mark the propeller shaft.
3. Remove the bolts from the rear of the pinion flange. 4. Remove the retainers.
Important: Do not pound on the original propeller shaft yoke ears. The injection joints may fracture.
Never pry or place any tool between a yoke and a universal joint.
5. Remove the yoke and cross assembly. 6. Tape the bearing cups in order to prevent the loss of
bearing rollers. 7. Remove the propeller shaft by using the following procedure:
7.1. Slide the propeller shaft forward.
7.2. Lower the propeller shaft and remove under the rear axle.
7.3. Do not allow the universal joint to incline greatly; the joint may fracture.
8. Clean all the parts with a suitable solvent. 9. Inspect the outer diameter of the nylon injected
yoke for burrs. Burring damages the transmission seal.
10. Inspect for proper installation and uniform seating of the bearing cups. 11. Inspect the slip yoke
splines for wear. 12. Inspect for twisted slip yoke splines or possibly the wrong universal joint.
Replace the parts as necessary.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the propeller shaft into the transmission.
Important: Install a new universal joint whenever a slip joint or companion flange is serviced.
2. Lubricate the slip joint. 3. Install the yoke and cross assembly onto the pinion flange. 4. Align the
reference marks on the pinion flange and the propeller shaft rear yoke. Seat the yoke properly. 5.
Install the retainers.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 5956
6. Install the bolts into the pinion flange.
Tighten the bolts to 36 Nm (27 ft. lbs.).
7. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 5957
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Universal Joint Replacement - Nylon Injected Ring
Universal Joint: Service and Repair Universal Joint Replacement - Nylon Injected Ring
Universal Joint Replacement - Nylon Injected Ring
^ Tools Required J 9522-3 U Joint Bearing Separator
- J 9522-5 U Joint Bearing Spacer Remover
Removal Procedure
Notice: Never clamp propeller shaft tubing in a vise. Clamping propeller shaft tubing in a vise could
dent or deform the tube causing an imbalance or unsafe condition. Always clamp on one of the
yokes and support the shaft horizontally. Avoid damaging the slip yoke sealing surface. Nicks may
damage the bushing or cut the lip seal.
1. Remove the propeller shaft. 2. Support the propeller shaft in a line horizontal with the table of a
press. 3. Mark the propeller shaft in order to show which end connects to the transmission or
transfer case and which end connects to the rear or front axle. 4. Place the universal joint so that
the lower ear of the yoke is supported on a 30 mm (1 1/8 inch) socket.
5. In order to shear the plastic retaining ring on the bearing cup, place the J 9522-3 on the on the
open horizontal bearing cups and press the lower
bearing cup out of the yoke ear.
6. If the bearing cup is not completely removed, lift the cross, and insert J 9522-5 between the seal
and bearing cup being removed. Continue
pressing the bearing cup out of the yoke.
7. Rotate the propeller shaft and press the opposite bearing cup out of the yoke. 8. Disassemble
the cross from the yoke. 9. Remove the remaining universal joint parts from the yoke.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Universal Joint Replacement - Nylon Injected Ring >
Page 5962
10. If you are replacing the front universal joint (rear axle only), remove the bearing cups in the slip
yoke in the same manner. 11. Inspect the retaining ring grooves for plastic. 12. Inspect the bearing
cup bores for burrs or imperfections. 13. Clean the remains of the sheared plastic bearing retainers
from the grooves in the yoke. 14. The sheared plastic may prevent the bearing cups from being
pressed into place and thus prevent the bearing retainers from being properly seated.
Installation Procedure
1. Remove the bearing cups from the new universal joint journals.
2. Coat the needle bearings in the bearing cups with a thin layer of chassis grease. Use your finger
to apply the grease. 3. Install one bearing cup part way into one side of the yoke. 4. Turn the yoke
ear towards the bottom. 5. Install the cross into the yoke so that the trunnion seats freely into the
bearing cup. 6. With the trunnion seated in the bearing cup, press the bearing cup into the yoke
until it is flush with the yoke ear.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Universal Joint Replacement - Nylon Injected Ring >
Page 5963
7. Install the opposite bearing cup part way into the yoke ear. Make sure that the trunnions are
started straight and true into both bearing cups.
Important: If the bearing cup seems to bind or hang-up, stop pressing. Check the needle bearings
for misalignment in the bearing cup.
8. Press the opposite bearing cup into the yoke ear.
^ Work the cross all the time.
^ Check for free unbinding movement of the trunnions in the bearing cups.
^ Press the bearing cup into the yoke until the bearing retainer groove clears the inside of the yoke.
9. Install the bearing retainer in the retainer groove.
^ Continue pressing until you can snap both retainers into place.
^ A small amount of chassis grease may help the snap ring seat in the bearing cup groove.
10. It the retainer does not seat, spring the yoke slightly with a firm blow from a dead blow hammer.
11. Install the propeller shaft.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Universal Joint Replacement - Nylon Injected Ring >
Page 5964
Universal Joint: Service and Repair Universal Joint Replacement - External Snap Ring
Universal Joint Replacement - External Snap Ring
^ Tools Required J 9522-3 U Joint Bearing Separator
- J 9522-5 U Joint Bearing Spacer Remover
Removal Procedure
Notice: Never clamp propeller shaft tubing in a vise. Clamping propeller shaft tubing in a vise could
dent or deform the tube causing an imbalance or unsafe condition. Always clamp on one of the
yokes and support the shaft horizontally. Avoid damaging the slip yoke sealing surface. Nicks may
damage the bushing or cut the lip seal.
1. Remove the propeller shaft. 2. Support the propeller shaft in a line horizontal with the table of a
press. 3. Mark the propeller shaft in order to show which end connects to the transmission or
transfer case and which end connects to the rear or front axle. 4. Remove the snap rings.
^ Pinch the ends of the snap ring together with a pair of pliers.
^ If a snap ring does not readily snap out of the groove in the yoke, tap the end of the bearing cup
lightly in order to relieve the pressure from the ring.
5. Place the universal joint so that the lower ear of the yoke is supported on a 30 mm (1 1/8 inch)
socket.
6. Press the lower bearing cup out of the yoke ear. Use the J 9522-3.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Universal Joint Replacement - Nylon Injected Ring >
Page 5965
7. If the bearing cup is not completely removed, do the following:
7.1. Lift the cross and insert the J 9522-5 between the seal and the bearing cup.
7.2. Continue pressing the bearing cup out of the yoke.
8. Rotate the propeller shaft and press the opposite bearing cup out of the yoke.
9. Remove the cross from the yoke.
10. Remove the remaining universal joint parts from the yoke. 11. If you are replacing the front
universal joint (rear axle only), remove the bearing cups in the slip yoke in the same manner. 12.
Inspect the retaining ring grooves for dirt, corrosion, or pieces of the old ring. 13. Inspect the
bearing cup bores for burrs or imperfections.
Important: Corrosion or dirt may prevent the bearing cup installation and may prohibit the proper
seating of the bearing retainers.
14. Clean the retaining ring grooves.
Installation Procedure
1. Remove the bearing cups from the new universal joint journals.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Universal Joint Replacement - Nylon Injected Ring >
Page 5966
2. Coat the needle bearings in the bearing cups with a thin layer of the grease that is present on
the journal. Use your finger to apply the grease. 3. Install one bearing cup part way into one side of
the yoke. 4. Turn the yoke ear towards the bottom. 5. Install the cross into the yoke so that the
trunnion seats freely into the bearing cup.
6. With the trunnion seated in the bearing cup, press the bearing cup into the yoke until it is flush
with the yoke ear. 7. Install the opposite bearing cup part way into the yoke ear. 8. Make sure that
the trunnions are started straight and true into both bearing cups.
Important: If the bearing cup seems to bind or hang-up, stop pressing. Check the needle bearings
for misalignment in the bearing cup.
9. Press the opposite bearing cup into the yoke ear.
^ Work the cross all the time.
^ Check for free unbinding movement of the trunnions in the bearing cups.
^ Press the bearing cup into the yoke until the bearing retainer groove is visible over the top of the
bearing cup.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Universal Joint Replacement - Nylon Injected Ring >
Page 5967
10. Install the bearing retainer in the retainer groove.
^ Continue pressing until you can snap both retainers into place.
^ A small amount of chassis grease may help the snap ring seat in the bearing cup groove.
11. If the retainer does not seat, spring the yoke slightly with a firm blow from a dead blow hammer.
12. Install the propeller shaft.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flex Plate > Component Information > Specifications
Flex Plate: Specifications
Engine Flywheel Bolt ...........................................................................................................................
............................................................... 74 ft. lbs. Flywheel to Torque Converter Bolt ......................
.............................................................................................................................................. 46 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flex Plate > Component Information > Specifications > Page
5971
Flex Plate: Service and Repair
Engine Flywheel Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the transmission assembly.
2. Remove the bolts and the engine flywheel. 3. Clean and inspect all parts.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the engine flywheel to the crankshaft. 2. Align the locator hole to the pin.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flex Plate > Component Information > Specifications > Page
5972
3. Install the engine flywheel bolts.
Tighten the engine flywheel bolts in sequence to 100 Nm (74 ft. lbs.).
4. Install the transmission assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Manual Transmission - M/T Operating Characteristics
Manual Transmission/Transaxle: Technical Service Bulletins Manual Transmission - M/T Operating
Characteristics
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 03-07-29-004G
Date: December 15, 2010
Subject: Manual Transmission Operating Characteristics
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2009 and Prior
Chevrolet and GMC Medium Duty Trucks 2006-2010 HUMMER H3 with Manual Transmission
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year and to add Cold Operation
information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 03-07-29-004F (Section 07 Transmission/Transaxle).
Important Even though this bulletin attempts to cover operating characteristics of manual
transmissions, it cannot be all inclusive. Be sure to compare any questionable concerns to a similar
vehicle and if possible, with similar mileage. Even though many of the conditions are described as
characteristics and may not be durability issues, GM may attempt to improve specific issues for
customer satisfaction.
The purpose of this bulletin is to assist in identifying characteristics of manual transmissions that
repair attempts will not change. The following are explanations and examples of conditions that will
generally occur in all manual transmissions. All noises will vary between transmissions due to build
variation, type of transmission (usually the more heavy duty, the more noise), type of flywheel and
clutch, level of insulation, etc.
Basic Information
Many transmission noises are created by the firing pulses of the engine. Each firing pulse creates a
sudden change in angular acceleration at the crankshaft. These changes in speed can be reduced
with clutch damper springs and dual mass flywheels. However, some speed variation will make it
through to the transmission. This can create noise as the various gears will accel and decel against
each other because of required clearances.
Cold Operation
Manual transmission operation will be affected by temperature because the transmission fluid will
be thicker when cold. The thicker fluid will increase the amount of force needed to shift the
transmission when cold. The likelihood of gear clash will also increase due to the greater time
needed for the synchronizer assembly to perform its function. Therefore when the transmission is
cold, or before it has reached operating temperature, quick, hard shifts should be avoided to
prevent damage to the transmission.
Gear Rattle
Rattling or grinding (not to be confused with a missed shift type of grinding, also described as a
combustion knock type of noise) type noises usually occur while operating the engine at low RPMs
(lugging the engine). This can occur while accelerating from a stop (for example, a Corvette) or
while operating at low RPMs while under a load (for example, Kodiak in a lower gear and at low
engine speed). Vehicles equipped with a dual-mass flywheel (for example, a 3500 HD Sierra with
the 6-speed manual and Duramax(R)) will have reduced noise levels as compared to vehicles
without (for example, a 4500 Kodiak with the 6-speed manual and Duramax(R)). However,
dual-mass flywheels do not eliminate all noise.
Neutral Rattle
There are often concerns of rattle while idling in neutral with the clutch engaged. This is related to
the changes in angular acceleration described earlier. This is a light rattle, and once again, vehicles
with dual mass flywheels will have reduced noise. If the engine is shut off while idling in neutral with
the clutch engaged, the sudden stop of the engine will create a rapid change in angular
acceleration that even dual mass flywheels cannot compensate. Because of the mass of all the
components, this will create a noise. This type of noise should not be heard if the clutch is released
(pedal pushed to the floor).
Backlash
Backlash noise is created when changing engine or driveline loading. This can occur when
accelerating from a stop, coming to a stop, or applying and releasing the throttle (loading and
unloading the driveline). This will vary based on vehicle type, build variations, driver input, vehicle
loading, etc. and is created from the necessary clearance between all of the mating gears in the
transmission, axle(s) and transfer case (if equipped).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Manual Transmission - M/T Operating Characteristics > Page 5977
Shift Effort
Shift effort will vary among different style transmissions and synchronizer designs. Usually the
more heavy duty the transmission, the higher the shift effort because of the increased mass of the
components. Shift effort can also be higher in cold weather because the fluid will be thicker.
Medium duty transmissions will not shift as quickly as a Corvette transmission. To reduce shift
effort, do not attempt to rush the shift - allow the synchronizers to work as designed. Shifting harder
will only increase the chance of rushing past the synchronizer leading to grinding while shifting.
Non-Synchronized Gears
Some light duty truck transmissions in 1st gear (creeper-gear) and reverse gears in various
transmissions, along with all gears in some medium duty transmissions, may be non-synchronized.
This means there is not a mechanism to match input and output shaft speeds to allow for a smooth
shift. This function is left up to the driver. This can be noticed if a shift into 1st or reverse is
attempted while the vehicle is rolling or before the input shaft stops rotating leading to a gear grind.
The grinding can be reduced by coming to a complete stop and pausing for a moment before
shifting into the 1st or reverse gear. Some slight grinding can be expected. In medium duty
non-synchronized transmissions, the driver must match input shaft (engine) speed to output shaft
(driveshaft) speed with every shift. This can be accomplished by double clutching, or by using other
methods. If the driver is not able to perform this function properly, there will be gear grinding with
each improperly completed shift. Driver training may be required to correct this condition. Clutch
brakes are used in medium duty non-synchronized transmissions to allow a shift into gear at a
stop. The clutch brake is used to stop the input shaft from spinning, allowing a shift into gear at a
stop without grinding. The clutch brake is activated by pressing the clutch pedal all the way to the
floor. When the clutch brake is used, it is possible to have a blocked shift with the vehicle
stationary. If this occurs, engage the clutch slightly to rotate the input gear to allow the shift. The
clutch brake is intended to only be used while at a stop. Care must be taken to not activate the
clutch brake while shifting between gears. This could lead to excessive grinding or a blocked or
missed shift.
Skip Shift
Currently, the Cadillac CTS-V, Pontiac GTO, Chevrolet Corvette and Camaro SS (other models
may follow) equipped with the 6-speed manual transmission have a feature referred to as a
"skip-shift." This feature only allows a shift from 1st to 4th gear when the indicator lamp is
illuminated on the dash. Dealers cannot disable this feature as it was established to help meet fuel
economy standards. The conditions for this feature are: engine coolant at normal operating
temperature, vehicle speed of 24-31 km/h (15-19 mph), 21% or less throttle being used (refer to
Service Information or the Owner Manual for more details.)
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Transmission Mode Switch: Testing and Inspection
Tow/Haul Switch/Indicator Always On or Inoperative
Circuit Description
Tow/haul mode enables the operator to achieve enhanced shift performance when towing or
hauling a load. When tow/haul mode is selected, the tow/haul switch input signal to the Body
Control Module (BCM) is momentarily toggled to zero volts. This signals the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) to extend the length of time between upshifts and increase transmission line
pressure. Cycling the tow/haul switch again disables tow/haul mode and returns the transmission to
a normal shift pattern.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page
5983
Test Description
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. This step tests for a faulty
tow/haul switch. 3. This step tests for voltage input from the BCM to the tow/haul switch.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Park/Neutral Position Switch Screw
................................................................................................................................................... 3 Nm
(27 inch lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page
5987
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams
Automatic Transmission Related Connector End Views
Transmission Range Switch Connector, Wiring Harness Side
Tow/Haul Switch Connector, Column Wiring Harness Side
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page
5988
Park/Neutral Position Switch (C1)
Park/Neutral Position Switch (C2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page
5989
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Adjustments
Park/Neutral Position Switch Adjustment
Important: ^
The following procedure is for vehicles that have not had the switch removed or replaced. If the
switch has been removed or replaced, refer to Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement for the
proper adjustment procedure.
^ Apply the parking brake.
^ The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) positions only.
^ Check the switch for proper operation. If adjustment is required, proceed as follows:
1. Place the transmission range selector in the N (Neutral) position. 2. With an assistant in the
drivers seat, raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 3. Loosen the park/neutral position switch
mounting bolts. 4. With the vehicle in the N (Neutral) position, rotate the switch while the assistant
attempts to start the engine. 5. Following a successful start, turn the engine off.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
6. Tighten the bolts securing the switch to the transmission.
Tighten the bolts to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Check the switch for proper operation. The engine must start in the P
(Park) or N (Neutral) positions only. 9. Replace the park/neutral position switch if proper operation
can not be achieved.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page
5990
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement
^ Tools Required J 41364-A Neutral Position Adjustment Tool
Removal Procedure
1. Apply the parking brake. 2. Shift the transmission into neutral. 3. Raise the vehicle. Refer to
Vehicle Lifting.
4. Remove the nut securing the transmission control lever to the manual shaft. 5. Remove the
transmission control lever from the manual shaft. 6. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the
switch. 7. Remove the bolts securing the park/neutral position switch to the transmission. 8.
Remove the park/neutral position switch from the manual shaft. If the park/neutral position switch
did not slide off the manual shaft, file the outer
edge of the manual shaft in order to remove any burrs.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the switch to the transmission manual shaft by aligning the switch hub flats with the
manual shaft flats.
2. Slide the switch onto the transmission manual shaft until the switch mounting bracket contacts
the mounting bosses on the transmission.
Important: If a new switch is being installed, the switch will come with a positive assurance bracket.
The positive assurance bracket aligns the new switch in it proper position for installation and the
use of neutral position adjustment tool will not be necessary.
3. Install the switch to the transmission with two bolts finger tight.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page
5991
4. Position the tool J 41364-A onto the park/neutral position switch. Ensure that the two slots on the
switch where the manual shaft is inserted are
lined up with the lower two tabs on the tool.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
5. Rotate the tool until the upper locator pin on the tool is lined up with the slot on the top of the
switch.
Tighten the bolts securing the switch to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
6. Remove the J 41364-A from the switch. If installing a new switch, remove the positive assurance
bracket at this time. 7. Connect the electrical connectors to the switch.
8. Install the transmission control lever to the manual shaft with the nut.
Tighten the control lever nut to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
9. Lower the vehicle.
10. Check the switch for proper operation. The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral)
positions only. If proper operation of the switch can
not be obtained, replace the switch.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Speed Sensor: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Speed Sensor Retainer Bolt
............................................................................................................................................ 10.5 13.5 Nm (7.7 - 10 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5995
VSS Assembly Connector, Wiring Harness Side
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5996
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) Replacement
^ Tools Required J 38417 Speed Sensor Remover
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting.
2. Remove the harness connector. 3. Remove the bolt. 4. Place a drain pan under the vehicle. 5.
Remove the vehicle speed sensor using J 38417. 6. Remove the O-ring seal.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the new speed sensor and O-ring seal using J 38417 2. Coat the seal with a thin film of
transmission fluid.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the bolt.
Tighten the bolt to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
4. Install the harness connector. 5. Lower the vehicle. 6. Refill the fluid as required.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Specifications
Transmission Fluid Temperature (TFT) Sensor Specifications
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair
Pressure Regulator Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the transmission oil pan and
filter.
3. Compress the reverse boost valve sleeve into the bore of the oil pump to release tension on the
reverse boost valve retaining ring. 4. Remove the reverse boost valve retaining ring, then slowly
release tension on the reverse boost valve sleeve.
5. Remove the reverse boost valve sleeve (5) and the reverse boost valve (4). 6. Remove the
pressure regulator isolator spring (3) and the pressure regulator valve spring (2). 7. Remove the
pressure regulator valve (1).
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 6006
1. Install the pressure regulator valve (1). 2. Install the pressure regulator isolator spring (3) and the
pressure regulator valve spring (2). 3. Install the reverse boost valve (4) in the reverse boost valve
sleeve (5). 4. Install the reverse boost valve (4) and sleeve (5) in the oil pump cover.
5. Compress the reverse boost valve sleeve into the bore of the oil pump to expose the retaining
ring slot. 6. Install the reverse boost valve retaining ring, then slowly release tension on the reverse
boost valve sleeve. 7. Install the transmission oil filter and pan. 8. Lower the vehicle. 9. Fill the
transmission to the proper level with DEXRON III transmission fluid.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Service and Repair
Automatic Transmission Shift Lock Actuator Replacement
Removal Procedure
Caution: Refer to SIR Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disable the SIR system. 2. Remove the lower steering column trim cover.
3. Disconnect the automatic transmission shift lock control actuator electrical connector. 4. Place
the shift lever clevis into the neutral position. 5. Use a small screwdriver to pry the automatic
transmission shift lock control actuator from the steering column jacket assembly. 6. Remove the
automatic transmission shift lock control actuator from the steering column.
Installation Procedure
1. Firmly install the automatic transmission shift lock control actuator onto the steering column
jacket assembly. 2. Connect the automatic transmission shift lock control actuator electrical
connector.
3. Adjust the automatic transmission shift lock control actuator (with the shift lever clevis in the
neutral position) in the following way:
3.1. Pull out the tab (1) on the adjuster block side (2) of the automatic transmission shift lock
control actuator.
3.2. Press on the adjuster block (2) to disengage the adjuster teeth. Slide the adjuster block (2) as
far away from the actuator as possible.
3.3. Lock the adjuster block in place by pushing inward on the tab (1).
4. Inspect the automatic transmission shift lock control actuator for the following items:
4.1. The automatic transmission shift lock control actuator must lock the shift lever clevis when the
shift lever clevis is put into the PARK position.
4.2. Turn the ignition to the ON position and depress the brake pedal in order to move the gear shift
lever out of the PARK position. The actuator will be energized.
4.3. Readjust the automatic transmission shift lock control actuator if needed.
5. Install the lower steering column trim cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Page 6010
6. Enable the SIR system.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair
Control and Shift Solenoids Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the transmission oil pan and filter.
Important: Do not remove the valve body for the following procedures. Removal of the 1-2
accumulator is necessary only if servicing the pressure control solenoid.
2. Remove the 1-2 accumulator if necessary.
3. Disconnect the internal wiring harness electrical connectors from the following components:
^ Transmission fluid pressure switch (1)
^ 1-2 shift control solenoid (2)
^ 2-3 shift control solenoid (3)
^ Pressure control solenoid (4)
^ TCC PWM solenoid (5)
^ 3-2 control solenoid (6)
4. Remove the pressure control solenoid retainer.
5. Remove the pressure control solenoid.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 6014
6. Remove the 1-2 and 2-3 shift solenoid retainers. 7. Remove the 1-2 and 2-3 shift solenoids.
8. Remove the 3-2 control solenoid retainer. 9. Remove the 3-2 control solenoid.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the 3-2 control solenoid. 2. Install the 3-2 control solenoid retainer.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 6015
3. Install the 1-2 and 2-3 shift solenoids. 4. Install the 1-2 and 2-3 shift solenoid retainers.
5. Install the pressure control solenoid. Ensure that the electrical tabs are facing outboard.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
6. Install the pressure control solenoid retainer and retaining bolt.
Tighten the pressure control solenoid retaining bolt to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
7. Connect the internal wiring harness electrical connectors to the following components:
^ Transmission fluid pressure switch (1)
^ 1-2 shift control solenoid (2)
^ 2-3 shift control solenoid (3)
^ Pressure control solenoid (4)
^ TCC PWM solenoid (5)
^ 3-2 control solenoid (6)
8. Install the 1-2 accumulator.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 6016
9. Install the transmission oil pan and filter.
10. Fill the transmission to the proper level with DEXRON III transmission fluid.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
TCC Solenoid Assembly to Case Bolt
................................................................................................................................ 8.0 - 14.0 Nm (6 10 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6020
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Service and Repair
Torque Converter Clutch Pulse Width Modulation (TCC PWM) Solenoid, TCC Solenoid, and Wiring
Harness
^ Tools Required J 28458 Seal Protector Retainer Installer
Removal Procedure
1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the transmission oil pan and
the filter.
3. Disconnect the transmission harness 20-way connector from the transmission internal harness
pass-through connector. Depress both tabs on the
connector and pull straight up; do not pry the connector.
Important: Removal of the valve body is not necessary for the following procedure.
4. Remove the 1-2 accumulator assembly. Do not remove the spacer plate.
5. Disconnect the internal wiring harness electrical connectors from the following components:
^ Transmission fluid pressure switch (1)
^ 1-2 shift control solenoid (2)
^ 2-3 shift control solenoid (3)
^ Pressure control solenoid (4)
^ TCC PWM solenoid (5)
^ 3-2 control solenoid (6)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6021
6. Remove the TCC PWM solenoid retainer. 7. Remove the TCC PWM solenoid in order to access
one of the TCC solenoid retaining bolts. 8. Remove the pressure control solenoid retainer.
9. Remove the pressure control solenoid.
10. Remove the TCC solenoid retaining bolts and the valve body bolts which retain the internal
wiring harness.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6022
11. Using J 28458, release the pass-through electrical connector from the transmission case.
11.1. Use the small end of the J 28458 over the top of the connector.
11.2. Twist in order to release the four tabs retaining the connector.
11.3. Pull the harness connector down through the transmission case.
12. Remove the TCC solenoid (with O-ring seal) and wiring harness assembly from the
transmission case.
13. Inspect the TCC solenoid and wiring harness assembly for the following defects:
^ Damage
^ Cracked connectors
^ Exposed wires
^ Loose pins
Installation Procedure
1. Install the wiring harness and TCC solenoid assembly with a new O-ring seal to the
transmission. 2. Install the pass-through electrical connector to the transmission case.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6023
3. Install the valve body bolts which retain the internal wiring harness and install the TCC solenoid
retaining bolts.
^ Tighten the control valve body retaining bolts to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
^ Tighten the TCC solenoid retaining bolts to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
4. Install the pressure control solenoid. Ensure that the electrical tabs are facing outboard. 5. Install
the pressure control solenoid retainer and retaining bolt.
Tighten the pressure control solenoid retaining bolt to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
6. Install the TCC PWM solenoid to the control valve body. 7. Install the TCC PWM solenoid
retainer.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6024
8. Connect the internal wiring harness electrical connectors to the following components:
^ Transmission fluid pressure switch (1)
^ 1-2 shift control solenoid (2)
^ 2-3 shift control solenoid (3)
^ Pressure control solenoid (4)
^ TCC PWM solenoid (5)
^ 3-2 control solenoid (6)
9. Install the 1-2 accumulator.
10. Connect the transmission harness 20-way connector to the transmission pass-through
connector. Align the arrows on each half of the connector and
insert straight down.
11. Install the transmission oil pan and filter. 12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Fill the transmission to the
proper level with DEXRON III transmission fluid.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection
Transmission Mode Switch: Testing and Inspection
Tow/Haul Switch/Indicator Always On or Inoperative
Circuit Description
Tow/haul mode enables the operator to achieve enhanced shift performance when towing or
hauling a load. When tow/haul mode is selected, the tow/haul switch input signal to the Body
Control Module (BCM) is momentarily toggled to zero volts. This signals the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) to extend the length of time between upshifts and increase transmission line
pressure. Cycling the tow/haul switch again disables tow/haul mode and returns the transmission to
a normal shift pattern.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Page 6030
Test Description
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. This step tests for a faulty
tow/haul switch. 3. This step tests for voltage input from the BCM to the tow/haul switch.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Park/Neutral Position Switch Screw
................................................................................................................................................... 3 Nm
(27 inch lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6034
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams
Automatic Transmission Related Connector End Views
Transmission Range Switch Connector, Wiring Harness Side
Tow/Haul Switch Connector, Column Wiring Harness Side
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6035
Park/Neutral Position Switch (C1)
Park/Neutral Position Switch (C2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6036
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Adjustments
Park/Neutral Position Switch Adjustment
Important: ^
The following procedure is for vehicles that have not had the switch removed or replaced. If the
switch has been removed or replaced, refer to Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement for the
proper adjustment procedure.
^ Apply the parking brake.
^ The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) positions only.
^ Check the switch for proper operation. If adjustment is required, proceed as follows:
1. Place the transmission range selector in the N (Neutral) position. 2. With an assistant in the
drivers seat, raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 3. Loosen the park/neutral position switch
mounting bolts. 4. With the vehicle in the N (Neutral) position, rotate the switch while the assistant
attempts to start the engine. 5. Following a successful start, turn the engine off.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
6. Tighten the bolts securing the switch to the transmission.
Tighten the bolts to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Check the switch for proper operation. The engine must start in the P
(Park) or N (Neutral) positions only. 9. Replace the park/neutral position switch if proper operation
can not be achieved.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6037
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
Park/Neutral Position Switch Replacement
^ Tools Required J 41364-A Neutral Position Adjustment Tool
Removal Procedure
1. Apply the parking brake. 2. Shift the transmission into neutral. 3. Raise the vehicle. Refer to
Vehicle Lifting.
4. Remove the nut securing the transmission control lever to the manual shaft. 5. Remove the
transmission control lever from the manual shaft. 6. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the
switch. 7. Remove the bolts securing the park/neutral position switch to the transmission. 8.
Remove the park/neutral position switch from the manual shaft. If the park/neutral position switch
did not slide off the manual shaft, file the outer
edge of the manual shaft in order to remove any burrs.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the switch to the transmission manual shaft by aligning the switch hub flats with the
manual shaft flats.
2. Slide the switch onto the transmission manual shaft until the switch mounting bracket contacts
the mounting bosses on the transmission.
Important: If a new switch is being installed, the switch will come with a positive assurance bracket.
The positive assurance bracket aligns the new switch in it proper position for installation and the
use of neutral position adjustment tool will not be necessary.
3. Install the switch to the transmission with two bolts finger tight.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6038
4. Position the tool J 41364-A onto the park/neutral position switch. Ensure that the two slots on the
switch where the manual shaft is inserted are
lined up with the lower two tabs on the tool.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
5. Rotate the tool until the upper locator pin on the tool is lined up with the slot on the top of the
switch.
Tighten the bolts securing the switch to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
6. Remove the J 41364-A from the switch. If installing a new switch, remove the positive assurance
bracket at this time. 7. Connect the electrical connectors to the switch.
8. Install the transmission control lever to the manual shaft with the nut.
Tighten the control lever nut to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
9. Lower the vehicle.
10. Check the switch for proper operation. The engine must start in the P (Park) or N (Neutral)
positions only. If proper operation of the switch can
not be obtained, replace the switch.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications
Transmission Speed Sensor: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Speed Sensor Retainer Bolt
............................................................................................................................................ 10.5 13.5 Nm (7.7 - 10 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6042
VSS Assembly Connector, Wiring Harness Side
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6043
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) Replacement
^ Tools Required J 38417 Speed Sensor Remover
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting.
2. Remove the harness connector. 3. Remove the bolt. 4. Place a drain pan under the vehicle. 5.
Remove the vehicle speed sensor using J 38417. 6. Remove the O-ring seal.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the new speed sensor and O-ring seal using J 38417 2. Coat the seal with a thin film of
transmission fluid.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the bolt.
Tighten the bolt to 11 Nm (97 inch lbs.).
4. Install the harness connector. 5. Lower the vehicle. 6. Refill the fluid as required.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Specifications
Transmission Fluid Temperature (TFT) Sensor Specifications
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Description and Operation
ABS Light: Description and Operation
ABS Indicator
The IPC illuminates the ABS indicator when the following occurs: ^
The electronic brake control module (EBCM) detects an ABS-disabling malfunction. The IPC
receives a class 2 message from the EBCM requesting illumination.
^ The IPC performs the bulb check.
^ The IPC detects a loss of class 2 communications with the EBCM.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Specifications
Electronic Brake Control Module: Specifications
Brake Pressure Modulator Bleeder Valves 80 inch lbs.
EBCM to BPMV 39 inch lbs.
Front Brake Lines to BPMV 18 ft. lbs.
Rear Brake Line to BPMV 18 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Specifications > Page 6055
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Specifications > Page 6056
Electronic Brake Control Module: Diagrams
Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM) C1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Specifications > Page 6057
Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM) C2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Specifications > Page 6058
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair
Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM) Replacement
Removal Procedure
Important: After installation, calibrate the new EBCM to the tire size that is appropriate to the
vehicle.
1. Remove the fuel pipe shield (3) from the frame bracket (2) by removing the 2 nuts (4).
Important: Thoroughly wash all contaminants from around the EHCU (1). The area around the
EHCU must be free from loose dirt to prevent contamination of disassembled ABS components.
2. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the EBCM.
3. Remove the 4 T-25 Tort mounting screws (1) that fasten the EBCM (2) to the BPMV (5). 4.
Remove the EBCM (2) from the BPMV (5). Removal may require a light amount of force.
Important: Do not use a tool to pry the EBCM or the BPMV. Excessive force will damage the
EBCM.
5. Clean the BPMV to EBCM mounting surfaces with a clean cloth.
Installation Procedure
Important: Do not reuse the old mounting screws (1). Always install new mounting screws with the
new EBCM.
Important: Do not use RTV or any other type of sealant on the EBCM gasket or mating surfaces.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Specifications > Page 6059
1. Install EBCM (2) on to the BPMV (5).
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the 4 new T-25 Torx screws (1) in the EBCM (2).
^ Tighten the 4 T-25 Torx screws to 5 Nm (39 inch lbs.) in an X-pattern.
3. Connect the electrical connectors to the EBCM. 4. Secure the module (1) to the frame bracket
(3) and fuel pipe shield (2) with the two nuts (4). 5. Revise the tire calibration using the Scan Tool
Tire Size Calibration function. 6. Return to Diagnostic System Check - ABS on. See: Testing and
Inspection/Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview/Diagnostic System Check
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic
Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Service and Repair
Brake Pressure Modulator Valve (BPMV) Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the fuel pipe shield (3) from the frame bracket (2) by removing the 2 nuts (4).
Important: Thoroughly wash all contaminants from around the EHCU (1). The area around the
EHCU (1) MUST be free from loose dirt to prevent contamination of disassembled ABS
components.
2. Disconnect the 2 electrical harness connectors from the EBCM.
Important: Make sure that brake lines are tagged and kept in order for proper reassembly.
3. Disconnect 5 brake lines from the BPMV. 4. Slide the EHCU (1) off of the frame bracket (2).
5. Remove 2 bolts (4) securing the BPMV mounting bracket (3) to the BPMV (5). 6. Disconnect the
2-way ABS pump motor connector. 7. Remove the 4 T-25 Torx bolts (1) from the EBCM (2).
Important: Do not use a tool to pry the EBCM or the BPMV. Excessive force will damage the
EBCM.
8. Remove the EBCM (2) from the BPMV (5). Removal may require a light amount of force.
Important: Do not reuse the EBCM mounting bolts. Always install new bolts.
9. Clean the EBCM to BPMV mounting surfaces with a clean cloth.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic
Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 6063
Important: Do not use RTV or any other type of sealant on the EBCM gasket or mating surfaces.
1. Install EBCM (2) onto BPMV (5).
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Important: Do not reuse the old mounting bolts. Always install new bolts with the new BPMV.
2. Install the 4 EBCM bolts (1).
^ Tighten the 4 bolts to 5 Nm (39 inch lbs.) in an X-pattern.
3. Connect the 2-way ABS pump motor connector to the EBCM. 4. Install the BPMV (5) to the
BPMV mounting bracket (3) with the 2 bolts (4).
5. Slide the EHCU (1) back onto the frame bracket (2).
Important: The brake pipes are held in the proper place by a frame mounted plastic bracket. Make
sure that the brake pipes stay in the correct place for proper reassembly.
6. Install the 5 brake pipes to the EHCU (1).
^ Tighten the brake pipe fittings to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
7. Connect the 2 electrical harness connectors to the EBCM (1). 8. Secure the module (1) to the
frame bracket (3) and fuel pipe shield (2) with the 2 nuts (4). 9. Bleed the brake system.
10. Return to Diagnostic System Check - ABS. See: Testing and Inspection/Initial Inspection and
Diagnostic Overview/Diagnostic System Check
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
02-05-25-006B > Jan > 06 > Brakes - Low Speed (Below 5 MPH) ABS Activation
Wheel Speed Sensor: Customer Interest Brakes - Low Speed (Below 5 MPH) ABS Activation
Bulletin No.: 02-05-25-006B
Date: January 05, 2006
TECHNICAL
Subject: Antilock Brake (ABS) Activation At Low Speeds (Clean Wheel Speed Sensor Mounting
Surface)
Models: 1999-2000 Cadillac Escalade 1995-1999 Chevrolet Silverado (Old Style) 1995-2000
Chevrolet Suburban, Tahoe (Old Style) 1995-2003 Chevrolet Astro Van, Blazer, S10 1995-1999
GMC Sierra (Old Style) 1995-2000 GMC Yukon, Yukon XL (Old Style) 1995-2001 GMC Envoy,
Jimmy 1995-2003 GMC Safari Van, Sonoma 1995-2001 Oldsmobile Bravada
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to update the correction and warranty information. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 02-05-25-006A (Section 05 - Brakes).
Condition
Some customers may comment on ABS activation at low speeds, usually below 8 km/h (5 mph).
Upon investigation, the technician will find no DTCs set.
Cause
The cause of this condition may be an increased air gap between the wheel speed sensor and the
hub reluctor ring due to rust and debris built up on the sensor mounting surface.
Correction
Measure AC voltage and clean wheel speed sensor mounting surfaces.
1. Raise the vehicle on a hoist.
2. Disconnect both the front wheel speed sensor harness connectors.
3. Place a DVM across the terminals of each sensor connector.
4. Rotate the wheel with hand speed and measure the ACmV's. The reading should be at least 350
ACmV's.
5. If the reading is between 200 and 350 ACmV's, remove the wheel, caliper and rotor in order to
gain access to the speed sensor.
6. Remove the wheel speed sensor and plug the hole to prevent debris from falling into the hub
during service.
7. Clean the wheel speed sensor mounting surface using a wire brush, sand paper, emery cloth,
ScotchBrite(TM) or other suitable material. Be sure to thoroughly clean the wheel speed sensor
surface. There should be no rust or corrosion.
8. Check the sensor head to determine if it has been warped/distorted due to the corrosion build up
or other causes. Check the mounting surface on the sensor head for flatness by placing it on the
edge of a metal machinists scale or other suitable straight edge to measure the flatness. Check the
sensor for flatness in multiple (minimum 3) positions/directions. If the sensor head is distorted,
replace the sensor.
9. Apply (spray) two thin coats of the specified rust penetrating lubricant (corrosion inhibitor) to the
complete sensor mounting surface on the bearing hub. Allow to dry for 3-5 minutes between coats.
Use ONLY Rust Penetrating Lubricant, P/N 89022217 (Canadian P/N 89022218).
10. When the corrosion inhibitor is dry to the touch (about 10 minutes), apply a thin layer of bearing
grease to the hub surface and sensor 0-ring prior to sensor installation. Use ONLY Wheel Bearing
Lubricant, P/N 01051344 (Canadian P/N 993037).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
02-05-25-006B > Jan > 06 > Brakes - Low Speed (Below 5 MPH) ABS Activation > Page 6072
11. Install either the original sensor or a new one in the hub and secure the sensor. Ensure that the
sensor is seated flush against the hub.
12. Install the rotor, the caliper and the wheel.
13. Place the DVM across the sensor terminals and recheck the voltage while rotating the wheel by
hand. The voltage should now read at least 350 ACmV's.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
02-05-25-006B > Jan > 06 > Brakes - Low Speed (Below 5 MPH) ABS Activation
Wheel Speed Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Low Speed (Below 5 MPH) ABS
Activation
Bulletin No.: 02-05-25-006B
Date: January 05, 2006
TECHNICAL
Subject: Antilock Brake (ABS) Activation At Low Speeds (Clean Wheel Speed Sensor Mounting
Surface)
Models: 1999-2000 Cadillac Escalade 1995-1999 Chevrolet Silverado (Old Style) 1995-2000
Chevrolet Suburban, Tahoe (Old Style) 1995-2003 Chevrolet Astro Van, Blazer, S10 1995-1999
GMC Sierra (Old Style) 1995-2000 GMC Yukon, Yukon XL (Old Style) 1995-2001 GMC Envoy,
Jimmy 1995-2003 GMC Safari Van, Sonoma 1995-2001 Oldsmobile Bravada
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to update the correction and warranty information. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 02-05-25-006A (Section 05 - Brakes).
Condition
Some customers may comment on ABS activation at low speeds, usually below 8 km/h (5 mph).
Upon investigation, the technician will find no DTCs set.
Cause
The cause of this condition may be an increased air gap between the wheel speed sensor and the
hub reluctor ring due to rust and debris built up on the sensor mounting surface.
Correction
Measure AC voltage and clean wheel speed sensor mounting surfaces.
1. Raise the vehicle on a hoist.
2. Disconnect both the front wheel speed sensor harness connectors.
3. Place a DVM across the terminals of each sensor connector.
4. Rotate the wheel with hand speed and measure the ACmV's. The reading should be at least 350
ACmV's.
5. If the reading is between 200 and 350 ACmV's, remove the wheel, caliper and rotor in order to
gain access to the speed sensor.
6. Remove the wheel speed sensor and plug the hole to prevent debris from falling into the hub
during service.
7. Clean the wheel speed sensor mounting surface using a wire brush, sand paper, emery cloth,
ScotchBrite(TM) or other suitable material. Be sure to thoroughly clean the wheel speed sensor
surface. There should be no rust or corrosion.
8. Check the sensor head to determine if it has been warped/distorted due to the corrosion build up
or other causes. Check the mounting surface on the sensor head for flatness by placing it on the
edge of a metal machinists scale or other suitable straight edge to measure the flatness. Check the
sensor for flatness in multiple (minimum 3) positions/directions. If the sensor head is distorted,
replace the sensor.
9. Apply (spray) two thin coats of the specified rust penetrating lubricant (corrosion inhibitor) to the
complete sensor mounting surface on the bearing hub. Allow to dry for 3-5 minutes between coats.
Use ONLY Rust Penetrating Lubricant, P/N 89022217 (Canadian P/N 89022218).
10. When the corrosion inhibitor is dry to the touch (about 10 minutes), apply a thin layer of bearing
grease to the hub surface and sensor 0-ring prior to sensor installation. Use ONLY Wheel Bearing
Lubricant, P/N 01051344 (Canadian P/N 993037).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
02-05-25-006B > Jan > 06 > Brakes - Low Speed (Below 5 MPH) ABS Activation > Page 6078
11. Install either the original sensor or a new one in the hub and secure the sensor. Ensure that the
sensor is seated flush against the hub.
12. Install the rotor, the caliper and the wheel.
13. Place the DVM across the sensor terminals and recheck the voltage while rotating the wheel by
hand. The voltage should now read at least 350 ACmV's.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6079
Wheel Speed Sensor: Specifications
Front Wheel Speed Sensor Mounting Bolt 12 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6080
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6081
Wheel Speed Sensor: Diagrams
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6082
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
Wheel Speed Sensor Replacement (RWD)
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. 2. Remove the tire and wheel. 3. Remove the brake caliper (1). 4. Remove the
hub and rotor assembly (3). 5. Remove the wheel speed sensor cable electrical connector (2). 6.
Remove the wheel speed sensor harness clip rivets using a 3/16 inch drill bit. 7. Remove the clips
from the wheel speed sensor wire. Save the clips for the replacement sensor. 8. Remove the wheel
speed sensor mounting bolts and nut. 9. Remove the 2 splash shield mounting bolts (7).
10. Remove the wheel speed sensor and the splash shield assembly (6). 11. Remove the splash
shield gasket. 12. Clean the gasket and knuckle (8) surfaces thoroughly with a dry cloth.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the splash shield gasket. 2. Install the wheel speed sensor splash shield (6).
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the 2 11 mm splash shield mounting bolts.
^ Tighten the splash shield mounting bolts to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
4. Install the wheel speed sensor mounting bolts and nut.
^ Tighten the speed sensor mounting bolts to 26 Nm (19 ft. lbs.).
5. Install the harness clips to the wheel speed sensor wire. Locate the clips at the paint dots on the
wire. 6. Install the harness clips with 3/16 inch rivets. 7. Connect the wheel speed sensor electrical
connector (2).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6083
8. Install the hub and rotor (3). 9. Install the brake caliper (1).
10. Install the tire and wheel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Specifications
Brake Bleeding: Specifications
Brake System Pressure Bleed Initial Pressure Adjustment Setting (Leak Testing the Hydraulic
Brake System) 10 psi
Pressure Bleed Procedure Setting 35 psi
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
ABS Automated Bleed Procedure
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair ABS Automated Bleed Procedure
ABS Automated Bleed Procedure
Two Person Procedure
Important: ^
Use the 2-person bleed procedure under the following conditions: Installing a new Electro-Hydraulic Control Unit (EHCU) or new Brake Pressure Modulator Valve
(BPMV).
- Air is trapped in the valve body
^ Do not drive the vehicle until the brake pedal feels firm.
^ Do not reuse brake fluid that is used during bleeding.
^ Use the vacuum, the pressure and the gravity bleeding procedures only for base brake bleeding.
1. Raise the vehicle in order to access the system bleed screws. 2. Bleed the system at the right
rear wheel first. 3. Install a clear hose on the bleed screw. 4. Immerse the opposite end of the hose
into a container partially filled with clean DOT 3 brake fluid. 5. Open the bleed screw 1/2 to one full
turn. 6. Slowly depress the brake pedal. While the pedal is depressed to its full extent, tighten the
bleed screw. 7. Release the brake pedal and wait 10-15 seconds for the master cylinder pistons to
return to the home position. 8. Repeat the previous steps for the remaining wheels. The brake fluid
that is present at each bleed screw should be clean and free of air. 9. This procedure may use
more than a pint of fluid per wheel. Check the master cylinder fluid level every four to six strokes of
the brake pedal in
order to avoid running the system dry.
10. Press the brake pedal firmly and run the Scan Tool Automated Bleed Procedure. Release the
brake pedal between each test. 11. Bleed all four wheels again using Steps 3-9. This will remove
the remaining air from the brake system. 12. Evaluate the feel of the brake pedal before attempting
to drive the vehicle. 13. Bleed the system as many times as necessary in order to obtain the
appropriate feel of the pedal.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
ABS Automated Bleed Procedure > Page 6089
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Hydraulic Brake System Bleeding (Manual)
Hydraulic Brake System Bleeding (Manual)
Notice: When adding fluid to the brake master cylinder reservoir, use only Delco Supreme 11, GM
P/N 12377967, or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container. The use
of any type of fluid other than the recommended type of brake fluid, may cause contamination
which could result in damage to the internal rubber seals and/or rubber linings of hydraulic brake
system components.
Notice: Refer to Brake Fluid Effects on Paint and Electrical Components Notice in Service
Precautions.
1. Place a clean shop cloth beneath the brake master cylinder to prevent brake fluid spills. 2. With
the ignition OFF and the brakes cool, apply the brakes 3-5 times, or until the brake pedal becomes
firm, in order to deplete the brake booster
power reserve.
3. If you have performed a brake master cylinder bench bleeding on this vehicle, or if you
disconnected the brake pipes from the master cylinder, you
must perform the following steps: 3.1.
Ensure that the brake master cylinder reservoir is full to the maximum-fill level. If necessary add
Delco Supreme 11, GM P/N 12377967 (Canadian P/N 992667) or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid
from a clean, sealed brake fluid container. Clean the outside of the reservoir on and around the
reservoir cap prior to removing the cap and diaphragm, if cap removal is necessary.
3.2. With the rear brake pipe installed securely to the master cylinder, loosen and separate the
front brake pipe from the front port of the brake master cylinder.
3.3. Allow a small amount of brake fluid to gravity bleed from the open port of the master cylinder.
3.4. Reconnect the brake pipe to the master cylinder port and tighten securely.
3.5. Have an assistant slowly depress the brake pedal fully and maintain steady pressure on the
pedal.
3.6. Loosen the same brake pipe to purge air from the open port of the master cylinder.
3.7. Tighten the brake pipe, then have the assistant slowly release the brake pedal.
3.8. Wait 15 seconds, then repeat steps 3.3-3.7 until all air is purged from the same port of the
master cylinder.
3.9. With the front brake pipe installed securely to the master cylinder, after all air has been purged
from the front port of the master cylinder, loosen and separate the rear brake pipe from the master
cylinder; then repeat steps 3.3-3.8.
3.10. After completing the final master cylinder port bleeding procedure, ensure that both of the
brake pipe-to-master cylinder fittings are properly tightened.
4. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with Delco Supreme 11, GM P/N 12377967 (Canadian
P/N 992667) or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from
a clean, sealed brake fluid container. Ensure that the brake master cylinder reservoir remains at
least half-full during this bleeding procedure. Add fluid as needed to maintain the proper level.
Clean the outside of the reservoir on and around the reservoir cap prior to removing the cap and
diaphragm, when cap removal is necessary.
5. Install a proper box-end wrench onto the RIGHT REAR wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve,
then install a transparent hose over the end of the
bleeder valve.
6. Submerge the open end of the transparent hose into a transparent container partially filled with
Delco Supreme 11, GM PIN 12377967 (Canadian
P/N 992667) or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container.
7. Have an assistant slowly depress the brake pedal fully and maintain pedal position. 8. Loosen
the bleeder valve to purge air from the wheel hydraulic circuit. 9. Tighten the bleeder valve, then
have the assistant slowly release the brake pedal.
10. Wait 15 seconds, then repeat steps 7-9 until all air is purged from the same wheel hydraulic
circuit. 11. With the right rear wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve tightened securely, after all air
has been purged from the right rear hydraulic circuit;
install a proper box-end wrench onto the LEFT REAR wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve, install a
transparent hose over the end of the bleeder valve, then repeat steps 6-10.
12. With the left rear wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve tightened securely, after all air has been
purged from the left rear hydraulic circuit; install a
proper box-end wrench onto the RIGHT FRONT wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve, install a
transparent hose over the end of the bleeder valve, then repeat steps 6-10.
13. With the right front wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve tightened securely, after all air has
been purged from the right front hydraulic circuit;
install a proper box-end wrench onto the LEFT FRONT wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve, install
a transparent hose over the end of the bleeder valve, then repeat steps 6-10.
14. After completing the final wheel hydraulic circuit bleeding procedure, ensure that each of the 4
wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valves are properly
tightened.
15. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir to the maximum-fill level with Delco Supreme 11, GM
P/N 12377967 (Canadian P/N 992667) or
equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container.
16. Slowly depress and release the brake pedal. Observe the feel of the brake pedal. 17. If the
brake pedal feels spongy, repeat the bleeding procedure again. If the brake pedal still feels spongy
after repeating the bleeding procedure,
perform the following steps: 17.1.
Inspect the brake system for external leaks.
17.2. Pressure bleed the hydraulic brake system in order to purge any air that may still be trapped
in the system.
18. Turn the ignition key ON, with the engine OFF. Check to see if the brake system warning lamp
remains illuminated. 19. If the brake system warning lamp remains illuminated, the hydraulic brake
pressure differential switch plunger may have be forced out of position
during the bleeding procedure and may need to be reset. Perform the following steps to reset the
switch. 19.1.
Install a proper box-end wrench onto the RIGHT REAR wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve, then
install a transparent hose over the end of the bleeder valve.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
ABS Automated Bleed Procedure > Page 6090
19.2. Submerge the open end of the transparent hose into a transparent container partially filled
with Delco Supreme 11, GM P/N 12377967 (Canadian P/N 992667) or equivalent DOT-3 brake
fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container.
19.3. With the ignition key still ON, with the engine OFF, loosen the bleeder valve.
19.4. Have an assistant slowly depress the brake pedal until the brake system warning lamp turns
OFF and maintain pedal position while you tighten the bleeder valve.
19.5. Have the assistant slowly release the brake pedal.
20. If the brake system warning lamp continues to remain illuminated, DO NOT allow the vehicle to
be driven until it is diagnosed and repaired. Refer
to Symptoms - Hydraulic Brakes. See: Hydraulic System/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
ABS Automated Bleed Procedure > Page 6091
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Hydraulic Brake System Bleeding (Pressure)
Hydraulic Brake System Bleeding (Pressure)
^ Tools Required J 29532 Diaphragm Type Brake Pressure Bleeder, or equivalent
- J 29567 Brake Pressure Bleeder Adapter
- J 39177 Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool, or equivalent
- J 41618 Brake Bleeder Adapter Set
Notice: When adding fluid to the brake master cylinder reservoir, use only Delco Supreme 11, GM
P/N 12377967, or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container. The use
of any type of fluid other than the recommended type of brake fluid, may cause contamination
which could result in damage to the internal rubber seals and/or rubber linings of hydraulic brake
system components.
Notice: Refer to Brake Fluid Effects on Paint and Electrical Components Notice in Service
Precautions.
1. Place a clean shop cloth beneath the brake master cylinder to prevent brake fluid spills. 2. With
the ignition OFF and the brakes cool, apply the brakes 3-5 times, or until the brake pedal becomes
firm, in order to deplete the brake booster
power reserve.
3. If you have performed a brake master cylinder bench bleeding on this vehicle, or if you
disconnected the brake pipes from the master cylinder, you
must perform the following steps: 3.1.
Ensure that the brake master cylinder reservoir is full to the maximum-fill level. If necessary add
Delco Supreme 11, (GM P/N 12377967) or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed
brake fluid container. Clean the outside of the reservoir on and around the reservoir cap prior to
removing the cap and diaphragm, if cap removal is necessary.
3.2. With the rear brake pipe installed securely to the master cylinder, loosen and separate the
front brake pipe from the front port of the brake master cylinder.
3.3. Allow a small amount of brake fluid to gravity bleed from the open port of the master cylinder.
3.4. Reconnect the brake pipe to the master cylinder port and tighten securely.
3.5. Have an assistant slowly depress the brake pedal fully and maintain steady pressure on the
pedal.
3.6. Loosen the same brake pipe to purge air from the open port of the master cylinder.
3.7. Tighten the brake pipe, then have the assistant slowly release the brake pedal.
3.8. Wait 15 seconds, then repeat steps 3.3-3.7 until all air is purged from the same port of the
master cylinder.
3.9. With the front brake pipe installed securely to the master cylinder, (after all air has been
purged from the front port of the master cylinder), loosen and separate the rear brake pipe from the
master cylinder, then repeat steps 3.3-3.8.
3.10. After completing the final master cylinder port bleeding procedure, ensure that both of the
brake pipe-to-master cylinder fittings are properly tightened.
4. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir to the maximum-fill level with Delco Supreme 11, (GM
P/N 12377967) or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid
from a clean, sealed brake fluid container. Clean the outside of the reservoir on and around the
reservoir cap prior to removing the cap and diaphragm.
5. Remove the cap from the metering valve end of the combination valve, then install the J 39177,
or equivalent to the metering valve. 6. Using the J 39177, depress the shaft of the metering valve to
maintain the proper flow of brake fluid to the front wheel hydraulic circuit during the
pressure bleeding procedure.
7. Assemble the J41613 to the J29567. 8. Install the J41618 and J29567to the brake master
cylinder reservoir. 9. Check the brake fluid level in the J 29532, or equivalent. Add Delco Supreme
11, (GM P/N 12377967) or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a
clean, sealed brake fluid container as necessary to bring the level to approximately the half-full
point.
10. Connect the J29532, or equivalent, to the J 29567. 11. Charge the J 29532, or equivalent, air
tank to 175 - 205 kPa (25 - 30 psi). 12. Open the J29532, or equivalent, fluid tank valve to allow
pressurized brake fluid to enter the brake system. 13. Wait approximately 30 seconds, then inspect
the entire hydraulic brake system in order to ensure that there are no existing external brake fluid
leaks. Any brake fluid leaks identified require repair prior to completing this procedure.
14. Install a proper box-end wrench onto the RIGHT REAR wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve,
then install a transparent hose over the end of the
bleeder valve.
15. Submerge the open end of the transparent hose into a transparent container partially filled with
Delco Supreme 11, (GM P/N 12377967) or
equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container.
16. Loosen the bleeder valve to purge air from the wheel hydraulic circuit. Allow fluid to flow until air
bubbles stop flowing from the bleeder, then
tighten the bleeder valve.
17. With the right rear wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve tightened securely, (after all air has
been purged from the right rear hydraulic circuit),
install a proper box-end wrench onto the LEFT REAR wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve, install a
transparent hose over the end of the bleeder valve, then repeat steps 15-16.
18. With the left rear wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve tightened securely, (after all air has been
purged from the left rear hydraulic circuit), install
a proper box-end wrench onto the RIGHT FRONT wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve, install a
transparent hose over the end of the bleeder valve, then repeat steps 15-16.
19. With the right front wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve tightened securely, (after all air has
been purged from the right front hydraulic circuit),
install a proper box-end wrench onto the LEFT FRONT wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve, install
a transparent hose over the end of the bleeder
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
ABS Automated Bleed Procedure > Page 6092
valve, then repeat steps 15-16.
20. After completing the final wheel hydraulic circuit bleeding procedure, ensure that each of the 4
wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valves are properly
tightened.
21. Close the J 29532, or equivalent, fluid tank valve, then disconnect the J 29532, or equivalent,
from the J 29567. 22. Remove the J 41618 and J29567 from the brake master cylinder reservoir.
23. Remove the J 39177, or equivalent from the metering valve, then install the cap to the metering
valve end of the combination valve. 24. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir to the maximum-fill
level with Delco Supreme 11, (GM P/N 12377967) or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid
from a clean, sealed brake fluid container.
25. Slowly depress and release the brake pedal. Observe the feel of the brake pedal. 26. If the
brake pedal feels spongy perform the following steps:
26.1. Inspect the brake system for external leaks.
26.2. Using a scan tool, perform the antilock brake system automated bleeding procedure to
remove any air that may have been trapped in the BPMV.
27. Turn the ignition key ON, with the engine OFF. Check to see if the brake system warning lamp
remains illuminated. 28. If the brake system warning lamp remains illuminated, DO NOT allow the
vehicle to be driven until it is diagnosed and repaired. Refer to
Symptoms - Hydraulic Brakes. See: Hydraulic System/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
ABS Automated Bleed Procedure > Page 6093
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Master Cylinder Bench Bleeding
Master Cylinder Bench Bleeding
Notice: When adding fluid to the brake master cylinder reservoir, use only Delco Supreme 11, GM
P/N 12377967, or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container. The use
of any type of fluid other than the recommended type of brake fluid, may cause contamination
which could result in damage to the internal rubber seals and/or rubber linings of hydraulic brake
system components.
1. Secure the mounting flange of the brake master cylinder in a bench vise so that the rear of the
primary piston is accessible. 2. Remove the master cylinder reservoir cap and diaphragm. 3. Install
suitable fittings to the master cylinder ports that match the type of flare seat required and also
provide for hose attachment. 4. Install transparent hoses to the fittings installed to the master
cylinder ports, then route the hoses into the master cylinder reservoir. 5. Fill the master cylinder
reservoir to at least the halfway point with Delco Supreme 11, GM P/N 12377967, or equivalent
DOT-3 brake fluid from a
clean, sealed brake fluid container.
6. Ensure that the ends of the transparent hoses running into the master cylinder reservoir are fully
submerged in the brake fluid. 7. Using a smooth, round-ended tool, depress and release the
primary piston as far as it will travel, a depth of about 25 mm (1 in), several times.
Observe the flow of fluid coming from the ports. As air is bled from the primary and secondary
pistons, the effort required to depress the primary piston will increase and the amount of travel will
decrease.
8. Continue to depress and release the primary piston until fluid flows freely from the ports with no
evidence of air bubbles. 9. Remove the transparent hoses from the master cylinder reservoir.
10. Install the master cylinder reservoir cap and diaphragm. 11. Remove the fittings with the
transparent hoses from the master cylinder ports. Wrap the master cylinder with a clean shop cloth
to prevent brake
fluid spills.
12. Remove the master cylinder from the vise.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Specifications
Brake Pedal Assy: Specifications
Brake Pedal Bracket Bolt 26 ft. lbs.
Brake Pedal Pivot Bolt 33 ft. lbs.
Brake Pedal Maximum Travel* Hydraulic Power Assist 2.83 in.
*Specification with 100 lbs. of force applied to the brake
pedal, the ignition Off, and the brake booster power
reserve depleted.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 6097
Brake Pedal Assy: Service and Repair
Brake Pedal Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the booster pushrod (4) and stop lamp switch (2) from brake pedal (1). 2. Detach and
pivot the instrument panel down to access the brake pedal mounting bolt. 3. Remove the nut from
the brake pedal pivot bolt. 4. Remove the brake pedal pivot bolt. 5. Remove the brake pedal (1),
spacers and bushings from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the brake pedal (1) to the vehicle. 2. Install the through bolt, spacers and bushings to the
vehicle.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the nut to the brake pedal pivot bolt.
^ Tighten the nut to 45 Nm (33 ft. lbs.).
4. Pivot and attach the instrument panel. 5. Install the booster pushrod (4) and the stop lamp switch
(2) to the brake pedal (1).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Brake Warning Indicator: Description and Operation
Brake Warning Indicator
The instrument panel cluster (IPC) illuminates the brake warning indicator when the following
occurs: ^
The body control module (BCM) detects that the park brake is engaged. The IPC receives a class 2
message from the BCM requesting illumination.
^ The EBCM detects a low brake fluid condition and sends a class 2 message to the IPC.
^ The IPC performs the bulb check.
^ An ABS-disabling malfunction also disables dynamic rear proportioning (DRP).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 6101
Brake Warning Indicator: Testing and Inspection
For information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Hydraulic System Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Specifications
Brake Caliper: Specifications
Brake Caliper Bleeder Valve (Front) 115 inch lbs.
Brake Caliper Bleeder Valve (Rear) 115 inch lbs.
Caliper Mounting Bolts 38 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Caliper Inspection
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Brake Caliper Inspection
Brake Caliper Inspection
1. Inspect the brake caliper housing (1) for cracks, excessive wear, and/or damage. If any of these
conditions are present, the brake caliper requires
replacement.
2. Inspect the caliper piston dust boot seal (2) for cracks, tears, cuts, deterioration and/or improper
seating in the caliper body. If any of these
conditions are present, the brake caliper requires overhaul or replacement.
3. Inspect for brake fluid leakage around the caliper piston dust boot seal (2) and on the disc brake
pads. If there is any evidence of brake fluid
leakage, the brake caliper requires overhaul or replacement.
4. Inspect for smooth and complete travel of the caliper piston(s) into the caliper bore(s).
The movement of the caliper piston(s) into the caliper bore(s) should be smooth and even. If the
caliper piston is frozen or difficult to bottom, the caliper requires overhaul or replacement. ^
For single piston caliper applications, insert a discarded inner brake pad (2) or block of wood in
front of the piston. Using a large C-clamp (1) installed over the body of the caliper (3) and against
the brake pad or block of wood, slowly bottom the piston in the bore.
^ For dual piston caliper applications, insert a discarded inner brake pad (2) or block of wood in
front of the pistons. Using 2 large C-clamps (1) installed over the body of the caliper (3) and against
the brake pad or block of wood, slowly bottom the pistons evenly into the bores.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Caliper Inspection > Page 6108
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Brake Caliper Overhaul
Brake Caliper Overhaul
^ Tools Required J 26267 Piston Seal Installer
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the caliper. 2. Drain all the brake fluid from the caliper.
Caution: Do not place your fingers in front of the piston in order to catch or protect the piston while
applying compressed air. This could result in serious injury.
Notice: Use just enough air pressure to ease the piston out of the bore. You can damage a
blown-out piston even with the padding.
3. Pad the interior of the caliper with clean shop towels. 4. Remove the piston from the caliper bore.
5. Remove the boot from the caliper bore. Do not scratch the housing bore.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Caliper Inspection > Page 6109
6. Remove the piston seal from the caliper bore. Do not use a metal tool.
7. Remove the bleeder valve from the caliper body. 8. Clean the bleeder valve, the caliper bore, the
caliper passages and the piston with denatured alcohol. Dry the parts and blow out the brake fluid
passages. Use dry and filtered compressed air.
9. Inspect the piston and the caliper for the following conditions:
^ Scoring on the piston surface or in the caliper bore
^ Corrosion on the piston
^ Chrome plating damage on the piston
^ Corrosion in the caliper bore Use crocus cloth in order to polish light corrosion from the caliper
bore. Replace the caliper if the corrosion cannot be removed.
^ Pitting in the caliper bore
10. Replace the piston or the caliper if you found any of the above conditions.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Caliper Inspection > Page 6110
1. Lubricate the new piston seal, the caliper bore, and the piston with clean brake fluid.
2. Install the piston seal. Make sure the piston seal is not twisted in the caliper bore groove.
3. Install the boot on the piston.
4. Install the piston in the caliper bore.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Caliper Inspection > Page 6111
5. Install the boot into the caliper housing bore using the J 26267.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
6. Install the bleeder valve in the caliper body.
^ Tighten the bleeder valve to 13 Nm (115 inch lbs.).
Important: Before moving the vehicle, pump the brake pedal until it is firm. Check the brake fluid
level in the master cylinder after pumping the brakes.
7. Install the caliper.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Caliper Inspection > Page 6112
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Brake Caliper Replacement
Brake Caliper Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Inspect the fluid level in the brake master cylinder reservoir. 2. If the brake fluid level is midway
between the maximum-full point and the minimum allowable level, no brake fluid needs to be
removed from the
reservoir before proceeding.
3. If the brake fluid level is higher than midway between the maximum-full point and the minimum
allowable level, remove brake fluid to the
midway point before proceeding.
4. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 5. Remove the tire and wheel
assembly. 6. Install and hand tighten a wheel lug nut in order to retain the rotor (A4WD only). 7.
Compress the front caliper piston.
^ Install a large C-clamp over the top of the caliper housing and against the back of the outboard
pad.
^ Slowly tighten the C-clamp until the piston pushes into the caliper bore enough to slide the caliper
off the rotor.
^ Remove the C-clamp from the caliper.
8. Remove the brake hose-to-caliper bolt (1) from the caliper.
Discard the 2 copper gaskets (3). These gaskets may be stuck to the brake caliper and/or the
brake hose end.
9. Plug the opening in the front brake hose (2) in order to prevent excessive brake fluid loss and
contamination.
Do not pinch off the brake hose with any tools.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Caliper Inspection > Page 6113
10. Remove the caliper mounting bolts. 11. Remove the caliper. 12. Remove the brake pads.
13. Remove the bushings. 14. Remove the sleeves (RWD only). 15. Inspect the caliper bolts for
corrosion or damage. Do not attempt to polish away any corrosion. If corrosion is found, use new
parts, including
bushings, when installing the caliper.
Installation Procedure
1. If reusing the brake caliper pin bolts and retainers, clean the brake caliper pin bolts and retainers
using denatured alcohol, or equivalent. 2. Dry the brake caliper pin bolts using non-lubricated,
filtered air. 3. Apply high temperature silicone brake lubricant to the brake caliper pin bolts and
retainers. DO NOT apply lubricant to the brake pad hardware.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Caliper Inspection > Page 6114
4. Install the bushings. 5. Install the sleeves (RWD only). 6. Install the brake pads. 7. Install the
caliper assembly.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
8. Install the mounting bolts.
^ Tighten the bolts to 51 Nm (38 ft. lbs.).
Important: Install NEW copper brake hose gaskets.
9. Install the brake hose bolt (1) and the NEW copper brake hose gaskets (3) to the brake hose (2).
10. Install the brake hose-to-caliper bolt to the brake caliper.
^ Tighten the bolt to 44 Nm (32 ft. lbs.).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Caliper Inspection > Page 6115
11. Remove the wheel lug nut securing the rotor to the hub.
12. Measure the clearance between the caliper and the steering knuckle.
Measure the clearance at each end of the caliper individually and then add the measurements
together. Specification The total should be 0.26 - 0.60 mm (0.010 - 0.024 in). ^
If the total clearance between the caliper and the steering knuckle is less than 0.26 mm (0.010 in),
file the steering knuckle equally on each side until the proper clearance is obtained.
^ If the total clearance between the caliper and the steering knuckle is more than 0.60 mm (0.024
in), inspect the brake caliper and the steering knuckle for damage and replace as needed.
13. Install the tire and wheel. 14. Lower the vehicle. 15. Fill the master cylinder to the proper level
with clean brake fluid. 16. Bleed the brake system.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Specifications
Brake Pad: Specifications Minimum Thickness
Minimum Thickness
Disc Brake Pad 0.030 in
Replace the disc brake pads when the friction surface is
worn to within 0.030 in of the mounting plates.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6119
Brake Pad: Service Precautions
Caution: Road test a vehicle under safe conditions and while obeying all traffic laws. Do not
attempt any maneuvers that could jeopardize vehicle control. Failure to adhere to these
precautions could lead to serious personal injury and vehicle damage.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Brake Pads Replacement
Brake Pad: Service and Repair Brake Pads Replacement
Brake Pads Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Inspect the fluid level in the brake master cylinder reservoir. 2. If the brake fluid level is midway
between the maximum-full point and the minimum allowable level, no brake fluid needs to be
removed from the
reservoir before proceeding.
3. If the brake fluid level is higher than midway between the maximum-full point and the minimum
allowable level, remove brake fluid to the
midway point before proceeding.
4. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 5. Remove the tire and wheel
assembly. 6. Only on the A4WD, install and hand tighten a wheel lug nut in order to retain the rotor.
7. Compress the front caliper piston, with the following procedure:
7.1. Install a large C-clamp over the top of the caliper housing and against the back of the outboard
pad.
7.2. Slowly tighten the C-clamp until the piston pushes into the caliper bore enough to slide the
caliper off the rotor.
7.3. Remove the C-clamp from the caliper.
Notice: Refer to Support the Brake Caliper While Flex Hose is Connected Notice in Service
Precautions.
Important: DO NOT disconnect the hydraulic brake flexible hose from the caliper.
8. Remove the caliper from the mounting bracket and support the caliper with heavy mechanics
wire or equivalent.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Brake Pads Replacement > Page 6122
9. Only on the RWD, remove the inboard brake pad.
10. Only on the RWD, remove the retainer spring. 11. Only on the RWD, remove the outboard
brake pad.
12. Only on the A4WD, remove the inboard and outboard brake pads. 13. Inspect the following
parts for cuts, tears, or deterioration:
^ The disc brake mounting hardware
^ The caliper dust boot
14. Replace any damaged parts.
Important: Do not attempt to polish away any corrosion. If corrosion is found, use new parts,
including bushings, when installing the caliper.
15. Inspect the caliper bolts for corrosion or damage.
Installation Procedure
Important: Do not damage the piston or the caliper boot.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Brake Pads Replacement > Page 6123
1. Using a C-clamp (1), bottom the piston into the caliper bore. Use an old brake pad or wooden
block (2) placed across the face of the piston.
2. Only on the A4WD, install the inboard brake pad. 3. Only on the A4WD, install the outboard
brake pad.
4. Only on the RWD, install the retainer spring onto the inboard brake pad. 5. Only on the RWD,
install the inboard brake pad. 6. Only on the RWD, install the outboard brake pad.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Brake Pads Replacement > Page 6124
7. Only on the RWD, compress the outboard pad ears to the caliper.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
8. Install the caliper mounting bolts.
^ Tighten the bolts to 51 Nm (38 ft. lbs.).
9. Only on the A4WD, remove the wheel lug nut securing the rotor to the hub.
10. Install the tire and wheel. 11. Lower the vehicle. 12. With the engine OFF, gradually apply the
brake pedal approximately 2/3 of the pedal's travel distance. 13. Slowly release the brake pedal.
14. Wait 15 seconds, then repeat steps 12-13 until a firm brake pedal is obtained. This will properly
seat the brake caliper pistons and brake pads. 15. Fill the brake master cylinder to the proper level.
16. Burnish the pads and rotors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Brake Pads Replacement > Page 6125
Brake Pad: Service and Repair Burnishing Pads and Rotors
Burnishing Pads and Rotors
Caution: Road test a vehicle under safe conditions and while obeying all traffic laws. Do not
attempt any maneuvers that could jeopardize vehicle control. Failure to adhere to these
precautions could lead to serious personal injury and vehicle damage.
Burnishing the brake pads and brake rotors is necessary in order to ensure that the braking
surfaces are properly prepared after service has been performed on the disc brake system. This
procedure should be performed whenever the disc brake rotors have been refinished or replaced,
and/or whenever the disc brake pads have been replaced. 1. Select a smooth road with little or no
traffic. 2. Accelerate the vehicle to 48 km/h (30 mph).
Important: Use care to avoid overheating the brakes while performing this step.
3. Using moderate to firm pressure, apply the brakes to bring the vehicle to a stop. Do not allow the
brakes to lock. 4. Repeat steps 2 and 3 until approximately 20 stops have been completed. Allow
sufficient cooling periods between stops in order to properly
burnish the brake pads and rotors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes- Disc Brake Warranty Service And Procedures
Technical Service Bulletin # 00-05-22-002L Date: 090326
Brakes- Disc Brake Warranty Service And Procedures
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-05-22-002L
Date: March 26, 2009
Subject: Disc Brake Warranty Service and Procedures
Models: 1999-2010 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2003-2010 HUMMER H2
2006-2010 HUMMER H3 1999-2004 Isuzu Light Duty Trucks (Canada Only) 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
(Canada Only) 1999-2010 Saturn Vehicles (Canada Only)
EXCLUDING 2009-2010 Chevrolet Corvette ZR1
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to inform you that due to improvements in vehicle brake
corner and wheel design, assembly plant build processes and dealership required tools like the
On-Car Lathe, measuring for Lateral Run Out (LRO) is no longer a required step when performing
base brake service. Due to this change, you are no longer required to enter the LRO measurement
on the repair order or in the warranty system failure code section. The bulletin information below
and the base brake labor operations have been updated accordingly. Due to this change it is more
important than ever to properly maintain your brake lathe (per the Brake Lathe Calibration
Procedure in this bulletin). Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 00-05-22-002K (Section 05 Brakes).
For your convenience, this bulletin updates and centralizes all GM's Standard Brake Service
Procedures and Policy Guidelines for brake rotor and brake pad service and wear. For additional
information, the Service Technical College lists a complete index of available Brake courses. This
information can be accessed at www.gmtraining.com > resources > training materials > brakes
courseware index. In Canada, refer to Service Know How course 55040.00V and Hydraulic Brake
Certification program 15003.16H.
Important
PLEASE FAMILIARIZE YOURSELF WITH THESE UPDATES BEFORE PERFORMING YOUR
NEXT GM BRAKE SERVICE.
The following four (4) key steps are a summary of this bulletin and are REQUIRED in completing a
successful brake service.
1. Measure and Document Pre-Service Rotor Thickness* (REQUIRED on Repair Order) determine rotor clean-up/refinish/replace
2. Properly clean ALL brake corner mating surfaces - hub, rotor and wheel
3. Properly clean-up/refinish rotor, measure and document post-service rotor thickness
(REQUIRED on Repair Order)
Important If it is determined the rotor needs to be refinished, verify lathe equipment is properly
calibrated.
4. Properly reassemble the brake corner using proper torque tools, torque specification and torque
sequence - wheel lug nuts.
* The bulletin refers to Minimum Thickness specification as the minimum allowable thickness after
refinish. Always refer to SI to verify the spec stamped on the rotor is the minimum thickness spec
after refinish and not the discard spec.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes- Disc Brake Warranty Service And Procedures > Page 6130
Bulletin Format
***REPAIR ORDER REQUIRED DOCUMENTATION
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes- Disc Brake Warranty Service And Procedures > Page 6131
Important
When using any one of the brake labor operations listed in this bulletin (except for H9709 - Brake
Burnish), the following two rotor measurements (1. Original Rotor Thickness, 2. Refinished Rotor
Thickness are required and MUST be written/documented on the repair order, or for your
convenience, complete the form (GM Brake Service Repair Order Documentation for Required
Measurements) shown above and attach it to the repair order. If the Warranty Parts Center
generates a request, this Documentation/Form must be attached to the repair order that is sent
back.
Important
Documentation of brake lathe maintenance and calibration as recommended by the lathe
manufacturer must be available for review upon request.
Repair Order Documentation - Rotor Original And Refinished Thickness - REQUIRED
When resurfacing a brake rotor or drum, the ORIGINAL thickness (measured thickness before
refinish) and REFINISHED thickness (measured thickness after refinish) MUST be
written/documented on the repair order hard copy for each rotor serviced. If a rotor replacement is
necessary, only the original thickness measurement needs to be recorded.
Repair Order Documentation - Explanation of Part Replacement - REQUIRED
If replacement of a brake component is necessary, proper documentation on the repair order is
required. See the following examples:
^ Brake rotor replacement - Customer comment was brake pulsation. Rotor was refinished on a
prior brake service. After rotor measurement, it was determined that refinishing the rotor again
would take it under the Minimum Thickness specification.
^ Brake pad replacement - Customer comment was brake squeak noise. On inspection, found pads
contaminated by fluid leak at caliper.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes- Disc Brake Warranty Service And Procedures > Page 6132
TOOL INFORMATION
CORRECTION PLATE PART INFORMATION
Refer to TSB 01-05-23-001 for the Brake Align(R) application chart.
For vehicles repaired under warranty, Brake Align(R) Run-Out Correction Plates should be
submitted in the Net Amount at cost plus 40%. Brake Align(R) Run-Out Correction Plates are
available through the following suppliers:
- Dealer Equipment and Services
- Brake Align(R) LLC (U.S. Dealers Only)
* We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such products. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products from this firm or for any such items, which may be available from
other sources.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes- Disc Brake Warranty Service And Procedures > Page 6133
WARRANTY INFORMATION
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes- Disc Brake Warranty Service And Procedures > Page 6134
WORKSHEET - BRAKE LATHE CALIBRATION
Important
Brake lathe calibration should be performed and recorded monthly or if you are consistently
measuring high LRO after rotor refinishing.
Disclaimer
GM Brake Service Procedure
GM BRAKE SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Remove the wheel and caliper.
2. Measure rotor thickness. In order to determine if the rotor can be refinished, do the following
steps:
Important
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes- Disc Brake Warranty Service And Procedures > Page 6135
If performing routine Brake Service for worn pads only, and the rotors are not damaged and
measure within specification - DO NOT REFINISH ROTORS.
1. Remove the rotor(s).
2. Measure the rotor for original thickness using a brake micrometer. Multiple measure points
should be taken and the lowest measurement
should be recorded.
3. Reference the Minimum Thickness specification stamped on the backside of the rotor or SI for
Minimum Thickness specification/other. In
most cases, the rotor should be refinished unless the measurement taken makes it obvious that
refinishing the rotor would take the measurement under the Minimum Thickness specification (then
replacement is necessary). DO NOT use any other manufacturers rotor specifications.
3. ***Record the lowest ORIGINAL rotor thickness measurement on the repair order hard copy as
noted in the "Repair Order Documentation - Rotor
Refinish" section of this bulletin.
4. Clean all of the mating surfaces between the hub, the rotor and the wheel using the J 42450A Wheel Hub Cleaning Kit and J 41013 - Whiz
Wheel(R).
If rotors are not to be refinished - Go To Step 8.
Important Cleaning all mating surfaces and making them free of corrosion, burrs and other debris
(which includes removal of Hubless rotors) is critical and MUST be performed whether using an
On-Car or Bench Lathe Refinish Procedure.
5. Be sure to follow the appropriate refinishing procedure listed below for the type of lathe you are
using.
Important Only replace the rotors if they do not meet the Minimum Thickness specification.
Important DO NOT REFINISH NEW ROTORS.
Important Only remove the necessary amount of material from each side of the rotor and note that
equal amounts of material do not have to be removed from both sides on any brake system using a
floating caliper.
Important Prior to making the cut, install the recommended clip-on style disc silencer supplied with
the lathe. Use of this silencer is critical to prevent chatter from occurring during the cut.
Bench Type Lathe
1. Refinish the existing rotor on an approved, well-maintained lathe to guarantee smooth, flat and
parallel surfaces.
2. Check for clean and true lathe adapters and make sure the arbor shoulder is clean and free of
debris or burrs. For more information, see the
"Brake Lathe Calibration Procedure (Bench-Type)" section in this bulletin.
3. On the outboard area of the rotor, position the cutting tools one eighth of an inch into the brake
pad area of the rotor. Feed the cutting tools
into the rotor until they cut the rotor to new metal, a full 360 degrees. Zero each dial and back off a
full turn
4. Move the cutting bits to the middle of the rotor and do the same procedure. If zero is passed
during the process, reset zero. Back off a full turn.
5. Position the cutting bits one eighth of an inch inside the inboard (closest to the hub) edge of the
brake pad contact area. Do the same
procedure. If zero is passed during the process, reset zero.
6. Back off a full turn and position the cutting bits all the way inboard in preparation to refinish the
full rotor surface. Advance both tool cutters to the
zero setting plus just enough to clean up the entire rotor surface.
7. After completing the refinish, sand both sides of the rotor for approximately one minute per side
using a sanding block and 130-150 grit sandpaper
to obtain a non-directional finish.
On-Car Type Lathe
1. Reinstall the rotor(s).
Important
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes- Disc Brake Warranty Service And Procedures > Page 6136
When using the On-Car lathe on vehicles equipped with limited slip (or posi-trac) rear system, it is
critical that the rear drive shaft is disconnected/disengaged prior to operation of the On-Car lathe.
Remember to mark and re-index the drive shaft correctly on re-assembly to prevent creating
driveline vibration. Whenever the lathe drive motor is being switched on, the operator MUST keep
their body out of the wheel well area until the machine has reached its normal operating RPM.
2. Refinish the existing rotor on an approved, well-maintained lathe to guarantee smooth, flat and
parallel surfaces.
Important When raising the vehicle on the lift, be sure to have it at a good working height (waist
high is average) to accommodate mounting the On-Car lathe. Optimally, the center piston on the
lathe trolley will be mid-travel. If the lathe trolley center piston is completely compressed (bottoming
out) or inversely fully extended and hanging off the vehicle hub, this could affect the calibration time
of the lathe.
3. Select the correct adapter for the vehicle you're working on and mount it to the hub with the
vehicle lug nuts. Hand tighten 34-41 Nm (25-30 lb
ft) the nuts using equal torque. DO NOT use impact wrenches, excessive torque will damage the
adapter.
Important Ensure the adapter sits flush on the rotor hat surface. Be sure to remove any rust, rotor
retaining clips, etc. that may preclude the adapter from sitting flat on the mounting surface.
4. Connect the lathe to the adapter, turn on the lathe and activate the computer to compensate for
run-out in the hub.
5. Once the computer indicates the compensation process was successful, on the outboard area of
the rotor, position the cutting tools one eighth
of an inch into the brake pad area of the rotor. Feed the cutting tools into the rotor until they cut the
rotor to new metal, a full 360 degrees. Zero each dial and back off a full turn.
6. Move the cutting bits to the middle of the rotor and do the same procedure. If zero is passed
during the process, reset zero. Back off a full turn.
7. Position the cutting bits one eighth of an inch inside the inboard (closest to the hub) edge of the
brake pad contact area. Do the same
procedure. If zero is passed during the process, reset zero.
8. Back off a full turn and position the cutting bits all the way inboard in preparation to refinish the
full rotor surface. Advance both tool cutters
to the zero setting plus just enough to clean up the entire rotor surface.
9. After completing the refinish, sand both sides of the rotor for approximately one minute per side
using a sanding block and 130-150 grit
sandpaper to obtain a non-directional finish.
10. Dismount the lathe, but leave the lathe adapter attached to the vehicle.
6. Once the rotor has been properly machined, wash the rotor with soap and water (use a mild dish
washing soap) or wipe it clean with GM approved
brake cleaner, P/N 88862650 (Canadian P/N 88901247).
Important Thoroughly cleaning the rotor will prevent the possible transfer of finite metal dust left as
a by-product of machining to the pad material during the seating process, thus reducing the
opportunity for squeaks or other noises to occur.
7. ***Record the REFINISHED rotor thickness measurement on the repair order hard copy. Refer
to the "Repair Order Documentation - Rotor
Refinish" section of this bulletin.
8. Setting up to measure for Lateral Run Out (LRO):
Important Measuring for Lateral Run Out (LRO) (steps 8 - 15) is no longer required however, these
steps are being left in the overall procedure as a good check to be performed in the case of a
repeat pulsation complaint. If you are not checking for LRO, go to step 16.
Bench-Type Lathe
1. Ensure that the mating surfaces of the rotor hat section and the hub mating surface are clean
and free of debris.
2. Mount the new, original or refinished rotor onto the vehicle hub.
Important Always hold the rotor on the bottom half so any debris that may be dislodged from the
vents will fall out instead of falling into the mounting area. Any movement or jarring from the rotor
falling over on the studs can release rust from the vents on the rotor.
3. Tilt the top of the rotor in towards the vehicle so you can see the studs and ease the rotor onto
the studs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes- Disc Brake Warranty Service And Procedures > Page 6137
4. Slide the rotor all the way to the hub and hold it in place until you have placed one of the conical
washers (with the tapered hole side facing
out) and run the first lug nut up tight by hand so the rotor doesn't move when you release it.
5. Place the conical washers on the rest of the studs (with the tapered hole side facing out), start
and snug the lug nuts by hand.
6. Using the one half inch drive impact wrench and a torque stick (J 39544) or equivalent, start with
the lug nut opposite of the one you first
tightened by hand and tighten the lug nuts using a star pattern until they touch the hub but do not
completely torque. Then again, starting with the first lug nut you tightened by hand, tighten all the
lug nuts in a star pattern to the specific vehicle torque specification.
7. DO NOT reinstall the caliper or the wheel at this time.
On-Car Type Lathe
1. Leave the On-Car adapter on the wheel.
2. Proceed to Step 9.
9. Fasten the dial indicator to the steering knuckle so that the indicator needle contacts the rotor
outboard friction surface approximately 6.35 mm
(0.25 in) from the rotor's outer edge. The stylus should be perpendicular to the friction surface of
the rotor.
Important Make sure the dial indicator needle tip is screwed tight, a loose tip could cause false
readings.
10. Measure for LRO. Follow the procedure below to determine if the LRO is within specification
(0.050 mm (0.002 in) or LESS).
1. Rotate the rotor and locate the point on the rotor where the lowest dial indicator reading is
indicated and set the dial indicator to zero.
2. Rotate the rotor from the low point and locate the point with the highest dial indicator reading
(rotor "high spot"). Note the amount and mark
the location of the "high spot" on the rotor and mark the closest wheel stud relative to this location.
If the high point falls between two studs, mark both studs. In instances where the vehicle has
"capped lug nuts" you should mark the hub.
11. If the Lateral Run Out (LRO) measurement is 0.050 mm (0.002 in) or LESS, no correction is
necessary. Go to Step 15 if this is the first rotor
completed. Go to Step 16 if this is the second rotor completed. If the LRO is GREATER than 0.050
mm (0.002 in), go to Step 12.
12. If the LRO measurement is greater than 0.050 mm (0.002 in), use the following procedure to
correct for LRO:
Important If the LRO measurement is over 0.279 mm (0.011 in), determine the source or cause of
the LRO and correct it (i.e. verify drive axle nut torque specification, refinished rotor is source of
LRO due to a lathe qualification issue - see "Brake Lathe Calibration Procedure").
Hubless Rotor
1. Remove the rotor and using the Brake Align(R) application chart (found in TSB 01-05-23-001B),
choose the correct plate to bring the rotor
LRO to 0.050 mm (0.002 in) or less. The plates come in 0.0762 mm (0.003 in), 0.1524 mm (0.006
in) and 0.2286 (0.009 in) compensation. For more information on proper plate selection, see the
instruction video/DVD included in the "Brake Align(R)" kit or TSB 01-05-23-001B.
2. Align the V-notch of the selected Brake Align(R) correction plate to the marked wheel stud ("high
spot") or between the two points marked (if
the "high spot" is between two wheel studs).
Important IF Brake Align(R) Correction Plates are not available for the vehicle being serviced, refer
to SI Document - Brake Rotor Assembled Lateral Runout Correction for correcting LRO.
Important Per Brake Align(R) manufacturer, NEVER attempt to stack two or more Correction Plates
together on one hub. NEVER attempt to reuse a previously installed Correction Plate.
3. Reinstall the rotor using the same method and precautions as the first time - found in Step 8.
Make sure to index the rotor correctly to the
marks made in step 10, otherwise LRO will be comprised.
Hubbed / Captured / Trapped Rotor
1. Measure the rotor thickness.
2. Refinish or replace the rotor (see Service Information for further details).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes- Disc Brake Warranty Service And Procedures > Page 6138
13. Use a Dial Indicator to measure the rotor to verify the LRO is within specification.
14. If using,
BENCH LATHE - DO NOT remove conical washers and lug nuts at this time.
ON-CAR LATHE - You must remove adapter and install conical washers and lug nuts to retain
rotor position.
Important For Hubless rotor design, while removing the adapter, you must hold the rotor tight to the
hub and install the top conical washer and lug nut first to ensure no debris falls between the
surface while removing the adapter. Then, install the remaining conical washers and lug nuts.
Otherwise, LRO will be comprised.
15. Perform Steps 1 through 7 on the opposite side of the vehicle (steps 1-12, if performing LRO).
16. Reinstall the rotors on both sides of the vehicle and perform the following steps:
1. Reinstall the calipers and pads.
2. Pump the brakes to pressurize the calipers.
3. Remove the lug nuts/conical washers.
4. Install and properly torque the wheels.
Important It is critical to follow the star pattern wheel torque procedure and use the proper tools
(torque stick or torque wrench) as referenced in SI.
17. Road test the vehicle to verify the repairs.
Brake Lathe Calibration Procedure
BRAKE LATHE CALIBRATION PROCEDURE
Calibration of the brake lathe should be performed and recorded monthly or whenever post-service
brake rotor LRO measurements are consistently reading above specification.
BENCH-TYPE LATHE
Use the following procedure to calibrate a Bench-type brake lathe:
1. After refinishing a rotor, loosen the arbor nut and while holding the inside bell clamp to keep it
from rotating, rotate the rotor 180 degrees.
2. Retighten the arbor nut and set the dial indicator on the rotor using the same instructions as
checking the run out on the vehicle.
3. Rotate the arbor and read the runout.
4. Divide the reading by two and this will give you the amount of runout the lathe is cutting into the
rotor.
Important If there is any runout, you will need to machine the inside bell clamp in place on the lathe
(this procedure is for a Bench type lathe ONLY, DO NOT machine inside the bell clamp on an
On-Car type lathe).
Machining the Inside Bell Clamp (Bench Type Lathe Only)
Any nicks or burrs on the shoulder of the arbor must be removed. An 80-grit stone can be used to
accomplish this. Spray WD-40(R) on the shoulder and with the lathe running, hold the stone flat
against the shoulder surface using slight pressure. When the burrs are gone, clean the surface.
Burrs must also be removed from the hub of the inside bell clamp. This can be accomplished with
the stone and WD-40(R). Keep the stone flat on the hub while removing the burrs. After removing
the burrs, clean the hub.
Place the bell clamp on the arbor of the lathe and use the small radius adapters first and then
spacers to allow you to tighten the arbor nut to secure the bell clamp to the lathe. Position the tool
bit in the left hand of the rotor truer so you can machine the face of the bell clamp. Machine the
face of the bell clamp taking just enough off of it to cut the full face of the clamp the full 360
degrees. Before you loosen the arbor nut, match mark the hub of the bell clamp to the arbor and
line up these marks before machining a rotor. A magic marker can be used to make the match
marks. Machine a rotor and recheck the calibration. Repeat this procedure on all Inside Bell
Clamps used.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes- Disc Brake Warranty Service And Procedures > Page 6139
Important
If runout is still present, contact the brake lathe supplier.
ON-CAR TYPE LATHE
Use the following procedure to calibrate an On-Car brake lathe:
1. Connect the lathe to a vehicle using the appropriate adapter.
2. Attach a vise-grip dial indicator to a fixed point in the wheel well and bring the dial indicator to a
flat surface on the cutting head.
3. Turn on the lathe and press the "start" button so the lathe begins to compensate.
4. Once compensation is complete, note the runout as measured by the dial indicator. Measured
runout at this point is overstated given that it is
outside the rotor diameter.
5. If runout is in excess of 0.1016 mm (0.004 in) (0.050 mm (0.002 in) as measured within the rotor
diameter), calibration must be tightened. Follow
manufacturer's instructions for tightening the calibration of the lathe. This information is found in the
manual supplied with the lathe.
Important If the machine is taking a long time to compensate during normal use, prior to checking
the lathe calibration, it is recommended that the machine be disconnected from the adapter and the
adapter (still connected to the vehicle) is rotated 180 degrees and the machine reattached. This will
accomplish two things: - It will re-verify the machine is properly attached to the adapter. - It will
change the location of the runout (phase) relative to the machine and thus possibly allow for quick
compensation as a result of the position change.
The following information has been added as a reference to ensure your Pro-Cut PFM lathe
provides a consistent smooth surface finish over long term usage.
Cutting Tips / Depth of Cut / Tip Life
The cutting tips must be right side up. Reference marks always face up. The cutting tips may not
have chips or dings in the surface of the points. Cuts of 0.1016-0.381 mm (0.004-0.015 in) will
provide the best surface finish and the optimal tip life. When cleaning or rotating the cutting bits,
make sure that the seat area for the tip on the tool is free and clear of debris.
Cutting Head
On each brake job, the technician must center the cutting head for that particular vehicle using one
of the mounting bolt holes on the slide plate. Once the head is centered, it is vital that the
technician use one hand to push the head firmly and squarely back into the dovetail on the slide
plate while using the other hand to tighten the Allen-Hex bolt that secures the head. Failure to do
this could result in chatter occurring during the cut.
Tool Holder Plate (Cutting Head)
The tool holder plate is the plate that the cutting arms are attached to. It can bend or break if a
technician accidently runs the cutting arms into the hub of the rotor while the rotor is turning. (Cuts
of more than 0.508 mm (0.020 in) can also bend this plate). Once bent, the lathe will most likely not
cut properly until the tool holder plate is replaced. In order to verify the condition of the tool holder
plate on a machine that will not cut right, remove the mounting bolt and remove the cutting head
from the slide plate. With the cutting head titled at an angle, lay the long edge of the tool holder
plate down on the flat part of the slide plate. If any gap can be seen between the edge and the slide
plate, the tool holder plate is bent and the source of vibration. Also check to ensure that the cutting
arms are lying flat on the upper side of the tool holder plate. If the mounting arm post is bent, it will
show itself by having the back of the cutting arm lifting off the surface of the tool holder.
Gib Adjustment / Loose Gib
As wear occurs between the slide plate and the box it rides on, you must take up the slack. You do
this by way of a moveable wedge, which we call the gib. Your lathe manual details adjustment
process, which you should perform when required after monthly checks or whenever surface finish
is inconsistent.
Brake Pulsation
BRAKE PULSATION
Brake pulsation is caused by brake rotor thickness variation. Brake rotor thickness variation causes
the piston in the brake caliper, when applied, to "pump" in and out of the caliper housing. The
"pumping" effect is transmitted hydraulically to the brake pedal. Brake pulsation concerns may
result from two basic conditions:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes- Disc Brake Warranty Service And Procedures > Page 6140
1. Thickness Variation Pulsation is Caused by Lateral Run Out (LRO). LRO on a brake corner
assembly is virtually undetectable unless measured
(with a dial indicator after the brake service) and will not be detected as brake pulsation during an
after brake service test drive. If the brake corner is assembled with excessive LRO (greater than
0.050 mm (0.002 in), thickness variation will develop on the brake rotor over time and miles.
Excessive LRO will cause the brake pads to wear the brake rotors unevenly, which causes rotor
thickness variation. Pulsation that is the result of excessive Lateral Run Out usually develops in
4,800-16,000 km (3,000-10,000 mi). The more excessive the LRO, the faster the pulsation will
develop. LRO can also be induced when uneven torque is applied to wheel nuts (lug nuts).
Improper wheel tightening after tire rotation, spare tire usage, brake inspection, etc. can be the
cause of brake pulsation. Again, it usually takes 4,800-16,000 km (3,000-10,000 mi) AFTER the
service event for the condition to develop. The customer does not usually make the connection
between the service event and the awareness of the pulsation. The proper usage of torque
wrenches and/or torque sticks (torque limiting sockets) will greatly reduce or eliminate the pulsation
conditions after wheel service events. The improper use of impact wrenches on wheel nuts greatly
increases the likelihood of pulsation after wheel service.
The following are examples of pulsation conditions and reimbursement recommendations:
- If the customer noticed the condition between 4,800-16,000 km (3,000-10,000 mi) and it gradually
got worse, normally the repair would be covered. The customer may tolerate the condition until it
becomes very apparent.
- If a GM dealer performed a prior brake service, consider paying for the repair and then strongly
reinforce proper brake lathe maintenance.
- If the customer had the brake service done outside of a GM dealership, normally GM would not
offer any assistance.
- If a customer indicated they had wheel service, ask who performed the service. Then;
- If a GM dealer performed the service, consider paying for the repair and then strongly reinforce
the use of torque sticks at the dealer. Two common size torque sticks cover 90% of all GM
products. Each technician needs to use torque sticks properly every time the wheel nuts are
tightened.
- If the customer had the wheel service done outside of a GM dealership, normally GM would not
offer any assistance.
2. Thickness Variation Pulsation Caused by Brake Rotor Corrosion - Rotor corrosion is another
form of thickness variation, which can cause a
pulsation concern and can be addressed as follows:
- Cosmetic Corrosion:
In most instances rotor corrosion is cosmetic and refinishing the rotor is unnecessary.
- Corrosion - Pulsation Caused by Thickness Variation (Lot Rot / Low Miles - 0-321 km (0-200 mi):
At times more extensive corrosion can cause pulsation due to thickness variation. This usually
happens when the vehicle is parked for long periods of time in humid type conditions and the
braking surface area under the pads corrodes at a different rate compared to the rest of the braking
surface area. Cleaning up of braking surfaces (burnishing) can be accomplished by 10 - 15
moderate stops from 56- 64 km/h (35 - 40 mph) with cooling time between stops. If multiple
moderate braking stops do not correct this condition, follow the "Brake Rotor Clean-Up Procedure"
below.
- Corrosion - Pulsation Caused by Thickness Variation (without rotor flaking / higher mileage 3,200-8,000 km (2,000-5,000 mi):
In some cases, more extensive corrosion that is not cleaned up by the brake pad over time and
miles can cause the same type of pulsation complaint due to thickness variation. In these cases,
the rotor surface is usually darker instead of shiny and a brake pad foot print can be seen against
the darker surface. This darker surface is usually due to build-up, on the rotor material surface,
caused by a combination of corrosion, pad material and heat. To correct this condition, follow the
"Brake Rotor Clean-up Procedure" below.
- Corrosion - Pulsation Caused by Thickness Variation (with rotor flaking / higher mileage - 8,000 +
km (5,000 + miles) :
At times, more extensive corrosion over time and miles can cause pulsation due to thickness
variation (flaking). This flaking is usually a build up, mostly on the rotor material surface, caused by
a combination of corrosion, pad material and heat. When rotor measurements are taken, the low
areas are usually close to the original rotor thickness (new rotor) measurement and the high areas
usually measure more than the original rotor thickness (new rotor) measurement (depending on
mileage and normal wear). To correct this condition, follow the "Brake Rotor Clean-up Procedure"
described below.
Important In some flaking instances, cleaning-up this type of corrosion may require more rotor
material to be removed then desired. Customer consideration should be taken in these situations
and handled on a case by case basis, depending on the amount/percentage of rotor life remaining
and the vehicle's warranty time and miles.
Brake Rotor Clean-Up Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes- Disc Brake Warranty Service And Procedures > Page 6141
BRAKE ROTOR CLEAN-UP PROCEDURE
Clean-up the rotors on an approved, well-maintained brake lathe to guarantee smooth, flat and
parallel surfaces. Check for clean and true lathe adapters and make sure the arbor shoulder is
clean and free of debris or burrs. For more information see the "Brake Lathe Calibration Procedure"
section in this bulletin.
1. On the outboard area of the rotor, position the cutting tools one eighth of an inch into the brake
pad area of the rotor. Feed the cutting tools into the
rotor until they cut the rotor to new metal, a full 360 degrees. Zero each dial and back off a full turn.
2. Move the cutting bits to the middle of the rotor and do the same procedure. If zero is passed
during the process, reset zero. Back off a full turn.
3. Position the cutting bits one eighth of an inch inside the inboard (closest to the hub) edge of the
brake pad contact area. Do the same procedure. If
zero is passed during the process, reset zero.
4. Back off a full turn and position the cutting bits all the way inboard in preparation to refinish the
full rotor surface. Advance both tool cutters to the
zero setting plus just enough to clean up the entire rotor surface.
5. After completing the refinish, sand both sides of the rotor for approximately one minute per side
using a sanding block and 130-150 grit sandpaper
to obtain a non-directional finish.
Important Only remove the necessary amount of material from each side of the rotor and note that
equal amounts of material do not have to be removed from both sides on any brake system using a
floating caliper.
Important In many of these instances, such a minimal amount of material is removed from the rotor
that customer satisfaction is not a concern for future brake services. This procedure is intended to
"Clean-up" the rotor surface and should be conveyed to the customer as such - not as "cut",
"refinish" or "machine", which tends to be terms understood as a substantial reduction of rotor
material/life. If the brake lathe equipment being used is not capable of removing minor amounts of
material while holding tolerances, further lathe maintenance, repair, updates or equipment
replacement may be necessary.
Brake Noise
BRAKE NOISE
Some brake noise is normal and differences in loading, type of driving, or driving style can make a
difference in brake wear on the same make and model. Depending on weather conditions, driving
patterns and the local environment, brake noise may become more or less apparent. Verify all
metal-to-metal contact areas between pads, pad guides, caliper and knuckles are clean and
lubricated with a thin layer of high temperature silicone grease. Brake noise is caused by a
"slip-stick" vibration of brake components. While intermittent brake noise may be normal,
performing 3 to 4 aggressive stops may temporarily reduce or eliminate most brake squeal. If the
noise persists and is consistently occurring, a brake dampening compound may be applied to the
back of each pad. This allows parts to slide freely and not vibrate when moving relative to each
other. Use Silicone Brake Lubricant, ACDelco P/N 88862181 (Canadian P/N 88862496) or
equivalent.
The following noises are characteristics of all braking systems and are unavoidable. They may not
indicate improper operation of the brake system.
Squeak/Squeal Noise:
- Occurs with front semi-metallic brake pads at medium speeds when light to medium pressure is
applied to the brake pedal.
- Occasionally a noise may occur on rear brakes during the first few stops or with cold brakes
and/or high humidity.
Grinding Noise:
- Common to rear brakes and some front disc brakes during initial stops after the vehicle has been
parked overnight.
- Caused by corrosion on the metal surfaces during vehicle non-use. Usually disappears after a few
stops.
Groan Noise:
A groan type noise may be heard when stopping quickly or moving forward slowly from a complete
stop. This is normal. On vehicles equipped with ABS, a groan or moan type noise during hard
braking applications or loose gravel, wet or icy road conditions is a normal function of the ABS
activation.
Key Points - Frequently Asked Questions
KEY POINTS - FREQUENTLY ASKED QUESTIONS
- Q: How do on-car lathes react to Axle Float? Does the play affect the machining of the rotor,
either surface finish or LRO?
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes- Disc Brake Warranty Service And Procedures > Page 6142
A: Because the Pro-Cut on-car lathe adjusts in a live mode while spinning the hub/rotor, the
dynamics of a floating axle are effectively eliminated. Once the lathe is compensated, there is no
difference in the cutting/surface finish and LRO are just the same as with a non-floating axle.
- Q: Which lathe is essential for performing brake work, the bench or on-car?
A: Dealers must have a well maintained bench lathe and well maintained on-car lathe. These
lathes need to be calibrated on a monthly basis. BOTH lathes are essential to providing quality
brake service.
- Q: What is the expected tip life for an on-car lathe?
A: The geometry and composition of the Pro-Cut tips are designed for "single pass" cutting. When
using the Pro-Cut the cutting depth should be set to take all material needed to get below rust
grooves, eliminate all run-out and resurface the entire disc in a single pass. Cuts of 0.1016-0.381
mm (0.004-0.015 in) will provide the best surface finish and the optimal tip life. No "skim cut" or
"finish cut" is needed. Failure to follow this procedure will shorten tip life. The Pro-cut tips will last
between 7-12 cuts per corner. With three usable corners, a pair of tips is good for at least 21 cuts.
- Q: Why does GM recommend the use of single pass (referred to as "positive rake") bench and
on-car brake lathes?
A: GM Service and GM Brake Engineering have performed competitive evaluations on a significant
number of bench and on-car brake lathes. These tests measured critical performance
characteristics such as flatness, surface finish and the ability of the lathe to repeat accuracy over
many uses. In each test, single pass lathe designs out performed the competitors. Single pass
brake lathes are more productive requiring less time to perform the same procedure.
- Q: Is it okay to leave the caliper/pads installed while cutting rotors using an on-car lathe?
A: On-car lathes should never be used with the pads and calipers installed on the vehicle. The
debris from cutting the rotors can contaminate the brake pads/calipers which can lead to other
brake concerns and comebacks.
- Q: What information needs to be documented on the Repair Order?
A: Any claim that is submitted using the labor operations in this bulletin, must have the Original
Rotor Thickness and Refinish Rotor Thickness (if refinished) documented on the repair order. For
more information, refer to the "Repair Order Required Documentation" section of this bulletin.
All Warranty Repair Orders paid by GM, are subject to review for compliance and may be debited
where the repair does not comply with this procedure.
Brake Warranty
BRAKE WARRANTY
Brake Rotors:
- Brake rotor warranty is covered under the terms of the GM New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
Reference the vehicle's warranty guide for verification.
- Rotors should not be refinished or replaced during normal/routine pad replacement.
- Rotors should not be refinished or replaced and is ineffective in correcting brake squeal type
noises and/or premature lining wear out.
- Rotors should not be refinished or replaced for cosmetic corrosion. Clean up of braking surfaces
can be accomplished by 10-15 moderate stops from 56-64 km/h (35-40 mph) with cooling time
between stops.
- Rotors should not be refinished or replaced for rotor discoloration/hard spots.
- Rotors should be refinished NOT replaced for Customer Pulsation concerns. This condition is a
result of rotor thickness variation, usually caused by LRO (wear induced over time and miles) or
corrosion (Lot Rot).
- When rotor refinishing, only remove the necessary amount of material from each side of the rotor
and note that equal amounts of material do not have to be removed from both sides on any brake
system using a floating caliper.
- Rotors should be refinished for severe scoring - depth in excess of 1.5 mm (0.060 in).
Important If the scoring depth is more than 1.5 mm (0.060 in) after the rotor is refinished, it should
be replaced.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes- Disc Brake Warranty Service And Procedures > Page 6143
- It is not necessary to replace rotors in pairs. Rotors may be replaced individually. However,
caution should be exercised, as a variance in surface finish may cause a brake pull condition.
- New rotors should not be refinished before installation. Original equipment rotor surfaces are
ground to ensure smooth finish and parallelism between mounting and friction surfaces. If a new
rotor has more than 0.050 mm (0.002 in) Lateral Run Out (LRO) when properly mounted on the
hub, correct it using one of the following methods:
1. For hubless rotor designs, use the correction plate procedure found in the "GM Brake Service
Procedure for Hubless Rotors" outlined in this
bulletin.
2. For hubbed/trapped/captured rotor designs, refinish the rotor using an On-Car lathe and the
procedure outlined in this bulletin.
- Never reuse rotors that measure under the Minimum Thickness specification. In this instance, the
rotor should be replaced.
Important If the Minimum Thickness specification is not visible on the rotor, reference Service
Information (SI) for the specific vehicle application. DO NOT use any other manufacturers rotor
specifications.
Brake Pads:
Important When determining the warranty coverage (as an example) - if all four front or four rear
brake pads are excessively worn evenly, that would NOT be covered under warranty since this
type of wear is most likely due to driving habits or trailering. However, if the brake pads are
excessively worn un-evenly, side-to-side or same side/inner-to-outer pads, then consideration
should be given to cover this under warranty since this type of wear is most likely due to poor
operation of other braking components.
- Consideration should be given for covering brake pads up to 39,000 km (24,000 mi) (excluding
owner abuse, excessive trailering, or the situations that would not be considered normal use).
- Installation of new rotors does not require pad replacement. Do not replace pads unless their
condition requires it - excessively worn, damage or contaminated.
Brake Wear:
Several factors impact brake lining wear and should be taken into account when reviewing related
issues:
- heavy loads / high temperatures / towing / mountainous driving / city driving / aggressive driving /
driver braking characteristics (left foot or two feet)
The following are conditions that may extend brake lining wear:
- light loads / highway driving / conservative driving / level terrain
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6144
Brake Rotor/Disc: Specifications
Rotor Maximum Allowable Radial Runout 0.006 in
Rotor Maximum Allowable Scoring 0.059 in
Splash Shield Bolts 12 ft. lbs.
M-Van (RWD) Rotor Discard Thickness* 0.965 in
*All brake rotors have a discard dimension cast into them.
Replace any rotor that does not meet this specification. After
refinishing the rotor, replace any rotor that does not meet the
minimum or discard thickness specifications.
Rotor Minimum Allowable Thickness After Refinish 0.980 in
Rotor Thickness (new) 1.04 in
Rotor Maximum Allowable Lateral Runout 0.002 in
Rotor Maximum Allowable Scoring 0.059 in
Rotor Maximum Allowable Thickness Variation (0.001 in
L-Van (A4WD) Rotor Discard Thickness* 1.215 in
*All brake rotors have a discard dimension cast into them.
Replace any rotor that does not meet this specification. After
refinishing the rotor, replace any rotor that does not meet the
minimum or discard thickness specifications.
Rotor Minimum Allowable Thickness After Refinish 1.23 in
Rotor Thickness (new) 1.25 in
Rotor Maximum Allowable Lateral Runout 0.002 in
Rotor Maximum Allowable Scoring 0.059 in
Rotor Maximum Allowable Thickness Variation 0.001 in
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6145
Brake Rotor/Disc: Service Precautions
Caution: Road test a vehicle under safe conditions and while obeying all traffic laws. Do not
attempt any maneuvers that could jeopardize vehicle control. Failure to adhere to these
precautions could lead to serious personal injury and vehicle damage.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Rotor Replacement
Brake Rotor/Disc: Service and Repair Brake Rotor Replacement
Brake Rotor Replacement
Removal Procedure
Notice: Any new rotor must have the protective coating removed from the friction surfaces before
being placed in service. Use Goodwrench Brake Parts Cleaner, GM P/N 123777981, or the
equivalent, and wipe the surface clean with clean cloths. Do not use gasoline, kerosene, or other
oil base solvents that may leave an oily residue. This residue is damaging to the brake lining and is
flammable.
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the tire and wheel assembly.
Notice: Support the brake caliper with heavy mechanic's wire, or equivalent, whenever it is
separated from it's mount and the hydraulic flexible brake hose is still connected. Failure to support
the caliper in this manner will cause the flexible brake hose to bear the weight of the caliper, which
may cause damage to the brake hose and in turn may cause a brake fluid leak.
3. Remove the brake caliper. 4. Remove the rotor (RWD only).
5. Remove the rotor (A4WD only). 6. Inspect all of the parts. Replace any damaged or corroded
parts.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Rotor Replacement > Page 6148
1. Install the rotor to the hub and bearing assembly (A4WD only).
2. Install the rotor to the steering knuckle (RWD only). 3. Install the brake caliper. 4. Install the tire
and wheel assembly.
Important: Before moving the vehicle, pump the brake pedal until it is firm. Check the brake fluid
level in the master cylinder after pumping the brakes.
5. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Rotor Replacement > Page 6149
Brake Rotor/Disc: Service and Repair Disc Brake Splash Shield Replacement- Front
Disc Brake Splash Shield Replacement- Front
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the tire and wheel. 3. Remove the brake
rotor. 4. Remove the two wheel hub and bearing mounting bolts that secure the splash shield to the
spindle. 5. Remove the splash shield.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the splash shield.
Notice: Refer to fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the two wheel hub and bearing mounting bolts that secure the splash shield to the spindle.
^ Tighten the wheel hub and bearing mounting bolts to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs.).
3. Install the brake rotor. 4. Install the tire and wheel. 5. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Rotor Replacement > Page 6150
Brake Rotor/Disc: Service and Repair Brake Rotor Refinishing
Brake Rotor Refinishing
^ Tools Required J 39144 Composite Rotor Mounting Adapter
- J 41013 Rotor Resurfacing Kit
- J 42450-A Wheel Hub Resurfacing Kit
- J 39544-KIT Complete Torque Socket Set (10 Pieces)
Important: Do NOT refinish the brake rotors in order to correct any of the following complaints: ^
Brake noise (growl/squeal)
^ Premature brake lining wear
^ Cosmetic or superficial corrosion of the rotor braking surface
^ Rotor discoloration
Refinish the brake rotors ONLY when one or more of the following conditions exist: ^
Severe scoring of the rotor braking surface (groove depth in excess of 1.5 mm (0.060 in)
^ Brake pulsation caused by the following: Brake rotor thickness variation in excess of 0.025 mm (0.001 in)
- Corrosion or pitting of the rotor braking surface that is deeper than the rotor braking surface
The following brake lathes are approved and achieve satisfactory results. ^
Accu Turn (off-vehicle)
^ Pro-Cut (on-vehicle)
Notice: Do not allow the brake components to hang from the flexible brake hoses. Damage to the
brake hoses could result.
1. Remove and support the brake caliper. 2. Make a mark on the brake rotor in order to identify the
relationship to the hub.
Notice: Whenever the brake rotor has been separated from the wheel bearing flange, clean any
rust or foreign material from the mating surface of the rotor and flange with the J 42450 hub
cleaning kit. Failure to do this may result in increased lateral runout of the rotor and brake
pulsation.
3. Remove the brake rotor. 4. Use the J 42450-A in order to clean the wheel bearing/hub. 5. Use a
micrometer in order to measure the thinnest point of the brake rotor. If the thinnest point of the
brake rotor exceeds the brake rotor minimum
thickness, do NOT refinish the brake rotor. Replace the brake rotor.
6. Use the J41013 (or equivalent) in order to thoroughly clean the rust from the rotor/hub flange
and from the rotor/wheel mating surfaces. 7. Install the brake rotor.
^ If you use the Accu Turn (off-vehicle) brake lathe, install the brake rotor to the brake lathe. If you
are machining a composite rotor, use the J 39144. Refer to the brake lathe manufacturer's
operating instructions.
^ If you use the Pro-Cut (on-vehicle) brake lathe, install the brake rotor to the vehicle. Align the
brake rotor to the hub using the marks made during the removal procedure.
8. Refinish the brake rotor. Refer to the brake lathe manufacturer's operating instructions.
Important: Failure to obtain the best possible rotor finish may cause the vehicle to stop with
difficulty.
9. After machining the rotor, use 120 grit aluminum oxide sandpaper and a non-directional rotor
finisher (if available) in order to create a
non-directional braking surface.
10. Clean the braking surfaces with denatured alcohol or with a suitable brake cleaner. 11. If you
use the Accu Turn (off-vehicle) brake lathe, remove the brake rotor from the brake lathe and install
the brake rotor to the vehicle. Align the
brake rotor to the hub using the marks made during the removal procedure.
12. Install the brake caliper.
Notice: Improperly tightened wheel nuts can lead to brake pulsation and rotor damage. In order to
avoid expensive brake repairs, evenly tighten the wheel nuts to the proper torque specification.
13. Use the applicable torque socket from the J 39544-KIT or a torque wrench in order to install the
wheel to the correct specification.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Backing Plate > Component
Information > Specifications
Backing Plate: Specifications
Backing Plate Mounting Bolts 35 inch lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Backing Plate > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6155
Backing Plate: Service and Repair
Brake Backing Plate Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the tire and wheel assembly. 3. Remove
the brake drum. 4. Remove the brake shoes. 5. Remove the wheel cylinder. 6. Remove the axle
shaft. 7. Remove the backing plate bolts. 8. Remove the backing plate.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the backing plate.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the backing plate bolts.
^ Tighten the bolts to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
3. Install the axle shaft. 4. Install the wheel cylinder. 5. Install the brake shoes. 6. Install the brake
drum. 7. Install the tire and wheel assembly. 8. Lower the vehicle. 9. Bleed the brake system.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Drum > Component Information
> Specifications
Brake Drum: Specifications
Drum Discard Diameter* 9.59 in
*All brake drums have a discard dimension cast into them.
Replace any drum that does not meet this specification. After
refinishing the drum, replace any drum that does not meet the
maximum or discard diameter specifications.
Drum Maximum Allowable Diameter After Refinish 9.56 in
Inside Diameter (new) 9.50 in
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Drum > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Brake Drum Replacement
Brake Drum: Service and Repair Brake Drum Replacement
Brake Drum Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle and support the vehicle with suitable safety stands. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2.
Remove the tire and the wheel from the vehicle. 3. Mark the relationship of the rear brake drum to
the axle for reference. 4. Remove the rear brake drum retainers if present. 5. Remove the rear
brake drum from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Locate the relationship mark and install the brake drum to the axle. 2. Install the tire and the
wheel. 3. Adjust the rear brakes. 4. Remove the safety stands. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Drum > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Brake Drum Replacement > Page 6161
Brake Drum: Service and Repair Brake Drum Refinishing
Brake Drum Refinishing
^ Tools Required J 41013 Rotor Resurfacing Kit
Important: Do NOT refinish the brake drums in order to correct any of the following complaints: ^
Brake noise (growl/squeal)
^ Premature brake lining wear
^ Cosmetic or superficial corrosion of the drum braking surface
^ Drum discoloration
Refinish the brake drums ONLY when one or more of the following conditions exist: ^
Severe scoring of the drum braking surface (groove depth in excess of specification)
^ Brake pulsation caused by the following: Brake drum out of round (runout in excess of specification)
- Corrosion or pitting that is deeper than the drum braking surface
1. Use a micrometer in order to measure the largest diameter of the brake drum. If the largest
diameter of the brake drum exceeds the brake drum
maximum refinish diameter, do NOT refinish the brake drum. Replace the brake drum.
2. Use the J41013 or an equivalent tool in order to THOROUGHLY clean the rust from the brake
drum flange. 3. Refinish the brake drum. Refer to the brake lathe manufacturer's operating
instructions.
Important: Failure to obtain the best possible braking surface finish may cause the vehicle to stop
with difficulty.
4. After machining the brake drum, use 120 grit aluminum oxide sandpaper in order to create a
non-directional braking surface. 5. Clean the braking surfaces with GM P/N 12377981 or equivalent
brake parts cleaner.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information
> Specifications
Brake Shoe: Specifications
Information not supplied by the manufacturer.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 6165
Brake Shoe: Adjustments
Drum Brake Adjustment
^ Tools Required J 21177-A Drum to Brake Shoe Clearance Gauge
The rear brakes must be adjusted manually after replacing the brake shoes. 1. Raise the vehicle.
Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the brake drum. 3. Using the J21177-A measure the inside
diameter of the brake drum.
4. Position the J21177-A over the linings of the rear brake shoes. 5. Turn the star wheel on the
adjusting screw until there is approximately 0.50 mm (0.020 in) clearance between the J21177-A
and the shoe linings at
their widest point.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 6166
6. Using a punch and hammer, remove and discard the knockout plug in the backing plate (1)
which is directly behind the star wheel adjuster. 7. Install the brake drum. 8. Tighten the adjusting
screw until light drag is present when the drum is rotated. The brake lining drag should be equal at
both drums. 9. Apply the brake pedal two times in order to center the brake shoes on the locating
pins.
10. Check the drums again for light drag. Adjust as necessary. 11. Install an adjusting hole cover in
the backing plate. 12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Check the park brake adjustment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 6167
Brake Shoe: Service and Repair
Brake Shoe Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the tire and wheel assembly. 3. Mark the
relationship of the brake drum to the axle. 4. Remove the brake drum. 5. Remove the brake shoe
return springs.
6. Remove the brake shoe guide.
7. Remove the hold down springs. 8. Remove the hold down pins. 9. Remove the actuator lever
and the actuator lever pivot.
10. Remove the actuator lever and the lever pivot. 11. Remove the lever return spring.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 6168
12. Remove the parking brake strut and the strut spring. 13. Remove the parking brake lever.
14. Remove the brake shoes. 15. Remove the adjusting screw assembly and the adjusting screw
spring from the brake shoes. 16. Inspect all parts for discoloration due to heat or stress. Replace
parts as needed. 17. Replace all worn parts. 18. Inspect the wheel cylinder for signs of leakage. If
there are signs of leakage, overhaul or replace the wheel cylinder. 19. Inspect the brake drum for
scoring and machining tolerance.
Installation Procedure
1. Lubricate the brake shoe backing plate, the adjusting screw threads, socket and socket face with
a thin coat of high temperature silicone lubricant.
Important: Do not interchange the right and left adjusting screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 6169
2. Install the adjusting screw assembly and the adjusting screw spring on the brake shoes. The
coils of the adjusting screw spring must not touch the
adjusting screw.
3. Install the brake shoes on the backing plate.
4. Install the parking brake lever. 5. Install the strut spring on the parking brake strut. 6. Install the
parking brake strut.
7. Install the actuator lever and the lever pivot. 8. Install the actuator lever return spring. 9. Install
the hold down pins.
10. Install the hold down springs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 6170
11. Install the brake shoe guide.
12. Install the brake shoe return springs. 13. Install the brake drum.
Align the marks made during disassembly.
14. Install the tire and wheel assembly. 15. Adjust the brakes. 16. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes - Wheel Cylinder Inspection Guidelines
Wheel Cylinder: Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Wheel Cylinder Inspection Guidelines
Bulletin No.: 03-05-24-001A
Date: March 21, 2005
INFORMATION
Subject: Service Information Regarding Rear Brake Drum Wheel Cylinder Inspections
Models: 2005 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2005 and Prior Saturn Vehicles
with Rear Drum Brakes
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised add model years and include all GM vehicles. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 03-05-24-001 (Section 03 - Suspension).
This bulletin provides information on proper inspection of rear drum brake wheel cylinders.
Important:
It is not recommended that dust boots be removed during inspection processes as dirt and debris
could contaminate the wheel cylinder bore causing premature wear of the wheel cylinder. In
addition, most bores should look damp and some lubricant may drip out from under the boot as a
result of lubricant being present.
All rear drum brake wheel cylinders are assembled with a lubricant to aid in assembly, provide an
anti-corrosion coating to the cylinder bore, and lubricate internal rubber components. As a result of
this lubrication process, it is not uncommon for some amount of lubricant to accumulate at the ends
of the cylinder under the dust boot.
Over time, the lubricant may work its way to the outside of the boot and cause an area of the boot
to look damp. Evidence of a damp area on the boot does not indicate a leak in the cylinder.
However, if there is excessive wetness (i.e. drips) coming from the boot area of the wheel cylinder,
it could indicate a brake hydraulic fluid leak requiring wheel cylinder replacement. (Refer to the
Wheel Cylinder Replacement procedures in the appropriate Service Manual.)
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6175
Wheel Cylinder: Specifications
Wheel Cylinder Mounting Bolts 13 inch lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6176
Wheel Cylinder: Service and Repair
Wheel Cylinder Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the brake shoes. 2. Disconnect the brake pipe. 3. Remove the wheel cylinder bolts. 4.
Remove the wheel cylinder.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the wheel cylinder.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the wheel cylinder bolts.
^ Tighten the wheel cylinder bolts to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
3. Connect the brake pipe to the wheel cylinder.
^ Tighten the brake pipe fitting to 17 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
4. Install the brake shoes. 5. Bleed the brake system.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System
Information > Specifications
Brake Bleeding: Specifications
Brake System Pressure Bleed Initial Pressure Adjustment Setting (Leak Testing the Hydraulic
Brake System) 10 psi
Pressure Bleed Procedure Setting 35 psi
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > ABS Automated Bleed Procedure
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair ABS Automated Bleed Procedure
ABS Automated Bleed Procedure
Two Person Procedure
Important: ^
Use the 2-person bleed procedure under the following conditions: Installing a new Electro-Hydraulic Control Unit (EHCU) or new Brake Pressure Modulator Valve
(BPMV).
- Air is trapped in the valve body
^ Do not drive the vehicle until the brake pedal feels firm.
^ Do not reuse brake fluid that is used during bleeding.
^ Use the vacuum, the pressure and the gravity bleeding procedures only for base brake bleeding.
1. Raise the vehicle in order to access the system bleed screws. 2. Bleed the system at the right
rear wheel first. 3. Install a clear hose on the bleed screw. 4. Immerse the opposite end of the hose
into a container partially filled with clean DOT 3 brake fluid. 5. Open the bleed screw 1/2 to one full
turn. 6. Slowly depress the brake pedal. While the pedal is depressed to its full extent, tighten the
bleed screw. 7. Release the brake pedal and wait 10-15 seconds for the master cylinder pistons to
return to the home position. 8. Repeat the previous steps for the remaining wheels. The brake fluid
that is present at each bleed screw should be clean and free of air. 9. This procedure may use
more than a pint of fluid per wheel. Check the master cylinder fluid level every four to six strokes of
the brake pedal in
order to avoid running the system dry.
10. Press the brake pedal firmly and run the Scan Tool Automated Bleed Procedure. Release the
brake pedal between each test. 11. Bleed all four wheels again using Steps 3-9. This will remove
the remaining air from the brake system. 12. Evaluate the feel of the brake pedal before attempting
to drive the vehicle. 13. Bleed the system as many times as necessary in order to obtain the
appropriate feel of the pedal.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > ABS Automated Bleed Procedure > Page 6183
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Hydraulic Brake System Bleeding (Manual)
Hydraulic Brake System Bleeding (Manual)
Notice: When adding fluid to the brake master cylinder reservoir, use only Delco Supreme 11, GM
P/N 12377967, or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container. The use
of any type of fluid other than the recommended type of brake fluid, may cause contamination
which could result in damage to the internal rubber seals and/or rubber linings of hydraulic brake
system components.
Notice: Refer to Brake Fluid Effects on Paint and Electrical Components Notice in Service
Precautions.
1. Place a clean shop cloth beneath the brake master cylinder to prevent brake fluid spills. 2. With
the ignition OFF and the brakes cool, apply the brakes 3-5 times, or until the brake pedal becomes
firm, in order to deplete the brake booster
power reserve.
3. If you have performed a brake master cylinder bench bleeding on this vehicle, or if you
disconnected the brake pipes from the master cylinder, you
must perform the following steps: 3.1.
Ensure that the brake master cylinder reservoir is full to the maximum-fill level. If necessary add
Delco Supreme 11, GM P/N 12377967 (Canadian P/N 992667) or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid
from a clean, sealed brake fluid container. Clean the outside of the reservoir on and around the
reservoir cap prior to removing the cap and diaphragm, if cap removal is necessary.
3.2. With the rear brake pipe installed securely to the master cylinder, loosen and separate the
front brake pipe from the front port of the brake master cylinder.
3.3. Allow a small amount of brake fluid to gravity bleed from the open port of the master cylinder.
3.4. Reconnect the brake pipe to the master cylinder port and tighten securely.
3.5. Have an assistant slowly depress the brake pedal fully and maintain steady pressure on the
pedal.
3.6. Loosen the same brake pipe to purge air from the open port of the master cylinder.
3.7. Tighten the brake pipe, then have the assistant slowly release the brake pedal.
3.8. Wait 15 seconds, then repeat steps 3.3-3.7 until all air is purged from the same port of the
master cylinder.
3.9. With the front brake pipe installed securely to the master cylinder, after all air has been purged
from the front port of the master cylinder, loosen and separate the rear brake pipe from the master
cylinder; then repeat steps 3.3-3.8.
3.10. After completing the final master cylinder port bleeding procedure, ensure that both of the
brake pipe-to-master cylinder fittings are properly tightened.
4. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with Delco Supreme 11, GM P/N 12377967 (Canadian
P/N 992667) or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from
a clean, sealed brake fluid container. Ensure that the brake master cylinder reservoir remains at
least half-full during this bleeding procedure. Add fluid as needed to maintain the proper level.
Clean the outside of the reservoir on and around the reservoir cap prior to removing the cap and
diaphragm, when cap removal is necessary.
5. Install a proper box-end wrench onto the RIGHT REAR wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve,
then install a transparent hose over the end of the
bleeder valve.
6. Submerge the open end of the transparent hose into a transparent container partially filled with
Delco Supreme 11, GM PIN 12377967 (Canadian
P/N 992667) or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container.
7. Have an assistant slowly depress the brake pedal fully and maintain pedal position. 8. Loosen
the bleeder valve to purge air from the wheel hydraulic circuit. 9. Tighten the bleeder valve, then
have the assistant slowly release the brake pedal.
10. Wait 15 seconds, then repeat steps 7-9 until all air is purged from the same wheel hydraulic
circuit. 11. With the right rear wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve tightened securely, after all air
has been purged from the right rear hydraulic circuit;
install a proper box-end wrench onto the LEFT REAR wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve, install a
transparent hose over the end of the bleeder valve, then repeat steps 6-10.
12. With the left rear wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve tightened securely, after all air has been
purged from the left rear hydraulic circuit; install a
proper box-end wrench onto the RIGHT FRONT wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve, install a
transparent hose over the end of the bleeder valve, then repeat steps 6-10.
13. With the right front wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve tightened securely, after all air has
been purged from the right front hydraulic circuit;
install a proper box-end wrench onto the LEFT FRONT wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve, install
a transparent hose over the end of the bleeder valve, then repeat steps 6-10.
14. After completing the final wheel hydraulic circuit bleeding procedure, ensure that each of the 4
wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valves are properly
tightened.
15. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir to the maximum-fill level with Delco Supreme 11, GM
P/N 12377967 (Canadian P/N 992667) or
equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container.
16. Slowly depress and release the brake pedal. Observe the feel of the brake pedal. 17. If the
brake pedal feels spongy, repeat the bleeding procedure again. If the brake pedal still feels spongy
after repeating the bleeding procedure,
perform the following steps: 17.1.
Inspect the brake system for external leaks.
17.2. Pressure bleed the hydraulic brake system in order to purge any air that may still be trapped
in the system.
18. Turn the ignition key ON, with the engine OFF. Check to see if the brake system warning lamp
remains illuminated. 19. If the brake system warning lamp remains illuminated, the hydraulic brake
pressure differential switch plunger may have be forced out of position
during the bleeding procedure and may need to be reset. Perform the following steps to reset the
switch. 19.1.
Install a proper box-end wrench onto the RIGHT REAR wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve, then
install a transparent hose over the end of the bleeder valve.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > ABS Automated Bleed Procedure > Page 6184
19.2. Submerge the open end of the transparent hose into a transparent container partially filled
with Delco Supreme 11, GM P/N 12377967 (Canadian P/N 992667) or equivalent DOT-3 brake
fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container.
19.3. With the ignition key still ON, with the engine OFF, loosen the bleeder valve.
19.4. Have an assistant slowly depress the brake pedal until the brake system warning lamp turns
OFF and maintain pedal position while you tighten the bleeder valve.
19.5. Have the assistant slowly release the brake pedal.
20. If the brake system warning lamp continues to remain illuminated, DO NOT allow the vehicle to
be driven until it is diagnosed and repaired. Refer
to Symptoms - Hydraulic Brakes. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic
Procedures
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > ABS Automated Bleed Procedure > Page 6185
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Hydraulic Brake System Bleeding (Pressure)
Hydraulic Brake System Bleeding (Pressure)
^ Tools Required J 29532 Diaphragm Type Brake Pressure Bleeder, or equivalent
- J 29567 Brake Pressure Bleeder Adapter
- J 39177 Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool, or equivalent
- J 41618 Brake Bleeder Adapter Set
Notice: When adding fluid to the brake master cylinder reservoir, use only Delco Supreme 11, GM
P/N 12377967, or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container. The use
of any type of fluid other than the recommended type of brake fluid, may cause contamination
which could result in damage to the internal rubber seals and/or rubber linings of hydraulic brake
system components.
Notice: Refer to Brake Fluid Effects on Paint and Electrical Components Notice in Service
Precautions.
1. Place a clean shop cloth beneath the brake master cylinder to prevent brake fluid spills. 2. With
the ignition OFF and the brakes cool, apply the brakes 3-5 times, or until the brake pedal becomes
firm, in order to deplete the brake booster
power reserve.
3. If you have performed a brake master cylinder bench bleeding on this vehicle, or if you
disconnected the brake pipes from the master cylinder, you
must perform the following steps: 3.1.
Ensure that the brake master cylinder reservoir is full to the maximum-fill level. If necessary add
Delco Supreme 11, (GM P/N 12377967) or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed
brake fluid container. Clean the outside of the reservoir on and around the reservoir cap prior to
removing the cap and diaphragm, if cap removal is necessary.
3.2. With the rear brake pipe installed securely to the master cylinder, loosen and separate the
front brake pipe from the front port of the brake master cylinder.
3.3. Allow a small amount of brake fluid to gravity bleed from the open port of the master cylinder.
3.4. Reconnect the brake pipe to the master cylinder port and tighten securely.
3.5. Have an assistant slowly depress the brake pedal fully and maintain steady pressure on the
pedal.
3.6. Loosen the same brake pipe to purge air from the open port of the master cylinder.
3.7. Tighten the brake pipe, then have the assistant slowly release the brake pedal.
3.8. Wait 15 seconds, then repeat steps 3.3-3.7 until all air is purged from the same port of the
master cylinder.
3.9. With the front brake pipe installed securely to the master cylinder, (after all air has been
purged from the front port of the master cylinder), loosen and separate the rear brake pipe from the
master cylinder, then repeat steps 3.3-3.8.
3.10. After completing the final master cylinder port bleeding procedure, ensure that both of the
brake pipe-to-master cylinder fittings are properly tightened.
4. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir to the maximum-fill level with Delco Supreme 11, (GM
P/N 12377967) or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid
from a clean, sealed brake fluid container. Clean the outside of the reservoir on and around the
reservoir cap prior to removing the cap and diaphragm.
5. Remove the cap from the metering valve end of the combination valve, then install the J 39177,
or equivalent to the metering valve. 6. Using the J 39177, depress the shaft of the metering valve to
maintain the proper flow of brake fluid to the front wheel hydraulic circuit during the
pressure bleeding procedure.
7. Assemble the J41613 to the J29567. 8. Install the J41618 and J29567to the brake master
cylinder reservoir. 9. Check the brake fluid level in the J 29532, or equivalent. Add Delco Supreme
11, (GM P/N 12377967) or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a
clean, sealed brake fluid container as necessary to bring the level to approximately the half-full
point.
10. Connect the J29532, or equivalent, to the J 29567. 11. Charge the J 29532, or equivalent, air
tank to 175 - 205 kPa (25 - 30 psi). 12. Open the J29532, or equivalent, fluid tank valve to allow
pressurized brake fluid to enter the brake system. 13. Wait approximately 30 seconds, then inspect
the entire hydraulic brake system in order to ensure that there are no existing external brake fluid
leaks. Any brake fluid leaks identified require repair prior to completing this procedure.
14. Install a proper box-end wrench onto the RIGHT REAR wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve,
then install a transparent hose over the end of the
bleeder valve.
15. Submerge the open end of the transparent hose into a transparent container partially filled with
Delco Supreme 11, (GM P/N 12377967) or
equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container.
16. Loosen the bleeder valve to purge air from the wheel hydraulic circuit. Allow fluid to flow until air
bubbles stop flowing from the bleeder, then
tighten the bleeder valve.
17. With the right rear wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve tightened securely, (after all air has
been purged from the right rear hydraulic circuit),
install a proper box-end wrench onto the LEFT REAR wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve, install a
transparent hose over the end of the bleeder valve, then repeat steps 15-16.
18. With the left rear wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve tightened securely, (after all air has been
purged from the left rear hydraulic circuit), install
a proper box-end wrench onto the RIGHT FRONT wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve, install a
transparent hose over the end of the bleeder valve, then repeat steps 15-16.
19. With the right front wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve tightened securely, (after all air has
been purged from the right front hydraulic circuit),
install a proper box-end wrench onto the LEFT FRONT wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valve, install
a transparent hose over the end of the bleeder
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > ABS Automated Bleed Procedure > Page 6186
valve, then repeat steps 15-16.
20. After completing the final wheel hydraulic circuit bleeding procedure, ensure that each of the 4
wheel hydraulic circuit bleeder valves are properly
tightened.
21. Close the J 29532, or equivalent, fluid tank valve, then disconnect the J 29532, or equivalent,
from the J 29567. 22. Remove the J 41618 and J29567 from the brake master cylinder reservoir.
23. Remove the J 39177, or equivalent from the metering valve, then install the cap to the metering
valve end of the combination valve. 24. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir to the maximum-fill
level with Delco Supreme 11, (GM P/N 12377967) or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid
from a clean, sealed brake fluid container.
25. Slowly depress and release the brake pedal. Observe the feel of the brake pedal. 26. If the
brake pedal feels spongy perform the following steps:
26.1. Inspect the brake system for external leaks.
26.2. Using a scan tool, perform the antilock brake system automated bleeding procedure to
remove any air that may have been trapped in the BPMV.
27. Turn the ignition key ON, with the engine OFF. Check to see if the brake system warning lamp
remains illuminated. 28. If the brake system warning lamp remains illuminated, DO NOT allow the
vehicle to be driven until it is diagnosed and repaired. Refer to
Symptoms - Hydraulic Brakes. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic
Procedures
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > ABS Automated Bleed Procedure > Page 6187
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Master Cylinder Bench Bleeding
Master Cylinder Bench Bleeding
Notice: When adding fluid to the brake master cylinder reservoir, use only Delco Supreme 11, GM
P/N 12377967, or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container. The use
of any type of fluid other than the recommended type of brake fluid, may cause contamination
which could result in damage to the internal rubber seals and/or rubber linings of hydraulic brake
system components.
1. Secure the mounting flange of the brake master cylinder in a bench vise so that the rear of the
primary piston is accessible. 2. Remove the master cylinder reservoir cap and diaphragm. 3. Install
suitable fittings to the master cylinder ports that match the type of flare seat required and also
provide for hose attachment. 4. Install transparent hoses to the fittings installed to the master
cylinder ports, then route the hoses into the master cylinder reservoir. 5. Fill the master cylinder
reservoir to at least the halfway point with Delco Supreme 11, GM P/N 12377967, or equivalent
DOT-3 brake fluid from a
clean, sealed brake fluid container.
6. Ensure that the ends of the transparent hoses running into the master cylinder reservoir are fully
submerged in the brake fluid. 7. Using a smooth, round-ended tool, depress and release the
primary piston as far as it will travel, a depth of about 25 mm (1 in), several times.
Observe the flow of fluid coming from the ports. As air is bled from the primary and secondary
pistons, the effort required to depress the primary piston will increase and the amount of travel will
decrease.
8. Continue to depress and release the primary piston until fluid flows freely from the ports with no
evidence of air bubbles. 9. Remove the transparent hoses from the master cylinder reservoir.
10. Install the master cylinder reservoir cap and diaphragm. 11. Remove the fittings with the
transparent hoses from the master cylinder ports. Wrap the master cylinder with a clean shop cloth
to prevent brake
fluid spills.
12. Remove the master cylinder from the vise.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Specifications
Brake Caliper: Specifications
Brake Caliper Bleeder Valve (Front) 115 inch lbs.
Brake Caliper Bleeder Valve (Rear) 115 inch lbs.
Caliper Mounting Bolts 38 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Caliper Inspection
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Brake Caliper Inspection
Brake Caliper Inspection
1. Inspect the brake caliper housing (1) for cracks, excessive wear, and/or damage. If any of these
conditions are present, the brake caliper requires
replacement.
2. Inspect the caliper piston dust boot seal (2) for cracks, tears, cuts, deterioration and/or improper
seating in the caliper body. If any of these
conditions are present, the brake caliper requires overhaul or replacement.
3. Inspect for brake fluid leakage around the caliper piston dust boot seal (2) and on the disc brake
pads. If there is any evidence of brake fluid
leakage, the brake caliper requires overhaul or replacement.
4. Inspect for smooth and complete travel of the caliper piston(s) into the caliper bore(s).
The movement of the caliper piston(s) into the caliper bore(s) should be smooth and even. If the
caliper piston is frozen or difficult to bottom, the caliper requires overhaul or replacement. ^
For single piston caliper applications, insert a discarded inner brake pad (2) or block of wood in
front of the piston. Using a large C-clamp (1) installed over the body of the caliper (3) and against
the brake pad or block of wood, slowly bottom the piston in the bore.
^ For dual piston caliper applications, insert a discarded inner brake pad (2) or block of wood in
front of the pistons. Using 2 large C-clamps (1) installed over the body of the caliper (3) and against
the brake pad or block of wood, slowly bottom the pistons evenly into the bores.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Caliper Inspection > Page 6193
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Brake Caliper Overhaul
Brake Caliper Overhaul
^ Tools Required J 26267 Piston Seal Installer
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the caliper. 2. Drain all the brake fluid from the caliper.
Caution: Do not place your fingers in front of the piston in order to catch or protect the piston while
applying compressed air. This could result in serious injury.
Notice: Use just enough air pressure to ease the piston out of the bore. You can damage a
blown-out piston even with the padding.
3. Pad the interior of the caliper with clean shop towels. 4. Remove the piston from the caliper bore.
5. Remove the boot from the caliper bore. Do not scratch the housing bore.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Caliper Inspection > Page 6194
6. Remove the piston seal from the caliper bore. Do not use a metal tool.
7. Remove the bleeder valve from the caliper body. 8. Clean the bleeder valve, the caliper bore, the
caliper passages and the piston with denatured alcohol. Dry the parts and blow out the brake fluid
passages. Use dry and filtered compressed air.
9. Inspect the piston and the caliper for the following conditions:
^ Scoring on the piston surface or in the caliper bore
^ Corrosion on the piston
^ Chrome plating damage on the piston
^ Corrosion in the caliper bore Use crocus cloth in order to polish light corrosion from the caliper
bore. Replace the caliper if the corrosion cannot be removed.
^ Pitting in the caliper bore
10. Replace the piston or the caliper if you found any of the above conditions.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Caliper Inspection > Page 6195
1. Lubricate the new piston seal, the caliper bore, and the piston with clean brake fluid.
2. Install the piston seal. Make sure the piston seal is not twisted in the caliper bore groove.
3. Install the boot on the piston.
4. Install the piston in the caliper bore.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Caliper Inspection > Page 6196
5. Install the boot into the caliper housing bore using the J 26267.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
6. Install the bleeder valve in the caliper body.
^ Tighten the bleeder valve to 13 Nm (115 inch lbs.).
Important: Before moving the vehicle, pump the brake pedal until it is firm. Check the brake fluid
level in the master cylinder after pumping the brakes.
7. Install the caliper.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Caliper Inspection > Page 6197
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Brake Caliper Replacement
Brake Caliper Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Inspect the fluid level in the brake master cylinder reservoir. 2. If the brake fluid level is midway
between the maximum-full point and the minimum allowable level, no brake fluid needs to be
removed from the
reservoir before proceeding.
3. If the brake fluid level is higher than midway between the maximum-full point and the minimum
allowable level, remove brake fluid to the
midway point before proceeding.
4. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 5. Remove the tire and wheel
assembly. 6. Install and hand tighten a wheel lug nut in order to retain the rotor (A4WD only). 7.
Compress the front caliper piston.
^ Install a large C-clamp over the top of the caliper housing and against the back of the outboard
pad.
^ Slowly tighten the C-clamp until the piston pushes into the caliper bore enough to slide the caliper
off the rotor.
^ Remove the C-clamp from the caliper.
8. Remove the brake hose-to-caliper bolt (1) from the caliper.
Discard the 2 copper gaskets (3). These gaskets may be stuck to the brake caliper and/or the
brake hose end.
9. Plug the opening in the front brake hose (2) in order to prevent excessive brake fluid loss and
contamination.
Do not pinch off the brake hose with any tools.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Caliper Inspection > Page 6198
10. Remove the caliper mounting bolts. 11. Remove the caliper. 12. Remove the brake pads.
13. Remove the bushings. 14. Remove the sleeves (RWD only). 15. Inspect the caliper bolts for
corrosion or damage. Do not attempt to polish away any corrosion. If corrosion is found, use new
parts, including
bushings, when installing the caliper.
Installation Procedure
1. If reusing the brake caliper pin bolts and retainers, clean the brake caliper pin bolts and retainers
using denatured alcohol, or equivalent. 2. Dry the brake caliper pin bolts using non-lubricated,
filtered air. 3. Apply high temperature silicone brake lubricant to the brake caliper pin bolts and
retainers. DO NOT apply lubricant to the brake pad hardware.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Caliper Inspection > Page 6199
4. Install the bushings. 5. Install the sleeves (RWD only). 6. Install the brake pads. 7. Install the
caliper assembly.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
8. Install the mounting bolts.
^ Tighten the bolts to 51 Nm (38 ft. lbs.).
Important: Install NEW copper brake hose gaskets.
9. Install the brake hose bolt (1) and the NEW copper brake hose gaskets (3) to the brake hose (2).
10. Install the brake hose-to-caliper bolt to the brake caliper.
^ Tighten the bolt to 44 Nm (32 ft. lbs.).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Caliper Inspection > Page 6200
11. Remove the wheel lug nut securing the rotor to the hub.
12. Measure the clearance between the caliper and the steering knuckle.
Measure the clearance at each end of the caliper individually and then add the measurements
together. Specification The total should be 0.26 - 0.60 mm (0.010 - 0.024 in). ^
If the total clearance between the caliper and the steering knuckle is less than 0.26 mm (0.010 in),
file the steering knuckle equally on each side until the proper clearance is obtained.
^ If the total clearance between the caliper and the steering knuckle is more than 0.60 mm (0.024
in), inspect the brake caliper and the steering knuckle for damage and replace as needed.
13. Install the tire and wheel. 14. Lower the vehicle. 15. Fill the master cylinder to the proper level
with clean brake fluid. 16. Bleed the brake system.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid > Component
Information > Specifications
Brake Fluid: Specifications
Type Delco Supreme 11 or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Specifications
Brake Hose/Line: Specifications
Brake Hose to Caliper Bolt 32 ft. lbs.
Brake Pipes to Combination Valve Nuts 22 ft. lbs.
Front Brake Pipe Nuts 22 ft. lbs.
Front Brake Pipe to Hose Nuts 13 ft. lbs.
Rear Brake Hose Junction Block to Rear Axle Bracket Bolt 13 ft. lbs.
Rear Brake Pipe Nuts 13 ft. lbs.
Brake Pipe Fittings 13 inch lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Hose Replacement
Brake Hose/Line: Service and Repair Brake Hose Replacement
Front
Brake Hose Replacement - Front (RWD)
Removal Procedure
1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Clean all dirt and foreign
material from the brake hoses and brake pipe fitting.
Important: Install a rubber cap or plug to the exposed brake pipe fitting ends in order to prevent
brake fluid loss and contamination.
3. Use a backup wrench on the hose fitting (4), disconnect the brake pipe fitting (1) from the brake
hose, then cap or plug the brake pipe fitting end. 4. Remove the brake hose retaining clip (2) from
the hose mounting bracket. 5. Remove the hose (4) from the bracket. 6. Remove the brake hose to
caliper bolt (5) from the brake caliper. 7. Remove the brake hose (4) from the brake caliper. 8.
Remove and discard the 2 copper brake hose gaskets (6). These gaskets may be stuck to the
brake caliper and/or the brake hose end.
Installation Procedure
Important: Install NEW copper brake hose gaskets (6).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Hose Replacement > Page 6209
1. Assemble the NEW copper brake hose gaskets (6), and the brake hose bolt (5) to the brake
hose.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the brake hose to caliper bolt and NEW washers to the brake caliper.
^ Tighten the bolt to 44 Nm (32 ft. lbs.).
Important: The hose must not be twisted. Make sure the hose is not in contact with any suspension
component.
3. With the weight of the vehicle on the suspension, install the brake hose into the bracket. 4. Install
the retainer (2) onto the hose fitting (4) at the bracket. 5. Remove the rubber cap or plug from the
exposed brake pipe fitting end. 6. Connect the brake pipe fitting nut (1) to the brake hose (4):
^ Use a backup wrench on the hose fitting.
^ Do not bend the bracket or the pipe.
^ Tighten the pipe nut to 17 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
7. Ensure that the hose does not make contact with any part of the suspension. Check the hose in
extreme right and extreme left turn conditions. If the
hose makes contact, remove the hose and correct the condition.
8. Bleed the hydraulic brake system. 9. Lower the vehicle.
Rear
Brake Hose Replacement- Rear
Removal Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Hose Replacement > Page 6210
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Clean all dirt and foreign material from the brake
hoses and brake pipe fitting.
Important: Install a rubber cap or plug to the exposed brake pipe fitting ends in order to prevent
brake fluid loss and contamination.
3. Use a backup wrench on the hose fitting, disconnect the brake pipe fittings from the junction
block, then cap or plug the brake pipe fitting ends. Do
not bend the brake pipe or the bracket.
4. Disconnect the brake pipe fitting (9). 5. Remove the brake hose retaining clip (2). 6. Remove the
junction block bolt (5). 7. Remove the rear brake hose (4).
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Hose Replacement > Page 6211
1. Install the rear brake hose (4).
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the junction block bolt (5).
^ Tighten the junction block bolt to 17 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
3. Install the brake hose retaining clip (2). 4. Connect the brake pipe fitting (9).
^ Tighten the brake pipe fitting to 17 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
5. Loosely connect the rear brake pipe fittings to the junction block.
^ Using a backup wrench, tighten the rear brake pipe fittings to 17 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
6. Ensure that the hose does not make contact with any part of the suspension. Check the hose in
extreme right and extreme left turn conditions. If the
hose makes contact, remove the hose and correct the condition.
7. Bleed the hydraulic brake system. 8. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Hose Replacement > Page 6212
Brake Hose/Line: Service and Repair Brake Pipe Replacement
Brake Pipe Replacement
Caution: Always use double-walled steel brake pipe when replacing brake pipes. The use of any
other pipe is not recommended and may cause brake system failure. Carefully route and retain
replacement brake pipes. Always use the correct fasteners and in the original location for
replacement brake pipes. Failure to properly route and retain brake pipes may cause damage to
the brake pipes and brake system resulting in personal injury.
Maintain a 6 mm (0.25 in) clearance between brake pipes that run parallel to each other.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake
Proportioning/Combination Valve > Component Information > Specifications
Brake Proportioning/Combination Valve: Specifications
Combination Valve Bolts 12 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake
Proportioning/Combination Valve > Component Information > Specifications > Page 6216
Brake Proportioning/Combination Valve: Service and Repair
Combination Valve Replacement
Removal Procedure
Important: Note the identification code on the combination valve. The new valve must have the
same identification number as the old valve.
1. Remove the Master Cylinder. 2. Remove the combination valve electrical connector. 3. Remove
the front and the rear brake pipes. 4. Remove the combination valve from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
Important: Verify that the replacement combination valve has the same pin punched identification
code as the code on the old combination valve.
1. Install the combination valve to the vehicle.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the front and the rear brake pipes to the combination valve.
^ Tighten the brake pipe nuts to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
3. Connect the combination valve electrical connector. 4. Install the Master Cylinder.
Important: Verify that the combination valve metering rod is depressed during bleeding.
5. Bleed the brake system.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Service and Repair
Brake Pressure Modulator Valve (BPMV) Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the fuel pipe shield (3) from the frame bracket (2) by removing the 2 nuts (4).
Important: Thoroughly wash all contaminants from around the EHCU (1). The area around the
EHCU (1) MUST be free from loose dirt to prevent contamination of disassembled ABS
components.
2. Disconnect the 2 electrical harness connectors from the EBCM.
Important: Make sure that brake lines are tagged and kept in order for proper reassembly.
3. Disconnect 5 brake lines from the BPMV. 4. Slide the EHCU (1) off of the frame bracket (2).
5. Remove 2 bolts (4) securing the BPMV mounting bracket (3) to the BPMV (5). 6. Disconnect the
2-way ABS pump motor connector. 7. Remove the 4 T-25 Torx bolts (1) from the EBCM (2).
Important: Do not use a tool to pry the EBCM or the BPMV. Excessive force will damage the
EBCM.
8. Remove the EBCM (2) from the BPMV (5). Removal may require a light amount of force.
Important: Do not reuse the EBCM mounting bolts. Always install new bolts.
9. Clean the EBCM to BPMV mounting surfaces with a clean cloth.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 6220
Important: Do not use RTV or any other type of sealant on the EBCM gasket or mating surfaces.
1. Install EBCM (2) onto BPMV (5).
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Important: Do not reuse the old mounting bolts. Always install new bolts with the new BPMV.
2. Install the 4 EBCM bolts (1).
^ Tighten the 4 bolts to 5 Nm (39 inch lbs.) in an X-pattern.
3. Connect the 2-way ABS pump motor connector to the EBCM. 4. Install the BPMV (5) to the
BPMV mounting bracket (3) with the 2 bolts (4).
5. Slide the EHCU (1) back onto the frame bracket (2).
Important: The brake pipes are held in the proper place by a frame mounted plastic bracket. Make
sure that the brake pipes stay in the correct place for proper reassembly.
6. Install the 5 brake pipes to the EHCU (1).
^ Tighten the brake pipe fittings to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
7. Connect the 2 electrical harness connectors to the EBCM (1). 8. Secure the module (1) to the
frame bracket (3) and fuel pipe shield (2) with the 2 nuts (4). 9. Bleed the brake system.
10. Return to Diagnostic System Check - ABS. See: Antilock Brakes / Traction Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Initial Inspection and
Diagnostic Overview/Diagnostic System Check
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Specifications
Brake Master Cylinder: Specifications
Master Cylinder Brake Pipe Nuts 22 ft. lbs.
Master Cylinder to Booster Nuts 27 ft. lbs.
Master Cylinder brake lines to BPMV 18 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Overhaul
Brake Master Cylinder: Service and Repair Master Cylinder Overhaul
Master Cylinder Overhaul
Disassembly Procedure
1. Remove the brake master cylinder from the vehicle. 2. Secure the mounting flange of the brake
master cylinder in a bench vise so that the rear of the primary piston is accessible. 3. Clean the
outside of the master cylinder reservoir on and around the reservoir cap prior to removing the cap
and diaphragm. 4. Remove the reservoir cap and diaphragm from the reservoir. 5. Inspect the
reservoir cap and diaphragm for the following conditions. If any of these conditions are present,
replace the affected components.
^ Cuts or cracks
^ Nicks or deformation
6. Remove the master cylinder reservoir from the master cylinder. 7. Using a smooth, round-ended
tool, depress the primary piston (2) and remove the piston retainer. 8. Remove the primary piston
assembly from the cylinder bore. 9. Plug the cylinder inlet ports and the rear outlet port. Apply low
pressure, non-lubricated, filtered air into the front outlet port, in order the remove
the secondary piston (1) with the primary (6) and secondary (5) seals, and the return spring.
10. Discard the primary piston assembly, the piston retainer, and the seals and seal retainer from
the secondary piston.
Assembly Procedure
Important: Do not use abrasives to clean the brake master cylinder bore.
1. Clean the interior and exterior of the master cylinder, the secondary piston (1), and the return
spring in denatured alcohol, or equivalent. 2. Inspect the master cylinder bore, inlet and outlet
ports, the secondary piston (1), and the return spring for cracks, scoring, pitting, and/or corrosion.
Replace the master cylinder if any of these conditions exist.
3. Dry the master cylinder and the individual components with non-lubricated, filtered air. 4.
Lubricate the master cylinder bore, the secondary piston (1), the return spring, and all of the
individual overhaul components with Delco Supreme
11, GM P/N 12377967 (Canadian P/N 992667), or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean,
sealed brake fluid container.
5. Assemble the lubricated, new primary seal (6) and retainer, and new secondary seal (5) onto the
secondary piston. 6. Install the lubricated return spring and secondary piston assembly (1) into the
cylinder bore. 7. Install the lubricated, new primary piston assembly (2) into the cylinder bore. 8.
Using a smooth, round-ended tool, depress the primary piston (2) and install the new piston
retainer.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Overhaul > Page 6226
9. Install the master cylinder reservoir to the master cylinder.
10. Install the reservoir cap and diaphragm to the reservoir. 11. Install the master cylinder to the
vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Overhaul > Page 6227
Brake Master Cylinder: Service and Repair Master Cylinder Replacement
Master Cylinder Replacement
Removal Procedure
Notice: Refer to Brake Fluid Effects on Paint and Electrical Components Notice in Service
Precautions.
1. Apply the parking brake and block the wheels. 2. Disconnect the brake pipes from the master
cylinder.
Important: Install a rubber cap or plug to the exposed brake pipe fitting ends in order to prevent
brake fluid loss and contamination.
3. Plug the open brake pipe ends.
4. Remove the master cylinder nuts and bolts. 5. Remove the combination valve bracket. 6.
Remove the master cylinder from the vehicle. 7. Drain the master cylinder of all brake fluid.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Overhaul > Page 6228
1. Bench bleed the master cylinder. 2. Install the master cylinder to the vehicle. 3. Install the
combination valve bracket.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the master cylinder bolts and nuts.
^ Tighten the nuts to 36 Nm (27 ft. lbs.).
5. Connect the brake pipes to the master cylinder.
^ Tighten the pipe nuts to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
6. Bleed the hydraulic brake system.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Overhaul > Page 6229
Brake Master Cylinder: Service and Repair Master Cylinder Reservoir Replacement
Master Cylinder Reservoir Replacement
Disassembly Procedure
1. Remove the master cylinder from the vehicle. 2. Secure the master cylinder in a vise. Do not
clamp the master cylinder body, secure only at the flange.
3. Carefully tap out the reservoir retaining pins.
4. Remove the reservoir from the master cylinder by pulling the reservoir straight up and away from
the cylinder. 5. Remove the seals from the master cylinder.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Overhaul > Page 6230
Assembly Procedure
1. Inspect the reservoir for cracks or deformation. If found, replace the reservoir. 2. Clean the
reservoir with denatured alcohol, or equivalent. 3. Dry the reservoir with non-lubricated, filtered air.
4. Lubricate the new seals and the outer surface area of the reservoir-to-housing barrels with Delco
Supreme 11 (GM P/N 12377967) or equivalent
DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container.
5. Install the lubricated seals, make sure they are fully seated. 6. Install the reservoir to the master
cylinder by pressing the reservoir straight down on the master cylinder until the pin holes are
aligned.
7. Carefully tap the reservoir retaining pins into place to secure the reservoir.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Overhaul > Page 6231
8. Install the diaphragm in the cover. 9. Install the cover on the reservoir.
10. Remove the master cylinder from the vice. 11. Install the master cylinder.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Overhaul > Page 6232
Brake Master Cylinder: Service and Repair Master Cylinder Reservoir Filling
Master Cylinder Reservoir Filling
Notice: When adding fluid to the brake master cylinder reservoir, use only Delco Supreme 11, GM
P/N 12377967, or equivalent DOT-3 brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container. The use
of any type of fluid other than the recommended type of brake fluid, may cause contamination
which could result in damage to the internal rubber seals and/or rubber linings of hydraulic brake
system components.
Notice: Refer to Brake Fluid Effects on Paint and Electrical Components Notice in Service
Precautions.
1. Visually inspect the brake fluid level through the brake master cylinder reservoir. 2. If the brake
fluid level is at or below the half-full point during routine fluid checks, the brake system should be
inspected for wear and possible
brake fluid leaks.
3. If the brake fluid level is at or below the half-full point during routine fluid checks, and an
inspection of the brake system did not reveal wear or
brake fluid leaks, the brake fluid may be topped-off up to the maximum-fill level.
4. If brake system service was just completed, the brake fluid may be topped-off up to the
maximum-fill level. 5. If the brake fluid level is above the half-full point, adding brake fluid is not
recommended under normal conditions. 6. If brake fluid is to be added to the master cylinder
reservoir, clean the outside of the reservoir on and around the reservoir cap prior to removing
the cap and diaphragm. Use only Delco Supreme 11, GM P/N 12377967, or equivalent DOT-3
brake fluid from a clean, sealed brake fluid container.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes - Wheel Cylinder Inspection Guidelines
Wheel Cylinder: Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Wheel Cylinder Inspection Guidelines
Bulletin No.: 03-05-24-001A
Date: March 21, 2005
INFORMATION
Subject: Service Information Regarding Rear Brake Drum Wheel Cylinder Inspections
Models: 2005 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2005 and Prior Saturn Vehicles
with Rear Drum Brakes
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised add model years and include all GM vehicles. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 03-05-24-001 (Section 03 - Suspension).
This bulletin provides information on proper inspection of rear drum brake wheel cylinders.
Important:
It is not recommended that dust boots be removed during inspection processes as dirt and debris
could contaminate the wheel cylinder bore causing premature wear of the wheel cylinder. In
addition, most bores should look damp and some lubricant may drip out from under the boot as a
result of lubricant being present.
All rear drum brake wheel cylinders are assembled with a lubricant to aid in assembly, provide an
anti-corrosion coating to the cylinder bore, and lubricate internal rubber components. As a result of
this lubrication process, it is not uncommon for some amount of lubricant to accumulate at the ends
of the cylinder under the dust boot.
Over time, the lubricant may work its way to the outside of the boot and cause an area of the boot
to look damp. Evidence of a damp area on the boot does not indicate a leak in the cylinder.
However, if there is excessive wetness (i.e. drips) coming from the boot area of the wheel cylinder,
it could indicate a brake hydraulic fluid leak requiring wheel cylinder replacement. (Refer to the
Wheel Cylinder Replacement procedures in the appropriate Service Manual.)
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6237
Wheel Cylinder: Specifications
Wheel Cylinder Mounting Bolts 13 inch lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6238
Wheel Cylinder: Service and Repair
Wheel Cylinder Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the brake shoes. 2. Disconnect the brake pipe. 3. Remove the wheel cylinder bolts. 4.
Remove the wheel cylinder.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the wheel cylinder.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the wheel cylinder bolts.
^ Tighten the wheel cylinder bolts to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
3. Connect the brake pipe to the wheel cylinder.
^ Tighten the brake pipe fitting to 17 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
4. Install the brake shoes. 5. Bleed the brake system.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Specifications
Parking Brake Cable: Specifications
Cable Clip Bolts 71 inch lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Park Brake Cable Replacement
Parking Brake Cable: Service and Repair Park Brake Cable Replacement
Front
Park Brake Cable Replacement- Front
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Loosen the park brake cable at the equalizer. 3.
Remove the front park brake cable from the park brake cable connector. 4. Lower the vehicle.
5. Remove the front cable (1) from the lever assembly (2). 6. Remove the cowl side panel trim. 7.
Remove the lever assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Park Brake Cable Replacement > Page 6245
8. Remove the step trim plate. Lift the rocker panel trim and peel back the carpet to expose the
park brake cable grommet (4). 9. Remove the front cable (3). Unclip the cable and pull through the
body.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the front cable.
^ Secure the grommet (4) to the body.
^ Clip the cable at the kick panel.
2. Connect the cable (1) to the lever assembly (2). 3. Install the lever assembly. 4. Install the cowl
side panel. 5. Install the step trim plate. 6. Connect the front cable to the lever assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Park Brake Cable Replacement > Page 6246
7. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 8. Connect the front cable to the park brake cable
connector. 9. Adjust the park brake.
10. Lower the vehicle.
Rear
Park Brake Cable Replacement- Rear
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Loosen the equalizer. 3. Remove the rear cable
from the equalizer. 4. Remove the brake drum and the shoe assembly. 5. Depress the
cable-retaining fingers and remove the cable from the backing plate. 6. Remove the rear cable from
the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Park Brake Cable Replacement > Page 6247
1. Install the rear cable into the backing plate. Ensure all retaining fingers are completely through
the backing plate. 2. Install the brake shoes and the drum assembly. 3. Install the park brake cable
to the equalizer. 4. Adjust the park brake. 5. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Park Brake Cable Replacement > Page 6248
Parking Brake Cable: Service and Repair Park Brake Cable Equalizer Replacement
Park Brake Cable Equalizer Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Loosen the equalizer and remove the threaded rod.
3. Remove the front park brake cable from the connector. 4. Remove the left rear park brake cable
from the equalizer.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the left rear park brake cable to the equalizer. 2. Install the front park brake cable to the
connector. 3. Install the threaded rod to the equalizer and install the nut to the rod. 4. Adjust the
park brake. 5. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Lever > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Parking Brake Lever: Service and Repair
Park Brake Release Handle Assembly Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the release handle cable and grommet from the park brake pedal assembly (1). 2.
Depress the locking tabs and remove the release handle (5) from the instrument panel.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the release handle (5) to the instrument panel. Ensure the locking tabs secure the handle
to the instrument panel. 2. Install the release handle grommet and cable to the park brake pedal
assembly (1).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Pedal > Component
Information > Specifications
Parking Brake Pedal: Specifications
Park Brake Pedal Mounting Bolts 18 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Pedal > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6255
Parking Brake Pedal: Service and Repair
Park Brake Pedal Assembly Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Release the park brake (5). 2. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 3. Loosen the
equalizer. 4. Lower the vehicle. 5. Remove the release handle cable and grommet from the park
brake pedal assembly. 6. Depress the locking tabs and remove the release handle from the
instrument panel. 7. Disconnect the electrical connector from the park brake switch. 8. Remove the
bolts (2). 9. Disconnect the park brake cable (3) from the lever (1). The locating tab on the lever
must be straightened to release the cable.
10. Depress the locking tabs on the park brake cable housing and remove the cable housing from
the pedal assembly. 11. Remove the lever assembly from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the park brake cable housing to the park brake pedal assembly. Ensure that the locking
tabs secure the housing to the assembly. 2. Connect the park brake cable (3) to the lever
assembly. Bend the locating tab over the cable. 3. Install the lever assembly to the vehicle.
Notice: Refer to fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the bolts (2).
^ Tighten the bolts to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
5. Connect the connector to the park brake switch. 6. Install the release handle to the instrument
panel. Ensure the locking tabs secure the handle to the instrument panel. 7. Install the release
handle grommet and cable to the park brake pedal assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Pedal > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6256
8. Adjust the park brake.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Warning Lamp >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Parking Brake Warning Lamp: Description and Operation
Brake Lamp
The BRAKE warning lamp on the instrument cluster turns on when the park brake is applied. The
BRAKE lamp can also be turned on by the switch in the combination valve and the antilock brake
system.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Warning Lamp >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 6260
Parking Brake Warning Lamp: Service and Repair
Park Brake Warning Lamp Switch Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the park brake warning lamp switch electrical connector. 2. Remove the retainer from
the switch. 3. Remove the park brake indicator switch (1) from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the park brake indicator switch (1) to the vehicle.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the retaining screw.
^ Tighten the retaining screw to 4 Nm (35 inch lbs.).
3. Install the park brake indicator switch electrical connector.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Hydraulic Brake Booster > Component
Information > Specifications
Hydraulic Brake Booster: Specifications
Hydraulic Brake Booster Hose Nuts 20 ft. lbs.
Hydraulic Brake Booster Relief Valve 9 ft. lbs.
Hydraulic Brake Booster to Engine Cowl Nuts 27 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Hydraulic Brake Booster > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6265
Hydraulic Brake Booster: Service and Repair
Hydraulic Brake Booster Replacement
Removal Procedure
Notice: Hydraulic brake systems use two distinct and incompatible fluids. Power steering fluid is
used in the hydraulic brake booster system. Brake fluid is used in the master cylinder and brake
pipes. Use extreme care when selecting brake system fluids, or seal damage can result.
1. Apply the park brake. 2. Place a drain pan under the hydraulic brake booster and the booster
reservoir. 3. Disconnect the reservoir hose from the booster.
4. Disconnect the power steering hoses from the booster.
Important: Do not remove the brake pipes from the master cylinder.
5. Remove the master cylinder nuts. 6. Support the master cylinder. 7. Disconnect the pushrod
from the brake pedal.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Hydraulic Brake Booster > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6266
8. Remove the hydraulic booster mounting nuts from the inside of the vehicle. 9. Remove the
booster assembly.
10. Remove the gasket.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the gasket. 2. Install the booster assembly.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the booster mounting nuts.
^ Tighten the nuts to 36 Nm (27 ft. lbs.).
4. Connect the pushrod to the brake pedal.
5. Install the master cylinder. 6. Install the master cylinder nuts.
^ Tighten the nuts to 36 Nm (27 ft. lbs.).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Hydraulic Brake Booster > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6267
7. Connect the power steering hoses to the booster.
^ Tighten the hose fittings to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.).
8. Connect the reservoir hose to the booster. 9. Bleed the hydraulic brake booster.
10. Release the parking brake.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Hydraulic Fluid Accumulator >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Hydraulic Fluid Accumulator: Service and Repair
Hydraulic Brake Booster Accumulator Replacement
^ Tools Required J 26889 Accumulator Piston Compressor
Removal Procedure
Caution: The accumulator contains compressed gas. Always use the proper tools and follow the
recommended procedures or personal injury may result. Do not apply heat to accumulator. Do not
attempt to repair an inoperative accumulator. Always replace an inoperative accumulator with a
new one. Dispose of an inoperative accumulator by drilling a 1.5 mm (1/16 in) diameter hole
through the end of the accumulator can, opposite the O-ring.
Caution: Push rod removal is not recommended. Improper staking of the push rod to the
Hydroboost reaction piston can result in a loss of brakes. If the rod or seals require service, the
entire unit must be replaced.
1. Depress brake pedal at least twenty times to relieve pressure in the accumulator. 2. Remove the
master cylinder nuts from the hydraulic booster. 3. Remove the master cylinder and secure away
from the hydraulic booster. 4. Remove the hydraulic booster.
5. Place the J 26689 over the end of the accumulator. 6. Install the nut on the stud. 7. Depress the
accumulator with a C-clamp.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Hydraulic Fluid Accumulator >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 6271
8. Rotate retaining ring (2) until either end of the ring is under the access hole (1). 9. Depress and
hold the ring with a small tool inserted into the access hole
10. Remove the accumulator retainer ring (1) using a small hook shaped tool.
11. Release the C-clamp. 12. Remove the nut from the stud. 13. Remove the J26889.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Hydraulic Fluid Accumulator >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 6272
14. Remove the accumulator (2) and O-ring seal (3).
Installation Procedure
1. Lubricate all seals and metal friction points with power steering fluid. 2. Install the accumulator
(2) and O-ring seal (3).
3. Place the J 26889 over the end of the accumulator. 4. Install the nut on the stud. 5. Depress the
accumulator with a C-clamp.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Hydraulic Fluid Accumulator >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 6273
6. Install the accumulator retainer ring (2).
7. Release the C-clamp. 8. Remove the nut from the stud. 9. Remove the J 26889.
10. Install the hydraulic booster. 11. Install the master cylinder to the hydraulic brake booster.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
12. Install the master cylinder nuts.
^ Tighten the master cylinder nuts to 36 Nm (27 ft. lbs.).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Vacuum Brake Booster: > 02-02-32-005A > Apr > 02 >
Power Steering - Whining Noise While Turning
Vacuum Brake Booster: Customer Interest Power Steering - Whining Noise While Turning
File in section: 02 - Steering
Bulletin No.: 02-02-32-005A
Date: April, 2002
TECHNICAL
Subject: Excessive Noise from Power Steering System While Turning or Under Light Braking
(Replace Power Brake Booster Inlet Hose)
Models: 1999-2002 Chevrolet and GMC M/L-Van Models
This bulletin is being revised to change the model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
02-02-32-005 (Section 02 - Steering).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a whine noise coming from the power steering system while
turning or braking.
Correction
Replace the power brake booster inlet hose, P/N 15094588. Follow the service procedure listed
below.
1. Remove the power brake booster inlet hose from the pump to the hydraulic booster and discard
the hose. Refer to the Power Brake Booster Inlet Hose Replacement procedure in the Service
Manual (SI ID # 546584).
Important:
Routing of the power brake booster inlet hose (1) at the hydraulic brake booster is critical for proper
installation.
2. Install and route the inlet brake booster hose (1) from the hydraulic brake booster to the rear of
the outlet brake booster hose (2) and under the brake lines (3) and down to the rear of the pump.
Tighten
Tighten the power brake booster inlet hose fittings to 27 N.m (20 lb ft).
3. Bleed the power steering system. Refer to the Bleeding the Power Steering System procedure in
the Service Manual (SI ID # 487449).
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Vacuum Brake Booster: > 02-02-32-005A > Apr > 02 >
Power Steering - Whining Noise While Turning > Page 6282
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table shown.
DISCLAIMER
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Vacuum Brake Booster: > 02-02-32-005A >
Apr > 02 > Power Steering - Whining Noise While Turning
Vacuum Brake Booster: All Technical Service Bulletins Power Steering - Whining Noise While
Turning
File in section: 02 - Steering
Bulletin No.: 02-02-32-005A
Date: April, 2002
TECHNICAL
Subject: Excessive Noise from Power Steering System While Turning or Under Light Braking
(Replace Power Brake Booster Inlet Hose)
Models: 1999-2002 Chevrolet and GMC M/L-Van Models
This bulletin is being revised to change the model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
02-02-32-005 (Section 02 - Steering).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a whine noise coming from the power steering system while
turning or braking.
Correction
Replace the power brake booster inlet hose, P/N 15094588. Follow the service procedure listed
below.
1. Remove the power brake booster inlet hose from the pump to the hydraulic booster and discard
the hose. Refer to the Power Brake Booster Inlet Hose Replacement procedure in the Service
Manual (SI ID # 546584).
Important:
Routing of the power brake booster inlet hose (1) at the hydraulic brake booster is critical for proper
installation.
2. Install and route the inlet brake booster hose (1) from the hydraulic brake booster to the rear of
the outlet brake booster hose (2) and under the brake lines (3) and down to the rear of the pump.
Tighten
Tighten the power brake booster inlet hose fittings to 27 N.m (20 lb ft).
3. Bleed the power steering system. Refer to the Bleeding the Power Steering System procedure in
the Service Manual (SI ID # 487449).
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Vacuum Brake Booster: > 02-02-32-005A >
Apr > 02 > Power Steering - Whining Noise While Turning > Page 6288
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table shown.
DISCLAIMER
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control >
Electronic Brake Control Module > Component Information > Specifications
Electronic Brake Control Module: Specifications
Brake Pressure Modulator Bleeder Valves 80 inch lbs.
EBCM to BPMV 39 inch lbs.
Front Brake Lines to BPMV 18 ft. lbs.
Rear Brake Line to BPMV 18 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control >
Electronic Brake Control Module > Component Information > Specifications > Page 6293
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control >
Electronic Brake Control Module > Component Information > Specifications > Page 6294
Electronic Brake Control Module: Diagrams
Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM) C1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control >
Electronic Brake Control Module > Component Information > Specifications > Page 6295
Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM) C2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control >
Electronic Brake Control Module > Component Information > Specifications > Page 6296
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair
Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM) Replacement
Removal Procedure
Important: After installation, calibrate the new EBCM to the tire size that is appropriate to the
vehicle.
1. Remove the fuel pipe shield (3) from the frame bracket (2) by removing the 2 nuts (4).
Important: Thoroughly wash all contaminants from around the EHCU (1). The area around the
EHCU must be free from loose dirt to prevent contamination of disassembled ABS components.
2. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the EBCM.
3. Remove the 4 T-25 Tort mounting screws (1) that fasten the EBCM (2) to the BPMV (5). 4.
Remove the EBCM (2) from the BPMV (5). Removal may require a light amount of force.
Important: Do not use a tool to pry the EBCM or the BPMV. Excessive force will damage the
EBCM.
5. Clean the BPMV to EBCM mounting surfaces with a clean cloth.
Installation Procedure
Important: Do not reuse the old mounting screws (1). Always install new mounting screws with the
new EBCM.
Important: Do not use RTV or any other type of sealant on the EBCM gasket or mating surfaces.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control >
Electronic Brake Control Module > Component Information > Specifications > Page 6297
1. Install EBCM (2) on to the BPMV (5).
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the 4 new T-25 Torx screws (1) in the EBCM (2).
^ Tighten the 4 T-25 Torx screws to 5 Nm (39 inch lbs.) in an X-pattern.
3. Connect the electrical connectors to the EBCM. 4. Secure the module (1) to the frame bracket
(3) and fuel pipe shield (2) with the two nuts (4). 5. Revise the tire calibration using the Scan Tool
Tire Size Calibration function. 6. Return to Diagnostic System Check - ABS on. See: Antilock
Brakes / Traction Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Initial Inspection and
Diagnostic Overview/Diagnostic System Check
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control >
Wheel Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Speed Sensor:
> 02-05-25-006B > Jan > 06 > Brakes - Low Speed (Below 5 MPH) ABS Activation
Wheel Speed Sensor: Customer Interest Brakes - Low Speed (Below 5 MPH) ABS Activation
Bulletin No.: 02-05-25-006B
Date: January 05, 2006
TECHNICAL
Subject: Antilock Brake (ABS) Activation At Low Speeds (Clean Wheel Speed Sensor Mounting
Surface)
Models: 1999-2000 Cadillac Escalade 1995-1999 Chevrolet Silverado (Old Style) 1995-2000
Chevrolet Suburban, Tahoe (Old Style) 1995-2003 Chevrolet Astro Van, Blazer, S10 1995-1999
GMC Sierra (Old Style) 1995-2000 GMC Yukon, Yukon XL (Old Style) 1995-2001 GMC Envoy,
Jimmy 1995-2003 GMC Safari Van, Sonoma 1995-2001 Oldsmobile Bravada
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to update the correction and warranty information. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 02-05-25-006A (Section 05 - Brakes).
Condition
Some customers may comment on ABS activation at low speeds, usually below 8 km/h (5 mph).
Upon investigation, the technician will find no DTCs set.
Cause
The cause of this condition may be an increased air gap between the wheel speed sensor and the
hub reluctor ring due to rust and debris built up on the sensor mounting surface.
Correction
Measure AC voltage and clean wheel speed sensor mounting surfaces.
1. Raise the vehicle on a hoist.
2. Disconnect both the front wheel speed sensor harness connectors.
3. Place a DVM across the terminals of each sensor connector.
4. Rotate the wheel with hand speed and measure the ACmV's. The reading should be at least 350
ACmV's.
5. If the reading is between 200 and 350 ACmV's, remove the wheel, caliper and rotor in order to
gain access to the speed sensor.
6. Remove the wheel speed sensor and plug the hole to prevent debris from falling into the hub
during service.
7. Clean the wheel speed sensor mounting surface using a wire brush, sand paper, emery cloth,
ScotchBrite(TM) or other suitable material. Be sure to thoroughly clean the wheel speed sensor
surface. There should be no rust or corrosion.
8. Check the sensor head to determine if it has been warped/distorted due to the corrosion build up
or other causes. Check the mounting surface on the sensor head for flatness by placing it on the
edge of a metal machinists scale or other suitable straight edge to measure the flatness. Check the
sensor for flatness in multiple (minimum 3) positions/directions. If the sensor head is distorted,
replace the sensor.
9. Apply (spray) two thin coats of the specified rust penetrating lubricant (corrosion inhibitor) to the
complete sensor mounting surface on the bearing hub. Allow to dry for 3-5 minutes between coats.
Use ONLY Rust Penetrating Lubricant, P/N 89022217 (Canadian P/N 89022218).
10. When the corrosion inhibitor is dry to the touch (about 10 minutes), apply a thin layer of bearing
grease to the hub surface and sensor 0-ring prior to sensor installation. Use ONLY Wheel Bearing
Lubricant, P/N 01051344 (Canadian P/N 993037).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control >
Wheel Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Speed Sensor:
> 02-05-25-006B > Jan > 06 > Brakes - Low Speed (Below 5 MPH) ABS Activation > Page 6307
11. Install either the original sensor or a new one in the hub and secure the sensor. Ensure that the
sensor is seated flush against the hub.
12. Install the rotor, the caliper and the wheel.
13. Place the DVM across the sensor terminals and recheck the voltage while rotating the wheel by
hand. The voltage should now read at least 350 ACmV's.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control >
Wheel Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel
Speed Sensor: > 02-05-25-006B > Jan > 06 > Brakes - Low Speed (Below 5 MPH) ABS Activation
Wheel Speed Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Low Speed (Below 5 MPH) ABS
Activation
Bulletin No.: 02-05-25-006B
Date: January 05, 2006
TECHNICAL
Subject: Antilock Brake (ABS) Activation At Low Speeds (Clean Wheel Speed Sensor Mounting
Surface)
Models: 1999-2000 Cadillac Escalade 1995-1999 Chevrolet Silverado (Old Style) 1995-2000
Chevrolet Suburban, Tahoe (Old Style) 1995-2003 Chevrolet Astro Van, Blazer, S10 1995-1999
GMC Sierra (Old Style) 1995-2000 GMC Yukon, Yukon XL (Old Style) 1995-2001 GMC Envoy,
Jimmy 1995-2003 GMC Safari Van, Sonoma 1995-2001 Oldsmobile Bravada
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to update the correction and warranty information. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 02-05-25-006A (Section 05 - Brakes).
Condition
Some customers may comment on ABS activation at low speeds, usually below 8 km/h (5 mph).
Upon investigation, the technician will find no DTCs set.
Cause
The cause of this condition may be an increased air gap between the wheel speed sensor and the
hub reluctor ring due to rust and debris built up on the sensor mounting surface.
Correction
Measure AC voltage and clean wheel speed sensor mounting surfaces.
1. Raise the vehicle on a hoist.
2. Disconnect both the front wheel speed sensor harness connectors.
3. Place a DVM across the terminals of each sensor connector.
4. Rotate the wheel with hand speed and measure the ACmV's. The reading should be at least 350
ACmV's.
5. If the reading is between 200 and 350 ACmV's, remove the wheel, caliper and rotor in order to
gain access to the speed sensor.
6. Remove the wheel speed sensor and plug the hole to prevent debris from falling into the hub
during service.
7. Clean the wheel speed sensor mounting surface using a wire brush, sand paper, emery cloth,
ScotchBrite(TM) or other suitable material. Be sure to thoroughly clean the wheel speed sensor
surface. There should be no rust or corrosion.
8. Check the sensor head to determine if it has been warped/distorted due to the corrosion build up
or other causes. Check the mounting surface on the sensor head for flatness by placing it on the
edge of a metal machinists scale or other suitable straight edge to measure the flatness. Check the
sensor for flatness in multiple (minimum 3) positions/directions. If the sensor head is distorted,
replace the sensor.
9. Apply (spray) two thin coats of the specified rust penetrating lubricant (corrosion inhibitor) to the
complete sensor mounting surface on the bearing hub. Allow to dry for 3-5 minutes between coats.
Use ONLY Rust Penetrating Lubricant, P/N 89022217 (Canadian P/N 89022218).
10. When the corrosion inhibitor is dry to the touch (about 10 minutes), apply a thin layer of bearing
grease to the hub surface and sensor 0-ring prior to sensor installation. Use ONLY Wheel Bearing
Lubricant, P/N 01051344 (Canadian P/N 993037).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control >
Wheel Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel
Speed Sensor: > 02-05-25-006B > Jan > 06 > Brakes - Low Speed (Below 5 MPH) ABS Activation > Page 6313
11. Install either the original sensor or a new one in the hub and secure the sensor. Ensure that the
sensor is seated flush against the hub.
12. Install the rotor, the caliper and the wheel.
13. Place the DVM across the sensor terminals and recheck the voltage while rotating the wheel by
hand. The voltage should now read at least 350 ACmV's.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control >
Wheel Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6314
Wheel Speed Sensor: Specifications
Front Wheel Speed Sensor Mounting Bolt 12 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control >
Wheel Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6315
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control >
Wheel Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6316
Wheel Speed Sensor: Diagrams
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control >
Wheel Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6317
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
Wheel Speed Sensor Replacement (RWD)
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. 2. Remove the tire and wheel. 3. Remove the brake caliper (1). 4. Remove the
hub and rotor assembly (3). 5. Remove the wheel speed sensor cable electrical connector (2). 6.
Remove the wheel speed sensor harness clip rivets using a 3/16 inch drill bit. 7. Remove the clips
from the wheel speed sensor wire. Save the clips for the replacement sensor. 8. Remove the wheel
speed sensor mounting bolts and nut. 9. Remove the 2 splash shield mounting bolts (7).
10. Remove the wheel speed sensor and the splash shield assembly (6). 11. Remove the splash
shield gasket. 12. Clean the gasket and knuckle (8) surfaces thoroughly with a dry cloth.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the splash shield gasket. 2. Install the wheel speed sensor splash shield (6).
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the 2 11 mm splash shield mounting bolts.
^ Tighten the splash shield mounting bolts to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
4. Install the wheel speed sensor mounting bolts and nut.
^ Tighten the speed sensor mounting bolts to 26 Nm (19 ft. lbs.).
5. Install the harness clips to the wheel speed sensor wire. Locate the clips at the paint dots on the
wire. 6. Install the harness clips with 3/16 inch rivets. 7. Connect the wheel speed sensor electrical
connector (2).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control >
Wheel Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6318
8. Install the hub and rotor (3). 9. Install the brake caliper (1).
10. Install the tire and wheel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition Lock Cylinder - Revised
Replacement Procedure
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Technical Service Bulletins Ignition Lock Cylinder - Revised
Replacement Procedure
File In Section: 02 - Steering
Bulletin No.: 02-02-35-001
Date: January, 2002
SERVICE MANUAL UPDATE
Subject: Revised Ignition Lock Cylinder Replacement
Models: 1998-2002 Chevrolet and GMC C/K, S/T, M/L and G Model Vehicles 1999-2000 Cadillac
Escalade 2002 Cadillac Escalade 1998-2002 Oldsmobile Bravada
This bulletin is being issued to revise the Ignition Lock Cylinder Replacement procedure in the
Steering Wheel and Column - Standard or Steering Wheel and Column - Tilt sub-sections of the
Service Manual. Please replace the current information in the Service Manual with the following
information.
The following information has been updated within SI2000. If you are using a paper version of this
Service Manual, please make a reference to this bulletin on the affected page.
The above mentioned Service Manuals omitted information regarding performing the Passlock
Relearn or Autolearn procedure after an ignition lock cylinder has been replaced. If you have
replaced the ignition lock cylinder, refer to the following procedures:
For 1998-2000 model year vehicles, refer to Passlock Reprogramming in the Theft Deterrent
subsection.
For 2001-2002 model year vehicles, refer to Programming Theft Deterrent System Components in
the Theft Deterrent subsection.
DISCLAIMER
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Jump Starting > System Information > Service
Precautions
Jump Starting: Service Precautions
CAUTION: Batteries produce explosive gases. Batteries contain corrosive acid. Batteries supply
levels of electrical current high enough to cause burns. Therefore, in order to reduce the risk of
personal injury while working near a battery, observe the following guidelines:
^ Always shield your eyes.
^ Avoid leaning over the battery whenever possible.
^ Do not expose the battery to open flames or sparks.
^ Do not allow battery acid to contact the eyes or the skin. Flush any contacted areas with water immediately and thoroughly.
- Get medical help.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Jump Starting > System Information > Service
Precautions > Page 6334
Jump Starting: Service and Repair
JUMP STARTING IN CASE OF EMERGENCY
CAUTION: Batteries produce explosive gases. Batteries contain corrosive acid. Batteries supply
levels of electrical current high enough to cause burns. Therefore, in order to reduce the risk of
personal injury while working near a battery, observe the following guidelines:
^ Always shield your eyes.
^ Avoid leaning over the battery whenever possible.
^ Do not expose the battery to open flames or sparks.
^ Do not allow battery acid to contact the eyes or the skin. Flush any contacted areas with water immediately and thoroughly.
- Get medical help.
NOTE: This vehicle has a 12 volt, negative ground electrical system. Make sure the vehicle or
equipment being used to jump start the engine is also 12 volt, negative ground. Use of any other
type of system will damage the vehicle's electrical components.
This vehicle has a 12 volt positive, negative ground electrical system. Do not try to jump start a
vehicle if you are unsure of the other vehicle's positive voltage or ground position. The booster
battery and the discharged battery should be treated carefully when using jumper cables.
1. Position the vehicle with the booster battery so that the jumper cables will comfortably reach the
battery of the other vehicle.
^ Do not let the 2 vehicles touch.
^ Make sure that the jumper cables do not have loose clamps or missing insulation.
2. Perform the following steps on both vehicles:
2.1. Place the automatic transmission in PARK.
2.2. Block the wheels.
2.3. Set the parking brake.
2.4. Turn off all electrical loads that are not needed. Leave the hazard flashers ON.
2.5. Turn OFF the ignition switch.
IMPORTANT: Some vehicles have a battery remote positive stud. ALWAYS use the battery remote
positive stud in order to give or to receive a jump start.
3. Attach the end of one jumper cable to the positive terminal of the discharged battery. 4. Attach
the other end of the first cable to the positive terminal of the booster battery. 5. Attach one end of
the remaining jumper cable to the negative terminal of the booster battery.
NOTE: Do not connect the negative charger lead to the housings of other vehicle electrical
accessories or equipment. The action of the battery charger may damage such equipment.
6. Make the final connection of the negative jumper cable to the block or suitable bracket
connected directly to the block, away from the battery. 7. Start the engine of the vehicle that is
providing the jump start and turn off all electrical accessories. Raise the engine RPM to
approximately 1,500
RPM.
8. Crank the engine of the vehicle with the weak battery.
If the engine does not crank or cranks too slowly, perform the following steps: 8.1.
Turn the ignition OFF.
8.2. Allow the booster vehicle engine to run at approximately 1,500 RPM for 5 minutes.
8.3. Attempt to start the engine of the vehicle with the discharged battery.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Jump Starting > System Information > Service
Precautions > Page 6335
9. Reverse the steps exactly when removing the jumper cables. The negative battery cable must
first be disconnected from the engine that was jump
started.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Negative, Battery Cable > System
Information > Service Precautions
Negative: Service Precautions
CAUTION: In order to prevent possible personal injury from a moving vehicle or from an operating
engine, perform the following steps before performing the checks:
1. Place the transmission in park. 2. Engage the parking brakes and block the wheels. 3.
Disconnect the battery feed at the distributor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Negative, Battery Cable > System
Information > Service and Repair > Battery Negative Cable Disconnect/Connect Procedure
Negative: Service and Repair Battery Negative Cable Disconnect/Connect Procedure
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Turn off all the lamps and accessories. 2. Turn the ignition OFF. 3. Remove the battery ground
(negative) cable and bolt from the battery 4.3L.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Clean any existing corrosion from the battery terminal bolt flange and the battery
cable end.
Install the battery ground (negative) cable and bolt to the battery.
Tighten Tighten the battery terminal bolt to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Negative, Battery Cable > System
Information > Service and Repair > Battery Negative Cable Disconnect/Connect Procedure > Page 6342
Negative: Service and Repair Battery Negative Cable Replacement
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39200 Digital Multimeter
Excessive resistance caused by poor terminal connections and partial short circuits through worn
cable insulation will result in an abnormal voltage drop in the starter cable. Low voltage at the
starter will prevent the normal starter operation and cause hard starting.
Whenever the battery cables are replaced, use a replacement cable that is the same in the type,
the diameter, and the length. Some positive cables have additional feed wires attached to them
and some of the negative cables have additional ground leads attached.
Inspection Procedure
CAUTION: In order to prevent possible personal injury from a moving vehicle or from an operating
engine, perform the following steps before performing the checks: 1. Place the transmission in
park. 2. Engage the parking brakes and block the wheels. 3. Disconnect the battery feed at the
distributor.
1. Check the voltage drop between the ground (the battery negative terminal) and the vehicle
frame.
Place one probe of the J 39200 on the grounded battery post (not on the cable clamp) and the
other on the frame. Operate the starter and note the voltage reading.
2. Check the voltage drop between the battery positive terminal and the starter terminal stud with
the starter operating. 3. Check the voltage drop between the starter housing and the frame with the
starter operating. 4. If the voltage drop in any of the above is more than 0.5 volts, there is
excessive resistance in the circuit.
In order to eliminate resistance, the cables should be disconnected and the connections should be
cleaned.
If the cables are frayed or the clamps are corroded, the cables should be replaced.
When selecting the new cables, ensure that the new cables are the same length and the same
diameter as the original cables being replaced.
Removal Procedure
CAUTION: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable bolt from the battery. 2. Disconnect the battery negative
cable from the engine. 3. Disconnect any additional ground leads attached to the battery negative
cable. 4. Remove the battery negative cable.
Installation Procedure 1. For RWD, install the battery negative cable in the same position as the
original.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Negative, Battery Cable > System
Information > Service and Repair > Battery Negative Cable Disconnect/Connect Procedure > Page 6343
2. For A4WD, install the battery negative cable in the same position as the original.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Connect the battery negative cable to the engine.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 40 N.m (29 lb ft).
4. Install the engine harness to the stud.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
5. Connect the battery negative cable ground lead to the radiator support.
Tighten Tighten the stud to 45 N.m (33 lb ft).
6. Connect the battery negative terminal bolt to the battery.
Tighten Tighten the bolt to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Positive, Battery Cable > System
Information > Service Precautions
Positive: Service Precautions
CAUTION: In order to prevent possible personal injury from a moving vehicle or from an operating
engine, perform the following steps before performing the checks:
1. Place the transmission in park. 2. Engage the parking brakes and block the wheels. 3.
Disconnect the binary feed at the distributor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Positive, Battery Cable > System
Information > Service Precautions > Page 6347
Positive: Service and Repair
BATTERY POSITIVE CABLE REPLACEMENT
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39200 Digital Multimeter
Excessive resistance caused by poor terminal connections and partial short circuits through worn
cable insulation will result in an abnormal voltage drop in the starter cable. Low voltage at the
starter will prevent the normal starter operation and cause hard starting.
Whenever the battery cables are replaced, use a replacement cable that is the same in the type,
the diameter, and the length. Some positive cables have additional feed wires attached to them
and some of the negative cables have additional ground leads attached.
Inspection Procedure
CAUTION: In order to prevent possible personal injury from a moving vehicle or from an operating
engine, perform the following steps before performing the checks: 1. Place the transmission in
park. 2. Engage the parking brakes and block the wheels. 3. Disconnect the binary feed at the
distributor.
1. Check the voltage drop between the ground (the battery negative terminal) and the vehicle
frame.
Place one probe of the J 39200 on the grounded battery post (not on the cable clamp) and the
other on the frame. Operate the starter and note the voltage reading.
2. Check the voltage drop between the battery positive terminal and the starter terminal stud with
the starter operating. 3. Check the voltage drop between the starter housing and the frame with the
starter operating. 4. If the voltage drop in any of the above is more than 0.5 volts, there is
excessive resistance in the circuit.
In order to eliminate resistance, the cables should be disconnected and the connections should be
cleaned. If the cables are frayed or the clamps are corroded, the cables should be replaced. When
selecting the new cables, ensure that the new cables are the same length and the same diameter
as the original cables being replaced.
Removal Procedure
CAUTION: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disconnect the battery positive cable bolt from the battery. 2. Disconnect the battery positive
cable from the starter motor. 3. Disconnect the additional battery positive cable lead to the
electrical convenience center. 4. Remove the battery positive cable.
Installation Procedure
1. For RWD, install the battery positive cable in the same position as the original.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Positive, Battery Cable > System
Information > Service Precautions > Page 6348
2. For A4WD, install the battery positive cable in the same position as the original.
NOTE:
^ When installing the positive battery cable to the starter solenoid, the inner nut on the solenoid
battery terminal must be tightened before the battery cable and the other leads are installed.
Failure to do so will result in the solenoid or the solenoid terminal damage.
^ Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Connect the battery positive cable to the starter solenoid.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 9 N.m (80 lb in).
4. Connect the additional battery positive cable lead to the underhood electrical center.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 9 N.m (80 lb in).
5. Connect the battery positive terminal bolt to the battery.
Tighten Tighten the bolt to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Specifications > Amperage
Generator Usage
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Specifications > Amperage > Page 6354
Alternator: Specifications Voltage
Voltage
Charging Voltage 13-16 Volts
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6355
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Alternator: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6358
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6359
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6360
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6361
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6362
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6363
Alternator: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6364
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6365
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6366
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6367
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6368
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6369
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6370
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6371
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6372
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6373
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6374
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6375
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6376
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6377
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6378
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6379
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6380
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6381
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6382
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6383
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6384
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6385
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6386
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6387
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6388
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6389
Generator
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 6390
Alternator: Description and Operation
GENERATOR
The AD-230 generator is non-repairable. They are electrically similar to earlier models. The
generator(s) feature the following major components:
^ The delta stator
^ The rectifier bridge
^ The rotor with slip rings and brushes
^ A conventional pulley
^ Dual internal fans
^ A voltage regulator
The pulley and the fan cool the slip ring and the frame. The AD stands for Air-Cooled Dual internal
fan; the 2 is an electrical design designator; the 30 denotes the outside diameter of the stator
laminations in millimeters, over 100 millimeters. The generator is rated at 105 amperes.
The generator features permanently lubricated bearings. Service should only include the tightening
of mounting components. Otherwise, the generator is replaced as a complete unit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 6391
Alternator: Service and Repair
GENERATOR REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the air cleaner assembly. 3. Remove the drive
belt. 4. Disconnect the regulator electrical connector. 5. Remove the generator front mounting
bolts. 6. Remove the generator rear mounting bolt. 7. Remove the generator output (BAT) terminal
nut. 8. Remove the generator.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Position the generator on the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Loosely install the mounting bolts. 3. Install the generator output (BAT) lead. 4. Loosely install
the generator output (BAT) nut.
Tighten
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 6392
^ Tighten the mounting bolts to 50 N.m (37 lb ft).
^ Tighten the generator output (BAT) terminal nut to 20 N.m (15 lb ft).
5. Connect the regulator electrical connector. 6. Install the drive belt. 7. Install the air cleaner. 8.
Connect the battery negative cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Lock > Component Information >
Locations
Ignition Lock: Locations
For additional steering column components locations,
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition Lock Cylinder - Revised Replacement Procedure
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Technical Service Bulletins Ignition Lock Cylinder - Revised
Replacement Procedure
File In Section: 02 - Steering
Bulletin No.: 02-02-35-001
Date: January, 2002
SERVICE MANUAL UPDATE
Subject: Revised Ignition Lock Cylinder Replacement
Models: 1998-2002 Chevrolet and GMC C/K, S/T, M/L and G Model Vehicles 1999-2000 Cadillac
Escalade 2002 Cadillac Escalade 1998-2002 Oldsmobile Bravada
This bulletin is being issued to revise the Ignition Lock Cylinder Replacement procedure in the
Steering Wheel and Column - Standard or Steering Wheel and Column - Tilt sub-sections of the
Service Manual. Please replace the current information in the Service Manual with the following
information.
The following information has been updated within SI2000. If you are using a paper version of this
Service Manual, please make a reference to this bulletin on the affected page.
The above mentioned Service Manuals omitted information regarding performing the Passlock
Relearn or Autolearn procedure after an ignition lock cylinder has been replaced. If you have
replaced the ignition lock cylinder, refer to the following procedures:
For 1998-2000 model year vehicles, refer to Passlock Reprogramming in the Theft Deterrent
subsection.
For 2001-2002 model year vehicles, refer to Programming Theft Deterrent System Components in
the Theft Deterrent subsection.
DISCLAIMER
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Key > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Locks - Key Code Security Rules and Information
Key: Technical Service Bulletins Locks - Key Code Security Rules and Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 10-00-89-010
Date: May 27, 2010
Subject: Key Code Security Rules and Information on GM KeyCode Look-Up Application (Canada
Only)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior
Saturn and Saab 2002 and Prior Isuzu
Attention:
This bulletin has been created to address potential issues and questions regarding KeyCode
security. This bulletin should be read by all parties involved in KeyCode activity, including dealer
operator, partner security coordinator, sales, service and parts departments. A copy of this bulletin
should be printed and maintained in the parts department for use as a reference.
Important U.S. dealers should refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 10-00-89-009.
Where Are Key Codes Located?
General Motors provides access to KeyCodes through three sources when a vehicle is delivered to
a dealer. Vehicle KeyCodes are located on the original vehicle invoice to the dealership. There is a
small white bar coded tag sent with most new vehicles that also has the key code printed on it.
Dealerships should make a practice of comparing the tag's keycode numbers to the keycode listed
on the invoice. Any discrepancy should be reported immediately to the GM of Canada Key Code
Inquiry Desk. Remember to remove the key tag prior to showing vehicles to potential customers.
The third source for Key codes is through the GM KeyCode Look-Up feature within the
OEConnection D2DLink application. KeyCode Look-Up currently goes back 17 previous model
years from the current model year.
When a vehicle is received by the dealership, care should be taken to safeguard the original
vehicle invoice and KeyCode tag provided with the vehicle. Potential customers should not have
access to the invoice or this KeyCode tag prior to the sale being completed. After a sale has been
completed, the KeyCode information belongs to the customer and General Motors.
Tip
Only the original invoice contains key code information, a re-printed invoice does not.
GM KeyCode Look-Up Application for GM of Canada Dealers
All dealers should review the General Motors of Canada KeyCode Look-Up Policies and
Procedures (Service Policy & Procedures Manual Section 3.1.6 "Replacement of VIN plates &
keys").
Please note that the KeyCode Access site is restricted. Only authorized users should be using this
application. Please see your Parts Manager for site authorized users. KeyCode Look-Up currently
goes back 17 years from current model year.
Important notes about security:
- Users may not access the system from multiple computers simultaneously.
- Users may only request one KeyCode at a time.
- KeyCode information will only be available on the screen for 2 minutes.
- Each user is personally responsible for maintaining and protecting their password.
- Never share your password with others.
- User Id's are suspended after 6 consecutive failed attempts.
- User Id's are disabled if not used for 90 days.
- Processes must be in place for regular dealership reviews.
- The Parts Manager (or assigned management) must have processes in place for employee
termination or life change events. Upon termination individuals access must be turned off
immediately and access should be re-evaluated upon any position changes within the dealership.
- If you think your password or ID security has been breached, contact Dealer Systems Support at
1-800-265-0573.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Key > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Locks - Key Code Security Rules and Information > Page 6406
Each user will be required to accept the following agreement each time the KeyCode application is
used.
Key Code User Agreement
- Key codes are proprietary information belonging to General Motors Corporation and to the vehicle
owner.
- Unauthorized access to, or use of, key code information is unlawful and may subject the user to
criminal and civil penalties.
- This information should be treated as strictly confidential and should not be disclosed to anyone
unless authorized.
I will ensure that the following information is obtained prior to releasing any Key Code information:
1. Government issued picture ID (Drivers License) 2. Registration or other proof of ownership.
Registration should have normal markings from the Province that issued the registration and
possibly the
receipt for payment recorded as well.
Important
- GM takes this agreement seriously. Each user must be certain of vehicle ownership before giving
out key codes.
- When the ownership of the vehicle is in doubt, dealership personnel should not provide the
information.
Key code requests should never be received via a fax or the internet and key codes should never
be provided to anyone in this manner. A face to face contact with the owner of the vehicle is the
expected manner that dealers will use to release a key code or as otherwise stipulated in this
bulletin or other materials.
- Key codes should NEVER be sent via a fax or the internet.
- Each Dealership should create a permanent file to document all KeyCode Look Up transactions.
Requests should be filed by VIN and in each folder retain copies of the following:
- Government issued picture ID (Drivers License)
- Registration or other proof of ownership.
- Copy of the paid customer receipt which has the name of the employee who cut and sold the key
to the customer.
- Do not put yourself or your Dealership in the position of needing to "explain" a KeyCode Look Up
to either GM or law enforcement officials.
- Dealership Management has the ability to review all KeyCode Look-Up transactions.
- Dealership KeyCode documentation must be retained for two years.
Frequently Asked Questions (FAQs) for GM of Canada Dealers
How do I request a KeyCode for customer owned vehicle that is not registered?
Scrapped, salvaged or stored vehicles that do not have a current registration should still have the
ownership verified by requesting the vehicle title, current insurance policy and / or current lien
holder information from the customers financing source. If you cannot determine if the customer is
the owner of the vehicle, do not provide the key code information. In these cases, a short
description of the vehicle (scrapped, salvaged, etc.) and the dealership location should be kept on
file. Any clarifying explanation should be entered into the comments field.
How do I document a KeyCode request for a vehicle that is being repossessed?
The repossessor must document ownership of the vehicle by providing a court ordered
repossession order and lien-holder documents prior to providing key code information. Copies of
the repossessors Drivers License and a business card should be retained by the dealership for
documentation.
What do I do if the registration information is locked in the vehicle?
Every effort should be made to obtain complete information for each request. Each Dealership will
have to decide on a case by case basis if enough information is available to verify the customer's
ownership of the vehicle. Other forms of documentation include vehicle title, insurance policy, and
or current lien information from the customers financing source. Dealership Management must be
involved in any request without complete information. If you cannot determine if the customer is the
owner of the vehicle, do not provide the key code information.
Can I get a print out of the information on the screen?
It is important to note that the Key Code Look Up Search Results contain sensitive and/or
proprietary information. For this reason GM recommends against printing it. If the Search Results
must be printed, store and/or dispose of the printed copy properly to minimize the risk of improper
or illegal use.
Who in the dealership has access to the KeyCode application?
Dealership Parts Manager (or assigned management) will determine, and control, who is
authorized to access the KeyCode Look Up application. However, we anticipate that dealership
parts and service management will be the primary users of the application. The KeyCode Look Up
application automatically tracks each user activity session. Information tracked by the system
includes: User name, User ID, all other entered data and the date/time of access.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Key > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Locks - Key Code Security Rules and Information > Page 6407
What if I input the VIN incorrectly?
If an incorrect VIN is entered into the system (meaning that the system does not recognize the VIN
or that the VIN has been entered incorrectly) the system will return an error message.
If I am an authorized user for the KeyCode application, can I access the application from home?
Yes.
What if I suspect key code misuse?
Your dealership should communicate the proper procedures for requesting key codes. Any
suspicious activity either within the dealership or externally should be reported to Dealer Systems
Support at 1-800-265-0573 or GM of Canada Key Code Inquiry Desk at 1-905-644-4892.
Whose key codes can I access through the system?
At this time the following Canadian vehicle codes are available through the system: Chevrolet,
Cadillac, Buick, Pontiac, GMC, HUMMER (H2 and H3 only), Oldsmobile, Saturn, Saab and Isuzu
(up to 2002 model year) for a maximum of 17 model years.
What should I do if I enter a valid VIN and the system does not produce any key code information?
Occasionally, the KeyCode Look Up application may not produce a key code for a valid VIN. This
may be the result of new vehicle information not yet available. In addition, older vehicle information
may have been sent to an archive status. If you do not receive a key code returned for valid VIN,
you should contact GM of Canada Key Code Inquiry Desk at 1-905-644-4892.
How do I access KeyCodes if the KeyCode Look-up system is down?
If the KeyCode Look-up system is temporarily unavailable, you can contact the original selling
dealer who may have it on file or contact GM of Canada Key Code Inquiry Desk at
1-905-644-4892. If the customer is dealing with an emergency lock-out situation, you need to have
the customer contact Roadside assistance, OnStar if subscribed, or 911.
What should I do if the KeyCode from the look-up system does not work on the vehicle?
On occasion a dealer may encounter a KeyCode that will not work on the vehicle in question. In
cases where the KeyCode won't work you will need to verify with the manufacturer of the cutting
equipment that the key has been cut correctly. If the key has been cut correctly you may be able to
verify the proper KeyCode was given through the original selling dealer. When unable to verify the
KeyCode through the original selling dealer contact GM of Canada Key Code Inquiry Desk at
1-905-644-4892. If the key has been cut correctly and the code given does not work, the lock
cylinder may have been changed. In these situations following the proper SI document for recoding
a key or replacing the lock cylinder may be necessary.
How long do I have to keep KeyCode Records?
Dealership KeyCode documentation must be retained for two years.
Can I get a KeyCode changed in the Look-Up system?
Yes, KeyCodes can be changed in the Look-Up system if a lock cylinder has been changed.
Contact GM of Canada Key Code Inquiry Desk at 1-905-644-4892.
What information do I need before I can provide a driver of a company fleet vehicle Keys or
KeyCode information?
The dealership should have a copy of the individual's driver's license, proof of employment and
registration. If there is any question as to the customer's employment by the fleet company, the
dealer should attempt to contact the fleet company for verification. If there is not enough
information to determine ownership and employment, this information should not be provided.
How do I document a request from an Independent Repair facility for a KeyCode or Key?
The independent must provide a copy of their driver's license, proof of employment and signed
copy of the repair order for that repair facility. The repair order must include customer's name,
address, VIN, city, province and license plate number. Copies of this information must be included
in your dealer KeyCode file.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Key > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Locks - Key Code Security Rules and Information > Page 6408
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Locations
Fuse Block - Underhood
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Starter Motor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6414
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6415
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6416
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6417
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6418
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6419
Starter Motor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6420
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6421
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6422
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6423
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6424
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6425
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6426
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6427
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6428
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6429
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6430
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6431
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6432
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6433
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6434
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6435
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6436
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6437
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6438
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6439
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6440
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6441
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6442
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6443
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6444
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 6445
Starter Motor: Service and Repair
STARTER MOTOR REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable. 2. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the
Vehicle. 3. Remove the starter motor mounting bolts. 4. Remove any shims previously used. 5.
Lower the starter motor.
6. Disconnect the starter enable relay lead (1), the battery positive cable (2), and the generator
output (BAT) lead (3) from the starter solenoid field
leads.
7. Remove the starter motor.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Caution and Notices.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 6446
1. Connect the starter motor field leads to the starter motor as follows:
1.1. Loosely install the starter enable relay lead (1) to the starter solenoid terminal. Align the
terminal retaining tab to the starter solenoid.
1.2. Loosely install generator output (BAT) lead (3) and the battery positive cable (2) to the
solenoid terminal. Align the battery positive cable terminal retaining tab to the starter solenoid.
Tighten ^
Tighten the starter enable relay lead nut to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
^ Tighten the battery positive cable nut to 19 N.m (14 lb ft).
2. Install the two starter motor mounting bolts and the shims (if necessary) through the starter to
the engine.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 43 N.m (32 lb ft).
3. Lower the vehicle. 4. Connect the battery negative cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information >
Locations
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Locations
Fuse Block - Underhood
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6457
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Diagrams
Auxiliary Power Outlet - Front No. 1
Auxiliary Power Outlet - Rear
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6458
Auxiliary Power Outlet - Front No. 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Aftermarket Fuse Warning
Fuse: Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Aftermarket Fuse Warning
Bulletin No.: 07-08-45-002
Date: September 05, 2007
ADVANCED SERVICE INFORMATION
Subject: Service Alert: Concerns With Aftermarket Fuses in GM Vehicles
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2008 and
Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2008 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Concerns with Harbor Freight Tools "Storehouse" Branded Blade Type Fuses
General Motors has become aware of a fuse recall by Harbor Freight Tools/Storehouse for a
variety of aftermarket fuses. In two cases, these fuses have not provided protection for the wiring
system of the vehicles they were customer installed in.
Upon testing the 15 amp version, it was found that the fuse still would not "open" when shorted
directly across the battery terminals.
How to Identify These Fuses
Packed in a 120 piece set, the fuse has a translucent, hard plastic, blue body with the amperage
stamped into the top. There are no white painted numbers on the fuse to indicate amperage. There
are no identifying marks on the fuse to tell who is making it. The fuses are known to be distributed
by Harbor Freight Tools but there may be other marketers, and packaging of this style of fuse. It
would be prudent to replace these fuses if found in a customers vehicle. Likewise, if wiring
overheating is found you should check the fuse panel for the presence of this style of fuse.
All GM dealers should use genuine GM fuses on the vehicles they service. You should also
encourage the use of GM fuses to your customers to assure they are getting the required electrical
system protection. GM has no knowledge of any concerns with other aftermarket fuses. If
additional information becomes available, this bulletin will be updated.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Fuse Block - I/P
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Fuse Block - I/P > Page 6465
Fuse Block - Underhood
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block I/P (Front View)
Fuse: Application and ID Fuse Block I/P (Front View)
Fuse Block I/P (Front View) Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block I/P (Front View) > Page 6468
Fuse Block I/P (Front View) Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block I/P (Front View) > Page 6469
Fuse: Application and ID Fuse Block I/P (Rear View)
Fuse Block - I/P (Rear View) Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block I/P (Front View) > Page 6470
Fuse Block - I/P (Rear View) Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block I/P (Front View) > Page 6471
Fuse: Application and ID Fuse Block - Underhood (Front View)
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block I/P (Front View) > Page 6472
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) Part 2 Of 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block I/P (Front View) > Page 6473
Fuse: Application and ID Fuse Block - Underhood (Rear View)
Fuse Block - Underhood (Rear View) Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block I/P (Front View) > Page 6474
Fuse Block - Underhood (Rear View) Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Locations > Instrument Panel (I/P) Fuse Block
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Locations > Instrument Panel (I/P) Fuse Block > Page 6479
Fuse Block - Underhood
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6480
Fuse Block: Diagrams
Convenience Center C1
Convenience Center C3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6481
Convenience Center C4
Convenience Center C5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6482
Convenience Center C6
Convenience Center C8
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6483
Convenience Center C9
Convenience Center C10
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block - Underhood (Front View)
Fuse Block: Application and ID Fuse Block - Underhood (Front View)
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block - Underhood (Front View) > Page 6486
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) Part 2 Of 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block - Underhood (Front View) > Page 6487
Fuse Block: Application and ID Fuse Block - Underhood (Rear View)
Fuse Block - Underhood (Rear View) Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block - Underhood (Front View) > Page 6488
Fuse Block - Underhood (Rear View) Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block - Underhood (Front View) > Page 6489
Fuse Block: Application and ID Fuse Block I/P (Front View)
Fuse Block I/P (Front View) Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block - Underhood (Front View) > Page 6490
Fuse Block I/P (Front View) Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block - Underhood (Front View) > Page 6491
Fuse Block: Application and ID Fuse Block I/P (Rear View)
Fuse Block - I/P (Rear View) Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block - Underhood (Front View) > Page 6492
Fuse Block - I/P (Rear View) Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Relay Replacement (Within an Electrical Center)
Fuse Block: Service and Repair Relay Replacement (Within an Electrical Center)
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 43244 Relay Puller Pliers
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the electrical center cover. 2. Locate the relay.
IMPORTANT: ^
Always note the orientation of the relay.
^ Make sure the electrical center is secure, as not to put added stress on the wires or terminals.
3. Using the J 43244 (1) position the tool on opposing corners of the relay (2).
NOTE: Use J 43244 to pull the relay straight out from the electrical center terminals. The use of
pliers or a flat bladed tool could damage the electrical center.
4. Remove the relay (2) from the electrical center.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Relay Replacement (Within an Electrical Center) > Page 6495
1. Install the relay (2) in the same position as removed. 2. Install the electrical center cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Relay Replacement (Within an Electrical Center) > Page 6496
Fuse Block: Service and Repair Relay Replacement (Attached to Wire Harness)
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Locate the relay. Refer to the Master Electrical Component List to locate the relay in the vehicle.
2. Remove any fasteners which hold the relay in place. 3. Remove any Connector Position
Assurance (CPA) devices or secondary locks.
IMPORTANT: Use care when removing a relay in a wiring harness when the relay is secured by
fasteners or tape.
4. Separate the relay (1) from the wire harness connector (2).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Connect the relay (1) to the wire harness connector (2). 2. Install any Connector Position
Assurance (CPA) devices or secondary locks. 3. Install the relay using any fasteners or tape that
originally held the relay in place.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Ground Strap > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Ground Strap: Service and Repair
GROUND STRAP REPLACEMENT
Additional ground straps are used to connect the body frame to the engine and the transmission.
Always connect all ground straps to ensure a good ground path to the battery for all electrical
components.
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the bolt. 2. Clean the bolt and the mounting surface.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the ground lead.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the bolt.
Tighten Tighten the bolt to 40 N.m (29 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Grounding Point > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair
Grounding Point: Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 10-08-45-001B
Date: October 25, 2010
Subject: Information for Electrical Ground Repair - Use New Replacement Fasteners with
Conductive Finish
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year and update the Warranty
Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-08-45-001A (Section 08 - Body and
Accessories).
Electrical Ground Repair Overview
Proper electrical system function relies on secure, stable and corrosion-free electrical ground
connections. Loose, stripped, or corroded connections increase the possibility of improper system
function and loss of module communication. These conditions may also lead to unnecessary
repairs and component replacement.
In general, electrical ground connections are accomplished using one, or a combination of the
following attachment methods:
- Welded M6 stud and nut
- Welded M6 nut and bolt
- Welded M8 nut and bolt
Determine which attachment method is used and perform the appropriate or alternative repair as
described in this bulletin.
M6 Weld Stud Replacement
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. Select a location adjacent the damaged or missing M6 ground stud having 20 mm (0.79 in)
clearance behind the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in)
clearance surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange.
2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site
and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
3. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel.
4. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is
visible.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Grounding Point > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6504
Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of
0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any
air gaps to ensure a good ground.
5. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit.
6. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool
(2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet
stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3).
7. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive
rivet stud. 8. Ensure the rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement. 9.
Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent.
Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the
installation of the ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable and
corrosion-free electrical ground.
10. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 11. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective
material applied to the rivet stud threads. 12. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet
stud threads. 13. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet
stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 14. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet
stud.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Grounding Point > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6505
15. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 16. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the rivet stud. 17. Select a M6
conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 18. Install the M6 conductive
nut to the rivet stud and:
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
19. Verify proper system operation.
M6 Weld Nut
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M6 weld nut at the electrical ground location is damaged or stripped, a M7 conductive
self-threading bolt may be used to secure the ground
wire terminal.
2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the weld nut and allow to dry. 3. Remove any loose metal particles from the damaged
or stripped weld nut with a stiff brush. 4. Select a M7 conductive self-threading bolt. Refer to the
Parts Information section of this bulletin 5. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N
12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M7 conductive self-threading
bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
6. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 7. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M7 conductive self-threading bolt.
8. Install the M7 conductive self-threading bolt and:
Tighten Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb in).
9. Verify proper system operation.
M6 Weld Nut Alternative Repair
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6 conductive bolt
and a M6 conductive nut may be used to secure
the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M6 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind
the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance
surrounding the new electrical ground site.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the ground location and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 8.5 mm (0.33 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the
area surrounding the 8.5 mm (0.33 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M6 conductive
bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M6 conductive bolt to the ground
location.
10. Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the
M6 conductive nut to the bolt and:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Grounding Point > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6506
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free
electrical ground.
12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation.
M8 Weld Nut
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M8
conductive bolt and a M8 conductive nut may be
used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this
bulletin.
2. Select a location adjacent the M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind the panel
surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance surrounding
the new electrical ground site.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the ground location and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the
area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M8 conductive
bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M8 conductive bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M8 conductive bolt to the ground
location.
10. Select a M8 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the
M8 conductive nut to the bolt and:
Tighten Tighten to 22 Nm (16 lb ft).
Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free
electrical ground.
12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation.
M8 Weld Nut Alternative Repair
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is not accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6
conductive rivet stud and a M6 conductive nut
may be used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal.
2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind
the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance
surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site
and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Grounding Point > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6507
5. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) until bare metal is
visible.
Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of
0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any
air gaps to ensure a good ground.
6. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit.
7. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool
(2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet
stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3).
8. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive
rivet stud. 9. Ensure the new rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement.
10. Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Grounding Point > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6508
Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the
installation of the electrical ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable
and corrosion-free electrical ground.
11. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 12. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective
material applied to the rivet stud threads. 13. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet
stud threads. 14. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet
stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 15. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet
stud.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
16. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 17. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M6 conductive rivet stud. 18.
Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 19. Install the M6
conductive nut to the rivet stud and:
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in)
20. Verify proper system operation.
Parts Information
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Grounding Point > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6509
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C100 - C110
Multiple Junction Connector: Diagrams C100 - C110
C104 (Engine To Forward Lamp)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6514
C100 (Engine To I/P) Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6515
C100 (Engine To I/P) Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6516
C102 (I/P To Forward Lamp)
C108 (I/P to Rear Lamp Jumper VE1 Japan)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6517
C108 (I/P To Rear Lamp Jumper VE1 Japan)
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article or any of the images therein, refer to the
RPO Code List found at Vehicle/Application See: Application and ID
C109 (I/P to Forward Lamp)
C109 (I/P To Forward Lamp)
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article or any of the images therein, refer to the
RPO Code List found at Vehicle/Application See: Application and ID
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6518
C110 (Engine To Brake Pressure Differential Switch)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6519
Multiple Junction Connector: Diagrams C200 - C223
C200 (I/P to Main Body)
C200 (I/P To Main Body)
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article or any of the images therein, refer to the
RPO Code List found at Vehicle/Application See: Application and ID
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6520
C201 (Steering Column to I/P)
C201 (Steering Column To I/P) Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6521
C201 (Steering Column To I/P) Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6522
C201 (Steering Column To I/P) Part 3
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article or any of the images therein, refer to the
RPO Code List found at Vehicle/Application See: Application and ID
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6523
C202 (I/P To Cig/Aux Power Jumper)
C203 (I/P to Liftgate)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6524
C203 (I/P To Liftgate)
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article or any of the images therein, refer to the
RPO Code List found at Vehicle/Application See: Application and ID
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6525
C205 (I/P To Right/Passenger Door)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6526
C212 (Heater Jumper To Heater Body)
C212 (Heater Jumper To Heater Body)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6527
C223 (Upfitter Harness)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6528
Multiple Junction Connector: Diagrams C300 - C333
C300 (I/P To Main Body)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6529
C301 (I/P To Left/Driver Door)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6530
C302 (Body To Overhead Console)
C303 (Body To Overhead Console)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6531
C306 (Power Seat Supply Voltage To LH Power Seat)
C308 (Transfer Case Harness To Transfer Case Extension Jumper)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6532
C309 (Transfer Case Harness To Transfer Case Extension Jumper)
C310 (Engine To Fuel Pump Jumper)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6533
C314 (Engine To Wheel Speed Sensor Jumper)
C333 (Upfitter Harness)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6534
Multiple Junction Connector: Diagrams C401 - C404
C401 (Main Body To Rear Door Jamb Switch)
C403 (Rear Lamp Jumper to Rear Lamp Assembly Export W/WX7)
C403 (Rear Lamp Jumper To Rear Lamp Assembly Export W/WX7)
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article or any of the images therein, refer to the
RPO Code List found at Vehicle/Application See: Application and ID
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6535
C404 (Main Body To Rear - Dome Lamp)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Relay Block #1
Relay Box: Locations Relay Block #1
Relay Block # 1 Under left side of dash on data link connector bracket facing rear of vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Relay Block #1 > Page 6541
Relay Box: Locations Relay Block #2
Relay Block # 2 Under left side of dash on data link connector bracket facing front of vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Relay Block #1 > Page 6542
Fuse Block - Underhood
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Relay Block #1
Relay Block No. 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Relay Block #1 > Page 6545
Relay Block No. 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Relay Block #1 > Page 6546
Relay Box: Application and ID Underhood Fuse-Relay Center (Front View)
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Relay Block #1 > Page 6547
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) Part 2 Of 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Relay Block #1 > Page 6548
Relay Box: Application and ID Underhood Fuse-Relay Center (Rear View)
Fuse Block - Underhood (Rear View) Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Relay Block #1 > Page 6549
Fuse Block - Underhood (Rear View) Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component
Information > Locations > Relay Block #1
Relay Box: Locations Relay Block #1
Relay Block # 1 Under left side of dash on data link connector bracket facing rear of vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component
Information > Locations > Relay Block #1 > Page 6554
Relay Box: Locations Relay Block #2
Relay Block # 2 Under left side of dash on data link connector bracket facing front of vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component
Information > Locations > Relay Block #1 > Page 6555
Fuse Block - Underhood
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component
Information > Application and ID > Relay Block #1
Relay Block No. 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component
Information > Application and ID > Relay Block #1 > Page 6558
Relay Block No. 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component
Information > Application and ID > Relay Block #1 > Page 6559
Relay Box: Application and ID Underhood Fuse-Relay Center (Front View)
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component
Information > Application and ID > Relay Block #1 > Page 6560
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) Part 2 Of 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component
Information > Application and ID > Relay Block #1 > Page 6561
Relay Box: Application and ID Underhood Fuse-Relay Center (Rear View)
Fuse Block - Underhood (Rear View) Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component
Information > Application and ID > Relay Block #1 > Page 6562
Fuse Block - Underhood (Rear View) Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set
By Various Control Modules
Wiring Harness: Customer Interest Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-06-03-004D
Date: December 08, 2010
Subject: Intermittent No Crank/No Start, No Module Communication, MIL, Warning Lights, Vehicle
Messages or DTCs Set by Various Control Modules - Diagnosing and Repairing Fretting Corrosion
(Disconnect Affected Connector and Apply Dielectric Lubricant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Attention:
This repair can be applied to ANY electrical connection including, but not limited to: lighting, body
electrical, in-line connections, powertrain control sensors, etc. DO NOT over apply lubricant to the
point where it prevents the full engagement of sealed connectors. A light coating on the terminal
surfaces is sufficient to correct the condition.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Attention statement and add the 2011
model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-03-004C (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions:
- An intermittent no crank/no start
- Intermittent malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illumination
- Intermittent service lamp illumination
- Intermittent service message(s) being displayed
The technician may determine that he is unable to duplicate the intermittent condition.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a buildup of nonconductive insulating oxidized debris known as
fretting corrosion, occurring between two electrical contact surfaces of the connection or connector.
This may be caused by any of the following conditions:
- Vibration
- Thermal cycling
- Poor connection/terminal retention
- Micro motion
- A connector, component or wiring harness not properly secured resulting in movement
On low current signal circuits this condition may cause high resistance, resulting in intermittent
connections.
On high current power circuits this condition may cause permanent increases in the resistance and
may cause a device to become inoperative.
Representative List of Control Modules and Components
The following is only a representative list of control modules and components that may be affected
by this connection or connector condition and DOES NOT include every possible module or
component for every vehicle.
- Blower Control Module
- Body Control Module (BCM)
- Communication Interface Module (CIM)
- Cooling Fan Control Module
- Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)
- Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module (EBTCM)
- Electronic Suspension Control (ESC) Module
- Engine Control Module (ECM)
- Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) Control Module
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set
By Various Control Modules > Page 6571
- HVAC Actuator
- Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM)
- Any AIR BAG module
- Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner
- Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner
- An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set:
B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023
- Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
- Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Correction
Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions:
- The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated.
- The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can
no longer be duplicated.
Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above.
1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any
existing history or current DTCs from all of the
control modules (refer to SI).
‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the
connector(s) of the control module/component
which may be causing the condition (refer to SI).
‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control
module/component which may be causing the
condition (refer to SI).
2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component
Connector End Views and Component Locator
documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the
condition.
Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the
actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or
identified without the use of a magnifying glass.
Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown,
as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush
that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin.
3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side
and the harness side of the affected connector(s).
4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present.
5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information:
- DTC Diagnostic Procedure
- Circuit/System Description
- Conditions for Running the DTC
- Conditions for Setting the DTC
- Diagnostic Aids
- Circuit/System Verification
‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated,
then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI).
Repair Order Documentation
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set
By Various Control Modules > Page 6572
Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so
may result in a chargeback.
- Customer vehicle condition.
- Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or
Service Message.
- Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set.
- After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated?
‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector
name and number on the repair order.
- If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and
additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID
Number MUST be written on the repair order.
Parts Information
Alternate Distributor For All of North America
Note
NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada),
specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set
By Various Control Modules > Page 6573
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table
above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10
> Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules
Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control
Modules
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-06-03-004D
Date: December 08, 2010
Subject: Intermittent No Crank/No Start, No Module Communication, MIL, Warning Lights, Vehicle
Messages or DTCs Set by Various Control Modules - Diagnosing and Repairing Fretting Corrosion
(Disconnect Affected Connector and Apply Dielectric Lubricant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Attention:
This repair can be applied to ANY electrical connection including, but not limited to: lighting, body
electrical, in-line connections, powertrain control sensors, etc. DO NOT over apply lubricant to the
point where it prevents the full engagement of sealed connectors. A light coating on the terminal
surfaces is sufficient to correct the condition.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Attention statement and add the 2011
model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-03-004C (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions:
- An intermittent no crank/no start
- Intermittent malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illumination
- Intermittent service lamp illumination
- Intermittent service message(s) being displayed
The technician may determine that he is unable to duplicate the intermittent condition.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a buildup of nonconductive insulating oxidized debris known as
fretting corrosion, occurring between two electrical contact surfaces of the connection or connector.
This may be caused by any of the following conditions:
- Vibration
- Thermal cycling
- Poor connection/terminal retention
- Micro motion
- A connector, component or wiring harness not properly secured resulting in movement
On low current signal circuits this condition may cause high resistance, resulting in intermittent
connections.
On high current power circuits this condition may cause permanent increases in the resistance and
may cause a device to become inoperative.
Representative List of Control Modules and Components
The following is only a representative list of control modules and components that may be affected
by this connection or connector condition and DOES NOT include every possible module or
component for every vehicle.
- Blower Control Module
- Body Control Module (BCM)
- Communication Interface Module (CIM)
- Cooling Fan Control Module
- Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)
- Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module (EBTCM)
- Electronic Suspension Control (ESC) Module
- Engine Control Module (ECM)
- Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) Control Module
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10
> Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 6579
- HVAC Actuator
- Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM)
- Any AIR BAG module
- Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner
- Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner
- An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set:
B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023
- Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
- Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Correction
Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions:
- The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated.
- The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can
no longer be duplicated.
Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above.
1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any
existing history or current DTCs from all of the
control modules (refer to SI).
‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the
connector(s) of the control module/component
which may be causing the condition (refer to SI).
‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control
module/component which may be causing the
condition (refer to SI).
2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component
Connector End Views and Component Locator
documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the
condition.
Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the
actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or
identified without the use of a magnifying glass.
Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown,
as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush
that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin.
3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side
and the harness side of the affected connector(s).
4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present.
5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information:
- DTC Diagnostic Procedure
- Circuit/System Description
- Conditions for Running the DTC
- Conditions for Setting the DTC
- Diagnostic Aids
- Circuit/System Verification
‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated,
then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI).
Repair Order Documentation
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10
> Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 6580
Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so
may result in a chargeback.
- Customer vehicle condition.
- Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or
Service Message.
- Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set.
- After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated?
‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector
name and number on the repair order.
- If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and
additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID
Number MUST be written on the repair order.
Parts Information
Alternate Distributor For All of North America
Note
NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada),
specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10
> Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 6581
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table
above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10
> Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair
Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 10-08-45-001B
Date: October 25, 2010
Subject: Information for Electrical Ground Repair - Use New Replacement Fasteners with
Conductive Finish
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year and update the Warranty
Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-08-45-001A (Section 08 - Body and
Accessories).
Electrical Ground Repair Overview
Proper electrical system function relies on secure, stable and corrosion-free electrical ground
connections. Loose, stripped, or corroded connections increase the possibility of improper system
function and loss of module communication. These conditions may also lead to unnecessary
repairs and component replacement.
In general, electrical ground connections are accomplished using one, or a combination of the
following attachment methods:
- Welded M6 stud and nut
- Welded M6 nut and bolt
- Welded M8 nut and bolt
Determine which attachment method is used and perform the appropriate or alternative repair as
described in this bulletin.
M6 Weld Stud Replacement
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. Select a location adjacent the damaged or missing M6 ground stud having 20 mm (0.79 in)
clearance behind the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in)
clearance surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange.
2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site
and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
3. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel.
4. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is
visible.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10
> Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6586
Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of
0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any
air gaps to ensure a good ground.
5. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit.
6. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool
(2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet
stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3).
7. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive
rivet stud. 8. Ensure the rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement. 9.
Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent.
Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the
installation of the ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable and
corrosion-free electrical ground.
10. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 11. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective
material applied to the rivet stud threads. 12. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet
stud threads. 13. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet
stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 14. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet
stud.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10
> Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6587
15. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 16. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the rivet stud. 17. Select a M6
conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 18. Install the M6 conductive
nut to the rivet stud and:
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
19. Verify proper system operation.
M6 Weld Nut
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M6 weld nut at the electrical ground location is damaged or stripped, a M7 conductive
self-threading bolt may be used to secure the ground
wire terminal.
2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the weld nut and allow to dry. 3. Remove any loose metal particles from the damaged
or stripped weld nut with a stiff brush. 4. Select a M7 conductive self-threading bolt. Refer to the
Parts Information section of this bulletin 5. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N
12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M7 conductive self-threading
bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
6. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 7. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M7 conductive self-threading bolt.
8. Install the M7 conductive self-threading bolt and:
Tighten Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb in).
9. Verify proper system operation.
M6 Weld Nut Alternative Repair
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6 conductive bolt
and a M6 conductive nut may be used to secure
the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M6 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind
the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance
surrounding the new electrical ground site.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the ground location and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 8.5 mm (0.33 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the
area surrounding the 8.5 mm (0.33 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M6 conductive
bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M6 conductive bolt to the ground
location.
10. Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the
M6 conductive nut to the bolt and:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10
> Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6588
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free
electrical ground.
12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation.
M8 Weld Nut
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M8
conductive bolt and a M8 conductive nut may be
used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this
bulletin.
2. Select a location adjacent the M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind the panel
surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance surrounding
the new electrical ground site.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the ground location and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the
area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M8 conductive
bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M8 conductive bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M8 conductive bolt to the ground
location.
10. Select a M8 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the
M8 conductive nut to the bolt and:
Tighten Tighten to 22 Nm (16 lb ft).
Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free
electrical ground.
12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation.
M8 Weld Nut Alternative Repair
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is not accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6
conductive rivet stud and a M6 conductive nut
may be used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal.
2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind
the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance
surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site
and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10
> Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6589
5. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) until bare metal is
visible.
Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of
0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any
air gaps to ensure a good ground.
6. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit.
7. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool
(2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet
stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3).
8. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive
rivet stud. 9. Ensure the new rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement.
10. Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10
> Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6590
Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the
installation of the electrical ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable
and corrosion-free electrical ground.
11. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 12. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective
material applied to the rivet stud threads. 13. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet
stud threads. 14. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet
stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 15. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet
stud.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
16. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 17. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M6 conductive rivet stud. 18.
Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 19. Install the M6
conductive nut to the rivet stud and:
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in)
20. Verify proper system operation.
Parts Information
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10
> Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6591
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 06-08-45-004 > May > 06 >
Electrical - Instrument Panel & General Wiring Repair
Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Instrument Panel & General Wiring
Repair
Bulletin No.: 06-08-45-004
Date: May 02, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Instrument Panel (I/P), Body and General Wiring Harness Repair
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Trucks 2003-2007 HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3
Important:
A part restriction has been implemented on all Body and I/P harnesses and is being administered
by the PQC. If a body or I/P harness replacement is required, it can take 12-28 weeks for a
harness to be built and delivered to a dealer. The dealer technician is expected to repair any
harness damage as the first and best choice before replacing a harness.
In an effort to standardize repair practices, General Motors is requiring that all wiring harnesses be
repaired instead of replaced. If there is a question concerning which connector and/or terminal you
are working on, refer to the information in the appropriate Connector End Views in SI. The
Instruction Manual J 38125-620, which is sent with each new update of the J 38125 Terminal
Repair Kit, also has terminal crimping and terminal remove information.
Important:
There are some parts in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit (i.e. SIR connector CPAs and heat shrink
tube (used in high heat area pigtail replacement) and some TPAs that are not available from
GMSPO. It is vitally important that each update to the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit be done as soon
as it arrives at the dealer.
Utilize the Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125) to achieve an effective wiring repair. The Terminal Repair
Kit has been an essential tool for all GM Dealers since 1987. Replacement terminals and tools for
this kit are available through SPX/Kent Moore. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 06-08-45-001
for more information.
The Instruction Manual J 38125-620, which is sent with each new update to the J 38125 Terminal
Repair Kit, also has terminal crimping and terminal removal information.
U.S. Dealers Only - Training courses (including Tech Assists, Emerging Issues, Web, IDL and
Hands-on) are available through the GM Training website. Refer to Resources and then Training
Materials for a complete list of available courses.
Canadian Dealers Only - Refer to the Training section of GM infoNet for a complete list of available
courses and a copy of the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit Instruction Manual.
Wiring repair information is also available in Service Information (SI). The Wiring Repair section
contains information for the following types of wiring repairs:
- Testing for intermittent conditions and poor conditions
- Flat wire repairs
- GMLAN wiring repairs
- High temperature wiring repairs
- Splicing copper wire using splice clips
- Splicing copper wire using splice sleeves
- Splicing twisted or shielded cable
- Splicing inline harness diodes
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 06-08-45-004 > May > 06 >
Electrical - Instrument Panel & General Wiring Repair > Page 6596
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 >
Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair
Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 10-08-45-001B
Date: October 25, 2010
Subject: Information for Electrical Ground Repair - Use New Replacement Fasteners with
Conductive Finish
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year and update the Warranty
Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-08-45-001A (Section 08 - Body and
Accessories).
Electrical Ground Repair Overview
Proper electrical system function relies on secure, stable and corrosion-free electrical ground
connections. Loose, stripped, or corroded connections increase the possibility of improper system
function and loss of module communication. These conditions may also lead to unnecessary
repairs and component replacement.
In general, electrical ground connections are accomplished using one, or a combination of the
following attachment methods:
- Welded M6 stud and nut
- Welded M6 nut and bolt
- Welded M8 nut and bolt
Determine which attachment method is used and perform the appropriate or alternative repair as
described in this bulletin.
M6 Weld Stud Replacement
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. Select a location adjacent the damaged or missing M6 ground stud having 20 mm (0.79 in)
clearance behind the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in)
clearance surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange.
2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site
and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
3. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel.
4. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is
visible.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 >
Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6602
Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of
0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any
air gaps to ensure a good ground.
5. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit.
6. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool
(2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet
stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3).
7. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive
rivet stud. 8. Ensure the rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement. 9.
Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent.
Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the
installation of the ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable and
corrosion-free electrical ground.
10. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 11. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective
material applied to the rivet stud threads. 12. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet
stud threads. 13. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet
stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 14. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet
stud.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 >
Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6603
15. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 16. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the rivet stud. 17. Select a M6
conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 18. Install the M6 conductive
nut to the rivet stud and:
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
19. Verify proper system operation.
M6 Weld Nut
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M6 weld nut at the electrical ground location is damaged or stripped, a M7 conductive
self-threading bolt may be used to secure the ground
wire terminal.
2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the weld nut and allow to dry. 3. Remove any loose metal particles from the damaged
or stripped weld nut with a stiff brush. 4. Select a M7 conductive self-threading bolt. Refer to the
Parts Information section of this bulletin 5. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N
12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M7 conductive self-threading
bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
6. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 7. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M7 conductive self-threading bolt.
8. Install the M7 conductive self-threading bolt and:
Tighten Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb in).
9. Verify proper system operation.
M6 Weld Nut Alternative Repair
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6 conductive bolt
and a M6 conductive nut may be used to secure
the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M6 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind
the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance
surrounding the new electrical ground site.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the ground location and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 8.5 mm (0.33 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the
area surrounding the 8.5 mm (0.33 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M6 conductive
bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M6 conductive bolt to the ground
location.
10. Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the
M6 conductive nut to the bolt and:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 >
Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6604
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free
electrical ground.
12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation.
M8 Weld Nut
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M8
conductive bolt and a M8 conductive nut may be
used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this
bulletin.
2. Select a location adjacent the M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind the panel
surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance surrounding
the new electrical ground site.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the ground location and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the
area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M8 conductive
bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M8 conductive bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M8 conductive bolt to the ground
location.
10. Select a M8 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the
M8 conductive nut to the bolt and:
Tighten Tighten to 22 Nm (16 lb ft).
Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free
electrical ground.
12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation.
M8 Weld Nut Alternative Repair
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is not accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6
conductive rivet stud and a M6 conductive nut
may be used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal.
2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind
the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance
surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site
and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 >
Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6605
5. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) until bare metal is
visible.
Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of
0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any
air gaps to ensure a good ground.
6. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit.
7. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool
(2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet
stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3).
8. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive
rivet stud. 9. Ensure the new rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement.
10. Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 >
Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6606
Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the
installation of the electrical ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable
and corrosion-free electrical ground.
11. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 12. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective
material applied to the rivet stud threads. 13. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet
stud threads. 14. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet
stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 15. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet
stud.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
16. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 17. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M6 conductive rivet stud. 18.
Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 19. Install the M6
conductive nut to the rivet stud and:
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in)
20. Verify proper system operation.
Parts Information
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 >
Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6607
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 06-08-45-004 > May > 06 >
Electrical - Instrument Panel & General Wiring Repair
Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Instrument Panel & General Wiring
Repair
Bulletin No.: 06-08-45-004
Date: May 02, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Instrument Panel (I/P), Body and General Wiring Harness Repair
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Trucks 2003-2007 HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3
Important:
A part restriction has been implemented on all Body and I/P harnesses and is being administered
by the PQC. If a body or I/P harness replacement is required, it can take 12-28 weeks for a
harness to be built and delivered to a dealer. The dealer technician is expected to repair any
harness damage as the first and best choice before replacing a harness.
In an effort to standardize repair practices, General Motors is requiring that all wiring harnesses be
repaired instead of replaced. If there is a question concerning which connector and/or terminal you
are working on, refer to the information in the appropriate Connector End Views in SI. The
Instruction Manual J 38125-620, which is sent with each new update of the J 38125 Terminal
Repair Kit, also has terminal crimping and terminal remove information.
Important:
There are some parts in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit (i.e. SIR connector CPAs and heat shrink
tube (used in high heat area pigtail replacement) and some TPAs that are not available from
GMSPO. It is vitally important that each update to the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit be done as soon
as it arrives at the dealer.
Utilize the Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125) to achieve an effective wiring repair. The Terminal Repair
Kit has been an essential tool for all GM Dealers since 1987. Replacement terminals and tools for
this kit are available through SPX/Kent Moore. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 06-08-45-001
for more information.
The Instruction Manual J 38125-620, which is sent with each new update to the J 38125 Terminal
Repair Kit, also has terminal crimping and terminal removal information.
U.S. Dealers Only - Training courses (including Tech Assists, Emerging Issues, Web, IDL and
Hands-on) are available through the GM Training website. Refer to Resources and then Training
Materials for a complete list of available courses.
Canadian Dealers Only - Refer to the Training section of GM infoNet for a complete list of available
courses and a copy of the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit Instruction Manual.
Wiring repair information is also available in Service Information (SI). The Wiring Repair section
contains information for the following types of wiring repairs:
- Testing for intermittent conditions and poor conditions
- Flat wire repairs
- GMLAN wiring repairs
- High temperature wiring repairs
- Splicing copper wire using splice clips
- Splicing copper wire using splice sleeves
- Splicing twisted or shielded cable
- Splicing inline harness diodes
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 06-08-45-004 > May > 06 >
Electrical - Instrument Panel & General Wiring Repair > Page 6612
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information >
Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information >
Locations > Page 6617
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Diagrams
Auxiliary Power Outlet - Front No. 1
Auxiliary Power Outlet - Rear
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information >
Locations > Page 6618
Auxiliary Power Outlet - Front No. 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Electrical - Aftermarket Fuse Warning
Fuse: Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Aftermarket Fuse Warning
Bulletin No.: 07-08-45-002
Date: September 05, 2007
ADVANCED SERVICE INFORMATION
Subject: Service Alert: Concerns With Aftermarket Fuses in GM Vehicles
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2008 and
Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2008 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Concerns with Harbor Freight Tools "Storehouse" Branded Blade Type Fuses
General Motors has become aware of a fuse recall by Harbor Freight Tools/Storehouse for a
variety of aftermarket fuses. In two cases, these fuses have not provided protection for the wiring
system of the vehicles they were customer installed in.
Upon testing the 15 amp version, it was found that the fuse still would not "open" when shorted
directly across the battery terminals.
How to Identify These Fuses
Packed in a 120 piece set, the fuse has a translucent, hard plastic, blue body with the amperage
stamped into the top. There are no white painted numbers on the fuse to indicate amperage. There
are no identifying marks on the fuse to tell who is making it. The fuses are known to be distributed
by Harbor Freight Tools but there may be other marketers, and packaging of this style of fuse. It
would be prudent to replace these fuses if found in a customers vehicle. Likewise, if wiring
overheating is found you should check the fuse panel for the presence of this style of fuse.
All GM dealers should use genuine GM fuses on the vehicles they service. You should also
encourage the use of GM fuses to your customers to assure they are getting the required electrical
system protection. GM has no knowledge of any concerns with other aftermarket fuses. If
additional information becomes available, this bulletin will be updated.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Fuse Block
- I/P
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Fuse Block
- I/P > Page 6625
Fuse Block - Underhood
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID >
Fuse Block I/P (Front View)
Fuse: Application and ID Fuse Block I/P (Front View)
Fuse Block I/P (Front View) Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID >
Fuse Block I/P (Front View) > Page 6628
Fuse Block I/P (Front View) Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID >
Fuse Block I/P (Front View) > Page 6629
Fuse: Application and ID Fuse Block I/P (Rear View)
Fuse Block - I/P (Rear View) Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID >
Fuse Block I/P (Front View) > Page 6630
Fuse Block - I/P (Rear View) Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID >
Fuse Block I/P (Front View) > Page 6631
Fuse: Application and ID Fuse Block - Underhood (Front View)
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID >
Fuse Block I/P (Front View) > Page 6632
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) Part 2 Of 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID >
Fuse Block I/P (Front View) > Page 6633
Fuse: Application and ID Fuse Block - Underhood (Rear View)
Fuse Block - Underhood (Rear View) Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID >
Fuse Block I/P (Front View) > Page 6634
Fuse Block - Underhood (Rear View) Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations >
Instrument Panel (I/P) Fuse Block
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations >
Instrument Panel (I/P) Fuse Block > Page 6639
Fuse Block - Underhood
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Page
6640
Fuse Block: Diagrams
Convenience Center C1
Convenience Center C3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Page
6641
Convenience Center C4
Convenience Center C5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Page
6642
Convenience Center C6
Convenience Center C8
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Page
6643
Convenience Center C9
Convenience Center C10
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID
> Fuse Block - Underhood (Front View)
Fuse Block: Application and ID Fuse Block - Underhood (Front View)
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID
> Fuse Block - Underhood (Front View) > Page 6646
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) Part 2 Of 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID
> Fuse Block - Underhood (Front View) > Page 6647
Fuse Block: Application and ID Fuse Block - Underhood (Rear View)
Fuse Block - Underhood (Rear View) Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID
> Fuse Block - Underhood (Front View) > Page 6648
Fuse Block - Underhood (Rear View) Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID
> Fuse Block - Underhood (Front View) > Page 6649
Fuse Block: Application and ID Fuse Block I/P (Front View)
Fuse Block I/P (Front View) Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID
> Fuse Block - Underhood (Front View) > Page 6650
Fuse Block I/P (Front View) Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID
> Fuse Block - Underhood (Front View) > Page 6651
Fuse Block: Application and ID Fuse Block I/P (Rear View)
Fuse Block - I/P (Rear View) Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID
> Fuse Block - Underhood (Front View) > Page 6652
Fuse Block - I/P (Rear View) Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Relay Replacement (Within an Electrical Center)
Fuse Block: Service and Repair Relay Replacement (Within an Electrical Center)
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 43244 Relay Puller Pliers
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the electrical center cover. 2. Locate the relay.
IMPORTANT: ^
Always note the orientation of the relay.
^ Make sure the electrical center is secure, as not to put added stress on the wires or terminals.
3. Using the J 43244 (1) position the tool on opposing corners of the relay (2).
NOTE: Use J 43244 to pull the relay straight out from the electrical center terminals. The use of
pliers or a flat bladed tool could damage the electrical center.
4. Remove the relay (2) from the electrical center.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Relay Replacement (Within an Electrical Center) > Page 6655
1. Install the relay (2) in the same position as removed. 2. Install the electrical center cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Relay Replacement (Within an Electrical Center) > Page 6656
Fuse Block: Service and Repair Relay Replacement (Attached to Wire Harness)
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Locate the relay. Refer to the Master Electrical Component List to locate the relay in the vehicle.
2. Remove any fasteners which hold the relay in place. 3. Remove any Connector Position
Assurance (CPA) devices or secondary locks.
IMPORTANT: Use care when removing a relay in a wiring harness when the relay is secured by
fasteners or tape.
4. Separate the relay (1) from the wire harness connector (2).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Connect the relay (1) to the wire harness connector (2). 2. Install any Connector Position
Assurance (CPA) devices or secondary locks. 3. Install the relay using any fasteners or tape that
originally held the relay in place.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Ground Strap > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Ground Strap: Service and Repair
GROUND STRAP REPLACEMENT
Additional ground straps are used to connect the body frame to the engine and the transmission.
Always connect all ground straps to ensure a good ground path to the battery for all electrical
components.
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the bolt. 2. Clean the bolt and the mounting surface.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the ground lead.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the bolt.
Tighten Tighten the bolt to 40 N.m (29 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Grounding Point > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair
Grounding Point: Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 10-08-45-001B
Date: October 25, 2010
Subject: Information for Electrical Ground Repair - Use New Replacement Fasteners with
Conductive Finish
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year and update the Warranty
Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-08-45-001A (Section 08 - Body and
Accessories).
Electrical Ground Repair Overview
Proper electrical system function relies on secure, stable and corrosion-free electrical ground
connections. Loose, stripped, or corroded connections increase the possibility of improper system
function and loss of module communication. These conditions may also lead to unnecessary
repairs and component replacement.
In general, electrical ground connections are accomplished using one, or a combination of the
following attachment methods:
- Welded M6 stud and nut
- Welded M6 nut and bolt
- Welded M8 nut and bolt
Determine which attachment method is used and perform the appropriate or alternative repair as
described in this bulletin.
M6 Weld Stud Replacement
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. Select a location adjacent the damaged or missing M6 ground stud having 20 mm (0.79 in)
clearance behind the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in)
clearance surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange.
2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site
and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
3. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel.
4. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is
visible.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Grounding Point > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6664
Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of
0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any
air gaps to ensure a good ground.
5. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit.
6. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool
(2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet
stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3).
7. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive
rivet stud. 8. Ensure the rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement. 9.
Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent.
Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the
installation of the ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable and
corrosion-free electrical ground.
10. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 11. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective
material applied to the rivet stud threads. 12. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet
stud threads. 13. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet
stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 14. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet
stud.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Grounding Point > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6665
15. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 16. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the rivet stud. 17. Select a M6
conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 18. Install the M6 conductive
nut to the rivet stud and:
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
19. Verify proper system operation.
M6 Weld Nut
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M6 weld nut at the electrical ground location is damaged or stripped, a M7 conductive
self-threading bolt may be used to secure the ground
wire terminal.
2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the weld nut and allow to dry. 3. Remove any loose metal particles from the damaged
or stripped weld nut with a stiff brush. 4. Select a M7 conductive self-threading bolt. Refer to the
Parts Information section of this bulletin 5. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N
12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M7 conductive self-threading
bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
6. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 7. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M7 conductive self-threading bolt.
8. Install the M7 conductive self-threading bolt and:
Tighten Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb in).
9. Verify proper system operation.
M6 Weld Nut Alternative Repair
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6 conductive bolt
and a M6 conductive nut may be used to secure
the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M6 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind
the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance
surrounding the new electrical ground site.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the ground location and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 8.5 mm (0.33 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the
area surrounding the 8.5 mm (0.33 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M6 conductive
bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M6 conductive bolt to the ground
location.
10. Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the
M6 conductive nut to the bolt and:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Grounding Point > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6666
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free
electrical ground.
12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation.
M8 Weld Nut
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M8
conductive bolt and a M8 conductive nut may be
used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this
bulletin.
2. Select a location adjacent the M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind the panel
surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance surrounding
the new electrical ground site.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the ground location and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the
area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M8 conductive
bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M8 conductive bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M8 conductive bolt to the ground
location.
10. Select a M8 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the
M8 conductive nut to the bolt and:
Tighten Tighten to 22 Nm (16 lb ft).
Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free
electrical ground.
12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation.
M8 Weld Nut Alternative Repair
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is not accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6
conductive rivet stud and a M6 conductive nut
may be used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal.
2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind
the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance
surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site
and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Grounding Point > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6667
5. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) until bare metal is
visible.
Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of
0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any
air gaps to ensure a good ground.
6. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit.
7. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool
(2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet
stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3).
8. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive
rivet stud. 9. Ensure the new rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement.
10. Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Grounding Point > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6668
Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the
installation of the electrical ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable
and corrosion-free electrical ground.
11. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 12. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective
material applied to the rivet stud threads. 13. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet
stud threads. 14. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet
stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 15. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet
stud.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
16. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 17. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M6 conductive rivet stud. 18.
Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 19. Install the M6
conductive nut to the rivet stud and:
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in)
20. Verify proper system operation.
Parts Information
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Grounding Point > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6669
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C100 - C110
Multiple Junction Connector: Diagrams C100 - C110
C104 (Engine To Forward Lamp)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6674
C100 (Engine To I/P) Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6675
C100 (Engine To I/P) Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6676
C102 (I/P To Forward Lamp)
C108 (I/P to Rear Lamp Jumper VE1 Japan)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6677
C108 (I/P To Rear Lamp Jumper VE1 Japan)
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article or any of the images therein, refer to the
RPO Code List found at Vehicle/Application See: Application and ID
C109 (I/P to Forward Lamp)
C109 (I/P To Forward Lamp)
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article or any of the images therein, refer to the
RPO Code List found at Vehicle/Application See: Application and ID
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6678
C110 (Engine To Brake Pressure Differential Switch)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6679
Multiple Junction Connector: Diagrams C200 - C223
C200 (I/P to Main Body)
C200 (I/P To Main Body)
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article or any of the images therein, refer to the
RPO Code List found at Vehicle/Application See: Application and ID
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6680
C201 (Steering Column to I/P)
C201 (Steering Column To I/P) Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6681
C201 (Steering Column To I/P) Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6682
C201 (Steering Column To I/P) Part 3
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article or any of the images therein, refer to the
RPO Code List found at Vehicle/Application See: Application and ID
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6683
C202 (I/P To Cig/Aux Power Jumper)
C203 (I/P to Liftgate)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6684
C203 (I/P To Liftgate)
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article or any of the images therein, refer to the
RPO Code List found at Vehicle/Application See: Application and ID
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6685
C205 (I/P To Right/Passenger Door)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6686
C212 (Heater Jumper To Heater Body)
C212 (Heater Jumper To Heater Body)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6687
C223 (Upfitter Harness)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6688
Multiple Junction Connector: Diagrams C300 - C333
C300 (I/P To Main Body)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6689
C301 (I/P To Left/Driver Door)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6690
C302 (Body To Overhead Console)
C303 (Body To Overhead Console)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6691
C306 (Power Seat Supply Voltage To LH Power Seat)
C308 (Transfer Case Harness To Transfer Case Extension Jumper)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6692
C309 (Transfer Case Harness To Transfer Case Extension Jumper)
C310 (Engine To Fuel Pump Jumper)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6693
C314 (Engine To Wheel Speed Sensor Jumper)
C333 (Upfitter Harness)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6694
Multiple Junction Connector: Diagrams C401 - C404
C401 (Main Body To Rear Door Jamb Switch)
C403 (Rear Lamp Jumper to Rear Lamp Assembly Export W/WX7)
C403 (Rear Lamp Jumper To Rear Lamp Assembly Export W/WX7)
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article or any of the images therein, refer to the
RPO Code List found at Vehicle/Application See: Application and ID
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C100 - C110 > Page 6695
C404 (Main Body To Rear - Dome Lamp)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Relay Block #1
Relay Box: Locations Relay Block #1
Relay Block # 1 Under left side of dash on data link connector bracket facing rear of vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Relay Block #1 > Page 6701
Relay Box: Locations Relay Block #2
Relay Block # 2 Under left side of dash on data link connector bracket facing front of vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Relay Block #1 > Page 6702
Fuse Block - Underhood
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Relay Block #1
Relay Block No. 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Relay Block #1 > Page 6705
Relay Block No. 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Relay Block #1 > Page 6706
Relay Box: Application and ID Underhood Fuse-Relay Center (Front View)
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Relay Block #1 > Page 6707
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) Part 2 Of 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Relay Block #1 > Page 6708
Relay Box: Application and ID Underhood Fuse-Relay Center (Rear View)
Fuse Block - Underhood (Rear View) Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Relay Block #1 > Page 6709
Fuse Block - Underhood (Rear View) Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Relay
Block #1
Relay Box: Locations Relay Block #1
Relay Block # 1 Under left side of dash on data link connector bracket facing rear of vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Relay
Block #1 > Page 6714
Relay Box: Locations Relay Block #2
Relay Block # 2 Under left side of dash on data link connector bracket facing front of vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Relay
Block #1 > Page 6715
Fuse Block - Underhood
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID
> Relay Block #1
Relay Block No. 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID
> Relay Block #1 > Page 6718
Relay Block No. 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID
> Relay Block #1 > Page 6719
Relay Box: Application and ID Underhood Fuse-Relay Center (Front View)
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID
> Relay Block #1 > Page 6720
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) Part 2 Of 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID
> Relay Block #1 > Page 6721
Relay Box: Application and ID Underhood Fuse-Relay Center (Rear View)
Fuse Block - Underhood (Rear View) Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID
> Relay Block #1 > Page 6722
Fuse Block - Underhood (Rear View) Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control
Modules
Wiring Harness: Customer Interest Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-06-03-004D
Date: December 08, 2010
Subject: Intermittent No Crank/No Start, No Module Communication, MIL, Warning Lights, Vehicle
Messages or DTCs Set by Various Control Modules - Diagnosing and Repairing Fretting Corrosion
(Disconnect Affected Connector and Apply Dielectric Lubricant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Attention:
This repair can be applied to ANY electrical connection including, but not limited to: lighting, body
electrical, in-line connections, powertrain control sensors, etc. DO NOT over apply lubricant to the
point where it prevents the full engagement of sealed connectors. A light coating on the terminal
surfaces is sufficient to correct the condition.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Attention statement and add the 2011
model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-03-004C (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions:
- An intermittent no crank/no start
- Intermittent malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illumination
- Intermittent service lamp illumination
- Intermittent service message(s) being displayed
The technician may determine that he is unable to duplicate the intermittent condition.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a buildup of nonconductive insulating oxidized debris known as
fretting corrosion, occurring between two electrical contact surfaces of the connection or connector.
This may be caused by any of the following conditions:
- Vibration
- Thermal cycling
- Poor connection/terminal retention
- Micro motion
- A connector, component or wiring harness not properly secured resulting in movement
On low current signal circuits this condition may cause high resistance, resulting in intermittent
connections.
On high current power circuits this condition may cause permanent increases in the resistance and
may cause a device to become inoperative.
Representative List of Control Modules and Components
The following is only a representative list of control modules and components that may be affected
by this connection or connector condition and DOES NOT include every possible module or
component for every vehicle.
- Blower Control Module
- Body Control Module (BCM)
- Communication Interface Module (CIM)
- Cooling Fan Control Module
- Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)
- Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module (EBTCM)
- Electronic Suspension Control (ESC) Module
- Engine Control Module (ECM)
- Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) Control Module
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control
Modules > Page 6731
- HVAC Actuator
- Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM)
- Any AIR BAG module
- Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner
- Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner
- An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set:
B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023
- Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
- Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Correction
Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions:
- The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated.
- The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can
no longer be duplicated.
Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above.
1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any
existing history or current DTCs from all of the
control modules (refer to SI).
‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the
connector(s) of the control module/component
which may be causing the condition (refer to SI).
‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control
module/component which may be causing the
condition (refer to SI).
2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component
Connector End Views and Component Locator
documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the
condition.
Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the
actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or
identified without the use of a magnifying glass.
Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown,
as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush
that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin.
3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side
and the harness side of the affected connector(s).
4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present.
5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information:
- DTC Diagnostic Procedure
- Circuit/System Description
- Conditions for Running the DTC
- Conditions for Setting the DTC
- Diagnostic Aids
- Circuit/System Verification
‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated,
then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI).
Repair Order Documentation
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control
Modules > Page 6732
Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so
may result in a chargeback.
- Customer vehicle condition.
- Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or
Service Message.
- Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set.
- After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated?
‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector
name and number on the repair order.
- If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and
additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID
Number MUST be written on the repair order.
Parts Information
Alternate Distributor For All of North America
Note
NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada),
specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control
Modules > Page 6733
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table
above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL
ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules
Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control
Modules
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-06-03-004D
Date: December 08, 2010
Subject: Intermittent No Crank/No Start, No Module Communication, MIL, Warning Lights, Vehicle
Messages or DTCs Set by Various Control Modules - Diagnosing and Repairing Fretting Corrosion
(Disconnect Affected Connector and Apply Dielectric Lubricant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Attention:
This repair can be applied to ANY electrical connection including, but not limited to: lighting, body
electrical, in-line connections, powertrain control sensors, etc. DO NOT over apply lubricant to the
point where it prevents the full engagement of sealed connectors. A light coating on the terminal
surfaces is sufficient to correct the condition.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Attention statement and add the 2011
model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-03-004C (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions:
- An intermittent no crank/no start
- Intermittent malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illumination
- Intermittent service lamp illumination
- Intermittent service message(s) being displayed
The technician may determine that he is unable to duplicate the intermittent condition.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a buildup of nonconductive insulating oxidized debris known as
fretting corrosion, occurring between two electrical contact surfaces of the connection or connector.
This may be caused by any of the following conditions:
- Vibration
- Thermal cycling
- Poor connection/terminal retention
- Micro motion
- A connector, component or wiring harness not properly secured resulting in movement
On low current signal circuits this condition may cause high resistance, resulting in intermittent
connections.
On high current power circuits this condition may cause permanent increases in the resistance and
may cause a device to become inoperative.
Representative List of Control Modules and Components
The following is only a representative list of control modules and components that may be affected
by this connection or connector condition and DOES NOT include every possible module or
component for every vehicle.
- Blower Control Module
- Body Control Module (BCM)
- Communication Interface Module (CIM)
- Cooling Fan Control Module
- Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)
- Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module (EBTCM)
- Electronic Suspension Control (ESC) Module
- Engine Control Module (ECM)
- Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) Control Module
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL
ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 6739
- HVAC Actuator
- Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM)
- Any AIR BAG module
- Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner
- Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner
- An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set:
B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023
- Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
- Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Correction
Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions:
- The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated.
- The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can
no longer be duplicated.
Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above.
1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any
existing history or current DTCs from all of the
control modules (refer to SI).
‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the
connector(s) of the control module/component
which may be causing the condition (refer to SI).
‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control
module/component which may be causing the
condition (refer to SI).
2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component
Connector End Views and Component Locator
documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the
condition.
Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the
actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or
identified without the use of a magnifying glass.
Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown,
as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush
that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin.
3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side
and the harness side of the affected connector(s).
4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present.
5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information:
- DTC Diagnostic Procedure
- Circuit/System Description
- Conditions for Running the DTC
- Conditions for Setting the DTC
- Diagnostic Aids
- Circuit/System Verification
‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated,
then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI).
Repair Order Documentation
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL
ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 6740
Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so
may result in a chargeback.
- Customer vehicle condition.
- Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or
Service Message.
- Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set.
- After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated?
‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector
name and number on the repair order.
- If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and
additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID
Number MUST be written on the repair order.
Parts Information
Alternate Distributor For All of North America
Note
NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada),
specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL
ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 6741
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table
above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical - Information
For Electrical Ground Repair
Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 10-08-45-001B
Date: October 25, 2010
Subject: Information for Electrical Ground Repair - Use New Replacement Fasteners with
Conductive Finish
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year and update the Warranty
Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-08-45-001A (Section 08 - Body and
Accessories).
Electrical Ground Repair Overview
Proper electrical system function relies on secure, stable and corrosion-free electrical ground
connections. Loose, stripped, or corroded connections increase the possibility of improper system
function and loss of module communication. These conditions may also lead to unnecessary
repairs and component replacement.
In general, electrical ground connections are accomplished using one, or a combination of the
following attachment methods:
- Welded M6 stud and nut
- Welded M6 nut and bolt
- Welded M8 nut and bolt
Determine which attachment method is used and perform the appropriate or alternative repair as
described in this bulletin.
M6 Weld Stud Replacement
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. Select a location adjacent the damaged or missing M6 ground stud having 20 mm (0.79 in)
clearance behind the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in)
clearance surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange.
2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site
and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
3. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel.
4. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is
visible.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical - Information
For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6746
Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of
0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any
air gaps to ensure a good ground.
5. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit.
6. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool
(2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet
stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3).
7. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive
rivet stud. 8. Ensure the rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement. 9.
Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent.
Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the
installation of the ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable and
corrosion-free electrical ground.
10. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 11. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective
material applied to the rivet stud threads. 12. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet
stud threads. 13. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet
stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 14. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet
stud.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical - Information
For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6747
15. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 16. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the rivet stud. 17. Select a M6
conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 18. Install the M6 conductive
nut to the rivet stud and:
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
19. Verify proper system operation.
M6 Weld Nut
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M6 weld nut at the electrical ground location is damaged or stripped, a M7 conductive
self-threading bolt may be used to secure the ground
wire terminal.
2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the weld nut and allow to dry. 3. Remove any loose metal particles from the damaged
or stripped weld nut with a stiff brush. 4. Select a M7 conductive self-threading bolt. Refer to the
Parts Information section of this bulletin 5. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N
12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M7 conductive self-threading
bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
6. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 7. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M7 conductive self-threading bolt.
8. Install the M7 conductive self-threading bolt and:
Tighten Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb in).
9. Verify proper system operation.
M6 Weld Nut Alternative Repair
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6 conductive bolt
and a M6 conductive nut may be used to secure
the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M6 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind
the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance
surrounding the new electrical ground site.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the ground location and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 8.5 mm (0.33 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the
area surrounding the 8.5 mm (0.33 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M6 conductive
bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M6 conductive bolt to the ground
location.
10. Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the
M6 conductive nut to the bolt and:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical - Information
For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6748
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free
electrical ground.
12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation.
M8 Weld Nut
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M8
conductive bolt and a M8 conductive nut may be
used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this
bulletin.
2. Select a location adjacent the M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind the panel
surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance surrounding
the new electrical ground site.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the ground location and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the
area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M8 conductive
bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M8 conductive bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M8 conductive bolt to the ground
location.
10. Select a M8 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the
M8 conductive nut to the bolt and:
Tighten Tighten to 22 Nm (16 lb ft).
Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free
electrical ground.
12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation.
M8 Weld Nut Alternative Repair
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is not accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6
conductive rivet stud and a M6 conductive nut
may be used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal.
2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind
the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance
surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site
and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical - Information
For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6749
5. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) until bare metal is
visible.
Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of
0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any
air gaps to ensure a good ground.
6. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit.
7. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool
(2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet
stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3).
8. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive
rivet stud. 9. Ensure the new rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement.
10. Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical - Information
For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6750
Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the
installation of the electrical ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable
and corrosion-free electrical ground.
11. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 12. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective
material applied to the rivet stud threads. 13. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet
stud threads. 14. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet
stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 15. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet
stud.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
16. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 17. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M6 conductive rivet stud. 18.
Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 19. Install the M6
conductive nut to the rivet stud and:
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in)
20. Verify proper system operation.
Parts Information
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical - Information
For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6751
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 06-08-45-004 > May > 06 > Electrical - Instrument
Panel & General Wiring Repair
Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Instrument Panel & General Wiring
Repair
Bulletin No.: 06-08-45-004
Date: May 02, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Instrument Panel (I/P), Body and General Wiring Harness Repair
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Trucks 2003-2007 HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3
Important:
A part restriction has been implemented on all Body and I/P harnesses and is being administered
by the PQC. If a body or I/P harness replacement is required, it can take 12-28 weeks for a
harness to be built and delivered to a dealer. The dealer technician is expected to repair any
harness damage as the first and best choice before replacing a harness.
In an effort to standardize repair practices, General Motors is requiring that all wiring harnesses be
repaired instead of replaced. If there is a question concerning which connector and/or terminal you
are working on, refer to the information in the appropriate Connector End Views in SI. The
Instruction Manual J 38125-620, which is sent with each new update of the J 38125 Terminal
Repair Kit, also has terminal crimping and terminal remove information.
Important:
There are some parts in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit (i.e. SIR connector CPAs and heat shrink
tube (used in high heat area pigtail replacement) and some TPAs that are not available from
GMSPO. It is vitally important that each update to the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit be done as soon
as it arrives at the dealer.
Utilize the Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125) to achieve an effective wiring repair. The Terminal Repair
Kit has been an essential tool for all GM Dealers since 1987. Replacement terminals and tools for
this kit are available through SPX/Kent Moore. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 06-08-45-001
for more information.
The Instruction Manual J 38125-620, which is sent with each new update to the J 38125 Terminal
Repair Kit, also has terminal crimping and terminal removal information.
U.S. Dealers Only - Training courses (including Tech Assists, Emerging Issues, Web, IDL and
Hands-on) are available through the GM Training website. Refer to Resources and then Training
Materials for a complete list of available courses.
Canadian Dealers Only - Refer to the Training section of GM infoNet for a complete list of available
courses and a copy of the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit Instruction Manual.
Wiring repair information is also available in Service Information (SI). The Wiring Repair section
contains information for the following types of wiring repairs:
- Testing for intermittent conditions and poor conditions
- Flat wire repairs
- GMLAN wiring repairs
- High temperature wiring repairs
- Splicing copper wire using splice clips
- Splicing copper wire using splice sleeves
- Splicing twisted or shielded cable
- Splicing inline harness diodes
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 06-08-45-004 > May > 06 > Electrical - Instrument
Panel & General Wiring Repair > Page 6756
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical - Information For
Electrical Ground Repair
Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 10-08-45-001B
Date: October 25, 2010
Subject: Information for Electrical Ground Repair - Use New Replacement Fasteners with
Conductive Finish
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year and update the Warranty
Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-08-45-001A (Section 08 - Body and
Accessories).
Electrical Ground Repair Overview
Proper electrical system function relies on secure, stable and corrosion-free electrical ground
connections. Loose, stripped, or corroded connections increase the possibility of improper system
function and loss of module communication. These conditions may also lead to unnecessary
repairs and component replacement.
In general, electrical ground connections are accomplished using one, or a combination of the
following attachment methods:
- Welded M6 stud and nut
- Welded M6 nut and bolt
- Welded M8 nut and bolt
Determine which attachment method is used and perform the appropriate or alternative repair as
described in this bulletin.
M6 Weld Stud Replacement
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. Select a location adjacent the damaged or missing M6 ground stud having 20 mm (0.79 in)
clearance behind the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in)
clearance surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange.
2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site
and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
3. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel.
4. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is
visible.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical - Information For
Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6762
Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of
0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any
air gaps to ensure a good ground.
5. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit.
6. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool
(2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet
stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3).
7. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive
rivet stud. 8. Ensure the rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement. 9.
Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent.
Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the
installation of the ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable and
corrosion-free electrical ground.
10. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 11. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective
material applied to the rivet stud threads. 12. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet
stud threads. 13. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet
stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 14. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet
stud.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical - Information For
Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6763
15. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 16. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the rivet stud. 17. Select a M6
conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 18. Install the M6 conductive
nut to the rivet stud and:
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
19. Verify proper system operation.
M6 Weld Nut
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M6 weld nut at the electrical ground location is damaged or stripped, a M7 conductive
self-threading bolt may be used to secure the ground
wire terminal.
2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the weld nut and allow to dry. 3. Remove any loose metal particles from the damaged
or stripped weld nut with a stiff brush. 4. Select a M7 conductive self-threading bolt. Refer to the
Parts Information section of this bulletin 5. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N
12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M7 conductive self-threading
bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
6. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 7. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M7 conductive self-threading bolt.
8. Install the M7 conductive self-threading bolt and:
Tighten Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb in).
9. Verify proper system operation.
M6 Weld Nut Alternative Repair
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6 conductive bolt
and a M6 conductive nut may be used to secure
the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M6 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind
the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance
surrounding the new electrical ground site.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the ground location and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 8.5 mm (0.33 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the
area surrounding the 8.5 mm (0.33 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M6 conductive
bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M6 conductive bolt to the ground
location.
10. Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the
M6 conductive nut to the bolt and:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical - Information For
Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6764
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free
electrical ground.
12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation.
M8 Weld Nut
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M8
conductive bolt and a M8 conductive nut may be
used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this
bulletin.
2. Select a location adjacent the M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind the panel
surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance surrounding
the new electrical ground site.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the ground location and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the
area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M8 conductive
bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M8 conductive bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M8 conductive bolt to the ground
location.
10. Select a M8 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the
M8 conductive nut to the bolt and:
Tighten Tighten to 22 Nm (16 lb ft).
Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free
electrical ground.
12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation.
M8 Weld Nut Alternative Repair
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is not accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6
conductive rivet stud and a M6 conductive nut
may be used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal.
2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind
the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance
surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site
and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical - Information For
Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6765
5. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) until bare metal is
visible.
Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of
0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any
air gaps to ensure a good ground.
6. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit.
7. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool
(2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet
stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3).
8. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive
rivet stud. 9. Ensure the new rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement.
10. Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical - Information For
Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6766
Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the
installation of the electrical ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable
and corrosion-free electrical ground.
11. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 12. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective
material applied to the rivet stud threads. 13. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet
stud threads. 14. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet
stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 15. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet
stud.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
16. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 17. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M6 conductive rivet stud. 18.
Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 19. Install the M6
conductive nut to the rivet stud and:
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in)
20. Verify proper system operation.
Parts Information
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical - Information For
Electrical Ground Repair > Page 6767
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 06-08-45-004 > May > 06 > Electrical - Instrument Panel
& General Wiring Repair
Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Instrument Panel & General Wiring
Repair
Bulletin No.: 06-08-45-004
Date: May 02, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Instrument Panel (I/P), Body and General Wiring Harness Repair
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Trucks 2003-2007 HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3
Important:
A part restriction has been implemented on all Body and I/P harnesses and is being administered
by the PQC. If a body or I/P harness replacement is required, it can take 12-28 weeks for a
harness to be built and delivered to a dealer. The dealer technician is expected to repair any
harness damage as the first and best choice before replacing a harness.
In an effort to standardize repair practices, General Motors is requiring that all wiring harnesses be
repaired instead of replaced. If there is a question concerning which connector and/or terminal you
are working on, refer to the information in the appropriate Connector End Views in SI. The
Instruction Manual J 38125-620, which is sent with each new update of the J 38125 Terminal
Repair Kit, also has terminal crimping and terminal remove information.
Important:
There are some parts in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit (i.e. SIR connector CPAs and heat shrink
tube (used in high heat area pigtail replacement) and some TPAs that are not available from
GMSPO. It is vitally important that each update to the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit be done as soon
as it arrives at the dealer.
Utilize the Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125) to achieve an effective wiring repair. The Terminal Repair
Kit has been an essential tool for all GM Dealers since 1987. Replacement terminals and tools for
this kit are available through SPX/Kent Moore. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 06-08-45-001
for more information.
The Instruction Manual J 38125-620, which is sent with each new update to the J 38125 Terminal
Repair Kit, also has terminal crimping and terminal removal information.
U.S. Dealers Only - Training courses (including Tech Assists, Emerging Issues, Web, IDL and
Hands-on) are available through the GM Training website. Refer to Resources and then Training
Materials for a complete list of available courses.
Canadian Dealers Only - Refer to the Training section of GM infoNet for a complete list of available
courses and a copy of the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit Instruction Manual.
Wiring repair information is also available in Service Information (SI). The Wiring Repair section
contains information for the following types of wiring repairs:
- Testing for intermittent conditions and poor conditions
- Flat wire repairs
- GMLAN wiring repairs
- High temperature wiring repairs
- Splicing copper wire using splice clips
- Splicing copper wire using splice sleeves
- Splicing twisted or shielded cable
- Splicing inline harness diodes
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 06-08-45-004 > May > 06 > Electrical - Instrument Panel
& General Wiring Repair > Page 6772
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications
Alignment: Technical Service Bulletins Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
Bulletin No.: 05-03-07-009C
Date: December 09, 2010
Subject: Wheel Alignment Specifications, Requirements and Recommendations for GM Vehicles
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being extensively revised to provide technicians and warranty
administrators with an all inclusive guide for wheel alignments. PLEASE FAMILIARIZE YOURSELF
WITH THESE UPDATES BEFORE PERFORMING YOUR NEXT GM WHEEL ALIGNMENT
SERVICE. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-07-009B (Section 03 - Suspension).
Purpose
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide retail, wholesale and fleet personnel with General Motors'
warranty service requirements and recommendations for customer concerns related to wheel
alignment. For your convenience, this bulletin updates and centralizes all of GM's Standard Wheel
Alignment Service Procedures, Policy Guidelines and bulletins on wheel alignment warranty
service.
Important PLEASE FAMILIARIZE YOURSELF WITH THESE UPDATES BEFORE PERFORMING
YOUR NEXT GM WHEEL ALIGNMENT SERVICE.
The following five (5) key steps are a summary of this bulletin and are REQUIRED in completing a
successful wheel alignment service.
1. Verify the vehicle is in an Original Equipment condition for curb weight, tires, wheels, suspension
and steering configurations. Vehicles
modified in any of these areas are not covered for wheel alignment warranty.
2. Review the customer concern relative to "Normal Operation" definitions. 3. Verify that vehicle is
within the "Mileage Policy" range. 4. Document wheel alignment warranty claims appropriately for
labor operations E2000 and E2020.
The following information must be documented or attached to the repair order:
- Customer concern in detail
- What corrected the customer concern?
- If a wheel alignment is performed:
- Consult SI for proper specifications.
- Document the "Before" AND "After" wheel alignment measurements/settings.
- Completed "Wheel Alignment Repair Order Questionnaire" (form attached to this bulletin)
5. Use the proper wheel alignment equipment (preferred with print-out capability), process and the
appropriate calibration maintenance schedules.
Important If it is determined that a wheel alignment is necessary under warranty, use the proper
labor code for the repair. E2000 for Steering Wheel Angle and/or Front Toe set or E2020 for Wheel
Alignment Check/Adjust includes Caster, Camber and Toe set (Wheel alignment labor time for
other component repairs is to be charged to the component that causes a wheel alignment
operation.).
The following flowchart is to help summarize the information detailed in this bulletin and should be
used whenever a wheel alignment is performed.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications > Page 6778
Verify Original Equipment Condition of the Vehicle
- Verify that Original Equipment Tires and Wheels or Official GM Accessory Tires and Wheels are
on the vehicle.
- Verify that aftermarket suspension "Lift" or "Lowering" Kits or other suspension alterations have
NOT been done to the vehicle.
- Check for accidental damage to the vehicle; for example, severe pothole or curb impacts, collision
damage that may have affected the wheel alignment of the vehicle; e.g., engine cradles,
suspension control arms, axles, wheels, wheel covers, tires may show evidence of damage/impact.
- Check to be sure vehicle has seen "Normal Use" rather than abuse; e.g., very aggressive driving
may show up by looking at the tires and condition of the vehicle.
- Check for other additional equipment items that may significantly affect vehicle mass such as
large tool boxes, campers, snow plow packages (without the snowplow RPO), etc., especially in
trucks and cutaway/incomplete vehicles. Significant additional mass can affect trim height and
wheel alignment of the vehicle and may necessitate a customer pay wheel alignment when placed
semi-permanently in the vehicle (Upfitter instructions are to realign the vehicle after placement of
these types of items. (This typically applies to trucks and incomplete vehicles that can be upfit with
equipment such as the above.)
Customer Concerns, "Normal Operation" Conditions and "Mileage Policy"
Possible Concerns
The following are typical conditions that may require wheel alignment warranty service:
1. Lead/Pull: defined as "at a constant highway speed on a typical straight road, the amount of
effort required at the steering wheel to maintain the
vehicle's straight heading."
Important Please evaluate for the condition with hands-on the steering wheel. Follow the "Vehicle
Leads/Pulls" diagnostic tree located in SI to determine the cause of a lead/pull concern. Lead/Pull
concerns can be due to road crown or road slope, tires, wheel alignment or even in rare
circumstances a steering gear issue. Lead/pull concerns due to road crown are considered
"Normal Operation" and are NOT a warrantable condition -- the customer should be advised that
this is "Normal Operation."
Important Some customers may comment on a "Lead/Pull" when they hold the steering wheel in a
level condition. If so, this is more likely a "steering wheel angle" concern because the customer is
"steering" the vehicle to obtain a "level" steering wheel.
2. Steering wheel angle to the left or right (counter-clockwise or clockwise, respectively): Defined
as the steering wheel angle (clocking)
deviation from "level" while maintaining a straight heading on a typical straight road.
3. Irregular or Premature tire wear: Slight to very slight "feathering" or "edge" wear on the
shoulders of tires is NOT considered unusual and
should even out with a tire rotation; if the customer is concerned about a "feathering" condition of
the tires, the customer could be advised to rotate the tires earlier than the next scheduled
mileage/maintenance interval (but no later than the next interval). Be sure to understand the
customer's driving habits as this will also heavily influence the tire wear performance; tire wear from
aggressive or abusive driving habits is NOT a warrantable condition.
Important Slight or mild feathering, cupping, edge or heel/toe wear of tire tread shoulders is
"normal" and can show up very early in a tire/vehicle service mileage; in fact, some new tires can
show evidence of feathering from the factory. These issues do NOT affect the overall performance
and tread life of the tire. Dealer personnel should always check the customer's maintenance
records to ensure that tire inflation pressure is being maintained to placard and that the tires are
being rotated (modified-X pattern) at the proper mileage intervals. Wheel alignments are NOT to be
performed for the types of "Normal" Tire Feathering shown in Figures 1-4 below.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications > Page 6779
Figure 1: Full Tread View - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear on the Shoulder/Adjacent/Center
Ribs
Figure 2: Tire Shoulder View Example 1 - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear on the Shoulder
Figure 3: Tire Shoulder View Example 2 - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear
Figure 4: Detail Side View of Tire Shoulder Area - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear
Important When a wheel alignment is deemed necessary for tire wear, be sure to document on the
repair order, in as much detail as possible, the severity and type of tire wear (e.g., severe center
wear or severe inside or outside shoulder wear) and the position of the tire on the vehicle (RF, LF,
LR, RR). Please note the customer's concern with the wear such as, noise, appearance, wear life,
etc. A field product report with pictures of the tire wear condition is recommended. Refer to
Corporate Bulletin Number 02-00-89-002J and #07-00-89-036C.
4. Other repairs that affect wheel alignment; e.g., certain component replacement such as
suspension control arm replacement, engine cradle
adjustment/replace, steering gear replacement, steering tie rod replace, suspension strut/shock,
steering knuckle, etc. may require a wheel alignment.
Important If other components or repairs are identified as affecting the wheel alignment, policy calls
for the wheel alignment labor time to be charged to the replaced/repaired component's labor
operation time rather than the wheel alignment labor operations.
Important Vibration type customer concerns are generally NOT due to wheel alignment except in
the rare cases; e.g., extreme diagonal wear across the tread. In general, wheel alignments are
NOT to be performed as an investigation/correction for vibration concerns.
"Normal Operation" Conditions
Vehicle Lead/Pull Due to Road Crown or Slope:
As part of "Normal Operation," vehicles will follow side-to-side or left to right road crown or slope.
Be sure to verify from the customer the types of roads they are driving as they may not recognize
the influence of road crown on vehicle lead/pull and steering wheel angle. If a vehicle requires
significant steering effort to prevent it from "climbing" the road crown there may be an issue to be
looked into further.
Important
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications > Page 6780
A wheel alignment will generally NOT correct vehicles that follow the road crown since this is within
"Normal Operation."
Mileage Policy
The following mileage policy applies for E2020 and E2000 labor operations: Note
Wheel Alignment is NOT covered under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty for Express and Savana
Cutaway vehicles as these vehicles require Upfitters to set the wheel alignment after completing
the vehicles.
- 0-800 km (0-500 mi): E2000/E2020 claims ONLY allowed with Call Center Authorization. Due to
the tie down during shipping, the vehicle's suspension requires some time to reach normal
operating position. For this reason, new vehicles are generally NOT to be aligned until they have
accumulated at least 800 km (500 mi). A field product report should accompany any claim within
this mileage range.
- 801-12,000 km (501-7,500 mi):
- If a vehicle came from the factory with incorrect alignment settings, any resulting off-angle
steering wheel, lead/pull characteristics or the rare occurrence of excessive tire wear would be
apparent early in the life of the vehicle. The following policy applies:
- Vehicles 100% Factory Set/Measured for Caster/Camber/Toe - Escalade/ESV/EXT,
Tahoe/Suburban, Yukon/XL/Denali, Silverado/Sierra, Express/Savana, Corvette and
Colorado/Canyon: E2000/E2020 Claims: Call Center Authorization Required
- All Vehicles NOT 100% Factory Set/Measured for Caster/Camber/Toe as noted above:
E2000/E2020 Claims: Dealer Service Manager Authorization Required
- 12,001 km and beyond (7,501 miles and beyond): During this period, customers are responsible
for the wheel alignment expense or dealers may provide on a case-by case basis a one-time
customer enthusiasm claim up to 16,000 km (10,000 mi). In the event that a defective component
required the use of the subject labor operations, the identified defective component labor operation
will include the appropriate labor time for a wheel alignment as an add condition to the component
repair.
Important Only one wheel alignment labor operation claim (E2000 or E2020) may be used per VIN.
Warranty Documentation Requirements
When a wheel alignment service has been deemed necessary, the following items will need to be
clearly documented on/with the repair order:
- Customer concern in detail
- What corrected the customer concern?
- If a wheel alignment is performed:
- Consult SI for proper specifications.
- Document the "Before" AND "After" wheel alignment measurements/settings.
- Completed "Wheel Alignment Repair Order Questionnaire" (form attached to this bulletin)
1. Document the customer concern in as much detail as possible on the repair order and in the
warranty administration system. Preferred examples:
- Steering wheel is off angle in the counterclockwise direction by approximately x degrees or
clocking position.
- Vehicle lead/pulls to the right at approximately x-y mph. Vehicle will climb the road crown. Severe,
Moderate or Slight.
- RF and LF tires are wearing on the outside shoulders with severe feathering.
Important In the event of a lead/pull or steering wheel angle concern, please note the direction of
lead/pull (left or right) or direction of steering wheel angle (clockwise or counterclockwise) on the
repair order and within the warranty claim verbatim.
Important In the event of a tire wear concern, please note the position on the vehicle and where the
wear is occurring on the tire; i.e., the RF tire is wearing on the inside shoulder.
2. Document the technician's findings on cause and correction of the issue. Examples:
- Reset LF toe from 0.45 degrees to 0.10 degrees and RF toe from -0.25 degrees to 0.10 degrees
to correct the steering wheel angle from 5 degrees counterclockwise to 0 degrees.
- Reset LF camber from 0.25 degrees to -0.05 degrees to correct the cross-camber condition of
+0.30 degrees to 0.00 degrees on the vehicle.
- Front Sum toe was found to be 0.50 degrees, reset to 0.20 degrees.
3. Print-out the "Before" and "After" wheel alignment measurements/settings and attach them to the
Repair Order or if print-out capability is not
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications > Page 6781
available, measurements may also be clearly and legibly handwritten into the Wheel Alignment
Repair Order Questionnaire attached to this bulletin.
4. Attach the Wheel Alignment Repair Order Questionnaire below along with the print-out of
"Before" and "After" wheel alignment measurements to
the Repair Order and retain for use by GM.
Wheel Alignment Equipment and Process
Wheel alignments must be performed with a quality machine that will give accurate results when
performing checks. "External Reference" (image-based camera technology) is preferred. Please
refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 05-00-89-029B: General Motors Dealership Critical Equipment
Requirements and Recommendations.
Requirements:
- Computerized four wheel alignment system.
- Computer capable of printing before and after alignment reports.
- Computer capable of time and date stamp printout.
- Racking system must have jacking capability
- Racking system must be capable of level to 1.6 mm (1/16 in)
- Appropriate wheel stops and safety certification
- Built-in turn plates and slip plates
- Wheel clamps capable of attaching to 20" or larger wheels
- Racking capable of accepting any GM passenger car or light duty truck
- Operator properly trained and ASE-certified (U.S. only) in wheel alignment
Recommendations:
Racking should have front and rear jacking capability.
Equipment Maintenance and Calibration:
Alignment machines must be regularly calibrated in order to give correct information. Most
manufacturers recommend the following:
- Alignment machines with "internal reference" sensors should be checked (and calibrated, if
necessary) every six months.
- Alignment machines with "external reference" (image-based camera technology) should be
checked (and calibrated, if necessary) once a year.
- Racks must be kept level to within 1.6 mm (1/16 in).
- If any instrument that is part of the alignment machine is dropped or damaged in some way,
check the calibration immediately.
Check with the manufacturer of your specific equipment for their recommended service/calibration
schedule.
Wheel Alignment Process
When performing wheel alignment measurement and/or adjustment, the following steps should be
taken:
Preliminary Steps:
1. Verify that the vehicle has a full tank of fuel (compensate as necessary). 2. Inspect the wheels
and the tires for damage. 3. Inspect the tires for the proper inflation and irregular tire wear. 4.
Inspect the wheel bearings for excessive play. 5. Inspect all suspension and steering parts for
looseness, wear, or damage. 6. Inspect the steering wheel for excessive drag or poor return due to
stiff or rusted linkage or suspension components. 7. Inspect the vehicle trim height. 8. Compensate
for frame angle on targeted vehicles (refer to Wheel Alignment Specifications in SI).
Satisfactory vehicle operation may occur over a wide range of alignment angles. However, if the
wheel alignment angles are not within the range of specifications, adjust the wheel alignment to the
specifications. Refer to Wheel Alignment Specifications in SI. Give consideration to excess loads,
such as tool boxes, sample cases, etc. Follow the wheel alignment equipment manufacturer's
instructions.
Measure/Adjust:
Important Prior to making any adjustments to wheel alignment on a vehicle, technicians must verify
that the wheel alignment specifications loaded into their wheel alignment machine are up-to-date
by comparing these to the wheel alignment specifications for the appropriate model and model year
in SI. Using incorrect and/or outdated specifications may result in unnecessary adjustments,
irregular and/or premature tire wear and repeat customer concerns
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications > Page 6782
Important When performing adjustments to vehicles requiring a 4-wheel alignment, set the rear
wheel alignment angles first in order to obtain proper front wheel alignment angles.
Perform the following steps in order to measure the front and rear alignment angles:
1. Install the alignment equipment according to the manufacturer's instructions. 2. Jounce the front
and the rear bumpers 3 times prior to checking the wheel alignment. 3. Measure the alignment
angles and record the readings.
If necessary, adjust the wheel alignment to vehicle specification and record the before and after
measurements. Refer to Wheel Alignment Specifications in SI.
Important Technicians must refer to SI for the correct wheel alignment specifications. SI is the only
source of GM wheel alignment specifications that is kept up-to-date throughout the year.
Test drive vehicle to ensure proper repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications > Page 6783
Frame Angle Measurement (Express / Savana Only) ........
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications > Page 6784
What corrected the customer concern and was the repair verified?
Please Explain: .............
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Wheel
Alignment Specifications
Alignment: Specifications
Camber Service Allowed -0.40 to + 1.60
Service Preferred 0.6
Cross Camber (L-R) Service Allowed -0.5 to +0.5
Service Preferred 0
Caster-Left Wheel Service Allowed 2.0 to 4.0
Service Preferred 3.0
Caster-Right Wheel Service Allowed 2.50 to 4.50
Service Preferred 3.5
Cross Caster (L-R) Service Allowed -1 to 0
Service Preferred -0.5
Steering Wheel Angle Service Allowed -6.0 to +4.0
Service Preferred -1.0
Toe (Total) Service Allowed 0.20 to 0.20
Service Preferred 0
Z Trim Height Service Allowed 2.86 to 3.34 in
Service Preferred 3.10 in
D Trim Height Service Allowed 5.31 to 5.71 in
Service Preferred 5.50 in
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Wheel
Alignment Specifications > Page 6787
Alignment: Specifications
Z Trim Height RWD Service Allowed 2.86 to 3.34 in
Service Preferred 3.10 in
AWD Service Allowed 5.16 to 5.64 in
Service Preferred 5.40 in
D Trim Height ALL Service Allowed 5.31 to 5.71 in
Service Preferred 5.50 in
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 6788
Alignment: Description and Operation
Caster Description
Caster is the tilting of the uppermost point of the steering axis either forward or backward, when
viewed from the side of the vehicle. A backward tilt is positive (+) and a forward tilt is negative (-).
Caster influences directional control of the steering but does not affect the tire wear and is not
adjustable on this vehicle. Caster is affected by the vehicle height, therefore it is important to keep
the body at its designed height. Overloading the vehicle or a weak or sagging rear spring will affect
caster. When the rear of the vehicle is lower than its designated trim height, the front suspension
moves to a more positive caster. If the rear of the vehicle is higher than its designated trim height,
the front suspension moves to a less positive caster. With too little positive caster, steering may be
touchy at high speed and wheel returnability may be diminished when coming out of a turn. If one
wheel has more positive caster than the other, that wheel will pull toward the center of the vehicle.
This condition will cause the vehicle to pull or lead to the side with the least amount of positive
caster.
Camber Description
Camber is the tilting of the wheels from the vertical when viewed from the front of the vehicle.
When the wheels tilt outward at the top, the camber is positive (+). When the wheel tilts inward at
the top, the camber is negative (-). The amount of tilt is measured in degrees from the vertical.
Camber settings influence the directional control and the tire wear. Too much positive camber will
result in premature wear on the outside of the tire and cause excessive wear on the suspension
parts. Too much negative camber will result in premature wear on the inside of the tire and cause
excessive wear on the suspension parts. Unequal side-to-side camber of 1 degree or more will
cause the vehicle to pull or lead to the side with the most positive camber.
Toe Description
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 6789
Toe is a measurement of how much the front and/or rear wheels are turned in or out from a
straight-ahead position. When the wheels are turned in, toe is positive (+). When the wheels are
turned out, toe is negative (-). The actual amount of toe is normally only a fraction of a degree. The
purpose of toe is to ensure that the wheels roll parallel. Toe also offsets the small deflections of the
wheel support system that occur when the vehicle is rolling forward. In other words, with the vehicle
standing still and the wheels set with toe-in, the wheels tend to roll parallel on the road when the
vehicle is moving. Improper toe adjustment will cause premature tire wear and cause steering
instability.
Setback Description
Setback applies to both the front and the rear wheels. Setback is the amount that one wheel may
be aligned behind the other wheel. Setback may be the result of a road hazard or a collision. The
first clue is a caster difference from side-to-side of more than 1 degree.
Thrust Angles Description
The front wheels aim or steer the vehicle. The rear wheels control tracking. This tracking action
relates to the thrust angle (3). The thrust angle is the path that the rear wheels take. Ideally, the
thrust angle is geometrically aligned with the body centerline (2). In the illustration, toe-in is shown
on the left rear wheel, moving the thrust line (1) off center. The resulting deviation from the
centerline is the thrust angle.
Lead/Pull Description
Lead/pull is the deviation of the vehicle from a straight path, on a level road, without hand pressure
on the steering wheel. Lead/pull is usually caused by the following factors: Tire construction
- Uneven brake adjustment
- Wheel alignment
The way in which a tire is built may produce lead/pull. The rear tires will not cause lead.
Memory Steer Description
Memory steer is when the vehicle wants to lead or pull in the direction the driver previously turned
the vehicle. Additionally, after turning in the opposite direction, the vehicle will want to lead or pull in
that direction.
Wander Description
Wander is the undesired drifting or deviation of a vehicle to either side from a straight path with
hand pressure on the steering wheel. Wander is a symptom of the vehicle's sensitivity to external
disturbances, such as road crown and crosswind, and accentuated by poor on-center steering feel.
Scrub Radius Description
Ideally, the scrub radius is as small as possible. Normally, the SAI angle and the centerline of the
tire and the wheel intersect below the road surface,
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 6790
causing a positive scrub radius. With struts, the SAI angle is much larger than the long arm/short
arm type of suspension. This allows the SAI angle to intersect the camber angle above the road
surface, forming a negative scrub radius. The smaller the scrub radius, the better the directional
stability. Installing aftermarket wheels that have additional offset will dramatically increase the
scrub radius. The newly installed wheels may cause the centerline of the tires to move further away
from the spindle. This will increase the scrub radius. A large amount of scrub radius can cause
severe shimmy after hitting a bump. Four-wheel drive vehicles with large tires use a steering
damper to compensate for an increased scrub radius. Scrub radius is not directly measurable by
the conventional methods. Scrub radius is projected geometrically by engineers during the design
phase of the suspension.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Trim
Height Inspection
Alignment: Service and Repair Trim Height Inspection
Trim Height Inspection Procedure
Trim Height Measurements
Trim height is a predetermined measurement relating to vehicle ride height. Incorrect trim heights
can cause bottoming out over bumps, damage to the suspension components and symptoms
similar to wheel alignment problems. Check the trim heights when diagnosing suspension concerns
and before checking the wheel alignment. Perform the following before measuring the trim heights:
1. Set the tire pressures to the pressure shown on the certification label. 2. Check the fuel level.
Add additional weight if necessary to simulate a full tank. 3. Make sure the rear compartment is
empty except for the spare tire. 4. Make sure the vehicle is on a level surface, such as an
alignment rack. 5. Close the doors. 6. Close the hood. 7. All dimensions are measured vertical to
the ground. Trim heights should be within 13 mm (0.5 inch) to be considered correct.
Z Height Measurement
The Z height dimension measurement determines the proper ride height for the front end of the
vehicle. Vehicles equipped with torsion bars use an adjusting arm in order to adjust the Z height
dimension. Vehicles without torsion bars have no adjustment and could require replacement of
suspension components.
1. Lift the front bumper of the vehicle up about 38 mm (1.5 inch). 2. Gently remove your hands. Let
the vehicle settle. 3. Repeat this operation for a total of 3 times. 4. Measure from the pivot bolt
center line (3) down to the lower corner (5) of the lower ball joint (1) in order to obtain the Z height
measurement (4). 5. Push the front bumper of the vehicle down about 38 mm (1.5 inch). 6. Gently
remove your hands. 7. Allow the vehicle to settle into position. 8. Repeat the jouncing operation 2
more times for a total of 3 times. 9. Measure the Z dimension.
10. The true Z height dimension number is the average of the high and the low measurements.
Z Height Adjustment
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Trim
Height Inspection > Page 6793
1. For vehicles equipped with a torsion bar suspension, turn the bolt (1) that contacts the torsion
arm as needed. One revolution of the bolt (1) into
the nut, increases the Z height by approximately 6.0 mm (0.2 inch).
2. For vehicles without torsion bars replace damaged or worn components as necessary.
D Height Measurement
The D height dimension measurement determines the proper rear end ride height. There is no
adjustment procedure. Repair may require replacement of suspension components.
1. With the vehicle on a flat surface, lift upward on the rear bumper 38 mm (1.5 inch). 2. Gently
remove your hands. Allow the vehicle to settle into position. 3. Repeat the jouncing operation 2
more times for a total of 3 times.
4. Measure the D height by measuring the distance between the bumper bracket and the top of the
rear axle tube. 5. Push the rear bumper downward to 38 mm (1.5 inch). 6. Gently remove your
hands. Allow the vehicle to settle into position. 7. Repeat the jouncing operation 2 more times for a
total of 3 times. 8. Measure the D height dimension. 9. The true D height dimension number is the
average of the high and the low measurements.
10. If these measurements are out of specifications, inspect for the following conditions:
- Sagging front suspension.
- Worn rear suspension components, such as leaf spring bushings.
- Improper tire inflation.
- Improper weight distribution.
- Collision damage.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Trim
Height Inspection > Page 6794
Alignment: Service and Repair Measuring Wheel Alignment
Measuring Wheel Alignment
Steering and vibration complaints are not always the result of improper alignment. One possible
cause is wheel and tire imbalance. Another possibility is tire lead due to worn or improperly
manufactured tires. Lead is the vehicle deviation from a straight path on a level road without
pressure on the steering wheel. Refer to Radial Tire Lead/Pull Correction in order to determine if
the vehicle has a tire lead problem. Before performing any adjustment affecting wheel alignment,
perform the following inspections and adjustments in order to ensure correct alignment readings: Inspect the tires for the proper inflation and irregular tire wear.
- Inspect the runout of the wheels and the tires.
- Inspect the wheel bearings for backlash and excessive play.
- Inspect the ball joints and tie rod ends for looseness or wear.
- Inspect the control arms and stabilizer shaft for looseness or wear.
- Inspect the steering gear for looseness at the frame.
- Inspect the struts/shock absorbers for wear, leaks, and any noticeable noises.
- Inspect the vehicle trim height.
- Inspect the steering wheel for excessive drag or poor return due to stiff or rusted linkage or
suspension components.
- Inspect the fuel level. The fuel tank should be full or the vehicle should have a compensating load
added.
Give consideration to excess loads, such as tool boxes, sample cases, etc. If normally carried in
the vehicle, these items should remain in the vehicle during alignment adjustments. Give
consideration also to the condition of the equipment being used for the alignment. Follow the
equipment manufacturer's instructions. Satisfactory vehicle operation may occur over a wide range
of alignment settings. However, if the setting exceeds the service allowable specifications, correct
the alignment to the service preferred specifications. Perform the following steps in order to
measure the front and rear alignment angles:
1. Install the alignment equipment according to the manufacturer's instructions. 2. Jounce the front
and the rear bumpers 3 times prior to checking the wheel alignment. 3. Measure the alignment
angles and record the readings.
Important: When performing adjustments to vehicles requiring a 4-wheel alignment, set the rear
wheel alignment angles first in order to obtain proper front alignment angles.
4. Adjust alignment angles to vehicle specification, if necessary.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Trim
Height Inspection > Page 6795
Alignment: Service and Repair Front Wheel Alignment
Front Caster and Camber Adjustment
Front Caster and Camber Adjustment
The caster and the camber adjustments are made by inserting shims between the upper control
arm shaft and the frame bracket. The shims may be added, subtracted, or transferred in order to
change the readings.
Important: Before adjusting the caster and the camber angles, jounce the front bumper 3 times to allow the
vehicle to return to the normal height.
- Measure and adjust the caster and the camber with the vehicle at curb height. The front
suspension Z dimension and the rear suspension D dimension are indicated in Trim Heights.
- When checking the left and the right side caster and camber, it must be equal within 1.0 degree.
- When setting the left and the right side caster and camber, it must be equal within 0.50 degree.
- The caster and the camber set is relative to the ground.
1. Loosen the upper control arm shaft to frame nuts (1).
Important: A normal shim pack will leave at least 24/~ threads of the bolt exposed beyond the nut. The
maximum shim pack cannot be thicker than 21.3 mm (0.84 inch).
- The difference between the front shim packs and the rear shim packs must not exceed 10 mm
(0.40 inch). If these requirements cannot be met, check for damaged control arms and damaged
related parts.
2. If the caster is not within specifications, adjust the caster by transferring the front shims to the
rear, or the rear shims to the front. The transfer of
the one shim from the rear bolt to the front bolt will decrease the positive caster.
3. If the camber is not within specification, adjust the camber by changing the shims at both the
front and the rear of the shaft. Add or subtract the
shims (2) as required. Adding an equal number of shims at both the front and rear of the cross
shaft will decrease positive camber.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Tighten the nut on the thinner shim pack first.
- Tighten the nuts to 110 Nm (81 ft. lbs.). Tightening the nut on the thinner shim pack first improves
the shaft to frame clamping force and torque retention.
5. Check the toe-in after changing the caster or the camber.
Front Wheel Toe Adjustment
Front Toe Adjustment
The toe-in can be increased or decreased by changing the length of the tie rods. A threaded sleeve
is provided for this purpose. When the tie rods are mounted ahead of the steering knuckle, the tie
rods must be modified as follows: Decreased in length in order to increase the toe-in. Increased in length in order to decrease the
toe-in.
Important: When checking and setting the toe-in, the left and right side to be set separately and the steering
wheel must be held straight ahead position within 4 - 6 degrees. Before adjusting the toe-in, jounce
the front bumper 3 times to allow the vehicle to return to the normal height.
- Adjust the toe-in with the vehicle at curb height. The front suspension Z dimension and the rear
suspension D dimension are indicated in Trim Heights.
- For an accurate toe-in reading, do not push or pull on the tires during the alignment process.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Trim
Height Inspection > Page 6796
1. Set the steering wheel in the straight ahead position. 2. Loosen the clamp bolts at each end of
the steering tie rod adjustable sleeves.
Important: The tie rod adjuster often becomes rusted in service.
3. If the torque needed to rotate the adjuster tube exceeds 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.), perform the
following steps:
3.1. Remove the adjuster tube clamp nuts and the bolts. Discard the nuts and the bolts.
3.2. Apply the penetrating oil between the adjuster tube and the tie rod threads.
3.3. Rotate the adjuster tube until the tube moves freely.
3.4. Install the new bolts and the nuts with the correct part number. The nut must be towards the
front of the vehicle.
4. Rotate the inner and the outer tie rod sockets rearward to the limit of the ball stud travel.
5. Turn the tie rod adjusting sleeves to set the toe-in to specifications.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Important: Before tightening the adjuster tube nuts, do the following: Check the number of threads on each tie rod within the adjuster tube. The tie rod threads within the
adjuster tube must be equal to within 3 threads.
- Check the relationship of the adjuster tube to the clamp. The adjuster tube slot and the clamp
opening must not be in the same position. The position of the adjuster tube clamp must not exceed
30 degrees in either direction.
- The adjuster tube clamp must be on the inside of the adjuster tube dimple.
6. Tighten the adjuster tube clamp nuts.
- Tighten the adjuster tube clamp nuts to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). The clamp ends may touch when the
nuts are tightened to specification.
7. Rotate the tie rod sockets to the centered position.
Ensure that the outer socket is square with the stud.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Monitor Receiver / Transponder > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Tire Monitor System - TPM Sensor Information
Tire Pressure Monitor Receiver / Transponder: Technical Service Bulletins Tire Monitor System TPM Sensor Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-03-16-003
Date: May 12, 2008
Subject: Warranty Reduction - Transfer of Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensors to
Replacement Wheels and Allowable TPM Sensor Replacements
Models: 2000-2009 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2009
HUMMER H2 2006-2009 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7x
with On-Wheel TPM Sensors
TPM Sensor / Wheel Warranty Reviews
During the last warranty review period it was noted that wheels being returned under the GM New
Vehicle Warranty were being shipped back to General Motors with the TPM sensor still attached to
the wheel. Return rates ran as high as 60% with the TPM sensors still attached. Operational TPM
sensors should not be returned to GM and are to be transferred to replacement wheels if they
become necessary.
Important:
Operational TPM Sensors that are returned under warranty to General Motors will be charged back
to the dealer.Sensors have a 10 year /150,000 mile (240,000 km) battery life, and should be
transferred if one or more wheels are replaced.
TPM Valve Stem / Grommet (0-ring) Replacement
When the TPM sensors are transferred to new wheels you should replace the component used to
seal the TPM sensor stem to the wheel. On sensors with an aluminum stem and visible nut on the
outside of the wheel a replacement grommet (0-ring) should be used to assure a proper seal. The
sensor retaining nut (except Aveo) should be tightened to 7 N.m (62 lb in) for all vehicles except
Pontiac Vibe (4.0 N.m (35.4 lb in)).
Important:
^ DO NOT overtorque the retaining nut.
Notice:
^ Factory installed TPM Sensors come with plastic aluminum or nickel-plated brass stem caps.
These caps should not be changed. Chrome plated steel caps may cause corrosion of aluminum
valve stems due to incompatibility of the metals.
On current style sensors the entire rubber stem is replaceable. The service interval on the revised
TPM sensor with replaceable stem is the same as for any other traditional valve stem. Replace the
stem at the time of tire replacement sensor transfer or whenever air seepage is suspected at the
valve stem. When replacing the valve stem tighten the screw to 1.3 N.m (11.5 lb in).
For either style of TPM sensor see the service parts guide for the correct GM part numbers to order
and use.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors
and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Tire
Monitor System - TPM Sensor Information
Tire Pressure Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Tire Monitor System - TPM Sensor Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-03-16-003
Date: May 12, 2008
Subject: Warranty Reduction - Transfer of Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensors to
Replacement Wheels and Allowable TPM Sensor Replacements
Models: 2000-2009 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2009
HUMMER H2 2006-2009 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7x
with On-Wheel TPM Sensors
TPM Sensor / Wheel Warranty Reviews
During the last warranty review period it was noted that wheels being returned under the GM New
Vehicle Warranty were being shipped back to General Motors with the TPM sensor still attached to
the wheel. Return rates ran as high as 60% with the TPM sensors still attached. Operational TPM
sensors should not be returned to GM and are to be transferred to replacement wheels if they
become necessary.
Important:
Operational TPM Sensors that are returned under warranty to General Motors will be charged back
to the dealer.Sensors have a 10 year /150,000 mile (240,000 km) battery life, and should be
transferred if one or more wheels are replaced.
TPM Valve Stem / Grommet (0-ring) Replacement
When the TPM sensors are transferred to new wheels you should replace the component used to
seal the TPM sensor stem to the wheel. On sensors with an aluminum stem and visible nut on the
outside of the wheel a replacement grommet (0-ring) should be used to assure a proper seal. The
sensor retaining nut (except Aveo) should be tightened to 7 N.m (62 lb in) for all vehicles except
Pontiac Vibe (4.0 N.m (35.4 lb in)).
Important:
^ DO NOT overtorque the retaining nut.
Notice:
^ Factory installed TPM Sensors come with plastic aluminum or nickel-plated brass stem caps.
These caps should not be changed. Chrome plated steel caps may cause corrosion of aluminum
valve stems due to incompatibility of the metals.
On current style sensors the entire rubber stem is replaceable. The service interval on the revised
TPM sensor with replaceable stem is the same as for any other traditional valve stem. Replace the
stem at the time of tire replacement sensor transfer or whenever air seepage is suspected at the
valve stem. When replacing the valve stem tighten the screw to 1.3 N.m (11.5 lb in).
For either style of TPM sensor see the service parts guide for the correct GM part numbers to order
and use.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Center Link > Component Information >
Specifications
Center Link: Specifications
Connecting Rod to Pitman Arm Nut 48 ft. lbs.
Connecting Rod to Relay Rod 35 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Center Link > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Connecting Rod Replacement
Center Link: Service and Repair Connecting Rod Replacement
Connecting Rod Replacement
- Tools Required J 29193 Steering Linkage Installer (12 mm)
Removal Procedure
Important: Use the proper tool in order to separate all the ball joints.
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the prevailing torque nut (5) from the
connecting rod (1) ball stud. Discard the prevailing torque nut (5). 3. Use the J24319-B in order to
remove the connecting rod (1) from the relay rod (4). 4. Remove the prevailing torque nut (2) from
the pitman arm (3) ball stud. Discard the prevailing torque nut (2). 5. Use the J24319-B in order to
remove the connecting rod (1) from the pitman arm (3). 6. Inspect the ball stud threads for damage.
7. Inspect the ball stud seals for excessive wear. 8. Clean the threads on the ball stud.
Installation
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Use the J 29193 in order to connect the connecting rod to the pitman arm ball stud. Ensure that
the seal is on the stud.
- Tighten the J 29193 to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) in order to seat the tapers. Remove the J29193.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Center Link > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Connecting Rod Replacement > Page 6815
2. Install the new prevailing torque nut (2) to the pitman arm (3) ball stud.
- Tighten the nut to 62 Nm (48 ft. lbs.).
3. Use the J 29193 in order to install the connecting rod (1) ball stud to the relay rod (4).
Ensure that the seal is on the stud. Tighten the J 29193 to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) in order to seat the tapers.
4. Remove the J 29193. 5. Install the new prevailing torque nut (5) to the ball stud.
- Tighten the nut to 47 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
6. Lower the vehicle. 7. Adjust the toe-in.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Center Link > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Connecting Rod Replacement > Page 6816
Center Link: Service and Repair Relay Rod Replacement
Relay Rod Replacement
- Tools Required J 24319-B Steering Linkage and Tie Rod Puller
- J 29193 Steering Linkage Installer (12 mm)
Removal Procedure
Important: Use the proper tool in order to separate all ball joints.
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the inner tie rods (5) from the relay rod.
3. Remove the prevailing torque nut (5) from the connecting rod (1) ball stud.
Discard the prevailing torque nut (5).
4. Use the J24319-B in order to remove the connecting rod from the relay rod.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Center Link > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Connecting Rod Replacement > Page 6817
5. Remove the prevailing torque nuts (5) from the idler arm (1) ball studs. Discard the prevailing
torque nuts (1). 6. Use the J24319-B in order to remove the relay rod from the idler arms. 7. Inspect
the threads on the tie rod for damage. 8. Inspect the ball stud threads for damage. 9. Inspect the
ball stud seals for excessive wear.
10. Clean the threads on the ball studs.
Installation Procedure
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Use the J29193 in order to install the relay rod to the idler arm ball studs. Ensure that the seal is
on the stud.
- Tighten the J 29193 to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) in order to seat the tapers.
2. Remove the J29193.
3. Install the new prevailing torque nut (5) to the idler arm (1) ball studs.
- Tighten the prevailing torque nut to 47 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Center Link > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Connecting Rod Replacement > Page 6818
4. Use the J 29193 in order to install the relay rod to the connecting rod ball stud. Ensure that the
seal is on the stud.
- Tighten the J 29193 to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) in order to seat the tapers.
5. Remove the J29193.
6. Install the new prevailing torque nut (5) to the connecting rod (1) ball stud.
- Tighten the prevailing torque nut to 47 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
7. Use the J29193 in order to install the inner tie rod (5) to the relay rod (8).
Ensure that the seal is on the stud. Tighten the J 29193 to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) in order to seat the tapers.
8. Remove the J 29193. 9. Install the new prevailing torque nut (7) to the inner tie rod (5).
- Tighten the prevailing torque nut to 47 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
10. Lower the vehicle. 11. Adjust the toe-in.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications
Front Steering Knuckle: Specifications
Steering Knuckle to Tie Rod End Nut 35 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6822
Front Steering Knuckle: Service and Repair
Steering Knuckle Replacement
- Tools Required J 24319-B Steering Linkage and Tie Rod Puller
- J 23742 Ball Joint Separator
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting.
Caution: Floor jack must remain under the lower control arm during removal and installation to
retain the lower control arm in position. Failure to do so could result in personal injury.
2. Support the lower control arm with a safety stand. 3. Remove the tire and wheel. 4. Remove the
wheel hub and bearing assembly.
5. Remove the outer tie rod to steering knuckle retaining nut.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6823
6. Disconnect the tie rod end from the steering knuckle using J 24319-B.
7. Remove the steering knuckle gasket only if the steering knuckle is being repaired or replaced.
8. Remove the upper and lower control arms cotter pins and the retaining nuts.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6824
9. Remove the upper ball joint stud from the steering knuckle using J 23742.
10. Raise the upper control arm. Disengage the upper ball joint from the steering knuckle.
11. Disconnect the steering knuckle from the lower ball joint using J 23742. 12. Remove the
steering knuckle from the vehicle. 13. Clean the steering knuckle with solvent, then air dry. 14.
Inspect the steering knuckle tapered holes that attach to the ball joints and the outer tie rod.
Replace the steering knuckle if any of the 3 holes are
out-of-round, deformed, or damaged.
15. Inspect the spindle for wear or damage.
Installation Procedure
1. Connect the steering knuckle to the lower ball joint. Press the steering knuckle onto the lower
ball joint until the lower ball joint is fully seated. 2. Connect the steering knuckle to the upper ball
joint. Lower the upper control arm in order to seat the upper ball joint into the steering knuckle.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6825
3. Install the upper and lower ball joint retaining nuts.
- Tighten the upper ball joint retaining nut to 83 Nm (61 ft. lbs.).
- Tighten the lower ball joint retaining nut to 125 Nm (90 ft. lbs.).
4. Install new cotter pins. Tighten the upper and lower ball joint nuts up to an additional 1/6 amount
to insert the cotter pin through the nuts. Bend the
cotter pin flat against the nut.
5. Install the steering knuckle gasket, if necessary.
6. Connect the outer tie rod to the steering knuckle. 7. Install the outer tie rod retaining nut.
- Tighten the outer tie rod retaining nut to 47 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
8. Install the rotor/hub assembly. 9. Install the tire and wheel.
10. Remove the safety stand from the lower control arm. 11. Lower the vehicle. 12. Check the front
wheel alignment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Idler Arm > Component Information > Specifications
Idler Arm: Specifications
Idler Arm to Frame Bolts 77 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Idler Arm > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 6829
Idler Arm: Service and Repair
Idler Arm Replacement
- Tools Required J 24319-B Steering Linkage and Tie Rod Puller
- J 29193 Steering Linkage Installer (12 mm)
Removal Procedure
Important: Use the proper tool in order to separate all of the ball joints.
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the bolts (3) from the idler arm (4). 3.
Remove the prevailing torque nut (2) from the idler arm (4) ball stud. Discard the prevailing torque
nut (2). 4. Use the J 24319-B in order to remove the relay rod (1) from the idler arm (4). 5. Remove
the idler arm (4). 6. Inspect the ball stud threads for damage. 7. Inspect the ball stud seal for cuts
or other damage. 8. Clean the threads on the ball stud and in the ball stud nut.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the idler arm (4) to the frame.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the idler arm to frame mounting bolts (3).
- Tighten the idler arm to frame mounting bolts to 105 Nm (77 ft. lbs.).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Idler Arm > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 6830
3. Use the J29193 in order to install the relay rod to the idler arm ball stud.
Ensure that the seal is on the stud. Tighten the J29193 to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) in order to seat the tapers.
4. Remove the J29193.
5. Install the new prevailing torque nut (2) to the idler arm (4) ball stud.
- Tighten the prevailing torque nut to 47 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
6. Lower the vehicle. 7. Adjust the toe-in.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Pitman Arm > Component Information >
Specifications
Pitman Arm: Specifications
Pitman Arm to Steering Gear Nut 184 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Pitman Arm > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6834
Pitman Arm: Service and Repair
Pitman Arm Replacement
- Tools Required J 24319-B Steering Linkage and Tie Rod Puller
- J 29107-A Pitman Arm Puller
- J 29193 Steering Linkage Installer (12 mm)
Removal Procedure
Important: Use the proper tool in order to separate all of the ball joints.
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the prevailing torque nut (2) from the
connecting rod (1) ball stud at the pitman arm (3). Discard the prevailing torque nut (2).
3. Use the J24319-B in order to remove the connecting rod from the pitman arm. 4. Remove the
prevailing torque nut and the washer from the steering gear shaft.
- Discard the prevailing torque nut.
- Mark the pitman arm and the pitman shaft in order to permit proper alignment during assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Pitman Arm > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6835
Notice: Do not hammer on the pitman arm, pitman arm shaft or puller. Damage to the pitman arm
or steering gear may result.
5. Use the J29107-A in order to remove the pitman arm (1). 6. Inspect the ball stud threads for
damage. 7. Inspect the ball stud seals for excessive wear. 8. Clean the threads on the ball stud and
the ball stud nut.
Installation Procedure
1. Align the marks made on the pitman arm during removal in order to install the pitman arm on the
pitman shaft.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the washer and the new prevailing torque nut to the pitman shaft.
- Tighten the pitman arm prevailing torque nut to 250 Nm (185 ft. lbs.).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Pitman Arm > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6836
3. Use the J29193 in order to install the connecting rod ball stud to the pitman arm. Ensure that the
seal is on the stud.
- Tighten the J 29193 to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) in order to seat the tapers.
4. Remove the J 29193.
5. Install the new prevailing torque nut (2) to the connecting rod (1) ball stud at the pitman arm (3).
- Tighten the connecting rod to pitman arm prevailing torque nut to 62 Nm (48 ft. lbs.).
6. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair
Power Steering Bleeding: Service and Repair
Bleeding the Power Steering System
- Tools Required J 35555 Metal Mity vac
- J 43485 Power Steering Bleeder Adapter
Important: Hoses touching the frame, body, or engine may cause system noise.
1. Verify that the hoses do not touch any other part of the vehicle.
Important: Loose connections may not leak, but could allow air into the steering system.
2. Verify that all hose connections are tight.
Notice: If the power steering system has been serviced, an accurate fluid level reading cannot be
obtained unless air is bled from the steering system. The air in the fluid may cause pump cavitation
noise and may cause pump damage over a period of time.
Important: Maintain the fluid level throughout the bleed procedure.
3. Remove the pump reservoir cap.
Important: Use clean, new power steering fluid only.
4. Fill the pump reservoir with fluid to the FULL COLD level.
5. Attach the J 43485 to the J 35555 or equivalent. 6. Place the J 43485 on or in the pump
reservoir filler neck. 7. Apply a vacuum of 68 kPa (20 in Hg) maximum. 8. Wait 5 minutes. Typical
vacuum drop is 7 - 10 kPa (2 - 3 in Hg). If the vacuum does not remain steady, refer to Excessive
Vacuum Drop
Diagnosis.
9. Remove the J 43485 and the J 35555.
10. Reinstall the pump reservoir cap. 11. Start the engine. Allow the engine to idle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 6841
12. Turn off the engine. 13. Verify the fluid level. Repeat steps 11-13 until the fluid stabilizes.
Important: Do not turn steering wheel to lock.
14. Start the engine. Allow the engine to idle. 15. Turn the steering wheel 180-360 degrees in both
directions 5 times. 16. Switch the ignition off.
Notice: When adding fluid or making a complete fluid change, always use the proper power
steering fluid. Failure to use the proper fluid will cause hose and seal damage and fluid leaks.
17. Verify the fluid level.
18. Remove the pump reservoir cap.
19. Attach the J 43485 to the J 35555 or equivalent. 20. Place the J 43485 on or in the pump
reservoir filler neck. 21. Apply a vacuum of 68 kPa (20 in Hg) maximum. 22. Wait 5 minutes. 23.
Remove the J 43485 and the J 35555. 24. Verify the fluid level.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 6842
25. Reinstall the pump reservoir cap.
Excessive Vacuum Drop Diagnosis
1. If the vacuum continues to drop, remove the pressure and return hose from the pump. 2. Install
the plugs (1,2) supplied with the J 43485 into the pressure and return port.
3. Attach the J 43485 to the J 35555 or equivalent. 4. Place the J 43485 on or in the pump
reservoir filler neck. 5. Apply a vacuum of 68 kPa (20 in Hg) maximum. 6. If the vacuum drops
again, repair or replace the pump. If the vacuum holds steady, continue to check the other parts of
the steering system.
Important: Fluid must be free from bubbles and foam. Be aware of periodic bubbles that indicate a
loose connection or leaking O-ring seal in the return hose or the pressure hose. Fluid must be free
from discoloration.
7. Observe the fluid. 8. If condition persists, replace the following parts:
- The return hose clamps
- The return hose O-rings
- The pressure hose O-rings
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 6843
- The gear cylinder line O-rings
- The reservoir to pump O-ring
9. Repeat the bleed procedure from the beginning.
10. Drive the vehicle approximately 16 km (10 mi) in order to warm the system to operating
temperature. Evaluate vehicle on a smooth flat surface. 11. Verify the following conditions:
- There is smooth power assist.
- The vehicle operates quietly.
- The pump maintains the proper fluid level.
- There is not any leaking in the steering system.
- The fluid is free of foam or discoloration.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid >
Component Information > Specifications
Power Steering Fluid: Specifications
Power Steering System GM Power Steering Fluid (GM Part No. 1052884 - 1 pint, 1050017 - 1
quart, or equivalent).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Reservoir >
Component Information > Specifications
Power Steering Fluid Reservoir: Specifications
Remote Reservoir Mounting Bolts 35 inch lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Reservoir >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Reservoir Replacement - Off Vehicle
Power Steering Fluid Reservoir: Service and Repair Power Steering Reservoir Replacement - Off
Vehicle
Power Steering Reservoir Replacement -Off Vehicle
Disassembly Procedure
1. Drain the power steering fluid from the power steering pump. 2. Remove the pump mounting
studs (2). 3. Remove the connector and fitting assembly (4). 4. Remove the O-ring seal (3) from the
connector and fitting assembly (4). 5. If replacement is required, remove the control valve assembly
and the flow control spring from the pump housing assembly.
6. Remove the reservoir assembly (1) from the pump housing assembly (2).
7. Remove the O-ring seals (1), (4) and (5). 8. Remove the magnet (3). 9. Clean the magnet (3).
10. Inspect the Welch plug in the power steering pump housing (2). Do not remove. If the Welch
plug is deformed or dislodged, replace the power
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Reservoir >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Reservoir Replacement - Off Vehicle > Page 6852
steering pump.
Assembly Procedure
Important: Use new O-ring seals when assembling the power steering pump assembly.
1. Lubricate the O-ring seals (1), (4) and (5) with power steering fluid. 2. To install the control valve
assembly and flow control spring to the pump housing assembly (2); refer to Power Steering Pump
Flow Control Valve
Replacement - Off Vehicle.
3. Install the O-ring seals (1), (4) and (5) to the pump housing assembly (2). 4. Install the magnet
(3) to the pump housing assembly (2).
5. Connect the reservoir assembly (1) to the pump housing assembly (2). 6. Install the O-ring seal.
7. Install the connector and fitting assembly (4) to the pump housing (1).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Reservoir >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Reservoir Replacement - Off Vehicle > Page 6853
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
8. Install the pump mounting studs (2) to the pump housing (1).
- Tighten the pump mounting studs (2) to 58 Nm (43 ft. lbs.).
- Tighten the connector and fitting assembly (4) to 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Reservoir >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Reservoir Replacement - Off Vehicle > Page 6854
Power Steering Fluid Reservoir: Service and Repair Remote Power Steering Fluid Reservoir
Replacement
Remote Power Steering Fluid Reservoir Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Place drain pan under the vehicle. 2. Draw all of the fluid out of the reservoir in order to avoid
spills. 3. Disconnect the hydraulic brake booster hose from the power steering reservoir.
4. Disconnect the power steering reservoir to the power steering pump hose from the power
steering reservoir.
5. Remove the power steering reservoir mounting bolts.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Reservoir >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Reservoir Replacement - Off Vehicle > Page 6855
6. Remove the power steering reservoir.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the power steering reservoir.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the power steering reservoir mounting bolts.
- Tighten the power steering reservoir mounting bolts to 4 Nm (35 inch lbs.).
3. Connect the power steering reservoir to the power steering pump hose to the power steering
reservoir.
4. Connect the hydraulic brake booster hose to the power steering reservoir.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Reservoir >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Reservoir Replacement - Off Vehicle > Page 6856
5. Bleed the power steering system.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 03-02-32-047 >
Oct > 03 > Steering - Whistle Noise When Driving Straight
Power Steering Line/Hose: Customer Interest Steering - Whistle Noise When Driving Straight
Bulletin No.: 03-02-32-047
Date: October 23, 2003
TECHNICAL
Subject:
Whistle Noise from Front of Vehicle (Install Power Steering Hose Adapter)
Models: 2002-2003 Chevrolet Astro Van Models 2002-2003 GMC Safari Van Models
Condition
Some customers may comment on a whistle noise from the front of the vehicle, but noise will quit
when turning the steering wheel.
Cause
Interaction with the fluid flow through the pressure port and the poppet valve at the power steering
(PS) gear box may cause this condition.
Correction
Install an adapter and 0-ring to the PS gear box high pressure inlet using the following procedure.
1. Remove the return line from the PS gear box in order to gain access to the high pressure line.
2. Remove the high pressure line from the PS gear box.
3. Install the adapter and 0-ring to the PS gear box high pressure inlet.
Tighten Tighten to 27.5 N.m (21 lb ft).
4. Install the high pressure line and 0-ring to the adapter.
Tighten Tighten to 27.5 N.m (21 lb ft).
5. Install the return line and 0-ring to the PS gear box.
Tighten Tighten to 27.5 N.m (21 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 03-02-32-047 >
Oct > 03 > Steering - Whistle Noise When Driving Straight > Page 6865
6. Bleed the PS system.
7. Clean the area with brake cleaner.
8. Inspect for leaks.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Line/Hose: >
03-02-32-047 > Oct > 03 > Steering - Whistle Noise When Driving Straight
Power Steering Line/Hose: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering - Whistle Noise When Driving
Straight
Bulletin No.: 03-02-32-047
Date: October 23, 2003
TECHNICAL
Subject:
Whistle Noise from Front of Vehicle (Install Power Steering Hose Adapter)
Models: 2002-2003 Chevrolet Astro Van Models 2002-2003 GMC Safari Van Models
Condition
Some customers may comment on a whistle noise from the front of the vehicle, but noise will quit
when turning the steering wheel.
Cause
Interaction with the fluid flow through the pressure port and the poppet valve at the power steering
(PS) gear box may cause this condition.
Correction
Install an adapter and 0-ring to the PS gear box high pressure inlet using the following procedure.
1. Remove the return line from the PS gear box in order to gain access to the high pressure line.
2. Remove the high pressure line from the PS gear box.
3. Install the adapter and 0-ring to the PS gear box high pressure inlet.
Tighten Tighten to 27.5 N.m (21 lb ft).
4. Install the high pressure line and 0-ring to the adapter.
Tighten Tighten to 27.5 N.m (21 lb ft).
5. Install the return line and 0-ring to the PS gear box.
Tighten Tighten to 27.5 N.m (21 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Line/Hose: >
03-02-32-047 > Oct > 03 > Steering - Whistle Noise When Driving Straight > Page 6871
6. Bleed the PS system.
7. Clean the area with brake cleaner.
8. Inspect for leaks.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6872
Power Steering Line/Hose: Specifications
Power Steering Hose Fittings 20 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > P/S Cooler Pipe/Hose Replacement
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair P/S Cooler Pipe/Hose Replacement
Power Steering Cooler Pipe/Hose Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Disconnect the power steering cooler hose from the steering pump. 2. Raise the vehicle. Refer
to Vehicle Lifting. 3. Install a drain pan under the vehicle. 4. Disconnect the power steering cooler
pipe hose from the steering gear.
5. Remove the power steering cooler pipe (2) from the air baffle (3). 6. Remove the power steering
cooler pipe from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > P/S Cooler Pipe/Hose Replacement > Page 6875
1. Install the power steering cooler pipe to the vehicle. 2. Install the power steering cooler pipe (2)
to the air baffle (3).
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Connect the power steering cooler pipe to the steering gear.
- Tighten the power steering cooler pipe to the steering gear to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.).
4. Lower the vehicle. 5. Connect the power steering cooler hose to the steering pump. 6. Bleed the
power steering system.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > P/S Cooler Pipe/Hose Replacement > Page 6876
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Power Brake Booster Inlet Hose Replacement
Power Brake Booster Inlet Hose Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Disconnect the hydraulic brake booster
inlet hose from the of the power steering pump. 3. Lower the vehicle.
4. Disconnect the hydraulic brake booster inlet hose from the hydraulic brake booster. 5. Remove
the hydraulic brake booster inlet hose from vehicle.
Installation Procedure
Notice: Do not start the engine with any power steering hose disconnected, or damage to the
components could occur.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > P/S Cooler Pipe/Hose Replacement > Page 6877
1. Install the hydraulic brake booster inlet hose to vehicle. 2. Connect the hydraulic brake booster
inlet hose to the hydraulic brake booster. 3. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Connect the hydraulic brake booster inlet hose to the power steering pump.
- Tighten the hydraulic brake booster inlet hose to the power steering pump to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.).
5. Bleed the system.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > P/S Cooler Pipe/Hose Replacement > Page 6878
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Power Brake Booster Outlet Hose Replacement
Power Brake Booster Outlet Hose Replacement
Removal Procedure
Important: Note the position of all the tie-straps, power steering hoses and the hose insulators for
proper re-installation.
1. Remove the power brake booster outlet hose tie-straps. 2. Place a drain pan under the vehicle.
3. Disconnect the power steering cooler hose from the power steering gear. 4. Disconnect the
hydraulic brake booster outlet hose from the steering gear. 5. Disconnect the hydraulic brake
booster outlet hose from the hydraulic brake booster.
6. Remove the hydraulic brake booster outlet hose from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
Notice: Do not start the engine with any power steering hose disconnected, or damage to the
components could occur.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > P/S Cooler Pipe/Hose Replacement > Page 6879
1. Install the hydraulic brake booster outlet hose to the vehicle.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Connect the hydraulic brake booster outlet hose to the hydraulic brake booster.
- Tighten the hydraulic brake booster outlet hose to the hydraulic brake booster to 27 Nm (20 ft.
lbs.).
3. Connect the hydraulic brake booster outlet hose to the power steering gear.
- Tighten the hydraulic brake booster outlet hose to the power steering gear to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.).
4. Remove the drain pan. 5. Install the hydraulic brake booster outlet hose tie straps. 6. Bleed the
system.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Motor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Steering - Power Steering Pump Replacement Tips
Power Steering Motor: Technical Service Bulletins Steering - Power Steering Pump Replacement
Tips
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 06-02-32-013B
Date: August 07, 2009
Subject: Diagnostic Tips/Recommendations When Power Steering Pump Replacement is
Necessary
Models:
1997-2010 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER
H2, H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years and update the information. Please
discard Corporate Bulletin Number 06-02-32-013A (Section 02 - Steering).
A recently completed analysis of returned power steering (PS) pumps that had been replaced for
noise, no power assist, no or low pressure and leaking conditions has indicated a high number of
"No Trouble Found" results.
Corporate Bulletin Number 01-02-32-004 indicates that when attempting to repair a power steering
concern, the steering system analyzer should be utilized to assist the technician in a successful
diagnosis. Note- Saturn ASTRA does not utilize the Power Steering System Analyzer.
In addition, extensive warranty analysis has shown that the following situations are all significant
root causes of PS pump failures:
- Improper pulley installation
- Re-using the O-rings
- Using fluid other than the OE-specified steering fluid
- Failure to flush the PS system
In order to help improve customer satisfaction and reduce comebacks, GM recommends the
following tips for replacing a PS pump:
1. Low or no pressure from the PS pump may be the results of dirty or contaminated fluid, which
could cause the pressure relief valve to stop
functioning. Using the proper tools, flush and bleed the PS system. Any residual contaminants will
result in pump failure.
2. When removing the pulley, use the proper special tools. Because the pulley alignment is critical,
distorting the pulley may damage bearings on the
new PS pump.
Note Some new PS pumps may not include a new O-ring. Please refer to the appropriate Parts
Catalog. Saturn retailers should refer to the appropriate model year Parts & Illustration Catalog for
the vehicle.
3. Be sure to use only the new O-rings included with the PS pump. The new reservoir O-ring must
be lubricated with OE-specific PS fluid prior to
installation. Also make sure that the control valve O-ring is in its exact groove position and is NOT
covering the pressure bypass hole.
4. Bleed the PS system according to the procedures/recommendations in SI.
Following these procedures and using the correct tools and fluids should help ensure that the new
PS pump operates properly. Skipping steps may cost you time and trouble later.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump >
Component Information > Specifications
Power Steering Pump: Specifications
Power Steering Pump Control Valve Fitting 55 ft. lbs.
Power Steering Pump Mountings Bolts 37 ft. lbs.
Power Steering Pump Mounting Nut 30 ft. lbs.
Power Steering Pump Mounting Studs 43 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 6887
Power Steering Pump Disassembled View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 6888
Power Steering Pump: Testing and Inspection
Please see STEERING/TESTING and INSPECTION for information on this component.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump Flow Control Valve Replacement
Power Steering Pump: Service and Repair Power Steering Pump Flow Control Valve Replacement
Power Steering Pump Flow Control Valve Replacement - Off Vehicle
Disassembly Procedure
1. Drain the oil from the reservoir (1). 2. Remove the connector and fitting assembly (2). 3. Remove
the control valve assembly (4) from the pump housing (1). Make sure the flow control spring (5)
does not fall out of the pump housing
(1).
4. Remove and discard the O-ring seal (3) from the connector and fitting assembly (2).
Assembly Procedure
1. Install the flow control spring (5), if removed from the pump housing (1). 2. Lubricate the new
O-ring seal (3) with power steering fluid. 3. Install the O-ring seal (3) onto the connector and fitting
assembly (2). 4. Install the control valve assembly (4).
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
5. Install the connector and fitting assembly (2).
- Tighten the connector and fitting assembly to 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump Flow Control Valve Replacement > Page 6891
Power Steering Pump: Service and Repair Power Steering Pump Pulley Replacement
Power Steering Pulley Replacement
- Tools Required J 25034-C Power Steering Pump Pulley Remover
- J 25033-C Power Steering Pump Pulley Installer
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the lower fan shroud. 2. Remove the drive belt. 3. Remove the power steering pump
pulley using the J 25034-C.
Installation Procedure
1. Place the power steering pump pulley on the end of the power steering pump shaft. 2. Install the
power steering pump pulley using J 25033-C.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump Flow Control Valve Replacement > Page 6892
3. Ensure that the power steering pump pulley (1) is flush against the power steering pump shaft
(2), with an allowable variance of 0.25 mm (0.010
inch).
4. Install the drive belt. 5. Install the lower fan shroud.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump Flow Control Valve Replacement > Page 6893
Power Steering Pump: Service and Repair Power Steering Pump Replacement
Power Steering Pump Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the power steering pump pulley. 2. Place a drain pan under the vehicle.
Important: Cap or plug the ends of the power steering hoses to prevent fluid loss.
3. Disconnect the power brake booster inlet hose from the power brake booster.
4. Disconnect the power steering cooler hose from the power steering pump.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump Flow Control Valve Replacement > Page 6894
5. Disconnect the power steering pump remote reservoir hose from the power steering pump.
6. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 7. Remove the power steering pump rear
mounting bracket nut. 8. Lower the vehicle. 9. Loosen the accessory bracket bolts and nut. Pull the
accessory bracket forward.
10. Remove the power steering pump mounting bolts. 11. Remove the power steering pump and
the power brake booster inlet hose from the vehicle. 12. Remove the power brake booster inlet
hose from the power steering pump.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the power brake booster inlet hose to the power steering pump. 2. Install the power
steering pump and the power brake booster inlet hose to the vehicle.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the power steering pump mounting bolts.
- Tighten the power steering pump mounting bolts to 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs.).
4. Reposition the accessory mounting bracket and tighten the bolts and nut.
- Tighten the accessory mounting bracket bolts to 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs.).
- Tighten the accessory mounting bracket nut to 41 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump Flow Control Valve Replacement > Page 6895
5. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 6. Install the power steering pump rear mounting
bracket nut.
- Tighten the power steering pump rear mounting bracket nut to 41 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Uncap the ends of the power steering hoses. 9. Connect the power
steering pump remote reservoir hose to the power steering pump.
10. Connect the power steering cooler hose to the power steering pump.
11. Connect the power brake booster inlet hose to the power brake booster.
- Tighten the power brake booster inlet hose to the power brake booster to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.).
12. Remove the drain pan from under the vehicle. 13. Install the power steering pump pulley. 14.
Bleed the power steering system. 15. Inspect the power steering pump for leaks and the hoses for
proper clearance from the frame and from other components.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming
> System Information > Service and Repair > Disabling
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Disabling
IMPORTANT: Refer to SIR Service Precautions before disabling the SIR system.
1. Turn the steering wheel until the vehicle's wheels are pointing straight ahead. 2. Turn OFF the
ignition. 3. Remove the key from the ignition.
IMPORTANT: With the AIR BAG Fuse removed and the ignition ON, the AIR BAG indicator
illuminates. This is normal operation and does not indicate an SIR system malfunction.
4. Remove the AIR BAG Fuse from the IP fuse block. 5. Remove the sound insulator, if equipped.
6. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) from the steering wheel module yellow 2-way
connector (1) located at the base of the steering
column.
7. Disconnect the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector (1) located at the base of the
steering column.
8. Remove the instrument panel extension. 9. Remove the CPA (2) from the IP module yellow
2-way connector (1) located under the instrument panel extension.
10. Disconnect the IP module yellow 2-way connector (1) located under the instrument panel
extension.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming
> System Information > Service and Repair > Disabling > Page 6901
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Enabling
1. Remove the key from the ignition. 2. Connect the IP module yellow 2-way connector (1) located
under the instrument panel extension. 3. Install the connector position assurance (CPA) (2) to the
IP module yellow 2-way connector (1) located under the instrument panel extension. 4. Install the
instrument panel extension.
5. Connect the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector (1) located at the base of the
steering column. 6. Install the CPA to the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector (1)
located at the base of the steering column. 7. Install the sound insulator, if equipped. 8. Install the
AIR BAG Fuse to the IP fuse block. 9. Staying well away from the air bags, turn ON the ignition,
with the engine OFF.
9.1. The AIR BAG indicator will flash 7 times.
9.2. The AIR BAG indicator will then turn OFF.
10. Perform Diagnostic System Check - SIR if the AIR BAG indicator does not operate as
described.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Steering Gear Seal > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Steering Gear Seal: Service and Repair
Pitman Shaft Seal Replacement On Vehicle
- Tools Required J 4245 Internal Snap Ring Pliers
- J 6219 Pitman Shaft Seal Installer
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the pitman arm. 2. Remove the snap ring (1) using J 4245.
3. Remove the following components from the power steering gear (1):
3.1. The dust seal (5)
3.2. The return ring (4)
3.3. The washer (3)
3.4. The pitman shaft oil seal (2)
4. Inspect the Pitman shaft surface for roughness or pitting. Replace the pitman shaft if the shaft is
pitted. 5. Clean the pitman shaft and seal areas using a wire brush.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Steering Gear Seal > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 6906
1. Lubricate the new seals with grease. 2. Apply a single layer of tape to the pitman shaft in order
to avoid damaging the seals. 3. Install the pitman shaft oil seal (2) and washer (3) to the power
steering gear.
4. Use the J 6219 to install the pitman shaft seal and washer to the power steering gear.
The seal should be in far enough to install the return ring, dust seal, and the snap ring.
5. Install the return ring and the dust seal to the power steering gear. 6. Use J 6219 in order to seat
the return ring and the dust seal in the power steering gear.
7. Install the snap ring to the pitman shaft using J 4245. 8. Install the pitman arm.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft > Component Information >
Specifications
Steering Shaft: Specifications
Intermediate Shaft to Steering Gear Pinch Bolt 30 ft. lbs.
Intermediate Shaft to Steering Column Pinch Bolt 30 ft. lbs.
Intermediate Shaft to Steering Gear Pinch Bolt 30 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6910
Steering Shaft: Service and Repair
"For information regarding this component please refer to steering column service and repair"
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information >
Specifications
Steering Wheel: Specifications
Steering Wheel Nut 30 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6914
Steering Wheel: Description and Operation
STEERING WHEEL AND COLUMN
The steering wheel and column are designed to absorb energy when driver contact is made with
the steering wheel or inflated air bag. In a frontal collision the driver may contact the steering wheel
directly or load the steering wheel and column through the inflated air bag. When the driver applies
load to the air bag or steering wheel the column will compress downward absorbing some of the
impact, helping to reduce bodily injuries to the driver. The steering wheel and column must be
inspected for damage after a collision.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Component Information > Specifications
Tie Rod: Specifications
Adjuster Tube Clamp Bolts 18 ft. lbs.
Tie Rod to Relay Rod Nut 35 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 6918
Tie Rod: Service and Repair
Tie Rod Replacement
- Tools Required J 6627-A Tie Rod Puller
- J 24319-B Steering Linkage and Tie Rod Puller
- J 29193 Steering Linkage Installer (12 mm)
Removal Procedure
Important: Use the proper tool in order to separate all of the tie rods and the ball joints.
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the cotter pin and the castellated nut from
the outer tie rod. 3. Remove the prevailing torque nut from the inner tie rod.
Discard the prevailing torque nut.
Notice: Do not attempt to disconnect a steering linkage joint by driving a wedge between the joint
and the attached part. Seal damage may result which will cause premature failure of the joint.
4. Use the J 24319-B in order to remove the outer tie rod ball stud from the steering knuckle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 6919
5. Use the J 6627-A in order to remove the inner tie rod from the relay rod.
6. Loosen the adjuster tube clamp bolts (3). 7. Unscrew the tie rod ends from the adjuster tube (4).
8. Remove the inner tie rod ends (5) from the adjuster tube (4). 9. Inspect the following
components for damage:
- The threads on the tie rod (1, 5)
- The ball stud threads
- The adjuster tube (4) for bending or damaged threads
- The tie rod end seals for excessive wear
10. Clean the threads on the ball stud and in the ball stud nut. 11. Clean the tapered surfaces.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 6920
Lubricate the tie rod threads with chassis lubricant if the tie rod ends were removed from the
adjuster tube.
1. Loosen the clamps (2) on the adjuster tube (4). 2. Install the tie rod ends to the adjuster tube (4).
The number of threads on the inner tie rod (5) and the outer tie rod (1) ends must be equal within 3
threads.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Use the J29193 in order to install the inner tie rod to the relay rod.
Ensure that the seal is on the stud. Tighten the J 29193 to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) in order to seat the tapers.
4. Remove the J 29193. 5. Install the new prevailing torque nut to the inner tie rod.
- Tighten the prevailing torque nut to 47 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
6. Install the outer tie rod ball stud to the steering knuckle. Ensure that the seal is on the stud.
Important: Tighten the castellated nut up to an additional 1/6 amount in order to insert the cotter pin
through the outer tie rod ball stud. Do not back the nut off in order to align the cotter pin hole.
7. Install the castellated nut.
- Tighten the castellated nut to 47 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 6921
8. Install the new cotter pin. Bend the cotter pin ends flat against the nut flats. 9. Lower the vehicle.
10. Adjust the toe-in.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information >
Specifications
Ball Joint: Specifications
Ball Joint to Lower Control Arm 22 ft. lbs.
Lower Ball Joint to Steering Knuckle Nut 90 ft. lbs.
Lower Ball Joint Wear limit 0.125 in
Ball Joint to Upper Control Arm 22 ft. lbs.
Upper Ball Joint to Steering Knuckle Nut 61 ft. lbs.
Upper Ball Joint Wear Limit See Note
Disconnect the upper ball joint from the steering knuckle.
If you find any looseness or can twist the stud with your
fingers, replace the upper ball joint.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6926
Ball Joint: Testing and Inspection
Ball Joint Inspection
- Tools Required J 8001 Dial indicator
Important: The vehicle must rest on a level surface.
- The vehicle must be stable. Do not rock the vehicle on the jack stands.
- The upper control arm bumper must not contact the frame.
1. Raise and support the vehicle with safety stands. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Support the lower
control arm with a jack stand, as far outboard as possible, near the lower ball joint.
Important: If a seal is cut or torn, replace the ball joint.
3. Wipe the ball joints clean. Check the seals for cuts or tears. 4. Check the wheel bearings for
looseness. If looseness in the wheel bearings is present, refer to Wheel Bearings Diagnosis
(Sealed) or Wheel
Bearings Diagnosis (Tapered).
5. Check the ball joints for horizontal looseness.
5.1. Position the J 8001 dial indicator against the lowest outboard point on the wheel rim.
5.2. Rock the wheel in and out while reading the dial indicator. This shows horizontal looseness in
both joints.
5.3. The dial indicator reading should be no more than 3.18 mm (0.125 inch). If the reading is too
high, check the lower ball joints for vertical looseness.
6. Check the lower ball joints for wear and for vertical looseness using the following procedure:
6.1. Inspect by sight the lower ball joint for wear. The position of the housing into which the grease
fitting is threaded indicates wear. This round housing projects 1.27 mm (0.050 inch) beyond the
surface of the lower ball joint cover on a new ball joint Under normal wear, the surface of the lower
ball joint housing retreats inward very slowly.
6.2. First observe, then scrape a scale, screwdriver, or a fingernail across the cover. If the round
housing is flush with or inside of the cover surface, replace the lower ball joint.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6927
7. Place a J 8001 dial indicator (1) against the spindle in order to show vertical movement.
8. Pry between the lower control arm (2) and the outer bearing race (1) while reading the dial
indicator. This shows vertical looseness in the ball
joints. The lower ball joint is not preloaded and may show some looseness.
9. If the dial indicator reading is more than 3.18 mm (0.125 inch), replace the lower ball joint.
10. If the lower ball joint is within specifications, and there is too much horizontal looseness, check
the upper ball joint for wear.
10.1. Disconnect the upper ball joint from the steering knuckle.
10.2. If you find any looseness or can twist the stud with your fingers, replace the upper ball joint.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Lower Ball Joint
Ball Joint: Service and Repair Lower Ball Joint
Lower Ball Joint Replacement
- Tools Required J 9519-E Lower Ball Joint Remover and Installer Set
- J 23742 Ball Joint Separator
Removal Procedure
Caution: Floor jack must remain under the lower control arm during removal and Installation to
retain the lower control arm In position. Failure to do so could result in personal injury.
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Support the lower control arm with a safety stand.
3. Remove the tire and wheel.
4. Remove the lower ball joint cotter pin and the retaining nut. 5. Break the lower ball joint loose
from the steering knuckle using J 23742. 6. Remove J 23742. 7. Pull the steering knuckle free from
the lower ball joint. 8. Support the steering knuckle in order to prevent the steering knuckle weight
from damaging the brake hose. 9. Remove the rubber grease seal from the lower ball joint.
10. Remove the lower ball joint grease fining.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Lower Ball Joint > Page 6930
11. Remove the lower ball joint from the lower control arm using J9519-E.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the lower ball joint to the lower control arm. 2. Press the lower ball joint into the lower
control arm using J 9519-E. Press in until the ball joint bottoms in the control arm. 3. Install the
grease seal and the grease fitting to the lower ball joint.
- The grease-purge hole of the seal must face inboard.
- Press the grease seal into place. The seal must be fully seated on the ball joint.
4. Remove the steering knuckle support. 5. Install the lower ball joint to the steering knuckle.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
6. Install the lower ball joint retaining nut.
- Tighten the lower ball joint retaining nut to 125 Nm (90 ft. lbs.).
7. Install a new cotter pin. Tighten the nut up to an additional 1/6 amount in order to insert the
cotter pin through the lower ball joint stud. Bend the
pin ends against the nut flats.
8. Using a grease gun, grease to the lower ball joint until grease appears at the lower ball joint
grease seal. 9. Install the tire and wheel.
10. Remove the safety stand from the lower control arm. 11. Lower the vehicle. 12. Check the front
wheel alignment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Lower Ball Joint > Page 6931
Ball Joint: Service and Repair Upper Ball Joint
Upper Ball Joint Replacement
- Tools Required J 23742 Ball Joint Separator
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting.
Caution: Floor jack must remain under the lower control arm during removal and installation to
retain the lower control arm in position. Failure to do so could result in personal injury.
2. Support the lower control arm with a safety stand. 3. Remove the tire and wheel.
4. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor connector from the upper control arm. 5. Remove the cotter
pin and the upper ball joint retaining nut.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Lower Ball Joint > Page 6932
6. Separate the upper ball joint from the steering knuckle using J 23742. Apply pressure on the tool
until the stud breaks loose. 7. Remove J 23742. 8. Pull the steering knuckle free from the upper
ball joint. 9. Support the steering knuckle in order to prevent the steering knuckle weight from
damaging the brake hose.
10. Use a 3.175 mm (1/8 inch) drill bit in order to cut 6.35 mm (1/4 inch) deep holes in the center of
each rivet head.
11. Drill away the rivet heads using a 12.7 mm (1/2 inch) drill bit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Lower Ball Joint > Page 6933
12. Using a small pin punch, punch out the rivets. 13. Remove the upper ball joint from the upper
control arm.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the upper ball joint to the upper control arm.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the upper ball joint to upper control arm mounting bolts and nuts.
- Tighten the upper ball joint to upper control arm mounting nuts to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
3. Remove the steering knuckle support.
4. Connect the upper ball joint to the steering knuckle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Lower Ball Joint > Page 6934
5. Install the upper ball joint retaining nut.
- Tighten the upper ball joint retaining nut to 83 Nm (61 ft. lbs.).
6. Install a new cotter pin. Tighten the nut up to an additional 1/6 amount in order to insert the
cotter pin through the upper ball joint stud. Bend the
pin ends flat against the nut flats.
7. Connect the wheel speed sensor connector. 8. Install the upper ball joint grease fitting. 9. Using
a grease gun, grease the upper ball joint until grease appears at the upper ball joint grease seal.
10. Install the tire and wheel. 11. Remove the safety stands from the lower control arm. 12. Lower
the vehicle. 13. Check the front wheel alignment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Control Arm Bushing >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Control Arm Bushing: Service and Repair
Upper Control Arm Bushings Replacement
- Tools Required J 22269-01 Accumulator and Servo Piston Remover
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the upper control arm. 2. Mount the upper control arm in a vise. 3. Remove the upper
control arm shaft nuts and the retainers.
4. Remove the upper control arm bushings. Use the J22269-01, a slotted washer, and a short
piece of pipe slightly larger than the bushing.
5. Remove the upper control arm shaft from the upper control arm.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Control Arm Bushing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 6939
1. Install the upper control arm shaft into the upper control arm.
2. Install the upper control arm bushings into the upper control arm. Use the J 22269-01 and a
short piece of pipe that is the same outer diameter as
the rubber bushing.
3. Tighten the J 22269-01 until the bushing is positioned on the shaft and the control arm as
shown. The measurement should be 12.1 - 13.8 mm
(0.48 - 0.52 inch) on both ends.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Control Arm Bushing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 6940
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the upper control arm shah retainers and the retaining nuts.
- Tighten the upper control arm shaft retaining nuts to 115 Nm (85 ft. lbs.).
5. Install the upper control arm to the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Frame and Underbody
Cross-Member: Service and Repair Frame and Underbody
Crossmember Brace Replacement - Front
Removal Procedure
1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle (See: Wheels
and Tires/Vehicle Lifting/Service and Repair) in
General Information.
2. Remove the bolts that retain the forward edge of the crossmember brace to the frame. 3.
Remove the bolts and the nuts that retain the rear edge of the crossmember brace to the frame. 4.
Remove the crossmember brace from the frame.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the crossmember brace to the frame.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the bolts and the nuts in order to retain the rear edge of the crossmember brace to the
frame.
Tighten the crossmember brace to the frame bolts and the nuts to 35 N.m (26 lb ft).
3. Install the bolts that retain the forward edge of the crossmember brace to the frame.
Tighten the crossmember brace to the frame bolts to 35 N.m (26 lb ft).
4. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Frame and Underbody > Page 6945
Cross-Member: Service and Repair Frame Stop Replacement
Frame Stop Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle (See: Wheels
and Tires/Vehicle Lifting/Service and Repair) in
General Information.
2. Remove the bolts that retain the frame stop to the frame. 3. Remove the frame stop.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the frame stop.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the bolts that retain the frame stop to the frame.
Tighten the bolts that retain the frame stop to 35 N.m (26 lb ft).
3. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Frame and Underbody > Page 6946
Cross-Member: Service and Repair Transmission Support Replacement
Transmission Support Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle (See: Wheels
and Tires/Vehicle Lifting/Service and Repair) in
General Information.
2. Support the transmission with a transmission jack. 3. Remove the two nuts securing the
transmission mount to the transmission support.
4. Remove the transmission support nuts and bolts. 5. Remove the transmission support from the
vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the transmission support to the vehicle.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the transmission support nuts and bolts.
Tighten the nuts and bolts to 70 N.m (52 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Frame and Underbody > Page 6947
3. Install the two nuts securing the transmission mount to the transmission support.
Tighten the nuts to 40 N.m (30 lb ft).
4. Remove the transmission jack. 5. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information
> Specifications
Front Steering Knuckle: Specifications
Steering Knuckle to Tie Rod End Nut 35 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 6951
Front Steering Knuckle: Service and Repair
Steering Knuckle Replacement
- Tools Required J 24319-B Steering Linkage and Tie Rod Puller
- J 23742 Ball Joint Separator
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting.
Caution: Floor jack must remain under the lower control arm during removal and installation to
retain the lower control arm in position. Failure to do so could result in personal injury.
2. Support the lower control arm with a safety stand. 3. Remove the tire and wheel. 4. Remove the
wheel hub and bearing assembly.
5. Remove the outer tie rod to steering knuckle retaining nut.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 6952
6. Disconnect the tie rod end from the steering knuckle using J 24319-B.
7. Remove the steering knuckle gasket only if the steering knuckle is being repaired or replaced.
8. Remove the upper and lower control arms cotter pins and the retaining nuts.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 6953
9. Remove the upper ball joint stud from the steering knuckle using J 23742.
10. Raise the upper control arm. Disengage the upper ball joint from the steering knuckle.
11. Disconnect the steering knuckle from the lower ball joint using J 23742. 12. Remove the
steering knuckle from the vehicle. 13. Clean the steering knuckle with solvent, then air dry. 14.
Inspect the steering knuckle tapered holes that attach to the ball joints and the outer tie rod.
Replace the steering knuckle if any of the 3 holes are
out-of-round, deformed, or damaged.
15. Inspect the spindle for wear or damage.
Installation Procedure
1. Connect the steering knuckle to the lower ball joint. Press the steering knuckle onto the lower
ball joint until the lower ball joint is fully seated. 2. Connect the steering knuckle to the upper ball
joint. Lower the upper control arm in order to seat the upper ball joint into the steering knuckle.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 6954
3. Install the upper and lower ball joint retaining nuts.
- Tighten the upper ball joint retaining nut to 83 Nm (61 ft. lbs.).
- Tighten the lower ball joint retaining nut to 125 Nm (90 ft. lbs.).
4. Install new cotter pins. Tighten the upper and lower ball joint nuts up to an additional 1/6 amount
to insert the cotter pin through the nuts. Bend the
cotter pin flat against the nut.
5. Install the steering knuckle gasket, if necessary.
6. Connect the outer tie rod to the steering knuckle. 7. Install the outer tie rod retaining nut.
- Tighten the outer tie rod retaining nut to 47 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
8. Install the rotor/hub assembly. 9. Install the tire and wheel.
10. Remove the safety stand from the lower control arm. 11. Lower the vehicle. 12. Check the front
wheel alignment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Bushing
> Component Information > Service and Repair
Stabilizer Bushing: Service and Repair
Stabilizer Shaft Insulator Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the stabilizer shaft insulator bracket bolts.
3. Remove the stabilizer shaft insulator bracket. 4. Using a pry bar, lower the stabilizer shaft. 5.
Remove the stabilizer shaft insulator.
Installation Procedure
1. Using a pry bar, lower the stabilizer shaft. 2. Install the stabilizer shaft insulator to the stabilizer
shaft. Position the slit on the stabilizer shaft insulator toward the front of the vehicle. 3. Install the
stabilizer shaft bracket over the stabilizer shaft insulator.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the stabilizer shaft bracket retaining bolts.
- Tighten the stabilizer shaft bracket retaining bolts to 36 Nm (27 ft. lbs.).
5. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Link >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Stabilizer Link: Service and Repair
Stabilizer Shaft Link Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the tire and wheel. 3. Remove the
stabilizer shaft link nut. 4. Remove the retainer and insulator from the stabilizer shaft link bolt. 5.
Remove the stabilizer shaft link bolt, retainers, insulators, and stabilizer shaft link by pulling the bolt
down through the stabilizer shaft and lower
control arm.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the retainer and the insulator to the stabilizer shaft link bolt. Position the parts correctly. 2.
Install the stabilizer shaft link bolt through the lower control arm hole. 3. Install the stabilizer shaft
link retainers, insulators, and stabilizer shaft link to the stabilizer shaft link bolt. 4. Insert the
stabilizer shaft link bolt through the stabilizer shaft and install the stabilizer shaft link insulator and
retainer. 5. Install the stabilizer shaft link bolts through the stabilizer shaft. 6. Install the insulators
and retainers to the stabilizer shaft link bolt.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
7. Install the stabilizer shaft link retaining nut to the stabilizer shaft link bolt.
^ Tighten the stabilizer shaft link retaining nut to 17 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
8. Install the tire and wheel. 9. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ): > 00-03-09-001A > Jul >
03 > Drivetrain - Booming Noise at Highway Speeds
Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ): Customer Interest Drivetrain - Booming Noise at Highway
Speeds
Bulletin No.: 00-03-09-001A
Date: July 29, 2003
TECHNICAL
Subject: Rolling Boom Noise Inside Vehicle (Install Pinion Nose Damper and/or New Rear Leaf
Spring Dampers)
Models: 1995-2004 Chevrolet Astro Van Models 1995-2004 GMC Safari Van Models
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
00-03-09-001 (Section 03 - Suspension).
Condition
Some owners may comment about a "boom" noise inside the vehicle while driving at speeds
ranging between 97-105 km/h (60-65 mph). This condition is most noticeable from behind the
driver's seat.
Cause
The condition may result from an engine-firing harmonic, which becomes noticeable at torque
converter clutch (TCC) lock-up.
Correction
A new rear leaf spring damper kit (one per spring) has been developed, to be used in conjunction
with a pinion nose damper tuned to 86 Hertz (Hz), to reduce the resultant noise level.
AFFECTED VEHICLES MAY REQUIRE THE INSTALLATION OF THE PINION NOSE DAMPER,
THE SPRING DAMPERS, OR BOTH. THE INSTALLATION OF EITHER OF THESE DAMPERS IS
AT THE DISCRETION OF THE TECHNICIAN FOR BEST RESULTS. Use the following
procedures and the appropriate part number listed below.
Important:
Installation of these dampers will not totally eliminate the boom noise. The boom noise may only be
reduced to a more acceptable level. There may be other boom noises, such as body or exhaust,
associated with the vehicle and this fix may either diminish or enhance the noise. These other
noises should be addressed prior to the correction for the TCC boom dampener being installed.
Pinion Nose Damper Installation Procedure
Use Damper Kit, Rr. Axle Vib., P/N 15006567, for this procedure.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ): > 00-03-09-001A > Jul >
03 > Drivetrain - Booming Noise at Highway Speeds > Page 6970
1. Place the template (1), P/N 15005879, on the bottom surface of the triangular flanged portion of
the rear axle.
2. Mark the hole locations.
3. Using a pin punch (1), mark the center location of the holes.
4. Drill a 11 mm (0.44 in) diameter hole in two places.
5. Clean out the holes, including the top and bottom surface of the axle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ): > 00-03-09-001A > Jul >
03 > Drivetrain - Booming Noise at Highway Speeds > Page 6971
6. Install the rear axle pinion nose damper (1), P/N 15005880.
7. Install the rear axle pinion nose damper washers (2), P/N 15614758, and the nuts (3), P/N
11516072.
Tighten
Tighten each nut to 37-53 N.m (27-39 lb ft).
8. Rotate the driveshaft in order to verify that there is no contact between the driveshaft and the
pinion nose damper.
9. Test drive the vehicle. Inspect for contact between the driveshaft and the damper.
Rear Leaf Spring Damper Installation Procedure
Use Damper Kit, Rear Spring Vib., P/N 15042486, for this procedure.
1. Raise the vehicle. Support the rear axle. Refer to the General Information subsection of the
appropriate Service Manual for lifting and jacking information.
2. Remove the leaf spring. Refer to the Rear Suspension subsection of the appropriate Service
Manual for leaf spring replacement procedures.
3. Locate the rear spring clip closest to the shackle. This clip maintains the alignment of the rear
spring plates # 1 and # 2.
Note:
Do not damage the top surfaces of the # 1 and # 2 spring plates. Damage may cause premature
spring breakage.
4. Insert a wood wedge, no metal or sharp objects, between rear spring plates # 1 and # 2, located
forward of the clip. Allow enough clearance to work around. This should maximize the gap between
spring plates # 1 and # 2.
5. Grind off or, using an 11 mm (0.44 in) drill bit, drill out the rivet head holding the clip to the # 2
spring plate.
6. Remove the clip and the plastic clip liner from the spring assembly. Discard the spring clip only.
7. Knock out any remaining rivet residue from spring plate # 2.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ): > 00-03-09-001A > Jul >
03 > Drivetrain - Booming Noise at Highway Speeds > Page 6972
8. Insert the stud bolt (2), P/N 15042491, from the top of spring plate # 2 (3) so that the bolt head
sits into the hole's counter sink.
9. Place the spring clip (1), P/N 15042492, over the stud so that the clip is in a similar position as
the original clip removed previously. Do not close the clip at this time.
10. Install the damper (8), P/N 15042487, onto the stud. Install the damper completely onto the
stud so that the clip is securely trapped between the # 2 spring plate (bottom) and the damper inner
sleeve.
Tighten
Tighten the damper to 30 N.m (22 lb ft) while holding the stud.
11. Install the jam nut (6), P/N 11508189, onto the stud until the nut is against the inner sleeve of
the damper.
Tighten
Tighten the nut to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
Note:
Do not break the clip liner or damage the top surface of the # 1 spring plate.
12. Install the plastic clip liner in the same orientation as when removed. The bolt head may stick
up above the top surface of the spring plate.
13. Remove the wood wedge.
14. Using a press or a vise, close the clip to the same position as the removed clip. The maximum
width of the installed clip is 91.5 mm (3.6 in) and the maximum height is 46.5 mm (1.8 in). This
ensures proper clearance to the body rails.
15. Install the leaf spring onto the vehicle. Refer to the Rear Suspension subsection of the
appropriate Service Manual for leaf spring replacement procedures.
16. Repeat steps 2-15 for the other spring.
Parts Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ): > 00-03-09-001A > Jul >
03 > Drivetrain - Booming Noise at Highway Speeds > Page 6973
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ): >
00-03-09-001A > Jul > 03 > Drivetrain - Booming Noise at Highway Speeds
Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ): All Technical Service Bulletins Drivetrain - Booming Noise at
Highway Speeds
Bulletin No.: 00-03-09-001A
Date: July 29, 2003
TECHNICAL
Subject: Rolling Boom Noise Inside Vehicle (Install Pinion Nose Damper and/or New Rear Leaf
Spring Dampers)
Models: 1995-2004 Chevrolet Astro Van Models 1995-2004 GMC Safari Van Models
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
00-03-09-001 (Section 03 - Suspension).
Condition
Some owners may comment about a "boom" noise inside the vehicle while driving at speeds
ranging between 97-105 km/h (60-65 mph). This condition is most noticeable from behind the
driver's seat.
Cause
The condition may result from an engine-firing harmonic, which becomes noticeable at torque
converter clutch (TCC) lock-up.
Correction
A new rear leaf spring damper kit (one per spring) has been developed, to be used in conjunction
with a pinion nose damper tuned to 86 Hertz (Hz), to reduce the resultant noise level.
AFFECTED VEHICLES MAY REQUIRE THE INSTALLATION OF THE PINION NOSE DAMPER,
THE SPRING DAMPERS, OR BOTH. THE INSTALLATION OF EITHER OF THESE DAMPERS IS
AT THE DISCRETION OF THE TECHNICIAN FOR BEST RESULTS. Use the following
procedures and the appropriate part number listed below.
Important:
Installation of these dampers will not totally eliminate the boom noise. The boom noise may only be
reduced to a more acceptable level. There may be other boom noises, such as body or exhaust,
associated with the vehicle and this fix may either diminish or enhance the noise. These other
noises should be addressed prior to the correction for the TCC boom dampener being installed.
Pinion Nose Damper Installation Procedure
Use Damper Kit, Rr. Axle Vib., P/N 15006567, for this procedure.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ): >
00-03-09-001A > Jul > 03 > Drivetrain - Booming Noise at Highway Speeds > Page 6979
1. Place the template (1), P/N 15005879, on the bottom surface of the triangular flanged portion of
the rear axle.
2. Mark the hole locations.
3. Using a pin punch (1), mark the center location of the holes.
4. Drill a 11 mm (0.44 in) diameter hole in two places.
5. Clean out the holes, including the top and bottom surface of the axle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ): >
00-03-09-001A > Jul > 03 > Drivetrain - Booming Noise at Highway Speeds > Page 6980
6. Install the rear axle pinion nose damper (1), P/N 15005880.
7. Install the rear axle pinion nose damper washers (2), P/N 15614758, and the nuts (3), P/N
11516072.
Tighten
Tighten each nut to 37-53 N.m (27-39 lb ft).
8. Rotate the driveshaft in order to verify that there is no contact between the driveshaft and the
pinion nose damper.
9. Test drive the vehicle. Inspect for contact between the driveshaft and the damper.
Rear Leaf Spring Damper Installation Procedure
Use Damper Kit, Rear Spring Vib., P/N 15042486, for this procedure.
1. Raise the vehicle. Support the rear axle. Refer to the General Information subsection of the
appropriate Service Manual for lifting and jacking information.
2. Remove the leaf spring. Refer to the Rear Suspension subsection of the appropriate Service
Manual for leaf spring replacement procedures.
3. Locate the rear spring clip closest to the shackle. This clip maintains the alignment of the rear
spring plates # 1 and # 2.
Note:
Do not damage the top surfaces of the # 1 and # 2 spring plates. Damage may cause premature
spring breakage.
4. Insert a wood wedge, no metal or sharp objects, between rear spring plates # 1 and # 2, located
forward of the clip. Allow enough clearance to work around. This should maximize the gap between
spring plates # 1 and # 2.
5. Grind off or, using an 11 mm (0.44 in) drill bit, drill out the rivet head holding the clip to the # 2
spring plate.
6. Remove the clip and the plastic clip liner from the spring assembly. Discard the spring clip only.
7. Knock out any remaining rivet residue from spring plate # 2.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ): >
00-03-09-001A > Jul > 03 > Drivetrain - Booming Noise at Highway Speeds > Page 6981
8. Insert the stud bolt (2), P/N 15042491, from the top of spring plate # 2 (3) so that the bolt head
sits into the hole's counter sink.
9. Place the spring clip (1), P/N 15042492, over the stud so that the clip is in a similar position as
the original clip removed previously. Do not close the clip at this time.
10. Install the damper (8), P/N 15042487, onto the stud. Install the damper completely onto the
stud so that the clip is securely trapped between the # 2 spring plate (bottom) and the damper inner
sleeve.
Tighten
Tighten the damper to 30 N.m (22 lb ft) while holding the stud.
11. Install the jam nut (6), P/N 11508189, onto the stud until the nut is against the inner sleeve of
the damper.
Tighten
Tighten the nut to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
Note:
Do not break the clip liner or damage the top surface of the # 1 spring plate.
12. Install the plastic clip liner in the same orientation as when removed. The bolt head may stick
up above the top surface of the spring plate.
13. Remove the wood wedge.
14. Using a press or a vise, close the clip to the same position as the removed clip. The maximum
width of the installed clip is 91.5 mm (3.6 in) and the maximum height is 46.5 mm (1.8 in). This
ensures proper clearance to the body rails.
15. Install the leaf spring onto the vehicle. Refer to the Rear Suspension subsection of the
appropriate Service Manual for leaf spring replacement procedures.
16. Repeat steps 2-15 for the other spring.
Parts Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ): >
00-03-09-001A > Jul > 03 > Drivetrain - Booming Noise at Highway Speeds > Page 6982
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6983
Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ): Service and Repair
Front Coil Springs Replacement
- Tools Required J 23028-01 Coil Spring Remover and Installer
Removal Procedure
Notice: Use care when handling the coil springs in order to avoid chipping or scratching the
coating. Damage to the coating will result in premature failure of the coil springs.
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. The lower control arms must hang free. 2. Remove
the shock absorber.
Caution: Tool J23028-01 should be secured to a suitable jack or personal injury could result.
3. Secure the J23028-01 to a suitable jack. Position the J23028-01 so the tool cradles the inner
bushings. 4. Remove the stabilizer shaft link.
5. Raise the jack, under the J23028-01 in order to relieve tension from the lower control arm bolts.
6. Remove the lower control arm bolts and the nuts. Remove the rear bolt and the rear nut first.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6984
7. Lower the lower control arm by lowering the jack slowly to relieve the tension of the coil spring.
Important: Do not apply force on the lower control arm or the lower ball joint in order to remove the
coil spring. Proper maneuvering of the coil spring will allow for easy removal.
8. After all compression is removed from the coil spring, remove the coil spring and coil spring
insulators from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the coil spring and the coil spring insulators to the lower control arm.
- The insulators must be in place on the top and bottom of the coil spring.
- Install the coil spring with the identification tape towards the lower control arm.
- Align the edge of the coil spring with the edge of the insulator. Align the insulator and the drain
hole.
- The end of the lower spring coil must cover all or part of one inspection drain hole. The other
drain hole must be partially exposed or completely uncovered.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6985
Caution: Tool J 23028 01 should be secured to a suitable jack or personal injury could result.
2. Support the lower control arm with J 23028-01. 3. Raise the jack to install the lower control arm
so that the bushings match up to the proper holes in the frame.
Insure that the coil spring is properly seated in the upper control arm.
4. Install the lower control arm bolts and nuts.
- Install the front bolt first, then the rear bolt.
- Install the bolts in the proper direction.
- Tighten the nuts, but do not torque.
5. Remove the J23028-01 from the vehicle. 6. Install the stabilizer shaft link. 7. Install the shock
absorber.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
8. Lower the vehicle.
8.1. Tighten the lower control arm front nut to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs.), with the vehicle weight on the
wheels.
8.2. Tighten the lower control arm rear nut to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs.), with the vehicle weight on the
wheels.
9. Check the front wheel alignment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Suspension - Shock Absorber/Strut Leakage Information
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Technical Service Bulletins Suspension - Shock
Absorber/Strut Leakage Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 05-03-08-002C
Date: October 16, 2009
Subject: Information on Replacement of Shock Absorbers and Struts Due to Fluid Leaks
Models:
2010 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2010 model year and Inspection Procedures.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-08-002B (Section 03 - Suspension).
This bulletin is intended to help identify the severity of shock absorber and strut fluid seepage.
Improper diagnosis may lead to components being replaced that are within the manufacturer's
specification. Shock absorbers and strut assemblies are fluid-filled components and will normally
exhibit some seepage. Seepage is defined as oil film or dust accumulation on the exterior of the
shock housing. Shock absorbers and struts are not to be replaced under warranty for seepage.
Use the following information to determine if the condition is normal acceptable seepage or a
defective component.
Important Electronically controlled shock absorbers (MR) may have a tendency to attract dust to
this oil film. Often this film and dust can be wiped off and will not return until similar mileage is
accumulated again.
Inspection Procedure
Note
The shock absorber or strut assembly DOES NOT have to be removed from the vehicle to perform
the following inspection procedure.
Use the following descriptions and graphics to determine the serviceability of the component.
Shock Absorbers
Do Not Replace shock absorbers displaying condition 1 or 2 levels of seepage.
1. Oil or fluid residue only on the bottom or top of the shock absorber and not originating from the
shaft seal (the upper part of the lower shock tube). 2. Light film/residue on approximately 1/3 (a) or
less of the lower shock tube (A) and originating from the shaft seal.
Replace shock absorbers displaying conditions 3 and 4 levels of leaks.
3. Oil drip or trail down the lower shock tube and originating from the shaft seal. 4. An extreme wet
film of oil covering more than 1/3 (b) of the lower shock tube and originating from the shaft seal.
Coil-over Shock Absorber
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Suspension - Shock Absorber/Strut Leakage Information > Page 6990
Do Not Replace coil-over shock absorbers displaying condition 1 or 2 levels of seepage.
1. Oil or fluid residue only on the bottom of the lower shock absorber tube or the coil-over shock
absorber components and not originating from the
shaft seal (located at the top of the coil-over shock tube).
2. Light film/residue on the shock absorber tube, but not on the spring seat and originating from the
shaft seal.
Replace coil-over shock absorbers displaying conditions 3 and 4 levels of leaks.
3. Oil drip or trail down the lower shock tube and originating from the shaft seal. 4. An extreme, wet
film of oil covering the shock absorber tube and pooling in the spring seat and originating from the
shaft seal.
Struts
Do Not Replace Struts displaying condition 1 or 2 levels of seepage.
1. Oil or fluid residue only on the bottom of the strut tube or on other strut components and not
originating from the shaft seal. 2. Light film/residue on the strut tube, but not on the spring seat and
originating from the shaft seal.
Replace Struts displaying conditions 3 and 4 levels of leaks.
3. Oil drip or trail down the strut tube and originating from the shaft seal (located at the top of the
strut tube). 4. Extreme wet film of oil covering the strut tube and pooling in the spring seat and
originating from the shaft seal.
Correction
Use the information published in SI for diagnosis and repair.
Use the applicable published labor operation.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6991
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Specifications
Shock Absorber Lower Attaching Screws 18 ft. lbs.
Shock Absorber Upper Attaching Nut 15 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6992
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Service and Repair
Shock Absorber Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the tire and wheel. 3. Remove the shock
absorber mounting nut, the retainer, and the insulator. Hold the shock absorber upper stem in order
to keep the stem from
turning. A hex is provided on the end of the stem for this purpose.
4. Remove the shock absorber mounting screws. The nuts will remain attached to the lower control
arm. 5. Pull the shock absorber out through the hole in the lower control arm.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the shock absorber, fully extended, up through the hole in the lower control arm.
- The lower retainer and the insulator must be attached to the shock absorber upper stem before
positioning the shock absorber.
- The shock absorber upper stem will pass through the mounting hole in the upper control arm
frame bracket.
2. Install the upper insulator, the retainer, and the shock absorber mounting nut over the shock
absorber upper stem.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the shock absorber mounting screws through the holes in the lower control arm.
3.1. Make sure the nuts are aligned properly.
3.2. Tighten the shock absorber mounting nut to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.), while holding the upper stem of
the shock absorber.
3.3. Tighten the shock absorber mounting screws to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
4. Install the tire and wheel. 5. Lower the vehicle. 6. Dispose of the shock absorber.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Specifications
Wheel Bearing: Specifications
"Information not supplied by the manufacturer"
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed
Wheel Bearing: Testing and Inspection Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed
Wheel Bearings Diagnosis (Sealed)
- Tools Required J 8001 Dial Indicator
The following procedure describes how to inspect the wheel bearing/hub for excessive looseness.
If you are inspecting the wheel bearing/hub for excessive runout, refer to Tire and Wheel Assembly
Runout Measurement - On-Vehicle.
Important: If you are inspecting the FRONT wheel bearing/hub, support the front of the vehicle by
the lower control arms in order to load the lower ball joint.
1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Mount and secure the J 8001 to a
stand. 3. Ensure that the J 8001 contacts the vertical surface of the wheel as close as possible to
the top wheel stud. 4. Push and pull on the TOP of the tire. 5. Inspect the total movement indicated
by the J 8001. 6. If the measurement exceeds 0.127 mm (0.005 inch), replace the wheel
bearing/hub.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed > Page 6998
Wheel Bearing: Testing and Inspection Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Tapered
Wheel Bearings Diagnosis (Tapered)
Tapered Roller Bearing Diagnosis
The following procedure describes how to inspect the wheel bearing for excessive looseness. If
excessive wheel bearing looseness is present, adjust the wheel bearings. If excessive looseness is
still present after adjustment, inspect the wheel bearings. Consider the following factors when
diagnosing the wheel bearing condition: General condition of the following parts during disassembly and inspection: Wheel bearings
- Races
- Seals
- Lubricant
- Steering Knuckle
- Classify the failure of the wheel bearing with the aid of the illustrations.
- Determine the cause of the wheel bearing failure.
- Replace the damaged parts.
Abrasive Roller Wear
The pattern on the races and the rollers is caused by fine abrasives. 1. Clean all of the parts and
the housings. 2. Check the seals and the bearings. 3. Replace leaky seals, rough, or noisy
bearings.
Abrasive Step Wear
The pattern on the roller ends is caused by fine abrasives. 1. Clean all of the parts and the
housings. 2. Check the seals and the bearings. 3. Replace leaky seals, rough, or noisy bearings.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed > Page 6999
Galling
The metal smears on the roller ends are due to overheating, lubricant failure, or lubricant overload.
1. Check the seals. 2. Check for proper lubrication. 3. Clean all of the parts and the housings. 4.
Replace the bearing.
Etching
The bearing surfaces appear gray or grayish black in color, with related etching away of material
usually at roller spacing. 1. Check the seals. 2. Check for proper lubrication. 3. Clean all of the
parts and the housings. 4. Replace the bearings.
Bent Cage
When a cage is damaged due to improper handling or improper tool usage. Replace the bearing.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed > Page 7000
Bent Cage
The cage may be damaged due to improper handling or improper tool usage. Replace the bearing.
Cage Wear
The wear around the outside diameter of the cage and the roller pockets is caused by abrasive
material or inefficient lubrication. 1. Check the seals. 2. Clean all the parts and the housings. 3.
Replace the bearings.
Indentations
The surface depressions on the race and the rollers are caused by hard particles of foreign matter.
1. Check the seals. 2. Clean all the parts and the housings. 3. Replace the bearings.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed > Page 7001
Frettage
The corrosion caused by small relative movement of parts with no lubrication. 1. Check the seals.
2. Check for proper lubrication. 3. Clean all the parts and the housings. 4. Replace the bearings.
Smears
The smearing of the metal is due to slippage. Slippage can be caused by the following factors: Poor fits
- Lubrication
- Overheating
- Overloads
- Handling damage
If this condition occurs, perform the following: 1. Check the seals. 2. Check for proper fit. 3. Check
for proper lubrication. 4. Clean all the parts and the housings. 5. Replace the bearings.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed > Page 7002
Stain Discoloration
The discoloration on the bearings is caused by incorrect lubrication or moisture and ranges in color
from light brown to black. Reuse the bearing if you can remove the stains with light polishing and
there is no evidence of overheating. If this condition occurs, perform the following: 1. Check the
seals. 2. Clean all the parts and the housings. 3. Replace the bearings, if necessary.
Heat Discoloration
The heat discoloration on the bearings ranges from faint yellow to dark blue and results from
overload or an incorrect lubricant. Excessive heat causes softening of the races or the rollers. In
order to check for loss of temper on the races and the rollers, perform a file test. A file drawn over a
tempered part will grab and cut the metal and fail the file test. A file drawn over a hard part will glide
with no metal cutting. If overheating damage is indicated, perform the following: 1. Check the seals.
2. Clean all the parts and the housings. 3. Replace the bearings.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed > Page 7003
Misalignment
The outer race is misaligned due to a foreign object. 1. Clean all the parts and the housings. 2.
Ensure the races are properly seated. 3. Replace the bearing.
Cracked Inner Race
The race is cracked due to improper fit, cocking, or poor bearing seats. 1. Clean all the parts and
the housings. 2. Ensure the races are properly seated. 3. Replace the bearing.
Fatigue Spalling
The surface is flaked with metal due to bearing fatigue. 1. Clean all the parts and the housings. 2.
Replace the bearing.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed > Page 7004
Brinelling
The surface indentations in the race way are caused by the rollers under impact loading or from
vibration while the bearing is not rotating. 1. Clean all the parts and the housings. 2. Replace the
bearing.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Page 7005
Wheel Bearing: Adjustments
Front Wheel Bearing Adjustment
Important: ^
Adjust the front wheel bearings correctly in order to ensure the front suspension functions properly.
^ The bearings must be a slip fit on the spindle.
^ Lubricate the bearings in order to ensure the bearings will creep.
^ The spindle nut must have a free-running fit on the spindle threads.
1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle with safety stands. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the
wheel cover. 3. Remove the dust cap from the wheel hub.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Remove the cotter pin.
^ Tighten the wheel hub nut to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.), while turning the wheel forward by hand. This will
seat the bearings.
Important: Do not back the nut off more than 1/2 flat.
5. Adjust the nut to a finger tight position by hand. Then, back the nut off until the hole in the
spindle aligns with a slot in the nut. 6. Install a new cotter pin.
6.1. Make sure the cotter pin ends do not interfere with the cap. Bend the ends of the cotter pin
against the nut. Cut off any extra pin length.
6.2. Measure the endplay. Proper endplay is 0.0 - 0.13 mm (0.001 - 0.005 inch).
7. Install the dust cap to the wheel hub. 8. Install the wheel cover. 9. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Page 7006
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair
"For information regarding this component please refer to wheel hub service and repair"
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information
> Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
wheel hub nut 12 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information >
Service Precautions
Vehicle Lifting: Service Precautions
CAUTION:
To avoid any vehicle damage, serious personal injury or death when major components are
removed from the vehicle and the vehicle is supported by a hoist, support the vehicle with jack
stands at the opposite end from which the components are being removed.
To avoid any vehicle damage, serious personal injury or death, always use the jackstands to
support the vehicle when lifting the vehicle with a jack.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information >
Service Precautions > Page 7015
Vehicle Lifting: Service and Repair
Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle
Caution: To avoid any vehicle damage, serious personal injury or death when major components
are removed from the vehicle and the vehicle is supported by a hoist, support the vehicle with jack
stands at the opposite end from which the components are being removed.
Caution: To avoid any vehicle damage, serious personal injury or death, always use the jackstands
to support the vehicle when lifting the vehicle with a jack.
Notice: Perform the following steps before beginning any vehicle lifting or jacking procedure:
* Remove or secure all of the vehicle's contents in order to avoid any shifting or any movement that
may occur during the vehicle lifting or jacking procedure.
* The lifting equipment or the jacking equipment weight rating must meet or exceed the weight of
the vehicle and any vehicle contents.
* The lifting equipment or the jacking equipment must meet the operational standards of the lifting
equipment or jacking equipment's manufacturer.
* Perform the vehicle lifting or jacking procedure on a clean, hard, dry, level surface.
* Perform the vehicle lifting or jacking procedure only at the identified lift points. DO NOT allow the
lifting equipment or jacking equipment to contact any other vehicle components.
Failure to perform the previous steps could result in damage to the lifting equipment or the jacking
equipment, the vehicle, and/or the vehicle's contents.
Use only the prescribed lift points when elevating the vehicle.
Vehicle Lifting Points
1 - Lower Control Arm; Inboard of the Lower Ball Joint 1 - Lower Control Arm; Inboard of the Lower
Ball Joint 2 - Frame; at Second Crossmember 2 - Frame; at Second Crossmember 3 - Rear Spring;
at Forward Spring Hanger 3 - Rear Spring; at Forward Spring Hanger 4 - Axle; Inboard of Shock
Absorber Hanger 4 - Axle; Inboard of Shock Absorber Hanger 5 - Differential; at Center 6 - Front
Suspension Crossmember; Center 1 - Lower Control Arm; Inboard of the Lower Ball Joint 1 - Lower
Control Arm; Inboard of the Lower Ball Joint 2 - Frame; at Second Crossmember 2 - Frame; at
Second Crossmember
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information >
Service Precautions > Page 7016
3 - Rear Spring; at Forward Spring Hanger 3 - Rear Spring; at Forward Spring Hanger 4 - Axle;
Inboard of Shock Absorber Hanger 4 - Axle; Inboard of Shock Absorber Hanger 5 - Differential; at
Center 6 - Front Suspension Crossmember; Center
The jack and hoist lift points for the front of the vehicle are located between the front body mounts
and the transmission crossmember. The jack and hoist lift points for the rear of the vehicle are
located at the front hangers for the rear springs.
The front end lift points for the floor jack are at the following locations:
* Beneath the lower control arms, inboard from the shock absorber mounts
* Beneath the center of the front crossmember
The rear end lift points for the floor jack are at the following locations:
* Beneath the axle housing, inboard from the shock absorber mounts
* Beneath the axle differential
Whenever the vehicle is lifted using a jack or a floor jack, observe the following precautions:
* Chock the wheels at the end of the vehicle opposite the end being lifted
* Use jack stands for support. Place jack stands at the any of the following locations:
- Beneath the frame
- Beneath the front suspension crossmember
- Beneath the axle
When removing major components from the vehicle while the vehicle is on a hoist, chain the
vehicle frame to the hoist pads in order to prevent tip-off.
Jacking and Lifting Notice: When jacking or lifting a vehicle, do not allow the lift pads to contact any
of the following parts:
* The catalytic converter
* The brake lines
* The brake cables
* The fuel lines
* The accelerator cables
* The transmission shift cables
Lift pad contact may damage the parts. Lift pad contact may cause unsatisfactory vehicle
performance.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Relays and Modules - Wheels and Tires >
Tire Pressure Monitor Receiver / Transponder > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Tire Monitor
System - TPM Sensor Information
Tire Pressure Monitor Receiver / Transponder: Technical Service Bulletins Tire Monitor System TPM Sensor Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-03-16-003
Date: May 12, 2008
Subject: Warranty Reduction - Transfer of Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensors to
Replacement Wheels and Allowable TPM Sensor Replacements
Models: 2000-2009 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2009
HUMMER H2 2006-2009 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7x
with On-Wheel TPM Sensors
TPM Sensor / Wheel Warranty Reviews
During the last warranty review period it was noted that wheels being returned under the GM New
Vehicle Warranty were being shipped back to General Motors with the TPM sensor still attached to
the wheel. Return rates ran as high as 60% with the TPM sensors still attached. Operational TPM
sensors should not be returned to GM and are to be transferred to replacement wheels if they
become necessary.
Important:
Operational TPM Sensors that are returned under warranty to General Motors will be charged back
to the dealer.Sensors have a 10 year /150,000 mile (240,000 km) battery life, and should be
transferred if one or more wheels are replaced.
TPM Valve Stem / Grommet (0-ring) Replacement
When the TPM sensors are transferred to new wheels you should replace the component used to
seal the TPM sensor stem to the wheel. On sensors with an aluminum stem and visible nut on the
outside of the wheel a replacement grommet (0-ring) should be used to assure a proper seal. The
sensor retaining nut (except Aveo) should be tightened to 7 N.m (62 lb in) for all vehicles except
Pontiac Vibe (4.0 N.m (35.4 lb in)).
Important:
^ DO NOT overtorque the retaining nut.
Notice:
^ Factory installed TPM Sensors come with plastic aluminum or nickel-plated brass stem caps.
These caps should not be changed. Chrome plated steel caps may cause corrosion of aluminum
valve stems due to incompatibility of the metals.
On current style sensors the entire rubber stem is replaceable. The service interval on the revised
TPM sensor with replaceable stem is the same as for any other traditional valve stem. Replace the
stem at the time of tire replacement sensor transfer or whenever air seepage is suspected at the
valve stem. When replacing the valve stem tighten the screw to 1.3 N.m (11.5 lb in).
For either style of TPM sensor see the service parts guide for the correct GM part numbers to order
and use.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires
> Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Tire Monitor System - TPM Sensor
Information
Tire Pressure Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Tire Monitor System - TPM Sensor Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-03-16-003
Date: May 12, 2008
Subject: Warranty Reduction - Transfer of Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensors to
Replacement Wheels and Allowable TPM Sensor Replacements
Models: 2000-2009 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2009
HUMMER H2 2006-2009 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7x
with On-Wheel TPM Sensors
TPM Sensor / Wheel Warranty Reviews
During the last warranty review period it was noted that wheels being returned under the GM New
Vehicle Warranty were being shipped back to General Motors with the TPM sensor still attached to
the wheel. Return rates ran as high as 60% with the TPM sensors still attached. Operational TPM
sensors should not be returned to GM and are to be transferred to replacement wheels if they
become necessary.
Important:
Operational TPM Sensors that are returned under warranty to General Motors will be charged back
to the dealer.Sensors have a 10 year /150,000 mile (240,000 km) battery life, and should be
transferred if one or more wheels are replaced.
TPM Valve Stem / Grommet (0-ring) Replacement
When the TPM sensors are transferred to new wheels you should replace the component used to
seal the TPM sensor stem to the wheel. On sensors with an aluminum stem and visible nut on the
outside of the wheel a replacement grommet (0-ring) should be used to assure a proper seal. The
sensor retaining nut (except Aveo) should be tightened to 7 N.m (62 lb in) for all vehicles except
Pontiac Vibe (4.0 N.m (35.4 lb in)).
Important:
^ DO NOT overtorque the retaining nut.
Notice:
^ Factory installed TPM Sensors come with plastic aluminum or nickel-plated brass stem caps.
These caps should not be changed. Chrome plated steel caps may cause corrosion of aluminum
valve stems due to incompatibility of the metals.
On current style sensors the entire rubber stem is replaceable. The service interval on the revised
TPM sensor with replaceable stem is the same as for any other traditional valve stem. Replace the
stem at the time of tire replacement sensor transfer or whenever air seepage is suspected at the
valve stem. When replacing the valve stem tighten the screw to 1.3 N.m (11.5 lb in).
For either style of TPM sensor see the service parts guide for the correct GM part numbers to order
and use.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Monitor Receiver / Transponder > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Tire Monitor System - TPM
Sensor Information
Tire Pressure Monitor Receiver / Transponder: Technical Service Bulletins Tire Monitor System TPM Sensor Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-03-16-003
Date: May 12, 2008
Subject: Warranty Reduction - Transfer of Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensors to
Replacement Wheels and Allowable TPM Sensor Replacements
Models: 2000-2009 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2009
HUMMER H2 2006-2009 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7x
with On-Wheel TPM Sensors
TPM Sensor / Wheel Warranty Reviews
During the last warranty review period it was noted that wheels being returned under the GM New
Vehicle Warranty were being shipped back to General Motors with the TPM sensor still attached to
the wheel. Return rates ran as high as 60% with the TPM sensors still attached. Operational TPM
sensors should not be returned to GM and are to be transferred to replacement wheels if they
become necessary.
Important:
Operational TPM Sensors that are returned under warranty to General Motors will be charged back
to the dealer.Sensors have a 10 year /150,000 mile (240,000 km) battery life, and should be
transferred if one or more wheels are replaced.
TPM Valve Stem / Grommet (0-ring) Replacement
When the TPM sensors are transferred to new wheels you should replace the component used to
seal the TPM sensor stem to the wheel. On sensors with an aluminum stem and visible nut on the
outside of the wheel a replacement grommet (0-ring) should be used to assure a proper seal. The
sensor retaining nut (except Aveo) should be tightened to 7 N.m (62 lb in) for all vehicles except
Pontiac Vibe (4.0 N.m (35.4 lb in)).
Important:
^ DO NOT overtorque the retaining nut.
Notice:
^ Factory installed TPM Sensors come with plastic aluminum or nickel-plated brass stem caps.
These caps should not be changed. Chrome plated steel caps may cause corrosion of aluminum
valve stems due to incompatibility of the metals.
On current style sensors the entire rubber stem is replaceable. The service interval on the revised
TPM sensor with replaceable stem is the same as for any other traditional valve stem. Replace the
stem at the time of tire replacement sensor transfer or whenever air seepage is suspected at the
valve stem. When replacing the valve stem tighten the screw to 1.3 N.m (11.5 lb in).
For either style of TPM sensor see the service parts guide for the correct GM part numbers to order
and use.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Tire Monitor System - TPM Sensor Information
Tire Pressure Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Tire Monitor System - TPM Sensor Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-03-16-003
Date: May 12, 2008
Subject: Warranty Reduction - Transfer of Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensors to
Replacement Wheels and Allowable TPM Sensor Replacements
Models: 2000-2009 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2009
HUMMER H2 2006-2009 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7x
with On-Wheel TPM Sensors
TPM Sensor / Wheel Warranty Reviews
During the last warranty review period it was noted that wheels being returned under the GM New
Vehicle Warranty were being shipped back to General Motors with the TPM sensor still attached to
the wheel. Return rates ran as high as 60% with the TPM sensors still attached. Operational TPM
sensors should not be returned to GM and are to be transferred to replacement wheels if they
become necessary.
Important:
Operational TPM Sensors that are returned under warranty to General Motors will be charged back
to the dealer.Sensors have a 10 year /150,000 mile (240,000 km) battery life, and should be
transferred if one or more wheels are replaced.
TPM Valve Stem / Grommet (0-ring) Replacement
When the TPM sensors are transferred to new wheels you should replace the component used to
seal the TPM sensor stem to the wheel. On sensors with an aluminum stem and visible nut on the
outside of the wheel a replacement grommet (0-ring) should be used to assure a proper seal. The
sensor retaining nut (except Aveo) should be tightened to 7 N.m (62 lb in) for all vehicles except
Pontiac Vibe (4.0 N.m (35.4 lb in)).
Important:
^ DO NOT overtorque the retaining nut.
Notice:
^ Factory installed TPM Sensors come with plastic aluminum or nickel-plated brass stem caps.
These caps should not be changed. Chrome plated steel caps may cause corrosion of aluminum
valve stems due to incompatibility of the metals.
On current style sensors the entire rubber stem is replaceable. The service interval on the revised
TPM sensor with replaceable stem is the same as for any other traditional valve stem. Replace the
stem at the time of tire replacement sensor transfer or whenever air seepage is suspected at the
valve stem. When replacing the valve stem tighten the screw to 1.3 N.m (11.5 lb in).
For either style of TPM sensor see the service parts guide for the correct GM part numbers to order
and use.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Spare Tire > Component
Information > Specifications
Spare Tire: Specifications
Spare Tire Carrier Mounting Bolts 11 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Spare Tire > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 7040
Spare Tire: Service and Repair
Tire Hoist and Shaft Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the spare tire from the tire carrier. 2. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to
Vehicle Lifting. 3. Remove the pin and retainer from the shaft. 4. Remove the shaft from the hoist.
5. Remove the hoist mounting bolts. 6. Remove the hoist from the rear crossmember.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the hoist to the rear crossmember.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the hoist mounting bolts and nuts.
^ Tighten the hoist mounting bolts and nuts to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.).
3. Install the shaft to the hoist. 4. Install the pin and retainer to the shaft. 5. Lower the vehicle. 6.
Install the spare tire to the carrier.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation
(RFV)
Wheels: Customer Interest Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV)
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-03-10-006F
Date: May 04, 2010
Subject: Information on Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009
and Prior Saab 9-7X 2000-2005 Saturn L Series 2003-2007 Saturn ION
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to considerably expand the available information on
Radial Force Variation (RFV) and should be reviewed in whole. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-03-10-006E (Section 03 - Suspension).
Important
- Before measuring tires on equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700, the vehicle MUST be driven
a minimum of 16 km (10 mi) to ensure removal of any flat-spotting. Refer to Corporate Bulletin
Number 03-03-10-007E - Tire/Wheel Characteristics of GM Original Equipment Tires.
- Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 MUST be calibrated prior to measuring tire/wheel
assemblies for each vehicle.
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide guidance to GM dealers when using tire force variation
measurement equipment, such as the Hunter GSP9700. This type of equipment can be a valuable
tool in diagnosing vehicle ride concerns. The most common ride concern involving tire radial force
variation is highway speed shake on smooth roads.
Tire related smooth road highway speed shake can be caused by three conditions: imbalance, out
of round and tire force variation. These three conditions are not necessarily related. All three
conditions must be addressed.
Imbalance is normally addressed first, because it is the simpler of the three to correct. Off-vehicle,
two plane dynamic wheel balancers are readily available and can accurately correct any
imbalance. Balancer calibration and maintenance, proper attachment of the wheel to the balancer,
and proper balance weights, are all factors required for a quality balance. However, a perfectly
balanced tire/wheel assembly can still be "oval shaped" and cause a vibration.
Before balancing, perform the following procedures.
Tire and Wheel Diagnosis
1. Set the tire pressure to the placard values. 2. With the vehicle raised, ensure the wheels are
centered on the hub by loosening all wheel nuts and hand-tightening all nuts first by hand while
shaking the wheel, then torque to specifications using a torque wrench, NOT a torque stick.
3. Visually inspect the tires and the wheels. Inspect for evidence of the following conditions and
correct as necessary:
- Missing balance weights
- Bent rim flange
- Irregular tire wear
- Incomplete bead seating
- Tire irregularities (including pressure settings)
- Mud/ice build-up in wheel
- Stones in the tire tread
- Remove any aftermarket wheels and/or tires and restore vehicle to original condition prior to
diagnosing a smooth road shake condition.
4. Road test the vehicle using the Electronic Vibration Analyzer (EVA) essential tool. Drive for a
sufficient distance on a known, smooth road
surface to duplicate the condition. Determine if the vehicle is sensitive to brake apply. If the brakes
are applied lightly and the pulsation felt in the steering wheel increases, refer to the Brakes section
of the service manual that deals with brake-induced pulsation. If you can start to hear the vibration
as a low boom noise (in addition to feeling it), but cannot see it, the vehicle likely has a first order
(one pulse per propshaft revolution) driveline vibration. Driveline first order vibrations are high
enough in frequency that most humans can start to hear them at highway speeds, but are too high
to be able to be easily seen. These issues can be caused by driveline imbalance or misalignment.
If the vehicle exhibits this low boom and the booming pulses in-and-out on a regular basis (like a
throbbing), chances are good that the vehicle could have driveline vibration. This type
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation
(RFV) > Page 7049
of vibration is normally felt more in the "seat of the pants" than the steering wheel.
5. Next, record the Hertz (Hz) reading as displayed by the EVA onto the tire data worksheet found
at the end of this bulletin. This should be done
after a tire break-in period of at least 16 km (10 mi) at 72 km/h (45 mph) or greater, in order to
eliminate any possible tire flat-spotting. This reading confirms what the vehicle vibration frequency
is prior to vehicle service and documents the amount of improvement occurring as the result of the
various steps taken to repair. Completing the Steering Wheel Shake Worksheet below is required.
A copy of the completed worksheet must be saved with the R.O. and a copy included with any
parts returned to the Warranty Parts Center for analysis. A reading of 35 to 50 Hz typically
indicates a first order propshaft vibration. If this is the situation, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
08-07-30-044D. Generally, a reading between 10 and 20 Hz indicates a tire/wheel vibration and if
this is the reading obtained, continue using this bulletin. If the tire 1st order vibration goes away
and stays away during this evaluation, the cause is likely tire flat-spotting. Tire flat-spotting vibration
may come and go at any speed over 72 km/h (45 mph) during the first 10 minutes of operation, if
vibration continues after 10 minutes of driving at speeds greater than 72 km/h (45 mph), tire
flat-spotting can be ruled out as the cause for vibration.
6. If flat-spotting is the cause, provide the explanation that this has occurred due to the vehicle
being parked for long periods of time and that the
nature of the tire is to take a set. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 03-03-10-007E: Information
on Tire/Wheel Characteristics (Vibration, Balance, Shake, Flat Spotting) of GM Original Equipment
Tires.
7. If the road test indicates a shake/vibration exists, check the imbalance of each tire/wheel
assembly on a known, calibrated, off-car dynamic
balancer.Make sure the mounting surface of the wheel and the surface of the balancer are
absolutely clean and free of debris. Be sure to chose the proper cone/collet for the wheel, and
always use the pilot bore for centering. Never center the wheel using the hub-cap bore since it is
not a precision machined surface. If any assembly calls for more than 1/4 ounce on either rim
flange, remove all balance weights and rebalance to as close to zero as possible. If you can see
the vibration (along with feeling it) in the steering wheel (driving straight without your hands on the
wheel), it is very likely to be a tire/wheel first order (one pulse per revolution) disturbance. First
order disturbances can be caused by imbalance as well as non-uniformities in tires, wheels or
hubs. This first order frequency is too low for a human to hear, but if the amplitude is high enough,
it can be seen.
If a vibration or shake still exists after balancing, any out of round conditions, of the wheel, and
force variation conditions of the tire, must be addressed. Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700
can address both (it is also a wheel balancer).
Tire radial force vibration (RFV) can be defined as the amount of stiffness variation the tire will
produce in one revolution under a constant load. Radial force variation is what the vehicle feels
because the load (weight) of the vehicle is always on the tires. Although free runout of tires (not
under load) is not always a good indicator of a smooth ride, it is critical that total tire/wheel
assembly runout be within specification.
Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 loads the tire, similar to on the vehicle, and measures
radial force variation of the tire/wheel assembly. Note that the wheel is affecting the tire's RFV
measurement at this point. To isolate the wheel, its runout must be measured. This can be easily
done on the Hunter, without the need to set up dial indicators. If the wheel meets the runout
specification, the tire's RFV can then be addressed.
After measuring the tire/wheel assembly under load, and the wheel alone, the machine then
calculates (predicts) the radial force variation of the tire. However, because this is a prediction that
can include mounting inaccuracies, and the load wheel is much smaller in diameter than used in
tire production, this type of service equipment should NOT be used to audit new tires. Rather, it
should be used as a service diagnostic tool to minimize radial force variation of the tire/wheel
assembly.
Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 does an excellent job of measuring wheel runout, and of
finding the low point of the wheel (for runout) and the high point of the tire (for radial force
variation). This allows the tire to be matched mounted to the wheel for lowest tire/wheel assembly
force variation.
The machine will simplify this process into easy steps. The following assembly radial force variation
numbers should be used as a guide:
When measuring RFV and match mounting tires perform the following steps.
Measuring Wheel Runout and Assembly Radial Force Variation
Important The completed worksheet at the end of this bulletin must be attached to the hard copy of
the repair order.
- Measure radial force variation and radial runout.
- If a road force/balancing machine is used, record the radial force variation (RFV) on the
worksheet at the end of this bulletin. It may be of benefit to have the lowest RFV assembly to the
front left corner. If the machine is not available and the EVA data suggests there is an issue, swap
the tire and wheel assemblies from the front to the back. Re-check on the EVA and if the problem
still exists, test another vehicle to find tires that do not exhibit the same frequency and swap those
tires onto the subject vehicle.
- If a runout/balancing machine is used, record the radial runout of the tire/wheel assemblies on the
worksheet at the end of this bulletin. If one or more of the tire/wheel assemblies are more than.040
in (1.02 mm), match mount the tire to the wheel to get below.040 in (1.02 mm). For sensitive
customers, readings of 0.030 inch (0.76 mm) or less are preferable, it may also be of benefit to
have the lowest runout assembly to the front left corner. If the machine is not available and the
EVA data suggests there is an issue, swap the tire and wheel assemblies from the front to the
back. Re-check on the EVA and if the problem still exists, test another vehicle to find tires that do
not exhibit the same frequency and swap those tires
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation
(RFV) > Page 7050
onto the subject vehicle.
- After match mounting, the tire/wheel assembly must be rebalanced.
If match mounting tires to in-spec wheels produces assembly values higher than these, tire
replacement may be necessary. Replacing tires at lower values will probably mean good tires are
being condemned. Because tires can sometimes become temporarily flat-spotted, which will affect
force variation, it is important that the vehicle be driven at least 16 km (10 mi) prior to measuring.
Tire pressure must also be adjusted to the usage pressure on the vehicle's tire placard prior to
measuring.
Most GM vehicles will tolerate radial force variation up to these levels. However, some vehicles are
more sensitive, and may require lower levels. Also, there are other tire parameters that equipment
such as the Hunter GSP9700 cannot measure that may be a factor. In such cases, TAC should be
contacted for further instructions.
Important
- When mounting a GM wheel to a wheel balancer/force variation machine, always use the wheel's
center pilot hole. This is the primary centering mechanism on all GM wheels; the bolt holes are
secondary. Usually a back cone method to the machine should be used. For added accuracy and
repeatability, a flange plate should be used to clamp the wheel onto the cone and machine. This
system is offered by all balancer manufacturers in GM's dealer program.
- Any type of service equipment that removes tread rubber by grinding, buffing or truing is NOT
recommended, and may void the tire warranty. However, tires may have been ground by the tire
company as part of their tire manufacturing process. This is a legitimate procedure.
Steering Wheel Shake Worksheet
When diagnosing vibration concerns, use the following worksheet in conjunction with the
appropriate Vibration Analysis-Road testing procedure in the Vibration Correction sub-section in SI.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation
(RFV) > Page 7051
Refer to the appropriate section of SI for specifications and repair procedures that are related to the
vibration concern.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 05-03-10-003F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast
Aluminum Wheels
Wheels: Customer Interest Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 05-03-10-003F
Date: April 27, 2010
Subject: Low Tire Pressure, Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels (Repair with Adhesive Sealant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X with Cast Aluminum Wheels
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years and the bulletin reference
information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-10-003E (Section 03 - Suspension).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a low tire pressure condition.
Diagnosis of the low tire pressure condition indicates an air leak through the cast aluminum wheel.
Cause
Porosity in the cast aluminum wheel may be the cause.
Notice
This bulletin specifically addresses issues related to the wheel casting that may result in an air
leak. For issues related to corrosion of the wheel in service, please refer to Corporate Bulletin
Number 08-03-10-006C - Tire Slowly Goes Flat, Tire Air Loss, Low Tire Pressure Warning Light
Illuminated, Aluminum Wheel Bead Seat Corrosion (Clean and Resurface Wheel Bead Seat).
Correction
1. Remove the tire and wheel assembly from the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate service
procedure in SI. 2. Locate the leaking area by inflating the tire to 276 kPa (40 psi) and dipping the
tire/wheel assembly in a water bath, or use a spray bottle with soap
and water to locate the specific leak location.
Important
- If the porosity leak is located in the bead area of the aluminum rim (where the tire meets the rim),
the wheel should be replaced.
- If two or more leaks are located on one wheel, the wheel should be replaced.
3. If air bubbles are observed, mark the location.
- If the leak location is on the tire/rubber area, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 04-03-10-001F Tire Puncture Repair Procedures for All Cars and Light Duty Trucks.
- If the leak is located on the aluminum wheel area, continue with the next step.
4. Inscribe a mark on the tire at the valve stem in order to indicate the orientation of the tire to the
wheel. 5. Dismount the tire from the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. 6. Remove
the tire pressure sensor. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor removal procedure in SI. 7. Scuff the
INSIDE rim surface at the leak area with #80 grit paper and clean the area with general purpose
cleaner, such as 3M(R) General Purpose
Adhesive Cleaner, P/N 08984, or equivalent.
8. Apply a 3 mm (0.12 in) thick layer of Silicone - Adhesive/Sealant, P/N 12378478 (in Canada, use
88900041), or equivalent, to the leak area. 9. Allow for the adhesive/sealant to dry.
Notice Caution must be used when mounting the tire so as not to damage the sealer. Damaging
the repair area may result in an air leak.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 05-03-10-003F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast
Aluminum Wheels > Page 7056
10. Align the inscribed mark on the tire with the valve stem on the wheel. 11. Reinstall the Tire
Pressure Sensor. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor installation procedure in SI. 12. Mount the tire on
the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. 13. Pressurize the tire to 276 kPa (40 psi) and
inspect for leaks. 14. Adjust tire pressure to meet the placard specification. 15. Balance the
tire/wheel assembly. Refer to Tire and Wheel Assembly Balancing - Off-Vehicle. 16. Install the tire
and wheel assembly onto the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate service procedure in SI.
Parts Information
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
Important The Silicone - Adhesive/Sealant comes in a case quantity of six. ONLY charge warranty
one tube of adhesive/sealant per wheel repair.
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
One leak repair per wheel.
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 08-03-10-006C > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Tire Slowly Goes
Flat/Warning Light ON
Wheels: Customer Interest Tires/Wheels - Tire Slowly Goes Flat/Warning Light ON
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 08-03-10-006C
Date: April 27, 2010
Subject: Tire Slowly Goes Flat, Tire Air Loss, Low Tire Pressure Warning Light Illuminated,
Aluminum Wheel Bead Seat Corrosion (Clean and Resurface Wheel Bead Seat)
Models:
2000-2011 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2009 HUMMER H2
2006-2010 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 08-03-10-006B (Section 03 - Suspension).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a tire that slowly loses air pressure over a period of days or
weeks.
Cause
Abrasive elements in the environment may intrude between the tire and wheel at the bead seat.
There is always some relative motion between the tire and wheel (when the vehicle is driven) and
this motion may cause the abrasive particles to wear the wheel and tire materials. As the wear
continues, there may also be intrusion at the tire/wheel interface by corrosive media from the
environment. Eventually a path for air develops and a 'slow' leak may ensue. This corrosion may
appear on the inboard or outboard bead seating surface of the wheel. This corrosion will not be
visible until the tire is dismounted from the wheel.
Notice
This bulletin specifically addresses issues related to wheel bead seat corrosion that may result in
an air leak. For issues related to porosity of the wheel casting that may result in an air leak, please
refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-10-006F - Low Tire Pressure, Leaking Cast Aluminum
Wheels (Repair with Adhesive Sealant)
Correction
In most cases, this type of air loss can be corrected by following the procedure below.
Important DO NOT replace a wheel for slow air loss unless you have evaluated and/or tried to
repair the wheel with the procedure below.
Notice
The repair is no longer advised or applicable for chromed aluminum wheels.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly for diagnosis. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and
Installation in SI. 2. After a water dunk tank leak test, if you determine the source of the air leak to
be around the bead seat of the wheel, dismount the tire to examine
the bead seat. Shown below is a typical area of bead seat corrosion.Typical Location of Bead Seat
Corrosion
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 08-03-10-006C > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Tire Slowly Goes
Flat/Warning Light ON > Page 7061
Important Other forms of slow air leaks are possible. If the body of the tire, valve stem and wheel
flange show no signs of air seepage, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-10-003D for
additional information on possible wheel porosity issues.
3. Bead seat corrosion is identified by what appears like blistering of the wheel finish, causing a
rough or uneven surface that is difficult for the tire to
maintain a proper seal on. Below is a close-up photo of bead seat corrosion on an aluminum wheel
that was sufficient to cause slow air loss. Close-Up of Bead Seat Corrosion
4. If corrosion is found on the wheel bead seat, measure the affected area as shown below.
- For vehicles with 32,186 km (20,000 mi) or less, the total allowable combined linear area of
repairable corrosion is 100 mm (4 in) or less. If the total area(s) of corrosion exceed these
dimensions, the wheel should be replaced.
- For vehicles that have exceeded 32,186 km (20,000 mi), the total allowable combined linear area
of repairable corrosion is 200 mm (8 in) or less. If the total area(s) of corrosion exceed these
dimensions, the wheel should be replaced.
5. In order to correct the wheel leak, use a clean-up (fine cut) sanding disc or biscuit to remove the
corrosion and any flaking paint. You should
remove the corrosion back far enough until you reach material that is stable and firmly bonded to
the wheel. Try to taper the edge of any flaking paint as best you can in order to avoid sharp edges
that may increase the chance of a leak reoccurring. The photo below shows an acceptable repaired
surface.
Notice Corrosion that extends up the lip of the wheel, where after the clean-up process it would be
visible with the tire mounted, is only acceptable on the inboard flange. The inboard flange is not
visible with the wheel assembly in the mounted position. If any loose coatings or corrosion extend
to the visible surfaces on the FACE of the wheel, that wheel must be replaced.
Important Remove ONLY the material required to eliminate the corrosion from the bead seating
surface. DO NOT remove excessive amounts of material. ALWAYS keep the sealing surface as
smooth and level as possible.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 08-03-10-006C > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Tire Slowly Goes
Flat/Warning Light ON > Page 7062
Acceptably Prepared (Cleaned-Up) Wheel Surface
6. Once the corrosion has been eliminated, you should coat the repaired area with a commercially
available tire sealant such as Patch Brand Bead
Sealant or equivalent. Commercially available bead sealants are black rubber-like coatings that will
permanently fill and seal the resurfaced bead seat. At 21°C (70°F) ambient temperature, this
sealant will set-up sufficiently for tire mounting in about 10 minutes.Coated and Sealed Bead Seat
7. Remount the tire and install the repaired wheel and tire assembly. Refer to Tire and Wheel
Removal and Installation in SI.
Parts Information
Patch Brand Bead Sealer is available from Myers Tires at 1-800-998-9897 or on the web at
www.myerstiresupply.com. The one-quart size can of sealer will repair about 20 wheels.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 08-03-10-006C > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Tire Slowly Goes
Flat/Warning Light ON > Page 7063
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome
Wheel Staining/Pitting/Corrosion
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Chrome Wheel Staining/Pitting/Corrosion
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-03-10-002F
Date: April 21, 2011
Subject: Chemical Staining, Pitting, Corrosion and/or Spotted Appearance of Chromed Aluminum
Wheels
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years, suggest additional restorative
products and add additional corrosion information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
00-03-10-002E (Section 03 - Suspension). Important You may give a copy of this bulletin to the
customer.
What is Chemical Staining of Chrome Wheels? Figure 1
Chemical staining in most cases results from acid based cleaners (refer to Figure 1 for an
example). These stains are frequently milky, black, or greenish in appearance. They result from
using cleaning solutions that contain acids on chrome wheels. Soap and water is usually sufficient
to clean wheels.
If the customer insists on using a wheel cleaner they should only use one that specifically states
that it is safe for chromed wheels and does not contain anything in the following list. (Dealers
should also survey any products they use during prep or normal cleaning of stock units for these
chemicals.)
- Ammonium Bifluoride (fluoride source for dissolution of chrome)
- Hydrofluoric Acid (directly dissolves chrome)
- Hydrochloric Acid (directly dissolves chrome)
- Sodium Dodecylbenzenesulfonic Acid
- Sulfamic Acid
- Phosphoric Acid
- Hydroxyacetic Acid
Notice
Many wheel cleaner instructions advise to take care to avoid contact with painted surfaces. Most
customers think of painted surfaces as the fenders, quarter panels and other exterior sheet metal.
Many vehicles have painted brake calipers. Acidic wheel cleaners may craze, crack, or discolor the
paint on the brake calipers. Damage from wheel cleaners is not covered under the vehicle new car
warranty. Soap and water applied with a soft brush is usually all that is required to clean the
calipers.
Whenever any wheel cleaner is used, it must be THOROUGHLY rinsed off of the wheel with clean,
clear water. Special care must be taken to rinse under the hub cap, balance weights, wheel nuts,
lug nut caps, between the wheel cladding and off the back side of the wheel. Wheels returned to
the Warranty Parts Center (WPC) that exhibit damage from wheel cleaners most often have the
damage around and under the wheel weight where the cleaner was incompletely flushed away.
Notice
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome
Wheel Staining/Pitting/Corrosion > Page 7069
Do not use cleaning solutions that contain hydrofluoric, oxalic and most other acids on chrome
wheels (or any wheels).
If the customer is unsure of the chemical make-up of a particular wheel cleaner, it should be
avoided.
For wheels showing signs of milky staining from acidic cleaners, refer to Customer Assistance and
Instructions below.
Warranty of Stained Chrome Wheels
Stained wheels are not warrantable. Most acid based cleaners will permanently stain chrome
wheels. Follow-up with dealers has confirmed that such cleaners were used on wheels that were
returned to the Warranty Parts Center (WPC). Any stained wheels received by the WPC will be
charged back to the dealership. To assist the customer, refer to Customer Assistance and
Instructions below.
Pitting or Spotted Appearance of Chrome Wheels Figure 2
A second type or staining or finish disturbance may result from road chemicals, such as calcium
chloride used for dust control of unpaved roads. The staining will look like small pitting (refer to
Figure 2). This staining will usually be on the leading edges of each wheel spoke, but may be
uniformly distributed. If a vehicle must be operated under such conditions, the chrome wheels
should be washed with mild soap and water and thoroughly rinsed as soon as conveniently
possible.
Important Road chemicals, such as calcium chloride used for dust control of unpaved roads, can
also stain chrome wheels. The staining will look like small pitting. This staining will usually be on
the leading edges of each wheel spoke. This is explained by the vehicle traveling in the forward
direction while being splashed by the road chemical. If a vehicle must be operated under such
conditions, the chrome wheels should be washed with mild soap and water and thoroughly rinsed
as soon as conveniently possible.
Warranty of Pitted or Spotted Chrome Wheels
Wheels returned with pitting or spotting as a result of road chemicals may be replaced one time.
Damage resulting from contact with these applied road chemicals is corrosive to the wheels finish
and may cause damage if the wheels are not kept clean.
Important Notify the customer that this is a one time replacement. Please stress to the customer
the vital importance of keeping the wheels clean if they are operating the vehicle in an area that
applies calcium chloride or other dust controlling chemicals! "GM of Canada" dealers require prior
approval by the District Manager - Customer Care and Service Process (DM-CCSP).
"Stardust" Corrosion of Chrome Wheels Figure 3
A third type of finish disturbance results from prolonged exposure to brake dust and resultant
penetration of brake dust through the chrome. As brakes are applied hot particles of brake material
are thrown off and tend to be forced through the leading edge of the wheel spoke windows by
airflow. These
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome
Wheel Staining/Pitting/Corrosion > Page 7070
hot particles embed themselves in the chrome layer and create a small pit. If the material is allowed
to sit on the wheel while it is exposed to moisture or salt, it will corrode the wheel beneath the
chrome leaving a pit or small blister in the chrome.
Heavy brake dust build-up should be removed from wheels by using GM Chrome Cleaner and
Polish, P/N 1050173 (in Canada use 10953013). For moderate cleaning, light brake dust build-up
or water spots use GM Swirl Remover Polish, P/N 12377965 (in Canada, use Meguiars
Plast-X(TM) Clear Plastic Cleaner and Polish #G12310C**). After cleaning, the wheel should be
waxed using GM Cleaner Wax, P/N 12377966 (in Canada, use Meguiars Cleaner Wax
#M0616C**), which will help protect the wheel from brake dust and reduce adhesion of any brake
dust that gets on the wheel surface. For general maintenance cleaning, PEEK Metal Polish† may
be used. It will clean and shine the chrome and leave behind a wax coating that may help protect
the finish.
Warranty of Stardust Corroded Chrome Wheels
Wheels returned with pitting or spotting as a result of neglect and brake dust build-up may be
replaced one time.
Important Notify the customer that this is a one time replacement. Please stress to the customer
the vital importance of keeping the wheels clean and free of prolonged exposure to brake dust
build-up. "GM of Canada" dealers require prior approval by the District Manager - Customer Care
and Service Process (DM-CCSP).
Customer Assistance and Instructions
GM has looked for ways customers may improve the appearance of wheels damaged by acidic
cleaners. The following product and procedure has been found to dramatically improve the
appearance of stained wheels. For wheels that have milky stains caused by acidic cleaners try the
following:
Notice
THE 3M CHROME AND METAL POLISH REQUIRED FOR THIS PROCEDURE IS AN
EXTREMELY AGGRESSIVE POLISH/CLEANER. THE WHEELS MUST BE CLEANED BEFORE
APPLICATION TO AVOID SCRATCHING THE WHEEL SURFACE. THIS PRODUCT WILL
REDUCE THE THICKNESS OF THE CHROME PLATING ON THE WHEEL AND IF USED
INCORRECTLY OR EXCESSIVELY MAY REMOVE THE CHROME PLATING ALL TOGETHER,
EXPOSING A LESS BRIGHT AND BRASSY COLORED SUB-LAYER. FOLLOW INSTRUCTIONS
EXACTLY.
1. Wash the wheels with vigorously with soap and water. This step will clean and may reduce
wheel staining. Flood all areas of the wheel with water
to rinse.
2. Dry the wheels completely.
Notice Begin with a small section of the wheel and with light pressure buff off polish and examine
results. ONLY apply and rub with sufficient force and time to remove enough staining that you are
satisfied with the results. Some wheels may be stained to the extent that you may only achieve a
50% improvement while others may be able to be restored to the original lustre. IN ALL CASES,
only apply until the results are satisfactory.
3. Apply 3M Chrome and Metal Polish #39527* with a clean terry cloth towel. As you apply the
polish, the staining will be diminished. 4. When dry, buff off the polish with a clean portion of the
towel. 5. Repeat application of the 3M Chrome and Metal Polish until satisfied with the results. If
continued applications fail to improve the appearance
further discontinue use.
This procedure will improve the appearance of the wheels and may, with repeated applications,
restore the finish dramatically. For wheels that exhibit spotting from road chemicals the above
procedure may marginally improve the condition but will not restore the finish or remove the pitting.
In this type of staining the wheel finish has actually been removed in spots and no manner of
cleaning will restore the finish.
†*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or
assume any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may
be available from other sources.
Parts Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome
Wheel Staining/Pitting/Corrosion > Page 7071
*This product is currently available from 3M. To obtain information for your local retail location
please call 3M at 1-888-364-3577.
**This product is currently available from Meguiars (Canada). To obtain information for your local
retail location please call Meguiars at 1-800-347-5700 or at www.meguiarscanada.com.
^ This product is currently available from Tri-Peek International. To obtain information for your local
retail location please call Tri-Peek at
1-877-615-4272 or at www.tripeek.com.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 99-08-51-007E > Mar > 11 > Wheels/Tires Refinishing Aluminum Wheels
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Refinishing Aluminum Wheels
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 99-08-51-007E
Date: March 17, 2011
Subject: Refinishing Aluminum Wheels
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add additional model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 99-08-51-007D (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
This bulletin updates General Motor's position on refinishing aluminum wheels. GM does not
endorse any repairs that involve welding, bending, straightening or re-machining. Only cosmetic
refinishing of the wheel's coatings, using recommended procedures, is allowed.
Evaluating Damage
In evaluating damage, it is the GM Dealer's responsibility to inspect the wheel for corrosion,
scrapes, gouges, etc. The Dealer must insure that such damage is not deeper than what can be
sanded or polished off. The wheel must be inspected for cracks. If cracks are found, discard the
wheel. Any wheels with bent rim flanges must not be repaired or refinished. Wheels that have been
refinished by an outside company must be returned to the same vehicle. The Dealer must record
the wheel ID stamp or the cast date on the wheel in order to assure this requirement. Refer to
Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company later in this bulletin.
Aluminum Wheel Refinishing Recommendations
- Chrome-plated aluminum wheels Re-plating these wheels is not recommended.
- Polished aluminum wheels These wheels have a polyester or acrylic clearcoat on them. If the
clearcoat is damaged, refinishing is possible. However, the required refinishing process cannot be
performed in the dealer environment. Refer to Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company later
in this bulletin.
- Painted aluminum wheels These wheels are painted using a primer, color coat, and clearcoat
procedure. If the paint is damaged, refinishing is possible. As with polished wheels, all original
coatings must be removed first. Media blasting is recommended. Refer to GM Aluminum
Refinishing Bulletin #53-17-03A for the re-painting of this type of wheel.
- Bright, machined aluminum wheels These wheels have a polyester or acrylic clearcoat on them.
In some cases, the recessed "pocket" areas of the wheel may be painted. Surface refinishing is
possible. The wheel must be totally stripped by media blasting or other suitable means. The wheel
should be resurfaced by using a sanding process rather than a machining process. This allows the
least amount of material to be removed.
Important Do not use any re-machining process that removes aluminum. This could affect the
dimensions and function of the wheel.
Painting is an option to re-clearcoating polished and bright machined aluminum wheels. Paint will
better mask any surface imperfections and is somewhat more durable than clearcoat alone. GM
recommends using Corsican SILVER WAEQ9283 for a fine "aluminum-like" look or Sparkle
SILVER WA9967 for a very bright look. As an option, the body color may also be used. When using
any of the painting options, it is recommended that all four wheels be refinished in order to maintain
color uniformity. Refer to GM Aluminum Refinishing Bulletin #53-17-03A for specific procedures
and product recommendations.
Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company
Important Some outside companies are offering wheel refinishing services. Such refinished wheels
will be permanently marked by the refinisher and are warranted by the refinisher. Any process that
re-machines or otherwise re-manufactures the wheel should not be used.
A refinisher's responsibility includes inspecting for cracks using the Zyglo system or the equivalent.
Any cracked wheels must not be refinished. No welding, hammering or reforming of any kind is
allowed. The wheel ID must be recorded and follow the wheel throughout the process in order to
assure that the same wheel is returned. A plastic media blast may be used for clean up of the
wheel. Hand and/or lathe sanding of the machined surface and the wheel window is allowed.
Material removal, though, must be kept to a minimum. Re-machining of the wheel is not allowed.
Paint and/or clear coat must not be present on the following surfaces: the nut chamfers, the wheel
mounting surfaces and the wheel pilot hole. The refinisher must permanently ID stamp the wheel
and warrant the painted/clearcoated surfaces for a minimum of one year or the remainder of the
new vehicle warranty, whichever is
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 99-08-51-007E > Mar > 11 > Wheels/Tires Refinishing Aluminum Wheels > Page 7076
longer.
Important Whenever a wheel is refinished, the mounting surface and the wheel nut contact
surfaces must not be painted or clearcoated. Coating these surfaces could affect the wheel nut
torque.
When re-mounting a tire on an aluminum wheel, coated balance weights must be used in order to
reduce the chance of future cosmetic damage.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 06-03-10-010A > Jun > 10 > Wheels - Changing
Procedures/Precautions
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Changing Procedures/Precautions
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 06-03-10-010A
Date: June 09, 2010
Subject: Information on Proper Wheel Changing Procedures and Cautions
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER Models 2005-2009 Saab
9-7X 2005-2009 Saturn Vehicles
Attention:
Complete wheel changing instructions for each vehicle line can be found under Tire and Wheel
Removal and Installation in Service Information (SI). This bulletin is intended to quickly review and
reinforce simple but vital procedures to reduce the possibility of achieving low torque during wheel
installation. Always refer to SI for wheel lug nut torque specifications and complete jacking
instructions for safe wheel changing.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to include the 2011 model year and update the available
special tool list. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 06-03-10-010 (Section 03 Suspension).
Frequency of Wheel Changes - Marketplace Driven
Just a few years ago, the increasing longevity of tires along with greater resistance to punctures
had greatly reduced the number of times wheels were removed to basically required tire rotation
intervals. Today with the booming business in accessory wheels/special application tires (such as
winter tires), consumers are having tire/wheel assemblies removed - replaced - or installed more
than ever. With this increased activity, it opens up more of a chance for error on the part of the
technician. This bulletin will review a few of the common concerns and mistakes to make yourself
aware of.
Proper Servicing Starts With the Right Tools
The following tools have been made available to assist in proper wheel and tire removal and
installation.
- J 41013 Rotor Resurfacing Kit (or equivalent)
- J 42450-A Wheel Hub Resurfacing Kit (or equivalent)
Corroded Surfaces
One area of concern is corrosion on the mating surfaces of the wheel to the hub on the vehicle.
Excessive corrosion, dirt, rust or debris built up on these surfaces can mimic a properly tightened
wheel in the service stall. Once the vehicle is driven, the debris may loosen, grind up or be washed
away from water splash. This action may result in clearance at the mating surface of the wheel and
an under-torqued condition.
Caution
Before installing a wheel, remove any buildup on the wheel mounting surface and brake drum or
brake disc mounting surface. Installing wheels with poor metal-to-metal contact at the mounting
surfaces can cause wheel nuts to loosen. This may cause a wheel to come off when the vehicle is
moving, possibly resulting in a loss of control or personal injury.
Whenever you remove the tire/wheel assemblies, you must inspect the mating surfaces. If
corrosion is found, you should remove the debris with a die grinder equipped with a fine sanding
pad, wire brush or cleaning disc. Just remove enough material to assure a clean, smooth mating
surface.
The J 41013 (or equivalent) can be used to clean the following surfaces:
- The hub mounting surface
- The brake rotor mounting surface
- The wheel mounting surface
Use the J 42450-A (or equivalent) to clean around the base of the studs and the hub.
Lubricants, Grease and Fluids
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 06-03-10-010A > Jun > 10 > Wheels - Changing
Procedures/Precautions > Page 7081
Some customers may use penetrating oils, grease or other lubricants on wheel studs to aid in
removal or installation. Always use a suitable cleaner/solvent to remove these lubricants prior to
installing the wheel and tire assemblies. Lubricants left on the wheel studs may cause improper
readings of wheel nut torque. Always install wheels to clean, dry wheel studs ONLY.
Notice
Lubricants left on the wheel studs or vertical mounting surfaces between the wheel and the rotor or
drum may cause the wheel to work itself loose after the vehicle is driven. Always install wheels to
clean, dry wheel studs and surfaces ONLY. Beginning with 2011 model year vehicles, put a light
coating of grease, GM P/N 1051344 (in Canada, P/N 9930370), on the inner surface of the wheel
pilot hole to prevent wheel seizure to the axle or bearing hub.
Wheel Stud and Lug Nut Damage
Always inspect the wheel studs and lug nuts for signs of damage from crossthreading or abuse.
You should never have to force wheel nuts down the stud. Lug nuts that are damaged may not
retain properly, yet give the impression of fully tightening. Always inspect and replace any
component suspected of damage.
Tip
Always start wheel nuts by hand! Be certain that all wheel nut threads have been engaged
BEFORE tightening the nut.
Important If the vehicle has directional tread tires, verify the directional arrow on the outboard side
of the tire is pointing in the direction of forward rotation.
Wheel Nut Tightening and Torque
Improper wheel nut tightening can lead to brake pulsation and rotor damage. In order to avoid
additional brake repairs, evenly tighten the wheel nuts to the proper torque specification as shown
for each vehicle in SI. Always observe the proper wheel nut tightening sequence as shown below in
order to avoid trapping the wheel on the wheel stud threads or clamping the wheel slightly off
center resulting in vibration.
The Most Important Service You Provide
While the above information is well known, and wheel removal so common, technicians run the risk
of becoming complacent on this very important
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 06-03-10-010A > Jun > 10 > Wheels - Changing
Procedures/Precautions > Page 7082
service operation. A simple distraction or time constraint that rushes the job may result in personal
injury if the greatest of care is not exercised. Make it a habit to double check your work and to
always side with caution when installing wheels.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire
Radial Force Variation (RFV)
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV)
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-03-10-006F
Date: May 04, 2010
Subject: Information on Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009
and Prior Saab 9-7X 2000-2005 Saturn L Series 2003-2007 Saturn ION
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to considerably expand the available information on
Radial Force Variation (RFV) and should be reviewed in whole. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-03-10-006E (Section 03 - Suspension).
Important
- Before measuring tires on equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700, the vehicle MUST be driven
a minimum of 16 km (10 mi) to ensure removal of any flat-spotting. Refer to Corporate Bulletin
Number 03-03-10-007E - Tire/Wheel Characteristics of GM Original Equipment Tires.
- Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 MUST be calibrated prior to measuring tire/wheel
assemblies for each vehicle.
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide guidance to GM dealers when using tire force variation
measurement equipment, such as the Hunter GSP9700. This type of equipment can be a valuable
tool in diagnosing vehicle ride concerns. The most common ride concern involving tire radial force
variation is highway speed shake on smooth roads.
Tire related smooth road highway speed shake can be caused by three conditions: imbalance, out
of round and tire force variation. These three conditions are not necessarily related. All three
conditions must be addressed.
Imbalance is normally addressed first, because it is the simpler of the three to correct. Off-vehicle,
two plane dynamic wheel balancers are readily available and can accurately correct any
imbalance. Balancer calibration and maintenance, proper attachment of the wheel to the balancer,
and proper balance weights, are all factors required for a quality balance. However, a perfectly
balanced tire/wheel assembly can still be "oval shaped" and cause a vibration.
Before balancing, perform the following procedures.
Tire and Wheel Diagnosis
1. Set the tire pressure to the placard values. 2. With the vehicle raised, ensure the wheels are
centered on the hub by loosening all wheel nuts and hand-tightening all nuts first by hand while
shaking the wheel, then torque to specifications using a torque wrench, NOT a torque stick.
3. Visually inspect the tires and the wheels. Inspect for evidence of the following conditions and
correct as necessary:
- Missing balance weights
- Bent rim flange
- Irregular tire wear
- Incomplete bead seating
- Tire irregularities (including pressure settings)
- Mud/ice build-up in wheel
- Stones in the tire tread
- Remove any aftermarket wheels and/or tires and restore vehicle to original condition prior to
diagnosing a smooth road shake condition.
4. Road test the vehicle using the Electronic Vibration Analyzer (EVA) essential tool. Drive for a
sufficient distance on a known, smooth road
surface to duplicate the condition. Determine if the vehicle is sensitive to brake apply. If the brakes
are applied lightly and the pulsation felt in the steering wheel increases, refer to the Brakes section
of the service manual that deals with brake-induced pulsation. If you can start to hear the vibration
as a low boom noise (in addition to feeling it), but cannot see it, the vehicle likely has a first order
(one pulse per propshaft revolution) driveline vibration. Driveline first order vibrations are high
enough in frequency that most humans can start to hear them at highway speeds, but are too high
to be able to be easily seen. These issues can be caused by driveline imbalance or misalignment.
If the vehicle exhibits this low boom and the booming pulses in-and-out on a regular basis (like a
throbbing), chances are good that the vehicle could have driveline vibration. This type
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire
Radial Force Variation (RFV) > Page 7087
of vibration is normally felt more in the "seat of the pants" than the steering wheel.
5. Next, record the Hertz (Hz) reading as displayed by the EVA onto the tire data worksheet found
at the end of this bulletin. This should be done
after a tire break-in period of at least 16 km (10 mi) at 72 km/h (45 mph) or greater, in order to
eliminate any possible tire flat-spotting. This reading confirms what the vehicle vibration frequency
is prior to vehicle service and documents the amount of improvement occurring as the result of the
various steps taken to repair. Completing the Steering Wheel Shake Worksheet below is required.
A copy of the completed worksheet must be saved with the R.O. and a copy included with any
parts returned to the Warranty Parts Center for analysis. A reading of 35 to 50 Hz typically
indicates a first order propshaft vibration. If this is the situation, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
08-07-30-044D. Generally, a reading between 10 and 20 Hz indicates a tire/wheel vibration and if
this is the reading obtained, continue using this bulletin. If the tire 1st order vibration goes away
and stays away during this evaluation, the cause is likely tire flat-spotting. Tire flat-spotting vibration
may come and go at any speed over 72 km/h (45 mph) during the first 10 minutes of operation, if
vibration continues after 10 minutes of driving at speeds greater than 72 km/h (45 mph), tire
flat-spotting can be ruled out as the cause for vibration.
6. If flat-spotting is the cause, provide the explanation that this has occurred due to the vehicle
being parked for long periods of time and that the
nature of the tire is to take a set. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 03-03-10-007E: Information
on Tire/Wheel Characteristics (Vibration, Balance, Shake, Flat Spotting) of GM Original Equipment
Tires.
7. If the road test indicates a shake/vibration exists, check the imbalance of each tire/wheel
assembly on a known, calibrated, off-car dynamic
balancer.Make sure the mounting surface of the wheel and the surface of the balancer are
absolutely clean and free of debris. Be sure to chose the proper cone/collet for the wheel, and
always use the pilot bore for centering. Never center the wheel using the hub-cap bore since it is
not a precision machined surface. If any assembly calls for more than 1/4 ounce on either rim
flange, remove all balance weights and rebalance to as close to zero as possible. If you can see
the vibration (along with feeling it) in the steering wheel (driving straight without your hands on the
wheel), it is very likely to be a tire/wheel first order (one pulse per revolution) disturbance. First
order disturbances can be caused by imbalance as well as non-uniformities in tires, wheels or
hubs. This first order frequency is too low for a human to hear, but if the amplitude is high enough,
it can be seen.
If a vibration or shake still exists after balancing, any out of round conditions, of the wheel, and
force variation conditions of the tire, must be addressed. Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700
can address both (it is also a wheel balancer).
Tire radial force vibration (RFV) can be defined as the amount of stiffness variation the tire will
produce in one revolution under a constant load. Radial force variation is what the vehicle feels
because the load (weight) of the vehicle is always on the tires. Although free runout of tires (not
under load) is not always a good indicator of a smooth ride, it is critical that total tire/wheel
assembly runout be within specification.
Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 loads the tire, similar to on the vehicle, and measures
radial force variation of the tire/wheel assembly. Note that the wheel is affecting the tire's RFV
measurement at this point. To isolate the wheel, its runout must be measured. This can be easily
done on the Hunter, without the need to set up dial indicators. If the wheel meets the runout
specification, the tire's RFV can then be addressed.
After measuring the tire/wheel assembly under load, and the wheel alone, the machine then
calculates (predicts) the radial force variation of the tire. However, because this is a prediction that
can include mounting inaccuracies, and the load wheel is much smaller in diameter than used in
tire production, this type of service equipment should NOT be used to audit new tires. Rather, it
should be used as a service diagnostic tool to minimize radial force variation of the tire/wheel
assembly.
Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 does an excellent job of measuring wheel runout, and of
finding the low point of the wheel (for runout) and the high point of the tire (for radial force
variation). This allows the tire to be matched mounted to the wheel for lowest tire/wheel assembly
force variation.
The machine will simplify this process into easy steps. The following assembly radial force variation
numbers should be used as a guide:
When measuring RFV and match mounting tires perform the following steps.
Measuring Wheel Runout and Assembly Radial Force Variation
Important The completed worksheet at the end of this bulletin must be attached to the hard copy of
the repair order.
- Measure radial force variation and radial runout.
- If a road force/balancing machine is used, record the radial force variation (RFV) on the
worksheet at the end of this bulletin. It may be of benefit to have the lowest RFV assembly to the
front left corner. If the machine is not available and the EVA data suggests there is an issue, swap
the tire and wheel assemblies from the front to the back. Re-check on the EVA and if the problem
still exists, test another vehicle to find tires that do not exhibit the same frequency and swap those
tires onto the subject vehicle.
- If a runout/balancing machine is used, record the radial runout of the tire/wheel assemblies on the
worksheet at the end of this bulletin. If one or more of the tire/wheel assemblies are more than.040
in (1.02 mm), match mount the tire to the wheel to get below.040 in (1.02 mm). For sensitive
customers, readings of 0.030 inch (0.76 mm) or less are preferable, it may also be of benefit to
have the lowest runout assembly to the front left corner. If the machine is not available and the
EVA data suggests there is an issue, swap the tire and wheel assemblies from the front to the
back. Re-check on the EVA and if the problem still exists, test another vehicle to find tires that do
not exhibit the same frequency and swap those tires
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire
Radial Force Variation (RFV) > Page 7088
onto the subject vehicle.
- After match mounting, the tire/wheel assembly must be rebalanced.
If match mounting tires to in-spec wheels produces assembly values higher than these, tire
replacement may be necessary. Replacing tires at lower values will probably mean good tires are
being condemned. Because tires can sometimes become temporarily flat-spotted, which will affect
force variation, it is important that the vehicle be driven at least 16 km (10 mi) prior to measuring.
Tire pressure must also be adjusted to the usage pressure on the vehicle's tire placard prior to
measuring.
Most GM vehicles will tolerate radial force variation up to these levels. However, some vehicles are
more sensitive, and may require lower levels. Also, there are other tire parameters that equipment
such as the Hunter GSP9700 cannot measure that may be a factor. In such cases, TAC should be
contacted for further instructions.
Important
- When mounting a GM wheel to a wheel balancer/force variation machine, always use the wheel's
center pilot hole. This is the primary centering mechanism on all GM wheels; the bolt holes are
secondary. Usually a back cone method to the machine should be used. For added accuracy and
repeatability, a flange plate should be used to clamp the wheel onto the cone and machine. This
system is offered by all balancer manufacturers in GM's dealer program.
- Any type of service equipment that removes tread rubber by grinding, buffing or truing is NOT
recommended, and may void the tire warranty. However, tires may have been ground by the tire
company as part of their tire manufacturing process. This is a legitimate procedure.
Steering Wheel Shake Worksheet
When diagnosing vibration concerns, use the following worksheet in conjunction with the
appropriate Vibration Analysis-Road testing procedure in the Vibration Correction sub-section in SI.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire
Radial Force Variation (RFV) > Page 7089
Refer to the appropriate section of SI for specifications and repair procedures that are related to the
vibration concern.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 05-03-10-003F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Low
Tire/Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 05-03-10-003F
Date: April 27, 2010
Subject: Low Tire Pressure, Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels (Repair with Adhesive Sealant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X with Cast Aluminum Wheels
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years and the bulletin reference
information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-10-003E (Section 03 - Suspension).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a low tire pressure condition.
Diagnosis of the low tire pressure condition indicates an air leak through the cast aluminum wheel.
Cause
Porosity in the cast aluminum wheel may be the cause.
Notice
This bulletin specifically addresses issues related to the wheel casting that may result in an air
leak. For issues related to corrosion of the wheel in service, please refer to Corporate Bulletin
Number 08-03-10-006C - Tire Slowly Goes Flat, Tire Air Loss, Low Tire Pressure Warning Light
Illuminated, Aluminum Wheel Bead Seat Corrosion (Clean and Resurface Wheel Bead Seat).
Correction
1. Remove the tire and wheel assembly from the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate service
procedure in SI. 2. Locate the leaking area by inflating the tire to 276 kPa (40 psi) and dipping the
tire/wheel assembly in a water bath, or use a spray bottle with soap
and water to locate the specific leak location.
Important
- If the porosity leak is located in the bead area of the aluminum rim (where the tire meets the rim),
the wheel should be replaced.
- If two or more leaks are located on one wheel, the wheel should be replaced.
3. If air bubbles are observed, mark the location.
- If the leak location is on the tire/rubber area, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 04-03-10-001F Tire Puncture Repair Procedures for All Cars and Light Duty Trucks.
- If the leak is located on the aluminum wheel area, continue with the next step.
4. Inscribe a mark on the tire at the valve stem in order to indicate the orientation of the tire to the
wheel. 5. Dismount the tire from the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. 6. Remove
the tire pressure sensor. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor removal procedure in SI. 7. Scuff the
INSIDE rim surface at the leak area with #80 grit paper and clean the area with general purpose
cleaner, such as 3M(R) General Purpose
Adhesive Cleaner, P/N 08984, or equivalent.
8. Apply a 3 mm (0.12 in) thick layer of Silicone - Adhesive/Sealant, P/N 12378478 (in Canada, use
88900041), or equivalent, to the leak area. 9. Allow for the adhesive/sealant to dry.
Notice Caution must be used when mounting the tire so as not to damage the sealer. Damaging
the repair area may result in an air leak.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 05-03-10-003F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Low
Tire/Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels > Page 7094
10. Align the inscribed mark on the tire with the valve stem on the wheel. 11. Reinstall the Tire
Pressure Sensor. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor installation procedure in SI. 12. Mount the tire on
the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. 13. Pressurize the tire to 276 kPa (40 psi) and
inspect for leaks. 14. Adjust tire pressure to meet the placard specification. 15. Balance the
tire/wheel assembly. Refer to Tire and Wheel Assembly Balancing - Off-Vehicle. 16. Install the tire
and wheel assembly onto the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate service procedure in SI.
Parts Information
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
Important The Silicone - Adhesive/Sealant comes in a case quantity of six. ONLY charge warranty
one tube of adhesive/sealant per wheel repair.
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
One leak repair per wheel.
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 08-03-10-006C > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Tire
Slowly Goes Flat/Warning Light ON
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Tires/Wheels - Tire Slowly Goes Flat/Warning Light ON
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 08-03-10-006C
Date: April 27, 2010
Subject: Tire Slowly Goes Flat, Tire Air Loss, Low Tire Pressure Warning Light Illuminated,
Aluminum Wheel Bead Seat Corrosion (Clean and Resurface Wheel Bead Seat)
Models:
2000-2011 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2009 HUMMER H2
2006-2010 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 08-03-10-006B (Section 03 - Suspension).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a tire that slowly loses air pressure over a period of days or
weeks.
Cause
Abrasive elements in the environment may intrude between the tire and wheel at the bead seat.
There is always some relative motion between the tire and wheel (when the vehicle is driven) and
this motion may cause the abrasive particles to wear the wheel and tire materials. As the wear
continues, there may also be intrusion at the tire/wheel interface by corrosive media from the
environment. Eventually a path for air develops and a 'slow' leak may ensue. This corrosion may
appear on the inboard or outboard bead seating surface of the wheel. This corrosion will not be
visible until the tire is dismounted from the wheel.
Notice
This bulletin specifically addresses issues related to wheel bead seat corrosion that may result in
an air leak. For issues related to porosity of the wheel casting that may result in an air leak, please
refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-10-006F - Low Tire Pressure, Leaking Cast Aluminum
Wheels (Repair with Adhesive Sealant)
Correction
In most cases, this type of air loss can be corrected by following the procedure below.
Important DO NOT replace a wheel for slow air loss unless you have evaluated and/or tried to
repair the wheel with the procedure below.
Notice
The repair is no longer advised or applicable for chromed aluminum wheels.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly for diagnosis. Refer to Tire and Wheel Removal and
Installation in SI. 2. After a water dunk tank leak test, if you determine the source of the air leak to
be around the bead seat of the wheel, dismount the tire to examine
the bead seat. Shown below is a typical area of bead seat corrosion.Typical Location of Bead Seat
Corrosion
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 08-03-10-006C > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Tire
Slowly Goes Flat/Warning Light ON > Page 7099
Important Other forms of slow air leaks are possible. If the body of the tire, valve stem and wheel
flange show no signs of air seepage, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-10-003D for
additional information on possible wheel porosity issues.
3. Bead seat corrosion is identified by what appears like blistering of the wheel finish, causing a
rough or uneven surface that is difficult for the tire to
maintain a proper seal on. Below is a close-up photo of bead seat corrosion on an aluminum wheel
that was sufficient to cause slow air loss. Close-Up of Bead Seat Corrosion
4. If corrosion is found on the wheel bead seat, measure the affected area as shown below.
- For vehicles with 32,186 km (20,000 mi) or less, the total allowable combined linear area of
repairable corrosion is 100 mm (4 in) or less. If the total area(s) of corrosion exceed these
dimensions, the wheel should be replaced.
- For vehicles that have exceeded 32,186 km (20,000 mi), the total allowable combined linear area
of repairable corrosion is 200 mm (8 in) or less. If the total area(s) of corrosion exceed these
dimensions, the wheel should be replaced.
5. In order to correct the wheel leak, use a clean-up (fine cut) sanding disc or biscuit to remove the
corrosion and any flaking paint. You should
remove the corrosion back far enough until you reach material that is stable and firmly bonded to
the wheel. Try to taper the edge of any flaking paint as best you can in order to avoid sharp edges
that may increase the chance of a leak reoccurring. The photo below shows an acceptable repaired
surface.
Notice Corrosion that extends up the lip of the wheel, where after the clean-up process it would be
visible with the tire mounted, is only acceptable on the inboard flange. The inboard flange is not
visible with the wheel assembly in the mounted position. If any loose coatings or corrosion extend
to the visible surfaces on the FACE of the wheel, that wheel must be replaced.
Important Remove ONLY the material required to eliminate the corrosion from the bead seating
surface. DO NOT remove excessive amounts of material. ALWAYS keep the sealing surface as
smooth and level as possible.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 08-03-10-006C > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Tire
Slowly Goes Flat/Warning Light ON > Page 7100
Acceptably Prepared (Cleaned-Up) Wheel Surface
6. Once the corrosion has been eliminated, you should coat the repaired area with a commercially
available tire sealant such as Patch Brand Bead
Sealant or equivalent. Commercially available bead sealants are black rubber-like coatings that will
permanently fill and seal the resurfaced bead seat. At 21°C (70°F) ambient temperature, this
sealant will set-up sufficiently for tire mounting in about 10 minutes.Coated and Sealed Bead Seat
7. Remount the tire and install the repaired wheel and tire assembly. Refer to Tire and Wheel
Removal and Installation in SI.
Parts Information
Patch Brand Bead Sealer is available from Myers Tires at 1-800-998-9897 or on the web at
www.myerstiresupply.com. The one-quart size can of sealer will repair about 20 wheels.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 08-03-10-006C > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Tire
Slowly Goes Flat/Warning Light ON > Page 7101
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 04-03-10-012B > Feb > 08 > Wheels - Chrome
Wheel Brake Dust Accumulation/Pitting
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Chrome Wheel Brake Dust Accumulation/Pitting
Bulletin No.: 04-03-10-012B
Date: February 01, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Pitting and Brake Dust on Chrome wheels
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2008 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
04-03-10-012A (Section 03 - Suspension).
Analysis of Returned Wheels
Chrome wheels returned under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty for pitting concerns have
recently been evaluated. This condition is usually most severe in the vent (or window) area of the
front wheels. This "pitting" may actually be brake dust that has been allowed to accumulate on the
wheel. The longer this accumulation builds up, the more difficult it is to remove.
Cleaning the Wheels
In all cases, the returned wheels could be cleaned to their original condition using GM Vehicle Care
Cleaner Wax, P/N 12377966 (in Canada, P/N 10952905). When using this product, you should
confine your treatment to the areas of the wheel that show evidence of the brake dust build-up.
This product is only for use on chromed steel or chromed aluminum wheels.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
Wheel replacement for this condition is NOT applicable under the terms of the New Vehicle Limited
Warranty.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Chrome Wheel Staining/Pitting/Corrosion
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-03-10-002F
Date: April 21, 2011
Subject: Chemical Staining, Pitting, Corrosion and/or Spotted Appearance of Chromed Aluminum
Wheels
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years, suggest additional restorative
products and add additional corrosion information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
00-03-10-002E (Section 03 - Suspension). Important You may give a copy of this bulletin to the
customer.
What is Chemical Staining of Chrome Wheels? Figure 1
Chemical staining in most cases results from acid based cleaners (refer to Figure 1 for an
example). These stains are frequently milky, black, or greenish in appearance. They result from
using cleaning solutions that contain acids on chrome wheels. Soap and water is usually sufficient
to clean wheels.
If the customer insists on using a wheel cleaner they should only use one that specifically states
that it is safe for chromed wheels and does not contain anything in the following list. (Dealers
should also survey any products they use during prep or normal cleaning of stock units for these
chemicals.)
- Ammonium Bifluoride (fluoride source for dissolution of chrome)
- Hydrofluoric Acid (directly dissolves chrome)
- Hydrochloric Acid (directly dissolves chrome)
- Sodium Dodecylbenzenesulfonic Acid
- Sulfamic Acid
- Phosphoric Acid
- Hydroxyacetic Acid
Notice
Many wheel cleaner instructions advise to take care to avoid contact with painted surfaces. Most
customers think of painted surfaces as the fenders, quarter panels and other exterior sheet metal.
Many vehicles have painted brake calipers. Acidic wheel cleaners may craze, crack, or discolor the
paint on the brake calipers. Damage from wheel cleaners is not covered under the vehicle new car
warranty. Soap and water applied with a soft brush is usually all that is required to clean the
calipers.
Whenever any wheel cleaner is used, it must be THOROUGHLY rinsed off of the wheel with clean,
clear water. Special care must be taken to rinse under the hub cap, balance weights, wheel nuts,
lug nut caps, between the wheel cladding and off the back side of the wheel. Wheels returned to
the Warranty Parts Center (WPC) that exhibit damage from wheel cleaners most often have the
damage around and under the wheel weight where the cleaner was incompletely flushed away.
Notice
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion > Page 7111
Do not use cleaning solutions that contain hydrofluoric, oxalic and most other acids on chrome
wheels (or any wheels).
If the customer is unsure of the chemical make-up of a particular wheel cleaner, it should be
avoided.
For wheels showing signs of milky staining from acidic cleaners, refer to Customer Assistance and
Instructions below.
Warranty of Stained Chrome Wheels
Stained wheels are not warrantable. Most acid based cleaners will permanently stain chrome
wheels. Follow-up with dealers has confirmed that such cleaners were used on wheels that were
returned to the Warranty Parts Center (WPC). Any stained wheels received by the WPC will be
charged back to the dealership. To assist the customer, refer to Customer Assistance and
Instructions below.
Pitting or Spotted Appearance of Chrome Wheels Figure 2
A second type or staining or finish disturbance may result from road chemicals, such as calcium
chloride used for dust control of unpaved roads. The staining will look like small pitting (refer to
Figure 2). This staining will usually be on the leading edges of each wheel spoke, but may be
uniformly distributed. If a vehicle must be operated under such conditions, the chrome wheels
should be washed with mild soap and water and thoroughly rinsed as soon as conveniently
possible.
Important Road chemicals, such as calcium chloride used for dust control of unpaved roads, can
also stain chrome wheels. The staining will look like small pitting. This staining will usually be on
the leading edges of each wheel spoke. This is explained by the vehicle traveling in the forward
direction while being splashed by the road chemical. If a vehicle must be operated under such
conditions, the chrome wheels should be washed with mild soap and water and thoroughly rinsed
as soon as conveniently possible.
Warranty of Pitted or Spotted Chrome Wheels
Wheels returned with pitting or spotting as a result of road chemicals may be replaced one time.
Damage resulting from contact with these applied road chemicals is corrosive to the wheels finish
and may cause damage if the wheels are not kept clean.
Important Notify the customer that this is a one time replacement. Please stress to the customer
the vital importance of keeping the wheels clean if they are operating the vehicle in an area that
applies calcium chloride or other dust controlling chemicals! "GM of Canada" dealers require prior
approval by the District Manager - Customer Care and Service Process (DM-CCSP).
"Stardust" Corrosion of Chrome Wheels Figure 3
A third type of finish disturbance results from prolonged exposure to brake dust and resultant
penetration of brake dust through the chrome. As brakes are applied hot particles of brake material
are thrown off and tend to be forced through the leading edge of the wheel spoke windows by
airflow. These
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion > Page 7112
hot particles embed themselves in the chrome layer and create a small pit. If the material is allowed
to sit on the wheel while it is exposed to moisture or salt, it will corrode the wheel beneath the
chrome leaving a pit or small blister in the chrome.
Heavy brake dust build-up should be removed from wheels by using GM Chrome Cleaner and
Polish, P/N 1050173 (in Canada use 10953013). For moderate cleaning, light brake dust build-up
or water spots use GM Swirl Remover Polish, P/N 12377965 (in Canada, use Meguiars
Plast-X(TM) Clear Plastic Cleaner and Polish #G12310C**). After cleaning, the wheel should be
waxed using GM Cleaner Wax, P/N 12377966 (in Canada, use Meguiars Cleaner Wax
#M0616C**), which will help protect the wheel from brake dust and reduce adhesion of any brake
dust that gets on the wheel surface. For general maintenance cleaning, PEEK Metal Polish† may
be used. It will clean and shine the chrome and leave behind a wax coating that may help protect
the finish.
Warranty of Stardust Corroded Chrome Wheels
Wheels returned with pitting or spotting as a result of neglect and brake dust build-up may be
replaced one time.
Important Notify the customer that this is a one time replacement. Please stress to the customer
the vital importance of keeping the wheels clean and free of prolonged exposure to brake dust
build-up. "GM of Canada" dealers require prior approval by the District Manager - Customer Care
and Service Process (DM-CCSP).
Customer Assistance and Instructions
GM has looked for ways customers may improve the appearance of wheels damaged by acidic
cleaners. The following product and procedure has been found to dramatically improve the
appearance of stained wheels. For wheels that have milky stains caused by acidic cleaners try the
following:
Notice
THE 3M CHROME AND METAL POLISH REQUIRED FOR THIS PROCEDURE IS AN
EXTREMELY AGGRESSIVE POLISH/CLEANER. THE WHEELS MUST BE CLEANED BEFORE
APPLICATION TO AVOID SCRATCHING THE WHEEL SURFACE. THIS PRODUCT WILL
REDUCE THE THICKNESS OF THE CHROME PLATING ON THE WHEEL AND IF USED
INCORRECTLY OR EXCESSIVELY MAY REMOVE THE CHROME PLATING ALL TOGETHER,
EXPOSING A LESS BRIGHT AND BRASSY COLORED SUB-LAYER. FOLLOW INSTRUCTIONS
EXACTLY.
1. Wash the wheels with vigorously with soap and water. This step will clean and may reduce
wheel staining. Flood all areas of the wheel with water
to rinse.
2. Dry the wheels completely.
Notice Begin with a small section of the wheel and with light pressure buff off polish and examine
results. ONLY apply and rub with sufficient force and time to remove enough staining that you are
satisfied with the results. Some wheels may be stained to the extent that you may only achieve a
50% improvement while others may be able to be restored to the original lustre. IN ALL CASES,
only apply until the results are satisfactory.
3. Apply 3M Chrome and Metal Polish #39527* with a clean terry cloth towel. As you apply the
polish, the staining will be diminished. 4. When dry, buff off the polish with a clean portion of the
towel. 5. Repeat application of the 3M Chrome and Metal Polish until satisfied with the results. If
continued applications fail to improve the appearance
further discontinue use.
This procedure will improve the appearance of the wheels and may, with repeated applications,
restore the finish dramatically. For wheels that exhibit spotting from road chemicals the above
procedure may marginally improve the condition but will not restore the finish or remove the pitting.
In this type of staining the wheel finish has actually been removed in spots and no manner of
cleaning will restore the finish.
†*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or
assume any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may
be available from other sources.
Parts Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion > Page 7113
*This product is currently available from 3M. To obtain information for your local retail location
please call 3M at 1-888-364-3577.
**This product is currently available from Meguiars (Canada). To obtain information for your local
retail location please call Meguiars at 1-800-347-5700 or at www.meguiarscanada.com.
^ This product is currently available from Tri-Peek International. To obtain information for your local
retail location please call Tri-Peek at
1-877-615-4272 or at www.tripeek.com.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 99-08-51-007E > Mar > 11 > Wheels/Tires Refinishing Aluminum Wheels
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Refinishing Aluminum Wheels
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 99-08-51-007E
Date: March 17, 2011
Subject: Refinishing Aluminum Wheels
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add additional model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 99-08-51-007D (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
This bulletin updates General Motor's position on refinishing aluminum wheels. GM does not
endorse any repairs that involve welding, bending, straightening or re-machining. Only cosmetic
refinishing of the wheel's coatings, using recommended procedures, is allowed.
Evaluating Damage
In evaluating damage, it is the GM Dealer's responsibility to inspect the wheel for corrosion,
scrapes, gouges, etc. The Dealer must insure that such damage is not deeper than what can be
sanded or polished off. The wheel must be inspected for cracks. If cracks are found, discard the
wheel. Any wheels with bent rim flanges must not be repaired or refinished. Wheels that have been
refinished by an outside company must be returned to the same vehicle. The Dealer must record
the wheel ID stamp or the cast date on the wheel in order to assure this requirement. Refer to
Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company later in this bulletin.
Aluminum Wheel Refinishing Recommendations
- Chrome-plated aluminum wheels Re-plating these wheels is not recommended.
- Polished aluminum wheels These wheels have a polyester or acrylic clearcoat on them. If the
clearcoat is damaged, refinishing is possible. However, the required refinishing process cannot be
performed in the dealer environment. Refer to Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company later
in this bulletin.
- Painted aluminum wheels These wheels are painted using a primer, color coat, and clearcoat
procedure. If the paint is damaged, refinishing is possible. As with polished wheels, all original
coatings must be removed first. Media blasting is recommended. Refer to GM Aluminum
Refinishing Bulletin #53-17-03A for the re-painting of this type of wheel.
- Bright, machined aluminum wheels These wheels have a polyester or acrylic clearcoat on them.
In some cases, the recessed "pocket" areas of the wheel may be painted. Surface refinishing is
possible. The wheel must be totally stripped by media blasting or other suitable means. The wheel
should be resurfaced by using a sanding process rather than a machining process. This allows the
least amount of material to be removed.
Important Do not use any re-machining process that removes aluminum. This could affect the
dimensions and function of the wheel.
Painting is an option to re-clearcoating polished and bright machined aluminum wheels. Paint will
better mask any surface imperfections and is somewhat more durable than clearcoat alone. GM
recommends using Corsican SILVER WAEQ9283 for a fine "aluminum-like" look or Sparkle
SILVER WA9967 for a very bright look. As an option, the body color may also be used. When using
any of the painting options, it is recommended that all four wheels be refinished in order to maintain
color uniformity. Refer to GM Aluminum Refinishing Bulletin #53-17-03A for specific procedures
and product recommendations.
Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company
Important Some outside companies are offering wheel refinishing services. Such refinished wheels
will be permanently marked by the refinisher and are warranted by the refinisher. Any process that
re-machines or otherwise re-manufactures the wheel should not be used.
A refinisher's responsibility includes inspecting for cracks using the Zyglo system or the equivalent.
Any cracked wheels must not be refinished. No welding, hammering or reforming of any kind is
allowed. The wheel ID must be recorded and follow the wheel throughout the process in order to
assure that the same wheel is returned. A plastic media blast may be used for clean up of the
wheel. Hand and/or lathe sanding of the machined surface and the wheel window is allowed.
Material removal, though, must be kept to a minimum. Re-machining of the wheel is not allowed.
Paint and/or clear coat must not be present on the following surfaces: the nut chamfers, the wheel
mounting surfaces and the wheel pilot hole. The refinisher must permanently ID stamp the wheel
and warrant the painted/clearcoated surfaces for a minimum of one year or the remainder of the
new vehicle warranty, whichever is
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 99-08-51-007E > Mar > 11 > Wheels/Tires Refinishing Aluminum Wheels > Page 7118
longer.
Important Whenever a wheel is refinished, the mounting surface and the wheel nut contact
surfaces must not be painted or clearcoated. Coating these surfaces could affect the wheel nut
torque.
When re-mounting a tire on an aluminum wheel, coated balance weights must be used in order to
reduce the chance of future cosmetic damage.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 06-03-10-010A > Jun > 10 > Wheels - Changing
Procedures/Precautions
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Changing Procedures/Precautions
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 06-03-10-010A
Date: June 09, 2010
Subject: Information on Proper Wheel Changing Procedures and Cautions
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER Models 2005-2009 Saab
9-7X 2005-2009 Saturn Vehicles
Attention:
Complete wheel changing instructions for each vehicle line can be found under Tire and Wheel
Removal and Installation in Service Information (SI). This bulletin is intended to quickly review and
reinforce simple but vital procedures to reduce the possibility of achieving low torque during wheel
installation. Always refer to SI for wheel lug nut torque specifications and complete jacking
instructions for safe wheel changing.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to include the 2011 model year and update the available
special tool list. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 06-03-10-010 (Section 03 Suspension).
Frequency of Wheel Changes - Marketplace Driven
Just a few years ago, the increasing longevity of tires along with greater resistance to punctures
had greatly reduced the number of times wheels were removed to basically required tire rotation
intervals. Today with the booming business in accessory wheels/special application tires (such as
winter tires), consumers are having tire/wheel assemblies removed - replaced - or installed more
than ever. With this increased activity, it opens up more of a chance for error on the part of the
technician. This bulletin will review a few of the common concerns and mistakes to make yourself
aware of.
Proper Servicing Starts With the Right Tools
The following tools have been made available to assist in proper wheel and tire removal and
installation.
- J 41013 Rotor Resurfacing Kit (or equivalent)
- J 42450-A Wheel Hub Resurfacing Kit (or equivalent)
Corroded Surfaces
One area of concern is corrosion on the mating surfaces of the wheel to the hub on the vehicle.
Excessive corrosion, dirt, rust or debris built up on these surfaces can mimic a properly tightened
wheel in the service stall. Once the vehicle is driven, the debris may loosen, grind up or be washed
away from water splash. This action may result in clearance at the mating surface of the wheel and
an under-torqued condition.
Caution
Before installing a wheel, remove any buildup on the wheel mounting surface and brake drum or
brake disc mounting surface. Installing wheels with poor metal-to-metal contact at the mounting
surfaces can cause wheel nuts to loosen. This may cause a wheel to come off when the vehicle is
moving, possibly resulting in a loss of control or personal injury.
Whenever you remove the tire/wheel assemblies, you must inspect the mating surfaces. If
corrosion is found, you should remove the debris with a die grinder equipped with a fine sanding
pad, wire brush or cleaning disc. Just remove enough material to assure a clean, smooth mating
surface.
The J 41013 (or equivalent) can be used to clean the following surfaces:
- The hub mounting surface
- The brake rotor mounting surface
- The wheel mounting surface
Use the J 42450-A (or equivalent) to clean around the base of the studs and the hub.
Lubricants, Grease and Fluids
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 06-03-10-010A > Jun > 10 > Wheels - Changing
Procedures/Precautions > Page 7123
Some customers may use penetrating oils, grease or other lubricants on wheel studs to aid in
removal or installation. Always use a suitable cleaner/solvent to remove these lubricants prior to
installing the wheel and tire assemblies. Lubricants left on the wheel studs may cause improper
readings of wheel nut torque. Always install wheels to clean, dry wheel studs ONLY.
Notice
Lubricants left on the wheel studs or vertical mounting surfaces between the wheel and the rotor or
drum may cause the wheel to work itself loose after the vehicle is driven. Always install wheels to
clean, dry wheel studs and surfaces ONLY. Beginning with 2011 model year vehicles, put a light
coating of grease, GM P/N 1051344 (in Canada, P/N 9930370), on the inner surface of the wheel
pilot hole to prevent wheel seizure to the axle or bearing hub.
Wheel Stud and Lug Nut Damage
Always inspect the wheel studs and lug nuts for signs of damage from crossthreading or abuse.
You should never have to force wheel nuts down the stud. Lug nuts that are damaged may not
retain properly, yet give the impression of fully tightening. Always inspect and replace any
component suspected of damage.
Tip
Always start wheel nuts by hand! Be certain that all wheel nut threads have been engaged
BEFORE tightening the nut.
Important If the vehicle has directional tread tires, verify the directional arrow on the outboard side
of the tire is pointing in the direction of forward rotation.
Wheel Nut Tightening and Torque
Improper wheel nut tightening can lead to brake pulsation and rotor damage. In order to avoid
additional brake repairs, evenly tighten the wheel nuts to the proper torque specification as shown
for each vehicle in SI. Always observe the proper wheel nut tightening sequence as shown below in
order to avoid trapping the wheel on the wheel stud threads or clamping the wheel slightly off
center resulting in vibration.
The Most Important Service You Provide
While the above information is well known, and wheel removal so common, technicians run the risk
of becoming complacent on this very important
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 06-03-10-010A > Jun > 10 > Wheels - Changing
Procedures/Precautions > Page 7124
service operation. A simple distraction or time constraint that rushes the job may result in personal
injury if the greatest of care is not exercised. Make it a habit to double check your work and to
always side with caution when installing wheels.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 04-03-10-012B > Feb > 08 > Wheels - Chrome
Wheel Brake Dust Accumulation/Pitting
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Chrome Wheel Brake Dust Accumulation/Pitting
Bulletin No.: 04-03-10-012B
Date: February 01, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Pitting and Brake Dust on Chrome wheels
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2008 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
04-03-10-012A (Section 03 - Suspension).
Analysis of Returned Wheels
Chrome wheels returned under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty for pitting concerns have
recently been evaluated. This condition is usually most severe in the vent (or window) area of the
front wheels. This "pitting" may actually be brake dust that has been allowed to accumulate on the
wheel. The longer this accumulation builds up, the more difficult it is to remove.
Cleaning the Wheels
In all cases, the returned wheels could be cleaned to their original condition using GM Vehicle Care
Cleaner Wax, P/N 12377966 (in Canada, P/N 10952905). When using this product, you should
confine your treatment to the areas of the wheel that show evidence of the brake dust build-up.
This product is only for use on chromed steel or chromed aluminum wheels.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
Wheel replacement for this condition is NOT applicable under the terms of the New Vehicle Limited
Warranty.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7129
Wheels: Testing and Inspection
Wheel Mounting Surface Check
Replace any wheels that are bent or dented, or have excessive lateral or radial runout. Wheels with
runout greater than specified may cause objectionable vibrations.
1. Use a straight edge 200 - 229 mm (09 inch) long. Place the straight edge on the wheel inboard
mounting surface. Try to rock the straightedge up
and down within the mounting surface.
2. Repeat this procedure on at least 3-4 different positions on the inboard mounting surface.
^ The outer ring of the mounting surface normally is raised above everything inside the mounting
surface.
^ The mounting surface will be raised above the outer ring if the wheel mounting surface has been
bent on a tire changer.
^ If you can rock the straight edge, the mounting surface is bent and you must replace the wheel.
3. Inspect the mounting wheel/nut holes for damage caused from over-torquing the wheel/nuts.
Inspect for collapsed wheel/nut bosses. Inspect for
cracked wheel bosses.
Notice: The use of non-GM original equipment wheels may cause: ^
Damage to the wheel bearing, the wheel fasteners and the wheel
^ Tire damage caused by the modified clearance to the adjacent vehicle components
^ Adverse vehicle steering stability caused by the modified scrub radius
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7130
^ Damage to the vehicle caused by the modified ground clearance
^ Speedometer and odometer inaccuracy
Important: ^
Replacement wheels must be equivalent to the original equipment wheels in the following ways: The load capacity
- The wheel diameter
- The rim width
- The wheel offset
- The mounting configuration
^ A wheel of the incorrect size or type may affect the following conditions: Wheel and hub-bearing life
- Brake cooling
- Speedometer/odometer calibration
- Vehicle ground clearance
- Tire clearance to the body and the chassis
4. Replace the wheel if the wheel is bent. 5. Replace the wheel if the wheel/nut boss area is
cracked. Identify steel wheels with a 2 or 3-letter code stamped into the rim near the valve stem.
Aluminum wheels have the code, the part number, and the manufacturer identification cast into the
back side of the wheel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Aluminum Wheel Porosity Repair
Wheels: Service and Repair Aluminum Wheel Porosity Repair
Aluminum Wheel Porosity Repair
1. Remove the tire and wheel. 2. Inflate the tire to the manufactures specified pressure as stated
on the tire. 3. Submerge the tire/wheel into a water bath in order to locate the leak. 4. Inscribe a
mark on the wheel in order to indicate the leak areas. 5. Inscribe a mark on the tire at the valve
stem in order to indicate the orientation of the tire to the wheel. 6. Remove the tire from the wheel.
Important: Do not damage the exterior surface of the wheel.
7. Use number 80 grit sandpaper to scuff the inside of the rim surface at the leak area. 8. Use
general purpose cleaner such as EMS, P/N 08984 or equivalent, to clean the leak area. 9. Apply 3
mm (0.12 inch) thick layer of adhesive/sealant, GM P/N 12378478 (Canadian P/N 88900041) or
equivalent, to the leak area.
10. Allow for the adhesive/sealant to dry. 11. Align the inscribed mark on the tire with the valve
stem on the wheel. 12. Install the tire to the wheel. 13. Inflate the tire to the manufactures specified
pressure as stated on the tire. 14. Submerge the tire/wheel into a water bath in order ensure the
leak is sealed. 15. Balance the tire and wheel. 16. Install the tire and wheel. 17. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Aluminum Wheel Porosity Repair > Page 7133
Wheels: Service and Repair Aluminum Wheel Refinishing
Aluminum Wheel Refinishing
Finish Damage Evaluation Procedure
Important: ^
If the wheels are chrome-plated, do not re-plate or refinish the wheels.
^ If the wheels are polished aluminum, do not refinish the wheels in the dealer environment. Utilize
a refinisher that meets manufacturer guidelines.
1. Inspect the wheels for damage from uncoated wheel balance weights or from automatic car
wash facilities. 2. Inspect the wheels for the following conditions:
^ Corrosion
^ Scrape
^ Gouges
3. Verify the damage is not deeper than what sanding can remove. 4. Inspect the wheels for
cracks. If a wheel has cracks, discard the wheel. 5. Inspect the wheels for bent rim flanges. If a rim
flange is bent, discard the wheel.
Refinishing Procedure
Caution: To avoid serious personal injury when applying any two part component paint system,
follow the specific precautions provided by the paint manufacturer. Failure to follow these
precautions may cause lung irritation and allergic respiratory reaction.
1. Remove the tire and wheel assembly from the vehicle. 2. Remove the balance weights from the
wheel. 3. Remove the tire from the wheel. 4. Use a suitable cleaner in order to remove the
following contaminants from the wheel:
^ Lubricants
^ Wax
^ Dirt
Important: ^
Do not re-machine the wheel.
^ Do not use chemicals in order to strip the paint from the wheel.
5. Use plastic media blasting in order to remove the paint from the wheel. 6. If the wheel had a
machined aluminum finish, spin the wheel and use sand paper in order to restore the circular
machined appearance.
Important: The wheel mounting surface and the wheel nut contact surface must remain free of
paint.
7. Mask the wheel mounting surface and the wheel nut contact surface. 8. Follow the paint
manufacturer's instructions for painting the wheel. 9. Unmask the wheel.
10. Install a new valve stem.
Important: Use new coated balance weights in order to balance the wheel.
11. Install the tire to the wheel. 12. Use a suitable cleaner in order to remove the following
contaminants from the wheel mounting surface:
^ Corrosion
^ Overspray
^ Dirt
13. Install the tire and wheel assembly to the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Specifications
Wheel Bearing: Specifications
"Information not supplied by the manufacturer"
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed
Wheel Bearing: Testing and Inspection Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed
Wheel Bearings Diagnosis (Sealed)
- Tools Required J 8001 Dial Indicator
The following procedure describes how to inspect the wheel bearing/hub for excessive looseness.
If you are inspecting the wheel bearing/hub for excessive runout, refer to Tire and Wheel Assembly
Runout Measurement - On-Vehicle.
Important: If you are inspecting the FRONT wheel bearing/hub, support the front of the vehicle by
the lower control arms in order to load the lower ball joint.
1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Mount and secure the J 8001 to a
stand. 3. Ensure that the J 8001 contacts the vertical surface of the wheel as close as possible to
the top wheel stud. 4. Push and pull on the TOP of the tire. 5. Inspect the total movement indicated
by the J 8001. 6. If the measurement exceeds 0.127 mm (0.005 inch), replace the wheel
bearing/hub.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed > Page 7139
Wheel Bearing: Testing and Inspection Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Tapered
Wheel Bearings Diagnosis (Tapered)
Tapered Roller Bearing Diagnosis
The following procedure describes how to inspect the wheel bearing for excessive looseness. If
excessive wheel bearing looseness is present, adjust the wheel bearings. If excessive looseness is
still present after adjustment, inspect the wheel bearings. Consider the following factors when
diagnosing the wheel bearing condition: General condition of the following parts during disassembly and inspection: Wheel bearings
- Races
- Seals
- Lubricant
- Steering Knuckle
- Classify the failure of the wheel bearing with the aid of the illustrations.
- Determine the cause of the wheel bearing failure.
- Replace the damaged parts.
Abrasive Roller Wear
The pattern on the races and the rollers is caused by fine abrasives. 1. Clean all of the parts and
the housings. 2. Check the seals and the bearings. 3. Replace leaky seals, rough, or noisy
bearings.
Abrasive Step Wear
The pattern on the roller ends is caused by fine abrasives. 1. Clean all of the parts and the
housings. 2. Check the seals and the bearings. 3. Replace leaky seals, rough, or noisy bearings.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed > Page 7140
Galling
The metal smears on the roller ends are due to overheating, lubricant failure, or lubricant overload.
1. Check the seals. 2. Check for proper lubrication. 3. Clean all of the parts and the housings. 4.
Replace the bearing.
Etching
The bearing surfaces appear gray or grayish black in color, with related etching away of material
usually at roller spacing. 1. Check the seals. 2. Check for proper lubrication. 3. Clean all of the
parts and the housings. 4. Replace the bearings.
Bent Cage
When a cage is damaged due to improper handling or improper tool usage. Replace the bearing.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed > Page 7141
Bent Cage
The cage may be damaged due to improper handling or improper tool usage. Replace the bearing.
Cage Wear
The wear around the outside diameter of the cage and the roller pockets is caused by abrasive
material or inefficient lubrication. 1. Check the seals. 2. Clean all the parts and the housings. 3.
Replace the bearings.
Indentations
The surface depressions on the race and the rollers are caused by hard particles of foreign matter.
1. Check the seals. 2. Clean all the parts and the housings. 3. Replace the bearings.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed > Page 7142
Frettage
The corrosion caused by small relative movement of parts with no lubrication. 1. Check the seals.
2. Check for proper lubrication. 3. Clean all the parts and the housings. 4. Replace the bearings.
Smears
The smearing of the metal is due to slippage. Slippage can be caused by the following factors: Poor fits
- Lubrication
- Overheating
- Overloads
- Handling damage
If this condition occurs, perform the following: 1. Check the seals. 2. Check for proper fit. 3. Check
for proper lubrication. 4. Clean all the parts and the housings. 5. Replace the bearings.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed > Page 7143
Stain Discoloration
The discoloration on the bearings is caused by incorrect lubrication or moisture and ranges in color
from light brown to black. Reuse the bearing if you can remove the stains with light polishing and
there is no evidence of overheating. If this condition occurs, perform the following: 1. Check the
seals. 2. Clean all the parts and the housings. 3. Replace the bearings, if necessary.
Heat Discoloration
The heat discoloration on the bearings ranges from faint yellow to dark blue and results from
overload or an incorrect lubricant. Excessive heat causes softening of the races or the rollers. In
order to check for loss of temper on the races and the rollers, perform a file test. A file drawn over a
tempered part will grab and cut the metal and fail the file test. A file drawn over a hard part will glide
with no metal cutting. If overheating damage is indicated, perform the following: 1. Check the seals.
2. Clean all the parts and the housings. 3. Replace the bearings.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed > Page 7144
Misalignment
The outer race is misaligned due to a foreign object. 1. Clean all the parts and the housings. 2.
Ensure the races are properly seated. 3. Replace the bearing.
Cracked Inner Race
The race is cracked due to improper fit, cocking, or poor bearing seats. 1. Clean all the parts and
the housings. 2. Ensure the races are properly seated. 3. Replace the bearing.
Fatigue Spalling
The surface is flaked with metal due to bearing fatigue. 1. Clean all the parts and the housings. 2.
Replace the bearing.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Wheel Bearings Diagnosis - Sealed > Page 7145
Brinelling
The surface indentations in the race way are caused by the rollers under impact loading or from
vibration while the bearing is not rotating. 1. Clean all the parts and the housings. 2. Replace the
bearing.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Page 7146
Wheel Bearing: Adjustments
Front Wheel Bearing Adjustment
Important: ^
Adjust the front wheel bearings correctly in order to ensure the front suspension functions properly.
^ The bearings must be a slip fit on the spindle.
^ Lubricate the bearings in order to ensure the bearings will creep.
^ The spindle nut must have a free-running fit on the spindle threads.
1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle with safety stands. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the
wheel cover. 3. Remove the dust cap from the wheel hub.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Remove the cotter pin.
^ Tighten the wheel hub nut to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.), while turning the wheel forward by hand. This will
seat the bearings.
Important: Do not back the nut off more than 1/2 flat.
5. Adjust the nut to a finger tight position by hand. Then, back the nut off until the hole in the
spindle aligns with a slot in the nut. 6. Install a new cotter pin.
6.1. Make sure the cotter pin ends do not interfere with the cap. Bend the ends of the cotter pin
against the nut. Cut off any extra pin length.
6.2. Measure the endplay. Proper endplay is 0.0 - 0.13 mm (0.001 - 0.005 inch).
7. Install the dust cap to the wheel hub. 8. Install the wheel cover. 9. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Page 7147
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair
"For information regarding this component please refer to wheel hub service and repair"
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component
Information > Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
wheel hub nut 12 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Fastener: > 01-03-10-009A > Jul > 04 > Wheels - Plastic Wheel
Nut Covers Loose/Missing
Wheel Fastener: Customer Interest Wheels - Plastic Wheel Nut Covers Loose/Missing
Bulletin No.: 01-03-10-009A
Date: July 27, 2004
TECHNICAL
Subject: Plastic Wheel Nut Covers Missing and/or Loose (Replace Missing Covers and Add
Sealant to All Covers)
Models: 2005 and All Prior Passenger Cars (Except All Cadillac Models and Pontiac GTO)
with Plastic Wheel Nut Covers
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add additional models years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 01-03-10-009.
Condition
Some customers may comment that the plastic wheel nut covers are missing and/or loose.
Correction
Important:
^ DO NOT USE a silicone-based adhesive.
^ Do not apply the *permatex(R) around the threads in a circular pattern.
^ Apply a single bead across the threads approximately 10 mm (0.4 in) in length, 5 mm (0.2 in) in
height and 5 mm (0.2 in) in width.
Replace any missing plastic wheel nut covers with the appropriate covers and apply Permatex(R) #
2 Form A Gasket Sealant(R) to the threads of all the plastic wheel nut covers. Tighten finger tight
plus a 1/4 turn with a hand wrench.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such material.
General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any responsibility for the
products from this firm or for any other such items which may be available from other sources.
Permatex(R) # 2 Form A Gasket Sealant(R) part numbers (available at your local parts supplier)
^ P/N 80009 (2A/2AR) - 44 ml (1.5 oz) tube boxed
^ P/N 80015 (2AR) - 44 ml (1.5 oz) tube carded
^ P/N 80010 (2B/2BR) - 89 ml (3 oz) tube boxed
^ P/N 80016 (2BR) - 89 ml (3 oz) tube carded
^ P/N 80011 (2C) - 325 ml (11 oz) tube boxed
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Fastener: > 01-03-10-009A > Jul > 04 > Wheels - Plastic Wheel
Nut Covers Loose/Missing > Page 7160
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Fastener: > 01-03-10-009A > Jul > 04 > Wheels Plastic Wheel Nut Covers Loose/Missing
Wheel Fastener: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Plastic Wheel Nut Covers Loose/Missing
Bulletin No.: 01-03-10-009A
Date: July 27, 2004
TECHNICAL
Subject: Plastic Wheel Nut Covers Missing and/or Loose (Replace Missing Covers and Add
Sealant to All Covers)
Models: 2005 and All Prior Passenger Cars (Except All Cadillac Models and Pontiac GTO)
with Plastic Wheel Nut Covers
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add additional models years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 01-03-10-009.
Condition
Some customers may comment that the plastic wheel nut covers are missing and/or loose.
Correction
Important:
^ DO NOT USE a silicone-based adhesive.
^ Do not apply the *permatex(R) around the threads in a circular pattern.
^ Apply a single bead across the threads approximately 10 mm (0.4 in) in length, 5 mm (0.2 in) in
height and 5 mm (0.2 in) in width.
Replace any missing plastic wheel nut covers with the appropriate covers and apply Permatex(R) #
2 Form A Gasket Sealant(R) to the threads of all the plastic wheel nut covers. Tighten finger tight
plus a 1/4 turn with a hand wrench.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such material.
General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any responsibility for the
products from this firm or for any other such items which may be available from other sources.
Permatex(R) # 2 Form A Gasket Sealant(R) part numbers (available at your local parts supplier)
^ P/N 80009 (2A/2AR) - 44 ml (1.5 oz) tube boxed
^ P/N 80015 (2AR) - 44 ml (1.5 oz) tube carded
^ P/N 80010 (2B/2BR) - 89 ml (3 oz) tube boxed
^ P/N 80016 (2BR) - 89 ml (3 oz) tube carded
^ P/N 80011 (2C) - 325 ml (11 oz) tube boxed
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Fastener: > 01-03-10-009A > Jul > 04 > Wheels Plastic Wheel Nut Covers Loose/Missing > Page 7166
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7167
Wheel Fastener: Specifications
Wheel nuts 100 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Front
Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair Front
Wheel Stud Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the rotor. 2. Remove the wheel stud.
^ Press the stud out using an arbor press.
^ Do not damage the wheel mounting surface on the wheel hub flange.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the stud into the hole in the wheel hub.
1.1. Start the serrated stud into the hole in the wheel hub by tapping lightly with a hammer.
1.2. The stud must be square with the wheel hub before pressing on the arbor press.
2. Install the rotor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Front > Page 7170
Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair Rear
Wheel Stud Replacement (Rear Drum Brakes)
^ Tools Required J 43631 Ball Joint Separator
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle. Refer to Vehicle Lifting. 2. Remove the tire and the wheel. 3. Remove the
brake drum.
4. Remove the wheel stud from the axle flange using J 43631.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Front > Page 7171
1. Start the new stud into the axle flange hole by pressing firmly with your hand. 2. Install a washer
and thread the lug nut on the wheel stud with the flat side of the lug nut to the vehicle. 3. Tighten
the lug nut in order to draw the wheel stud into the rear of the flange. 4. Remove the lug nut and
washers from the wheel stud.
5. Install the brake drum. 6. Install the tire and the wheel. 7. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Page 7172
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Accumulator HVAC > Component Information >
Specifications
Refrigerant System Capacities - Heating, Ventilation And Air Conditioning
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Accumulator HVAC > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 7177
Accumulator HVAC: Service and Repair
ACCUMULATOR REPLACEMENT
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the air cleaner. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant
Recovery and Recharging. 3. Remove the accumulator nut (1) from the evaporator. 4. Remove the
compressor suction hose (7) from the accumulator. 5. Remove the O-ring seals. 6. Disconnect the
electrical connectors. 7. Remove the pressure switch.
8. Remove the accumulator mounting bracket bolt. 9. Remove the accumulator mounting bracket.
10. Remove the accumulator. 11. Install sealing caps if you are not replacing the accumulator.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Accumulator HVAC > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 7178
1. Install the accumulator mounting bracket.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the accumulator mounting bracket bolt.
Tighten Tighten the mounting bracket bolt to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
3. Install the pressure switch. 4. Connect the electrical connections. 5. Install new O-ring seals.
6. Install the compressor suction hose (7) to the accumulator. 7. Install the accumulator nut (1) to
the evaporator.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 27 N.m (20 lb ft).
8. Evacuate and charge the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 9. Leak test
the fitting(s) of the repaired or reinstalled component using the J 39400-A.
10. Install the air cleaner.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7183
Air Temperature Actuator - HVAC Systems - Manual
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7184
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Description and Operation
AIR TEMPERATURE ACTUATORS
The vehicle operator can determine the temperature of the air by using the air temperature switch.
When a desired temperature setting is selected, a voltage divider is used to determine the air
temperature door position signal circuit's value. The air temperature door position signal circuit's
value is a voltage that is applied to the air temperature actuator. The motor opens the air mixture
door to a position to divert sufficient air past the heater core to achieve the desired vehicle
temperature. Warm heater air is mixed with cool A/C air at the air mixture door. When the coldest
temperature control setting is selected, no warm heater air is mixed with the cool A/C air.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Air Temperature Actuator
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Service and Repair Air Temperature Actuator
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the IP extension. 2. Remove the engine cover. 3. Remove the screws that retain the
actuator to the heater assembly. 4. Disconnect the electrical connector (2).
5. Remove the air temperature actuator from the heater assembly.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Air Temperature Actuator > Page 7187
1. Install the air temperature actuator to the heater assembly. 2. Connect the electrical connector.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the screws that retain the air temperature actuator to the heater assembly.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
4. Install the engine cover. 5. Install the IP extension.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Air Temperature Actuator > Page 7188
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Service and Repair Defroster Actuator
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the right knee bolster. 2. Remove the right cowl trim panel. 3. Disconnect the defrost
actuator vacuum hose from the defrost actuator (1). 4. Depress the retaining clip and remove the
defrost actuator (1) from the air distribution housing (2).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the defrost actuator (1) to the air distribution housing (2). 2. Connect the defrost actuator
vacuum hose to the defrost actuator (1). 3. Install the right cowl trim panel. 4. Install the right knee
bolster.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Air Temperature Actuator > Page 7189
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Service and Repair Mode Actuator
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the IP assembly from the vehicle. in Instrument Panel, Gages and Console. 2. Remove
the mode actuator vacuum hose connector. 3. Slide the actuator off the mounting bracket in order
to remove the actuator. 4. Rotate the actuator (2) so that the actuator linkage slips off the post on
the mode door linkage. 5. Remove the actuator linkage from the mode door linkage.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Rotate the actuator so that the actuator linkage slips over the post on the mode door linkage. 2.
Install the actuator linkage to the mode door linkage. 3. Slide the actuator (2) onto the mounting
bracket in order to install the actuator.
Firmly press the actuator into place in order to fully seat the fastener.
4. Install the mode actuator vacuum hose connector. 5. Install the IP assembly to the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Air Temperature Actuator > Page 7190
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Service and Repair Recirculation Actuator
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the passenger side knee bolster. 2. Remove the right cowl trim panel. 3. Remove the
recirculation actuator vacuum (3) connector. 4. Remove the nuts that retain the recirculation
actuator. 5. Remove the recirculation actuator from the recirculation door.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the recirculation actuator to the recirculation door.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the nuts that retain the recirculation actuator.
Tighten Tighten the nuts to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Install the recirculation actuator vacuum (3) connector. 4. Install the right cowl trim panel. 5.
Install the passenger side knee bolster.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Distributor Duct Replacement
Air Duct: Service and Repair Air Distributor Duct Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the IP assembly. 2. Remove the left floor air outlet.
3. Remove the retaining screw at the IP assembly on the left side of the duct. 4. Remove the
retaining clips from the air distributor assembly. 5. Remove the duct from the IP vent extensions. 6.
Remove the air distributor duct from the IP.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Distributor Duct Replacement > Page 7195
1. Install the air distributor duct to the IP. 2. Install the air distributor duct to the IP vent extensions.
3. Install the retaining clips to the air distributor assembly.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice
4. Install the retaining screws to the IP carrier on the left side of the duct.
Tighten Tighten the screws to the IP carrier on the left side of the duct to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
5. Install the left floor air outlet. 6. Install the IP carrier.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Distributor Duct Replacement > Page 7196
Air Duct: Service and Repair Air Outlet Duct Replacement - Auxiliary
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the left D- pillar garnish molding. 2. Remove the set screw in the side of the 2 piece
duct. 3. Slide the bottom half of the duct up into the top half. 4. Swing the bottom edge of the duct
toward the interior of the vehicle. 5. Remove the top edge of the duct clear of the headliner duct. 6.
Remove the air outlet duct from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the air outlet duct to the vehicle. 2. Install the top edge of the duct into the headliner duct.
3. Swing the bottom edge of the duct into the fourth pillar. 4. Swing the bottom edge of the duct into
place over the auxiliary evaporator module. 5. Slide the bottom half of the duct down onto the
auxiliary evaporator module.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Caution and Notices.
6. Tighten the set screw on the side of the duct.
Tighten Tighten the set screw on the side of the duct to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Distributor Duct Replacement > Page 7197
7. Install the left fourth pillar garnish molding.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Distributor Duct Replacement > Page 7198
Air Duct: Service and Repair Air Outlet Duct Replacement - Left Defogger
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: Do not remove the instrument panel.
1. Roll the instrument panel down. Refer to IP Carrier Replacement. 2. Remove the duct from the
left side floor air outlet. 3. Remove the duct from the left body side window defogger outlet. 4.
Remove the duct from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the duct to the vehicle. 2. Install the duct to the left body side window defogger outlet. 3.
Install the duct to the left side floor air outlet. 4. Roll the instrument panel up. Refer to IP Carrier
Replacement.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Distributor Duct Replacement > Page 7199
Air Duct: Service and Repair Air Outlet Duct Replacement - Left Floor
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the instrument panel carrier. 2. Remove the windshield defroster duct. 3. Remove the
screws that retain the air outlet duct to the instrument panel carrier. 4. Remove the side window
defroster ducts. 5. Remove the air outlet duct from instrument panel.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the air outlet duct to the instrument panel. 2. Install the side window defroster ducts.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice
3. Install the screws that retain the floor air outlet duct to the instrument panel carrier.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
4. Install the windshield defroster duct. 5. Install the instrument panel carrier.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Distributor Duct Replacement > Page 7200
Air Duct: Service and Repair
Air Distributor Duct Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the IP assembly. 2. Remove the left floor air outlet.
3. Remove the retaining screw at the IP assembly on the left side of the duct. 4. Remove the
retaining clips from the air distributor assembly. 5. Remove the duct from the IP vent extensions. 6.
Remove the air distributor duct from the IP.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Distributor Duct Replacement > Page 7201
1. Install the air distributor duct to the IP. 2. Install the air distributor duct to the IP vent extensions.
3. Install the retaining clips to the air distributor assembly.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice
4. Install the retaining screws to the IP carrier on the left side of the duct.
Tighten Tighten the screws to the IP carrier on the left side of the duct to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
5. Install the left floor air outlet. 6. Install the IP carrier.
Air Outlet Duct Replacement - Auxiliary
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Distributor Duct Replacement > Page 7202
1. Remove the left D- pillar garnish molding. 2. Remove the set screw in the side of the 2 piece
duct. 3. Slide the bottom half of the duct up into the top half. 4. Swing the bottom edge of the duct
toward the interior of the vehicle. 5. Remove the top edge of the duct clear of the headliner duct. 6.
Remove the air outlet duct from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the air outlet duct to the vehicle. 2. Install the top edge of the duct into the headliner duct.
3. Swing the bottom edge of the duct into the fourth pillar. 4. Swing the bottom edge of the duct into
place over the auxiliary evaporator module. 5. Slide the bottom half of the duct down onto the
auxiliary evaporator module.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Caution and Notices.
6. Tighten the set screw on the side of the duct.
Tighten Tighten the set screw on the side of the duct to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
7. Install the left fourth pillar garnish molding.
Air Outlet Duct Replacement - Left Defogger
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Distributor Duct Replacement > Page 7203
IMPORTANT: Do not remove the instrument panel.
1. Roll the instrument panel down. Refer to IP Carrier Replacement. 2. Remove the duct from the
left side floor air outlet. 3. Remove the duct from the left body side window defogger outlet. 4.
Remove the duct from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the duct to the vehicle. 2. Install the duct to the left body side window defogger outlet. 3.
Install the duct to the left side floor air outlet. 4. Roll the instrument panel up. Refer to IP Carrier
Replacement.
Air Outlet Duct Replacement - Left Floor
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Distributor Duct Replacement > Page 7204
1. Remove the instrument panel carrier. 2. Remove the windshield defroster duct. 3. Remove the
screws that retain the air outlet duct to the instrument panel carrier. 4. Remove the side window
defroster ducts. 5. Remove the air outlet duct from instrument panel.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the air outlet duct to the instrument panel. 2. Install the side window defroster ducts.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice
3. Install the screws that retain the floor air outlet duct to the instrument panel carrier.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
4. Install the windshield defroster duct. 5. Install the instrument panel carrier.
Air Outlet Duct Replacement - Left Lap
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Distributor Duct Replacement > Page 7205
1. Remove the left knee bolster. 2. Remove the screws that retain the outlet duct. 3. Remove the
duct from the air distribution duct.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the duct to the air distribution duct. 2. Install the outlet duct.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice
3. Install the screws that retain the outlet duct.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
4. Install the left knee bolster.
Air Outlet Duct Replacement - Right Defogger
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: Do not remove the instrument panel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Distributor Duct Replacement > Page 7206
1. Roll the instrument panel down. Refer to IP Carrier Replacement 2. Remove the screws that
retain the duct. 3. Remove the duct from the instrument panel.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the duct to the instrument panel.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice
2. Install the screws in order to retain the duct.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Roll the instrument panel up. Refer to IP Carrier Replacement.
Air Outlet Duct Replacement - Right Lap
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Distributor Duct Replacement > Page 7207
1. Remove the right knee bolster. 2. Remove the air outlet duct from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the air outlet duct to the vehicle. 2. Install the right knee bolster.
Deflector Replacement - Auxiliary A/C Outlet - Headliner
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Air Distributor Duct Replacement > Page 7208
1. Use a flat blade tool in order to remove the air deflector from the headliner. 2. Remove the air
deflector from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Align the air deflector into the opening in the headliner. 2. Push the air outlet into the headliner
until the deflector snaps into place.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Air Outlet Replacement - Center Floor
Air Register: Service and Repair Air Outlet Replacement - Center Floor
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the IP extension. 2. Remove the floor air outlet duct from the air distributor. 3. Remove
the bucket seats. 4. Remove the front section of the carpet, if equipped.
5. Remove the retaining nuts from the floor outlet duct, if equipped. 6. Remove the floor air outlet
from the ducts to the rear seat, if equipped.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Air Outlet Replacement - Center Floor > Page 7213
1. Install the floor air outlet to the ducts to the rear seat, if equipped.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice
2. Install the retaining nuts to the floor outlet duct, if equipped.
Tighten Tighten the retaining nuts to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Install the front section of the carpet, if equipped. 4. Install the bucket seats. 5. Install the floor air
outlet duct from the air distributor. 6. Install the IP extension.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Air Outlet Replacement - Center Floor > Page 7214
Air Register: Service and Repair Air Outlet Replacement - Defroster
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: Do not remove the instrument panel.
1. Roll the instrument panel down. Refer to IP Carrier Replacement. 2. Remove the windshield
defroster duct grille from the instrument panel. 3. Remove the windshield defroster duct retainers
from the instrument panel. 4. Remove the retaining screw on the instrument panel carrier. 5.
Remove the windshield defroster duct by rotating the duct downward and away from the instrument
panel.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the windshield defroster duct to the instrument panel.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice
2. Install the retaining screw to the instrument panel carrier.
Tighten Tighten the screw to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Install the windshield defroster duct retainers to the instrument panel. 4. Install the windshield
defroster duct grille to the instrument panel. 5. Roll the instrument panel up. Refer to IP Carrier
Replacement.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Air Outlet Replacement - Center Floor > Page 7215
Air Register: Service and Repair Air Outlet Replacement - Rear Floor
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the IP extension. 2. Remove the floor air outlet duct from the air distributor. 3. Remove
the bucket seats. 4. Remove the front section of the carpet if equipped.
5. Remove the retaining nuts from the floor outlet duct, if equipped. 6. Remove the floor air outlet
from the ducts to the rear seat if equipped.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Air Outlet Replacement - Center Floor > Page 7216
1. Install the floor air outlet to the ducts to the rear seat, if equipped.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice
2. Install the retaining nuts to the floor outlet duct, if equipped.
Tighten Tighten the retaining nuts to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Install the front section of the carpet if equipped. 4. Install the bucket seats.
5. Install the floor air outlet duct to the air distributor. 6. Install the IP extension.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Air Outlet Replacement - Center Floor > Page 7217
Air Register: Service and Repair Grille Replacement - Body Side Rear Trim Air Outlet
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Pull out ward on the vent in order to remove the vent from the trim panel.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Press the vent inward in order to install the vent to the trim panel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Air Outlet Replacement - Center Floor > Page 7218
Air Register: Service and Repair IP Air Outlet Vent Replacement
IP AIR OUTLET VENT REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the right side knee bolster. 2. Remove the screw that retains the air outlet vent to the
instrument panel.
3. Lift upward on the instrument panel assist handle. 4. Remove the air outlet vent from the
instrument panel.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Lift upward on the instrument panel assist handle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Air Outlet Replacement - Center Floor > Page 7219
2. Install the air outlet vent to the instrument panel.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the screw that retains the air outlet vent to the instrument panel.
Tighten Tighten the screw that retains the air outlet vent to the instrument pane to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
4. Install the right side knee bolster.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component
Information > Specifications
Ambient Air Temperature Sensor Resistance
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 7223
Ambient Air Temperature Sensor (DIC)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 7224
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Service and Repair
AMBIENT AIR TEMPERATURE GAGE SENSOR REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the radiator grille from the vehicle. 2. Remove the outside air temperature sensor from
the center support bracket by sliding the sensor upward. 3. Disconnect the temperature sensor
electrical connector.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Connect the temperature sensor electrical connector. 2. Install the temperature sensor by sliding
the sensor downward. 3. Install the radiator grille to the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Auxiliary Blower Motor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7230
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7231
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7232
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7233
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7234
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7235
Auxiliary Blower Motor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7236
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7237
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7238
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7239
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7240
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7241
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7242
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7243
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7244
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7245
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7246
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7247
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7248
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7249
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7250
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7251
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7252
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7253
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7254
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7255
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7256
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7257
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7258
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7259
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7260
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Blower Motor Relay: Service and Repair
BLOWER MOTOR RELAY REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: The blower motor relay that is used on the M/L van is an integral part of the blower
motor resistor and can not be serviced separately from the resistor.
1. Remove the air cleaner. 2. Remove the windshield washers and the coolant reservoir. 3.
Disconnect the electrical connectors. 4. Remove the screws from the blower motor resistor
assembly. 5. Remove the blower motor resistor assembly (4).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the blower motor resistor assembly (4).
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice
2. Install the screws to the blower motor resistor assembly.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Install the windshield washers and the coolant reservoir. 4. Connect the electrical connectors. 5.
Install the air cleaner.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information >
Locations
Blower Motor Resistor: Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7267
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7268
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7269
Blower Motor Resistor: Diagrams
Blower Motor Resistor Assembly - HVAC Systems - Manual
Blower Motor Resistor - A/C Auxiliary - HVAC Systems - Manual
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7270
Blower Motor Resistor - Heater Auxiliary - HVAC Systems - Manual
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Blower Motor Resistor Assembly Replacement (C60)
Blower Motor Resistor: Service and Repair Blower Motor Resistor Assembly Replacement (C60)
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: The blower motor relay is an integral part of the blower motor resistor and can not be
serviced separately from the resistor.
1. Remove the air cleaner. 2. Remove the windshield washers and the coolant reservoir. 3.
Disconnect the electrical connectors. 4. Remove the screws from the blower motor resistor
assembly. 5. Remove the blower motor resistor assembly (4).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the blower motor resistor assembly (4).
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice
2. Install the screws to the blower motor resistor assembly.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Connect the electrical connectors. 4. Install the windshield washers and the coolant reservoir. 5.
Install the air cleaner.
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article/images refer to the RPO Code List found
at Vehicle/Application ID. See: Application and ID/RPO Codes
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Blower Motor Resistor Assembly Replacement (C60) > Page 7273
Blower Motor Resistor: Service and Repair Blower Motor Resistor Assembly Replacement (YG6)
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the air cleaner. 2. Remove the windshield washers and the coolant reservoir. 3.
Disconnect the electrical connectors. 4. Remove the screws from the blower motor resistor
assembly. 5. Remove the blower motor resistor assembly.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the blower motor resistor assembly.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice
2. Install the screws to the blower motor resistor assembly.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Connect the electrical connectors. 4. Install the windshield washers and the coolant reservoir. 5.
Install the air cleaner.
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article/images refer to the RPO Code List found
at Vehicle/Application ID. See: Application and ID/RPO Codes
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Blower Motor Resistor Assembly Replacement (C60) > Page 7274
Blower Motor Resistor: Service and Repair Blower Motor Resistor Replacement - Auxiliary Air
Conditioning
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the left body side trim panel. 2. Remove the electrical connector. 3. Remove the screws
that retain the resistor (4) to the case. 4. Remove the auxiliary A/C blower motor resistor assembly
from the case.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the auxiliary A/C blower motor resistor assembly into the case.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Caution and Notices.
2. Install the screws that retain the resistor to the case.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Install the electrical connector. 4. Install the left body side rear trim panel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Blower Motor Resistor Assembly Replacement (C60) > Page 7275
Blower Motor Resistor: Service and Repair Blower Motor Resistor Replacement - Heater Auxiliary
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the left body side trim panel. 2. Remove the electrical connector. 3. Remove the screws
from the auxiliary heater blower motor resistor assembly. 4. Remove the auxiliary heater blower
motor resistor assembly (1) from the heater case.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the auxiliary heater blower motor resistor assembly (1) into the heater case.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Caution and Notices.
2. Install the auxiliary heater blower motor resistor assembly screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Install the electrical connector. 4. Install the left body side rear trim panel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Page 7279
Blower Motor Switch: Diagrams
Blower Motor Switch - A/C Auxiliary - HVAC Systems - Manual
Blower Motor Switch - Heater Auxiliary Part 1 - HVAC Systems - Manual
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Page 7280
Blower Motor Switch - Heater Auxiliary Part 2 - HVAC Systems - Manual
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Blower Motor Switch Replacement - Auxiliary Air Conditioning
Blower Motor Switch: Service and Repair Blower Motor Switch Replacement - Auxiliary Air
Conditioning
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Set the parking brake, turn the ignition key to the ON position and move the gear selector to 1st
gear position. 2. Lower the tilt steering column to the lowest position. 3. Pull the instrument panel
cluster trim plate rearward by grasping it around the edges until the retainers release from the
instrument panel.
4. Remove the auxiliary A/C blower motor switch (2) from the instrument panel cluster trim plate (3)
by releasing the tabs located on the sides of
each switch.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Blower Motor Switch Replacement - Auxiliary Air Conditioning > Page 7283
1. Install the auxiliary A/C blower motor switch (2) to the instrument panel cluster trim plate (3) by
engaging the tabs located on the sides of each
switch.
2. Install the instrument panel cluster trim plate by aligning the retainers to the opening in the
instrument panel and push in place until fully seated. 3. Move gear selector into PARK position,
turn the ignition to the OFF position and release the park brake.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Blower Motor Switch Replacement - Auxiliary Air Conditioning > Page 7284
Blower Motor Switch: Service and Repair Blower Motor Switch Replacement - Heater Auxiliary
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Set the parking brake, turn the ignition key to the ON position and move the gear selector to 1st
gear position. 2. Lower the tilt steering column to the lowest position. 3. Pull the instrument panel
cluster trim plate rearward by grasping it around the edges until the retainers release from the
instrument panel.
4. Remove the auxiliary heat blower motor switch (1) from the instrument panel cluster trim plate
(3) by releasing the tabs located on the sides of
each switch.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Blower Motor Switch Replacement - Auxiliary Air Conditioning > Page 7285
1. Install the auxiliary heat blower motor switch (1) to the instrument panel cluster trim plate (3) by
engaging the tabs located on the sides of each
switch.
2. Install the instrument panel cluster trim plate by aligning the retainers to the opening in the
instrument panel and push in place until fully seated. 3. Move gear selector into PARK position,
turn the ignition to the OFF position and release the park brake.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Specifications
Compressor Clutch: Specifications Compressor Clutch Gap
Compressor Clutch Gap
Gap 0.50 - 0.76 mm (0.020 - 0.030 in)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 7290
A/C Compressor Clutch - HVAC Systems - Manual
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Clutch Rotor and/or Bearing Removal
Compressor Clutch Bearing: Service and Repair Clutch Rotor and/or Bearing Removal
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 6083 Snap Ring Pliers
^ J 33023-A Puller Pilot
^ J 41552 Pulley Puller
^ J 29886 Driver Handle
^ J 9398-A Bearing Remover
1. Remove the clutch plate and hub assembly. 2. Use the J 6083 in order to remove the following
components:
^ The pulley rotor (1)
^ The bearing assembly retaining ring (2)
3. Install the J 33023-A to the front head. 4. Install the J 41552 down into the inner circle of slots (1)
in the rotor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Clutch Rotor and/or Bearing Removal > Page 7295
5. Turn the J 41552 clockwise in the slots in the rotor. 6. Perform the following steps in order to
remove the pulley rotor and bearing assembly:
6.1. Hold the J 41552 in position.
6.2. Tighten the puller screw against the puller guide.
6.3. Remove the pulley rotor and bearing assembly.
7. Use the following procedure in order to properly support the rotor hub during bearing removal in
order to prevent pulley rotor damage:
7.1. Remove the forcing screw from the J 41552.
7.2. Ensure that the puller tangs still engage in the rotor slots.
7.3. Invert the assembly onto a solid flat surface or blocks.
NOTE: It is not necessary to remove the staking in front of the bearing to remove the bearing,
however, it will be necessary to file away the old stake metal for proper clearance for the new
bearing to be installed into the rotor bore or the bearing may be damaged.
8. Use the J 9398-A and the J 29886 in order to drive the bearing out of the rotor hub.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Clutch Rotor and/or Bearing Removal > Page 7296
Compressor Clutch Bearing: Service and Repair Clutch Rotor and/or Bearing Install
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 6083 Snap Ring Pliers
^ J 33023-A Puller Pilot
^ J 41552 Pulley Puller
^ J 29886 Driver Handle
^ J 21352-A Support Block
^ J 9481-A Bearing Installer
^ J 33019 Bearing Staking Tool
^ J 33017 Pulley and Bearing Assembly Installer
^ J 8433-1 Puller Bar
^ J 9398-A Bearing Remover
^ J 34992 Holding Fixture
NOTE: Do not support the rotor by resting the pulley rim on a flat surface during the bearing
installation or the rotor face will be bent.
1. Place the pulley rotor on the J 21352-A in order to fully support the rotor hub during bearing
installation. 2. Use the following tools in order to align the new bearing squarely with the hub bore:
^ The J 41552
^ The J 9481-A
^ The J 29886
3. Drive the bearing fully into the hub.
The installer will apply force to the outer race of the bearing, if used as shown.
4. Place the J 33019 in the hub bore.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Clutch Rotor and/or Bearing Removal > Page 7297
5. Shift the rotor and bearing assembly on the J 21352-A in order to fully support the hub under the
staking pin location.
Use a heavy-duty rubber band (1) in order to hold the stake pin in the guide. Properly position the
stake pin in the guide after each impact on the pin.
IMPORTANT: Use care in order to prevent personal injury when striking the staking pin with a
hammer.
6. Strike the staking pin with a hammer until a metal stake, similar to the original, forms down to but
not touching the bearing.
IMPORTANT: Noisy bearing operation and reduced bearing life may result if the outer bearing race
is deformed while staking. Ensure that the stake metal does not contact the outer race of the
bearing.
7. Stake 3 locations on the bearing race 120 degrees apart as shown.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Clutch Rotor and/or Bearing Removal > Page 7298
8. With the compressor mounted on the J 34992, position the pulley rotor (1) and the bearing
assembly on the front head. 9. Position the J 33017 and the J 33023-A directly over the inner race
of the bearing.
10. Position the J 8433-1 on the J 33023-A. 11. Assemble the 2 through bolts and the washers
through the puller bar slots. 12. Thread the through bolts into the J 34992. Ensure that the thread of
the through bolts engage the full thickness of the J 34992. 13. Tighten the center screw in the J
8433-1 in order to force the pulley rotor and bearing assembly onto the compressor front head.
If the J 33017 slips off direct in-line contact with the inner race of the bearing, perform the following
steps: 13.1. Loosen the J 8433-3. 13.2. Realign the installer and the pilot in order to ensure that the
J 33017 properly clears the front head.
14. Use the snap ring pliers in order to install the following components:
14.1. The pulley rotor (1) 14.2. The retaining ring (2) 14.3. Install the clutch plate and hub
assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Clutch Rotor and/or Bearing Removal > Page 7299
Compressor Clutch Bearing: Service and Repair Clutch Rotor and/or Bearing Replacement
(HT6/HD6/HU6)
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Tools Required ^
J 6083 External Snap Ring Pliers
^ J 33023-A Puller Pilot
^ J 41552 Compressor Pulley Puller
^ J 29886 Driver Handle
^ J 21352-A Support Block
^ J 9481-A Bearing Installer
^ J 33019 Pulley Bearing Staking Tool
^ J 33017 Pulley and Bearing Installer
^ J 8433-1 Puller Bar
^ J 9398-A Rotor Bearing Remover
^ J 34992 Compressor Holding Fixture
1. Remove the A/C compressor. 2. Remove the clutch plate and hub assembly. 3. Use the J 6083
in order to remove the following components:
^ The pulley rotor (1)
^ The bearing assembly retaining ring (2)
4. Install the J 33023-A to the front head. 5. Install the J 41552 down into the inner circle of slots (1)
in the rotor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Clutch Rotor and/or Bearing Removal > Page 7300
6. Turn the J 41552 clockwise in the slots in the rotor. 7. Perform the following steps in order to
remove the pulley rotor and bearing assembly:
7.1. Hold the J 41552 in position.
7.2. Tighten the puller screw against the puller guide.
7.3. Remove the pulley rotor and bearing assembly.
8. Use the following procedure to properly support the rotor hub during bearing removal in order to
prevent pulley rotor damage:
8.1. Remove the forcing screw from the J 41552.
8.2. Ensure that the puller tangs still engage in the rotor slots.
8.3. Invert the assembly onto a solid flat surface or blocks.
NOTE: It is not necessary to remove the staking in front of the bearing to remove the bearing,
however, it will be necessary to file away the old stake metal for proper clearance for the new
bearing to be installed into the rotor bore or the bearing may be damaged.
9. Use the J 9398-A and the J 29886 in order to drive the bearing out of the rotor hub.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: Do not support the rotor by resting the pulley rim on a flat surface during the bearing
installation or the rotor face will be bent.
1. Place the pulley rotor on the J 21352-A in order to fully support the rotor hub during bearing
installation. 2. Use the following tools in order to align the new bearing squarely with the hub bore:
^ The J 41552
^ The J 9481-A
^ The J 29886
3. Drive the bearing fully into the hub.
The installer will apply force to the outer race of the bearing, if used as shown.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Clutch Rotor and/or Bearing Removal > Page 7301
4. Place the J 33019 in the hub bore. 5. Shift the rotor and bearing assembly on the J 21352-A in
order to fully support the hub under the staking pin location.
Use a heavy-duty rubber band (1) in order to hold the stake pin in the guide. Properly position the
stake pin in the guide after each impact on the pin.
IMPORTANT: Use care in order to prevent personal injury when striking the staking pin with a
hammer.
6. Strike the staking pin with a hammer until a metal stake, similar to the original, forms down to but
not touching the bearing.
IMPORTANT: Noisy bearing operation and reduced bearing life may result if the outer bearing race
is deformed while staking. Ensure that the stake metal does not contact the outer race of the
bearing.
7. Stake 3 locations on the bearing race 120 degrees apart as shown.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Clutch Rotor and/or Bearing Removal > Page 7302
8. With the compressor mounted on the J 34992, position the pulley rotor (1) and the bearing
assembly on the front head. 9. Position the J 33017 and the J 33023-A directly over the inner race
of the bearing.
10. Position the J 8433-1 on the J 33023-A. 11. Assemble the 2 through bolts and the washers
through the puller bar slots 12. Thread the through bolts into the J 34992. Ensure that the thread of
the through bolts engage the full thickness of the J 34992. 13. Tighten the center screw in the J
8433-1 in order to force the pulley rotor and bearing assembly onto the compressor front head.
If the J 33017 slips off direct in-line contact with the inner race of the bearing, perform the following
steps: 13.1. Loosen the J 8433-3. 13.2. Realign the installer and the pilot in order to ensure that the
J 33017 properly clears the front head.
14. Use the snap ring pliers in order to install the following components:
14.1. The pulley rotor (1) 14.2. The retaining ring (2) 14.3. Install the clutch plate and hub
assembly. 14.4. Install the A/C compressor.
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article/images refer to the RPO Code List found
at Vehicle/Application ID. See: Application and ID/RPO Codes
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Compressor Clutch Coil Removal
Compressor Clutch Coil: Service and Repair Compressor Clutch Coil Removal
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 6083 Snap Ring Pliers
^ J 33023-A Puller Pilot
^ J 41552 Pulley Puller
^ J 8433-1 Puller Bar
^ J 33025 Clutch Coil Puller Legs
^ J 8433-3 Forcing Screw
1. Remove the clutch plate and hub assembly. 2. Use the J 6083 in order to remove the following
components:
^ The pulley rotor (1)
^ The bearing assembly retaining ring (2)
3. Install the J 33023-A to the front head. 4. Install the J 41552 down into the inner circle of slots (1)
in the rotor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Compressor Clutch Coil Removal > Page 7307
5. Turn the J 41552 clockwise in the slots in the rotor. 6. Perform the following steps in order to
remove the pulley rotor and bearing assembly:
6.1. Hold the J 41552 in position.
6.2. Tighten the puller screw against the puller guide.
6.3. Remove the pulley rotor and bearing assembly.
7. Mark the clutch coil terminal location (1) on the compressor front head. Refer to Clutch Rotor
and/or Bearing Removal. 8. Install the J 33023-A on the front head of the compressor. 9. Install the
J 8433-1 and the J 33025.
10. Tighten the J 8433-3 against the puller pilot in order to remove the clutch coil (2).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Compressor Clutch Coil Removal > Page 7308
Compressor Clutch Coil: Service and Repair Compressor Clutch Coil Install
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 33024 Clutch Coil Installer Adapter
^ J 8433-1 Puller Bar
^ J 34992 Holding Fixture
^ J 33017 Pulley and Bearing Assembly Installer
^ J 33023-A Puller Pilot
^ J 6083 Snap Ring Pliers
1. Place the clutch coil assembly (1) on the front head. Position the terminals at the marked
location. 2. Place the J 33024 over the internal opening of the clutch coil housing. 3. Align the J
33024 with the compressor front head. 4. Center the J 8433-1 in the counter-sunk center hole of
the J 33024. 5. Install the 2 through bolts and washers through the crossbar slots. 6. Thread the
bolts into the J 34992 in order to achieve full fixture thickness. 7. Turn the center forcing screw of
the J 8433-1 in order to force the clutch coil onto the front head. Ensure that the clutch coil and the
J 33024
remain aligned during installation.
8. When the coil is fully seated on the front head, use a 1/8 inch diameter drift punch (2) in order to
stake the front head at 3 places 120 degrees
apart (3), in order to ensure that the clutch coil (1) remains in position.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Compressor Clutch Coil Removal > Page 7309
9. Ensure that the stake size is only one-half the area of the punch tip. Ensure that the stake is only
approximately 0.28-0.35 mm (0.01-0.015 in)
deep.
10. With the compressor mounted to the J 34992, position the pulley rotor (1) and bearing
assembly on the front head. 11. Position the J 33017 and the J 33023-A directly over the inner race
of the bearing. 12. Position the J 8433-1 on the J 33023-A. 13. Assemble the 2 through bolts and
washers through the puller bar slots. 14. Thread the bolts into the J 34992. Ensure that the thread
of the through bolts engages the full thickness of the J 34992. 15. Tighten the center screw in the J
8433-1 in order to force the pulley rotor and bearing assembly onto the compressor front head.
If the J 33017 slips off direct in-line contact with the inner race and bearing, perform the following
steps: 15.1. Loosen the J 8433-3. 15.2. Realign the installer and the pilot in order to ensure that the
J 33017 properly clears the front head.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Compressor Clutch Coil Removal > Page 7310
16. Use the J 6083 in order to install the following components:
^ The pulley rotor (1)
^ The retainer ring (2)
17. Install the clutch plate and hub assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Compressor Clutch Coil Removal > Page 7311
Compressor Clutch Coil: Service and Repair Compressor Clutch Coil Replacement
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 6083 Snap Ring Pliers
^ J 8433-1 Puller Bar
^ J 8433-3 Forcing Screw
^ J 33017 Pulley and Bearing Assembly Installer
^ J 33023-A Puller Pilot
^ J 33024 Clutch Coil Installer Adapter
^ J 33025 Clutch Coil Puller Legs
^ J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
^ J 34992 Holding Fixture
^ J 41552 Pulley Puller
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Remove the compressor from the vehicle. 3. Remove the clutch plate and hub assembly. 4. Use
the J 6083 in order to remove the following components:
^ The pulley rotor
^ The bearing assembly retaining ring
5. Install the J 33023-A to the front head. 6. Install the J 41552 down into the inner circle of slots (1)
in the rotor.
7. Turn the J 41552 clockwise in the slots in the rotor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Compressor Clutch Coil Removal > Page 7312
8. Perform the following steps in order to remove the pulley rotor and bearing assembly:
8.1. Hold the J 41552 in position.
8.2. Tighten the puller screw against the puller guide.
8.3. Remove the pulley rotor and bearing assembly.
9. Mark the clutch coil terminal location (1) on the compressor front head.
10. Install the J 33023-A on the front head of the compressor. 11. Install the J 8433-1 and the J
33025. 12. Tighten the J 8433-3 against the puller pilot in order to remove the clutch coil (2). 13.
Remove the clutch coil from the compressor.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Compressor Clutch Coil Removal > Page 7313
1. Install the clutch coil to the compressor. 2. Place the clutch coil assembly on the front head.
Position the terminals (1) at the marked location.
3. Place the J 33024 over the internal opening of the clutch coil housing (1). 4. Align the J 33024
with the compressor front head. 5. Center the J 8433-1 in the counter-sunk center hole of the J
33024. 6. Install the two bolts and washers through the crossbar slots. 7. Thread the bolts into the J
34992 in order to achieve full fixture thickness. 8. Turn the center forcing screw of the J 8433-1 in
order to force the clutch coil onto the front head. Ensure that the clutch coil and the J 33024
remain aligned during installation.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Compressor Clutch Coil Removal > Page 7314
9. When the coil is fully seated on the front head, mark the front head at 3 places 120 degrees
apart.
IMPORTANT: Ensure that the stake size is only one-half the area of the punch tip. Ensure that the
stake is only approximately 0.28-0.35 mm ( 0.01-0.015 in) deep.
10. Use a 1/8 inch diameter drift punch (2) in order to stake the front head at 3 places 120 degrees
apart (3), in order to ensure that the clutch coil (1)
remains in position.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Compressor Clutch Coil Removal > Page 7315
11. With the compressor mounted to the J 34992, position the pulley rotor (1) and bearing
assembly on the front head. 12. Position the J 33017 and the J 33023-A directly over the inner race
of the bearing. 13. Position the J 8433-1 on the J 33023-A. 14. Assemble the two bolts and
washers through the puller bar slots. 15. Thread the bolts into the J 34992. Ensure that the thread
of the through bolts engages the full thickness of the J 34992. 16. Tighten the center screw in the J
8433-1 in order to force the pulley rotor and bearing assembly onto the compressor front head. 17.
If the J 33017 slips off direct in-line contact with the inner race and bearing, perform the following
steps:
17.1. Loosen the J 8433-3.
17.2. Realign the installer and the pilot in order to ensure that the J 33017 properly clears the front
head.
18. Use the J 6083 in order to install the following components:
^ The pulley rotor (1)
^ The retainer ring (2)
19. Install the clutch plate and hub assembly. 20. Install the compressor to the vehicle. 21.
Evacuate and recharge the refrigerant system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 22.
Leak test the fitting(s) of the repaired or reinstalled component using the J 39400-A.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Hub > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Compressor Clutch Plate and Hub Assembly Removal
Compressor Clutch Hub: Service and Repair Compressor Clutch Plate and Hub Assembly
Removal
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 34992 Compressor Holding Fixture
^ J 33013-B Hub and Drive Plate Remover/Installer
1. Clamp the J 34992 in a vise. 2. Use thumb screws in order to attach the compressor to the
holding fixture.
NOTE: Do not drive or pound on the clutch hub or shaft. Internal damage to the compressor may
result. The forcing tip on the J 33013-B remover/installer center screw must be flat or the end of the
shaft/axial plate assembly will be damaged.
3. Ensure that the center screw forces the tip to thrust against the end of the shaft. 4. Thread the J
33013-B into the hub. 5. While holding the body of J 33013-B of the remover with a wrench, turn
the center screw into the remover body in order to remove the clutch
plate and hub assembly (1).
6. Remove the shaft key. Retain the shaft key for reassembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Hub > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Compressor Clutch Plate and Hub Assembly Removal > Page 7320
Compressor Clutch Hub: Service and Repair Compressor Clutch Plate/Hub Assembly Install
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 33013-B Hub and Drive Plate Remover/Installer
1. Install the shaft key (4) into the hub key groove. Allow the key to project approximately 3.2 mm
(0.125 in) out of the keyway (3). The shaft key
curves slightly in order to provide an interference fit in the hub key groove.
2. Clean the following components:
^ The clutch plate
^ The clutch rotor (2)
3. Align the shaft key (4) with the shaft keyway (3). 4. Place the clutch plate and the hub assembly
(1) onto the compressor shaft.
5. Remove the forcing tip on the J 33013-B. 6. Reverse the body direction on the center screw. 7.
Install the J 33013-B with the bearing. 8. Back off the body of the J 33013-B as necessary in order
to permit the center screw to be threaded onto the end of the compressor shaft. 9. Hold the center
screw with a wrench.
10. Tighten the hex portion of the J 33013-B body in order to press the hub onto the shaft. 11.
Tighten the body several turns. 12. Remove the installer. Ensure that the shaft key remains in
place in the keyway. 13. Install the clutch plate and hub assembly to the final position.
Ensure that the air gap (2) between frictional surfaces of the clutch plate and clutch rotor measures
within 0.50-0.76 mm (0.20-0.30 in).
14. Remove the J 33013-B. 15. Verify proper positioning of the shaft key. Ensure that the shaft key
is even with or slightly above the clutch hub.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Hub > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Compressor Clutch Plate and Hub Assembly Removal > Page 7321
16. Spin the pulley rotor by hand in order to verify that the rotor does not rub against the clutch
drive plate.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Hub > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Compressor Clutch Plate and Hub Assembly Removal > Page 7322
Compressor Clutch Hub: Service and Repair Compressor Clutch Plate/Hub Assembly
Replacement
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 33013-B Hub and Drive Plate Installer
^ J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Remove the compressor from the vehicle. 3. Use the Compressor Holding Fixture HD-6 tool in
order to hold the compressor in a vise. 4. Use both thumb screws in order to attach the compressor
to the holding fixture. 5. Install the compressor into a vise. 6. Remove the shaft protector from the
clutch hub shaft.
NOTE: Do not drive or pound on the clutch hub or shaft. Internal damage to the compressor may
result. The forcing tip on the J 33013-B remover/installer center screw must be flat or the end of the
shaft/axial plate assembly will be damaged.
7. Ensure that the center screw forces the tip to thrust against the end of the shaft.
8. Thread the J 33013-B into the hub. 9. While holding the body of J 33013-8 of the remover with a
wrench, turn the center screw into the remover body in order to remove the clutch plate
and hub assembly.
10. Remove the shaft key. Retain the shaft key for reassembly. 11. Remove the old clutch plate
and hub assembly from the compressor.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Hub > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Compressor Clutch Plate and Hub Assembly Removal > Page 7323
1. Install the shaft key (4) into the hub key groove. 2. Allow the key to project approximately 3.2 mm
(0.125 in) out of the keyway (3). The shaft key curves slightly in order to provide an interference
fit in the hub key groove.
3. Clean the following components:
^ The clutch plate
^ The clutch rotor (2)
4. Align the shaft key (4) with the shaft keyway (3). 5. Place the clutch plate and the hub assembly
(1) onto the compressor shaft.
6. Install the forcing tip on the J 33013-B. 7. Reverse the body direction on the center screw. 8.
Install the J 33013-B with the bearing. 9. Back off the body of the J 33013-B as necessary in order
to permit the center screw to be threaded onto the end of the compressor shaft.
10. Hold the center screw with a wrench. 11. Tighten the hex portion of the J 33013-B body in order
to press the hub onto the shaft. 12. Tighten the body several turns.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Hub > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Compressor Clutch Plate and Hub Assembly Removal > Page 7324
13. Install the clutch plate and hub assembly to the final position.
Ensure that the air gap between frictional surfaces of the clutch plate and clutch rotor measures
within 3.81-0.51 mm (0.15-0.20 in).
14. Check the clutch plate and hub assembly in three places for clearance. 15. Remove the
installer. Ensure that the shaft key remains in place in the keyway. 16. Remove the J 33013-B. 17.
Verify proper positioning of the shaft key. Ensure that the shaft key is even with or slightly above
the clutch hub. 18. Spin the pulley rotor by hand in order to verify that the rotor does not rub against
the clutch drive plate.
19. Install the shaft protector to the clutch hub shaft. 20. Remove both thumb screws from the
compressor holding fixture Compressor Holding Fixture HD-6 Compressor Holding Fixture HD-6.
21. Remove the Compressor Holding Fixture HD-6 Compressor Holding Fixture HD-6 tool from the
vise. 22. Install the compressor to the vehicle. 23. Evacuate and recharge the refrigerant system.
Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 24. Leak test the fitting(s) of the repaired or
reinstalled component using the J 39400-A.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information >
Locations
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7328
Compressor Clutch Relay: Service and Repair
COMPRESSOR RELAY REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the cover from the underhood convenience center. 2. Remove the compressor relay
(2).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the compressor relay (2). 2. Install the cover to the underhood convenience center.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information >
Specifications
Refrigerant System Capacities - Heating, Ventilation And Air Conditioning
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 7332
Condenser HVAC: Service and Repair
CONDENSER REPLACEMENT
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the air cleaner. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant
Recovery and Recharging. 3. Remove the grille. 4. Remove the compressor hose assembly from
the condenser. 5. Remove the evaporator tube from the condenser. 6. Remove the center support
bracket. 7. Remove the bolts that retain the condenser to the radiator. 8. Remove the condenser.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the condenser.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Caution and Notices.
2. Install the bolts that retain the condenser to the radiator.
Tighten Tighten the bolts that retain the condenser to the radiator to 6 N.m (53 lb in).
3. Install the center support bracket. 4. Install the evaporator tube to the condenser.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 7333
5. Install the compressor hose assembly to the condenser.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 28 N.m (21 lb ft).
6. Install the grille. 7. Evacuate and recharge the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and
Recharging. 8. Leak test the fittings of the component using the J 39400-A. 9. Install the air
cleaner.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > A/C - Control Knob Replacement Availability
Control Assembly: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Control Knob Replacement Availability
Bulletin No.: 04-01-37-001
Date: January 06, 2004
INFORMATION
Subject: HVAC Control Knob Replacement
Models: 2000-2004 All Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2003-04 HUMMER H2
HVAC Control Knob Availability
Important:
If a knob becomes loose or broken, you MUST first check for availability of the control knob before
attempting to replace the entire HVAC controller.
The various knobs used on the HVAC controls of most GM vehicles are available for purchase
separately from the HVAC head units. If a knob becomes loose or broken, you MUST first check for
availability of the control knob before attempting to replace the entire HVAC controller. Please use
only the labor operation code listed below when replacing an HVAC control knob.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7338
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > HVAC Control Assembly C1
HVAC Control Assembly C1 - HVAC Systems - Manual
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > HVAC Control Assembly C1 > Page 7341
Control Assembly: Diagrams HVAC Control Assembly C2
HVAC Control Assembly C2 Part 1 - HVAC Systems - Manual
HVAC Control Assembly C2 Part 2 - HVAC Systems - Manual
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > HVAC Control Assembly C1 > Page 7342
HVAC Control Assembly C3 - HVAC Systems - Manual
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 7343
Control Assembly: Service and Repair
HVAC CONTROL ASSEMBLY REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the IP cluster trim plate. 2. Remove the retaining screw from the left edge of the HVAC
control assembly. 3. Pivot the HVAC control assembly from the IP. 4. Remove the HVAC control
assembly from the IP in order to access the vacuum and the electrical connectors.
5. Disconnect the following items from the HVAC control assembly:
^ The electrical connectors
^ The vacuum connectors
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 7344
1. Connect the following items to the HVAC control assembly:
^ The vacuum connectors
^ The electrical connectors
2. Align the tab on the HVAC control assembly with the slot in the IP. 3. Install the HVAC control
assembly to the IP.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the screw to the HVAC control assembly.
Tighten Tighten the screw to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
5. Install the IP cluster trim plate.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Coupler HVAC > A/C Coupler O-ring > Component
Information > Service and Repair > O-Ring Replacement
A/C Coupler O-ring: Service and Repair O-Ring Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Disassemble the A/C refrigerant components. Refer to the appropriate repair procedure
^ For compression style fittings use a back up wrench on the fitting (2) and loosen the fitting nut (1).
^ For banjo style fittings remove the bolt retaining the banjo type fitting.
2. Remove the A/C seal from the A/C refrigerant component. 3. Inspect the A/C seal for signs of
damage to help determine the root cause of the failure. 4. Inspect the A/C refrigerant components
for damage or burrs. Repair if necessary.
IMPORTANT: Cap or tape the open A/C refrigerant components immediately to prevent system
contamination.
5. Cap or tape the A/C refrigerant components. 6. Discard the O-ring seal.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Inspect the new O-ring seal for any sign or cracks, cuts, or damage. Replace if necessary. 2.
Remove the cap or tape from the A/C refrigerant components. 3. Using a lint-free clean, dry cloth,
carefully clean the sealing surfaces of the A/C refrigerant components.
IMPORTANT: DO NOT allow any of the mineral base 525 viscosity refrigerant oil on the new O-ring
seal to enter the refrigerant system.
4. Lightly coat the new O-ring seal with mineral base 525 viscosity refrigerant oil.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Coupler HVAC > A/C Coupler O-ring > Component
Information > Service and Repair > O-Ring Replacement > Page 7350
IMPORTANT: DO NOT reuse O-ring seals.
5. Carefully slide the new O-ring seal onto the A/C refrigerant component. 6. The O-ring seal must
be fully seated.
7. Assemble the A/C components.
Refer to the appropriate repair procedure. ^
For compression style fittings use a back up wrench on the fitting (2) and tighten the fitting nut (1)
to specification.
^ For banjo style fittings install the bolt retaining the banjo type fitting and tighten to specification.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Coupler HVAC > A/C Coupler O-ring > Component
Information > Service and Repair > O-Ring Replacement > Page 7351
A/C Coupler O-ring: Service and Repair Sealing Washer Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the seal washer from the A/C refrigerant component.
IMPORTANT: Cap or tape the open A/C refrigerant components immediately to prevent system
contamination.
2. Inspect the seal washer for signs of damage to help determine the root cause of the failure. 3.
Inspect the A/C refrigerant components for damage or burrs. Repair if necessary.
IMPORTANT: DO NOT reuse sealing washer.
4. Discard the sealing washer.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: Flat washer type seals do not require lubrication.
1. Inspect the new seal washer for any signs of cracks, cuts, or damage.
Do not use a damaged seal washer.
2. Remove the cap or tape from the A/C refrigerant components. 3. Using a lint-free clean, dry
cloth, clean the sealing surfaces of the A/C refrigerant components. 4. Carefully install the new seal
washer onto the A/C refrigerant component. 5. The washer must completely bottom against the
surface of the fitting.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Coupler HVAC > A/C Coupler O-ring > Component
Information > Service and Repair > O-Ring Replacement > Page 7352
IMPORTANT: After tightening the A/C components, there should be a slight sealing washer gap of
approximately 1.2 mm (3/64 in) between the A/C line and the A/C component.
6. Assemble the remaining A/C refrigerant components. Refer to the appropriate repair procedure.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Core: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > A/C - Musty Odors Emitted From
(HVAC) System
Evaporator Core: Customer Interest A/C - Musty Odors Emitted From (HVAC) System
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 99-01-39-004C
Date: June 12, 2009
Subject: Air Conditioning Odor (Install Evaporator Core Dryer Kit and Apply Cooling Coil Coating)
Models:
1993-2010 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 All
Equipped with Air Conditioning
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2009 and 2010 model years. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 99-01-39-004B (Section 01 - HVAC).
Condition
Some customers may comment about musty odors emitted from the Heating, Ventilation and Air
Conditioning (HVAC) system at vehicle start-up in hot, humid conditions.
Cause
This condition may be caused by condensate build-up on the evaporator core, which does not
evaporate by itself in high humidity conditions. The odor may be the result of microbial growth on
the evaporator core. When the blower motor fan is turned on, the microbial growth may release an
unpleasant musty odor into the passenger compartment.
There are several other possible sources of a musty odor in a vehicle. A common source is a water
leak into the interior of the vehicle or foreign material in the HVAC air distribution system. Follow
the procedures in SI for identifying and correcting water leaks and air inlet inspection.
The procedure contained in this bulletin is only applicable if the odor source has been determined
to be microbial growth on the evaporator core inside the HVAC module.
Correction
Many vehicles currently incorporate an afterblow function within the HVAC control module
software. The afterblow feature, when enabled, employs the HVAC blower fan to dry the
evaporator after vehicle shut down and this function will inhibit microbial growth. Technicians are to
confirm that the customer concern is evaporator core odor and that the vehicle has the imbedded
afterblow feature, as defined in the SI document for that specific vehicle model, model year and
specific HVAC option. Refer to SI for enabling the afterblow function. Vehicles being delivered in
areas prone to high humidity conditions may benefit from having the afterblow enabled calibration
installed prior to any customer comment.
Important If the vehicle is not factory equipped with the imbedded afterblow enable feature, it may
be added with the Electronic Evaporator Dryer Module Kit (P/N 12497910 or AC Delco 15-5876).
Important When installing the Electronic Evaporator Dryer Module, you MUST use the included
electrical splice connectors to ensure a proper splice. Complete detailed installation instructions
and self testing procedures are supplied with the kit. If necessary, the Electronic Evaporator Dryer
Module may be installed underhood if it is protected from extreme heat and water splash areas.
To immediately remove the evaporator core odor on all suspect vehicles, it is necessary to
eliminate the microbial growth and prevent its re-occurrence. To accomplish this, perform the
following procedure:
Vehicle and Applicator Tool Preparation
1. The evaporator core must be dry. This may be accomplished by disabling the compressor and
running the blower fan on the recirc heat setting for
an extended period of time.
Note Compressor engagement will cause the evaporator core to remain wet and will prevent full
adherence of the Coiling Coil Coating to the evaporator core surfaces.
2. Verify that the air conditioning drain hose is not clogged and place a drain pan beneath the
vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Core: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > A/C - Musty Odors Emitted From
(HVAC) System > Page 7361
3. Place a protective cover over the carpet below the evaporator core. 4. Remove the cabin air
filter, if equipped, and cover the opening prior to applying the Cooling Coil Coating, as the product
may clog the filter. If the
cabin air filter appears to have little or no remaining life, suggest a replacement to your customer.
5. If the HVAC module has a blower motor cooling tube, be careful NOT TO SPRAY THE
COOLING COIL COATING INTO THE
BLOWER MOTOR COOLING TUBE.
6. Attach the Flexible Applicator Pressure Spray Tool (J-43810-20A) to a compressed air line
operating at 586 kPa (85 psi) to 793 kPa (115 psi). 7. Shake the bottle of Cooling Coil Coating well.
Screw the bottle onto the cap on the applicator tool's pick-up tube.
Note The pick-up tube is designed for 120 ml (4 oz) and 240 ml (8 oz) bottles and should coil
slightly in the bottom of a 120 ml (4 oz) bottle.
8. Use one of the following three methods to apply the Cooling Coil Coating.
Important If the Pressure Applicator Spray Tool (J-43810-20A) is not available, the Cooling Coil
Coating is also available in an aerosol can (P/N 12377951 (in Canada, 10953503)).
Application Through Blower Motor Control Module Opening
- Remove the blower motor control module (blower motor resistor). Refer to the applicable
procedure in SI.
- Clean any debris or foreign material from inside the HVAC module and on the evaporator core
surface.
- Apply the Cooling Coil Coating directly to the evaporator core through the blower motor blower
motor control module (blower motor resistor) opening.
- Use the flexible wand to direct the Cooling Coil Coating over the entire evaporator core and
surrounding gasket surfaces.
- When the application is complete, install the blower motor blower motor control module (blower
motor control module).
Application Through Blower Motor Opening
- Remove the blower motor. Refer to the applicable blower motor removal procedure in SI.
- Clean any debris or foreign material from inside the HVAC module and on the evaporator core
surface.
- Apply the Cooling Coil Coating directly to the evaporator core through the blower motor opening.
- Use the flexible wand to direct the Cooling Coil Coating over the entire evaporator core and
surrounding gasket surfaces.
- When the application is complete, install the blower motor.
Application Through a Hole in the HVAC Module
- If neither of the two previous application methods are available, it may be necessary to drill a hole
in the HVAC module.
- Locate an area of the HVAC module between the blower motor and the evaporator core. Drill a 10
mm (3/8 in) hole in the HVAC module. Use caution to keep the drill clear of the evaporator core and
the blower motor fan.
- With the air distribution vents closed and the blower motor fan speed on HIGH, insert the
applicator tool into the hole and spray the Cooling Coil Coating into the airstream toward the
evaporator core.
- Use a GM approved RTV sealant to plug the hole in the HVAC module.
9. After the Cooling Coil Coating application is complete, start and run the vehicle for approximately
10 minutes, with the compressor disabled,
HVAC mode set to Recirculate/Max, heat set to full warm, blower motor fan speed on high, and
one window open approximately 12 mm (1/2 in). This cures the Cooling Coil Coating onto the
evaporator core surface.
10. While the engine is running, rinse the applicator tool with warm water to prolong the life of the
tool. Be sure to spray warm water through the
nozzle to rinse out any residual Cooling Coil Coating still in the capillary pick up tube, otherwise it
will dry and clog the applicator tool. Also remove the small green valve from the bottle cap and
rinse it thoroughly while rolling it between two fingers and then reinstall it. If this valve is clogged ,
the Cooling Coil Coating will not flow through the applicator tool.
11. Shut off the engine and enable the compressor again. 12. Verify proper HVAC system
operation. 13. Remove the protective cover from inside the vehicle. 14. Remove the drain pan from
underneath the vehicle. 15. Reinstall the cabin air filter if necessary.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Core: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > A/C - Musty Odors Emitted From
(HVAC) System > Page 7362
Parts Information
Important The Cooling Coil Coating listed below is the only GM approved product for use under
warranty as an evaporator core disinfectant and for the long term control of evaporator core
microbial growth.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > A/C - Musty Odors
Emitted From (HVAC) System
Evaporator Core: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Musty Odors Emitted From (HVAC) System
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 99-01-39-004C
Date: June 12, 2009
Subject: Air Conditioning Odor (Install Evaporator Core Dryer Kit and Apply Cooling Coil Coating)
Models:
1993-2010 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 All
Equipped with Air Conditioning
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2009 and 2010 model years. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 99-01-39-004B (Section 01 - HVAC).
Condition
Some customers may comment about musty odors emitted from the Heating, Ventilation and Air
Conditioning (HVAC) system at vehicle start-up in hot, humid conditions.
Cause
This condition may be caused by condensate build-up on the evaporator core, which does not
evaporate by itself in high humidity conditions. The odor may be the result of microbial growth on
the evaporator core. When the blower motor fan is turned on, the microbial growth may release an
unpleasant musty odor into the passenger compartment.
There are several other possible sources of a musty odor in a vehicle. A common source is a water
leak into the interior of the vehicle or foreign material in the HVAC air distribution system. Follow
the procedures in SI for identifying and correcting water leaks and air inlet inspection.
The procedure contained in this bulletin is only applicable if the odor source has been determined
to be microbial growth on the evaporator core inside the HVAC module.
Correction
Many vehicles currently incorporate an afterblow function within the HVAC control module
software. The afterblow feature, when enabled, employs the HVAC blower fan to dry the
evaporator after vehicle shut down and this function will inhibit microbial growth. Technicians are to
confirm that the customer concern is evaporator core odor and that the vehicle has the imbedded
afterblow feature, as defined in the SI document for that specific vehicle model, model year and
specific HVAC option. Refer to SI for enabling the afterblow function. Vehicles being delivered in
areas prone to high humidity conditions may benefit from having the afterblow enabled calibration
installed prior to any customer comment.
Important If the vehicle is not factory equipped with the imbedded afterblow enable feature, it may
be added with the Electronic Evaporator Dryer Module Kit (P/N 12497910 or AC Delco 15-5876).
Important When installing the Electronic Evaporator Dryer Module, you MUST use the included
electrical splice connectors to ensure a proper splice. Complete detailed installation instructions
and self testing procedures are supplied with the kit. If necessary, the Electronic Evaporator Dryer
Module may be installed underhood if it is protected from extreme heat and water splash areas.
To immediately remove the evaporator core odor on all suspect vehicles, it is necessary to
eliminate the microbial growth and prevent its re-occurrence. To accomplish this, perform the
following procedure:
Vehicle and Applicator Tool Preparation
1. The evaporator core must be dry. This may be accomplished by disabling the compressor and
running the blower fan on the recirc heat setting for
an extended period of time.
Note Compressor engagement will cause the evaporator core to remain wet and will prevent full
adherence of the Coiling Coil Coating to the evaporator core surfaces.
2. Verify that the air conditioning drain hose is not clogged and place a drain pan beneath the
vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > A/C - Musty Odors
Emitted From (HVAC) System > Page 7368
3. Place a protective cover over the carpet below the evaporator core. 4. Remove the cabin air
filter, if equipped, and cover the opening prior to applying the Cooling Coil Coating, as the product
may clog the filter. If the
cabin air filter appears to have little or no remaining life, suggest a replacement to your customer.
5. If the HVAC module has a blower motor cooling tube, be careful NOT TO SPRAY THE
COOLING COIL COATING INTO THE
BLOWER MOTOR COOLING TUBE.
6. Attach the Flexible Applicator Pressure Spray Tool (J-43810-20A) to a compressed air line
operating at 586 kPa (85 psi) to 793 kPa (115 psi). 7. Shake the bottle of Cooling Coil Coating well.
Screw the bottle onto the cap on the applicator tool's pick-up tube.
Note The pick-up tube is designed for 120 ml (4 oz) and 240 ml (8 oz) bottles and should coil
slightly in the bottom of a 120 ml (4 oz) bottle.
8. Use one of the following three methods to apply the Cooling Coil Coating.
Important If the Pressure Applicator Spray Tool (J-43810-20A) is not available, the Cooling Coil
Coating is also available in an aerosol can (P/N 12377951 (in Canada, 10953503)).
Application Through Blower Motor Control Module Opening
- Remove the blower motor control module (blower motor resistor). Refer to the applicable
procedure in SI.
- Clean any debris or foreign material from inside the HVAC module and on the evaporator core
surface.
- Apply the Cooling Coil Coating directly to the evaporator core through the blower motor blower
motor control module (blower motor resistor) opening.
- Use the flexible wand to direct the Cooling Coil Coating over the entire evaporator core and
surrounding gasket surfaces.
- When the application is complete, install the blower motor blower motor control module (blower
motor control module).
Application Through Blower Motor Opening
- Remove the blower motor. Refer to the applicable blower motor removal procedure in SI.
- Clean any debris or foreign material from inside the HVAC module and on the evaporator core
surface.
- Apply the Cooling Coil Coating directly to the evaporator core through the blower motor opening.
- Use the flexible wand to direct the Cooling Coil Coating over the entire evaporator core and
surrounding gasket surfaces.
- When the application is complete, install the blower motor.
Application Through a Hole in the HVAC Module
- If neither of the two previous application methods are available, it may be necessary to drill a hole
in the HVAC module.
- Locate an area of the HVAC module between the blower motor and the evaporator core. Drill a 10
mm (3/8 in) hole in the HVAC module. Use caution to keep the drill clear of the evaporator core and
the blower motor fan.
- With the air distribution vents closed and the blower motor fan speed on HIGH, insert the
applicator tool into the hole and spray the Cooling Coil Coating into the airstream toward the
evaporator core.
- Use a GM approved RTV sealant to plug the hole in the HVAC module.
9. After the Cooling Coil Coating application is complete, start and run the vehicle for approximately
10 minutes, with the compressor disabled,
HVAC mode set to Recirculate/Max, heat set to full warm, blower motor fan speed on high, and
one window open approximately 12 mm (1/2 in). This cures the Cooling Coil Coating onto the
evaporator core surface.
10. While the engine is running, rinse the applicator tool with warm water to prolong the life of the
tool. Be sure to spray warm water through the
nozzle to rinse out any residual Cooling Coil Coating still in the capillary pick up tube, otherwise it
will dry and clog the applicator tool. Also remove the small green valve from the bottle cap and
rinse it thoroughly while rolling it between two fingers and then reinstall it. If this valve is clogged ,
the Cooling Coil Coating will not flow through the applicator tool.
11. Shut off the engine and enable the compressor again. 12. Verify proper HVAC system
operation. 13. Remove the protective cover from inside the vehicle. 14. Remove the drain pan from
underneath the vehicle. 15. Reinstall the cabin air filter if necessary.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > A/C - Musty Odors
Emitted From (HVAC) System > Page 7369
Parts Information
Important The Cooling Coil Coating listed below is the only GM approved product for use under
warranty as an evaporator core disinfectant and for the long term control of evaporator core
microbial growth.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 7370
Refrigerant System Capacities - Heating, Ventilation And Air Conditioning
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Evaporator Core - Auxiliary
Evaporator Core: Service and Repair Evaporator Core - Auxiliary
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Remove the left body side rear trim panel. 3. Remove the air outlet duct assembly. 4. Disconnect
the electrical connectors. 5. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle.
6. Remove the retaining nut in order to remove the auxiliary evaporator rear tube assembly from
the core. 7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Remove the bolts that retain the case to the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Evaporator Core - Auxiliary > Page 7373
9. Remove the auxiliary evaporator module assembly from the vehicle.
10. Remove the screws from the case. 11. Separate the case halves. 12. Remove the evaporator
core seal. 13. Remove the core from the case. 14. Inspect the gaskets and the seals for damage.
15. Replace the gaskets and the seals.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the evaporator core into the case. 2. Install the evaporator core seal. 3. Reassemble the
case halves. 4. Install the auxiliary evaporator module assembly to the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Caution and Notices.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Evaporator Core - Auxiliary > Page 7374
5. Install the bolts that retain the case to the vehicle.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 10 N.m (86 lb in).
6. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 7. Install the auxiliary
evaporator underbody rear tube assembly to the core with the retaining nut.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 10 N.m (86 lb in).
8. Lower the vehicle.
9. Connect the electrical connectors.
10. Install the air outlet duct assembly. 11. Install the left body side rear trim panel. 12. Evacuate
and recharge the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 13. Leak test the fittings
of the component using the J 39400-A.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Evaporator Core - Auxiliary > Page 7375
Evaporator Core: Service and Repair Evaporator Core Replacement
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the air cleaner. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant
Recovery and Recharging 3. Remove the coolant recovery reservoir. 4. Disconnect the electrical
connectors. 5. Remove the compressor hose assembly from the accumulator. 6. Remove the
bypass valve bracket from the outer case. 7. Remove the evaporator tube from the accumulator. 8.
Remove the relay bracket. 9. Remove the evaporator tube from the evaporator. Refer to the
appropriate procedure:
^ Evaporator Tube Replacement
^ Evaporator Tube Replacement - Auxiliary Front
10. Remove the screws from the outer evaporator case.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Evaporator Core - Auxiliary > Page 7376
11. Remove the outer case from the module. 12. Remove the screws in order to split the
evaporator module in half. 13. Remove the inner case from the module. 14. Remove the
evaporator core.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the evaporator core.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice.
2. Install the inner case to the evaporator module.
Tighten Tighten the screws to the evaporator case to 6 N.m (53 lb in)
3. Install the outer case to the evaporator module.
Tighten Tighten the screws to the evaporator case to 6 N.m (53 lb in)
4. Install the evaporator tube to the evaporator.
^ Evaporator Tube Replacement
^ Evaporator Tube Replacement - Auxiliary Front
5. Install the bypass valve bracket to the outer case. 6. Install the evaporator to the accumulator. 7.
Install the compressor hose assembly to the accumulator. 8. Install the relay bracket. 9. Connect
the electrical connectors.
10. Install the coolant recovery reservoir. 11. Refill the engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling
Cooling System 12. Evacuate and recharge the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and
Recharging 13. Install the air cleaner.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Block/Orifice Tube > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Expansion Block/Orifice Tube: Service and Repair
EXPANSION (ORIFICE) TUBE REPLACEMENT
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 26549-E Orifice Tube Remover
^ J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the air cleaner. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant
Recovery and Recharging. 3. Remove the evaporator tube from the evaporator. 4. Remove the
O-ring seal. 5. Use the J 26549-E in order to remove the orifice tube. 6. If you have difficulty
removing a restricted or plugged expansion (orifice) tube, use the following procedure.
6.1. Remove as much of any impacted residue as possible.
NOTE: If the system has a pressure switch near the expansion (orifice) tube location, it should be
removed prior to heating the pipe to avoid damage to switch.
6.2. Carefully apply heat with a heat gun (hair dryer, epoxy dryer, or equivalent) approximately 7
mm (0.25 in) from the dimples on the inlet pipe. DO NOT overheat the pipe.
6.3. While applying heat, use the J 26549-E in order to remove the orifice tube.
6.4. Use a turning motion along with a push-pull motion in order to loosen the impacted expansion
(orifice) tube.
6.5. Remove the expansion (orifice) tube.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: Install the shorter screen end of the expansion (orifice) tube into the evaporator first.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Block/Orifice Tube > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 7380
1. Use the J 26549-E in order to install the expansion (orifice) tube. 2. Install the new O-ring seal.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Caution and Notices.
3. Install the evaporator tube to the evaporator.
Tighten Tighten the evaporator tube nut to 28 N.m (20 lb ft).
4. Evacuate and recharge the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 5. Leak test
the fittings of the component using the J 39400-A. 6. Install the air cleaner.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Expansion Valve: Service and Repair
THERMAL EXPANSION VALVE REPLACEMENT - AUXILIARY
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the evaporator core. 2. Gently remove the sealer packed around the thermostatic
expansion valve (TXV).
IMPORTANT: Note the mounting location and the orientation of the capillary tube on the
evaporator core.
3. Remove the clip that retains the capillary tube to the evaporator core. 4. Remove the nuts that
retain the TXV to the evaporator core. 5. Remove the TXV from the core.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the TXV to the core.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Caution and Notices.
2. Install the nuts that retain the TXV to the evaporator core.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 7384
Tighten Tighten the nuts that retain the TXV to the evaporator core to 5 N.m (44 lb in).
IMPORTANT: Install the retaining clip and the capillary tube in the location and the orientation that
was noted during disassembly.
3. Install the capillary tube and the retaining clip to the evaporator core. 4. Pack the sealer around
the TXV as found during disassembly. 5. Install the evaporator core.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Control Valve > Component Information > Diagrams
Coolant Bypass Valve Solenoid - HVAC Systems - Manual
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Control Valve > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Hot Water Bypass Valve Replacement (Front)
Heater Control Valve: Service and Repair Hot Water Bypass Valve Replacement (Front)
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38185 Hose Clamp Pliers
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the air cleaner. 2. Remove the upper fan shroud. 3. Drain the engine coolant. Refer to
Draining and Filling Cooling System 4. Remove the heater inlet pipe (5) and the outlet pipe (6) from
the bypass valves (4). 5. Remove the bolt (3) that retains the valve (4) to the heater assembly. 6.
Remove the bypass valve (4) from the heater assembly.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the bypass valve (4) to the heater assembly.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice
2. Install the bolt (3) that retains the valve (4) to the heater assembly.
Tighten Tighten the bolt to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Control Valve > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Hot Water Bypass Valve Replacement (Front) > Page 7390
3. Install the heater inlet pipe (5) and the outlet pipe (6) to the bypass valves. 4. Refill the cooling
system. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System 5. Install the upper fan shroud. 6. Install the
air cleaner.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Control Valve > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Hot Water Bypass Valve Replacement (Front) > Page 7391
Heater Control Valve: Service and Repair Hot Water Bypass Valve Replacement (Rear)
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38185 Hose Clamp Pliers
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the air cleaner. 2. Remove the upper fan shroud. 3. Drain the engine coolant. Refer to
Draining and Filling Cooling System 4. Disconnect the electrical connector from the valve. 5.
Disconnect the vacuum hose from the valve. 6. Remove the hose clamps from the outlet pipe (8)
and from the inlet pipe (4). 7. Remove the bolt (3) that retains the valve to the heater assembly. 8.
Remove the bypass valve (5) from the heater assembly. 9. Remove the heater hoses from the
engine to the hot water bypass valve.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the heater hoses to the engine to the hot water bypass valve. 2. Install the bypass valve
(5) to the heater assembly.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice.
3. Install the bolt (3) that retains the valve (5) to the heater assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Control Valve > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Hot Water Bypass Valve Replacement (Front) > Page 7392
Tighten Tighten the bolt to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
4. Install the heater inlet pipe (4) and the outlet pipe to the bypass valves. 5. Connect the vacuum
hose to the valve. 6. Connect the electrical connector to the valve. 7. Refill the cooling system.
Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System 8. Install the upper fan shroud. 9. Install the air
cleaner.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators
Heater Core: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 05-06-02-001A
Date: July 16, 2008
Subject: Information On Aluminum Heater Core and/or Radiator Replacement
Models: 2005 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2005
HUMMER H2
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to update the Warranty Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 05-06-02-001 (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
Important:
2004-05 Chevrolet Aveo (Pontiac Wave, Canada Only) does not use DEX-COOL(R). Refer to the
flushing procedure explained later in this bulletin.
The following information should be utilized when servicing aluminum heater core and/or radiators
on repeat visits. A replacement may be necessary because erosion, corrosion, or insufficient
inhibitor levels may cause damage to the heater core, radiator or water pump. A coolant check
should be performed whenever a heater core, radiator, or water pump is replaced. The following
procedures/ inspections should be done to verify proper coolant effectiveness.
Caution:
To avoid being burned, do not remove the radiator cap or surge tank cap while the engine is hot.
The cooling system will release scalding fluid and steam under pressure if the radiator cap or surge
tank cap is removed while the engine and radiator are still hot.
Important:
If the vehicle's coolant is low, drained out, or the customer has repeatedly added coolant or water
to the system, then the system should be completely flushed using the procedure explained later in
this bulletin.
Technician Diagnosis
^ Verify coolant concentration. A 50% coolant/water solution ensures proper freeze and corrosion
protection. Inhibitor levels cannot be easily measured in the field, but can be indirectly done by the
measurement of coolant concentration. This must be done by using a Refractometer J 23688
(Fahrenheit scale) or J 26568 (centigrade scale), or equivalent, coolant tester. The Refractometer
uses a minimal amount of coolant that can be taken from the coolant recovery reservoir, radiator or
the engine block. Inexpensive gravity float testers (floating balls) will not completely analyze the
coolant concentration fully and should not be used. The concentration levels should be between
50% and 65% coolant concentrate. This mixture will have a freeze point protection of -34 degrees
Fahrenheit (-37 degrees Celsius). If the concentration is below 50%, the cooling system must be
flushed.
^ Inspect the coolant flow restrictor if the vehicle is equipped with one. Refer to Service Information
(SI) and/or the appropriate Service Manual for component location and condition for operation.
^ Verify that no electrolysis is present in the cooling system. This electrolysis test can be performed
before or after the system has been repaired. Use a digital voltmeter set to 12 volts. Attach one test
lead to the negative battery post and insert the other test lead into the radiator coolant, making sure
the lead does not touch the filler neck or core. Any voltage reading over 0.3 volts indicates that
stray current is finding its way into the coolant. Electrolysis is often an intermittent condition that
occurs when a device or accessory that is mounted to the radiator is energized. This type of current
could be caused from a poorly grounded cooling fan or some other accessory and can be verified
by watching the volt meter and turning on and off various accessories or engage the starter motor.
Before using one of the following flush procedures, the coolant recovery reservoir must be
removed, drained, cleaned and reinstalled before refilling the system.
Notice:
^ Using coolant other than DEX‐COOL(R) may cause premature engine, heater core or
radiator corrosion. In addition, the engine coolant may require changing sooner, at 30,000 miles
(50,000 km) or 24 months, whichever occurs first. Any repairs would not be covered by your
warranty. Always use DEX‐COOL(R) (silicate free) coolant in your vehicle.
^ If you use an improper coolant mixture, your engine could overheat and be badly damaged. The
repair cost would not be covered by your warranty. Too much water in the mixture can freeze and
crack the engine, radiator, heater core and other parts.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators > Page 7397
Flushing Procedures using DEX-COOL(R)
Important:
The following procedure recommends refilling the system with DEX-COOL(R), P/N 12346290 (in
Canada, use P/N 10953464), GM specification 6277M. This coolant is orange in color and has a
service interval of 5 years or 240,000 km (150,000 mi). However, when used on vehicles built prior
to the introduction of DEX-COOL(R), maintenance intervals will remain the same as specified in the
Owner's Manual.
^ If available, use the approved cooling system flush and fill machine (available through the GM
Dealer Equipment Program) following the manufacturer's operating instructions.
^ If approved cooling system flush and fill machine is not available, drain the coolant and dispose of
properly following the draining procedures in the appropriate Service Manual. Refill the system
using clear, drinkable water and run the vehicle until the thermostat opens. Repeat and run the
vehicle three (3) times to totally remove the old coolant or until the drained coolant is almost clear.
Once the system is completely flushed, refill the cooling system to a 50%-60% concentration with
DEX‐COOL(R), P/N 12346290 (in Canada, use P/N 10953464), GM specification 6277M,
following the refill procedures in the appropriate Service Manual.
If a Service Manual is not available, fill half the capacity of the system with 100% DEX-COOL(R),
P/N 12346290 (in Canada, use P/N 10953464), GM specification 6277M. Then slowly add clear,
drinkable water (preferably distilled) to the system until the level of the coolant mixture has reached
the base of the radiator neck. Wait two (2) minutes and reverify the coolant level. If necessary, add
clean water to restore the coolant to the appropriate level.
Once the system is refilled, reverify the coolant concentration using a Refractometer J 23688
(Fahrenheit scale) or J 26568 (centigrade scale) coolant tester, or equivalent. The concentration
levels should be between 50% and 65%.
Flushing Procedures using Conventional Silicated (Green Colored) Coolant
Important:
2004-2005 Chevrolet Aveo (Pontiac Wave, Canada Only) does not use DEX‐COOL(R).
The Aveo and Wave are filled with conventional, silicated engine coolant that is blue in color.
Silicated coolants are typically green in color and are required to be drained, flushed and refilled
every 30,000 miles (48,000 km). The Aveo and Wave are to be serviced with conventional, silicated
coolant. Use P/N 12378560 (1 gal) (in Canada, use P/N 88862159 (1 L). Refer to the Owner's
Manual or Service Information (SI) for further information on OEM coolant.
Important:
Do not mix the OEM orange colored DEX-COOL(R) coolant with green colored coolant when
adding coolant to the system or when servicing the vehicle's cooling system. Mixing the orange and
green colored coolants will produce a brown coolant which may be a customer dissatisfier and will
not extend the service interval to that of DEX-COOL(R). Conventional silicated coolants offered by
GM Service and Parts Operations are green in color.
^ If available, use the approved cooling system flush and fill machine (available through the GM
Dealer Equipment Program) following the manufacturer's operating instructions.
^ If approved cooling systems flush and fill machine is not available, drain coolant and dispose of
properly following the draining procedures in appropriate Service Manual. Refill the system using
clear, drinkable water and run vehicle until thermostat opens. Repeat and run vehicle three (3)
times to totally remove old coolant or until drained coolant is almost clear. Once the system is
completely flushed, refill the cooling system to a 50%-60% concentration with a good quality
ethylene glycol base engine coolant, P/N 12378560, 1 gal (in Canada, use P/N 88862159 1 L),
conforming to GM specification 1825M, or recycled coolant conforming to GM specification 1825M,
following the refill procedures in the appropriate Service Manual.
If a Service Manual is not available, fill half the capacity of the system with 100% good quality
ethylene glycol base (green colored) engine coolant, P/N 12378560 1 gal., (in Canada, use P/N
88862159 1 L) conforming to GM specification 1825M. Then slowly add clear, drinkable water
(preferably distilled) to system until the level of the coolant mixture has reached the base of the
radiator neck. Wait two (2) minutes and recheck coolant level. If necessary, add clean water to
restore coolant to the appropriate level.
Once the system is refilled, recheck the coolant concentration using a Refractometer J 23688
(Fahrenheit scale) or J 26568 (centigrade scale) coolant tester, or equivalent. Concentration levels
should be between 50% and 65%.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators > Page 7398
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Heater Case/Cover Replacement
Heater Core: Service and Repair Heater Case/Cover Replacement
HEATER CASE REPLACEMENT (C60)
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Drain the engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System in Cooling System. 2.
Recover the refrigerant. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 3. Remove the heater
hoses from the heater core. 4. Remove the evaporator case from the vehicle.
5. Remove the heater case retaining nuts (2) from the engine compartment. 6. Roll out the
instrument panel. Refer to IP Carrier Replacement in Instrument Panel, Gages and Console. 7.
Disconnect the electrical connectors. 8. Disconnect the vacuum lines. 9. Remove the heater case
(5) from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Heater Case/Cover Replacement > Page 7401
1. Install the heater case (5) to the vehicle. 2. Connect the vacuum lines. 3. Connect the electrical
connectors. 4. Roll the instrument panel upward. Refer to IP Carrier Replacement in Instrument
Panel, Gages and Console.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
5. Install the heater case retaining nuts (2) to the engine compartment.
Tighten Tighten the nuts to 6 N.m (53 lb in).
6. Install the evaporator casing to the vehicle.
7. Connect the heater hoses from the heater core. 8. Evacuate and recharge the A/C system. Refer
to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 9. Fill the engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling
Cooling System in Cooling System.
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article/images refer to the RPO Code List found
at Vehicle/Application ID. See: Application and ID/RPO Codes
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Heater Case/Cover Replacement > Page 7402
Heater Core: Service and Repair Heater Core Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Drain the engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System in Cooling System. 2.
Remove the heater hoses. 3. Remove the screws (9) that retain the cover to the heater case
assembly. 4. Remove the straps (8) that retain the heater core to the heater case assembly. 5.
Remove the heater core (7) from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the heater core to the vehicle. 2. Install the straps that retain the heater core to the heater
case assembly.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the screws that retain the heater core to the heater case assembly.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
4. Install the heater hoses. 5. Refill the cooling system. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling
System in Cooling System.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Heater Case/Cover Replacement > Page 7403
Heater Core: Service and Repair Heater Core Replacement - Auxiliary
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Drain the engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System in Cooling System. 2.
Remove the body side front lower trim panel. 3. Remove the clamps from the auxiliary heater
pipes. 4. Disconnect the auxiliary heater pipes from the auxiliary heater module. 5. Remove the
screws and the band clamp from the right side of the heater core. 6. Remove the screw and the
band clamp from the left side of the heater core.
IMPORTANT: Before removing the auxiliary heater module from the vehicle, be sure to place a
protective cover on the floor in order to prevent coolant from leaking onto the carpet.
7. Remove the heater core from the heater core case. 8. Remove the seals from the heater core.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the seals to the heater core. 2. Install the heater core into the heater core case.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the screw and the band clamp to the left side of the heater core.
Tighten Tighten the screws and the band clamp to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
4. Install the screws and the band clamp to the right side of the heater core.
Tighten Tighten the screw and the band clamp to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Heater Case/Cover Replacement > Page 7404
5. Connect the auxiliary heater pipes from the auxiliary heater module. 6. Install the clamps to the
auxiliary heater pipes. 7. Install the body side front lower trim panel. 8. Refill the system with engine
coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System in Cooling System.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Heater Pipe Replacement - Auxiliary Front
Heater Hose: Service and Repair Heater Pipe Replacement - Auxiliary Front
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Drain the engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System in Cooling System. 2.
Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 3. Remove the front pipes (5) from the
rear pipes. 4. Remove the bolts (3) that retain the front pipes (5) to the body. 5. Remove the clips
(4) that retain the front pipes (5) to the body. 6. Remove the auxiliary heater front pipes (5) from the
heater hoses (1). 7. Remove the auxiliary heater front pipes (5).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the auxiliary heater front pipes (5). 2. Connect the auxiliary heater front pipes (5) to the
heater hoses (1). 3. Install the front pipe retaining clips (4) that retains the front pipes (5) to the
body.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the bolts (3) that retain the front pipes (5) to the body.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
5. Connect the auxiliary heater front pipes (5) to the rear pipes. 6. Fill the cooling system with
engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System in Cooling System.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Heater Pipe Replacement - Auxiliary Front > Page 7409
7. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Heater Pipe Replacement - Auxiliary Front > Page 7410
Heater Hose: Service and Repair Heater Pipe Replacement - Auxiliary Rear
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Drain the engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System in Cooling System. 2.
Raise the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 3. Disconnect the auxiliary heater rear
pipes from the heater core inlet and outlet tubes. 4. Disconnect the auxiliary heater rear pipes from
the front pipes. 5. Remove the pipe retainers from the body. 6. Remove the auxiliary heater rear
pipes.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the auxiliary heater rear pipes. 2. Install the pipe retainers to the body. 3. Connect the
auxiliary heater rear pipes to the front pipes. 4. Connect the rear pipes to the auxiliary heater core
inlet and outlet tubes. 5. Refill the cooling system with engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling
Cooling System in Cooling System. 6. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Heater Pipe Replacement - Auxiliary Front > Page 7411
Heater Hose: Service and Repair Heater Hose Replacement - Inlet
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 38185 Hose Clamp Pliers
^ J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the air cleaner. 2. Drain the engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling
System in Cooling System. 3. Remove the windshield washers and the coolant reservoir from the
vehicle. 4. Remove the heater hose support bolt (5) from the clamp (4). 5. Remove the clamp from
the heater hose. 6. Disconnect the inlet (3) hose from the heater core. 7. Disconnect the inlet (3)
hose from the water valve.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Connect the inlet (3) hose to the water valve. 2. Connect the inlet (3) hose to the heating core. 3.
Install the clamp to the heater hose.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the heater hose support bolt (5) to the heater hose clamp (4).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Heater Pipe Replacement - Auxiliary Front > Page 7412
Tighten Tighten the bolt to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
5. Use the J 38185 6. Install the windshield washers and the coolant reservoir. 7. Fill the cooling
system. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System in Cooling System. 8. Leak test the fittings
component using the J 39400-A 9. Install the air cleaner.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Heater Pipe Replacement - Auxiliary Front > Page 7413
Heater Hose: Service and Repair Heater Hose Replacement - Outlet
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 38185 Hose Clamp Pliers
^ J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the air cleaner. 2. Drain the engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling
System in Cooling System. 3. Remove the windshield washers and the coolant reservoir from the
vehicle. 4. Remove the heater hose support bolt (5) from the clamp (4). 5. Remove the clamp from
the heater hose. 6. Disconnect the outlet (2) hoses from the heater core. 7. Disconnect the outlet
(2) hoses from the water valve.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Connect the outlet (2) hose to the water valve. 2. Connect the outlet (2) hose to the heating core.
3. Install the clamp to the heater hose.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the heater hose support bolt (5) to the heater hose clamp (4).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Heater Pipe Replacement - Auxiliary Front > Page 7414
Tighten Tighten the bolt to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
5. Use the J 38185 6. Install the windshield washers and the coolant reservoir. 7. Fill the cooling
system. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System in Cooling System. 8. Leak test the fitting
component using the J 39400-A 9. Install the air cleaner.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Compressor Pressure Relief Valve Removal
High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC: Service and Repair Compressor Pressure Relief Valve
Removal
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 34992 Compressor Holding Fixture
1. Install the compressor onto the J 34992. 2. Remove the pressure relief valve (5) from the rear
head of the compressor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Compressor Pressure Relief Valve Removal > Page 7419
High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC: Service and Repair Compressor Pressure Relief Valve Install
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 43600 Refrigerant Station
1. Clean the valve seat area on the rear head. 2. Lubricate the O-ring of the new pressure relief
valve (5) and the O-ring assembly using new 525 viscosity refrigerant oil.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the new pressure relief valve (5).
Tighten Tighten the new valve to 9.0 N.m (6.1 lb ft).
4. Evacuate and recharge the system using the J 39500-B. 5. Leak test the system.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Compressor Pressure Relief Valve Removal > Page 7420
High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC: Service and Repair Compressor Pressure Relief Valve
Replacement
TOOL REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant
Recovery and Recharging. 3. Clean the valve seat area on the rear head. 4. Remove the pressure
relief valve (1).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Lubricate the O-ring of the new pressure relief valve (1) using new 525 viscosity refrigerant oil.
NOTE: Refer to Component Fastener Tightening Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the pressure relief valve (1).
Tighten The pressure relief valve to 9 N.m (80 lb in).
3. Evacuate and recharge the refrigerant system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Compressor Pressure Relief Valve Removal > Page 7421
4. Leak test the fitting(s) of the repaired or reinstalled component using the J 39400-A. 5. Install the
engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the IAT sensor. 2. Disconnect the MAF sensor. 3. Remove the air cleaner. 4.
Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 5.
Remove the grille. 6. Remove the engine cover. 7. Remove the compressor hose assembly bolt (2)
from the compressor. 8. Remove the old sealing washers from the compressor.
9. Remove the hose clamp bracket nut (3) from the engine stud.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 7426
10. Remove the compressor hose assembly nut (6) from the condenser. 11. Remove the
compressor hose assembly nut (1) from the accumulator. 12. Remove the bolt from the
transmission filler tube to the oil indicator tube. 13. Remove transmission filler tube from the throttle
cable bracket. 14. Remove the compressor hose assembly from the vehicle. 15. Cap or plug all
open connections on the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Uncap or unplug all open connections. 2. Install the compressor hose assembly to the vehicle. 3.
Install transmission filler tube to the throttle cable bracket.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the bolt to the transmission filler tube to the oil indicator tube.
Tighten Tighten the bolt to the oil indicator tube to 12 N.m (106 lb in).
5. Install the compressor hose assembly nut (1) to the accumulator.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 48 N.m (35 lb ft).
6. Install the compressor hose assembly nut (6) to the condenser.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 28 N.m (21 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 7427
7. Install the hose clamp bracket nut (3) to the engine stud.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 5 N.m (44 lb in).
8. Install the compressor hose assembly seals. 9. Install the sealing washers.
10. Install the compressor hose assembly bolt to the compressor.
Tighten Tighten the bolt to 34 N.m (25 lb ft).
11. Install the engine cover. 12. Install the grille. 13. Evacuate and recharge the system. Refer to
Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 14. Leak test the fittings of the component using the J
39400-A. 15. Install the air cleaner. 16. Connect the IAT sensor. 17. Connect the MAF sensor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 7428
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Accumulator Tube Replacement - Auxiliary Side
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 3. Remove the auxiliary
evaporator outlet side tube (3) from the rear tube. 4. Remove the O-ring seal.
5. Remove the auxiliary evaporator outlet side tube from the compressor hose assembly. 6.
Remove the O-ring seal.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 7429
7. Remove the bolts (1) that retain the clips on the outlet side tube (3) to the body. 8. Remove the
auxiliary evaporator side tube (3) from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the auxiliary evaporator outlet side tube (3) to the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Caution and Notices.
2. Install the bolts (1) that retain the clips on the outlet side tube (3) to the body.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
3. Install the new O-ring seal. Coat the O-ring seal with 525 viscosity refrigerant oil.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 7430
4. Install the auxiliary evaporator outlet side tube to the compressor hose assembly.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 47.5 N.m (35 lb ft).
5. Install the new O-ring seal.
6. Install the auxiliary evaporator outlet underside body tube (3) to the auxiliary evaporator rear
tube.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 47.5 N.m (35 lb ft).
7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Evacuate and recharge the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and
Recharging. 9. Leak test the fittings of the component using the J 39400-A.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 7431
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Compressor/Condenser Hose Replacement - Auxiliary
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the IAT sensor. 2. Disconnect the MAF sensor. 3. Remove the air cleaner. 4.
Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 5.
Remove the grille. 6. Remove the engine cover. 7. Raise vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the
Vehicle. 8. Disconnect the auxiliary evaporator lines nut from the compressor hose assembly. 9.
Lower vehicle.
10. Remove the nut that attaches the compressor hose assembly bracket to the engine.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 7432
11. Remove the hose clamp bracket nut (3) from the engine stud.
12. Remove the compressor hose assembly bolt from the compressor. 13. Remove the sealing
washers from the compressor.
14. Remove the compressor hose assembly nut (6) from the condenser. 15. Remove the
compressor hose assembly nut (1) from the accumulator. 16. Remove the compressor hose
assembly from the vehicle. 17. Cap or plug all open connections.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 7433
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Uncap or unplug all open connections. 2. Install the compressor hose assembly to the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the compressor hose assembly nut (1) to the accumulator.
Tighten Tighten the compressor hose assembly nut (1) to the accumulator to 48 N.m (35 lb ft).
4. Install the compressor hose assembly nut (6) to the condenser.
Tighten Tighten the compressor hose assembly nut to the condenser to 28 N.m (21 lb ft).
5. Install new seal washers to the compressor. 6. Install the compressor hose assembly bolt to the
compressor.
Tighten Tighten the bolt to 34 N.m (25 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 7434
7. Install the hose clamp bracket nut (3) to the engine stud.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 5 N.m (44 lb in).
8. Install the nut that attaches the compressor hose assembly bracket to the engine.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 5 N.m (44 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 7435
9. Raise the vehicle.
10. Connect the auxiliary evaporator hose nut to the compressor hose assembly.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 28 N.m (21 lb ft).
11. Lower the vehicle. 12. Install the engine cover. 13. Install the grille. 14. Evacuate and recharge
the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 15. Leak test the fittings of the
component using the J 39400-A. 16. Install the air cleaner. 17. Connect the IAT sensor. 18.
Connect the MAF sensor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 7436
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Evaporator Tube Replacement
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the air cleaner. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant
Recovery and Recharging. 3. Remove the evaporator tube (2) from the evaporator. 4. Remove the
O-ring seal. 5. Remove the grille. 6. Remove the evaporator tube (2) from the condenser (4). 7.
Remove the O-ring seal. 8. Remove the evaporator tube from the auxiliary A/C evaporator
underbody front tube assembly (if equipped).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the NEW O-ring seal. 2. Install the evaporator tube (2) to the condenser (4).
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Caution and Notices.
3. Tighten the evaporator tube nut (3) to the condenser (4).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 7437
Tighten Tighten the nut to 28 N.m (20 lb ft).
4. Install the grille. 5. Install the new O-ring seal. 6. Install the evaporator tube to the evaporator.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 28 N.m (20 lb ft).
7. Install the evaporator tube to the auxiliary A/C evaporator underbody front tube assembly (if
equipped).
Tighten Tighten the evaporator tube nut to the auxiliary A/C evaporator to 28 N.m (20 lb ft).
8. Evacuate and recharge the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 9. Leak test
the fittings of the component using the J 39400-A.
10. Install the air cleaner.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 7438
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair
Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the IAT sensor. 2. Disconnect the MAF sensor. 3. Remove the air cleaner. 4.
Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 5.
Remove the grille. 6. Remove the engine cover. 7. Remove the compressor hose assembly bolt (2)
from the compressor. 8. Remove the old sealing washers from the compressor.
9. Remove the hose clamp bracket nut (3) from the engine stud.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 7439
10. Remove the compressor hose assembly nut (6) from the condenser. 11. Remove the
compressor hose assembly nut (1) from the accumulator. 12. Remove the bolt from the
transmission filler tube to the oil indicator tube. 13. Remove transmission filler tube from the throttle
cable bracket. 14. Remove the compressor hose assembly from the vehicle. 15. Cap or plug all
open connections on the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Uncap or unplug all open connections. 2. Install the compressor hose assembly to the vehicle. 3.
Install transmission filler tube to the throttle cable bracket.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the bolt to the transmission filler tube to the oil indicator tube.
Tighten Tighten the bolt to the oil indicator tube to 12 N.m (106 lb in).
5. Install the compressor hose assembly nut (1) to the accumulator.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 48 N.m (35 lb ft).
6. Install the compressor hose assembly nut (6) to the condenser.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 28 N.m (21 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 7440
7. Install the hose clamp bracket nut (3) to the engine stud.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 5 N.m (44 lb in).
8. Install the compressor hose assembly seals. 9. Install the sealing washers.
10. Install the compressor hose assembly bolt to the compressor.
Tighten Tighten the bolt to 34 N.m (25 lb ft).
11. Install the engine cover. 12. Install the grille. 13. Evacuate and recharge the system. Refer to
Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 14. Leak test the fittings of the component using the J
39400-A. 15. Install the air cleaner. 16. Connect the IAT sensor. 17. Connect the MAF sensor.
Accumulator Tube Replacement - Auxiliary Side
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 7441
1. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 3. Remove the auxiliary
evaporator outlet side tube (3) from the rear tube. 4. Remove the O-ring seal.
5. Remove the auxiliary evaporator outlet side tube from the compressor hose assembly. 6.
Remove the O-ring seal.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 7442
7. Remove the bolts (1) that retain the clips on the outlet side tube (3) to the body. 8. Remove the
auxiliary evaporator side tube (3) from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the auxiliary evaporator outlet side tube (3) to the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Caution and Notices.
2. Install the bolts (1) that retain the clips on the outlet side tube (3) to the body.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
3. Install the new O-ring seal. Coat the O-ring seal with 525 viscosity refrigerant oil.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 7443
4. Install the auxiliary evaporator outlet side tube to the compressor hose assembly.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 47.5 N.m (35 lb ft).
5. Install the new O-ring seal.
6. Install the auxiliary evaporator outlet underside body tube (3) to the auxiliary evaporator rear
tube.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 47.5 N.m (35 lb ft).
7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Evacuate and recharge the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and
Recharging. 9. Leak test the fittings of the component using the J 39400-A.
Compressor/Condenser Hose Replacement - Auxiliary
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 7444
1. Disconnect the IAT sensor. 2. Disconnect the MAF sensor. 3. Remove the air cleaner. 4.
Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 5.
Remove the grille. 6. Remove the engine cover. 7. Raise vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the
Vehicle. 8. Disconnect the auxiliary evaporator lines nut from the compressor hose assembly. 9.
Lower vehicle.
10. Remove the nut that attaches the compressor hose assembly bracket to the engine.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 7445
11. Remove the hose clamp bracket nut (3) from the engine stud.
12. Remove the compressor hose assembly bolt from the compressor. 13. Remove the sealing
washers from the compressor.
14. Remove the compressor hose assembly nut (6) from the condenser. 15. Remove the
compressor hose assembly nut (1) from the accumulator. 16. Remove the compressor hose
assembly from the vehicle. 17. Cap or plug all open connections.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 7446
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Uncap or unplug all open connections. 2. Install the compressor hose assembly to the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the compressor hose assembly nut (1) to the accumulator.
Tighten Tighten the compressor hose assembly nut (1) to the accumulator to 48 N.m (35 lb ft).
4. Install the compressor hose assembly nut (6) to the condenser.
Tighten Tighten the compressor hose assembly nut to the condenser to 28 N.m (21 lb ft).
5. Install new seal washers to the compressor. 6. Install the compressor hose assembly bolt to the
compressor.
Tighten Tighten the bolt to 34 N.m (25 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 7447
7. Install the hose clamp bracket nut (3) to the engine stud.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 5 N.m (44 lb in).
8. Install the nut that attaches the compressor hose assembly bracket to the engine.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 5 N.m (44 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 7448
9. Raise the vehicle.
10. Connect the auxiliary evaporator hose nut to the compressor hose assembly.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 28 N.m (21 lb ft).
11. Lower the vehicle. 12. Install the engine cover. 13. Install the grille. 14. Evacuate and recharge
the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 15. Leak test the fittings of the
component using the J 39400-A. 16. Install the air cleaner. 17. Connect the IAT sensor. 18.
Connect the MAF sensor.
Evaporator Tube Replacement
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the air cleaner. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant
Recovery and Recharging. 3. Remove the evaporator tube (2) from the evaporator. 4. Remove the
O-ring seal. 5. Remove the grille.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 7449
6. Remove the evaporator tube (2) from the condenser (4). 7. Remove the O-ring seal. 8. Remove
the evaporator tube from the auxiliary A/C evaporator underbody front tube assembly (if equipped).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the NEW O-ring seal. 2. Install the evaporator tube (2) to the condenser (4).
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Caution and Notices.
3. Tighten the evaporator tube nut (3) to the condenser (4).
Tighten Tighten the nut to 28 N.m (20 lb ft).
4. Install the grille. 5. Install the new O-ring seal. 6. Install the evaporator tube to the evaporator.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 28 N.m (20 lb ft).
7. Install the evaporator tube to the auxiliary A/C evaporator underbody front tube assembly (if
equipped).
Tighten Tighten the evaporator tube nut to the auxiliary A/C evaporator to 28 N.m (20 lb ft).
8. Evacuate and recharge the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 9. Leak test
the fittings of the component using the J 39400-A.
10. Install the air cleaner.
Evaporator Tube Replacement - Auxiliary Front
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 7450
1. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 3. Remove the auxiliary
evaporator front inlet tube from the evaporator inlet tube (2) at the accumulator. 4. Remove the
O-ring seal. 5. Remove the bolts (3) that retain the clips on the auxiliary evaporator front inlet tube
(2) to the body. 6. Remove the auxiliary evaporator front inlet tube (2) from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the auxiliary evaporator front inlet tube (2) to the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Caution and Notices.
2. Install the bolts that retain the clips on the auxiliary evaporator front inlet tube (2) to the body.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
3. Install the new O-ring seal. 4. Install the auxiliary evaporator front inlet tube (2) to the auxiliary
evaporator side inlet tube.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 27 N.m (20 lb ft).
5. Lower the vehicle. 6. Evacuate and recharge the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and
Recharging. 7. Leak test the fittings of the component using the J 39400-A.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 7451
Evaporator Tube Replacement - Auxiliary Rear
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 3. Remove the auxiliary
evaporator rear outlet tube from the auxiliary evaporator outlet side tubes. 4. Remove the auxiliary
evaporator rear inlet tube from the auxiliary evaporator inlet side tubes. 5. Remove the bolts that
retain the clips on the tubes to the body. 6. Remove the nut that retains the tube to the auxiliary
evaporator module.
7. Remove the tube from the auxiliary evaporator module. 8. Remove the seal washers
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 7452
1. Install the seal washers. 2. Install the tube to the auxiliary evaporator module.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Caution and Notices.
3. Install the nut that retains the tube to the auxiliary evaporator module.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
4. Install the bolts that retain the clips on the tubes to the body.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
5. Install the auxiliary evaporator rear tube inlet tube to the auxiliary evaporator inlet side tube.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 27 N.m (20 lb ft).
6. Install the auxiliary evaporator rear tube outlet tube to the auxiliary evaporator outlet side tube.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 47.5 N.m (35 lb ft).
7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Evacuate and recharge the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and
Recharging.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 7453
9. Leak test the fitting(s) of the repaired or reinstalled component using the J 39400-A.
Evaporator Tube Replacement - Auxiliary Side
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle. 3. Remove the auxiliary
evaporator side inlet tube from the auxiliary evaporator rear tube (3). 4. Remove the O-ring seal.
5. Remove the auxiliary evaporator side inlet tube from the auxiliary evaporator front tube (2). 6.
Remove the O-ring seal.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 7454
7. Remove the bolts (1) that retain the clips on the auxiliary side inlet tube (3) to the body. 8.
Remove the auxiliary evaporator side inlet tube (3) from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the auxiliary evaporator side inlet tube (3) to the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Caution and Notices.
2. Install the bolts that retain the clips on the auxiliary evaporator side inlet tube (3) to the body.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
3. Install the new O-ring seal.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Compressor Hose Assembly Replacement > Page 7455
4. Install the auxiliary evaporator side inlet tube to the auxiliary evaporator front inlet tube (2).
Tighten Tighten the nut to 27 N.m (20 lb ft).
5. Install the new O-ring seal. Coat the O-ring seal with 525 viscosity refrigerant oil.
6. Install the auxiliary evaporator side inlet tube (3) to the auxiliary evaporator rear tube.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 27 N.m (20 lb ft).
7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Evacuate and recharge the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and
Recharging. 9. Leak test the fittings of the component using the J 39400-A.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Housing Assembly HVAC: Service and Repair
HEATER MODULE REPLACEMENT - AUXILIARY
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Drain the engine coolant. Refer to Draining and Filling Cooling System in Cooling System. 2.
Remove the body side front lower trim panel. 3. Remove the auxiliary heater module cover
retaining screws. 4. Remove the auxiliary heater module cover. 5. Remove the auxiliary heater pipe
clamps. 6. Disconnect the auxiliary heater pipes from the auxiliary heater module.
7. Remove the bolts retaining the auxiliary heater module to the floor.
IMPORTANT: Before removing the auxiliary heater module from the vehicle, be sure to place a
protective cover on the floor in order to prevent coolant from leaking onto the carpet.
8. Remove the auxiliary heater module from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the auxiliary heater module.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 7459
2. Install the bolts that retain the auxiliary heater module to the floor.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 5 N.m (44 lb in).
3. Connect the auxiliary heater pipes to the auxiliary heater module. 4. Install the auxiliary heater
pipe clamps.
5. Install the auxiliary heater module cover. 6. Install the auxiliary heater module cover retaining
screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 5 N.m (44 lb in).
7. Install the body side front lower trim panel. 8. Refill the cooling system. Refer to Draining and
Filling Cooling System in Cooling System.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recycling/Equipment
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recycling/Equipment
Bulletin No.: 08-01-38-001
Date: January 25, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Information On New GE-48800 CoolTech Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2008 and
Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
Attention:
This bulletin is being issued to announce the release of GM approved Air Conditioning (A/C)
Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging Equipment that meets the new Society of Automotive
Engineers (SAE) J2788 Refrigerant Recovery Standards. The ACR2000 (J-43600) cannot be
manufactured in its current state after December 2007 and will be superseded by GE-48800.
The new J2788 standard does not require that GM Dealers replace their ACR2000 units.
ACR2000's currently in use are very capable of servicing today's refrigerant systems when used
correctly and can continue to be used. Details regarding the new SAE J2788 standard are outlined
in GM Bulletin 07-01-38-004.
Effective February 1 2008, new A/C Refrigerant Recovery/Recharging equipment (P/N GE-48800)
will be released as a required replacement for the previously essential ACR2000 (J-43600). This
equipment is SAE J2788 compliant and meets GM requirements for A/C Refrigerant System
Repairs on all General Motors vehicles, including Hybrid systems with Polyolester (POE)
refrigerant oil. This equipment will not be shipped as an essential tool to GM Dealerships.
In addition, this equipment is Hybrid compliant and designed to prevent oil cross contamination
when servicing Hybrid vehicles with Electric A/C Compressors that use POE refrigerant oil.
The ACR2000 (J-43600) will need to be retrofitted with a J-43600-50 (Hose - ACR2000 Oil Flush
Loop) to be able to perform Hybrid A/C service work. All Hybrid dealers will receive the J-43600-50,
with installation instructions, as a component of the Hybrid essential tool package. Dealerships that
do not sell Hybrids, but may need to service Hybrids, can obtain J-43600-50 from SPX Kent Moore.
Refer to GM Bulletin 08-01-39-001 for the ACR2000 Hose Flush procedure.
The High Voltage (HV) electric A/C compressor used on Two Mode Hybrid vehicles uses a
Polyolester (POE) refrigerant oil instead of a Polyalkylene Glycol (PAG) synthetic refrigerant oil.
This is due to the better electrical resistance of the POE oil and its ability to provide HV isolation.
Failure to flush the hoses before adding refrigerant to a Hybrid vehicle with an electric A/C
compressor may result in an unacceptable amount of PAG oil entering the refrigerant system. It
may cause a Battery Energy Control Module Hybrid Battery Voltage System Isolation Lost
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC P1AE7) to be set. Additionally, the A/C system warranty will be
voided.
Warranty Submission Requirements
The Electronically Generated Repair Data (snapshot summary) and printer functions have been
eliminated from the GE-48800. The VGA display and temperature probes were eliminated to
reduce equipment costs. As a result, effective immediately the 18 digit "Snapshot/Charge
Summary" code is no longer required for Air Conditioning (A/C) refrigerant system repairs that are
submitted for warranty reimbursement. The charge summary data from before and after system
repairs will continue to required, but documented on the repair order only. Both high and low
pressures and the recovery and charge amounts should be noted during the repair and entered on
the repair order. If using ACR2000 (J-43600), the "Snapshot/Charge Summary" printouts should
continue to be attached to the shops copy of the repair order.
The labor codes that are affected by this requirement are D3000 through D4500.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recycling/Equipment > Page 7464
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Contaminated R134A Refrigerant
Bulletin No.: 06-01-39-007
Date: July 25, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Contaminated R134a Refrigerant Found on Market for Automotive Air-Conditioning
Systems
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2007 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2007 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Attention:
This bulletin should be directed to the Service Manager as well as the Parts Manager.
Commercially Available Contaminated R134a Refrigerant
Impurities have been found in new commercially available containers of R134a. High levels of
contaminates may cause decreased performance, and be detrimental to some air-conditioning
components. Accompanying these contaminates has been high levels of moisture.
Tip:
Excessive moisture may cause system concerns such as orifice tube freeze-up and reduced
performance.
Industry Reaction: New Industry Purity Standards
Due to the potential availability of these lower quality refrigerants, the Society of Automotive
Engineers (SAE), and the Air Conditioning and Refrigeration Industry (ARI) are in the process of
instituting reliable standards that will be carried on the labels of future R134a refrigerant containers.
This identifying symbol will be your assurance of a product that conforms to the minimum standard
for OEM Automotive Air-Conditioning use.
How Can You Protect Yourself Today?
It is recommended to use GM or ACDelco(R) sourced refrigerants for all A/C repair work. These
refrigerants meet General Motors own internal standards for quality and purity, insuring that your
completed repairs are as good as the way it left the factory.
Parts Information
The part numbers shown are available through GMSPO or ACDelco(R). The nearest ACDelco(R)
distributor in your area can be found by calling 1-800-223-3526 (U.S. Only).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recycling/Equipment > Page 7465
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications
Refrigerant: Capacity Specifications
Air Conditioning Refrigerant ................................................................................................................
....................................................... 2.0 lb. (0.91 kg.) Air Conditioning Refrigerant with Rear A/C
.............................................................................................................................................. 3.0 lb.
(1.36 kg.)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications > Page 7468
Refrigerant: Fluid Type Specifications
Type R-134a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 7469
Refrigerant: Service Precautions
CAUTION:
^ Avoid breathing the A/C Refrigerant 134a (R-134a) and the lubricant vapor or the mist. Exposure
may irritate the eyes, nose, and throat. Work in a well ventilated area. In order to remove R-134a
from the A/C system, use service equipment that is certified to meet the requirements of SAE J
2210 (R-134a recycling equipment). If an accidental system discharge occurs, ventilate the work
area before continuing service. Additional health and safety information may be obtained from the
refrigerant and lubricant manufacturers.
^ For personal protection, goggles and gloves should be worn and a clean cloth wrapped around
fittings, valves, and connections when doing work that includes opening the refrigerant system. If
R-134a comes in contact with any part of the body severe frostbite and personal injury can result.
The exposed area should be flushed immediately with cold water and prompt medical help should
be obtained.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 7470
Refrigerant: Service and Repair
REFRIGERANT RECOVERY AND RECHARGING
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 43600 ACR 2000 Air Conditioning Service Center
^ J 45037 A/C Oil Injector
CAUTION:
^ Avoid breathing the A/C Refrigerant 134a (R-134a) and the lubricant vapor or the mist. Exposure
may irritate the eyes, nose, and throat. Work in a well ventilated area. In order to remove R-134a
from the A/C system, use service equipment that is certified to meet the requirements of SAE J
2210 (R-134a recycling equipment). If an accidental system discharge occurs, ventilate the work
area before continuing service. Additional health and safety information may be obtained from the
refrigerant and lubricant manufacturers.
^ For personal protection, goggles and gloves should be worn and a clean cloth wrapped around
fittings, valves, and connections when doing work that includes opening the refrigerant system. If
R-134a comes in contact with any part of the body severe frostbite and personal injury can result.
The exposed area should be flushed immediately with cold water and prompt medical help should
be obtained.
NOTE:
^ R-134a is the only approved refrigerant for use in this vehicle. The use of any other refrigerant
may result in poor system performance or component failure.
^ To avoid system damage use only R-134a dedicated tools when servicing the A/C system.
^ Use only Polyalkylene Glycol Synthetic Refrigerant Oil (PAG) for internal circulation through the
R-134a A/C system and only 525 viscosity mineral oil on fitting threads and O-rings. If lubricants
other than those specified are used, compressor failure and/or fitting seizure may result.
^ R-12 refrigerant and R-134a refrigerant must never be mixed, even in the smallest of amounts, as
they are incompatible with each other. If the refrigerants are mixed, compressor failure is likely to
occur. Refer to the manufacturer instructions included with the service equipment before servicing.
The J 43600 is a complete air conditioning service center for R-134a. The ACR 2000 recovers,
recycles, evacuates and recharges A/C refrigerant quickly, accurately and automatically. The unit
has a display screen that contains the function controls and displays prompts that will lead the
technician through the recover, recycle, evacuate and recharge operations. R-134a is recovered
into and charged out of an internal storage vessel. The ACR 2000 automatically replenishes this
vessel from an external source tank in order to maintain a constant 5.45-6.82 kg (12-15 lbs) of A/C
refrigerant.
The ACR 2000 has a built in A/C refrigerant identifier that will test for contamination, prior to
recovery and will notify the technician if there are foreign gases present in the A/C system. If
foreign gases are present, the ACR 2000 will not recover the refrigerant from the A/C system.
The ACR 2000 also features automatic air purge, single pass recycling and an automatic oil drain.
Refer to the J 43600 ACR 2000 for operation and setup instruction. Always recharge the A/C
System with the proper amount of R-134a. Refer to Refrigerant System Capacities for the correct
amount.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60)
Refrigerant Filter: Service and Repair Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60)
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
IMPORTANT: The A/C refrigerant filter, ACDelco P/N 15-1697 must be installed to the A/C
evaporator tube between the condenser and evaporator. The installation of this A/C refrigerant filter
eliminates the need for flushing.
1. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Remove the air cleaner. 3. Remove the upper radiator shroud. 4. Remove the grille. 5. Remove the
evaporator tube (1) from the vehicle. 6. Measure 40 mm (1.5 in) from the bend on the evaporator
tube (1) near the high side access port.. 7. Measure 50.8 mm (2 in) from the mark on the
evaporator tube (1) from the previous step.
IMPORTANT: Do not allow metal burrs to enter the evaporator tube (1) during cutting or when
removing the burrs.
8. Using a tubing cutter, cut the marked section of the evaporator tube (1). 9. Remove the burrs
from the evaporator tube (1).
10. Remove the nuts (4), the ferrules (3), and the O-rings (2) from the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
IMPORTANT: DO NOT install the O-rings (2) in this step.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 7475
11. Push the nuts (4) and ferrules (3) over each of the evaporator tube halves. 12. Install the
ferrules (3) with the small end toward the nut (4).
13. Install the A/C refrigerant filter (6) to the evaporator tube (1) with the flow arrow pointing
towards the evaporator.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
14. While holding the evaporator tube in the A/C refrigerant filter (1) tighten the nuts (4) to the A/C
refrigerant filter (1).
Tighten Tighten the nuts to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
15. Remove the nuts (4) from the A/C refrigerant filter (1). 16. Coat the O-rings (2) with 525
viscosity refrigerant oil. 17. Install the O-rings (2) to the evaporator tube. 18. Install the nuts (4) to
the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
Tighten Tighten the nuts to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 7476
19. Install the evaporator tube (1) to the vehicle. 20. Recharge the A/C system. Refer to Refrigerant
Recovery and Recharging. 21. Leak test the fitting(s) of the repaired or reinstalled component
using the J 39400-A. 22. Install the upper radiator shroud. 23. Install the grille. 24. Install the air
cleaner.
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article/images refer to the RPO Code List found
at Vehicle/Application ID. See: Application and ID/RPO Codes
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 7477
Refrigerant Filter: Service and Repair Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C69)
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
IMPORTANT: The A/C refrigerant filter, ACDelco P/N 15-1697 must be installed to the A/C
evaporator tube between the condenser and evaporator. The installation of this A/C refrigerant filter
eliminates the need for flushing.
1. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Remove the air cleaner. 3. Remove the upper radiator shroud. 4. Remove the grille. 5. Remove the
evaporator tube (1) from the vehicle. 6. Measure 40 mm (1.5 in) from the bend on the evaporator
tube (1) near the high side access port. 7. Measure 50.8 mm (2 in) from the mark on the evaporator
tube (1) from the previous step.
IMPORTANT: Do not allow metal burrs to enter the evaporator tube (1) during cutting or when
removing the burrs.
8. Using a tubing cutter, cut the marked section of the evaporator tube (1). 9. Remove the burrs
from the evaporator tube (1).
10. Remove the nuts (4), the ferrules (3), and the O-rings (2) from the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
IMPORTANT: DO NOT install the O-rings (2) in this step.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 7478
11. Push the nuts (4) and ferrules (3) over each of the evaporator tube halves. 12. Install the
ferrules (3) with the small end toward the nut (4).
13. Install the A/C refrigerant filter (6) to the evaporator tube (1) with the flow arrow pointing
towards the evaporator.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
14. While holding the evaporator tube in the A/C refrigerant filter (1), tighten the nuts (4) to the A/C
refrigerant filter (1).
Tighten Tighten the nuts to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
15. Remove the nuts (4) from the A/C refrigerant filter (1). 16. Coat the O-rings (2) with 525
viscosity refrigerant oil. 17. Install the O-rings (2) to the evaporator tube. 18. Install the nuts (4) to
the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
Tighten Tighten the nuts to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 7479
19. Install the evaporator tube (1) to the vehicle. 20. Recharge the A/C system. Refer to Refrigerant
Recovery and Recharging. 21. Leak test the fitting(s) of the repaired or reinstalled component
using the J 39400-A. 22. Install the upper radiator shroud. 23. Install the grille. 24. Install the air
cleaner.
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article/images refer to the RPO Code List found
at Vehicle/Application ID. See: Application and ID/RPO Codes
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 7480
Refrigerant Filter: Service and Repair Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Replacement (C60)
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Remove the air cleaner. 3. Remove the upper radiator shroud. 4. Remove the grille. 5. Remove the
evaporator tube (1) from the vehicle.
IMPORTANT: The ruts (4) and ferrules (3) will remain on the evaporator tube. Do not try to remove.
6. Remove the nuts (4) from the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 7481
7. Remove the A/C refrigerant filter from the evaporator tube (1).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the new O-rings (2) to the evaporator tube.
2. Install the A/C refrigerant filter to the evaporator tube (1) with the flow arrow pointing towards the
evaporator.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 7482
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the nuts (4) to the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
Tighten Tighten the nuts to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
4. Install the evaporator tube. 5. Recharge the A/C system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and
Recharging. 6. Leak test the fitting(s) of the repaired or reinstalled component using the J 39400-A.
7. Install the grille. 8. Install the upper radiator shroud. 9. Install the air cleaner.
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article/images refer to the RPO Code List found
at Vehicle/Application ID. See: Application and ID/RPO Codes
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 7483
Refrigerant Filter: Service and Repair Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Replacement (C69)
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Remove the air cleaner. 3. Remove the upper radiator shroud. 4. Remove the grille. 5. Remove the
evaporator tube (1) from the vehicle.
IMPORTANT: The nuts (4) and ferrules (3) will remain on the evaporator tube. Do not try to
remove.
6. Remove the nuts (4) from the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 7484
7. Remove the A/C refrigerant filter (6) from the evaporator tube (1).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the new O-rings (2) to the evaporator tube.
2. Install the A/C refrigerant filter (6) to the evaporator tube (1) with the flow arrow pointing towards
the evaporator.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 7485
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the nuts (4) to the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
Tighten Tighten the nuts to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
4. Install the evaporator tube. 5. Recharge the A/C system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and
Recharging. 6. Leak test the fitting(s) of the repaired or reinstalled component using the J 39400-A.
7. Install the grille. 8. Install the upper radiator shroud. 9. Install the air cleaner.
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article/images refer to the RPO Code List found
at Vehicle/Application ID. See: Application and ID/RPO Codes
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 7486
Refrigerant Filter: Service and Repair
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60)
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
IMPORTANT: The A/C refrigerant filter, ACDelco P/N 15-1697 must be installed to the A/C
evaporator tube between the condenser and evaporator. The installation of this A/C refrigerant filter
eliminates the need for flushing.
1. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Remove the air cleaner. 3. Remove the upper radiator shroud. 4. Remove the grille. 5. Remove the
evaporator tube (1) from the vehicle. 6. Measure 40 mm (1.5 in) from the bend on the evaporator
tube (1) near the high side access port.. 7. Measure 50.8 mm (2 in) from the mark on the
evaporator tube (1) from the previous step.
IMPORTANT: Do not allow metal burrs to enter the evaporator tube (1) during cutting or when
removing the burrs.
8. Using a tubing cutter, cut the marked section of the evaporator tube (1). 9. Remove the burrs
from the evaporator tube (1).
10. Remove the nuts (4), the ferrules (3), and the O-rings (2) from the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 7487
IMPORTANT: DO NOT install the O-rings (2) in this step.
11. Push the nuts (4) and ferrules (3) over each of the evaporator tube halves. 12. Install the
ferrules (3) with the small end toward the nut (4).
13. Install the A/C refrigerant filter (6) to the evaporator tube (1) with the flow arrow pointing
towards the evaporator.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
14. While holding the evaporator tube in the A/C refrigerant filter (1) tighten the nuts (4) to the A/C
refrigerant filter (1).
Tighten Tighten the nuts to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
15. Remove the nuts (4) from the A/C refrigerant filter (1). 16. Coat the O-rings (2) with 525
viscosity refrigerant oil. 17. Install the O-rings (2) to the evaporator tube. 18. Install the nuts (4) to
the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
Tighten Tighten the nuts to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 7488
19. Install the evaporator tube (1) to the vehicle. 20. Recharge the A/C system. Refer to Refrigerant
Recovery and Recharging. 21. Leak test the fitting(s) of the repaired or reinstalled component
using the J 39400-A. 22. Install the upper radiator shroud. 23. Install the grille. 24. Install the air
cleaner.
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article/images refer to the RPO Code List found
at Vehicle/Application ID. See: Application and ID/RPO Codes
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C69)
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
IMPORTANT: The A/C refrigerant filter, ACDelco P/N 15-1697 must be installed to the A/C
evaporator tube between the condenser and evaporator. The installation of this A/C refrigerant filter
eliminates the need for flushing.
1. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Remove the air cleaner. 3. Remove the upper radiator shroud. 4. Remove the grille. 5. Remove the
evaporator tube (1) from the vehicle. 6. Measure 40 mm (1.5 in) from the bend on the evaporator
tube (1) near the high side access port. 7. Measure 50.8 mm (2 in) from the mark on the evaporator
tube (1) from the previous step.
IMPORTANT: Do not allow metal burrs to enter the evaporator tube (1) during cutting or when
removing the burrs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 7489
8. Using a tubing cutter, cut the marked section of the evaporator tube (1). 9. Remove the burrs
from the evaporator tube (1).
10. Remove the nuts (4), the ferrules (3), and the O-rings (2) from the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
IMPORTANT: DO NOT install the O-rings (2) in this step.
11. Push the nuts (4) and ferrules (3) over each of the evaporator tube halves. 12. Install the
ferrules (3) with the small end toward the nut (4).
13. Install the A/C refrigerant filter (6) to the evaporator tube (1) with the flow arrow pointing
towards the evaporator.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 7490
14. While holding the evaporator tube in the A/C refrigerant filter (1), tighten the nuts (4) to the A/C
refrigerant filter (1).
Tighten Tighten the nuts to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
15. Remove the nuts (4) from the A/C refrigerant filter (1). 16. Coat the O-rings (2) with 525
viscosity refrigerant oil. 17. Install the O-rings (2) to the evaporator tube. 18. Install the nuts (4) to
the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
Tighten Tighten the nuts to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
19. Install the evaporator tube (1) to the vehicle. 20. Recharge the A/C system. Refer to Refrigerant
Recovery and Recharging. 21. Leak test the fitting(s) of the repaired or reinstalled component
using the J 39400-A. 22. Install the upper radiator shroud. 23. Install the grille. 24. Install the air
cleaner.
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article/images refer to the RPO Code List found
at Vehicle/Application ID. See: Application and ID/RPO Codes
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Replacement (C60)
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 7491
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Remove the air cleaner. 3. Remove the upper radiator shroud. 4. Remove the grille. 5. Remove the
evaporator tube (1) from the vehicle.
IMPORTANT: The ruts (4) and ferrules (3) will remain on the evaporator tube. Do not try to remove.
6. Remove the nuts (4) from the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 7492
7. Remove the A/C refrigerant filter from the evaporator tube (1).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the new O-rings (2) to the evaporator tube.
2. Install the A/C refrigerant filter to the evaporator tube (1) with the flow arrow pointing towards the
evaporator.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 7493
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the nuts (4) to the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
Tighten Tighten the nuts to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
4. Install the evaporator tube. 5. Recharge the A/C system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and
Recharging. 6. Leak test the fitting(s) of the repaired or reinstalled component using the J 39400-A.
7. Install the grille. 8. Install the upper radiator shroud. 9. Install the air cleaner.
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article/images refer to the RPO Code List found
at Vehicle/Application ID. See: Application and ID/RPO Codes
Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Replacement (C69)
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 7494
1. Recover the refrigerant from the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Remove the air cleaner. 3. Remove the upper radiator shroud. 4. Remove the grille. 5. Remove the
evaporator tube (1) from the vehicle.
IMPORTANT: The nuts (4) and ferrules (3) will remain on the evaporator tube. Do not try to
remove.
6. Remove the nuts (4) from the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 7495
7. Remove the A/C refrigerant filter (6) from the evaporator tube (1).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the new O-rings (2) to the evaporator tube.
2. Install the A/C refrigerant filter (6) to the evaporator tube (1) with the flow arrow pointing towards
the evaporator.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 7496
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the nuts (4) to the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
Tighten Tighten the nuts to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
4. Install the evaporator tube. 5. Recharge the A/C system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and
Recharging. 6. Leak test the fitting(s) of the repaired or reinstalled component using the J 39400-A.
7. Install the grille. 8. Install the upper radiator shroud. 9. Install the air cleaner.
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article/images refer to the RPO Code List found
at Vehicle/Application ID. See: Application and ID/RPO Codes
Suction Screen Installation
TOOL REQUIRED
J 44551 Suction Screen Installation/ Removal Kit
IMPORTANT: Suction screens are intended to be installed in the suction hose after a major
compressor failure.
The suction screens are available in 3 different sizes.
1. Insert the J 44551-5 sizing tool into the suction hose to select the correct size suction screen.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Air Conditioning (A/C) Refrigerant Filter Installation (C60) > Page 7497
2. Insert the suction screen into the compressor end of the suction hose. 3. Install the correct
mandrel to the J 44551-5. 4. Install the J 44551-5 screen installation tool over the end of the
suction hose and the suction screen.
IMPORTANT: Correct placement of the J 44551-5 is critical.
5. Tighten the forcing screw of the J 44551-5. The suction screen is fully installed when the screen
is flush with the end of the suction hose fitting. 6. Remove the J 44551-5 suction screen tool from
the suction hose.
IMPORTANT: After major compressor failure a A/C refrigerant filter should also be installed.
7. Install an A/C refrigerant filter. 8. Install the J 44551-1 Suction Screen Notification label.
Suction Screen Replacement
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42220 Universal Leak Detection Lamp
^ J 44551 Suction Screen Kit
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Recover the refrigerant from the A/C system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 2.
Remove the Engine cover. 3. Remove the A/C compressor hose assembly bolt. 4. Separate the
A/C compressor hose assembly from the A/C compressor.
IMPORTANT: The suction screens are available in 3 different sizes.
5. Select the proper size removal tool from the J 44551. 6. Remove the suction screen using the J
44551-31 suction screen removal tool.
^ Thread the forcing screw into the suction screen.
^ Tighten the nut on the forcing screw to remove the suction screen.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Insert the J 44551-6 sizing tool into the suction hose to select the correct size suction screen. 2.
Insert the suction screen into the suction hose. 3. Install the J 44551-3 mandrel to the J 44551-5. 4.
Install the J 44551-5 suction screen installation tool over the end of the suction hose and the
suction screen.
IMPORTANT: Correct placement of the J 44551-5 is critical.
5. Tighten the forcing screw of the J 44551-5. The suction screen is fully installed when the screen
is flush with the end of the suction hose. 6. Remove the J 44551-5 suction screen tool from the
suction hose. 7. Replace the seal washers. 8. Install the A/C compressor hose assembly to the A/C
compressor.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
9. Install the A/C compressor hose assembly bolt.
Tighten Tighten the bolt to (25 lb ft).
10. Evacuate and recharge the A/C system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 11.
Leak test the fittings of the component using the J 42220. 12. Install the engine cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > A/C - New PAG Oil
Refrigerant Oil: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - New PAG Oil
Bulletin No.: 02-01-39-004B
Date: November 16, 2005
INFORMATION
Subject: New PAG Oil Released
Models: 2006 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2006 HUMMER
H2 2006 HUMMER H3 2005-2006 Saab 9-7X
Built With R-134a Refrigeration System
All Air Conditioning Compressor Types (Excluding R4 and A6 Type Compressors)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to change the PAG oil part number used for R4 and A6 compressors
with R-134a refrigerant systems. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-01-39-004A
(Section 01 - HVAC).
All General Motors vehicles built with R-134a refrigerant systems shall now be serviced with GM
Universal PAG Oil (excluding vehicles equipped with an R4 or A6 compressor).
R4 and A6 compressors with R-134a refrigerant systems shall use PAG OIL, GM P/N 12356151
(A/C Delco part number 15-118) (in Canada, use P/N 10953486).
Important:
The PAG oil referenced in this bulletin is formulated with specific additive packages that meet
General Motors specifications and use of another oil may void the A/C systems warranty.
Use this new PAG oil when servicing the A/C system on the vehicles listed above. Oil packaged in
an 8 oz tube should be installed using A/C Oil Injector, J 45037. Refer to the HVAC Section of
Service Information for detailed information on Oil Balancing and Capacities.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications
Refrigerant System Capacities - Heating, Ventilation And Air Conditioning
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications > Page 7504
Refrigerant Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
PAG (Polyalkaline Glycol) synthetic refrigerant oil (GM part number 12345923) or equivalent. For
Canada use GM P/N 10953486.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 7505
Refrigerant Oil: Service and Repair
A/C REFRIGERANT SYSTEM OIL CHARGE REPLENISHING
If oil was removed from the A/C system during the recovery process or due to component
replacement, the oil must be replenished. Oil can be injected into a charged system using J 45037.
For the proper quantities of oil to add to the A/C refrigerant system, refer to Refrigerant System
Capacities.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > High
Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
A/C High Pressure Switch - HVAC Systems - Manual
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > High
Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7510
High Pressure Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) HIGH PRESSURE SWITCH REPLACEMENT
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 5403 Snap Ring Pliers
^ J 9553-01 O-Ring Remover
^ J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Recover the refrigerant the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery
and Recharging. 3. Clean the control A/C high pressure switch area before removing the snap ring.
4. Disconnect the electrical connector from the A/C high pressure switch (2) in the rear head of the
compressor. 5. Remove the A/C high pressure switch snap ring using a pair of 90 degree angle
pliers or J 5403. 6. Remove the A/C high pressure switch (2) from the compressor. 7. Remove the
old O-ring seal from the A/C high pressure switch cavity using the J 9553-01. 8. Inspect the A/C
high pressure switch cavity and the O-ring groove in the rear head for dirt or foreign material. Clean
the components as necessary.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: If you reinstall an existing control switch in the compressor, use a new O-ring and a
new retainer ring. An O-ring and a retainer ring is included in a new switch kit.
1. Lubricate the new O-ring using new 525 viscosity refrigerant oil. 2. Install the new O-ring into the
groove in the switch cavity. 3. Lubricate the control switch housing using new 525 viscosity
refrigerant oil. 4. Install the switch (2) into the switch cavity until the switch bottoms in the cavity. 5.
Install the A/C high pressure switch snap ring using a pair of 90 degree angle pliers or J 5403.
Ensure that the high point of the curved sides is
adjacent to the switch housing. Ensure that the snap ring is properly seated in the switch cavity
retaining groove.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > High
Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7511
6. Evacuate and recharge the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 7. Leak test
the fitting(s) of the repaired or reinstalled components using the J 39400-A. 8. Install the engine
cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Low
Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Low
Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 7515
A/C Low Pressure Switch - HVAC Systems - Manual
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Low
Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 7516
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) LOW PRESSURE SWITCH REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the electrical connector from the A/C low pressure switch. 2. Remove the A/C low
pressure switch (2) from the accumulator (3).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Lightly coat the NEW O-ring seal with mineral base 525 viscosity refrigerant oil. 2. Install the
NEW O-ring seal to the switch.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the A/C low pressure switch (1) to the accumulator (3).
Tighten Tighten the switch to 6 N.m (53 lb in).
4. Connect the electrical connector to the A/C low pressure switch.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Blower Motor Relay: Service and Repair
BLOWER MOTOR RELAY REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: The blower motor relay that is used on the M/L van is an integral part of the blower
motor resistor and can not be serviced separately from the resistor.
1. Remove the air cleaner. 2. Remove the windshield washers and the coolant reservoir. 3.
Disconnect the electrical connectors. 4. Remove the screws from the blower motor resistor
assembly. 5. Remove the blower motor resistor assembly (4).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the blower motor resistor assembly (4).
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice
2. Install the screws to the blower motor resistor assembly.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Install the windshield washers and the coolant reservoir. 4. Connect the electrical connectors. 5.
Install the air cleaner.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7524
Compressor Clutch Relay: Service and Repair
COMPRESSOR RELAY REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the cover from the underhood convenience center. 2. Remove the compressor relay
(2).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the compressor relay (2). 2. Install the cover to the underhood convenience center.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature
Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component Information > Specifications
Ambient Air Temperature Sensor Resistance
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature
Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component Information > Specifications > Page 7529
Ambient Air Temperature Sensor (DIC)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature
Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component Information > Specifications > Page 7530
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Service and Repair
AMBIENT AIR TEMPERATURE GAGE SENSOR REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the radiator grille from the vehicle. 2. Remove the outside air temperature sensor from
the center support bracket by sliding the sensor upward. 3. Disconnect the temperature sensor
electrical connector.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Connect the temperature sensor electrical connector. 2. Install the temperature sensor by sliding
the sensor downward. 3. Install the radiator grille to the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7534
Blower Motor Switch: Diagrams
Blower Motor Switch - A/C Auxiliary - HVAC Systems - Manual
Blower Motor Switch - Heater Auxiliary Part 1 - HVAC Systems - Manual
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7535
Blower Motor Switch - Heater Auxiliary Part 2 - HVAC Systems - Manual
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Blower Motor Switch Replacement - Auxiliary Air Conditioning
Blower Motor Switch: Service and Repair Blower Motor Switch Replacement - Auxiliary Air
Conditioning
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Set the parking brake, turn the ignition key to the ON position and move the gear selector to 1st
gear position. 2. Lower the tilt steering column to the lowest position. 3. Pull the instrument panel
cluster trim plate rearward by grasping it around the edges until the retainers release from the
instrument panel.
4. Remove the auxiliary A/C blower motor switch (2) from the instrument panel cluster trim plate (3)
by releasing the tabs located on the sides of
each switch.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Blower Motor Switch Replacement - Auxiliary Air Conditioning > Page 7538
1. Install the auxiliary A/C blower motor switch (2) to the instrument panel cluster trim plate (3) by
engaging the tabs located on the sides of each
switch.
2. Install the instrument panel cluster trim plate by aligning the retainers to the opening in the
instrument panel and push in place until fully seated. 3. Move gear selector into PARK position,
turn the ignition to the OFF position and release the park brake.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Blower Motor Switch Replacement - Auxiliary Air Conditioning > Page 7539
Blower Motor Switch: Service and Repair Blower Motor Switch Replacement - Heater Auxiliary
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Set the parking brake, turn the ignition key to the ON position and move the gear selector to 1st
gear position. 2. Lower the tilt steering column to the lowest position. 3. Pull the instrument panel
cluster trim plate rearward by grasping it around the edges until the retainers release from the
instrument panel.
4. Remove the auxiliary heat blower motor switch (1) from the instrument panel cluster trim plate
(3) by releasing the tabs located on the sides of
each switch.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Blower Motor Switch Replacement - Auxiliary Air Conditioning > Page 7540
1. Install the auxiliary heat blower motor switch (1) to the instrument panel cluster trim plate (3) by
engaging the tabs located on the sides of each
switch.
2. Install the instrument panel cluster trim plate by aligning the retainers to the opening in the
instrument panel and push in place until fully seated. 3. Move gear selector into PARK position,
turn the ignition to the OFF position and release the park brake.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
A/C High Pressure Switch - HVAC Systems - Manual
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7545
High Pressure Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) HIGH PRESSURE SWITCH REPLACEMENT
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 5403 Snap Ring Pliers
^ J 9553-01 O-Ring Remover
^ J 39400-A Halogen Leak Detector
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the engine cover. 2. Recover the refrigerant the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery
and Recharging. 3. Clean the control A/C high pressure switch area before removing the snap ring.
4. Disconnect the electrical connector from the A/C high pressure switch (2) in the rear head of the
compressor. 5. Remove the A/C high pressure switch snap ring using a pair of 90 degree angle
pliers or J 5403. 6. Remove the A/C high pressure switch (2) from the compressor. 7. Remove the
old O-ring seal from the A/C high pressure switch cavity using the J 9553-01. 8. Inspect the A/C
high pressure switch cavity and the O-ring groove in the rear head for dirt or foreign material. Clean
the components as necessary.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: If you reinstall an existing control switch in the compressor, use a new O-ring and a
new retainer ring. An O-ring and a retainer ring is included in a new switch kit.
1. Lubricate the new O-ring using new 525 viscosity refrigerant oil. 2. Install the new O-ring into the
groove in the switch cavity. 3. Lubricate the control switch housing using new 525 viscosity
refrigerant oil. 4. Install the switch (2) into the switch cavity until the switch bottoms in the cavity. 5.
Install the A/C high pressure switch snap ring using a pair of 90 degree angle pliers or J 5403.
Ensure that the high point of the curved sides is
adjacent to the switch housing. Ensure that the snap ring is properly seated in the switch cavity
retaining groove.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7546
6. Evacuate and recharge the system. Refer to Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging. 7. Leak test
the fitting(s) of the repaired or reinstalled components using the J 39400-A. 8. Install the engine
cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 7550
A/C Low Pressure Switch - HVAC Systems - Manual
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 7551
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) LOW PRESSURE SWITCH REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the electrical connector from the A/C low pressure switch. 2. Remove the A/C low
pressure switch (2) from the accumulator (3).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Lightly coat the NEW O-ring seal with mineral base 525 viscosity refrigerant oil. 2. Install the
NEW O-ring seal to the switch.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the A/C low pressure switch (1) to the accumulator (3).
Tighten Tighten the switch to 6 N.m (53 lb in).
4. Connect the electrical connector to the A/C low pressure switch.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Vacuum Harness HVAC > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Vacuum Harness HVAC: Service and Repair
VACUUM HOSE HARNESS REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the vacuum supply lines (3) from the cowl panel under the hood. 2. Disconnect the
vacuum supply lines (2) from the vacuum harness in the vehicle.
3. Remove the vacuum supply lines harness and grommet (1) from the cowl panel by grasping the
grommet at the base and pulling rearward. 4. Remove the vacuum supply harness.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Vacuum Harness HVAC > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 7555
1. Install the vacuum supply harness. 2. Install the vacuum supply lines harness and grommet (1)
to the corner of the cowl panel. 3. Insert the vacuum supply lines harness and grommet to the cowl
panel hole, push inward until fully seated. 4. Connect the vacuum supply lines (2) to the vacuum
harness. 5. Connect the vacuum supply lines (3) to the cowl panel under the hood.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Vacuum Reservoir HVAC > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Vacuum Reservoir HVAC: Service and Repair
VACUUM TANK REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the air cleaner. 2. Remove the upper fan shroud. 3. Remove the vacuum hose(s).
4. Remove the screws from the vacuum tank. 5. Remove the vacuum tank.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Vacuum Reservoir HVAC > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 7559
1. Install the vacuum tank.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the screws to the vacuum tank.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 3 N.m (26 lb in).
3. Install the vacuum hose(s). 4. Install the upper fan shroud. 5. Install the air cleaner.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision > System
Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag System
Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision: Service and Repair Air Bag System
Accident With Frontal Air Bag Deployment
CAUTION: Proper operation of the Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) sensing system
requires that any repairs to the vehicle structure return the vehicle structure to the original
production configuration. Not properly repairing the vehicle structure could cause non-deployment
of the air bag(s) in a frontal collision or deployment of the air bag(s) for conditions less severe than
intended.
After a collision involving frontal air bag deployment, replace the following components.
^ Inflatable restraint electronic frontal sensor (EFS)
^ Inflatable restraint front end discriminating sensor
^ Inflatable restraint IP module
^ Inflatable restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM)
^ Inflatable restraint steering wheel module
Perform additional inspections on the following components.
^ Steering wheel module coil and coil wiring pigtail - Inspect for melting, scorching, or other
damage due to excessive heat.
^ Mounting points and mounting hardware for the EFS, front end discriminating sensor, IP module,
steering wheel module, and SDM - Inspect for damage and repair or replace each component as
needed.
Accident With Side Air Bag Deployment
CAUTION: Proper operation of the Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) sensing system
requires that any repairs to the vehicle structure return the vehicle structure to the original
production configuration. Not properly repairing the vehicle structure could cause non-deployment
of the side impact air bag(s) in a side impact collision or deployment of the side impact air bag(s)
for conditions less severe than Intended.
After a collision involving side air bag deployment, replace the following components.
^ Inflatable restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM)
^ Inflatable restraint side impact module, on side of impact
^ Inflatable restraint side impact sensor (SIS), on side of impact
Perform additional inspections on the mounting points and mounting hardware for the side impact
module, SIS, and SDM - Inspect for damage and repair or replace each component as needed.
Accident With/Without Air Bag Deployment
After a collision, the following components need to be inspected as indicated. If any damage is
detected, replace the component. If damage to the mounting points or mounting hardware is
detected, repair or replace the mounting points and mounting hardware as needed.
^ Steering column - Perform the steering column accident damage checking procedures. Refer to
Steering Column Accident Damage Inspection - Off Vehicle in Steering Wheel and Column.
^ I/P Knee Bolsters and Mounting Points - Inspect the knee bolsters for bending, twisting, buckling,
or any other type of damage.
^ I/P brackets, braces, etc. - Inspect for bending, twisting, buckling, or any other type of damage.
^ Seat Belts - Perform the seat belt operational and functional checks. Refer to Operational and
Functional Checks in Seat Belts.
^ Seats and Seat Mounting Points - Inspect for bending, twisting, buckling, or any other type of
damage.
After inspecting the components listed above, proceed to the following Component Replacement
and Inspections if air bag deployment has occurred.
Sensor Replacement Guidelines
The SIR sensor replacement policy requires replacing sensors in the area of collision damage. The
area of collision damage is defined as the portion of the vehicle which is crushed, bent, or
damaged due to a collision.
^ Replace the sensor even if the air bags have not deployed.
^ Replace the sensor even if it appears to be undamaged.
Sensor damage which is not visible, such as slight bending of the mounting bracket or cuts in the
wire insulation, can cause improper operation of the SIR sensing system. Do not try to determine
whether the sensor is undamaged, replace the sensor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision > System
Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag System > Page 7565
Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision: Service and Repair Seat Belt System
REPAIRS AND INSPECTIONS REQUIRED AFTER A COLLISION
CAUTION: Restraint systems can be damaged in a collision. To help avoid injury and ensure that
all parts in need of replacement are replaced:
^ Replace any seat belt system that was in use during the collision serious enough to deploy any
automatic restraint device such as air bags and seat belt pretensioners. This not only includes seat
belt systems in use by people of adult size, but seat belt systems used to secure child restraints,
infant carriers and booster seats, including LATCH system and top tether anchorages.
^ Replace any seat belt system that has torn, worn, or damaged components. This not only
includes adult seat belt systems, but built-in child restraints and LATCH system components, if any.
^ Replace any seat belt system if you observe the words "REPLACE" or "CAUTION", or if a yellow
tag is visible. Do not replace a seat belt if only the child seat caution label is visible.
^ Replace any seat belt system if you are doubtful about its condition. This not only includes adult
seat belt systems, but built-in child restraints, LATCH system components, and any restraint
system used to secure infant carriers, child restraints, and booster seats.
Do NOT replace single seat belt system components in vehicles that have been in a collision as
described above. Always replace the entire seat belt system with the buckle, guide and retractor
assembly, which includes the latch and webbing material.
After a minor collision where no automatic restraint device was deployed, seat belt system
replacement may not be necessary, unless some of the parts are torn, worn, or damaged.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision > System
Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag System > Page 7566
Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision: Service and Repair Steering Column
Steering Column Accident Damage Inspection - Off Vehicle
Notice: Vehicles involved in accidents that result in any of the following kinds of damage or
situations, may also have a damaged or misaligned steering column: Frame damage
- Major body damage
- Sheet metal damage
- If the steering column has been impacted
- If the supplemental inflatable restraints system was deployed
- Check the capsules on the steering column bracket assembly: all must be securely seated in the
bracket slots and checked for any loose conditions when pushed or pulled by hand. If not, the
bracket should be replaced if bolted to the jacket assembly. If the bracket is welded to the jacket
assembly replace the jacket assembly.
Important: If measured dimensions are not within specifications, a new jacket must be installed. Check for jacket assembly collapse by measuring the distance from the lower edge of the upper
jacket to a defined point on the lower jacket.
- Remove the inflatable restraint steering wheel module coil.
- Visually inspect steering shaft for sheared injected plastic (1). If steering shaft shows sheared
plastic, a new steering shaft must be installed.
- Any frame damage that could cause a bent steering shaft must have the steering shaft runout
checked in the following manner. Using a dial indicator at the lower end of the steering shaft, have
the steering wheel rotated. Runout must not exceed 1.60 mm.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Disabling
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Disabling
IMPORTANT: Refer to SIR Service Precautions before disabling the SIR system.
1. Turn the steering wheel until the vehicle's wheels are pointing straight ahead. 2. Turn OFF the
ignition. 3. Remove the key from the ignition.
IMPORTANT: With the AIR BAG Fuse removed and the ignition ON, the AIR BAG indicator
illuminates. This is normal operation and does not indicate an SIR system malfunction.
4. Remove the AIR BAG Fuse from the IP fuse block. 5. Remove the sound insulator, if equipped.
6. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) from the steering wheel module yellow 2-way
connector (1) located at the base of the steering
column.
7. Disconnect the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector (1) located at the base of the
steering column.
8. Remove the instrument panel extension. 9. Remove the CPA (2) from the IP module yellow
2-way connector (1) located under the instrument panel extension.
10. Disconnect the IP module yellow 2-way connector (1) located under the instrument panel
extension.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Disabling > Page 7572
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Enabling
1. Remove the key from the ignition. 2. Connect the IP module yellow 2-way connector (1) located
under the instrument panel extension. 3. Install the connector position assurance (CPA) (2) to the
IP module yellow 2-way connector (1) located under the instrument panel extension. 4. Install the
instrument panel extension.
5. Connect the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector (1) located at the base of the
steering column. 6. Install the CPA to the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector (1)
located at the base of the steering column. 7. Install the sound insulator, if equipped. 8. Install the
AIR BAG Fuse to the IP fuse block. 9. Staying well away from the air bags, turn ON the ignition,
with the engine OFF.
9.1. The AIR BAG indicator will flash 7 times.
9.2. The AIR BAG indicator will then turn OFF.
10. Perform Diagnostic System Check - SIR if the AIR BAG indicator does not operate as
described.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Air Bag Harness > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Air Bag Harness: Description and Operation
INFLATABLE RESTRAINT WIRING HARNESSES
The inflatable restraint wiring harnesses connect the Sensing And Diagnostic Module (SDM),
inflator modules, discriminating sensor, and the class 2 serial data circuit together using weather
pack connectors. SIR system connectors are yellow in color for easy identification. When repairing
SIR system wiring harnesses, follow the proper testing and wiring repair procedures outlined.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7580
Inflatable Restraint Sensing And Diagnostic Module (SDM)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7581
Air Bag Control Module: Service Precautions
CAUTION:
^ Proper operation of the Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) sensing system requires that any
repairs to the vehicle structure return the vehicle structure to the original production configuration.
Not properly repairing the vehicle structure could cause non-deployment of the air bag(s) in a
frontal collision or deployment of the air bag(s) for conditions less severe than intended.
^ Be careful when you handle a sensing and diagnostic module (SDM). Do not strike or jolt the
SDM. Before applying power to the SDM: ^
Remove any dirt, grease, etc. from the mounting surface
^ Position the SDM horizontally on the mounting surface
^ Point the arrow on the SDM toward the front of the vehicle
^ Tighten all of the SDM fasteners and SDM bracket fasteners to the specified torque value
Failure to follow the correct procedure could cause air bag deployment, personal injury, or
unnecessary SIR system repairs.
^ If any water enters the vehicle's interior up to the level of the carpet or higher and soaks the
carpet, the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) and the SDM harness connector may need to be
replaced. The SDM could be activated when powered, which could cause deployment of the air
bag(s) and result in personal injury. Before attempting these procedures, the SIR system must be
disabled. Refer to Disabling the SIR System. With the ignition OFF, inspect the SDM mounting
area, including the carpet. If any significant soaking or evidence of significant soaking is detected,
you must perform the following tasks: 1. Remove all water. 2. Repair the water damage. 3. Replace
the SDM harness connector. 4. Replace the SDM. Failure to follow these tasks could result in
possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded SIR system repairs.
^ Proper operation of the Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) sensing system requires that any
repairs to the vehicle structure return the vehicle structure to the original production configuration.
Not properly repairing the vehicle structure could cause non-deployment of the side impact air
bag(s) in a side impact collision or deployment of the side impact air bag(s) for conditions less
severe than Intended.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7582
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation
INFLATABLE RESTRAINT SENSING AND DIAGNOSTIC MODULE (SDM)
The Sensing And Diagnostic Module (SDM) is a microprocessor and the control center for the SIR
system. The SDM contains internal sensors along with several external sensors, if equipped,
mounted at various locations on the vehicle. In the event of a collision, the SDM performs
calculations using the signals received from the internal and external sensors. The SDM compares
the results of the calculations to values stored in memory. When these calculations exceed the
stored value, the SDM will cause current to flow through the appropriate deployment loops to
deploy the air bags. The SDM records the SIR system status when a deployment occurs and turns
the AIR BAG indicator ON. The SDM performs continuous diagnostic monitoring of the SIR system
electrical components and circuitry when the ignition is turned ON. If the SDM detects a
malfunction, a DTC will be stored and the SDM will command the AIR BAG indicator ON. In the
event that ignition 1 voltage is lost during a collision, the SDM maintains a 23-volt loop reserve (23
VLR) for deployment of the air bags. It is important to note, when disabling the SIR system for
servicing or rescue operations to allow the 23 VLR to dissipate, which could take up to 1 minute.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7583
Air Bag Control Module: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Air Bag Systems / Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7584
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair
INFLATABLE RESTRAINT SENSING AND DIAGNOSTIC MODULE REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: ^
Be careful when you handle a sensing and diagnostic module (SDM). Do not strike or jolt the SDM.
Before applying power to the SDM: ^
Remove any dirt, grease, etc. from the mounting surface
^ Position the SDM horizontally on the mounting surface
^ Point the arrow on the SDM toward the front of the vehicle
^ Tighten all of the SDM fasteners and SDM bracket fasteners to the specified torque value
Failure to follow the correct procedure could cause air bag deployment, personal injury, or
unnecessary SIR system repairs.
^ If any water enters the vehicle's interior up to the level of the carpet or higher and soaks the
carpet, the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) and the SDM harness connector may need to be
replaced. The SDM could be activated when powered, which could cause deployment of the air
bag(s) and result in personal injury. Before attempting these procedures, the SIR system must be
disabled. Refer to Disabling the SIR System. With the ignition OFF, inspect the SDM mounting
area, including the carpet. If any significant soaking or evidence of significant soaking is detected,
you must perform the following tasks: 1. Remove all water. 2. Repair the water damage. 3. Replace
the SDM harness connector. 4. Replace the SDM. Failure to follow these tasks could result in
possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded SIR system repairs.
^ Refer to SIR Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disable the SIR system. Refer to Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming. 2. Remove the drivers seat.
3. Remove the carpet retaining sill trim molding. 4. Fold back the carpet to access the inflatable
restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM). 5. Remove the connector position assurance
(CPA) (1) from the inflatable restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) wiring harness
connector
(2).
6. Push down the flex lock button (3) and slide the connector locking cover (4) to the open position.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7585
7. Disconnect the SDM wiring harness connector (2) from the SDM (4). 8. Remove the SDM
mounting fasteners (1). 9. Remove the SDM (4) from the vehicle (5).
IMPORTANT: The following repair procedures should only be used in the event that the inflatable
restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) mounting studs and/or fasteners are damaged to
the extent that the SDM may no longer be properly mounted.
10. Repair the fasteners using the following procedure:
10.1. Remove the stripped nut and discard the nut. 10.2. Drill out the weld spots to the weld stud
from the floor pan side, then remove and discard the stud. 10.3. Condition the floor panel attaching
surface where the new stud is to be installed. 10.4. Install new weld stud GM P/N 115115602 and
clamp the weld stud. 10.5. Migweld the stud at the drilled holes form above or below the floor pan,
as required. 10.6. Apply body sealer around any exposed openings. 10.7. Install a new fastener
GM P/N 11515933.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the SDM (4) to the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the SDM mounting fasteners (1).
Tighten Tighten fasteners to 12 N.m (106 lb in).
3. Connect the SDM wiring harness connector (2) to the SDM (4).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7586
4. Push down the flex lock button (3) and slide the connector locking cover (4) to the close position.
5. Install the connector position assurance (CPA) (1) to the inflatable restraint sensing and
diagnostic module (SDM) wiring harness connector (2). 6. Position the carpet to cover the inflatable
restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM). 7. Install the carpet retaining sill trim molding. 8.
Install the driver seat. 9. Enable the SIR system. Refer to Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Description and Operation
INFLATABLE RESTRAINT STEERING WHEEL MODULE COIL
The steering wheel module coil is attached to the steering column and is located under the steering
wheel. The steering wheel module coil consists of two or more current-carrying coils. The coils
allow the rotation of the steering wheel while maintaining continuous electrical contact between the
driver deployment loop and the steering wheel module. Two coil wires are used for the steering
wheel module deployment loop. Additional coil wires are used for accessories attached to the
steering wheel depending on the vehicle model. The steering wheel module coil connector is
located near the base of the steering column. The connector contains a shorting bar that shorts the
steering wheel module coil deployment loop circuitry to prevent unwanted deployment of the air
bag when it is disconnected.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 7590
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Air Bag Systems / Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 7591
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Service and Repair
INFLATABLE RESTRAINT STEERING WHEEL MODULE COIL REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disable the SIR system. Refer to Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming. 2. Remove the steering
column trim covers. 3. Remove the wire harness assembly (4) from the wire harness strap (5). 4.
Remove the 3 wire harness straps (3) from the wire harness assembly. 5. Remove the wire
harness strap (2) from the upper tilt head assembly (1).
6. Remove the SIR steering wheel module coil retaining clip (1). 7. Remove the SIR steering wheel
module coil (2). 8. Remove the wave washer (3) from the steering column upper shaft.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 7592
1. Align the block tooth on the upper shaft to the 12 o'clock position.
NOTE: Ensure all fasteners are securely seated before applying needed torque. Failure to do so
may result in component damage or malfunctioning of steering column.
2. Install the wave washer (1) to the steering column upper shaft.
IMPORTANT: ^
Verify that the SIR steering wheel module coil is centered.
^ The SIR steering wheel module coil becomes uncentered under the following conditions: The steering column is separated from the steering gear and allowed to rotate.
- The centering spring is pushed down, letting the hub rotate while the coil is removed from the
steering column.
^ If the SIR steering wheel module coil becomes uncentered, refer to Inflatable Restraint Coil
Centering - Off Vehicle (Column Shift And Floor Shift) in Steering Wheel and Column.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 7593
3. Align the SIR steering wheel module coil (2) with the horn tower on the turn signal cancel cam
(1) 4. Install the pre-centered SIR steering wheel module coil (2) to the steering column upper
shaft.
5. Remove the centering tab (1) and discard.
NOTE: Gently pull on the lower coil assembly wire in order to remove any wire kinks inside of the
column assembly. Verify that there are NO kinks or bends in the SIR coil assembly wire. If a kink or
bend is present, interference may occur with the shaft lock mechanism. Turning the steering wheel
may cut or damage the wire.
6. Install the SIR steering wheel module coil retaining ring. Verify that the ring (1) is firmly seated in
the groove on the upper shaft (2).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 7594
7. Install the wire harness assembly (4) into the wire strap (5). 8. Install the wire harness strap (2)
into the wire strap (1). 9. Install wire harness straps (3) to the wire harness assembly.
10. Install the steering column trim covers. 11. Enable the SIR system. Refer to Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information >
Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7598
Inflatable Restraint Front End Discriminating Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7599
Impact Sensor: Service Precautions
CAUTION: Be careful when you handle a sensor. Do not strike or jolt a sensor. Before applying
power to a sensor:
^ Remove any dirt, grease, etc. from the mounting surface.
^ Position the sensor horizontally on the mounting surface.
^ Point the arrow on the sensor toward the front of the vehicle.
^ Tighten all of the sensor fasteners and sensor bracket fasteners to the specified torque value.
Failure to follow the correct procedure could cause air bag deployment, personal injury, or
unnecessary SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7600
Impact Sensor: Description and Operation
INFLATABLE RESTRAINT FRONT END DISCRIMINATING SENSOR
The front end discriminating sensor is equipped on some vehicles to supplement SIR system
performance. The discriminating sensor is an electro-mechanical sensor and is not part of the
deployment loops, but instead provides an input to the SDM. The SDM uses the input from the
discriminating sensor to assist in determining the severity of a frontal collision further supporting air
bag deployment. If the SDM determines a deployment is warranted, the SDM will cause current to
flow through the deployment loops deploying the frontal air bags.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7601
Impact Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Air Bag Systems / Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Inflatable Restraint Front End Discriminating Sensor Replacement
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Inflatable Restraint Front End Discriminating Sensor
Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Disable the SIR system. Refer to Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming. 2. Disconnect the mass air
flow (MAF) and the intake air temperature (IAT) sensors harness connectors. 3. Loosen the clamp.
4. Remove the air tube from the throttle body air intake cover. 5. Remove the bolts. 6. Remove the
upper radiator shroud. 7. Remove the fan and clutch assembly. 8. Remove the lower radiator
shroud. 9. Disconnect the inflatable restraint front end discriminating sensor harness connector
located at the top of the cradle (1).
10. Remove the bolts (2). 11. Remove the inflatable restraint front end discriminating sensor (3)
from the cradle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Be careful when you handle a sensor. Do not strike or jolt a sensor. Before applying
power to a sensor: ^
Remove any dirt, grease, etc. from the mounting surface.
^ Position the sensor horizontally on the mounting surface.
^ Point the arrow on the sensor toward the front of the vehicle.
^ Tighten all of the sensor fasteners and sensor bracket fasteners to the specified torque value.
Failure to follow the correct procedure could cause air bag deployment, personal injury, or
unnecessary SIR system repairs.
1. Install the inflatable restraint front end discriminating sensor to the top of the cradle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the inflatable restraint front end discriminating sensor mounting fasteners (2).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Inflatable Restraint Front End Discriminating Sensor Replacement > Page 7604
Tighten Tighten fastener to 6.5 N.m (58 lb in).
IMPORTANT: The following procedures should be utilized in the event that sensor mounting holes
or fasteners are damaged to the extent that the sensor may no longer be properly mounted.
3. Perform the following steps in order to complete the first fastener repair;
3.1. Remove and discard the improperly installed rivet.
3.2. Reattach sensor with new rivet (GM P/N 15715058) or equivalent.
4. Perform the following steps, if needed, in order to complete a second fastener repair:
4.1. Remove the improperly installed rivet.
4.2. Enlarge the mounting holes in the lower radiator support to 9.0 mm (0.35 in).
4.3. Insert and properly seat rivnut (GM P/N 15699834) or equivalent.
4.4. Install sensor with screw GM P/N 11515664, or equivalent.
Tighten Tighten fasteners to 6.5 N.m (58 lb in).
5. Connect the inflatable restraint front end discriminating sensor harness connector to the sensor.
6. Install the lower radiator shroud. 7. Install the fan and clutch assembly. 8. Install the upper
radiator shroud. 9. Install the air box with MAF sensor to the upper radiator shroud.
10. Connect the air tube to the throttle body air intake cover with the clamp. 11. Connect the MAF
and IAT sensors harness connectors. 12. Enable the SIR system. Refer to Air Bag(s) Arming and
Disarming.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Inflatable Restraint Front End Discriminating Sensor Replacement > Page 7605
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module
Replacement
INFLATABLE RESTRAINT SENSING AND DIAGNOSTIC MODULE REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: ^
Be careful when you handle a sensing and diagnostic module (SDM). Do not strike or jolt the SDM.
Before applying power to the SDM: ^
Remove any dirt, grease, etc. from the mounting surface
^ Position the SDM horizontally on the mounting surface
^ Point the arrow on the SDM toward the front of the vehicle
^ Tighten all of the SDM fasteners and SDM bracket fasteners to the specified torque value
Failure to follow the correct procedure could cause air bag deployment, personal injury, or
unnecessary SIR system repairs.
^ If any water enters the vehicle's interior up to the level of the carpet or higher and soaks the
carpet, the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) and the SDM harness connector may need to be
replaced. The SDM could be activated when powered, which could cause deployment of the air
bag(s) and result in personal injury. Before attempting these procedures, the SIR system must be
disabled. Refer to Disabling the SIR System. With the ignition OFF, inspect the SDM mounting
area, including the carpet. If any significant soaking or evidence of significant soaking is detected,
you must perform the following tasks: 1. Remove all water. 2. Repair the water damage. 3. Replace
the SDM harness connector. 4. Replace the SDM. Failure to follow these tasks could result in
possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded SIR system repairs.
^ Refer to SIR Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disable the SIR system. Refer to Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming. 2. Remove the drivers seat.
3. Remove the carpet retaining sill trim molding. 4. Fold back the carpet to access the inflatable
restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM). 5. Remove the connector position assurance
(CPA) (1) from the inflatable restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) wiring harness
connector
(2).
6. Push down the flex lock button (3) and slide the connector locking cover (4) to the open position.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Inflatable Restraint Front End Discriminating Sensor Replacement > Page 7606
7. Disconnect the SDM wiring harness connector (2) from the SDM (4). 8. Remove the SDM
mounting fasteners (1). 9. Remove the SDM (4) from the vehicle (5).
IMPORTANT: The following repair procedures should only be used in the event that the inflatable
restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) mounting studs and/or fasteners are damaged to
the extent that the SDM may no longer be properly mounted.
10. Repair the fasteners using the following procedure:
10.1. Remove the stripped nut and discard the nut. 10.2. Drill out the weld spots to the weld stud
from the floor pan side, then remove and discard the stud. 10.3. Condition the floor panel attaching
surface where the new stud is to be installed. 10.4. Install new weld stud GM P/N 115115602 and
clamp the weld stud. 10.5. Migweld the stud at the drilled holes form above or below the floor pan,
as required. 10.6. Apply body sealer around any exposed openings. 10.7. Install a new fastener
GM P/N 11515933.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the SDM (4) to the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the SDM mounting fasteners (1).
Tighten Tighten fasteners to 12 N.m (106 lb in).
3. Connect the SDM wiring harness connector (2) to the SDM (4).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Inflatable Restraint Front End Discriminating Sensor Replacement > Page 7607
4. Push down the flex lock button (3) and slide the connector locking cover (4) to the close position.
5. Install the connector position assurance (CPA) (1) to the inflatable restraint sensing and
diagnostic module (SDM) wiring harness connector (2). 6. Position the carpet to cover the inflatable
restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM). 7. Install the carpet retaining sill trim molding. 8.
Install the driver seat. 9. Enable the SIR system. Refer to Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Inflatable Restraint Front End Discriminating Sensor Replacement > Page 7608
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair SIR Sensor Replacement Guidelines
The SIR sensor replacement policy requires replacing sensors in the area of collision damage. The
area of collision damage is defined as the portion of the vehicle which is crushed, bent, or
damaged due to a collision.
^ Replace the sensor even if the air bags have not deployed.
^ Replace the sensor even if it appears to be undamaged.
Sensor damage which is not visible, such as slight bending of the mounting bracket or cuts in the
wire insulation, can cause improper operation of the SIR sensing system. Do not try to determine
whether the sensor is undamaged, replace the sensor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Passenger Presence System Information
Seat Occupant Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Passenger Presence System
Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 06-08-50-009F
Date: December 23, 2010
Subject: Information on Passenger Presence Sensing System (PPS or PSS) Concerns With
Custom Upholstery, Accessory Seat Heaters or Other Comfort Enhancing Devices
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Equipped with Passenger Presence Sensing
System
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 06-08-50-009E (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Concerns About Safety and Alterations to the Front Passenger Seat
Important ON A GM VEHICLE EQUIPPED WITH A PASSENGER SENSING SYSTEM, USE THE
SEAT COVERS AND OTHER SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT AS RELEASED BY GM FOR THAT
VEHICLE. DO NOT ALTER THE SEAT COVERS OR SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT. ANY
ALTERATIONS TO SEAT COVERS OR GM ACCESSORIES DEFEATS THE INTENDED DESIGN
OF THE SYSTEM. GM WILL NOT BE LIABLE FOR ANY PROBLEMS CAUSED BY USE OF
SUCH IMPROPER SEAT ALTERATIONS, INCLUDING ANY WARRANTY REPAIRS INCURRED.
The front passenger seat in many GM vehicles is equipped with a passenger sensing system that
will turn off the right front passenger's frontal airbag under certain conditions, such as when an
infant or child seat is present. In some vehicles, the passenger sensing system will also turn off the
right front passenger's seat mounted side impact airbag. For the system to function properly,
sensors are used in the seat to detect the presence of a properly-seated occupant. The passenger
sensing system may not operate properly if the original seat trim is replaced (1) by non-GM covers,
upholstery or trim, or (2) by GM covers, upholstery or trim designed for a different vehicle or (3) by
GM covers, upholstery or trim that has been altered by a trim shop, or (4) if any object, such as an
aftermarket seat heater or a comfort enhancing pad or device is installed under the seat fabric or
between the occupant and the seat fabric.
Aftermarket Seat Heaters, Custom Upholstery, and Comfort Enhancing Pads or Devices
Important ON A GM VEHICLE EQUIPPED WITH A PASSENGER SENSING SYSTEM, USE ONLY
SEAT COVERS AND OTHER SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT RELEASED AS GM
ACCESSORIES FOR THAT VEHICLE. DO NOT USE ANY OTHER TYPE OF SEAT COVERS OR
SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT, OR GM ACCESSORIES RELEASED FOR OTHER VEHICLE
APPLICATIONS. GM WILL NOT BE LIABLE FOR ANY PROBLEMS CAUSED BY USE OF SUCH
IMPROPER SEAT ACCESSORIES, INCLUDING ANY WARRANTY REPAIRS MADE
NECESSARY BY SUCH USE.
Many types of aftermarket accessories are available to customers, upfitting shops, and dealers.
Some of these devices sit on top of, or are Velcro(R) strapped to the seat while others such as seat
heaters are installed under the seat fabric. Additionally, seat covers made of leather or other
materials may have different padding thickness installed that could prevent the Passenger Sensing
System from functioning properly. Never alter the vehicle seats. Never add pads or other devices to
the seat cushion, as this may interfere with the operation of the Passenger Sensing System and
either prevent proper deployment of the passenger airbag or prevent proper suppression of the
passenger air bag.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Side Air Bag > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection
Side Air Bag: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Air Bag Systems / Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Side Air Bag > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 7616
Side Air Bag: Service and Repair
SIDE AIR BAG DEPLOYMENT - COMPONENT REPLACEMENT AND INSPECTIONS
CAUTION: Proper operation of the Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) sensing system
requires that any repairs to the vehicle structure return the vehicle structure to the original
production configuration. Not properly repairing the vehicle structure could cause non-deployment
of the side impact air bag(s) in a side impact collision or deployment of the side impact air bag(s)
for conditions less severe than Intended.
After a collision involving side air bag deployment, replace the following components.
^ Inflatable restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM)
^ Inflatable restraint side impact module, on side of impact
^ Inflatable restraint side impact sensor (SIS), on side of impact
Perform additional inspections on the mounting points and mounting hardware for the side impact
module, SIS, and SDM - Inspect for damage and repair or replace each component as needed.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Malfunction Lamp / Indicator: Description and Operation
AIR BAG INDICATOR
The AIR BAG indicator, located in the IPC is used to notify the driver of SIR system malfunctions
and to verify that the SDM is communicating with the IPC. When the ignition is turned ON, the SDM
is supplied with ignition 1 voltage and the IPC flashes the AIR BAG indicator seven times. While
flashing the indicator, the SDM conducts test on all SIR system components and circuits. If no
malfunctions are detected the SDM will communicate with the IPC through the class 2 serial data
circuit and request the IPC to turn the AIR BAG indicator OFF. The SDM provides continuous
monitoring of the air bag circuits by conducting a sequence of checks. If a malfunction is detected
the SDM will store a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) and request the IPC to turn the AIR BAG
indicator ON. The presence of a SIR system malfunction could result in non-deployment of the air
bags. The AIR BAG indicator will remain ON until the malfunction has been repaired.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Head Restraint System > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Restraints - Driver/Passenger Seat Head Rest Information
Head Restraint System: Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Driver/Passenger Seat Head Rest
Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 10-08-50-003A
Date: March 24, 2011
Subject: Information on Driver or Passenger Seat Head Restraint Concerns with Comfort, Custom
Upholstery or Other Comfort Enhancing Devices
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Equipped with Adjustable Head Restraints
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 10-08-50-003 (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Important ON A GM VEHICLE EQUIPPED WITH ADJUSTABLE HEAD RESTRAINTS, USE THE
HEAD RESTRAINT COVERS, FOAM AND OTHER SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT AS
RELEASED BY GM FOR THAT VEHICLE. DO NOT ALTER OR REPOSITION THE HEAD
RESTRAINT SYSTEM. ANY ALTERATIONS TO HEAD RESTRAINTS DEFEATS THE INTENDED
DESIGN OF THE SYSTEM. GM WILL NOT BE LIABLE FOR ANY PROBLEMS CAUSED BY USE
OF SUCH IMPROPER DESIGN ALTERATIONS, INCLUDING ANY WARRANTY REPAIRS
INCURRED.
You may have a customer with a concern that the head restraint is uncomfortable or sits too far
forward. The front driver and passenger seats are equipped with head restraints that have been
designed to help minimize injuries while still providing comfort to the occupants. Each GM vehicle
has its own specifically designed head restraint.
The head restraints should only be used in the vehicle for which they were designed. The head
restraint will not operate to its design intent if the original foam is replaced (1) by non-GM foam or
head restraint, (2) by GM foam or head restraint designed for a different vehicle, (3) by GM foam or
head restraint that has been altered by a trim shop or (4) if any object, such as an aftermarket
comfort enhancing pad or device, is installed.
Never modify the design of the head restraint or remove the head restraint from the vehicle as this
may interfere with the operation of the seating and restraint systems and may prevent proper
positioning of the passenger within the vehicle.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Knee Diverter > Component Information > Description and Operation
Knee Diverter: Description and Operation
DRIVER AND PASSENGER KNEE BOLSTERS
The knee bolsters are designed to help restrain the lower torsos of front seat occupants by
absorbing energy through the front seat occupants' upper legs. In a frontal collision the front seat
occupants legs may come in contact with the knee bolsters. The knee bolsters are designed to
crush or deform absorbing some of the impact, which helps to reduce bodily injuries. The driver
and passenger knee bolsters are located in the lower part of the instrument panel and must be
inspected for damage after a collision.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Knee Diverter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Knee
Bolster Bracket Replacement - Right
Knee Diverter: Service and Repair Knee Bolster Bracket Replacement - Right
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the passenger's knee bolster.
IMPORTANT: Do not remove the instrument panel to replace right or right center knee bolster
brackets.
2. Roll the instrument panel down. Refer to IP Assembly Replacement. 3. Remove the knee bolster
bracket right side screws. 4. Remove the knee bolster bracket right side.
5. Remove the knee bolster bracket right center screws. 6. Remove the knee bolster bracket right
center.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Knee Diverter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Knee
Bolster Bracket Replacement - Right > Page 7629
1. Install the knee bolster bracket right center.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the knee bolster bracket right center screws.
Tighten Tighten the knee bolster bracket right center screws to 8 N.m (71 lb in).
3. Install the knee bolster bracket right side.
Install the knee bolster bracket right side screws.
Tighten Tighten the knee bolster bracket right side screws to 8 N.m (71 lb in).
4. Roll the instrument panel up. Refer to IP Assembly Replacement. 5. Install the passenger's knee
bolster.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Knee Diverter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Knee
Bolster Bracket Replacement - Right > Page 7630
Knee Diverter: Service and Repair Knee Bolster Bracket Replacement - Left
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the driver's knee bolster. 2. Remove the bolts that retain the brackets to the instrument
panel trim pad. 3. Roll the instrument panel back, but do not remove the instrument panel. Refer to
IP Assembly Replacement. 4. Remove the bolts that retain the knee bolster brackets to the
instrument panel carrier. 5. Remove the knee bolster brackets from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the knee bolster brackets to the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the bolts that retain the brackets to the instrument panel carrier.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to the brackets to the instrument panel carrier to 10 N.m (89 lb in).
3. Install the instrument panel to the vehicle. 4. Install the bolts that retain the brackets to the
instrument panel trim pad.
Tighten
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Knee Diverter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Knee
Bolster Bracket Replacement - Right > Page 7631
Tighten the bolts that retain the bracket to the instrument panel to 10 N.m (89 lb in).
5. Install the driver's knee bolster.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Knee Diverter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Knee
Bolster Bracket Replacement - Right > Page 7632
Knee Diverter: Service and Repair Knee Bolster Replacement - Left
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the screws that retain the bolster to the instrument panel. 2. Pull back on the bolster in
order to release the two retainers and remove the bolster. 3. Remove the parking brake release
lever from the knee bolster.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the parking brake release lever to the knee bolster. 2. Install the knee bolster:
2.1. Align the retainers. 2.2. Press the panel into place.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the screws that retain the knee bolster to the instrument panel.
Tighten Tighten the knee bolster screws to 8 N.m (71 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Knee Diverter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Knee
Bolster Bracket Replacement - Right > Page 7633
Knee Diverter: Service and Repair Knee Bolster Deflector Replacement - Left
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the instrument panel extension. 2. Remove the driver's knee bolster. 3. Remove the
nuts that retain the knee bolster deflector to the instrument panel carrier. 4. Remove the bolts that
retain the knee bolster deflector to the instrument panel carrier. 5. Remove the knee bolster
deflector from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the knee bolster deflector to the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the bolts that retain the knee bolster deflector to the instrument panel carrier.
Tighten Tighten the bolts that retain the knee bolster deflector to the instrument panel carrier 10
N.m (89 lb in).
3. Install the bolts that retain the knee bolster deflector to the instrument panel carrier.
Tighten Tighten the nuts that retain the knee bolster deflector to the instrument panel carrier to 10
N.m (89 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Knee Diverter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Knee
Bolster Bracket Replacement - Right > Page 7634
4. Install the driver's knee bolster.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Knee Diverter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Knee
Bolster Bracket Replacement - Right > Page 7635
Knee Diverter: Service and Repair Knee Bolster Replacement - Right
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the instrument panel extension. 2. Remove the screws that retain the knee bolster to
the instrument panel. 3. Pull back on the knee bolster in order to release the retainers from the
instrument panel. 4. Remove the knee bolster.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the knee bolster. 2. Install the knee bolster to the instrument panel:
2.1. Align the retainers. 2.2. Press the panel into place.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the screws that retain the bolster to the instrument panel.
Tighten Tighten the knee bolster screws to 8 N.m (71 lb in).
4. Install the instrument panel extension.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7640
Inflatable Restraint Sensing And Diagnostic Module (SDM)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7641
Air Bag Control Module: Service Precautions
CAUTION:
^ Proper operation of the Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) sensing system requires that any
repairs to the vehicle structure return the vehicle structure to the original production configuration.
Not properly repairing the vehicle structure could cause non-deployment of the air bag(s) in a
frontal collision or deployment of the air bag(s) for conditions less severe than intended.
^ Be careful when you handle a sensing and diagnostic module (SDM). Do not strike or jolt the
SDM. Before applying power to the SDM: ^
Remove any dirt, grease, etc. from the mounting surface
^ Position the SDM horizontally on the mounting surface
^ Point the arrow on the SDM toward the front of the vehicle
^ Tighten all of the SDM fasteners and SDM bracket fasteners to the specified torque value
Failure to follow the correct procedure could cause air bag deployment, personal injury, or
unnecessary SIR system repairs.
^ If any water enters the vehicle's interior up to the level of the carpet or higher and soaks the
carpet, the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) and the SDM harness connector may need to be
replaced. The SDM could be activated when powered, which could cause deployment of the air
bag(s) and result in personal injury. Before attempting these procedures, the SIR system must be
disabled. Refer to Disabling the SIR System. With the ignition OFF, inspect the SDM mounting
area, including the carpet. If any significant soaking or evidence of significant soaking is detected,
you must perform the following tasks: 1. Remove all water. 2. Repair the water damage. 3. Replace
the SDM harness connector. 4. Replace the SDM. Failure to follow these tasks could result in
possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded SIR system repairs.
^ Proper operation of the Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) sensing system requires that any
repairs to the vehicle structure return the vehicle structure to the original production configuration.
Not properly repairing the vehicle structure could cause non-deployment of the side impact air
bag(s) in a side impact collision or deployment of the side impact air bag(s) for conditions less
severe than Intended.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7642
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation
INFLATABLE RESTRAINT SENSING AND DIAGNOSTIC MODULE (SDM)
The Sensing And Diagnostic Module (SDM) is a microprocessor and the control center for the SIR
system. The SDM contains internal sensors along with several external sensors, if equipped,
mounted at various locations on the vehicle. In the event of a collision, the SDM performs
calculations using the signals received from the internal and external sensors. The SDM compares
the results of the calculations to values stored in memory. When these calculations exceed the
stored value, the SDM will cause current to flow through the appropriate deployment loops to
deploy the air bags. The SDM records the SIR system status when a deployment occurs and turns
the AIR BAG indicator ON. The SDM performs continuous diagnostic monitoring of the SIR system
electrical components and circuitry when the ignition is turned ON. If the SDM detects a
malfunction, a DTC will be stored and the SDM will command the AIR BAG indicator ON. In the
event that ignition 1 voltage is lost during a collision, the SDM maintains a 23-volt loop reserve (23
VLR) for deployment of the air bags. It is important to note, when disabling the SIR system for
servicing or rescue operations to allow the 23 VLR to dissipate, which could take up to 1 minute.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7643
Air Bag Control Module: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Air Bag Systems / Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7644
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair
INFLATABLE RESTRAINT SENSING AND DIAGNOSTIC MODULE REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: ^
Be careful when you handle a sensing and diagnostic module (SDM). Do not strike or jolt the SDM.
Before applying power to the SDM: ^
Remove any dirt, grease, etc. from the mounting surface
^ Position the SDM horizontally on the mounting surface
^ Point the arrow on the SDM toward the front of the vehicle
^ Tighten all of the SDM fasteners and SDM bracket fasteners to the specified torque value
Failure to follow the correct procedure could cause air bag deployment, personal injury, or
unnecessary SIR system repairs.
^ If any water enters the vehicle's interior up to the level of the carpet or higher and soaks the
carpet, the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) and the SDM harness connector may need to be
replaced. The SDM could be activated when powered, which could cause deployment of the air
bag(s) and result in personal injury. Before attempting these procedures, the SIR system must be
disabled. Refer to Disabling the SIR System. With the ignition OFF, inspect the SDM mounting
area, including the carpet. If any significant soaking or evidence of significant soaking is detected,
you must perform the following tasks: 1. Remove all water. 2. Repair the water damage. 3. Replace
the SDM harness connector. 4. Replace the SDM. Failure to follow these tasks could result in
possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded SIR system repairs.
^ Refer to SIR Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disable the SIR system. Refer to Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming. 2. Remove the drivers seat.
3. Remove the carpet retaining sill trim molding. 4. Fold back the carpet to access the inflatable
restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM). 5. Remove the connector position assurance
(CPA) (1) from the inflatable restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) wiring harness
connector
(2).
6. Push down the flex lock button (3) and slide the connector locking cover (4) to the open position.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7645
7. Disconnect the SDM wiring harness connector (2) from the SDM (4). 8. Remove the SDM
mounting fasteners (1). 9. Remove the SDM (4) from the vehicle (5).
IMPORTANT: The following repair procedures should only be used in the event that the inflatable
restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) mounting studs and/or fasteners are damaged to
the extent that the SDM may no longer be properly mounted.
10. Repair the fasteners using the following procedure:
10.1. Remove the stripped nut and discard the nut. 10.2. Drill out the weld spots to the weld stud
from the floor pan side, then remove and discard the stud. 10.3. Condition the floor panel attaching
surface where the new stud is to be installed. 10.4. Install new weld stud GM P/N 115115602 and
clamp the weld stud. 10.5. Migweld the stud at the drilled holes form above or below the floor pan,
as required. 10.6. Apply body sealer around any exposed openings. 10.7. Install a new fastener
GM P/N 11515933.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the SDM (4) to the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the SDM mounting fasteners (1).
Tighten Tighten fasteners to 12 N.m (106 lb in).
3. Connect the SDM wiring harness connector (2) to the SDM (4).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7646
4. Push down the flex lock button (3) and slide the connector locking cover (4) to the close position.
5. Install the connector position assurance (CPA) (1) to the inflatable restraint sensing and
diagnostic module (SDM) wiring harness connector (2). 6. Position the carpet to cover the inflatable
restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM). 7. Install the carpet retaining sill trim molding. 8.
Install the driver seat. 9. Enable the SIR system. Refer to Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Disabling
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Disabling
IMPORTANT: Refer to SIR Service Precautions before disabling the SIR system.
1. Turn the steering wheel until the vehicle's wheels are pointing straight ahead. 2. Turn OFF the
ignition. 3. Remove the key from the ignition.
IMPORTANT: With the AIR BAG Fuse removed and the ignition ON, the AIR BAG indicator
illuminates. This is normal operation and does not indicate an SIR system malfunction.
4. Remove the AIR BAG Fuse from the IP fuse block. 5. Remove the sound insulator, if equipped.
6. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) from the steering wheel module yellow 2-way
connector (1) located at the base of the steering
column.
7. Disconnect the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector (1) located at the base of the
steering column.
8. Remove the instrument panel extension. 9. Remove the CPA (2) from the IP module yellow
2-way connector (1) located under the instrument panel extension.
10. Disconnect the IP module yellow 2-way connector (1) located under the instrument panel
extension.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Disabling > Page 7652
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Enabling
1. Remove the key from the ignition. 2. Connect the IP module yellow 2-way connector (1) located
under the instrument panel extension. 3. Install the connector position assurance (CPA) (2) to the
IP module yellow 2-way connector (1) located under the instrument panel extension. 4. Install the
instrument panel extension.
5. Connect the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector (1) located at the base of the
steering column. 6. Install the CPA to the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector (1)
located at the base of the steering column. 7. Install the sound insulator, if equipped. 8. Install the
AIR BAG Fuse to the IP fuse block. 9. Staying well away from the air bags, turn ON the ignition,
with the engine OFF.
9.1. The AIR BAG indicator will flash 7 times.
9.2. The AIR BAG indicator will then turn OFF.
10. Perform Diagnostic System Check - SIR if the AIR BAG indicator does not operate as
described.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Child Seat Top Teather Attachment Kits
Child Seat Tether Attachment: Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Child Seat Top Teather
Attachment Kits
Bulletin No.: 99-09-40-004a
Date: April 12, 2005
INFORMATION
Subject: Top Tether Hardware Package for Child Restraint Seats
Models: 1989-2002 Passenger Cars, Light Duty Trucks and Multi-Purpose Passenger Vehicles
(Except EV1 and Prizm)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2000-2002 model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 99-09-40-009 (Section 09 - Restraints).
Important:
GM of Canada and IPC Dealers are not authorized to utilize this service bulletin.
Beginning in August, 1997 General Motors began providing Child Restraint Seat Top Tether
Hardware Packages to customers in the United States who requested them. The Top Tether
Hardware Package contains the necessary hardware for anchoring a forward facing child restraint
seat top tether.
One Child Restraint Seat Top Tether Hardware Package will be provided per vehicle to the retail
customer at no charge for installation. Charges for installation of additional Top Tether Hardware
Packages per vehicle are the responsibility of the customer.
Most forward facing child restraint seats (CRS) sold in the United States prior to calendar year
1999 were not sold with top tether straps, but have provisions for them. Top tethers, which are
required in Canada, can help to better secure the seat in the vehicle. When a forward facing CRS
including a top tether is used, specially designed components must be used to secure the child
seat top tether. These components are included in the Hardware Package from GMSPO.
Top tethers are not normally required or used with rearward facing infant restraint seats. Rearward
facing infant restraint seats should never be secured in the front seat of an air bag equipped
vehicle unless the vehicle is equipped with an air bag de-activation (shut-off) switch and the switch
has been used to turn the air bag off.
Should a retail customer request installation of a Tether Hardware Package at the time of sale or
delivery, it is to be installed at no charge to the owner. The labor to install a Tether Hardware
Package prior to delivery of a new vehicle to the customer is considered to be part of the delivery
"get ready process", and as such, is not claimable. Claiming for the cost and applicable handling
allowance of the proper Tether Hardware Package used in the installation is allowed.
If the customer requests installation of a Tether Hardware Package some time after delivery, the
package is to be provided free of charge. Hardware Packages include installation instructions
which are easily followed and can be installed by most customers. However, should the customer
request the dealership's assistance to install the Tether Hardware Package, it is to be installed at
no charge to the customer and the labor may be claimed. All claims submitted for installation labor
of an approved Tether Hardware Package must be supported by a signed customer work order.
Additional Hardware Packages and installation charges are the responsibility of the customer.
In addition, passenger vehicle deliveries, including vans and sport utilities for daily rental usage,
may have one tether hardware package supplied. Additional packages are the owner's
responsibility. Dealers may claim appropriate parts under these circumstances. Sufficient quantities
of parts should be ordered in advance of the arrival of vehicles to avoid delays.
Important:
When installing a Child Restraint Seat Top Tether Hardware Package, follow the installation
instructions included in the package. Additional information about specific mounting locations and
installations may be available in the Seat Belt Section (Sections 9, 10-10, 10-11 or 10A) I of the
appropriate Service Manual, or the Restraints section of SI.
Any questions regarding this policy should be directed to your Area Manager, Parts or Service.
Parts Information
For Top Tether Hardware Package part numbers and usage, see Group 14.870 (passenger cars &
U-van), or Group 16.710 (Light Duty Truck) of the appropriate GMSPO Parts Catalog. In addition,
they can also be found in Accessories Group 21.042.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Child Seat Top Teather Attachment Kits > Page 7658
Warranty Information
The dealership will be reimbursed for the parts and labor, if applicable, through the submission of a
regular warranty claim.
All claims submitted must be supported by a signed customer work order. Purchase and installation
of additional Hardware Packages is the responsibility of the customer.
For Top Tether Hardware Packages installed in the United States, submit as a normal warranty
claim using the labor operations and time allowances shown.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7659
Child Seat Tether Attachment: Service and Repair
CHILD RESTRAINT TETHER ANCHOR REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Inspect the seat belt tether spacer bar hook (1) for damage. If damaged, replace the bucket seat
riser spacer bar. Refer to Seat Riser Trim Cover
Replacement - Power in Seats.
2. The front bucket seat passenger side tether belt (2) runs down the center of seatback and hooks
to the seat belt tether spacer bar (4) located in the
center of the seat riser.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7660
3. For the bench seats YC6, the tether belt must run under the headrest and hook into the seat belt
tether anchor. Located behind the seatback and
integrated into the center seat belt. If the seat belt tether anchor or seat belt are damaged the rear
center seat belts must be replaced. Refer to Sear Belt Buckle and Latch Replacement - No. 2 Rear.
4. For the bench seats YC7, the seat belt tether belt must run under the headrest and hook into the
seat belt tether anchor. Located behind the
seatback and integrated into the center seat belt. If the seat belt tether anchor or seat belt are
damaged the rear center seat belts must be replaced. Refer to Seat Belt Buckle and Latch
Replacement - No. 2 Rear.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7661
1. For the bench seats YC7, the seat belt tether belt must run under the headrest and hook into the
seat belt tether anchor. Located behind the
seatback and integrated into the center seat belt. If the seat belt tether anchor or seat belt are
damaged the rear center seat belts must be replaced. Refer to Seat Belt Buckle and Latch
Replacement - No. 2 Rear.
2. For the bench seats YC6, the tether belt must run under the headrest and hook into the seat belt
tether anchor. Located behind the seatback and
integrated into the center seat belt. If the seat belt tether anchor or seat belt are damaged the rear
center seat belts must be replaced. Refer to Sear Belt Buckle and Latch Replacement - No. 2 Rear.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7662
3. The front bucket seat passenger side tether belt (2) runs down the center of seatback and hooks
to the seat belt tether spacer bar (4) located in the
center of the seat riser support bar.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Service
Precautions
Seat Belt: Service Precautions
IMPORTANT: If the vehicle has been in a collision, refer to Repairs and Inspections Required After
a Collision for additional information.
^ Do not bleach or dye the seat belt webbing. Use only the following items in order to clean the
seat belt webbing: A mild soap and water solution
- A soft brush or cloth
^ Keep sharp edges and damaging objects away from the seat belts. Do not bend or damage any
part of the seat belt buckle or latch plate. Replace any seat belts that are cut or damaged in any
manner.
^ Use only the correct seat belt anchor bolts. Tighten the correct seat belt anchor bolt/ screw to the
correct torque value. Refer to Fastener Tightening Specifications. Begin tightening the seat belt
anchor bolts by hand in order to ensure that the bolt is threaded straight.
^ Some seat belts and retractors require service as a set with service replacement components
only. Do not repair individual components that require service as a set.
^ Verify that the replacement part number is correct for the vehicle at that seating position. Do not
substitute a seat belt from a different seating position.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Page 7666
Seat Belt: Description and Operation
FRONT SEAT BELT SYSTEM OPERATION
CAUTION: To help avoid personal injury from unrepaired crash damage to a restraint system,
perform the seat belt check for each seat belt system. Replace the seat belt system if there is any
doubt about the condition of system components.
1. The front seat belt system includes a driver and/or passenger seat belt retractor and buckle. 2.
The LF seat belt system, includes a seat belt switch in the LF seat buckle which controls a fasten
safety belts indicator and a tone alarm. When the
LF seat belt is buckled, the LF door is closed, and the ignition switch is in the ON position, the
following events will not occur: ^
The tone alarm will not operate.
^ The fasten safety belts indicator will not operate.
3. When the LF seat belt is not buckled, the LF door closed, and the ignition switch is in the RUN
position, the following events will occur:
^ The tone alarm will operate for 4 to 8 seconds and then turn OFF.
^ The fasten safety belts indicator will operate for 20 seconds, until the LF seat belt is buckled.
^ Then the fasten safety belts indicator will flash for an additional 55 seconds before turning OFF.
To diagnose a failure of the fasten safety belts indicator refer to Symptoms - Seat Belts or the tone
alarm, refer to Audible Warnings in Instrument Panel, Gauges and Console.
SEAT BELT SYSTEM CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The fasten safety belts indicator will illuminate when the following conditions occur simultaneously:
^
The ignition switch is in one of the following positions: RUN
- BULB TEST
- START
^ The LF safety belt is not fastened.
The audio fasten safety belt warning alarm, located within the Body Control Module (BCM), also
incorporates an indicator within the Instrument Panel Cluster (IPC). The fasten safety belt indicator
works in conjunction with the fasten safety belt warning alarm. When the BCM receives a signal
that the LF safety belt is unfastened, the BCM sends a signal to the IPC to command ON the fasten
safety belt indicator.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Belt Buckle: > 09-09-40-001A > Feb > 11 > Restraints - Seat Belt
Warning Lamp On/Buckling Issues
Seat Belt Buckle: Customer Interest Restraints - Seat Belt Warning Lamp On/Buckling Issues
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 09-09-40-001A
Date: February 02, 2011
Subject: Seat Belt Buckle Latching Issues and/or Seat Belt Warning Lights Illuminated
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7 X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 09-09-40-001 (Section 09 - Restraints).
This bulletin is being published to advise dealers about seat belt buckles not operating and/or seat
belt warning light illumination, as well as difficulty latching and unlatching the buckle or the buckle
release button sticking.
Analysis of warranty data has determined that this condition may be caused by sticky beverages
being spilled onto or into the seat belt buckle assembly. Foreign debris from food, candy wrappers,
paper and coins can also contribute to this condition.
Important If foreign material (debris) or sticky liquids are the cause of the concern, show the
customer the condition of the component (buckle assembly) and explain how it is affecting the
function of the restraint system. Strongly recommend that the component be replaced. Point out the
fact that this is not a manufacturing defect and is not covered by the new vehicle warranty. If the
customer declines to have parts replaced, the service department management must make a
notation on the service record that the lack of functionality of seating position with an inoperative
buckle was fully explained to the customer. The service department management must advise the
customer that having a non-functioning buckle in a seating position voids ability to use that seating
position (no one should ride in the seat). Also make the customer aware that it may be against the
law to ride in a vehicle without wearing a restraint system.
Important Never insert anything other than the seat belt latch plate into the buckle assembly. Do
not attempt to dig anything out of a buckle with a tool. Never try to wash out a buckle to remove a
spilled liquid as this may damage the buckle.
Use the following steps to determine the cause of the concern.
1. Inspect the buckle assembly with a light shining on the latch plate insertion area. Look for any
debris or foreign objects in the buckle. 2. If any debris or foreign objects are observed, try to
vacuum out the item. After the foreign material is removed, latch and unlatch the seat belt. If
the system functions properly, do not replace the seat belt buckle assembly.
3. If the condition has not been corrected, inspect the buckle assembly for any sticky residue. If
sticky residue is found, inform the customer that a
substance was spilled on the seat belt buckle assembly causing the malfunction. The buckle
assembly will need to be replaced at the customer's expense.
4. Refer to SI for seat belt component replacement.
Important If foreign material (debris) or sticky liquids are the cause of the concern, show the
customer the condition of the component (buckle assembly) and explain how it is affecting the
function of the restraint system. Strongly recommend that the component be replaced at the
customer's expense. Point out the fact that this is not a manufacturing defect and is not covered by
the new vehicle warranty. If the customer declines to have parts replaced, the service department
management must make a notation on the service record that the lack of functionality of seating
position with an inoperative buckle was fully explained to the customer. The service department
management must advise customer that having a non-functioning buckle in a seating position voids
ability to use that seating position (no one should ride in the seat). Also make the customer aware
that it may be against the law to ride in a vehicle without wearing a restraint system.
5. If further restraint diagnosis is required, refer to Seat Belt System Operational and Functional
Checks in SI.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Belt Buckle: > 09-09-40-001A > Feb > 11 > Restraints - Seat Belt
Warning Lamp On/Buckling Issues > Page 7675
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Belt Buckle: > 09-09-40-001A > Feb > 11 > Restraints
- Seat Belt Warning Lamp On/Buckling Issues
Seat Belt Buckle: All Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Seat Belt Warning Lamp On/Buckling
Issues
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 09-09-40-001A
Date: February 02, 2011
Subject: Seat Belt Buckle Latching Issues and/or Seat Belt Warning Lights Illuminated
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7 X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 09-09-40-001 (Section 09 - Restraints).
This bulletin is being published to advise dealers about seat belt buckles not operating and/or seat
belt warning light illumination, as well as difficulty latching and unlatching the buckle or the buckle
release button sticking.
Analysis of warranty data has determined that this condition may be caused by sticky beverages
being spilled onto or into the seat belt buckle assembly. Foreign debris from food, candy wrappers,
paper and coins can also contribute to this condition.
Important If foreign material (debris) or sticky liquids are the cause of the concern, show the
customer the condition of the component (buckle assembly) and explain how it is affecting the
function of the restraint system. Strongly recommend that the component be replaced. Point out the
fact that this is not a manufacturing defect and is not covered by the new vehicle warranty. If the
customer declines to have parts replaced, the service department management must make a
notation on the service record that the lack of functionality of seating position with an inoperative
buckle was fully explained to the customer. The service department management must advise the
customer that having a non-functioning buckle in a seating position voids ability to use that seating
position (no one should ride in the seat). Also make the customer aware that it may be against the
law to ride in a vehicle without wearing a restraint system.
Important Never insert anything other than the seat belt latch plate into the buckle assembly. Do
not attempt to dig anything out of a buckle with a tool. Never try to wash out a buckle to remove a
spilled liquid as this may damage the buckle.
Use the following steps to determine the cause of the concern.
1. Inspect the buckle assembly with a light shining on the latch plate insertion area. Look for any
debris or foreign objects in the buckle. 2. If any debris or foreign objects are observed, try to
vacuum out the item. After the foreign material is removed, latch and unlatch the seat belt. If
the system functions properly, do not replace the seat belt buckle assembly.
3. If the condition has not been corrected, inspect the buckle assembly for any sticky residue. If
sticky residue is found, inform the customer that a
substance was spilled on the seat belt buckle assembly causing the malfunction. The buckle
assembly will need to be replaced at the customer's expense.
4. Refer to SI for seat belt component replacement.
Important If foreign material (debris) or sticky liquids are the cause of the concern, show the
customer the condition of the component (buckle assembly) and explain how it is affecting the
function of the restraint system. Strongly recommend that the component be replaced at the
customer's expense. Point out the fact that this is not a manufacturing defect and is not covered by
the new vehicle warranty. If the customer declines to have parts replaced, the service department
management must make a notation on the service record that the lack of functionality of seating
position with an inoperative buckle was fully explained to the customer. The service department
management must advise customer that having a non-functioning buckle in a seating position voids
ability to use that seating position (no one should ride in the seat). Also make the customer aware
that it may be against the law to ride in a vehicle without wearing a restraint system.
5. If further restraint diagnosis is required, refer to Seat Belt System Operational and Functional
Checks in SI.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Belt Buckle: > 09-09-40-001A > Feb > 11 > Restraints
- Seat Belt Warning Lamp On/Buckling Issues > Page 7681
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Rear
Seat Belt Buckle: Service and Repair Rear
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the nuts located on the inside of the seat riser. 2. Remove the seat belt buckle from the
floor stud by lifting upward on the seat. The seat does not have to be removed from the vehicle. 3.
Remove the seat belt buckle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the seat belt buckle. 2. Install the seat belt buckle to the floor stud.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the nuts located at the base of the seat riser.
Tighten Tighten the bucket seat to the floor to 35 N.m (26 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Rear > Page 7684
Seat Belt Buckle: Service and Repair Front
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the nuts located on the inside of the seat riser. 2. Remove the seat belt buckle from the
floor stud by lifting upward on the seat. The seat does not have to be removed from the vehicle. 3.
Disconnect the seat belt buckle warning lamp electrical connector. 4. Remove the seat belt buckle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the seat belt buckle. 2. Connect the seat belt buckle warning electrical connector. 3. Install
the seat belt buckle to the floor stud.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the nuts located at the base of the seat riser.
Tighten Tighten the bucket seat to the floor to 35 N.m (26 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Rear > Page 7685
Seat Belt Buckle: Service and Repair Center Rear
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the rear bench seat from the vehicle. 2. Remove the seat belt buckle retaining bolt from
the seat frame.
3. Remove the seat belt buckle through the seat back.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Rear > Page 7686
1. Install the seat belt buckle through the seat back.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the seat belt buckle retaining bolt to the seat frame.
Tighten Tighten the seat belt buckle bolt to the seat frame to 53 N.m (39 lb ft).
3. Install the rear bench seat to the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Rear > Page 7687
Seat Belt Buckle: Service and Repair Seat Belt Buckle and Latch Replacement - Rear (RPO ZP7)
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the seat belt buckle latch bolt from the side of the riser. 2. Remove the seat belt buckle
latch. The seat does not have to be removed from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the seat belt buckle latch to the side of the riser.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the seat belt buckle latch bolt.
Tighten Tighten the seat belt buckle latch bolt to the riser to 35 N.m (26 lb ft).
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article/image, refer to the RPO Code List found
at Vehicle/Application ID See: Application and ID/RPO Codes
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Rear > Page 7688
Seat Belt Buckle: Service and Repair
Rear
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the nuts located on the inside of the seat riser. 2. Remove the seat belt buckle from the
floor stud by lifting upward on the seat. The seat does not have to be removed from the vehicle. 3.
Remove the seat belt buckle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the seat belt buckle. 2. Install the seat belt buckle to the floor stud.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the nuts located at the base of the seat riser.
Tighten Tighten the bucket seat to the floor to 35 N.m (26 lb ft).
Front
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Rear > Page 7689
1. Remove the nuts located on the inside of the seat riser. 2. Remove the seat belt buckle from the
floor stud by lifting upward on the seat. The seat does not have to be removed from the vehicle. 3.
Disconnect the seat belt buckle warning lamp electrical connector. 4. Remove the seat belt buckle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the seat belt buckle. 2. Connect the seat belt buckle warning electrical connector. 3. Install
the seat belt buckle to the floor stud.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the nuts located at the base of the seat riser.
Tighten Tighten the bucket seat to the floor to 35 N.m (26 lb ft).
Center Rear
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Rear > Page 7690
1. Remove the rear bench seat from the vehicle. 2. Remove the seat belt buckle retaining bolt from
the seat frame.
3. Remove the seat belt buckle through the seat back.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the seat belt buckle through the seat back.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Rear > Page 7691
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the seat belt buckle retaining bolt to the seat frame.
Tighten Tighten the seat belt buckle bolt to the seat frame to 53 N.m (39 lb ft).
3. Install the rear bench seat to the vehicle.
Seat Belt Buckle and Latch Replacement - Rear (RPO ZP7)
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the seat belt buckle latch bolt from the side of the riser. 2. Remove the seat belt buckle
latch. The seat does not have to be removed from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Rear > Page 7692
1. Install the seat belt buckle latch to the side of the riser.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the seat belt buckle latch bolt.
Tighten Tighten the seat belt buckle latch bolt to the riser to 35 N.m (26 lb ft).
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article/image, refer to the RPO Code List found
at Vehicle/Application ID See: Application and ID/RPO Codes
Seat Belt Buckle and Latch Replacement - Rear (RPO ZP5)
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the rear bench seat from the vehicle. 2. Remove the seat belt latch by removing the hog
rings and lifting up on the cover to expose the nut. The complete seat cover does not have to be
removed.
3. Remove the seat belt latch nut. 4. Remove the seat belt latch.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Rear > Page 7693
1. Install the seat belt latch.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the seat belt latch nut.
Tighten Tighten the seat belt latch nut to 53 N.m (39 lb ft).
3. Install the seat cover and rehog ring it back in place. 4. Install the rear bench seat to the vehicle.
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article/image, refer to the RPO Code List found
at Vehicle/Application ID See: Application and ID/RPO Codes
Seat Belt Buckle and Latch Replacement - Rear (RPO ZP8)
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the rear bench seat side cover screw to expose the seat belt latch bolt. 2. Remove the
rear bench seat side cover screw. 3. Remove the seat belt latch nut. 4. Remove the seat belt latch.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Rear > Page 7694
1. Install the seat belt latch.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the seat belt latch nut.
Tighten Tighten the seat belt latch nut to 53 N.m (39 lb ft).
3. Install the rear bench seat side cover and screw.
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article/image, refer to the RPO Code List found
at Vehicle/Application ID See: Application and ID/RPO Codes
Seat Belt Buckle and Latch Replacement - No.2 Rear
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the rear seat form the vehicle. 2. Remove the seat belt buckle and latch retaining bolt
from the seat frame.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Rear > Page 7695
3. Remove the seat belt buckle and latch through the seat back.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the seat belt buckle and latch through the seat back.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Rear > Page 7696
2. Install the seat belt buckle and latch retaining bolt to the seat frame.
Tighten Tighten the seat belt buckle and latch retaining bolt to 53 N.m (39 lb ft).
3. Install the rear bench seat in the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch > Component
Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7700
Seat Belt Buckle Switch
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Extension > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Extender Availability For Seat Belt
Seat Belt Extension: Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Extender Availability For Seat Belt
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 99-09-40-005F
Date: June 23, 2010
Subject: Seat Belt Extender Availability
Models: 2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2009 and Prior
HUMMER H2 2010 and Prior HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2009‐2011 model years and update the Warranty
Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 99-09-40-005E (Section 09 Restraints).
Important:
DO NOT use belt extenders when securing a child restraint.
The seat and shoulder belt restraint systems used in all General Motors vehicles have sufficient
belt length to accommodate most drivers and passengers. Consequently, requests for belt
extensions (extenders) should be minimal.
Seat belt extenders are available ONLY IN BLACK for most GM passenger cars and trucks
produced in recent years. They are available in two different lengths, 23 cm (9 in) and 38 cm (15
in). They are designed to be coupled with the existing belts in each vehicle. When in use, the
extender makes the belt arrangement a "custom fit" and use by anyone else or in another vehicle
will lessen or nullify the protection offered by the vehicle's restraint system. For this reason, it is
extremely important that the correct length extender be used for the vehicle and occupant intended.
Important:
Do not use an extender just to make it easier to buckle the safety belt. Use an extender only when
you cannot buckle the safety belt without using an extender.
Parts Information
For part numbers, usage and availability of extenders, see Extension Kit in Group 14.875 (cars) or
Group 16.714 (trucks) of the appropriate parts catalog. Saturn retailers should refer to the
appropriate model year Parts & Illustration catalog for the vehicle. U.S. Saab dealers should contact
the Parts Help line. Canadian Saab dealers should fax requests to Partech Canada.
Warranty Information
^ Seat belt extenders are a NO CHARGE item to all GM customers who request them for their
specific vehicles.
^ Dealers should not be charging part costs since these extenders are supplied by GM to the
dealers.
^ Dealers should not be charging labor costs since the extender can be customer installed.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Height Adjuster > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Shoulder Belt Guide Adjuster Replacement - Front
Seat Belt Height Adjuster: Service and Repair Shoulder Belt Guide Adjuster Replacement - Front
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the cover for the front seat shoulder belt to expose the bolt. 2. Remove the front seat
shoulder belt retaining bolt from the guide adjuster bracket. 3. Remove the left front side door lock
pillar garnish molding. 4. Remove the right front side door lock pillar garnish molding. 5. Remove
the 2 guide adjuster bracket retaining bolts from the pillar. 6. Remove the guide adjuster bracket
from the pillar.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the guide adjuster bracket to the pillar.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the 2 guide adjuster bracket retaining bolts to the pillar.
Tighten Tighten the guide adjuster bracket retaining bolts to the pillar to 20 N.m (15 lb ft).
3. Install the left front side door lock pillar garnish molding. 4. Install the right front side door lock
pillar garnish molding. 5. Install the shoulder belt retaining bolt to the guide adjuster bracket.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Height Adjuster > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Shoulder Belt Guide Adjuster Replacement - Front > Page 7709
Tighten Tighten the front seat shoulder belt retaining bolt to the guide adjuster bracket to 53 N.m
(39 lb ft).
6. Install the cover for the front seat shoulder belt.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Height Adjuster > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Shoulder Belt Guide Adjuster Replacement - Front > Page 7710
Seat Belt Height Adjuster: Service and Repair Shoulder Belt Guide Adjuster Replacement - Rear
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Open the cover on the rear seat shoulder belt to expose the bolt. 2. Remove the rear seat
shoulder belt retaining bolt from the guide adjuster bracket. 3. Remove the left rear - C-pillar side
garnish molding trim by grasping both the sides and pull rearward. 4. Remove the 2 guide adjuster
bracket retaining bolts from the pillar. 5. Remove the guide adjuster bracket from the pillar.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the guide adjuster bracket to the pillar.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the 2 guide adjuster bracket retaining bolts to the pillar.
Tighten Tighten the guide adjuster bracket retaining bolts to the pillar to 20 N.m (15 lb ft).
3. Align the tabs of the C-pillar side garnish molding trim with the openings in the pillar and push
inward until fully seated. 4. Install the shoulder belt retaining bolt to the guide adjuster bracket.
Tighten Tighten the shoulder belt retaining bolt to the guide adjuster bracket to 53 N.m (39 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Height Adjuster > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Shoulder Belt Guide Adjuster Replacement - Front > Page 7711
5. Close the cover on the rear seat shoulder belt bolt.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Latch > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Seat belt Buckle and Latch Replacement - Rear (RPO ZP5)
Seat Belt Latch: Service and Repair Seat belt Buckle and Latch Replacement - Rear (RPO ZP5)
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the rear bench seat from the vehicle. 2. Remove the seat belt latch by removing the hog
rings and lifting up on the cover to expose the nut. The complete seat cover does not have to be
removed.
3. Remove the seat belt latch nut. 4. Remove the seat belt latch.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the seat belt latch.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the seat belt latch nut.
Tighten Tighten the seat belt latch nut to 53 N.m (39 lb ft).
3. Install the seat cover and rehog ring it back in place. 4. Install the rear bench seat to the vehicle.
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article/image, refer to the RPO Code List found
at Vehicle/Application ID See: Application and ID/RPO Codes
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Latch > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Seat belt Buckle and Latch Replacement - Rear (RPO ZP5) > Page 7716
Seat Belt Latch: Service and Repair Seat Belt Buckle and Latch Replacement - Rear (RPO ZP7)
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the seat belt buckle latch bolt from the side of the riser. 2. Remove the seat belt buckle
latch. The seat does not have to be removed from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the seat belt buckle latch to the side of the riser.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the seat belt buckle latch bolt.
Tighten Tighten the seat belt buckle latch bolt to the riser to 35 N.m (26 lb ft).
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article/image, refer to the RPO Code List found
at Vehicle/Application ID See: Application and ID/RPO Codes
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Latch > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Seat belt Buckle and Latch Replacement - Rear (RPO ZP5) > Page 7717
Seat Belt Latch: Service and Repair Seat Belt Buckle and Latch Replacement - Rear (RPO ZP8)
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the rear bench seat side cover screw to expose the seat belt latch bolt. 2. Remove the
rear bench seat side cover screw. 3. Remove the seat belt latch nut. 4. Remove the seat belt latch.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the seat belt latch.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the seat belt latch nut.
Tighten Tighten the seat belt latch nut to 53 N.m (39 lb ft).
3. Install the rear bench seat side cover and screw.
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article/image, refer to the RPO Code List found
at Vehicle/Application ID See: Application and ID/RPO Codes
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Latch > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Seat belt Buckle and Latch Replacement - Rear (RPO ZP5) > Page 7718
Seat Belt Latch: Service and Repair Seat Belt Buckle and Latch Replacement - No.2 Rear
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the rear seat form the vehicle. 2. Remove the seat belt buckle and latch retaining bolt
from the seat frame.
3. Remove the seat belt buckle and latch through the seat back.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Latch > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Seat belt Buckle and Latch Replacement - Rear (RPO ZP5) > Page 7719
1. Install the seat belt buckle and latch through the seat back.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the seat belt buckle and latch retaining bolt to the seat frame.
Tighten Tighten the seat belt buckle and latch retaining bolt to 53 N.m (39 lb ft).
3. Install the rear bench seat in the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Latch > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Seat belt Buckle and Latch Replacement - Rear (RPO ZP5) > Page 7720
Seat Belt Latch: Service and Repair Seat Belt Latch Replacement - Center Rear
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the rear seat from the vehicle. 2. Remove the seat belt latch retaining bolts from the
seat frame.
3. Remove the seat belt latch retaining bolts from the seat frame. 4. Remove the seat belt latch
through the seat back. 5. Remove the seat belt latch from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Latch > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Seat belt Buckle and Latch Replacement - Rear (RPO ZP5) > Page 7721
1. Install the seat belt latch to the vehicle through the seat back.
2. Install the seat belt latch to the vehicle through the seat back.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the bolts that hold the seat belt latch to the seat frame.
Tighten Tighten the seat belt latch bolts to 53 N.m (39 lb ft).
4. Install the rear seat to the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Fasten Safety Belt Indicator/Chime Inoperative
Seat Belt Reminder Lamp: Testing and Inspection Fasten Safety Belt Indicator/Chime Inoperative
Steps 1-4
Steps 5-11
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Fasten Safety Belt Indicator/Chime Inoperative > Page 7726
Steps 1-9
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection
Seat Belt Retractor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Seat Belt Systems / Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Left Front
Seat Belt Retractor: Service and Repair Left Front
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Slide the front seat all the way forward. 2. Remove the seat belt from the seat belt guide located
on the side of the bucket seat. 3. Remove the cover from the shoulder belt guide to expose the
bolt. 4. Remove the retaining bolt from the shoulder belt guide adjuster bracket. 5. Remove the left
inside garnish molding. 6. Remove the body side front lower molding. 7. Remove the electrical
connectors. 8. Remove the bolt retaining the retractor from the pillar, lift upward to release. 9.
Remove the retractor from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the retractor to the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the retractor bolt to the pillar.
Tighten Tighten the retractor bolt to the pillar to 53 N.m (39 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Left Front > Page 7732
3. Install the electrical connectors. 4. Install the body side front lower molding. 5. Install the left
inside garnish molding. 6. Install the bolt retaining the shoulder belt guide to the adjuster bracket.
Tighten Tighten the shoulder belt retaining bolt to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
7. Install the cover to the shoulder belt guide. 8. Install the seat belt to the seat belt guide located
on the side of the bucket seat. 9. Slide the front seat back in position.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Left Front > Page 7733
Seat Belt Retractor: Service and Repair Right Front
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Slide the front seat all the way forward. 2. Remove the seat belt from the seat belt guide located
on the side of the bucket seat. 3. Remove the cover from the shoulder belt guide to expose the
bolt. 4. Remove the retaining bolt from the shoulder belt guide adjuster bracket. 5. Remove the
right front lock pillar inside garnish molding. 6. Remove the cover on the base of the retractor to
expose the bolt. 7. Remove the bolt from the retractor to the pillar. 8. Remove the electrical
connectors. 9. Remove the retractor from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the retractor to the vehicle. 2. Install the electrical connectors.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the retractor bolt to the pillar.
Tighten Tighten the retractor bolt to the pillar to 53 N.m (39 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Left Front > Page 7734
4. Install the cover to the base of the retractor. 5. Install the bolt retaining the shoulder belt to the
guide adjuster bracket.
Tighten Tighten the shoulder belt retaining bolt to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
6. Install the right front lock pillar inside garnish molding. 7. Install the cover to the shoulder belt
guide. 8. Install the seat belt to the seat belt guide located on the side of the bucket seat. 9. Slide
the front seat back in position.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Left Front > Page 7735
Seat Belt Retractor: Service and Repair Left Rear
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the left rear bucket seat. 2. Remove the seat belt bolt from the rear floor. 3. Remove the
body side trim panel.
4. Remove the cover from the shoulder belt to expose the bolt. 5. Remove the shoulder belt
retaining bolt from the body side pillar. 6. Remove the retractor bolt from the body side panel.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Left Front > Page 7736
1. Install the retractor bolt to the body side panel.
Tighten Tighten the retractor bolt to 53 N.m (39 lb ft).
2. Install the shoulder belt bolt to the body side pillar.
Tighten Tighten the shoulder belt bolt to the body side pillar to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
3. Install the cover to the shoulder belt. 4. Install the body side trim panel.
5. Install the seat belt bolt to the rear floor.
Tighten Tighten the seat belt bolt to the rear floor to 53 N.m (39 lb ft).
6. Install the left rear bucket seat.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Left Front > Page 7737
Seat Belt Retractor: Service and Repair Right Rear
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the trim cover from the rear seat belt retractor, by grasping the sides and pull
downward. 2. Remove the seat belt retractor buckle from the latch.
2.1. Locate the red dot in the center of the buckle.
2.2. Insert a small pointed tool in the center of the buckle.
2.3. Push inward for it to release from the latch.
3. Remove the rear seat belt retractor nuts from the roof reinforcement. 4. Remove the rear seat
belt retractor from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Left Front > Page 7738
1. Install the rear seat belt retractor to the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the rear seat belt retractor nuts to the roof reinforcement panel.
Tighten Tighten the seat belt retractor nuts to 35 N.m (26 lb ft).
3. Snap the retractor cover into place.
4. Install the seat belt buckle to the latch.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Left Front > Page 7739
Seat Belt Retractor: Service and Repair
Left Front
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Slide the front seat all the way forward. 2. Remove the seat belt from the seat belt guide located
on the side of the bucket seat. 3. Remove the cover from the shoulder belt guide to expose the
bolt. 4. Remove the retaining bolt from the shoulder belt guide adjuster bracket. 5. Remove the left
inside garnish molding. 6. Remove the body side front lower molding. 7. Remove the electrical
connectors. 8. Remove the bolt retaining the retractor from the pillar, lift upward to release. 9.
Remove the retractor from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the retractor to the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the retractor bolt to the pillar.
Tighten Tighten the retractor bolt to the pillar to 53 N.m (39 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Left Front > Page 7740
3. Install the electrical connectors. 4. Install the body side front lower molding. 5. Install the left
inside garnish molding. 6. Install the bolt retaining the shoulder belt guide to the adjuster bracket.
Tighten Tighten the shoulder belt retaining bolt to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
7. Install the cover to the shoulder belt guide. 8. Install the seat belt to the seat belt guide located
on the side of the bucket seat. 9. Slide the front seat back in position.
Right Front
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Slide the front seat all the way forward. 2. Remove the seat belt from the seat belt guide located
on the side of the bucket seat. 3. Remove the cover from the shoulder belt guide to expose the
bolt. 4. Remove the retaining bolt from the shoulder belt guide adjuster bracket. 5. Remove the
right front lock pillar inside garnish molding. 6. Remove the cover on the base of the retractor to
expose the bolt. 7. Remove the bolt from the retractor to the pillar. 8. Remove the electrical
connectors. 9. Remove the retractor from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Left Front > Page 7741
1. Install the retractor to the vehicle. 2. Install the electrical connectors.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the retractor bolt to the pillar.
Tighten Tighten the retractor bolt to the pillar to 53 N.m (39 lb ft).
4. Install the cover to the base of the retractor. 5. Install the bolt retaining the shoulder belt to the
guide adjuster bracket.
Tighten Tighten the shoulder belt retaining bolt to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
6. Install the right front lock pillar inside garnish molding. 7. Install the cover to the shoulder belt
guide. 8. Install the seat belt to the seat belt guide located on the side of the bucket seat. 9. Slide
the front seat back in position.
Left Rear
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the left rear bucket seat. 2. Remove the seat belt bolt from the rear floor. 3. Remove the
body side trim panel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Left Front > Page 7742
4. Remove the cover from the shoulder belt to expose the bolt. 5. Remove the shoulder belt
retaining bolt from the body side pillar. 6. Remove the retractor bolt from the body side panel.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the retractor bolt to the body side panel.
Tighten Tighten the retractor bolt to 53 N.m (39 lb ft).
2. Install the shoulder belt bolt to the body side pillar.
Tighten Tighten the shoulder belt bolt to the body side pillar to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
3. Install the cover to the shoulder belt. 4. Install the body side trim panel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Left Front > Page 7743
5. Install the seat belt bolt to the rear floor.
Tighten Tighten the seat belt bolt to the rear floor to 53 N.m (39 lb ft).
6. Install the left rear bucket seat.
Right Rear
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the trim cover from the rear seat belt retractor, by grasping the sides and pull
downward. 2. Remove the seat belt retractor buckle from the latch.
2.1. Locate the red dot in the center of the buckle.
2.2. Insert a small pointed tool in the center of the buckle.
2.3. Push inward for it to release from the latch.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Left Front > Page 7744
3. Remove the rear seat belt retractor nuts from the roof reinforcement. 4. Remove the rear seat
belt retractor from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the rear seat belt retractor to the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the rear seat belt retractor nuts to the roof reinforcement panel.
Tighten Tighten the seat belt retractor nuts to 35 N.m (26 lb ft).
3. Snap the retractor cover into place.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Left Front > Page 7745
4. Install the seat belt buckle to the latch.
No. 2 Left Rear
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the left rear storage trays. Squeeze the storage tray and pull upward to release.
2. Remove the shoulder belt cover to expose the bolt.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Left Front > Page 7746
3. Remove the shoulder belt retaining bolt from the bracket.
4. Remove the retractor retaining bolt. 5. Remove the retractor from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the retractor to the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the retractor retaining bolt.
Tighten Tighten the retractor retaining bolt to 53 N.m (39 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Left Front > Page 7747
3. Install the shoulder belt retaining bolt to the bracket.
Tighten Tighten the shoulder belt retaining bolt to the bracket to 35 N.m (26 lb ft).
4. Install the retractor retaining bolt.
Tighten Tighten the retractor retaining bolt to 53 N.m (39 lb ft).
5. Install the storage trays. Squeeze the storage tray together. Press the storage tray into place.
No. 2 Right Rear
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Left Front > Page 7748
1. Remove the jack storage access door. 2. Remove the storage tray. Squeeze the storage tray
from underneath. This will expose the retractor bolt.
3. Remove the retractor retaining bolt.
4. Remove the shoulder belt cover to expose the bolt. 5. Remove the shoulder belt retaining bolt
from the bracket. 6. Remove the retractor from the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Left Front > Page 7749
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the retractor to the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the bolt retaining the shoulder belt to the bracket.
Tighten Tighten the bolt retaining the shoulder belt to the bracket to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
3. Install the shoulder belt cover. 4. Install the retractor retaining bolt.
Tighten Tighten the retractor retaining bolt to 53 N.m (39 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Left Front > Page 7750
5. Install the storage tray. Squeeze the storage tray together. Press the storage tray into place. 6.
Install the jack storage access door.
Seat Belt Retractor Reinforcement Replacement - Left
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the cover from the rear seat shoulder belt anchor. 2. Remove the bolt retaining the rear
seat shoulder belt anchor to the bracket. 3. Remove the rear seat shoulder belt bracket cover. 4.
Remove the nut retaining the rear seat shoulder belt bracket to the reinforcement.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Left Front > Page 7751
5. Remove the headliner. 6. Remove the nuts retaining the rear seat shoulder belt reinforcement to
the roof. 7. Remove the bolts retaining the rear seat shoulder belt reinforcement to the roof. 8.
Remove the rear seat shoulder belt reinforcement from the roof.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the rear seat shoulder belt reinforcement to the roof.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the bolts to retain the rear seat shoulder belt reinforcement to the roof.
Tighten Tighten the rear seat shoulder belt reinforcement bolts to 35 N.m (26 lb ft).
3. Install the nuts to retain the rear seat shoulder belt reinforcement to the roof.
Tighten Tighten the rear seat shoulder belt reinforcement to the roof nuts to 35 N.m (26 lb ft).
4. Install the headliner.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Left Front > Page 7752
5. Install the nut to retain the rear seat shoulder belt bracket to the reinforcement.
Tighten Tighten the rear seat shoulder belt bracket to the reinforcement nut to 35 N.m (26 lb ft).
6. Install the rear seat shoulder belt bracket cover. 7. Install the bolt to retain the rear seat shoulder
belt to the bracket.
Tighten Tighten the rear seat shoulder belt to the bracket bolt to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
8. Install the cover to the rear seat shoulder belt
Seat Belt Retractor Reinforcement Replacement - Right
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the cover from the rear seat shoulder belt. 2. Remove the bolt retaining the rear seat
shoulder belt to the bracket. 3. Remove the rear seat shoulder belt bracket cover. 4. Remove the
nut retaining the rear seat shoulder belt bracket to the reinforcement.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Left Front > Page 7753
5. Remove the headliner. 6. Remove the nuts retaining the rear seat shoulder belt reinforcement to
the roof. 7. Remove the bolts retaining the rear seat shoulder belt reinforcement to the roof. 8.
Remove the rear seat shoulder belt reinforcement from the roof.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the rear seat shoulder belt reinforcement to the roof.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the bolts to retain the rear seat shoulder belt reinforcement to the roof.
Tighten Tighten the rear seat shoulder belt reinforcement bolts to the roof 35 N.m (26 lb ft).
3. Install the nuts to retain the rear seat shoulder belt reinforcement to the roof.
Tighten Tighten the rear seat shoulder belt reinforcement nuts to the roof to 35 N.m (26 lb ft).
4. Install the headliner.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Left Front > Page 7754
5. Install the nut to retain the rear seat shoulder belt bracket to the reinforcement.
Tighten Tighten the seat shoulder belt bracket to the reinforcement nut to 35 N.m (26 lb ft).
6. Install the rear seat shoulder belt bracket cover. 7. Install the bolt to retain the rear seat shoulder
belt to the bracket.
Tighten Tighten the seat shoulder belt bracket to the reinforcement bolt to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
8. Install the cover to the rear seat shoulder belt bolt.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7759
Inflatable Restraint Front End Discriminating Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7760
Impact Sensor: Service Precautions
CAUTION: Be careful when you handle a sensor. Do not strike or jolt a sensor. Before applying
power to a sensor:
^ Remove any dirt, grease, etc. from the mounting surface.
^ Position the sensor horizontally on the mounting surface.
^ Point the arrow on the sensor toward the front of the vehicle.
^ Tighten all of the sensor fasteners and sensor bracket fasteners to the specified torque value.
Failure to follow the correct procedure could cause air bag deployment, personal injury, or
unnecessary SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7761
Impact Sensor: Description and Operation
INFLATABLE RESTRAINT FRONT END DISCRIMINATING SENSOR
The front end discriminating sensor is equipped on some vehicles to supplement SIR system
performance. The discriminating sensor is an electro-mechanical sensor and is not part of the
deployment loops, but instead provides an input to the SDM. The SDM uses the input from the
discriminating sensor to assist in determining the severity of a frontal collision further supporting air
bag deployment. If the SDM determines a deployment is warranted, the SDM will cause current to
flow through the deployment loops deploying the frontal air bags.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7762
Impact Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Air Bag Systems / Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Inflatable Restraint Front End Discriminating Sensor Replacement
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Inflatable Restraint Front End Discriminating Sensor
Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Disable the SIR system. Refer to Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming. 2. Disconnect the mass air
flow (MAF) and the intake air temperature (IAT) sensors harness connectors. 3. Loosen the clamp.
4. Remove the air tube from the throttle body air intake cover. 5. Remove the bolts. 6. Remove the
upper radiator shroud. 7. Remove the fan and clutch assembly. 8. Remove the lower radiator
shroud. 9. Disconnect the inflatable restraint front end discriminating sensor harness connector
located at the top of the cradle (1).
10. Remove the bolts (2). 11. Remove the inflatable restraint front end discriminating sensor (3)
from the cradle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Be careful when you handle a sensor. Do not strike or jolt a sensor. Before applying
power to a sensor: ^
Remove any dirt, grease, etc. from the mounting surface.
^ Position the sensor horizontally on the mounting surface.
^ Point the arrow on the sensor toward the front of the vehicle.
^ Tighten all of the sensor fasteners and sensor bracket fasteners to the specified torque value.
Failure to follow the correct procedure could cause air bag deployment, personal injury, or
unnecessary SIR system repairs.
1. Install the inflatable restraint front end discriminating sensor to the top of the cradle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the inflatable restraint front end discriminating sensor mounting fasteners (2).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Inflatable Restraint Front End Discriminating Sensor Replacement > Page
7765
Tighten Tighten fastener to 6.5 N.m (58 lb in).
IMPORTANT: The following procedures should be utilized in the event that sensor mounting holes
or fasteners are damaged to the extent that the sensor may no longer be properly mounted.
3. Perform the following steps in order to complete the first fastener repair;
3.1. Remove and discard the improperly installed rivet.
3.2. Reattach sensor with new rivet (GM P/N 15715058) or equivalent.
4. Perform the following steps, if needed, in order to complete a second fastener repair:
4.1. Remove the improperly installed rivet.
4.2. Enlarge the mounting holes in the lower radiator support to 9.0 mm (0.35 in).
4.3. Insert and properly seat rivnut (GM P/N 15699834) or equivalent.
4.4. Install sensor with screw GM P/N 11515664, or equivalent.
Tighten Tighten fasteners to 6.5 N.m (58 lb in).
5. Connect the inflatable restraint front end discriminating sensor harness connector to the sensor.
6. Install the lower radiator shroud. 7. Install the fan and clutch assembly. 8. Install the upper
radiator shroud. 9. Install the air box with MAF sensor to the upper radiator shroud.
10. Connect the air tube to the throttle body air intake cover with the clamp. 11. Connect the MAF
and IAT sensors harness connectors. 12. Enable the SIR system. Refer to Air Bag(s) Arming and
Disarming.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Inflatable Restraint Front End Discriminating Sensor Replacement > Page
7766
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module
Replacement
INFLATABLE RESTRAINT SENSING AND DIAGNOSTIC MODULE REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: ^
Be careful when you handle a sensing and diagnostic module (SDM). Do not strike or jolt the SDM.
Before applying power to the SDM: ^
Remove any dirt, grease, etc. from the mounting surface
^ Position the SDM horizontally on the mounting surface
^ Point the arrow on the SDM toward the front of the vehicle
^ Tighten all of the SDM fasteners and SDM bracket fasteners to the specified torque value
Failure to follow the correct procedure could cause air bag deployment, personal injury, or
unnecessary SIR system repairs.
^ If any water enters the vehicle's interior up to the level of the carpet or higher and soaks the
carpet, the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) and the SDM harness connector may need to be
replaced. The SDM could be activated when powered, which could cause deployment of the air
bag(s) and result in personal injury. Before attempting these procedures, the SIR system must be
disabled. Refer to Disabling the SIR System. With the ignition OFF, inspect the SDM mounting
area, including the carpet. If any significant soaking or evidence of significant soaking is detected,
you must perform the following tasks: 1. Remove all water. 2. Repair the water damage. 3. Replace
the SDM harness connector. 4. Replace the SDM. Failure to follow these tasks could result in
possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded SIR system repairs.
^ Refer to SIR Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disable the SIR system. Refer to Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming. 2. Remove the drivers seat.
3. Remove the carpet retaining sill trim molding. 4. Fold back the carpet to access the inflatable
restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM). 5. Remove the connector position assurance
(CPA) (1) from the inflatable restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) wiring harness
connector
(2).
6. Push down the flex lock button (3) and slide the connector locking cover (4) to the open position.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Inflatable Restraint Front End Discriminating Sensor Replacement > Page
7767
7. Disconnect the SDM wiring harness connector (2) from the SDM (4). 8. Remove the SDM
mounting fasteners (1). 9. Remove the SDM (4) from the vehicle (5).
IMPORTANT: The following repair procedures should only be used in the event that the inflatable
restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) mounting studs and/or fasteners are damaged to
the extent that the SDM may no longer be properly mounted.
10. Repair the fasteners using the following procedure:
10.1. Remove the stripped nut and discard the nut. 10.2. Drill out the weld spots to the weld stud
from the floor pan side, then remove and discard the stud. 10.3. Condition the floor panel attaching
surface where the new stud is to be installed. 10.4. Install new weld stud GM P/N 115115602 and
clamp the weld stud. 10.5. Migweld the stud at the drilled holes form above or below the floor pan,
as required. 10.6. Apply body sealer around any exposed openings. 10.7. Install a new fastener
GM P/N 11515933.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the SDM (4) to the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the SDM mounting fasteners (1).
Tighten Tighten fasteners to 12 N.m (106 lb in).
3. Connect the SDM wiring harness connector (2) to the SDM (4).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Inflatable Restraint Front End Discriminating Sensor Replacement > Page
7768
4. Push down the flex lock button (3) and slide the connector locking cover (4) to the close position.
5. Install the connector position assurance (CPA) (1) to the inflatable restraint sensing and
diagnostic module (SDM) wiring harness connector (2). 6. Position the carpet to cover the inflatable
restraint sensing and diagnostic module (SDM). 7. Install the carpet retaining sill trim molding. 8.
Install the driver seat. 9. Enable the SIR system. Refer to Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Inflatable Restraint Front End Discriminating Sensor Replacement > Page
7769
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair SIR Sensor Replacement Guidelines
The SIR sensor replacement policy requires replacing sensors in the area of collision damage. The
area of collision damage is defined as the portion of the vehicle which is crushed, bent, or
damaged due to a collision.
^ Replace the sensor even if the air bags have not deployed.
^ Replace the sensor even if it appears to be undamaged.
Sensor damage which is not visible, such as slight bending of the mounting bracket or cuts in the
wire insulation, can cause improper operation of the SIR sensing system. Do not try to determine
whether the sensor is undamaged, replace the sensor.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch
> Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 7773
Seat Belt Buckle Switch
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Passenger Presence System Information
Seat Occupant Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Passenger Presence System
Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 06-08-50-009F
Date: December 23, 2010
Subject: Information on Passenger Presence Sensing System (PPS or PSS) Concerns With
Custom Upholstery, Accessory Seat Heaters or Other Comfort Enhancing Devices
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Equipped with Passenger Presence Sensing
System
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 06-08-50-009E (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Concerns About Safety and Alterations to the Front Passenger Seat
Important ON A GM VEHICLE EQUIPPED WITH A PASSENGER SENSING SYSTEM, USE THE
SEAT COVERS AND OTHER SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT AS RELEASED BY GM FOR THAT
VEHICLE. DO NOT ALTER THE SEAT COVERS OR SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT. ANY
ALTERATIONS TO SEAT COVERS OR GM ACCESSORIES DEFEATS THE INTENDED DESIGN
OF THE SYSTEM. GM WILL NOT BE LIABLE FOR ANY PROBLEMS CAUSED BY USE OF
SUCH IMPROPER SEAT ALTERATIONS, INCLUDING ANY WARRANTY REPAIRS INCURRED.
The front passenger seat in many GM vehicles is equipped with a passenger sensing system that
will turn off the right front passenger's frontal airbag under certain conditions, such as when an
infant or child seat is present. In some vehicles, the passenger sensing system will also turn off the
right front passenger's seat mounted side impact airbag. For the system to function properly,
sensors are used in the seat to detect the presence of a properly-seated occupant. The passenger
sensing system may not operate properly if the original seat trim is replaced (1) by non-GM covers,
upholstery or trim, or (2) by GM covers, upholstery or trim designed for a different vehicle or (3) by
GM covers, upholstery or trim that has been altered by a trim shop, or (4) if any object, such as an
aftermarket seat heater or a comfort enhancing pad or device is installed under the seat fabric or
between the occupant and the seat fabric.
Aftermarket Seat Heaters, Custom Upholstery, and Comfort Enhancing Pads or Devices
Important ON A GM VEHICLE EQUIPPED WITH A PASSENGER SENSING SYSTEM, USE ONLY
SEAT COVERS AND OTHER SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT RELEASED AS GM
ACCESSORIES FOR THAT VEHICLE. DO NOT USE ANY OTHER TYPE OF SEAT COVERS OR
SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT, OR GM ACCESSORIES RELEASED FOR OTHER VEHICLE
APPLICATIONS. GM WILL NOT BE LIABLE FOR ANY PROBLEMS CAUSED BY USE OF SUCH
IMPROPER SEAT ACCESSORIES, INCLUDING ANY WARRANTY REPAIRS MADE
NECESSARY BY SUCH USE.
Many types of aftermarket accessories are available to customers, upfitting shops, and dealers.
Some of these devices sit on top of, or are Velcro(R) strapped to the seat while others such as seat
heaters are installed under the seat fabric. Additionally, seat covers made of leather or other
materials may have different padding thickness installed that could prevent the Passenger Sensing
System from functioning properly. Never alter the vehicle seats. Never add pads or other devices to
the seat cushion, as this may interfere with the operation of the Passenger Sensing System and
either prevent proper deployment of the passenger airbag or prevent proper suppression of the
passenger air bag.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Accessory Delay Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7783
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7784
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7785
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7786
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7787
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7788
Accessory Delay Module: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7789
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7790
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7791
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7792
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7793
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7794
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7795
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7796
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7797
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7798
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7799
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7800
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7801
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7802
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7803
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7804
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7805
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7806
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7807
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7808
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7809
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7810
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7811
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7812
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7813
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Page 7814
Accessory Delay Module: Description and Operation
RETAINED ACCESSORY POWER (RAP) POWER MODE
RAP is a vehicle power mode that permits the operation of selected customer convenience items
after the ignition switch is turned OFF. These selected items will remain in operation until a
passenger compartment door is opened or until the RAP function timer reaches its shut-off limit.
The body control module monitors the ignition switch position, battery condition and passenger
compartment door status to determine whether RAP should be initiated. If the ignition switch
transitions from RUN/ON to OFF, the battery level is within the acceptable range and the
passenger compartment doors are closed, the body control module closes the RAP relay.
This provides power for the following: ^
Sunroof
^ Power windows
^ Power door locks
^ Radio
^ Rear radio
^ OnStar
The BCM turns OFF the RAP function and opens the RAP relay when one of the following
conditions are met: ^
The BCM senses the opening of any door or the liftgate.
^ The BCM detects a decrease in battery capacity below a prescribed limit.
^ The BCM receives a message from its internal timer indicating the end of the RAP period after 20
minutes.
^ The transition from OFF to RUN/ON or ACC of the ignition switch.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Accessory Delay Module: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Diagnostic Starting Point
Begin the system diagnosis with the Diagnostic System Check - Accessory Delay Module. The
Diagnostic System Check will provide the following information:
^ The identification of the control module which commands the system
^ The ability of the control module to communicate through the serial data circuit
^ The identification of any stored DTCs and their status
The use of the Diagnostic System Check will identify the correct procedure for diagnosing the
system and where the procedure is located.
Diagnostic System Check
TEST DESCRIPTION
Steps 1-5
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. Lack of communication
may be due to a partial malfunction of the class 2 serial data circuit or due to a total malfunction of
the class 2 serial data
circuit. The specified procedure will determine the particular condition.
4. This step is checking for DTCs in the BCM. 5. This step is checking for RAP specific DTCs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7817
Accessory Delay Module: Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes
With Scan Tool
PROCEDURE
Use a Tech II or equivalent Scan tool to clear Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) from the PCM
memory. When clearing DTCs, follow the instructions supplied by the Scan tool manufacturer.
NOTES: ^
Do not clear the DTCs unless directed to do so by the service information provided for each
diagnostic procedure. All of the diagnostic data that was saved along with the DTC (freeze frame
data and/or malfunction history records) which may be helpful for some diagnostic procedures will
be erased from the memory when the DTCs are cleared.
^ Interrupting PCM battery voltage to clear DTCs is NOT recommended.
Without Scan Tool
PROCEDURE
Use a Tech II or equivalent Scan tool to clear Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) from the PCM
memory. When clearing DTCs, follow the instructions supplied by the Scan tool manufacturer.
NOTES: ^
Do not clear the DTCs unless directed to do so by the service information provided for each
diagnostic procedure. All of the diagnostic data that was saved along with the DTC (freeze frame
data and/or malfunction history records) which may be helpful for some diagnostic procedures will
be erased from the memory when the DTCs are cleared.
^ Interrupting PCM battery voltage to clear DTCs is NOT recommended.
With Scan Tool
PROCEDURE
A Tech II or equivalent Scan tool must be used to retrieve Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) from
the PCM memory. DTCs can no longer be retrieved at the data link connector. This also eliminates
the PCM function of flashing Code 12. Follow the instructions supplied by the Scan tool
manufacturer in order to access and read either current and/or history DTCs.
Without Scan Tool
A Tech II or equivalent scan tool must be used to retrieve Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) from
the PCM memory. DTCs can no longer be retrieved at the data link connector. This also eliminates
the PCM function of flashing Code 12. Follow the instructions supplied by the scan tool
manufacturer in order to access and read either current and/or history DTCs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7818
Accessory Delay Module: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
A Symptoms
IMPORTANT PRELIMINARY CHECKS BEFORE STARTING
1. Perform the Diagnostic System Check - Accessory Delay Module before using the Symptom
Tables in order to verify that all of the following are
true: ^
There are no DTCs set.
^ The control module(s) can communicate via the serial data link. See: Initial Inspection and
Diagnostic Overview/Diagnostic System Check
2. Review the system operation in order to familiarize yourself with the system functions. Refer to
Retained Accessory Power (RAP) Description and
Operation.
VISUAL/PHYSICAL INSPECTION ^
Inspect for aftermarket devices which could affect the operation of the Retained Accessory Power
system. Refer to Checking Aftermarket Accessories in Diagnostic Aids.
^ Inspect the easily accessible or visible system components for obvious damage or conditions
which could cause the symptom.
INTERMITTENT Faulty electrical connections or wiring may be the cause of intermittent conditions.
Refer to Testing for Intermittent and Poor Connections in Diagnostic Aids.
SYMPTOM LIST Refer to a symptom diagnostic procedure from the following list in order to
diagnose the symptom: ^
Retained Accessory Power (RAP) On After Timeout
^ Retained Accessory Power (RAP) Inoperative
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7819
Steps 1-10
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7820
Steps 1-9
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7821
Accessory Delay Module: Scan Tool Testing and Procedures
Scan Tool Data Definitions
MODULE INFORMATION 1
Julian Date of Build: The scan tool displays the date upon which the Body Control Module (BCM)
was manufactured.
Manufacture Enable Counter (MEC): The scan tool displays the actual value for the MEC in the
BCM. This information is for the assembly plant only.
Module Part Number: The scan tool displays the pan number assigned to the BCM that is currently
in the vehicle.
Software Design Suffix: The scan tool displays the version of the software pan number in the BCM.
Software Part Number: The scan tool displays the software identification number (ID) in the BCM.
MODULE INFORMATION 2
Retained Accessory Power (RAP) Calibration Number: The scan tool displays the RAP calibration
part number in the BCM.
Retained Accessory Power (RAP) Suffix: The scan tool displays the RAP identification number in
the BCM.
DATA
Battery Voltage: The scan tool displays the battery system voltage.
Inadvertent Power Timer: The scan tool displays the seconds left before the BCM turns the
inadvertent power relay OFF. The BCM uses this feature to protect the battery against inadvertent
battery rundown caused by components that are part of the courtesy lamp circuit. The inadvertent
power relay is supplied power by the BCM for 2400 seconds / 40 minutes after the ignition is turned
OFF.
RAP Timer: The scan tool displays the seconds left before the BCM turns the RAP relay OFF. The
BCM uses this feature to allow the operation of the radio and the power windows for up to 1198
seconds / 20 minutes after the ignition is turned OFF. After the time has elapsed or the door is
opened the BCM will open the ground circuit for the RAP relay.
INPUT 1
Door Handle Switch: The scan tool displays the position of the door handle. The scan tool displays
ACTIVE when a door handle is raised and INACTIVE with all doors closed and the door handles at
rest.
Drivers Door Jamb Switch: The scan tool displays the position of the drivers door. The scan tool
displays ACTIVE when the drivers door is open.
Ignition 1: The scan tool displays the position of the ignition switch. The scan tool displays ACTIVE
when the ignition switch is in the RUN or CRANK position.
Ignition 3: The scan tool displays the position of the ignition switch. The scan tool displays ACTIVE
when the ignition switch is in the RUN position only.
Ignition Power Mode: The scan tool displays the position of the ignition switch. The scan tool
displays OFF, RUN, CRANK and UNKNOWN. The UNKNOWN display is when the BCM can not
determine the position of the ignition switch.
Key In Ignition: The scan tool displays the position of the ignition key in the ignition switch cylinder.
The scan tool displays YES when the ignition key is completely inserted into the ignition switch
cylinder. The BCM uses this data in controlling the operation of the reminder chime feature.
RAP Relay Feedback: The scan tool displays the state of the RAP relay. The scan tool displays ON
when the BCM activates the RAP relay.
OUTPUTS
RAP Relay: The scan tool displays the commanded state of the RAP relay. The scan tool displays
ON when the BCM allows the RAP relay to go to ground. The BCM will allow operation of the radio
and the power windows with the ignition OFF and the doors closed for up to 1198 seconds,
approximately 20 minutes.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7822
Scan Tool Data List
Scan Tool Output Controls
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna Mast > Component Information
> Service and Repair
Antenna Mast: Service and Repair
FIXED ANTENNA MAST REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
NOTE: Use tape on the tool surface so that you do not damage the paint on the antenna mast.
1. Unscrew the antenna mast. 2. Remove the antenna mast from the antenna base.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: Use tape on the tool surface so that you do not damage the paint on the antenna mast.
1. Install the antenna mast to the antenna base.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Secure the antenna mast to the antenna base.
Tighten Tighten the antenna mast to 5.5 N.m (49 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Navigation > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-08-46-003B > Feb > 05 > Instruments - GPS System
Performance Degradation
Antenna, Navigation: Customer Interest Instruments - GPS System Performance Degradation
Info - Global Position Sensor (GPS) Performance Degradation # 00-08-46-003B - (Feb 9, 2005)
Models: 1996-2005 Passenger Cars and Trucks 2002-2005 Saturn Vehicles
with Navigation Systems and/or OnStar(R)
This bulletin is being revised to include additional information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-08-46-003A (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Navigation and OnStar(R) systems require a GPS antenna in order to function properly. This
antenna may be located inside the vehicle. If the GPS antenna is located inside the vehicle,
performance of the system may be compromised by window tinting film.
If the GPS system performance is in question and the vehicle has window tinting, a quick
diagnostic check can be made by temporarily moving the GPS antenna to an external vehicle
surface, such as the decklid or roof. If the GPS function of the navigation or On Star(R) system
operates normally with the antenna relocated the repair would not be considered a warranty repair.
The subsequent repair procedure or GPS placement would be up to the customer.
Some vehicles have the GPS antenna located on the rear window shelf Objects placed on the rear
window shelf such as tissue boxes, books, dolls, etc,, also have the potential to interfere with GPS
performance.
Warranty Information
Repairs made to the vehicle navigation and/or OnStar(R) system, which are the result of window
tinting, are not considered warranty repairs.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Navigation > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 00-08-46-002A > Apr > 05 > OnStar(R) Cellular Antenna Replacement Parts
Antenna, Navigation: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Cellular Antenna Replacement
Parts
Bulletin No.: 00-08-46-002A
Date: April 12, 2005
INFORMATION
Subject: OnStar(R) System Cellular Antenna Replacement Parts Availability
Models: 1996-2005 Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2003-2005 HUMMER H2
with OnStar(R) and Glass Mounted Antennas
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to update the model years, models and parts information. Please
discard Corporate Bulletin Number 00-08-46-002 (Section 08 - Body & Accessories).
Replacement parts for the OnStar(R) system cellular antenna are available as follows:
^ Cellular Antenna Kit - If the antenna mast or exterior base is damaged or missing or if the
antenna base has separated from the exterior glass surface.
^ Cellular Antenna Inner Coupling - If the antenna coupling on the inside of the glass requires
replacement.
Important:
If glass replacement is required, both the Cellular Antenna Kit and the Cellular Antenna Inner
Coupling are required. The kits listed contain all the necessary parts and instructions needed to
properly install a new cellular antenna exterior base or interior coupling to the glass surface. To
obtain maximum adhesion during installation, the instructions included in the kits must be followed
carefully and exactly as written.
Important:
Do not attempt to reinstall the original cellular antenna exterior base or interior coupling using any
type of glue, adhesive tapes, etc. Doing so may eliminate the cellular signal transfer through the
glass and reduce the maximum performance of the system that includes air bag deployment
notification.
Important:
To obtain maximum adhesion between the new cellular exterior base or interior coupling and the
glass surface, the base, coupling and glass must be kept dry and above 15°C (60°F) during the
installation and for the 24 hours immediately following the installation. Not keeping the vehicle dry
and above the temperature listed for 24 hours may result in the new cellular antenna exterior base
or interior coupling coming off.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Navigation > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 00-08-46-002A > Apr > 05 > OnStar(R) Cellular Antenna Replacement Parts > Page 7840
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Navigation > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 00-08-46-003B > Feb > 05 > Instruments GPS System Performance Degradation
Antenna, Navigation: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - GPS System Performance
Degradation
Info - Global Position Sensor (GPS) Performance Degradation # 00-08-46-003B - (Feb 9, 2005)
Models: 1996-2005 Passenger Cars and Trucks 2002-2005 Saturn Vehicles
with Navigation Systems and/or OnStar(R)
This bulletin is being revised to include additional information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-08-46-003A (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Navigation and OnStar(R) systems require a GPS antenna in order to function properly. This
antenna may be located inside the vehicle. If the GPS antenna is located inside the vehicle,
performance of the system may be compromised by window tinting film.
If the GPS system performance is in question and the vehicle has window tinting, a quick
diagnostic check can be made by temporarily moving the GPS antenna to an external vehicle
surface, such as the decklid or roof. If the GPS function of the navigation or On Star(R) system
operates normally with the antenna relocated the repair would not be considered a warranty repair.
The subsequent repair procedure or GPS placement would be up to the customer.
Some vehicles have the GPS antenna located on the rear window shelf Objects placed on the rear
window shelf such as tissue boxes, books, dolls, etc,, also have the potential to interfere with GPS
performance.
Warranty Information
Repairs made to the vehicle navigation and/or OnStar(R) system, which are the result of window
tinting, are not considered warranty repairs.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Navigation > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Antenna, Navigation: > 05-08-46-004C > Dec > 10
> OnStar(R) - Number Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Number
Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 05-08-46-004C
Date: December 23, 2010
Subject: OnStar(R) Phone Number Concerns (Phone Number Incorrect/Assigned to Another
Vehicle/Phone) That Occur During Diagnosis of OnStar(R) System
Models:
2000-2011 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Equipped with OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years up to 2011. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 05-08-46-004B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
During diagnosis of an OnStar(R) concern, the technician may be told that the OnStar(R) phone
number is incorrect or tied to another vehicle and/or phone of some kind. To resolve these
concerns, the Tech 2(R) with software version 22.005 (or higher), has the capability to change the
OnStar(R) phone number.
Service Procedure
1. With the Tech 2(R), build the vehicle to specifications within the Diagnostics area of the Tech
2(R). 2. For vehicles with physical-based diagnostics - under Body, go to the OnStar(R) section.
Then select the Special Functions menu.
For vehicles with functional-based diagnostics - under Body and Accessories, go to the Cellular
Communication section. Select Module Setup and then Vehicle Communication Interface Module.
3. Locate the Program Phone Number prompt and select it. The original phone number will be
displayed on the Tech 2(R) screen. 4. Contact the OnStar(R) team at the GM Technical Assistance
Center (TAC) to obtain a new phone number. 5. Highlight the digits of the phone number one at a
time and enter the new phone number using the number keys on the Tech 2(R). 6. Press the Soft
key at the base of the screen for Done once these numbers have been changed on the screen. 7.
Press the Soft key for Done again. The area code or new phone number has now been
programmed into the phone. 8. Cycle the ignition to Off and open the driver's door. 9. Press the
blue OnStar(R) button to make sure that a normal connection can be made to the OnStar(R) call
center. If applicable, make sure the
Hands-Free Calling (HFC) works properly by making a phone call.
10. If the system is working properly, fax or voicemail a case closing into the OnStar(R) team at
TAC with the results. Dealers in Canada should
submit case closing information through the GM infoNET.
Please follow this diagnostic process thoroughly and complete each step. If the condition exhibited
is resolved WITHOUT completing every step, the remaining steps do not need to be performed. If
the procedure above does not resolve the condition, you must contact TAC for further assistance.
This diagnostic approach was developed specifically for this condition and should not automatically
be used for other vehicles with similar symptoms.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Navigation > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Antenna, Navigation: > 05-08-46-004C > Dec > 10
> OnStar(R) - Number Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned > Page 7850
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Navigation > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Antenna, Navigation: > 02-08-44-007D > May >
09 > OnStar(R) - Negative Impact of Cloth/Vinyl Roofs
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Negative Impact of
Cloth/Vinyl Roofs
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 02-08-44-007D
Date: May 12, 2009
Subject: Negative Impact of Dealer-Installed Cloth/Vinyl Roofs on XM Radio and/or OnStar(R)
Systems
Models:
2002-2009 Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2009
HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X with XM Radio (RPO U2K) and/or OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................................................. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to
include the 2009 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-08-44-007C (Section
08 - Body and Accessories).
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................
Dealers should not install a cloth or vinyl roof on vehicles that have been ordered with the XM radio
option (RPO U2K) and/or OnStar(R) (RPO UE1). The performance of these systems may be
negatively impacted by the installation of the cloth/vinyl roof. Additionally, water leaks may result
from installing a cloth or vinyl roof on vehicles with roof-mounted antenna systems. Relocating the
antenna to another spot on the vehicle exterior, in order to install a cloth or vinyl roof, is not advised
either. The performance of the OnStar(R) and XM Radio antennas has been optimized for their
current locations. Relocating the antennas may result in a performance degradation.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Navigation > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Antenna, Navigation: > 08-08-46-004 > Aug > 08
> OnStar(R) - Aftermarket Device Interference Information
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Aftermarket Device
Interference Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-08-46-004
Date: August 14, 2008
Subject: Information on Aftermarket Device Interference with OnStar(R) Diagnostic Services
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Car and Truck (including Saturn) 2009 and Prior HUMMER
H2, H3 Models 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
with OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
This bulletin is being issued to provide dealer service personnel with information regarding
aftermarket devices connected to the Diagnostic Link Connector (DLC) and the impact to
OnStar(R) diagnostic probes and Vehicle Diagnostic e-mails.
Certain aftermarket devices, when connected to the Diagnostic Link Connector, such as, but not
limited to, Scan Tools, Trip Computers, Fuel Economy Analyzers and Insurance Tracking Devices,
interfere with OnStar's ability to perform a diagnostic probe when requested (via a blue button call)
by a subscriber. These devices also prohibit the ability to gather diagnostic and tire pressure data
for a subscriber's scheduled OnStar(R) Vehicle Diagnostic (OVD) e-mail.
These aftermarket devices utilize the Vehicles serial data bus to perform data requests and/or
information gathering. When these devices are requesting data, OnStar(R) is designed not to
interfere with any data request being made by these devices as required by OBD II regulations.
The OnStar(R) advisor is unable to definitively detect the presence of these devices and will only
be able to inform the caller or requester of the unsuccessful or incomplete probe and may in some
cases refer the subscriber/requester to take the vehicle to a dealer for diagnosis of the concern.
When performing a diagnostic check for an unsuccessful or incomplete OnStar(R) diagnostic
probe, or for concerns regarding completeness of the OnStar(R) Vehicle Diagnostic (OVD) e-mail,
verify that an aftermarket device was not present at the time of the requested probe. Regarding the
OVD e-mail, if an aftermarket device is interfering (including a Scan Tool of any type), the e-mail
will consistently display a "yellow" indication in diagnostics section for all vehicle systems except
the OnStar(R) System and Tire Pressure data (not available on all vehicles) will not be displayed
(i.e. section is collapsed). Successful diagnostic probes and complete OVD e-mails will resume
following the removal or disconnecting of the off-board device.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Navigation > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Antenna, Navigation: > 00-08-46-004C > Jan > 08
> OnStar(R) - Re-establishing OnStar(R) Communications
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Re-establishing OnStar(R)
Communications
Bulletin No.: 00-08-46-004C
Date: January 17, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Re-establishing Communications with OnStar(R) Center After Battery Disconnect
Models: 2000-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn and Saab)
with Digital OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-08-46-004B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
When servicing any of the above models and a battery cable is disconnected or power to the
OnStar(R) Vehicle Communication Interface Module (VCIM) is interrupted for any reason the
following procedure must be performed to verify proper Global Positioning System (GPS) function.
Never swap OnStar(R) Vehicle Communication Interface Modules (VCIM) from other vehicles.
Transfer of OnStar(R) modules from other vehicles should not be done. Each OnStar(R) module
has a unique identification number. The VCIM has a specific Station Identification (STID). This
identification number is used by the National Cellular Telephone Network and OnStar(R) systems
and is stored in General Motors Vehicle History files by VIN.
After completing ALL repairs to the vehicle you must perform the following procedure:
Move the vehicle into an open area of the service lot.
Sit in the vehicle with the engine running and the radio turned on for five minutes.
Press the OnStar(R) button in the vehicle.
When the OnStar(R) advisor answers ask the advisor to verify the current location of the vehicle.
If the vehicle location is different than the location the OnStar(R) advisor gives contact GM
Technical Assistance (TAC) and choose the OnStar(R) prompt. GM OnStar(R) TAC will assist in
the diagnosis of a failed VCIM and, if appropriate, order a replacement part. Replacement parts are
usually shipped out within 24 hours, and a pre-paid return package label will be included for
returning the faulty part. By returning the faulty part, you will avoid a non-return core charge.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Navigation > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Antenna, Navigation: > 02-08-46-006C > Jan > 08
> OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position Reported During Call
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position
Reported During Call
Bulletin No.: 02-08-46-006C
Date: January 08, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Incorrect OnStar(R) Global Positioning System (GPS) Location Reported During
OnStar(R) Call
Models: 2000-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2008
HUMMER H2 2006-2008 HUMMER H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
with OnStar(R)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
02-08-46-006B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
A small number of the above-mentioned vehicles may exhibit a condition in which the vehicle
reports an inaccurate location to the OnStar(R) Call Center. This condition can only be identified
via a button press to the OnStar(R) Call Center by the customer. Call Center personnel will be able
to identify this inaccurate location condition. Customers will then be notified through the mail by
OnStar(R) if their vehicle exhibits this condition. Once this condition has been identified OnStar(R)
will instruct the customer to return to the dealership to have this condition corrected.
It is not necessary to reconfigure the vehicle after the following procedure.
In order to correct this condition you must cycle power to the OnStar(R) system. This can be done
by either removing the fuses powering the OnStar(R) system or disconnecting the OnStar(R)
module (VCIM) from the vehicle. As a last resort you can disconnect the vehicle's battery.
The power needs to be removed from the system for approximately 15 minutes.
After completing this procedure the vehicle should be taken to an area with an unobstructed view of
the sky. The vehicle should be kept running for approximately 10 minutes to allow the vehicle to
reacquire the global positioning system (GPS). Then contact the OnStar(R) Call Center via the blue
OnStar(R) button and ask the advisor to verify the GPS position.
If the OnStar(R) advisor still has an inaccurate GPS location refer to the Navigation Systems and
Cellular Communications sub-sections in the Service Manual in order to diagnose and repair the
concern. If the normal diagnostics lead to module replacement you will need to contact Technical
Assistance (TAC) and choose the OnStar(R) prompt. GM OnStar(R) TAC will assist in the
diagnosis and if appropriate order a replacement part. Replacement parts are usually shipped out
within 24 hours and a pre-paid return package label will be included for returning the faulty part. By
returning the faulty part you will avoid a significant non-return core charge.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab US Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Warranty Information (Saab US Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Navigation > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Antenna, Navigation: > 02-08-46-006C > Jan > 08
> OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position Reported During Call > Page 7867
For vehicles repaired under warranty use, the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Navigation > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Antenna, Navigation: > 02-08-46-007C > Nov > 07
> OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands Free Issues
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands
Free Issues
Bulletin No.: 02-08-46-007C
Date: November 19, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Information on OnStar(R) System - Possible Loss of GPS Signal, Hands-Free Calling
Minutes Expire Prematurely and/or Inability to Add Hands-Free Calling Minutes
Models: 2001-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2008
HUMMER H2 2006-2008 HUMMER H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
with OnStar(R) System (RPO UE1)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2008 model year, warranty information and to provide GPS
signal recovery steps (under Dealer Action heading) to do PRIOR to determining if the VIU/VCIM
needs replacement. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-08-46-007B (Section 08 - Body
& Accessories).
If the vehicle currently has analog-upgradable OnStar(R) hardware, then the customer should be
made aware of the digital upgrade program per the latest version of Service Bulletin #
05-08-46-006. Any analog OnStar system that is not upgraded prior to the end of 2007 will be
deactivated due to the upcoming phase-out of the analog cellular network in the U.S. and Canada.
If the vehicle has recently been upgraded or has had a service replacement unit installed, this
bulletin may not be applicable.
Certain 2001-2008 model year vehicles equipped with OnStar(R) may exhibit a condition with the
Global Positioning System (GPS) that causes inaccuracies in the GPS clock. The GPS system is
internal to the OnStar(R) Vehicle Interface Unit (VIU) or the Vehicle Communication Interface
Module (VCIM). This inaccuracy can result in a symptom where the OnStar(R) Call Center is
unable to obtain an accurate GPS signal, hands-Free Calling minutes expire prematurely and/or
the inability to add Hands-Free calling minutes.
Customer Notification
OnStar(R) will notify the customer by mail with instructions to contact their dealership service
department.
Dealer Action
Not all vehicles will require VIU/VCIM replacement.
The GPS signal in some vehicles may be recoverable. To determine if the signal is recoverable,
simply connect the Tech2(R) and using the GPS information data display option, observe the GPS
date and time. If the date/time stamps are equal to a date approximately 19 years in the future, the
GPS clock has exceeded its capacity and the VIU/VCIM will need to be replaced. If the date/time
stamp is in the past or near future, the GPS clock has simply generated an inaccurate value and
may be recoverable by performing the following power-up reset.
To initiate a power-up reset, battery voltage (batt. +) must be removed from the VIU/VCIM. The
preferred methods, in order, of initiating the reset are outlined below.
Remove the fuse that supplies Battery positive (Batt. +) voltage to the module (refer to the
applicable Service Information schematics for the appropriate fuse).
The next preferred method is to remove the connector to the OnStar(R) unit that Batt + is
contained.
The least preferable method is to remove the negative terminal of the vehicle battery. This will not
only initiate the power-up reset, but it may also result in the loss of radio presets and other stored
personalization information/settings in other modules as well.
After initiating the power-up reset, the GPS data will be set to the defaulted date and time and will
require an acquisition of the GPS signal in order to gain the proper date and time.
Acquiring the GPS signal requires running the vehicle in an open/unobstructed view of the sky.
First, contact OnStar(R) Technical Support by pressing the blue button. Allow the OnStar(R)
Technical Advisor to activate the GPS recovery process. This should take approximately 10
minutes. Continue to
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Navigation > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Antenna, Navigation: > 02-08-46-007C > Nov > 07
> OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands Free Issues > Page 7872
monitor the Tech2(R) for the current time and date. REMINDER - Keep in mind that the time
displayed on the Tech2(R) is in Greenwich Mean Time (GMT) and the offset is based on the time
zones relationship to GMT.
If replacement of the VIU/VCIM is necessary, you MUST reconfigure the OnStar® system. Failure
to reconfigure the system will result in an additional customer visit for repair. OnStar® VIU,
Generations 2 and 3, will require the technician to press the blue OnStar® button to reconfigure the
vehicle with an OnStar® advisor.
OnStar(R) VCIM, Generations 4-7 will require the technician to reconfigure the vehicle with the use
of the TIS2WEB and SPS applications (pass thru only), along with the Tech2(R).
The configuration and set-up procedure is a two-step process that must be completed step-by-step
without interruption or delay in between each step. This procedure enables an automated activation
without a button press by the technician to the OnStar(R) Call Center. Following this procedure, it
may take up to 24 hours for all OnStar(R) services to be fully activated.
How to Order Parts
If the OnStar(R) GPS date/time stamp is non-recoverable and the unit needs to be replaced,
dealers in the U.S. should contact Autocraft Electronics select the catalog item that contains this
bulletin number. Canadian dealers should contact MASS Electronics.
Dealers DO NOT need to call the GM Technical Assistance Center (TAC) for replacement
approval. Autocraft Electronics and MASS Electronics will be responsible for verifying that the
subject vehicle is a candidate for a replacement VIU/VCIM.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Navigation > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Antenna, Navigation: > 02-08-46-007C > Nov > 07
> OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands Free Issues > Page 7873
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Navigation > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Antenna, Navigation: > 05-08-46-004C > Dec > 10
> OnStar(R) - Number Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned > Page 7879
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Navigation > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Antenna, Navigation: > 02-08-46-006C > Jan > 08
> OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position Reported During Call > Page 7896
For vehicles repaired under warranty use, the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Navigation > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Antenna, Navigation: > 02-08-46-007C > Nov > 07
> OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands Free Issues > Page 7901
monitor the Tech2(R) for the current time and date. REMINDER - Keep in mind that the time
displayed on the Tech2(R) is in Greenwich Mean Time (GMT) and the offset is based on the time
zones relationship to GMT.
If replacement of the VIU/VCIM is necessary, you MUST reconfigure the OnStar® system. Failure
to reconfigure the system will result in an additional customer visit for repair. OnStar® VIU,
Generations 2 and 3, will require the technician to press the blue OnStar® button to reconfigure the
vehicle with an OnStar® advisor.
OnStar(R) VCIM, Generations 4-7 will require the technician to reconfigure the vehicle with the use
of the TIS2WEB and SPS applications (pass thru only), along with the Tech2(R).
The configuration and set-up procedure is a two-step process that must be completed step-by-step
without interruption or delay in between each step. This procedure enables an automated activation
without a button press by the technician to the OnStar(R) Call Center. Following this procedure, it
may take up to 24 hours for all OnStar(R) services to be fully activated.
How to Order Parts
If the OnStar(R) GPS date/time stamp is non-recoverable and the unit needs to be replaced,
dealers in the U.S. should contact Autocraft Electronics select the catalog item that contains this
bulletin number. Canadian dealers should contact MASS Electronics.
Dealers DO NOT need to call the GM Technical Assistance Center (TAC) for replacement
approval. Autocraft Electronics and MASS Electronics will be responsible for verifying that the
subject vehicle is a candidate for a replacement VIU/VCIM.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Navigation > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Antenna, Navigation: > 02-08-46-007C > Nov > 07
> OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands Free Issues > Page 7902
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Phone > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > OnStar(R) - Cellular Antenna Replacement Parts
Antenna, Phone: Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Cellular Antenna Replacement Parts
Bulletin No.: 00-08-46-002A
Date: April 12, 2005
INFORMATION
Subject: OnStar(R) System Cellular Antenna Replacement Parts Availability
Models: 1996-2005 Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2003-2005 HUMMER H2
with OnStar(R) and Glass Mounted Antennas
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to update the model years, models and parts information. Please
discard Corporate Bulletin Number 00-08-46-002 (Section 08 - Body & Accessories).
Replacement parts for the OnStar(R) system cellular antenna are available as follows:
^ Cellular Antenna Kit - If the antenna mast or exterior base is damaged or missing or if the
antenna base has separated from the exterior glass surface.
^ Cellular Antenna Inner Coupling - If the antenna coupling on the inside of the glass requires
replacement.
Important:
If glass replacement is required, both the Cellular Antenna Kit and the Cellular Antenna Inner
Coupling are required. The kits listed contain all the necessary parts and instructions needed to
properly install a new cellular antenna exterior base or interior coupling to the glass surface. To
obtain maximum adhesion during installation, the instructions included in the kits must be followed
carefully and exactly as written.
Important:
Do not attempt to reinstall the original cellular antenna exterior base or interior coupling using any
type of glue, adhesive tapes, etc. Doing so may eliminate the cellular signal transfer through the
glass and reduce the maximum performance of the system that includes air bag deployment
notification.
Important:
To obtain maximum adhesion between the new cellular exterior base or interior coupling and the
glass surface, the base, coupling and glass must be kept dry and above 15°C (60°F) during the
installation and for the 24 hours immediately following the installation. Not keeping the vehicle dry
and above the temperature listed for 24 hours may result in the new cellular antenna exterior base
or interior coupling coming off.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Phone > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > OnStar(R) - Cellular Antenna Replacement Parts > Page 7907
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Global Positioning System Antenna >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > OnStar(R) - Cellular Antenna Replacement Parts
Global Positioning System Antenna: Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Cellular Antenna
Replacement Parts
Bulletin No.: 00-08-46-002A
Date: April 12, 2005
INFORMATION
Subject: OnStar(R) System Cellular Antenna Replacement Parts Availability
Models: 1996-2005 Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2003-2005 HUMMER H2
with OnStar(R) and Glass Mounted Antennas
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to update the model years, models and parts information. Please
discard Corporate Bulletin Number 00-08-46-002 (Section 08 - Body & Accessories).
Replacement parts for the OnStar(R) system cellular antenna are available as follows:
^ Cellular Antenna Kit - If the antenna mast or exterior base is damaged or missing or if the
antenna base has separated from the exterior glass surface.
^ Cellular Antenna Inner Coupling - If the antenna coupling on the inside of the glass requires
replacement.
Important:
If glass replacement is required, both the Cellular Antenna Kit and the Cellular Antenna Inner
Coupling are required. The kits listed contain all the necessary parts and instructions needed to
properly install a new cellular antenna exterior base or interior coupling to the glass surface. To
obtain maximum adhesion during installation, the instructions included in the kits must be followed
carefully and exactly as written.
Important:
Do not attempt to reinstall the original cellular antenna exterior base or interior coupling using any
type of glue, adhesive tapes, etc. Doing so may eliminate the cellular signal transfer through the
glass and reduce the maximum performance of the system that includes air bag deployment
notification.
Important:
To obtain maximum adhesion between the new cellular exterior base or interior coupling and the
glass surface, the base, coupling and glass must be kept dry and above 15°C (60°F) during the
installation and for the 24 hours immediately following the installation. Not keeping the vehicle dry
and above the temperature listed for 24 hours may result in the new cellular antenna exterior base
or interior coupling coming off.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Global Positioning System Antenna >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > OnStar(R) - Cellular Antenna Replacement Parts > Page 7912
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Global Positioning System Antenna >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > OnStar(R) - Cellular Antenna Replacement Parts > Page 7913
Global Positioning System Antenna: Technical Service Bulletins Onstar(R) - Antenna Coupling
Revised Procedures
File In Section: 08 - Body and Accessories
Bulletin No.: 01-08-46-006A
Date: December, 2001
SERVICE MANUAL UPDATE
Subject: Revised OnStar(R) Antenna Coupling Replacement Procedures
Models: 2000-2002 Passenger Cars and Trucks with Glass Mounted Antenna
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2002 model year and revise the service procedures. Please
discard Corporate Bulletin Number 01-08-46-006 (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
This bulletin is being issued to revise the OnStar(R) inner and outer antenna coupling replacement
procedures in the Cellular Communication sub-section of the Body and Accessories section in the
appropriate Service Manual. Please use the following to replace the existing information in the
Service Manual.
This information has been updated within SI2000. If you are using a paper version of this Service
Manual, please mark a reference to this bulletin on the affected page in the Cellular
Communication sub-section of the Service Manual.
Coupling Replacement - Antenna Inner
Removal Procedure
Important:
Use the described adhesion promoter to assure adequate bonding of the coupling to the glass. To
obtain maximum adhesion between the new mobile antenna couplings and the glass surface, the
couplings and the glass must be kept dry and above 15°C (60°F) during the installation and for 6-8
hours immediately following the installation. Otherwise the new couplings may come off. Also,
disregard the drying or curing time information listed in the instructions included in the replacement
antenna coupling kits. In the near future, those instructions will be updated with the drying or curing
times listed in this bulletin.
^ Do not attempt to reinstall the original cellular couplings using any type of glue, adhesive tapes,
etc. Doing so may eliminate the cellular signal transfer through the glass and reduce the maximum
performance of the system, including the air bag deployment notification.
1. Disconnect the coaxial cable from the inner coupling of the mobile communication antenna.
Notice:
If you use a razor blade or other sharp tool in order to remove the adhesives or foreign objects from
the inside of the rear window, use the blade carefully. Damage to the grid lines may result.
Use a small, wide-bladed plastic tool to cut the double back tape material while lifting up on the
inner antenna coupling.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Global Positioning System Antenna >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > OnStar(R) - Cellular Antenna Replacement Parts > Page 7914
1. Clean the inside of the glass with an alcohol wipe.
2. Dry the glass thoroughly using a lint free cloth.
Important:
The glass adhesion promoter described in the next step must be used to ensure a bonding of the
coupling to the glass surface. Failure to use the described adhesion promoter may result in the
coupling coming off the glass.
3. Apply Glass Adhesion Promoter, P/N 12378555 (in Canada, use P/N 88901239), to the glass in
the area where you will install the antenna coupling. Follow the Glass Adhesion Promoter
instructions on the product label.
Important:
^ On rear backglass applications the RF connections for the inner antenna coupling should run
parallel to the defogger gridline.
^ Align the inner and the outer antenna couplings.
^ Do not touch the adhesive backing on the antenna coupling.
4. Remove the protective film from the adhesive backing on the inner antenna coupling.
5. Align the inner antenna coupling to the existing exterior coupling.
6. Press firmly on all 4 corners and on the center of the antenna inner coupling (2) in order to
ensure proper adhesion to the glass (4).
Hold pressure on the inner coupling (2) for 10 to 30 seconds.
7. Ensure that no gaps occur between the couplings (5, 2) and the glass (4).
8. Connect the coaxial cable to the inner coupling (2).
9. Keep the vehicle dry. Allow 6 to 8 hours, at 15°C (60° F), for the adhesive to cure after
installation.
Coupling Replacement - Antenna Outer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Global Positioning System Antenna >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > OnStar(R) - Cellular Antenna Replacement Parts > Page 7915
Removal Procedure
Important:
Use the described adhesion promoter to assure adequate bonding of the coupling to the glass.
To obtain maximum adhesion between the new mobile antenna couplings and the glass surface,
the couplings and the glass must be kept dry and above 15°C (60° F) during the installation and for
the 6-8 hours immediately following the installation. Otherwise the new couplings may come off.
Also, disregard the drying or curing time information listed in the instructions included in the
replacement antenna coupling kits. In the near future, those instructions will be updated with the
drying or curing times listed in this bulletin.
^ Do not attempt to reinstall the original cellular couplings using any type of glue, adhesive tapes,
etc. Doing so may eliminate the cellular signal transfer through the glass and reduce the maximum
performance of the system, including the air bag deployment notification.
1. Install the inner coupling first if both the inner and the outer coupling are to be replaced.
Refer to Coupling Replacement - Antenna Inner.
Notice:
If you use a razor blade or other sharp tool in order to remove the adhesives or foreign objects from
the inside of the rear window, use the blade carefully. Damage to the grid lines may result.
2. Use a small, wide-bladed plastic tool to cut the double back tape material while lifting up on the
outer antenna coupling.
Installation Procedure
1. Clean the glass with an alcohol wipe.
2. Dry the glass thoroughly using a lint free cloth.
Important:
The glass adhesion promoter described in the next step must be used to ensure a bonding of the
coupling to the glass surface. Failure to use the described adhesion promoter may result in the
coupling coming off the glass.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Global Positioning System Antenna >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > OnStar(R) - Cellular Antenna Replacement Parts > Page 7916
3. Apply Glass Adhesion Promoter, P/N 12378555 (in Canada, use P/N 88901239), to the glass in
the area where you will install the antenna coupling. Follow the Glass Adhesion Promoter
instructions on the product label.
Important:
^ Align the outer antenna coupling with the inner coupling.
^ Do not touch the adhesive backing on the antenna coupling.
4. Remove the protective film from the adhesive backing on the outer antenna coupling.
5. Align the outer antenna coupling to the inner antenna coupling.
6. Press firmly on all 4 corners and on the center of the outer antenna coupling (5) in order to
ensure proper adhesion to the glass (4).
Hold pressure on the outer coupling (5) for 10 to 30 seconds.
7. Ensure that no gaps occur between the couplings (5, 2) and the glass (4).
8. Keep the vehicle dry. Allow 6 to 8 hours, at 15°C (60°F), for the adhesive to cure after
installation.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Antenna - Keyless Entry > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Antenna - Keyless Entry > Component Information > Locations > Page 7922
Antenna - Keyless Entry: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the instrument panel cluster trim plate. 2. Remove the instrument panel cluster. 3.
Disconnect the remote keyless entry antenna (1) from the receiver (2).
4. Remove the remote keyless entry antenna (1) from the carrier. 5. Remove the remote keyless
entry antenna from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Antenna - Keyless Entry > Component Information > Locations > Page 7923
1. Install the remote keyless entry antenna to the vehicle. 2. Install the remote keyless entry
antenna (1) to the carrier.
3. Connect the remote keyless entry antenna (1) to the receiver (2). 4. Install the instrument panel
cluster. 5. Install the instrument panel cluster trim plate. 6. Reprogram the transmitter. Refer to
Transmitter Programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning 7. Verify that
the system operates properly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Receiver > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Receiver > Component Information > Locations > Page 7927
Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Receiver > Component Information > Locations > Page 7928
Keyless Entry Receiver: Service and Repair
REMOTE CONTROL DOOR LOCK RECEIVER REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the left knee bolster. 2. Disconnect the remote keyless entry antenna (2) from the
receiver (5). 3. Disconnect the remote keyless entry electrical connector (4) from the receiver (5). 4.
Remove the remote keyless entry module screws from the bracket (3). 5. Remove the remote
keyless entry module from the carrier.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the remote keyless entry module to the carrier.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the remote keyless entry module screws to the bracket (3).
Tighten Tighten the remote keyless entry module screws to the bracket (3) to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Connect the remote keyless entry antenna (2) to the receiver (5). 4. Connect the remote keyless
entry electrical connector (4) to the receiver (5). 5. Install the left knee bolster. 6. Reprogram the
transmitter. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Receiver > Component Information > Locations > Page 7929
7. Verify that the system operates properly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Keyless Entry Transmitter Battery > Component Information > Service and Repair
Keyless Entry Transmitter Battery: Service and Repair
TRANSMITTER BATTERY REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Insert a small coin between the 2 halves of the transmitter case at the slot provided near the key
ring hole. 2. Twist the coin in order to open the case. 3. Open the transmitter case.
4. Remove the battery (2).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Keyless Entry Transmitter Battery > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 7934
1. Install the battery (2) with the positive (+) side down.
Use one 3 V CR2032 battery (or the equivalent).
2. Close the transmitter case (6, 4).
3. Ensure the seal is in position. Align the 2 halves of the case and snap the two halves together. 4.
Synchronize the transmitter. Refer to Transmitter Synchronization. 5. Replace the batteries when
the range of the transmitter decreases to less than 7 m (23 ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Lock Cylinder Switch
> Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 05-08-46-004C > Dec > 10 > OnStar(R) - Number Incorrect/Incorrectly
Assigned
Cellular Phone: Customer Interest OnStar(R) - Number Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 05-08-46-004C
Date: December 23, 2010
Subject: OnStar(R) Phone Number Concerns (Phone Number Incorrect/Assigned to Another
Vehicle/Phone) That Occur During Diagnosis of OnStar(R) System
Models:
2000-2011 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Equipped with OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years up to 2011. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 05-08-46-004B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
During diagnosis of an OnStar(R) concern, the technician may be told that the OnStar(R) phone
number is incorrect or tied to another vehicle and/or phone of some kind. To resolve these
concerns, the Tech 2(R) with software version 22.005 (or higher), has the capability to change the
OnStar(R) phone number.
Service Procedure
1. With the Tech 2(R), build the vehicle to specifications within the Diagnostics area of the Tech
2(R). 2. For vehicles with physical-based diagnostics - under Body, go to the OnStar(R) section.
Then select the Special Functions menu.
For vehicles with functional-based diagnostics - under Body and Accessories, go to the Cellular
Communication section. Select Module Setup and then Vehicle Communication Interface Module.
3. Locate the Program Phone Number prompt and select it. The original phone number will be
displayed on the Tech 2(R) screen. 4. Contact the OnStar(R) team at the GM Technical Assistance
Center (TAC) to obtain a new phone number. 5. Highlight the digits of the phone number one at a
time and enter the new phone number using the number keys on the Tech 2(R). 6. Press the Soft
key at the base of the screen for Done once these numbers have been changed on the screen. 7.
Press the Soft key for Done again. The area code or new phone number has now been
programmed into the phone. 8. Cycle the ignition to Off and open the driver's door. 9. Press the
blue OnStar(R) button to make sure that a normal connection can be made to the OnStar(R) call
center. If applicable, make sure the
Hands-Free Calling (HFC) works properly by making a phone call.
10. If the system is working properly, fax or voicemail a case closing into the OnStar(R) team at
TAC with the results. Dealers in Canada should
submit case closing information through the GM infoNET.
Please follow this diagnostic process thoroughly and complete each step. If the condition exhibited
is resolved WITHOUT completing every step, the remaining steps do not need to be performed. If
the procedure above does not resolve the condition, you must contact TAC for further assistance.
This diagnostic approach was developed specifically for this condition and should not automatically
be used for other vehicles with similar symptoms.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 05-08-46-004C > Dec > 10 > OnStar(R) - Number Incorrect/Incorrectly
Assigned > Page 7946
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 02-08-46-006C > Jan > 08 > OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position
Reported During Call
Cellular Phone: Customer Interest OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position Reported During Call
Bulletin No.: 02-08-46-006C
Date: January 08, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Incorrect OnStar(R) Global Positioning System (GPS) Location Reported During
OnStar(R) Call
Models: 2000-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2008
HUMMER H2 2006-2008 HUMMER H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
with OnStar(R)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
02-08-46-006B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
A small number of the above-mentioned vehicles may exhibit a condition in which the vehicle
reports an inaccurate location to the OnStar(R) Call Center. This condition can only be identified
via a button press to the OnStar(R) Call Center by the customer. Call Center personnel will be able
to identify this inaccurate location condition. Customers will then be notified through the mail by
OnStar(R) if their vehicle exhibits this condition. Once this condition has been identified OnStar(R)
will instruct the customer to return to the dealership to have this condition corrected.
It is not necessary to reconfigure the vehicle after the following procedure.
In order to correct this condition you must cycle power to the OnStar(R) system. This can be done
by either removing the fuses powering the OnStar(R) system or disconnecting the OnStar(R)
module (VCIM) from the vehicle. As a last resort you can disconnect the vehicle's battery.
The power needs to be removed from the system for approximately 15 minutes.
After completing this procedure the vehicle should be taken to an area with an unobstructed view of
the sky. The vehicle should be kept running for approximately 10 minutes to allow the vehicle to
reacquire the global positioning system (GPS). Then contact the OnStar(R) Call Center via the blue
OnStar(R) button and ask the advisor to verify the GPS position.
If the OnStar(R) advisor still has an inaccurate GPS location refer to the Navigation Systems and
Cellular Communications sub-sections in the Service Manual in order to diagnose and repair the
concern. If the normal diagnostics lead to module replacement you will need to contact Technical
Assistance (TAC) and choose the OnStar(R) prompt. GM OnStar(R) TAC will assist in the
diagnosis and if appropriate order a replacement part. Replacement parts are usually shipped out
within 24 hours and a pre-paid return package label will be included for returning the faulty part. By
returning the faulty part you will avoid a significant non-return core charge.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab US Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Warranty Information (Saab US Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 02-08-46-006C > Jan > 08 > OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position
Reported During Call > Page 7951
For vehicles repaired under warranty use, the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone: > 05-08-46-004C > Dec > 10 > OnStar(R) Number Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned
Cellular Phone: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Number Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 05-08-46-004C
Date: December 23, 2010
Subject: OnStar(R) Phone Number Concerns (Phone Number Incorrect/Assigned to Another
Vehicle/Phone) That Occur During Diagnosis of OnStar(R) System
Models:
2000-2011 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Equipped with OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years up to 2011. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 05-08-46-004B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
During diagnosis of an OnStar(R) concern, the technician may be told that the OnStar(R) phone
number is incorrect or tied to another vehicle and/or phone of some kind. To resolve these
concerns, the Tech 2(R) with software version 22.005 (or higher), has the capability to change the
OnStar(R) phone number.
Service Procedure
1. With the Tech 2(R), build the vehicle to specifications within the Diagnostics area of the Tech
2(R). 2. For vehicles with physical-based diagnostics - under Body, go to the OnStar(R) section.
Then select the Special Functions menu.
For vehicles with functional-based diagnostics - under Body and Accessories, go to the Cellular
Communication section. Select Module Setup and then Vehicle Communication Interface Module.
3. Locate the Program Phone Number prompt and select it. The original phone number will be
displayed on the Tech 2(R) screen. 4. Contact the OnStar(R) team at the GM Technical Assistance
Center (TAC) to obtain a new phone number. 5. Highlight the digits of the phone number one at a
time and enter the new phone number using the number keys on the Tech 2(R). 6. Press the Soft
key at the base of the screen for Done once these numbers have been changed on the screen. 7.
Press the Soft key for Done again. The area code or new phone number has now been
programmed into the phone. 8. Cycle the ignition to Off and open the driver's door. 9. Press the
blue OnStar(R) button to make sure that a normal connection can be made to the OnStar(R) call
center. If applicable, make sure the
Hands-Free Calling (HFC) works properly by making a phone call.
10. If the system is working properly, fax or voicemail a case closing into the OnStar(R) team at
TAC with the results. Dealers in Canada should
submit case closing information through the GM infoNET.
Please follow this diagnostic process thoroughly and complete each step. If the condition exhibited
is resolved WITHOUT completing every step, the remaining steps do not need to be performed. If
the procedure above does not resolve the condition, you must contact TAC for further assistance.
This diagnostic approach was developed specifically for this condition and should not automatically
be used for other vehicles with similar symptoms.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone: > 05-08-46-004C > Dec > 10 > OnStar(R) Number Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned > Page 7957
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone: > 02-08-44-007D > May > 09 > OnStar(R) Negative Impact of Cloth/Vinyl Roofs
Cellular Phone: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Negative Impact of Cloth/Vinyl Roofs
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 02-08-44-007D
Date: May 12, 2009
Subject: Negative Impact of Dealer-Installed Cloth/Vinyl Roofs on XM Radio and/or OnStar(R)
Systems
Models:
2002-2009 Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2009
HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X with XM Radio (RPO U2K) and/or OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................................................. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to
include the 2009 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-08-44-007C (Section
08 - Body and Accessories).
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................
Dealers should not install a cloth or vinyl roof on vehicles that have been ordered with the XM radio
option (RPO U2K) and/or OnStar(R) (RPO UE1). The performance of these systems may be
negatively impacted by the installation of the cloth/vinyl roof. Additionally, water leaks may result
from installing a cloth or vinyl roof on vehicles with roof-mounted antenna systems. Relocating the
antenna to another spot on the vehicle exterior, in order to install a cloth or vinyl roof, is not advised
either. The performance of the OnStar(R) and XM Radio antennas has been optimized for their
current locations. Relocating the antennas may result in a performance degradation.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone: > 00-08-46-004C > Jan > 08 > OnStar(R) Re-establishing OnStar(R) Communications
Cellular Phone: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Re-establishing OnStar(R)
Communications
Bulletin No.: 00-08-46-004C
Date: January 17, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Re-establishing Communications with OnStar(R) Center After Battery Disconnect
Models: 2000-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn and Saab)
with Digital OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-08-46-004B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
When servicing any of the above models and a battery cable is disconnected or power to the
OnStar(R) Vehicle Communication Interface Module (VCIM) is interrupted for any reason the
following procedure must be performed to verify proper Global Positioning System (GPS) function.
Never swap OnStar(R) Vehicle Communication Interface Modules (VCIM) from other vehicles.
Transfer of OnStar(R) modules from other vehicles should not be done. Each OnStar(R) module
has a unique identification number. The VCIM has a specific Station Identification (STID). This
identification number is used by the National Cellular Telephone Network and OnStar(R) systems
and is stored in General Motors Vehicle History files by VIN.
After completing ALL repairs to the vehicle you must perform the following procedure:
Move the vehicle into an open area of the service lot.
Sit in the vehicle with the engine running and the radio turned on for five minutes.
Press the OnStar(R) button in the vehicle.
When the OnStar(R) advisor answers ask the advisor to verify the current location of the vehicle.
If the vehicle location is different than the location the OnStar(R) advisor gives contact GM
Technical Assistance (TAC) and choose the OnStar(R) prompt. GM OnStar(R) TAC will assist in
the diagnosis of a failed VCIM and, if appropriate, order a replacement part. Replacement parts are
usually shipped out within 24 hours, and a pre-paid return package label will be included for
returning the faulty part. By returning the faulty part, you will avoid a non-return core charge.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone: > 02-08-46-006C > Jan > 08 > OnStar(R) Incorrect GPS Position Reported During Call
Cellular Phone: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position Reported During
Call
Bulletin No.: 02-08-46-006C
Date: January 08, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Incorrect OnStar(R) Global Positioning System (GPS) Location Reported During
OnStar(R) Call
Models: 2000-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2008
HUMMER H2 2006-2008 HUMMER H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
with OnStar(R)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
02-08-46-006B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
A small number of the above-mentioned vehicles may exhibit a condition in which the vehicle
reports an inaccurate location to the OnStar(R) Call Center. This condition can only be identified
via a button press to the OnStar(R) Call Center by the customer. Call Center personnel will be able
to identify this inaccurate location condition. Customers will then be notified through the mail by
OnStar(R) if their vehicle exhibits this condition. Once this condition has been identified OnStar(R)
will instruct the customer to return to the dealership to have this condition corrected.
It is not necessary to reconfigure the vehicle after the following procedure.
In order to correct this condition you must cycle power to the OnStar(R) system. This can be done
by either removing the fuses powering the OnStar(R) system or disconnecting the OnStar(R)
module (VCIM) from the vehicle. As a last resort you can disconnect the vehicle's battery.
The power needs to be removed from the system for approximately 15 minutes.
After completing this procedure the vehicle should be taken to an area with an unobstructed view of
the sky. The vehicle should be kept running for approximately 10 minutes to allow the vehicle to
reacquire the global positioning system (GPS). Then contact the OnStar(R) Call Center via the blue
OnStar(R) button and ask the advisor to verify the GPS position.
If the OnStar(R) advisor still has an inaccurate GPS location refer to the Navigation Systems and
Cellular Communications sub-sections in the Service Manual in order to diagnose and repair the
concern. If the normal diagnostics lead to module replacement you will need to contact Technical
Assistance (TAC) and choose the OnStar(R) prompt. GM OnStar(R) TAC will assist in the
diagnosis and if appropriate order a replacement part. Replacement parts are usually shipped out
within 24 hours and a pre-paid return package label will be included for returning the faulty part. By
returning the faulty part you will avoid a significant non-return core charge.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab US Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Warranty Information (Saab US Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone: > 02-08-46-006C > Jan > 08 > OnStar(R) Incorrect GPS Position Reported During Call > Page 7970
For vehicles repaired under warranty use, the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone: > 02-08-46-004A > Apr > 06 > Cell Phone Error Messages, Bulletin Cancellation
Cellular Phone: All Technical Service Bulletins Cell Phone - Error Messages, Bulletin Cancellation
Bulletin No.: 02-08-46-004A
Date: April 11, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Cellular Error Messages Received When Trying to Connect to OnStar(R)
Models: 2000-2002 Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks
with Factory-Installed OnStar(R)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to cancel this bulletin. The Subject information is addressed in
Corporate Bulletin Number 03-08-46-004B. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
02-08-46-004 (Section 08 - Body & Accessories).
Please reference Corporate Bulletin Number 03-08-46-004B for the Subject information.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone: > 01-08-46-004A > Mar > 05 >
OnStar(R)/Cell Phone - Integration
Cellular Phone: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R)/Cell Phone - Integration
Bulletin No.: 01-08-46-004A
Date: March 08, 2005
INFORMATION
Subject: Vehicle Integration of Cellular Phones and Normal Operating Characteristics
Models: 2002 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks
Supercede:
This bulletin is being issued to cancel Corporate Bulletin Number 01-08-46-004. Please discard all
copies of Corporate Bulletin Number 01-08-46-004 (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
This bulletin effectively cancels Corporate Bulletin Number 01-08-46-004. OnStar(R) no longer
offers cellular phones as part of the OnStar(R) system.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone: > 02-08-44-007D > May > 09 > OnStar(R) Negative Impact of Cloth/Vinyl Roofs
Cellular Phone: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Negative Impact of Cloth/Vinyl Roofs
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 02-08-44-007D
Date: May 12, 2009
Subject: Negative Impact of Dealer-Installed Cloth/Vinyl Roofs on XM Radio and/or OnStar(R)
Systems
Models:
2002-2009 Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2009
HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X with XM Radio (RPO U2K) and/or OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................................................. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to
include the 2009 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-08-44-007C (Section
08 - Body and Accessories).
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................
Dealers should not install a cloth or vinyl roof on vehicles that have been ordered with the XM radio
option (RPO U2K) and/or OnStar(R) (RPO UE1). The performance of these systems may be
negatively impacted by the installation of the cloth/vinyl roof. Additionally, water leaks may result
from installing a cloth or vinyl roof on vehicles with roof-mounted antenna systems. Relocating the
antenna to another spot on the vehicle exterior, in order to install a cloth or vinyl roof, is not advised
either. The performance of the OnStar(R) and XM Radio antennas has been optimized for their
current locations. Relocating the antennas may result in a performance degradation.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone: > 00-08-46-004C > Jan > 08 > OnStar(R) Re-establishing OnStar(R) Communications
Cellular Phone: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Re-establishing OnStar(R)
Communications
Bulletin No.: 00-08-46-004C
Date: January 17, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Re-establishing Communications with OnStar(R) Center After Battery Disconnect
Models: 2000-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn and Saab)
with Digital OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-08-46-004B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
When servicing any of the above models and a battery cable is disconnected or power to the
OnStar(R) Vehicle Communication Interface Module (VCIM) is interrupted for any reason the
following procedure must be performed to verify proper Global Positioning System (GPS) function.
Never swap OnStar(R) Vehicle Communication Interface Modules (VCIM) from other vehicles.
Transfer of OnStar(R) modules from other vehicles should not be done. Each OnStar(R) module
has a unique identification number. The VCIM has a specific Station Identification (STID). This
identification number is used by the National Cellular Telephone Network and OnStar(R) systems
and is stored in General Motors Vehicle History files by VIN.
After completing ALL repairs to the vehicle you must perform the following procedure:
Move the vehicle into an open area of the service lot.
Sit in the vehicle with the engine running and the radio turned on for five minutes.
Press the OnStar(R) button in the vehicle.
When the OnStar(R) advisor answers ask the advisor to verify the current location of the vehicle.
If the vehicle location is different than the location the OnStar(R) advisor gives contact GM
Technical Assistance (TAC) and choose the OnStar(R) prompt. GM OnStar(R) TAC will assist in
the diagnosis of a failed VCIM and, if appropriate, order a replacement part. Replacement parts are
usually shipped out within 24 hours, and a pre-paid return package label will be included for
returning the faulty part. By returning the faulty part, you will avoid a non-return core charge.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone: > 02-08-46-004A > Apr > 06 > Cell Phone Error Messages, Bulletin Cancellation
Cellular Phone: All Technical Service Bulletins Cell Phone - Error Messages, Bulletin Cancellation
Bulletin No.: 02-08-46-004A
Date: April 11, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Cellular Error Messages Received When Trying to Connect to OnStar(R)
Models: 2000-2002 Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks
with Factory-Installed OnStar(R)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to cancel this bulletin. The Subject information is addressed in
Corporate Bulletin Number 03-08-46-004B. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
02-08-46-004 (Section 08 - Body & Accessories).
Please reference Corporate Bulletin Number 03-08-46-004B for the Subject information.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone: > 01-08-46-004A > Mar > 05 > OnStar(R)/Cell
Phone - Integration
Cellular Phone: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R)/Cell Phone - Integration
Bulletin No.: 01-08-46-004A
Date: March 08, 2005
INFORMATION
Subject: Vehicle Integration of Cellular Phones and Normal Operating Characteristics
Models: 2002 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks
Supercede:
This bulletin is being issued to cancel Corporate Bulletin Number 01-08-46-004. Please discard all
copies of Corporate Bulletin Number 01-08-46-004 (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
This bulletin effectively cancels Corporate Bulletin Number 01-08-46-004. OnStar(R) no longer
offers cellular phones as part of the OnStar(R) system.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8000
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8001
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8002
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8003
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8004
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8005
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8006
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8007
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8008
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8009
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8010
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8011
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8012
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8013
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8014
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8015
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8016
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8017
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8018
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8019
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8020
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8021
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8022
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8023
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8024
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8025
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8026
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8027
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8028
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8029
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8030
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8031
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Connector Views
Ambient Air Temperature Sensor (DIC)
Driver Information Center (DIC)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8032
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Electrical Diagrams
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators Diagrams.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 8033
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 05-08-46-004C > Dec > 10 > OnStar(R) - Number
Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned
Emergency Contact Module: Customer Interest OnStar(R) - Number Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 05-08-46-004C
Date: December 23, 2010
Subject: OnStar(R) Phone Number Concerns (Phone Number Incorrect/Assigned to Another
Vehicle/Phone) That Occur During Diagnosis of OnStar(R) System
Models:
2000-2011 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Equipped with OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years up to 2011. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 05-08-46-004B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
During diagnosis of an OnStar(R) concern, the technician may be told that the OnStar(R) phone
number is incorrect or tied to another vehicle and/or phone of some kind. To resolve these
concerns, the Tech 2(R) with software version 22.005 (or higher), has the capability to change the
OnStar(R) phone number.
Service Procedure
1. With the Tech 2(R), build the vehicle to specifications within the Diagnostics area of the Tech
2(R). 2. For vehicles with physical-based diagnostics - under Body, go to the OnStar(R) section.
Then select the Special Functions menu.
For vehicles with functional-based diagnostics - under Body and Accessories, go to the Cellular
Communication section. Select Module Setup and then Vehicle Communication Interface Module.
3. Locate the Program Phone Number prompt and select it. The original phone number will be
displayed on the Tech 2(R) screen. 4. Contact the OnStar(R) team at the GM Technical Assistance
Center (TAC) to obtain a new phone number. 5. Highlight the digits of the phone number one at a
time and enter the new phone number using the number keys on the Tech 2(R). 6. Press the Soft
key at the base of the screen for Done once these numbers have been changed on the screen. 7.
Press the Soft key for Done again. The area code or new phone number has now been
programmed into the phone. 8. Cycle the ignition to Off and open the driver's door. 9. Press the
blue OnStar(R) button to make sure that a normal connection can be made to the OnStar(R) call
center. If applicable, make sure the
Hands-Free Calling (HFC) works properly by making a phone call.
10. If the system is working properly, fax or voicemail a case closing into the OnStar(R) team at
TAC with the results. Dealers in Canada should
submit case closing information through the GM infoNET.
Please follow this diagnostic process thoroughly and complete each step. If the condition exhibited
is resolved WITHOUT completing every step, the remaining steps do not need to be performed. If
the procedure above does not resolve the condition, you must contact TAC for further assistance.
This diagnostic approach was developed specifically for this condition and should not automatically
be used for other vehicles with similar symptoms.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 05-08-46-004C > Dec > 10 > OnStar(R) - Number
Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned > Page 8042
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 02-08-46-006C > Jan > 08 > OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS
Position Reported During Call
Emergency Contact Module: Customer Interest OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position Reported
During Call
Bulletin No.: 02-08-46-006C
Date: January 08, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Incorrect OnStar(R) Global Positioning System (GPS) Location Reported During
OnStar(R) Call
Models: 2000-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2008
HUMMER H2 2006-2008 HUMMER H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
with OnStar(R)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
02-08-46-006B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
A small number of the above-mentioned vehicles may exhibit a condition in which the vehicle
reports an inaccurate location to the OnStar(R) Call Center. This condition can only be identified
via a button press to the OnStar(R) Call Center by the customer. Call Center personnel will be able
to identify this inaccurate location condition. Customers will then be notified through the mail by
OnStar(R) if their vehicle exhibits this condition. Once this condition has been identified OnStar(R)
will instruct the customer to return to the dealership to have this condition corrected.
It is not necessary to reconfigure the vehicle after the following procedure.
In order to correct this condition you must cycle power to the OnStar(R) system. This can be done
by either removing the fuses powering the OnStar(R) system or disconnecting the OnStar(R)
module (VCIM) from the vehicle. As a last resort you can disconnect the vehicle's battery.
The power needs to be removed from the system for approximately 15 minutes.
After completing this procedure the vehicle should be taken to an area with an unobstructed view of
the sky. The vehicle should be kept running for approximately 10 minutes to allow the vehicle to
reacquire the global positioning system (GPS). Then contact the OnStar(R) Call Center via the blue
OnStar(R) button and ask the advisor to verify the GPS position.
If the OnStar(R) advisor still has an inaccurate GPS location refer to the Navigation Systems and
Cellular Communications sub-sections in the Service Manual in order to diagnose and repair the
concern. If the normal diagnostics lead to module replacement you will need to contact Technical
Assistance (TAC) and choose the OnStar(R) prompt. GM OnStar(R) TAC will assist in the
diagnosis and if appropriate order a replacement part. Replacement parts are usually shipped out
within 24 hours and a pre-paid return package label will be included for returning the faulty part. By
returning the faulty part you will avoid a significant non-return core charge.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab US Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Warranty Information (Saab US Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 02-08-46-006C > Jan > 08 > OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS
Position Reported During Call > Page 8047
For vehicles repaired under warranty use, the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 02-08-46-007C > Nov > 07 > OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS
Signal/Hands Free Issues
Emergency Contact Module: Customer Interest OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands Free Issues
Bulletin No.: 02-08-46-007C
Date: November 19, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Information on OnStar(R) System - Possible Loss of GPS Signal, Hands-Free Calling
Minutes Expire Prematurely and/or Inability to Add Hands-Free Calling Minutes
Models: 2001-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2008
HUMMER H2 2006-2008 HUMMER H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
with OnStar(R) System (RPO UE1)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2008 model year, warranty information and to provide GPS
signal recovery steps (under Dealer Action heading) to do PRIOR to determining if the VIU/VCIM
needs replacement. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-08-46-007B (Section 08 - Body
& Accessories).
If the vehicle currently has analog-upgradable OnStar(R) hardware, then the customer should be
made aware of the digital upgrade program per the latest version of Service Bulletin #
05-08-46-006. Any analog OnStar system that is not upgraded prior to the end of 2007 will be
deactivated due to the upcoming phase-out of the analog cellular network in the U.S. and Canada.
If the vehicle has recently been upgraded or has had a service replacement unit installed, this
bulletin may not be applicable.
Certain 2001-2008 model year vehicles equipped with OnStar(R) may exhibit a condition with the
Global Positioning System (GPS) that causes inaccuracies in the GPS clock. The GPS system is
internal to the OnStar(R) Vehicle Interface Unit (VIU) or the Vehicle Communication Interface
Module (VCIM). This inaccuracy can result in a symptom where the OnStar(R) Call Center is
unable to obtain an accurate GPS signal, hands-Free Calling minutes expire prematurely and/or
the inability to add Hands-Free calling minutes.
Customer Notification
OnStar(R) will notify the customer by mail with instructions to contact their dealership service
department.
Dealer Action
Not all vehicles will require VIU/VCIM replacement.
The GPS signal in some vehicles may be recoverable. To determine if the signal is recoverable,
simply connect the Tech2(R) and using the GPS information data display option, observe the GPS
date and time. If the date/time stamps are equal to a date approximately 19 years in the future, the
GPS clock has exceeded its capacity and the VIU/VCIM will need to be replaced. If the date/time
stamp is in the past or near future, the GPS clock has simply generated an inaccurate value and
may be recoverable by performing the following power-up reset.
To initiate a power-up reset, battery voltage (batt. +) must be removed from the VIU/VCIM. The
preferred methods, in order, of initiating the reset are outlined below.
Remove the fuse that supplies Battery positive (Batt. +) voltage to the module (refer to the
applicable Service Information schematics for the appropriate fuse).
The next preferred method is to remove the connector to the OnStar(R) unit that Batt + is
contained.
The least preferable method is to remove the negative terminal of the vehicle battery. This will not
only initiate the power-up reset, but it may also result in the loss of radio presets and other stored
personalization information/settings in other modules as well.
After initiating the power-up reset, the GPS data will be set to the defaulted date and time and will
require an acquisition of the GPS signal in order to gain the proper date and time.
Acquiring the GPS signal requires running the vehicle in an open/unobstructed view of the sky.
First, contact OnStar(R) Technical Support by pressing the blue button. Allow the OnStar(R)
Technical Advisor to activate the GPS recovery process. This should take approximately 10
minutes. Continue to
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 02-08-46-007C > Nov > 07 > OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS
Signal/Hands Free Issues > Page 8052
monitor the Tech2(R) for the current time and date. REMINDER - Keep in mind that the time
displayed on the Tech2(R) is in Greenwich Mean Time (GMT) and the offset is based on the time
zones relationship to GMT.
If replacement of the VIU/VCIM is necessary, you MUST reconfigure the OnStar® system. Failure
to reconfigure the system will result in an additional customer visit for repair. OnStar® VIU,
Generations 2 and 3, will require the technician to press the blue OnStar® button to reconfigure the
vehicle with an OnStar® advisor.
OnStar(R) VCIM, Generations 4-7 will require the technician to reconfigure the vehicle with the use
of the TIS2WEB and SPS applications (pass thru only), along with the Tech2(R).
The configuration and set-up procedure is a two-step process that must be completed step-by-step
without interruption or delay in between each step. This procedure enables an automated activation
without a button press by the technician to the OnStar(R) Call Center. Following this procedure, it
may take up to 24 hours for all OnStar(R) services to be fully activated.
How to Order Parts
If the OnStar(R) GPS date/time stamp is non-recoverable and the unit needs to be replaced,
dealers in the U.S. should contact Autocraft Electronics select the catalog item that contains this
bulletin number. Canadian dealers should contact MASS Electronics.
Dealers DO NOT need to call the GM Technical Assistance Center (TAC) for replacement
approval. Autocraft Electronics and MASS Electronics will be responsible for verifying that the
subject vehicle is a candidate for a replacement VIU/VCIM.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 02-08-46-007C > Nov > 07 > OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS
Signal/Hands Free Issues > Page 8053
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 05-08-46-004C
> Dec > 10 > OnStar(R) - Number Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Number
Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 05-08-46-004C
Date: December 23, 2010
Subject: OnStar(R) Phone Number Concerns (Phone Number Incorrect/Assigned to Another
Vehicle/Phone) That Occur During Diagnosis of OnStar(R) System
Models:
2000-2011 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Equipped with OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years up to 2011. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 05-08-46-004B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
During diagnosis of an OnStar(R) concern, the technician may be told that the OnStar(R) phone
number is incorrect or tied to another vehicle and/or phone of some kind. To resolve these
concerns, the Tech 2(R) with software version 22.005 (or higher), has the capability to change the
OnStar(R) phone number.
Service Procedure
1. With the Tech 2(R), build the vehicle to specifications within the Diagnostics area of the Tech
2(R). 2. For vehicles with physical-based diagnostics - under Body, go to the OnStar(R) section.
Then select the Special Functions menu.
For vehicles with functional-based diagnostics - under Body and Accessories, go to the Cellular
Communication section. Select Module Setup and then Vehicle Communication Interface Module.
3. Locate the Program Phone Number prompt and select it. The original phone number will be
displayed on the Tech 2(R) screen. 4. Contact the OnStar(R) team at the GM Technical Assistance
Center (TAC) to obtain a new phone number. 5. Highlight the digits of the phone number one at a
time and enter the new phone number using the number keys on the Tech 2(R). 6. Press the Soft
key at the base of the screen for Done once these numbers have been changed on the screen. 7.
Press the Soft key for Done again. The area code or new phone number has now been
programmed into the phone. 8. Cycle the ignition to Off and open the driver's door. 9. Press the
blue OnStar(R) button to make sure that a normal connection can be made to the OnStar(R) call
center. If applicable, make sure the
Hands-Free Calling (HFC) works properly by making a phone call.
10. If the system is working properly, fax or voicemail a case closing into the OnStar(R) team at
TAC with the results. Dealers in Canada should
submit case closing information through the GM infoNET.
Please follow this diagnostic process thoroughly and complete each step. If the condition exhibited
is resolved WITHOUT completing every step, the remaining steps do not need to be performed. If
the procedure above does not resolve the condition, you must contact TAC for further assistance.
This diagnostic approach was developed specifically for this condition and should not automatically
be used for other vehicles with similar symptoms.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 05-08-46-004C
> Dec > 10 > OnStar(R) - Number Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned > Page 8059
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 02-08-44-007D
> May > 09 > OnStar(R) - Negative Impact of Cloth/Vinyl Roofs
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Negative Impact of
Cloth/Vinyl Roofs
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 02-08-44-007D
Date: May 12, 2009
Subject: Negative Impact of Dealer-Installed Cloth/Vinyl Roofs on XM Radio and/or OnStar(R)
Systems
Models:
2002-2009 Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2009
HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X with XM Radio (RPO U2K) and/or OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................................................. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to
include the 2009 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-08-44-007C (Section
08 - Body and Accessories).
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................
Dealers should not install a cloth or vinyl roof on vehicles that have been ordered with the XM radio
option (RPO U2K) and/or OnStar(R) (RPO UE1). The performance of these systems may be
negatively impacted by the installation of the cloth/vinyl roof. Additionally, water leaks may result
from installing a cloth or vinyl roof on vehicles with roof-mounted antenna systems. Relocating the
antenna to another spot on the vehicle exterior, in order to install a cloth or vinyl roof, is not advised
either. The performance of the OnStar(R) and XM Radio antennas has been optimized for their
current locations. Relocating the antennas may result in a performance degradation.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 08-08-46-004
> Aug > 08 > OnStar(R) - Aftermarket Device Interference Information
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Aftermarket Device
Interference Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-08-46-004
Date: August 14, 2008
Subject: Information on Aftermarket Device Interference with OnStar(R) Diagnostic Services
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Car and Truck (including Saturn) 2009 and Prior HUMMER
H2, H3 Models 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
with OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
This bulletin is being issued to provide dealer service personnel with information regarding
aftermarket devices connected to the Diagnostic Link Connector (DLC) and the impact to
OnStar(R) diagnostic probes and Vehicle Diagnostic e-mails.
Certain aftermarket devices, when connected to the Diagnostic Link Connector, such as, but not
limited to, Scan Tools, Trip Computers, Fuel Economy Analyzers and Insurance Tracking Devices,
interfere with OnStar's ability to perform a diagnostic probe when requested (via a blue button call)
by a subscriber. These devices also prohibit the ability to gather diagnostic and tire pressure data
for a subscriber's scheduled OnStar(R) Vehicle Diagnostic (OVD) e-mail.
These aftermarket devices utilize the Vehicles serial data bus to perform data requests and/or
information gathering. When these devices are requesting data, OnStar(R) is designed not to
interfere with any data request being made by these devices as required by OBD II regulations.
The OnStar(R) advisor is unable to definitively detect the presence of these devices and will only
be able to inform the caller or requester of the unsuccessful or incomplete probe and may in some
cases refer the subscriber/requester to take the vehicle to a dealer for diagnosis of the concern.
When performing a diagnostic check for an unsuccessful or incomplete OnStar(R) diagnostic
probe, or for concerns regarding completeness of the OnStar(R) Vehicle Diagnostic (OVD) e-mail,
verify that an aftermarket device was not present at the time of the requested probe. Regarding the
OVD e-mail, if an aftermarket device is interfering (including a Scan Tool of any type), the e-mail
will consistently display a "yellow" indication in diagnostics section for all vehicle systems except
the OnStar(R) System and Tire Pressure data (not available on all vehicles) will not be displayed
(i.e. section is collapsed). Successful diagnostic probes and complete OVD e-mails will resume
following the removal or disconnecting of the off-board device.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 00-08-46-004C
> Jan > 08 > OnStar(R) - Re-establishing OnStar(R) Communications
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Re-establishing OnStar(R)
Communications
Bulletin No.: 00-08-46-004C
Date: January 17, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Re-establishing Communications with OnStar(R) Center After Battery Disconnect
Models: 2000-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn and Saab)
with Digital OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-08-46-004B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
When servicing any of the above models and a battery cable is disconnected or power to the
OnStar(R) Vehicle Communication Interface Module (VCIM) is interrupted for any reason the
following procedure must be performed to verify proper Global Positioning System (GPS) function.
Never swap OnStar(R) Vehicle Communication Interface Modules (VCIM) from other vehicles.
Transfer of OnStar(R) modules from other vehicles should not be done. Each OnStar(R) module
has a unique identification number. The VCIM has a specific Station Identification (STID). This
identification number is used by the National Cellular Telephone Network and OnStar(R) systems
and is stored in General Motors Vehicle History files by VIN.
After completing ALL repairs to the vehicle you must perform the following procedure:
Move the vehicle into an open area of the service lot.
Sit in the vehicle with the engine running and the radio turned on for five minutes.
Press the OnStar(R) button in the vehicle.
When the OnStar(R) advisor answers ask the advisor to verify the current location of the vehicle.
If the vehicle location is different than the location the OnStar(R) advisor gives contact GM
Technical Assistance (TAC) and choose the OnStar(R) prompt. GM OnStar(R) TAC will assist in
the diagnosis of a failed VCIM and, if appropriate, order a replacement part. Replacement parts are
usually shipped out within 24 hours, and a pre-paid return package label will be included for
returning the faulty part. By returning the faulty part, you will avoid a non-return core charge.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 02-08-46-006C
> Jan > 08 > OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position Reported During Call
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position
Reported During Call
Bulletin No.: 02-08-46-006C
Date: January 08, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Incorrect OnStar(R) Global Positioning System (GPS) Location Reported During
OnStar(R) Call
Models: 2000-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2008
HUMMER H2 2006-2008 HUMMER H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
with OnStar(R)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
02-08-46-006B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
A small number of the above-mentioned vehicles may exhibit a condition in which the vehicle
reports an inaccurate location to the OnStar(R) Call Center. This condition can only be identified
via a button press to the OnStar(R) Call Center by the customer. Call Center personnel will be able
to identify this inaccurate location condition. Customers will then be notified through the mail by
OnStar(R) if their vehicle exhibits this condition. Once this condition has been identified OnStar(R)
will instruct the customer to return to the dealership to have this condition corrected.
It is not necessary to reconfigure the vehicle after the following procedure.
In order to correct this condition you must cycle power to the OnStar(R) system. This can be done
by either removing the fuses powering the OnStar(R) system or disconnecting the OnStar(R)
module (VCIM) from the vehicle. As a last resort you can disconnect the vehicle's battery.
The power needs to be removed from the system for approximately 15 minutes.
After completing this procedure the vehicle should be taken to an area with an unobstructed view of
the sky. The vehicle should be kept running for approximately 10 minutes to allow the vehicle to
reacquire the global positioning system (GPS). Then contact the OnStar(R) Call Center via the blue
OnStar(R) button and ask the advisor to verify the GPS position.
If the OnStar(R) advisor still has an inaccurate GPS location refer to the Navigation Systems and
Cellular Communications sub-sections in the Service Manual in order to diagnose and repair the
concern. If the normal diagnostics lead to module replacement you will need to contact Technical
Assistance (TAC) and choose the OnStar(R) prompt. GM OnStar(R) TAC will assist in the
diagnosis and if appropriate order a replacement part. Replacement parts are usually shipped out
within 24 hours and a pre-paid return package label will be included for returning the faulty part. By
returning the faulty part you will avoid a significant non-return core charge.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab US Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Warranty Information (Saab US Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 02-08-46-006C
> Jan > 08 > OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position Reported During Call > Page 8076
For vehicles repaired under warranty use, the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 02-08-46-007C
> Nov > 07 > OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands Free Issues
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands
Free Issues
Bulletin No.: 02-08-46-007C
Date: November 19, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Information on OnStar(R) System - Possible Loss of GPS Signal, Hands-Free Calling
Minutes Expire Prematurely and/or Inability to Add Hands-Free Calling Minutes
Models: 2001-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2008
HUMMER H2 2006-2008 HUMMER H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
with OnStar(R) System (RPO UE1)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2008 model year, warranty information and to provide GPS
signal recovery steps (under Dealer Action heading) to do PRIOR to determining if the VIU/VCIM
needs replacement. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-08-46-007B (Section 08 - Body
& Accessories).
If the vehicle currently has analog-upgradable OnStar(R) hardware, then the customer should be
made aware of the digital upgrade program per the latest version of Service Bulletin #
05-08-46-006. Any analog OnStar system that is not upgraded prior to the end of 2007 will be
deactivated due to the upcoming phase-out of the analog cellular network in the U.S. and Canada.
If the vehicle has recently been upgraded or has had a service replacement unit installed, this
bulletin may not be applicable.
Certain 2001-2008 model year vehicles equipped with OnStar(R) may exhibit a condition with the
Global Positioning System (GPS) that causes inaccuracies in the GPS clock. The GPS system is
internal to the OnStar(R) Vehicle Interface Unit (VIU) or the Vehicle Communication Interface
Module (VCIM). This inaccuracy can result in a symptom where the OnStar(R) Call Center is
unable to obtain an accurate GPS signal, hands-Free Calling minutes expire prematurely and/or
the inability to add Hands-Free calling minutes.
Customer Notification
OnStar(R) will notify the customer by mail with instructions to contact their dealership service
department.
Dealer Action
Not all vehicles will require VIU/VCIM replacement.
The GPS signal in some vehicles may be recoverable. To determine if the signal is recoverable,
simply connect the Tech2(R) and using the GPS information data display option, observe the GPS
date and time. If the date/time stamps are equal to a date approximately 19 years in the future, the
GPS clock has exceeded its capacity and the VIU/VCIM will need to be replaced. If the date/time
stamp is in the past or near future, the GPS clock has simply generated an inaccurate value and
may be recoverable by performing the following power-up reset.
To initiate a power-up reset, battery voltage (batt. +) must be removed from the VIU/VCIM. The
preferred methods, in order, of initiating the reset are outlined below.
Remove the fuse that supplies Battery positive (Batt. +) voltage to the module (refer to the
applicable Service Information schematics for the appropriate fuse).
The next preferred method is to remove the connector to the OnStar(R) unit that Batt + is
contained.
The least preferable method is to remove the negative terminal of the vehicle battery. This will not
only initiate the power-up reset, but it may also result in the loss of radio presets and other stored
personalization information/settings in other modules as well.
After initiating the power-up reset, the GPS data will be set to the defaulted date and time and will
require an acquisition of the GPS signal in order to gain the proper date and time.
Acquiring the GPS signal requires running the vehicle in an open/unobstructed view of the sky.
First, contact OnStar(R) Technical Support by pressing the blue button. Allow the OnStar(R)
Technical Advisor to activate the GPS recovery process. This should take approximately 10
minutes. Continue to
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 02-08-46-007C
> Nov > 07 > OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands Free Issues > Page 8081
monitor the Tech2(R) for the current time and date. REMINDER - Keep in mind that the time
displayed on the Tech2(R) is in Greenwich Mean Time (GMT) and the offset is based on the time
zones relationship to GMT.
If replacement of the VIU/VCIM is necessary, you MUST reconfigure the OnStar® system. Failure
to reconfigure the system will result in an additional customer visit for repair. OnStar® VIU,
Generations 2 and 3, will require the technician to press the blue OnStar® button to reconfigure the
vehicle with an OnStar® advisor.
OnStar(R) VCIM, Generations 4-7 will require the technician to reconfigure the vehicle with the use
of the TIS2WEB and SPS applications (pass thru only), along with the Tech2(R).
The configuration and set-up procedure is a two-step process that must be completed step-by-step
without interruption or delay in between each step. This procedure enables an automated activation
without a button press by the technician to the OnStar(R) Call Center. Following this procedure, it
may take up to 24 hours for all OnStar(R) services to be fully activated.
How to Order Parts
If the OnStar(R) GPS date/time stamp is non-recoverable and the unit needs to be replaced,
dealers in the U.S. should contact Autocraft Electronics select the catalog item that contains this
bulletin number. Canadian dealers should contact MASS Electronics.
Dealers DO NOT need to call the GM Technical Assistance Center (TAC) for replacement
approval. Autocraft Electronics and MASS Electronics will be responsible for verifying that the
subject vehicle is a candidate for a replacement VIU/VCIM.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 02-08-46-007C
> Nov > 07 > OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands Free Issues > Page 8082
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 02-08-44-007D >
May > 09 > OnStar(R) - Negative Impact of Cloth/Vinyl Roofs
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Negative Impact of
Cloth/Vinyl Roofs
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 02-08-44-007D
Date: May 12, 2009
Subject: Negative Impact of Dealer-Installed Cloth/Vinyl Roofs on XM Radio and/or OnStar(R)
Systems
Models:
2002-2009 Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2009
HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X with XM Radio (RPO U2K) and/or OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................................................. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to
include the 2009 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-08-44-007C (Section
08 - Body and Accessories).
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................
Dealers should not install a cloth or vinyl roof on vehicles that have been ordered with the XM radio
option (RPO U2K) and/or OnStar(R) (RPO UE1). The performance of these systems may be
negatively impacted by the installation of the cloth/vinyl roof. Additionally, water leaks may result
from installing a cloth or vinyl roof on vehicles with roof-mounted antenna systems. Relocating the
antenna to another spot on the vehicle exterior, in order to install a cloth or vinyl roof, is not advised
either. The performance of the OnStar(R) and XM Radio antennas has been optimized for their
current locations. Relocating the antennas may result in a performance degradation.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 08-08-46-004 >
Aug > 08 > OnStar(R) - Aftermarket Device Interference Information
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Aftermarket Device
Interference Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-08-46-004
Date: August 14, 2008
Subject: Information on Aftermarket Device Interference with OnStar(R) Diagnostic Services
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Car and Truck (including Saturn) 2009 and Prior HUMMER
H2, H3 Models 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
with OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
This bulletin is being issued to provide dealer service personnel with information regarding
aftermarket devices connected to the Diagnostic Link Connector (DLC) and the impact to
OnStar(R) diagnostic probes and Vehicle Diagnostic e-mails.
Certain aftermarket devices, when connected to the Diagnostic Link Connector, such as, but not
limited to, Scan Tools, Trip Computers, Fuel Economy Analyzers and Insurance Tracking Devices,
interfere with OnStar's ability to perform a diagnostic probe when requested (via a blue button call)
by a subscriber. These devices also prohibit the ability to gather diagnostic and tire pressure data
for a subscriber's scheduled OnStar(R) Vehicle Diagnostic (OVD) e-mail.
These aftermarket devices utilize the Vehicles serial data bus to perform data requests and/or
information gathering. When these devices are requesting data, OnStar(R) is designed not to
interfere with any data request being made by these devices as required by OBD II regulations.
The OnStar(R) advisor is unable to definitively detect the presence of these devices and will only
be able to inform the caller or requester of the unsuccessful or incomplete probe and may in some
cases refer the subscriber/requester to take the vehicle to a dealer for diagnosis of the concern.
When performing a diagnostic check for an unsuccessful or incomplete OnStar(R) diagnostic
probe, or for concerns regarding completeness of the OnStar(R) Vehicle Diagnostic (OVD) e-mail,
verify that an aftermarket device was not present at the time of the requested probe. Regarding the
OVD e-mail, if an aftermarket device is interfering (including a Scan Tool of any type), the e-mail
will consistently display a "yellow" indication in diagnostics section for all vehicle systems except
the OnStar(R) System and Tire Pressure data (not available on all vehicles) will not be displayed
(i.e. section is collapsed). Successful diagnostic probes and complete OVD e-mails will resume
following the removal or disconnecting of the off-board device.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 00-08-46-004C >
Jan > 08 > OnStar(R) - Re-establishing OnStar(R) Communications
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Re-establishing OnStar(R)
Communications
Bulletin No.: 00-08-46-004C
Date: January 17, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Re-establishing Communications with OnStar(R) Center After Battery Disconnect
Models: 2000-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn and Saab)
with Digital OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-08-46-004B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
When servicing any of the above models and a battery cable is disconnected or power to the
OnStar(R) Vehicle Communication Interface Module (VCIM) is interrupted for any reason the
following procedure must be performed to verify proper Global Positioning System (GPS) function.
Never swap OnStar(R) Vehicle Communication Interface Modules (VCIM) from other vehicles.
Transfer of OnStar(R) modules from other vehicles should not be done. Each OnStar(R) module
has a unique identification number. The VCIM has a specific Station Identification (STID). This
identification number is used by the National Cellular Telephone Network and OnStar(R) systems
and is stored in General Motors Vehicle History files by VIN.
After completing ALL repairs to the vehicle you must perform the following procedure:
Move the vehicle into an open area of the service lot.
Sit in the vehicle with the engine running and the radio turned on for five minutes.
Press the OnStar(R) button in the vehicle.
When the OnStar(R) advisor answers ask the advisor to verify the current location of the vehicle.
If the vehicle location is different than the location the OnStar(R) advisor gives contact GM
Technical Assistance (TAC) and choose the OnStar(R) prompt. GM OnStar(R) TAC will assist in
the diagnosis of a failed VCIM and, if appropriate, order a replacement part. Replacement parts are
usually shipped out within 24 hours, and a pre-paid return package label will be included for
returning the faulty part. By returning the faulty part, you will avoid a non-return core charge.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Headphones / Earphones
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Entertainment System - Headphone Foam Pad Replacement
Headphones / Earphones: Technical Service Bulletins Entertainment System - Headphone Foam
Pad Replacement
Bulletin No.: 05-08-44-005A
Date: July 19, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Information on Rear Seat Headphone Foam Ear Pad Replacement if Worn or Damaged
Models: 2001-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2008
HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
with Rear Seat Entertainment System (RPOs U32, U42)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years and update the shipping costs.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-08-44-005 (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Foam ear pads on the rear headphone may become worn or damaged. The headphone foam ear
pads may wear out when not handled and stored carefully.
If the headphone foam ear pads become damaged or worn out, the foam pads can be replaced
separately from the headphone set. It is not necessary to replace the complete headphone set.
Parts Information
All pricing information listed in this bulletin is in U.S. dollars and is subject to change without notice.
The headphone replacement foam ear pads can be ordered in pairs directly through the supplier.
Have your customer call Unwired at 1-888-293-3332, then prompt zero (0). The replacement, P/N
CS-980 (thick earfoam), can be ordered for $3.50 (USD) per pair plus $2.50 USPS shipping.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 01-08-97-002 > Nov > 01 > HomeLink(R) Transmitter Programming Difficulties
Garage Door Opener Transmitter: Customer Interest HomeLink(R) Transmitter - Programming
Difficulties
File In Section: 08 - Body and Accessories
Bulletin No.: 01-08-97-002
Date: November, 2001
INFORMATION
Subject: Programming the HomeLink(R) Transmitter
Models: 2000-2002 Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks with Universal Garage Door Opener
(RPO UG1)
If you have customers that are having difficulties programming their HomeLink(R) transmitter, you
may suggest the following options:
^ The customer may contact HomeLink(R) directly at 1-800-355-3515 for assistance. Assistance is
available in English, French and Spanish languages.
^ The customer may also be directed to the HomeLink(R) website at www.homelink.com.
The website is user-friendly and actively demonstrates how to program the transmitter. Many
newer garage door openers have a "rolling code" feature and the website does a great job of
guiding the owner through the entire programming process.
The HomeLink(R) phone number, website address, and other useful information can also be found
in Section 2 of the Owner's Manual under HomeLink(R) Transmitter.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 01-08-97-002 > Nov > 01 > HomeLink(R)
Transmitter - Programming Difficulties
Garage Door Opener Transmitter: All Technical Service Bulletins HomeLink(R) Transmitter Programming Difficulties
File In Section: 08 - Body and Accessories
Bulletin No.: 01-08-97-002
Date: November, 2001
INFORMATION
Subject: Programming the HomeLink(R) Transmitter
Models: 2000-2002 Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks with Universal Garage Door Opener
(RPO UG1)
If you have customers that are having difficulties programming their HomeLink(R) transmitter, you
may suggest the following options:
^ The customer may contact HomeLink(R) directly at 1-800-355-3515 for assistance. Assistance is
available in English, French and Spanish languages.
^ The customer may also be directed to the HomeLink(R) website at www.homelink.com.
The website is user-friendly and actively demonstrates how to program the transmitter. Many
newer garage door openers have a "rolling code" feature and the website does a great job of
guiding the owner through the entire programming process.
The HomeLink(R) phone number, website address, and other useful information can also be found
in Section 2 of the Owner's Manual under HomeLink(R) Transmitter.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Garage Door Opener Transmitter: >
09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules
Relay Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control
Modules
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-06-03-004D
Date: December 08, 2010
Subject: Intermittent No Crank/No Start, No Module Communication, MIL, Warning Lights, Vehicle
Messages or DTCs Set by Various Control Modules - Diagnosing and Repairing Fretting Corrosion
(Disconnect Affected Connector and Apply Dielectric Lubricant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Attention:
This repair can be applied to ANY electrical connection including, but not limited to: lighting, body
electrical, in-line connections, powertrain control sensors, etc. DO NOT over apply lubricant to the
point where it prevents the full engagement of sealed connectors. A light coating on the terminal
surfaces is sufficient to correct the condition.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Attention statement and add the 2011
model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-03-004C (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions:
- An intermittent no crank/no start
- Intermittent malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illumination
- Intermittent service lamp illumination
- Intermittent service message(s) being displayed
The technician may determine that he is unable to duplicate the intermittent condition.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a buildup of nonconductive insulating oxidized debris known as
fretting corrosion, occurring between two electrical contact surfaces of the connection or connector.
This may be caused by any of the following conditions:
- Vibration
- Thermal cycling
- Poor connection/terminal retention
- Micro motion
- A connector, component or wiring harness not properly secured resulting in movement
On low current signal circuits this condition may cause high resistance, resulting in intermittent
connections.
On high current power circuits this condition may cause permanent increases in the resistance and
may cause a device to become inoperative.
Representative List of Control Modules and Components
The following is only a representative list of control modules and components that may be affected
by this connection or connector condition and DOES NOT include every possible module or
component for every vehicle.
- Blower Control Module
- Body Control Module (BCM)
- Communication Interface Module (CIM)
- Cooling Fan Control Module
- Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)
- Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module (EBTCM)
- Electronic Suspension Control (ESC) Module
- Engine Control Module (ECM)
- Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) Control Module
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Garage Door Opener Transmitter: >
09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 8119
- HVAC Actuator
- Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM)
- Any AIR BAG module
- Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner
- Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner
- An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set:
B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023
- Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
- Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Correction
Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions:
- The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated.
- The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can
no longer be duplicated.
Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above.
1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any
existing history or current DTCs from all of the
control modules (refer to SI).
‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the
connector(s) of the control module/component
which may be causing the condition (refer to SI).
‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control
module/component which may be causing the
condition (refer to SI).
2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component
Connector End Views and Component Locator
documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the
condition.
Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the
actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or
identified without the use of a magnifying glass.
Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown,
as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush
that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin.
3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side
and the harness side of the affected connector(s).
4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present.
5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information:
- DTC Diagnostic Procedure
- Circuit/System Description
- Conditions for Running the DTC
- Conditions for Setting the DTC
- Diagnostic Aids
- Circuit/System Verification
‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated,
then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI).
Repair Order Documentation
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Garage Door Opener Transmitter: >
09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 8120
Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so
may result in a chargeback.
- Customer vehicle condition.
- Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or
Service Message.
- Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set.
- After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated?
‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector
name and number on the repair order.
- If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and
additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID
Number MUST be written on the repair order.
Parts Information
Alternate Distributor For All of North America
Note
NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada),
specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Garage Door Opener Transmitter: >
09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 8121
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table
above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Garage Door Opener Transmitter: >
09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 8127
- HVAC Actuator
- Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM)
- Any AIR BAG module
- Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner
- Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner
- An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set:
B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023
- Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
- Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Correction
Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions:
- The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated.
- The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can
no longer be duplicated.
Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above.
1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any
existing history or current DTCs from all of the
control modules (refer to SI).
‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the
connector(s) of the control module/component
which may be causing the condition (refer to SI).
‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control
module/component which may be causing the
condition (refer to SI).
2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component
Connector End Views and Component Locator
documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the
condition.
Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the
actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or
identified without the use of a magnifying glass.
Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown,
as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush
that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin.
3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side
and the harness side of the affected connector(s).
4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present.
5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information:
- DTC Diagnostic Procedure
- Circuit/System Description
- Conditions for Running the DTC
- Conditions for Setting the DTC
- Diagnostic Aids
- Circuit/System Verification
‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated,
then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI).
Repair Order Documentation
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Garage Door Opener Transmitter: >
09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 8128
Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so
may result in a chargeback.
- Customer vehicle condition.
- Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or
Service Message.
- Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set.
- After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated?
‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector
name and number on the repair order.
- If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and
additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID
Number MUST be written on the repair order.
Parts Information
Alternate Distributor For All of North America
Note
NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada),
specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Garage Door Opener Transmitter: >
09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 8129
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table
above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8130
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Garage Door Opener Transmitter: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8133
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8134
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8135
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8136
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8137
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8138
Garage Door Opener Transmitter: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8139
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8140
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8141
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8142
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8143
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8144
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8145
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8146
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8147
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8148
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8149
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8150
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8151
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8152
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8153
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8154
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8155
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8156
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8157
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8158
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8159
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8160
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8161
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8162
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8163
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8164
Garage Door Opener
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8165
Garage Door Opener Schematics
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 8166
Garage Door Opener Transmitter: Application and ID
Transmitter Reference Table Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 8167
Transmitter Reference Table Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 8168
Garage Door Opener Transmitter: Description and Operation
The garage door opener is located in the overhead console. The valet switch provides battery
voltage to the garage door opener. If battery voltage is lost due to a condition such as a dead
battery, the garage door opener unit relies on the non-servicable internal power backup supply.
The unit is programmed using the customer's hand-held transmitters for the garage doors, electric
entrance gates, or lighting and security systems.
The garage door opener is rolling code capable. Rolling code is a system that allows the code that
the customers receiver receives from the garage door opener to change every time the garage
door opener is used within operating range of the receiver. When the receiver and the garage door
opener are initially programmed together, a code is established, a new code is created for every
new transmission. The software in the receiver recognizes the garage door opener and accepts the
new code.
The garage door opener is compatible with most, but not all types and brands of transmitters. If a
problem should occur with a compatibility conflict with a transmitter, call HomeLink(TM) at
1-800-355-3515. The garage door opener is a transmitter operating between 288-399 MHz. The
power and range of the transmitter is limited to comply with laws governing the generation of Radio
Frequency Interference (RFI). The transmitter is programmed by the user to accept the signal
generated by the user's transmitters, refer to Garage Door Opener Programming - Universal.
The garage door opener has 3 buttons that may be programmed for individual transmitter/receiver
combinations to control up to 3 garage door openers, security gates, and lighting systems. Each
button represents a transmitter code section of the transmitter, which operates separately from any
other button, and may be considered a separate transmitter. Operation consists of simply pressing
a button to activate the corresponding transmitter.
Battery voltage is provided to the garage door opener from the IGN SEN fuse in the IP fuse block.
The garage door opener is grounded through G400. Inadvertent power is supplied from the Body
Control Module (BCM).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Garage Door Opener Transmitter: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
- Symptoms - Garage Door Opener
IMPORTANT: Review the system description and operation in order to familiarize yourself with the
system functions. Refer to Garage Door Opener Description and Operation.
Visual/Physical Inspection ^
Inspect for aftermarket devices which could affect the operation of the garage door opener. Refer
to Checking Aftermarket Accessories in Diagnostic Aids.
^ Inspect the easily accessible or visible system components for obvious damage or conditions
which could cause the symptom.
Intermittent Faulty electrical connections or wiring may be the cause of intermittent conditions.
Refer to Testing for Intermittent and Poor Connections in Diagnostic Aids.
Symptom List Refer to Garage Door Opener Inoperative in order to diagnose the symptom.
Garage Door Opener Inoperative
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 8171
Steps 1-10
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Garage Door Opener Replacement
Garage Door Opener Transmitter: Service and Repair Garage Door Opener Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Release the barbed tab at the center of the access panel.
2. Swing the panel down and forward in order to access the module. 3. Disconnect the electrical
connector from the module and switch assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Garage Door Opener Replacement > Page 8174
4. Remove the screws that retain the garage door opener and the switch assembly to the console.
5. Remove the opener and the switch assembly from the console.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Align the LED indicator with the hole in the access panel when setting the opener into place. 2.
Install the opener and the switch assembly to the console.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the screws that retain the opener and the switch assembly to the console.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Garage Door Opener Replacement > Page 8175
4. Connect the electrical connector to the opener and the switch assembly. 5. Swing the access
panel up and rearward in order to close the access panel.
6. Snap the barbed tab into place in the console.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Garage Door Opener Replacement > Page 8176
Garage Door Opener Transmitter: Service and Repair Garage Door Opener Programming Universal
GARAGE DOOR OPENER PROGRAMMING
IMPORTANT: Do not use the garage door opener (GDO) with any garage door opener that does
not have the stop and reverse safety feature. This includes any garage door opener model
manufactured before April 1,1982.
Be sure that people and objects are clear of the garage door you are programming.
The GDO is programmed by using the customer's hand-held transmitter(s).
Turn the ignition OFF while programming the GDO transmitter. Follow these steps to program up to
3 channels: 1. If you have previously programmed a transmitter, proceed to Step 2. Otherwise, hold
down the 2 outside buttons on the GDO transmitter for
approximately 20 seconds, until the light on the GDO transmitter begins to flash rapidly. Then
release the buttons. This procedure erases any previous settings and initializes the memory for all
3 channels.
2. Decide which of the 3 channels you want to program to the transmitter you have. 3. Hold the end
of the hand-held transmitter against the front surface of the GDO (less than 1 inch) so you can still
see the light. 4. Using both hands, press the hand-held transmitter button and the desired button on
the GDO transmitter. Continue to hold both buttons through
Step 5.
IMPORTANT: The GDO is compatible with most, but not all, types and brands of transmitters. If the
GDO light does not flash rapidly after 90 seconds, there may be a compatibility conflict with the
transmitter used to program the GDO. Call HomeLink(TM) at 1-800-355- 3515 in order to address
this problem.
5. Hold down the buttons on both transmitters until you see the light on the GDO transmitter flash
slowly and then rapidly. The rapid flashing, which
could take up to 90 seconds, indicates that the GDO transmitter has been programmed. Release
the buttons on both transmitters when the light starts to flash rapidly.
TRAINING THE GDO FOR ROLLING CODE RECEIVERS
This procedure is for training the customer's rolling code garage door openers to their GDO
transmitter. The GDO must already be programmed to its hand-held transmitter. The training
process below must be completed within 30 seconds or it must be repeated. 1. Locate the train
button on the garage door opener receiver. Refer for the garage door opener (or call
HomeLink(TM) at 1-800-355-3515 for
assistance). Follow instructions for the garage door opener in order to determine when the unit is in
train mode.
2. Return to the GDO transmitter in the vehicle, and press the button that you want trained for
rolling codes 3 times, for 1 second each time. 3. Press the button used again in order to verify that
the GDO transmitter has been programmed.
You may use either the hand-held transmitter or the GDO to open the garage door.
The GDO is compatible with most, but not all, types and brands of transmitters. If the GDO light
does not flash rapidly after 90 seconds, there may be a compatibility conflict with the transmitter
used to program the GDO. Call HomeLink(TM) at 1-800-355-3515 in order to address compatibility
concerns.
ERASING CHANNELS
To erase programmed channels, hold down the 2 outside buttons until the light on the GDO
transmitter begins to flash. Individual channels cannot be erased, but can be reprogrammed using
the Garage Door Opener Programming and the Training GDO for Rolling Code Receivers
procedures.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Garage Door Opener Replacement > Page 8177
Non-Compatible Garage Door Openers
NON-COMPATIBLE GARAGE DOOR OPENERS
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 8178
Special Tools And Equipment
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Global Positioning System > Global Positioning
System Antenna > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > OnStar(R) - Cellular Antenna Replacement Parts
Global Positioning System Antenna: Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Cellular Antenna
Replacement Parts
Bulletin No.: 00-08-46-002A
Date: April 12, 2005
INFORMATION
Subject: OnStar(R) System Cellular Antenna Replacement Parts Availability
Models: 1996-2005 Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2003-2005 HUMMER H2
with OnStar(R) and Glass Mounted Antennas
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to update the model years, models and parts information. Please
discard Corporate Bulletin Number 00-08-46-002 (Section 08 - Body & Accessories).
Replacement parts for the OnStar(R) system cellular antenna are available as follows:
^ Cellular Antenna Kit - If the antenna mast or exterior base is damaged or missing or if the
antenna base has separated from the exterior glass surface.
^ Cellular Antenna Inner Coupling - If the antenna coupling on the inside of the glass requires
replacement.
Important:
If glass replacement is required, both the Cellular Antenna Kit and the Cellular Antenna Inner
Coupling are required. The kits listed contain all the necessary parts and instructions needed to
properly install a new cellular antenna exterior base or interior coupling to the glass surface. To
obtain maximum adhesion during installation, the instructions included in the kits must be followed
carefully and exactly as written.
Important:
Do not attempt to reinstall the original cellular antenna exterior base or interior coupling using any
type of glue, adhesive tapes, etc. Doing so may eliminate the cellular signal transfer through the
glass and reduce the maximum performance of the system that includes air bag deployment
notification.
Important:
To obtain maximum adhesion between the new cellular exterior base or interior coupling and the
glass surface, the base, coupling and glass must be kept dry and above 15°C (60°F) during the
installation and for the 24 hours immediately following the installation. Not keeping the vehicle dry
and above the temperature listed for 24 hours may result in the new cellular antenna exterior base
or interior coupling coming off.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Global Positioning System > Global Positioning
System Antenna > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > OnStar(R) - Cellular Antenna Replacement Parts
> Page 8184
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Global Positioning System > Global Positioning
System Antenna > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > OnStar(R) - Cellular Antenna Replacement Parts
> Page 8185
Global Positioning System Antenna: Technical Service Bulletins Onstar(R) - Antenna Coupling
Revised Procedures
File In Section: 08 - Body and Accessories
Bulletin No.: 01-08-46-006A
Date: December, 2001
SERVICE MANUAL UPDATE
Subject: Revised OnStar(R) Antenna Coupling Replacement Procedures
Models: 2000-2002 Passenger Cars and Trucks with Glass Mounted Antenna
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2002 model year and revise the service procedures. Please
discard Corporate Bulletin Number 01-08-46-006 (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
This bulletin is being issued to revise the OnStar(R) inner and outer antenna coupling replacement
procedures in the Cellular Communication sub-section of the Body and Accessories section in the
appropriate Service Manual. Please use the following to replace the existing information in the
Service Manual.
This information has been updated within SI2000. If you are using a paper version of this Service
Manual, please mark a reference to this bulletin on the affected page in the Cellular
Communication sub-section of the Service Manual.
Coupling Replacement - Antenna Inner
Removal Procedure
Important:
Use the described adhesion promoter to assure adequate bonding of the coupling to the glass. To
obtain maximum adhesion between the new mobile antenna couplings and the glass surface, the
couplings and the glass must be kept dry and above 15°C (60°F) during the installation and for 6-8
hours immediately following the installation. Otherwise the new couplings may come off. Also,
disregard the drying or curing time information listed in the instructions included in the replacement
antenna coupling kits. In the near future, those instructions will be updated with the drying or curing
times listed in this bulletin.
^ Do not attempt to reinstall the original cellular couplings using any type of glue, adhesive tapes,
etc. Doing so may eliminate the cellular signal transfer through the glass and reduce the maximum
performance of the system, including the air bag deployment notification.
1. Disconnect the coaxial cable from the inner coupling of the mobile communication antenna.
Notice:
If you use a razor blade or other sharp tool in order to remove the adhesives or foreign objects from
the inside of the rear window, use the blade carefully. Damage to the grid lines may result.
Use a small, wide-bladed plastic tool to cut the double back tape material while lifting up on the
inner antenna coupling.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Global Positioning System > Global Positioning
System Antenna > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > OnStar(R) - Cellular Antenna Replacement Parts
> Page 8186
1. Clean the inside of the glass with an alcohol wipe.
2. Dry the glass thoroughly using a lint free cloth.
Important:
The glass adhesion promoter described in the next step must be used to ensure a bonding of the
coupling to the glass surface. Failure to use the described adhesion promoter may result in the
coupling coming off the glass.
3. Apply Glass Adhesion Promoter, P/N 12378555 (in Canada, use P/N 88901239), to the glass in
the area where you will install the antenna coupling. Follow the Glass Adhesion Promoter
instructions on the product label.
Important:
^ On rear backglass applications the RF connections for the inner antenna coupling should run
parallel to the defogger gridline.
^ Align the inner and the outer antenna couplings.
^ Do not touch the adhesive backing on the antenna coupling.
4. Remove the protective film from the adhesive backing on the inner antenna coupling.
5. Align the inner antenna coupling to the existing exterior coupling.
6. Press firmly on all 4 corners and on the center of the antenna inner coupling (2) in order to
ensure proper adhesion to the glass (4).
Hold pressure on the inner coupling (2) for 10 to 30 seconds.
7. Ensure that no gaps occur between the couplings (5, 2) and the glass (4).
8. Connect the coaxial cable to the inner coupling (2).
9. Keep the vehicle dry. Allow 6 to 8 hours, at 15°C (60° F), for the adhesive to cure after
installation.
Coupling Replacement - Antenna Outer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Global Positioning System > Global Positioning
System Antenna > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > OnStar(R) - Cellular Antenna Replacement Parts
> Page 8187
Removal Procedure
Important:
Use the described adhesion promoter to assure adequate bonding of the coupling to the glass.
To obtain maximum adhesion between the new mobile antenna couplings and the glass surface,
the couplings and the glass must be kept dry and above 15°C (60° F) during the installation and for
the 6-8 hours immediately following the installation. Otherwise the new couplings may come off.
Also, disregard the drying or curing time information listed in the instructions included in the
replacement antenna coupling kits. In the near future, those instructions will be updated with the
drying or curing times listed in this bulletin.
^ Do not attempt to reinstall the original cellular couplings using any type of glue, adhesive tapes,
etc. Doing so may eliminate the cellular signal transfer through the glass and reduce the maximum
performance of the system, including the air bag deployment notification.
1. Install the inner coupling first if both the inner and the outer coupling are to be replaced.
Refer to Coupling Replacement - Antenna Inner.
Notice:
If you use a razor blade or other sharp tool in order to remove the adhesives or foreign objects from
the inside of the rear window, use the blade carefully. Damage to the grid lines may result.
2. Use a small, wide-bladed plastic tool to cut the double back tape material while lifting up on the
outer antenna coupling.
Installation Procedure
1. Clean the glass with an alcohol wipe.
2. Dry the glass thoroughly using a lint free cloth.
Important:
The glass adhesion promoter described in the next step must be used to ensure a bonding of the
coupling to the glass surface. Failure to use the described adhesion promoter may result in the
coupling coming off the glass.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Global Positioning System > Global Positioning
System Antenna > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > OnStar(R) - Cellular Antenna Replacement Parts
> Page 8188
3. Apply Glass Adhesion Promoter, P/N 12378555 (in Canada, use P/N 88901239), to the glass in
the area where you will install the antenna coupling. Follow the Glass Adhesion Promoter
instructions on the product label.
Important:
^ Align the outer antenna coupling with the inner coupling.
^ Do not touch the adhesive backing on the antenna coupling.
4. Remove the protective film from the adhesive backing on the outer antenna coupling.
5. Align the outer antenna coupling to the inner antenna coupling.
6. Press firmly on all 4 corners and on the center of the outer antenna coupling (5) in order to
ensure proper adhesion to the glass (4).
Hold pressure on the outer coupling (5) for 10 to 30 seconds.
7. Ensure that no gaps occur between the couplings (5, 2) and the glass (4).
8. Keep the vehicle dry. Allow 6 to 8 hours, at 15°C (60°F), for the adhesive to cure after
installation.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Memory Positioning Systems > System Information
> Description and Operation > Personalization
Memory Positioning Systems: Description and Operation Personalization
Personalization features may be set for the vehicle or the driver. Vehicle features do not change
with each driver. Specific drivers are recognized by the vehicle through the keyless entry
transmitters, the memory buttons, or the Driver Information Center (DIC), and the personalization
settings for that driver are recalled. For more information on vehicle personalization features for this
vehicle, refer to Vehicle Personalization.
This vehicle does not have specific driver personalization available.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Memory Positioning Systems > System Information
> Description and Operation > Personalization > Page 8193
Memory Positioning Systems: Description and Operation Vehicle Personalization
PROGRAMMABLE AUTOMATIC DOOR LOCKS (IF EQUIPPED)
If the vehicle has power door locks, it is equipped with a feature that enables you to program the
power door locks.
The vehicle left the factory programmed to automatically lock all doors when the vehicle is shifted
out of PARK (P), and all doors unlock when the vehicle is shifted into PARK (P).
If the vehicle has a manual transmission it left the factory programmed to lock all doors when the
vehicle speed is greater than 24 km/h (15 mph) for two seconds, and unlock all doors once the key
is removed from the ignition.
The following instructions detail how enter the programming mode for the power door lock feature:
1. Begin with the ignition in OFF. Then pull the signal/multifunction lever all the way toward you and
hold it there while you perform the next step. 2. Turn the key to RUN and OFF twice. Then, with the
key in OFF, release the turn signal/multifunction lever. Once you do this you will hear the
lock switch lock and unlock.
3. You are now ready to program the automatic door locks. Select one of the following four
programming options and follow the instructions. You
will have 30 seconds to complete programming. If you exceed the 30 second limit, The locks will
automatically lock and unlock to indicate that you have left the program mode. If this occurs, repeat
the procedure beginning with step 1. You can exit the program mode any time by turning the
ignition to RUN. If the LOCK/UNLOCK switches are not pressed while in the programming mode,
the current LOCK/UNLOCK mode will not be modified. ^
The following is a list of available programming options:
^ All doors lock/Only the driver's door unlocks: Press the lock side of the power door lock switch on
the door panel once, and then the unlock side once.
^ All doors lock/All doors unlock: Press the lock side of the power door lock switch on the door
panel once, and then the unlock side twice.
^ All doors lock/None of the doors unlock: Press the lock side of the power door lock switch on the
door panel once, and then the unlock side three times.
^ No doors lock/None of the doors unlock: Press the lock side of the power door lock switch on the
door panel twice. This turns off the automatic door lock feature.
ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
Refer to Power Door Locks Description and Operation in Doors for more information about the
automatic door lock feature.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 05-08-46-004C > Dec > 10 > OnStar(R) - Number Incorrect/Incorrectly
Assigned
Navigation System: Customer Interest OnStar(R) - Number Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 05-08-46-004C
Date: December 23, 2010
Subject: OnStar(R) Phone Number Concerns (Phone Number Incorrect/Assigned to Another
Vehicle/Phone) That Occur During Diagnosis of OnStar(R) System
Models:
2000-2011 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Equipped with OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years up to 2011. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 05-08-46-004B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
During diagnosis of an OnStar(R) concern, the technician may be told that the OnStar(R) phone
number is incorrect or tied to another vehicle and/or phone of some kind. To resolve these
concerns, the Tech 2(R) with software version 22.005 (or higher), has the capability to change the
OnStar(R) phone number.
Service Procedure
1. With the Tech 2(R), build the vehicle to specifications within the Diagnostics area of the Tech
2(R). 2. For vehicles with physical-based diagnostics - under Body, go to the OnStar(R) section.
Then select the Special Functions menu.
For vehicles with functional-based diagnostics - under Body and Accessories, go to the Cellular
Communication section. Select Module Setup and then Vehicle Communication Interface Module.
3. Locate the Program Phone Number prompt and select it. The original phone number will be
displayed on the Tech 2(R) screen. 4. Contact the OnStar(R) team at the GM Technical Assistance
Center (TAC) to obtain a new phone number. 5. Highlight the digits of the phone number one at a
time and enter the new phone number using the number keys on the Tech 2(R). 6. Press the Soft
key at the base of the screen for Done once these numbers have been changed on the screen. 7.
Press the Soft key for Done again. The area code or new phone number has now been
programmed into the phone. 8. Cycle the ignition to Off and open the driver's door. 9. Press the
blue OnStar(R) button to make sure that a normal connection can be made to the OnStar(R) call
center. If applicable, make sure the
Hands-Free Calling (HFC) works properly by making a phone call.
10. If the system is working properly, fax or voicemail a case closing into the OnStar(R) team at
TAC with the results. Dealers in Canada should
submit case closing information through the GM infoNET.
Please follow this diagnostic process thoroughly and complete each step. If the condition exhibited
is resolved WITHOUT completing every step, the remaining steps do not need to be performed. If
the procedure above does not resolve the condition, you must contact TAC for further assistance.
This diagnostic approach was developed specifically for this condition and should not automatically
be used for other vehicles with similar symptoms.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 05-08-46-004C > Dec > 10 > OnStar(R) - Number Incorrect/Incorrectly
Assigned > Page 8202
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 02-08-46-006C > Jan > 08 > OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position
Reported During Call
Navigation System: Customer Interest OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position Reported During Call
Bulletin No.: 02-08-46-006C
Date: January 08, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Incorrect OnStar(R) Global Positioning System (GPS) Location Reported During
OnStar(R) Call
Models: 2000-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2008
HUMMER H2 2006-2008 HUMMER H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
with OnStar(R)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
02-08-46-006B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
A small number of the above-mentioned vehicles may exhibit a condition in which the vehicle
reports an inaccurate location to the OnStar(R) Call Center. This condition can only be identified
via a button press to the OnStar(R) Call Center by the customer. Call Center personnel will be able
to identify this inaccurate location condition. Customers will then be notified through the mail by
OnStar(R) if their vehicle exhibits this condition. Once this condition has been identified OnStar(R)
will instruct the customer to return to the dealership to have this condition corrected.
It is not necessary to reconfigure the vehicle after the following procedure.
In order to correct this condition you must cycle power to the OnStar(R) system. This can be done
by either removing the fuses powering the OnStar(R) system or disconnecting the OnStar(R)
module (VCIM) from the vehicle. As a last resort you can disconnect the vehicle's battery.
The power needs to be removed from the system for approximately 15 minutes.
After completing this procedure the vehicle should be taken to an area with an unobstructed view of
the sky. The vehicle should be kept running for approximately 10 minutes to allow the vehicle to
reacquire the global positioning system (GPS). Then contact the OnStar(R) Call Center via the blue
OnStar(R) button and ask the advisor to verify the GPS position.
If the OnStar(R) advisor still has an inaccurate GPS location refer to the Navigation Systems and
Cellular Communications sub-sections in the Service Manual in order to diagnose and repair the
concern. If the normal diagnostics lead to module replacement you will need to contact Technical
Assistance (TAC) and choose the OnStar(R) prompt. GM OnStar(R) TAC will assist in the
diagnosis and if appropriate order a replacement part. Replacement parts are usually shipped out
within 24 hours and a pre-paid return package label will be included for returning the faulty part. By
returning the faulty part you will avoid a significant non-return core charge.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab US Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Warranty Information (Saab US Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 02-08-46-006C > Jan > 08 > OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position
Reported During Call > Page 8207
For vehicles repaired under warranty use, the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 05-08-46-004C > Dec > 10 >
OnStar(R) - Number Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned
Navigation System: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Number Incorrect/Incorrectly
Assigned
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 05-08-46-004C
Date: December 23, 2010
Subject: OnStar(R) Phone Number Concerns (Phone Number Incorrect/Assigned to Another
Vehicle/Phone) That Occur During Diagnosis of OnStar(R) System
Models:
2000-2011 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Equipped with OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years up to 2011. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 05-08-46-004B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
During diagnosis of an OnStar(R) concern, the technician may be told that the OnStar(R) phone
number is incorrect or tied to another vehicle and/or phone of some kind. To resolve these
concerns, the Tech 2(R) with software version 22.005 (or higher), has the capability to change the
OnStar(R) phone number.
Service Procedure
1. With the Tech 2(R), build the vehicle to specifications within the Diagnostics area of the Tech
2(R). 2. For vehicles with physical-based diagnostics - under Body, go to the OnStar(R) section.
Then select the Special Functions menu.
For vehicles with functional-based diagnostics - under Body and Accessories, go to the Cellular
Communication section. Select Module Setup and then Vehicle Communication Interface Module.
3. Locate the Program Phone Number prompt and select it. The original phone number will be
displayed on the Tech 2(R) screen. 4. Contact the OnStar(R) team at the GM Technical Assistance
Center (TAC) to obtain a new phone number. 5. Highlight the digits of the phone number one at a
time and enter the new phone number using the number keys on the Tech 2(R). 6. Press the Soft
key at the base of the screen for Done once these numbers have been changed on the screen. 7.
Press the Soft key for Done again. The area code or new phone number has now been
programmed into the phone. 8. Cycle the ignition to Off and open the driver's door. 9. Press the
blue OnStar(R) button to make sure that a normal connection can be made to the OnStar(R) call
center. If applicable, make sure the
Hands-Free Calling (HFC) works properly by making a phone call.
10. If the system is working properly, fax or voicemail a case closing into the OnStar(R) team at
TAC with the results. Dealers in Canada should
submit case closing information through the GM infoNET.
Please follow this diagnostic process thoroughly and complete each step. If the condition exhibited
is resolved WITHOUT completing every step, the remaining steps do not need to be performed. If
the procedure above does not resolve the condition, you must contact TAC for further assistance.
This diagnostic approach was developed specifically for this condition and should not automatically
be used for other vehicles with similar symptoms.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 05-08-46-004C > Dec > 10 >
OnStar(R) - Number Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned > Page 8213
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 10-08-44-006 > Oct > 10 > Navigation
- Report Missing/Inaccurate Nav. Map Info
Navigation System: All Technical Service Bulletins Navigation - Report Missing/Inaccurate Nav.
Map Info
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 10-08-44-006
Date: October 11, 2010
Subject: Reporting Missing or Inaccurate Navigation Radio Map Disc Information - Complete and
Submit Feedback Form at GM Navigation Disc Center Website
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Equipped with Navigation Radio
Some customers may notice that some navigation radio map discs may have missing or incorrect
information.
The following list contains some examples:
- Missing or incorrect roads, road names or road shapes
- Missing or incorrect addresses
- Missing or incorrect highway labeling
- Missing or incorrect highway exit numbers
- Missing or incorrect traffic restrictions
- Missing points of interest (POI) or incorrect details, such as location, category or phone number
General Motors uses a map database from two different suppliers. The two map suppliers are
consistently updating their map database and will gladly accept any input regarding missing or
incorrect information on the navigation radio map disc.
To report any missing or incorrect information, please access the GM Navigation Disc Center at the
following web site: http://www.gmnavdisc.com.
At the GM Navigation Disc Center home page, select the tab: Your Feedback. In the Navigation
Data Feedback form, fill in the appropriate information as required and then select: Submit, to send
the form.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 06-08-44-012E > Apr > 10 >
Navigation System - Software/DVD Update Program
Navigation System: All Technical Service Bulletins Navigation System - Software/DVD Update
Program
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 06-08-44-012E
Date: April 20, 2010
Subject: DVD Navigation Update Program, Navigation Disc Diagnostic Aid, AVN Software Update
Discs and Ordering Information
Models:
2002-2010 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2004-2010 HUMMER H2, H3
2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Attention:
Please direct this information to your Sales Consultants, Service Consultants, Parts Personnel and
Used Car Department. This bulletin ONLY applies to North American dealers/retailers.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to include the 2010 model year and update the usage
table. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 06-08-44-012D (Section 08 - Body and
Accessories).
DVD Navigation Update Program
The data on the DVD map disc ages at a rate of 15-20% per year. As the data ages, the
functionality of the navigation system declines. Offering GM customers new navigation DVDs will
ensure that the customers have the latest information for their system.
General Motors offered a Navigation Disc Update Program for 2006 and 2007 model year vehicles.
This program concluded on December 31, 2009. The DVD Navigation Update Program policy has
changed and customers are no longer eligible for free annual updates, however, a navigation DVD
update disc can be purchased for $199 (USD) + shipping.
If the navigation disc is needed for a warranty situation, the disc can be purchased for $120 (USD).
The dealer must provide a VIN and RO# to qualify for the reduced price. The dealer must call the
GM Navigation Disc Center, as this option is not available on the website.
The GM Navigation Disc Center launched on March 15, 2006. There are two ways to obtain an
updated disc:
- Via the web through gmnavdisc.com
- GM Navigation Disc Center
Navigation Disc Diagnostic Aid
The following table can be used to identify acceptable discs for testing the navigation unit's map
drive functionality. This should only be used to verify the map drive's ability to read the map disc
properly and to determine if there is an issue with the unit's map drive or the disc. Some functions,
such as voice recognition, may not work properly with some of the discs in the list. If the disc is
found to be defective always contact the GM Navigation Disc Center to obtain the most recent disc
for the vehicle.
AVN Software Update Discs
Technical Service Bulletins are sometimes generated to address specific navigation radio
operational or performance issues. When a navigation radio bulletin is issued, it may contain
instructions to utilize an advanced vehicle navigation (AVN) software update with a specific part
number. GM dealers must order advanced vehicle navigation (AVN) software update discs as
directed in the specific bulletin.
AVN software update discs are for the dealer to update the navigation radio software only. They do
NOT update or replace the navigation map disc that is supplied with the vehicle. Please order
these parts only as needed. There is a limited supply of these discs available. Do not order these
discs for stock. AVN software update discs can be used to reprogram more than one vehicle. The
first update disc for each P/N is free. Subsequent copies of the same P/N for the same dealer will
cost $50 (USD).
To obtain an AVN software update disc, follow the specific ordering information provided in the
bulletin.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 06-08-44-012E > Apr > 10 >
Navigation System - Software/DVD Update Program > Page 8222
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 02-08-44-007D > May > 09 >
OnStar(R) - Negative Impact of Cloth/Vinyl Roofs
Navigation System: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Negative Impact of Cloth/Vinyl
Roofs
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 02-08-44-007D
Date: May 12, 2009
Subject: Negative Impact of Dealer-Installed Cloth/Vinyl Roofs on XM Radio and/or OnStar(R)
Systems
Models:
2002-2009 Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2009
HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X with XM Radio (RPO U2K) and/or OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................................................. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to
include the 2009 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-08-44-007C (Section
08 - Body and Accessories).
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................
Dealers should not install a cloth or vinyl roof on vehicles that have been ordered with the XM radio
option (RPO U2K) and/or OnStar(R) (RPO UE1). The performance of these systems may be
negatively impacted by the installation of the cloth/vinyl roof. Additionally, water leaks may result
from installing a cloth or vinyl roof on vehicles with roof-mounted antenna systems. Relocating the
antenna to another spot on the vehicle exterior, in order to install a cloth or vinyl roof, is not advised
either. The performance of the OnStar(R) and XM Radio antennas has been optimized for their
current locations. Relocating the antennas may result in a performance degradation.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 >
Navigation Radio - Diagnostic Tips
Navigation System: All Technical Service Bulletins Navigation Radio - Diagnostic Tips
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-08-44-010F
Date: March 09, 2009
Subject: Navigation Radio Diagnostic Tips
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2008 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2008 and Prior Saab 9-7X
All Equipped with Navigation Radio
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to update the model years involved, the radio part number list, remove
the PQC parts restriction and revise the diagnostic information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 08-08-44-010E (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Recent part reviews indicate that the majority of Navigation Radios returned for analysis do not test
as defective. In many cases, published SI documents were available to correct the condition
without the need for an exchange unit. The following Diagnostic Tips may assist with the proper
diagnosis and repair of Navigation Radio Concerns.
Note
For U.S. dealers the 2009 and 2010 Model Year Navigation Radios are currently on restriction
through the Technical Assistance Center (TAC). Refer to PI PIC5102. To order Radios and
Instrument Panel Clusters (IPC) for 2008 and prior model year vehicles, please continue to follow
the normal process and contact an authorized Electronic Service Center (ESC) for assistance.
For any Navigation Radio replaced, a copy of the Repair Order (RO) must be included with the
returned radio. Be sure to document the customer's concern in detail, including unusual noises and
what functions are affected. List any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) on the RO.
Ensure the radio is sufficiently protected during shipping to prevent damage to the radio assembly.
Note
Navigation Radios with physical damage (for example: shattered displays, impact damage to the
radio face and fluid damage) must be reviewed with the District Service Manager for appropriate
coverage prior to replacing the radio. The dealership must note the District Service Manager's
approval on the Repair Order, along with the reason for the goodwill assistance. Do NOT
disassemble the radio to try and retrieve stuck CDs/DVDs as this may result in a debit to the
dealership. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 08-08-44-015, Information on Inappropriate
Warranty Claims submitted for Damaged Radios and Instrument Panel Clusters.
Getting Started
Retrieve the Navigation Radio part number using the Tech 2(R). Refer to Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-08-44-005C - Utilizing Tech 2 to Retrieve Part Numbers for Radios, Compact Disc (CD)
Changers and Instrument Panel Clusters (IPC). Use the table below to determine the appropriate
Diagnostic Tips Review to follow based on the radio part number. Scroll down the bulletin to find
the corresponding Diagnostic Tips Review.
Printing This Document
To print the applicable Diagnostic Tips Review pages, select File then Print Preview. Use the
arrows at the top of the screen to scroll left and right through the bulletin to identify the correct
pages containing the questions. With the pages identified, click on the Print button at the top left. In
the pop-up box, select "Pages" in the "Print Range" and type in the pages. For example, to print
pages 19 through 22, type in the box provided "19-22". Once the page range has been filled in,
click the Print box at the bottom of the pop-up box.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 >
Navigation Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8231
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 >
Navigation Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8232
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 >
Navigation Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8233
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 >
Navigation Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8234
Diagnostic Tips Review Table
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 >
Navigation Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8235
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 >
Navigation Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8236
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 >
Navigation Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8237
Diagnostic Tips Review # 1 - Delphi Super Nav and Black Tie Nav
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 >
Navigation Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8238
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 >
Navigation Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8239
Diagnostic Tips Review # 2 - Delphi Legacy Navigation Radio
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 >
Navigation Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8240
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 >
Navigation Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8241
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 >
Navigation Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8242
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 >
Navigation Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8243
Diagnostic Tips Review # 3 - Denso Navigation Radios
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 >
Navigation Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8244
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 >
Navigation Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8245
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 >
Navigation Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8246
Diagnostic Tips Review # 4 - Denso legacy Navigation Radio
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 >
Navigation Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8247
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 >
Navigation Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8248
Diagnostic Tips Review # 5 - Alpine Silver Box Navigation Radio
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-46-004 > Aug > 08 > OnStar(R)
- Aftermarket Device Interference Information
Navigation System: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Aftermarket Device Interference
Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-08-46-004
Date: August 14, 2008
Subject: Information on Aftermarket Device Interference with OnStar(R) Diagnostic Services
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Car and Truck (including Saturn) 2009 and Prior HUMMER
H2, H3 Models 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
with OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
This bulletin is being issued to provide dealer service personnel with information regarding
aftermarket devices connected to the Diagnostic Link Connector (DLC) and the impact to
OnStar(R) diagnostic probes and Vehicle Diagnostic e-mails.
Certain aftermarket devices, when connected to the Diagnostic Link Connector, such as, but not
limited to, Scan Tools, Trip Computers, Fuel Economy Analyzers and Insurance Tracking Devices,
interfere with OnStar's ability to perform a diagnostic probe when requested (via a blue button call)
by a subscriber. These devices also prohibit the ability to gather diagnostic and tire pressure data
for a subscriber's scheduled OnStar(R) Vehicle Diagnostic (OVD) e-mail.
These aftermarket devices utilize the Vehicles serial data bus to perform data requests and/or
information gathering. When these devices are requesting data, OnStar(R) is designed not to
interfere with any data request being made by these devices as required by OBD II regulations.
The OnStar(R) advisor is unable to definitively detect the presence of these devices and will only
be able to inform the caller or requester of the unsuccessful or incomplete probe and may in some
cases refer the subscriber/requester to take the vehicle to a dealer for diagnosis of the concern.
When performing a diagnostic check for an unsuccessful or incomplete OnStar(R) diagnostic
probe, or for concerns regarding completeness of the OnStar(R) Vehicle Diagnostic (OVD) e-mail,
verify that an aftermarket device was not present at the time of the requested probe. Regarding the
OVD e-mail, if an aftermarket device is interfering (including a Scan Tool of any type), the e-mail
will consistently display a "yellow" indication in diagnostics section for all vehicle systems except
the OnStar(R) System and Tire Pressure data (not available on all vehicles) will not be displayed
(i.e. section is collapsed). Successful diagnostic probes and complete OVD e-mails will resume
following the removal or disconnecting of the off-board device.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-023 > Jun > 08 > Navigation
Radio - Adaptation After Radio/Battery R&R;
Navigation System: All Technical Service Bulletins Navigation Radio - Adaptation After
Radio/Battery R&R;
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-08-44-023
Date: June 18, 2008
Subject: Information On Navigation Radio Not Displaying Accurate Vehicle Location After Radio
Replacement, Power Loss Or Battery Replacement
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2009 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
with Navigation Radio
The purpose of this bulletin is to inform technicians and customers that the Navigation Radio may
not display the vehicle location icon on the map accurately after a radio or battery has been
replaced or after battery power has been removed from the radio. The vehicle location icon
accuracy may be degraded if the GPS signal is not available and the GPS displayed icon has a red
line through it.
The Navigation Radio does not keep learned GPS information or gyroscope and vehicle speed
signals stored when the battery power is removed from the radio. The Navigation radio continually
uses GPS, gyroscope and vehicle speed data to maintain the vehicle location icon positioned
accurately on the displayed map. There may be periods of time during a drive cycle when the GPS
signal may not be available and the vehicle location icon still appears to be accurate. This is due to
the radio having internal gyroscopes and receiving a vehicle speed signal to maintain accuracy if
the radio had received a good GPS signal earlier in the drive cycle.
Normal driving will improve the accuracy of the vehicle location icon on the displayed map. It may
be necessary for the vehicle to be driven up to 40 km (25 mi) with 15 left and 15 right turns while
the vehicle location icon is matched to roads on the displayed map. Do not replace the radio for this
condition.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 00-08-46-004C > Jan > 08 >
OnStar(R) - Re-establishing OnStar(R) Communications
Navigation System: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Re-establishing OnStar(R)
Communications
Bulletin No.: 00-08-46-004C
Date: January 17, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Re-establishing Communications with OnStar(R) Center After Battery Disconnect
Models: 2000-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn and Saab)
with Digital OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-08-46-004B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
When servicing any of the above models and a battery cable is disconnected or power to the
OnStar(R) Vehicle Communication Interface Module (VCIM) is interrupted for any reason the
following procedure must be performed to verify proper Global Positioning System (GPS) function.
Never swap OnStar(R) Vehicle Communication Interface Modules (VCIM) from other vehicles.
Transfer of OnStar(R) modules from other vehicles should not be done. Each OnStar(R) module
has a unique identification number. The VCIM has a specific Station Identification (STID). This
identification number is used by the National Cellular Telephone Network and OnStar(R) systems
and is stored in General Motors Vehicle History files by VIN.
After completing ALL repairs to the vehicle you must perform the following procedure:
Move the vehicle into an open area of the service lot.
Sit in the vehicle with the engine running and the radio turned on for five minutes.
Press the OnStar(R) button in the vehicle.
When the OnStar(R) advisor answers ask the advisor to verify the current location of the vehicle.
If the vehicle location is different than the location the OnStar(R) advisor gives contact GM
Technical Assistance (TAC) and choose the OnStar(R) prompt. GM OnStar(R) TAC will assist in
the diagnosis of a failed VCIM and, if appropriate, order a replacement part. Replacement parts are
usually shipped out within 24 hours, and a pre-paid return package label will be included for
returning the faulty part. By returning the faulty part, you will avoid a non-return core charge.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 02-08-46-006C > Jan > 08 >
OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position Reported During Call
Navigation System: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position Reported
During Call
Bulletin No.: 02-08-46-006C
Date: January 08, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Incorrect OnStar(R) Global Positioning System (GPS) Location Reported During
OnStar(R) Call
Models: 2000-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2008
HUMMER H2 2006-2008 HUMMER H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
with OnStar(R)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
02-08-46-006B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
A small number of the above-mentioned vehicles may exhibit a condition in which the vehicle
reports an inaccurate location to the OnStar(R) Call Center. This condition can only be identified
via a button press to the OnStar(R) Call Center by the customer. Call Center personnel will be able
to identify this inaccurate location condition. Customers will then be notified through the mail by
OnStar(R) if their vehicle exhibits this condition. Once this condition has been identified OnStar(R)
will instruct the customer to return to the dealership to have this condition corrected.
It is not necessary to reconfigure the vehicle after the following procedure.
In order to correct this condition you must cycle power to the OnStar(R) system. This can be done
by either removing the fuses powering the OnStar(R) system or disconnecting the OnStar(R)
module (VCIM) from the vehicle. As a last resort you can disconnect the vehicle's battery.
The power needs to be removed from the system for approximately 15 minutes.
After completing this procedure the vehicle should be taken to an area with an unobstructed view of
the sky. The vehicle should be kept running for approximately 10 minutes to allow the vehicle to
reacquire the global positioning system (GPS). Then contact the OnStar(R) Call Center via the blue
OnStar(R) button and ask the advisor to verify the GPS position.
If the OnStar(R) advisor still has an inaccurate GPS location refer to the Navigation Systems and
Cellular Communications sub-sections in the Service Manual in order to diagnose and repair the
concern. If the normal diagnostics lead to module replacement you will need to contact Technical
Assistance (TAC) and choose the OnStar(R) prompt. GM OnStar(R) TAC will assist in the
diagnosis and if appropriate order a replacement part. Replacement parts are usually shipped out
within 24 hours and a pre-paid return package label will be included for returning the faulty part. By
returning the faulty part you will avoid a significant non-return core charge.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab US Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Warranty Information (Saab US Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 02-08-46-006C > Jan > 08 >
OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position Reported During Call > Page 8265
For vehicles repaired under warranty use, the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 07-08-44-007 > Apr > 07 > Navigation
System - Replacement Navigation Discs
Navigation System: All Technical Service Bulletins Navigation System - Replacement Navigation
Discs
Bulletin No.: 07-08-44-007
Date: April 17, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Information on Obtaining Replacement Navigation Discs When Radios are Exchanged Order Replacement Navigation Disc Through Navigation Disc Center
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2007 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2007 and Prior Saab 9-7X
with a Navigation Radio
Attention:
The purpose of this bulletin is to inform dealership personnel of a new procedure for obtaining a
replacement navigation disc for radios that are sent to an ESC for exchange. This bulletin applies
to U.S. and Canadian dealers only and is not intended for use by export dealers.
When a navigation radio warranty exchange is performed, the customer must have a navigation
disc to operate the new radio. If the customer's navigation disc was damaged or is stuck in the
failed radio, the customer would have to wait for an excessive period of time for the disc to be
returned or replaced. The Electronic Service Centers (ESC) are not authorized to remove stuck
navigation discs from cores, as the cores must be returned to the supplier for analysis prior to any
disassembly. The time it would take for the supplier to return the navigation disc would significantly
delay the completion of the repair at the dealership.
If the customer's navigation disc is damaged or cannot be removed from the radio, the dealership
is to obtain an exchange radio through an ESC and a new navigation disc through the GM
Navigation Disc Center. Both items can be shipped overnight to the dealership upon request.
GM Navigation Disc Center Contact Information
Via the web through gmnavdisc.com
The GM Navigation Disc Center is also the center of expertise for navigation system questions.
Warranty Information
Include the part number and cost of the new navigation disc on the warranty claim for the
navigation radio exchange.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 10-08-44-006 > Oct > 10 > Navigation Report Missing/Inaccurate Nav. Map Info
Navigation System: All Technical Service Bulletins Navigation - Report Missing/Inaccurate Nav.
Map Info
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 10-08-44-006
Date: October 11, 2010
Subject: Reporting Missing or Inaccurate Navigation Radio Map Disc Information - Complete and
Submit Feedback Form at GM Navigation Disc Center Website
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Equipped with Navigation Radio
Some customers may notice that some navigation radio map discs may have missing or incorrect
information.
The following list contains some examples:
- Missing or incorrect roads, road names or road shapes
- Missing or incorrect addresses
- Missing or incorrect highway labeling
- Missing or incorrect highway exit numbers
- Missing or incorrect traffic restrictions
- Missing points of interest (POI) or incorrect details, such as location, category or phone number
General Motors uses a map database from two different suppliers. The two map suppliers are
consistently updating their map database and will gladly accept any input regarding missing or
incorrect information on the navigation radio map disc.
To report any missing or incorrect information, please access the GM Navigation Disc Center at the
following web site: http://www.gmnavdisc.com.
At the GM Navigation Disc Center home page, select the tab: Your Feedback. In the Navigation
Data Feedback form, fill in the appropriate information as required and then select: Submit, to send
the form.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 06-08-44-012E > Apr > 10 > Navigation
System - Software/DVD Update Program
Navigation System: All Technical Service Bulletins Navigation System - Software/DVD Update
Program
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 06-08-44-012E
Date: April 20, 2010
Subject: DVD Navigation Update Program, Navigation Disc Diagnostic Aid, AVN Software Update
Discs and Ordering Information
Models:
2002-2010 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2004-2010 HUMMER H2, H3
2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Attention:
Please direct this information to your Sales Consultants, Service Consultants, Parts Personnel and
Used Car Department. This bulletin ONLY applies to North American dealers/retailers.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to include the 2010 model year and update the usage
table. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 06-08-44-012D (Section 08 - Body and
Accessories).
DVD Navigation Update Program
The data on the DVD map disc ages at a rate of 15-20% per year. As the data ages, the
functionality of the navigation system declines. Offering GM customers new navigation DVDs will
ensure that the customers have the latest information for their system.
General Motors offered a Navigation Disc Update Program for 2006 and 2007 model year vehicles.
This program concluded on December 31, 2009. The DVD Navigation Update Program policy has
changed and customers are no longer eligible for free annual updates, however, a navigation DVD
update disc can be purchased for $199 (USD) + shipping.
If the navigation disc is needed for a warranty situation, the disc can be purchased for $120 (USD).
The dealer must provide a VIN and RO# to qualify for the reduced price. The dealer must call the
GM Navigation Disc Center, as this option is not available on the website.
The GM Navigation Disc Center launched on March 15, 2006. There are two ways to obtain an
updated disc:
- Via the web through gmnavdisc.com
- GM Navigation Disc Center
Navigation Disc Diagnostic Aid
The following table can be used to identify acceptable discs for testing the navigation unit's map
drive functionality. This should only be used to verify the map drive's ability to read the map disc
properly and to determine if there is an issue with the unit's map drive or the disc. Some functions,
such as voice recognition, may not work properly with some of the discs in the list. If the disc is
found to be defective always contact the GM Navigation Disc Center to obtain the most recent disc
for the vehicle.
AVN Software Update Discs
Technical Service Bulletins are sometimes generated to address specific navigation radio
operational or performance issues. When a navigation radio bulletin is issued, it may contain
instructions to utilize an advanced vehicle navigation (AVN) software update with a specific part
number. GM dealers must order advanced vehicle navigation (AVN) software update discs as
directed in the specific bulletin.
AVN software update discs are for the dealer to update the navigation radio software only. They do
NOT update or replace the navigation map disc that is supplied with the vehicle. Please order
these parts only as needed. There is a limited supply of these discs available. Do not order these
discs for stock. AVN software update discs can be used to reprogram more than one vehicle. The
first update disc for each P/N is free. Subsequent copies of the same P/N for the same dealer will
cost $50 (USD).
To obtain an AVN software update disc, follow the specific ordering information provided in the
bulletin.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 06-08-44-012E > Apr > 10 > Navigation
System - Software/DVD Update Program > Page 8279
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 02-08-44-007D > May > 09 > OnStar(R) Negative Impact of Cloth/Vinyl Roofs
Navigation System: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Negative Impact of Cloth/Vinyl
Roofs
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 02-08-44-007D
Date: May 12, 2009
Subject: Negative Impact of Dealer-Installed Cloth/Vinyl Roofs on XM Radio and/or OnStar(R)
Systems
Models:
2002-2009 Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2009
HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X with XM Radio (RPO U2K) and/or OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................................................. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to
include the 2009 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-08-44-007C (Section
08 - Body and Accessories).
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................
Dealers should not install a cloth or vinyl roof on vehicles that have been ordered with the XM radio
option (RPO U2K) and/or OnStar(R) (RPO UE1). The performance of these systems may be
negatively impacted by the installation of the cloth/vinyl roof. Additionally, water leaks may result
from installing a cloth or vinyl roof on vehicles with roof-mounted antenna systems. Relocating the
antenna to another spot on the vehicle exterior, in order to install a cloth or vinyl roof, is not advised
either. The performance of the OnStar(R) and XM Radio antennas has been optimized for their
current locations. Relocating the antennas may result in a performance degradation.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 > Navigation
Radio - Diagnostic Tips
Navigation System: All Technical Service Bulletins Navigation Radio - Diagnostic Tips
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-08-44-010F
Date: March 09, 2009
Subject: Navigation Radio Diagnostic Tips
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2008 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2008 and Prior Saab 9-7X
All Equipped with Navigation Radio
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to update the model years involved, the radio part number list, remove
the PQC parts restriction and revise the diagnostic information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 08-08-44-010E (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Recent part reviews indicate that the majority of Navigation Radios returned for analysis do not test
as defective. In many cases, published SI documents were available to correct the condition
without the need for an exchange unit. The following Diagnostic Tips may assist with the proper
diagnosis and repair of Navigation Radio Concerns.
Note
For U.S. dealers the 2009 and 2010 Model Year Navigation Radios are currently on restriction
through the Technical Assistance Center (TAC). Refer to PI PIC5102. To order Radios and
Instrument Panel Clusters (IPC) for 2008 and prior model year vehicles, please continue to follow
the normal process and contact an authorized Electronic Service Center (ESC) for assistance.
For any Navigation Radio replaced, a copy of the Repair Order (RO) must be included with the
returned radio. Be sure to document the customer's concern in detail, including unusual noises and
what functions are affected. List any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) on the RO.
Ensure the radio is sufficiently protected during shipping to prevent damage to the radio assembly.
Note
Navigation Radios with physical damage (for example: shattered displays, impact damage to the
radio face and fluid damage) must be reviewed with the District Service Manager for appropriate
coverage prior to replacing the radio. The dealership must note the District Service Manager's
approval on the Repair Order, along with the reason for the goodwill assistance. Do NOT
disassemble the radio to try and retrieve stuck CDs/DVDs as this may result in a debit to the
dealership. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 08-08-44-015, Information on Inappropriate
Warranty Claims submitted for Damaged Radios and Instrument Panel Clusters.
Getting Started
Retrieve the Navigation Radio part number using the Tech 2(R). Refer to Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-08-44-005C - Utilizing Tech 2 to Retrieve Part Numbers for Radios, Compact Disc (CD)
Changers and Instrument Panel Clusters (IPC). Use the table below to determine the appropriate
Diagnostic Tips Review to follow based on the radio part number. Scroll down the bulletin to find
the corresponding Diagnostic Tips Review.
Printing This Document
To print the applicable Diagnostic Tips Review pages, select File then Print Preview. Use the
arrows at the top of the screen to scroll left and right through the bulletin to identify the correct
pages containing the questions. With the pages identified, click on the Print button at the top left. In
the pop-up box, select "Pages" in the "Print Range" and type in the pages. For example, to print
pages 19 through 22, type in the box provided "19-22". Once the page range has been filled in,
click the Print box at the bottom of the pop-up box.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 > Navigation
Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8288
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 > Navigation
Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8289
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 > Navigation
Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8290
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 > Navigation
Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8291
Diagnostic Tips Review Table
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 > Navigation
Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8292
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 > Navigation
Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8293
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 > Navigation
Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8294
Diagnostic Tips Review # 1 - Delphi Super Nav and Black Tie Nav
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 > Navigation
Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8295
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 > Navigation
Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8296
Diagnostic Tips Review # 2 - Delphi Legacy Navigation Radio
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 > Navigation
Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8297
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 > Navigation
Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8298
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 > Navigation
Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8299
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 > Navigation
Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8300
Diagnostic Tips Review # 3 - Denso Navigation Radios
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 > Navigation
Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8301
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 > Navigation
Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8302
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 > Navigation
Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8303
Diagnostic Tips Review # 4 - Denso legacy Navigation Radio
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 > Navigation
Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8304
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-010F > Mar > 09 > Navigation
Radio - Diagnostic Tips > Page 8305
Diagnostic Tips Review # 5 - Alpine Silver Box Navigation Radio
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-46-004 > Aug > 08 > OnStar(R) Aftermarket Device Interference Information
Navigation System: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Aftermarket Device Interference
Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-08-46-004
Date: August 14, 2008
Subject: Information on Aftermarket Device Interference with OnStar(R) Diagnostic Services
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Car and Truck (including Saturn) 2009 and Prior HUMMER
H2, H3 Models 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
with OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
This bulletin is being issued to provide dealer service personnel with information regarding
aftermarket devices connected to the Diagnostic Link Connector (DLC) and the impact to
OnStar(R) diagnostic probes and Vehicle Diagnostic e-mails.
Certain aftermarket devices, when connected to the Diagnostic Link Connector, such as, but not
limited to, Scan Tools, Trip Computers, Fuel Economy Analyzers and Insurance Tracking Devices,
interfere with OnStar's ability to perform a diagnostic probe when requested (via a blue button call)
by a subscriber. These devices also prohibit the ability to gather diagnostic and tire pressure data
for a subscriber's scheduled OnStar(R) Vehicle Diagnostic (OVD) e-mail.
These aftermarket devices utilize the Vehicles serial data bus to perform data requests and/or
information gathering. When these devices are requesting data, OnStar(R) is designed not to
interfere with any data request being made by these devices as required by OBD II regulations.
The OnStar(R) advisor is unable to definitively detect the presence of these devices and will only
be able to inform the caller or requester of the unsuccessful or incomplete probe and may in some
cases refer the subscriber/requester to take the vehicle to a dealer for diagnosis of the concern.
When performing a diagnostic check for an unsuccessful or incomplete OnStar(R) diagnostic
probe, or for concerns regarding completeness of the OnStar(R) Vehicle Diagnostic (OVD) e-mail,
verify that an aftermarket device was not present at the time of the requested probe. Regarding the
OVD e-mail, if an aftermarket device is interfering (including a Scan Tool of any type), the e-mail
will consistently display a "yellow" indication in diagnostics section for all vehicle systems except
the OnStar(R) System and Tire Pressure data (not available on all vehicles) will not be displayed
(i.e. section is collapsed). Successful diagnostic probes and complete OVD e-mails will resume
following the removal or disconnecting of the off-board device.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 08-08-44-023 > Jun > 08 > Navigation
Radio - Adaptation After Radio/Battery R&R;
Navigation System: All Technical Service Bulletins Navigation Radio - Adaptation After
Radio/Battery R&R;
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-08-44-023
Date: June 18, 2008
Subject: Information On Navigation Radio Not Displaying Accurate Vehicle Location After Radio
Replacement, Power Loss Or Battery Replacement
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2009 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
with Navigation Radio
The purpose of this bulletin is to inform technicians and customers that the Navigation Radio may
not display the vehicle location icon on the map accurately after a radio or battery has been
replaced or after battery power has been removed from the radio. The vehicle location icon
accuracy may be degraded if the GPS signal is not available and the GPS displayed icon has a red
line through it.
The Navigation Radio does not keep learned GPS information or gyroscope and vehicle speed
signals stored when the battery power is removed from the radio. The Navigation radio continually
uses GPS, gyroscope and vehicle speed data to maintain the vehicle location icon positioned
accurately on the displayed map. There may be periods of time during a drive cycle when the GPS
signal may not be available and the vehicle location icon still appears to be accurate. This is due to
the radio having internal gyroscopes and receiving a vehicle speed signal to maintain accuracy if
the radio had received a good GPS signal earlier in the drive cycle.
Normal driving will improve the accuracy of the vehicle location icon on the displayed map. It may
be necessary for the vehicle to be driven up to 40 km (25 mi) with 15 left and 15 right turns while
the vehicle location icon is matched to roads on the displayed map. Do not replace the radio for this
condition.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 00-08-46-004C > Jan > 08 > OnStar(R) Re-establishing OnStar(R) Communications
Navigation System: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Re-establishing OnStar(R)
Communications
Bulletin No.: 00-08-46-004C
Date: January 17, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Re-establishing Communications with OnStar(R) Center After Battery Disconnect
Models: 2000-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn and Saab)
with Digital OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-08-46-004B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
When servicing any of the above models and a battery cable is disconnected or power to the
OnStar(R) Vehicle Communication Interface Module (VCIM) is interrupted for any reason the
following procedure must be performed to verify proper Global Positioning System (GPS) function.
Never swap OnStar(R) Vehicle Communication Interface Modules (VCIM) from other vehicles.
Transfer of OnStar(R) modules from other vehicles should not be done. Each OnStar(R) module
has a unique identification number. The VCIM has a specific Station Identification (STID). This
identification number is used by the National Cellular Telephone Network and OnStar(R) systems
and is stored in General Motors Vehicle History files by VIN.
After completing ALL repairs to the vehicle you must perform the following procedure:
Move the vehicle into an open area of the service lot.
Sit in the vehicle with the engine running and the radio turned on for five minutes.
Press the OnStar(R) button in the vehicle.
When the OnStar(R) advisor answers ask the advisor to verify the current location of the vehicle.
If the vehicle location is different than the location the OnStar(R) advisor gives contact GM
Technical Assistance (TAC) and choose the OnStar(R) prompt. GM OnStar(R) TAC will assist in
the diagnosis of a failed VCIM and, if appropriate, order a replacement part. Replacement parts are
usually shipped out within 24 hours, and a pre-paid return package label will be included for
returning the faulty part. By returning the faulty part, you will avoid a non-return core charge.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation System: > 07-08-44-007 > Apr > 07 > Navigation
System - Replacement Navigation Discs
Navigation System: All Technical Service Bulletins Navigation System - Replacement Navigation
Discs
Bulletin No.: 07-08-44-007
Date: April 17, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Information on Obtaining Replacement Navigation Discs When Radios are Exchanged Order Replacement Navigation Disc Through Navigation Disc Center
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2007 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2007 and Prior Saab 9-7X
with a Navigation Radio
Attention:
The purpose of this bulletin is to inform dealership personnel of a new procedure for obtaining a
replacement navigation disc for radios that are sent to an ESC for exchange. This bulletin applies
to U.S. and Canadian dealers only and is not intended for use by export dealers.
When a navigation radio warranty exchange is performed, the customer must have a navigation
disc to operate the new radio. If the customer's navigation disc was damaged or is stuck in the
failed radio, the customer would have to wait for an excessive period of time for the disc to be
returned or replaced. The Electronic Service Centers (ESC) are not authorized to remove stuck
navigation discs from cores, as the cores must be returned to the supplier for analysis prior to any
disassembly. The time it would take for the supplier to return the navigation disc would significantly
delay the completion of the repair at the dealership.
If the customer's navigation disc is damaged or cannot be removed from the radio, the dealership
is to obtain an exchange radio through an ESC and a new navigation disc through the GM
Navigation Disc Center. Both items can be shipped overnight to the dealership upon request.
GM Navigation Disc Center Contact Information
Via the web through gmnavdisc.com
The GM Navigation Disc Center is also the center of expertise for navigation system questions.
Warranty Information
Include the part number and cost of the new navigation disc on the warranty claim for the
navigation radio exchange.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Amplifier,
Sound System > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Amplifier,
Sound System > Component Information > Locations > Page 8326
Audio Amplifier
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Amplifier,
Sound System > Component Information > Locations > Page 8327
Amplifier: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the body side front lower trim panel. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector from the
amplifier.
3. Remove the amplifier from the vehicle by sliding the amplifier toward the rear of the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Amplifier,
Sound System > Component Information > Locations > Page 8328
1. Align the mounting tabs and slide the amplifier toward the front of the vehicle in order to install
the amplifier to the vehicle.
2. Connect the electrical connector to the amplifier. 3. Install the body front lower trim panel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Locations
Compact Disc Player (CD): Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Locations > Page 8332
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Locations > Page 8333
Remote Playback Device
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Locations > Page 8334
Compact Disc Player (CD): Service and Repair
REMOTE CD PLAYER REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the instrument panel extension trim plate. 2. Squeeze the fasteners on both sides of the
remote compact disc player. 3. Pull out the remote compact disc player. 4. Disconnect the electrical
connectors.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Connect the electrical connectors. 2. Align the fasteners on the remote compact disc player with
the slots in the instrument panel extension. 3. Slide the remote compact disc player into place until
the fasteners are fully seated. 4. Install the instrument panel extension trim plate.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Audio - Inadvertent Steering
Wheel Button Activation
Remote Switch: Technical Service Bulletins Audio - Inadvertent Steering Wheel Button Activation
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-08-44-028
Date: August 28, 2008
Subject: Information On Inadvertent Steering Wheel Control (SWC) Button Press Causing Radio
Anomalies
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2009 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 Models 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
All Vehicles with Steering Wheel Controls
This bulletin is being issued to provide a recommendation for vehicles with a customer concern of
the radio station tuning changing by itself, volume changing by itself, radio changing by itself, or
radio muting or going silent when driving and turning the steering wheel.
The switches on the right hand side of the steering wheel are easily pressed and may inadvertently
be pressed when turning the steering wheel.
These concerns may be affected by the location of the steering wheel controls.
Recommendation
Do Not Replace The Radio
1. Please determine that the switch controls on the steering wheel are functioning correctly.
2. Ask the customer if their hand was in close proximity to the steering wheel controls when the
condition happened. Explain to the customer that bumping the controls would have caused this
undesired action. Explain to the customer the proper use and function of the steering wheel
controls.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Locations
Speaker: Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8343
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8344
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8345
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Speaker: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8348
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8349
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8350
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8351
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8352
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8353
Speaker: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8354
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8355
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8356
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8357
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8358
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8359
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8360
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8361
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8362
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8363
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8364
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8365
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8366
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8367
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8368
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8369
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8370
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8371
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8372
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8373
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8374
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8375
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8376
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8377
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8378
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8379
Speaker: Connector Views
Speaker - LF Door
Speaker - LR
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8380
Speaker - LF Door Tweeter
Speaker - LR Door
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8381
Speaker - LR Subwoofer
Speaker - RF Door Tweeter
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8382
Speaker - RF Door
Speaker - RR
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8383
Speaker - RR Door
Speaker - RR Subwoofer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8384
Speaker: Electrical Diagrams
Radio/Audio System Schematics: Speakers And Sub-Woofers (Premium W/O RSA)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8385
Radio/Audio System Schematics: Speaker And Sub-Woofer (Premium W/ RSA)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Base Level
Speaker: Description and Operation Base Level
BAL
1. Turn the BAL control knob behind the VOLUME knob to select more or less sound, distributed
between the left or the right speakers. 2. The middle position will deliver an equal balance of sound
between the left and right speakers.
FADE
1. Turn the FADE control knob behind the TUNE knob to select more or less sound, distributed
between the front and rear speakers. 2. The middle position will deliver an equal balance of sound
between the front and rear speakers.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Base Level > Page 8388
Speaker: Description and Operation Uplevel
BALANCE
1. Depress the BAL control in order to remove the control from the recessed position. 2. Rotate the
balance to the right in order to adjust the sound to the right speakers. 3. Rotate the balance to the
left in order to adjust the sound to the left speakers. 4. Push the control knob back in to store when
not in use.
FADE
1. Depress the FADE control in order to remove the control from the recessed position. 2. Rotate
the FADE control knob to the right in order to adjust the sound to the front speakers. 3. Rotate the
FADE control knob to the left in order to adjust the sound to the rear speakers. 4. Push the control
knob back in order to store when not in use.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Speaker: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Steps 1-9
Steps 1-2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 8391
Steps 3-6
Steps 1-7
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 8392
Steps 1-5
Steps 6-11
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 8393
Steps 1-6
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 8394
Steps 7-16
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Speaker Replacement - Front Lower
Speaker: Service and Repair Speaker Replacement - Front Lower
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the door trim panel. 2. Remove the mounting screws. 3. Remove the speaker from the
door. 4. Disconnect the electrical connector from the speaker.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Connect the electrical connector to the speaker. 2. Install the speaker to the door.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the speaker mounting screws.
Tighten Tighten the speaker mounting screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
4. Verify component operation. 5. Install the door trim panel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Speaker Replacement - Front Lower > Page 8397
Speaker: Service and Repair Speaker Replacement - Front Upper
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the assist handle from the door. 2. Remove the retaining screw from the trim plate. 3.
Remove the escutcheon from the trim plate. 4. Swing the plate down. 5. Remove the tweeter
speaker from the trim plate by rotating in order to clear the mounting tabs. 6. Disconnect the
electrical connector.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Connect the electrical connector. 2. Install the tweeter speaker to the trim plate by rotating in
order to lock the mounting tabs. 3. Verify component operation. 4. Swing the trim plate up. 5. Install
the escutcheon to the trim plate.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
6. Install the retaining screw to the trim plate.
Tighten Tighten the trim plate screw to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Speaker Replacement - Front Lower > Page 8398
7. Install the assist handle to the door.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Speaker Replacement - Front Lower > Page 8399
Speaker: Service and Repair Speaker Replacement - Rear Pillar
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Gently pry the rear speaker grille from the trim panel using a suitable flat-bladed tool. 2. Remove
the speaker mounting screws. 3. Remove the rear speaker from the panel. 4. Disconnect the
electrical connector.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Connect the electrical connector. 2. Install the rear speaker to the trim panel.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the speaker mounting screws.
Tighten Tighten the speaker mounting screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
4. Verify component operation. 5. Install the rear speaker grille to the trim panel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Speaker Replacement - Front Lower > Page 8400
Speaker: Service and Repair Speaker Replacement - Rear Door
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the door trim panel. 2. Remove the rivets that retain the speaker to the door. 3.
Disconnect the electrical connector from the speaker. 4. Remove the speaker from the door.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Position the speaker to the door. 2. Connect the electrical connector to the speaker. 3. Install the
speaker to the door. 4. Use a rivit gun in order to secure the speaker to the door with new rivets. 5.
Install the door trim panel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Speaker Replacement - Front Lower > Page 8401
Speaker: Service and Repair Speaker Grille Replacement - Rear
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Open the rear door(s). 2. Separate the corners of the grille from the trim panel, one at a time, in
order to remove the grille. 3. Remove the grille from the door trim panel.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Align the grill retaining clips with the slots in the door trim panel. 2. Seat the grille into place. 3.
Close the door(s).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Audio System - Clearing `CLN' Message From Display
Tape Player: Technical Service Bulletins Audio System - Clearing `CLN' Message From Display
File In Section: 08 - Body and Accessories
Bulletin No.: 01-08-44-006A
Date: June, 2001
INFORMATION
Subject: Cleaning the Cassette Tape Player and Clearing the CLN Message from the Radio
Display
Models: 1996-2002 Chevrolet and GMC Truck Models With Remote Cassette Tape Player (RP0
UP0)
This bulletin is being revised to include additional model years and models, parts information, and
to provide a procedure for cleaning the cassette tape player and resetting the CLN indicator on the
radio display. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 01-08-44-006 (Section 08 - Body and
Accessories).
When the CLN message appears on the audio system, it indicates that the cassette tape player
requires cleaning. Customers should follow the listed instructions. The recommended cleaning
method for the remote cassette player is to use a scrubbing action, non-abrasive cleaning cassette,
GM P/N 12344789. The cleaning cassette scrubs the tape head as the hubs of the cleaner
cassette turn.
Use the following procedure to clean the remote cassette player and reset the CLN indicator on the
radio.
1. With the radio ON, insert the recommended cleaning cassette.
2. After a few seconds, the cleaning cassette may eject because it may appear to the player as a
cassette with a broken tape. If ejection occurs, reinsert the cleaning cassette. Continue this
process three or four times until the cleaning cassette is engaged for the time recommended by the
cleaning cassette instructions.
3. Eject the cleaning cassette if the cassette does not eject on its own.
4. Press and hold the RECALL button on the radio until CLN appears on the radio display. While
still pressing the radio RECALL button, press EJECT on the remote player. Release both buttons
when the radio display indicates that the CLN indicator timer has been reset.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
DISCLAIMER
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8406
Tape Player: Service and Repair
CASSETTE PLAYER CARE AND CLEANING
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 39916-A CD and Cassette Diagnostic Audio Kit
If you do not regularly clean the tape player, the tape player is subject to the following conditions:
^ Reduced sound quality
^ Ruined cassettes
^ A damaged tape mechanism
Cassette tapes may not operate properly if they are not stored in their cases away from the
following conditions:
^ Contaminants
^ Direct sunlight
^ Extreme heat
Cleaning Intervals Clean the cassette tape player after every 15 hours of operation for optimum
performance.
Clean the cassette tape player at a maximum of every 50 hours of playing time. This will prevent
damage to the cassette tape player mechanism. The radio may display CLN, CLEAN, or CLEAN
TAPE (depending on the type of radio being used), if equipped with the clean tape indicator
feature. This indicates that you have used the tape player for 50 hours without resetting the tape
clean timer. If this message appears on the display, clean the cassette tape player. The player can
still play tapes but the player should be cleaned as soon as possible in order to prevent damage to
the tapes and/or the player.
Cassettes are subject to wear and the sound quality may degrade over time. If you notice a
reduction in sound quality, play a different cassette. A new cassette may indicate whether the tape
or the tape player is at fault.
If the sound quality does not improve when the second tape is played, clean the cassette player.
Perform this step regardless of when you last cleaned the cassette player.
If a noticeable improvement is not achieved after cleaning the player, remove the radio assembly
for repair.
Head and Capstan Cleaning The following 2 components are cleaned on a cassette player: ^
The head
^ The capstan
IMPORTANT: Do not contact the tape head with magnetized tools. If the head becomes
magnetized, every cassette played in the player will be degraded.
In order to properly clean a tape player, use the cleaning cassette in J 39916-A in order to clean
the head and the capstan. The cleaning cassette is a scrubbing action, non-abrasive cassette with
pads which scrub the tape head as the hubs of the cleaner cassette turn. When using a scrubbing
action, non-abrasive cleaning, the cassette may eject. The unit is equipped with a cut tape
detection feature. The feature than may detected as a broken tape.
In order to prevent the cleaning cassette from being ejected, perform the following steps: 1. Turn
the ignition switch to one of the following positions (depending upon the vehicle):
^ ON
^ RUN
^ ACC
^ ACCESSORY
2. Turn OFF the radio. 3. Press and hold the TAPE button for 5 seconds. The tape symbol on the
display will flash for 2 seconds. 4. Insert the scrubbing action cleaning cassette. 5. Eject the
cleaning cassette after the manufacturer's recommended cleaning time. When the cleaning
cassette has been ejected, the cut tape
detection feature is active again.
The alternative method is to use a non-scrubbing action, wet type cleaning cassette. This cassette
uses a fabric belt to clean the tape head. This type of cleaning cassette does not eject on its own.
A non-scrubbing action cassette may not clean as thoroughly as the scrubbing type cleaning
cassette. The use of this cassette is not recommended.
After you clean the player, press and hold the EJECT button for 5 seconds to reset the CLEAN
indicator. The radio display shows that the indicator has been reset.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Accessory Delay Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8412
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8413
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8414
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8415
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8416
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8417
Accessory Delay Module: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8418
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8419
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8420
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8421
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8422
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8423
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8424
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8425
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8426
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8427
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8428
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8429
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8430
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8431
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8432
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8433
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8434
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8435
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8436
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8437
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8438
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8439
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8440
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8441
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8442
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8443
Accessory Delay Module: Description and Operation
RETAINED ACCESSORY POWER (RAP) POWER MODE
RAP is a vehicle power mode that permits the operation of selected customer convenience items
after the ignition switch is turned OFF. These selected items will remain in operation until a
passenger compartment door is opened or until the RAP function timer reaches its shut-off limit.
The body control module monitors the ignition switch position, battery condition and passenger
compartment door status to determine whether RAP should be initiated. If the ignition switch
transitions from RUN/ON to OFF, the battery level is within the acceptable range and the
passenger compartment doors are closed, the body control module closes the RAP relay.
This provides power for the following: ^
Sunroof
^ Power windows
^ Power door locks
^ Radio
^ Rear radio
^ OnStar
The BCM turns OFF the RAP function and opens the RAP relay when one of the following
conditions are met: ^
The BCM senses the opening of any door or the liftgate.
^ The BCM detects a decrease in battery capacity below a prescribed limit.
^ The BCM receives a message from its internal timer indicating the end of the RAP period after 20
minutes.
^ The transition from OFF to RUN/ON or ACC of the ignition switch.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and
Diagnostic Overview
Accessory Delay Module: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Diagnostic Starting Point
Begin the system diagnosis with the Diagnostic System Check - Accessory Delay Module. The
Diagnostic System Check will provide the following information:
^ The identification of the control module which commands the system
^ The ability of the control module to communicate through the serial data circuit
^ The identification of any stored DTCs and their status
The use of the Diagnostic System Check will identify the correct procedure for diagnosing the
system and where the procedure is located.
Diagnostic System Check
TEST DESCRIPTION
Steps 1-5
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. Lack of communication
may be due to a partial malfunction of the class 2 serial data circuit or due to a total malfunction of
the class 2 serial data
circuit. The specified procedure will determine the particular condition.
4. This step is checking for DTCs in the BCM. 5. This step is checking for RAP specific DTCs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and
Diagnostic Overview > Page 8446
Accessory Delay Module: Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes
With Scan Tool
PROCEDURE
Use a Tech II or equivalent Scan tool to clear Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) from the PCM
memory. When clearing DTCs, follow the instructions supplied by the Scan tool manufacturer.
NOTES: ^
Do not clear the DTCs unless directed to do so by the service information provided for each
diagnostic procedure. All of the diagnostic data that was saved along with the DTC (freeze frame
data and/or malfunction history records) which may be helpful for some diagnostic procedures will
be erased from the memory when the DTCs are cleared.
^ Interrupting PCM battery voltage to clear DTCs is NOT recommended.
Without Scan Tool
PROCEDURE
Use a Tech II or equivalent Scan tool to clear Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) from the PCM
memory. When clearing DTCs, follow the instructions supplied by the Scan tool manufacturer.
NOTES: ^
Do not clear the DTCs unless directed to do so by the service information provided for each
diagnostic procedure. All of the diagnostic data that was saved along with the DTC (freeze frame
data and/or malfunction history records) which may be helpful for some diagnostic procedures will
be erased from the memory when the DTCs are cleared.
^ Interrupting PCM battery voltage to clear DTCs is NOT recommended.
With Scan Tool
PROCEDURE
A Tech II or equivalent Scan tool must be used to retrieve Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) from
the PCM memory. DTCs can no longer be retrieved at the data link connector. This also eliminates
the PCM function of flashing Code 12. Follow the instructions supplied by the Scan tool
manufacturer in order to access and read either current and/or history DTCs.
Without Scan Tool
A Tech II or equivalent scan tool must be used to retrieve Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) from
the PCM memory. DTCs can no longer be retrieved at the data link connector. This also eliminates
the PCM function of flashing Code 12. Follow the instructions supplied by the scan tool
manufacturer in order to access and read either current and/or history DTCs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and
Diagnostic Overview > Page 8447
Accessory Delay Module: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
A Symptoms
IMPORTANT PRELIMINARY CHECKS BEFORE STARTING
1. Perform the Diagnostic System Check - Accessory Delay Module before using the Symptom
Tables in order to verify that all of the following are
true: ^
There are no DTCs set.
^ The control module(s) can communicate via the serial data link. See: Initial Inspection and
Diagnostic Overview/Diagnostic System Check
2. Review the system operation in order to familiarize yourself with the system functions. Refer to
Retained Accessory Power (RAP) Description and
Operation.
VISUAL/PHYSICAL INSPECTION ^
Inspect for aftermarket devices which could affect the operation of the Retained Accessory Power
system. Refer to Checking Aftermarket Accessories in Diagnostic Aids.
^ Inspect the easily accessible or visible system components for obvious damage or conditions
which could cause the symptom.
INTERMITTENT Faulty electrical connections or wiring may be the cause of intermittent conditions.
Refer to Testing for Intermittent and Poor Connections in Diagnostic Aids.
SYMPTOM LIST Refer to a symptom diagnostic procedure from the following list in order to
diagnose the symptom: ^
Retained Accessory Power (RAP) On After Timeout
^ Retained Accessory Power (RAP) Inoperative
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and
Diagnostic Overview > Page 8448
Steps 1-10
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and
Diagnostic Overview > Page 8449
Steps 1-9
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and
Diagnostic Overview > Page 8450
Accessory Delay Module: Scan Tool Testing and Procedures
Scan Tool Data Definitions
MODULE INFORMATION 1
Julian Date of Build: The scan tool displays the date upon which the Body Control Module (BCM)
was manufactured.
Manufacture Enable Counter (MEC): The scan tool displays the actual value for the MEC in the
BCM. This information is for the assembly plant only.
Module Part Number: The scan tool displays the pan number assigned to the BCM that is currently
in the vehicle.
Software Design Suffix: The scan tool displays the version of the software pan number in the BCM.
Software Part Number: The scan tool displays the software identification number (ID) in the BCM.
MODULE INFORMATION 2
Retained Accessory Power (RAP) Calibration Number: The scan tool displays the RAP calibration
part number in the BCM.
Retained Accessory Power (RAP) Suffix: The scan tool displays the RAP identification number in
the BCM.
DATA
Battery Voltage: The scan tool displays the battery system voltage.
Inadvertent Power Timer: The scan tool displays the seconds left before the BCM turns the
inadvertent power relay OFF. The BCM uses this feature to protect the battery against inadvertent
battery rundown caused by components that are part of the courtesy lamp circuit. The inadvertent
power relay is supplied power by the BCM for 2400 seconds / 40 minutes after the ignition is turned
OFF.
RAP Timer: The scan tool displays the seconds left before the BCM turns the RAP relay OFF. The
BCM uses this feature to allow the operation of the radio and the power windows for up to 1198
seconds / 20 minutes after the ignition is turned OFF. After the time has elapsed or the door is
opened the BCM will open the ground circuit for the RAP relay.
INPUT 1
Door Handle Switch: The scan tool displays the position of the door handle. The scan tool displays
ACTIVE when a door handle is raised and INACTIVE with all doors closed and the door handles at
rest.
Drivers Door Jamb Switch: The scan tool displays the position of the drivers door. The scan tool
displays ACTIVE when the drivers door is open.
Ignition 1: The scan tool displays the position of the ignition switch. The scan tool displays ACTIVE
when the ignition switch is in the RUN or CRANK position.
Ignition 3: The scan tool displays the position of the ignition switch. The scan tool displays ACTIVE
when the ignition switch is in the RUN position only.
Ignition Power Mode: The scan tool displays the position of the ignition switch. The scan tool
displays OFF, RUN, CRANK and UNKNOWN. The UNKNOWN display is when the BCM can not
determine the position of the ignition switch.
Key In Ignition: The scan tool displays the position of the ignition key in the ignition switch cylinder.
The scan tool displays YES when the ignition key is completely inserted into the ignition switch
cylinder. The BCM uses this data in controlling the operation of the reminder chime feature.
RAP Relay Feedback: The scan tool displays the state of the RAP relay. The scan tool displays ON
when the BCM activates the RAP relay.
OUTPUTS
RAP Relay: The scan tool displays the commanded state of the RAP relay. The scan tool displays
ON when the BCM allows the RAP relay to go to ground. The BCM will allow operation of the radio
and the power windows with the ignition OFF and the doors closed for up to 1198 seconds,
approximately 20 minutes.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and
Diagnostic Overview > Page 8451
Scan Tool Data List
Scan Tool Output Controls
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: >
05-08-46-004C > Dec > 10 > OnStar(R) - Number Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned
Emergency Contact Module: Customer Interest OnStar(R) - Number Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 05-08-46-004C
Date: December 23, 2010
Subject: OnStar(R) Phone Number Concerns (Phone Number Incorrect/Assigned to Another
Vehicle/Phone) That Occur During Diagnosis of OnStar(R) System
Models:
2000-2011 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Equipped with OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years up to 2011. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 05-08-46-004B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
During diagnosis of an OnStar(R) concern, the technician may be told that the OnStar(R) phone
number is incorrect or tied to another vehicle and/or phone of some kind. To resolve these
concerns, the Tech 2(R) with software version 22.005 (or higher), has the capability to change the
OnStar(R) phone number.
Service Procedure
1. With the Tech 2(R), build the vehicle to specifications within the Diagnostics area of the Tech
2(R). 2. For vehicles with physical-based diagnostics - under Body, go to the OnStar(R) section.
Then select the Special Functions menu.
For vehicles with functional-based diagnostics - under Body and Accessories, go to the Cellular
Communication section. Select Module Setup and then Vehicle Communication Interface Module.
3. Locate the Program Phone Number prompt and select it. The original phone number will be
displayed on the Tech 2(R) screen. 4. Contact the OnStar(R) team at the GM Technical Assistance
Center (TAC) to obtain a new phone number. 5. Highlight the digits of the phone number one at a
time and enter the new phone number using the number keys on the Tech 2(R). 6. Press the Soft
key at the base of the screen for Done once these numbers have been changed on the screen. 7.
Press the Soft key for Done again. The area code or new phone number has now been
programmed into the phone. 8. Cycle the ignition to Off and open the driver's door. 9. Press the
blue OnStar(R) button to make sure that a normal connection can be made to the OnStar(R) call
center. If applicable, make sure the
Hands-Free Calling (HFC) works properly by making a phone call.
10. If the system is working properly, fax or voicemail a case closing into the OnStar(R) team at
TAC with the results. Dealers in Canada should
submit case closing information through the GM infoNET.
Please follow this diagnostic process thoroughly and complete each step. If the condition exhibited
is resolved WITHOUT completing every step, the remaining steps do not need to be performed. If
the procedure above does not resolve the condition, you must contact TAC for further assistance.
This diagnostic approach was developed specifically for this condition and should not automatically
be used for other vehicles with similar symptoms.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: >
05-08-46-004C > Dec > 10 > OnStar(R) - Number Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned > Page 8460
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: >
02-08-46-006C > Jan > 08 > OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position Reported During Call
Emergency Contact Module: Customer Interest OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position Reported
During Call
Bulletin No.: 02-08-46-006C
Date: January 08, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Incorrect OnStar(R) Global Positioning System (GPS) Location Reported During
OnStar(R) Call
Models: 2000-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2008
HUMMER H2 2006-2008 HUMMER H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
with OnStar(R)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
02-08-46-006B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
A small number of the above-mentioned vehicles may exhibit a condition in which the vehicle
reports an inaccurate location to the OnStar(R) Call Center. This condition can only be identified
via a button press to the OnStar(R) Call Center by the customer. Call Center personnel will be able
to identify this inaccurate location condition. Customers will then be notified through the mail by
OnStar(R) if their vehicle exhibits this condition. Once this condition has been identified OnStar(R)
will instruct the customer to return to the dealership to have this condition corrected.
It is not necessary to reconfigure the vehicle after the following procedure.
In order to correct this condition you must cycle power to the OnStar(R) system. This can be done
by either removing the fuses powering the OnStar(R) system or disconnecting the OnStar(R)
module (VCIM) from the vehicle. As a last resort you can disconnect the vehicle's battery.
The power needs to be removed from the system for approximately 15 minutes.
After completing this procedure the vehicle should be taken to an area with an unobstructed view of
the sky. The vehicle should be kept running for approximately 10 minutes to allow the vehicle to
reacquire the global positioning system (GPS). Then contact the OnStar(R) Call Center via the blue
OnStar(R) button and ask the advisor to verify the GPS position.
If the OnStar(R) advisor still has an inaccurate GPS location refer to the Navigation Systems and
Cellular Communications sub-sections in the Service Manual in order to diagnose and repair the
concern. If the normal diagnostics lead to module replacement you will need to contact Technical
Assistance (TAC) and choose the OnStar(R) prompt. GM OnStar(R) TAC will assist in the
diagnosis and if appropriate order a replacement part. Replacement parts are usually shipped out
within 24 hours and a pre-paid return package label will be included for returning the faulty part. By
returning the faulty part you will avoid a significant non-return core charge.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab US Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Warranty Information (Saab US Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: >
02-08-46-006C > Jan > 08 > OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position Reported During Call > Page 8465
For vehicles repaired under warranty use, the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: >
02-08-46-007C > Nov > 07 > OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands Free Issues
Emergency Contact Module: Customer Interest OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands Free Issues
Bulletin No.: 02-08-46-007C
Date: November 19, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Information on OnStar(R) System - Possible Loss of GPS Signal, Hands-Free Calling
Minutes Expire Prematurely and/or Inability to Add Hands-Free Calling Minutes
Models: 2001-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2008
HUMMER H2 2006-2008 HUMMER H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
with OnStar(R) System (RPO UE1)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2008 model year, warranty information and to provide GPS
signal recovery steps (under Dealer Action heading) to do PRIOR to determining if the VIU/VCIM
needs replacement. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-08-46-007B (Section 08 - Body
& Accessories).
If the vehicle currently has analog-upgradable OnStar(R) hardware, then the customer should be
made aware of the digital upgrade program per the latest version of Service Bulletin #
05-08-46-006. Any analog OnStar system that is not upgraded prior to the end of 2007 will be
deactivated due to the upcoming phase-out of the analog cellular network in the U.S. and Canada.
If the vehicle has recently been upgraded or has had a service replacement unit installed, this
bulletin may not be applicable.
Certain 2001-2008 model year vehicles equipped with OnStar(R) may exhibit a condition with the
Global Positioning System (GPS) that causes inaccuracies in the GPS clock. The GPS system is
internal to the OnStar(R) Vehicle Interface Unit (VIU) or the Vehicle Communication Interface
Module (VCIM). This inaccuracy can result in a symptom where the OnStar(R) Call Center is
unable to obtain an accurate GPS signal, hands-Free Calling minutes expire prematurely and/or
the inability to add Hands-Free calling minutes.
Customer Notification
OnStar(R) will notify the customer by mail with instructions to contact their dealership service
department.
Dealer Action
Not all vehicles will require VIU/VCIM replacement.
The GPS signal in some vehicles may be recoverable. To determine if the signal is recoverable,
simply connect the Tech2(R) and using the GPS information data display option, observe the GPS
date and time. If the date/time stamps are equal to a date approximately 19 years in the future, the
GPS clock has exceeded its capacity and the VIU/VCIM will need to be replaced. If the date/time
stamp is in the past or near future, the GPS clock has simply generated an inaccurate value and
may be recoverable by performing the following power-up reset.
To initiate a power-up reset, battery voltage (batt. +) must be removed from the VIU/VCIM. The
preferred methods, in order, of initiating the reset are outlined below.
Remove the fuse that supplies Battery positive (Batt. +) voltage to the module (refer to the
applicable Service Information schematics for the appropriate fuse).
The next preferred method is to remove the connector to the OnStar(R) unit that Batt + is
contained.
The least preferable method is to remove the negative terminal of the vehicle battery. This will not
only initiate the power-up reset, but it may also result in the loss of radio presets and other stored
personalization information/settings in other modules as well.
After initiating the power-up reset, the GPS data will be set to the defaulted date and time and will
require an acquisition of the GPS signal in order to gain the proper date and time.
Acquiring the GPS signal requires running the vehicle in an open/unobstructed view of the sky.
First, contact OnStar(R) Technical Support by pressing the blue button. Allow the OnStar(R)
Technical Advisor to activate the GPS recovery process. This should take approximately 10
minutes. Continue to
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: >
02-08-46-007C > Nov > 07 > OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands Free Issues > Page 8470
monitor the Tech2(R) for the current time and date. REMINDER - Keep in mind that the time
displayed on the Tech2(R) is in Greenwich Mean Time (GMT) and the offset is based on the time
zones relationship to GMT.
If replacement of the VIU/VCIM is necessary, you MUST reconfigure the OnStar® system. Failure
to reconfigure the system will result in an additional customer visit for repair. OnStar® VIU,
Generations 2 and 3, will require the technician to press the blue OnStar® button to reconfigure the
vehicle with an OnStar® advisor.
OnStar(R) VCIM, Generations 4-7 will require the technician to reconfigure the vehicle with the use
of the TIS2WEB and SPS applications (pass thru only), along with the Tech2(R).
The configuration and set-up procedure is a two-step process that must be completed step-by-step
without interruption or delay in between each step. This procedure enables an automated activation
without a button press by the technician to the OnStar(R) Call Center. Following this procedure, it
may take up to 24 hours for all OnStar(R) services to be fully activated.
How to Order Parts
If the OnStar(R) GPS date/time stamp is non-recoverable and the unit needs to be replaced,
dealers in the U.S. should contact Autocraft Electronics select the catalog item that contains this
bulletin number. Canadian dealers should contact MASS Electronics.
Dealers DO NOT need to call the GM Technical Assistance Center (TAC) for replacement
approval. Autocraft Electronics and MASS Electronics will be responsible for verifying that the
subject vehicle is a candidate for a replacement VIU/VCIM.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: >
02-08-46-007C > Nov > 07 > OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands Free Issues > Page 8471
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 05-08-46-004C > Dec > 10 > OnStar(R) - Number Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Number
Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 05-08-46-004C
Date: December 23, 2010
Subject: OnStar(R) Phone Number Concerns (Phone Number Incorrect/Assigned to Another
Vehicle/Phone) That Occur During Diagnosis of OnStar(R) System
Models:
2000-2011 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Equipped with OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years up to 2011. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 05-08-46-004B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
During diagnosis of an OnStar(R) concern, the technician may be told that the OnStar(R) phone
number is incorrect or tied to another vehicle and/or phone of some kind. To resolve these
concerns, the Tech 2(R) with software version 22.005 (or higher), has the capability to change the
OnStar(R) phone number.
Service Procedure
1. With the Tech 2(R), build the vehicle to specifications within the Diagnostics area of the Tech
2(R). 2. For vehicles with physical-based diagnostics - under Body, go to the OnStar(R) section.
Then select the Special Functions menu.
For vehicles with functional-based diagnostics - under Body and Accessories, go to the Cellular
Communication section. Select Module Setup and then Vehicle Communication Interface Module.
3. Locate the Program Phone Number prompt and select it. The original phone number will be
displayed on the Tech 2(R) screen. 4. Contact the OnStar(R) team at the GM Technical Assistance
Center (TAC) to obtain a new phone number. 5. Highlight the digits of the phone number one at a
time and enter the new phone number using the number keys on the Tech 2(R). 6. Press the Soft
key at the base of the screen for Done once these numbers have been changed on the screen. 7.
Press the Soft key for Done again. The area code or new phone number has now been
programmed into the phone. 8. Cycle the ignition to Off and open the driver's door. 9. Press the
blue OnStar(R) button to make sure that a normal connection can be made to the OnStar(R) call
center. If applicable, make sure the
Hands-Free Calling (HFC) works properly by making a phone call.
10. If the system is working properly, fax or voicemail a case closing into the OnStar(R) team at
TAC with the results. Dealers in Canada should
submit case closing information through the GM infoNET.
Please follow this diagnostic process thoroughly and complete each step. If the condition exhibited
is resolved WITHOUT completing every step, the remaining steps do not need to be performed. If
the procedure above does not resolve the condition, you must contact TAC for further assistance.
This diagnostic approach was developed specifically for this condition and should not automatically
be used for other vehicles with similar symptoms.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 05-08-46-004C > Dec > 10 > OnStar(R) - Number Incorrect/Incorrectly Assigned
> Page 8477
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 02-08-44-007D > May > 09 > OnStar(R) - Negative Impact of Cloth/Vinyl Roofs
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Negative Impact of
Cloth/Vinyl Roofs
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 02-08-44-007D
Date: May 12, 2009
Subject: Negative Impact of Dealer-Installed Cloth/Vinyl Roofs on XM Radio and/or OnStar(R)
Systems
Models:
2002-2009 Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2009
HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X with XM Radio (RPO U2K) and/or OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................................................. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to
include the 2009 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-08-44-007C (Section
08 - Body and Accessories).
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................
Dealers should not install a cloth or vinyl roof on vehicles that have been ordered with the XM radio
option (RPO U2K) and/or OnStar(R) (RPO UE1). The performance of these systems may be
negatively impacted by the installation of the cloth/vinyl roof. Additionally, water leaks may result
from installing a cloth or vinyl roof on vehicles with roof-mounted antenna systems. Relocating the
antenna to another spot on the vehicle exterior, in order to install a cloth or vinyl roof, is not advised
either. The performance of the OnStar(R) and XM Radio antennas has been optimized for their
current locations. Relocating the antennas may result in a performance degradation.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 08-08-46-004 > Aug > 08 > OnStar(R) - Aftermarket Device Interference
Information
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Aftermarket Device
Interference Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-08-46-004
Date: August 14, 2008
Subject: Information on Aftermarket Device Interference with OnStar(R) Diagnostic Services
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Car and Truck (including Saturn) 2009 and Prior HUMMER
H2, H3 Models 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
with OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
This bulletin is being issued to provide dealer service personnel with information regarding
aftermarket devices connected to the Diagnostic Link Connector (DLC) and the impact to
OnStar(R) diagnostic probes and Vehicle Diagnostic e-mails.
Certain aftermarket devices, when connected to the Diagnostic Link Connector, such as, but not
limited to, Scan Tools, Trip Computers, Fuel Economy Analyzers and Insurance Tracking Devices,
interfere with OnStar's ability to perform a diagnostic probe when requested (via a blue button call)
by a subscriber. These devices also prohibit the ability to gather diagnostic and tire pressure data
for a subscriber's scheduled OnStar(R) Vehicle Diagnostic (OVD) e-mail.
These aftermarket devices utilize the Vehicles serial data bus to perform data requests and/or
information gathering. When these devices are requesting data, OnStar(R) is designed not to
interfere with any data request being made by these devices as required by OBD II regulations.
The OnStar(R) advisor is unable to definitively detect the presence of these devices and will only
be able to inform the caller or requester of the unsuccessful or incomplete probe and may in some
cases refer the subscriber/requester to take the vehicle to a dealer for diagnosis of the concern.
When performing a diagnostic check for an unsuccessful or incomplete OnStar(R) diagnostic
probe, or for concerns regarding completeness of the OnStar(R) Vehicle Diagnostic (OVD) e-mail,
verify that an aftermarket device was not present at the time of the requested probe. Regarding the
OVD e-mail, if an aftermarket device is interfering (including a Scan Tool of any type), the e-mail
will consistently display a "yellow" indication in diagnostics section for all vehicle systems except
the OnStar(R) System and Tire Pressure data (not available on all vehicles) will not be displayed
(i.e. section is collapsed). Successful diagnostic probes and complete OVD e-mails will resume
following the removal or disconnecting of the off-board device.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 00-08-46-004C > Jan > 08 > OnStar(R) - Re-establishing OnStar(R)
Communications
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Re-establishing OnStar(R)
Communications
Bulletin No.: 00-08-46-004C
Date: January 17, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Re-establishing Communications with OnStar(R) Center After Battery Disconnect
Models: 2000-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn and Saab)
with Digital OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-08-46-004B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
When servicing any of the above models and a battery cable is disconnected or power to the
OnStar(R) Vehicle Communication Interface Module (VCIM) is interrupted for any reason the
following procedure must be performed to verify proper Global Positioning System (GPS) function.
Never swap OnStar(R) Vehicle Communication Interface Modules (VCIM) from other vehicles.
Transfer of OnStar(R) modules from other vehicles should not be done. Each OnStar(R) module
has a unique identification number. The VCIM has a specific Station Identification (STID). This
identification number is used by the National Cellular Telephone Network and OnStar(R) systems
and is stored in General Motors Vehicle History files by VIN.
After completing ALL repairs to the vehicle you must perform the following procedure:
Move the vehicle into an open area of the service lot.
Sit in the vehicle with the engine running and the radio turned on for five minutes.
Press the OnStar(R) button in the vehicle.
When the OnStar(R) advisor answers ask the advisor to verify the current location of the vehicle.
If the vehicle location is different than the location the OnStar(R) advisor gives contact GM
Technical Assistance (TAC) and choose the OnStar(R) prompt. GM OnStar(R) TAC will assist in
the diagnosis of a failed VCIM and, if appropriate, order a replacement part. Replacement parts are
usually shipped out within 24 hours, and a pre-paid return package label will be included for
returning the faulty part. By returning the faulty part, you will avoid a non-return core charge.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 02-08-46-006C > Jan > 08 > OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position Reported
During Call
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position
Reported During Call
Bulletin No.: 02-08-46-006C
Date: January 08, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Incorrect OnStar(R) Global Positioning System (GPS) Location Reported During
OnStar(R) Call
Models: 2000-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2008
HUMMER H2 2006-2008 HUMMER H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
with OnStar(R)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
02-08-46-006B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
A small number of the above-mentioned vehicles may exhibit a condition in which the vehicle
reports an inaccurate location to the OnStar(R) Call Center. This condition can only be identified
via a button press to the OnStar(R) Call Center by the customer. Call Center personnel will be able
to identify this inaccurate location condition. Customers will then be notified through the mail by
OnStar(R) if their vehicle exhibits this condition. Once this condition has been identified OnStar(R)
will instruct the customer to return to the dealership to have this condition corrected.
It is not necessary to reconfigure the vehicle after the following procedure.
In order to correct this condition you must cycle power to the OnStar(R) system. This can be done
by either removing the fuses powering the OnStar(R) system or disconnecting the OnStar(R)
module (VCIM) from the vehicle. As a last resort you can disconnect the vehicle's battery.
The power needs to be removed from the system for approximately 15 minutes.
After completing this procedure the vehicle should be taken to an area with an unobstructed view of
the sky. The vehicle should be kept running for approximately 10 minutes to allow the vehicle to
reacquire the global positioning system (GPS). Then contact the OnStar(R) Call Center via the blue
OnStar(R) button and ask the advisor to verify the GPS position.
If the OnStar(R) advisor still has an inaccurate GPS location refer to the Navigation Systems and
Cellular Communications sub-sections in the Service Manual in order to diagnose and repair the
concern. If the normal diagnostics lead to module replacement you will need to contact Technical
Assistance (TAC) and choose the OnStar(R) prompt. GM OnStar(R) TAC will assist in the
diagnosis and if appropriate order a replacement part. Replacement parts are usually shipped out
within 24 hours and a pre-paid return package label will be included for returning the faulty part. By
returning the faulty part you will avoid a significant non-return core charge.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab US Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Warranty Information (Saab US Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 02-08-46-006C > Jan > 08 > OnStar(R) - Incorrect GPS Position Reported
During Call > Page 8494
For vehicles repaired under warranty use, the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 02-08-46-007C > Nov > 07 > OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands Free
Issues
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands
Free Issues
Bulletin No.: 02-08-46-007C
Date: November 19, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Information on OnStar(R) System - Possible Loss of GPS Signal, Hands-Free Calling
Minutes Expire Prematurely and/or Inability to Add Hands-Free Calling Minutes
Models: 2001-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2008
HUMMER H2 2006-2008 HUMMER H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
with OnStar(R) System (RPO UE1)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2008 model year, warranty information and to provide GPS
signal recovery steps (under Dealer Action heading) to do PRIOR to determining if the VIU/VCIM
needs replacement. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-08-46-007B (Section 08 - Body
& Accessories).
If the vehicle currently has analog-upgradable OnStar(R) hardware, then the customer should be
made aware of the digital upgrade program per the latest version of Service Bulletin #
05-08-46-006. Any analog OnStar system that is not upgraded prior to the end of 2007 will be
deactivated due to the upcoming phase-out of the analog cellular network in the U.S. and Canada.
If the vehicle has recently been upgraded or has had a service replacement unit installed, this
bulletin may not be applicable.
Certain 2001-2008 model year vehicles equipped with OnStar(R) may exhibit a condition with the
Global Positioning System (GPS) that causes inaccuracies in the GPS clock. The GPS system is
internal to the OnStar(R) Vehicle Interface Unit (VIU) or the Vehicle Communication Interface
Module (VCIM). This inaccuracy can result in a symptom where the OnStar(R) Call Center is
unable to obtain an accurate GPS signal, hands-Free Calling minutes expire prematurely and/or
the inability to add Hands-Free calling minutes.
Customer Notification
OnStar(R) will notify the customer by mail with instructions to contact their dealership service
department.
Dealer Action
Not all vehicles will require VIU/VCIM replacement.
The GPS signal in some vehicles may be recoverable. To determine if the signal is recoverable,
simply connect the Tech2(R) and using the GPS information data display option, observe the GPS
date and time. If the date/time stamps are equal to a date approximately 19 years in the future, the
GPS clock has exceeded its capacity and the VIU/VCIM will need to be replaced. If the date/time
stamp is in the past or near future, the GPS clock has simply generated an inaccurate value and
may be recoverable by performing the following power-up reset.
To initiate a power-up reset, battery voltage (batt. +) must be removed from the VIU/VCIM. The
preferred methods, in order, of initiating the reset are outlined below.
Remove the fuse that supplies Battery positive (Batt. +) voltage to the module (refer to the
applicable Service Information schematics for the appropriate fuse).
The next preferred method is to remove the connector to the OnStar(R) unit that Batt + is
contained.
The least preferable method is to remove the negative terminal of the vehicle battery. This will not
only initiate the power-up reset, but it may also result in the loss of radio presets and other stored
personalization information/settings in other modules as well.
After initiating the power-up reset, the GPS data will be set to the defaulted date and time and will
require an acquisition of the GPS signal in order to gain the proper date and time.
Acquiring the GPS signal requires running the vehicle in an open/unobstructed view of the sky.
First, contact OnStar(R) Technical Support by pressing the blue button. Allow the OnStar(R)
Technical Advisor to activate the GPS recovery process. This should take approximately 10
minutes. Continue to
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 02-08-46-007C > Nov > 07 > OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands Free
Issues > Page 8499
monitor the Tech2(R) for the current time and date. REMINDER - Keep in mind that the time
displayed on the Tech2(R) is in Greenwich Mean Time (GMT) and the offset is based on the time
zones relationship to GMT.
If replacement of the VIU/VCIM is necessary, you MUST reconfigure the OnStar® system. Failure
to reconfigure the system will result in an additional customer visit for repair. OnStar® VIU,
Generations 2 and 3, will require the technician to press the blue OnStar® button to reconfigure the
vehicle with an OnStar® advisor.
OnStar(R) VCIM, Generations 4-7 will require the technician to reconfigure the vehicle with the use
of the TIS2WEB and SPS applications (pass thru only), along with the Tech2(R).
The configuration and set-up procedure is a two-step process that must be completed step-by-step
without interruption or delay in between each step. This procedure enables an automated activation
without a button press by the technician to the OnStar(R) Call Center. Following this procedure, it
may take up to 24 hours for all OnStar(R) services to be fully activated.
How to Order Parts
If the OnStar(R) GPS date/time stamp is non-recoverable and the unit needs to be replaced,
dealers in the U.S. should contact Autocraft Electronics select the catalog item that contains this
bulletin number. Canadian dealers should contact MASS Electronics.
Dealers DO NOT need to call the GM Technical Assistance Center (TAC) for replacement
approval. Autocraft Electronics and MASS Electronics will be responsible for verifying that the
subject vehicle is a candidate for a replacement VIU/VCIM.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 02-08-46-007C > Nov > 07 > OnStar(R) - Loss of GPS Signal/Hands Free
Issues > Page 8500
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 02-08-44-007D > May > 09 > OnStar(R) - Negative Impact of Cloth/Vinyl Roofs
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Negative Impact of
Cloth/Vinyl Roofs
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 02-08-44-007D
Date: May 12, 2009
Subject: Negative Impact of Dealer-Installed Cloth/Vinyl Roofs on XM Radio and/or OnStar(R)
Systems
Models:
2002-2009 Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2009
HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X with XM Radio (RPO U2K) and/or OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................................................. Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to
include the 2009 model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-08-44-007C (Section
08 - Body and Accessories).
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................
Dealers should not install a cloth or vinyl roof on vehicles that have been ordered with the XM radio
option (RPO U2K) and/or OnStar(R) (RPO UE1). The performance of these systems may be
negatively impacted by the installation of the cloth/vinyl roof. Additionally, water leaks may result
from installing a cloth or vinyl roof on vehicles with roof-mounted antenna systems. Relocating the
antenna to another spot on the vehicle exterior, in order to install a cloth or vinyl roof, is not advised
either. The performance of the OnStar(R) and XM Radio antennas has been optimized for their
current locations. Relocating the antennas may result in a performance degradation.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 08-08-46-004 > Aug > 08 > OnStar(R) - Aftermarket Device Interference
Information
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Aftermarket Device
Interference Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-08-46-004
Date: August 14, 2008
Subject: Information on Aftermarket Device Interference with OnStar(R) Diagnostic Services
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Car and Truck (including Saturn) 2009 and Prior HUMMER
H2, H3 Models 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
with OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
This bulletin is being issued to provide dealer service personnel with information regarding
aftermarket devices connected to the Diagnostic Link Connector (DLC) and the impact to
OnStar(R) diagnostic probes and Vehicle Diagnostic e-mails.
Certain aftermarket devices, when connected to the Diagnostic Link Connector, such as, but not
limited to, Scan Tools, Trip Computers, Fuel Economy Analyzers and Insurance Tracking Devices,
interfere with OnStar's ability to perform a diagnostic probe when requested (via a blue button call)
by a subscriber. These devices also prohibit the ability to gather diagnostic and tire pressure data
for a subscriber's scheduled OnStar(R) Vehicle Diagnostic (OVD) e-mail.
These aftermarket devices utilize the Vehicles serial data bus to perform data requests and/or
information gathering. When these devices are requesting data, OnStar(R) is designed not to
interfere with any data request being made by these devices as required by OBD II regulations.
The OnStar(R) advisor is unable to definitively detect the presence of these devices and will only
be able to inform the caller or requester of the unsuccessful or incomplete probe and may in some
cases refer the subscriber/requester to take the vehicle to a dealer for diagnosis of the concern.
When performing a diagnostic check for an unsuccessful or incomplete OnStar(R) diagnostic
probe, or for concerns regarding completeness of the OnStar(R) Vehicle Diagnostic (OVD) e-mail,
verify that an aftermarket device was not present at the time of the requested probe. Regarding the
OVD e-mail, if an aftermarket device is interfering (including a Scan Tool of any type), the e-mail
will consistently display a "yellow" indication in diagnostics section for all vehicle systems except
the OnStar(R) System and Tire Pressure data (not available on all vehicles) will not be displayed
(i.e. section is collapsed). Successful diagnostic probes and complete OVD e-mails will resume
following the removal or disconnecting of the off-board device.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 00-08-46-004C > Jan > 08 > OnStar(R) - Re-establishing OnStar(R)
Communications
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins OnStar(R) - Re-establishing OnStar(R)
Communications
Bulletin No.: 00-08-46-004C
Date: January 17, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Re-establishing Communications with OnStar(R) Center After Battery Disconnect
Models: 2000-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn and Saab)
with Digital OnStar(R) (RPO UE1)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-08-46-004B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
When servicing any of the above models and a battery cable is disconnected or power to the
OnStar(R) Vehicle Communication Interface Module (VCIM) is interrupted for any reason the
following procedure must be performed to verify proper Global Positioning System (GPS) function.
Never swap OnStar(R) Vehicle Communication Interface Modules (VCIM) from other vehicles.
Transfer of OnStar(R) modules from other vehicles should not be done. Each OnStar(R) module
has a unique identification number. The VCIM has a specific Station Identification (STID). This
identification number is used by the National Cellular Telephone Network and OnStar(R) systems
and is stored in General Motors Vehicle History files by VIN.
After completing ALL repairs to the vehicle you must perform the following procedure:
Move the vehicle into an open area of the service lot.
Sit in the vehicle with the engine running and the radio turned on for five minutes.
Press the OnStar(R) button in the vehicle.
When the OnStar(R) advisor answers ask the advisor to verify the current location of the vehicle.
If the vehicle location is different than the location the OnStar(R) advisor gives contact GM
Technical Assistance (TAC) and choose the OnStar(R) prompt. GM OnStar(R) TAC will assist in
the diagnosis of a failed VCIM and, if appropriate, order a replacement part. Replacement parts are
usually shipped out within 24 hours, and a pre-paid return package label will be included for
returning the faulty part. By returning the faulty part, you will avoid a non-return core charge.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Relay Module: >
09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules
Relay Module: Customer Interest Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-06-03-004D
Date: December 08, 2010
Subject: Intermittent No Crank/No Start, No Module Communication, MIL, Warning Lights, Vehicle
Messages or DTCs Set by Various Control Modules - Diagnosing and Repairing Fretting Corrosion
(Disconnect Affected Connector and Apply Dielectric Lubricant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Attention:
This repair can be applied to ANY electrical connection including, but not limited to: lighting, body
electrical, in-line connections, powertrain control sensors, etc. DO NOT over apply lubricant to the
point where it prevents the full engagement of sealed connectors. A light coating on the terminal
surfaces is sufficient to correct the condition.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Attention statement and add the 2011
model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-03-004C (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions:
- An intermittent no crank/no start
- Intermittent malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illumination
- Intermittent service lamp illumination
- Intermittent service message(s) being displayed
The technician may determine that he is unable to duplicate the intermittent condition.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a buildup of nonconductive insulating oxidized debris known as
fretting corrosion, occurring between two electrical contact surfaces of the connection or connector.
This may be caused by any of the following conditions:
- Vibration
- Thermal cycling
- Poor connection/terminal retention
- Micro motion
- A connector, component or wiring harness not properly secured resulting in movement
On low current signal circuits this condition may cause high resistance, resulting in intermittent
connections.
On high current power circuits this condition may cause permanent increases in the resistance and
may cause a device to become inoperative.
Representative List of Control Modules and Components
The following is only a representative list of control modules and components that may be affected
by this connection or connector condition and DOES NOT include every possible module or
component for every vehicle.
- Blower Control Module
- Body Control Module (BCM)
- Communication Interface Module (CIM)
- Cooling Fan Control Module
- Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)
- Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module (EBTCM)
- Electronic Suspension Control (ESC) Module
- Engine Control Module (ECM)
- Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) Control Module
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Relay Module: >
09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 8522
- HVAC Actuator
- Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM)
- Any AIR BAG module
- Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner
- Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner
- An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set:
B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023
- Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
- Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Correction
Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions:
- The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated.
- The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can
no longer be duplicated.
Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above.
1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any
existing history or current DTCs from all of the
control modules (refer to SI).
‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the
connector(s) of the control module/component
which may be causing the condition (refer to SI).
‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control
module/component which may be causing the
condition (refer to SI).
2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component
Connector End Views and Component Locator
documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the
condition.
Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the
actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or
identified without the use of a magnifying glass.
Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown,
as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush
that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin.
3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side
and the harness side of the affected connector(s).
4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present.
5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information:
- DTC Diagnostic Procedure
- Circuit/System Description
- Conditions for Running the DTC
- Conditions for Setting the DTC
- Diagnostic Aids
- Circuit/System Verification
‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated,
then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI).
Repair Order Documentation
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Relay Module: >
09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 8523
Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so
may result in a chargeback.
- Customer vehicle condition.
- Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or
Service Message.
- Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set.
- After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated?
‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector
name and number on the repair order.
- If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and
additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID
Number MUST be written on the repair order.
Parts Information
Alternate Distributor For All of North America
Note
NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada),
specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Relay Module: >
09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 8524
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table
above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules
Relay Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control
Modules
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-06-03-004D
Date: December 08, 2010
Subject: Intermittent No Crank/No Start, No Module Communication, MIL, Warning Lights, Vehicle
Messages or DTCs Set by Various Control Modules - Diagnosing and Repairing Fretting Corrosion
(Disconnect Affected Connector and Apply Dielectric Lubricant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Attention:
This repair can be applied to ANY electrical connection including, but not limited to: lighting, body
electrical, in-line connections, powertrain control sensors, etc. DO NOT over apply lubricant to the
point where it prevents the full engagement of sealed connectors. A light coating on the terminal
surfaces is sufficient to correct the condition.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Attention statement and add the 2011
model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-03-004C (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions:
- An intermittent no crank/no start
- Intermittent malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illumination
- Intermittent service lamp illumination
- Intermittent service message(s) being displayed
The technician may determine that he is unable to duplicate the intermittent condition.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a buildup of nonconductive insulating oxidized debris known as
fretting corrosion, occurring between two electrical contact surfaces of the connection or connector.
This may be caused by any of the following conditions:
- Vibration
- Thermal cycling
- Poor connection/terminal retention
- Micro motion
- A connector, component or wiring harness not properly secured resulting in movement
On low current signal circuits this condition may cause high resistance, resulting in intermittent
connections.
On high current power circuits this condition may cause permanent increases in the resistance and
may cause a device to become inoperative.
Representative List of Control Modules and Components
The following is only a representative list of control modules and components that may be affected
by this connection or connector condition and DOES NOT include every possible module or
component for every vehicle.
- Blower Control Module
- Body Control Module (BCM)
- Communication Interface Module (CIM)
- Cooling Fan Control Module
- Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)
- Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module (EBTCM)
- Electronic Suspension Control (ESC) Module
- Engine Control Module (ECM)
- Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) Control Module
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 8530
- HVAC Actuator
- Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM)
- Any AIR BAG module
- Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner
- Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner
- An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set:
B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023
- Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
- Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Correction
Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions:
- The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated.
- The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can
no longer be duplicated.
Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above.
1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any
existing history or current DTCs from all of the
control modules (refer to SI).
‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the
connector(s) of the control module/component
which may be causing the condition (refer to SI).
‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control
module/component which may be causing the
condition (refer to SI).
2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component
Connector End Views and Component Locator
documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the
condition.
Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the
actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or
identified without the use of a magnifying glass.
Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown,
as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush
that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin.
3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side
and the harness side of the affected connector(s).
4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present.
5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information:
- DTC Diagnostic Procedure
- Circuit/System Description
- Conditions for Running the DTC
- Conditions for Setting the DTC
- Diagnostic Aids
- Circuit/System Verification
‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated,
then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI).
Repair Order Documentation
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 8531
Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so
may result in a chargeback.
- Customer vehicle condition.
- Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or
Service Message.
- Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set.
- After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated?
‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector
name and number on the repair order.
- If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and
additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID
Number MUST be written on the repair order.
Parts Information
Alternate Distributor For All of North America
Note
NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada),
specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 8532
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table
above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's
Set By Various Control Modules
Relay Module: Customer Interest Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-06-03-004D
Date: December 08, 2010
Subject: Intermittent No Crank/No Start, No Module Communication, MIL, Warning Lights, Vehicle
Messages or DTCs Set by Various Control Modules - Diagnosing and Repairing Fretting Corrosion
(Disconnect Affected Connector and Apply Dielectric Lubricant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Attention:
This repair can be applied to ANY electrical connection including, but not limited to: lighting, body
electrical, in-line connections, powertrain control sensors, etc. DO NOT over apply lubricant to the
point where it prevents the full engagement of sealed connectors. A light coating on the terminal
surfaces is sufficient to correct the condition.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Attention statement and add the 2011
model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-03-004C (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions:
- An intermittent no crank/no start
- Intermittent malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illumination
- Intermittent service lamp illumination
- Intermittent service message(s) being displayed
The technician may determine that he is unable to duplicate the intermittent condition.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a buildup of nonconductive insulating oxidized debris known as
fretting corrosion, occurring between two electrical contact surfaces of the connection or connector.
This may be caused by any of the following conditions:
- Vibration
- Thermal cycling
- Poor connection/terminal retention
- Micro motion
- A connector, component or wiring harness not properly secured resulting in movement
On low current signal circuits this condition may cause high resistance, resulting in intermittent
connections.
On high current power circuits this condition may cause permanent increases in the resistance and
may cause a device to become inoperative.
Representative List of Control Modules and Components
The following is only a representative list of control modules and components that may be affected
by this connection or connector condition and DOES NOT include every possible module or
component for every vehicle.
- Blower Control Module
- Body Control Module (BCM)
- Communication Interface Module (CIM)
- Cooling Fan Control Module
- Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)
- Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module (EBTCM)
- Electronic Suspension Control (ESC) Module
- Engine Control Module (ECM)
- Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) Control Module
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's
Set By Various Control Modules > Page 8541
- HVAC Actuator
- Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM)
- Any AIR BAG module
- Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner
- Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner
- An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set:
B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023
- Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
- Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Correction
Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions:
- The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated.
- The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can
no longer be duplicated.
Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above.
1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any
existing history or current DTCs from all of the
control modules (refer to SI).
‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the
connector(s) of the control module/component
which may be causing the condition (refer to SI).
‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control
module/component which may be causing the
condition (refer to SI).
2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component
Connector End Views and Component Locator
documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the
condition.
Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the
actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or
identified without the use of a magnifying glass.
Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown,
as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush
that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin.
3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side
and the harness side of the affected connector(s).
4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present.
5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information:
- DTC Diagnostic Procedure
- Circuit/System Description
- Conditions for Running the DTC
- Conditions for Setting the DTC
- Diagnostic Aids
- Circuit/System Verification
‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated,
then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI).
Repair Order Documentation
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's
Set By Various Control Modules > Page 8542
Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so
may result in a chargeback.
- Customer vehicle condition.
- Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or
Service Message.
- Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set.
- After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated?
‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector
name and number on the repair order.
- If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and
additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID
Number MUST be written on the repair order.
Parts Information
Alternate Distributor For All of North America
Note
NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada),
specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's
Set By Various Control Modules > Page 8543
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table
above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules
Relay Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control
Modules
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-06-03-004D
Date: December 08, 2010
Subject: Intermittent No Crank/No Start, No Module Communication, MIL, Warning Lights, Vehicle
Messages or DTCs Set by Various Control Modules - Diagnosing and Repairing Fretting Corrosion
(Disconnect Affected Connector and Apply Dielectric Lubricant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Attention:
This repair can be applied to ANY electrical connection including, but not limited to: lighting, body
electrical, in-line connections, powertrain control sensors, etc. DO NOT over apply lubricant to the
point where it prevents the full engagement of sealed connectors. A light coating on the terminal
surfaces is sufficient to correct the condition.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Attention statement and add the 2011
model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-03-004C (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions:
- An intermittent no crank/no start
- Intermittent malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illumination
- Intermittent service lamp illumination
- Intermittent service message(s) being displayed
The technician may determine that he is unable to duplicate the intermittent condition.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a buildup of nonconductive insulating oxidized debris known as
fretting corrosion, occurring between two electrical contact surfaces of the connection or connector.
This may be caused by any of the following conditions:
- Vibration
- Thermal cycling
- Poor connection/terminal retention
- Micro motion
- A connector, component or wiring harness not properly secured resulting in movement
On low current signal circuits this condition may cause high resistance, resulting in intermittent
connections.
On high current power circuits this condition may cause permanent increases in the resistance and
may cause a device to become inoperative.
Representative List of Control Modules and Components
The following is only a representative list of control modules and components that may be affected
by this connection or connector condition and DOES NOT include every possible module or
component for every vehicle.
- Blower Control Module
- Body Control Module (BCM)
- Communication Interface Module (CIM)
- Cooling Fan Control Module
- Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)
- Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module (EBTCM)
- Electronic Suspension Control (ESC) Module
- Engine Control Module (ECM)
- Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) Control Module
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 8549
- HVAC Actuator
- Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM)
- Any AIR BAG module
- Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner
- Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner
- An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set:
B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023
- Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
- Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Correction
Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions:
- The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated.
- The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can
no longer be duplicated.
Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above.
1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any
existing history or current DTCs from all of the
control modules (refer to SI).
‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the
connector(s) of the control module/component
which may be causing the condition (refer to SI).
‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control
module/component which may be causing the
condition (refer to SI).
2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component
Connector End Views and Component Locator
documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the
condition.
Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the
actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or
identified without the use of a magnifying glass.
Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown,
as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush
that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin.
3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side
and the harness side of the affected connector(s).
4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present.
5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information:
- DTC Diagnostic Procedure
- Circuit/System Description
- Conditions for Running the DTC
- Conditions for Setting the DTC
- Diagnostic Aids
- Circuit/System Verification
‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated,
then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI).
Repair Order Documentation
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 8550
Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so
may result in a chargeback.
- Customer vehicle condition.
- Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or
Service Message.
- Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set.
- After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated?
‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector
name and number on the repair order.
- If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and
additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID
Number MUST be written on the repair order.
Parts Information
Alternate Distributor For All of North America
Note
NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada),
specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 8551
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table
above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Lock Cylinder Switch > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Audio - Inadvertent
Steering Wheel Button Activation
Remote Switch: Technical Service Bulletins Audio - Inadvertent Steering Wheel Button Activation
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-08-44-028
Date: August 28, 2008
Subject: Information On Inadvertent Steering Wheel Control (SWC) Button Press Causing Radio
Anomalies
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2009 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 Models 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
All Vehicles with Steering Wheel Controls
This bulletin is being issued to provide a recommendation for vehicles with a customer concern of
the radio station tuning changing by itself, volume changing by itself, radio changing by itself, or
radio muting or going silent when driving and turning the steering wheel.
The switches on the right hand side of the steering wheel are easily pressed and may inadvertently
be pressed when turning the steering wheel.
These concerns may be affected by the location of the steering wheel controls.
Recommendation
Do Not Replace The Radio
1. Please determine that the switch controls on the steering wheel are functioning correctly.
2. Ask the customer if their hand was in close proximity to the steering wheel controls when the
condition happened. Explain to the customer that bumping the controls would have caused this
undesired action. Explain to the customer the proper use and function of the steering wheel
controls.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Hitch >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Trailer Hitch: Service and Repair
Trailer Hitch Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle (See:
Maintenance/Vehicle Lifting/Service and Repair) in General
Information.
2. Remove the hitch from the frame nuts. 3. Remove the hitch to frame bolts. 4. Remove the hitch
and bumper from the vehicle. 5. Remove the hitch to bumper nuts. 6. Remove the hitch to bumper
bolts. 7. Remove the hitch from the bumper.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the hitch to the bumper.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the hitch to bumper bolts.
Tighten the hitch to bumper bolts to 35 N.m (26 lb ft).
3. Install the hitch to bumper nuts.
Tighten the hitch to bumper nuts to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
4. Install the hitch and the bumper to the vehicle. 5. Install the hitch to frame nuts.
Tighten the hitch to frame nuts to 60 N.m (44 lb ft).
6. Install the hitch to frame bolts.
Tighten the hitch to frame bolts to 55 N.m (41 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Hitch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8564
7. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Body Control Module (BCM) C1
Body Control Module C1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Body Control Module (BCM) C1 > Page 8571
Body Control Module C2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Body Control Module (BCM) C1 > Page 8572
Body Control Module C3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Page 8573
Body Control Module: Description and Operation
The BCM contains the logic of the theft deterrent system. The BCM provides the battery positive
voltage to operate the Passlock(TM) Sensor. The BCM also measures the voltage of the security
sensor signal circuit. The voltage measured will indicate whether the Passlock(TM) Sensor has
been activated and whether the resistance value from the sensor is a valid value or the tamper
value. If voltage measured is in the valid range, the BCM compares this voltage, voltage code, to a
previously learned voltage code. If the voltage codes match, the BCM sends a class 2 message
containing a password to the PCM. If the voltage codes do not match, or the voltage is in the
Tamper range, or there is a circuit fault, the BCM will not send the correct password to the PCM,
and the vehicle will not start.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures
Body Control Module: Procedures
IMPORTANT: If any module is replaced, programming the module with the proper RPO
configurations must be done prior to performing the Passlock Learn procedure.
1. The BCM must be programmed with the proper RPO configurations. The BCM stores the
information regarding the vehicle options. If the BCM is
not properly configured with the correct RPO codes the BCM will not control the features properly.
Ensure that the following conditions exist in order to prepare for BCM programming: ^
The battery is fully charged.
^ The ignition switch is in the RUN position.
^ The DLC is accessible.
^ All disconnected modules and devices are reconnected before programming.
2. Follow the SPS instructions on the Techline Terminal and scan tool to program the BCM. 3. If
the BCM fails to accept the program, perform the following steps:
^ Inspect all BCM connections.
^ Verify that the SPS Techline Terminal and scan tool have the latest software version.
Passlock Learn Procedures Refer to the Theft Deterrent sub-system for the appropriate learn
procedure.
IMPORTANT: After programming, perform the following to avoid future misdiagnosis: 1. Turn the
ignition OFF for 10 seconds. 2. Connect the scan tool to the data link connector. 3. Turn the ignition
ON with the engine OFF. 4. Use the scan tool in order to retrieve History DTCs from all modules. 5.
Clear all history DTCs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8576
Body Control Module: Removal and Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
Replacing the body control module (BCM) may be necessary when you service the body control
system.
IMPORTANT: The ignition switch should be in the OFF position when connecting or disconnecting
the connectors to the BCM. Always disconnect the Brown BCM connector FIRST and connect the
Brown BCM connector LAST. The BCM can set DTC(s) with the ignition switch in the OFF position.
The BCM has battery run down protection for the courtesy lamp circuit. The BCM battery run down
protection can not detect shorts on inputs or other circuits which it does not control. The scan tool
can be used to put the BCM to sleep in order to check for current draws on circuits which are not
controlled by the BCM or controlled by the battery run down protection system. If an excessive
current draw is detected, refer to Battery Electrical Drain/Parasitic Load Test (w/ BCM) in Starting
and Charging.
1. Remove the radio from the vehicle. 2. Remove the heater control.
Pull the heater control (2) out and down in order to gain access to the body control module.
3. Push upward on the bracket retainer slightly and pull the body control module (2) from the
bracket (1) at an angle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8577
4. Disconnect the electrical connectors (2) from the body control module (1). 5. Remove the body
control module from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the body control module (2) to the vehicle. 2. Install the body control module to the bracket
(1) at an angle under the wide hook retainer, with the label facing away from the bracket. 3. Apply
pressure on the center of the body control module in order to move the module toward the
mounting bracket base. Snap the module into
place.
4. Ensure that the module is fully seated. Ensure that both snap retainers are holding the module.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8578
5. Connect the electrical connectors (2) to the body control module (1).
6. Install the heater control (2). 7. Install the radio to the vehicle. 8. Use the following components
in order to program the body control module with the proper calibrations:
^ The Techline Terminal
^ The Scan Tool
9. Perform the body control module programing. Refer to Body Control Module (BCM)
Programming/RPO Configuration. See: Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning
10. Clear the diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Access Cover, Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures
Access Cover: Procedures
Engine Cover
ENGINE COVER
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the instrument panel extension. Refer to "Instrument Panel Extension". 2. Remove the
floor air outlet duct. Refer to "Air Outlet - Center Floor".
3. Remove the bolts from the brackets:
^ Loosen the bolt.
^ Rotate the bracket out of the way.
4. Remove the latches.
5. Remove the screws.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Access Cover, Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 8583
6. Remove the engine cover.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the engine cover. 2. Install the screws to the engine cover. Do not fully tighten the screws.
3. Install the latch screws.
Tighten Tighten the latch screws to 4 Nm (35 lb in).
4. Install the engine cover bolts to the brackets.
Tighten Tighten the engine cove bolt to 25 Nm (18 lb ft).
5. Insert the floor air outlet duct. 6. Insert the instrument panel extension.
Instrument Panel (IP) Extension
INSTRUMENT PANEL (I/P) EXTENSION REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the caps that cover the extension screws. 2. Remove the screws from the extension. 3.
Remove the nuts at the bottom of the extension.
4. Pull toward the rear of the vehicle in order to remove the extension from the instrument panel. 5.
Disconnect the electrical connectors.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Connect the electrical connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Access Cover, Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 8584
2. Install the extension to the instrument panel:
2.1. Align the retainers.
2.2. Press the extension into place until the retainers are seated.
3. Install the nuts that retain the extension to the floor.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Tighten Tighten the nuts that retain the extension to the floor to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
4. Install the retaining screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
5. Install the extension screw covers.
Air Outlet - Center Floor
AIR OUTLET REPLACEMENT - CENTER FLOOR
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the IP extension. Refer to "Instrument Panel (I/P) Extension". 2. Remove the floor air
outlet duct from the air distributor. 3. Remove the bucket seats. Refer to "Seat Replacement Bucket". 4. Remove the front section of the carpet, if equipped. Refer to "MAT/Carpet
Replacement".
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Access Cover, Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 8585
5. Remove the retaining nuts from the floor outlet duct, if equipped. 6. Remove the floor air outlet
from the ducts to the rear seat, if equipped.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the floor air outlet to the ducts to the rear seat, if equipped.
2. Install the retaining nuts to the floor outlet duct, if equipped.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Access Cover, Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 8586
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Tighten Tighten the nuts to 2 Nm (18 lb in).
3. Install the front section of the carpet, if equipped. 4. Install the bucket seats. 5. Install the floor air
outlet duct from the air distributor. 6. Install the IP extension.
Engine Cover Guide Assembly
ENGINE COVER GUIDE ASSEMBLY
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the engine cover. Refer to Engine Cover Replacement. 2. Remove the bolts that retain
the engine cover guide assembly to the vehicle. 3. Remove the engine cover guide assembly from
the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the engine cover guide assembly. 2. Install the bolts that retain the engine cover guide
assembly to the vehicle.
Tighten Tighten the bolts that retain the engine cover guide to 8.5 Nm (75 lb in).
3. Install the engine cover.
MAT/Carpet Replacement
MAT/CARPET REPLACEMENT - FRONT FLOOR
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the seats and the risers. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket. 2. Remove the engine
cover, if required. Refer to Engine Cover Replacement. 3. Remove the trim plates from the front
door openings. Refer to Carpet Retainer Replacement. 4. Remove the cowl side panel trim. Refer
to Trim Panel Replacement - Cowl Side.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Access Cover, Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 8587
5. Remove the throttle pedal guard. 6. Remove the screws from the center floor air duct. 7.
Remove the center floor air duct. 8. Remove the front side door lock pillar garnish molding, if
required. Refer to Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar. 9. Remove the carpet/mat from
the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
CAUTION: In order to avoid personal injury or vehicle damage when you repair or replace the
carpet, use the same thickness and material size as the original installation. Always return the
carpet to the original location.
1. Install the carpet/mat to the vehicle. 2. Install the center floor air duct.
NOTICE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the screws to the center floor air duct.
TIGHTEN
Screws to 2 Nm (18 lb. in.).
4. Install the front side door lock pillar garnish molding, if required. Refer to Garnish Molding
Replacement - LF Lock Pillar. 5. Install the trim plates to the front door openings. Refer to Carpet
Retainer Replacement. 6. Install the cowl side panel trim. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Cowl
Side. 7. Install the engine cover, if required. Refer to Engine Cover Replacement. 8. Install the
seats and the risers. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket in Seats.
Seat Replacement - Bucket
SEAT REPLACEMENT - BUCKET
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the seat belt from the side of the seat belt guide.
2. Remove the nuts that retain the seat to the floor. 3. Disconnect the electrical connector from the
power seat if equipped. 4. Remove the seat and the riser from the vehicle. 5. Remove the seat belt
guide from the seat riser.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Access Cover, Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 8588
6. Remove the bolts that retain the seat to the riser. 7. Remove the power seat from the seat risers
if equipped. 8. Remove the manual seat adjuster wire from the seat tracks. 9. Remove the seat
riser spacer nuts and bolts from the seat tracks.
10. Remove the seat riser spacer from the seat risers.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the seat riser spacer to the seat risers. 2. Install the seat riser spacer nuts and bolts to the
seat tracks.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Tighten Tighten the seat riser spacer nuts and bolts to the seat tracks to 30 Nm (22 lb ft).
3. Install the manual seat adjuster wire to the seat tracks. 4. Install the power seat to the seat risers
if equipped. 5. Install the seat belt guide to the seat riser.
6. Install the nuts that retain the seat to the risers.
Tighten Tighten the nuts that retain the seat to the riser to 43 Nm (32 lb ft).
7. Install the seat and the seat riser in the vehicle. 8. Connect the electrical connector to the power
seat if equipped.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Access Cover, Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 8589
9. Install the nuts that retain the seat to the floor.
Tighten Tighten the nuts that retain the seat to the floor to 43 Nm (32 lb ft).
10. Install the seat belt to the side of the seat belt guide.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Access Cover, Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 8590
Access Cover: Removal and Replacement
Engine Cover Replacement
Engine Cover Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the instrument panel extension. Refer to IP Extension Replacement (See: Interior
Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service
and Repair/IP Extension Replacement) in Instrument Panel, Gages and Console.
2. Remove the floor air outlet duct. Refer to Air Outlet Replacement - Center Floor in Heating,
Ventilation and Air Conditioning. 3. Remove the bolts from the brackets:
1. Loosen the bolt. 2. Rotate the bracket out of the way.
4. Remove the latches.
5. Remove the screws.
6. Remove the engine cover.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Access Cover, Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 8591
1. Install the engine cover.
2. Install the screws to the engine cover.
Do not fully tighten the screws.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the latch screws.
Tighten the latch screws to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
4. Install the engine cover bolts to the brackets.
Tighten the engine cover bolt to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
5. Insert the floor air outlet duct. Refer to IP Extension Replacement (See: Interior Moulding /
Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/IP Extension Replacement) in Instrument Panel, Gages and Console.
6. Insert the instrument panel extension. Refer to Air Outlet Replacement - Center Floor in Heating,
Ventilation and Air Conditioning.
Engine Cover Guide Replacement
Engine Cover Guide Replacement
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Access Cover, Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 8592
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the engine cover. Refer to Engine Cover Replacement (See: Engine Cover
Replacement) .
2. Remove the bolts that retain the engine cover guide assembly to the vehicle. 3. Remove the
engine cover guide assembly.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the engine cover guide assembly.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the bolts that retain the engine cover guide assembly to the vehicle.
Tighten the bolts that retain the engine cover guide to 8.5 N.m (75 lb in).
3. Install the engine cover. Refer to Engine Cover Replacement (See: Engine Cover Replacement)
.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > System Information > Service and
Repair > Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front
Auxiliary Step / Running Board: Service and Repair Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front
Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the screws from the front edge of the assist step. Open the door to expose the inner
screw.
2. Remove the push clips from the front edge of the assist step. 3. Raise the vehicle to a suitable
height. 4. Remove the nut from the front lower corner of the assist step.
5. Remove the assist step pad nuts. 6. Remove the assist step pad.
1. Insert a plastic tool along the edge. 2. Pull upward on the assist step pad until it fully releases
from the assist step plate.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > System Information > Service and
Repair > Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front > Page 8597
7. Remove the front section of the assist step as follows:
1. Lift in the center of the assist step. 2. Slide the front section forward. 3. Lift upward on the assist
step to release from the retainer.
8. Remove the nut and bolt (1) from the front assist step support bracket to the pinchweld flange. 9.
Remove the assist step support bracket bolts (2) from the underbody.
10. Remove the assist step support bracket.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the assist step support bracket.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the assist step support bracket bolts (2) to the underbody .
Tighten the assist step support bracket bolts (2) to the underbody to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
3. Install the nut and bolt (1) to the assist step support bracket and to the pinchweld flange.
Tighten the nut and bolt (1) to the assist step support bracket and to the pinchweld flange to 10
N.m (89 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > System Information > Service and
Repair > Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front > Page 8598
4. Use the following procedure when installing the assist step:
1. Check the fit to the step well and the door opening. 2. Check the height and the alignment to
rocker panel. 3. Check the alignment to the cladding and to the body. 4. Check the gaps between
the wheel well moldings. 5. Check the lower edge of the assist step to ensure a even gap along the
door edge and the body. 6. Install the front section of the assist step to fit over the rear section.
Align both sections before installing the nuts to the assist step pad.
5. Install the assist step pad to assist step.
Align the assist step pad to the assist step and press downward until fully seated.
6. Install the nuts to the assist step pad by hand.
Tighten the nuts to the assist step pad to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
7. Install the nut to the front lower corner of the assist step.
Tighten the nut to the front lower corner of the assist step to 10 N.m (89 lb in).
8. Lower the vehicle to a suitable height.
9. Install the push clips to the front edge of the assist step.
10. Install the screws to the front edge of the assist step. Open the door to expose the inner screw.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > System Information > Service and
Repair > Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front > Page 8599
Tighten the screws to the upper and inner edges of the assist step to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
11. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > System Information > Service and
Repair > Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front > Page 8600
Auxiliary Step / Running Board: Service and Repair Assist Step Plate Replacement
Assist Step Plate Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle to a suitable height. 2. Remove the front and rear assist step extensions. Refer
to Assist Step Replacement (See: Assist Step Replacement) . 3. Remove the nuts that attach the
assist step plate to the assist step support bracket. 4. Remove the assist step plate.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the assist step plate.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the nuts that attach the assist step plate to the support bracket.
Tighten the nuts that attach the assist step plate to the support bracket to 10 N.m (89 lb in).
3. Install the front and rear assist step extensions. Refer to Assist Step Replacement (See: Assist
Step Replacement) . 4. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > System Information > Service and
Repair > Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front > Page 8601
Auxiliary Step / Running Board: Service and Repair Assist Step Support Brace Replacement
Assist Step Support Brace Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle to a suitable height.
Important: The assist step assembly does not have to be removed to replace the assist step brace.
2. Remove the nuts and bolts (1) that attach the assist step brace to the assist step support
bracket. 3. Remove the assist step brace.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the assist step brace.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the nuts and bolts (1) that attach the assist step brace to the assist step support bracket
Tighten the nuts and bolts (1) that attach the assist step brace to the assist step support bracket to
10 N.m (89 lb in).
3. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > System Information > Service and
Repair > Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front > Page 8602
Auxiliary Step / Running Board: Service and Repair Assist Step Support Bracket Replacement
Assist Step Support Bracket Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle to a suitable height.
Important: The assist step assembly does not have to be removed to replace the assist step
support bracket.
2. Remove the nuts that attach the assist step plate to the assist step support bracket.
3. The assist step support brackets are to be numbered 1 through 5 in the order when removing.
4. Remove the nuts and bolts (1) that attach the assist step plate to the assist step bracket. 5.
Remove the bolts (2) that attach the assist step plate to the assist step support bracket to the
underbody. 6. Remove the assist step support bracket from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > System Information > Service and
Repair > Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front > Page 8603
1. Install the assist step support bracket to the vehicle. 2. Install the assist step support brackets 1
through 5 in the order which they were removed.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the bolts (2) that attach the assist step plate to the assist step support bracket to the
underbody.
Tighten the bolts (2) that attach the assist step plate to the assist step support bracket to the
underbody to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
4. Install the nuts and bolts (1) that attach the assist step brace to the assist step bracket
Tighten the nuts and bolts (1) that attach the assist step brace to the assist step bracket to 10 N.m
(89 lb in).
5. Install the nuts that attach the assist step plate to the assist step support bracket.
Tighten the nuts that attach the assist step plate to the assist step support bracket to 10 N.m (89 lb
in).
6. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > System Information > Service and
Repair > Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front > Page 8604
Auxiliary Step / Running Board: Service and Repair
Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front
Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the screws from the front edge of the assist step. Open the door to expose the inner
screw.
2. Remove the push clips from the front edge of the assist step. 3. Raise the vehicle to a suitable
height. 4. Remove the nut from the front lower corner of the assist step.
5. Remove the assist step pad nuts. 6. Remove the assist step pad.
1. Insert a plastic tool along the edge. 2. Pull upward on the assist step pad until it fully releases
from the assist step plate.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > System Information > Service and
Repair > Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front > Page 8605
7. Remove the front section of the assist step as follows:
1. Lift in the center of the assist step. 2. Slide the front section forward. 3. Lift upward on the assist
step to release from the retainer.
8. Remove the nut and bolt (1) from the front assist step support bracket to the pinchweld flange. 9.
Remove the assist step support bracket bolts (2) from the underbody.
10. Remove the assist step support bracket.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the assist step support bracket.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the assist step support bracket bolts (2) to the underbody .
Tighten the assist step support bracket bolts (2) to the underbody to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
3. Install the nut and bolt (1) to the assist step support bracket and to the pinchweld flange.
Tighten the nut and bolt (1) to the assist step support bracket and to the pinchweld flange to 10
N.m (89 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > System Information > Service and
Repair > Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front > Page 8606
4. Use the following procedure when installing the assist step:
1. Check the fit to the step well and the door opening. 2. Check the height and the alignment to
rocker panel. 3. Check the alignment to the cladding and to the body. 4. Check the gaps between
the wheel well moldings. 5. Check the lower edge of the assist step to ensure a even gap along the
door edge and the body. 6. Install the front section of the assist step to fit over the rear section.
Align both sections before installing the nuts to the assist step pad.
5. Install the assist step pad to assist step.
Align the assist step pad to the assist step and press downward until fully seated.
6. Install the nuts to the assist step pad by hand.
Tighten the nuts to the assist step pad to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
7. Install the nut to the front lower corner of the assist step.
Tighten the nut to the front lower corner of the assist step to 10 N.m (89 lb in).
8. Lower the vehicle to a suitable height.
9. Install the push clips to the front edge of the assist step.
10. Install the screws to the front edge of the assist step. Open the door to expose the inner screw.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > System Information > Service and
Repair > Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front > Page 8607
Tighten the screws to the upper and inner edges of the assist step to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
11. Lower the vehicle.
Assist Step Plate Replacement
Assist Step Plate Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle to a suitable height. 2. Remove the front and rear assist step extensions. Refer
to Assist Step Replacement (See: Assist Step Replacement) . 3. Remove the nuts that attach the
assist step plate to the assist step support bracket. 4. Remove the assist step plate.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the assist step plate.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the nuts that attach the assist step plate to the support bracket.
Tighten the nuts that attach the assist step plate to the support bracket to 10 N.m (89 lb in).
3. Install the front and rear assist step extensions. Refer to Assist Step Replacement (See: Assist
Step Replacement) . 4. Lower the vehicle.
Assist Step Support Brace Replacement
Assist Step Support Brace Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle to a suitable height.
Important: The assist step assembly does not have to be removed to replace the assist step brace.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > System Information > Service and
Repair > Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front > Page 8608
2. Remove the nuts and bolts (1) that attach the assist step brace to the assist step support
bracket. 3. Remove the assist step brace.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the assist step brace.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the nuts and bolts (1) that attach the assist step brace to the assist step support bracket
Tighten the nuts and bolts (1) that attach the assist step brace to the assist step support bracket to
10 N.m (89 lb in).
3. Lower the vehicle.
Assist Step Support Bracket Replacement
Assist Step Support Bracket Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle to a suitable height.
Important: The assist step assembly does not have to be removed to replace the assist step
support bracket.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > System Information > Service and
Repair > Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front > Page 8609
2. Remove the nuts that attach the assist step plate to the assist step support bracket.
3. The assist step support brackets are to be numbered 1 through 5 in the order when removing.
4. Remove the nuts and bolts (1) that attach the assist step plate to the assist step bracket. 5.
Remove the bolts (2) that attach the assist step plate to the assist step support bracket to the
underbody. 6. Remove the assist step support bracket from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the assist step support bracket to the vehicle. 2. Install the assist step support brackets 1
through 5 in the order which they were removed.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > System Information > Service and
Repair > Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front > Page 8610
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the bolts (2) that attach the assist step plate to the assist step support bracket to the
underbody.
Tighten the bolts (2) that attach the assist step plate to the assist step support bracket to the
underbody to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
4. Install the nuts and bolts (1) that attach the assist step brace to the assist step bracket
Tighten the nuts and bolts (1) that attach the assist step brace to the assist step bracket to 10 N.m
(89 lb in).
5. Install the nuts that attach the assist step plate to the assist step support bracket.
Tighten the nuts that attach the assist step plate to the assist step support bracket to 10 N.m (89 lb
in).
6. Lower the vehicle.
Assist Step Support Retainer Replacement
Assist Step Support Retainer Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle to a suitable height. 2. Remove the assist step extension. Refer to Assist Step
Replacement (See: Assist Step Replacement) .
Important: Do not use a sharp tool in the removal of the assist step retainer, It will damage the
paint. Use a plastic tool to assist in the removal of the assist step retainer.
3. Remove the assist step retainer screws from the rocker panel. 4. Insert a plastic tool along the
edge of the retainer to aid in the removal. 5. Remove the assist step retainer. The right side is a
one piece retainer, the left side is a two piece retainer.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > System Information > Service and
Repair > Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front > Page 8611
1. Install the assist step retainer to the rocker panel. The right side is a one piece retainer, the left
side is a two piece retainer .
1. Clean the rocker panel with isopropyl cleaner or equivalent to remove all of the old double back
tape. 2. Remove the strip from the double sided adhesive tape. 3. Align the assist step retainer to
the rocker panel and press firmly in place.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the assist step retainer screws to the rocker panel.
Tighten the assist step retainer screws to the rocker panel to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Install the assist step extensions. Refer to Assist Step Replacement (See: Assist Step
Replacement) . 4. Lower the vehicle.
Assist Step Rear Anchor Replacement
Assist Step Rear Anchor Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle to a suitable height.
Important: The assist step does not have to be removed to replace the assist step support bracket.
2. Remove the nuts that attach the assist step plate to the assist step support bracket.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > System Information > Service and
Repair > Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front > Page 8612
3. Remove the nuts and bolts (1) that attach the assist step brace to the assist step support
bracket.
4. Remove the nuts and bolts that attach the rear assist step support bracket to the in rocker panel.
5. Remove the assist step support bracket from the vehicle.
6. Remove the nuts and bolts from the rear anchor that attach to the inner pinchwell flange and to
the inner rocker panel. 7. Remove the rear anchor from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the rear anchor to the vehicle.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > System Information > Service and
Repair > Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front > Page 8613
2. Install the nuts and bolts to the rear anchor that attaches to the inner pinchwell flange and to the
inner rocker panel.
Tighten the nuts and bolts to the rear anchor that attaches to the inner pinchwell flange and to the
inner rocker panel to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
3. Install the assist step support bracket to the vehicle. 4. Install the nuts and bolts that attach the
rear assist step support bracket to the inner rocker panel.
Tighten the nuts and bolts that attach the rear assist step support bracket to the inner rocker panel
to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
5. Install the nuts and bolts (1) that attach the assist step brace to the assist step support bracket.
Tighten the nuts and bolts (1) that attach the assist step brace to the assist step support bracket to
10 N.m (89 lb in).
6. Install the nuts and bolts that attach the assist step plate to the assist step support bracket.
Tighten the nuts and bolts that attach the assist step plate to the assist step support bracket to 10
N.m (89 lb in).
7. Lower the vehicle.
Assist Step Replacement
Assist Step Replacement
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > System Information > Service and
Repair > Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front > Page 8614
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the screws from the front edge of the assist step extension. Open the door to expose
the inner screw.
2. Remove the push clips from the front edge of the assist step extension. 3. Raise the vehicle to a
suitable height. 4. Remove the nut from the front lower corner of the assist step extension.
5. Remove the assist step pad nuts. 6. Remove the assist step pad.
1. Insert a plastic tool along the edge. 2. Pull upward on the assist step pad until it is fully released
from the assist step plate.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > System Information > Service and
Repair > Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front > Page 8615
7. Remove the front section of the assist step extension as follows:
1. Lift in the center of the assist step extension. 2. Slide the front section forward. 3. Lift upward on
the assist step extension to release it from the retainer and assist plate.
8. Remove the screws from the right rear inner and outer wheel well. Open the sliding door to
expose the inner screw.
9. Remove the screws from the rear outer edge of the assist step extension. If the vehicle is
equipped with assist steps, the cladding is shorter on the
left side (bottom edge).
10. Remove the rear section of the assist step extension, by lifting upward until fully released from
the retainer.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > System Information > Service and
Repair > Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front > Page 8616
11. Remove the nuts that attach the assist step plate to the assist step support bracket .
12. Remove the bolt (1) from the assist step support brace.
13. The assist step support brackets are to be numbered (1, 2, 3, 4, 5) when removing.
14. Remove the bolts (2) from the underbody. 15. Remove the assist step support bracket .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > System Information > Service and
Repair > Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front > Page 8617
16. Remove the nuts and bolts from the rear assist step support bracket. 17. Remove the rear
assist step support bracket.
18. Remove the nuts and bolts from the rear anchor that attaches to the inner pinchwell flange and
to the inner rocker panel.
Important: Do not use a sharp tool in the removal of the assist step retainer, it will damage the
paint. Use a plastic tool to assist in the removal of the assist step retainer. The assist step retainer
is held in place by a double backing tape.
19. Remove the screws from the assist step retainer. The right side is a one piece retainer, the left
side is a two piece retainer. 20. Remove the assist step retainer from the rocker panel.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > System Information > Service and
Repair > Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front > Page 8618
1. Install the assist step retainer to the rocker panel.
The right side is a one piece retainer, the left side is a two piece retainer.
1. Clean the rocker panel with isopropyl cleaner or equivalent to remove all of the old double
backing tape. 2. Remove the strip from the double back tape if replacing retainer. 3. Align the assist
step retainer to the holes in the rocker panel and press in place.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the screws to the assist step retainer.
Tighten the screws to the assist step retainer to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Install the nuts and bolts to the rear anchor that attaches to the inner pinchwell flange and to the
inner rocker panel.
Tighten the nuts and bolts to the rear anchor that attaches to the inner pinchwell flange and to the
inner rocker panel to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
4. Install the rear assist step support bracket. 5. Install the nuts and bolts to the rear assist step
support bracket.
Tighten the nuts and bolts to rear assist step support bracket to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
6. Lay out the assist step support brackets in the order in which they were removed (1, 2, 3, 4, 5).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > System Information > Service and
Repair > Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front > Page 8619
7. Install the assist step support brackets and bolts (2) to the underbody.
Tighten the assist step support bracket and bolts (2) to the underbody to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
8. Install the bolt from the inside of the pinchweld flange. 9. Install the assist step support brace bolt
(1) to the pinchweld flange.
Tighten the assist step support brace bolt (1) to the pinchweld flange to 10 N.m (89 lb in).
10. Install the nuts that attach the assist step plate to the support bracket .
Tighten the nuts that attach the assist step plate to the support bracket to 10 N.m (89 lb in).
11. When installing the assist step, check the height and the alignment to rocker panel, cladding
and to the body. 12. Install the rear section of the assist step extension.
Align the rear edge of assist step extension with the rear edge of the retainer and pushing
downward until fully seated.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > System Information > Service and
Repair > Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front > Page 8620
13. Install the screws to the rear outer edge of the assist step extension. If the vehicle is equipped
with running boards, the cladding will be shorter on
the left side only.
Tighten the screws to the rear outer edge of the assist step extension to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
14. Install the screws to the right rear inner and outer wheel well. Open the sliding door to expose
the inner screw.
Tighten the screws to the right rear inner and outer wheel well to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Important: Use the following steps when installing the assist step extensions to the retainer:
* Check to ensure that the front assist step extension fits over the center of the rear extension.
* Check for a suitable fit to the step well and the door opening.
*
Check the height and the alignment to the rocker panel and to the door opening.
* Check the alignment to the cladding and to the body.
* Check the alignment gaps between the wheel well molding and body.
* Check the lower edge of the assist step extensions to ensure an even gap along the lower edge
of the body.
15. Install the assist step extensions to the retainer. 16. Install the nut to the front lower corner of
the assist step extension.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > System Information > Service and
Repair > Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front > Page 8621
Tighten the nut to the front lower corner of the assist step extension to 10 N.m (89 lb in).
17. Lower the vehicle to a suitable height. 18. Install the screws to the front assist step extension.
Open the door to expose the inner screw.
Tighten the front assist step extension screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
19. Install the push clips to the front edge of the assist step extension.
20. Install the screws to the front edge of the assist step extension.
Tighten the screws to the front edge of the assist step extension to 7 N.m (62 lb in).
21. Install the assist step pad. 22. Align the assist step pad to the assist step plate and press
downward firmly until fully seated. The nuts are to be hand torqued. 23. Install the assist step pad
nuts.
Tighten the assist step pad nuts to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
24. Lower the vehicle.
Assist Step Pad Replacement
Assist Step Pad Replacement
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > System Information > Service and
Repair > Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front > Page 8622
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle to a suitable height. 2. Remove the assist step pad nuts. 3. Remove the assist
step pad as follows:
1. Insert a plastic tool along the edge. 2. Pull upward on the assist step pad until it is fully released
from the assist step plate.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the assist step pad as follows:
1. Align the assist step pad to the assist step plate and press downward firmly until seated. 2. The
assist step pad nuts are to be hand torque.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the assist step pad nuts
Tighten the assist step pads nuts to 8 N.m (9 lb in).
3. Lower the vehicle.
Assist Step Extension Replacement - Rear
Assist Step Extension Replacement - Rear
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle to a suitable height. 2. Remove the front section of the assist step extension.
Refer to Assist Step Plate Replacement (See: Assist Step Plate Replacement) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > System Information > Service and
Repair > Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front > Page 8623
3. Remove the screws from the left rear outer edge of the assist step extension. 4. Lift upward on
the assist step extension until fully released from the retainer.
5. Remove the screws from the right rear inner and outer wheel well. 6. Open the sliding door to
expose the screw. 7. Lift upward on the assist step extension until fully released from the retainer.
8. Remove the rear section of the assist step extension.
Installation Procedure
Important: Use the following procedure when installing the assist step extension:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > System Information > Service and
Repair > Assist Step Extension Replacement - Front > Page 8624
* Check the height and the alignment to the rocker panel.
* Check the height and the alignment to the rocker panel cladding and to the body. If the vehicle is
equipped with assist steps, the cladding will be shorter across the bottom.
1. Install the rear section of the assist step extension, align the rear edge of the assist step with the
rear edge of the retainer and pushing downward
until fully seated.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the screw to the left rear outer edge of the assist step extension. Lift upward on the assist
step until fully released from the retainer.
Tighten the screw to the left rear outer edge of the assist step extension to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Install the screws to the right rear inner and outer wheel well. Open the sliding door to expose
the screw. Lift upward on the assist step extension
until fully released from the retainer
Tighten the screws to the right rear inner and outer wheel well to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
4. Install the front section of the assist step extension. Refer to Assist Step Plate Replacement
(See: Assist Step Plate Replacement) . 5. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Body - TPO Fascia Cleaning Prior to Painting
Front Bumper Cover / Fascia: Technical Service Bulletins Body - TPO Fascia Cleaning Prior to
Painting
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-08-51-002
Date: March 12, 2008
Subject: New Primer For TPO Fascias and Affected Cleaning Process of Painting Operation
Models: 2009 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3
The purpose of this bulletin is to inform the technician that General Motors has made a change in
the primer it uses for TPO plastic for service parts. This new primer comes in several different
colors from five different suppliers. This change affects the cleaning process of the painting
operation. The new process is as follows.
1. Wash with soap and water.
2. Clean with a 50% mix of isopropyl alcohol and water (or a waterborne cleaner). Check with your
paint supplier for product recommendations.
3. Scuff sand per your paint suppliers recommendations.
Note:
The use of a solvent-type cleaner will soften, or begin to dissolve the primer. Base coats do not
have any affect on this primer.
4. Reclean with a 50% mix of isopropyl alcohol and water (or a waterborne cleaner).
All fascias, with the exception of the Corvette, Camaro, and Cadillac XLR, are made of TPO. You
may find other TPO parts with this primer. If the technician has a question as to the type of plastic
they are painting, inspect the back of the part for the plastic symbol (TPO).
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8631
Front Bumper Cover / Fascia: Service and Repair
Fascia Replacement - Front Bumper
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the grille. Refer to Grille Replacement (See: Grille/Service and Repair/Grille
Replacement) in Exterior Trim. 2. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the
Vehicle (See: Maintenance/Vehicle Lifting/Service and Repair) in General
Information.
3. Remove the front bumper fascia to bumper lower brace bolts.
4. Remove the front bumper fascia to fender bolts.
5. Remove the front bumper fascia to impact bar push-in retainers.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8632
6. Remove the front bumper fascia from the impact bar.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the front bumper fascia to the impact bar.
2. Install the front bumper fascia to impact bar push-in retainers.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the front bumper fascia to the fender bolts.
Tighten the bolts to 6 N.m (53 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8633
4. Install the front bumper fascia to the bumper lower brace bolts.
Tighten the bolts to 6 N.m (53 lb in).
5. Install the grille. Refer to Grille Replacement (See: Grille/Service and Repair/Grille Replacement)
in Exterior Trim. 6. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Reinforcement > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Body - Polypropylene Energy Absorber Replacement
Front Bumper Reinforcement: Technical Service Bulletins Body - Polypropylene Energy Absorber
Replacement
Bulletin No.: 07-08-63-001
Date: April 17, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Information on Repair of Polypropylene Energy Absorbers
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2007 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to change the repair information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 63-20-02 (Section 8 - Body and Accessories).
Because the energy absorbers are relatively low in cost to replace, it is now more cost efficient to
replace the energy absorbers whenever they are damaged.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Reinforcement > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8638
Front Bumper Reinforcement: Service and Repair
Impact Bar Replacement - Front Bumper
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the grille. Refer to Grille Replacement (See: Grille/Service and Repair/Grille
Replacement) in Exterior Trim.
2. Remove the front bumper fascia. Refer to Fascia Replacement - Front Bumper (See: Front
Bumper Cover / Fascia/Service and Repair) . 3. Remove the bracket bolts from the impact bar. 4.
Remove the impact bar from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
1. Install the impact bar to the bracket bolts.
Tighten the bolts to 58 N.m (43 lb ft).
2. Install the front bumper fascia. Refer to Fascia Replacement - Front Bumper (See: Front Bumper
Cover / Fascia/Service and Repair) . 3. Install the grille. Refer to Grille Replacement (See:
Grille/Service and Repair/Grille Replacement) in Exterior Trim.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Body - TPO Fascia Cleaning Prior to Painting
Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia: Technical Service Bulletins Body - TPO Fascia Cleaning Prior to
Painting
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-08-51-002
Date: March 12, 2008
Subject: New Primer For TPO Fascias and Affected Cleaning Process of Painting Operation
Models: 2009 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3
The purpose of this bulletin is to inform the technician that General Motors has made a change in
the primer it uses for TPO plastic for service parts. This new primer comes in several different
colors from five different suppliers. This change affects the cleaning process of the painting
operation. The new process is as follows.
1. Wash with soap and water.
2. Clean with a 50% mix of isopropyl alcohol and water (or a waterborne cleaner). Check with your
paint supplier for product recommendations.
3. Scuff sand per your paint suppliers recommendations.
Note:
The use of a solvent-type cleaner will soften, or begin to dissolve the primer. Base coats do not
have any affect on this primer.
4. Reclean with a 50% mix of isopropyl alcohol and water (or a waterborne cleaner).
All fascias, with the exception of the Corvette, Camaro, and Cadillac XLR, are made of TPO. You
may find other TPO parts with this primer. If the technician has a question as to the type of plastic
they are painting, inspect the back of the part for the plastic symbol (TPO).
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8644
Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia: Service and Repair
Fascia Replacement - Rear Bumper
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the top fascia retainers. 2. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking
the Vehicle (See: Maintenance/Vehicle Lifting/Service and Repair) in General
Information.
3. Disengage the retainers from the underside of the fascia. 4. Remove the fascia from the impact
bar.
Installation Procedure
1. Align the locator pin of the fascia to the hole in the impact bar.
2. Press the retainers into the underside of the fascia. 3. Lower the vehicle. 4. Install the top fascia
retainers.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > Rear Bumper Reinforcement > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Body - Polypropylene Energy Absorber Replacement
Rear Bumper Reinforcement: Technical Service Bulletins Body - Polypropylene Energy Absorber
Replacement
Bulletin No.: 07-08-63-001
Date: April 17, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Information on Repair of Polypropylene Energy Absorbers
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2007 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to change the repair information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 63-20-02 (Section 8 - Body and Accessories).
Because the energy absorbers are relatively low in cost to replace, it is now more cost efficient to
replace the energy absorbers whenever they are damaged.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Service and
Repair
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair
Air Inlet Grille Panel Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Disconnect the windshield washer hoses from the windshield wiper arm. 2. Remove the
windshield wiper arms. Refer to Wiper Arm Replacement in Wipers/Washer Systems. 3. Remove
the antenna. Refer to Fixed Antenna Mast Replacement in Entertainment. 4. Remove the air inlet
grille panel to cowl screws.
5. Remove the air inlet grille panel from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the air inlet grille panel to the vehicle.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the air inlet grille panel to cowl screws.
Tighten the air inlet grille panel to cowl screws 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Install the antenna. Refer to Fixed Antenna Mast Replacement in Entertainment. 4. Install the
windshield wiper arms. Refer to Wiper Arm Replacement in Wipers/Washer Systems.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle >
Front Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Exterior Handle: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: It door lock cylinders require replacement for any reason, apply a coating of GM P/N
12346241 or equivalent lubricant inside of the lock case and the cylinder keyway prior to
assembling and installing the cylinder.
1. Remove the trim panel. 2. Use a sharp bladed tool in order to separate the water deflector at the
perforations. Refer to Water Deflector Replacement - Front Door. 3. Remove the access hole plug
(1). 4. Remove the lock rod from the door handle. 5. Remove the nuts from the door handle (4). 6.
Remove the door handle from the door (2). 7. Remove the lock rod from the lock cylinder (3). 8.
Remove the lock cylinder retainer. 9. Remove the lock cylinder and the gasket (5) from the door.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: Install new plastic retainer clips whenever the lock rods are removed.
1. Install the gasket (5) and the lock cylinder to the door. 2. Install the lock cylinder retainer. 3.
Install the lock rod to the lock cylinder. 4. Install the handle to the door (2).
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle >
Front Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair > Page 8660
5. Install the nuts to the door handle (4).
Tighten Tighten the nuts to the door handle to 6 N.m (53 lb in).
6. Install the door handle lock rod to the handle. 7. Install the access hole plug (1). 8. Install the
water deflector. 9. Install the trim panel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Hinge >
System Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Hinge: Service and Repair
Hinge Replacement - Front Door
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the door. Refer to Door Replacement - Front (See: Service and Repair) . 2. Remove the
sealer from around the edge of the hinge.
3. Scribe the location of the existing hinges on the door and the body pillar (1). 4. Center punch
each of the original welds on each hinge base (3). 5. Drill a 3.0 mm (1/8 in) pilot hole completely
through each weld at each punch mark.
Drill through the hinge base only. Do not drill through the door or the body pillar.
6. Drill a 13.0 mm (1/2 in) hole through the hinge base. Use the 3.0 mm (1/8 in) hole as a pilot.
Do not drill through the door or the body pillar.
7. Use a chisel in order to separate any remaining weld attaching the hinge to the door or the body
pillar. 8. Remove the hinge from the door or the body pillar.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Hinge >
System Information > Service and Repair > Page 8664
1. Install the bolt on replacement hinge (4) to the door or the body pillar within the scribe marks (1)
previously made:
1. Use the replacement hinge (4) as a template in order to center punch each bolt hole location. 2.
Drill a 13.0 mm (1/2 in) hole through the door or the body pillar at the center punch marks made
previously. 3. Dress and prepare the door or the hinge pillar for the replacement hinge. This
includes grinding off any remaining welds.
2. Apply a medium-bodied sealer to the hinge surface that mates with the door or the hinge pillar
surface.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Use the bolts and the anchor plate supplied with the replacement hinge in order to install the
hinge to the door.
Tighten the bolts hinge to the door to 27 N.m (20 lb ft).
4. Apply paint to the hinge and the surrounding area. 5. Install the door. 6. Adjust the door to fit
properly in the door frame. The 13.0 mm (1/2 in) holes drilled for the replacement will provide for
some adjustment.
Do not completely shut the door until a visual check of the lock fork bolt to striker alignment is
made.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel >
System Information > Service and Repair > Panel Replacement
Front Door Panel: Service and Repair Panel Replacement
Trim Panel Replacement - Door
Tools Required
J 38778 Door Trim Pad and Garnish Clip Remover
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the screws and the armrest cover (YC5).
2. Remove the window regulator handle, if equipped.
3. Pull out on the lock lever escutcheon, starting with the front edge, in order to remove the lock
lever escutcheon.
4. Pull out on the top edge of the escutcheon and pivot down in order to clear the tab at the trim
panel and remove the upper corner trim if equipped. 5. Remove the caps that cover the screws
retaining the assist handle. 6. Remove the screws that retain the handle to the door. 7. Remove the
one screw at the front edge of the accessory switch mount plate. 8. Remove the plate from the trim
panel. 9. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the switches on the plate, as needed.
10. Remove the door courtesy lamp from the door panel, if equipped. Refer to Courtesy
Lamp/Reflector Replacement - Door .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel >
System Information > Service and Repair > Panel Replacement > Page 8669
11. Use J 38778 to release the door trim panel retainers. 12. Remove the trim panel from the door.
Installation Procedure
Important: Replace any trim panel retainers that were damaged during removal.
1. Position the trim panel to the door. 2. Secure the trim panel retainers to the door by pressing into
the door until fully seated. 3. Place the window seal portion of the panel over the door frame in
order to install the trim panel to the door. 4. Install the door courtesy lamp to the door panel. Refer
to Courtesy Lamp/Reflector Replacement - Door . 5. Connect the electrical connectors to the
switches on the accessory switch mounting plate, as needed. 6. Install the plate to the trim panel.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
7. Install the one screw at the front edge of the accessory switch mount plate.
Tighten the one screw at the front edge of the accessory switch mount plate to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
8. Install the handle to the door with screws.
Tighten the handle to the door with screws to 5 N.m (44 lb in).
9. Install the caps that cover the screws on the assist handle.
10. Insert the tab in the slot on the door trim panel and seat the fastener into the door at the top in
order to install the upper corner trim.
11. Push the lock lever escutcheon into place, starting at the rear edge.
12. Install the window regulator handle, if equipped.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel >
System Information > Service and Repair > Panel Replacement > Page 8670
13. Install the armrest cover and the screws (YC5).
Tighten the armrest cover screws to 5 N.m (44 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel >
System Information > Service and Repair > Panel Replacement > Page 8671
Front Door Panel: Service and Repair Water Deflector Replacement - Front Door
Water Deflector Replacement - Front Door
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Door (See: ) . 2. Use a 6 mm (0.24
in) drill bit in order to remove the head from the door bracket rivets. 3. Remove the rivets that retain
the bracket to the door.
Important: Water deflectors seal the inner panel. Water deflectors prevent water from entering into
the body. A strip of adhesive between the deflector and the door secures the deflector.
4. In order to remove the water deflector, several components need to be removed first. Remove
the armrest bracket. 5. Remove the lock lever.
6. Use a soft-faced scraper in order to peel the water deflector away from the door.
Installation Procedure
Important: When replacing deflectors which have been peeled back or removed, the adhesive on
the door and the deflector from the factory will usually be adequate in order to re-adhere the
deflector to the door. If additional adhesive is required, use a small amount of weatherstrip
adhesive, such as GM P/N 12345096, Canadian P/N 993365, or an equivalent adhesive. If the
deflector was separated at a perforation, use a cloth reinforced tape with a strong adhesive in order
to secure the piece together. Replace the deflector if the deflector
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel >
System Information > Service and Repair > Panel Replacement > Page 8672
is too badly damaged to provide a proper seal.
1. Install the water deflector. 2. Install the lock lever. 3. Install the armrest bracket to the door. 4.
Install the 6 mm (1/4 in) rivets to the door. 5. Install the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel
Replacement - Door (See: ) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Striker >
System Information > Service and Repair > Door Striker Replacement
Front Door Striker: Service and Repair Door Striker Replacement
Striker Replacement - Door
Tools Required
J 29843-9 Door Lock Striker and Seat Belt Torx Wrench
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the interior trim if necessary to gain access to the striker nut.
2. Remove door striker using J 29843-9 .
Hold the nut in order to prevent the nut from falling into the body pillar.
3. Remove the nut from the vehicle. 4. Remove the spacer from the vehicle. 5. Remove the
insulator from the vehicle. 6. Adjust the striker to properly engage the door lock once the door is
adjusted within the frame. 7. Ensure that the striker is used to adjust the door for flushness only,
not to raise or lower the door.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the spacer and the insulator to the striker.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the door striker using J 29843-9 .
Hold the nut in order to prevent the nut from falling into the body pillar.
Tighten the door striker to 67 N.m (49 lb ft).
3. Install the interior trim which was previously removed.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Striker >
System Information > Service and Repair > Door Striker Replacement > Page 8677
Front Door Striker: Service and Repair Striker Replacement - Sliding Door Rear
Striker Replacement - Sliding Door Rear
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the right hand body side trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Right Body Side
(See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Right Body Side) .
2. Remove the two bolts that retain the rear storage compartment, if equipped. 3. Remove the bolts
(5).
4. Remove the striker (4). 5. Remove the spacer (3). 6. Remove the washer (2). 7. Remove the nut
plate (1).
Installation Procedure
1. Install the nut plate (1). 2. Install the washer (2). 3. Install the spacer (3).
4. Install the striker (4).
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
5. Install the striker bolts (5).
Tighten the striker bolts to 24 N.m (18 lb ft).
6. Install the right hand body side trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Right Body Side
(See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Right Body Side) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Weatherstrip
> Component Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
Weatherstrip Replacement - Front Door Opening
Tools Required
J 38778 Door Trim Pad and Garnish Clip Remover
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the interior garnish moldings.
2. Use the J 38778 in order to pull the weatherstrip from the pinchweld flange of the door. Start at
the upper right corner (6), and pull the
weatherstrip down (5,4). Keep pulling the weatherstrip (3) until you reach the top (1) of the door,
and have pulled the weatherstrip free.
Installation Procedure
Important: Ensure that the weatherstrip length is equally distributed around the door opening.
1. Partially attach the weatherstrip to the pinchweld flange in 6 key areas (1,2,3,4,5,6).
Important: Fit the weatherstrip to the opening by hand.
2. Seat the weatherstrip onto the pinchweld flange to approximately 154 mm (6 in) on each side of
the corner in order to install the weatherstrip at
each corner (6,4,3,1).
Important: Use a rubber mallet and hit the weatherstrip square to the flange. Otherwise, an
undesirable spreading of the carrier will occur that will result in reduced retention.
3. Use a rubber mallet in order to install the weatherstrip into each corner. 4. Use a rubber mallet in
order to install the pinchweld flange areas of the hinge and the windshield pillars. 5. Ensure that the
following conditions are met:
* The weatherstrip fits into the corner and matches the radius of the pinchweld flange.
* The weatherstrip is seated completely onto the flange in all areas, resulting in a smooth vinyl-trim
around the entire door opening.
* There is not any distortion or excess spreading of the carrier as a result of hitting the carrier
improperly with the rubber mallet.
* The weatherstrip is not kinked or distorted after installation.
* The weatherstrip is lubricated with GM weatherstrip silicone lube. Refer to Fluid and Lubricant
Recommendations in Maintenance and Lubrication.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Weatherstrip
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8681
* Install the interior garnish moldings.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window
Glass > Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
Sealing Strip Replacement - Front Door Upper
Removal Procedure
1. Pull the molding (1) from the molding flange. 2. Remove the molding (1).
Installation Procedure
1. Install the molding (1). 2. Push the molding (1) onto the flange. Start at the pre-formed corners.
Work toward the straight flanges.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window
Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Window Motor: Service and Repair
Motor Replacement - Power Window
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the power window regulator. Refer to Window Regulator Replacement (See: Front Door
Window Regulator/Service and Repair/Door
Window Regulator Replacement (Manual)) .
Caution: Do not attempt to service the regulator motor without releasing the counterbalance spring
tension. The regulator lift arm is under tension from the counterbalance spring and can cause
personal injury if the motor is removed from the regulator.
2. Install a self-tapping, pan head sheet metal screw through the sector gear and the backing plate
at the hole provided. This will lock the sector gear
into position.
3. Drill out the rivets (2) attaching the power window motor to window regulator . 4. Remove the
power window motor from the window regulator (3).
Installation Procedure
1. Install the power window motor to the window regulator (3).
Caution: Do not attempt to service the regulator motor without releasing the counterbalance spring
tension. The regulator lift arm is under tension from the counterbalance spring and can cause
personal injury if the motor is removed from the regulator.
2. Install the rivets (2) attaching the power window motor to window regulator . 3. Remove the
self-tapping, pan head sheet metal screw through the sector gear and the backing plate hole. 4.
Install the power window regulator. Refer to Window Regulator Replacement (See: Front Door
Window Regulator/Service and Repair/Door
Window Regulator Replacement (Manual)) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair > Door Window Regulator Replacement
Front Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair Door Window Regulator Replacement
Door Window Regulator Replacement
Tools Required
M 39010 Heavy Duty Rivet Gun
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the trim panel. Refer to Door Trim Panel Replacement (See: Front Door Panel/Service
and Repair) . 2. Remove the inner panel upper bar. Refer to Inner Panel Bar Replacement - Front
Door Upper () . 3. Remove the water deflector. Refer to Front Side Door Water Deflector
Replacement See: Front Door Panel/Service and Repair
Use a soft-faced scraper, if needed, in order to peel the water deflector away from the door.
4. Roll up the window. 5. Apply a cloth backed body tape from the window over the top of the door
to the other side of the window in order to hold the window in position
when the regulator is removed.
6. Disconnect the wiring harness from the power window regulator motor, if equipped.
7. Remove the window regulator rivet (2) heads by using a 6 mm (1/4 in) drill bit. 8. Remove the
regulator (3) from the door:
1. Push the regulator into the door and slide the regulator forward. and then rearward in order to
remove the power window regulator arms from
the sash and the regulator rail.
2. Fold the regulator arms together and remove it through the access hole.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the regulator (3) to the door:
1. Place the window regulator into the door through the access hole. 2. Place the window regulator
arm rollers into the sash and the regulator rail. 3. Push the window regulator through the regulator
door opening and align the holes in the regulator with the holes in the door.
2. Install the rivets to the window regulator (3) using the M 39010 . 3. Connect the wiring harness to
the power window regulator, if equipped. 4. Install the water deflector. Refer to Front Side Door
Water Deflector Replacement See: Front Door Panel/Service and Repair 5. Install the inner panel
upper bar. Refer to Inner Panel Bar Replacement - Front Door Upper () . 6. Remove the tape from
the door and the window. 7. Check the window operation. 8. Install the trim panel. Refer to Door
Trim Panel Replacement (See: Front Door Panel/Service and Repair) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair > Door Window Regulator Replacement > Page 8693
Front Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair Door Window Regulator Replacement (Manual)
Window Regulator Replacement
Tools Required
M 39010 Heavy Duty Rivet Gun
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Door (See: Front Door Panel/Service
and Repair) .
2. Remove the bolts that retain the inner panel upper bar. 3. Remove the water deflector. Refer to
Water Deflector Replacement - Front Door See: Front Door Panel/Service and Repair.
Use a soft-faced scraper, if needed, in order to peel the water deflector away from the door.
4. Roll up the window. 5. Apply a cloth backed body tape from the window over the top of the door
to the other side of the window in order to hold the window in position
when the regulator is removed.
6. Disconnect the wiring harness from the power window regulator motor, if equipped.
7. Remove the window regulator rivet (2) heads by using a 6 mm (1/4 in) drill bit. 8. Remove the
regulator (3) from the door:
1. Push the regulator into the door and slide the regulator forward and then rearward in order to
remove the power window regulator arms from
the sash and the regulator rail.
2. Fold the regulator arms together and remove it through the access hole.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the regulator (3) to the door:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair > Door Window Regulator Replacement > Page 8694
1. Place the window regulator into the door through the access hole. 2. Place the window regulator
arm rollers into the sash and the regulator rail. 3. Push the window regulator through the regulator
door opening and align the holes in the regulator with the holes in the door.
2. Install the rivets to the window regulator (3) using the M 39010 . 3. Connect the wiring harness to
the power window regulator, if equipped. 4. Install the water deflector. Refer to Water Deflector
Replacement - Front Door See: Front Door Panel/Service and Repair.
5. Install the inner panel upper bar with the bolts.
Tighten the bolts to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
6. Remove the tape from the door and the window. 7. Check the window operation. 8. Install the
trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Door (See: Front Door Panel/Service and Repair) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle >
Rear Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair > Handle Replacement - Rear Door Outside
Rear Door Exterior Handle: Service and Repair Handle Replacement - Rear Door Outside
Handle Replacement - Rear Door Outside
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors) (See:
Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and
Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors))Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door
(E54) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Rear
Door (E54)) .
2. Use a soft-faced scraper, if needed, in order to peel the water deflector away from the door.
Refer to Water Deflector Replacement (See: Rear
Door Panel/Service and Repair) .
3. Remove the control rod from the outside handle. 4. Remove the outside handle nuts. 5. Remove
the outside handle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the outside handle to the door.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the outside handle nuts.
Tighten the outside handle nuts to 7 N.m (62 lb in).
3. Install the control rod to the outside handle through the clip. 4. Install the water deflector. Refer
to Water Deflector Replacement (See: Rear Door Panel/Service and Repair) . 5. Install the trim
panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors) (See: Interior Moulding /
Trim/Console/Service and
Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors))Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door
(E54) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Rear
Door (E54)) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle >
Rear Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair > Handle Replacement - Rear Door Outside > Page
8701
Rear Door Exterior Handle: Service and Repair Door Handle Replacement
Outside Handle and Lock Cylinder Replacement
Removal Procedure
Important: If door lock cylinders require replacement for any reason, apply a coating of GM P/N
12346241 or equivalent lubricant inside of the lock case and the cylinder keyway prior to
assembling and installing the cylinder.
1. Remove the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Door (See: Front Door/Front Door
Panel/Service and Repair) . 2. Use a sharp bladed tool in order to separate the water deflector at
the perforations. Refer to Water Deflector Replacement - Front Door See: Front
Door/Front Door Panel/Service and Repair
3. Remove the access hole plug (1). 4. Remove the lock rod from the door handle. 5. Remove the
nuts from the door handle (4).
6. Remove the door handle from the door (2). 7. Remove the lock rod from the lock cylinder (3). 8.
Remove the lock cylinder retainer. 9. Remove the lock cylinder and the gasket (5) from the door.
Installation Procedure
Important: Install new plastic retainer clips whenever the lock rods are removed.
1. Install the gasket (5) and the lock cylinder to the door. 2. Install the lock cylinder retainer . 3.
Install the lock rod to the lock cylinder.
4. Install the handle to the door (2).
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
5. Install the nuts to the door handle (4).
Tighten the nuts to the door handle to 6 N.m (53 lb in).
6. Install the door handle lock rod to the handle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle >
Rear Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair > Handle Replacement - Rear Door Outside > Page
8702
7. Install the access hole plug (1). 8. Install the water deflector. Refer to Water Deflector
Replacement - Front Door See: Front Door/Front Door Panel/Service and Repair 9. Install the trim
panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Door (See: Front Door/Front Door Panel/Service and
Repair) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Hinge >
System Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Hinge: Service and Repair
Hinge Replacement - Rear Door
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the door from the vehicle. Refer to Door Replacement - Rear (Cargo Doors) (See:
Service and Repair/Door Replacement - Rear (Cargo
Doors))Door Replacement - Rear (E54) (See: Service and Repair/Door Replacement - Rear (E54))
.
2. Remove the taillamp. Refer to Tail Lamp Replacement . 3. Remove the taillamp filler panel.
4. Remove the trim panel: Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Door (See: Front Door/Front Door
Panel/Service and Repair) .
1. Scribe an outline of the hinge halves on the door (2) and the body (1). 2. Use the template
provided with the service hinge in order to center punch the existing welds. 3. Drill a 3.0 mm (1/8
in) pilot hole completely through the following components at the punch marks:
* Hinge
* Frame
* Reinforcement
* Gusset
4. Use the pilot holes as guides in order to drill a 13.0 mm (1/2 in) hole through the following
components at the punch marks:
* Hinge
* Frame
* Reinforcement
* Gusset
5. Drive a chisel between the hinge and the door frame if any additional weld holds the hinge to the
frame in order to remove the hinge halves. 6. Remove any additional weld on the door or the body
side frame. This step may include using a grinder in order to remove any remaining weld.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Hinge >
System Information > Service and Repair > Page 8706
1. Install the hinge pin bushings. 2. Apply a medium-bodied sealer to the mating surface of the
hinge halves.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the following components to the door and the body frame:
* Anchor plates
* Bolts (3)
Tighten the bolts to the door and the body frame to 27 N.m (20 lb ft).
* Hinge halves Align the hinge with the previously made mark.
4. Paint the hinge and the surrounding area. 5. Install the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel
Replacement - Door (See: Front Door/Front Door Panel/Service and Repair) . 6. Install the taillamp
filler panel. 7. Install the taillamp. Refer to Tail Lamp Replacement . 8. Install the door to the
vehicle. Refer to Door Replacement - Rear (Cargo Doors) (See: Service and Repair/Door
Replacement - Rear (Cargo
Doors))Door Replacement - Rear (E54) (See: Service and Repair/Door Replacement - Rear (E54))
.
9. Adjust the door to fit properly in the door opening frame:
1. Ensure that the left door is closed when adjusting the right door. 2. Do not close the right door
completely until a visual check is made in order to determine that the lock assembly is properly
engaged to the
striker.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Limiter >
System Information > Service and Repair > Check Link Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Door)
Rear Door Limiter: Service and Repair Check Link Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Door)
Check Link Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Door)
Removal Procedure
1. Open the door. 2. Remove the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Door (See: Front
Door/Front Door Panel/Service and Repair) . 3. Remove the water deflector.
4. Remove the check link from the check link mounting bracket by lifting upward to release.
Important: Remove the one screw that retains the check link lock spring, if replacing just the check
link lock spring. When replacing the check link bracket all three screws will need to be removed.
Remove one screw at a time when replacing the check link bracket. If all three screws are removed
at once this may cause the loss of the threaded anchor plate. If this occurs, remove the taillamp
and the taillamp pocket in order to access the cavity where the threaded plate is located.
5. Remove the check link screws from the bracket (2). 6. Remove the check link bracket (1) and
the check link lock spring. 7. Remove the check link bolts from the door. 8. Remove the check link
boot from the door (6). 9. Remove the check link (5) from the inside of the door.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the check link (5) to the door. 2. Install the check link boot to the door (6).
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the check link boot bolts to the door.
Tighten the check link bolts to the door to 6 N.m (53 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Limiter >
System Information > Service and Repair > Check Link Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Door) > Page 8711
4. Install the check link bracket (1) and the check link lock spring. 5. Install the check link bracket
screws (2).
Tighten the check link bracket screws to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
6. Install the water deflector. 7. Install the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Door
(See: Front Door/Front Door Panel/Service and Repair) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Limiter >
System Information > Service and Repair > Check Link Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Door) > Page 8712
Rear Door Limiter: Service and Repair Check Link Replacement - Rear Door (E54)
Check Link Replacement - Rear Door (E54)
Removal Procedure
1. Open the door. 2. Remove the door trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door
(Cargo Doors) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and
Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors))Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door
(E54) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Rear
Door (E54)) .
3. Remove the water deflector. Refer to Water Deflector Replacement (See: Rear Door
Panel/Service and Repair) .
4. Remove the check link from the check link mounting bracket by lifting upward to release.
Important: Remove the one screw that retains the check link lock spring, if replacing just the check
link lock spring. When replacing the check link bracket all three screws will need to be removed.
Remove one screw at a time when replacing the check link bracket. If all three screws are removed
at once this may cause the loss of the threaded anchor plate. If this occurs, remove the taillamp
and the taillamp pocket in order to access the cavity where the threaded plate is located.
5. Remove the check link screws from the bracket (2). 6. Remove the check link bracket (1) and
the check link lock spring. 7. Remove the check link bolts from the door. 8. Remove the check link
boot from the door (6). 9. Remove the check link (5) from the inside of the door.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the check link (5) to the door. 2. Install the check link boot to the door (6).
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the check link boot bolts to the door.
Tighten the check link bolts to the door to 6 N.m (53 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Limiter >
System Information > Service and Repair > Check Link Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Door) > Page 8713
4. Install the check link bracket (1) and the check link lock spring. 5. Install the check link bracket
screws (2).
Tighten the check link bracket screws to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
6. Remove the water deflector. Refer to Water Deflector Replacement (See: Rear Door
Panel/Service and Repair) . 7. Install the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Door (See:
Front Door/Front Door Panel/Service and Repair) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel >
System Information > Service and Repair > Panel Replacement
Rear Door Panel: Service and Repair Panel Replacement
Rear Door Trim Panel Replacement (Cargo Doors)
Rear Door Trim Panel Replacement (Cargo Doors)
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the window garnish molding. Refer to Window Garnish Molding Replacement (See:
Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Window Garnish Molding Replacement).
2. Remove the screws.
3. Remove the trim panel.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the trim panel.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the trim panel screws.
Tighten the trim panel screws to 2 Nm (18 lb.in.).
3. Install the window garnish molding. Refer to Window Garnish Molding Replacement (See:
Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Window Garnish Molding Replacement).
Rear Door Trim Panel Replacement (E54)
Rear Door Trim Panel Replacement (E54)
Tools Required
J 38778 Door Trim Pad and Garnish Clip Remover
Removal Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel >
System Information > Service and Repair > Panel Replacement > Page 8718
1. Remove the lace.
2. Use J 38778 in order to remove the trim panel.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the trim panel to the door.
2. Install the lace.
Door Trim Panel - Rear
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel >
System Information > Service and Repair > Panel Replacement > Page 8719
TRIM PANEL REPLACEMENT - DOOR
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38778 Door Trim Pad and Garnish Clip Remover
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the screws and the armrest cover (YC5).
2. Remove the window regulator handle, if equipped.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel >
System Information > Service and Repair > Panel Replacement > Page 8720
3. Pull out on the lock lever escutcheon, starting with the front edge, in order to remove the lock
lever escutcheon.
4. Pull out on the top edge of the escutcheon and pivot down in order to clear the tab at the trim
panel and remove the upper corner trim if equipped. 5. Remove the caps that cover the screws
retaining the assist handle. 6. Remove the screws that retain the handle to the door. 7. Remove the
one screw at the front edge of the accessory switch mount plate. 8. Remove the plate from the trim
panel. 9. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the switches on the plate, as needed.
10. Remove the door courtesy lamp from the door panel, if equipped. 11. Use J 38778 to release
the door trim panel retainers. 12. Remove the trim panel from the door.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: Replace any trim panel retainers that were damaged during removal.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel >
System Information > Service and Repair > Panel Replacement > Page 8721
1. Position the trim panel to the door. 2. Secure the trim panel retainers to the door by pressing into
the door until fully seated. 3. Place the window seal portion of the panel over the door frame in
order to install the trim panel to the door. 4. Install the door courtesy lamp to the door panel. 5.
Connect the electrical connectors to the switches on the accessory switch mounting plate, as
needed. 6. Install the plate to the trim panel.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
7. Install the one screw at the front edge of the accessory switch mount plate.
Tighten Tighten the one screw at the front edge of the accessory switch mount plate to 2 N.m (18
lb in).
8. Install the handle to the door with screws.
Tighten Tighten the handle to the door with screws to 5 N.m (44 lb in).
9. Install the caps that cover the screws on the assist handle.
10. Insert the tab in the slot on the door trim panel and seat the fastener into the door at the top in
order to install the upper corner trim.
11. Push the lock lever escutcheon into place starting at the rear edge.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel >
System Information > Service and Repair > Panel Replacement > Page 8722
12. Install the window regulator handle, if equipped.
13. Install the armrest cover and the screws (YC5).
Tighten Tighten the armrest cover screws to 5 N.m (44 lb in).
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article/images refer to the RPO Code List found
at Vehicle/Application ID See: Application and ID/RPO Codes
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel >
System Information > Service and Repair > Panel Replacement > Page 8723
Rear Door Panel: Service and Repair Water Deflector
Water Deflector Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Door (See: Front Door/Front Door
Panel/Service and Repair) .
2. Peel the water deflector from the door and remove from the door.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the water deflector.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel >
System Information > Service and Repair > Panel Replacement > Page 8724
2. Install the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Door (See: Front Door/Front Door
Panel/Service and Repair) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel >
System Information > Service and Repair > Panel Replacement > Page 8725
Rear Door Panel: Service and Repair Access Cover Replacement - Cargo Van Upper
Access Cover Replacement - Cargo Van Upper
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the screws (3) that retain the upper access cover (2) to the door.
2. Remove the upper access cover (2) from the door.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the upper access cover (2) to the door.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the screws (3) that retain the upper access cover to the door.
Tighten the screws that retain the upper access cover to the door to 4 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Striker >
System Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Striker: Service and Repair
Door Striker Replacement - Left Rear
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors) (See:
Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and
Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors))Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door
(E54) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Rear
Door (E54)) .
2. Separate the water deflector at the perforations. Use a sharp-bladed tool if needed. Refer to
Water Deflector Replacement (See: Rear Door
Panel/Service and Repair) .
3. Remove the nuts from the striker (2). 4. Remove the insulator (3). 5. Remove the striker (4).
Installation Procedure
1. Install the striker to the door (4).
The narrow part on the wedge plate of the striker should point toward the rear of the vehicle.
2. Install the insulator (3).
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the nuts to the striker (2).
Tighten the nuts to the striker to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
4. Install the water deflector. Refer to Water Deflector Replacement (See: Rear Door Panel/Service
and Repair) . 5. Install the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors)
(See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and
Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors))Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door
(E54) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Rear
Door (E54)) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Weatherstrip
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Sealing Strip Replacement - Outer Belt
Rear Door Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Sealing Strip Replacement - Outer Belt
Sealing Strip Replacement - Outer Belt
Removal Procedure
1. Roll the window down. 2. Remove the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Door (See:
Front Door/Front Door Panel/Service and Repair) .
3. Remove the outer sealing strip from the door frame.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the outer sealing strip to the door frame. 2. Install the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel
Replacement - Door (See: Front Door/Front Door Panel/Service and Repair) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Weatherstrip
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Sealing Strip Replacement - Outer Belt > Page 8733
Rear Door Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Weatherstrip Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors)
Weatherstrip Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors)
Tools Required
J 38778 Door Trim Pad and Garnish Clip Remover
Removal Procedure
1. Use the J 38778 in order to remove the retainers (2). 2. Use the 3M Release Agent or an
equivalent in order to break the weatherstrip adhesive bond. 3. Use the J 38778 in order to remove
the plastic weather retainers (3).
4. Remove the weatherstrip (1) from the left door.
5. Remove the weatherstrip from the right door.
Installation Procedure
1. Use 3M Weatherstrip adhesive or an equivalent in order to install the weatherstrip to the right
door.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Weatherstrip
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Sealing Strip Replacement - Outer Belt > Page 8734
2. Use 3M Weatherstrip adhesive or an equivalent in order to install the weatherstrip (3) to the left
door. 3. Install the plastic retainers (2) into place. Push the retainers into place until the retainers
are fully seated.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Weatherstrip
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Sealing Strip Replacement - Outer Belt > Page 8735
Rear Door Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Weatherstrip Replacement - Rear Door (E54)
Weatherstrip Replacement - Rear Door (E54)
Tools Required
J 38778 Door Trim Pad and Garnish Clip Remover
Removal Procedure
1. Use the J 38778 in order to remove the retainers. 2. Use 3M Release Agent in order to break the
weatherstrip adhesive bond. 3. Use the J 38778 in order to remove the plastic retainers.
4. Remove the left door weatherstrip.
5. Remove the right door weatherstrip.
Installation Procedure
1. Use 3M Weatherstrip adhesive or an equivalent in order to install the right door weatherstrip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Weatherstrip
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Sealing Strip Replacement - Outer Belt > Page 8736
2. Use 3M Weatherstrip adhesive or an equivalent in order to install the left door weatherstrip. 3.
Install the plastic retainers into place. Push the retainers into place until the retainers are fully
seated.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Sliding Door > Center Sliding Door
Roller > Component Information > Service and Repair
Center Sliding Door Roller: Service and Repair
Roller Bracket Replacement - Center
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the center roller track cover. Refer to Center Track Cover Replacement - Sliding Door ()
.
2. Position the sliding door inward for door clearance.
Remove the bolts (5) that retain the center roller bracket (2) to the door.
3. Disconnect the retaining spring located around the pin in order to release. 4. Support the sliding
door at the bottom rear corner. 5. Slide the bracket rearward. 6. Remove the bracket (2) from the
center roller track.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the bracket (2) to the center roller track. 2. Slide the bracket forward. 3. Remove the
support from the sliding door. 4. Push the retaining pin back in place. 5. Check the retaining spring
located around the pin for damage. If damaged, replace the spring.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
6. Install the bolts (5) that retain the center roller bracket to the door.
Tighten the center roller bracket retaining bolts to 35 N.m (26 lb ft).
7. Install the center roller track cover. Refer to Center Track Cover Replacement - Sliding Door () .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Sliding Door > Lower Sliding Door
Roller > Component Information > Service and Repair
Lower Sliding Door Roller: Service and Repair
Roller Bracket Replacement - Lower
Removal Procedure
1. Use a grease pencil in order to mark the position of the bracket on the door. 2. Disconnect the
lower corner of the door trim panel to expose the bracket (2) to door bolts. 3. Support the bottom of
the door. 4. Remove the bracket (2) to door bolts.
5. Slide the bracket (2) out of the rear of the track in order to remove the bracket from the body.
Installation Procedure
1. Slide the bracket rollers (2) into the rear of the track in order to install the bracket to the body.
2. Align the bracket with the marks made during removal in order to install the bracket to the door.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the bolts that retain the bracket to the door.
Tighten the bracket retaining bolts to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
4. Remove the support from the bottom of the door. 5. Install the lower corner of the door trim panel
by pressing into place until fully seated.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Sliding Door > Sliding Door Handle >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Sliding Door Handle: Service and Repair
Door Handle Replacement - Outside Sliding
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Door (See: Front Door/Front Door
Panel/Service and Repair) . 2. Remove the water deflector. Refer to Water Deflector Replacement
- Sliding Door (See: Sliding Door Interior Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Water Deflector Replacement - Sliding Door) .
3. Remove the lock control. Refer to Lock Replacement - Sliding Door (See: Locks/Door
Locks/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Lock Replacement - Sliding Door) .
4. Remove the lock rods from the handle (1). 5. Remove the outside handle nuts (2).
6. Remove the outside handle and gasket from the door.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the outside handle and gasket to the door.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the outside handle nuts (2).
Tighten the outside handle nuts to 6 N.m (50 lb in).
3. Install the lock rods to the handle (1). 4. Install the lock control. Refer to Lock Replacement Sliding Door (See: Locks/Door Locks/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Lock
Replacement - Sliding Door) .
5. Install the water deflector. Refer to Water Deflector Replacement - Sliding Door (See: Sliding
Door Interior Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Water
Deflector Replacement - Sliding Door) .
6. Install the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Door (See: Front Door/Front Door
Panel/Service and Repair) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Sliding Door > Sliding Door Interior
Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sliding Door
Sliding Door Interior Trim Panel: Service and Repair Sliding Door
TRIM PANEL REPLACEMENT - SLIDING DOOR
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38778 Door Trim Pad and Garnish Clip Remover
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the screws that retain the inside handle bezel (1) to the door. 2. Pull in order to
disengage the clips (2). 3. Remove the inside handle bezel (1). 4. Remove the garnish molding. 5.
Use J 38778 in order to release the trim panel retainers. 6. Remove the sliding door trim panel.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the trim panel to the door:
1.1. Align the retainers to the holes in the door.
1.2. Press the panel in order to engage the retainers into the door.
2. Press in order to engage the clips and install the inside handle bezel.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Sliding Door > Sliding Door Interior
Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sliding Door > Page 8751
3. Install the screws (3) that retain the inside handle bezel (1).
Tighten Tighten the screws that retain the inside handle bezel to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
4. Install the garnish molding.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Sliding Door > Sliding Door Interior
Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sliding Door > Page 8752
Sliding Door Interior Trim Panel: Service and Repair Sliding Door Trim Panel Replacement
Trim Panel Replacement - Sliding Door
Tools Required
J 38778 Door Trim Pad and Garnish Clip Remover
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the screws that retain the inside handle bezel (1) to the door. 2. Pull in order to
disengage the clips (2) and remove the inside handle bezel (1). 3. Remove the garnish molding.
Refer to Garnish Molding Replacement - Sliding Door (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim
Panel/Service and
Repair/Garnish Molding Replacement - Sliding Door) in Interior Trim.
4. Use J 38778 in order to release the trim panel retainers. 5. Remove the sliding door trim panel.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the trim panel to the door:
1. Align the retainers to the holes in the door. 2. Press the panel in order to engage the retainers
into the door.
2. Press in order to engage the clips (2) and install the inside handle bezel (1).
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the screws (3) that retain the inside handle bezel (1).
Tighten the screws that retain the inside handle bezel to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
4. Install the garnish molding. Refer to Garnish Molding Replacement - Sliding Door (See: Interior
Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Sliding Door > Sliding Door Interior
Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sliding Door > Page 8753
Repair/Garnish Molding Replacement - Sliding Door) in Interior Trim.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Sliding Door > Sliding Door Interior
Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sliding Door > Page 8754
Sliding Door Interior Trim Panel: Service and Repair Water Deflector Replacement - Sliding Door
Water Deflector Replacement - Sliding Door
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the garnish molding. Refer to Garnish Molding Replacement - Sliding Door (See:
Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Garnish Molding Replacement - Sliding Door) in Interior Trim.
2. Remove the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Sliding Door (See: ) .
Important: Water deflectors seal the inner panel. Water deflectors prevent water from entering into
the body. A strip of adhesive between the deflector and the door secures the deflector.
3. Peel the water deflector (1) away from the door.
Installation Procedure
Important: When replacing deflectors which have been peeled back or removed, the adhesive on
the door and the deflector from the factory will usually be adequate in order to re-adhere the
deflector to the door. If additional adhesive is required, use a small amount of weatherstrip
adhesive, such as GM P/N 12345096, Canadian P/N 993365, or an equivalent adhesive. If the
deflector was separated at a perforation, use a cloth reinforced tape with a strong adhesive in order
to secure the piece together. Replace the deflector if the deflector is too badly damaged to provide
a proper seal.
1. Install the water deflector (1).
Important: Ensure that the water deflector is properly attached to the door in order to help prevent
the intrusion of exhaust gases.
2. Install the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Sliding Door (See: ) . 3. Install the
garnish molding. Refer to Garnish Molding Replacement - Sliding Door (See: Interior Moulding /
Trim/Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Garnish Molding Replacement - Sliding Door) in Interior Trim.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Sliding Door > Upper Sliding Door
Roller > Component Information > Service and Repair
Upper Sliding Door Roller: Service and Repair
Roller Bracket Replacement - Upper
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the upper roller bracket garnish molding. 2. Remove the rubber stopper from the upper
roller track. 3. Remove the front cap. 4. Remove the bracket (1) to door bolts (4).
5. Remove the upper roller bracket from the track.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the upper roller bracket (1) to the track.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the bracket to door and bolts (4).
Tighten the bracket bolts to the door to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
3. Install the front cap. 4. Install the rubber stopper to the upper roller track. 5. Install the upper
roller bracket garnish molding.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Sliding Door > Sliding Door Striker >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Sliding Door Striker: Service and Repair
Striker Bolt Replacement - Sliding Door Front
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the shoulder belt guide bolt from the door pillar. Refer to Seat Belt Retractor
Replacement - Right Rear . 2. Pull the trim panel forward and reach behind the trim panel to the
striker bolt nut in order to remove the screw at the bottom of the door pillar trim.
3. Remove the striker bolt (4). 4. Remove the striker nut (1).
Installation Procedure
1. Install the striker nut to the inside of the door pillar.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the striker bolt (4).
Tighten the striker bolt to 67 N.m (49 lb ft).
3. Install the trim panel to the door pillar and the screw. 4. Install the shoulder belt guide bolt to the
door pillar. Refer to Seat Belt Retractor Replacement - Right Rear .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Fuel Door > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Fuel Filler Door Replacement
Fuel Door: Service and Repair Fuel Filler Door Replacement
Fuel Filler Door Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the screws that retain the fuel filler door.
2. Remove the fuel filler door.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the fuel filler door.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the screws that retain the fuel filler door.
Tighten the screws that retain the fuel filler door to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Fuel Door > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Fuel Filler Door Replacement > Page 8765
Fuel Door: Service and Repair Fuel Filler Pocket Replacement
Fuel Filler Pocket Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the fuel filler door. Refer to Fuel Filler Door Replacement (See: Fuel Filler Door
Replacement) . 2. Remove the fuel filler cap. 3. Remove the screws that retain the pocket to the
fuel filler pipe. 4. Remove the screws that retain the fuel filler pocket to the body.
5. Remove the fuel filler pocket.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the fuel filler pocket. 2. Install the screws that retain the fuel filler pocket to the body.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the screws that retain the pocket to the fuel filler pipe.
Tighten the screws that retain the pocket to the fuel filler pipe to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
4. Install the fuel filler cap. 5. Install the fuel filler door. Refer to Fuel Filler Door Replacement (See:
Fuel Filler Door Replacement) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Hinge > Component Information
> Service and Repair
Hood Hinge: Service and Repair
Hood Hinge Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the air inlet panel grille. Refer to Air Inlet Grille Panel Replacement (See: Cowl/Cowl
Moulding / Trim/Service and Repair) .
Caution: When a hood hold open device is being removed or installed, provide alternate support to
avoid the possibility of damage to the vehicle or personal injury.
2. Raise and support the hood.
3. Remove the hinge to fender nut. 4. Remove the hinge to fender bolt. 5. Using a grease pencil,
mark the position of the hinge to hood. 6. Remove the hinge to hood bolts.
7. Remove the hinge from the hood.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the hinge to the hood with the aid of an assistant. 2. Align the new hinge according to the
marks made before the old hinge was removed.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Hinge > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Page 8770
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the hood to hinge bolts.
Tighten the bolts to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
4. Install the hinge to fender nut. 5. Install the hinge to fender bolt.
Tighten the bolt to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
6. Lower the hood. 7. Install the air inlet grille panel. Refer to Air Inlet Grille Panel Replacement
(See: Cowl/Cowl Moulding / Trim/Service and Repair) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Insulator / Pad > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Hood Insulator / Pad: Service and Repair
Hood Insulator Replacement
Tools Required
J 38778 Door Trim Pad and Garnish Clip Remover
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the hood. 2. Remove the hood insulator push-in retainers by using J 38778 .
3. Remove the insulator from the hood.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the hood insulator to the hood. 2. Install the hood insulator retainers into the hood by
pushing in the retainers.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Hood Latch Replacement - Primary
Hood Latch: Service and Repair Hood Latch Replacement - Primary
Hood Latch Replacement - Primary
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the hood release cable from the latch with the following procedure:
1. Place a screwdriver into the cable clip. 2. Pry the cable clip open in order to remove the cable. 3.
Pry the cable housing from the latch.
2. Remove the primary latch support bolts to the radiator. 3. Remove the primary latch with the
bracket from the vehicle.
4. Remove the bracket from the latch.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the bracket to the latch.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the primary latch to the bracket bolts.
Tighten the bolts to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
3. Install the primary latch and bracket to the vehicle.
Important: In the next step, do not tighten the bolts.
4. Install the primary latch support bolts to the radiator. 5. Adjust the latch right and left until the
latch lines up with the striker pins in the hood. 6. Raise the hood and tighten the latch to the
radiator support bolts.
Tighten the bolts to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Hood Latch Replacement - Primary > Page 8778
7. Use a suitable tool in order to crimp the cable clip and retain the hood release cable to the latch.
8. Verify that the hood is operating correctly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Hood Latch Replacement - Primary > Page 8779
Hood Latch: Service and Repair Hood Latch Replacement - Secondary
Hood Latch Replacement - Secondary
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the hood latch bolt.
2. Remove the secondary hood latch from the hood.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the secondary hood latch to the hood. Position the tab into the slot.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the hood latch bolt
Tighten the hood latch bolt to 27 N.m (20 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Hood Latch Replacement - Primary > Page 8780
Hood Latch: Service and Repair Hood Pop-Up Spring Replacement
Hood Pop-Up Spring Replacement
Removal Procedure
Using a suitable flat-bladed tool, push on the hood mounted end of the spring outward to remove
the spring from the hood.
Installation Procedure
Insert the spring into the hood retainers in order to install the spring to the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch Release > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Hood Latch Release: Service and Repair
HOOD RELEASE LEVER REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the left cowl side trim panel 2. Remove the screws that retain the hood release lever to
the cowl side trim panel.
3. Remove the hood release cable from the hood latch.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch Release > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 8784
1. Install the hood release cable to the hood latch.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the screws that retain the hood release lever to the cowl side trim panel.
Tighten Tighten the hood release lever screws to 8 N.m (71 lb in).
3. Install the left cowl side trim panel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch Release Cable >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Hood Latch Release Cable Replacement
Hood Latch Release Cable: Service and Repair Hood Latch Release Cable Replacement
Hood Latch Release Cable Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Disconnect the cable from the primary latch with the following procedure:
1. Use a suitable tool to pry the cable clip open to allow removal of the cable. 2. Pry the cable
housing from the latch.
2. Remove the cable from the fasteners on the radiator support.
3. Remove the cable grommet from the cowl by gently pulling on the grommet. 4. Disconnect the
cable from the cowl. 5. Remove the left cowl side trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement Cowl Side (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Cowl Side) .
6. Pull the cable through the cowl in order to remove the screws that retain the cable assembly to
the cowl side panel.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch Release Cable >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Hood Latch Release Cable Replacement > Page 8789
1. Route the cable through the front of the cowl.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the screws that retain the cable to cowl side panel.
Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Install the left cowl side trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Cowl Side (See: Interior
Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Cowl Side) .
4. Pull the cable assembly from the front of the cowl until the grommet is seated. 5. Connect the
cable to the fasteners in the radiator support.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch Release Cable >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Hood Latch Release Cable Replacement > Page 8790
6. Use a suitable tool in order to clamp the cable clip and connect the cable to the primary latch. 7.
Verify that the hood is operating correctly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch Release Cable >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Hood Latch Release Cable Replacement > Page 8791
Hood Latch Release Cable: Service and Repair Hood Release Lever Replacement
Hood Release Lever Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the left cowl side trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Cowl Side (See:
Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Cowl Side) .
2.
Remove the screws that retain the hood release lever to the cowl side trim panel.
3. Remove the hood release cable from the hood latch. Refer to Hood Latch Release Cable
Replacement (See: Hood Latch Release Cable
Replacement) in Body Front End.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the hood release cable to the hood latch. Refer to Hood Latch Release Cable
Replacement (See: Hood Latch Release Cable Replacement)
in Body Front End.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch Release Cable >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Hood Latch Release Cable Replacement > Page 8792
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the screws that retain the hood release lever to the cowl side trim panel.
Tighten the hood release lever screws to 8 N.m (71 lb in).
3. Install the left cowl side trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Cowl Side (See: Interior
Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Cowl Side) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Shock / Support > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Hood Shock / Support: Service and Repair
Hood Hold-Open Rod Replacement
Removal Procedure
Caution: When a hood hold open device is being removed or installed, provide alternate support to
avoid the possibility of damage to the vehicle or personal injury.
1. Raise and suitably support the hood without using the support rod. 2. Remove the support
rod-to-radiator support bolt.
3. Remove the support rod from the vehicle. 4. Use a suitable tool to carefully pry the support rod
retainer from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Push the support rod retainer into place.
2. Insert the retainer tab into the slot in order to install the support rod to the vehicle.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the support rod-to-radiator support bolt.
Tighten the support rod to radiator support bolts to 15 N.m (11 lb ft).
4. Lower the hood.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Stop > Component Information
> Service and Repair
Hood Stop: Service and Repair
Hood Bumper Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Measure the height of the hood adjust front bumper before removing in order to aid in
adjustment. 2. Rotate the hood adjust front bumper counterclockwise.
Installation Procedure
1. Rotate the hood adjust front bumpers clockwise until the hood adjust front bumper is at the same
height as measured before removal. 2. Check the alignment of the hood panel assembly.
Ensure the top of the hood is flush with the fenders and parallel to the grille.
3. Rotate the bumper clockwise or counterclockwise in order to align the hood.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Hood Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
Seal Replacement - Hood Rear
Tools Required
J 38778 Door Trim Pad and Garnish Clip Remover
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the rear hood seal retainers by using J 38778 . 2. Remove the rear hood seal from the
hood.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the rear hood seal to the hood.
2. Push the retainers into the hood in order to retain the rear hood seal.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Liftgate Window Glass >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Liftgate Window Glass: Service and Repair
Window Replacement - Lift Gate
Tools Required
* J 24402-A Glass Sealant (Cold Knife) Remover
* J 39032 Stationary Glass Removal Tool
* Urethane Adhesive Kit GM P/N 12346392 or Equivalent
* Isopropyl Alcohol or Equivalent
* Cartridge-type Caulking Gun
* Commercial-type Utility Knife
* Razor Blade Scraper
* Suction Cups
* Plastic Paddle
Removal Procedure
Caution: If a window is cracked but still intact, crisscross the window with masking tape in order to
reduce the risk of damage or personal injury.
Important: Before cutting out a stationary window, apply a double layer of masking tape around the
perimeter of the painted surfaces and the interior trim.
1. Disconnect the washer hose from the liftgate. 2. Remove the back window wiper arm from the
liftgate. Refer to Wiper Arm Replacement - Rear in Wipers/Washer Systems. 3. Open liftgate
window. 4. Remove the liftgate window garnish molding. Refer to Garnish Molding Replacement Lift Gate (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim
Panel/Service and Repair) in Body Rear End.
5. Disconnect the electrical connector from the rear window defogger on the liftgate window.
Caution: If broken glass falls into the defroster outlets, it can be blown into the passenger
compartment and cause personal injury.
6. Cover to protect the following parts from broken glass:
1. Upper dash pad 2. Defroster outlets and A/C outlets 3. Seats and carpeting
7. Using a sharp utility knife, make a preliminary cut around the perimeter of the quarter window.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Liftgate Window Glass >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8806
Important: Keep the cutting edge of the tool against the window.
8. This will allow the urethane adhesive to be separated from the window.
* Leave a base of urethane on the pinchweld flange.
* The only suitable lubrication is clear water.
* Use J 24402-A , J 39032 or equivalent in order to remove the window.
9. With the aid of an assistant, remove the liftgate window from the liftgate frame.
Installation Procedure
1. Install a stationary window into the opening. Refer to Urethane Adhesive Installation of
Stationary Windows (See: Windows and
Glass/Windows/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Urethane Adhesive Installation of
Stationary Windows) .
2. Connect the electrical connector to the rear window defogger on the liftgate window. 3. Install the
liftgate window garnish molding. Refer to Garnish Molding Replacement - Lift Gate (See: Interior
Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service
and Repair) in Body Rear End.
4. Close liftgate window. 5. Install the back window wiper arm to the liftgate. Refer toWiper Arm
Replacement - Rear in Wipers/Washer Systems. 6. Connect the washer hose to the liftgate. 7.
Remove the double layer of masking tape around the perimeter of the painted surfaces and the
interior trim.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Actuator > Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock Actuator: Service and Repair
Lock Actuator Replacement - Lift Gate
Tools Required
M 39010 Heavy Duty Rivet Gun
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the liftgate garnish molding. Refer to Garnish Molding Replacement - Lift Gate (See:
Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and
Repair) .
2. Remove the brace from the liftgate. 3. Remove the wiper motor from the liftgate. 4. Remove the
actuator electrical connector. 5. Remove the right and the left control rods from the actuator lever.
6. Use a 5 mm (3/16 in) drill bit in order to drill out the head of the rivet. 7. Remove the actuator
from the liftgate rivets. 8. Remove the actuator from the liftgate.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the actuator to the liftgate. 2. Use M 39010 in order to install the actuator to the liftgate
rivets.
Important: Install new retainers whenever the control rods are removed.
3. Install the right and the left control rods to the actuator lever. 4. Install the wiper motor to the
liftgate. 5. Install the actuator electrical connector. 6. Install the brace to the liftgate. 7. Install the
liftgate garnish molding. Refer to Garnish Molding Replacement - Lift Gate (See: Interior Moulding /
Trim/Trim Panel/Service and
Repair) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Latch Replacement - Lift Gate
Trunk / Liftgate Latch: Service and Repair Latch Replacement - Lift Gate
Latch Replacement - Lift Gate
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the liftgate garnish molding (1). Refer to Garnish Molding Replacement - Lift Gate (See:
Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service
and Repair) .
2. Remove the control rods from the actuator lever (2). 3. Remove the liftgate latch screws (6).
4. Remove the slide latch (4) from the liftgate. 5. Remove the control rod from the liftgate. 6.
Remove the control rod from the liftgate latch.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Latch Replacement - Lift Gate > Page 8814
1. Install the latch (4) with the control rod to the liftgate (3).
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
Important: Install the new retainers whenever the control rods are removed.
2. Install the liftgate latch screws (6).
Tighten the liftgate latch screws to 10 N.m (88 lb in).
3. Use the following procedure in order to install the control rods to the actuator lever (2):
1. Push the actuator lever and the control rod together (2). 2. Push the control rod through the hole.
4. Install the liftgate garnish molding (1). Refer to Garnish Molding Replacement - Lift Gate (See:
Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and
Repair) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Latch Replacement - Lift Gate > Page 8815
Trunk / Liftgate Latch: Service and Repair Latch Replacement - Lower
Latch Replacement - Lower
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors) (See:
Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and
Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors))Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door
(E54) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Rear
Door (E54)) .
2. Separate the weatherstrip deflector at the perforation. Use a sharp-bladed tool if needed. Refer
to Water Deflector Replacement (See: Doors/Rear
Door/Rear Door Panel/Service and Repair) .
3. Remove the control rod from the lock assembly.
4. Remove the bolts and the reinforcement.
5. Remove the following components from the door:
* The latch
* The rod
* The retainer
6. Remove the rod and the retainer from the latch.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Latch Replacement - Lift Gate > Page 8816
Installation Procedure
1. Install the control rod and the retainer to the latch. 2. Install the retainer as shown in order to
prevent squeaks and rattles.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the following components to the door. Ensure that the arrow on the retainer points toward
the front of the vehicle:
* The latch
* The retainer
* The bolts
Tighten the bolts to the door to 8 N.m (71 lb in).
Important: Install new nylon retainers whenever you remove the control rods.
4. Install the control rod to the lock assembly. 5. Install the water deflector. Refer to Water Deflector
Replacement (See: Doors/Rear Door/Rear Door Panel/Service and Repair) . 6. Install the trim
panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors) (See: Interior Moulding /
Trim/Console/Service and
Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors))Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door
(E54) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Rear
Door (E54)) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Latch Replacement - Lift Gate > Page 8817
Trunk / Liftgate Latch: Service and Repair Latch Replacement - Upper and Lower
Latch Replacement - Upper and Lower
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors) (See:
Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and
Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors))Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door
(E54) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Rear
Door (E54)) .
2. Peel the water deflector away from the door. Use a soft-surfaced scraper if needed. Refer to
Water Deflector Replacement (See: Doors/Rear
Door/Rear Door Panel/Service and Repair) .
3. Remove the control rods from the remote lock.
1. Pry the anchor out of the hole. 2. Push the clip away from the lever. 3. Pull the rod and the clip
away from the lever.
4. Remove the upper latch screws.
5. Remove the upper latch, if equipped.
6. Remove the upper latch and the rod from the door.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Latch Replacement - Lift Gate > Page 8818
7. Remove the lower latch screws. 8. Remove the reinforcement.
9. Remove the lower latch and the rod from the door.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the clips to the remote lock.
2. Install the lower latch and the rod to the door. 3. Install the reinforcement.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Latch Replacement - Lift Gate > Page 8819
4. Install the lower latch screws.
Tighten the lower latch screws to 8 N.m (71 lb in).
5. Install the upper latch and the rod to the door.
6. Install the cover, if equipped.
7. Install the upper latch screws.
Tighten the upper latch screws to 10 N.m (88 lb in).
8. Install the control rods through the clips to the remote lock. 9. Install the water deflector. Refer to
Water Deflector Replacement (See: Doors/Rear Door/Rear Door Panel/Service and Repair) .
10. Install the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors) (See:
Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and
Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors))Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door
(E54) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Rear
Door (E54)) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Cylinder > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Trunk / Liftgate Lock Cylinder: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Trunk/Liftgate,
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Cylinder > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 8823
Trunk / Liftgate Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair
Lock Cylinder Replacement - Lift Gate
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the liftgate garnish molding. Refer to Garnish Molding Replacement - Lift Gate (See:
Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and
Repair) .
2. Disconnect the electrical connector. 3. Remove the rear wiper motor from the liftgate.
4. Remove the lock cylinder retainer. 5. Remove the lock cylinder from the liftgate.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the lock cylinder to the liftgate. 2. Install the lock cylinder retainer. 3. Install the rear wiper
motor to the liftgate. 4. Connect the electrical connector. 5. Install the liftgate garnish molding.
Refer to Garnish Molding Replacement - Lift Gate (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service
and
Repair) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Shock /
Support > Component Information > Service and Repair > Strut Ball Stud Replacement - Lift Gate
Trunk / Liftgate Shock / Support: Service and Repair Strut Ball Stud Replacement - Lift Gate
Strut Ball Stud Replacement - Lift Gate
Removal Procedure
1. Open and support the liftgate. 2. Remove the strut. Refer to Strut Replacement - Lift Gate (See:
Strut Replacement - Liftgate) .
3. Remove the strut ball from the lid or body by turning counterclockwise.
Installation Procedure
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
1. Install the strut ball to lid or body by turning clockwise into the weldnut.
Tighten the strut ball to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
2. Install the strut. Refer to Strut Replacement - Lift Gate (See: Strut Replacement - Liftgate) . 3.
Install the support. Close liftgate.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Shock /
Support > Component Information > Service and Repair > Strut Ball Stud Replacement - Lift Gate > Page 8828
Trunk / Liftgate Shock / Support: Service and Repair Strut Replacement - Liftgate
Strut Replacement - Lift Gate
Removal Procedure
Caution: When a lift window hold open device is being removed or installed, provide alternate
support to avoid the possibility of damage to the vehicle or personal injury.
Notice: Apply pressure only at the end of the hood assist rod that you are removing or attaching.
Do NOT apply pressure to the middle of the rod because damage or bending will result.
1. Open and support the liftgate.
2. Remove the strut retaining clips from each end of the strut. Use a small flat bladed tool to lift up
on the retaining clip in order to release the strut
from the strut ball.
3. If equipped with a rear window defogger, remove the following components:
1. The body side rear garnish molding from the headliner
Refer toTrim Replacement - Fourth Pillar Left (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Trim Replacement - Fourth Pillar Left) in Interior Trim.
2. The body side rear garnish molding and speaker as one
Refer toTrim Replacement - Third Pillar Left (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Trim Replacement - Third Pillar Left) in Interior Trim.
3. The rear window defogger electrical connector from the harness 4. The grommet and electrical
connector from the body, by pulling the components out
4. Remove the strut.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the strut with the following steps:
1. Install the strut to each end of the strut balls. 2. Pull back on the ends of strut to ensure a firm
lock.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Shock /
Support > Component Information > Service and Repair > Strut Ball Stud Replacement - Lift Gate > Page 8829
2. If equipped with a rear defogger, install the following components:
1. The rear window defogger electrical connector to the harness 2. The grommet, fully to the body,
in order to ensure that water can not enter 3. The body-side rear garnish molding and speaker as
one unit
Refer to Trim Replacement - Third Pillar Left (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Trim Replacement - Third Pillar Left) in Interior Trim.
4. The body-side rear garnish molding to the headliner
Refer to Trim Replacement - Fourth Pillar Left (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service
and Repair/Trim Replacement - Fourth Pillar Left) in Interior Trim.
3. Inspect the rear defogger operations. 4. Remove the prop and close the liftgate. 5. Inspect the
rear defogger in order to verify that the component is operating correctly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Striker >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Trunk / Liftgate Striker: Service and Repair
Lock Striker Replacement - Lift Gate
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the screws (1). 2. Remove the striker assembly (2).
Installation Procedure
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
Install the liftgate striker (2) with the screws (1).
Tighten the liftgate striker screws to 10 N.m (88 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Weatherstrip
> Component Information > Service and Repair
Trunk / Liftgate Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
Weatherstrip Replacement - Lift Gate
Removal Procedure
1. Remove all of the interior trim in order to access the weatherstrip. 2. Pull the weatherstrip from
the pinch-weld flange. Start at the upper right corner.
Installation Procedure
Important: The weatherstrip attaches to the pinch-weld flange in 6 areas. The weatherstrip length
distributes equally around the door opening.
1. Install the weatherstrip at the top right corner. Seat the weatherstrip onto the pinch-weld flange.
2. Position and install the weatherstrip by hand. 3. Using a rubber mallet during the final installation
may be required in the thick flange areas and in each corner.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Body Emblem > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > 06-08-111-004B - BULLETIN CANCELLATION NOTIFICATION
Body Emblem: Technical Service Bulletins 06-08-111-004B - BULLETIN CANCELLATION
NOTIFICATION
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 06-08-111-004B
Date: September 25, 2009
Subject: Information on Discoloration, Blistering, Peeling or Erosion of Various Exterior Emblems
Including Chevy Bowtie (Bulletin Cancelled)
Models:
2009 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2009 HUMMER H2
2006-2009 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being cancelled. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
06-08-111-004A (Section 08 - Body & Accessories).
This bulletin is being cancelled. The information is no longer applicable.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Body Emblem > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Molding/Nameplate Replacement - Exterior Trim
Body Emblem: Service and Repair Molding/Nameplate Replacement - Exterior Trim
Molding/Nameplate Replacement - Exterior Trim
Tools Required
J 41409 Body Molding Removal Tool
Removal Procedure
Remove the emblem or the molding:
1. Apply masking tape to the body side border of the emblem or the molding in order to protect the
body from scratches. The tape will also aid in
aligning the moldings during installation.
2. Use J 41409 or a 0.8 mm (0.03 in) fishing line in order to cut through the adhesive material.
Installation Procedure
Important: Apply these items in an environment free of dust or dirt that could come in contact with
the sticky backing and prevent proper adhesion.
1. Clean the area where the molding or the emblem is to be mounted.
Use a suitable solvent, such as a mixture of 50 percent isopropyl alcohol and 50 percent water, or
equivalent.
2. Dry the area thoroughly. 3. Ensure that the body area is at a temperature range of 27-41°C
(80-105°F).
Heat the area, if needed.
4. Ensure that the emblems are at a temperature range of 29-32°C (85-90°F).
Place the emblem, adhesive side down, on a heated surface or use a heat lamp or a heat gun in
order to raise the temperature.
5. Remove the protective liner on the back of the molding or the emblem. 6. Apply the molding or
the emblem to the body surface. 7. Apply an equal amount of pressure along the molding or the
emblem in order to uniformly bond the molding or the emblem to the body surface.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Body Emblem > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Molding/Nameplate Replacement - Exterior Trim > Page 8843
Body Emblem: Service and Repair Door Lower Molding Replacement (Rear Door)
Emblem Replacement - Grille
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the grille from the vehicle. Refer to Grille Replacement (See: Grille/Service and
Repair/Grille Replacement) . 2. Protect the face of the grille while removing the grille emblem. 3.
Remove the nuts from the back side of the grille emblem. 4. Remove the grille emblem from the
grille.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the grille emblem to the grille.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the nuts to the back side of the grille emblem.
Tighten the emblem nuts to the grille to 2.5 N.m (22 lb in).
3. Install the grille to the vehicle. Refer to Grille Replacement (See: Grille/Service and Repair/Grille
Replacement) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information >
Service and Repair
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair
Air Inlet Grille Panel Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Disconnect the windshield washer hoses from the windshield wiper arm. 2. Remove the
windshield wiper arms. Refer to Wiper Arm Replacement in Wipers/Washer Systems. 3. Remove
the antenna. Refer to Fixed Antenna Mast Replacement in Entertainment. 4. Remove the air inlet
grille panel to cowl screws.
5. Remove the air inlet grille panel from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the air inlet grille panel to the vehicle.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the air inlet grille panel to cowl screws.
Tighten the air inlet grille panel to cowl screws 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Install the antenna. Refer to Fixed Antenna Mast Replacement in Entertainment. 4. Install the
windshield wiper arms. Refer to Wiper Arm Replacement in Wipers/Washer Systems.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > License Plate Bracket > Component
Information > Service and Repair
License Plate Bracket: Service and Repair
License Plate Pocket Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors) (See:
Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and
Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors))Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door
(E54) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Rear
Door (E54)) .
2. Use a soft-faced scraper, if needed, in order to peel the water deflector away from the door.
Refer to Water Deflector Replacement (See: Doors,
Hood and Trunk/Doors/Rear Door/Rear Door Panel/Service and Repair) .
3. Remove the lamp harness from the license plate housing (2). 4. Remove the bolts (1) from the
housing. 5. Remove the housing from the door (2).
Installation Procedure
1. Install the housing (2) to the door.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the housing to door bolts (1).
Tighten the door bolts to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
3. Install the lamp harness to the housing. 4. Install the water deflector. Refer to Water Deflector
Replacement (See: Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Rear Door/Rear Door Panel/Service and
Repair) .
5. Install the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors) (See: Interior
Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and
Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors))Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door
(E54) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Rear
Door (E54)) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Upper Side Moulding / Trim > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Cladding Replacement - Adhesive Retained
Upper Side Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair Cladding Replacement - Adhesive Retained
Cladding Replacement - Adhesive Retained
Tools Required
* J 41409 Body Molding Removal Tool
* 3M 07502 3M Scotch Brite Adhesive Stripe and Removal Disc, or equivalent
Attach body cladding to the body with a varying combination of the following items:
* Double-sided adhesive tape (1)
* Plastic retainers (4)
* Screws (2)
In order to ensure a good replacement of new or old adhesive retained cladding, ensure that the
panel surface temperature is approximately 24-41°C (80-105°F), and the panel surface is clean
and free of any wax or oily film. If you will be painting the cladding, do not bake the cladding. Doing
this will distort the part, making it useless.
Ensure that the replacement screws on the rear side door have a head no taller than the original
screws. If screws with a taller head are used, they can cause damage to the body due to physical
interference when the door is opened.
General procedures are listed below in order to remove adhesive retained to the cladding, and in
order to replace the adhesive retained to the cladding. Refer to Cladding Replacement specific
component replacement procedures.
Removal Procedure
1. Apply masking tape to the body side border of the cladding in order to protect the body from
scratches. The tape will also aid in aligning the
cladding during installation.
2. Remove all of the mechanical fasteners. Refer to the Cladding Replacement procedure below
that is specific to the cladding location.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Upper Side Moulding / Trim > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Cladding Replacement - Adhesive Retained > Page 8854
3. Use the J 41409 or a 0.8 mm (0.03 in) fishing line in order to cut through the adhesive material.
Installation Procedure
1. Use a general purpose adhesive remover or an adhesive removal disc (3M 07502 or equivalent)
attached to a drill in order to remove all traces of
adhesive from the body panel. A 2-3 inch square rubber or felt block may also be used in order to
aid in the removal of old adhesive.
2. Clean the affected panel area with wax and grease remover, and wipe with isopropyl alcohol. 3.
Mark the proper position of the cladding with masking tape. Use the adjacent cladding as a guide.
4. Warm the body panel with a heat gun or a heat lamp to 24-41°C (80-105°F). 5. Make a trial
fitting of the piece to the vehicle, checking the alignment and all the gaps and the clearances. Do
this before you remove the plastic
backing.
Important: Do not distort the part while you are installing the part. The part may take a temporary
set to the distorted shape and appear to have the proper adhesion, but the part will spring back to
its original shape and cause a loss of adhesion.
6. Once you are satisfied with the trial fit, peel the backing from all of the tape.
Set the top row of tape first, and work down the panel to the other rows of tape.
Important: Once the cladding is set into place, do not attempt to remove the panel. This will destroy
the adhesive strips and could lead to part distortion and damage.
7. Hand roll the cladding to the body in order to ensure proper adhesion. A shop towel rolled into a
ball and held in the palm of your fist will aid in
applying a consistent, evenly distributed pressure to the panel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Upper Side Moulding / Trim > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Cladding Replacement - Adhesive Retained > Page 8855
Upper Side Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair Cladding Replacement - Left Quarter Panel
Cladding Replacement - Left Quarter Panel
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the wheel opening screws. If the vehicle is equipped with assist steps, the cladding will
be shorter across the bottom.
2. Remove the cladding from the rear quarter panel. Refer toCladding Replacement - Adhesive
Retained (See: Cladding Replacement - Adhesive
Retained) .
Installation Procedure
1. Install the cladding to the rear quarter panel. Refer to Cladding Replacement - Adhesive
Retained (See: Cladding Replacement - Adhesive
Retained) .
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the wheel opening screws.
Tighten the wheel opening screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Upper Side Moulding / Trim > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Cladding Replacement - Adhesive Retained > Page 8856
Upper Side Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair Cladding Replacement - Right Quarter Panel
Cladding Replacement - Right Quarter Panel
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the rear corner extension molding retainers. 2. Remove the rear corner extension
molding. 3. Remove the cladding screws. 4. Remove the cladding retainers. 5. Remove the
cladding from the body. Refer to Cladding Replacement - Adhesive Retained (See: Cladding
Replacement - Adhesive Retained) .
Installation Procedure
1. Install the cladding to the body. Refer to Cladding Replacement - Adhesive Retained (See:
Cladding Replacement - Adhesive Retained) .
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the cladding screws.
Tighten the cladding screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Install the cladding retainers. 4. Install the rear corner extension molding.
5. Install the rear corner extension molding retainers.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Upper Side Moulding / Trim > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Cladding Replacement - Adhesive Retained > Page 8857
Upper Side Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair Cladding Replacement - Left Rocker Panel
Cladding Replacement - Left Rocker Panel
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the screws from the cladding. 2. Remove the retainers from the wheelhouse. 3.
Remove the nut on the back of the cladding from the stud. 4. Remove the cladding from the
retaining rail.
5. Remove the retaining rail screws. 6. Remove the retaining rail from the body.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the retaining rail to the body.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the retaining rail screws.
Tighten the retaining rail screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Upper Side Moulding / Trim > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Cladding Replacement - Adhesive Retained > Page 8858
3. Install the cladding to the vehicle. 4. Install the nut on the back of the cladding to the stud.
Tighten the nut to 7 N.m (62 lb in).
5. Install the screws into the cladding.
Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
6. Install the retainers into the wheelhouse extension flange.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Upper Side Moulding / Trim > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Cladding Replacement - Adhesive Retained > Page 8859
Upper Side Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair Cladding Replacement - Right Rocker Panel
Cladding Replacement - Right Rocker Panel
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the screws retaining the front half of the cladding to the front wheelhouse. 2. Remove
the push-in retainers from the front wheelhouse. 3. Remove the nut from the stud on the front half
of the cladding. 4. Remove the push-in retainers that retain the front half of the cladding to the
retaining rail. 5. Remove the cladding from the retaining rail.
6. Remove the screws retaining the rear half of the cladding to the rear wheelhouse. 7. Remove the
push-in retainers that retain the rear half of the cladding to the retaining rail.
8. Remove the retaining rail screws. 9. Remove the retaining rail from the body.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Upper Side Moulding / Trim > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Cladding Replacement - Adhesive Retained > Page 8860
1. Install the retaining rail to the body.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the retaining rail screws.
Tighten the retaining rail screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Install the rear half of the cladding to the retaining rail. 4. Install the push-in retainers that retain
the cladding to the retaining rail. 5. Install the screws that retain the cladding to the rear
wheelhouse.
Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
6. Install the front half of the cladding to the retaining rail. 7. Install the push-in retainers that retain
the front half of the cladding to the retaining rail. 8. Install the nut on the back of the cladding to the
stud.
Tighten the nut to 7 N.m (62 lb in).
9. Install the retainers into the front wheelhouse extension flange.
10. Install the screws retaining the front half of the cladding to the front wheelhouse.
Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Fender > Front Fender > Front Fender Liner > System Information >
Service and Repair
Front Fender Liner: Service and Repair
Splash Shield Replacement - Wheelhouse
Tools Required
J 38778 Door Trim Pad and Garnish Clip Remover
Removal Procedure
1. Use J 38778 to remove the retainers from the wheelhouse and the splash shield. 2. Remove the
wheelhouse splash shield from the wheelhouse.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the wheelhouse splash shield to the wheelhouse.
2. Push the retainers into the wheelhouse holes in order to retain the splash shield to the
wheelhouse.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Fender > Rear Fender > Rear Fender Liner > System Information >
Service and Repair
Rear Fender Liner: Service and Repair
Wheelhouse Extension Replacement
Tools Required
J 38778 Door Trim Pad and Garnish Clip Remover
Removal Procedure
1. Use J 38778 in order to remove the retainers from the fender and the extension and from the
wheelhouse. 2. Remove the extension from the wheelhouse.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the extension to the wheelhouse.
2. Install the extension push pins to the wheelhouse.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Body / Frame Mount Bushing: Service and Repair
Frame Cushion or Insulator Replacement
Tools Required
J 41602 Body Protection Hoist Adapter Set
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle at the frame. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle (See:
Maintenance/Vehicle Lifting/Service and Repair) in General
Information.
Important: Properly support the frame and the body while changing the mount. If you are changing
only one mount, the entire side on which the mount is placed must be lowered enough to provide
clearance for the mount.
2. Use the J 41602 in order to support the body at the pinchweld flange.
3. Remove the bolts that retain the front bumper fascia at the brace.
4. Remove the bolts that retain the front bumper fascia at the fender.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 8874
5. Remove the bolt, the retainer, and the lower insulator of the mount:
1. Loosen the remaining bolts on that side far enough for the upper insulator to be removed. 2.
Gradually lower the screw jack in order to allow the frame to come away from the body.
6. Remove the upper body insulator.
Installation Procedure
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
1. Install the upper body insulator:
1. Gradually raise the screw jack in order to allow the frame to meet the body. 2. Tighten the bolts
of the mounts not replaced.
Tighten the bolts of the mounts to 35 N.m (26 lb ft).
2. Install the lower insulator, the retainer, and the bolt to the mount. Do not tighten.
Important: Follow the body mount tightening sequence.
3. Snug the right #2 body mount (2). 4. Snug the left #2 body mount (2). 5. Tighten the remaining
body mounts:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 8875
* Tighten the center mount bolt to 155 N.m (114 lb ft).
* Tighten the end mount bolts to 90 N.m (66 lb ft).
6. Reinstall the bumper fascia bolts.
Tighten the bumper fascia bolts to 6 N.m (53 lb in).
7. Remove the screw jack. 8. Lower the vehicle. 9. Remove the J 41602 from the pinchweld flange.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Frame and Underbody
Cross-Member: Service and Repair Frame and Underbody
Crossmember Brace Replacement - Front
Removal Procedure
1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle (See:
Maintenance/Vehicle Lifting/Service and Repair) in General
Information.
2. Remove the bolts that retain the forward edge of the crossmember brace to the frame. 3.
Remove the bolts and the nuts that retain the rear edge of the crossmember brace to the frame. 4.
Remove the crossmember brace from the frame.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the crossmember brace to the frame.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the bolts and the nuts in order to retain the rear edge of the crossmember brace to the
frame.
Tighten the crossmember brace to the frame bolts and the nuts to 35 N.m (26 lb ft).
3. Install the bolts that retain the forward edge of the crossmember brace to the frame.
Tighten the crossmember brace to the frame bolts to 35 N.m (26 lb ft).
4. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Frame and Underbody > Page 8880
Cross-Member: Service and Repair Frame Stop Replacement
Frame Stop Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle (See:
Maintenance/Vehicle Lifting/Service and Repair) in General
Information.
2. Remove the bolts that retain the frame stop to the frame. 3. Remove the frame stop.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the frame stop.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the bolts that retain the frame stop to the frame.
Tighten the bolts that retain the frame stop to 35 N.m (26 lb ft).
3. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Frame and Underbody > Page 8881
Cross-Member: Service and Repair Transmission Support Replacement
Transmission Support Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle (See:
Maintenance/Vehicle Lifting/Service and Repair) in General
Information.
2. Support the transmission with a transmission jack. 3. Remove the two nuts securing the
transmission mount to the transmission support.
4. Remove the transmission support nuts and bolts. 5. Remove the transmission support from the
vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the transmission support to the vehicle.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the transmission support nuts and bolts.
Tighten the nuts and bolts to 70 N.m (52 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Frame and Underbody > Page 8882
3. Install the two nuts securing the transmission mount to the transmission support.
Tighten the nuts to 40 N.m (30 lb ft).
4. Remove the transmission jack. 5. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Hitch > Component Information > Service and Repair
Trailer Hitch: Service and Repair
Trailer Hitch Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Raise and suitably support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle (See:
Maintenance/Vehicle Lifting/Service and Repair) in General
Information.
2. Remove the hitch from the frame nuts. 3. Remove the hitch to frame bolts. 4. Remove the hitch
and bumper from the vehicle. 5. Remove the hitch to bumper nuts. 6. Remove the hitch to bumper
bolts. 7. Remove the hitch from the bumper.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the hitch to the bumper.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the hitch to bumper bolts.
Tighten the hitch to bumper bolts to 35 N.m (26 lb ft).
3. Install the hitch to bumper nuts.
Tighten the hitch to bumper nuts to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
4. Install the hitch and the bumper to the vehicle. 5. Install the hitch to frame nuts.
Tighten the hitch to frame nuts to 60 N.m (44 lb ft).
6. Install the hitch to frame bolts.
Tighten the hitch to frame bolts to 55 N.m (41 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Hitch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Page 8886
7. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Grille > Component Information > Service and Repair > Grille Molding
Replacement - Lower
Grille: Service and Repair Grille Molding Replacement - Lower
Grille Molding Replacement - Lower
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the grille. Refer to Grille Replacement (See: Grille Replacement) .
2. Remove the push-in fasteners that retain the grille molding. 3. Remove the grille molding from
the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the grille molding to the vehicle.
2. Install the push-in fasteners that retain the grille molding. 3. Install the grille. Refer to Grille
Replacement (See: Grille Replacement) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Grille > Component Information > Service and Repair > Grille Molding
Replacement - Lower > Page 8891
Grille: Service and Repair Grille Replacement
Grille Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the park/turn signal lamp. Refer to Park/Turn Signal Lamp Replacement . 2. Remove
the screws from the grille to radiator support. 3. Remove the screw from the signal housing.
4. Remove the grille from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the grille to the vehicle.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the screws to grille to radiator support.
Tighten the screws to the grille to radiator support to 3 N.m (27 lb in).
3. Install the park/turn signal lamp. Refer to Park/Turn Signal Lamp Replacement in Lighting
Systems.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Arm Rest > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Armrest Replacement (YC6)
Arm Rest: Service and Repair Armrest Replacement (YC6)
Armrest Replacement (YC6)
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the armrest by rotating it to the down position.
Slip a pair of snap-ring pliers between the seat and the armrest.
2. Ensure that the snap-ring pliers go between the arms of the snap plate. 3. Keeping the armrest
plate arms open, pull the armrest straight back off the seat post.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the armrest by setting it at approximately 45 degrees. 2. Press the armrest until fully
engaged into the groove of the seat post (1).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Arm Rest > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Armrest Replacement (YC6) > Page 8897
Arm Rest: Service and Repair Armrest Replacement (YC7)
Armrest Replacement (YC7)
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the bucket seat from the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See:
Seats/Service and Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) . 2. Place the seat in the fully upright
position.
3. Release the J-hook at the bottom of the seat back.
4. Reach up and inside the seat back. Remove the armrest retaining clip. 5. Slide the armrest
assembly out of the seat back. 6. Remove the armrest cover for cleaning or replacement:
1. Unzip the armrest cover. 2. Pull the armrest cover off of the seat pad.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the armrest cover to the armrest, if the cover was removed.
2. Reach inside the seat back and insert the armrest retaining clip into the seat back frame.
* Install the retaining clip with the opening facing down.
* Observe the fit of the clip once installed. If the clip is loose when fitted in the groove in the seat
back frame, remove the clip and crimp the clip closed slightly. Repeat this procedure until the clip
fits snugly in the groove, or install a new clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Arm Rest > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Armrest Replacement (YC6) > Page 8898
3. Insert the armrest into the seat back until the armrest retaining clip engages the groove on the
armrest post.
Pull on the armrest in order to verify that the clip is holding.
4. Attach the halves of the J-hook along the bottom edge of the seat back. 5. Install the bucket seat
in the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Seats/Service and Repair/Seat
Replacement - Bucket) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Arm Rest > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Armrest Replacement (YC6) > Page 8899
Arm Rest: Service and Repair Armrest Replacement - Rear Seat (YC7)
Armrest Replacement - Rear Seat (YC7)
Removal Procedure
1. Place the seat back in the fully-upright position.
2. Release the J-hook along the bottom edge of the seat back. 3. Reach up inside the seat back.
Remove the armrest retaining clip. 4. Slide the armrest assembly out of the seat back. 5. Remove
the armrest cover for cleaning or replacement, if needed:
1. Unzip the cover. 2. Slide the cover off the armrest.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the armrest cover to the armrest, if you removed the cover. 2. Reach inside the seat back.
Install the armrest retaining clip:
* Install the clip with the opening facing down.
* Check the fit of the clip once installed. If the clip is loose when fitted in the groove in the seat back
frame, remove the clip and crimp the clip closed slightly. Repeat this procedure until the clip fits
snugly in the groove, or install a new clip.
3. Insert the armrest into the seat back until the clip engages the groove on the armrest post. 4.
Pull on the armrest in order to verify that the clip is holding the armrest securely.
5. Attach the halves of the J-hook along the bottom edge of the seat back.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Arm Rest > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Armrest Replacement (YC6) > Page 8900
Arm Rest: Service and Repair Armrest Replacement - Rear Seat (YC5 and YC6)
Armrest Replacement - Rear Seat (YC5 and YC6)
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the rear bench seat from the vehicle. Refer toSeat Replacement - Rear Bench (See:
Seats/Service and Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear
Bench) .
2. Fold down the seat back. 3. Remove the upper and lower seat back latch and seat back hinge
trim. Refer to Seat Back Hinge Trim Replacement - Rear Left (See: Seats/Seat
Back/Service and Repair/Seat Back Hinge Trim Replacement - Rear Left) , or Seat Back Hinge
Trim Replacement - Rear Right (YC6) (See: Seats/Seat Back/Service and Repair/Seat Back Hinge
Trim Replacement - Rear Right (YC6)) .
4. Unzip the seat back cover. 5. Reach inside the seat back and remove the armrest retaining clip
from the stud.
6. Remove the armrest from the seat back. 7. Remove the armrest cover for cleaning or
replacement, if needed:
1. Unzip the cover. 2. Slide the cover off the armrest.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the armrest cover to the armrest, if you removed the cover.
2. Install the armrest from the seat back. 3. Reach inside the seat back and install the armrest
retaining clip.
* Install the clip with the opening facing down.
* Observe the fit of the clip once installed. If the clip is loose when fitted in the groove in the seat
back frame, remove the clip and crimp the clip closed slightly. Repeat this procedure until the clip
fits snugly in the groove, or install a new clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Arm Rest > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Armrest Replacement (YC6) > Page 8901
4. Zip the seat back cover. 5. Install the upper and lower seat back latch and seat back hinge trim.
Refer to Seat Back Hinge Trim Replacement - Rear Left (See: Seats/Seat
Back/Service and Repair/Seat Back Hinge Trim Replacement - Rear Left) , or Seat Back Hinge
Trim Replacement - Rear Right (YC6) (See: Seats/Seat Back/Service and Repair/Seat Back Hinge
Trim Replacement - Rear Right (YC6)) .
6. Fold up the seat back. 7. Install the rear bench seat to the Vehicle. Refer toSeat Replacement Rear Bench (See: Seats/Service and Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear Bench)
.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Interior - Proper Use of Floor Mats
Carpet: Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Proper Use of Floor Mats
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 10-08-110-001
Date: March 30, 2010
Subject: Information on Proper Use of Floor Mats
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2009 HUMMER H2
2006-2010 HUMMER H3, H3T 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
GM's carpeted and all-weather (rubber) floor mats are especially designed for use in specific GM
vehicles. Using floor mats that were not designed for the specific vehicle or using them incorrectly
may cause interference with the accelerator or brake pedal. Please review the following safety
guidelines regarding proper driver's side floor mat usage with the customer.
Warning
If a floor mat is the wrong size or is not properly installed, it can interfere with the accelerator pedal
and/or brake pedal. Interference with the pedals can cause unintended acceleration and/or
increased stopping distance which can cause a crash and injury. Make sure the floor mat does not
interfere with the accelerator or brake pedal.
- Do not flip the driver's floor mat over (in an effort to keep the floor mat clean)
- Do not place anything on top of the driver's floor mat (e.g. carpet remnant, towel)
- Do not place another mat on top of the driver's floor mat (e.g. do not place all-weather rubber
mats over carpeted floor mats)
- Only use floor mats that are designed specifically for your vehicle
- When using replacement mats, make certain the mats do not interfere with the accelerator or
brake pedal before driving the vehicle
If your vehicle is equipped with a floor mat retaining pin(s) or clip(s), make certain the mat is
installed correctly and according to the instructions.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Interior - Proper Use of Floor Mats > Page 8906
After installing floor mats, make certain they cannot move and do not interfere with the accelerator
or brake pedals.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Interior - Proper Use of Floor Mats > Page 8907
Carpet: Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Elimination Of Unwanted Odors
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-00-89-027E
Date: September 29, 2008
Subject: Eliminating Unwanted Odors in Vehicles
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2009 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 Vehicles 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years and refine the instructions. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 00-00-89-027D (Section 00 - General Information).
Vehicle Odor Elimination
General Motors offers a product that may control or eliminate odors in the interior and luggage
compartment areas of GM vehicles. GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator is a non-toxic,
biodegradable odor remover. This odorless product has been shown to greatly reduce or remove
objectionable smells of mold and mildew resulting from vehicle water leaks (as well as customer
created odors, i.e. smoke). You may use GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator on fabrics, vinyl,
leather, carpet and sound deadening materials. It may also be induced into HVAC modules and
instrument panel ducts (for the control of non-bacterial related odors).
Important:
This product leaves no residual scent and should not be sold as or considered an air freshener.
Product action may result in the permanent elimination of an odor and may be preferable to
customers with allergies who are sensitive to perfumes.
How to Use This Product
GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator may be sprayed on in a ready-to-use formula or used in steam
cleaners as an additive with carpet shampoo. This water-based, odorless product is safe for all
vehicle interiors. Do not wet or soak any interior surface that plain water would cause to
deteriorate, as this product will have the same effect. Also avoid letting this product come into
contact with vinegar or any acidic substance. Acid-based products will hamper the effectiveness of,
or render GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator inert.
Note:
Complete eight page treatment sheets are enclosed within each case of GM Vehicle Care Odor
Eliminator. These treatment instructions range from simple vehicle odor elimination to full step by
step procedures for odor removal from water leaks. If lost, contact 800-977-4145 to get a
replacement set faxed or e-mailed to your dealership.
Instructions and cautions are printed on the bottle, but additional help is available. If you encounter
a difficult to eliminate or reoccurring odor, you may call 1-800-955-8591 (in Canada,
1-800-977-4145) to obtain additional information and usage suggestions.
Important:
This product may effectively remove odors when directly contacting the odor source. It should be
used in conjunction with diagnostic procedures (in cases such as a water leak) to first eliminate the
root cause of the odor, and then the residual odor to permanently correct the vehicle condition.
Vehicle Waterleak Odor Elimination
STEP ONE:
Confirm that all water leaks have been repaired. Determine what areas of the vehicle were water
soaked or wet. Components with visible mold/mildew staining should be replaced. Isolate the odor
source inside the vehicle. Often an odor can be isolated to an area or component of the vehicle
interior by careful evaluation. Odor evaluation may need to be performed by multiple persons.
Another method of isolating an odor source is to remove and segregate interior trim and
components. Plastic sheeting or drop cloths can be used to confine seats, headliners, etc. to assist
in evaluation and diagnoses. If appropriate the vehicle and interior trim should be evaluated
separately to determine if the odor stays with the vehicle or the interior components. Odors that
stay with the vehicle may be isolated to insulating and sound deadening materials (i.e. water leak
at the windshield or standing water in the front foot well area caused mold/mildew to form on the
bulkhead or kick panel sound deadening pads. If the interior is removed the floor pan and
primed/painted surfaces should be treated with bleach/soap solution, rinsed with clean water and
dried. Interior surfaces should then be treated with GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator product
before reinstalling carpet or reassembling.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Interior - Proper Use of Floor Mats > Page 8908
The GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator product is an effective odor elimination product when used
properly. It must come into direct contact with the odor source. It should be used in conjunction with
diagnostic procedures to first eliminate the root cause of the odor. Some procedures for use after
odor root cause correction are:
STEP TWO:
^ Use the trigger spray head.
^ Put a drop of dish soap the size of a quarter in the bottom of a bottle.
^ Add 8 oz. of GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator (1 cup) to the dish soap and top off the bottle with
tap water.
^ This formula should be used on hard surfaces (dash, interior plastic molding, and floor pan)
STEP THREE:
The third step to neutralizing the vehicle is a light to medium treatment of all carpeting and
upholstered seats with the GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator formula and a wide fan spray setting
(at full strength) (i.e.: carpeting on the driver's side requires 4-5 triggers pulls for coverage). The
headliner and trunk should be sprayed next. Lightly brushing the formula into the carpeting and
upholstery is a recommended step for deep odor problems. The dash and all hard surfaces should
be sprayed with dish soap/water mixture. Let stand for 1-2 minutes then wipe off the surface.
STEP FOUR: (vehicle ventilation system treatment)
The ventilation system is generally the last step in the treatment of the vehicle.
a. Spray the GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator formula into all dash vents. (1-2 trigger pulls per
vent).
b. Start the vehicle and turn the vehicle fan on high cool (not A/C setting).
c. Spray the formula (10 trigger pulls) into the outside fresh air intake vent (cowl at base of
windshield)
d. Enter the vehicle after 1 minute and wipe off the excess formula spurting out of the dash vents.
e. Smell the air coming from the dash vents. If odors are still present, spray another 5 triggers into
the cowl, wait another minute and smell the results. Once you have obtained a fresh, clean smell
coming from the vents, turn the system to the A/C re-circulation setting. Roll up the windows, spray
3-5 pumps into the right lower IP area and let the vehicle run with the fan set on high for 5-7
minutes.
Please follow this diagnosis process thoroughly and complete each step. If the condition exhibited
is resolved without completing every step, the remaining steps do not need to be performed. If
these steps do not resolve the condition, please contact GM TAC for further diagnostic assistance.
Additional Suggestions to Increase Customer Satisfaction
Here are some additional ideas to benefit your dealership and to generate greater customer
enthusiasm for this product.
^ Keep this product on-hand for both the Service Department and the Used Car lot. Add value to
your used car trades; treat loaner and demo cars during service and at final sale to eliminate
smoke, pet, and other common odors offensive to customers. Make deodorizing a vehicle part of
your normal vehicle detailing service.
^ Consider including GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator as a give-away item with new vehicle
purchases. Many dealers give away as "gifts" various cleaning supplies at time of delivery. GM
Odor Eliminator is one of a few products GM offers that has as many uses in the home as in the
vehicle. Customers may find this product can be used for a host of recreational activities
associated with their new vehicle, such as deodorizing a boat they tow, or a camper.
^ GM Odor Eliminator and many of the GM Vehicle Care products offer you the chance to increase
dealership traffic as these superior quality products cannot be purchased in stores. Many
Dealerships have product displays at the parts counter. Consider additional displays in the
Customer Service Lounge, the Showroom and at the Service Desk or Cashier Window. Many
customers who purchase vehicles and receive regular maintenance at your dealership may never
visit the parts counter, and subsequently are not exposed to the variety and value that these
products offer.
Parts Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Interior - Proper Use of Floor Mats > Page 8909
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Carpet Retainer Replacement
Carpet: Service and Repair Carpet Retainer Replacement
Carpet Retainer Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Open the door(s).
2. Remove the screws that retain the left front door step trim plate to the vehicle.
3. Remove the screws that retain the right front door step trim plate to the vehicle.
4. Remove the screws that retain the sliding door step trim plate to the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Carpet Retainer Replacement > Page 8912
5. Remove the screws that retain the rear trim plate to the vehicle. 6. Remove the trim plate from
the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the trim plate to the vehicle.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the screws that retain the left front door step trim plate to the vehicle.
Tighten the screws that retain the left front door step trim plate to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Install the screws that retain the right front door step trim plate.
Tighten the screws that retain the right front door step trim plate to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Carpet Retainer Replacement > Page 8913
4. Install the screws that retain the sliding door step trim plate to the vehicle.
Tighten the screws that retain the sliding door step trim plate to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
5. Install the screws that retain the rear trim plate to the vehicle.
Tighten the screws that retain the rear trim plate to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
6. Close the door(s).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Carpet Retainer Replacement > Page 8914
Carpet: Service and Repair Mat Replacement - Stepwell
Mat Replacement - Stepwell
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the screws from the step plate cover.
2. Remove the step panel cover.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the step panel cover.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the step panel cover screws.
Tighten the step panel cover screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Carpet Retainer Replacement > Page 8915
Carpet: Service and Repair Mat/Carpet Replacement - Front Floor
Mat/Carpet Replacement - Front Floor
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the seats and the risers. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Seats/Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) . 2. Remove the engine cover. Refer to Engine Cover
Replacement (See: Access Cover/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Engine Cover
Replacement) .
3. Remove the trim plates from the front door openings. Refer to Carpet Retainer Replacement
(See: Carpet Retainer Replacement) . 4. Remove the cowl side panel trim. Refer to Trim Panel
Replacement - Cowl Side (See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Panel Replacement Cowl Side) .
5. Remove the throttle pedal guard. 6. Remove the screws from the center floor air duct. 7.
Remove the center floor air duct. 8. Remove the front side door lock pillar garnish molding. Refer to
Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar (See: Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar) .
9. Remove the carpet/mat from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the carpet/mat to the vehicle. 2. Install the center floor air duct.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the screws to the center floor air duct.
Tighten the screws to the center floor air duct to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
4. Install the front side door lock pillar garnish molding. Refer to Garnish Molding Replacement - LF
Lock Pillar (See: Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar) .
5. Install the trim plates to the front door openings. Refer to Carpet Retainer Replacement (See:
Carpet Retainer Replacement) . 6. Install the cowl side panel trim. Refer to Trim Panel
Replacement - Cowl Side (See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Panel Replacement Cowl Side) .
7. Install the engine cover. Refer to Engine Cover Replacement (See: Access Cover/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Engine Cover
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Carpet Retainer Replacement > Page 8916
Replacement) .
8. Install the seats and the risers. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Seats/Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) in Seats.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Carpet Retainer Replacement > Page 8917
Carpet: Service and Repair Mat/Carpet Replacement - Rear Floor (B31)
Mat/Carpet Replacement - Rear Floor (B31)
Removal Procedure
1. Unsnap the seat belts from the second seat belt latches. 2. Remove the seats and the risers
from the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Rear Bench (See: Seats/Service and Repair/Seat
Replacement -
Rear Bench) in Seats.
3. Remove the engine cover. Refer to Engine Cover Replacement (See: Access Cover/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Engine Cover
Replacement) .
4. Remove the trim plates from the following:
* The front
* The rear side
* The rear Refer to Carpet Retainer Replacement (See: Carpet Retainer Replacement) .
5. Remove the cowl side panel trim. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Cowl Side (See: Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Panel Replacement Cowl Side) .
6. Remove the right front side door lock pillar garnish molding. Refer to Garnish Molding
Replacement - RF Lock Pillar (See: Trim Panel/Service
and Repair/Garnish Molding Replacement - RF Lock Pillar) .
7. Remove the body side front lower trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Body Side
Front Lower (See: Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Body Side Front Lower) .
8. Remove the left body side trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Left Body Side (See:
Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Panel
Replacement - Left Body Side) .
9. Remove the right body side trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Right Body Side
(See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Panel
Replacement - Right Body Side) .
10. Remove the bolt that retains each cargo net anchor to the floor of the vehicle, if equipped. 11.
The carpet bezels are retained by sonic weld and are not to be removed from the carpet.
12. Remove the carpet from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the carpet into the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Carpet Retainer Replacement > Page 8918
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the bolt that retains each cargo net anchor to the floor of the vehicle, if equipped.
Tighten the bolt that retains each cargo net anchor to the floor 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Install the right body side trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Right Body Side (See:
Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Panel
Replacement - Right Body Side) .
4. Install the left body side trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Left Body Side (See:
Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Panel
Replacement - Left Body Side) .
5. Install the body side front lower trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Body Side Front
Lower (See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim
Panel Replacement - Body Side Front Lower) .
6. Install the cowl side panel trim. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Cowl Side (See: Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Panel Replacement Cowl Side) .
7. Install the right front side door lock pillar garnish molding. Refer to Garnish Molding Replacement
- RF Lock Pillar (See: Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Garnish Molding Replacement - RF Lock Pillar) .
8. Install the trim plates at the following doors:
* The front
* The rear side
* The rear Refer to Carpet Retainer Replacement (See: Carpet Retainer Replacement) .
9. Install the engine cover. Refer to Engine Cover Replacement (See: Access Cover/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Engine Cover
Replacement) .
10. Install the seats and the risers. Refer to Seat Replacement - Rear Bench (See: Seats/Service
and Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear Bench) in Seats. 11. Snap the seat belts to the second seat
belt latches.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Carpet Retainer Replacement > Page 8919
Carpet: Service and Repair
Carpet Retainer Replacement
Carpet Retainer Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Open the door(s).
2. Remove the screws that retain the left front door step trim plate to the vehicle.
3. Remove the screws that retain the right front door step trim plate to the vehicle.
4. Remove the screws that retain the sliding door step trim plate to the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Carpet Retainer Replacement > Page 8920
5. Remove the screws that retain the rear trim plate to the vehicle. 6. Remove the trim plate from
the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the trim plate to the vehicle.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the screws that retain the left front door step trim plate to the vehicle.
Tighten the screws that retain the left front door step trim plate to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Install the screws that retain the right front door step trim plate.
Tighten the screws that retain the right front door step trim plate to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Carpet Retainer Replacement > Page 8921
4. Install the screws that retain the sliding door step trim plate to the vehicle.
Tighten the screws that retain the sliding door step trim plate to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
5. Install the screws that retain the rear trim plate to the vehicle.
Tighten the screws that retain the rear trim plate to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
6. Close the door(s).
Mat Replacement - Stepwell
Mat Replacement - Stepwell
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the screws from the step plate cover.
2. Remove the step panel cover.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Carpet Retainer Replacement > Page 8922
1. Install the step panel cover.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the step panel cover screws.
Tighten the step panel cover screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Mat/Carpet Replacement - Front Floor
Mat/Carpet Replacement - Front Floor
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the seats and the risers. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Seats/Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) . 2. Remove the engine cover. Refer to Engine Cover
Replacement (See: Access Cover/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Engine Cover
Replacement) .
3. Remove the trim plates from the front door openings. Refer to Carpet Retainer Replacement
(See: Carpet Retainer Replacement) . 4. Remove the cowl side panel trim. Refer to Trim Panel
Replacement - Cowl Side (See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Panel Replacement Cowl Side) .
5. Remove the throttle pedal guard. 6. Remove the screws from the center floor air duct. 7.
Remove the center floor air duct. 8. Remove the front side door lock pillar garnish molding. Refer to
Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar (See: Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar) .
9. Remove the carpet/mat from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Carpet Retainer Replacement > Page 8923
1. Install the carpet/mat to the vehicle. 2. Install the center floor air duct.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the screws to the center floor air duct.
Tighten the screws to the center floor air duct to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
4. Install the front side door lock pillar garnish molding. Refer to Garnish Molding Replacement - LF
Lock Pillar (See: Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar) .
5. Install the trim plates to the front door openings. Refer to Carpet Retainer Replacement (See:
Carpet Retainer Replacement) . 6. Install the cowl side panel trim. Refer to Trim Panel
Replacement - Cowl Side (See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Panel Replacement Cowl Side) .
7. Install the engine cover. Refer to Engine Cover Replacement (See: Access Cover/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Engine Cover
Replacement) .
8. Install the seats and the risers. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Seats/Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) in Seats.
Mat/Carpet Replacement - Rear Floor (B31)
Mat/Carpet Replacement - Rear Floor (B31)
Removal Procedure
1. Unsnap the seat belts from the second seat belt latches. 2. Remove the seats and the risers
from the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Rear Bench (See: Seats/Service and Repair/Seat
Replacement -
Rear Bench) in Seats.
3. Remove the engine cover. Refer to Engine Cover Replacement (See: Access Cover/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Engine Cover
Replacement) .
4. Remove the trim plates from the following:
* The front
* The rear side
* The rear Refer to Carpet Retainer Replacement (See: Carpet Retainer Replacement) .
5. Remove the cowl side panel trim. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Cowl Side (See: Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Panel Replacement Cowl Side) .
6. Remove the right front side door lock pillar garnish molding. Refer to Garnish Molding
Replacement - RF Lock Pillar (See: Trim Panel/Service
and Repair/Garnish Molding Replacement - RF Lock Pillar) .
7. Remove the body side front lower trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Body Side
Front Lower (See: Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Body Side Front Lower) .
8. Remove the left body side trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Left Body Side (See:
Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Panel
Replacement - Left Body Side) .
9. Remove the right body side trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Right Body Side
(See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Panel
Replacement - Right Body Side) .
10. Remove the bolt that retains each cargo net anchor to the floor of the vehicle, if equipped. 11.
The carpet bezels are retained by sonic weld and are not to be removed from the carpet.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Carpet Retainer Replacement > Page 8924
12. Remove the carpet from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the carpet into the vehicle.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the bolt that retains each cargo net anchor to the floor of the vehicle, if equipped.
Tighten the bolt that retains each cargo net anchor to the floor 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Install the right body side trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Right Body Side (See:
Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Panel
Replacement - Right Body Side) .
4. Install the left body side trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Left Body Side (See:
Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Panel
Replacement - Left Body Side) .
5. Install the body side front lower trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Body Side Front
Lower (See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim
Panel Replacement - Body Side Front Lower) .
6. Install the cowl side panel trim. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Cowl Side (See: Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Panel Replacement Cowl Side) .
7. Install the right front side door lock pillar garnish molding. Refer to Garnish Molding Replacement
- RF Lock Pillar (See: Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Garnish Molding Replacement - RF Lock Pillar) .
8. Install the trim plates at the following doors:
* The front
* The rear side
* The rear Refer to Carpet Retainer Replacement (See: Carpet Retainer Replacement) .
9. Install the engine cover. Refer to Engine Cover Replacement (See: Access Cover/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Engine Cover
Replacement) .
10. Install the seats and the risers. Refer to Seat Replacement - Rear Bench (See: Seats/Service
and Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear Bench) in Seats. 11. Snap the seat belts to the second seat
belt latches.
Mat/Carpet Replacement - Rear Floor (B38)
Mat/Carpet Replacement - Rear Floor (B38)
Removal Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Carpet Retainer Replacement > Page 8925
1. Remove the seats and the risers. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Seats/Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) in Seats. 2. Remove the engine cover. Refer to Engine Cover
Replacement (See: Access Cover/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Engine Cover
Replacement) .
3. Remove the trim plates from the following doors:
* The front
* The rear side
* The rear Refer to Carpet Retainer Replacement (See: Carpet Retainer Replacement) .
4. Remove the cowl side panel trim. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Cowl Side (See: Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Panel Replacement Cowl Side) .
5. Remove the right front side door lock pillar garnish molding. Refer to Garnish Molding
Replacement - RF Lock Pillar (See: Trim Panel/Service
and Repair/Garnish Molding Replacement - RF Lock Pillar) .
6. Remove the body side front lower trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Body Side
Front Lower (See: Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Body Side Front Lower) .
7. Remove the left body side trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Left Body Side (See:
Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Panel
Replacement - Left Body Side) .
8. Remove the right body side trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Right Body Side
(See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Panel
Replacement - Right Body Side) .
9. Remove the bolt that retains each cargo net anchor to the floor of the vehicle, if equipped.
10. The carpet bezels are retained by sonic weld and are not to be removed.
11. Remove the carpet from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the carpet into the vehicle. 2. The carpet bezels are retained by sonic weld and are not to
be removed.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the bolt that retains each cargo net anchor to the floor of the vehicle, if equipped.
Tighten the bolt that retains each cargo net anchor to the floor 2 N.m (18 lb in).
4. Install the right body side trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Right Body Side (See:
Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Panel
Replacement - Right Body Side) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Carpet Retainer Replacement > Page 8926
5. Install the left body side trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Left Body Side (See:
Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Panel
Replacement - Left Body Side) .
6. Install the body side front lower trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Body Side Front
Lower (See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim
Panel Replacement - Body Side Front Lower) .
7. Install the cowl side panel trim. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Cowl Side (See: Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Panel Replacement Cowl Side) .
8. Install the right front side door lock pillar garnish molding. Refer to Garnish Molding Replacement
- RF Lock Pillar (See: Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Garnish Molding Replacement - RF Lock Pillar) .
9. Install the trim plates from the following doors:
* The front
* The rear side
* The rear Refer to Carpet Retainer Replacement (See: Carpet Retainer Replacement) .
10. Install the engine cover. Refer to Engine Cover Replacement (See: Access Cover/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Engine Cover
Replacement) .
11. Install the seats and the risers. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Seats/Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) in Seats.
Mat/Carpet Replacement - Rear Wheelhouse
Mat/Carpet Replacement - Rear Wheelhouse
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the body side trim panel. Refer to the following procedures:
* Trim Panel Replacement - Body Side Front Lower (See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim
Panel Replacement - Body Side Front Lower)
* Trim Panel Replacement - Left Body Side (See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Panel
Replacement - Left Body Side)
* Trim Panel Replacement - Right Body Side (See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Panel
Replacement - Right Body Side)
2. Remove the wheelhouse carpet from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the wheelhouse carpet to the vehicle. 2. Install the body side trim panel. Refer to the
following procedures:
* Trim Panel Replacement - Body Side Front Lower (See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim
Panel Replacement - Body Side Front Lower)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Carpet Retainer Replacement > Page 8927
* Trim Panel Replacement - Left Body Side (See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Panel
Replacement - Left Body Side)
* Trim Panel Replacement - Right Body Side (See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Panel
Replacement - Right Body Side)
Mat Replacement - Side Door Stepwell
Mat Replacement - Side Door Stepwell
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the screws.
2. Remove the step panel cover.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the step panel cover.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the step panel cover screws.
Tighten the step panel cover screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Console: Description and Operation
Overhead Console Description
The overhead console is a convenience package that contains the following components:
* A digital display (4) that provides:
* The outside temperature
* Eight primary compass readings indicating the direction the vehicle is travelling
* Two switches (3) including:
* An ON/OFF switch for the temperature/compass display
* A U.S./METRIC switch that changes the temperature readout from degrees Fahrenheit (F) to
degrees Celsius (C)
* Two pivoting courtesy/map lamps (1)
* A compartment (4) for a garage door opener with a transmitter (2) that can be activated by
pressing the button (3) on the compartment door.
* A compartment for storing sunglasses
* A compartment for storing compact discs or tapes
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Center Console Replacement - Rear Seat
Console: Service and Repair Center Console Replacement - Rear Seat
Center Console Replacement - Rear Seat
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the hog rings retaining the carpet to the seat cushion frame. 2. Remove the carpet
covering the center of the seat cushion frame along the rear edge of the seat, under the console.
3. Remove the bolts retaining the console to the seat cushion frame.
4. Remove the console and drink tray from the seat cushion frame.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the console and drink tray to the seat cushion frame.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the bolts retaining the console and drink tray the seat cushion frame.
Tighten the bolts retaining the console and drink tray to the seat cushion frame to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
3. Install the carpet covering the center of the seat cushion frame along the rear edge of the seat,
under the console.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Center Console Replacement - Rear Seat > Page 8933
4. Install the hog rings in order to retain the carpet to the frame.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Center Console Replacement - Rear Seat > Page 8934
Console: Service and Repair Console Replacement - Overhead
Console Replacement - Overhead
Removal Procedure
Because the compass system is so complex and susceptible to outside influences, examine the
system thoroughly before performing any repairs. Diagnose the system in an area free from
potential interference, such as an open field. Recalibrate the system before performing any other
repairs in order to verify the existence of a problem.
1. Remove the retaining screws from the overhead console.
1. Remove the dome lamp lens from the overhead console. 2. Remove the front screws from the
overhead console. 3. Remove the rear screws from the overhead console.
2. Disconnect the electrical connectors. 3. Remove the overhead console as follows:
1. Swing the overhead console downward. 2. Pull the overhead console forward in order to clear
the rear mounting tabs.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the rear part of the overhead console by inserting the mounting tabs into the roof panel. 2.
Connect the electrical connectors.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the overhead console retaining screws.
Tighten the screws to the overhead console to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
1. Install the rear screws to the overhead console .
Tighten the rear screws to the overhead console to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
2. Install the front screws to the overhead console .
Tighten the front screws to the overhead console to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Install the dome lamp lens to the overhead console .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Center Console Replacement - Rear Seat > Page 8935
Console: Service and Repair Overhead Console - Courtesy Lamp Replacement
COURTESY LAMP REPLACEMENT - OVERHEAD CONSOLE
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Unscrew the center of the lamp lens with a suitable flat bladed tool while pressing up on the
lamp assembly. 2. Remove the lamp assembly. 3. Remove the bulb from the socket.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the new lamp in the assembly. 2. Install the lamp assembly into the cavity. 3. Turn the
lamp assembly in order to latch the assembly into place.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Center Console Replacement - Rear Seat > Page 8936
Console: Service and Repair Storage Tray Replacement - Right Front Seat
Storage Tray Replacement - Right Front Seat
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the bucket seat from the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See:
Seats/Service and Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) .
2. Remove the passenger seat storage tray insert from the tray. 3. Remove the storage tray to
track assembly retainers. 4. Remove the storage tray from the track assembly. 5. Remove the track
assembly from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the track assembly to the vehicle. 2. Install the passenger seat storage tray to the track
assembly. 3. Install the storage tray to track assembly retainers. 4. Install the storage tray insert. 5.
Install the bucket seat in the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Seats/Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Center Console Replacement - Rear Seat > Page 8937
Console: Service and Repair
Center Console Replacement - Rear Seat
Center Console Replacement - Rear Seat
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the hog rings retaining the carpet to the seat cushion frame. 2. Remove the carpet
covering the center of the seat cushion frame along the rear edge of the seat, under the console.
3. Remove the bolts retaining the console to the seat cushion frame.
4. Remove the console and drink tray from the seat cushion frame.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the console and drink tray to the seat cushion frame.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the bolts retaining the console and drink tray the seat cushion frame.
Tighten the bolts retaining the console and drink tray to the seat cushion frame to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Center Console Replacement - Rear Seat > Page 8938
3. Install the carpet covering the center of the seat cushion frame along the rear edge of the seat,
under the console. 4. Install the hog rings in order to retain the carpet to the frame.
Console Replacement - Overhead
Console Replacement - Overhead
Removal Procedure
Because the compass system is so complex and susceptible to outside influences, examine the
system thoroughly before performing any repairs. Diagnose the system in an area free from
potential interference, such as an open field. Recalibrate the system before performing any other
repairs in order to verify the existence of a problem.
1. Remove the retaining screws from the overhead console.
1. Remove the dome lamp lens from the overhead console. 2. Remove the front screws from the
overhead console. 3. Remove the rear screws from the overhead console.
2. Disconnect the electrical connectors. 3. Remove the overhead console as follows:
1. Swing the overhead console downward. 2. Pull the overhead console forward in order to clear
the rear mounting tabs.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the rear part of the overhead console by inserting the mounting tabs into the roof panel. 2.
Connect the electrical connectors.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the overhead console retaining screws.
Tighten the screws to the overhead console to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
1. Install the rear screws to the overhead console .
Tighten the rear screws to the overhead console to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
2. Install the front screws to the overhead console .
Tighten the front screws to the overhead console to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Center Console Replacement - Rear Seat > Page 8939
3. Install the dome lamp lens to the overhead console .
Overhead Console - Courtesy Lamp Replacement
COURTESY LAMP REPLACEMENT - OVERHEAD CONSOLE
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Unscrew the center of the lamp lens with a suitable flat bladed tool while pressing up on the
lamp assembly. 2. Remove the lamp assembly. 3. Remove the bulb from the socket.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the new lamp in the assembly. 2. Install the lamp assembly into the cavity. 3. Turn the
lamp assembly in order to latch the assembly into place.
Storage Tray Replacement - Right Front Seat
Storage Tray Replacement - Right Front Seat
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the bucket seat from the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See:
Seats/Service and Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Center Console Replacement - Rear Seat > Page 8940
2. Remove the passenger seat storage tray insert from the tray. 3. Remove the storage tray to
track assembly retainers. 4. Remove the storage tray from the track assembly. 5. Remove the track
assembly from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the track assembly to the vehicle. 2. Install the passenger seat storage tray to the track
assembly. 3. Install the storage tray to track assembly retainers. 4. Install the storage tray insert. 5.
Install the bucket seat in the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Seats/Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) .
Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors)
Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors)
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the window garnish molding. Refer to Window Garnish Molding Replacement (See:
Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Window Garnish
Molding Replacement) .
2. Remove the screws.
3. Remove the trim panel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Center Console Replacement - Rear Seat > Page 8941
Installation Procedure
1. Install the trim panel.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the trim panel screws.
Tighten the trim panel screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Install the window garnish molding. Refer to Window Garnish Molding Replacement (See: Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Window Garnish
Molding Replacement) .
Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (E54)
Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (E54)
Tools Required
J 38778 Door Trim Pad and Garnish Clip Remover
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the lace.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Center Console Replacement - Rear Seat > Page 8942
2. Use J 38778 in order to remove the trim panel.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the trim panel to the door.
2. Install the lace.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Disabling
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Disabling
IMPORTANT: Refer to SIR Service Precautions before disabling the SIR system.
1. Turn the steering wheel until the vehicle's wheels are pointing straight ahead. 2. Turn OFF the
ignition. 3. Remove the key from the ignition.
IMPORTANT: With the AIR BAG Fuse removed and the ignition ON, the AIR BAG indicator
illuminates. This is normal operation and does not indicate an SIR system malfunction.
4. Remove the AIR BAG Fuse from the IP fuse block. 5. Remove the sound insulator, if equipped.
6. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) from the steering wheel module yellow 2-way
connector (1) located at the base of the steering
column.
7. Disconnect the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector (1) located at the base of the
steering column.
8. Remove the instrument panel extension. 9. Remove the CPA (2) from the IP module yellow
2-way connector (1) located under the instrument panel extension.
10. Disconnect the IP module yellow 2-way connector (1) located under the instrument panel
extension.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Disabling > Page 8948
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Enabling
1. Remove the key from the ignition. 2. Connect the IP module yellow 2-way connector (1) located
under the instrument panel extension. 3. Install the connector position assurance (CPA) (2) to the
IP module yellow 2-way connector (1) located under the instrument panel extension. 4. Install the
instrument panel extension.
5. Connect the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector (1) located at the base of the
steering column. 6. Install the CPA to the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector (1)
located at the base of the steering column. 7. Install the sound insulator, if equipped. 8. Install the
AIR BAG Fuse to the IP fuse block. 9. Staying well away from the air bags, turn ON the ignition,
with the engine OFF.
9.1. The AIR BAG indicator will flash 7 times.
9.2. The AIR BAG indicator will then turn OFF.
10. Perform Diagnostic System Check - SIR if the AIR BAG indicator does not operate as
described.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Glove Compartment > Component Information
> Service and Repair
Glove Compartment: Service and Repair
Compartment Replacement - IP Forward Extension
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the instrument panel extension trim plate. Refer to IP Extension Trim Plate
Replacement (See: Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/IP Extension Trim Plate Replacement) .
2. Squeeze the two retainers and pull out in order to remove the storage compartment.
Installation Procedure
1. Snap the storage compartment into place.
2. Install the instrument panel extension trim plate. Refer to IP Extension Trim Plate Replacement
(See: Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/IP Extension Trim Plate Replacement) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Headliner: Service and Repair
Headliner Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the sunshades. Refer to Sunshade Replacement (See: Sun Visor/Service and Repair) .
2. Remove the overhead console, if equipped. Refer to Console Replacement - Overhead (See:
Console/Service and Repair/Console Replacement Overhead) .
3. Refer to the following procedures in order to remove the necessary moldings:
* Garnish Molding Replacement - Rear Upper (See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Garnish
Molding Replacement - Rear Upper)
* Garnish Molding Replacement - Side Door Opening Frame (See: Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Garnish Molding Replacement - Side Door Opening Frame)
* Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar (See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Garnish
Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar)
* Garnish Molding Replacement - RF Lock Pillar (See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Garnish
Molding Replacement - RF Lock Pillar)
* Trim Replacement - Third Pillar Left (See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Replacement Third Pillar Left)
* Trim Replacement - Third Pillar Right (See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Replacement Third Pillar Right)
* Trim Replacement - Fourth Pillar Left (See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Replacement Fourth Pillar Left)
* Trim Replacement - Fourth Pillar Right (See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Replacement Fourth Pillar Right)
4. Release the front headliner from the roof panel by separating the retaining strips. 5. Remove the
front headliner from the vehicle. 6. Remove the right seat belt retractor. Refer to Seat Belt Retractor
Replacement - Right Front in Seat Belts. 7. Remove the dome lamp from the rear headliner. Refer
to Dome Lamp Replacement in Lighting Systems. 8. Remove the sliding door track garnish
molding. Refer to Garnish Molding Replacement - Sliding Door (See: Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Garnish Molding Replacement - Sliding Door) .
9. Remove the coat hooks. Refer to Coat Hook Replacement (See: Service and Repair) .
10. Remove the 2 push-in retainers (4) at the front edge of the rear headliner (2). 11. Detach the
rear headliner (2) from the retaining strips (3). 12. Remove the rear headliner (2) from the roof
panel (1). 13. With the aid of an assistant, remove the rear headliner from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Page 8955
1. In order to install the rear headliner to the roof panel perform the following:
1. With the aid of an assistant, position the rear headliner to the roof panel. 2. Attach the rear
headliner to the retaining strips. 3. Install the 2 push-in retainers (4) at the front edge of the rear
headliner.
2. Install the coat hooks. Refer to Coat Hook Replacement (See: Service and Repair) . 3. Install the
sliding door track garnish molding. Refer to Garnish Molding Replacement - Sliding Door (See:
Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/Garnish Molding Replacement - Sliding Door) .
4. Install the dome lamp to the rear headliner. Refer to Dome Lamp Replacement in Lighting
Systems. 5. Install the right seat belt retractor. Refer to Seat Belt Retractor Replacement - Right
Front in Seat Belts.
6. Position the front headliner to the roof panel. 7. Fasten the front headliner to the roof panel,
ensuring that the retaining strips are fully engaged. 8. Install the front side door opening frame
garnish molding. Refer to Garnish Molding Replacement - Side Door Opening Frame (See: Trim
Panel/Service and Repair/Garnish Molding Replacement - Side Door Opening Frame) .
9. Refer to the following procedures in order to install the necessary moldings:
* Trim Replacement - Fourth Pillar Right (See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Replacement Fourth Pillar Right)
* Trim Replacement - Fourth Pillar Left (See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Replacement Fourth Pillar Left)
* Trim Replacement - Third Pillar Right (See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Replacement Third Pillar Right)
* Trim Replacement - Third Pillar Left (See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Trim Replacement Third Pillar Left)
* Garnish Molding Replacement - RF Lock Pillar (See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Garnish
Molding Replacement - RF Lock Pillar)
* Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar (See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Garnish
Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar)
* Garnish Molding Replacement - Rear Upper (See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/Garnish
Molding Replacement - Rear Upper)
* Install the overhead console. Refer to Console Replacement - Overhead (See: Console/Service
and Repair/Console Replacement - Overhead) .
* Install the sunshades. Refer to Sunshade Replacement (See: Sun Visor/Service and Repair) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Passenger Assist Handle > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Passenger Assist Handle: Service and Repair
IP Assist Handle Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the inflatable restraint IP module. Refer to Inflatable Restraint Instrument Panel Module
Replacement in SIR.
2. Remove the nuts from the assist handle. 3. Remove the assist handle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the assist handle to the instrument panel.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the assist handle nuts.
Tighten the assist handle nuts to 8 N.m (71 lb ft).
3. Install the inflatable restraint IP module. Refer toInflatable Restraint Instrument Panel Module
Replacement in SIR.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Sun Visor > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Sun Visor: Service and Repair
Sunshade Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the sunshade retaining screws, unplug the wiring harness (if equipped). 2. Remove the
sunshade from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the sunshade to the vehicle.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the sunshade retaining screws, connect the sunshade wiring harness (if equipped).
Tighten the sunshade retaining screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar
Trim Panel: Service and Repair Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar
Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the retaining screw from the garnish molding. 2. Remove the driver's side seat belt
upper mounting bolt. Refer to Shoulder Belt Guide Adjuster Replacement - Front in Seat Belts.
3. Pull back on the garnish molding in order to release the fasteners. 4. Remove the garnish
molding from the pillar.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the garnish molding to the pillar:
1. Align the locator pin with the pillar. 2. Press the locator pin firmly into place, seating all fasteners.
2. Install the driver's seat belt upper mounting bolt. Refer toShoulder Belt Guide Adjuster
Replacement - Front in Seat Belts.
Notice: Refer toFastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the garnish molding retaining screw.
Tighten the garnish molding retaining screw to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar > Page 8966
Trim Panel: Service and Repair Garnish Molding Replacement - Lift Gate
Garnish Molding Replacement - Lift Gate
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the interior handle screw cover (12). 2. Remove the screws (11). 3. Remove the handle
(10) and the escutcheon (9). 4. Remove the garnish molding screws (3). 5. Remove the garnish
molding (2).
Installation Procedure
1. Install the garnish molding (2).
Install the locator pins into the locator hole on the liftgate.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Caution and Notices.
2. Install the garnish molding screws (3).
Tighten the garnish molding screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Install the handle escutcheon (9) and the handle (10). 4. Install the interior handle.
Tighten the interior handle screws to 6 N.m (53 lb in).
5. Install the interior handle screw covers (12).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar > Page 8967
Trim Panel: Service and Repair Garnish Molding Replacement - Rear Upper
Garnish Molding Replacement - Rear Upper
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the screws that retain the door frame garnish molding to the vehicle.
2. Remove the door frame garnish molding. 3. Disconnect the electrical connector.
Installation Procedure
1. Connect the electrical connector.
2. Install the molding to the roof.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the roof retaining screws.
Tighten the roof retaining screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar > Page 8968
Trim Panel: Service and Repair Garnish Molding Replacement - RF Lock Pillar
Garnish Molding Replacement - RF Lock Pillar
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the garnish molding screws. 2. Remove the front passenger's seat belt upper retainer.
Refer to Shoulder Belt Guide Adjuster Replacement - Front in Seat Belts.
3. Remove the bolts that retain the assist handle to the pillar.
4. Pull back on the garnish molding to release the fasteners. 5. Remove the garnish molding. 6.
Disconnect the electrical connector from the rear side door stepwell lamp.
Installation Procedure
1. Connect the electrical connector to the rear side door stepwell lamp.
2. Install the molding to the pillar:
1. Align the fasteners with the slots in the pillar. 2. Press firmly until the fasteners are fully seated.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar > Page 8969
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the bolts that retain the assist handle to the pillar.
Tighten the bolts that retain the assist handle to the pillar to 8 N.m (71 lb in).
4. Install the front passenger's seat belt upper retainer. Refer to Shoulder Belt Guide Adjuster
Replacement - Front in Seat Belts. 5. Install the retaining screws.
Tighten the retaining screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar > Page 8970
Trim Panel: Service and Repair
Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar
Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the retaining screw from the garnish molding. 2. Remove the driver's side seat belt
upper mounting bolt. Refer to Shoulder Belt Guide Adjuster Replacement - Front in Seat Belts.
3. Pull back on the garnish molding in order to release the fasteners. 4. Remove the garnish
molding from the pillar.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the garnish molding to the pillar:
1. Align the locator pin with the pillar. 2. Press the locator pin firmly into place, seating all fasteners.
2. Install the driver's seat belt upper mounting bolt. Refer toShoulder Belt Guide Adjuster
Replacement - Front in Seat Belts.
Notice: Refer toFastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the garnish molding retaining screw.
Tighten the garnish molding retaining screw to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Garnish Molding Replacement - Lift Gate
Garnish Molding Replacement - Lift Gate
Removal Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar > Page 8971
1. Remove the interior handle screw cover (12). 2. Remove the screws (11). 3. Remove the handle
(10) and the escutcheon (9). 4. Remove the garnish molding screws (3). 5. Remove the garnish
molding (2).
Installation Procedure
1. Install the garnish molding (2).
Install the locator pins into the locator hole on the liftgate.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Caution and Notices.
2. Install the garnish molding screws (3).
Tighten the garnish molding screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Install the handle escutcheon (9) and the handle (10). 4. Install the interior handle.
Tighten the interior handle screws to 6 N.m (53 lb in).
5. Install the interior handle screw covers (12).
Garnish Molding Replacement - Rear Upper
Garnish Molding Replacement - Rear Upper
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the screws that retain the door frame garnish molding to the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar > Page 8972
2. Remove the door frame garnish molding. 3. Disconnect the electrical connector.
Installation Procedure
1. Connect the electrical connector.
2. Install the molding to the roof.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the roof retaining screws.
Tighten the roof retaining screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Garnish Molding Replacement - RF Lock Pillar
Garnish Molding Replacement - RF Lock Pillar
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the garnish molding screws. 2. Remove the front passenger's seat belt upper retainer.
Refer to Shoulder Belt Guide Adjuster Replacement - Front in Seat Belts.
3. Remove the bolts that retain the assist handle to the pillar.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar > Page 8973
4. Pull back on the garnish molding to release the fasteners. 5. Remove the garnish molding. 6.
Disconnect the electrical connector from the rear side door stepwell lamp.
Installation Procedure
1. Connect the electrical connector to the rear side door stepwell lamp.
2. Install the molding to the pillar:
1. Align the fasteners with the slots in the pillar. 2. Press firmly until the fasteners are fully seated.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the bolts that retain the assist handle to the pillar.
Tighten the bolts that retain the assist handle to the pillar to 8 N.m (71 lb in).
4. Install the front passenger's seat belt upper retainer. Refer to Shoulder Belt Guide Adjuster
Replacement - Front in Seat Belts. 5. Install the retaining screws.
Tighten the retaining screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Garnish Molding Replacement - Side Door Opening Frame
Garnish Molding Replacement - Side Door Opening Frame
Tools Required
J 38778 Door Trim Pad and Garnish Clip Remover
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the garnish molding screw.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar > Page 8974
2. Use the J 38778 in order to remove the door opening garnish molding on the retainers at the
windshield pillar. 3. Remove the molding from one retainer in the center of the door opening.
This retainer will stay with the vehicle, not the molding.
4. Slide the molding up past the following components in order to remove the molding from the
vehicle:
* The cowl side trim panel
* The knee bolster
* The instrument panel
Installation Procedure
1. Slide the molding past the following components in order to install the molding to the vehicle:
* The instrument panel
* The knee bolster
* Behind the cowl side panel trim
2. Align the fasteners at the windshield pillar. 3. Press the fasteners into place until the fasteners
seat fully. 4. Install the tab on the molding in the clip in the center of the door opening.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
5. Install the screw that retains the end of the molding to the vehicle.
Tighten the screw that retains the end of the molding to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Garnish Molding Replacement - Sliding Door
Garnish Molding Replacement - Sliding Door
Tools Required
J 38778 Door Trim Pad and Garnish Clip Remover
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the swing-out window latch from the door, if equipped. Refer to Window Replacement Swing Out (See: Windows and
Glass/Windows/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Window Replacement - Swing Out)
.
2. Remove the door handle bezel screws. 3. Remove the door handle bezel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar > Page 8975
4. Use J 38778 in order to release the molding retainers.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the door garnish molding to the vehicle:
1. Align the retainers to the holes in the door. 2. Press the panel in order to engage the retainers
into the door.
2. Install the door handle bezel to the door.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the door handle bezel screws.
Tighten the door handle bezel screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
4. Install the swing-out window latch to the door, if equipped. Refer to Window Replacement Swing Out (See: Windows and
Glass/Windows/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Window Replacement - Swing Out)
.
Garnish Molding Replacement - Upper Roller Track
Garnish Molding Replacement - Upper Roller Track
Tools Required
J 38778 Door Trim Pad and Garnish Clip Remover
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the retaining screws from the upper garnish molding.
2. Use J 38778 in order to release the molding retainers.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar > Page 8976
1. Align the fasteners with the slots in the body. 2. Press the panel firmly into position, ensuring that
all fasteners are fully seated.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the retaining screws to the upper garnish molding.
Tighten the retaining screws to the upper garnish molding to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Trim Panel Replacement - Body Side Front Lower
Trim Panel Replacement - Body Side Front Lower
Tools Required
J 38778 Door Trim Pad and Garnish Clip Remover
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the intermediate seat. Refer to Seat Replacement - Rear Bench (See: Seats/Service
and Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear Bench) in Seats. 2. Remove the driver's door stepwell lamp
cover retaining screw. 3. Remove the stepwell lamp assembly from the body side lower storage
pocket.
4. Use the J 38778 in order to remove the body side front lower trim panel from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the body side front lower trim panel to the vehicle:
1. Align the fasteners. 2. Snap the fasteners into place.
2. Install the driver's door stepwell lamp assembly to the body side lower storage pocket.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar > Page 8977
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the stepwell lamp cover retaining screw.
Tighten the stepwell lamp cover retaining screw to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
4. Install the intermediate seat. Refer to Seat Replacement - Rear Bench (See: Seats/Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear Bench) in Seats.
Trim Panel Replacement - Body Side Front Upper
Trim Panel Replacement - Body Side Front Upper
Tools Required
J 38778 Door Trim Pad and Garnish Clip Remover
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the body side front lower trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Body Side
Front Lower (See: Trim Panel Replacement - Body
Side Front Lower) .
2. Remove the intermediate swing-out window latch. Refer to Window Replacement - Swing Out
(See: Windows and Glass/Windows/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Window Replacement - Swing Out) in Stationary Windows.
3. Remove the retaining screw at the B pillar.
4. Use the J 38778 in order to remove the body side front upper trim panel from the vehicle. 5.
Disconnect the electrical connector from the rear audio controls, if equipped. 6. Remove the rear
audio controls from the trim panel. Refer to Audio Control Replacement - Rear Seat in
Entertainment.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the rear audio controls to the trim panel, if equipped. Refer to Audio Control Replacement
- Rear Seat in Entertainment. 2. Connect the electrical connector to the rear audio controls.
3. Install the body side front upper trim panel to the vehicle:
1. Align the retaining clips with the holes in the body. 2. Press the panel in order to seat the
fasteners into place.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
4. Install the retaining screw to the B pillar.
Tighten the retaining screw to the B pillar to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar > Page 8978
5. Install the intermediate swing-out window latch. Refer to Window Replacement - Swing Out
(See: Windows and Glass/Windows/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Window Replacement - Swing Out) in Stationary Windows.
6. Install the body side front lower trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Body Side Front
Lower (See: Trim Panel Replacement - Body
Side Front Lower) .
Trim Panel Replacement - Cowl Side
Trim Panel Replacement - Cowl Side
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the driver's or the passenger's knee bolster. Refer to Knee Bolster Replacement - Left
(See: Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Knee Bolster Replacement - Left) orKnee Bolster Replacement - Right (See: Dashboard /
Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Knee Bolster Replacement - Right) in Instrument Panel,
Gages and Console.
2. Remove the screws that retain the panel to the cowl side. 3. Remove the trim panel from the
vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the trim panel to the vehicle.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the screws that retain the trim panel to the cowl side.
Tighten the screws that retain the trim panel to the cowl side to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Install the driver's or the passenger's knee bolster. Refer to Knee Bolster Replacement - Left
(See: Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Knee Bolster Replacement - Left) orKnee Bolster Replacement - Right (See: Dashboard /
Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Knee Bolster Replacement - Right) in Instrument Panel,
Gages and Console.
Trim Panel Replacement - Left Body Side
Trim Panel Replacement - Left Body Side
Tools Required
J 38778 Door Trim Pad and Garnish Clip Remover
Removal Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar > Page 8979
1. Remove the quarter panel swing-out window latch. Refer to Window Replacement - Swing Out
(See: Windows and Glass/Windows/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Window Replacement - Swing Out) in Stationary Windows.
2. Remove the third and the fourth pillar trim. Refer to Trim Replacement - Third Pillar Left (See:
Trim Replacement - Third Pillar Left) and Trim
Replacement - Fourth Pillar Left (See: Trim Replacement - Fourth Pillar Left) .
3. Remove the rear clip on the body side front lower trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement Body Side Front Lower (See: Trim Panel
Replacement - Body Side Front Lower) .
4. Remove the rear clips on the body side front trim panel, upper and lower. Refer to Trim Panel
Replacement - Body Side Front Lower (See: Trim
Panel Replacement - Body Side Front Lower) and Trim Panel Replacement - Body Side Front
Upper (See: Trim Panel Replacement - Body Side Front Upper) .
5. Remove the seat belt upper anchor. Refer to Shoulder Belt Guide Adjuster Replacement - Front
in Seat Belts. 6. Remove the cargo net bolt. 7. Use the J 38778 in order to remove the clips that
retain the trim panel to the vehicle. 8. Pull the trim panel back from the body side panel.
* Remove the seat belt retractor from the body side panel. Refer to appropriate procedure in Seat
Belts:
* Seat Belt Retractor Replacement - Left Front
* Seat Belt Retractor Replacement - Right Front
* Seat Belt Retractor Replacement - Right Rear
* Seat Belt Retractor Replacement - No. 2 Left Rear
* Seat Belt Retractor Replacement - No. 2 Right Rear
9. Squeeze the storage tray from underneath and press out in order to remove the storage tray
from the trim panel.
10. Remove the trim panel from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the panel to the vehicle. 2. Install the retractor through the trim panel. 3. Press the storage
tray into place in order to install the storage tray to the trim panel. 4. Install the seat belt retractor to
the body side panel. 5. Install the trim panel to the body side panel:
1. Align the retaining clips with the holes in the body. 2. Press the panel in order to seat the
fasteners into place.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
6. Install the cargo net bolt.
Tighten the cargo net bolt to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
7. Install the seat belt upper anchor. 8. Remove the rear clip on the body side front lower trim
panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Body Side Front Lower (See: Trim Panel
Replacement - Body Side Front Lower) .
9. Install the rear clips on the body side front trim panel, upper and lower. Refer to Trim Panel
Replacement - Body Side Front Lower (See: Trim
Panel Replacement - Body Side Front Lower) and Trim Panel Replacement - Body Side Front
Upper (See: Trim Panel Replacement - Body Side
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar > Page 8980
Front Upper) .
10. Install the third and the fourth pillar trim. Refer to Trim Replacement - Third Pillar Right (See:
Trim Replacement - Third Pillar Right) and Trim
Replacement - Fourth Pillar Left (See: Trim Replacement - Fourth Pillar Left) .
11. Install the quarter panel swing out window latch. Refer to Window Replacement - Swing Out
(See: Windows and Glass/Windows/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Window Replacement - Swing Out) in Stationary Windows.
Trim Panel Replacement - Right Body Side
Trim Panel Replacement - Right Body Side
Tools Required
J 38778 Door Trim Pad and Garnish Clip Remover
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the C and the D pillar trim. Refer to Trim Replacement - Third Pillar Right (See: Trim
Replacement - Third Pillar Right) and Trim
Replacement - Fourth Pillar Left (See: Trim Replacement - Fourth Pillar Left) .
2. Remove the jack access panel. 3. Remove the upper and the lower belt anchors. Refer to Seat
Belt Retractor Replacement - No. 2 Left Rear or Seat Belt Retractor Replacement No. 2 Right Rear in Seat Belts.
4. Remove the cargo net bolt. 5. Remove the screw that retains the panel to the C pillar.
6. Use the J 38778 in order to release the fasteners that retain the panel to the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the panel to the vehicle:
1. Align the retaining clips with the holes in the body. 2. Press the panel down in order to seat the
fasteners into place.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the screw that retains the panel to the C pillar.
Tighten the screw that retains the panel to the C pillar to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Install the cargo net bolt.
Tighten the cargo net bolt to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
4. Install the jack access panel. 5. Install the upper and the lower mounting bolts for the rear seat
belt. Refer to Seat Belt Retractor Replacement - No. 2 Left Rear Seat Belt
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar > Page 8981
Retractor Replacement - No. 2 Right Rear in seat belts.
6. Install the C and the D pillar trim. Refer to the appropriate procedure:
* Trim Replacement - Third Pillar Right (See: Trim Replacement - Third Pillar Right)
* Trim Replacement - Fourth Pillar Left (See: Trim Replacement - Fourth Pillar Left)
Trim Panel Vent Replace - Body Side Front Lower
Trim Panel Vent Replace - Body Side Front Lower
Removal Procedure
Pull out ward on the vent in order to remove the vent from the trim panel.
Installation Procedure
Press the vent inward in order to install the vent to the trim panel.
Trim Replacement - Fourth Pillar Left
Trim Replacement - Fourth Pillar Left
Tools Required
J 38778 Door Trim Pad and Garnish Clip Remover
Removal Procedure
1. Open the rear door(s).
2. Remove the screws from the panel in the rear door opening. 3. Use J 38778 in order to release
the fasteners that retain the panel to the vehicle. 4. Disconnect the speaker electrical connector, if
equipped.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar > Page 8982
Installation Procedure
1. Connect the speaker electrical connector, if equipped.
2. Install the panel to the vehicle:
1. Align the retaining clips with the holes in the body. 2. Press the panel down in order to seat the
fasteners into place.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the screws to the panel in the rear door opening.
Tighten the screws to the panel in the rear door opening to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Trim Replacement - Fourth Pillar Right
Trim Replacement - Fourth Pillar Right
Tools Required
J 38778 Door Trim Pad and Garnish Clip Remover
Removal Procedure
1. Open the rear door(s).
2. Remove the screws from the panel in the rear door opening. 3. Use J 38778 in order to release
the fasteners that retain the panel to the vehicle. 4. Disconnect the speaker electrical connector, if
equipped.
Installation Procedure
1. Connect the speaker electrical connector, if equipped.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar > Page 8983
2. Install the panel to the vehicle:
1. Align the retaining clips with the holes in the body. 2. Press the panel down in order to seat the
fasteners into place.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the screws to the panel in the rear door opening.
Tighten the screws to the panel in the rear door opening to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Trim Replacement - Third Pillar Left
Trim Replacement - Third Pillar Left
Tools Required
J 38778 Door Pad Trim and Garnish Clip Remover
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the seat belt upper mount. Refer to Shoulder Belt Guide Adjuster Replacement - Front
in Seat Belts. 2. Remove the retaining screw.
3. Use the J 38778 in order to release the fasteners that retain the panel to the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the panel to the vehicle:
1. Align the retaining clips with the holes in the body. 2. Press the panel in order to seat the
fasteners into place.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar > Page 8984
2. Install the retaining screw.
Tighten the retaining screw to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Install the seat belt upper mount. Refer to Shoulder Belt Guide Adjuster Replacement - Front in
Seat Belts.
Trim Replacement - Third Pillar Right
Trim Replacement - Third Pillar Right
Tools Required
J 38778 Door Trim Pad and Garnish Clip Remover.
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the C- pillar retaining screw.
2. Use the J 38778 in order to release the fasteners that retain the panel to the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the panel to the vehicle:
1. Align the C- pillar retaining clips with the holes in the body. 2. Press the panel in order to seat the
fasteners into place.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the C- pillar retaining screw.
Tighten the C- pillar retaining screw to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Window Garnish Molding Replacement
Window Garnish Molding Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the swing-out window latch. Refer to Window Replacement - Swing Out (See: Windows
and Glass/Windows/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Window Replacement - Swing Out) in Stationary Windows.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar > Page 8985
2. Remove the screws that retain the right molding on the sides and the bottom.
3. Remove the screws that retain the left molding on the sides and the bottom. 4. Remove the
molding from the door in the area of the retainers.
There are 2 retainers on top, one in the center of the panel, and 6 around the outside edge.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the left molding to the door:
1. Place the retainers into the holes. 2. Press on the panel at the retainer locations until the
retainers are fully seated.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Garnish Molding Replacement - LF Lock Pillar > Page 8986
2. Install the right molding to the door:
1. Place the retainers into the holes. 2. Press on the panel at the retainer locations until the
retainers are fully seated.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the screws that retain the panel to the door.
Tighten the screws that retain the panel to the door to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
4. Install the swing-out window latch. Refer to Window Replacement - Swing Out (See: Windows
and Glass/Windows/Service and Repair/Removal
and Replacement/Window Replacement - Swing Out) in Stationary Windows.
5. Ensure that the weatherstrip fits into the corner and matches the corner of the radius of the body
flange. 6. Ensure that the weatherstrip is seated completely onto the flange in all areas, resulting in
a smooth, vinyl trim around the entire door opening.
Important: When using the rubber mallet, the weatherstrip must be hit square to the flange.
Otherwise, an undesirable spreading of the carrier will occur, resulting in reduced retention.
7. Ensure that there is no distortion or excessive spreading of the carrier as a result of hitting the
carrier improperly with the rubber mallet. 8. Lubricate the weatherstrip with GM Weatherstrip
Silicone Lubricant P/N 12345579 or equivalent.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Door Locks > Door Lock Cylinder > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Door Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair
Outside Handle and Lock Cylinder Replacement
Removal Procedure
Important: If door lock cylinders require replacement for any reason, apply a coating of GM P/N
12346241 or equivalent lubricant inside of the lock case and the cylinder keyway prior to
assembling and installing the cylinder.
1. Remove the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Door (See: Doors, Hood and
Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front Door Panel/Service and
Repair) .
2. Use a sharp bladed tool in order to separate the water deflector at the perforations. Refer to
Water Deflector Replacement - Front Door. See:
Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front Door Panel/Service and Repair
3. Remove the access hole plug (1). 4. Remove the lock rod from the door handle. 5. Remove the
nuts from the door handle (4).
6. Remove the door handle from the door (2). 7. Remove the lock rod from the lock cylinder (3). 8.
Remove the lock cylinder retainer. 9. Remove the lock cylinder and the gasket (5) from the door.
Installation Procedure
Important: Install new plastic retainer clips whenever the lock rods are removed.
1. Install the gasket (5) and the lock cylinder to the door. 2. Install the lock cylinder retainer . 3.
Install the lock rod to the lock cylinder.
4. Install the handle to the door (2).
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
5. Install the nuts to the door handle (4).
Tighten the nuts to the door handle to 6 N.m (53 lb in).
6. Install the door handle lock rod to the handle. 7. Install the access hole plug (1).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Door Locks > Door Lock Cylinder > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 8992
8. Install the water deflector. Refer to Water Deflector Replacement - Front Door. See: Doors, Hood
and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front Door
Panel/Service and Repair
9. Install the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Door (See: Doors, Hood and
Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front Door Panel/Service and
Repair) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Key > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Locks - Key Code Security Rules and Information
Key: Technical Service Bulletins Locks - Key Code Security Rules and Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 10-00-89-010
Date: May 27, 2010
Subject: Key Code Security Rules and Information on GM KeyCode Look-Up Application (Canada
Only)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior
Saturn and Saab 2002 and Prior Isuzu
Attention:
This bulletin has been created to address potential issues and questions regarding KeyCode
security. This bulletin should be read by all parties involved in KeyCode activity, including dealer
operator, partner security coordinator, sales, service and parts departments. A copy of this bulletin
should be printed and maintained in the parts department for use as a reference.
Important U.S. dealers should refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 10-00-89-009.
Where Are Key Codes Located?
General Motors provides access to KeyCodes through three sources when a vehicle is delivered to
a dealer. Vehicle KeyCodes are located on the original vehicle invoice to the dealership. There is a
small white bar coded tag sent with most new vehicles that also has the key code printed on it.
Dealerships should make a practice of comparing the tag's keycode numbers to the keycode listed
on the invoice. Any discrepancy should be reported immediately to the GM of Canada Key Code
Inquiry Desk. Remember to remove the key tag prior to showing vehicles to potential customers.
The third source for Key codes is through the GM KeyCode Look-Up feature within the
OEConnection D2DLink application. KeyCode Look-Up currently goes back 17 previous model
years from the current model year.
When a vehicle is received by the dealership, care should be taken to safeguard the original
vehicle invoice and KeyCode tag provided with the vehicle. Potential customers should not have
access to the invoice or this KeyCode tag prior to the sale being completed. After a sale has been
completed, the KeyCode information belongs to the customer and General Motors.
Tip
Only the original invoice contains key code information, a re-printed invoice does not.
GM KeyCode Look-Up Application for GM of Canada Dealers
All dealers should review the General Motors of Canada KeyCode Look-Up Policies and
Procedures (Service Policy & Procedures Manual Section 3.1.6 "Replacement of VIN plates &
keys").
Please note that the KeyCode Access site is restricted. Only authorized users should be using this
application. Please see your Parts Manager for site authorized users. KeyCode Look-Up currently
goes back 17 years from current model year.
Important notes about security:
- Users may not access the system from multiple computers simultaneously.
- Users may only request one KeyCode at a time.
- KeyCode information will only be available on the screen for 2 minutes.
- Each user is personally responsible for maintaining and protecting their password.
- Never share your password with others.
- User Id's are suspended after 6 consecutive failed attempts.
- User Id's are disabled if not used for 90 days.
- Processes must be in place for regular dealership reviews.
- The Parts Manager (or assigned management) must have processes in place for employee
termination or life change events. Upon termination individuals access must be turned off
immediately and access should be re-evaluated upon any position changes within the dealership.
- If you think your password or ID security has been breached, contact Dealer Systems Support at
1-800-265-0573.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Key > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Locks - Key Code Security Rules and Information > Page 8997
Each user will be required to accept the following agreement each time the KeyCode application is
used.
Key Code User Agreement
- Key codes are proprietary information belonging to General Motors Corporation and to the vehicle
owner.
- Unauthorized access to, or use of, key code information is unlawful and may subject the user to
criminal and civil penalties.
- This information should be treated as strictly confidential and should not be disclosed to anyone
unless authorized.
I will ensure that the following information is obtained prior to releasing any Key Code information:
1. Government issued picture ID (Drivers License) 2. Registration or other proof of ownership.
Registration should have normal markings from the Province that issued the registration and
possibly the
receipt for payment recorded as well.
Important
- GM takes this agreement seriously. Each user must be certain of vehicle ownership before giving
out key codes.
- When the ownership of the vehicle is in doubt, dealership personnel should not provide the
information.
Key code requests should never be received via a fax or the internet and key codes should never
be provided to anyone in this manner. A face to face contact with the owner of the vehicle is the
expected manner that dealers will use to release a key code or as otherwise stipulated in this
bulletin or other materials.
- Key codes should NEVER be sent via a fax or the internet.
- Each Dealership should create a permanent file to document all KeyCode Look Up transactions.
Requests should be filed by VIN and in each folder retain copies of the following:
- Government issued picture ID (Drivers License)
- Registration or other proof of ownership.
- Copy of the paid customer receipt which has the name of the employee who cut and sold the key
to the customer.
- Do not put yourself or your Dealership in the position of needing to "explain" a KeyCode Look Up
to either GM or law enforcement officials.
- Dealership Management has the ability to review all KeyCode Look-Up transactions.
- Dealership KeyCode documentation must be retained for two years.
Frequently Asked Questions (FAQs) for GM of Canada Dealers
How do I request a KeyCode for customer owned vehicle that is not registered?
Scrapped, salvaged or stored vehicles that do not have a current registration should still have the
ownership verified by requesting the vehicle title, current insurance policy and / or current lien
holder information from the customers financing source. If you cannot determine if the customer is
the owner of the vehicle, do not provide the key code information. In these cases, a short
description of the vehicle (scrapped, salvaged, etc.) and the dealership location should be kept on
file. Any clarifying explanation should be entered into the comments field.
How do I document a KeyCode request for a vehicle that is being repossessed?
The repossessor must document ownership of the vehicle by providing a court ordered
repossession order and lien-holder documents prior to providing key code information. Copies of
the repossessors Drivers License and a business card should be retained by the dealership for
documentation.
What do I do if the registration information is locked in the vehicle?
Every effort should be made to obtain complete information for each request. Each Dealership will
have to decide on a case by case basis if enough information is available to verify the customer's
ownership of the vehicle. Other forms of documentation include vehicle title, insurance policy, and
or current lien information from the customers financing source. Dealership Management must be
involved in any request without complete information. If you cannot determine if the customer is the
owner of the vehicle, do not provide the key code information.
Can I get a print out of the information on the screen?
It is important to note that the Key Code Look Up Search Results contain sensitive and/or
proprietary information. For this reason GM recommends against printing it. If the Search Results
must be printed, store and/or dispose of the printed copy properly to minimize the risk of improper
or illegal use.
Who in the dealership has access to the KeyCode application?
Dealership Parts Manager (or assigned management) will determine, and control, who is
authorized to access the KeyCode Look Up application. However, we anticipate that dealership
parts and service management will be the primary users of the application. The KeyCode Look Up
application automatically tracks each user activity session. Information tracked by the system
includes: User name, User ID, all other entered data and the date/time of access.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Key > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Locks - Key Code Security Rules and Information > Page 8998
What if I input the VIN incorrectly?
If an incorrect VIN is entered into the system (meaning that the system does not recognize the VIN
or that the VIN has been entered incorrectly) the system will return an error message.
If I am an authorized user for the KeyCode application, can I access the application from home?
Yes.
What if I suspect key code misuse?
Your dealership should communicate the proper procedures for requesting key codes. Any
suspicious activity either within the dealership or externally should be reported to Dealer Systems
Support at 1-800-265-0573 or GM of Canada Key Code Inquiry Desk at 1-905-644-4892.
Whose key codes can I access through the system?
At this time the following Canadian vehicle codes are available through the system: Chevrolet,
Cadillac, Buick, Pontiac, GMC, HUMMER (H2 and H3 only), Oldsmobile, Saturn, Saab and Isuzu
(up to 2002 model year) for a maximum of 17 model years.
What should I do if I enter a valid VIN and the system does not produce any key code information?
Occasionally, the KeyCode Look Up application may not produce a key code for a valid VIN. This
may be the result of new vehicle information not yet available. In addition, older vehicle information
may have been sent to an archive status. If you do not receive a key code returned for valid VIN,
you should contact GM of Canada Key Code Inquiry Desk at 1-905-644-4892.
How do I access KeyCodes if the KeyCode Look-up system is down?
If the KeyCode Look-up system is temporarily unavailable, you can contact the original selling
dealer who may have it on file or contact GM of Canada Key Code Inquiry Desk at
1-905-644-4892. If the customer is dealing with an emergency lock-out situation, you need to have
the customer contact Roadside assistance, OnStar if subscribed, or 911.
What should I do if the KeyCode from the look-up system does not work on the vehicle?
On occasion a dealer may encounter a KeyCode that will not work on the vehicle in question. In
cases where the KeyCode won't work you will need to verify with the manufacturer of the cutting
equipment that the key has been cut correctly. If the key has been cut correctly you may be able to
verify the proper KeyCode was given through the original selling dealer. When unable to verify the
KeyCode through the original selling dealer contact GM of Canada Key Code Inquiry Desk at
1-905-644-4892. If the key has been cut correctly and the code given does not work, the lock
cylinder may have been changed. In these situations following the proper SI document for recoding
a key or replacing the lock cylinder may be necessary.
How long do I have to keep KeyCode Records?
Dealership KeyCode documentation must be retained for two years.
Can I get a KeyCode changed in the Look-Up system?
Yes, KeyCodes can be changed in the Look-Up system if a lock cylinder has been changed.
Contact GM of Canada Key Code Inquiry Desk at 1-905-644-4892.
What information do I need before I can provide a driver of a company fleet vehicle Keys or
KeyCode information?
The dealership should have a copy of the individual's driver's license, proof of employment and
registration. If there is any question as to the customer's employment by the fleet company, the
dealer should attempt to contact the fleet company for verification. If there is not enough
information to determine ownership and employment, this information should not be provided.
How do I document a request from an Independent Repair facility for a KeyCode or Key?
The independent must provide a copy of their driver's license, proof of employment and signed
copy of the repair order for that repair facility. The repair order must include customer's name,
address, VIN, city, province and license plate number. Copies of this information must be included
in your dealer KeyCode file.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Key > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Locks - Key Code Security Rules and Information > Page 8999
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Antenna - Keyless Entry > Component
Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Antenna - Keyless Entry > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9004
Antenna - Keyless Entry: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the instrument panel cluster trim plate. 2. Remove the instrument panel cluster. 3.
Disconnect the remote keyless entry antenna (1) from the receiver (2).
4. Remove the remote keyless entry antenna (1) from the carrier. 5. Remove the remote keyless
entry antenna from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Antenna - Keyless Entry > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9005
1. Install the remote keyless entry antenna to the vehicle. 2. Install the remote keyless entry
antenna (1) to the carrier.
3. Connect the remote keyless entry antenna (1) to the receiver (2). 4. Install the instrument panel
cluster. 5. Install the instrument panel cluster trim plate. 6. Reprogram the transmitter. Refer to
Transmitter Programming. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning 7. Verify that
the system operates properly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Receiver > Component
Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Receiver > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9009
Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Receiver > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9010
Keyless Entry Receiver: Service and Repair
REMOTE CONTROL DOOR LOCK RECEIVER REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the left knee bolster. 2. Disconnect the remote keyless entry antenna (2) from the
receiver (5). 3. Disconnect the remote keyless entry electrical connector (4) from the receiver (5). 4.
Remove the remote keyless entry module screws from the bracket (3). 5. Remove the remote
keyless entry module from the carrier.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the remote keyless entry module to the carrier.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the remote keyless entry module screws to the bracket (3).
Tighten Tighten the remote keyless entry module screws to the bracket (3) to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Connect the remote keyless entry antenna (2) to the receiver (5). 4. Connect the remote keyless
entry electrical connector (4) to the receiver (5). 5. Install the left knee bolster. 6. Reprogram the
transmitter. See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Receiver > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9011
7. Verify that the system operates properly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Keyless Entry
Transmitter Battery > Component Information > Service and Repair
Keyless Entry Transmitter Battery: Service and Repair
TRANSMITTER BATTERY REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Insert a small coin between the 2 halves of the transmitter case at the slot provided near the key
ring hole. 2. Twist the coin in order to open the case. 3. Open the transmitter case.
4. Remove the battery (2).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Keyless Entry
Transmitter Battery > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9016
1. Install the battery (2) with the positive (+) side down.
Use one 3 V CR2032 battery (or the equivalent).
2. Close the transmitter case (6, 4).
3. Ensure the seal is in position. Align the 2 halves of the case and snap the two halves together. 4.
Synchronize the transmitter. Refer to Transmitter Synchronization. 5. Replace the batteries when
the range of the transmitter decreases to less than 7 m (23 ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9021
Door Lock Relay
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams
Power Door Lock Switch: Diagrams
Door Lock Switch - Driver
Door Lock Switch - Front Passenger
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 9025
Power Door Lock Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the armrest screws and the armrest YC5. 2. Remove the window handle, if equipped. 3.
Pull out on the escutcheon in order to remove the lock lever escutcheon. Start with the front edge
of the escutcheon. 4. Remove the upper corner trim using the following method:
4.1. Pull the upper corner trim at the top edge.
4.2. Pivot the upper corner trim down in order to clear the tab at the trim panel, YC6 and YC7.
5. Remove the caps that cover the screws for the assist handle. 6. Remove the screws that retain
the assist handle to the door. 7. Remove the screw at the front edge of the accessory switch mount
plate. 8. Remove the plate from the trim panel. 9. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the
switches on the plate, as needed.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Connect the electrical connectors to the switches on the accessory switch mounting plate, as
needed. 2. Install the plate to the trim panel.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the screw at the front edge of the accessory switch mount plate.
Tighten Tighten the screws at the front edge of the accessory switch mount plate to 5 N.m (44 lb
in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 9026
4. Install the assist handle and screws to the door.
Tighten Tighten the assist handle screws to 5 N.m (44 lb in).
5. Install the caps that cover the screws on the assist handle. 6. Insert the tab in the slot on the
door trim panel.
Seat the fastener into the door at the top, YC6 and YC7 in order to install the upper corner trim.
7. Snap the lock lever escutcheon into place in order to install the lock lever escutcheon. Start at
the rear edge of the escutcheon. 8. Install the window handle, if equipped. 9. Install the armrest
and armrest screws, YC5.
Tighten Tighten the armrest screws to 5 N.m (44 lb in).
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article or any of the images therein, refer to the
RPO Code List found at Vehicle/Application See: Application and ID
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Trunk / Liftgate Lock Cylinder > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection
Trunk / Liftgate Lock Cylinder: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Trunk/Liftgate,
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Trunk / Liftgate Lock Cylinder > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Page 9030
Trunk / Liftgate Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair
Lock Cylinder Replacement - Lift Gate
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the liftgate garnish molding. Refer to Garnish Molding Replacement - Lift Gate (See:
Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and
Repair) .
2. Disconnect the electrical connector. 3. Remove the rear wiper motor from the liftgate.
4. Remove the lock cylinder retainer. 5. Remove the lock cylinder from the liftgate.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the lock cylinder to the liftgate. 2. Install the lock cylinder retainer. 3. Install the rear wiper
motor to the liftgate. 4. Connect the electrical connector. 5. Install the liftgate garnish molding.
Refer to Garnish Molding Replacement - Lift Gate (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service
and
Repair) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Heated Element, Mirror > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Mirrors - Heated Mirrors, Defrosting Time
Heated Element: Technical Service Bulletins Mirrors - Heated Mirrors, Defrosting Time
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-08-64-011A
Date: February 25, 2010
Subject: Information on Heated Electrochromatic Outside Rearview Mirror Performance
Models:
2010 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2009 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 08-08-64-011 (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Defrosting Time/Performance Concern
The electrochromatic (auto-dimming) outside rearview mirror used on the driver's side of many GM
vehicles is slower to defrost than the passenger side outside rearview mirror.
This is a normal condition. The glass on the driver's side electrochromatic mirror is twice as thick as
the traditional glass on the passenger side mirror. The heating elements for the mirrors on both
sides draw the same wattage, therefore the driver's side mirror will take approximately twice as
long to defrost as the passenger mirror (approximately four minutes versus two minutes). Should a
customer indicate that the driver's side heated mirror is not functioning correctly, verify it's function
based upon this information prior to replacing the mirror.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Memory Positioning Systems > System Information >
Description and Operation > Personalization
Memory Positioning Systems: Description and Operation Personalization
Personalization features may be set for the vehicle or the driver. Vehicle features do not change
with each driver. Specific drivers are recognized by the vehicle through the keyless entry
transmitters, the memory buttons, or the Driver Information Center (DIC), and the personalization
settings for that driver are recalled. For more information on vehicle personalization features for this
vehicle, refer to Vehicle Personalization.
This vehicle does not have specific driver personalization available.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Memory Positioning Systems > System Information >
Description and Operation > Personalization > Page 9040
Memory Positioning Systems: Description and Operation Vehicle Personalization
PROGRAMMABLE AUTOMATIC DOOR LOCKS (IF EQUIPPED)
If the vehicle has power door locks, it is equipped with a feature that enables you to program the
power door locks.
The vehicle left the factory programmed to automatically lock all doors when the vehicle is shifted
out of PARK (P), and all doors unlock when the vehicle is shifted into PARK (P).
If the vehicle has a manual transmission it left the factory programmed to lock all doors when the
vehicle speed is greater than 24 km/h (15 mph) for two seconds, and unlock all doors once the key
is removed from the ignition.
The following instructions detail how enter the programming mode for the power door lock feature:
1. Begin with the ignition in OFF. Then pull the signal/multifunction lever all the way toward you and
hold it there while you perform the next step. 2. Turn the key to RUN and OFF twice. Then, with the
key in OFF, release the turn signal/multifunction lever. Once you do this you will hear the
lock switch lock and unlock.
3. You are now ready to program the automatic door locks. Select one of the following four
programming options and follow the instructions. You
will have 30 seconds to complete programming. If you exceed the 30 second limit, The locks will
automatically lock and unlock to indicate that you have left the program mode. If this occurs, repeat
the procedure beginning with step 1. You can exit the program mode any time by turning the
ignition to RUN. If the LOCK/UNLOCK switches are not pressed while in the programming mode,
the current LOCK/UNLOCK mode will not be modified. ^
The following is a list of available programming options:
^ All doors lock/Only the driver's door unlocks: Press the lock side of the power door lock switch on
the door panel once, and then the unlock side once.
^ All doors lock/All doors unlock: Press the lock side of the power door lock switch on the door
panel once, and then the unlock side twice.
^ All doors lock/None of the doors unlock: Press the lock side of the power door lock switch on the
door panel once, and then the unlock side three times.
^ No doors lock/None of the doors unlock: Press the lock side of the power door lock switch on the
door panel twice. This turns off the automatic door lock feature.
ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
Refer to Power Door Locks Description and Operation in Doors for more information about the
automatic door lock feature.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 05-08-51-008C > Jun > 09 > Body - Bumps or Rust Colored Spots in Paint
Paint: Customer Interest Body - Bumps or Rust Colored Spots in Paint
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 05-08-51-008C
Date: June 22, 2009
Subject: Bumps or Rust Colored Spots in Paint Due to Rail or Iron Dust (Remove Rail Dust)
Models:
1994-2010 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2010 HUMMER H2
2006-2010 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 05-08-51-008B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Condition
Visible rust colored spots or bumps on a vehicle's paint surface from rail or iron dust.
Cause
Rail dust comes from tiny iron particles produced from the friction between train wheels and the
tracks and gets deposited on the vehicle surfaces. Iron dust can get deposited on the surface if the
vehicle is stored near any operation producing iron dust such as an iron ore yard. Either material
can lay on top of, or become embedded in, the paint surface.
Correction
Because the severity of the condition varies, proper diagnosis of the damage is critical to the
success of repairs. Diagnosis should be performed on horizontal surfaces (hood, roof, deck lid, pick
up box, etc.) after the vehicle has been properly cleaned. There are two types of repair materials
recommended to repair rail dust or iron dust:
1. GEL TYPE OXALIC ACID:
- Has the characteristics of the liquid type oxalic acid but stays where you put it because of its gel
consistency.
2. CLAY TYPE NON-ACID BASED:
- Requires surface lubricant during use. - Has different grades available.
Caution
Rail dust remover (Oxalic Acid) is an acidic substance containing chemicals that will break down
the iron particles embedded in the finish. When working with rail dust remover, use the necessary
safety equipment, including gloves and goggles. Follow the chemical manufacturer's directions
closely because it may require special handling and disposal.
If, upon inspection, some particles are still present, the various chemical manufacturer's processes
can be repeated.
After the removal process, small pits may remain in the clearcoat and can be corrected, in most
cases, with a finesse/polish operation.
Procedure
1. Move the vehicle to a cool shaded area and make sure that the vehicle surfaces are cool during
the removal process. DO NOT PERFORM THE
REMOVAL PROCESS IN DIRECT SUNLIGHT OR ON A VEHICLE WITH HOT OR WARM BODY
PANELS.
2. Wash the vehicle with soap and water. Dry it immediately and clean the affected areas with a
wax and grease remover. 3. Perform the removal process according to the chemical
manufacturer's directions.
Once the damage has been repaired, the final step involves a polishing process.
Rail Dust Remover Manufacturers
Use the chemical manufacturers listed below, or equivalent:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 05-08-51-008C > Jun > 09 > Body - Bumps or Rust Colored Spots in Paint > Page
9050
Auto Magic(R) or Clay Magic(R) products available from:
Auto Wax Company, Inc. 1275 Round Table Dr. Dallas, TX 75247 (800) 826-0828 (Toll-Free) or
(214) 631-4000 (Local) Fax (214) 634-1342 www.automagic.com
[email protected]
E038 Fallout Gel or E038E Liquid Fallout Remover II available from:
Valvoline Car Brite Company 1910 South State Avenue Indianapolis, In 46203 (800) 347-2439 (Toll
Free) or (317) 788-9925 (Local) Fax (317) 788-9930 www.carbrite.com
[email protected] *We
believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products from these firms or for any such items which may be available from
other sources.
If rail dust remover is not available in your area, call one of the numbers listed above for a
distributor near your location.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
Important Refer to the Policy & Procedures Manual, section 1.2.1.7 for detailed information
regarding warranty coverage for this condition.
Important In certain cases where the vehicle finish is severely damaged and the actual repair time
exceeds the published time, the additional time should be submitted in the "Other Labor Hours"
field.
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Paint: > 05-08-51-008C > Jun > 09 > Body - Bumps or Rust Colored
Spots in Paint
Paint: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Bumps or Rust Colored Spots in Paint
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 05-08-51-008C
Date: June 22, 2009
Subject: Bumps or Rust Colored Spots in Paint Due to Rail or Iron Dust (Remove Rail Dust)
Models:
1994-2010 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2010 HUMMER H2
2006-2010 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 05-08-51-008B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Condition
Visible rust colored spots or bumps on a vehicle's paint surface from rail or iron dust.
Cause
Rail dust comes from tiny iron particles produced from the friction between train wheels and the
tracks and gets deposited on the vehicle surfaces. Iron dust can get deposited on the surface if the
vehicle is stored near any operation producing iron dust such as an iron ore yard. Either material
can lay on top of, or become embedded in, the paint surface.
Correction
Because the severity of the condition varies, proper diagnosis of the damage is critical to the
success of repairs. Diagnosis should be performed on horizontal surfaces (hood, roof, deck lid, pick
up box, etc.) after the vehicle has been properly cleaned. There are two types of repair materials
recommended to repair rail dust or iron dust:
1. GEL TYPE OXALIC ACID:
- Has the characteristics of the liquid type oxalic acid but stays where you put it because of its gel
consistency.
2. CLAY TYPE NON-ACID BASED:
- Requires surface lubricant during use. - Has different grades available.
Caution
Rail dust remover (Oxalic Acid) is an acidic substance containing chemicals that will break down
the iron particles embedded in the finish. When working with rail dust remover, use the necessary
safety equipment, including gloves and goggles. Follow the chemical manufacturer's directions
closely because it may require special handling and disposal.
If, upon inspection, some particles are still present, the various chemical manufacturer's processes
can be repeated.
After the removal process, small pits may remain in the clearcoat and can be corrected, in most
cases, with a finesse/polish operation.
Procedure
1. Move the vehicle to a cool shaded area and make sure that the vehicle surfaces are cool during
the removal process. DO NOT PERFORM THE
REMOVAL PROCESS IN DIRECT SUNLIGHT OR ON A VEHICLE WITH HOT OR WARM BODY
PANELS.
2. Wash the vehicle with soap and water. Dry it immediately and clean the affected areas with a
wax and grease remover. 3. Perform the removal process according to the chemical
manufacturer's directions.
Once the damage has been repaired, the final step involves a polishing process.
Rail Dust Remover Manufacturers
Use the chemical manufacturers listed below, or equivalent:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Paint: > 05-08-51-008C > Jun > 09 > Body - Bumps or Rust Colored
Spots in Paint > Page 9056
Auto Magic(R) or Clay Magic(R) products available from:
Auto Wax Company, Inc. 1275 Round Table Dr. Dallas, TX 75247 (800) 826-0828 (Toll-Free) or
(214) 631-4000 (Local) Fax (214) 634-1342 www.automagic.com
[email protected]
E038 Fallout Gel or E038E Liquid Fallout Remover II available from:
Valvoline Car Brite Company 1910 South State Avenue Indianapolis, In 46203 (800) 347-2439 (Toll
Free) or (317) 788-9925 (Local) Fax (317) 788-9930 www.carbrite.com
[email protected] *We
believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products from these firms or for any such items which may be available from
other sources.
If rail dust remover is not available in your area, call one of the numbers listed above for a
distributor near your location.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
Important Refer to the Policy & Procedures Manual, section 1.2.1.7 for detailed information
regarding warranty coverage for this condition.
Important In certain cases where the vehicle finish is severely damaged and the actual repair time
exceeds the published time, the additional time should be submitted in the "Other Labor Hours"
field.
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Paint: > 08-08-51-002 > Mar > 08 > Body - TPO Fascia Cleaning Prior
to Painting
Paint: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - TPO Fascia Cleaning Prior to Painting
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-08-51-002
Date: March 12, 2008
Subject: New Primer For TPO Fascias and Affected Cleaning Process of Painting Operation
Models: 2009 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3
The purpose of this bulletin is to inform the technician that General Motors has made a change in
the primer it uses for TPO plastic for service parts. This new primer comes in several different
colors from five different suppliers. This change affects the cleaning process of the painting
operation. The new process is as follows.
1. Wash with soap and water.
2. Clean with a 50% mix of isopropyl alcohol and water (or a waterborne cleaner). Check with your
paint supplier for product recommendations.
3. Scuff sand per your paint suppliers recommendations.
Note:
The use of a solvent-type cleaner will soften, or begin to dissolve the primer. Base coats do not
have any affect on this primer.
4. Reclean with a 50% mix of isopropyl alcohol and water (or a waterborne cleaner).
All fascias, with the exception of the Corvette, Camaro, and Cadillac XLR, are made of TPO. You
may find other TPO parts with this primer. If the technician has a question as to the type of plastic
they are painting, inspect the back of the part for the plastic symbol (TPO).
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > 08-08-51-002 > Mar > 08 > Body - TPO Fascia Cleaning Prior to
Painting
Paint: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - TPO Fascia Cleaning Prior to Painting
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-08-51-002
Date: March 12, 2008
Subject: New Primer For TPO Fascias and Affected Cleaning Process of Painting Operation
Models: 2009 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3
The purpose of this bulletin is to inform the technician that General Motors has made a change in
the primer it uses for TPO plastic for service parts. This new primer comes in several different
colors from five different suppliers. This change affects the cleaning process of the painting
operation. The new process is as follows.
1. Wash with soap and water.
2. Clean with a 50% mix of isopropyl alcohol and water (or a waterborne cleaner). Check with your
paint supplier for product recommendations.
3. Scuff sand per your paint suppliers recommendations.
Note:
The use of a solvent-type cleaner will soften, or begin to dissolve the primer. Base coats do not
have any affect on this primer.
4. Reclean with a 50% mix of isopropyl alcohol and water (or a waterborne cleaner).
All fascias, with the exception of the Corvette, Camaro, and Cadillac XLR, are made of TPO. You
may find other TPO parts with this primer. If the technician has a question as to the type of plastic
they are painting, inspect the back of the part for the plastic symbol (TPO).
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > Page 9066
Paint: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 05-08-51-008C Date: 090622
Body - Bumps or Rust Colored Spots in Paint
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 05-08-51-008C
Date: June 22, 2009
Subject: Bumps or Rust Colored Spots in Paint Due to Rail or Iron Dust (Remove Rail Dust)
Models:
1994-2010 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2010 HUMMER H2
2006-2010 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 05-08-51-008B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Condition
Visible rust colored spots or bumps on a vehicle's paint surface from rail or iron dust.
Cause
Rail dust comes from tiny iron particles produced from the friction between train wheels and the
tracks and gets deposited on the vehicle surfaces. Iron dust can get deposited on the surface if the
vehicle is stored near any operation producing iron dust such as an iron ore yard. Either material
can lay on top of, or become embedded in, the paint surface.
Correction
Because the severity of the condition varies, proper diagnosis of the damage is critical to the
success of repairs. Diagnosis should be performed on horizontal surfaces (hood, roof, deck lid, pick
up box, etc.) after the vehicle has been properly cleaned. There are two types of repair materials
recommended to repair rail dust or iron dust:
1. GEL TYPE OXALIC ACID:
- Has the characteristics of the liquid type oxalic acid but stays where you put it because of its gel
consistency.
2. CLAY TYPE NON-ACID BASED:
- Requires surface lubricant during use. - Has different grades available.
Caution
Rail dust remover (Oxalic Acid) is an acidic substance containing chemicals that will break down
the iron particles embedded in the finish. When working with rail dust remover, use the necessary
safety equipment, including gloves and goggles. Follow the chemical manufacturer's directions
closely because it may require special handling and disposal.
If, upon inspection, some particles are still present, the various chemical manufacturer's processes
can be repeated.
After the removal process, small pits may remain in the clearcoat and can be corrected, in most
cases, with a finesse/polish operation.
Procedure
1. Move the vehicle to a cool shaded area and make sure that the vehicle surfaces are cool during
the removal process. DO NOT PERFORM THE
REMOVAL PROCESS IN DIRECT SUNLIGHT OR ON A VEHICLE WITH HOT OR WARM BODY
PANELS.
2. Wash the vehicle with soap and water. Dry it immediately and clean the affected areas with a
wax and grease remover. 3. Perform the removal process according to the chemical
manufacturer's directions.
Once the damage has been repaired, the final step involves a polishing process.
Rail Dust Remover Manufacturers
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > Page 9067
Use the chemical manufacturers listed below, or equivalent:
Auto Magic(R) or Clay Magic(R) products available from:
Auto Wax Company, Inc. 1275 Round Table Dr. Dallas, TX 75247 (800) 826-0828 (Toll-Free) or
(214) 631-4000 (Local) Fax (214) 634-1342 www.automagic.com
[email protected]
E038 Fallout Gel or E038E Liquid Fallout Remover II available from:
Valvoline Car Brite Company 1910 South State Avenue Indianapolis, In 46203 (800) 347-2439 (Toll
Free) or (317) 788-9925 (Local) Fax (317) 788-9930 www.carbrite.com
[email protected] *We
believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products from these firms or for any such items which may be available from
other sources.
If rail dust remover is not available in your area, call one of the numbers listed above for a
distributor near your location.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
Important Refer to the Policy & Procedures Manual, section 1.2.1.7 for detailed information
regarding warranty coverage for this condition.
Important In certain cases where the vehicle finish is severely damaged and the actual repair time
exceeds the published time, the additional time should be submitted in the "Other Labor Hours"
field.
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
Disclaimer
Technical Service Bulletin # 05-08-51-008C Date: 090622
Body - Bumps or Rust Colored Spots in Paint
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > Page 9068
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 05-08-51-008C
Date: June 22, 2009
Subject: Bumps or Rust Colored Spots in Paint Due to Rail or Iron Dust (Remove Rail Dust)
Models:
1994-2010 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2010 HUMMER H2
2006-2010 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 05-08-51-008B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Condition
Visible rust colored spots or bumps on a vehicle's paint surface from rail or iron dust.
Cause
Rail dust comes from tiny iron particles produced from the friction between train wheels and the
tracks and gets deposited on the vehicle surfaces. Iron dust can get deposited on the surface if the
vehicle is stored near any operation producing iron dust such as an iron ore yard. Either material
can lay on top of, or become embedded in, the paint surface.
Correction
Because the severity of the condition varies, proper diagnosis of the damage is critical to the
success of repairs. Diagnosis should be performed on horizontal surfaces (hood, roof, deck lid, pick
up box, etc.) after the vehicle has been properly cleaned. There are two types of repair materials
recommended to repair rail dust or iron dust:
1. GEL TYPE OXALIC ACID:
- Has the characteristics of the liquid type oxalic acid but stays where you put it because of its gel
consistency.
2. CLAY TYPE NON-ACID BASED:
- Requires surface lubricant during use. - Has different grades available.
Caution
Rail dust remover (Oxalic Acid) is an acidic substance containing chemicals that will break down
the iron particles embedded in the finish. When working with rail dust remover, use the necessary
safety equipment, including gloves and goggles. Follow the chemical manufacturer's directions
closely because it may require special handling and disposal.
If, upon inspection, some particles are still present, the various chemical manufacturer's processes
can be repeated.
After the removal process, small pits may remain in the clearcoat and can be corrected, in most
cases, with a finesse/polish operation.
Procedure
1. Move the vehicle to a cool shaded area and make sure that the vehicle surfaces are cool during
the removal process. DO NOT PERFORM THE
REMOVAL PROCESS IN DIRECT SUNLIGHT OR ON A VEHICLE WITH HOT OR WARM BODY
PANELS.
2. Wash the vehicle with soap and water. Dry it immediately and clean the affected areas with a
wax and grease remover. 3. Perform the removal process according to the chemical
manufacturer's directions.
Once the damage has been repaired, the final step involves a polishing process.
Rail Dust Remover Manufacturers
Use the chemical manufacturers listed below, or equivalent:
Auto Magic(R) or Clay Magic(R) products available from:
Auto Wax Company, Inc.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > Page 9069
1275 Round Table Dr. Dallas, TX 75247 (800) 826-0828 (Toll-Free) or (214) 631-4000 (Local) Fax
(214) 634-1342 www.automagic.com
[email protected] E038 Fallout Gel or E038E
Liquid Fallout Remover II available from:
Valvoline Car Brite Company 1910 South State Avenue Indianapolis, In 46203 (800) 347-2439 (Toll
Free) or (317) 788-9925 (Local) Fax (317) 788-9930 www.carbrite.com
[email protected] *We
believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products from these firms or for any such items which may be available from
other sources.
If rail dust remover is not available in your area, call one of the numbers listed above for a
distributor near your location.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
Important Refer to the Policy & Procedures Manual, section 1.2.1.7 for detailed information
regarding warranty coverage for this condition.
Important In certain cases where the vehicle finish is severely damaged and the actual repair time
exceeds the published time, the additional time should be submitted in the "Other Labor Hours"
field.
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Application
and ID > Paint Code Charts
Paint: Application and ID Paint Code Charts
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Application
and ID > Paint Code Charts > Page 9072
Paint: Application and ID Paint Identification Precautions
PAINT IDENTIFICATION
Caution: Exposure to isocyanates during paint preparation and application processes can cause
severe breathing problems. Read and follow all of the instructions from the manufacturers of
painting materials, equipment, and protective gear.
Important
Always refer to the GM Approved Refinish Materials book GM PIN 4901 MD This book identities
the paint systems you may use.
The basecoat/clearcoat paint is factory applied in the following 4 layers in order to give the finish a
high gloss look:
1. A cathodic immersion primer
2. A primer/surfacer
3. A basecoat
4. A clear top coat (clearcoat)
Refer to the Service Parts ID Label to identify the type of top coat on the vehicle. This label
contains all paint related information for the vehicle. This includes paint technology, paint codes,
trim level, and any special order paint colors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Application
and ID > Paint Code Charts > Page 9073
Paint: Application and ID Parts ID Label Location
LABEL - SERVICE PARTS ID
Label - Service Parts ID
The Service Parts Identification Label aids the service personnel in identifying the parts and options
originally installed on the vehicle. The label is located on the front passenger door frame.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Application
and ID > Paint Code Charts > Page 9074
Paint: Application and ID Basecoat/Clearcoat Paint Systems
Basecoat/Clearcoat Paint Systems
Caution: Exposure to isocyanates during paint preparation and application processes can cause
severe breathing problems. Read and follow all of the instructions from the manufacturers of
painting materials, equipment, and protective gear.
Caution: Refer to Eye Protection Caution in Cautions and Notices.
All paint finish repairs of rigid exterior surfaces must meet GM standards. The GM Approved
Refinish Materials book GM P/N GM4901M-D-99 identifies the paint systems you may use. Always
refer to the latest revision of the 4901M-D book. All approved products, including volatile organic
compound (VOC) compliant regulations are listed in the system approach recommended by the
individual manufacturer. Refer to the manufacturer's instructions for the detailed procedures for
materials used in the paint system in the painting repairs of rigid exterior surfaces. All components
of an approved paint system have been engineered in order to ensure proper adhesion between
layers.
If necessary, spot repairs or color blending in an open panel can be done. However, do not blend
clearcoat in an open panel. Always apply clearcoat to the next break point (body side molding,
feature line, or the next panel.)
Do not mix paint systems or substitute a product of one manufacturer for another manufacturer's
product. If incompatible products are used together the following problems may occur:
* Lifting of primer coats caused by overly aggressive solvents in subsequent layers
* Loss of adhesion between layers due to incompatibility of resin systems
* Solvent popping or pinholing due to inappropriate solvent selection
* Poor through-curing due to incompatible hardener resins or insufficient reactivity
* Gloss reduction due to incompatible resins and/or solvents
* Poor color accuracy due to pigment interactions with incompatible resins and/or solvents
* Film defects (craters, blisters, orange peel loss of gloss) due to the use of inferior quality raw
materials in incompatible products
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Application
and ID > Paint Code Charts > Page 9075
Paint: Application and ID Paint Identification
Paint Identification
Caution: Exposure to isocyanates during paint preparation and application processes can cause
severe breathing problems. Read and follow all of the instructions from the manufacturers of
painting materials, equipment, and protective gear.
Important: Always refer to the GM Approved Refinish Materials book GM P/N 4901M-D. This book
identifies the paint systems you may use.
The basecoat/clearcoat paint is factory applied in the following 4 layers in order to give the finish a
high gloss look:
* A cathodic immersion primer
* A primer/surfacer
* A basecoat
* A clear top coat (clearcoat)
Refer to Label - Service Parts ID (See: Application and ID/Label - Service Parts ID) in General
Information in order to identify the type of top coat on the vehicle. This label contains all paint
related information for the vehicle. This includes paint technology, paint codes, trim level, and any
special order paint colors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Radiator Support > Component Information > Service and Repair
Radiator Support: Service and Repair
Support Replacement - Center
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the grille. Refer to Grille Replacement (See: Grille/Service and Repair/Grille
Replacement) in Exterior Trim. 2. Remove the outside air temperature sensor and wiring, if
equipped. 3. Remove the center support bracket bolts.
4. Remove the support bracket from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the center support bracket to the vehicle.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the support bracket bolts.
Tighten the bolts to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
3. Install the outside air temperature sensor and wiring, if equipped.
4. Install the grille. Refer to Grille Replacement (See: Grille/Service and Repair/Grille Replacement)
in Exterior Trim.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9083
Door Lock Relay
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Luggage Rack > Component
Information > Specifications
Luggage Rack: Specifications
Fastener Tightening Specifications
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Luggage Rack > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Luggage Rack: Procedures
LUGGAGE CARRIER REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the rubber side rail cap from the center support. 2. Remove the bolts from the center
supports. 3. Remove the bolts from the end supports. 4. Remove the luggage carrier as an
assembly from the roof with an assistant. 5. Remove the side rail support gaskets.
6. Remove the screws from the side rail supports. 7. Remove the side rail supports from the side
rails. 8. Remove the screws from the cross rails. 9. Remove the cross rails from the sliders.
10. Remove the screws from the sliders and the lock plates. 11. Remove the sliders from the slots
in the side rails.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Luggage Rack > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 9090
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the sliders into the slots in the side rails. 2. Install the screws into the sliders and the lock
plates. 3. Install the cross rails onto the sliders.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the screws to the cross rails.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
5. Install the side rail supports to the side rails. 6. Install the screws to the side rail supports.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
7. Install the side rail support gaskets to the roof. 8. Install the luggage carrier as an assembly onto
the roof with an assistant. 9. Install the screws to the end supports.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 3 N.m (27 lb in).
10. Install the screws into the center supports.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 3 N.m (27 lb in).
11. Install the rubber side rail cap onto the center support.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Luggage Rack > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 9091
Luggage Rack: Removal and Replacement
Luggage Carrier Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the rubber side rail cap from the center support. 2. Remove the bolts from the center
supports. 3. Remove the bolts from the end supports. 4. Remove the luggage carrier as an
assembly from the roof with an assistant. 5. Remove the side rail support gaskets.
6. Remove the screws from the side rail supports. 7. Remove the side rail supports from the side
rails. 8. Remove the screws from the cross rails. 9. Remove the cross rails from the sliders.
10. Remove the screws from the sliders and the lock plates. 11. Remove the sliders from the slots
in the side rails.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the sliders into the slots in the side rails. 2. Install the screws into the sliders and the lock
plates. 3. Install the cross rails onto the sliders.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Luggage Rack > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 9092
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
4. Install the screws to the cross rails.
Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
5. Install the side rail supports to the side rails. 6. Install the screws to the side rail supports.
Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
7. Install the side rail support gaskets to the roof. 8. Install the luggage carrier as an assembly onto
the roof with an assistant. 9. Install the screws to the end supports.
Tighten the screws to 3 N.m (27 lb in).
10. Install the screws into the center supports.
Tighten the screws to 3 N.m (27 lb in).
11. Install the rubber side rail cap onto the center support.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Head Rest > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Head Restraint Replacement - Rear Seat
Head Rest: Service and Repair Head Restraint Replacement - Rear Seat
Head Restraint Replacement - Rear Seat
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the headrest. 2. If an assistant is available, proceed as follows:
1. Press the locking tabs on the headrest bushings in and down at a 45 degree angle in order to
release them. 2. Have the assistant lift up on the headrest. 3. Remove the headrest.
3. If working alone, proceed as follows:
1. Using 1 hand, depress 1 locking tab.
Use the other hand to lift up on the same side of the headrest.
2. While continuing to pull up on the headrest, depress the locking tab on the other side of the
headrest bushing. 3. Remove the headrest from the seat back.
Installation Procedure
1. Align the post of the headrest with the holes in the seat back.
2. Manipulate the posts within the seat back until the posts fall into the holes in the headrest
bushing. 3. Press the headrest all the way into the seat. 4. Raise the headrest in order to verify that
the locks are engaged.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Head Rest > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Head Restraint Replacement - Rear Seat > Page 9098
Head Rest: Service and Repair Head Restraint Replacement (YC6)
Head Restraint Replacement (YC6)
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the headrest.
2. Using a pointed tool, release the retainer on either side of the headrest while pulling up on the
headrest. 3. Remove the headrest from the seat.
Installation Procedure
1. Align the headrest posts with the openings in the seat back. 2. Press the headrest down into the
seat to the fully lowered position. 3. Pull the headrest back up in order to assure the retainers are
functioning properly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Head Rest > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Head Restraint Replacement - Rear Seat > Page 9099
Head Rest: Service and Repair Head Restraint Replacement (YC7)
Head Restraint Replacement (YC7)
Removal Procedure
1. Raise the headrest. 2. If an assistant is available, proceed as follows:
1. Press the locking tabs on the headrest bushings in and down at a 45 degree angle in order to
release them. 2. Have the assistant lift up on the headrest. 3. Remove the headrest.
3. If working alone, proceed as follows:
1. Using one hand, depress one locking tab.
Use the other hand to lift up on that side of the headrest.
2. While continuing to pull up on the headrest, depress the locking tab on the other side of the
headrest bushing. 3. Remove the headrest from the seat back.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the headrest to the seat back. 2. Push down on the headrest. 3. While continuing to press
down on the headrest, depress the locking tab on the other side of the headrest bushing. 4. The
locking tabs should click into place.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Head Rest > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Head Restraint Replacement - Rear Seat > Page 9100
Head Rest: Service and Repair Bucket Seat Head Restraint Bushing Replacement
Bucket Seat Head Restraint Bushing Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the seat back cover and pad. Refer to Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement (YC5
and YC6) (See: Seat Back/Service and Repair/Seat
Back Cover and Pad Replacement (YC5 and YC6))Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement (YC7)
(See: Seat Back/Service and Repair/Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement (YC7)) .
2. Remove the headrest bushings from the seat back frame as follows:
1. Squeeze together the retaining tabs at the base of the bushing. 2. Remove the bushing by lifting
the bushing up.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the headrest bushings by pressing the bushings into the seat back frame until the
retaining tabs snap into place. 2. Install the seat back trim cover and pad assembly. Refer to Seat
Back Cover and Pad Replacement (YC5 and YC6) (See: Seat Back/Service and
Repair/Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement (YC5 and YC6))Seat Back Cover and Pad
Replacement (YC7) (See: Seat Back/Service and Repair/Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement
(YC7)) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Head Restraint System > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Restraints - Driver/Passenger Seat Head Rest Information
Head Restraint System: Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Driver/Passenger Seat Head Rest
Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 10-08-50-003A
Date: March 24, 2011
Subject: Information on Driver or Passenger Seat Head Restraint Concerns with Comfort, Custom
Upholstery or Other Comfort Enhancing Devices
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Equipped with Adjustable Head Restraints
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 10-08-50-003 (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Important ON A GM VEHICLE EQUIPPED WITH ADJUSTABLE HEAD RESTRAINTS, USE THE
HEAD RESTRAINT COVERS, FOAM AND OTHER SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT AS
RELEASED BY GM FOR THAT VEHICLE. DO NOT ALTER OR REPOSITION THE HEAD
RESTRAINT SYSTEM. ANY ALTERATIONS TO HEAD RESTRAINTS DEFEATS THE INTENDED
DESIGN OF THE SYSTEM. GM WILL NOT BE LIABLE FOR ANY PROBLEMS CAUSED BY USE
OF SUCH IMPROPER DESIGN ALTERATIONS, INCLUDING ANY WARRANTY REPAIRS
INCURRED.
You may have a customer with a concern that the head restraint is uncomfortable or sits too far
forward. The front driver and passenger seats are equipped with head restraints that have been
designed to help minimize injuries while still providing comfort to the occupants. Each GM vehicle
has its own specifically designed head restraint.
The head restraints should only be used in the vehicle for which they were designed. The head
restraint will not operate to its design intent if the original foam is replaced (1) by non-GM foam or
head restraint, (2) by GM foam or head restraint designed for a different vehicle, (3) by GM foam or
head restraint that has been altered by a trim shop or (4) if any object, such as an aftermarket
comfort enhancing pad or device, is installed.
Never modify the design of the head restraint or remove the head restraint from the vehicle as this
may interfere with the operation of the seating and restraint systems and may prevent proper
positioning of the passenger within the vehicle.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Memory Positioning Systems > System Information >
Description and Operation > Personalization
Memory Positioning Systems: Description and Operation Personalization
Personalization features may be set for the vehicle or the driver. Vehicle features do not change
with each driver. Specific drivers are recognized by the vehicle through the keyless entry
transmitters, the memory buttons, or the Driver Information Center (DIC), and the personalization
settings for that driver are recalled. For more information on vehicle personalization features for this
vehicle, refer to Vehicle Personalization.
This vehicle does not have specific driver personalization available.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Memory Positioning Systems > System Information >
Description and Operation > Personalization > Page 9109
Memory Positioning Systems: Description and Operation Vehicle Personalization
PROGRAMMABLE AUTOMATIC DOOR LOCKS (IF EQUIPPED)
If the vehicle has power door locks, it is equipped with a feature that enables you to program the
power door locks.
The vehicle left the factory programmed to automatically lock all doors when the vehicle is shifted
out of PARK (P), and all doors unlock when the vehicle is shifted into PARK (P).
If the vehicle has a manual transmission it left the factory programmed to lock all doors when the
vehicle speed is greater than 24 km/h (15 mph) for two seconds, and unlock all doors once the key
is removed from the ignition.
The following instructions detail how enter the programming mode for the power door lock feature:
1. Begin with the ignition in OFF. Then pull the signal/multifunction lever all the way toward you and
hold it there while you perform the next step. 2. Turn the key to RUN and OFF twice. Then, with the
key in OFF, release the turn signal/multifunction lever. Once you do this you will hear the
lock switch lock and unlock.
3. You are now ready to program the automatic door locks. Select one of the following four
programming options and follow the instructions. You
will have 30 seconds to complete programming. If you exceed the 30 second limit, The locks will
automatically lock and unlock to indicate that you have left the program mode. If this occurs, repeat
the procedure beginning with step 1. You can exit the program mode any time by turning the
ignition to RUN. If the LOCK/UNLOCK switches are not pressed while in the programming mode,
the current LOCK/UNLOCK mode will not be modified. ^
The following is a list of available programming options:
^ All doors lock/Only the driver's door unlocks: Press the lock side of the power door lock switch on
the door panel once, and then the unlock side once.
^ All doors lock/All doors unlock: Press the lock side of the power door lock switch on the door
panel once, and then the unlock side twice.
^ All doors lock/None of the doors unlock: Press the lock side of the power door lock switch on the
door panel once, and then the unlock side three times.
^ No doors lock/None of the doors unlock: Press the lock side of the power door lock switch on the
door panel twice. This turns off the automatic door lock feature.
ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
Refer to Power Door Locks Description and Operation in Doors for more information about the
automatic door lock feature.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 9113
Power Seat Motor: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding the diagnosis of this component and the system that it is a part of,
please refer to Seats Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 9117
Seat Adjuster Switch - Driver
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 9118
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding the diagnosis of this component and the system that it is a part of,
please refer to Seats Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 9119
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair
Seat Switch Replacement - Power
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the screws that retain the power seat switch to the seat.
2. Disconnect the electrical connector from the power seat switch. 3. Remove the power seat
switch.
Installation Procedure
1. Connect the power seat switch electrical connector. 2. Install the power seat switch.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 9120
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the screws that retain the power seat switch to the seat.
Tighten the power seat switch retaining screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front
Seat Back: Service and Repair Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the bucket seat from the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service
and Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) .
2. Remove the seat back cover and pad . Refer to Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement (YC5
and YC6) (See: Seat Back Cover and Pad
Replacement (YC5 and YC6))Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement (YC7) (See: Seat Back
Cover and Pad Replacement (YC7)) .
3. Remove the lumbar support cable. Refer to Lumbar Support Cable Replacement (See: Service
and Repair/Lumbar Support Cable Replacement) . 4. Remove the bolts from the seat back hinges
on the right and left side.
5. Remove the seat back frame.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the seat back frame.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the bolts to the seat back hinges on the right and left side.
Tighten the bolts to the seat back hinges on the right and left side to 30 N.m (22 lb in).
3. Install the lumbar support cable. Refer to Lumbar Support Cable Replacement (See: Service and
Repair/Lumbar Support Cable Replacement) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front > Page 9125
4. Install the seat back cover and pad. Refer to Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement (YC5 and
YC6) (See: Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement
(YC5 and YC6))Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement (YC7) (See: Seat Back Cover and Pad
Replacement (YC7)) .
5. Install the bucket seat in the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front > Page 9126
Seat Back: Service and Repair Seat Back Hinge Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6)
Seat Back Hinge Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6)
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the bucket seat from the seat riser. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service
and Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) . 2. Remove the seat cover J-hook from the seat cushion
frame:
1. Remove the J-hook at the rear of the seat. 2. Remove the J-hook on the side of the seat
containing the seat back hinge. 3. Remove the J-hook that retains the cover to the carpet on the
back of the seat on the side of the seat containing the seat back hinge.
Important: Note the position and length of all the bolts removed. This will assist with reassembly.
3. Remove the bolts that retain the seat back hinge to the seat cushion frame. 4. Remove the
armrests, if equipped. Refer to Armrest Replacement (YC6) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm
Rest/Service and Repair/Armrest
Replacement (YC6))Armrest Replacement (YC7) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service
and Repair/Armrest Replacement (YC7)) .
5. Lift the seat back cover and pad above the bolts that retain the seat back hinge to the seat back
frame.
Important: Note the position and length of all the bolts removed. This will assist with reassembly.
6. Remove the bolts that retain the seat back hinge to the seat back frame.
Important: Handle the seat carefully when just one side of the seat back is attached to the seat
cushion. Improper handling may damage the seat back hinge or the lumbar support cable.
7. Remove the seat back hinge from the seat back frame.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the seat back hinge to the seat back frame.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the bolts retaining the seat back hinge to the seat back frame.
Install the bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Tighten the bolts retaining the seat back hinge to the seat back frame to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
3. Install the armrests, if equipped. Refer to Armrest Replacement (YC6) (See: Interior Moulding /
Trim/Arm Rest/Service and Repair/Armrest
Replacement (YC6))Armrest Replacement (YC7) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service
and Repair/Armrest Replacement (YC7)) .
4. Install the bolts that retain the seat back hinge to the seat cushion frame.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front > Page 9127
Install the bolts in the locations from which they were removed, as noted during disassembly.
Tighten the bolts that retain the seat back hinge to the seat cushion frame to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
5. Install the seat cushion J-hook to the seat cushion frame as follows:
1. Install the J-hook that retains the seat cover to the carpet on the back of the seat on the side of
the seat containing the recliner. 2. Install the J-hook to the seat frame on the side of the seat
containing the seat back hinge. 3. Install the J-hook to the rear of the seat back.
6. Install the bucket seat to the riser. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front > Page 9128
Seat Back: Service and Repair Seat Back Hinge Replacement - Front (YC7)
Seat Back Hinge Replacement - Front (YC7)
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the bucket seat from the seat riser. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service
and Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) . 2. Remove the armrest from the same side of the seat as
the hinge. Refer to Armrest Replacement (YC6) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm
Rest/Service and Repair/Armrest Replacement (YC6))Armrest Replacement (YC7) (See: Interior
Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service and Repair/Armrest Replacement (YC7)) .
3. Remove the J-hooks that retains the carpet on the seat back cushion and to the corners of the
seat cushion cover. 4. Remove the seat cover and pad. Refer toSeat Back Cover and Pad
Replacement (YC5 and YC6) (See: Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement
(YC5 and YC6))Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement (YC7) (See: Seat Back Cover and Pad
Replacement (YC7)) .
Important: Note the position and length of all the bolts removed. This will assist with reassembly.
5. Remove the bolts that retain the seat back hinges to the seat cushion and the seat back frame.
Important: Handle the seat carefully when just one side of the seat back is attached to the seat
cushion. Improper handling may damage the seat back hinge or the lumbar support cable.
6. Remove the seat back hinges from the seat frame.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the seat back hinges to the seat frame.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the bolts that retain the seat back hinges to the seat back frame and to the seat cushion
frame.
Tighten the bolts that retain the seat back hinges to the seat back frame and the seat cushion
frame to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
3. Install the bolts in the locations noted during disassembly. 4. Install seat cover and pad. Refer to
Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement (YC5 and YC6) (See: Seat Back Cover and Pad
Replacement (YC5
and YC6))Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement (YC7) (See: Seat Back Cover and Pad
Replacement (YC7)) .
5. Install the J-hooks that retain the carpet to the seat back and to seat cushion frame and to the
corners of the seat cushion cover. 6. Install the armrest. Refer to Armrest Replacement (YC6)
(See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service and Repair/Armrest Replacement
(YC6))Armrest Replacement (YC7) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service and
Repair/Armrest Replacement (YC7)) .
7. Install the bucket seat to the riser. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front > Page 9129
Seat Back: Service and Repair Seat Back Recliner Replacement - Front (YC5, YC6)
Seat Back Recliner Replacement - Front (YC5, YC6)
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the bucket seat from the riser. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) . 2. Remove the screw that retain the recliner handle to the
recliner. 3. Remove the following seat cover J-hooks from the seat cushion frame:
* The J-hook at the rear of the seat.
* The J-hook on the recliner side of the seat.
* The J-hook on the recliner side of the seat that retains the seat back cover and to the carpet to
the seat back.
Important: When removing the recliner retaining bolts, note the position and length of the bolts.
This will assist with reassembly.
4. Remove the bolts that retain the recliner to the seat cushion frame. 5. Remove the armrests, if
equipped. Refer to Armrest Replacement (YC6) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service
and Repair/Armrest
Replacement (YC6))Armrest Replacement (YC7) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service
and Repair/Armrest Replacement (YC7)) .
6. Lift the seat back cover and pad above the bolts that retain the recliner to the seat back frame.
Important: When removing the bolts, note the position and length of the bolts. This will assist with
reassembly.
7. Remove the bolts that retain the recliner.
Important: Handle the seat carefully when just one side of the seat back is attached to the seat
cushion. Improper handling may damage the seat back hinge or the lumbar support cable.
8. Remove the recliner from the seat back frame.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the recliner to the seat back frame.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the bolts that retain the recliner to the seat back frame. Install the bolts in the locations
noted during removal.
Tighten the bolts that retain the recliner to the seat back frame to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
3. Refit the seat back cover and pad over the bolts that retain the recliner to the seat back frame. 4.
Install the armrests, if equipped. Refer to Armrest Replacement (YC6) (See: Interior Moulding /
Trim/Arm Rest/Service and Repair/Armrest
Replacement (YC6))Armrest Replacement (YC7) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service
and Repair/Armrest Replacement (YC7)) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front > Page 9130
5. Install the bolts that retain the recliner to the seat cushion frame. Install the bolts in the positions
from which they were removed, as noted during
disassembly.
Tighten the bolts that retain the recliner to the seat cushion frame to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
6. Install the seat cover J-hooks to the seat cushion frame as follows:
1. Install the J-hook that retain the seat cover to the carpet on the back of the recliner side of the
seat. 2. Install the J-hook to the seat frame on the recliner side of the seat. 3. Install the J-hook at
the rear of the seat.
7. Install the screw that retains the recliner handle to the recliner.
Tighten the screw that retains the recliner handle to the recliner to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
8. Install the bucket seat to the riser. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front > Page 9131
Seat Back: Service and Repair
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the bucket seat from the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service
and Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) .
2. Remove the seat back cover and pad . Refer to Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement (YC5
and YC6) (See: Seat Back Cover and Pad
Replacement (YC5 and YC6))Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement (YC7) (See: Seat Back
Cover and Pad Replacement (YC7)) .
3. Remove the lumbar support cable. Refer to Lumbar Support Cable Replacement (See: Service
and Repair/Lumbar Support Cable Replacement) . 4. Remove the bolts from the seat back hinges
on the right and left side.
5. Remove the seat back frame.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the seat back frame.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the bolts to the seat back hinges on the right and left side.
Tighten the bolts to the seat back hinges on the right and left side to 30 N.m (22 lb in).
3. Install the lumbar support cable. Refer to Lumbar Support Cable Replacement (See: Service and
Repair/Lumbar Support Cable Replacement) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front > Page 9132
4. Install the seat back cover and pad. Refer to Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement (YC5 and
YC6) (See: Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement
(YC5 and YC6))Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement (YC7) (See: Seat Back Cover and Pad
Replacement (YC7)) .
5. Install the bucket seat in the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) .
Seat Back Hinge Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6)
Seat Back Hinge Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6)
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the bucket seat from the seat riser. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service
and Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) . 2. Remove the seat cover J-hook from the seat cushion
frame:
1. Remove the J-hook at the rear of the seat. 2. Remove the J-hook on the side of the seat
containing the seat back hinge. 3. Remove the J-hook that retains the cover to the carpet on the
back of the seat on the side of the seat containing the seat back hinge.
Important: Note the position and length of all the bolts removed. This will assist with reassembly.
3. Remove the bolts that retain the seat back hinge to the seat cushion frame. 4. Remove the
armrests, if equipped. Refer to Armrest Replacement (YC6) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm
Rest/Service and Repair/Armrest
Replacement (YC6))Armrest Replacement (YC7) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service
and Repair/Armrest Replacement (YC7)) .
5. Lift the seat back cover and pad above the bolts that retain the seat back hinge to the seat back
frame.
Important: Note the position and length of all the bolts removed. This will assist with reassembly.
6. Remove the bolts that retain the seat back hinge to the seat back frame.
Important: Handle the seat carefully when just one side of the seat back is attached to the seat
cushion. Improper handling may damage the seat back hinge or the lumbar support cable.
7. Remove the seat back hinge from the seat back frame.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the seat back hinge to the seat back frame.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front > Page 9133
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the bolts retaining the seat back hinge to the seat back frame.
Install the bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Tighten the bolts retaining the seat back hinge to the seat back frame to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
3. Install the armrests, if equipped. Refer to Armrest Replacement (YC6) (See: Interior Moulding /
Trim/Arm Rest/Service and Repair/Armrest
Replacement (YC6))Armrest Replacement (YC7) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service
and Repair/Armrest Replacement (YC7)) .
4. Install the bolts that retain the seat back hinge to the seat cushion frame.
Install the bolts in the locations from which they were removed, as noted during disassembly.
Tighten the bolts that retain the seat back hinge to the seat cushion frame to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
5. Install the seat cushion J-hook to the seat cushion frame as follows:
1. Install the J-hook that retains the seat cover to the carpet on the back of the seat on the side of
the seat containing the recliner. 2. Install the J-hook to the seat frame on the side of the seat
containing the seat back hinge. 3. Install the J-hook to the rear of the seat back.
6. Install the bucket seat to the riser. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) .
Seat Back Hinge Replacement - Front (YC7)
Seat Back Hinge Replacement - Front (YC7)
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the bucket seat from the seat riser. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service
and Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) . 2. Remove the armrest from the same side of the seat as
the hinge. Refer to Armrest Replacement (YC6) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm
Rest/Service and Repair/Armrest Replacement (YC6))Armrest Replacement (YC7) (See: Interior
Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service and Repair/Armrest Replacement (YC7)) .
3. Remove the J-hooks that retains the carpet on the seat back cushion and to the corners of the
seat cushion cover. 4. Remove the seat cover and pad. Refer toSeat Back Cover and Pad
Replacement (YC5 and YC6) (See: Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement
(YC5 and YC6))Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement (YC7) (See: Seat Back Cover and Pad
Replacement (YC7)) .
Important: Note the position and length of all the bolts removed. This will assist with reassembly.
5. Remove the bolts that retain the seat back hinges to the seat cushion and the seat back frame.
Important: Handle the seat carefully when just one side of the seat back is attached to the seat
cushion. Improper handling may damage the seat back hinge or the lumbar support cable.
6. Remove the seat back hinges from the seat frame.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front > Page 9134
Installation Procedure
1. Install the seat back hinges to the seat frame.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the bolts that retain the seat back hinges to the seat back frame and to the seat cushion
frame.
Tighten the bolts that retain the seat back hinges to the seat back frame and the seat cushion
frame to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
3. Install the bolts in the locations noted during disassembly. 4. Install seat cover and pad. Refer to
Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement (YC5 and YC6) (See: Seat Back Cover and Pad
Replacement (YC5
and YC6))Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement (YC7) (See: Seat Back Cover and Pad
Replacement (YC7)) .
5. Install the J-hooks that retain the carpet to the seat back and to seat cushion frame and to the
corners of the seat cushion cover. 6. Install the armrest. Refer to Armrest Replacement (YC6)
(See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service and Repair/Armrest Replacement
(YC6))Armrest Replacement (YC7) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service and
Repair/Armrest Replacement (YC7)) .
7. Install the bucket seat to the riser. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) .
Seat Back Recliner Replacement - Front (YC5, YC6)
Seat Back Recliner Replacement - Front (YC5, YC6)
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the bucket seat from the riser. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) . 2. Remove the screw that retain the recliner handle to the
recliner. 3. Remove the following seat cover J-hooks from the seat cushion frame:
* The J-hook at the rear of the seat.
* The J-hook on the recliner side of the seat.
* The J-hook on the recliner side of the seat that retains the seat back cover and to the carpet to
the seat back.
Important: When removing the recliner retaining bolts, note the position and length of the bolts.
This will assist with reassembly.
4. Remove the bolts that retain the recliner to the seat cushion frame. 5. Remove the armrests, if
equipped. Refer to Armrest Replacement (YC6) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service
and Repair/Armrest
Replacement (YC6))Armrest Replacement (YC7) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service
and Repair/Armrest Replacement (YC7)) .
6. Lift the seat back cover and pad above the bolts that retain the recliner to the seat back frame.
Important: When removing the bolts, note the position and length of the bolts. This will assist with
reassembly.
7. Remove the bolts that retain the recliner.
Important: Handle the seat carefully when just one side of the seat back is attached to the seat
cushion. Improper handling may damage
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front > Page 9135
the seat back hinge or the lumbar support cable.
8. Remove the recliner from the seat back frame.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the recliner to the seat back frame.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the bolts that retain the recliner to the seat back frame. Install the bolts in the locations
noted during removal.
Tighten the bolts that retain the recliner to the seat back frame to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
3. Refit the seat back cover and pad over the bolts that retain the recliner to the seat back frame. 4.
Install the armrests, if equipped. Refer to Armrest Replacement (YC6) (See: Interior Moulding /
Trim/Arm Rest/Service and Repair/Armrest
Replacement (YC6))Armrest Replacement (YC7) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service
and Repair/Armrest Replacement (YC7)) .
5. Install the bolts that retain the recliner to the seat cushion frame. Install the bolts in the positions
from which they were removed, as noted during
disassembly.
Tighten the bolts that retain the recliner to the seat cushion frame to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
6. Install the seat cover J-hooks to the seat cushion frame as follows:
1. Install the J-hook that retain the seat cover to the carpet on the back of the recliner side of the
seat. 2. Install the J-hook to the seat frame on the recliner side of the seat. 3. Install the J-hook at
the rear of the seat.
7. Install the screw that retains the recliner handle to the recliner.
Tighten the screw that retains the recliner handle to the recliner to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
8. Install the bucket seat to the riser. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) .
Seat Back Recliner Replacement - Front (YC7)
Seat Back Recliner Replacement - Front (YC7)
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the bucket seat from the riser. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) . 2. Remove the armrest from the recliner side of the seat.
Refer to Armrest Replacement (YC6) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service and
Repair/Armrest Replacement (YC6))Armrest Replacement (YC7) (See: Interior Moulding /
Trim/Arm Rest/Service and Repair/Armrest Replacement (YC7)) .
3. Remove the J-hooks that retain the carpet on the back of the seat cushion to the corners of the
seat cushion trim cover. 4. Remove the screw that retains the seat back recliner handle to the
recliner.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front > Page 9136
Important: When removing the bolts that retain the seat back recliner, note the position and length
of the bolts. This will assist with reassembly.
5. Remove the bolts that retain the recliner to the seat back and seat cushion frames.
Important: Handle the seat carefully when just one side of the seat back is attached to the seat
cushion. Improper handling may damage the seat back hinge or the lumbar support cable.
6. Remove the seat back recliner from the seat frame.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the seat back recliner to the seat frame.
2. Install the seat back bolts that retain the recliner to the seat back and the seat cushion frame.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the seat back bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Tighten the seat back bolts that retain the recliner to the seat back and the seat cushion frames to
30 N.m (22 lb ft).
4. Install the screw that retains the seat back recliner handle to the seat back recliner.
Tighten the screw that retains the seat back recliner handle to the seat back recliner to 2 N.m (18 lb
in).
5. Install the J-hooks that retain the carpet to the seat back and to seat cushion frame and to the
corners of the seat cushion cover. 6. Install the armrest to the seat back recliner side of the seat.
Refer to Armrest Replacement (YC6) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm
Rest/Service and Repair/Armrest Replacement (YC6))Armrest Replacement (YC7) (See: Interior
Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service and Repair/Armrest Replacement (YC7)) .
7. Install the bucket seat to the riser. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) .
Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement - Rear (YC5 and YC6)
Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement - Rear (YC5 and YC6)
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the rear bench seat from the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Rear Bench (See:
Service and Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear Bench) . 2. Remove the headrests. Refer to Head
Restraint Replacement (YC6) (See: Head Rest/Service and Repair/Head Restraint Replacement
(YC6))Head
Restraint Replacement (YC7) (See: Head Rest/Service and Repair/Head Restraint Replacement
(YC7)) .
3. Remove the rear seat armrests, if equipped. Refer to Armrest Replacement - Rear Seat (YC7)
(See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service
and Repair/Armrest Replacement - Rear Seat (YC7))Armrest Replacement - Rear Seat (YC5 and
YC6) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service and Repair/Armrest Replacement - Rear
Seat (YC5 and YC6)) .
4. Remove the right and left seat back hinge. Refer to Seat Back Hinge Trim Replacement - Rear
Right (YC6) (See: Seat Back Hinge Trim
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front > Page 9137
Replacement - Rear Right (YC6)) and Seat Back Hinge Trim Replacement - Rear Left (See: Seat
Back Hinge Trim Replacement - Rear Left) .
5. Remove the headrest bushings.
6. Unzip the seat back cover. 7. Remove the seat back cover and pad from the seat back frame.
Important: Note the locations of the hog rings. This will assist with reassembly.
8. Remove the hog rings that retain the seat back cover to the pad. 9. Remove the seat back cover
from the pad.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the seat back cover to the pad.
Important: Note install the hog rings in the locations noted during disassembly.
2. Install the hog rings in order to retain the seat back cover to the pad. 3. Install the seat back
cover and pad to the seat back frame.
4. Zip the seat back cover closed.
5. Press the headrest bushings into place. 6. Install the right and left seat back hinge. Refer to Seat
Back Hinge Trim Replacement - Rear Right (YC6) (See: Seat Back Hinge Trim
Replacement - Rear Right (YC6)) and Seat Back Hinge Trim Replacement - Rear Left (See: Seat
Back Hinge Trim Replacement - Rear Left) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front > Page 9138
7. Install the rear seat armrests, if equipped. Refer to Armrest Replacement - Rear Seat (YC7)
(See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service and
Repair/Armrest Replacement - Rear Seat (YC7))Armrest Replacement - Rear Seat (YC5 and YC6)
(See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service and Repair/Armrest Replacement - Rear Seat
(YC5 and YC6)) .
8. Install the headrests. Refer to Head Restraint Replacement (YC6) (See: Head Rest/Service and
Repair/Head Restraint Replacement (YC6))Head
Restraint Replacement (YC7) (See: Head Rest/Service and Repair/Head Restraint Replacement
(YC7)) .
9. Install the rear bench seat to the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Rear Bench (See: Service
and Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear Bench) .
Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement - Rear (YC7)
Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement - Rear (YC7)
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the rear bench seat to the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Rear Bench (See:
Service and Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear Bench) . 2. Remove the rear seat headrest. Refer to
Head Restraint Replacement (YC6) (See: Head Rest/Service and Repair/Head Restraint
Replacement
(YC6))Head Restraint Replacement (YC7) (See: Head Rest/Service and Repair/Head Restraint
Replacement (YC7)) .
3. Remove the rear seat armrests. Refer to Armrest Replacement (YC6) (See: Interior Moulding /
Trim/Arm Rest/Service and Repair/Armrest
Replacement (YC6))Armrest Replacement (YC7) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service
and Repair/Armrest Replacement (YC7)) .
4. Remove the J-hook along the bottom edge of the seat back. 5. Separate the J-hook fasteners
that retain the sea back cover to the pad along the seat back break line.
6. Remove the seat back cover and pad from the seat back.
7. Remove the pad from the seat back frame.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the pad to the seat back frame.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front > Page 9139
Important: For the best finished appearance, proceed as follows when attaching the seat back
cover to the pad:
2. Install the seat back cover to the seat back.
1. Center the seat back cover on the pad. 2. Starting at the top and working down the sides, apply
pressure along the break line in order to help attach the seat back cover to the J-hook to
the frame and attach the hook and loop.
3. Install the seat back to the frame and attach. 4. Install the armrests. Refer to Armrest
Replacement (YC6) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service and Repair/Armrest
Replacement
(YC6))Armrest Replacement (YC7) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service and
Repair/Armrest Replacement (YC7)) .
5. Install the headrests. Refer to Head Restraint Replacement (YC6) (See: Head Rest/Service and
Repair/Head Restraint Replacement (YC6))Head
Restraint Replacement (YC7) (See: Head Rest/Service and Repair/Head Restraint Replacement
(YC7)) .
6. Install the rear bench seat to the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Rear Bench (See: Service
and Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear Bench) .
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Rear (YC7)
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Rear (YC7)
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the rear bench seat from the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Rear Bench (See:
Service and Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear Bench) . 2. Remove the seat back cover and pad.
Refer to Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement - Rear (YC5 and YC6) (See: Seat Back Cover
and Pad
Replacement - Rear (YC5 and YC6))Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement - Rear (YC7) (See:
Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement - Rear (YC7)) .
Important: Note the position and the length of the bolts removed. This will assist with reassembly.
3. Remove the right and left bolts that retain the seat back frame to the seat back hinges.
4. Remove the seat back frame.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front > Page 9140
1. Install the seat back frame.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the bolts that retain the seat back frame to the seat back hinges in the locations noted
during disassembly.
Tighten the bolts that retain the seat back frame to the seat back hinges to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
3. Install the seat back cover and pad. Refer to Seat Cushion Cover and Pad Replacement - Rear
(See: Seat Cushion/Service and Repair/Seat
Cushion Cover and Pad Replacement - Rear) .
4. Install the bench seat in the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Rear Bench (See: Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear Bench) .
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Rear (YC5 and YC6)
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Rear (YC5 and YC6)
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the bench seat from the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Rear Bench (See:
Service and Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear Bench) . 2. Remove the seat back cover and pad.
Refer to Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement - Rear (YC5 and YC6) (See: Seat Back Cover
and Pad
Replacement - Rear (YC5 and YC6))Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement - Rear (YC7) (See:
Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement - Rear (YC7)) .
3. Remove the headrest bushing. Refer to Bucket Seat Head Restraint Bushing Replacement (See:
Head Rest/Service and Repair/Bucket Seat Head
Restraint Bushing Replacement) .
4. Remove the rear seat latch release cable. Refer to Seat Back Latch Release Cable
Replacement - Rear (See: Seat Back Latch Release Cable
Replacement - Rear) .
5. Remove the right and left seat back frame hinge bolts.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front > Page 9141
6. Remove the seat back frame.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the seat back frame.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the right and left seat back frame hinge bolts.
Tighten the right and left seat back frame hinge bolts to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
3. Install the rear seat latch release cable. Refer to Seat Back Latch Release Cable Replacement Rear (See: Seat Back Latch Release Cable
Replacement - Rear) .
4. Install the headrest bushing. Refer to Bucket Seat Head Restraint Bushing Replacement (See:
Head Rest/Service and Repair/Bucket Seat Head
Restraint Bushing Replacement)
5. Install the seat back cover and pad. Refer to Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement - Rear
(YC5 and YC6) (See: Seat Back Cover and Pad
Replacement - Rear (YC5 and YC6))Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement - Rear (YC7) (See:
Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement - Rear (YC7)) .
6. Install the bench seat to the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Rear Bench (See: Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear Bench) .
Seat Back Hinge Replacement - Rear (YC5 and YC6)
Seat Back Hinge Replacement - Rear (YC5 and YC6)
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the rear bench seat from the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Rear Bench (See:
Service and Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear Bench) . 2. Remove the right and left sides of the
seat back hinge trim. Refer to Seat Back Hinge Trim Replacement - Rear Right (YC6) (See: Seat
Back
Hinge Trim Replacement - Rear Right (YC6)) and Seat Back Hinge Trim Replacement - Rear Left
(See: Seat Back Hinge Trim Replacement - Rear Left) .
Important: Note the position and the length of the bolts removed. This will assist with reassembly.
3. Remove the bolts that retain the seat back hinge to the seat back frame and the seat cushion
frame. 4. Remove the latch release cable from the seat back hinge.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front > Page 9142
5. Remove the seat back hinge from the seat cushion frame.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the seat back hinge to the seat cushion frame. 2. Install the latch release cable to the seat
back hinge.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the right and left bolts that retain the seat back hinge to the seat back frame and the seat
cushion frame in the locations noted during
disassembly.
Tighten the right and left bolts retaining the seat back hinge to the seat back frame and the seat
cushion frame to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
4. Install the right and left sides of the rear seat back hinge trim. Refer to Seat Back Hinge Trim
Replacement - Rear Right (YC6) (See: Seat Back
Hinge Trim Replacement - Rear Right (YC6)) and Seat Back Hinge Trim Replacement - Rear Left
(See: Seat Back Hinge Trim Replacement - Rear Left) .
5. Install the rear bench seat to the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Rear Bench (See: Service
and Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear Bench) .
Seat Back Hinge Replacement - Rear (YC7)
Seat Back Hinge Replacement - Rear (YC7)
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the rear bench seat from the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Rear Bench (See:
Service and Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear Bench) . 2. Remove the carpet covering the center of
the seat cushion frame along the rear edge of the seat , near the inner hinge.
Important: Note the position of the hog rings for reassembly.
3. Remove the hog rings that retain the carpet to the frame.
Important: Note the position and length of the bolts removed. This will assist with reassembly.
4. Remove the bolt that retain the inner seat back hinge to the seat cushion frame. 5. Remove the
hook and loop fastener at the rear corner of the seat cushion cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front > Page 9143
6. Remove the hog rings that retain the seat back cover to the seat cushion frame along the side of
the seat cover.
* Remove only as many hog rings as necessary to gain access to the seat back hinge mounting
bolts on the seat cushion frame.
* Note the locations of the hog rings removed. This will assist with reassembly.
Important: Note the position and length of the bolts removed. This will assist with reassembly.
7. Remove the bolts that retain the seat back hinge to the seat cushion frame.
8. Remove the seat back and the seat back hinges from the seat back frame. 9. Remove the
armrests. Refer to Armrest Replacement - Rear Seat (YC7) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm
Rest/Service and Repair/Armrest
Replacement - Rear Seat (YC7))Armrest Replacement - Rear Seat (YC5 and YC6) (See: Interior
Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service and Repair/Armrest Replacement - Rear Seat (YC5 and YC6)) .
10. Remove the bolts that retain the seat back seat back hinges to the seat back frame. 11.
Remove the seat back hinges from the seat back frame.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the seat back hinges to the seat back frame.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions in Notices.
2. Install the bolts that retain the seat back hinges to the seat back frame in the locations noted
during disassembly.
Tighten the bolts that retain the seat back hinges to the seat back frame to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
3. Install the armrests. Refer to Seat Replacement - Rear Bench (See: Service and Repair/Seat
Replacement - Rear Bench) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front > Page 9144
4. Install the seat back and seat back hinges to the seat.
5. Install the bolts that retain the seat back hinge to the seat cushion frame in the locations noted
during disassembly.
Tighten the bolts that retain the seat back hinge to the seat cushion frame to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
6. Install the hog rings that retain the seat cushion cover and pad to the seat cushion frame along
the side of the seat cushion in the locations noted
during disassembly.
7. Connect the hook and loop fastener at the rear corner of the seat cushion cover. 8. Install the
bolt that retains the inner seat back hinge to the seat cushion frame.
Tighten the bolt that retain the inner seat back hinge to the seat cushion frame to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
9. Install the hog rings in the locations noted during disassembly.
10. Install the carpet covering the center of the seat cushion frame along the rear edge of the seat,
near the inner hinge. 11. Install the rear bench seat to the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement Rear Bench (See: Service and Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear Bench) .
Seat Back Hinge Trim Replacement - Rear Left
Seat Back Hinge Trim Replacement - Rear Left
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the rear bench seat to the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Rear Bench (See:
Service and Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear Bench) . 2. Remove the screw retaining the lower
hinge cover.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front > Page 9145
3. Pry off the lower hinge cover.
4. Pry off the upper hinge cover.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the upper seat back hinge cover as follows:
1. Align the fasteners with the hinge.
2. Press the lower seat back hinge cover into place.
2. Install the lower seat back hinge cover as follows:
1. Align the fasteners with the hinge.
2. Press the upper seat back hinge cover into place.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the lower seat back hinge cover retaining screw.
Tighten the lower seat back hinge cover retaining screw to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
4. Install the rear bench seat to the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Rear Bench (See: Service
and Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear Bench) .
Seat Back Recliner Handle Replacement - Front
Seat Back Recliner Handle Replacement - Front
Removal Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front > Page 9146
1. Remove the screw that retains the seat back recliner lever to the seat back recliner. 2. Remove
the seat back recliner lever from the seat back recliner.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the seat back recliner lever to the seat back recliner.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the screw that retains the seat back recliner lever.
Tighten the screw that retain the seat back recliner lever to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement (YC5 and YC6)
Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement (YC5 and YC6)
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the bucket seat from the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service
and Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) . 2. Remove the armrests. Refer to Armrest Replacement
(YC6) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service and Repair/Armrest Replacement
(YC6))Armrest Replacement (YC7) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service and
Repair/Armrest Replacement (YC7)) .
3. Disconnect the J-hook fasteners at the bottom corners of the seat back.
4. Remove the seat back cover and pad from the seat back frame.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front > Page 9147
Important: Note the locations of the hog rings. This will assist with reassembly.
5. Remove the hog rings that retain the seat back cover to the pad.
6. Remove the seat back cover from the pad.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the seat back cover to the pad.
Important: Install the hog rings that retain the seat back cover to the pad in the locations noted
during disassembly.
2. Install the hog rings to seat back cover to the pad.
3. Install the seat back and pad to the seat back frame. 4. Connect the J-hook fasteners at the
bottom corner of the seat back.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front > Page 9148
5. Install the armrests. Refer to Armrest Replacement (YC6) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm
Rest/Service and Repair/Armrest Replacement
(YC6))Armrest Replacement (YC7) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service and
Repair/Armrest Replacement (YC7)) .
6. Install the bucket seat in the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) .
Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement (YC7)
Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement (YC7)
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the bucket seat from the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service
and Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) . 2. Remove the headrest. Refer to Head Restraint
Replacement (YC6) (See: Head Rest/Service and Repair/Head Restraint Replacement
(YC6))Head
Restraint Replacement (YC7) (See: Head Rest/Service and Repair/Head Restraint Replacement
(YC7)) .
3. Remove the armrests. Refer to Armrest Replacement (YC6) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm
Rest/Service and Repair/Armrest Replacement
(YC6))Armrest Replacement (YC7) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service and
Repair/Armrest Replacement (YC7)) .
4. Disconnect the hook-and-loop fasteners that retain the seat cushion cover to the pad along the
seat back break line.
5. Remove the seat back cover and pad from the seat back.
Installation Procedure
Important: For the best finished appearance when attaching the seat back cover to the pad,
proceed as follows:
1. Install the seat back pad to the seat back frame. 2. Center the seat back cover on the pad. 3.
Starting at the top and working down the sides, apply pressure along the break line. This helps
attach the seat back cover to the J-hook fasteners. 4. Reset the hook-and-loop fasteners that retain
the seat back cushion to the pad. 5. Install the armrests. Refer to Armrest Replacement (YC6)
(See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service and Repair/Armrest Replacement
(YC6))Armrest Replacement (YC7) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Arm Rest/Service and
Repair/Armrest Replacement (YC7)) .
6. Install the headrest. Refer to Head Restraint Replacement (YC6) (See: Head Rest/Service and
Repair/Head Restraint Replacement (YC6))Head
Restraint Replacement (YC7) (See: Head Rest/Service and Repair/Head Restraint Replacement
(YC7)) .
7. Install the bucket seat in the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) .
Seat Back Latch Release Cable Replacement - Rear
Seat Back Latch Release Cable Replacement - Rear
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the bench seat from the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Rear Bench (See:
Service and Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear Bench) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front > Page 9149
2. Unzip the seat back cover. 3. Remove the seat back cushion cover and pad. Refer to Seat Back
Cover and Pad Replacement - Rear (YC5 and YC6) (See: Seat Back Cover and
Pad Replacement - Rear (YC5 and YC6))Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement - Rear (YC7)
(See: Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement - Rear (YC7)) .
4. Remove the seat back cable end from the seat back latch.
5. Remove the seat back latch release cable from the clips that retains the cable to the seat back
frame. 6. Remove the seat back latch release cable from the seat back frame.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the seat back latch release cable to the seat back frame.
2. Install the seat back latch release cable to the clips that retain the cable to the seat back frame.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front > Page 9150
3. Install the seat back cable end to the seat back latch. 4. Install the seat back cushion cover and
pad. Refer to Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement - Rear (YC5 and YC6) (See: Seat Back
Cover and
Pad Replacement - Rear (YC5 and YC6))Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement - Rear (YC7)
(See: Seat Back Cover and Pad Replacement - Rear (YC7)) .
5. Zip the seat back cover. 6. Install the bench seat to the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement Rear Bench (See: Service and Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear Bench) .
Seat Back Hinge Trim Replacement - Rear Right (YC6)
Seat Back Hinge Trim Replacement - Rear Right (YC6)
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the rear bench seat to the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Rear Bench (See:
Service and Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear Bench) .
2. Remove the screw that retains the lower seat back hinge cover . 3. Pry off the lower seat back
hinge cover. 4. Remove the latch lever escutcheon as follows:
1. Unfasten the J-hook fastener along the inner edge of the escutcheon. 2. Lift the inner edge of
the escutcheon. 3. Pivot the escutcheon in order to clear the latch lever and the retaining tabs at
the seat back hinge upper cover.
5. Pry off the upper seat back hinge.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the upper seat back hinge cover:
1. Align the seat back hinge cover fasteners with the hinge. 2. Press the seat back hinge cover into
place.
2. Install the latch lever escutcheon:
1. Pivot the escutcheon so that the escutcheon retaining tabs engage the slots on the upper hinge
cover and clear the latch lever. 2. Attach the J-hook fasteners at the escutcheon's inner edge to the
carpet on the back of the seat back trim cover.
3. Install the lower hinge cover:
1. Align the seat back hinge cover fasteners with the hinge. 2. Press the seat back hinge cover into
place.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front > Page 9151
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
4. Install the screw that retains the lower seat back hinge cover .
Tighten the lower seat back hinge cover retaining screw to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
5. Install the rear bench seat to the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Rear Bench (See: Service
and Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear Bench) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Interior - Seat Cover Wrinkle/Crease/Burn Info
Seat Cover: Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Seat Cover Wrinkle/Crease/Burn Info
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-08-50-006D
Date: September 09, 2010
Subject: Minor Wrinkles/Creases, Discoloration, Cigarette Burns and Customer Induced Cuts and
Stains on Front and Rear Driver and Passenger Seats with Leather, Vinyl or Cloth Seat Covers
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2 2010 and
Prior HUMMER H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X 2010 and Prior Saturn
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add a model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-08-50-006C (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
If a customer comes in to your dealership due to certain conditions of the seat covers (splits,
wrinkles, loose stitching, etc.), you must examine the seat cover in order to determine the validity of
the customer claim. Some components from the above listed vehicles have been returned to the
Warranty Parts Center (WPC) and analysis of these parts showed "customer induced damage" or
No Trouble Found (NTF).
The dealer should pay particular attention to the following conditions:
- Cigarette burns
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Interior - Seat Cover Wrinkle/Crease/Burn Info > Page 9156
- Customer induced cuts (knife cuts, cut by customer tools, etc.)
- Paint stains (customer should have cleaned paint stains while paint was still wet)
- Coffee stains and other removable dirt These should be cleaned as described in the Owner's
Manual under Appearance Care. Also, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 06-00-89-029A or later.
- Evidence of chemicals used for cleaning, other than those specified in the Owner's Manual
- Other chemical spills
- Minor and normal leather wrinkles as a result of use
- Other defects to the seat cover not detected during the pre-delivery inspection (PDI).
Inform the customer that the above issues were not present when the vehicle was purchased and
cannot be replaced under warranty. The covers, however, may be repaired or replaced at the
customer's expense.
The following conditions are not caused by the customer and should be covered by warranty:
- Split seams
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Interior - Seat Cover Wrinkle/Crease/Burn Info > Page 9157
- Wear/cracking/peeling
- Discoloration/dye transfer from customer clothing (if discoloration/dye transfer is not removed
after using GM Leather and Vinyl Plastic Cleaner, P/N 88861401 (in Canada, P/N 88861409),
replace the covers.)
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Interior - Seat Cover Wrinkle/Crease/Burn Info > Page 9158
Seat Cover: Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Elimination Of Unwanted Odors
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-00-89-027E
Date: September 29, 2008
Subject: Eliminating Unwanted Odors in Vehicles
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2009 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 Vehicles 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years and refine the instructions. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 00-00-89-027D (Section 00 - General Information).
Vehicle Odor Elimination
General Motors offers a product that may control or eliminate odors in the interior and luggage
compartment areas of GM vehicles. GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator is a non-toxic,
biodegradable odor remover. This odorless product has been shown to greatly reduce or remove
objectionable smells of mold and mildew resulting from vehicle water leaks (as well as customer
created odors, i.e. smoke). You may use GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator on fabrics, vinyl,
leather, carpet and sound deadening materials. It may also be induced into HVAC modules and
instrument panel ducts (for the control of non-bacterial related odors).
Important:
This product leaves no residual scent and should not be sold as or considered an air freshener.
Product action may result in the permanent elimination of an odor and may be preferable to
customers with allergies who are sensitive to perfumes.
How to Use This Product
GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator may be sprayed on in a ready-to-use formula or used in steam
cleaners as an additive with carpet shampoo. This water-based, odorless product is safe for all
vehicle interiors. Do not wet or soak any interior surface that plain water would cause to
deteriorate, as this product will have the same effect. Also avoid letting this product come into
contact with vinegar or any acidic substance. Acid-based products will hamper the effectiveness of,
or render GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator inert.
Note:
Complete eight page treatment sheets are enclosed within each case of GM Vehicle Care Odor
Eliminator. These treatment instructions range from simple vehicle odor elimination to full step by
step procedures for odor removal from water leaks. If lost, contact 800-977-4145 to get a
replacement set faxed or e-mailed to your dealership.
Instructions and cautions are printed on the bottle, but additional help is available. If you encounter
a difficult to eliminate or reoccurring odor, you may call 1-800-955-8591 (in Canada,
1-800-977-4145) to obtain additional information and usage suggestions.
Important:
This product may effectively remove odors when directly contacting the odor source. It should be
used in conjunction with diagnostic procedures (in cases such as a water leak) to first eliminate the
root cause of the odor, and then the residual odor to permanently correct the vehicle condition.
Vehicle Waterleak Odor Elimination
STEP ONE:
Confirm that all water leaks have been repaired. Determine what areas of the vehicle were water
soaked or wet. Components with visible mold/mildew staining should be replaced. Isolate the odor
source inside the vehicle. Often an odor can be isolated to an area or component of the vehicle
interior by careful evaluation. Odor evaluation may need to be performed by multiple persons.
Another method of isolating an odor source is to remove and segregate interior trim and
components. Plastic sheeting or drop cloths can be used to confine seats, headliners, etc. to assist
in evaluation and diagnoses. If appropriate the vehicle and interior trim should be evaluated
separately to determine if the odor stays with the vehicle or the interior components. Odors that
stay with the vehicle may be isolated to insulating and sound deadening materials (i.e. water leak
at the windshield or standing water in the front foot well area caused mold/mildew to form on the
bulkhead or kick panel sound deadening pads. If the interior is removed the floor pan and
primed/painted surfaces should be treated with bleach/soap solution, rinsed with clean water and
dried. Interior surfaces should then be treated with GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator product
before reinstalling carpet or reassembling.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Interior - Seat Cover Wrinkle/Crease/Burn Info > Page 9159
The GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator product is an effective odor elimination product when used
properly. It must come into direct contact with the odor source. It should be used in conjunction with
diagnostic procedures to first eliminate the root cause of the odor. Some procedures for use after
odor root cause correction are:
STEP TWO:
^ Use the trigger spray head.
^ Put a drop of dish soap the size of a quarter in the bottom of a bottle.
^ Add 8 oz. of GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator (1 cup) to the dish soap and top off the bottle with
tap water.
^ This formula should be used on hard surfaces (dash, interior plastic molding, and floor pan)
STEP THREE:
The third step to neutralizing the vehicle is a light to medium treatment of all carpeting and
upholstered seats with the GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator formula and a wide fan spray setting
(at full strength) (i.e.: carpeting on the driver's side requires 4-5 triggers pulls for coverage). The
headliner and trunk should be sprayed next. Lightly brushing the formula into the carpeting and
upholstery is a recommended step for deep odor problems. The dash and all hard surfaces should
be sprayed with dish soap/water mixture. Let stand for 1-2 minutes then wipe off the surface.
STEP FOUR: (vehicle ventilation system treatment)
The ventilation system is generally the last step in the treatment of the vehicle.
a. Spray the GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator formula into all dash vents. (1-2 trigger pulls per
vent).
b. Start the vehicle and turn the vehicle fan on high cool (not A/C setting).
c. Spray the formula (10 trigger pulls) into the outside fresh air intake vent (cowl at base of
windshield)
d. Enter the vehicle after 1 minute and wipe off the excess formula spurting out of the dash vents.
e. Smell the air coming from the dash vents. If odors are still present, spray another 5 triggers into
the cowl, wait another minute and smell the results. Once you have obtained a fresh, clean smell
coming from the vents, turn the system to the A/C re-circulation setting. Roll up the windows, spray
3-5 pumps into the right lower IP area and let the vehicle run with the fan set on high for 5-7
minutes.
Please follow this diagnosis process thoroughly and complete each step. If the condition exhibited
is resolved without completing every step, the remaining steps do not need to be performed. If
these steps do not resolve the condition, please contact GM TAC for further diagnostic assistance.
Additional Suggestions to Increase Customer Satisfaction
Here are some additional ideas to benefit your dealership and to generate greater customer
enthusiasm for this product.
^ Keep this product on-hand for both the Service Department and the Used Car lot. Add value to
your used car trades; treat loaner and demo cars during service and at final sale to eliminate
smoke, pet, and other common odors offensive to customers. Make deodorizing a vehicle part of
your normal vehicle detailing service.
^ Consider including GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator as a give-away item with new vehicle
purchases. Many dealers give away as "gifts" various cleaning supplies at time of delivery. GM
Odor Eliminator is one of a few products GM offers that has as many uses in the home as in the
vehicle. Customers may find this product can be used for a host of recreational activities
associated with their new vehicle, such as deodorizing a boat they tow, or a camper.
^ GM Odor Eliminator and many of the GM Vehicle Care products offer you the chance to increase
dealership traffic as these superior quality products cannot be purchased in stores. Many
Dealerships have product displays at the parts counter. Consider additional displays in the
Customer Service Lounge, the Showroom and at the Service Desk or Cashier Window. Many
customers who purchase vehicles and receive regular maintenance at your dealership may never
visit the parts counter, and subsequently are not exposed to the variety and value that these
products offer.
Parts Information
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Interior - Seat Cover Wrinkle/Crease/Burn Info > Page 9160
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Interior - Seat Cover Wrinkle/Crease/Burn Info > Page 9161
Seat Cover: Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Napped Seat Fabric Repair
Bulletin No.: 04-08-50-011A
Date: May 04, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Repairing Napped Seat Fabric
Models: 2007 Cadillac Escalade, Escalade ESV, Escalade EXT 1999-2006 Chevrolet Silverado
2000-2007 Chevrolet Suburban, Tahoe 2002-2005 Chevrolet Astro 2002-2006 Chevrolet Monte
Carlo 2002-2007 Chevrolet Avalanche 2002-2005 GMC Safari 2007 GMC Yukon, Yukon XL
2002-2004 Oldsmobile Alero 1997-2006 Pontiac Grand Prix
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years and models. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-08-50-011 (Section 08 - Body & Accessories).
This bulletin is being issued to advise technicians/dealers on the proper repair required when a
customer brings in a trimmed seat with the appearance of being worn, having a bald spot and/or
being discolored. The seats in the later vehicles are trimmed with a cloth that has a napped fabric.
Under some circumstances, the nap may become crushed down by normal use, giving the
appearance of being worn out. If the base material is NOT visible, use a small brass (NOT STEEL)
wire brush to carefully fluff and raise the nap. The wire brush (fine bristle brass) is available at most
hardware and home stores. If the base material is visible, replace the trim cover. The Astro/Safari
van will also have this material on the door trim.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6)
Seat Cushion: Service and Repair Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6)
Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6)
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the bucket seat from the seat risers. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service
and Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) .
2. Remove the screw from the recliner lever handle if equipped. 3. Remove the lever from the
recliner if equipped. 4. Remove the lumbar knob and clip if equipped. 5. Remove the J-hooks that
retain the seat cushion cover to the seat cushion frame.
Important: Note the positions of the hog rings for reassembly.
6. Remove the hog rings that retain the seat cushion cover to the seat cushion frame.
7. Remove the seat cushion cover and pad from the seat cushion frame. 8. Remove the seat
cushion cover from the pad.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the seat cushion cover to the pad. 2. Install the seat cushion cover and the pad to the seat
cushion frame.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6) > Page 9166
3. Install the hog rings that retain the seat cushion cover to the seat cushion frame in the locations
noted during disassembly. 4. Install the J-hook that retain the seat cushion cover to the seat
cushion frame.
5. Install the lumbar knob and clip if equipped. 6. Install the lever to the recliner if equipped.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
7. Install the screw to the recliner lever handle if equipped.
Tighten the screw to the recliner lever handle to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
8. Install the bucket seat to the seat risers. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6) > Page 9167
Seat Cushion: Service and Repair Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC7)
Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC7)
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the bucket seat from the seat risers. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service
and Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) .
Important: Note the position and length of the bolts you remove. This will assist with reassembly.
2. Remove the bolts that retain the seat back hinges to the seat cushion frame. Refer to Seat Back
Frame Replacement - Front (See: Seat
Back/Service and Repair/Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front) .
3. Remove the J-hooks that retain the seat cushion cover and pad to the seat cushion frame.
Important: Note the locations of the hog rings for reassembly.
4. Remove the hog rings that retain the seat cushion cover and pad to the seat cushion frame.
5. Remove the seat cushion cover and pad from the seat cushion frame.
Important: Note the locations of the hog rings for reassembly.
6. Remove the hog rings that retain the seat cushion cover to the pad. 7. Remove the seat cushion
cover from the pad.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the seat cushion cover to the pad.
2. Install the hog rings that retain the seat cushion cover to the pad in the locations noted during
disassembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6) > Page 9168
3. Install the seat cushion cover and the pad to the seat cushion frame. 4. Install the hog rings that
retain the seat cushion cover to the seat cushion frame in the locations noted during disassembly.
5. Install the J-hooks that retain the seat cushion cover and pad to the seat cushion frame.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
6. Install the bolts that retain the seat back hinges to the seat cushion frame.
Tighten the bolts to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
7. Install the bucket seat to the seat risers. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6) > Page 9169
Seat Cushion: Service and Repair Seat Cushion Frame Replacement
Seat Cushion Frame Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the bucket seat from the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service
and Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) . 2. Remove the seat cushion cover and pad. Refer to
Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6) (See: Seat Cushion Cover
Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6))Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC7) (See: Seat
Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC7)) .
3. Remove Lumbar support cable. Refer to Lumbar Support Cable Replacement (See: Service and
Repair/Lumbar Support Cable Replacement) .
4. Remove the seat back hinge bolts from the right side of the seat frame.
5. Remove the seat back hinge bolts from the left side of the seat frame. 6. Remove the seat
cushion frame from the seat back frame.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the seat cushion frame to the seat back frame.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the seat back hinge bolts to the left side of the seat frame.
Tighten the seat back hinge bolts to the left side of the seat frame to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6) > Page 9170
3. Install the bolts to the right side of the seat frame.
Tighten the seat back hinge bolts to the right side of the seat frame to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
4. Install the lumbar support cable. Refer to Lumbar Support Cable Replacement (See: Service and
Repair/Lumbar Support Cable Replacement) . 5. Install the seat cushion cover and pad . Refer to
Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6) (See: Seat Cushion Cover Replacement
- Front (YC5 and YC6))Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC7) (See: Seat Cushion Cover
Replacement - Front (YC7)) .
6. Install the bucket seat in the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6) > Page 9171
Seat Cushion: Service and Repair Seat Cushion Frame Replacement - Rear (YC5 and YC6)
Seat Cushion Frame Replacement - Rear (YC5 and YC6)
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the rear bench seat from the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Rear Bench (See:
Service and Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear Bench) . 2. Remove the seat cushion cover and pad.
Refer to Seat Cushion Cover and Pad Replacement - Rear (See: Seat Cushion Cover and Pad
Replacement - Rear) .
3. Remove the seat back hinge bolts from the right and left sides of the cushion frame.
4. Remove the seat cushion frame.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the seat cushion frame.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the seat back hinge bolts to the right and left sides of the seat cushion frame.
Tighten the seat back hinge bolts to the right and left sides of the seat cushion frame 30 N.m (22 lb
ft).
3. Install the seat cushion cover and pad. Refer to Seat Cushion Cover and Pad Replacement Rear (See: Seat Cushion Cover and Pad Replacement
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6) > Page 9172
- Rear) .
4. Install the rear bench seat to the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Rear Bench (See: Service
and Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear Bench) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6) > Page 9173
Seat Cushion: Service and Repair
Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6)
Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6)
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the bucket seat from the seat risers. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service
and Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) .
2. Remove the screw from the recliner lever handle if equipped. 3. Remove the lever from the
recliner if equipped. 4. Remove the lumbar knob and clip if equipped. 5. Remove the J-hooks that
retain the seat cushion cover to the seat cushion frame.
Important: Note the positions of the hog rings for reassembly.
6. Remove the hog rings that retain the seat cushion cover to the seat cushion frame.
7. Remove the seat cushion cover and pad from the seat cushion frame. 8. Remove the seat
cushion cover from the pad.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the seat cushion cover to the pad.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6) > Page 9174
2. Install the seat cushion cover and the pad to the seat cushion frame.
3. Install the hog rings that retain the seat cushion cover to the seat cushion frame in the locations
noted during disassembly. 4. Install the J-hook that retain the seat cushion cover to the seat
cushion frame.
5. Install the lumbar knob and clip if equipped. 6. Install the lever to the recliner if equipped.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
7. Install the screw to the recliner lever handle if equipped.
Tighten the screw to the recliner lever handle to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
8. Install the bucket seat to the seat risers. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) .
Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC7)
Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC7)
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the bucket seat from the seat risers. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service
and Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) .
Important: Note the position and length of the bolts you remove. This will assist with reassembly.
2. Remove the bolts that retain the seat back hinges to the seat cushion frame. Refer to Seat Back
Frame Replacement - Front (See: Seat
Back/Service and Repair/Seat Back Frame Replacement - Front) .
3. Remove the J-hooks that retain the seat cushion cover and pad to the seat cushion frame.
Important: Note the locations of the hog rings for reassembly.
4. Remove the hog rings that retain the seat cushion cover and pad to the seat cushion frame.
5. Remove the seat cushion cover and pad from the seat cushion frame.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6) > Page 9175
Important: Note the locations of the hog rings for reassembly.
6. Remove the hog rings that retain the seat cushion cover to the pad. 7. Remove the seat cushion
cover from the pad.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the seat cushion cover to the pad.
2. Install the hog rings that retain the seat cushion cover to the pad in the locations noted during
disassembly.
3. Install the seat cushion cover and the pad to the seat cushion frame. 4. Install the hog rings that
retain the seat cushion cover to the seat cushion frame in the locations noted during disassembly.
5. Install the J-hooks that retain the seat cushion cover and pad to the seat cushion frame.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
6. Install the bolts that retain the seat back hinges to the seat cushion frame.
Tighten the bolts to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
7. Install the bucket seat to the seat risers. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) .
Seat Cushion Frame Replacement
Seat Cushion Frame Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the bucket seat from the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service
and Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) . 2. Remove the seat cushion cover and pad. Refer to
Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6) (See: Seat Cushion Cover
Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6))Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC7) (See: Seat
Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC7)) .
3. Remove Lumbar support cable. Refer to Lumbar Support Cable Replacement (See: Service and
Repair/Lumbar Support Cable Replacement) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6) > Page 9176
4. Remove the seat back hinge bolts from the right side of the seat frame.
5. Remove the seat back hinge bolts from the left side of the seat frame. 6. Remove the seat
cushion frame from the seat back frame.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the seat cushion frame to the seat back frame.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the seat back hinge bolts to the left side of the seat frame.
Tighten the seat back hinge bolts to the left side of the seat frame to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
3. Install the bolts to the right side of the seat frame.
Tighten the seat back hinge bolts to the right side of the seat frame to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
4. Install the lumbar support cable. Refer to Lumbar Support Cable Replacement (See: Service and
Repair/Lumbar Support Cable Replacement) . 5. Install the seat cushion cover and pad . Refer to
Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6) (See: Seat Cushion Cover Replacement
- Front (YC5 and YC6))Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC7) (See: Seat Cushion Cover
Replacement - Front (YC7)) .
6. Install the bucket seat in the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Bucket (See: Service and
Repair/Seat Replacement - Bucket) .
Seat Cushion Frame Replacement - Rear (YC5 and YC6)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6) > Page 9177
Seat Cushion Frame Replacement - Rear (YC5 and YC6)
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the rear bench seat from the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Rear Bench (See:
Service and Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear Bench) . 2. Remove the seat cushion cover and pad.
Refer to Seat Cushion Cover and Pad Replacement - Rear (See: Seat Cushion Cover and Pad
Replacement - Rear) .
3. Remove the seat back hinge bolts from the right and left sides of the cushion frame.
4. Remove the seat cushion frame.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the seat cushion frame.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the seat back hinge bolts to the right and left sides of the seat cushion frame.
Tighten the seat back hinge bolts to the right and left sides of the seat cushion frame 30 N.m (22 lb
ft).
3. Install the seat cushion cover and pad. Refer to Seat Cushion Cover and Pad Replacement Rear (See: Seat Cushion Cover and Pad Replacement
- Rear) .
4. Install the rear bench seat to the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Rear Bench (See: Service
and Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear Bench) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6) > Page 9178
Seat Cushion Frame Replacement - Rear (YC7)
Seat Cushion Frame Replacement - Rear (YC7)
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the rear bench seat from the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Rear Bench (See:
Service and Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear Bench) . 2. Remove the seat cushion cover and pad.
Refer to Seat Cushion Cover and Pad Replacement - Rear (See: Seat Cushion Cover and Pad
Replacement - Rear) .
Important: Note the position and length of the bolts removed. This will assist with reassembly.
3. Remove the bolts retaining the seat back hinges to the seat cushion frame.
Important: Note the position and length of the bolts removed. This will assist with reassembly.
4. Remove the bolts retaining the console to the seat cushion frame. Refer to Center Console
Replacement - Rear Seat (See: Interior Moulding /
Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Center Console Replacement - Rear Seat) .
5. Remove the seat cushion frame.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the seat cushion frame.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the bolts that retain the console to the seat cushion frame in the locations noted during
disassembly. Refer to Center Console Replacement Rear Seat (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Center Console Replacement
- Rear Seat) .
Tighten the bolts that retain the console to the seat cushion frame to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6) > Page 9179
3. Install the bolts that retain the seat back hinges to the seat cushion frame in the locations noted
during disassembly.
Tighten the bolts that retain the seat back hinges to the bench seat cushion frame to 30 N.m (22 lb
ft).
4. Install the seat cushion cover and pad. 5. Install the rear bench seat to the vehicle. Refer to Seat
Replacement - Rear Bench (See: Service and Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear Bench) .
Seat Cushion Cover and Pad Replacement - Rear
Seat Cushion Cover and Pad Replacement - Rear
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the bench seat and risers from the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Rear Bench
(See: Service and Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear
Bench) .
2. Remove the right and left sides of the seat back hinge trim. Refer to Seat Back Hinge Trim
Replacement - Rear Right (YC6) (See: Seat
Back/Service and Repair/Seat Back Hinge Trim Replacement - Rear Right (YC6)) and Seat Back
Hinge Trim Replacement - Rear Left (See: Seat Back/Service and Repair/Seat Back Hinge Trim
Replacement - Rear Left) .
Important: Note the position and length of the bolts you remove. This will assist with reassembly.
3. Remove the bolts retaining the seat back hinges to the seat cushion frame.
4. Remove the J-hooks that retain the seat cushion cover to the seat cushion frame.
Important: Note the locations of the hog rings for reassembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6) > Page 9180
5. Remove the hog rings that retain the seat cushion cover to the seat cushion frame located at the
rear edge of the seat frame.
6. Remove the seat back cushion cover and pad from the seat cushion frame.
Important: Note the locations of the hog rings for reassembly.
7. Remove the hog rings that retain the seat cushion cover to the seat cushion pad located under
the seat cushion cover. 8. Remove the seat cushion cover from the seat cushion pad.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the seat cushion cover to the seat cushion pad.
2. Install the hog rings that retain the seat cushion cover to the seat cushion pad located under the
seat cushion cover.
3. Install the seat back cushion cover and pad to the seat cushion frame.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Cushion Cover Replacement - Front (YC5 and YC6) > Page 9181
4. Install the hog rings that retain the seat cushion cover to the seat cushion frame located at the
rear edge of the seat frame.
5. Install the J-hooks that retain the seat cushion cover to the seat cushion frame.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
6. Install the bolts that retain the seat back hinges to the seat cushion frame.
Tighten the bolts that retain the seat back hinges to the seat cushion frame to 30 N.m (22 lb ft).
7. Install the right and left sides of the seat back hinge trim. Refer to Seat Back Hinge Trim
Replacement - Rear Right (YC6) (See: Seat
Back/Service and Repair/Seat Back Hinge Trim Replacement - Rear Right (YC6)) and Seat Back
Hinge Trim Replacement - Rear Left (See: Seat Back/Service and Repair/Seat Back Hinge Trim
Replacement - Rear Left) .
8. Install the bench seat and risers in the vehicle. Refer to Seat Replacement - Rear Bench (See:
Service and Repair/Seat Replacement - Rear Bench)
.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams
Power Door Lock Switch: Diagrams
Door Lock Switch - Driver
Door Lock Switch - Front Passenger
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9186
Power Door Lock Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the armrest screws and the armrest YC5. 2. Remove the window handle, if equipped. 3.
Pull out on the escutcheon in order to remove the lock lever escutcheon. Start with the front edge
of the escutcheon. 4. Remove the upper corner trim using the following method:
4.1. Pull the upper corner trim at the top edge.
4.2. Pivot the upper corner trim down in order to clear the tab at the trim panel, YC6 and YC7.
5. Remove the caps that cover the screws for the assist handle. 6. Remove the screws that retain
the assist handle to the door. 7. Remove the screw at the front edge of the accessory switch mount
plate. 8. Remove the plate from the trim panel. 9. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the
switches on the plate, as needed.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Connect the electrical connectors to the switches on the accessory switch mounting plate, as
needed. 2. Install the plate to the trim panel.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the screw at the front edge of the accessory switch mount plate.
Tighten Tighten the screws at the front edge of the accessory switch mount plate to 5 N.m (44 lb
in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9187
4. Install the assist handle and screws to the door.
Tighten Tighten the assist handle screws to 5 N.m (44 lb in).
5. Install the caps that cover the screws on the assist handle. 6. Insert the tab in the slot on the
door trim panel.
Seat the fastener into the door at the top, YC6 and YC7 in order to install the upper corner trim.
7. Snap the lock lever escutcheon into place in order to install the lock lever escutcheon. Start at
the rear edge of the escutcheon. 8. Install the window handle, if equipped. 9. Install the armrest
and armrest screws, YC5.
Tighten Tighten the armrest screws to 5 N.m (44 lb in).
For a description of the RPO Code(s) shown in this article or any of the images therein, refer to the
RPO Code List found at Vehicle/Application See: Application and ID
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9191
Seat Adjuster Switch - Driver
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9192
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding the diagnosis of this component and the system that it is a part of,
please refer to Seats Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9193
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair
Seat Switch Replacement - Power
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the screws that retain the power seat switch to the seat.
2. Disconnect the electrical connector from the power seat switch. 3. Remove the power seat
switch.
Installation Procedure
1. Connect the power seat switch electrical connector. 2. Install the power seat switch.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9194
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3. Install the screws that retain the power seat switch to the seat.
Tighten the power seat switch retaining screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Spoilers, Flaps, and Air Dams > Air Dam > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Air Dam: Service and Repair
Air Intake Baffle Replacement - Radiator
Removal Procedure
1. Raise and support the vehicle. Refer to Lifting and Jacking the Vehicle (See:
Maintenance/Vehicle Lifting/Service and Repair) in General
Information.
2. Unhook the power steering cooler lines (2) from the air baffle. 3. Remove the push-in retainers
(4) on the right and left sides of the air baffle. 4. Remove the screws (3) that attaches the air baffle
to the radiator support. 5. Pull the air baffle rearward in order to release the air baffle from the
radiator support.
6. Remove the air baffle (1).
Installation Procedure
1. Position the air baffle (1) into the radiator support.
2. Align the tabs of the air baffle to the radiator support before installing the screws.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
3.
Install the screws (3) that attach the air baffle to the radiator support.
Tighten the screws that attaches the air baffle to the radiator support to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
4. Remove the push clips (4) on the right and left sides of the air baffle. 5. Hook the power steering
cooler lines (2) to the air baffle. 6. Lower the vehicle.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Tailgate > Tailgate Release Handle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Handle and Lock Cylinder - Rear Door Outside
Tailgate Release Handle: Service and Repair Handle and Lock Cylinder - Rear Door Outside
Handle and Lock Cylinder - Rear Door Outside
New lock cylinders are available as replacement parts. If the door lock cylinders require
replacement for any reason, apply a coating of lubricant. Use GM P/N 12346241 or the equivalent,
inside the lock case and the cylinder keyway prior to assembling and installing the cylinder.
Refer toBinding Lock Cylinders (See: Locks/Door Locks/Service and Repair/Procedures) in Doors
in order to repair a binding lock cylinder. Refer to Key and Lock Cylinder Coding (See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Service and Repair/Key & Lock Cylinder Coding) in General
Information in order to code a new lock cylinder.
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the trim panel and the access cover. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door
(Cargo Doors) (See: Interior Moulding /
Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors))Trim Panel
Replacement - Rear Door (E54) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Trim
Panel Replacement - Rear Door (E54)) .
2. Remove the Water Deflector. Refer to Water Deflector Replacement (See: Doors, Hood and
Trunk/Doors/Rear Door/Rear Door Panel/Service
and Repair) .
3. Use the following procedure in order to remove the control rod from the outside handle:
1. Pry the clip anchor out of the hole. 2. Push the clip away from the lever. 3. Pull the rod (1) and
the clip away from the lever.
4. Remove the outside handle nuts. 5. Remove the outside handle. 6. Disconnect the license lamp
wiring. 7. Remove the license plate housing bolts. 8. Remove the license plate housing. 9. Remove
the door lock shield.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Tailgate > Tailgate Release Handle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Handle and Lock Cylinder - Rear Door Outside > Page 9204
10. Use the following procedure in order to remove the control rod from the lock cylinder (3):
1. Pry the clip anchor out of the hole. 2. Push the clip away from the lever. 3. Pull the rod and the
clip away from the lever.
11. Remove the lock cylinder retainer (1). 12. Remove the lock cylinder.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the clip to the lock cylinder (3). 2. Install the lock cylinder to the door. 3. Install the lock
cylinder retainer (1). 4. Install the control rod to the lock cylinder through the clip. 5. Install the door
lock shield. 6. Install the license plate housing.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
7. Install the license plate housing bolts.
Tighten the bolts to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
8. Install the license lamp bolts.
Tighten the bolts to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Tailgate > Tailgate Release Handle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Handle and Lock Cylinder - Rear Door Outside > Page 9205
9. Install the clip to the outside handle.
10. Install the outside handle to the door. 11. Install the outside handle nuts.
Tighten the nuts to 7 N.m (62 lb in).
12. Install the control rod (1) to the outside handle through the clip. 13. Install the water deflector.
Refer to Water Deflector Replacement (See: Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Rear Door/Rear Door
Panel/Service and
Repair) .
14. Install the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors) (See:
Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and
Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors))Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door
(E54) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Rear
Door (E54)) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Tailgate > Tailgate Release Handle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Handle and Lock Cylinder - Rear Door Outside > Page 9206
Tailgate Release Handle: Service and Repair Handle Replacement - Lift Gate
Handle Replacement - Lift Gate
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the screws that retain the liftgate handle. 2. Remove the liftgate handle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the liftgate handle.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the screws that retain the liftgate handle.
Tighten the screws that retain the liftgate handle to 4 N.m (35 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Tailgate > Tailgate Release Handle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Handle and Lock Cylinder - Rear Door Outside > Page 9207
Tailgate Release Handle: Service and Repair Handle Replacement - Rear Door Inside
Handle Replacement - Rear Door Inside
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors) (See:
Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and
Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors))Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door
(E54) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Rear
Door (E54)) .
2. Remove the water deflector. Refer to Water Deflector Replacement (See: Doors, Hood and
Trunk/Doors/Rear Door/Rear Door Panel/Service and
Repair) .
3. Remove the control rod (1) from the door lock. 4. Remove the door handle nuts (2).
5. Remove the door handle from the door.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the door handle to the door.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Tailgate > Tailgate Release Handle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Handle and Lock Cylinder - Rear Door Outside > Page 9208
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the door handle nuts (2).
Tighten the nuts to 11 N.m (97 lb in).
Important: Install new control rod retainers whenever they are removed.
3. Install the control rod to the door handle (1). 4. Install the water deflector. Refer to Water
Deflector Replacement (See: Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Rear Door/Rear Door Panel/Service
and
Repair) .
5. Install the door trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors) (See:
Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and
Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors))Trim Panel Replacement - Rear Door
(E54) (See: Interior Moulding / Trim/Console/Service and Repair/Trim Panel Replacement - Rear
Door (E54)) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Tailgate > Tailgate Striker > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Tailgate Striker: Service and Repair
Lock Striker Replacement - Upper and Lower
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the bolts that retain the striker.
2. Remove the striker from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the lock striker to the vehicle.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the bolts that retain the lock striker to the vehicle.
Tighten the bolts that retain the lock striker to 8 N.m (71 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Unibody > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Service
and Repair
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair
Air Inlet Grille Panel Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Disconnect the windshield washer hoses from the windshield wiper arm. 2. Remove the
windshield wiper arms. Refer to Wiper Arm Replacement in Wipers/Washer Systems. 3. Remove
the antenna. Refer to Fixed Antenna Mast Replacement in Entertainment. 4. Remove the air inlet
grille panel to cowl screws.
5. Remove the air inlet grille panel from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the air inlet grille panel to the vehicle.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the air inlet grille panel to cowl screws.
Tighten the air inlet grille panel to cowl screws 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Install the antenna. Refer to Fixed Antenna Mast Replacement in Entertainment. 4. Install the
windshield wiper arms. Refer to Wiper Arm Replacement in Wipers/Washer Systems.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Front Door Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Front Door Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
Weatherstrip Replacement - Front Door Opening
Tools Required
J 38778 Door Trim Pad and Garnish Clip Remover
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the interior garnish moldings.
2. Use the J 38778 in order to pull the weatherstrip from the pinchweld flange of the door. Start at
the upper right corner (6), and pull the
weatherstrip down (5,4). Keep pulling the weatherstrip (3) until you reach the top (1) of the door,
and have pulled the weatherstrip free.
Installation Procedure
Important: Ensure that the weatherstrip length is equally distributed around the door opening.
1. Partially attach the weatherstrip to the pinchweld flange in 6 key areas (1,2,3,4,5,6).
Important: Fit the weatherstrip to the opening by hand.
2. Seat the weatherstrip onto the pinchweld flange to approximately 154 mm (6 in) on each side of
the corner in order to install the weatherstrip at
each corner (6,4,3,1).
Important: Use a rubber mallet and hit the weatherstrip square to the flange. Otherwise, an
undesirable spreading of the carrier will occur that will result in reduced retention.
3. Use a rubber mallet in order to install the weatherstrip into each corner. 4. Use a rubber mallet in
order to install the pinchweld flange areas of the hinge and the windshield pillars. 5. Ensure that the
following conditions are met:
* The weatherstrip fits into the corner and matches the radius of the pinchweld flange.
* The weatherstrip is seated completely onto the flange in all areas, resulting in a smooth vinyl-trim
around the entire door opening.
* There is not any distortion or excess spreading of the carrier as a result of hitting the carrier
improperly with the rubber mallet.
* The weatherstrip is not kinked or distorted after installation.
* The weatherstrip is lubricated with GM weatherstrip silicone lube. Refer to Fluid and Lubricant
Recommendations in Maintenance and Lubrication.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Front Door Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 9221
* Install the interior garnish moldings.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
Sealing Strip Replacement - Front Door Upper
Removal Procedure
1. Pull the molding (1) from the molding flange. 2. Remove the molding (1).
Installation Procedure
1. Install the molding (1). 2. Push the molding (1) onto the flange. Start at the pre-formed corners.
Work toward the straight flanges.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Hood Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Hood Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
Seal Replacement - Hood Rear
Tools Required
J 38778 Door Trim Pad and Garnish Clip Remover
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the rear hood seal retainers by using J 38778 . 2. Remove the rear hood seal from the
hood.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the rear hood seal to the hood.
2. Push the retainers into the hood in order to retain the rear hood seal.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Quarter Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Quarter Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
Weatherstrip Replacement - Swing Out Window
Removal Procedure
1. Open the swing out window. 2. Pull the weatherstrip from the pinch weld flange. 3. Grasp the
weatherstrip at the lower corner and pull up and away from the pinch-weld.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the weatherstrip to the pinch-weld flange. 2. Put the weatherstrip on the pinch-weld flange
and push downward until fully seated. 3. Close the swing out window.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Rear Door Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Sealing Strip Replacement - Outer Belt
Rear Door Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Sealing Strip Replacement - Outer Belt
Sealing Strip Replacement - Outer Belt
Removal Procedure
1. Roll the window down. 2. Remove the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Door (See:
Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front Door Panel/Service and
Repair) .
3. Remove the outer sealing strip from the door frame.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the outer sealing strip to the door frame. 2. Install the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel
Replacement - Door (See: Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front Door Panel/Service and
Repair) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Rear Door Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Sealing Strip Replacement - Outer Belt > Page 9235
Rear Door Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Weatherstrip Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors)
Weatherstrip Replacement - Rear Door (Cargo Doors)
Tools Required
J 38778 Door Trim Pad and Garnish Clip Remover
Removal Procedure
1. Use the J 38778 in order to remove the retainers (2). 2. Use the 3M Release Agent or an
equivalent in order to break the weatherstrip adhesive bond. 3. Use the J 38778 in order to remove
the plastic weather retainers (3).
4. Remove the weatherstrip (1) from the left door.
5. Remove the weatherstrip from the right door.
Installation Procedure
1. Use 3M Weatherstrip adhesive or an equivalent in order to install the weatherstrip to the right
door.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Rear Door Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Sealing Strip Replacement - Outer Belt > Page 9236
2. Use 3M Weatherstrip adhesive or an equivalent in order to install the weatherstrip (3) to the left
door. 3. Install the plastic retainers (2) into place. Push the retainers into place until the retainers
are fully seated.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Rear Door Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Sealing Strip Replacement - Outer Belt > Page 9237
Rear Door Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Weatherstrip Replacement - Rear Door (E54)
Weatherstrip Replacement - Rear Door (E54)
Tools Required
J 38778 Door Trim Pad and Garnish Clip Remover
Removal Procedure
1. Use the J 38778 in order to remove the retainers. 2. Use 3M Release Agent in order to break the
weatherstrip adhesive bond. 3. Use the J 38778 in order to remove the plastic retainers.
4. Remove the left door weatherstrip.
5. Remove the right door weatherstrip.
Installation Procedure
1. Use 3M Weatherstrip adhesive or an equivalent in order to install the right door weatherstrip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Rear Door Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Sealing Strip Replacement - Outer Belt > Page 9238
2. Use 3M Weatherstrip adhesive or an equivalent in order to install the left door weatherstrip. 3.
Install the plastic retainers into place. Push the retainers into place until the retainers are fully
seated.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Trunk / Liftgate Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Trunk / Liftgate Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
Weatherstrip Replacement - Lift Gate
Removal Procedure
1. Remove all of the interior trim in order to access the weatherstrip. 2. Pull the weatherstrip from
the pinch-weld flange. Start at the upper right corner.
Installation Procedure
Important: The weatherstrip attaches to the pinch-weld flange in 6 areas. The weatherstrip length
distributes equally around the door opening.
1. Install the weatherstrip at the top right corner. Seat the weatherstrip onto the pinch-weld flange.
2. Position and install the weatherstrip by hand. 3. Using a rubber mallet during the final installation
may be required in the thick flange areas and in each corner.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams
Cruise Control Module (CCM)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9246
Cruise Control Module: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the cruise control cable. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector. 3. Remove the cruise
control module bolts. 4. Remove the cruise control module.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the cruise control module.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the cruise control module bolts.
Tighten Tighten the cruise control module bolts to 12 N.m (106 lb in).
3. Connect the electrical connector.
IMPORTANT: The cruise control cable does not require mechanical adjusting after the
replacement. The cruise control module internally adjusts the cable.
4. Install the cruise control cable. 5. Perform the functional check.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Servo Cable > Component Information > Adjustments
Cruise Control Servo Cable: Adjustments
IMPORTANT: The cruise control cable does not require mechanical adjusting after the
replacement. The cruise control module internally adjusts the cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Servo Cable > Component Information > Adjustments >
Page 9250
Cruise Control Servo Cable: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Open the hood. 2. Remove the engine cover.
NOTE: Do not remove the C-clip from the cruise control connector. The C-clip was not designed for
removal. Damage may occur when removing.
3. Do not remove the C-clip from the cruise control end connector.
4. Do not remove the adjuster screw from the end of the cruise control cable. Adjustments will not
be needed.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Servo Cable > Component Information > Adjustments >
Page 9251
5. Remove the cruise control cable from the throttle linkage, using a suitable tool in order to lightly
pry off the end of the cruise control cable.
6. Disconnect the cruise control cable from the throttle linkage.
7. Disconnect the cruise control cable from the cable bracket (1). 8. Remove the screw that retains
the cruise control cable to the HVAC module (2). 9. Remove the cruise control cable from the
cruise control module housing.
IMPORTANT: Do not allow the cruise control ribbon to retract into the module assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Servo Cable > Component Information > Adjustments >
Page 9252
10. Disconnect the cruise control cable bead (2) from the end of the ribbon (1). 11. Remove the
cruise control cable from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the cruise control cable to the vehicle. 2. Remove all bends and twists from the cruise
control module ribbon and cable by rotating until removed.
Important: ^
Do not twist the cruise control module ribbon (1).
^ Pull the cruise control cable (2) in order to verify retention to the ribbon (1).
3. Attach the cruise control cable bead (2) to the cruise control module ribbon (1).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Servo Cable > Component Information > Adjustments >
Page 9253
4. Inspect the orientation of the cruise control ribbon buckle to the cable end fitting.
5. Install the cruise control cable to the cable bracket (1). 6. Install the screw that retains the cruise
control cable to the HVAC module (2). 7. Install the cruise control cable to the cruise control
module housing.
8. Connect the cruise control cable to the throttle linkage.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Servo Cable > Component Information > Adjustments >
Page 9254
9. Snap the cruise control cable fitting (3) into the cruise control module (4).
10. In order to install a new cruise control cable, pull the cruise control cable ferrule through the
opposite end of the fitting.
The ferrule color is natural and must be visible when pulled through the fitting.
11. From inside the vehicle, snap the cable fitting onto the stud on the throttle body linkage.
IMPORTANT: Verify that the cable fitting locking tabs are expanded, and that the tabs are locked in
the accelerator bracket hole.
12. Reroute and insert the cruise control cable fitting into the round hole in the accelerator bracket.
IMPORTANT: The cruise control cable does not require mechanical adjusting after the
replacement. The cruise control module internally adjusts the cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Servo Cable > Component Information > Adjustments >
Page 9255
13. When installing a new cruise control cable or adjusting an old cruise control cable (3), engage
the lock (1) on the cruise control adjuster (2). The
white paint mark will disappear when the adjuster is locked.
14. Install the cruise control cable to the HVAC module by placing the cable inside the module clip
and snapping the clip closed. 15. Perform the Cruise Control System Functional Test. Refer to
Cruise Control Inoperative/Malfunctioning.
16. If the cruise control cable (3) requires adjustment, release the lock on the cable adjuster (2)
using the following steps:
16.1. Gently squeeze the tabs on the adjuster plunger (1). 16.2. Pull upward on the adjuster
plunger (1). 16.3. Rotate the black plastic screw on the cruise control cable end that connects to
the throttle body until the proper lash is achieved.
SPECIFICATION The lash should be within 0.0-0.6 mm (0.0-0.024 in).
17. After completing the adjustment, reset the lock. 18. Install the engine cover. 19. Close the
hood.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams
Cruise Control Module (CCM)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9263
Cruise Control Module: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the cruise control cable. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector. 3. Remove the cruise
control module bolts. 4. Remove the cruise control module.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the cruise control module.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the cruise control module bolts.
Tighten Tighten the cruise control module bolts to 12 N.m (106 lb in).
3. Connect the electrical connector.
IMPORTANT: The cruise control cable does not require mechanical adjusting after the
replacement. The cruise control module internally adjusts the cable.
4. Install the cruise control cable. 5. Perform the functional check.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > ABS Light > Component Information >
Description and Operation
ABS Light: Description and Operation
ABS Indicator
The IPC illuminates the ABS indicator when the following occurs: ^
The electronic brake control module (EBCM) detects an ABS-disabling malfunction. The IPC
receives a class 2 message from the EBCM requesting illumination.
^ The IPC performs the bulb check.
^ The IPC detects a loss of class 2 communications with the EBCM.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Audible Warning Device: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9276
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9277
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9278
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9279
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9280
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9281
Audible Warning Device: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9282
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9283
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9284
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9285
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9286
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9287
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9288
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9289
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9290
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9291
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9292
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9293
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9294
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9295
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9296
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9297
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9298
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9299
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9300
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9301
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9302
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9303
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9304
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9305
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9306
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9307
Audible Warning Device: Electrical Diagrams
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators Diagrams.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 9308
Audible Warning Device: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device Control
Module > Component Information > Service and Repair
Audible Warning Device Control Module: Service and Repair
MULTIFUNCTION ALARM MODULE REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the multifunction alarm assembly from the convenience center located under the left
side of the instrument panel. 2. Release the single tab connector on the top of the assembly. 3. Pull
out the single tab connector.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the multifunction alarm assembly to the convenience center. 2. Align the retaining tab. 3.
Press the tab in place.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Brake Warning Indicator: Description and Operation
Brake Warning Indicator
The instrument panel cluster (IPC) illuminates the brake warning indicator when the following
occurs: ^
The body control module (BCM) detects that the park brake is engaged. The IPC receives a class 2
message from the BCM requesting illumination.
^ The EBCM detects a low brake fluid condition and sends a class 2 message to the IPC.
^ The IPC performs the bulb check.
^ An ABS-disabling malfunction also disables dynamic rear proportioning (DRP).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 9315
Brake Warning Indicator: Testing and Inspection
For information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Hydraulic System Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Cigarette Lighter: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9320
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9321
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9322
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9323
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9324
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9325
Cigarette Lighter: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9326
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9327
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9328
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9329
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9330
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9331
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9332
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9333
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9334
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9335
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9336
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9337
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9338
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9339
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9340
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9341
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9342
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9343
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9344
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9345
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9346
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9347
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9348
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9349
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9350
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9351
Cigar Lighter
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9352
Cigar Lighter/Auxiliary Outlets Schematics
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection
Compass: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air
Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Disabling
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Disabling
IMPORTANT: Refer to SIR Service Precautions before disabling the SIR system.
1. Turn the steering wheel until the vehicle's wheels are pointing straight ahead. 2. Turn OFF the
ignition. 3. Remove the key from the ignition.
IMPORTANT: With the AIR BAG Fuse removed and the ignition ON, the AIR BAG indicator
illuminates. This is normal operation and does not indicate an SIR system malfunction.
4. Remove the AIR BAG Fuse from the IP fuse block. 5. Remove the sound insulator, if equipped.
6. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) from the steering wheel module yellow 2-way
connector (1) located at the base of the steering
column.
7. Disconnect the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector (1) located at the base of the
steering column.
8. Remove the instrument panel extension. 9. Remove the CPA (2) from the IP module yellow
2-way connector (1) located under the instrument panel extension.
10. Disconnect the IP module yellow 2-way connector (1) located under the instrument panel
extension.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air
Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Disabling > Page 9361
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Enabling
1. Remove the key from the ignition. 2. Connect the IP module yellow 2-way connector (1) located
under the instrument panel extension. 3. Install the connector position assurance (CPA) (2) to the
IP module yellow 2-way connector (1) located under the instrument panel extension. 4. Install the
instrument panel extension.
5. Connect the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector (1) located at the base of the
steering column. 6. Install the CPA to the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector (1)
located at the base of the steering column. 7. Install the sound insulator, if equipped. 8. Install the
AIR BAG Fuse to the IP fuse block. 9. Staying well away from the air bags, turn ON the ignition,
with the engine OFF.
9.1. The AIR BAG indicator will flash 7 times.
9.2. The AIR BAG indicator will then turn OFF.
10. Perform Diagnostic System Check - SIR if the AIR BAG indicator does not operate as
described.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dimmer Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams
Headlamp And Panel Dimmer Switch
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Front
Door Switch: Service and Repair Front
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Loosen the nut on the door jamb switch. 2. Gently pull the switch away from the body. 3.
Disconnect the door jamb switch from the electrical connector(s). 4. Tape the wiring to the body in
order to prevent the wiring from entering the hole in the door pillar. 5. Remove the door jamb switch
from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the door jamb switch to the vehicle. 2. Connect the electrical connector(s) to the door
jamb switch.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Tighten the nut on the door jamb switch.
Tighten Tighten the door jamb switch nut to 3 N.m (27 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Front > Page 9369
Door Switch: Service and Repair Rear
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Loosen the nut on the door jamb switch. 2. Gently pull the switch away from the body. 3.
Disconnect the door jamb switch from the electrical connectors. 4. Tape the wiring to the body in
order to prevent the wiring from entering the hole in the door pillar. 5. Remove the door jamb switch
from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the door jamb switch to the vehicle. 2. Connect the electrical connectors to the door jamb
switch.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Tighten the nut on the door jamb switch.
Tighten Tighten the door jamb switch nut to 3 N.m (27 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9374
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9375
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9376
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9377
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9378
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9379
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9380
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9381
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9382
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9383
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9384
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9385
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9386
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9387
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9388
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9389
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9390
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9391
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9392
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9393
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9394
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9395
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9396
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9397
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9398
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9399
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9400
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9401
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9402
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9403
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9404
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9405
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Connector Views
Ambient Air Temperature Sensor (DIC)
Driver Information Center (DIC)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9406
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Electrical Diagrams
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators Diagrams.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9407
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuel Gauge: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9412
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9413
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9414
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9415
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9416
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9417
Fuel Gauge: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9418
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9419
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9420
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9421
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9422
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9423
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9424
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9425
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9426
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9427
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9428
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9429
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9430
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9431
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9432
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9433
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9434
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9435
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9436
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9437
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9438
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9439
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9440
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9441
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9442
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9443
Fuel Gauge: Electrical Diagrams
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators Diagrams.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Page 9444
Fuel Gauge: Description and Operation
The IPC displays the fuel level as determined by the PCM. The IPC receives a class 2 message
from the PCM indicating the fuel level percent. The fuel gage defaults to empty if:
^ The PCM detects a malfunction in the fuel level sensor circuit.
^ The IPC detects a loss of class 2 communications with the PCM.
When the IPC detects that the fuel level is less than 17 percent, the IPC illuminates the low fuel
indicator.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Diagrams > Page 9445
Fuel Gauge: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Specifications
Fuel Gauge Sender: Specifications
Fuel Level Specifications
The values in the table are approximate values based on information obtained from properly
operating vehicles. Actual results may vary slightly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 9449
Fuel Pump And Sender Assembly
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 9450
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor
The fuel level sensor consists of a float, a wire float arm, and a ceramic resistor card. The position
of the float arm indicates the fuel level. The fuel level sensor contains a variable resistor which
changes resistance in correspondence with the amount of fuel in the fuel tank. The Powertrain
Control Module ( PCM) sends the fuel level information via the class 2 circuit to the Instrument
Panel Cluster (IPC). This information is used for the IPC fuel gauge and the low fuel warning
indicator, if applicable. The PCM also monitors the fuel level input for various diagnostics.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 9451
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the fuel sender assembly. 2. Disconnect the fuel pump electrical connector (5). 3.
Remove the fuel level sensor electrical connector retaining clip (6). 4. Disconnect the fuel level
sensor electrical connector (7) from under the fuel sender cover. 5. Remove the fuel level sensor
retaining clip (4). 6. Squeeze the locking tangs and remove the fuel level sensor (3).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the fuel level sensor (3). 2. Install the fuel level sensor retaining clip (4). 3. Connect the
fuel level sensor electrical connector (7). 4. Connect the fuel level sensor electrical connector
retaining clip (6). 5. Connect the fuel pump electrical connector (5). 6. Install the fuel sender
assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air
Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Disabling
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Disabling
IMPORTANT: Refer to SIR Service Precautions before disabling the SIR system.
1. Turn the steering wheel until the vehicle's wheels are pointing straight ahead. 2. Turn OFF the
ignition. 3. Remove the key from the ignition.
IMPORTANT: With the AIR BAG Fuse removed and the ignition ON, the AIR BAG indicator
illuminates. This is normal operation and does not indicate an SIR system malfunction.
4. Remove the AIR BAG Fuse from the IP fuse block. 5. Remove the sound insulator, if equipped.
6. Remove the connector position assurance (CPA) from the steering wheel module yellow 2-way
connector (1) located at the base of the steering
column.
7. Disconnect the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector (1) located at the base of the
steering column.
8. Remove the instrument panel extension. 9. Remove the CPA (2) from the IP module yellow
2-way connector (1) located under the instrument panel extension.
10. Disconnect the IP module yellow 2-way connector (1) located under the instrument panel
extension.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air
Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Disabling > Page 9457
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Enabling
1. Remove the key from the ignition. 2. Connect the IP module yellow 2-way connector (1) located
under the instrument panel extension. 3. Install the connector position assurance (CPA) (2) to the
IP module yellow 2-way connector (1) located under the instrument panel extension. 4. Install the
instrument panel extension.
5. Connect the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector (1) located at the base of the
steering column. 6. Install the CPA to the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector (1)
located at the base of the steering column. 7. Install the sound insulator, if equipped. 8. Install the
AIR BAG Fuse to the IP fuse block. 9. Staying well away from the air bags, turn ON the ignition,
with the engine OFF.
9.1. The AIR BAG indicator will flash 7 times.
9.2. The AIR BAG indicator will then turn OFF.
10. Perform Diagnostic System Check - SIR if the AIR BAG indicator does not operate as
described.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection
Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Always On
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Testing and Inspection Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Always On
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Battery positive voltage is supplied directly to the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL). The powertrain
control module (PCM) turns the MIL ON by grounding the MIL control circuit.
MIL OPERATION
The MIL is located on the instrument panel.
MIL FUNCTION
^ The MIL informs the driver that a malfunction has occurred and the vehicle should be taken in for
service as soon as possible.
^ The MIL illuminates during a bulb test and a system test.
^ A DTC will be stored if a MIL is requested by the diagnostic test.
MIL ILLUMINATION
^ The MIL will illuminate with ignition switch ON and the engine not running.
^ The MIL will turn OFF when the engine is started.
^ The MIL will remain ON if the self-diagnostic system has detected a malfunction.
^ The MIL may turn OFF if the malfunction is not present.
^ If the MIL is illuminated and the engine stalls, the MIL will remain illuminated as long as the
ignition switch is ON.
^ If the MIL is not illuminated and the engine stalls, the MIL will not illuminate until the ignition
switch is cycled OFF, then ON.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS
If the problem is intermittent, refer to Intermittent Conditions. See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Initial Inspection and
Diagnostic Overview/Diagnostic Strategies/Intermittent Conditions
TEST DESCRIPTION
Steps 1-6
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 2. This step determines if the
condition is with the MIL control circuit or the PCM.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Always On > Page 9465
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Testing and Inspection Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Inoperative
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Battery positive voltage is supplied directly to the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL). The powertrain
control module (PCM) turns the MIL ON by grounding the MIL control circuit. There should be a
steady MIL with the ignition ON and the engine OFF.
MIL OPERATION
The MIL is located on the instrument panel.
MIL FUNCTION
^ The MIL informs the driver that a malfunction has occurred and the vehicle should be taken in for
service as soon as possible.
^ The MIL illuminates during a bulb test and a system test.
^ A DTC will be stored if a MIL is requested by the diagnostic test.
MIL ILLUMINATION
^ The MIL will illuminate with ignition switch ON and the engine not running.
^ The MIL will turn OFF when the engine is started.
^ The MIL will remain ON if the self-diagnostic system has detected a malfunction.
^ The MIL may turn OFF if the malfunction is not present.
^ If the MIL is illuminated and the engine stalls, the MIL will remain illuminated as long as the
ignition switch is ON.
^ If the MIL is not illuminated and the engine stalls, the MIL will not illuminate until the ignition
switch is cycled OFF, then ON.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS
If the problem is intermittent, refer to Intermittent Conditions. See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Initial Inspection and
Diagnostic Overview/Diagnostic Strategies/Intermittent Conditions
TEST DESCRIPTION
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) Always On > Page 9466
Steps 1-14
The numbers below refer to the step numbers on the diagnostic table. 3. This step determines if the
condition is with the MIL control circuit or the PCM. 4. This step determines if a voltage is
constantly being applied to the control circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Odometer > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Odometer: Description and Operation
The IPC contains a season odometer and a trip odometer. Momentarily press the trip/reset switch
on the IPC in order to toggle between the season odometer and the trip odometer. Press the
trip/reset switch for greater than 2 seconds, while the trip odometer is displayed, in order to reset
the trip odometer.
The IPC displays the vehicle mileage and the trip mileage as determined by the IPC. The IPC
calculates the mileage based on the vehicle speed signal from the PCM. The odometer will display
'error' if an internal IPC memory failure is detected.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Odometer > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 9470
Odometer: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Change Reminder Lamp >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Oil Change Reminder Lamp: Service and Repair
This vehicle does not use the GM Oil Life System, and does not have an oil life indicator to reset.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Gauge > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Oil Pressure Gauge: Description and Operation
ENGINE OIL PRESSURE GAGE
The IPC displays the engine oil pressure as determined by the PCM. The IPC receives a class 2
message from the PCM indicating the engine oil pressure. The engine oil pressure gage defaults to
0 kPa (0 psi) or below if:
^ The PCM detects a malfunction in the engine oil pressure sensor circuit.
^ The IPC detects a loss of class 2 communications with the PCM.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Diagrams
Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Brake Warning Lamp >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Parking Brake Warning Lamp: Description and Operation
Brake Lamp
The BRAKE warning lamp on the instrument cluster turns on when the park brake is applied. The
BRAKE lamp can also be turned on by the switch in the combination valve and the antilock brake
system.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Brake Warning Lamp >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 9483
Parking Brake Warning Lamp: Service and Repair
Park Brake Warning Lamp Switch Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the park brake warning lamp switch electrical connector. 2. Remove the retainer from
the switch. 3. Remove the park brake indicator switch (1) from the vehicle.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the park brake indicator switch (1) to the vehicle.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the retaining screw.
^ Tighten the retaining screw to 4 Nm (35 inch lbs.).
3. Install the park brake indicator switch electrical connector.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Relays and Modules - Instrument
Panel > Audible Warning Device Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair
Audible Warning Device Control Module: Service and Repair
MULTIFUNCTION ALARM MODULE REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the multifunction alarm assembly from the convenience center located under the left
side of the instrument panel. 2. Release the single tab connector on the top of the assembly. 3. Pull
out the single tab connector.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the multifunction alarm assembly to the convenience center. 2. Align the retaining tab. 3.
Press the tab in place.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Fasten Safety Belt Indicator/Chime Inoperative
Seat Belt Reminder Lamp: Testing and Inspection Fasten Safety Belt Indicator/Chime Inoperative
Steps 1-4
Steps 5-11
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Fasten Safety Belt Indicator/Chime Inoperative > Page 9492
Steps 1-9
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument
Panel > Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
Headlamp And Panel Dimmer Switch
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument
Panel > Door Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Door Switch: Service and Repair Front
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Loosen the nut on the door jamb switch. 2. Gently pull the switch away from the body. 3.
Disconnect the door jamb switch from the electrical connector(s). 4. Tape the wiring to the body in
order to prevent the wiring from entering the hole in the door pillar. 5. Remove the door jamb switch
from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the door jamb switch to the vehicle. 2. Connect the electrical connector(s) to the door
jamb switch.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Tighten the nut on the door jamb switch.
Tighten Tighten the door jamb switch nut to 3 N.m (27 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument
Panel > Door Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 9501
Door Switch: Service and Repair Rear
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Loosen the nut on the door jamb switch. 2. Gently pull the switch away from the body. 3.
Disconnect the door jamb switch from the electrical connectors. 4. Tape the wiring to the body in
order to prevent the wiring from entering the hole in the door pillar. 5. Remove the door jamb switch
from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the door jamb switch to the vehicle. 2. Connect the electrical connectors to the door jamb
switch.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Tighten the nut on the door jamb switch.
Tighten Tighten the door jamb switch nut to 3 N.m (27 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument
Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Specifications
Fuel Gauge Sender: Specifications
Fuel Level Specifications
The values in the table are approximate values based on information obtained from properly
operating vehicles. Actual results may vary slightly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument
Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Specifications > Page 9505
Fuel Pump And Sender Assembly
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument
Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Specifications > Page 9506
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor
The fuel level sensor consists of a float, a wire float arm, and a ceramic resistor card. The position
of the float arm indicates the fuel level. The fuel level sensor contains a variable resistor which
changes resistance in correspondence with the amount of fuel in the fuel tank. The Powertrain
Control Module ( PCM) sends the fuel level information via the class 2 circuit to the Instrument
Panel Cluster (IPC). This information is used for the IPC fuel gauge and the low fuel warning
indicator, if applicable. The PCM also monitors the fuel level input for various diagnostics.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument
Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Specifications > Page 9507
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the fuel sender assembly. 2. Disconnect the fuel pump electrical connector (5). 3.
Remove the fuel level sensor electrical connector retaining clip (6). 4. Disconnect the fuel level
sensor electrical connector (7) from under the fuel sender cover. 5. Remove the fuel level sensor
retaining clip (4). 6. Squeeze the locking tangs and remove the fuel level sensor (3).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the fuel level sensor (3). 2. Install the fuel level sensor retaining clip (4). 3. Connect the
fuel level sensor electrical connector (7). 4. Connect the fuel level sensor electrical connector
retaining clip (6). 5. Connect the fuel pump electrical connector (5). 6. Install the fuel sender
assembly.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Tachometer: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9512
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9513
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9514
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9515
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9516
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9517
Tachometer: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9518
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9519
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9520
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9521
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9522
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9523
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9524
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9525
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9526
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9527
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9528
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9529
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9530
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9531
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9532
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9533
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9534
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9535
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9536
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9537
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9538
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9539
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9540
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9541
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9542
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9543
Tachometer: Electrical Diagrams
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators Diagrams.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Page 9544
Tachometer: Description and Operation
The IPC displays the engine speed based on the information from the PCM. The PCM converts the
data from the engine speed sensor to a 2 pulses/engine revolution signal. The IPC uses the engine
speed signal circuit (2 pulses/engine revolution) from the PCM in order to calculate the engine
speed. If the IPC detects a malfunction in the engine speed signal circuit, the IPC uses the class 2
message from the PCM indicating the engine speed.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information
> Diagrams > Page 9545
Tachometer: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Temperature Gauge: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9550
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9551
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9552
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9553
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9554
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9555
Temperature Gauge: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9556
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9557
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9558
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9559
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9560
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9561
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9562
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9563
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9564
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9565
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9566
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9567
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9568
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9569
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9570
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9571
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9572
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9573
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9574
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9575
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9576
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9577
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9578
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9579
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9580
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9581
Temperature Gauge: Electrical Diagrams
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators Diagrams.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 9582
Temperature Gauge: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire
Pressure Monitor Receiver / Transponder > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Tire Monitor System TPM Sensor Information
Tire Pressure Monitor Receiver / Transponder: Technical Service Bulletins Tire Monitor System TPM Sensor Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-03-16-003
Date: May 12, 2008
Subject: Warranty Reduction - Transfer of Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensors to
Replacement Wheels and Allowable TPM Sensor Replacements
Models: 2000-2009 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2009
HUMMER H2 2006-2009 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7x
with On-Wheel TPM Sensors
TPM Sensor / Wheel Warranty Reviews
During the last warranty review period it was noted that wheels being returned under the GM New
Vehicle Warranty were being shipped back to General Motors with the TPM sensor still attached to
the wheel. Return rates ran as high as 60% with the TPM sensors still attached. Operational TPM
sensors should not be returned to GM and are to be transferred to replacement wheels if they
become necessary.
Important:
Operational TPM Sensors that are returned under warranty to General Motors will be charged back
to the dealer.Sensors have a 10 year /150,000 mile (240,000 km) battery life, and should be
transferred if one or more wheels are replaced.
TPM Valve Stem / Grommet (0-ring) Replacement
When the TPM sensors are transferred to new wheels you should replace the component used to
seal the TPM sensor stem to the wheel. On sensors with an aluminum stem and visible nut on the
outside of the wheel a replacement grommet (0-ring) should be used to assure a proper seal. The
sensor retaining nut (except Aveo) should be tightened to 7 N.m (62 lb in) for all vehicles except
Pontiac Vibe (4.0 N.m (35.4 lb in)).
Important:
^ DO NOT overtorque the retaining nut.
Notice:
^ Factory installed TPM Sensors come with plastic aluminum or nickel-plated brass stem caps.
These caps should not be changed. Chrome plated steel caps may cause corrosion of aluminum
valve stems due to incompatibility of the metals.
On current style sensors the entire rubber stem is replaceable. The service interval on the revised
TPM sensor with replaceable stem is the same as for any other traditional valve stem. Replace the
stem at the time of tire replacement sensor transfer or whenever air seepage is suspected at the
valve stem. When replacing the valve stem tighten the screw to 1.3 N.m (11.5 lb in).
For either style of TPM sensor see the service parts guide for the correct GM part numbers to order
and use.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Tire Monitor System - TPM Sensor Information
Tire Pressure Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Tire Monitor System - TPM Sensor Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-03-16-003
Date: May 12, 2008
Subject: Warranty Reduction - Transfer of Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPM) Sensors to
Replacement Wheels and Allowable TPM Sensor Replacements
Models: 2000-2009 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2009
HUMMER H2 2006-2009 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7x
with On-Wheel TPM Sensors
TPM Sensor / Wheel Warranty Reviews
During the last warranty review period it was noted that wheels being returned under the GM New
Vehicle Warranty were being shipped back to General Motors with the TPM sensor still attached to
the wheel. Return rates ran as high as 60% with the TPM sensors still attached. Operational TPM
sensors should not be returned to GM and are to be transferred to replacement wheels if they
become necessary.
Important:
Operational TPM Sensors that are returned under warranty to General Motors will be charged back
to the dealer.Sensors have a 10 year /150,000 mile (240,000 km) battery life, and should be
transferred if one or more wheels are replaced.
TPM Valve Stem / Grommet (0-ring) Replacement
When the TPM sensors are transferred to new wheels you should replace the component used to
seal the TPM sensor stem to the wheel. On sensors with an aluminum stem and visible nut on the
outside of the wheel a replacement grommet (0-ring) should be used to assure a proper seal. The
sensor retaining nut (except Aveo) should be tightened to 7 N.m (62 lb in) for all vehicles except
Pontiac Vibe (4.0 N.m (35.4 lb in)).
Important:
^ DO NOT overtorque the retaining nut.
Notice:
^ Factory installed TPM Sensors come with plastic aluminum or nickel-plated brass stem caps.
These caps should not be changed. Chrome plated steel caps may cause corrosion of aluminum
valve stems due to incompatibility of the metals.
On current style sensors the entire rubber stem is replaceable. The service interval on the revised
TPM sensor with replaceable stem is the same as for any other traditional valve stem. Replace the
stem at the time of tire replacement sensor transfer or whenever air seepage is suspected at the
valve stem. When replacing the valve stem tighten the screw to 1.3 N.m (11.5 lb in).
For either style of TPM sensor see the service parts guide for the correct GM part numbers to order
and use.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Shift Position Indicator
Lamp > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Instruments - Reduced PRNDL Display Visibility
Transmission Shift Position Indicator Lamp: Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Reduced
PRNDL Display Visibility
Bulletin No.: 02-08-42-004A
Date: March 30, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: PRNDL Display Reduced Visibility For Approximately One Minute
Models: 2007 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2007 and Prior HUMMER
H2, H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
with Automatic Headlamp Control and Vacuum Fluorescent PRNDL Indicator Instrument Panel
Cluster
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to include additional models and model years. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 02-08-42-0004 (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
After backing the vehicle out of a garage or dark environment into a daylight environment, the
PRNDL display has reduced visibility for approximately one minute.
While the vehicle is parked in a dark environment, the sensor for the automatic headlamp/driving
lamps senses that it is dark. When the key is turned to the run/start position, the automatic
headlamp module will turn all driving lamps, the instrument panel cluster and PRNDL display ON in
the night-time mode. The night-time mode intensity of the instrument panel lamps and PRNDL
display is controlled by the automatic headlamp module and can be dimmed further by the
customer using the dimming control of the headlamp switch.
When the customer then moves the vehicle from the dark environment into the bright sunlight, it will
take approximately one minute before the headlamp control module recognizes this as true daylight
and not just a bright overhead street lamp shining on the sensor. The headlamp control module will
then turn the headlamps off and restore the instrument panel and PRNDL display to full brilliance.
Without the time delay, the automatic headlamp control module would switch to the night mode
(turn on all driving lamps, instrument panel lamps and PRNDL display would dim) each time the
vehicle was driven under an overpass or other darkened environment.
This is a normal condition and no repair should be attempted.
Ensure the instrument panel backlighting control is in the full bright position. This will help alleviate
the condition. You may demonstrate to the customer what happens by placing a repair order over
the automatic headlamp control light sensor, which will cause the automatic headlamp control
module to switch to the night mode in approximately one minute. All driving lamps will come ON,
the instrument panel backlight will be dim, and the PRNDL display will also dim to the night setting
in conjunction with the position of the headlamp switch dimming control. Demonstrate to the
customer the variance in the instrument panel backlighting and PRNDL display while adjusting the
headlamp switch dimming control to both ends of its allowable range. Advise the customer to keep
the headlight switch dimming control in the highest position to allow viewing of the PRNDL display
in a bright environment.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Volt Meter Gauge: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9600
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9601
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9602
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9603
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9604
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9605
Volt Meter Gauge: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9606
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9607
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9608
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9609
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9610
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9611
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9612
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9613
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9614
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9615
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9616
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9617
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9618
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9619
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9620
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9621
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9622
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9623
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9624
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9625
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9626
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9627
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9628
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9629
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9630
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9631
Volt Meter Gauge: Electrical Diagrams
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators Diagrams.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 9632
Volt Meter Gauge: Testing and Inspection
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Ambient Light Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9639
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9640
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9641
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9642
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9643
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9644
Ambient Light Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9645
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9646
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9647
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9648
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9649
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9650
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9651
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9652
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9653
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9654
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9655
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9656
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9657
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9658
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9659
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9660
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9661
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9662
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9663
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9664
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9665
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9666
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9667
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9668
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9669
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9670
Ambient Light Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9671
Ambient Light Sensor: Electrical Diagrams
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Lighting and Horns Diagrams.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
9672
Ambient Light Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to Lighting
and Horns Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
9673
Ambient Light Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Lift upward on the center defogger grille located in center of the dash to expose the DRL photo
sensor (1) retainer. 2. Turn the DRL photo sensor counterclockwise 1/4 turn in order to remove. 3.
Disconnect the electrical connection from the DRL photo sensor (1).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Connect the electrical connection to the DRL photo sensor (1). 2. Insert the DRL photo sensor
(1) and turn counterclockwise 1/4 turn in order to seat. 3. Install the defogger grille located in the
center of the dash by push downward.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Lighting - Exterior Lamp Condensation and Replacement
Backup Lamp: Technical Service Bulletins Lighting - Exterior Lamp Condensation and
Replacement
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 01-08-42-001H
Date: January 05, 2011
Subject: Exterior Lamp Condensation and Replacement Guidelines
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 01-08-42-001G (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
The following information is being provided to better define the causes of condensation in exterior
lamps and includes guidelines for determining the difference between a lamp with a normal
atmospheric condition (condensation) and a lamp with a water leak.
Some exterior lamps, such as cornering, turn signal, backup, headlamps or tail lamps may exhibit
very small droplets of water, a fine mist or white fog (condensation) on the inside of the lamp lens.
This may be more noticeable on lamps with "multi-lens" designs and may be normal during certain
weather conditions.
Condensation occurs when the air inside the lamp assembly, through atmospheric changes,
reaches the "dew point". When this takes place, the moisture in the air within the lamp assembly
condenses, creating a fine mist or white fog on the inside surface of the lamp lens.
Most exterior lamps on General Motors vehicles use a vented design and feature a replaceable
bulb assembly. They are designed to remove any accumulated moisture vapor by expelling it
through a vent system. The vent system operates at all times, however, it is most effective when
the lamps are ON or when the vehicle is in motion. Depending on the size, shape and location of
the lamp on the vehicle, and the atmospheric conditions occurring, the amount of time required to
clear the lamp may vary from 2 to 6 hours.
Completely sealed headlamp assemblies (sealed beams) are still used on a limited number of
models being manufactured today. These lamps require the replacement of the complete lamp
assembly if a bulb filament burns out.
Condensation 2006 TrailBlazer Shown
A Fine Mist or White Fog on the Inside Surface of the Lamp Lens Occurring After a Period of High
Humidity
- May be located primarily in the lens corners (near the vents) and SHOULD NOT cover more than
half the lens surface.
- The condition should clear of moisture when the vehicle is parked in a dry environment, or when
the vehicle is driven with the lights ON.
- A comparison of the equivalent lamp on the opposing side of the vehicle indicates a SIMILAR
performance.
If the above conditions are noted, the customer should be advised that replacement of a lamp
assembly may not correct this condition.
Water Leak New Style Pickup Shown
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Lighting - Exterior Lamp Condensation and Replacement > Page 9678
Numerous & Various Size Drops of Water Collecting on the Inside Surface of the Lamp Lens After
the Vehicle Has Been Exposed to Rain or a Car Washing Environment
- A condition that covers more than half the surface of the lamp lens.
- An accumulation of water in the bottom of the lamp assembly.
- A condition that WON'T clear when the vehicle is parked in a dry environment, or when the
vehicle is driven with the lights ON.
- A comparison of the equivalent lamp on the opposing side of the vehicle indicates a different
performance.
Any of the above conditions would indicate the need to service the lens or lamp assembly.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Page 9679
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Backup Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9682
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9683
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9684
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9685
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9686
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9687
Backup Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9688
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9689
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9690
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9691
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9692
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9693
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9694
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9695
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9696
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9697
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9698
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9699
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9700
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9701
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9702
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9703
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9704
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9705
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9706
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9707
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9708
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9709
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9710
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9711
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9712
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9713
Backup Lamp: Connector Views
Backup Lamp - Right
Backup Lamp - Left
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9714
Backup Lamp: Electrical Diagrams
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Lighting and Horns Diagrams.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9715
Backup Lamp: Description and Operation
The TURN-B/U fuse in the IP fuse block supplies battery positive voltage to the normally open
backup lamp switch. When driver places the gear selector lever is in the REVERSE position, the
backup lamp switch closes and the current flow is from the backup lamp switch to the backup
lamps. The backup lamps are grounded at G400 and G401.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9716
Backup Lamp: Testing and Inspection
For information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to Lighting
and Horns Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Lighting - Exterior Lamp Condensation and Replacement
Brake Lamp: Technical Service Bulletins Lighting - Exterior Lamp Condensation and Replacement
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 01-08-42-001H
Date: January 05, 2011
Subject: Exterior Lamp Condensation and Replacement Guidelines
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 01-08-42-001G (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
The following information is being provided to better define the causes of condensation in exterior
lamps and includes guidelines for determining the difference between a lamp with a normal
atmospheric condition (condensation) and a lamp with a water leak.
Some exterior lamps, such as cornering, turn signal, backup, headlamps or tail lamps may exhibit
very small droplets of water, a fine mist or white fog (condensation) on the inside of the lamp lens.
This may be more noticeable on lamps with "multi-lens" designs and may be normal during certain
weather conditions.
Condensation occurs when the air inside the lamp assembly, through atmospheric changes,
reaches the "dew point". When this takes place, the moisture in the air within the lamp assembly
condenses, creating a fine mist or white fog on the inside surface of the lamp lens.
Most exterior lamps on General Motors vehicles use a vented design and feature a replaceable
bulb assembly. They are designed to remove any accumulated moisture vapor by expelling it
through a vent system. The vent system operates at all times, however, it is most effective when
the lamps are ON or when the vehicle is in motion. Depending on the size, shape and location of
the lamp on the vehicle, and the atmospheric conditions occurring, the amount of time required to
clear the lamp may vary from 2 to 6 hours.
Completely sealed headlamp assemblies (sealed beams) are still used on a limited number of
models being manufactured today. These lamps require the replacement of the complete lamp
assembly if a bulb filament burns out.
Condensation 2006 TrailBlazer Shown
A Fine Mist or White Fog on the Inside Surface of the Lamp Lens Occurring After a Period of High
Humidity
- May be located primarily in the lens corners (near the vents) and SHOULD NOT cover more than
half the lens surface.
- The condition should clear of moisture when the vehicle is parked in a dry environment, or when
the vehicle is driven with the lights ON.
- A comparison of the equivalent lamp on the opposing side of the vehicle indicates a SIMILAR
performance.
If the above conditions are noted, the customer should be advised that replacement of a lamp
assembly may not correct this condition.
Water Leak New Style Pickup Shown
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Lighting - Exterior Lamp Condensation and Replacement > Page 9721
Numerous & Various Size Drops of Water Collecting on the Inside Surface of the Lamp Lens After
the Vehicle Has Been Exposed to Rain or a Car Washing Environment
- A condition that covers more than half the surface of the lamp lens.
- An accumulation of water in the bottom of the lamp assembly.
- A condition that WON'T clear when the vehicle is parked in a dry environment, or when the
vehicle is driven with the lights ON.
- A comparison of the equivalent lamp on the opposing side of the vehicle indicates a different
performance.
Any of the above conditions would indicate the need to service the lens or lamp assembly.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 9722
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 9723
Brake Lamp: Diagrams
Tail/Stop And Turn Signal Lamp - Left
Tail/Stop Lamp - Left - Export
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 9724
Tail/Stop And Turn Signal Lamp - Right
Tail/Stop Lamp - Right - Export
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 9725
Brake Lamp: Description and Operation
STOPLAMPS
The STOP/HAZ fuse in the IP fuse block supplies battery positive voltage to the normally open
stoplamp switch. When the driver presses the brake pedal, the switch contacts close and battery
positive voltage is supplied to the multifunction turn signal switch. The current flow is now to the
stoplamps which are grounded at G400 and G401. The Center High Mounted Stoplamp (CHMSL)
is grounded at G400.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
9729
Stop Lamp Switch
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
9730
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
Stop Lamp Switch Replacement
Removal Procedure
Caution: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the retainer (3) from the brake pedal pin. 3.
Unsnap the switch (2) and pushrod (4) from the brake pedal (1) pin.
4. Disconnect the electrical connector.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
9731
1. Connect the electrical connector.
2. Install the switch (2) and pushrod (4) onto the brake pedal (1) pin. 3. Install the retainer (3) onto
the brake pedal (1) pin. 4. Connect the battery negative cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Locations
Center Mounted Brake Lamp: Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Locations >
Page 9735
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Center Mounted Brake Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9738
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9739
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9740
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9741
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9742
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9743
Center Mounted Brake Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9744
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9745
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9746
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9747
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9748
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9749
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9750
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9751
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9752
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9753
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9754
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9755
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9756
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9757
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9758
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9759
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9760
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9761
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9762
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9763
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9764
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9765
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9766
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9767
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9768
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9769
Center High Mounted Stoplamp (CHMSL)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9770
Center Mounted Brake Lamp: Electrical Diagrams
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Lighting and Horns Diagrams.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 9771
Center Mounted Brake Lamp: Testing and Inspection
For information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to Lighting
and Horns Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 9772
Center Mounted Brake Lamp: Service and Repair
HIGH MOUNTED STOP LAMP REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the center high-mounted stop lamp retaining screws. 2. Gently pull the electrical
connector through the top of the roof. 3. Disconnect the electrical connector. 4. Remove the
high-mounted stop lamp from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the high-mounted stop lamp to the vehicle. 2. Connect the electrical connector. 3.
Carefully push the electrical connector back into the roof.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the high-mounted stop lamp retaining screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Glove Box Lamp > Component Information >
Diagrams
I/P Compartment Lamp
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Glove Box Lamp > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 9777
Glove Box Lamp: Description and Operation
IP COMPARTMENT LAMP
The inadvertent power relay also provides battery positive voltage to the instrument panel
compartment lamp. When the IP compartment is opened, the internal switch closes to provide a
ground circuit and the IP compartment lamp illuminates.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Daytime Running Lamp Diode Assembly >
Component Information > Locations
Daytime Running Lamp Diode Assembly: Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Daytime Running Lamp Diode Assembly >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9782
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Daytime Running Lamp Diode Assembly >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9783
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Diode
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Daytime Running Lamp Diode Assembly >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9784
Daytime Running Lamp Diode Assembly: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the body side front lower trim panel. 2. Remove the screw that retains the diode to the
body lock pillar. 3. Disconnect the electrical connector from the diode. 4. Remove the diode from
the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the diode to the vehicle. 2. Connect the electrical connector to the diode.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the screw that retains the diode to the body lock pillar.
Tighten Tighten the screw that retains the diode to the body lock pillar to 6 N.m (53 lb in).
4. Install the body side front lower trim panel.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Daytime Running Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Daytime Running Lamp Relay: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the left side of the knee bolster. 2. Remove the cover (4) from the block to expose the
DRL daytime running lights relay. 3. Remove the relay from the block.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the relay to the block. 2. Install the cover (4) to the block for the DRL daytime running
lights relay. 3. Install the left side of the knee bolster.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
Headlamp And Panel Dimmer Switch
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dome Lamp > Dome Lamp Switch > Component Information >
Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Door Switch: Service and Repair Front
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Loosen the nut on the door jamb switch. 2. Gently pull the switch away from the body. 3.
Disconnect the door jamb switch from the electrical connector(s). 4. Tape the wiring to the body in
order to prevent the wiring from entering the hole in the door pillar. 5. Remove the door jamb switch
from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the door jamb switch to the vehicle. 2. Connect the electrical connector(s) to the door
jamb switch.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Tighten the nut on the door jamb switch.
Tighten Tighten the door jamb switch nut to 3 N.m (27 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front >
Page 9799
Door Switch: Service and Repair Rear
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Loosen the nut on the door jamb switch. 2. Gently pull the switch away from the body. 3.
Disconnect the door jamb switch from the electrical connectors. 4. Tape the wiring to the body in
order to prevent the wiring from entering the hole in the door pillar. 5. Remove the door jamb switch
from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the door jamb switch to the vehicle. 2. Connect the electrical connectors to the door jamb
switch.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Tighten the nut on the door jamb switch.
Tighten Tighten the door jamb switch nut to 3 N.m (27 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Flasher: > NHTSA05V099000 > Mar > 05 > Recall
05V099000: Brake/Hazard Lamp Failure
Hazard Warning Flasher: Recalls Recall 05V099000: Brake/Hazard Lamp Failure
MAKE/MODELS: MODEL/BUILD YEARS: Chevrolet/Astro 2001-2002 GMC/Safari 2001-2002
MANUFACTURER: General Motors Corp. NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 05V099000 RECALL
DATE: March 09, 2005
COMPONENT: Exterior Lighting: Brake Lights: Switch
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 77055
SUMMARY: On certain minivans, the multifunction switch may develop an open circuit condition in
the stop lamp or hazard lamp circuit that results in the stop lamps and hazard lamps being
inoperative.
CONSEQUENCE: The loss of stop lamps and rear hazard lamps could fail to warn a following
driver that the vehicle is braking and/or is stopped and could lead to a vehicle crash.
REMEDY: Dealers will replace the hazard warning flasher switch and apply special grease to the
contacts at the time of installation of the module. The repair would be used in vehicles in which the
hazard slider button is still movable. If a vehicle has a hazard slider button that is not movable
(frozen), the entire multifunction switch will be replaced. The manufacturer has not yet provided an
owner notification schedule. Owners should contact Chevrolet at 1-800-630-2438 or GMC at
1-866-996-9463.
NOTES: GM recall No. 05013. Customers can also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Auto Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Flasher: >
NHTSA05V099000 > Mar > 05 > Recall 05V099000: Brake/Hazard Lamp Failure
Hazard Warning Flasher: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 05V099000: Brake/Hazard Lamp
Failure
MAKE/MODELS: MODEL/BUILD YEARS: Chevrolet/Astro 2001-2002 GMC/Safari 2001-2002
MANUFACTURER: General Motors Corp. NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 05V099000 RECALL
DATE: March 09, 2005
COMPONENT: Exterior Lighting: Brake Lights: Switch
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 77055
SUMMARY: On certain minivans, the multifunction switch may develop an open circuit condition in
the stop lamp or hazard lamp circuit that results in the stop lamps and hazard lamps being
inoperative.
CONSEQUENCE: The loss of stop lamps and rear hazard lamps could fail to warn a following
driver that the vehicle is braking and/or is stopped and could lead to a vehicle crash.
REMEDY: Dealers will replace the hazard warning flasher switch and apply special grease to the
contacts at the time of installation of the module. The repair would be used in vehicles in which the
hazard slider button is still movable. If a vehicle has a hazard slider button that is not movable
(frozen), the entire multifunction switch will be replaced. The manufacturer has not yet provided an
owner notification schedule. Owners should contact Chevrolet at 1-800-630-2438 or GMC at
1-866-996-9463.
NOTES: GM recall No. 05013. Customers can also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Auto Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9814
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9815
Hazard Warning Flasher: Service and Repair
HAZARD AND TURN SIGNAL FLASHER REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Open the driver door. 2. In order to remove the flasher module (1) from the instrument panel (IP)
convenience center, simultaneously perform the following:
2.1. Lift upward on the tab that retains the flasher module to the IP convenience center. 2.2.
Remove the flasher module from the IP convenience center.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Position the flasher module (1) to the IP convenience center. 2. Engage the flasher module until
fully seated and the retaining tab clicks. 3. Close the driver door.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard
Warning Flasher Switch Replacement
Technical Service Bulletin # 05013A Date: 050526
Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement
Bulletin No.: 05013A
Date: May 26, 2005
SAFETY
Subject: 05013A - Multifunction Switch Contacts
Models: 2001-2002 Chevrolet Astro 2001-2002 GMC Safari
Supercede:
THE INSPECTION IN STEP 35 OF THE PROCEDURE "REPLACING THE HAZARD WARNING
FLASHER SWITCH" HAS BEEN REVISED AND PART NUMBER 15174447 HAS BEEN
ELIMINATED. PLEASE REVIEW THIS NEW INFORMATION IMMEDIATELY. DISCARD ALL
COPIES OF BULLETIN 05013 ISSUED APRIL 2005.
Condition
General Motors has decided that a defect, which relates to motor vehicle safety, exists in certain
2001-2002 Chevrolet Astro and GMC Safari vehicles. On some of these vehicles, the stop lamps
and rear hazard lamps may become inoperative. The usage factors that increase the possibility of
this condition occurring include frequency and length of brake applications, frequency of trailer
towing with brake applications, and exposure to high ambient temperatures. The center high
mounted stop lamp and turn signal lamp functionality are not affected. The loss of stop lamps
and/or rear hazard lamps could fail to warn a following driver that the vehicle is braking and/or is
stopped and could lead to a vehicle accident.
Correction
Dealers are to inspect and replace the hazard warning flasher switch, if necessary. In a small
number of vehicles, the multifunction switch will require replacement.
Vehicles Involved
Involved are certain 2001-2002 Chevrolet Astro and GMC Safari vehicles built within the VIN
breakpoints shown.
Important:
Dealers should confirm vehicle eligibility through GMVIS (GM Vehicle Inquiry System) before
beginning recall repairs. [Not all vehicles within the above breakpoints may be involved.]
For US & Canada
For dealers with involved vehicles, a Campaign Initiation Detail Report containing the complete
Vehicle Identification Number, customer name and address data has been prepared and will be
loaded to the GM DealerWorld (U.S.), GMinfoNet (Canada) Recall Information website. Dealers
that have no involved vehicles currently assigned will not have a report available in GM
DealerWorld/GMinfoNet.
For Export
For dealers with involved vehicles, a Campaign Initiation Detail Report containing the complete
Vehicle Identification Number, customer name and address data has been prepared, and is being
furnished to involved dealers. Dealers that have no involved vehicles currently assigned will not
receive a report with the recall bulletin.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard
Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9824
The Campaign Initiation Detail Report may contain customer names and addresses obtained from
Motor Vehicle Registration Records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any
purpose other than follow-up necessary to complete this recall is a violation of law in several
states/provinces/countries. Accordingly, you are urged to limit the use of this report to the follow-up
necessary to complete this recall.
Parts Information
Parts required to complete this recall are to be obtained from General Motors Service Parts
Operations (GMSPO). Please refer to your "involved vehicles listing" before ordering parts. Normal
orders should be placed on a DRO=Daily Replenishment Order. In an emergency situation, parts
should be ordered on a CSO = Customer Special Order.
Customer Reimbursement - For US
All customer requests for reimbursement for previous repairs for the recall condition will be handled
by the Customer Assistance Center, not by dealers.
A General Motors Product Recall Customer Reimbursement Procedure Form is shown in this
bulletin.
Important:
Refer to the GM Service Policies and Procedures Manual, section 6.1.12, for specific procedures
regarding customer reimbursement and the form.
Customer Reimbursement - For Canada & Export
Customer requests for reimbursement of previously paid repairs to correct the condition addressed
in this bulletin are to be submitted by April 30, 2006.
All reasonable customer paid receipts should be considered for reimbursement. The amount to be
reimbursed will be limited to the amount the repair would have cost if completed by an authorized
General Motors dealer.
When a customer requests reimbursement, they must provide the following:
^ Proof of ownership at time of repair.
^ Original paid receipt confirming the amount of repair expense(s) that were not reimbursed, a
description of the repair, and the person or entity performing the repair.
Claims for customer reimbursement on previously paid repairs are to be submitted as required by
WINS.
Important:
Refer to the GM Service Policies and Procedures Manual, section 1.6.2, for specific procedures
regarding customer reimbursement verification.
Courtesy Transportation
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard
Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9825
The General Motors Courtesy Transportation Program is intended to minimize customer
inconvenience when a vehicle requires a repair that is covered by the New Vehicle Limited
Warranty. The availability of courtesy transportation to customers whose vehicles are within the
warranty coverage period and involved in a product recall is very important in maintaining customer
satisfaction. Dealers are to ensure that these customers understand that shuttle service or some
other form of courtesy transportation is available and will be provided at no charge. Dealers should
refer to the General Motors Service Policies and Procedures Manual for courtesy transportation
guidelines.
Claim Information
Submit a Product Recall Claim with the information shown.
Refer to the General Motors WINS Claims Processing Manual for details on Product Recall Claim
Submission.
Customer Notification - For US and Canada
General Motors will notify customers of this recall on their vehicle (see copy of customer letter
shown in this bulletin).
Customer Notification - For Export
Letters will be sent to known owners of record located within areas covered by the US National
Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act. For owners outside these areas, dealers should notify
customers using the sample letter.
Dealer Recall Responsibility - For US and Export (US States, Territories, and Possessions)
The US National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act provides that each vehicle which is subject to
a recall of this type must be adequately repaired within a reasonable time after the customer has
tendered it for repair. A failure to repair within sixty days after tender of a vehicle is prima facie
evidence
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard
Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9826
of failure to repair within a reasonable time. If the condition is not adequately repaired within a
reasonable time, the customer may be entitled to an identical or reasonably equivalent vehicle at
no charge or to a refund of the purchase price less a reasonable allowance for depreciation. To
avoid having to provide these burdensome remedies, every effort must be made to promptly
schedule an appointment with each customer and to repair their vehicle as soon as possible. In the
recall notification letters, customers are told how to contact the US National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration if the recall is not completed within a reasonable time.
Dealer Recall Responsibility - All
All unsold new vehicles in dealers, possession and subject to this recall MUST be held and
inspected/repaired per the service procedure of this recall bulletin BEFORE customers take
possession of these vehicles.
Dealers are to service all vehicles subject to this recall at no charge to customers, regardless of
mileage, age of vehicle, or ownership, from this time forward.
Customers who have recently purchased vehicles sold from your vehicle inventory, and for which
there is no customer information indicated on the dealer listing, are to be contacted by the dealer.
Arrangements are to be made to make the required correction according to the instructions
contained in this bulletin. A copy of the customer letter is shown in this bulletin for your use in
contacting customers. Recall follow-up cards should not be used for this purpose, since the
customer may not as yet have received the notification letter.
In summary, whenever a vehicle subject to this recall enters your vehicle inventory, or is in your
dealership for service in the future, please take the steps necessary to be sure the recall correction
has been made before selling or releasing the vehicle.
GENERAL MOTORS PRODUCT RECALL CUSTOMER REIMBURSEMENT PROCEDURE
If you have paid to have this recall condition corrected prior to receiving this notification, you may
be eligible to receive reimbursement.
Requests for reimbursement may include parts, labor, fees and taxes. Reimbursement may be
limited to the amount the repair would have cost if completed by an authorized General Motors
dealer.
Your claim will be acted upon within 60 days of receipt.
If your claim is:
^ Approved, you will receive a check from General Motors.
^ Denied, you will receive a letter from General Motors with the reason(s) for the denial, or
^ Incomplete, you will receive a letter from General Motors identifying the documentation that is
needed to complete the claim and offered the opportunity to resubmit the claim when the missing
documentation is available.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard
Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9827
Please follow the instructions on the Claim Form shown to file a claim for reimbursement. If you
have questions about this reimbursement procedure, please call the toll-free telephone number
provided on the form. If you need assistance with any other concern, please contact the
appropriate Customer Assistance Center at the number also shown. The Customer Assistance
Center hours of operation are from 8:00 AM - 11:00 PM eastern standard time Monday through
Friday.
Disclaimer
Service Procedure
The following procedure describes how to inspect and replace the hazard warning flasher switch,
OR inspect and replace the multifunction (turn signal, headlamp dimmer, and windshield
wiper/washer) switch assembly. The part that you replace will be determined during the inspection
portion of this procedure. Do NOT replace any parts until after performing the inspection procedure.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard
Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9828
Inspection Procedure
1. From inside the vehicle, depress the hazard warning flasher switch located on the top of the
steering column.
2. Depress the hazard warning flasher switch again.
^ If the hazard warning flasher switch did not stick in either the up or down position, proceed to the
section titled "Replacing the Hazard Warning Flasher Switch." Do not order any replacement parts
until instructed to in the additional inspection procedure included in that section.
^ If the hazard warning flasher switch is sticking in either the up or down position, replace the
multifunction switch. Proceed to the section titled "Replacing the Multifunction Switch."
Replacing the Hazard Warning Flasher Switch
This procedure describes how to replace ONLY the hazard warning flasher switch assembly. The
procedure includes information on how to remove the original switch, where to apply the lubricant
on the new switch, and how to install the new switch.
DO NOT use this procedure if the inspection above indicates that the multifunction switch requires
replacement. Contained in this procedure are unique steps to address features or options such as
cruise control, standard or tilt column, and a column mounted automatic transmission lever.
Tools Required
^ J 1859-A Steering Wheel Puller
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
2. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
3. Remove the SIR fuse from the fuse block.
4. Remove the screws attaching the driver's side knee bolster trim panel underneath the I/P and
reposition the panel out of the way.
5. Locate the driver's side yellow 2-way air bag electrical connector at the base of the steering
column and remove the connector position assurance (CPA) from the connector.
6. Disconnect the yellow 2-way electrical connector.
7. If equipped, remove the tilt steering column lever.
Important:
Some of the illustrations included in this procedure show the steering column removed from the
vehicle. Those illustrations are for reference purposes only. DO NOT remove the steering column
from the vehicle to perform this repair procedure.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the RUN position to unlock the steering wheel.
9. Turn the steering wheel 90 degrees so that the side of the SIR module is at the 12 o'clock
position in order to gain access to the holes behind the
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard
Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9829
steering wheel.
10. Insert a flat-bladed tool into the access hole and push the leaf spring in order to release the
notched pin that retains the inflator module.
11. Turn the steering wheel 180 degrees in order to gain access to the remaining access hole.
12. Insert a screwdriver into the remaining hole and push the leaf spring in order to release the
notched pin that retains the inflator module.
13. Tilt the top of the inflator module rearward to gain access to the SIR wiring.
14. Disconnect the SIR lead wire from the clip on the inflator module.
15. Disconnect the SIR lead wire from the clip on the steering wheel.
16. Disconnect the CPA retainer.
17. Disconnect the electrical connector.
Caution:
When you are carrying an undeployed inflator module:
^ Do not carry the inflator module by the wires or connector on the inflator module.
^ Make sure the bag opening points away from you.
^ When you are storing an undeployed inflator module, make sure the bag opening points away
from the surface on which the inflator module rests. Provide free space for the air bag to expand in
case of an accidental deployment. Otherwise, personal injury may result.
18. Set the SIR module aside.
19. Remove the horn plunger from the steering column by pressing inward to the stop and rotate
the horn plunger 90 degrees.
20. Remove the steering wheel retaining nut.
21. Install the J 1859-A, Steering Wheel Puller, to the steering wheel.
22. Remove the steering wheel using the J 1859-A.
23. Remove the J 1859-A from the steering wheel.
24. Remove the tilt lever.
25. Remove the screws attaching the lower steering column cover to the steering column.
26. Remove the lower steering column trim cover from the upper steering column trim cover.
26.1 Tilt the lower steering column trim cover down.
26.2 Slide the lower steering column trim cover backward in order to disengage the locking tabs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard
Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9830
27. Remove the upper steering column trim cover mounting screws (1).
28. Lift the upper steering column trim cover to gain access to the lock cylinder access hole.
29. Using a bent tip awl, insert the tip into the ignition lock cylinder access hole.
30. Turn the ignition lock cylinder to the START position.
31. Using the bent tip awl, push down on the ignition lock cylinder retaining pin.
32. Release the ignition lock cylinder to the RUN position.
33. Remove the ignition lock cylinder from the lock module by pulling the ignition lock cylinder away
from the steering column.
34. Remove the upper column cover.
Important:
The illustration above is for the purpose of identifying the barcode only. The actual location of the
barcode on the switch may differ.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard
Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9831
35. Inspect the part number (1) on the multifunction switch at the location shown in the illustration.
36. If the part number is 26084051, 26084052, 26096834, 26096835, 26102157 or 26102158, no
repair is required. Proceed to the section titled "Reassemble Vehicle."
^ If there is NO part number or barcode on the switch, no repair is required. Proceed to the section
titled "Reassemble Vehicle."
^ If the part number or barcode on the switch is 26091775 or 26091776, proceed to the next step
and replace the hazard warning flasher switch using part number 15177379.
Important:
Carefully review the above illustration to determine the exact location to insert the screwdriver in
the next step.
37. Insert a small, pocket-sized, flat bladed screwdriver (2) into the small space between the
hazard warning flasher switch housing (1) and the multifunction switch (3).
38. Carefully tilt the screwdriver handle towards the instrument cluster. This will cause the blade of
the screwdriver to pry open the space between the hazard warning flasher switch housing and the
multifunction switch.
39. While the space is pried open, pull the hazard warning flasher switch out of the multifunction
switch. Discard the hazard warning flasher switch.
Note:
Do not touch the three triangle-shaped electrical contacts (1) on the side of the switch when
removing the protective packaging, handling, or applying grease to the new hazard warning flasher
switch in the next steps.
40. Remove the rubber band and protective plastic wrapping from the new hazard warning flasher
switch.
Important:
The electrical contacts on the new hazard warning flasher switch require a special lubricant, which
is included in the kit. Only apply this special lubricant as instructed in the next step. DO NOT use
any other type of grease or lubricant.
41. Open the container of special grease included in the kit and apply it to the surfaces of the three
triangle-shaped electrical contacts (1) on the side of the new hazard warning flasher switch. When
properly applied, the surfaces of the three triangle-shaped electrical contacts must be completely
covered and there should be no grease left in the container. DO NOT put any grease in the
opening that contains the small metal return spring.
42. Insert the hazard warning flasher switch into the opening of the multifunction switch and press
down until it locks into place.
43. Remove any excess grease that may appear around the base of the hazard warning flasher
switch. Proceed to the next section "Reassemble Vehicle."
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard
Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9832
Reassemble Vehicle
1. Install the upper steering column cover.
2. Insert the ignition lock cylinder through the upper shroud.
3. Install the ignition lock cylinder to the lock module by doing the following:
3.1. Align the positioning slot and locking tab slot on the lock module assembly to the positioning
tab and locking tab on the ignition lock cylinder.
3.2. Push the ignition lock cylinder into the lock module assembly until the locking tab locks against
the lock module.
4. Install the upper steering column cover screws.
Tighten
Tighten the screws to 1.5 N.m (13 lb in).
Important:
The shift lever seal must be seated in the covers.
5. Install the lower steering column trim cover to the upper steering column trim cover.
5.1. Match the tab slots on the lower steering column trim cover with the locking tabs on the upper
steering column trim cover.
5.2. Tilt the lower steering column trim cover up.
5.3. Slide the lower steering column trim cover forward until the locking tabs snap into the tab slots.
6. Install the lower steering column cover screws.
Tighten
Tighten the screws to 3.5 N.m (31 lb in).
7. Install the tilt lever.
8. Install the steering wheel to the steering shaft.
9. Install the steering wheel retaining nut.
Tighten
Tighten the steering wheel retaining nut to 41 N.m (30 lb ft).
10. Install the horn plunger to the steering column.
11. Position the SIR module near the steering wheel.
12. Connect the SIR electrical connector.
13. Connect the CPA retainer to the SIR connector.
14. Connect the SIR lead wire to the clip on the steering wheel.
15. Connect the SIR lead wire to the clip on the inflator module.
Important:
Verify that the wiring is not exposed or trapped between the inflatable restraint steering wheel
module and the steering wheel.
16. Press the inflator module into the steering wheel firmly enough that the module engages and
latches the notched pins in the leaf springs.
17. Rotate the steering wheel back into the straight position.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard
Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9833
18. Connect the I/P module yellow 2-way connector located under the I/P extension.
19. Install the CPA to the I/P module yellow 2-way connector located under the I/P extension.
20. Connect the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector located at the base of the steering
column.
21. Install the CPA to the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector located at the base of the
steering column.
22. Position the knee bolster trim panel to the I/P and install the attaching screws.
Tighten
Tighten the screws to 1.9 N.m (17 lb in).
23. Install the SIR fuse and install the fuse block cover.
24. Be sure that the ignition is in the OFF position.
25. Connect the negative battery.
Replacing the Multifunction Switch
This procedure describes how to replace ONLY the multifunction switch assembly. The new
multifunction switch assembly will come complete with a new hazard warning flasher switch already
installed.
DO NOT use this procedure if the results of the inspection procedure indicate that only the hazard
warning flasher switch requires replacement.
Contained in this procedure are unique steps to address features or options such as cruise control,
standard or tilt column, and a column-mounted automatic transmission lever.
Tools Required
^ J 1859-A Steering Wheel Puller
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
2. Disconnect the negative battery.
3. Remove the SIR fuse from the fuse block.
4. Remove the screws attaching the driver's side knee bolster trim panel underneath the I/P and
reposition the panel out of the way.
5. Locate the driver's side yellow 2-way air bag electrical connector at the base of the steering
column and remove the connector position assurance (CPA) from the connector.
6. Disconnect the yellow 2-way electrical connector.
7. If equipped, remove the tilt steering column lever.
Important:
Some of the illustrations included in this procedure show the steering column removed from the
vehicle. Those illustrations are for reference
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard
Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9834
purposes only. DO NOT remove the steering column from the vehicle to perform this repair
procedure.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the RUN position to unlock the steering wheel.
9. Turn the steering wheel 90 degrees so that the side of the SIR module is at the 12 o'clock
position in order to gain access to the holes behind the steering wheel.
10. Insert a flat-bladed tool into the access hole and push the leaf spring in order to release the
notched pin that retains the inflator module.
11. Turn the steering wheel 180 degrees in order to gain access to the remaining access hole.
12. Insert a screwdriver into the remaining hole and push the leaf spring in order to release the
notched pin that retains the inflator module.
13. Tilt the top of the inflator module rearward to gain access to the SIR wiring.
14. Disconnect the SIR lead wire from the clip on the inflator module.
15. Disconnect the SIR lead wire from the clip on the steering wheel.
16. Disconnect the CPA retainer.
17. Disconnect the electrical connector.
Caution:
When you are carrying an undeployed inflator module:
^ Do not carry the inflator module by the wires or connector on the inflator module.
^ Make sure the bag opening points away from you.
^ When you are storing an undeployed inflator module, make sure the bag opening points away
from the surface on which the inflator module rests. Provide free space for the air bag to expand in
case of an accidental deployment. Otherwise, personal injury may result.
18. Set the SIR module aside.
19. Remove the horn plunger from the steering column by pressing inward to the stop and rotate
the horn plunger 90 degrees.
20. Remove the steering wheel retaining nut.
21. Install the J 1859-A, Steering Wheel Puller, to the steering wheel.
22. Remove the steering wheel using the J 1859-A.
23. Remove the J 1859-A from the steering wheel.
24. Remove the tilt lever.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard
Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9835
25. Remove the screws attaching the lower steering column cover to the steering column.
26. Remove the lower steering column trim cover from the upper steering column trim cover.
27. Tilt the lower steering column trim cover down.
27.1 Slide the lower steering column trim cover backward in order to disengage the locking tabs.
28. Remove the upper steering column trim cover mounting screws (1).
29. Lift the upper steering column trim cover to gain access to the lock cylinder access hole.
30. Using a bent tip awl, insert the tip into the ignition lock cylinder access hole.
31. Turn the ignition lock cylinder to the START position.
32. Using the bent tip awl, push down on the ignition lock cylinder retaining pin.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard
Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9836
33. Release the ignition lock cylinder to the RUN position.
34. Remove the ignition lock cylinder from the lock module by pulling the ignition lock cylinder away
from the steering column.
35. Remove the upper column cover.
36. Disconnect the steering column electrical connectors.
37. Disconnect the multifunction switch connectors from the steering column electrical connector.
38. Remove the steering column wiring harness from the wiring harness strap.
39. Remove the wire harness straps from the steering column wire harness.
40. Remove the multifunction switch mounting screws.
41. Remove the multifunction switch.
Important:
The multifunction switch electrical contact must rest on the canceling cam assembly.
42. Install the new multifunction switch as follows:
42.1 Use a small blade screwdriver in order to compress the electrical contact.
42.2 Move the multifunction switch into position.
43. Install the multifunction switch mounting screws.
Tighten
Tighten the multifunction switch mounting screws to 6 N.m (53 lb in).
44. Connect the multifunction switch electrical connectors to the steering column electrical
connector.
45. Connect the steering column electrical connector to the I/P wire harness.
46. Install the wire harness straps to the steering column wire harness.
47. Install the steering column wire harness to the wiring harness strap.
48. Install the upper steering column cover.
49. Insert the ignition lock cylinder through the upper shroud.
50. Install the ignition lock cylinder to the lock module by doing the following:
50.1 Align the positioning slot and locking tab slot on the lock module assembly to the positioning
tab and locking tab on the ignition lock
cylinder.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard
Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9837
50.2 Push the ignition lock cylinder into the lock module assembly until the locking tab locks
against the lock module.
51. Install the upper steering column cover screws.
Tighten
Tighten the screws to 1.5 N.m (13 lb in).
Important:
The shift lever seal must be seated in the covers.
52. Install the lower steering column trim cover to the upper steering column trim cover.
52.1 Match the tab slots on the lower steering column trim cover with the locking tabs on the upper
steering column trim cover.
52.3 Tilt the lower steering column trim cover up.
52.3 Slide the lower steering column trim cover forward until the locking tabs snap into the tab
slots.
53. Install the lower steering column cover screws.
Tighten
Tighten the screws to 3.5 N.m (31 lb in).
54. Install the tilt lever.
55. Install the steering wheel to the steering shaft.
56. Install the steering wheel retaining nut.
Tighten
Tighten the steering wheel retaining nut to 41 N.m (30 lb ft).
57. Install the horn plunger to the steering column.
58. Position the SIR module near the steering wheel.
59. Connect the SIR electrical connector.
60. Connect the CPA retainer to the SIR connector.
61. Connect the SIR lead wire to the clip on the steering wheel.
62. Connect the SIR lead wire to the clip on the inflator module.
Important:
Verify that the wiring in not exposed or trapped between the inflatable restraint steering wheel
module and the steering wheel.
63. Press the inflator module into the steering wheel firmly enough that the module engages and
latches the notched pins in the leaf springs.
64. Rotate the steering wheel back into the straight position.
65. Connect the I/P module yellow 2-way connector located under the I/P extension.
66. Install the CPA to the I/P module yellow 2-way connector located under the I/P extension.
67. Connect the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector located at the base of the steering
column.
68. Install the CPA to the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector located at the base of the
steering column.
69. Position the knee bolster trim panel to the I/P and install the attaching screws.
Tighten
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard
Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9838
Tighten the screws to 1.9 N.m (17 lb in).
70. Install the SIR fuse and install the fuse block cover.
71. Be sure that the ignition is in the OFF position.
72. Connect the negative battery cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard
Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9839
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > NHTSA05V099000 > Mar > 05 > Recall
05V099000: Brake/Hazard Lamp Failure
Hazard Warning Switch: Recalls Recall 05V099000: Brake/Hazard Lamp Failure
MAKE/MODELS: MODEL/BUILD YEARS: Chevrolet/Astro 2001-2002 GMC/Safari 2001-2002
MANUFACTURER: General Motors Corp. NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 05V099000 RECALL
DATE: March 09, 2005
COMPONENT: Exterior Lighting: Brake Lights: Switch
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 77055
SUMMARY: On certain minivans, the multifunction switch may develop an open circuit condition in
the stop lamp or hazard lamp circuit that results in the stop lamps and hazard lamps being
inoperative.
CONSEQUENCE: The loss of stop lamps and rear hazard lamps could fail to warn a following
driver that the vehicle is braking and/or is stopped and could lead to a vehicle crash.
REMEDY: Dealers will replace the hazard warning flasher switch and apply special grease to the
contacts at the time of installation of the module. The repair would be used in vehicles in which the
hazard slider button is still movable. If a vehicle has a hazard slider button that is not movable
(frozen), the entire multifunction switch will be replaced. The manufacturer has not yet provided an
owner notification schedule. Owners should contact Chevrolet at 1-800-630-2438 or GMC at
1-866-996-9463.
NOTES: GM recall No. 05013. Customers can also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Auto Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement
Technical Service Bulletin # 05013A Date: 050526
Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement
Bulletin No.: 05013A
Date: May 26, 2005
SAFETY
Subject: 05013A - Multifunction Switch Contacts
Models: 2001-2002 Chevrolet Astro 2001-2002 GMC Safari
Supercede:
THE INSPECTION IN STEP 35 OF THE PROCEDURE "REPLACING THE HAZARD WARNING
FLASHER SWITCH" HAS BEEN REVISED AND PART NUMBER 15174447 HAS BEEN
ELIMINATED. PLEASE REVIEW THIS NEW INFORMATION IMMEDIATELY. DISCARD ALL
COPIES OF BULLETIN 05013 ISSUED APRIL 2005.
Condition
General Motors has decided that a defect, which relates to motor vehicle safety, exists in certain
2001-2002 Chevrolet Astro and GMC Safari vehicles. On some of these vehicles, the stop lamps
and rear hazard lamps may become inoperative. The usage factors that increase the possibility of
this condition occurring include frequency and length of brake applications, frequency of trailer
towing with brake applications, and exposure to high ambient temperatures. The center high
mounted stop lamp and turn signal lamp functionality are not affected. The loss of stop lamps
and/or rear hazard lamps could fail to warn a following driver that the vehicle is braking and/or is
stopped and could lead to a vehicle accident.
Correction
Dealers are to inspect and replace the hazard warning flasher switch, if necessary. In a small
number of vehicles, the multifunction switch will require replacement.
Vehicles Involved
Involved are certain 2001-2002 Chevrolet Astro and GMC Safari vehicles built within the VIN
breakpoints shown.
Important:
Dealers should confirm vehicle eligibility through GMVIS (GM Vehicle Inquiry System) before
beginning recall repairs. [Not all vehicles within the above breakpoints may be involved.]
For US & Canada
For dealers with involved vehicles, a Campaign Initiation Detail Report containing the complete
Vehicle Identification Number, customer name and address data has been prepared and will be
loaded to the GM DealerWorld (U.S.), GMinfoNet (Canada) Recall Information website. Dealers
that have no involved vehicles currently assigned will not have a report available in GM
DealerWorld/GMinfoNet.
For Export
For dealers with involved vehicles, a Campaign Initiation Detail Report containing the complete
Vehicle Identification Number, customer name and address data has been prepared, and is being
furnished to involved dealers. Dealers that have no involved vehicles currently assigned will not
receive a report with the recall bulletin.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9849
The Campaign Initiation Detail Report may contain customer names and addresses obtained from
Motor Vehicle Registration Records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any
purpose other than follow-up necessary to complete this recall is a violation of law in several
states/provinces/countries. Accordingly, you are urged to limit the use of this report to the follow-up
necessary to complete this recall.
Parts Information
Parts required to complete this recall are to be obtained from General Motors Service Parts
Operations (GMSPO). Please refer to your "involved vehicles listing" before ordering parts. Normal
orders should be placed on a DRO=Daily Replenishment Order. In an emergency situation, parts
should be ordered on a CSO = Customer Special Order.
Customer Reimbursement - For US
All customer requests for reimbursement for previous repairs for the recall condition will be handled
by the Customer Assistance Center, not by dealers.
A General Motors Product Recall Customer Reimbursement Procedure Form is shown in this
bulletin.
Important:
Refer to the GM Service Policies and Procedures Manual, section 6.1.12, for specific procedures
regarding customer reimbursement and the form.
Customer Reimbursement - For Canada & Export
Customer requests for reimbursement of previously paid repairs to correct the condition addressed
in this bulletin are to be submitted by April 30, 2006.
All reasonable customer paid receipts should be considered for reimbursement. The amount to be
reimbursed will be limited to the amount the repair would have cost if completed by an authorized
General Motors dealer.
When a customer requests reimbursement, they must provide the following:
^ Proof of ownership at time of repair.
^ Original paid receipt confirming the amount of repair expense(s) that were not reimbursed, a
description of the repair, and the person or entity performing the repair.
Claims for customer reimbursement on previously paid repairs are to be submitted as required by
WINS.
Important:
Refer to the GM Service Policies and Procedures Manual, section 1.6.2, for specific procedures
regarding customer reimbursement verification.
Courtesy Transportation
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9850
The General Motors Courtesy Transportation Program is intended to minimize customer
inconvenience when a vehicle requires a repair that is covered by the New Vehicle Limited
Warranty. The availability of courtesy transportation to customers whose vehicles are within the
warranty coverage period and involved in a product recall is very important in maintaining customer
satisfaction. Dealers are to ensure that these customers understand that shuttle service or some
other form of courtesy transportation is available and will be provided at no charge. Dealers should
refer to the General Motors Service Policies and Procedures Manual for courtesy transportation
guidelines.
Claim Information
Submit a Product Recall Claim with the information shown.
Refer to the General Motors WINS Claims Processing Manual for details on Product Recall Claim
Submission.
Customer Notification - For US and Canada
General Motors will notify customers of this recall on their vehicle (see copy of customer letter
shown in this bulletin).
Customer Notification - For Export
Letters will be sent to known owners of record located within areas covered by the US National
Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act. For owners outside these areas, dealers should notify
customers using the sample letter.
Dealer Recall Responsibility - For US and Export (US States, Territories, and Possessions)
The US National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act provides that each vehicle which is subject to
a recall of this type must be adequately repaired within a reasonable time after the customer has
tendered it for repair. A failure to repair within sixty days after tender of a vehicle is prima facie
evidence
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9851
of failure to repair within a reasonable time. If the condition is not adequately repaired within a
reasonable time, the customer may be entitled to an identical or reasonably equivalent vehicle at
no charge or to a refund of the purchase price less a reasonable allowance for depreciation. To
avoid having to provide these burdensome remedies, every effort must be made to promptly
schedule an appointment with each customer and to repair their vehicle as soon as possible. In the
recall notification letters, customers are told how to contact the US National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration if the recall is not completed within a reasonable time.
Dealer Recall Responsibility - All
All unsold new vehicles in dealers, possession and subject to this recall MUST be held and
inspected/repaired per the service procedure of this recall bulletin BEFORE customers take
possession of these vehicles.
Dealers are to service all vehicles subject to this recall at no charge to customers, regardless of
mileage, age of vehicle, or ownership, from this time forward.
Customers who have recently purchased vehicles sold from your vehicle inventory, and for which
there is no customer information indicated on the dealer listing, are to be contacted by the dealer.
Arrangements are to be made to make the required correction according to the instructions
contained in this bulletin. A copy of the customer letter is shown in this bulletin for your use in
contacting customers. Recall follow-up cards should not be used for this purpose, since the
customer may not as yet have received the notification letter.
In summary, whenever a vehicle subject to this recall enters your vehicle inventory, or is in your
dealership for service in the future, please take the steps necessary to be sure the recall correction
has been made before selling or releasing the vehicle.
GENERAL MOTORS PRODUCT RECALL CUSTOMER REIMBURSEMENT PROCEDURE
If you have paid to have this recall condition corrected prior to receiving this notification, you may
be eligible to receive reimbursement.
Requests for reimbursement may include parts, labor, fees and taxes. Reimbursement may be
limited to the amount the repair would have cost if completed by an authorized General Motors
dealer.
Your claim will be acted upon within 60 days of receipt.
If your claim is:
^ Approved, you will receive a check from General Motors.
^ Denied, you will receive a letter from General Motors with the reason(s) for the denial, or
^ Incomplete, you will receive a letter from General Motors identifying the documentation that is
needed to complete the claim and offered the opportunity to resubmit the claim when the missing
documentation is available.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9852
Please follow the instructions on the Claim Form shown to file a claim for reimbursement. If you
have questions about this reimbursement procedure, please call the toll-free telephone number
provided on the form. If you need assistance with any other concern, please contact the
appropriate Customer Assistance Center at the number also shown. The Customer Assistance
Center hours of operation are from 8:00 AM - 11:00 PM eastern standard time Monday through
Friday.
Disclaimer
Service Procedure
The following procedure describes how to inspect and replace the hazard warning flasher switch,
OR inspect and replace the multifunction (turn signal, headlamp dimmer, and windshield
wiper/washer) switch assembly. The part that you replace will be determined during the inspection
portion of this procedure. Do NOT replace any parts until after performing the inspection procedure.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9853
Inspection Procedure
1. From inside the vehicle, depress the hazard warning flasher switch located on the top of the
steering column.
2. Depress the hazard warning flasher switch again.
^ If the hazard warning flasher switch did not stick in either the up or down position, proceed to the
section titled "Replacing the Hazard Warning Flasher Switch." Do not order any replacement parts
until instructed to in the additional inspection procedure included in that section.
^ If the hazard warning flasher switch is sticking in either the up or down position, replace the
multifunction switch. Proceed to the section titled "Replacing the Multifunction Switch."
Replacing the Hazard Warning Flasher Switch
This procedure describes how to replace ONLY the hazard warning flasher switch assembly. The
procedure includes information on how to remove the original switch, where to apply the lubricant
on the new switch, and how to install the new switch.
DO NOT use this procedure if the inspection above indicates that the multifunction switch requires
replacement. Contained in this procedure are unique steps to address features or options such as
cruise control, standard or tilt column, and a column mounted automatic transmission lever.
Tools Required
^ J 1859-A Steering Wheel Puller
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
2. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
3. Remove the SIR fuse from the fuse block.
4. Remove the screws attaching the driver's side knee bolster trim panel underneath the I/P and
reposition the panel out of the way.
5. Locate the driver's side yellow 2-way air bag electrical connector at the base of the steering
column and remove the connector position assurance (CPA) from the connector.
6. Disconnect the yellow 2-way electrical connector.
7. If equipped, remove the tilt steering column lever.
Important:
Some of the illustrations included in this procedure show the steering column removed from the
vehicle. Those illustrations are for reference purposes only. DO NOT remove the steering column
from the vehicle to perform this repair procedure.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the RUN position to unlock the steering wheel.
9. Turn the steering wheel 90 degrees so that the side of the SIR module is at the 12 o'clock
position in order to gain access to the holes behind the
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9854
steering wheel.
10. Insert a flat-bladed tool into the access hole and push the leaf spring in order to release the
notched pin that retains the inflator module.
11. Turn the steering wheel 180 degrees in order to gain access to the remaining access hole.
12. Insert a screwdriver into the remaining hole and push the leaf spring in order to release the
notched pin that retains the inflator module.
13. Tilt the top of the inflator module rearward to gain access to the SIR wiring.
14. Disconnect the SIR lead wire from the clip on the inflator module.
15. Disconnect the SIR lead wire from the clip on the steering wheel.
16. Disconnect the CPA retainer.
17. Disconnect the electrical connector.
Caution:
When you are carrying an undeployed inflator module:
^ Do not carry the inflator module by the wires or connector on the inflator module.
^ Make sure the bag opening points away from you.
^ When you are storing an undeployed inflator module, make sure the bag opening points away
from the surface on which the inflator module rests. Provide free space for the air bag to expand in
case of an accidental deployment. Otherwise, personal injury may result.
18. Set the SIR module aside.
19. Remove the horn plunger from the steering column by pressing inward to the stop and rotate
the horn plunger 90 degrees.
20. Remove the steering wheel retaining nut.
21. Install the J 1859-A, Steering Wheel Puller, to the steering wheel.
22. Remove the steering wheel using the J 1859-A.
23. Remove the J 1859-A from the steering wheel.
24. Remove the tilt lever.
25. Remove the screws attaching the lower steering column cover to the steering column.
26. Remove the lower steering column trim cover from the upper steering column trim cover.
26.1 Tilt the lower steering column trim cover down.
26.2 Slide the lower steering column trim cover backward in order to disengage the locking tabs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9855
27. Remove the upper steering column trim cover mounting screws (1).
28. Lift the upper steering column trim cover to gain access to the lock cylinder access hole.
29. Using a bent tip awl, insert the tip into the ignition lock cylinder access hole.
30. Turn the ignition lock cylinder to the START position.
31. Using the bent tip awl, push down on the ignition lock cylinder retaining pin.
32. Release the ignition lock cylinder to the RUN position.
33. Remove the ignition lock cylinder from the lock module by pulling the ignition lock cylinder away
from the steering column.
34. Remove the upper column cover.
Important:
The illustration above is for the purpose of identifying the barcode only. The actual location of the
barcode on the switch may differ.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9856
35. Inspect the part number (1) on the multifunction switch at the location shown in the illustration.
36. If the part number is 26084051, 26084052, 26096834, 26096835, 26102157 or 26102158, no
repair is required. Proceed to the section titled "Reassemble Vehicle."
^ If there is NO part number or barcode on the switch, no repair is required. Proceed to the section
titled "Reassemble Vehicle."
^ If the part number or barcode on the switch is 26091775 or 26091776, proceed to the next step
and replace the hazard warning flasher switch using part number 15177379.
Important:
Carefully review the above illustration to determine the exact location to insert the screwdriver in
the next step.
37. Insert a small, pocket-sized, flat bladed screwdriver (2) into the small space between the
hazard warning flasher switch housing (1) and the multifunction switch (3).
38. Carefully tilt the screwdriver handle towards the instrument cluster. This will cause the blade of
the screwdriver to pry open the space between the hazard warning flasher switch housing and the
multifunction switch.
39. While the space is pried open, pull the hazard warning flasher switch out of the multifunction
switch. Discard the hazard warning flasher switch.
Note:
Do not touch the three triangle-shaped electrical contacts (1) on the side of the switch when
removing the protective packaging, handling, or applying grease to the new hazard warning flasher
switch in the next steps.
40. Remove the rubber band and protective plastic wrapping from the new hazard warning flasher
switch.
Important:
The electrical contacts on the new hazard warning flasher switch require a special lubricant, which
is included in the kit. Only apply this special lubricant as instructed in the next step. DO NOT use
any other type of grease or lubricant.
41. Open the container of special grease included in the kit and apply it to the surfaces of the three
triangle-shaped electrical contacts (1) on the side of the new hazard warning flasher switch. When
properly applied, the surfaces of the three triangle-shaped electrical contacts must be completely
covered and there should be no grease left in the container. DO NOT put any grease in the
opening that contains the small metal return spring.
42. Insert the hazard warning flasher switch into the opening of the multifunction switch and press
down until it locks into place.
43. Remove any excess grease that may appear around the base of the hazard warning flasher
switch. Proceed to the next section "Reassemble Vehicle."
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9857
Reassemble Vehicle
1. Install the upper steering column cover.
2. Insert the ignition lock cylinder through the upper shroud.
3. Install the ignition lock cylinder to the lock module by doing the following:
3.1. Align the positioning slot and locking tab slot on the lock module assembly to the positioning
tab and locking tab on the ignition lock cylinder.
3.2. Push the ignition lock cylinder into the lock module assembly until the locking tab locks against
the lock module.
4. Install the upper steering column cover screws.
Tighten
Tighten the screws to 1.5 N.m (13 lb in).
Important:
The shift lever seal must be seated in the covers.
5. Install the lower steering column trim cover to the upper steering column trim cover.
5.1. Match the tab slots on the lower steering column trim cover with the locking tabs on the upper
steering column trim cover.
5.2. Tilt the lower steering column trim cover up.
5.3. Slide the lower steering column trim cover forward until the locking tabs snap into the tab slots.
6. Install the lower steering column cover screws.
Tighten
Tighten the screws to 3.5 N.m (31 lb in).
7. Install the tilt lever.
8. Install the steering wheel to the steering shaft.
9. Install the steering wheel retaining nut.
Tighten
Tighten the steering wheel retaining nut to 41 N.m (30 lb ft).
10. Install the horn plunger to the steering column.
11. Position the SIR module near the steering wheel.
12. Connect the SIR electrical connector.
13. Connect the CPA retainer to the SIR connector.
14. Connect the SIR lead wire to the clip on the steering wheel.
15. Connect the SIR lead wire to the clip on the inflator module.
Important:
Verify that the wiring is not exposed or trapped between the inflatable restraint steering wheel
module and the steering wheel.
16. Press the inflator module into the steering wheel firmly enough that the module engages and
latches the notched pins in the leaf springs.
17. Rotate the steering wheel back into the straight position.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9858
18. Connect the I/P module yellow 2-way connector located under the I/P extension.
19. Install the CPA to the I/P module yellow 2-way connector located under the I/P extension.
20. Connect the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector located at the base of the steering
column.
21. Install the CPA to the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector located at the base of the
steering column.
22. Position the knee bolster trim panel to the I/P and install the attaching screws.
Tighten
Tighten the screws to 1.9 N.m (17 lb in).
23. Install the SIR fuse and install the fuse block cover.
24. Be sure that the ignition is in the OFF position.
25. Connect the negative battery.
Replacing the Multifunction Switch
This procedure describes how to replace ONLY the multifunction switch assembly. The new
multifunction switch assembly will come complete with a new hazard warning flasher switch already
installed.
DO NOT use this procedure if the results of the inspection procedure indicate that only the hazard
warning flasher switch requires replacement.
Contained in this procedure are unique steps to address features or options such as cruise control,
standard or tilt column, and a column-mounted automatic transmission lever.
Tools Required
^ J 1859-A Steering Wheel Puller
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
2. Disconnect the negative battery.
3. Remove the SIR fuse from the fuse block.
4. Remove the screws attaching the driver's side knee bolster trim panel underneath the I/P and
reposition the panel out of the way.
5. Locate the driver's side yellow 2-way air bag electrical connector at the base of the steering
column and remove the connector position assurance (CPA) from the connector.
6. Disconnect the yellow 2-way electrical connector.
7. If equipped, remove the tilt steering column lever.
Important:
Some of the illustrations included in this procedure show the steering column removed from the
vehicle. Those illustrations are for reference
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9859
purposes only. DO NOT remove the steering column from the vehicle to perform this repair
procedure.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the RUN position to unlock the steering wheel.
9. Turn the steering wheel 90 degrees so that the side of the SIR module is at the 12 o'clock
position in order to gain access to the holes behind the steering wheel.
10. Insert a flat-bladed tool into the access hole and push the leaf spring in order to release the
notched pin that retains the inflator module.
11. Turn the steering wheel 180 degrees in order to gain access to the remaining access hole.
12. Insert a screwdriver into the remaining hole and push the leaf spring in order to release the
notched pin that retains the inflator module.
13. Tilt the top of the inflator module rearward to gain access to the SIR wiring.
14. Disconnect the SIR lead wire from the clip on the inflator module.
15. Disconnect the SIR lead wire from the clip on the steering wheel.
16. Disconnect the CPA retainer.
17. Disconnect the electrical connector.
Caution:
When you are carrying an undeployed inflator module:
^ Do not carry the inflator module by the wires or connector on the inflator module.
^ Make sure the bag opening points away from you.
^ When you are storing an undeployed inflator module, make sure the bag opening points away
from the surface on which the inflator module rests. Provide free space for the air bag to expand in
case of an accidental deployment. Otherwise, personal injury may result.
18. Set the SIR module aside.
19. Remove the horn plunger from the steering column by pressing inward to the stop and rotate
the horn plunger 90 degrees.
20. Remove the steering wheel retaining nut.
21. Install the J 1859-A, Steering Wheel Puller, to the steering wheel.
22. Remove the steering wheel using the J 1859-A.
23. Remove the J 1859-A from the steering wheel.
24. Remove the tilt lever.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9860
25. Remove the screws attaching the lower steering column cover to the steering column.
26. Remove the lower steering column trim cover from the upper steering column trim cover.
27. Tilt the lower steering column trim cover down.
27.1 Slide the lower steering column trim cover backward in order to disengage the locking tabs.
28. Remove the upper steering column trim cover mounting screws (1).
29. Lift the upper steering column trim cover to gain access to the lock cylinder access hole.
30. Using a bent tip awl, insert the tip into the ignition lock cylinder access hole.
31. Turn the ignition lock cylinder to the START position.
32. Using the bent tip awl, push down on the ignition lock cylinder retaining pin.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9861
33. Release the ignition lock cylinder to the RUN position.
34. Remove the ignition lock cylinder from the lock module by pulling the ignition lock cylinder away
from the steering column.
35. Remove the upper column cover.
36. Disconnect the steering column electrical connectors.
37. Disconnect the multifunction switch connectors from the steering column electrical connector.
38. Remove the steering column wiring harness from the wiring harness strap.
39. Remove the wire harness straps from the steering column wire harness.
40. Remove the multifunction switch mounting screws.
41. Remove the multifunction switch.
Important:
The multifunction switch electrical contact must rest on the canceling cam assembly.
42. Install the new multifunction switch as follows:
42.1 Use a small blade screwdriver in order to compress the electrical contact.
42.2 Move the multifunction switch into position.
43. Install the multifunction switch mounting screws.
Tighten
Tighten the multifunction switch mounting screws to 6 N.m (53 lb in).
44. Connect the multifunction switch electrical connectors to the steering column electrical
connector.
45. Connect the steering column electrical connector to the I/P wire harness.
46. Install the wire harness straps to the steering column wire harness.
47. Install the steering column wire harness to the wiring harness strap.
48. Install the upper steering column cover.
49. Insert the ignition lock cylinder through the upper shroud.
50. Install the ignition lock cylinder to the lock module by doing the following:
50.1 Align the positioning slot and locking tab slot on the lock module assembly to the positioning
tab and locking tab on the ignition lock
cylinder.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9862
50.2 Push the ignition lock cylinder into the lock module assembly until the locking tab locks
against the lock module.
51. Install the upper steering column cover screws.
Tighten
Tighten the screws to 1.5 N.m (13 lb in).
Important:
The shift lever seal must be seated in the covers.
52. Install the lower steering column trim cover to the upper steering column trim cover.
52.1 Match the tab slots on the lower steering column trim cover with the locking tabs on the upper
steering column trim cover.
52.3 Tilt the lower steering column trim cover up.
52.3 Slide the lower steering column trim cover forward until the locking tabs snap into the tab
slots.
53. Install the lower steering column cover screws.
Tighten
Tighten the screws to 3.5 N.m (31 lb in).
54. Install the tilt lever.
55. Install the steering wheel to the steering shaft.
56. Install the steering wheel retaining nut.
Tighten
Tighten the steering wheel retaining nut to 41 N.m (30 lb ft).
57. Install the horn plunger to the steering column.
58. Position the SIR module near the steering wheel.
59. Connect the SIR electrical connector.
60. Connect the CPA retainer to the SIR connector.
61. Connect the SIR lead wire to the clip on the steering wheel.
62. Connect the SIR lead wire to the clip on the inflator module.
Important:
Verify that the wiring in not exposed or trapped between the inflatable restraint steering wheel
module and the steering wheel.
63. Press the inflator module into the steering wheel firmly enough that the module engages and
latches the notched pins in the leaf springs.
64. Rotate the steering wheel back into the straight position.
65. Connect the I/P module yellow 2-way connector located under the I/P extension.
66. Install the CPA to the I/P module yellow 2-way connector located under the I/P extension.
67. Connect the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector located at the base of the steering
column.
68. Install the CPA to the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector located at the base of the
steering column.
69. Position the knee bolster trim panel to the I/P and install the attaching screws.
Tighten
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9863
Tighten the screws to 1.9 N.m (17 lb in).
70. Install the SIR fuse and install the fuse block cover.
71. Be sure that the ignition is in the OFF position.
72. Connect the negative battery cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05
> Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 9864
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: > NHTSA05V099000
> Mar > 05 > Recall 05V099000: Brake/Hazard Lamp Failure
Hazard Warning Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 05V099000: Brake/Hazard Lamp
Failure
MAKE/MODELS: MODEL/BUILD YEARS: Chevrolet/Astro 2001-2002 GMC/Safari 2001-2002
MANUFACTURER: General Motors Corp. NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 05V099000 RECALL
DATE: March 09, 2005
COMPONENT: Exterior Lighting: Brake Lights: Switch
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 77055
SUMMARY: On certain minivans, the multifunction switch may develop an open circuit condition in
the stop lamp or hazard lamp circuit that results in the stop lamps and hazard lamps being
inoperative.
CONSEQUENCE: The loss of stop lamps and rear hazard lamps could fail to warn a following
driver that the vehicle is braking and/or is stopped and could lead to a vehicle crash.
REMEDY: Dealers will replace the hazard warning flasher switch and apply special grease to the
contacts at the time of installation of the module. The repair would be used in vehicles in which the
hazard slider button is still movable. If a vehicle has a hazard slider button that is not movable
(frozen), the entire multifunction switch will be replaced. The manufacturer has not yet provided an
owner notification schedule. Owners should contact Chevrolet at 1-800-630-2438 or GMC at
1-866-996-9463.
NOTES: GM recall No. 05013. Customers can also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Auto Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Headlamp Bulb: Service and Repair
HEADLAMP ASSEMBLY OR HEADLAMP BULB REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Turn OFF the headlamp switch. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector from the headlamp bulb.
CAUTION: Halogen bulbs contain gas under pressure. Handling a bulb improperly could cause it to
shatter into flying glass fragments. To help avoid personal injury: Turn off the lamp switch and allow the bulb to cool before changing the bulb.
- Leave the lamp switch OFF until the bulb change is complete.
- Always wear eye protection when changing a halogen bulb.
- Handle the bulb only by its base. A void touching the glass.
- Keep dirt and moisture off the bulb.
- Properly dispose of the used bulb.
- Keep halogen bulbs out of the reach of children.
3. Rotate the bulb counterclockwise in order to disengage the bulb from the headlamp. 4. Remove
the bulb from the headlamp.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the bulb to the headlamp. 2. Rotate the bulb clockwise in order to engage the bulb in the
headlamp. 3. Connect the electrical connector to the headlamp bulb.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Lens > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Lighting - Headlamp Polycarbonate Lens Damage Prevention
Headlamp Lens: Technical Service Bulletins Lighting - Headlamp Polycarbonate Lens Damage
Prevention
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 02-08-42-001D
Date: June 21, 2010
Subject: Headlamp Lens Overheating When Covered and Chemical Damage to Exterior
Polycarbonate Headlamp Lenses
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years and to revise the warning statements.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-08-42-001C (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
The bulletin is being issued to make dealers and customers aware of chemical damage that may
be caused to exterior polycarbonate headlamp lenses. Most late model vehicles have these types
of headlamp lenses. This material is used because of its temperature and high impact resistance.
A variety of chemicals can cause crazing or cracking of the headlamp lens. Headlamp lenses are
very sensitive. Care should be exercised to avoid contact with all exterior headlamp lenses when
treating a vehicle with any type of chemical, such as those recommended for rail dust removal.
Rubbing compound, grease tar and oil removers, tire cleaners, cleaner waxes and even car wash
soaps in too high a concentration may also attribute to this condition. This could result in the need
to replace the entire headlamp housing.
Warning
Use only lukewarm or cold water, a soft cloth and a car washing soap to clean exterior lamps and
lenses.
Also, crazing or deformations of the lens may occur if a shop mat or fender cover is draped over
the fender and covers a portion or all of the headlamp assembly while the DRL or headlamps are
on. This action restricts the amount of heat dissipated by the headlamps.
Warning
Care should be taken to not cover headlamps with shop mats or fender covers if the vehicle is
being serviced with the headlamps or DRL illuminated. Covering an illuminated lamp can cause
excessive heat build up and crazing/deformation of the lens may occur. The degradation of the lens
can be unnoticeable at first and eventually become hairline cracks in the lens. In extreme cases, it
could cause the lens to deform. This damage can also be caused by aftermarket shields that are
often tinted in color.
Once a heat buildup is generated by the headlamp, a degradation of the headlamp lens begins.
This degradation of the lens can be unnoticeable at first and eventually manifest as spider cracks.
In more extreme cases, it will begin to melt the lens of the headlamp.
Notice
Headlamps damaged by chemicals, improper cleaning, or overheating due to being covered are
not covered under the new vehicle warranty.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Relay > Component Information > Locations
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Page 9883
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the instrument panel cluster trim plate. 3.
Remove the switch from the plate by using the following procedure:
3.1. Release the retaining tabs on the sides of the switch. 3.2. Pull the switch out of the plate. 3.3.
Disconnect the electrical connector(s) at the back of the headlamp switch.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Connect the electrical connector(s) to the back of the switch. 2. Install the headlamp switch to
the plate by snapping the switch into place. 3. Install the instrument panel cluster trim plate. 4.
Connect the battery negative cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9888
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9889
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9890
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9891
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9892
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9893
Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9894
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9895
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9896
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9897
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9898
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9899
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9900
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9901
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9902
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9903
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9904
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9905
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9906
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9907
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9908
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9909
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9910
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9911
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9912
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9913
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9914
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9915
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9916
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9917
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9918
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9919
Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp: Electrical Diagrams
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Lighting and Horns Diagrams.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 9920
Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp: Testing and Inspection
For information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to Lighting
and Horns Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Relay > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Locations
License Plate Lamp: Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Page
9931
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
License Plate Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9934
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9935
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9936
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9937
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9938
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9939
License Plate Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9940
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9941
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9942
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9943
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9944
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9945
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9946
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9947
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9948
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9949
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9950
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9951
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9952
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9953
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9954
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9955
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9956
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9957
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9958
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9959
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9960
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9961
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9962
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9963
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9964
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9965
License Lamp
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9966
License Plate Lamp: Electrical Diagrams
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Lighting and Horns Diagrams.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
9967
License Plate Lamp: Description and Operation
PARK, TAIL, MARKER AND LICENSE LAMPS
The park, tail, marker and license lamps are turned on when the headlamp switch is placed in the
PARK or ON position or anytime the headlights are requested. The PK LPS fuse in the IP fuse
block supplies battery positive voltage to the park lamp relay and the headlamp switch. The Body
Control Module (BCM) provides a ground, or control circuit, to the park lamp relay coil circuit during
ALC operation. When the park lamps are turned on during ALC, the BCM energizes the park lamp
relay. The park lamps can also be supplied battery positive voltage directly from the headlamp
switch. Current flow is to the park, tail, marker and license lamps. The front park and marker lamps
are grounded at G100 and G101. The rear park, tail, marker and license lamps are grounded at
G400 and G401. If the headlight switch is left in the ON position, the park, tail and marker lamps
will remain on until turned off or the battery runs dead.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
9968
License Plate Lamp: Testing and Inspection
For information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to Lighting
and Horns Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
9969
License Plate Lamp: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Turn OFF the headlamp switch. 2. Remove the screws from the license lamp. 3. Remove the
bulb.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the bulb. 2. Install the license lamp.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Install the license lamp screws.
Tighten Tighten the license lamp screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Map Light > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Map Light > Component Information > Locations > Page 9973
Map Light: Diagrams
Courtesy/Reading Lamp - Center
Courtesy/Reading Lamp - Front
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Map Light > Component Information > Locations > Page 9974
Map Light: Service and Repair
DOME AND READING LAMP BULB REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Release the tab on one end of the lens. 2. Remove the lens by swinging the lens downward. 3.
Remove the bulb from the assembly by pulling the bulb straight down.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Push the bulb up into the contacts/retainers. 2. Align the tabs in the lens with the slots in the
assembly. 3. Push the lens into place.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Locations
Marker Lamp: Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Page 9978
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Page 9979
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Page 9980
Locations View
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Page 9981
Marker Lamp: Description and Operation
PARK, TAIL, MARKER AND LICENSE LAMPS
The park, tail, marker and license lamps are turned on when the headlamp switch is placed in the
PARK or ON position or anytime the headlights are requested. The PK LPS fuse in the IP fuse
block supplies battery positive voltage to the park lamp relay and the headlamp switch. The Body
Control Module (BCM) provides a ground, or control circuit, to the park lamp relay coil circuit during
ALC operation. When the park lamps are turned on during ALC, the BCM energizes the park lamp
relay. The park lamps can also be supplied battery positive voltage directly from the headlamp
switch. Current flow is to the park, tail, marker and license lamps. The front park and marker lamps
are grounded at G100 and G101. The rear park, tail, marker and license lamps are grounded at
G400 and G401. If the headlight switch is left in the ON position, the park, tail and marker lamps
will remain on until turned off or the battery runs dead.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Page 9982
Marker Lamp: Testing and Inspection
For information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to Lighting
and Horns Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Page 9983
Marker Lamp: Service and Repair
STEPWELL LAMP REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the screw that retains the lens. 2. Gently pry off the lens. 3. Pull out the bulb.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the bulb.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the lens to the body with the screw.
Tighten Tighten the stepwell lamp body screw to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Locations
Parking Lamp Relay: Locations
Convenience Center (Front View)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Parking Lamp Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9990
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9991
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9992
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9993
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9994
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9995
Parking Lamp Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9996
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9997
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9998
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9999
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10000
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10001
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10002
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10003
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10004
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10005
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10006
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10007
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10008
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10009
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10010
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10011
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10012
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10013
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10014
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10015
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10016
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10017
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10018
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10019
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10020
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Relay > Component Information > Service and Repair
Daytime Running Lamp Relay: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the left side of the knee bolster. 2. Remove the cover (4) from the block to expose the
DRL daytime running lights relay. 3. Remove the relay from the block.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the relay to the block. 2. Install the cover (4) to the block for the DRL daytime running
lights relay. 3. Install the left side of the knee bolster.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Underhood Fuse Block (Front View) (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Parking Lamp Relay: Locations
Convenience Center (Front View)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Parking Lamp Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10036
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10037
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10038
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10039
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10040
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10041
Parking Lamp Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10042
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10043
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10044
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10045
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10046
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10047
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10048
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10049
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10050
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10051
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10052
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10053
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10054
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10055
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10056
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10057
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10058
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10059
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10060
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10061
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10062
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10063
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10064
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10065
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10066
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Ambient Light Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10073
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10074
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10075
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10076
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10077
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10078
Ambient Light Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10079
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10080
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10081
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10082
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10083
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10084
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10085
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10086
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10087
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10088
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10089
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10090
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10091
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10092
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10093
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10094
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10095
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10096
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10097
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10098
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10099
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10100
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10101
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10102
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10103
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10104
Ambient Light Sensor
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10105
Ambient Light Sensor: Electrical Diagrams
For further information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Lighting and Horns Diagrams.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 10106
Ambient Light Sensor: Testing and Inspection
For information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to Lighting
and Horns Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 10107
Ambient Light Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Lift upward on the center defogger grille located in center of the dash to expose the DRL photo
sensor (1) retainer. 2. Turn the DRL photo sensor counterclockwise 1/4 turn in order to remove. 3.
Disconnect the electrical connection from the DRL photo sensor (1).
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Connect the electrical connection to the DRL photo sensor (1). 2. Insert the DRL photo sensor
(1) and turn counterclockwise 1/4 turn in order to seat. 3. Install the defogger grille located in the
center of the dash by push downward.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10111
Stop Lamp Switch
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10112
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
Stop Lamp Switch Replacement
Removal Procedure
Caution: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the retainer (3) from the brake pedal pin. 3.
Unsnap the switch (2) and pushrod (4) from the brake pedal (1) pin.
4. Disconnect the electrical connector.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10113
1. Connect the electrical connector.
2. Install the switch (2) and pushrod (4) onto the brake pedal (1) pin. 3. Install the retainer (3) onto
the brake pedal (1) pin. 4. Connect the battery negative cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Dome Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Door Switch: Service and Repair Front
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Loosen the nut on the door jamb switch. 2. Gently pull the switch away from the body. 3.
Disconnect the door jamb switch from the electrical connector(s). 4. Tape the wiring to the body in
order to prevent the wiring from entering the hole in the door pillar. 5. Remove the door jamb switch
from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the door jamb switch to the vehicle. 2. Connect the electrical connector(s) to the door
jamb switch.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Tighten the nut on the door jamb switch.
Tighten Tighten the door jamb switch nut to 3 N.m (27 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 10121
Door Switch: Service and Repair Rear
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Loosen the nut on the door jamb switch. 2. Gently pull the switch away from the body. 3.
Disconnect the door jamb switch from the electrical connectors. 4. Tape the wiring to the body in
order to prevent the wiring from entering the hole in the door pillar. 5. Remove the door jamb switch
from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the door jamb switch to the vehicle. 2. Connect the electrical connectors to the door jamb
switch.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
3. Tighten the nut on the door jamb switch.
Tighten Tighten the door jamb switch nut to 3 N.m (27 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 >
Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement
Technical Service Bulletin # 05013A Date: 050526
Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement
Bulletin No.: 05013A
Date: May 26, 2005
SAFETY
Subject: 05013A - Multifunction Switch Contacts
Models: 2001-2002 Chevrolet Astro 2001-2002 GMC Safari
Supercede:
THE INSPECTION IN STEP 35 OF THE PROCEDURE "REPLACING THE HAZARD WARNING
FLASHER SWITCH" HAS BEEN REVISED AND PART NUMBER 15174447 HAS BEEN
ELIMINATED. PLEASE REVIEW THIS NEW INFORMATION IMMEDIATELY. DISCARD ALL
COPIES OF BULLETIN 05013 ISSUED APRIL 2005.
Condition
General Motors has decided that a defect, which relates to motor vehicle safety, exists in certain
2001-2002 Chevrolet Astro and GMC Safari vehicles. On some of these vehicles, the stop lamps
and rear hazard lamps may become inoperative. The usage factors that increase the possibility of
this condition occurring include frequency and length of brake applications, frequency of trailer
towing with brake applications, and exposure to high ambient temperatures. The center high
mounted stop lamp and turn signal lamp functionality are not affected. The loss of stop lamps
and/or rear hazard lamps could fail to warn a following driver that the vehicle is braking and/or is
stopped and could lead to a vehicle accident.
Correction
Dealers are to inspect and replace the hazard warning flasher switch, if necessary. In a small
number of vehicles, the multifunction switch will require replacement.
Vehicles Involved
Involved are certain 2001-2002 Chevrolet Astro and GMC Safari vehicles built within the VIN
breakpoints shown.
Important:
Dealers should confirm vehicle eligibility through GMVIS (GM Vehicle Inquiry System) before
beginning recall repairs. [Not all vehicles within the above breakpoints may be involved.]
For US & Canada
For dealers with involved vehicles, a Campaign Initiation Detail Report containing the complete
Vehicle Identification Number, customer name and address data has been prepared and will be
loaded to the GM DealerWorld (U.S.), GMinfoNet (Canada) Recall Information website. Dealers
that have no involved vehicles currently assigned will not have a report available in GM
DealerWorld/GMinfoNet.
For Export
For dealers with involved vehicles, a Campaign Initiation Detail Report containing the complete
Vehicle Identification Number, customer name and address data has been prepared, and is being
furnished to involved dealers. Dealers that have no involved vehicles currently assigned will not
receive a report with the recall bulletin.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 >
Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10130
The Campaign Initiation Detail Report may contain customer names and addresses obtained from
Motor Vehicle Registration Records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any
purpose other than follow-up necessary to complete this recall is a violation of law in several
states/provinces/countries. Accordingly, you are urged to limit the use of this report to the follow-up
necessary to complete this recall.
Parts Information
Parts required to complete this recall are to be obtained from General Motors Service Parts
Operations (GMSPO). Please refer to your "involved vehicles listing" before ordering parts. Normal
orders should be placed on a DRO=Daily Replenishment Order. In an emergency situation, parts
should be ordered on a CSO = Customer Special Order.
Customer Reimbursement - For US
All customer requests for reimbursement for previous repairs for the recall condition will be handled
by the Customer Assistance Center, not by dealers.
A General Motors Product Recall Customer Reimbursement Procedure Form is shown in this
bulletin.
Important:
Refer to the GM Service Policies and Procedures Manual, section 6.1.12, for specific procedures
regarding customer reimbursement and the form.
Customer Reimbursement - For Canada & Export
Customer requests for reimbursement of previously paid repairs to correct the condition addressed
in this bulletin are to be submitted by April 30, 2006.
All reasonable customer paid receipts should be considered for reimbursement. The amount to be
reimbursed will be limited to the amount the repair would have cost if completed by an authorized
General Motors dealer.
When a customer requests reimbursement, they must provide the following:
^ Proof of ownership at time of repair.
^ Original paid receipt confirming the amount of repair expense(s) that were not reimbursed, a
description of the repair, and the person or entity performing the repair.
Claims for customer reimbursement on previously paid repairs are to be submitted as required by
WINS.
Important:
Refer to the GM Service Policies and Procedures Manual, section 1.6.2, for specific procedures
regarding customer reimbursement verification.
Courtesy Transportation
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 >
Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10131
The General Motors Courtesy Transportation Program is intended to minimize customer
inconvenience when a vehicle requires a repair that is covered by the New Vehicle Limited
Warranty. The availability of courtesy transportation to customers whose vehicles are within the
warranty coverage period and involved in a product recall is very important in maintaining customer
satisfaction. Dealers are to ensure that these customers understand that shuttle service or some
other form of courtesy transportation is available and will be provided at no charge. Dealers should
refer to the General Motors Service Policies and Procedures Manual for courtesy transportation
guidelines.
Claim Information
Submit a Product Recall Claim with the information shown.
Refer to the General Motors WINS Claims Processing Manual for details on Product Recall Claim
Submission.
Customer Notification - For US and Canada
General Motors will notify customers of this recall on their vehicle (see copy of customer letter
shown in this bulletin).
Customer Notification - For Export
Letters will be sent to known owners of record located within areas covered by the US National
Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act. For owners outside these areas, dealers should notify
customers using the sample letter.
Dealer Recall Responsibility - For US and Export (US States, Territories, and Possessions)
The US National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act provides that each vehicle which is subject to
a recall of this type must be adequately repaired within a reasonable time after the customer has
tendered it for repair. A failure to repair within sixty days after tender of a vehicle is prima facie
evidence
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 >
Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10132
of failure to repair within a reasonable time. If the condition is not adequately repaired within a
reasonable time, the customer may be entitled to an identical or reasonably equivalent vehicle at
no charge or to a refund of the purchase price less a reasonable allowance for depreciation. To
avoid having to provide these burdensome remedies, every effort must be made to promptly
schedule an appointment with each customer and to repair their vehicle as soon as possible. In the
recall notification letters, customers are told how to contact the US National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration if the recall is not completed within a reasonable time.
Dealer Recall Responsibility - All
All unsold new vehicles in dealers, possession and subject to this recall MUST be held and
inspected/repaired per the service procedure of this recall bulletin BEFORE customers take
possession of these vehicles.
Dealers are to service all vehicles subject to this recall at no charge to customers, regardless of
mileage, age of vehicle, or ownership, from this time forward.
Customers who have recently purchased vehicles sold from your vehicle inventory, and for which
there is no customer information indicated on the dealer listing, are to be contacted by the dealer.
Arrangements are to be made to make the required correction according to the instructions
contained in this bulletin. A copy of the customer letter is shown in this bulletin for your use in
contacting customers. Recall follow-up cards should not be used for this purpose, since the
customer may not as yet have received the notification letter.
In summary, whenever a vehicle subject to this recall enters your vehicle inventory, or is in your
dealership for service in the future, please take the steps necessary to be sure the recall correction
has been made before selling or releasing the vehicle.
GENERAL MOTORS PRODUCT RECALL CUSTOMER REIMBURSEMENT PROCEDURE
If you have paid to have this recall condition corrected prior to receiving this notification, you may
be eligible to receive reimbursement.
Requests for reimbursement may include parts, labor, fees and taxes. Reimbursement may be
limited to the amount the repair would have cost if completed by an authorized General Motors
dealer.
Your claim will be acted upon within 60 days of receipt.
If your claim is:
^ Approved, you will receive a check from General Motors.
^ Denied, you will receive a letter from General Motors with the reason(s) for the denial, or
^ Incomplete, you will receive a letter from General Motors identifying the documentation that is
needed to complete the claim and offered the opportunity to resubmit the claim when the missing
documentation is available.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 >
Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10133
Please follow the instructions on the Claim Form shown to file a claim for reimbursement. If you
have questions about this reimbursement procedure, please call the toll-free telephone number
provided on the form. If you need assistance with any other concern, please contact the
appropriate Customer Assistance Center at the number also shown. The Customer Assistance
Center hours of operation are from 8:00 AM - 11:00 PM eastern standard time Monday through
Friday.
Disclaimer
Service Procedure
The following procedure describes how to inspect and replace the hazard warning flasher switch,
OR inspect and replace the multifunction (turn signal, headlamp dimmer, and windshield
wiper/washer) switch assembly. The part that you replace will be determined during the inspection
portion of this procedure. Do NOT replace any parts until after performing the inspection procedure.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 >
Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10134
Inspection Procedure
1. From inside the vehicle, depress the hazard warning flasher switch located on the top of the
steering column.
2. Depress the hazard warning flasher switch again.
^ If the hazard warning flasher switch did not stick in either the up or down position, proceed to the
section titled "Replacing the Hazard Warning Flasher Switch." Do not order any replacement parts
until instructed to in the additional inspection procedure included in that section.
^ If the hazard warning flasher switch is sticking in either the up or down position, replace the
multifunction switch. Proceed to the section titled "Replacing the Multifunction Switch."
Replacing the Hazard Warning Flasher Switch
This procedure describes how to replace ONLY the hazard warning flasher switch assembly. The
procedure includes information on how to remove the original switch, where to apply the lubricant
on the new switch, and how to install the new switch.
DO NOT use this procedure if the inspection above indicates that the multifunction switch requires
replacement. Contained in this procedure are unique steps to address features or options such as
cruise control, standard or tilt column, and a column mounted automatic transmission lever.
Tools Required
^ J 1859-A Steering Wheel Puller
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
2. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
3. Remove the SIR fuse from the fuse block.
4. Remove the screws attaching the driver's side knee bolster trim panel underneath the I/P and
reposition the panel out of the way.
5. Locate the driver's side yellow 2-way air bag electrical connector at the base of the steering
column and remove the connector position assurance (CPA) from the connector.
6. Disconnect the yellow 2-way electrical connector.
7. If equipped, remove the tilt steering column lever.
Important:
Some of the illustrations included in this procedure show the steering column removed from the
vehicle. Those illustrations are for reference purposes only. DO NOT remove the steering column
from the vehicle to perform this repair procedure.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the RUN position to unlock the steering wheel.
9. Turn the steering wheel 90 degrees so that the side of the SIR module is at the 12 o'clock
position in order to gain access to the holes behind the
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 >
Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10135
steering wheel.
10. Insert a flat-bladed tool into the access hole and push the leaf spring in order to release the
notched pin that retains the inflator module.
11. Turn the steering wheel 180 degrees in order to gain access to the remaining access hole.
12. Insert a screwdriver into the remaining hole and push the leaf spring in order to release the
notched pin that retains the inflator module.
13. Tilt the top of the inflator module rearward to gain access to the SIR wiring.
14. Disconnect the SIR lead wire from the clip on the inflator module.
15. Disconnect the SIR lead wire from the clip on the steering wheel.
16. Disconnect the CPA retainer.
17. Disconnect the electrical connector.
Caution:
When you are carrying an undeployed inflator module:
^ Do not carry the inflator module by the wires or connector on the inflator module.
^ Make sure the bag opening points away from you.
^ When you are storing an undeployed inflator module, make sure the bag opening points away
from the surface on which the inflator module rests. Provide free space for the air bag to expand in
case of an accidental deployment. Otherwise, personal injury may result.
18. Set the SIR module aside.
19. Remove the horn plunger from the steering column by pressing inward to the stop and rotate
the horn plunger 90 degrees.
20. Remove the steering wheel retaining nut.
21. Install the J 1859-A, Steering Wheel Puller, to the steering wheel.
22. Remove the steering wheel using the J 1859-A.
23. Remove the J 1859-A from the steering wheel.
24. Remove the tilt lever.
25. Remove the screws attaching the lower steering column cover to the steering column.
26. Remove the lower steering column trim cover from the upper steering column trim cover.
26.1 Tilt the lower steering column trim cover down.
26.2 Slide the lower steering column trim cover backward in order to disengage the locking tabs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 >
Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10136
27. Remove the upper steering column trim cover mounting screws (1).
28. Lift the upper steering column trim cover to gain access to the lock cylinder access hole.
29. Using a bent tip awl, insert the tip into the ignition lock cylinder access hole.
30. Turn the ignition lock cylinder to the START position.
31. Using the bent tip awl, push down on the ignition lock cylinder retaining pin.
32. Release the ignition lock cylinder to the RUN position.
33. Remove the ignition lock cylinder from the lock module by pulling the ignition lock cylinder away
from the steering column.
34. Remove the upper column cover.
Important:
The illustration above is for the purpose of identifying the barcode only. The actual location of the
barcode on the switch may differ.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 >
Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10137
35. Inspect the part number (1) on the multifunction switch at the location shown in the illustration.
36. If the part number is 26084051, 26084052, 26096834, 26096835, 26102157 or 26102158, no
repair is required. Proceed to the section titled "Reassemble Vehicle."
^ If there is NO part number or barcode on the switch, no repair is required. Proceed to the section
titled "Reassemble Vehicle."
^ If the part number or barcode on the switch is 26091775 or 26091776, proceed to the next step
and replace the hazard warning flasher switch using part number 15177379.
Important:
Carefully review the above illustration to determine the exact location to insert the screwdriver in
the next step.
37. Insert a small, pocket-sized, flat bladed screwdriver (2) into the small space between the
hazard warning flasher switch housing (1) and the multifunction switch (3).
38. Carefully tilt the screwdriver handle towards the instrument cluster. This will cause the blade of
the screwdriver to pry open the space between the hazard warning flasher switch housing and the
multifunction switch.
39. While the space is pried open, pull the hazard warning flasher switch out of the multifunction
switch. Discard the hazard warning flasher switch.
Note:
Do not touch the three triangle-shaped electrical contacts (1) on the side of the switch when
removing the protective packaging, handling, or applying grease to the new hazard warning flasher
switch in the next steps.
40. Remove the rubber band and protective plastic wrapping from the new hazard warning flasher
switch.
Important:
The electrical contacts on the new hazard warning flasher switch require a special lubricant, which
is included in the kit. Only apply this special lubricant as instructed in the next step. DO NOT use
any other type of grease or lubricant.
41. Open the container of special grease included in the kit and apply it to the surfaces of the three
triangle-shaped electrical contacts (1) on the side of the new hazard warning flasher switch. When
properly applied, the surfaces of the three triangle-shaped electrical contacts must be completely
covered and there should be no grease left in the container. DO NOT put any grease in the
opening that contains the small metal return spring.
42. Insert the hazard warning flasher switch into the opening of the multifunction switch and press
down until it locks into place.
43. Remove any excess grease that may appear around the base of the hazard warning flasher
switch. Proceed to the next section "Reassemble Vehicle."
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 >
Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10138
Reassemble Vehicle
1. Install the upper steering column cover.
2. Insert the ignition lock cylinder through the upper shroud.
3. Install the ignition lock cylinder to the lock module by doing the following:
3.1. Align the positioning slot and locking tab slot on the lock module assembly to the positioning
tab and locking tab on the ignition lock cylinder.
3.2. Push the ignition lock cylinder into the lock module assembly until the locking tab locks against
the lock module.
4. Install the upper steering column cover screws.
Tighten
Tighten the screws to 1.5 N.m (13 lb in).
Important:
The shift lever seal must be seated in the covers.
5. Install the lower steering column trim cover to the upper steering column trim cover.
5.1. Match the tab slots on the lower steering column trim cover with the locking tabs on the upper
steering column trim cover.
5.2. Tilt the lower steering column trim cover up.
5.3. Slide the lower steering column trim cover forward until the locking tabs snap into the tab slots.
6. Install the lower steering column cover screws.
Tighten
Tighten the screws to 3.5 N.m (31 lb in).
7. Install the tilt lever.
8. Install the steering wheel to the steering shaft.
9. Install the steering wheel retaining nut.
Tighten
Tighten the steering wheel retaining nut to 41 N.m (30 lb ft).
10. Install the horn plunger to the steering column.
11. Position the SIR module near the steering wheel.
12. Connect the SIR electrical connector.
13. Connect the CPA retainer to the SIR connector.
14. Connect the SIR lead wire to the clip on the steering wheel.
15. Connect the SIR lead wire to the clip on the inflator module.
Important:
Verify that the wiring is not exposed or trapped between the inflatable restraint steering wheel
module and the steering wheel.
16. Press the inflator module into the steering wheel firmly enough that the module engages and
latches the notched pins in the leaf springs.
17. Rotate the steering wheel back into the straight position.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 >
Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10139
18. Connect the I/P module yellow 2-way connector located under the I/P extension.
19. Install the CPA to the I/P module yellow 2-way connector located under the I/P extension.
20. Connect the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector located at the base of the steering
column.
21. Install the CPA to the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector located at the base of the
steering column.
22. Position the knee bolster trim panel to the I/P and install the attaching screws.
Tighten
Tighten the screws to 1.9 N.m (17 lb in).
23. Install the SIR fuse and install the fuse block cover.
24. Be sure that the ignition is in the OFF position.
25. Connect the negative battery.
Replacing the Multifunction Switch
This procedure describes how to replace ONLY the multifunction switch assembly. The new
multifunction switch assembly will come complete with a new hazard warning flasher switch already
installed.
DO NOT use this procedure if the results of the inspection procedure indicate that only the hazard
warning flasher switch requires replacement.
Contained in this procedure are unique steps to address features or options such as cruise control,
standard or tilt column, and a column-mounted automatic transmission lever.
Tools Required
^ J 1859-A Steering Wheel Puller
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
2. Disconnect the negative battery.
3. Remove the SIR fuse from the fuse block.
4. Remove the screws attaching the driver's side knee bolster trim panel underneath the I/P and
reposition the panel out of the way.
5. Locate the driver's side yellow 2-way air bag electrical connector at the base of the steering
column and remove the connector position assurance (CPA) from the connector.
6. Disconnect the yellow 2-way electrical connector.
7. If equipped, remove the tilt steering column lever.
Important:
Some of the illustrations included in this procedure show the steering column removed from the
vehicle. Those illustrations are for reference
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 >
Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10140
purposes only. DO NOT remove the steering column from the vehicle to perform this repair
procedure.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the RUN position to unlock the steering wheel.
9. Turn the steering wheel 90 degrees so that the side of the SIR module is at the 12 o'clock
position in order to gain access to the holes behind the steering wheel.
10. Insert a flat-bladed tool into the access hole and push the leaf spring in order to release the
notched pin that retains the inflator module.
11. Turn the steering wheel 180 degrees in order to gain access to the remaining access hole.
12. Insert a screwdriver into the remaining hole and push the leaf spring in order to release the
notched pin that retains the inflator module.
13. Tilt the top of the inflator module rearward to gain access to the SIR wiring.
14. Disconnect the SIR lead wire from the clip on the inflator module.
15. Disconnect the SIR lead wire from the clip on the steering wheel.
16. Disconnect the CPA retainer.
17. Disconnect the electrical connector.
Caution:
When you are carrying an undeployed inflator module:
^ Do not carry the inflator module by the wires or connector on the inflator module.
^ Make sure the bag opening points away from you.
^ When you are storing an undeployed inflator module, make sure the bag opening points away
from the surface on which the inflator module rests. Provide free space for the air bag to expand in
case of an accidental deployment. Otherwise, personal injury may result.
18. Set the SIR module aside.
19. Remove the horn plunger from the steering column by pressing inward to the stop and rotate
the horn plunger 90 degrees.
20. Remove the steering wheel retaining nut.
21. Install the J 1859-A, Steering Wheel Puller, to the steering wheel.
22. Remove the steering wheel using the J 1859-A.
23. Remove the J 1859-A from the steering wheel.
24. Remove the tilt lever.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 >
Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10141
25. Remove the screws attaching the lower steering column cover to the steering column.
26. Remove the lower steering column trim cover from the upper steering column trim cover.
27. Tilt the lower steering column trim cover down.
27.1 Slide the lower steering column trim cover backward in order to disengage the locking tabs.
28. Remove the upper steering column trim cover mounting screws (1).
29. Lift the upper steering column trim cover to gain access to the lock cylinder access hole.
30. Using a bent tip awl, insert the tip into the ignition lock cylinder access hole.
31. Turn the ignition lock cylinder to the START position.
32. Using the bent tip awl, push down on the ignition lock cylinder retaining pin.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 >
Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10142
33. Release the ignition lock cylinder to the RUN position.
34. Remove the ignition lock cylinder from the lock module by pulling the ignition lock cylinder away
from the steering column.
35. Remove the upper column cover.
36. Disconnect the steering column electrical connectors.
37. Disconnect the multifunction switch connectors from the steering column electrical connector.
38. Remove the steering column wiring harness from the wiring harness strap.
39. Remove the wire harness straps from the steering column wire harness.
40. Remove the multifunction switch mounting screws.
41. Remove the multifunction switch.
Important:
The multifunction switch electrical contact must rest on the canceling cam assembly.
42. Install the new multifunction switch as follows:
42.1 Use a small blade screwdriver in order to compress the electrical contact.
42.2 Move the multifunction switch into position.
43. Install the multifunction switch mounting screws.
Tighten
Tighten the multifunction switch mounting screws to 6 N.m (53 lb in).
44. Connect the multifunction switch electrical connectors to the steering column electrical
connector.
45. Connect the steering column electrical connector to the I/P wire harness.
46. Install the wire harness straps to the steering column wire harness.
47. Install the steering column wire harness to the wiring harness strap.
48. Install the upper steering column cover.
49. Insert the ignition lock cylinder through the upper shroud.
50. Install the ignition lock cylinder to the lock module by doing the following:
50.1 Align the positioning slot and locking tab slot on the lock module assembly to the positioning
tab and locking tab on the ignition lock
cylinder.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 >
Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10143
50.2 Push the ignition lock cylinder into the lock module assembly until the locking tab locks
against the lock module.
51. Install the upper steering column cover screws.
Tighten
Tighten the screws to 1.5 N.m (13 lb in).
Important:
The shift lever seal must be seated in the covers.
52. Install the lower steering column trim cover to the upper steering column trim cover.
52.1 Match the tab slots on the lower steering column trim cover with the locking tabs on the upper
steering column trim cover.
52.3 Tilt the lower steering column trim cover up.
52.3 Slide the lower steering column trim cover forward until the locking tabs snap into the tab
slots.
53. Install the lower steering column cover screws.
Tighten
Tighten the screws to 3.5 N.m (31 lb in).
54. Install the tilt lever.
55. Install the steering wheel to the steering shaft.
56. Install the steering wheel retaining nut.
Tighten
Tighten the steering wheel retaining nut to 41 N.m (30 lb ft).
57. Install the horn plunger to the steering column.
58. Position the SIR module near the steering wheel.
59. Connect the SIR electrical connector.
60. Connect the CPA retainer to the SIR connector.
61. Connect the SIR lead wire to the clip on the steering wheel.
62. Connect the SIR lead wire to the clip on the inflator module.
Important:
Verify that the wiring in not exposed or trapped between the inflatable restraint steering wheel
module and the steering wheel.
63. Press the inflator module into the steering wheel firmly enough that the module engages and
latches the notched pins in the leaf springs.
64. Rotate the steering wheel back into the straight position.
65. Connect the I/P module yellow 2-way connector located under the I/P extension.
66. Install the CPA to the I/P module yellow 2-way connector located under the I/P extension.
67. Connect the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector located at the base of the steering
column.
68. Install the CPA to the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector located at the base of the
steering column.
69. Position the knee bolster trim panel to the I/P and install the attaching screws.
Tighten
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 >
Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10144
Tighten the screws to 1.9 N.m (17 lb in).
70. Install the SIR fuse and install the fuse block cover.
71. Be sure that the ignition is in the OFF position.
72. Connect the negative battery cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > 05013A > May > 05 >
Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10145
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Hazard Warning Switch: > NHTSA05V099000 > Mar >
05 > Recall 05V099000: Brake/Hazard Lamp Failure
Hazard Warning Switch: Recalls Recall 05V099000: Brake/Hazard Lamp Failure
MAKE/MODELS: MODEL/BUILD YEARS: Chevrolet/Astro 2001-2002 GMC/Safari 2001-2002
MANUFACTURER: General Motors Corp. NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 05V099000 RECALL
DATE: March 09, 2005
COMPONENT: Exterior Lighting: Brake Lights: Switch
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 77055
SUMMARY: On certain minivans, the multifunction switch may develop an open circuit condition in
the stop lamp or hazard lamp circuit that results in the stop lamps and hazard lamps being
inoperative.
CONSEQUENCE: The loss of stop lamps and rear hazard lamps could fail to warn a following
driver that the vehicle is braking and/or is stopped and could lead to a vehicle crash.
REMEDY: Dealers will replace the hazard warning flasher switch and apply special grease to the
contacts at the time of installation of the module. The repair would be used in vehicles in which the
hazard slider button is still movable. If a vehicle has a hazard slider button that is not movable
(frozen), the entire multifunction switch will be replaced. The manufacturer has not yet provided an
owner notification schedule. Owners should contact Chevrolet at 1-800-630-2438 or GMC at
1-866-996-9463.
NOTES: GM recall No. 05013. Customers can also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Auto Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: >
05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement
Technical Service Bulletin # 05013A Date: 050526
Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement
Bulletin No.: 05013A
Date: May 26, 2005
SAFETY
Subject: 05013A - Multifunction Switch Contacts
Models: 2001-2002 Chevrolet Astro 2001-2002 GMC Safari
Supercede:
THE INSPECTION IN STEP 35 OF THE PROCEDURE "REPLACING THE HAZARD WARNING
FLASHER SWITCH" HAS BEEN REVISED AND PART NUMBER 15174447 HAS BEEN
ELIMINATED. PLEASE REVIEW THIS NEW INFORMATION IMMEDIATELY. DISCARD ALL
COPIES OF BULLETIN 05013 ISSUED APRIL 2005.
Condition
General Motors has decided that a defect, which relates to motor vehicle safety, exists in certain
2001-2002 Chevrolet Astro and GMC Safari vehicles. On some of these vehicles, the stop lamps
and rear hazard lamps may become inoperative. The usage factors that increase the possibility of
this condition occurring include frequency and length of brake applications, frequency of trailer
towing with brake applications, and exposure to high ambient temperatures. The center high
mounted stop lamp and turn signal lamp functionality are not affected. The loss of stop lamps
and/or rear hazard lamps could fail to warn a following driver that the vehicle is braking and/or is
stopped and could lead to a vehicle accident.
Correction
Dealers are to inspect and replace the hazard warning flasher switch, if necessary. In a small
number of vehicles, the multifunction switch will require replacement.
Vehicles Involved
Involved are certain 2001-2002 Chevrolet Astro and GMC Safari vehicles built within the VIN
breakpoints shown.
Important:
Dealers should confirm vehicle eligibility through GMVIS (GM Vehicle Inquiry System) before
beginning recall repairs. [Not all vehicles within the above breakpoints may be involved.]
For US & Canada
For dealers with involved vehicles, a Campaign Initiation Detail Report containing the complete
Vehicle Identification Number, customer name and address data has been prepared and will be
loaded to the GM DealerWorld (U.S.), GMinfoNet (Canada) Recall Information website. Dealers
that have no involved vehicles currently assigned will not have a report available in GM
DealerWorld/GMinfoNet.
For Export
For dealers with involved vehicles, a Campaign Initiation Detail Report containing the complete
Vehicle Identification Number, customer name and address data has been prepared, and is being
furnished to involved dealers. Dealers that have no involved vehicles currently assigned will not
receive a report with the recall bulletin.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: >
05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10155
The Campaign Initiation Detail Report may contain customer names and addresses obtained from
Motor Vehicle Registration Records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any
purpose other than follow-up necessary to complete this recall is a violation of law in several
states/provinces/countries. Accordingly, you are urged to limit the use of this report to the follow-up
necessary to complete this recall.
Parts Information
Parts required to complete this recall are to be obtained from General Motors Service Parts
Operations (GMSPO). Please refer to your "involved vehicles listing" before ordering parts. Normal
orders should be placed on a DRO=Daily Replenishment Order. In an emergency situation, parts
should be ordered on a CSO = Customer Special Order.
Customer Reimbursement - For US
All customer requests for reimbursement for previous repairs for the recall condition will be handled
by the Customer Assistance Center, not by dealers.
A General Motors Product Recall Customer Reimbursement Procedure Form is shown in this
bulletin.
Important:
Refer to the GM Service Policies and Procedures Manual, section 6.1.12, for specific procedures
regarding customer reimbursement and the form.
Customer Reimbursement - For Canada & Export
Customer requests for reimbursement of previously paid repairs to correct the condition addressed
in this bulletin are to be submitted by April 30, 2006.
All reasonable customer paid receipts should be considered for reimbursement. The amount to be
reimbursed will be limited to the amount the repair would have cost if completed by an authorized
General Motors dealer.
When a customer requests reimbursement, they must provide the following:
^ Proof of ownership at time of repair.
^ Original paid receipt confirming the amount of repair expense(s) that were not reimbursed, a
description of the repair, and the person or entity performing the repair.
Claims for customer reimbursement on previously paid repairs are to be submitted as required by
WINS.
Important:
Refer to the GM Service Policies and Procedures Manual, section 1.6.2, for specific procedures
regarding customer reimbursement verification.
Courtesy Transportation
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: >
05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10156
The General Motors Courtesy Transportation Program is intended to minimize customer
inconvenience when a vehicle requires a repair that is covered by the New Vehicle Limited
Warranty. The availability of courtesy transportation to customers whose vehicles are within the
warranty coverage period and involved in a product recall is very important in maintaining customer
satisfaction. Dealers are to ensure that these customers understand that shuttle service or some
other form of courtesy transportation is available and will be provided at no charge. Dealers should
refer to the General Motors Service Policies and Procedures Manual for courtesy transportation
guidelines.
Claim Information
Submit a Product Recall Claim with the information shown.
Refer to the General Motors WINS Claims Processing Manual for details on Product Recall Claim
Submission.
Customer Notification - For US and Canada
General Motors will notify customers of this recall on their vehicle (see copy of customer letter
shown in this bulletin).
Customer Notification - For Export
Letters will be sent to known owners of record located within areas covered by the US National
Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act. For owners outside these areas, dealers should notify
customers using the sample letter.
Dealer Recall Responsibility - For US and Export (US States, Territories, and Possessions)
The US National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act provides that each vehicle which is subject to
a recall of this type must be adequately repaired within a reasonable time after the customer has
tendered it for repair. A failure to repair within sixty days after tender of a vehicle is prima facie
evidence
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: >
05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10157
of failure to repair within a reasonable time. If the condition is not adequately repaired within a
reasonable time, the customer may be entitled to an identical or reasonably equivalent vehicle at
no charge or to a refund of the purchase price less a reasonable allowance for depreciation. To
avoid having to provide these burdensome remedies, every effort must be made to promptly
schedule an appointment with each customer and to repair their vehicle as soon as possible. In the
recall notification letters, customers are told how to contact the US National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration if the recall is not completed within a reasonable time.
Dealer Recall Responsibility - All
All unsold new vehicles in dealers, possession and subject to this recall MUST be held and
inspected/repaired per the service procedure of this recall bulletin BEFORE customers take
possession of these vehicles.
Dealers are to service all vehicles subject to this recall at no charge to customers, regardless of
mileage, age of vehicle, or ownership, from this time forward.
Customers who have recently purchased vehicles sold from your vehicle inventory, and for which
there is no customer information indicated on the dealer listing, are to be contacted by the dealer.
Arrangements are to be made to make the required correction according to the instructions
contained in this bulletin. A copy of the customer letter is shown in this bulletin for your use in
contacting customers. Recall follow-up cards should not be used for this purpose, since the
customer may not as yet have received the notification letter.
In summary, whenever a vehicle subject to this recall enters your vehicle inventory, or is in your
dealership for service in the future, please take the steps necessary to be sure the recall correction
has been made before selling or releasing the vehicle.
GENERAL MOTORS PRODUCT RECALL CUSTOMER REIMBURSEMENT PROCEDURE
If you have paid to have this recall condition corrected prior to receiving this notification, you may
be eligible to receive reimbursement.
Requests for reimbursement may include parts, labor, fees and taxes. Reimbursement may be
limited to the amount the repair would have cost if completed by an authorized General Motors
dealer.
Your claim will be acted upon within 60 days of receipt.
If your claim is:
^ Approved, you will receive a check from General Motors.
^ Denied, you will receive a letter from General Motors with the reason(s) for the denial, or
^ Incomplete, you will receive a letter from General Motors identifying the documentation that is
needed to complete the claim and offered the opportunity to resubmit the claim when the missing
documentation is available.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: >
05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10158
Please follow the instructions on the Claim Form shown to file a claim for reimbursement. If you
have questions about this reimbursement procedure, please call the toll-free telephone number
provided on the form. If you need assistance with any other concern, please contact the
appropriate Customer Assistance Center at the number also shown. The Customer Assistance
Center hours of operation are from 8:00 AM - 11:00 PM eastern standard time Monday through
Friday.
Disclaimer
Service Procedure
The following procedure describes how to inspect and replace the hazard warning flasher switch,
OR inspect and replace the multifunction (turn signal, headlamp dimmer, and windshield
wiper/washer) switch assembly. The part that you replace will be determined during the inspection
portion of this procedure. Do NOT replace any parts until after performing the inspection procedure.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: >
05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10159
Inspection Procedure
1. From inside the vehicle, depress the hazard warning flasher switch located on the top of the
steering column.
2. Depress the hazard warning flasher switch again.
^ If the hazard warning flasher switch did not stick in either the up or down position, proceed to the
section titled "Replacing the Hazard Warning Flasher Switch." Do not order any replacement parts
until instructed to in the additional inspection procedure included in that section.
^ If the hazard warning flasher switch is sticking in either the up or down position, replace the
multifunction switch. Proceed to the section titled "Replacing the Multifunction Switch."
Replacing the Hazard Warning Flasher Switch
This procedure describes how to replace ONLY the hazard warning flasher switch assembly. The
procedure includes information on how to remove the original switch, where to apply the lubricant
on the new switch, and how to install the new switch.
DO NOT use this procedure if the inspection above indicates that the multifunction switch requires
replacement. Contained in this procedure are unique steps to address features or options such as
cruise control, standard or tilt column, and a column mounted automatic transmission lever.
Tools Required
^ J 1859-A Steering Wheel Puller
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
2. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
3. Remove the SIR fuse from the fuse block.
4. Remove the screws attaching the driver's side knee bolster trim panel underneath the I/P and
reposition the panel out of the way.
5. Locate the driver's side yellow 2-way air bag electrical connector at the base of the steering
column and remove the connector position assurance (CPA) from the connector.
6. Disconnect the yellow 2-way electrical connector.
7. If equipped, remove the tilt steering column lever.
Important:
Some of the illustrations included in this procedure show the steering column removed from the
vehicle. Those illustrations are for reference purposes only. DO NOT remove the steering column
from the vehicle to perform this repair procedure.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the RUN position to unlock the steering wheel.
9. Turn the steering wheel 90 degrees so that the side of the SIR module is at the 12 o'clock
position in order to gain access to the holes behind the
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: >
05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10160
steering wheel.
10. Insert a flat-bladed tool into the access hole and push the leaf spring in order to release the
notched pin that retains the inflator module.
11. Turn the steering wheel 180 degrees in order to gain access to the remaining access hole.
12. Insert a screwdriver into the remaining hole and push the leaf spring in order to release the
notched pin that retains the inflator module.
13. Tilt the top of the inflator module rearward to gain access to the SIR wiring.
14. Disconnect the SIR lead wire from the clip on the inflator module.
15. Disconnect the SIR lead wire from the clip on the steering wheel.
16. Disconnect the CPA retainer.
17. Disconnect the electrical connector.
Caution:
When you are carrying an undeployed inflator module:
^ Do not carry the inflator module by the wires or connector on the inflator module.
^ Make sure the bag opening points away from you.
^ When you are storing an undeployed inflator module, make sure the bag opening points away
from the surface on which the inflator module rests. Provide free space for the air bag to expand in
case of an accidental deployment. Otherwise, personal injury may result.
18. Set the SIR module aside.
19. Remove the horn plunger from the steering column by pressing inward to the stop and rotate
the horn plunger 90 degrees.
20. Remove the steering wheel retaining nut.
21. Install the J 1859-A, Steering Wheel Puller, to the steering wheel.
22. Remove the steering wheel using the J 1859-A.
23. Remove the J 1859-A from the steering wheel.
24. Remove the tilt lever.
25. Remove the screws attaching the lower steering column cover to the steering column.
26. Remove the lower steering column trim cover from the upper steering column trim cover.
26.1 Tilt the lower steering column trim cover down.
26.2 Slide the lower steering column trim cover backward in order to disengage the locking tabs.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: >
05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10161
27. Remove the upper steering column trim cover mounting screws (1).
28. Lift the upper steering column trim cover to gain access to the lock cylinder access hole.
29. Using a bent tip awl, insert the tip into the ignition lock cylinder access hole.
30. Turn the ignition lock cylinder to the START position.
31. Using the bent tip awl, push down on the ignition lock cylinder retaining pin.
32. Release the ignition lock cylinder to the RUN position.
33. Remove the ignition lock cylinder from the lock module by pulling the ignition lock cylinder away
from the steering column.
34. Remove the upper column cover.
Important:
The illustration above is for the purpose of identifying the barcode only. The actual location of the
barcode on the switch may differ.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: >
05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10162
35. Inspect the part number (1) on the multifunction switch at the location shown in the illustration.
36. If the part number is 26084051, 26084052, 26096834, 26096835, 26102157 or 26102158, no
repair is required. Proceed to the section titled "Reassemble Vehicle."
^ If there is NO part number or barcode on the switch, no repair is required. Proceed to the section
titled "Reassemble Vehicle."
^ If the part number or barcode on the switch is 26091775 or 26091776, proceed to the next step
and replace the hazard warning flasher switch using part number 15177379.
Important:
Carefully review the above illustration to determine the exact location to insert the screwdriver in
the next step.
37. Insert a small, pocket-sized, flat bladed screwdriver (2) into the small space between the
hazard warning flasher switch housing (1) and the multifunction switch (3).
38. Carefully tilt the screwdriver handle towards the instrument cluster. This will cause the blade of
the screwdriver to pry open the space between the hazard warning flasher switch housing and the
multifunction switch.
39. While the space is pried open, pull the hazard warning flasher switch out of the multifunction
switch. Discard the hazard warning flasher switch.
Note:
Do not touch the three triangle-shaped electrical contacts (1) on the side of the switch when
removing the protective packaging, handling, or applying grease to the new hazard warning flasher
switch in the next steps.
40. Remove the rubber band and protective plastic wrapping from the new hazard warning flasher
switch.
Important:
The electrical contacts on the new hazard warning flasher switch require a special lubricant, which
is included in the kit. Only apply this special lubricant as instructed in the next step. DO NOT use
any other type of grease or lubricant.
41. Open the container of special grease included in the kit and apply it to the surfaces of the three
triangle-shaped electrical contacts (1) on the side of the new hazard warning flasher switch. When
properly applied, the surfaces of the three triangle-shaped electrical contacts must be completely
covered and there should be no grease left in the container. DO NOT put any grease in the
opening that contains the small metal return spring.
42. Insert the hazard warning flasher switch into the opening of the multifunction switch and press
down until it locks into place.
43. Remove any excess grease that may appear around the base of the hazard warning flasher
switch. Proceed to the next section "Reassemble Vehicle."
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: >
05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10163
Reassemble Vehicle
1. Install the upper steering column cover.
2. Insert the ignition lock cylinder through the upper shroud.
3. Install the ignition lock cylinder to the lock module by doing the following:
3.1. Align the positioning slot and locking tab slot on the lock module assembly to the positioning
tab and locking tab on the ignition lock cylinder.
3.2. Push the ignition lock cylinder into the lock module assembly until the locking tab locks against
the lock module.
4. Install the upper steering column cover screws.
Tighten
Tighten the screws to 1.5 N.m (13 lb in).
Important:
The shift lever seal must be seated in the covers.
5. Install the lower steering column trim cover to the upper steering column trim cover.
5.1. Match the tab slots on the lower steering column trim cover with the locking tabs on the upper
steering column trim cover.
5.2. Tilt the lower steering column trim cover up.
5.3. Slide the lower steering column trim cover forward until the locking tabs snap into the tab slots.
6. Install the lower steering column cover screws.
Tighten
Tighten the screws to 3.5 N.m (31 lb in).
7. Install the tilt lever.
8. Install the steering wheel to the steering shaft.
9. Install the steering wheel retaining nut.
Tighten
Tighten the steering wheel retaining nut to 41 N.m (30 lb ft).
10. Install the horn plunger to the steering column.
11. Position the SIR module near the steering wheel.
12. Connect the SIR electrical connector.
13. Connect the CPA retainer to the SIR connector.
14. Connect the SIR lead wire to the clip on the steering wheel.
15. Connect the SIR lead wire to the clip on the inflator module.
Important:
Verify that the wiring is not exposed or trapped between the inflatable restraint steering wheel
module and the steering wheel.
16. Press the inflator module into the steering wheel firmly enough that the module engages and
latches the notched pins in the leaf springs.
17. Rotate the steering wheel back into the straight position.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: >
05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10164
18. Connect the I/P module yellow 2-way connector located under the I/P extension.
19. Install the CPA to the I/P module yellow 2-way connector located under the I/P extension.
20. Connect the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector located at the base of the steering
column.
21. Install the CPA to the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector located at the base of the
steering column.
22. Position the knee bolster trim panel to the I/P and install the attaching screws.
Tighten
Tighten the screws to 1.9 N.m (17 lb in).
23. Install the SIR fuse and install the fuse block cover.
24. Be sure that the ignition is in the OFF position.
25. Connect the negative battery.
Replacing the Multifunction Switch
This procedure describes how to replace ONLY the multifunction switch assembly. The new
multifunction switch assembly will come complete with a new hazard warning flasher switch already
installed.
DO NOT use this procedure if the results of the inspection procedure indicate that only the hazard
warning flasher switch requires replacement.
Contained in this procedure are unique steps to address features or options such as cruise control,
standard or tilt column, and a column-mounted automatic transmission lever.
Tools Required
^ J 1859-A Steering Wheel Puller
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
2. Disconnect the negative battery.
3. Remove the SIR fuse from the fuse block.
4. Remove the screws attaching the driver's side knee bolster trim panel underneath the I/P and
reposition the panel out of the way.
5. Locate the driver's side yellow 2-way air bag electrical connector at the base of the steering
column and remove the connector position assurance (CPA) from the connector.
6. Disconnect the yellow 2-way electrical connector.
7. If equipped, remove the tilt steering column lever.
Important:
Some of the illustrations included in this procedure show the steering column removed from the
vehicle. Those illustrations are for reference
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: >
05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10165
purposes only. DO NOT remove the steering column from the vehicle to perform this repair
procedure.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the RUN position to unlock the steering wheel.
9. Turn the steering wheel 90 degrees so that the side of the SIR module is at the 12 o'clock
position in order to gain access to the holes behind the steering wheel.
10. Insert a flat-bladed tool into the access hole and push the leaf spring in order to release the
notched pin that retains the inflator module.
11. Turn the steering wheel 180 degrees in order to gain access to the remaining access hole.
12. Insert a screwdriver into the remaining hole and push the leaf spring in order to release the
notched pin that retains the inflator module.
13. Tilt the top of the inflator module rearward to gain access to the SIR wiring.
14. Disconnect the SIR lead wire from the clip on the inflator module.
15. Disconnect the SIR lead wire from the clip on the steering wheel.
16. Disconnect the CPA retainer.
17. Disconnect the electrical connector.
Caution:
When you are carrying an undeployed inflator module:
^ Do not carry the inflator module by the wires or connector on the inflator module.
^ Make sure the bag opening points away from you.
^ When you are storing an undeployed inflator module, make sure the bag opening points away
from the surface on which the inflator module rests. Provide free space for the air bag to expand in
case of an accidental deployment. Otherwise, personal injury may result.
18. Set the SIR module aside.
19. Remove the horn plunger from the steering column by pressing inward to the stop and rotate
the horn plunger 90 degrees.
20. Remove the steering wheel retaining nut.
21. Install the J 1859-A, Steering Wheel Puller, to the steering wheel.
22. Remove the steering wheel using the J 1859-A.
23. Remove the J 1859-A from the steering wheel.
24. Remove the tilt lever.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: >
05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10166
25. Remove the screws attaching the lower steering column cover to the steering column.
26. Remove the lower steering column trim cover from the upper steering column trim cover.
27. Tilt the lower steering column trim cover down.
27.1 Slide the lower steering column trim cover backward in order to disengage the locking tabs.
28. Remove the upper steering column trim cover mounting screws (1).
29. Lift the upper steering column trim cover to gain access to the lock cylinder access hole.
30. Using a bent tip awl, insert the tip into the ignition lock cylinder access hole.
31. Turn the ignition lock cylinder to the START position.
32. Using the bent tip awl, push down on the ignition lock cylinder retaining pin.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: >
05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10167
33. Release the ignition lock cylinder to the RUN position.
34. Remove the ignition lock cylinder from the lock module by pulling the ignition lock cylinder away
from the steering column.
35. Remove the upper column cover.
36. Disconnect the steering column electrical connectors.
37. Disconnect the multifunction switch connectors from the steering column electrical connector.
38. Remove the steering column wiring harness from the wiring harness strap.
39. Remove the wire harness straps from the steering column wire harness.
40. Remove the multifunction switch mounting screws.
41. Remove the multifunction switch.
Important:
The multifunction switch electrical contact must rest on the canceling cam assembly.
42. Install the new multifunction switch as follows:
42.1 Use a small blade screwdriver in order to compress the electrical contact.
42.2 Move the multifunction switch into position.
43. Install the multifunction switch mounting screws.
Tighten
Tighten the multifunction switch mounting screws to 6 N.m (53 lb in).
44. Connect the multifunction switch electrical connectors to the steering column electrical
connector.
45. Connect the steering column electrical connector to the I/P wire harness.
46. Install the wire harness straps to the steering column wire harness.
47. Install the steering column wire harness to the wiring harness strap.
48. Install the upper steering column cover.
49. Insert the ignition lock cylinder through the upper shroud.
50. Install the ignition lock cylinder to the lock module by doing the following:
50.1 Align the positioning slot and locking tab slot on the lock module assembly to the positioning
tab and locking tab on the ignition lock
cylinder.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: >
05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10168
50.2 Push the ignition lock cylinder into the lock module assembly until the locking tab locks
against the lock module.
51. Install the upper steering column cover screws.
Tighten
Tighten the screws to 1.5 N.m (13 lb in).
Important:
The shift lever seal must be seated in the covers.
52. Install the lower steering column trim cover to the upper steering column trim cover.
52.1 Match the tab slots on the lower steering column trim cover with the locking tabs on the upper
steering column trim cover.
52.3 Tilt the lower steering column trim cover up.
52.3 Slide the lower steering column trim cover forward until the locking tabs snap into the tab
slots.
53. Install the lower steering column cover screws.
Tighten
Tighten the screws to 3.5 N.m (31 lb in).
54. Install the tilt lever.
55. Install the steering wheel to the steering shaft.
56. Install the steering wheel retaining nut.
Tighten
Tighten the steering wheel retaining nut to 41 N.m (30 lb ft).
57. Install the horn plunger to the steering column.
58. Position the SIR module near the steering wheel.
59. Connect the SIR electrical connector.
60. Connect the CPA retainer to the SIR connector.
61. Connect the SIR lead wire to the clip on the steering wheel.
62. Connect the SIR lead wire to the clip on the inflator module.
Important:
Verify that the wiring in not exposed or trapped between the inflatable restraint steering wheel
module and the steering wheel.
63. Press the inflator module into the steering wheel firmly enough that the module engages and
latches the notched pins in the leaf springs.
64. Rotate the steering wheel back into the straight position.
65. Connect the I/P module yellow 2-way connector located under the I/P extension.
66. Install the CPA to the I/P module yellow 2-way connector located under the I/P extension.
67. Connect the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector located at the base of the steering
column.
68. Install the CPA to the steering wheel module yellow 2-way connector located at the base of the
steering column.
69. Position the knee bolster trim panel to the I/P and install the attaching screws.
Tighten
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: >
05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10169
Tighten the screws to 1.9 N.m (17 lb in).
70. Install the SIR fuse and install the fuse block cover.
71. Be sure that the ignition is in the OFF position.
72. Connect the negative battery cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: >
05013A > May > 05 > Recall - Hazard Warning Flasher Switch Replacement > Page 10170
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hazard Warning Switch: >
NHTSA05V099000 > Mar > 05 > Recall 05V099000: Brake/Hazard Lamp Failure
Hazard Warning Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 05V099000: Brake/Hazard Lamp
Failure
MAKE/MODELS: MODEL/BUILD YEARS: Chevrolet/Astro 2001-2002 GMC/Safari 2001-2002
MANUFACTURER: General Motors Corp. NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 05V099000 RECALL
DATE: March 09, 2005
COMPONENT: Exterior Lighting: Brake Lights: Switch
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 77055
SUMMARY: On certain minivans, the multifunction switch may develop an open circuit condition in
the stop lamp or hazard lamp circuit that results in the stop lamps and hazard lamps being
inoperative.
CONSEQUENCE: The loss of stop lamps and rear hazard lamps could fail to warn a following
driver that the vehicle is braking and/or is stopped and could lead to a vehicle crash.
REMEDY: Dealers will replace the hazard warning flasher switch and apply special grease to the
contacts at the time of installation of the module. The repair would be used in vehicles in which the
hazard slider button is still movable. If a vehicle has a hazard slider button that is not movable
(frozen), the entire multifunction switch will be replaced. The manufacturer has not yet provided an
owner notification schedule. Owners should contact Chevrolet at 1-800-630-2438 or GMC at
1-866-996-9463.
NOTES: GM recall No. 05013. Customers can also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Auto Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10178
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Refer to Battery Disconnect Caution in Service Precautions.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the instrument panel cluster trim plate. 3.
Remove the switch from the plate by using the following procedure:
3.1. Release the retaining tabs on the sides of the switch. 3.2. Pull the switch out of the plate. 3.3.
Disconnect the electrical connector(s) at the back of the headlamp switch.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Connect the electrical connector(s) to the back of the switch. 2. Install the headlamp switch to
the plate by snapping the switch into place. 3. Install the instrument panel cluster trim plate. 4.
Connect the battery negative cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Lighting - Exterior Lamp Condensation and Replacement
Tail Lamp: Technical Service Bulletins Lighting - Exterior Lamp Condensation and Replacement
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 01-08-42-001H
Date: January 05, 2011
Subject: Exterior Lamp Condensation and Replacement Guidelines
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 01-08-42-001G (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
The following information is being provided to better define the causes of condensation in exterior
lamps and includes guidelines for determining the difference between a lamp with a normal
atmospheric condition (condensation) and a lamp with a water leak.
Some exterior lamps, such as cornering, turn signal, backup, headlamps or tail lamps may exhibit
very small droplets of water, a fine mist or white fog (condensation) on the inside of the lamp lens.
This may be more noticeable on lamps with "multi-lens" designs and may be normal during certain
weather conditions.
Condensation occurs when the air inside the lamp assembly, through atmospheric changes,
reaches the "dew point". When this takes place, the moisture in the air within the lamp assembly
condenses, creating a fine mist or white fog on the inside surface of the lamp lens.
Most exterior lamps on General Motors vehicles use a vented design and feature a replaceable
bulb assembly. They are designed to remove any accumulated moisture vapor by expelling it
through a vent system. The vent system operates at all times, however, it is most effective when
the lamps are ON or when the vehicle is in motion. Depending on the size, shape and location of
the lamp on the vehicle, and the atmospheric conditions occurring, the amount of time required to
clear the lamp may vary from 2 to 6 hours.
Completely sealed headlamp assemblies (sealed beams) are still used on a limited number of
models being manufactured today. These lamps require the replacement of the complete lamp
assembly if a bulb filament burns out.
Condensation 2006 TrailBlazer Shown
A Fine Mist or White Fog on the Inside Surface of the Lamp Lens Occurring After a Period of High
Humidity
- May be located primarily in the lens corners (near the vents) and SHOULD NOT cover more than
half the lens surface.
- The condition should clear of moisture when the vehicle is parked in a dry environment, or when
the vehicle is driven with the lights ON.
- A comparison of the equivalent lamp on the opposing side of the vehicle indicates a SIMILAR
performance.
If the above conditions are noted, the customer should be advised that replacement of a lamp
assembly may not correct this condition.
Water Leak New Style Pickup Shown
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Lighting - Exterior Lamp Condensation and Replacement > Page 10186
Numerous & Various Size Drops of Water Collecting on the Inside Surface of the Lamp Lens After
the Vehicle Has Been Exposed to Rain or a Car Washing Environment
- A condition that covers more than half the surface of the lamp lens.
- An accumulation of water in the bottom of the lamp assembly.
- A condition that WON'T clear when the vehicle is parked in a dry environment, or when the
vehicle is driven with the lights ON.
- A comparison of the equivalent lamp on the opposing side of the vehicle indicates a different
performance.
Any of the above conditions would indicate the need to service the lens or lamp assembly.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 10187
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 10188
Tail Lamp: Diagrams
Tail/Stop And Turn Signal Lamp - Left
Tail/Stop Lamp - Left - Export
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 10189
Tail/Stop And Turn Signal Lamp - Right
Tail/Stop Lamp - Right - Export
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 10190
Tail Lamp: Description and Operation
PARK, TAIL, MARKER AND LICENSE LAMPS
The park, tail, marker and license lamps are turned on when the headlamp switch is placed in the
PARK or ON position or anytime the headlights are requested. The PK LPS fuse in the IP fuse
block supplies battery positive voltage to the park lamp relay and the headlamp switch. The Body
Control Module (BCM) provides a ground, or control circuit, to the park lamp relay coil circuit during
ALC operation. When the park lamps are turned on during ALC, the BCM energizes the park lamp
relay. The park lamps can also be supplied battery positive voltage directly from the headlamp
switch. Current flow is to the park, tail, marker and license lamps. The front park and marker lamps
are grounded at G100 and G101. The rear park, tail, marker and license lamps are grounded at
G400 and G401. If the headlight switch is left in the ON position, the park, tail and marker lamps
will remain on until turned off or the battery runs dead.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 10191
Tail Lamp: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Turn OFF the headlamp switch. 2. Open the rear doors. 3. Remove the screws that retain the tail
lamp to the body. 4. Remove the lamp sockets from the back of the tail lamp by using the following
procedure:
4.1. Squeeze the tang at the electrical connector. 4.2. Turn the bulb and the base.
IMPORTANT: Do not remove the grease from the socket.
5. Remove the bulbs from the sockets.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Apply a light coating of lithium grease to the sockets if there is no grease in the sockets. 2. Install
the bulbs into the sockets. 3. Install the lamp sockets to the back of the tail lamp. 4. Install the tail
lamp to the body.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
5. Install the screws to retain the tail lamp to the body.
Tighten Tighten the tail lamp screws to 3 N.m (27 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trunk Lamp > Component Information > Service and Repair
Trunk Lamp: Service and Repair
IP STORAGE COMPARTMENT LAMP REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Open the instrument panel storage compartment.
2. Gently depress the tabs at the top and the bottom of the compartment lamp switch by using a
small flat-bladed tool. 3. Remove the compartment lamp switch. 4. Disconnect the electrical
connector from the switch. 5. Pull the bulb from the compartment lamp switch.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the bulb to the compartment lamp switch. 2. Connect the electrical connector to the
switch. 3. Install the compartment lamp switch and press in order to engage the tabs. 4. Close the
instrument panel storage compartment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Flasher > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Turn Signal Flasher: Service and Repair
HAZARD AND TURN SIGNAL FLASHER REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Open the driver door. 2. In order to remove the flasher module (1) from the instrument panel (IP)
convenience center, simultaneously perform the following:
2.1. Lift upward on the tab that retains the flasher module to the IP convenience center. 2.2.
Remove the flasher module from the IP convenience center.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Position the flasher module (1) to the IP convenience center. 2. Engage the flasher module until
fully seated and the retaining tab clicks. 3. Close the driver door.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Lighting - Exterior Lamp Condensation and Replacement
Turn Signal Lamp: Technical Service Bulletins Lighting - Exterior Lamp Condensation and
Replacement
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 01-08-42-001H
Date: January 05, 2011
Subject: Exterior Lamp Condensation and Replacement Guidelines
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 01-08-42-001G (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
The following information is being provided to better define the causes of condensation in exterior
lamps and includes guidelines for determining the difference between a lamp with a normal
atmospheric condition (condensation) and a lamp with a water leak.
Some exterior lamps, such as cornering, turn signal, backup, headlamps or tail lamps may exhibit
very small droplets of water, a fine mist or white fog (condensation) on the inside of the lamp lens.
This may be more noticeable on lamps with "multi-lens" designs and may be normal during certain
weather conditions.
Condensation occurs when the air inside the lamp assembly, through atmospheric changes,
reaches the "dew point". When this takes place, the moisture in the air within the lamp assembly
condenses, creating a fine mist or white fog on the inside surface of the lamp lens.
Most exterior lamps on General Motors vehicles use a vented design and feature a replaceable
bulb assembly. They are designed to remove any accumulated moisture vapor by expelling it
through a vent system. The vent system operates at all times, however, it is most effective when
the lamps are ON or when the vehicle is in motion. Depending on the size, shape and location of
the lamp on the vehicle, and the atmospheric conditions occurring, the amount of time required to
clear the lamp may vary from 2 to 6 hours.
Completely sealed headlamp assemblies (sealed beams) are still used on a limited number of
models being manufactured today. These lamps require the replacement of the complete lamp
assembly if a bulb filament burns out.
Condensation 2006 TrailBlazer Shown
A Fine Mist or White Fog on the Inside Surface of the Lamp Lens Occurring After a Period of High
Humidity
- May be located primarily in the lens corners (near the vents) and SHOULD NOT cover more than
half the lens surface.
- The condition should clear of moisture when the vehicle is parked in a dry environment, or when
the vehicle is driven with the lights ON.
- A comparison of the equivalent lamp on the opposing side of the vehicle indicates a SIMILAR
performance.
If the above conditions are noted, the customer should be advised that replacement of a lamp
assembly may not correct this condition.
Water Leak New Style Pickup Shown
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Lighting - Exterior Lamp Condensation and Replacement > Page 10203
Numerous & Various Size Drops of Water Collecting on the Inside Surface of the Lamp Lens After
the Vehicle Has Been Exposed to Rain or a Car Washing Environment
- A condition that covers more than half the surface of the lamp lens.
- An accumulation of water in the bottom of the lamp assembly.
- A condition that WON'T clear when the vehicle is parked in a dry environment, or when the
vehicle is driven with the lights ON.
- A comparison of the equivalent lamp on the opposing side of the vehicle indicates a different
performance.
Any of the above conditions would indicate the need to service the lens or lamp assembly.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10204
Turn Signal Lamp: Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10205
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10206
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10207
Turn Signal Lamp: Diagrams
Park/Turn Signal Lamp - LF
Park/Turn Signal Lamp - RF
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10208
Park/Turn Signal Lamp - LF - Export
Park/Turn Signal Lamp - RF - Export
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10209
Tail/Stop And Turn Signal Lamp - Left
Tail/Stop And Turn Signal Lamp - Right
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10210
Turn Signal Lamp - LR - Export
Turn Signal Lamp - RR - Export
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10211
Turn Signal Lamp: Description and Operation
The STOP/HAZ fuse in the IP fuse block supplies battery positive voltage to the multifunction
hazard switch assembly. The TURN-B/U fuse in the IP fuse block supplies Ignition positive voltage
to the multifunction turn signal switch assembly. With the ignition switch in the RUN or START
position, ignition positive voltage is connected through the multifunction turn signal and hazard
switch assembly to the flasher module which is grounded at G105. When the turn signal switch is
placed in either the left or right position, the circuit is complete from the flasher module to the turn
signal lamps and to ground.
The flasher module then sends an on-off voltage signal to either the left or right turn signals and
their Instrument Panel Cluster (IPC) indicator. When the hazard switch is activated, all turn signal
lamps will flash including both IPC turn indicators. The front turn signals are grounded at G101 and
G100. The rear turn signals are grounded at G400 and G401.
On the export vehicle, the rear turn signal lamps are separate amber lamps utilizing single filament
bulbs grounded at G400 and G401. There are also amber side repeater lamps on each fender
which are grounded at G101 and G110. The front side marker lamps stay on steady and do not
flash alternately with the turn signals as the domestic vehicle does due to they are grounded
directly to G101 and G100.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10212
Turn Signal Lamp: Service and Repair
PARK/TURN SIGNAL LAMP REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Turn OFF the headlamp switch. 2. Remove the mounting screws. 3. Remove the park/turn signal
lamp from the vehicle. 4. Remove the lamp sockets from the park/turn signal lamp housing. 5.
Remove the bulbs from the lamp sockets.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the bulbs into the lamp sockets. 2. Install the lamp socket to the park/turn signal lamp
housing. 3. Install the park/turn signal lamp to the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
4. Install the mounting screws.
Tighten Tighten the mounting screws to 1.4 N.m (12 lb in).
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Vanity Lamp > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Vanity Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Page 10216
Vanity Lamp: Diagrams
Vanity Mirror Lamp - Left
Vanity Mirror Lamp - Right
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Vanity Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Page 10217
Vanity Lamp: Description and Operation
The inadvertent power relay also provides battery positive voltage to each vanity mirror lamp.
When the vanity mirror cover on the sunshade is opened, the internal switch closes to provide a
ground circuit and the vanity lamp illuminates.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Vanity Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Page 10218
Vanity Lamp: Testing and Inspection
For information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to Lighting
and Horns Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Vanity Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Page 10219
Vanity Lamp: Service and Repair
VANITY MIRROR LAMP REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Turn the sunshade down. 2. Lift the vanity mirror cover. 3. Remove the lens by gently prying at
the top or the bottom of the lens with a suitable flat bladed tool. 4. Lift the bulb(s) straight out.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Vanity Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Page 10220
1. Press the bulb(s) in. 2. Install the lens. 3. Close the vanity mirror cover. 4. Turn the sunshade up.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Heated Glass Element: > 03-08-48-006H > Apr > 11 > A/C - Window Defroster
Contact/Tab Repair Information
Heated Glass Element: Customer Interest A/C - Window Defroster Contact/Tab Repair Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 03-08-48-006H
Date: April 11, 2011
Subject: Repair Information for Reconnection of Rear Window Defroster Contact or Tab
Models:
2000-2012 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2003-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2010 HUMMER H3
2005-2009 Saab 9-7X 2007-2010 Opel GT 2007-2008 Daewoo G2X Equipped With Electric Rear
Window Defroster - RPO C49
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2012 model year. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 03-08-48-006G (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Repair Suggestions
Soldering Defroster Contact Tabs
In many cases the terminal tab will still be in the connector when you examine the vehicle. For
Chevrolet Tahoe, Suburban, GMC Yukon, and Cadillac Escalade vehicles (with moveable glass),
always replace the defroster tab (GM P/N 25916031) and the defroster electrical power connector
(P/N 12034110). For all other vehicles, reconnect the original defroster tab.
In most applications it is preferable to create a new solder connection to reattach a separated rear
defroster tab. If you take note of the steps below, it is possible to create a new solder joint that is
equal to, or stronger than, the original. The generic procedure below is not very time intensive, but
does include minor preparation work to create a good bonding surface. Be sure to follow each of
the steps, as combined they will produce the strongest bond possible. Please consider the
following before attempting the repair:
- Soldering introduces significant heat to the glass window of the vehicle. When performing the
re-connection of the tab, use only the heat required to do the job. Pre-heat the soldering iron and
have the solder in your other hand, ready to go, the moment you have enough heat to melt the
solder.
- If it is winter, bring the vehicle into the service garage and remove any snow from the back
window area. Allow time for the glass to warm to the temperature inside the building. Soldering
creates a "hot spot" in the glass. DO NOT solder on cold glass.
Caution Heating the glass excessively, or repeatedly without time to cool, may result in glass
breakage. ALWAYS wear safety glasses when performing this repair!
- You MUST use a silver-bearing solder to make the connection. DO NOT attempt this repair with
conventional tin/lead alloy solders. Silver bearing solder will adhere to the electrical buss bar,
making a strong and lasting repair.
- Protect surfaces under the area to be soldered. It is very easy to drip solder when performing this
repair. Placing a shop towel under the soldering area is sufficient protection.
Soldering Procedure
1. It is imperative to remove and replace the rear defroster electrical power connector by crimping a
new connector to the feed wire. The proper
connector P/N 12034110 can be found in the Packard Electrical Assortment, Tray 18, Position 5.
- Insert Delphi pick 12094430 to depress the locking tab on the terminal.
- Insert Delphi pick 12094429 to release the secondary lock tab.
Important DO NOT re-use the existing defroster tab on new-style full-size utility vehicles with
moveable glass.
2. Connect the electrical connector to the defroster tab. Fully engage the connector. An improperly
seated connector may cause excessive resistance
and impede the proper operation of the defroster. Add a small bead of solder to mate the electrical
connector tab to the defroster tab.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Heated Glass Element: > 03-08-48-006H > Apr > 11 > A/C - Window Defroster
Contact/Tab Repair Information > Page 10230
3. Prepare the surface of the used defroster tab (not required for new tabs on new-style full-size
utility models) and the defroster buss bar with fine
grain (500 grit) sandpaper or Emery cloth. It is not necessary to remove all of the original solder,
but it should be scuffed sufficiently so that no oxidation is present. The photo above shows a close
up of a properly prepared surface.
Tip You may want to mask the glass around the contact area with tape. This is easy to do and will
allow you to safely prepare the contact surface without the risk of scratching the glass or the black
painted shading.
Important Most rear glass has a black painted masking around the edge of the glass. When
cleaning up the connection surface, be very careful not to damage the surface of the black shading
or the surface of the glass.
4. Wipe the newly prepared contact area with Kent Automotive* Acrysol(TM) (or equivalent) to
remove any residual oil or dirt.
Important
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Heated Glass Element: > 03-08-48-006H > Apr > 11 > A/C - Window Defroster
Contact/Tab Repair Information > Page 10231
You MUST use a silver-bearing solder to make the solder joint. DO NOT attempt this repair with
conventional tin/lead alloy solders. Most suppliers have this type of solder available and it is
available nationally at Radio Shack(R)*. It is sold in several diameters and either are acceptable for
this repair.
5. For this step, it is permitted that two technicians be used if required. Heat the new connector on
the surface of the buss bar that is to be soldered.
Long nose pliers are suggested to hold the electrical connector and the defroster tab in place. Keep
the solder ready and begin flowing out the solder as soon as the melting temperature has been
reached. Tip If a single technician is attempting this repair, it is beneficial to wrap one turn of the
solder around the new contacts base. In this manner, as the melting point of the solder is reached,
a layer is deposited on the bottom side of the contact.
Important Try to align the new contact so that it is positioned with the same orientation as the
original contact.
6. The above illustrates an ideal finished solder joint. Additional stray solder will not harm the
performance of the bond; however, while it is unlikely
that customers may refer to the appearance of the rear window defroster and its components as a
positive styling feature of the vehicle interior, it is easy to elicit the opposite reaction due to a poor
cosmetic application.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Parts Information
Acrysol(TM) can be ordered directly from Kent Automotive at 1-800-654-6333 (in Canada,
1-800-563-1717).
Radio Shack(R) products can be found nationally at retail locations, www.radioshack.com, or at
1-800-843-7422.
All other parts can be ordered through GMSPO or SSPO.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Heated Glass Element: > 03-08-48-006H > Apr > 11 > A/C - Window Defroster
Contact/Tab Repair Information > Page 10232
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Heated Glass Element: > 03-08-48-006H > Apr > 11 > A/C - Window Defroster
Contact/Tab Repair Information
Heated Glass Element: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Window Defroster Contact/Tab Repair
Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 03-08-48-006H
Date: April 11, 2011
Subject: Repair Information for Reconnection of Rear Window Defroster Contact or Tab
Models:
2000-2012 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2003-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2010 HUMMER H3
2005-2009 Saab 9-7X 2007-2010 Opel GT 2007-2008 Daewoo G2X Equipped With Electric Rear
Window Defroster - RPO C49
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2012 model year. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 03-08-48-006G (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Repair Suggestions
Soldering Defroster Contact Tabs
In many cases the terminal tab will still be in the connector when you examine the vehicle. For
Chevrolet Tahoe, Suburban, GMC Yukon, and Cadillac Escalade vehicles (with moveable glass),
always replace the defroster tab (GM P/N 25916031) and the defroster electrical power connector
(P/N 12034110). For all other vehicles, reconnect the original defroster tab.
In most applications it is preferable to create a new solder connection to reattach a separated rear
defroster tab. If you take note of the steps below, it is possible to create a new solder joint that is
equal to, or stronger than, the original. The generic procedure below is not very time intensive, but
does include minor preparation work to create a good bonding surface. Be sure to follow each of
the steps, as combined they will produce the strongest bond possible. Please consider the
following before attempting the repair:
- Soldering introduces significant heat to the glass window of the vehicle. When performing the
re-connection of the tab, use only the heat required to do the job. Pre-heat the soldering iron and
have the solder in your other hand, ready to go, the moment you have enough heat to melt the
solder.
- If it is winter, bring the vehicle into the service garage and remove any snow from the back
window area. Allow time for the glass to warm to the temperature inside the building. Soldering
creates a "hot spot" in the glass. DO NOT solder on cold glass.
Caution Heating the glass excessively, or repeatedly without time to cool, may result in glass
breakage. ALWAYS wear safety glasses when performing this repair!
- You MUST use a silver-bearing solder to make the connection. DO NOT attempt this repair with
conventional tin/lead alloy solders. Silver bearing solder will adhere to the electrical buss bar,
making a strong and lasting repair.
- Protect surfaces under the area to be soldered. It is very easy to drip solder when performing this
repair. Placing a shop towel under the soldering area is sufficient protection.
Soldering Procedure
1. It is imperative to remove and replace the rear defroster electrical power connector by crimping a
new connector to the feed wire. The proper
connector P/N 12034110 can be found in the Packard Electrical Assortment, Tray 18, Position 5.
- Insert Delphi pick 12094430 to depress the locking tab on the terminal.
- Insert Delphi pick 12094429 to release the secondary lock tab.
Important DO NOT re-use the existing defroster tab on new-style full-size utility vehicles with
moveable glass.
2. Connect the electrical connector to the defroster tab. Fully engage the connector. An improperly
seated connector may cause excessive resistance
and impede the proper operation of the defroster. Add a small bead of solder to mate the electrical
connector tab to the defroster tab.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Heated Glass Element: > 03-08-48-006H > Apr > 11 > A/C - Window Defroster
Contact/Tab Repair Information > Page 10238
3. Prepare the surface of the used defroster tab (not required for new tabs on new-style full-size
utility models) and the defroster buss bar with fine
grain (500 grit) sandpaper or Emery cloth. It is not necessary to remove all of the original solder,
but it should be scuffed sufficiently so that no oxidation is present. The photo above shows a close
up of a properly prepared surface.
Tip You may want to mask the glass around the contact area with tape. This is easy to do and will
allow you to safely prepare the contact surface without the risk of scratching the glass or the black
painted shading.
Important Most rear glass has a black painted masking around the edge of the glass. When
cleaning up the connection surface, be very careful not to damage the surface of the black shading
or the surface of the glass.
4. Wipe the newly prepared contact area with Kent Automotive* Acrysol(TM) (or equivalent) to
remove any residual oil or dirt.
Important
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Heated Glass Element: > 03-08-48-006H > Apr > 11 > A/C - Window Defroster
Contact/Tab Repair Information > Page 10239
You MUST use a silver-bearing solder to make the solder joint. DO NOT attempt this repair with
conventional tin/lead alloy solders. Most suppliers have this type of solder available and it is
available nationally at Radio Shack(R)*. It is sold in several diameters and either are acceptable for
this repair.
5. For this step, it is permitted that two technicians be used if required. Heat the new connector on
the surface of the buss bar that is to be soldered.
Long nose pliers are suggested to hold the electrical connector and the defroster tab in place. Keep
the solder ready and begin flowing out the solder as soon as the melting temperature has been
reached. Tip If a single technician is attempting this repair, it is beneficial to wrap one turn of the
solder around the new contacts base. In this manner, as the melting point of the solder is reached,
a layer is deposited on the bottom side of the contact.
Important Try to align the new contact so that it is positioned with the same orientation as the
original contact.
6. The above illustrates an ideal finished solder joint. Additional stray solder will not harm the
performance of the bond; however, while it is unlikely
that customers may refer to the appearance of the rear window defroster and its components as a
positive styling feature of the vehicle interior, it is easy to elicit the opposite reaction due to a poor
cosmetic application.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Parts Information
Acrysol(TM) can be ordered directly from Kent Automotive at 1-800-654-6333 (in Canada,
1-800-563-1717).
Radio Shack(R) products can be found nationally at retail locations, www.radioshack.com, or at
1-800-843-7422.
All other parts can be ordered through GMSPO or SSPO.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Heated Glass Element: > 03-08-48-006H > Apr > 11 > A/C - Window Defroster
Contact/Tab Repair Information > Page 10240
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
Heated Glass Element: Component Locations
Locations View
In the rear window of the vehicle
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 10243
Heated Glass Element: Connector Locations
Locations View
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Heated Glass Element: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10246
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10247
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10248
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10249
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10250
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10251
Heated Glass Element: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10252
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10253
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10254
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10255
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10256
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10257
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10258
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10259
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10260
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10261
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10262
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10263
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10264
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10265
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10266
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10267
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10268
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10269
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10270
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10271
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10272
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10273
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10274
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10275
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10276
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10277
Heated Glass Element: Connector Views
Rear Window Defogger Grid Connector - Left Hand
Rear Window Defogger Grid Connector - Right Hand
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10278
Defogger Schematics
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Heated Glass Element: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
A Symptoms
IMPORTANT: Review the system operation in order to familiarize yourself with the system
functions. Refer to Rear Window Defogger Description and Operation.
Visual/Physical Inspection ^
Inspect for aftermarket devices which could affect the operation of the Rear Window Defogger
System. Refer to Checking Aftermarket Accessories in Diagrams. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Inspect the easily accessible or visible system components for obvious damage or conditions
which could cause the symptom.
Intermittent Faulty electrical connections or wiring may be the cause of intermittent conditions.
Refer to Testing for Intermittent and Poor Connections in Diagrams.
Symptom List Refer to a symptom diagnostic procedure from the following list in order 10 diagnose
the symptom: ^
Defogger Inoperative - Rear Window
^ Defogger Indicator Always On
^ Defogger Grid Lines Diagnosis
Steps 1-4
Steps 5-7
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 10281
Steps 1-7
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 10282
Steps 8-16
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 10283
Heated Glass Element: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
1. Start the engine. 2. Activate the rear window defogger system. 3. Connect a test lamp to a good
ground.
IMPORTANT: The test lamp brilliance will decrease proportionately to the increased resistance in
the grid line as the probe is moved from the battery positive bus wire to the ground bus wire. The
test lamp brilliance may vary from one window to another.
4. Move the test lamp probe from zone 5 to zone 1 along each grid line.
^ If the test lamp shows full brilliance at both ends of the grid lines. Inspect for an open or poor
connection in the ground circuit of the rear window defogger grid. Refer to Testing for Intermittent
and Poor Connections and Connector Repairs in Diagrams.
^ If the test lamp goes out, test the grid line in at least 2 places ((1) and (3)) to eliminate the
possibility of bridging the open (2) in the grid line.
5. Once the open (2) is located, repair the grid line. Refer to Grid Line Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 10284
Heated Glass Element: Service and Repair
Rear Window Defogger Braided Lead Wire
Caution: Refer to Glass and Sheet Metal Handling Caution in Cautions and Notices.
1. Use a solder containing 3 percent silver and a rosin flux paste in order to solder and attach the
rear defogger bus bar lead wire and/or defogger
terminal.
2. Buff the repair area with a fine steel wool in order to remove the oxide coating that was formed
during window manufacture. 3. Use a brush in order to apply the paste-type rosin flux in small
quantities to the appropriate area:
* The rear defogger bus bar lead wire
* The defogger terminal repair area
Caution: Refer to Window Retention Caution in Cautions and Notices.
Important: Do not hold the tool in one spot or operate the tool on the window for longer than 30-40
seconds.
If the window becomes hot to the touch, allow the window to air cool before proceeding further.
Cooling with water may crack the heated window.
Avoid excessive pressure in order to ensure that the window will not overheat.
4. Coat the solder iron tip with solder. Apply only enough heat to melt the solder and only enough
solder to ensure a complete repair. 5. Apply the solder to the feed bus bar or the ground bus bar.
Draw the soldering iron tip across the fluxed area. Thinly coat the bus bar with solder.
6. Apply a small amount of flux to the appropriate areas:
* The underside of the rear defogger bus bar lead wire
* The defogger terminal
7. Align the spots with the flux to the appropriate areas:
* The underside of the rear defogger bus bar lead wire
* The defogger terminal
8. Coat the tip of the soldering iron with solder. 9. Solder the appropriate areas:
* The underside of the rear defogger bus bar lead wire
* The defogger terminal
10. Draw the iron across the fluxed spot. Thinly coat the spot with solder. 11. Solder the spot on the
braid against the spot on the feed bus bar or the ground bus bar. 12. Use pliers in order to hold the
appropriate component:
* The rear defogger bus bar lead wire
* The defogger terminal
13. Apply heat to the appropriate area in order to ensure the solder spot melts and fuses together:
* The top of the rear defogger bus bar lead wire
* The defogger terminal
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 10285
Important: Do not remove the holding force until the solder has solidified.
14. Remove the excess flux with the solvent. 15. Connect the electrical connector.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > A/C - Broken Rear Window Defogger Grid Detection
Rear Defogger: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Broken Rear Window Defogger Grid Detection
Bulletin No.: 04-08-48-001B
Date: June 28, 2005
INFORMATION
Subject: Rear Window Defogger - Broken Heating Grid Detection Method
Models: 2006 and Prior Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2006
HUMMER H2 2006 HUMMER H3
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2006 model year and additional models. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 04-08-48-001A (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
The addition of vertical grid lines to the heated back window defogger circuits has made it difficult
to detect broken defogger grid lines. In the past, it was a simple matter to use a voltmeter to check
the continuity of each grid line in order to locate a non-functional line. Some new design back
windows have two vertical grid lines that connect all of the horizontal grid lines together, thereby
providing alternate routes for the electrical current to follow. This makes the old test method
ineffective. If the vehicle does not have the vertical lines, the old (line-by-line) test methods can be
used.
Materials Required
^ Permatex(R) Quick Grid, GM P/N 12346001, or equivalent
^ A small ball of fine steel wool Type 00, or
^ Optional - A strip of liquid crystal heat sensitive paper, 51 mm x 305 mm (2 in x 12 in) or similar
size (Contact Edmund Scientific at 800-728-6999 for part number CR30723-70 or go to
www.scientificsonline.com), or
^ Optional-A portable infrared thermometer, GE-46819, available from Kent-Moore
(1-800-345-2233), or equivalent.
Correction
There are three distinct zones across the back window that must be checked. They are:
^ the driver's side outboard of the two vertical lines
^ the passenger side outboard of the two vertical lines
^ the central zone that falls between the two vertical lines
To detect a broken grid line in any of the above three zones and to isolate the exact location of the
break, perform the following steps:
Caution:
^ Approved safety glasses and gloves should be worn when performing this procedure to reduce
the chance of personal injury.
^ Cover the rear shelf area to prevent damage to the interior trim material.
1. Start the engine and turn on the back window defogger.
2. Take the ball of fine steel wool and twist one end to a point. Move the point slowly across each
grid line. Be sure to start at the far side of the zone and move it to the opposite side of the zone.
When you bridge the grid line break with the steel wool, you will see a small spark. Repeat the test
over the same area to be sure you have accurately located the break. Mark the exact location of
the grid line break. Repeat this portion of the test for each grid line. If you do not see a spark at any
point, it is possible that there are two breaks in the same line and zone. Close visual inspection
using a magnifying glass may be the only way to locate breaks in this case.
3. The following are provided as an alternative way to detect a non-functional grid line. If available,
use in addition to the steel wool.
3.1. Method using liquid crystal heat sensitive paper:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > A/C - Broken Rear Window Defogger Grid Detection > Page 10290
Important:
The first part of the test must be completed quickly before the entire surface of the back window
becomes warm.
3.1.1. From outside the vehicle, place the heat sensitive paper (dull surface in contact with the
glass) against the top driver side grid line. Start the
engine and turn on the back window defogger. A distinct color change will take place at each
conductive grid line. Repeat for the bottom grid lines until they have all been checked in the driver
side zone.
3.1.2. Repeat the process for the passenger side and center area zones.
3.1.3. If no color change is noted for a grid line, place a crayon or china marker check mark beside
it. Mark each grid line in the zone where it is
non-conductive and, therefore, not heating up. More than one broken grid line may be found.
3.2. Method using portable infrared thermometer:
3.2.1. Start the engine and turn on the rear back window defogger.
3.2.2. From inside the vehicle, start at the top driver side grid line and slowly run the portable
infrared thermometer vertically down the rear
window contacting each grid line. You should be able to see a district variation in temperature
readings.
3.2.3. Mark each grid line in the zone where it is non-conductive and, therefore, not heating up.
More than one broken grid line may be found.
3.2.4. Repeat the process for the passenger side and center area zones.
4. Use Permatex(R) Quick Grid, GM P/N 12346001, or equivalent, to repair each broken grid line.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions.
5. Wait 24 hours before turning the defogger on, or the repair can be fast cured using a heat gun,
260°C - 371°C (500°F - 700°F). Hold the heat gun within 25 - 51 mm (1-2 in) from the repair point
for 2 to 3 minutes.
6. Recheck the grid line with the heat sensitive paper or portable infrared thermometer to ensure
that the line is now functional and that the repair was successful.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Rear Defogger: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10293
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10294
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10295
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10296
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10297
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10298
Rear Defogger: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10299
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10300
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10301
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10302
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10303
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10304
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10305
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10306
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10307
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10308
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10309
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10310
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10311
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10312
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10313
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10314
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10315
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10316
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10317
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10318
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10319
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10320
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10321
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10322
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10323
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 10324
Rear Defogger: Testing and Inspection
For information regarding this component and the system that it is a part of, please refer to Heated
Glass Element Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Control
Module > Component Information > Diagrams
Power Window Control Module: Diagrams
Rear Window Wiper/Washer Module
Windshield Wiper Motor And Module
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Power Window Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10334
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10335
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10336
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10337
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10338
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10339
Power Window Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10340
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10341
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10342
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10343
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10344
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10345
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10346
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10347
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10348
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10349
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10350
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10351
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10352
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10353
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10354
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10355
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10356
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10357
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10358
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10359
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10360
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10361
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10362
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10363
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10364
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10365
Power Window Switch: Connector Views
Window Master Switch - Driver C1
Window Switch - Front Passenger C1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10366
Window Master Switch - Driver C2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10367
Window Switch - Front Passenger C2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Control Module > Component Information
> Diagrams
Power Window Control Module: Diagrams
Rear Window Wiper/Washer Module
Windshield Wiper Motor And Module
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Front Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Window Motor: Service and Repair
Motor Replacement - Power Window
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the power window regulator. Refer to Window Regulator Replacement (See: Window
Regulator/Front Door Window Regulator/Service
and Repair/Door Window Regulator Replacement (Manual)) .
Caution: Do not attempt to service the regulator motor without releasing the counterbalance spring
tension. The regulator lift arm is under tension from the counterbalance spring and can cause
personal injury if the motor is removed from the regulator.
2. Install a self-tapping, pan head sheet metal screw through the sector gear and the backing plate
at the hole provided. This will lock the sector gear
into position.
3. Drill out the rivets (2) attaching the power window motor to window regulator . 4. Remove the
power window motor from the window regulator (3).
Installation Procedure
1. Install the power window motor to the window regulator (3).
Caution: Do not attempt to service the regulator motor without releasing the counterbalance spring
tension. The regulator lift arm is under tension from the counterbalance spring and can cause
personal injury if the motor is removed from the regulator.
2. Install the rivets (2) attaching the power window motor to window regulator . 3. Remove the
self-tapping, pan head sheet metal screw through the sector gear and the backing plate hole. 4.
Install the power window regulator. Refer to Window Regulator Replacement (See: Window
Regulator/Front Door Window Regulator/Service
and Repair/Door Window Regulator Replacement (Manual)) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Power Window Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Utility/Van Zoning
All grounds, in-line connectors, pass-through grommets, and splices have identifying numbers that
correspond to where they are located in the vehicle. The table explains the numbering system.
Electrical Symbols
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10380
Electrical Symbols Part 1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10381
Electrical Symbols Part 2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10382
Electrical Symbols Part 3
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10383
Electrical Symbols Part 4
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10384
Electrical Symbols Part 5
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10385
Power Window Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures. You
should understand the basic theory of electricity, and know the meaning of voltage (volts), current
(amps), and resistance (ohms). You should also be able to read and understand a wiring diagram,
as well as understand what happens in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire.
Checking Aftermarket Accessories
Do not connect aftermarket accessories into the following circuits:
CAUTION: Refer to SIR Handling Caution in Service Precautions.
^ SIR circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the SIR symbol.
NOTE: Refer to OBD II Symbol Description Notice in Service Precautions.
^ OBD II circuits, all such circuits are indicated on circuit diagrams with the OBD II symbol.
Always check for aftermarket accessories (non-OEM) as the first step in diagnosing electrical
problems. If the vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on
accessories are not the cause of the problems.
Possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
^ Power feeds connected to points other than the battery
^ Antenna location
^ Transceiver wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring
^ Poor shielding or poor connectors on antenna feed line
^ Check for recent service bulletins detailing installation guidelines for aftermarket accessories.
Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
In order to duplicate the customer's concern, it may be necessary to manipulate the wiring harness
if the malfunction appears to be vibration related. Manipulation of a circuit can consist of a wide
variety of actions, including:
^ Wiggling the harness
^ Disconnecting a connector and reconnecting
^ Stressing the mechanical connection of a connector
^ Pulling on the harness or wire in order to identify a separation/break inside the insulation
^ Relocating a harness or wires
All these actions should be performed with some goal in mind. For instance, with a scan tool
connected, wiggling the wires may uncover a faulty input to the control module. The snapshot
option would be appropriate here. Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure. You may need to load
the vehicle in order to duplicate the concern. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
This may require the use of weights, floorjacks, jackstands, frame machines, etc. In these oases
you are attempting to duplicate the concern by manipulating the suspension or frame. This method
is useful in finding harnesses that are too short and their connectors pull apart enough to cause a
poor connection. A DMM set to Peak Min/Max mode and connected to the suspect circuit while
testing can yield desirable results. Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittents. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
Certainly, using the senses of sight, smell, and hearing while manipulating the circuit can provide
good results as well.
There may be instances where circuit manipulation alone will not meet the required criteria for the
fault condition to appear. In such cases it may be necessary to expose the suspect circuit to other
conditions while manipulating the harness. Such conditions would include high moisture conditions,
along with exceptionally high or low temperatures. The following discusses how to expose the
circuit to these kinds of conditions.
Salt Water Spray Some compounds possess the ability to conduct electricity when dissolved in
water such as ordinary salt. By mixing table salt with water in sufficient quantities, you can enhance
the conductive properties of water so that any circuit which may be sensitive to moisture will more
readily fail when liberally sprayed with this mixture.
Mixing 0.35L (12 oz) of water with approximately 1 tablespoon of salt will yield a salt solution of 5
percent. Fill a normal spray bottle with this mixture. This mixture is sufficient to enhance the water's
own conductivity. This may cause the circuit to fail more easily when sprayed. Once the mixture is
completed, spray the suspect area liberally with the solution. Then, while monitoring either a scan
tool or DMM, manipulate the harness as discussed previously.
High Temperature Conditions
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10386
J 25070 Heat Gun
If the complaint tends to be heat related, you can simulate the condition using the J 25070.
Using the heat gun, you can heat up the suspected area or component. Manipulate the harnesses
under high temperature conditions while monitoring the scan tool or DMM to locate the fault
condition.
The high temperature condition may be achieved simply by test driving the vehicle at normal
operating temperature. If a heat gun is unavailable, consider this option to enhance your diagnosis.
This option does not allow for the same control, however.
Low Temperature Conditions Depending on the nature of the fault condition, placing a fan in front
of the vehicle while the vehicle is in the shade can have the desired effect.
If this is unsuccessful, use local cooling treatments such as ice or a venturi type nozzle (one that
provides hot or cold air). This type of tool is capable of producing air stream temperatures down to
-18°C (0°F) from one end and 71°C (160°F) from the other. This is ideally suited for localized
cooling needs.
Once the vehicle, component, or harness has been sufficiently cooled, manipulate the harness or
components in an effort to duplicate the concern.
Measuring Frequency
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the frequency of a signal.
IMPORTANT: Connecting the DMM to the circuit before pressing the Hz button will allow the DMM
to autorange to an appropriate range.
1. Apply power to the circuit. 2. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (AC) position. 3. Connect
the positive lead of the DMM to the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to
a good ground. 5. Press the Hz button on the DMM. 6. The DMM will display the frequency
measured.
Measuring Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure measures the voltage at a selected point in a circuit.
1. Disconnect the electrical harness connector for the circuit being tested, if necessary. 2. Enable
the circuit and/or system being tested. Use the following methods:
^ Turn ON the ignition, with the engine OFF.
^ Turn ON the engine.
^ Turn ON the circuit and/or system with a scan tool in Output Controls.
^ Turn ON the switch for the circuit and/or system being tested.
3. Select the V (AC) or V (DC) position on the DMM. 4. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to the
point of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6. The
DMM displays the voltage measured at that point.
Measuring Voltage Drop
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure determines the difference in voltage potential between 2 points.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10387
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 point of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to the other point of the
circuit. 4. Operate the circuit. 5. The DMM displays the difference in voltage between the 2 points.
Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Snapshot is a recording of what a control module on the vehicle was receiving for information while
the snapshot is being made. A snapshot may be used to analyze the data during the time a vehicle
condition is current. This allows you to concentrate on making the condition occur, rather than
trying to view all the data in anticipation of the fault. The snapshot contains information around a
trigger point that you have determined.
Only a single data list may be recorded in each snapshot. The Scan Tool has the ability to store 2
snapshots. The ability to record 2 snapshots allows comparing hot versus cold and good versus
bad vehicle scenarios. The snapshots are stored on a 'first in, first out' basis. If a third snapshot is
taken, the first snapshot stored in the memory will be lost.
Snapshots can be 1 of 2 types:
^ Snapshot - taken from the Snapshot menu choice
^ Quick Snapshot - taken from the Data Display soft key choice, does not contain DTC information
When a snapshot is taken, it is recorded on the memory card and may contain as many as 1200
frames of information. Because the snapshot is recorded onto the memory card, snapshots are not
lost if the Scan Tool is powered down.
The snapshot replay screen has a plot soft key that can be of great value for intermittent diagnosis.
The snapshot plot feature can help you to quickly determine if a sensor is outside of its expected
values by plotting three parameters at a time. The data will be displayed both graphically and
numerically showing the minimum and maximum values for all frames captured. This is helpful,
especially if the fault occurs only once and does not set a DTC.
Testing For a Short To Voltage
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedure tests for a short to voltage in a circuit.
1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the V (DC) position. 2. Connect the positive lead of the DMM to
1 end of the circuit to be tested. 3. Connect the negative lead of the DMM to a good ground. 4.
Turn ON the ignition and operate all accessories. 5. If the voltage measured is greater than 1 volt,
there is a short to voltage in the circuit.
Testing for Continuity
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures verify good continuity in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 2. Disconnect the power feed
(i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 3. Disconnect the load. 4. Press the MIN MAX
button on the DMM. 5. Connect one lead of the DMM to one end of the circuit to be tested. 6.
Connect the other lead of the DMM to the other end of the circuit.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10388
7. If the DMM displays low or no resistance and a tone is heard, the circuit has good continuity.
With a Test Lamp
IMPORTANT: Only use the test lamp procedure on low impedance power and ground circuits.
1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2. Disconnect the
load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 4. Connect the other
lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 5. Connect the other end of the circuit to ground. 6.
If the test lamp illuminates (full intensity), then the circuit has good continuity.
Testing For Electrical Intermittents
Perform the following procedures while wiggling the harness from side to side. Continue this at
convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the test equipment.
^ Testing for Short to Ground See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For Short to Ground
^ Testing for Continuity See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing for
Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Voltage See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Testing For a Short To Voltage
If the fault is not identified, perform the procedure below using the MIN MAX feature on the J 39200
DMM. This feature allows you to manipulate the circuit without having to watch the J 39200. The J
39200 will generate an audible tone when a change is detected.
IMPORTANT: The J 39200 must be used in order to perform the following procedure since the J
39200 can monitor current, resistance or voltage while recording the minimum (MIN), and
maximum (MAX) values measured.
1. Connect the J 39200 to both sides of a suspected connector (still connected), or from one end of
a suspected circuit to the other. Refer to
Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter for information on connecting the J 39200 to the circuit.
See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Troubleshooting With A
Digital Multimeter
2. Set the rotary dial of the J 39200 to the V (AC) or V (DC) position. 3. Press the range button of
the J 39200 in order to select the desired voltage range. 4. Press the MIN MAX button of the J
39200. The J 39200 displays 100 ms RECORD and emits an audible tone (beep).
IMPORTANT: The 100 ms RECORD mode is the length of time an input must stay at a new value
in order to record the full change.
5. Simulate the condition that is potentially causing the intermittent connection, either by wiggling
the connections or the wiring, test driving, or
performing other operations. Refer to Inducing an Intermittent Fault Condition. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
6. Listen for the audible Min Max Alert which indicates that a new minimum or maximum value has
been recorded. 7. Press the MIN MAX button once in order to display the MAX value and note the
value. 8. Press the MIN MAX button again in order to display the MIN value and note the value. 9.
Determine the difference between the MIN and MAX values.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is 1 volt or greater an
intermittent open or high resistance condition exists. Repair the condition as necessary.
^ If the variation between the recorded MIN and MAX voltage values is less than 1 volt an
intermittent open or high resistance condition does not exist.
Testing For Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent conditions are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Inspect for the
following items:
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation
^ Poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector-Refer to Testing for
Proper Terminal Contact for the specific procedure. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Circuit Testing/Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
^ Poor terminal to wire connection-Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over the wire insulation rather than the wire itself and corrosion
in the wire to terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through- This causes an intermittent short as the bare area
touches other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Refer to Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions in order to duplicate the conditions required in
order to verify the complaint. See: General Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit
Testing/Inducing Intermittent Fault Conditions
^ Refer to Testing for Electrical Intermittent for test procedures to detect intermittent open, high
resistance, short to ground, and short to voltage conditions. See: Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids
^ Refer to Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure for advanced intermittent diagnosis. See: General
Electrical Diagnostic Procedures/Circuit Testing/Scan Tool Snapshot Procedure
Testing For Proper Terminal Contact
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 42675 flatware Probe Adapter
^ J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10389
It is important to test terminal contact at the component and any on-line connectors before
replacing a suspect component. Mating terminals must be inspected to ensure good terminal
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination may be caused by the connector halves being improperly connected. A missing or
damaged connector seal, damage to the connector itself, or exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt can also cause contamination. Contamination usually in the underhood or underbody
connectors, leads to terminal corrosion, causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves, or repeatedly separating and joining the
connector halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor
terminal contact causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Round Wire Connectors Follow the procedure below to test terminal contact of Metri-Pack or 56
series terminals. Refer to the J 38125-B or the J 38125-4 for terminal identification.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. 2.
Visually inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination may result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or
between terminals. This causes high terminal resistance, intermittent contact, or an open circuit. An
underhood or underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its
entirety: terminals, seals, and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the J 38125-B, test that the retention force is significantly
different between a good terminal and a suspect
terminal. Replace the female terminal in question.
Flat Wire (Dock and Lock) Connectors There are no serviceable parts for flat wire (dock and lock)
connectors on the harness side or the component side.
Follow the procedure below in order to test terminal contact. 1. Remove the component in question.
2. Visually inspect each side of the connector for signs of contamination. Avoid touching either side
of the connector as oil from your skin may be a
source of contamination as well.
3. Visually inspect the terminal bearing surfaces of the flat wire circuits for splits, cracks, or other
imperfections that could cause poor terminal
contact. Visually inspect the component side connector to ensure that all of the terminals are
uniform and free of damage or deformation.
4. Insert the appropriate adapter from the J 42675 on the flat wire harness connector in order to
test the circuit in question.
Testing For Short to Ground
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
The following procedures test for a short to ground in a circuit.
With a DMM 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Set the rotary dial of the DMM to the Ohm position. 4. Connect 1 lead of the
DMM to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. Connect the other lead of the DMM to a good ground. 6.
If the DMM does NOT display infinite resistance (OL), there is a short to ground in the circuit.
With a Test Lamp 1. Remove the power feed (i.e. fuse, control module) from the suspect circuit. 2.
Disconnect the load. 3. Connect 1 lead of the test lamp to battery positive voltage. 4. Connect the
other lead of the test lamp to 1 end of the circuit to be tested. 5. If the test lamp illuminates, there is
a short to ground in the circuit.
Fuse Powering Several Loads 1. Review the system schematic and locate the fuse that is open. 2.
Open the first connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Connect a DMM across
the fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered).
^ When the DMM displays voltage the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch.
^ If the DMM does not display voltage refer to the next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the DMM displays voltage in order to find which circuit is
shorted.
Circuit Testing
The Circuit Testing contains the following diagnostic testing information. Using this information
along with the diagnostic procedures will identify the cause of the electrical malfunction.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10390
^ Using Connector Test Adapters
^ Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Troubleshooting with a Digital Multimeter
^ Troubleshooting with a Test Lamp
^ Using Fused Jumper Wires
^ Measuring Voltage
^ Measuring Voltage Drop
^ Measuring Frequency
^ Testing for Continuity
^ Testing for Short to Ground
^ Testing for a Short to Voltage
Probing Electrical Connectors
IMPORTANT: Always be sure to reinstall the connector position assurance (CPA) and terminal
position assurance (TPA) when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals.
Frontprobe Disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the mating side (front) of the
connector.
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Backprobe
IMPORTANT: ^
Backprobe connector terminals only when specifically required in diagnostic procedures.
^ Do not backprobe a sealed (Weather Pack(R)) connector, less than a 280 series Metri-Pack
connector, a Micro-Pack connector, or a flat wire (dock and lock) connector.
^ Backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals. Use care in order to avoid
deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by using too large
of a test probe.
^ After backprobing any connector, inspect for terminal damage. If terminal damage is suspected,
test for proper terminal contact.
Do not disconnect the connector and probe the terminals from the harness side (back) of the
connector.
Troubleshooting With A Digital Multimeter
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
IMPORTANT: Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the PCM, should only
be tested with a 10 megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter such as the J 39200.
The J 39200 is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly upon receipt of the
DMM as well as kept on hand for future reference.
A DMM should be used instead of a test lamp in order to test for voltage in high impedance circuits.
While a test lamp shows whether voltage is present, a DMM indicates how much voltage is
present.
The ohmmeter function on a DMM shows how much resistance exists between 2 points along a
circuit. Low resistance in a circuit means good continuity.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the power feed from the suspect circuit when measuring resistance with
a DMM. This prevents incorrect readings. DMMs apply such a small voltage to measure resistance
that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause a DMM to display a false reading. To find
out if a component is affecting a measurement take a reading once, then reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the DMM to the circuit to be tested:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while you perform other
operations or test driving. Refer to Probing Electrical Connectors. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Troubleshooting Tools/Probing Electrical Connectors
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspected circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ If the system that is being diagnosed has a specified pinout or breakout box, it may be used in
order to simplify connecting the DMM to the circuit or for testing multiple circuits quickly.
Troubleshooting With A Test Lamp
TOOLS REQUIRED
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10391
J 34142-B 12 V Unpowered Test Lamp
NOTE: Refer to Test Probe Notice in Service Precautions.
A test lamp can simply and quickly test a low impedance circuit for voltage.
The J 34142-B is Micro-Pack compatible and comprised of a 12-volt light bulb with an attached pair
of leads.
To properly operate this tool use the following procedure.
1. Attach one lead to ground. 2. Touch the other lead to various points along the circuit where
voltage should be present. 3. When the bulb illuminates, there is voltage at the point being tested.
Using Connector Test Adapters
NOTE: Do not insert test equipment probes into any connector or fuse block terminal. The diameter
of the test probes will deform most terminals. A deformed terminal can cause a poor connection,
which can result in system failures. Always use the J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit or the J
42675 Flat Wire Probe Adapter kit in order to frontprobe terminals. Do not use paper clips or other
substitutes as they can damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Using Fused Jumper Wires
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 36169-A Fused Jumper Wire
IMPORTANT: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
The J 36169-A includes small clamp connectors that provide adaptation to most connectors without
damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20-A fuse which may not be suitable for some
circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the circuit being tested.
Fuses
Circuit Protection - Fuses
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10392
Fuse Types
The fuse is the most common method of an automotive wiring circuit protection. Whenever there is
an excessive amount of current flowing through a circuit the fusible element will melt and create an
open or incomplete circuit. Fuses are an one time protection device and must be replaced each
time the circuit is overloaded. To determine if a fuse is open, remove the suspected fuse and
examine the element in the fuse for an open (break). If not broken, also check for continuity using a
DMM or a continuity tester. If the element is open or continuity is suspect, replace the fuse with one
of equal current rating.
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device that is designed to open the circuit when a current load is in
excess of the rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the
circuit, the excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. Two types
of circuit breakers are used.
Circuit Breaker: This type opens when excessive current passes through it for a period of time. It
closes again after a few seconds, and if the cause of the high current is still present, it will open
again. The circuit breaker will continue to cycle open and closed until the condition causing the high
current is removed.
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) Circuit Breaker: This type greatly increases its resistance
when excessive current passes through it. The excessive current heats the PTC device, as the
device heats its resistance increases. Eventually the resistance gets so high that the circuit is
effectively open. Unlike the ordinary circuit breaker the PTC unit will not reset until the circuit is
opened, by removing the voltage from its terminals. Once the voltage is removed the circuit breaker
will re-close within a second or 2.
Fusible Links
Fusible link is wire designed to melt and break continuity when excessive current is applied. It is
often located between or near the battery and starter or electrical center. Use a continuity tester or
a DMM at each end of the wire containing the fusible link in order to determine if it is broken. If
broken, it must be replaced with fusible link of the same gage size.
Repairing a Fusible Link
IMPORTANT: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approximately 9 in) will not provide sufficient
overload protection.
Refer to Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips. See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
General Information
The Connector Repairs contains the following types of connector repair information. Using these
elements together will make connector repair faster and easier:
^ Connector Position Assurance Locks
^ Terminal Position Assurance Locks
^ Push to Seat Connectors
^ Pull to Seat Connectors
^ Weather Pack Connectors
^ Repairing Connector Terminals
Connector Position Assurance Locks
The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic insert that fits through the locking tabs of
all the SIR system electrical connectors. The CPA
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10393
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR mating terminals.
Pull to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair pull-to-seat connectors.
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves. 3. Using the proper pick or
removal tool insert into the front of the connector body. 4. Grasp the wire at the back of the
connector body and gently pull the terminal (1) from the connector body (3). 5. Inspect the terminal
for damage, if damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 6. Reform the locking tang (2) if the terminal is
being reused.
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
TERMINAL INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the terminal for damage. If damaged refer to Terminal Repair. 2. Reform the locking tang
(2) if the terminal is being reused. 3. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the
splice. 4. Insert the wire into the back of the connector body. Push until the terminal locking tang
locks into the connector body. 5. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Push to Seat Connectors
TERMINAL REMOVAL
Follow the steps below in order to repair push to seat connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10394
1. Remove the terminal position assurance (TPA) device, the connector position assurance (CPA)
device, and/or the secondary lock. 2. Separate the connector halves (1).
3. Use the proper pick or removal tool (1) in order to release the terminal. 4. Gently pull the cable
and the terminal (2) out of the back of the connector.
5. Re-form the locking device if you are going to reuse the terminal (1). 6. To repair the terminal,
refer to Terminal Repair.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10395
TERMINAL REPAIR
1. Slip the cable seal away from the terminal. 2. Cut the wire as close to the terminal as possible. 3.
Slip a new cable seal onto the wire. 4. Strip 5 mm (3/16 in) of insulation from the wire. 5. Crimp a
new terminal to the wire. 6. Solder the crimp with rosin core solder. 7. Slide the cable seal toward
the terminal. 8. Crimp the cable seal and the insulation. 9. If the connector is outside of the
passenger compartment, apply grease to the connector.
REINSTALLING TERMINAL
1. In order to reuse a terminal or lead assembly. Refer to Wiring Repairs. See:
Diagrams/Diagnostic Aids 2. Ensure that the cable seal is kept on the terminal side of the splice. 3.
Insert the lead from the back until it catches. 4. Install the TPA, CPA and/or the secondary locks.
Repairing Connector Terminals
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
Use the following repair procedures in order to repair the following.
^ Push to Seat terminals
^ Pull to Seat terminals
^ Weather Pack(R) terminals
Some terminals do not require all of the steps shown. Skip the steps that do not apply for your
immediate terminal repair. The J 38125-B contains further information.
1. Cut off the terminal between the core and the insulation crimp. Minimize any wire loss.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, remove the seal.
2. Apply the correct seal per gage size of the wire.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, slide the seal back along the wire in order to enable insulation
removal.
3. Remove the insulation. 4. For Weather Pack(R) terminals only, align the seal with the end of the
cable insulation. 5. Position the strip in the terminal
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, position the strip and seal in the terminal.
6. Hand crimp the core wings. 7. Hand crimp the insulation wings.
For Weather Pack(R) terminals, hand crimp the insulation wings around the seal and the cable.
8. Solder all of the hand crimp terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance Locks
The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the plastic combs used in the control
module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated in the connector body. Do not
remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a terminal for replacement.
Weather Pack Connectors
The following is the proper procedure for the repair of Weather Pack(R) Connectors.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10396
1. Separate the connector halves (1). 2. Open the secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in
terminal retention and is usually molded to the connector (1). 3. Grasp the wire and push the
terminal to the forward most position. Hold the wire in this position.
4. Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the connector
cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder (1). 5. Gently pull on the wire to remove the terminal
through the back of the connector (2).
IMPORTANT: Never use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
6. Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary. Refer to Repairing
Connector Terminals See: General Electrical Diagnostic
Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Connector Repairs/Repairing Connector Terminals
7. Reform the lock tang (2) and reset terminal in connector body. 8. Close secondary locks and join
connector halves. 9. Verify that circuit is complete and working satisfactorily.
10. Perform system check.
General Information
The Wiring Repairs contains the following types of wiring repair information. Using these elements
together will make wiring repair faster and easier:
^ Circuit Protection - Fuses
^ Circuit Protection - Circuit Breakers
^ Circuit Protection - Fusible Links
^ Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
^ Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
^ Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
^ Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
^ Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
^ SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10397
^ Flat Wire Repairs
Repairing Damaged Wire Insulation
If the conductive portion of the wire is not damaged, locate the problem and apply tape around the
wire. If the damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of the wire. Refer to Splicing
Copper Wire Using Splice Clips and follow the instruction to repair the wire. See: General Electrical
Diagnostic Procedures/Wiring Repairs/Typical Electrical Repairs/Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice
Clips
SIR/SRS Connector (Plastic Body and Terminal Metal Pin) Repair
Use the connector repair assembly packs in order to repair the damaged SIR/SRS wire harness
connectors and the terminals. Do not use the connector repair assembly pack in order to repair the
pigtails. These kits include an instruction sheet and the sealed splices.
Use the sealed splices in order to splice the new wires, connectors, and terminals to the harness.
The splice crimping tool is color keyed in order to match the splices from the J 38125-B. You must
use the splice crimping tool in order to apply these splices.
The terminals in the SIR/SRS system are made of a special metal. This metal provides the
necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low energy circuits. These terminals are only available
in the connector repair assembly packs. Do not substitute any other terminals for those in the
assembly packs.
If the individual terminals are damaged on the sensing and diagnostic module (SDM) harness
connector, use 1 of the following 2 components in order to replace the SDM harness connector:
^ The SDM harness connector pigtail assembly
^ The SDM harness connector replacement kit
If the individual terminals are damaged on any other SIR/SRS connection, use the appropriate
connector repair assembly pack in order to replace the entire connection. Replace the entire
SIR/SRS wiring harness, if needed, in order to maintain Restraint Systems/SRS circuit integrity.
SIR/SRS System Wire Splice Repair
Apply a new splice (not sealed) from the J 38125-B if damage occurs to any of the original
equipment splices (3 wires or more) in the SIR/SRS wiring harness. Carefully follow the instructions
included in the kit for proper splice clip application.
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) The connector position assurance (CPA) is a small plastic
insert that fits through the locking tabs of all the SIR/SRS system electrical connectors. The CPA
ensures that the connector halves cannot vibrate apart. You must have the CPA in place in order to
ensure good contact between the SIR/SRS mating terminals.
Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) The terminal position assurance (TPA) insert resembles the
plastic combs used in the control module connectors. The TPA keeps the terminal securely seated
in the connector body. Do not remove the TPA from the connector body unless you remove a
terminal for replacement.
SIR/SRS Wire Pigtail Repair
IMPORTANT: Do not make wire, connector, or terminal repairs on components with wire pigtails.
A wire pigtail is a wire or wires attached directly to the device (not by a connector). If a wiring pigtail
is damaged, you must replace the entire component (with pigtail). The inflatable restraint steering
wheel module coil is an example of a pigtail component.
SIR/SRS Wire Repair
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
IMPORTANT: Refer to Wiring Repairs in order to determine the correct wire size for the circuit you
are repairing. You must obtain this information in order to ensure circuit integrity.
If any wire except the pigtail is damaged, repair the wire by splicing in a new section of wire of the
same gage size (0.5 mm, 0.8 mm, 1.0 mm etc.).
Use the sealed splices and splice crimping tool from the J 38125-8. Use the following wiring repair
procedures in order to ensure the integrity of the sealed splice.
IMPORTANT: You must perform the following procedures in the listed order. Repeat the procedure
if any wire strands are damaged. You must obtain a clean strip with all of the wire strands intact.
1. Open the harness by removing any tape:
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10398
^ Use a sewing seam ripper (available from sewing supply stores) in order to cut open the harness
in order to avoid wire insulation damage.
^ Use the crimp and sealed splice sleeves on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial.
^ Do not use the crimp and sealed splice sleeve to form a splice with more than 2 wires coming
together.
2. Cut as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra length of wire in order to
change the location of a splice.
Adjust splice locations so that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from the other splices,
harness branches, or connectors.
3. Strip the insulation:
^ When adding a length of wire to the existing harness, use the same size wire as the original wire.
^ Perform one of the following items in order to find the correct wire size: Find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the equivalent AWG size.
- Use an AWG wire gage.
- If you are unsure of the wire size, begin with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work
down until achieving a clean strip of the insulation.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (0.313 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
^ Do not nick or cut any of the strands. Inspect the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands.
^ If the wire is damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
4. Select the proper sealed splice sleeve according to the wire size. Refer to the table at the
beginning of the repair procedure for the color coding of
the splice sleeves and the crimp tool nests.
5. Use the Splice Crimp Tool from the J 38125-B in order to position the splice sleeve in the proper
color nest of the Splice Crimp Tool.
6. Place the splice sleeve in the nest. Ensure that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop. The sleeve has a stop (3) in the
middle of the barrel (2) in order to prevent the wire (1) from going further. Close the hand crimper
handles slightly in order to firmly hold the splice sleeve in the proper nest.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10399
7. Insert the wire into the splice sleeve barrel until the wire hits the barrel stop. 8. Tightly close the
handles of the crimp tool until the crimper handles open when released.
The crimper handles will not open until you apply the proper amount of pressure to the splice
sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice.
9. Using the heat torch, apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
10. Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing:
^ The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
^ A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10400
Wire Size Conversion
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original (except fusible link).
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating. Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced.
5. Select the proper clip to secure the splice. Follow the instructions in the J 38125-B in order to
determine the proper clip size crimp tool and anvil. 6. Overlap the 2 stripped wire ends and hold
them between thumb and forefinger.
7. Center the splice clip (2) over the stripped wires (1) and hold the clip in place.
^ Ensure that the wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
^ Ensure that no insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10401
8. Center the crimp tool over the splice clip and wires. 9. Apply steady pressure until the crimp tool
closes.
Ensure that no strands of wire are cut.
10. Crimp the splice on each end (2).
11. Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for the solder equipment.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10402
12. Tape the splice. Roll on enough tape in order to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the
existing wires.
13. Additional tape can be applied to the wire if the wire does not belong in a conduit or another
harness covering. Use a winding motion in order to
cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Sleeves
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
Use crimp and seal splice sleeves to form a one-to-one splice on all types of insulation except
tefzel and coaxial to form a one-to-one splice. Use tefzel and coaxial where there is special
requirements such as moisture sealing. Follow the instructions below in order to splice copper wire
using crimp and seal splice sleeves.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the desired wire.
2. Cut the wire.
^ Cut as little wire off the harness as possible.
^ Ensure that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other splices, harness branches and
connectors. This helps prevent moisture from
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10403
bridging adjacent splices and causing damage.
3. Select the proper size and type of wire.
^ The wire must be of equal or greater size than the original.
^ The wire's insulation must have the same or higher temperature rating (4). Use general purpose insulation for areas that are not subject to high temperatures.
- Use a cross-linked polyethylene insulated wire for areas where high temperatures are expected.
IMPORTANT: Use cross-linked polyethylene wire to replace PVC, but do not replace cross-linked
polyethylene with PVC.
Cross-linked polyethylene wire is not fuel resistant. Do not use to replace wire where there is the
possibility of fuel contact.
4. Strip the insulation.
^ Select the correct size opening in the wire stripper or work down from the largest size.
^ Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be spliced (1).
5. Select the proper splice sleeve (2) and the required crimp nest tool, refer to the Crimp and Seal
Splice Table. 6. Place the nest tool in the J 38125-B crimp tool. 7. Place the splice sleeve in the
crimp tool nest so that the crimp falls at point 1 on the splice. 8. Close the hand crimper handles
slightly in order to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper crimp tool nest. 9. Insert the wires into
the splice sleeve until the wire hits the barrel stop. The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the
barrel in order to prevent
the wire from passing through the splice (3).
10. Close the handles of the J 38125-B until the crimper handles open when released. The crimper
handles will not open until the proper amount of
pressure is applied to the splice sleeve.
11. Shrink the insulation around the splice.
^ Using the heat torch apply heat to the crimped area of the barrel.
^ Gradually move the heat barrel to the open end of the tubing. The tubing will shrink completely as the heat is moved along the insulation.
- A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient shrinkage is
achieved.
Splicing Twisted or Shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is used in order to protect wiring from electrical noise. Two-conductor cable
of this construction is used between the radio and the Delco-Bose(R) speaker/amplifier units and
other applications where low level, sensitive signals must be carried. Follow the instructions below
in order to repair the twisted/shielded cable.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10404
1. Remove the outer jacket (1). Use care not to cut into the drain wire of the mylar tape. 2. Unwrap
the tape. Do not remove the tape. Use the tape in order to rewrap the twisted conductors after the
splice is made.
3. Prepare the splice. Untwist the conductors and follow the splicing instructions for copper wire.
Staggering the splices by 65 mm is recommended.
IMPORTANT: Apply the mylar tape with the aluminum side inward. This ensures good electrical
contact with the drain wire.
4. Re-assemble the cable.
^ Rewrap the conductors with the mylar tape.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10405
^ Use caution not to wrap the drain wire in the tape (1).
^ Follow the splicing instructions for copper wire and splice the drain wire.
^ Wrap the drain wire around the conductors and tape with mylar tape.
5. Tape over the entire cable. Use a winding motion when you apply the tape.
Splicing Inline Harness Diodes
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode use the following procedure.
1. Open the harness.
^ If the harness is taped, remove the tape.
^ To avoid wiring insulation damage, use a sewing ripper in order to cut open the harness.
^ If the harness has a black plastic conduit, pull out the diode.
2. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 3. Check and record the current flow
direction and orientation of diode. 4. Remove the inoperative diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool.
IMPORTANT: If the diode is located next to a connector terminal remove the terminal(s) from the
connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
5. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is needed to attach the
new diode.
6. Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with correct bias.
Reference the appropriate wiring schematic to
obtain the correct diode installation position.
7. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Before soldering attach some
heat sinks (aluminum alligator clips) across the
diode wire ends to protect the diode from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instruction for
the soldering equipment.
8. Reinstall terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed.
IMPORTANT: To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire
and diode attachment points with tape.
9. Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair Kit
NOTE: Do not solder repairs under any circumstances as this could result in the air reference being
obstructed.
If the heated oxygen sensor pigtail wiring, connector, or terminal is damaged the entire oxygen
sensor assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector, or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly it must have a clean air reference. This clean air reference
is obtained by way of the oxygen sensor signal and heater wires.
Any attempt to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air
reference and degrade oxygen sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the heated oxygen sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor, causing poor performance. Also, the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10406
path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor nor vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the oxygen sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wire sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor. Removal
of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The engine harness may be repaired using the J 38125-B.
SIR/SRS Wiring Repairs
TOOLS REQUIRED
J 38125-B Terminal Repair kit
The supplemental inflatable restraint (SIR) system/supplemental restraint system (SRS) requires
special wiring repair procedures due to the sensitive nature of the circuitry. Follow the specific
procedures and instructions when working with the SIR/SRS system wiring, and the wiring
components (such as connectors and terminals).
IMPORTANT: Do not use the terminals in the kit in order to replace damaged SIR/SRS system
terminals unless specifically indicated by the terminal package.
The tool kit J 38125-B contains the following items:
^ Special sealed splices - in order to repair the SIR/SRS system wiring
^ A wire stripping tool
^ A special crimping toot
^ A heat torch
The sealed splices have the following 2 critical features:
^ A special heat shrink sleeve environmentally seals the splice. The heat shrink sleeve contains a
sealing adhesive inside.
^ A cross hatched (knurled) core crimp provides necessary contact integrity for the sensitive, low
energy circuits.
The J 38125-B also serves as a generic terminal repair kit. The kit contains the following items:
^ A large sampling of common electrical terminals
^ The correct tools in order to attach the terminals to the wires
^ The correct tools in order to remove the terminals from the connectors
Flat Wire Repairs
NOTE: The flat wire within the flex wiring harness is not serviceable. If an open or short exists
within the flex wiring harness the complete harness must be replaced.
Equivalents - Decimal And Metric
Equivalents - Decimal and Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10407
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10408
Arrows and Symbols
Arrows and Symbols
This service manual uses various symbols in order to describe different service operations.
Arrows and Symbols
1 - Front of Vehicle 2 - View Detail 2 - View Detail 3 - Ambient Air Mixed With Another Gas or
Indicate Temperature Change 4 - Motion or Direction 5 - View Angle 6 - Dimension (1:2) 7 Ambient/Clean Air Flow or Cool Air Flow 8 - Lubrication Point - Oil or Fluid 9 - Task Related 10 Sectioning (1:3) 11 - Gas Other Than Ambient Air or Hot Air Flow 12 - Lubrication Point - Grease or
Jelly 13 - Multidirectional Arrow
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10409
Conversion - English/Metric
Conversion - English/Metric
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10410
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10411
Power Window Switch: Connector Views
Window Master Switch - Driver C1
Window Switch - Front Passenger C1
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10412
Window Master Switch - Driver C2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10413
Window Switch - Front Passenger C2
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Back Window Glass > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 03-08-48-006H > Apr > 11 > A/C - Window Defroster
Contact/Tab Repair Information
Back Window Glass: Customer Interest A/C - Window Defroster Contact/Tab Repair Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 03-08-48-006H
Date: April 11, 2011
Subject: Repair Information for Reconnection of Rear Window Defroster Contact or Tab
Models:
2000-2012 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2003-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2010 HUMMER H3
2005-2009 Saab 9-7X 2007-2010 Opel GT 2007-2008 Daewoo G2X Equipped With Electric Rear
Window Defroster - RPO C49
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2012 model year. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 03-08-48-006G (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Repair Suggestions
Soldering Defroster Contact Tabs
In many cases the terminal tab will still be in the connector when you examine the vehicle. For
Chevrolet Tahoe, Suburban, GMC Yukon, and Cadillac Escalade vehicles (with moveable glass),
always replace the defroster tab (GM P/N 25916031) and the defroster electrical power connector
(P/N 12034110). For all other vehicles, reconnect the original defroster tab.
In most applications it is preferable to create a new solder connection to reattach a separated rear
defroster tab. If you take note of the steps below, it is possible to create a new solder joint that is
equal to, or stronger than, the original. The generic procedure below is not very time intensive, but
does include minor preparation work to create a good bonding surface. Be sure to follow each of
the steps, as combined they will produce the strongest bond possible. Please consider the
following before attempting the repair:
- Soldering introduces significant heat to the glass window of the vehicle. When performing the
re-connection of the tab, use only the heat required to do the job. Pre-heat the soldering iron and
have the solder in your other hand, ready to go, the moment you have enough heat to melt the
solder.
- If it is winter, bring the vehicle into the service garage and remove any snow from the back
window area. Allow time for the glass to warm to the temperature inside the building. Soldering
creates a "hot spot" in the glass. DO NOT solder on cold glass.
Caution Heating the glass excessively, or repeatedly without time to cool, may result in glass
breakage. ALWAYS wear safety glasses when performing this repair!
- You MUST use a silver-bearing solder to make the connection. DO NOT attempt this repair with
conventional tin/lead alloy solders. Silver bearing solder will adhere to the electrical buss bar,
making a strong and lasting repair.
- Protect surfaces under the area to be soldered. It is very easy to drip solder when performing this
repair. Placing a shop towel under the soldering area is sufficient protection.
Soldering Procedure
1. It is imperative to remove and replace the rear defroster electrical power connector by crimping a
new connector to the feed wire. The proper
connector P/N 12034110 can be found in the Packard Electrical Assortment, Tray 18, Position 5.
- Insert Delphi pick 12094430 to depress the locking tab on the terminal.
- Insert Delphi pick 12094429 to release the secondary lock tab.
Important DO NOT re-use the existing defroster tab on new-style full-size utility vehicles with
moveable glass.
2. Connect the electrical connector to the defroster tab. Fully engage the connector. An improperly
seated connector may cause excessive resistance
and impede the proper operation of the defroster. Add a small bead of solder to mate the electrical
connector tab to the defroster tab.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Back Window Glass > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 03-08-48-006H > Apr > 11 > A/C - Window Defroster
Contact/Tab Repair Information > Page 10423
3. Prepare the surface of the used defroster tab (not required for new tabs on new-style full-size
utility models) and the defroster buss bar with fine
grain (500 grit) sandpaper or Emery cloth. It is not necessary to remove all of the original solder,
but it should be scuffed sufficiently so that no oxidation is present. The photo above shows a close
up of a properly prepared surface.
Tip You may want to mask the glass around the contact area with tape. This is easy to do and will
allow you to safely prepare the contact surface without the risk of scratching the glass or the black
painted shading.
Important Most rear glass has a black painted masking around the edge of the glass. When
cleaning up the connection surface, be very careful not to damage the surface of the black shading
or the surface of the glass.
4. Wipe the newly prepared contact area with Kent Automotive* Acrysol(TM) (or equivalent) to
remove any residual oil or dirt.
Important
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Back Window Glass > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 03-08-48-006H > Apr > 11 > A/C - Window Defroster
Contact/Tab Repair Information > Page 10424
You MUST use a silver-bearing solder to make the solder joint. DO NOT attempt this repair with
conventional tin/lead alloy solders. Most suppliers have this type of solder available and it is
available nationally at Radio Shack(R)*. It is sold in several diameters and either are acceptable for
this repair.
5. For this step, it is permitted that two technicians be used if required. Heat the new connector on
the surface of the buss bar that is to be soldered.
Long nose pliers are suggested to hold the electrical connector and the defroster tab in place. Keep
the solder ready and begin flowing out the solder as soon as the melting temperature has been
reached. Tip If a single technician is attempting this repair, it is beneficial to wrap one turn of the
solder around the new contacts base. In this manner, as the melting point of the solder is reached,
a layer is deposited on the bottom side of the contact.
Important Try to align the new contact so that it is positioned with the same orientation as the
original contact.
6. The above illustrates an ideal finished solder joint. Additional stray solder will not harm the
performance of the bond; however, while it is unlikely
that customers may refer to the appearance of the rear window defroster and its components as a
positive styling feature of the vehicle interior, it is easy to elicit the opposite reaction due to a poor
cosmetic application.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Parts Information
Acrysol(TM) can be ordered directly from Kent Automotive at 1-800-654-6333 (in Canada,
1-800-563-1717).
Radio Shack(R) products can be found nationally at retail locations, www.radioshack.com, or at
1-800-843-7422.
All other parts can be ordered through GMSPO or SSPO.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Back Window Glass > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 03-08-48-006H > Apr > 11 > A/C - Window Defroster
Contact/Tab Repair Information > Page 10425
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Back Window Glass > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Back Window Glass: > 03-08-48-006H > Apr >
11 > A/C - Window Defroster Contact/Tab Repair Information
Back Window Glass: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Window Defroster Contact/Tab Repair
Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 03-08-48-006H
Date: April 11, 2011
Subject: Repair Information for Reconnection of Rear Window Defroster Contact or Tab
Models:
2000-2012 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2003-2009 HUMMER H2 2006-2010 HUMMER H3
2005-2009 Saab 9-7X 2007-2010 Opel GT 2007-2008 Daewoo G2X Equipped With Electric Rear
Window Defroster - RPO C49
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2012 model year. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 03-08-48-006G (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Repair Suggestions
Soldering Defroster Contact Tabs
In many cases the terminal tab will still be in the connector when you examine the vehicle. For
Chevrolet Tahoe, Suburban, GMC Yukon, and Cadillac Escalade vehicles (with moveable glass),
always replace the defroster tab (GM P/N 25916031) and the defroster electrical power connector
(P/N 12034110). For all other vehicles, reconnect the original defroster tab.
In most applications it is preferable to create a new solder connection to reattach a separated rear
defroster tab. If you take note of the steps below, it is possible to create a new solder joint that is
equal to, or stronger than, the original. The generic procedure below is not very time intensive, but
does include minor preparation work to create a good bonding surface. Be sure to follow each of
the steps, as combined they will produce the strongest bond possible. Please consider the
following before attempting the repair:
- Soldering introduces significant heat to the glass window of the vehicle. When performing the
re-connection of the tab, use only the heat required to do the job. Pre-heat the soldering iron and
have the solder in your other hand, ready to go, the moment you have enough heat to melt the
solder.
- If it is winter, bring the vehicle into the service garage and remove any snow from the back
window area. Allow time for the glass to warm to the temperature inside the building. Soldering
creates a "hot spot" in the glass. DO NOT solder on cold glass.
Caution Heating the glass excessively, or repeatedly without time to cool, may result in glass
breakage. ALWAYS wear safety glasses when performing this repair!
- You MUST use a silver-bearing solder to make the connection. DO NOT attempt this repair with
conventional tin/lead alloy solders. Silver bearing solder will adhere to the electrical buss bar,
making a strong and lasting repair.
- Protect surfaces under the area to be soldered. It is very easy to drip solder when performing this
repair. Placing a shop towel under the soldering area is sufficient protection.
Soldering Procedure
1. It is imperative to remove and replace the rear defroster electrical power connector by crimping a
new connector to the feed wire. The proper
connector P/N 12034110 can be found in the Packard Electrical Assortment, Tray 18, Position 5.
- Insert Delphi pick 12094430 to depress the locking tab on the terminal.
- Insert Delphi pick 12094429 to release the secondary lock tab.
Important DO NOT re-use the existing defroster tab on new-style full-size utility vehicles with
moveable glass.
2. Connect the electrical connector to the defroster tab. Fully engage the connector. An improperly
seated connector may cause excessive resistance
and impede the proper operation of the defroster. Add a small bead of solder to mate the electrical
connector tab to the defroster tab.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Back Window Glass > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Back Window Glass: > 03-08-48-006H > Apr >
11 > A/C - Window Defroster Contact/Tab Repair Information > Page 10431
3. Prepare the surface of the used defroster tab (not required for new tabs on new-style full-size
utility models) and the defroster buss bar with fine
grain (500 grit) sandpaper or Emery cloth. It is not necessary to remove all of the original solder,
but it should be scuffed sufficiently so that no oxidation is present. The photo above shows a close
up of a properly prepared surface.
Tip You may want to mask the glass around the contact area with tape. This is easy to do and will
allow you to safely prepare the contact surface without the risk of scratching the glass or the black
painted shading.
Important Most rear glass has a black painted masking around the edge of the glass. When
cleaning up the connection surface, be very careful not to damage the surface of the black shading
or the surface of the glass.
4. Wipe the newly prepared contact area with Kent Automotive* Acrysol(TM) (or equivalent) to
remove any residual oil or dirt.
Important
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Back Window Glass > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Back Window Glass: > 03-08-48-006H > Apr >
11 > A/C - Window Defroster Contact/Tab Repair Information > Page 10432
You MUST use a silver-bearing solder to make the solder joint. DO NOT attempt this repair with
conventional tin/lead alloy solders. Most suppliers have this type of solder available and it is
available nationally at Radio Shack(R)*. It is sold in several diameters and either are acceptable for
this repair.
5. For this step, it is permitted that two technicians be used if required. Heat the new connector on
the surface of the buss bar that is to be soldered.
Long nose pliers are suggested to hold the electrical connector and the defroster tab in place. Keep
the solder ready and begin flowing out the solder as soon as the melting temperature has been
reached. Tip If a single technician is attempting this repair, it is beneficial to wrap one turn of the
solder around the new contacts base. In this manner, as the melting point of the solder is reached,
a layer is deposited on the bottom side of the contact.
Important Try to align the new contact so that it is positioned with the same orientation as the
original contact.
6. The above illustrates an ideal finished solder joint. Additional stray solder will not harm the
performance of the bond; however, while it is unlikely
that customers may refer to the appearance of the rear window defroster and its components as a
positive styling feature of the vehicle interior, it is easy to elicit the opposite reaction due to a poor
cosmetic application.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Parts Information
Acrysol(TM) can be ordered directly from Kent Automotive at 1-800-654-6333 (in Canada,
1-800-563-1717).
Radio Shack(R) products can be found nationally at retail locations, www.radioshack.com, or at
1-800-843-7422.
All other parts can be ordered through GMSPO or SSPO.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Back Window Glass > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Back Window Glass: > 03-08-48-006H > Apr >
11 > A/C - Window Defroster Contact/Tab Repair Information > Page 10433
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Back Window Glass > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Back Window Glass: > 00-08-48-005D > Sep
> 10 > Body - Vehicle Glass Distortion Information
Back Window Glass: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Vehicle Glass Distortion Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-08-48-005D
Date: September 10, 2010
Subject: Distortion in Outer Surface of Vehicle Glass
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X 2010 and Prior Saturn
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-08-48-005C (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Distortion in the outer surface of the windshield glass, door glass or backlite glass may appear after
the vehicle has:
- Accumulated some mileage.
- Been frequently washed in automatic car washes, particularly "touchless" car washes.
This distortion may look like a subtle orange peel pattern, or may look like a drip or sag etched into
the surface of the glass.
Some car wash solutions contain a buffered solution of hydrofluoric acid which is used to clean the
glass. This should not cause a problem if used in the correct concentration. However, if not used
correctly, hydrofluoric acid will attack the glass, and over time, will cause visual distortion in the
outer surface of the glass which cannot be removed by scraping or polishing.
If this condition is suspected, look at the area of the windshield under the wipers or below the belt
seal on the side glass. The area of the glass below the wipers or belt seal will not be affected and
what looks like a drip or sag may be apparent at the edge of the wiper or belt seal. You may also
see a line on the glass where the wiper blade or the belt seal contacts the glass.
Important The repair will require replacing the affected glass and is not a result of a defect in
material or workmanship. Therefore, is not covered by New Vehicle Warranty.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Back Window Glass > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Back Window Glass: > 00-08-48-005D > Sep > 10
> Body - Vehicle Glass Distortion Information
Back Window Glass: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Vehicle Glass Distortion Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-08-48-005D
Date: September 10, 2010
Subject: Distortion in Outer Surface of Vehicle Glass
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X 2010 and Prior Saturn
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-08-48-005C (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Distortion in the outer surface of the windshield glass, door glass or backlite glass may appear after
the vehicle has:
- Accumulated some mileage.
- Been frequently washed in automatic car washes, particularly "touchless" car washes.
This distortion may look like a subtle orange peel pattern, or may look like a drip or sag etched into
the surface of the glass.
Some car wash solutions contain a buffered solution of hydrofluoric acid which is used to clean the
glass. This should not cause a problem if used in the correct concentration. However, if not used
correctly, hydrofluoric acid will attack the glass, and over time, will cause visual distortion in the
outer surface of the glass which cannot be removed by scraping or polishing.
If this condition is suspected, look at the area of the windshield under the wipers or below the belt
seal on the side glass. The area of the glass below the wipers or belt seal will not be affected and
what looks like a drip or sag may be apparent at the edge of the wiper or belt seal. You may also
see a line on the glass where the wiper blade or the belt seal contacts the glass.
Important The repair will require replacing the affected glass and is not a result of a defect in
material or workmanship. Therefore, is not covered by New Vehicle Warranty.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Corner Window Glass >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Body - Vehicle Glass Distortion Information
Front Corner Window Glass: Technical Service Bulletins Body - Vehicle Glass Distortion
Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-08-48-005D
Date: September 10, 2010
Subject: Distortion in Outer Surface of Vehicle Glass
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X 2010 and Prior Saturn
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-08-48-005C (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Distortion in the outer surface of the windshield glass, door glass or backlite glass may appear after
the vehicle has:
- Accumulated some mileage.
- Been frequently washed in automatic car washes, particularly "touchless" car washes.
This distortion may look like a subtle orange peel pattern, or may look like a drip or sag etched into
the surface of the glass.
Some car wash solutions contain a buffered solution of hydrofluoric acid which is used to clean the
glass. This should not cause a problem if used in the correct concentration. However, if not used
correctly, hydrofluoric acid will attack the glass, and over time, will cause visual distortion in the
outer surface of the glass which cannot be removed by scraping or polishing.
If this condition is suspected, look at the area of the windshield under the wipers or below the belt
seal on the side glass. The area of the glass below the wipers or belt seal will not be affected and
what looks like a drip or sag may be apparent at the edge of the wiper or belt seal. You may also
see a line on the glass where the wiper blade or the belt seal contacts the glass.
Important The repair will require replacing the affected glass and is not a result of a defect in
material or workmanship. Therefore, is not covered by New Vehicle Warranty.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > Front Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
Sealing Strip Replacement - Front Door Upper
Removal Procedure
1. Pull the molding (1) from the molding flange. 2. Remove the molding (1).
Installation Procedure
1. Install the molding (1). 2. Push the molding (1) onto the flange. Start at the pre-formed corners.
Work toward the straight flanges.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Liftgate Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Liftgate Window Glass: Service and Repair
Window Replacement - Lift Gate
Tools Required
* J 24402-A Glass Sealant (Cold Knife) Remover
* J 39032 Stationary Glass Removal Tool
* Urethane Adhesive Kit GM P/N 12346392 or Equivalent
* Isopropyl Alcohol or Equivalent
* Cartridge-type Caulking Gun
* Commercial-type Utility Knife
* Razor Blade Scraper
* Suction Cups
* Plastic Paddle
Removal Procedure
Caution: If a window is cracked but still intact, crisscross the window with masking tape in order to
reduce the risk of damage or personal injury.
Important: Before cutting out a stationary window, apply a double layer of masking tape around the
perimeter of the painted surfaces and the interior trim.
1. Disconnect the washer hose from the liftgate. 2. Remove the back window wiper arm from the
liftgate. Refer to Wiper Arm Replacement - Rear in Wipers/Washer Systems. 3. Open liftgate
window. 4. Remove the liftgate window garnish molding. Refer to Garnish Molding Replacement Lift Gate (See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair) in Body Rear End.
5. Disconnect the electrical connector from the rear window defogger on the liftgate window.
Caution: If broken glass falls into the defroster outlets, it can be blown into the passenger
compartment and cause personal injury.
6. Cover to protect the following parts from broken glass:
1. Upper dash pad 2. Defroster outlets and A/C outlets 3. Seats and carpeting
7. Using a sharp utility knife, make a preliminary cut around the perimeter of the quarter window.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Liftgate Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 10454
Important: Keep the cutting edge of the tool against the window.
8. This will allow the urethane adhesive to be separated from the window.
* Leave a base of urethane on the pinchweld flange.
* The only suitable lubrication is clear water.
* Use J 24402-A , J 39032 or equivalent in order to remove the window.
9. With the aid of an assistant, remove the liftgate window from the liftgate frame.
Installation Procedure
1. Install a stationary window into the opening. Refer to Urethane Adhesive Installation of
Stationary Windows (See: Service and Repair/Removal
and Replacement/Urethane Adhesive Installation of Stationary Windows) .
2. Connect the electrical connector to the rear window defogger on the liftgate window. 3. Install the
liftgate window garnish molding. Refer to Garnish Molding Replacement - Lift Gate (See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding /
Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair) in Body Rear End.
4. Close liftgate window. 5. Install the back window wiper arm to the liftgate. Refer toWiper Arm
Replacement - Rear in Wipers/Washer Systems. 6. Connect the washer hose to the liftgate. 7.
Remove the double layer of masking tape around the perimeter of the painted surfaces and the
interior trim.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Quarter
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair
Quarter Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
Weatherstrip Replacement - Swing Out Window
Removal Procedure
1. Open the swing out window. 2. Pull the weatherstrip from the pinch weld flange. 3. Grasp the
weatherstrip at the lower corner and pull up and away from the pinch-weld.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the weatherstrip to the pinch-weld flange. 2. Put the weatherstrip on the pinch-weld flange
and push downward until fully seated. 3. Close the swing out window.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Front Door Window Regulator >
System Information > Service and Repair > Door Window Regulator Replacement
Front Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair Door Window Regulator Replacement
Door Window Regulator Replacement
Tools Required
M 39010 Heavy Duty Rivet Gun
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the trim panel. Refer to Door Trim Panel Replacement (See: Body and Frame/Doors,
Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front Door
Panel/Service and Repair) .
2. Remove the inner panel upper bar. Refer to Inner Panel Bar Replacement - Front Door Upper ()
. 3. Remove the water deflector. Refer to Front Side Door Water Deflector Replacement See: Body
and Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front
Door/Front Door Panel/Service and Repair Use a soft-faced scraper, if needed, in order to peel the
water deflector away from the door.
4. Roll up the window. 5. Apply a cloth backed body tape from the window over the top of the door
to the other side of the window in order to hold the window in position
when the regulator is removed.
6. Disconnect the wiring harness from the power window regulator motor, if equipped.
7. Remove the window regulator rivet (2) heads by using a 6 mm (1/4 in) drill bit. 8. Remove the
regulator (3) from the door:
1. Push the regulator into the door and slide the regulator forward. and then rearward in order to
remove the power window regulator arms from
the sash and the regulator rail.
2. Fold the regulator arms together and remove it through the access hole.
Installation Procedure
1. Install the regulator (3) to the door:
1. Place the window regulator into the door through the access hole. 2. Place the window regulator
arm rollers into the sash and the regulator rail. 3. Push the window regulator through the regulator
door opening and align the holes in the regulator with the holes in the door.
2. Install the rivets to the window regulator (3) using the M 39010 . 3. Connect the wiring harness to
the power window regulator, if equipped. 4. Install the water deflector. Refer to Front Side Door
Water Deflector Replacement See: Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front
Door/Front Door Panel/Service and Repair
5. Install the inner panel upper bar. Refer to Inner Panel Bar Replacement - Front Door Upper () .
6. Remove the tape from the door and the window. 7. Check the window operation.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Front Door Window Regulator >
System Information > Service and Repair > Door Window Regulator Replacement > Page 10464
8. Install the trim panel. Refer to Door Trim Panel Replacement (See: Body and Frame/Doors,
Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front Door
Panel/Service and Repair) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Front Door Window Regulator >
System Information > Service and Repair > Door Window Regulator Replacement > Page 10465
Front Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair Door Window Regulator Replacement (Manual)
Window Regulator Replacement
Tools Required
M 39010 Heavy Duty Rivet Gun
Removal Procedure
1. Remove the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Door (See: Body and Frame/Doors,
Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front Door
Panel/Service and Repair) .
2. Remove the bolts that retain the inner panel upper bar. 3. Remove the water deflector. Refer to
Water Deflector Replacement - Front Door See: Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and
Trunk/Doors/Front
Door/Front Door Panel/Service and Repair. Use a soft-faced scraper, if needed, in order to peel the
water deflector away from the door.
4. Roll up the window. 5. Apply a cloth backed body tape from the window over the top of the door
to the other side of the window in order to hold the window in position
when the regulator is removed.
6. Disconnect the wiring harness from the power window regulator motor, if equipped.
7. Remove the window regulator rivet (2) heads by using a 6 mm (1/4 in) drill bit. 8. Remove the
regulator (3) from the door:
1. Push the regulator into the door and slide the regulator forward and then rearward in order to
remove the power window regulator arms from
the sash and the regulator rail.
2. Fold the regulator arms together and remove it through the access hole.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Front Door Window Regulator >
System Information > Service and Repair > Door Window Regulator Replacement > Page 10466
1. Install the regulator (3) to the door:
1. Place the window regulator into the door through the access hole. 2. Place the window regulator
arm rollers into the sash and the regulator rail. 3. Push the window regulator through the regulator
door opening and align the holes in the regulator with the holes in the door.
2. Install the rivets to the window regulator (3) using the M 39010 . 3. Connect the wiring harness to
the power window regulator, if equipped. 4. Install the water deflector. Refer to Water Deflector
Replacement - Front Door See: Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front
Door/Front Door Panel/Service and Repair.
5. Install the inner panel upper bar with the bolts.
Tighten the bolts to 25 N.m (18 lb ft).
6. Remove the tape from the door and the window. 7. Check the window operation. 8. Install the
trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Door (See: Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and
Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front Door
Panel/Service and Repair) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Track > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Window Track: Service and Repair
Window Run Channel Replacement
Removal Procedure
1. Roll the window up completely. 2. Remove the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement Door (See: Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front Door
Panel/Service and Repair) .
3. Use a sharp bladed tool, if needed, in order to separate the water deflector at the perforations.
Refer to Water Deflector Replacement - Front Door
See: Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front Door Panel/Service and
Repair.
4. Remove the door to window run channel bolt.
5. Pull the run channel away from the upper channel (which is part of the door) in order to remove
the window run channel from the door.
Installation Procedure
1. Slide the clip of the channel into the upper channel in order to install the window run channel to
the door.
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the door to window run channel bolt.
Tighten the door to window run channel bolt to 9.5 N.m (84 lb in).
3. Install the water deflector. Refer to Water Deflector Replacement - Front Door See: Body and
Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front
Door/Front Door Panel/Service and Repair.
4. Install the trim panel. Refer to Trim Panel Replacement - Door (See: Body and Frame/Doors,
Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front Door
Panel/Service and Repair) .
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 09-08-48-006 > Sep > 09 > Body - Stain/Film On Windshield Glass Perimeter
Windshield: Customer Interest Body - Stain/Film On Windshield Glass Perimeter
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-08-48-006
Date: September 18, 2009
Subject: Clear Stain or Film on Inside Perimeter of Windshield Glass (Clean/Polish Glass)
Models:
2010 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn and Saab) 2010 and Prior HUMMER
H2, H3
Condition
Some customers may comment on a clear stain or film on the inside of the windshield glass. This
condition appears along the outer edges of the glass along the top, bottom or A-pillar areas.
Normal glass cleaning procedures will not remove the stain.
Cause
The assembly plant uses a clear sealer/primer on the outer edge of the windshield glass to improve
adhesion to the urethane adhesive that bonds the windshield glass to the vehicle body. Excess
sealer/primer may drip or flow onto the windshield and cause a stain. Once the sealer/primer dries,
it may appear to have etched the glass.
Correction
Note
A "white" type of toothpaste is recommended for this repair. Gel-type toothpaste may provide less
satisfactory results.
Use a small amount of toothpaste on a soft, cotton cloth to polish the stained area. It may be
necessary to wrap the cloth around a paint stir stick or a similar tool to reach the lower corners of
the windshield glass.
After polishing the glass, clean the inside of the windshield glass with a clean, damp, cotton cloth
and verify all of the stain is removed. Do not use any cleaners or solvents - use only clean warm
water.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 09-08-48-006 > Sep > 09 > Body - Stain/Film On Windshield Glass Perimeter > Page 10478
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 09-08-48-002A > Mar > 09 > Body - Marks/Stains on Windshield When Wet
Windshield: Customer Interest Body - Marks/Stains on Windshield When Wet
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-08-48-002A
Date: March 19, 2009
Subject: Marks/Stains on Windshield When Wet (Clean Windshield)
Models: 2010 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn and Saab) 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the models and model years. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 09-08-48-002 (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Condition
Some owners may comment that marks/stains appear on the windshield when the windshield is
wet.
Cause
This condition may be caused by contact between the windshield and the vacuum hoses or other
tools used in the assembly process. This contact may leave a residue that creates a water repellent
surface on the glass which, in wet conditions, appear as marks/stains on the surface.
Correction
Important
DO NOT REPLACE THE WINDSHIELD FOR THIS CONDITION.
To clean the windshield, use Eastwood Glass Polishing Compound*. Follow the manufacturer's
directions for product use. Use only hand tools. DO NOT USE POWER TOOLS.
Parts Information
Eastwood Glass Polishing Compound
1-800-343-9353 (for overseas inquiries: +1-610-705-2200)
http://www.eastwoodco.com/
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products from this firm or for any such items which may be available from
other sources.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 01-08-57-004 > Oct > 01 > Windshield - Water Dripping Into Interior From Top
Windshield: Customer Interest Windshield - Water Dripping Into Interior From Top
File In Section: 08 Body and Accessories
Bulletin No.: 01-08-57-004
Date: October, 2001
TECHNICAL
Subject: WaterLeak at Top of Windshield (Seal Pinhole)
Models: 1999-2002 Chevrolet and GMC M/L-Van Models
Condition
Some customers may comment that there is water dripping from the top of the windshield.
Cause
Important:
A large amount of water may be able to enter the vehicle through small holes in the body seam
sealer
The water may be entering from a pinhole in the body seam sealer at the upper "A" pillar. Refer to
the illustration above.
The water may also be entering from a pinhole in the body seam sealer at the "B" pillar and then
runs forward to the windshield. Refer to the illustrations above.
Correction
1. The affected surface must be clean, dry and free of dirt or contaminants. Clean the surface with
one of the cleaners listed below, or equivalent.
^ 3M(R) General Purpose Adhesive Cleaner, P/N 08984
^ Dominion Sure Seal, Sure Solve BSS
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 01-08-57-004 > Oct > 01 > Windshield - Water Dripping Into Interior From Top > Page 10487
^ Kent Acrosol
2. Fill the pinhole(s) with a clear seam sealer.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 06-08-43-003C > Feb > 11 > Glass/Body - Windshield Wiper Performance
Windshield: All Technical Service Bulletins Glass/Body - Windshield Wiper Performance
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 06-08-43-003C
Date: February 21, 2011
Subject: Windshield Wiper Performance, Cleaning Instructions and Maintenance
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2010 and Prior Isuzu Medium Duty Trucks 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 and 2012 model year. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 06-08-43-003B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Wiper Concerns
Most concerns about windshield wiper performance are the result of dirty wiper blades, damaged
wiper blades, or worn out blades that are continuing to be used beyond their useful life. Depending
on environmental conditions, wiper blades can have dramatic differences in lifespan. Here are
some tips and guidelines to maximize wiper performance to avoid damage to the blades, and to
avoid unnecessary replacements.
Many wiper blades are being replaced under warranty with reviews showing there is nothing wrong
with the returned blades other than a build-up of dirt. Additionally, advise the customer to review
the information in their Owner Manual.
Inspection and Cleaning
Scheduled Maintenance
- Inspect your wipers rubber blades every 4-6 months or 12,000 km (7,500 mi) for wear, cracking or
contamination.
- Clean the windshield and the rubber wiper blades (using the procedure below) if the blades are
not clearing the glass satisfactorily. If this does not correct the problem, then replace the rubber
elements.
Cleaning Procedure
Important Avoid getting windshield washer fluid on your hands. Wear rubber gloves or avoid direct
contact with washer fluid.
Important Do not use gasoline, kerosene, or petroleum based products to clean wiper blades.
- Clean the rubber blades using a lint free cloth or paper towel soaked with windshield washer fluid
or a mild detergent. You should see significant amounts of dirt being removed on the cloth.
- Be sure to wash the windshield thoroughly when you clean the blades. Bugs, road grime, sap and
a buildup of car wash/wax treatments may additionally cause wiper streaking.
Tip For a larger scale buildup on the windshield, use a non-abrasive cleaner such as Bon-Ami*
(www.faultless.com) cleanser with a wet sponge, being sure to use plenty of water to avoid
scratching the glass. Flush the surface and body panels completely.
Tip For day-to-day exterior glass cleaning and to maintain a streak free appearance, suggest
Vehicle Care Glass Cleaner, P/N 88862560 (in Canada, 992727). This product is an easy to use
foaming cleaner that quickly removes dirt and grime from glass surfaces.
Tip Interior glass should be cleaned with plain, clean water to eliminate any film or haze on the
window and help prevent fogging, a major customer dissatisfier. Refer to Corporate Bulletin
Number 03-00-89-006D for more information. The New Vehicle Pre-Delivery Inspection form also
recommends using plain water to clean interior glass.
*"We believe this material to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such material.
General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any responsibility for the
products or equipment from these firms or any such items which may be available from other
sources.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 06-08-43-003C > Feb > 11 > Glass/Body - Windshield Wiper Performance
> Page 10493
Avoiding Wiper Damage
The following are major contributors to wiper damage. Some of these you can control and others
are environmental concerns.
- Extremely dusty areas (such as driving on dirt roads) may cause the wipers rubber edge to wear
quickly and unevenly.
- Sand and salt used on roads for increasing winter traction and ice control will cause the wiper
blades to wear quicker. Areas with significant snowfall require more frequent blade replacements.
- Heat and time may cause the rubber blades to take a "permanent set" resulting in the rubber not
flexing and turning over uniformly. This condition may result in streaking and/or unwiped areas.
- Rubber blades are easily cut or torn when using ice scrapers. Likewise pulling blades up off a
frozen windshield can tear the rubber. Exercise caution when clearing ice and snow.
- Using your wipers to "wear through" frost and ice, instead of allowing the defrosters to melt the
ice, can dull, nick or tear the rubber blades.
- Banging wipers on the glass to remove ice and snow may cause the blade to bend, dislodging the
rubber and causing potential scratching of the windshield.
- Ice can form in the pin joints of the wipers, which can cause streaking and unwiped areas. To
remove ice from pin joints, compress the blade and rubber edge with your hand to loosen the
frozen joints. Consider using Winter Blades that have a rubber cover to avoid this condition.
Note
GM does not recommend the use of any spray on/wipe on windshield treatments or washer fluid
additives. The variation in friction that results on the glass from the use of these products causes
wipers to chatter and have premature wear.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 00-08-48-005D > Sep > 10 > Body - Vehicle Glass Distortion Information
Windshield: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Vehicle Glass Distortion Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-08-48-005D
Date: September 10, 2010
Subject: Distortion in Outer Surface of Vehicle Glass
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X 2010 and Prior Saturn
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-08-48-005C (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Distortion in the outer surface of the windshield glass, door glass or backlite glass may appear after
the vehicle has:
- Accumulated some mileage.
- Been frequently washed in automatic car washes, particularly "touchless" car washes.
This distortion may look like a subtle orange peel pattern, or may look like a drip or sag etched into
the surface of the glass.
Some car wash solutions contain a buffered solution of hydrofluoric acid which is used to clean the
glass. This should not cause a problem if used in the correct concentration. However, if not used
correctly, hydrofluoric acid will attack the glass, and over time, will cause visual distortion in the
outer surface of the glass which cannot be removed by scraping or polishing.
If this condition is suspected, look at the area of the windshield under the wipers or below the belt
seal on the side glass. The area of the glass below the wipers or belt seal will not be affected and
what looks like a drip or sag may be apparent at the edge of the wiper or belt seal. You may also
see a line on the glass where the wiper blade or the belt seal contacts the glass.
Important The repair will require replacing the affected glass and is not a result of a defect in
material or workmanship. Therefore, is not covered by New Vehicle Warranty.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 09-08-48-006 > Sep > 09 > Body - Stain/Film On Windshield Glass
Perimeter
Windshield: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Stain/Film On Windshield Glass Perimeter
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-08-48-006
Date: September 18, 2009
Subject: Clear Stain or Film on Inside Perimeter of Windshield Glass (Clean/Polish Glass)
Models:
2010 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn and Saab) 2010 and Prior HUMMER
H2, H3
Condition
Some customers may comment on a clear stain or film on the inside of the windshield glass. This
condition appears along the outer edges of the glass along the top, bottom or A-pillar areas.
Normal glass cleaning procedures will not remove the stain.
Cause
The assembly plant uses a clear sealer/primer on the outer edge of the windshield glass to improve
adhesion to the urethane adhesive that bonds the windshield glass to the vehicle body. Excess
sealer/primer may drip or flow onto the windshield and cause a stain. Once the sealer/primer dries,
it may appear to have etched the glass.
Correction
Note
A "white" type of toothpaste is recommended for this repair. Gel-type toothpaste may provide less
satisfactory results.
Use a small amount of toothpaste on a soft, cotton cloth to polish the stained area. It may be
necessary to wrap the cloth around a paint stir stick or a similar tool to reach the lower corners of
the windshield glass.
After polishing the glass, clean the inside of the windshield glass with a clean, damp, cotton cloth
and verify all of the stain is removed. Do not use any cleaners or solvents - use only clean warm
water.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 09-08-48-006 > Sep > 09 > Body - Stain/Film On Windshield Glass
Perimeter > Page 10502
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 09-08-48-002A > Mar > 09 > Body - Marks/Stains on Windshield When Wet
Windshield: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Marks/Stains on Windshield When Wet
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-08-48-002A
Date: March 19, 2009
Subject: Marks/Stains on Windshield When Wet (Clean Windshield)
Models: 2010 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn and Saab) 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the models and model years. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 09-08-48-002 (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Condition
Some owners may comment that marks/stains appear on the windshield when the windshield is
wet.
Cause
This condition may be caused by contact between the windshield and the vacuum hoses or other
tools used in the assembly process. This contact may leave a residue that creates a water repellent
surface on the glass which, in wet conditions, appear as marks/stains on the surface.
Correction
Important
DO NOT REPLACE THE WINDSHIELD FOR THIS CONDITION.
To clean the windshield, use Eastwood Glass Polishing Compound*. Follow the manufacturer's
directions for product use. Use only hand tools. DO NOT USE POWER TOOLS.
Parts Information
Eastwood Glass Polishing Compound
1-800-343-9353 (for overseas inquiries: +1-610-705-2200)
http://www.eastwoodco.com/
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products from this firm or for any such items which may be available from
other sources.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 01-08-57-004 > Oct > 01 > Windshield - Water Dripping Into Interior From
Top
Windshield: All Technical Service Bulletins Windshield - Water Dripping Into Interior From Top
File In Section: 08 Body and Accessories
Bulletin No.: 01-08-57-004
Date: October, 2001
TECHNICAL
Subject: WaterLeak at Top of Windshield (Seal Pinhole)
Models: 1999-2002 Chevrolet and GMC M/L-Van Models
Condition
Some customers may comment that there is water dripping from the top of the windshield.
Cause
Important:
A large amount of water may be able to enter the vehicle through small holes in the body seam
sealer
The water may be entering from a pinhole in the body seam sealer at the upper "A" pillar. Refer to
the illustration above.
The water may also be entering from a pinhole in the body seam sealer at the "B" pillar and then
runs forward to the windshield. Refer to the illustrations above.
Correction
1. The affected surface must be clean, dry and free of dirt or contaminants. Clean the surface with
one of the cleaners listed below, or equivalent.
^ 3M(R) General Purpose Adhesive Cleaner, P/N 08984
^ Dominion Sure Seal, Sure Solve BSS
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 01-08-57-004 > Oct > 01 > Windshield - Water Dripping Into Interior From
Top > Page 10511
^ Kent Acrosol
2. Fill the pinhole(s) with a clear seam sealer.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Other Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 06-08-43-003C > Feb > 11 > Glass/Body - Windshield Wiper Performance
Windshield: All Technical Service Bulletins Glass/Body - Windshield Wiper Performance
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 06-08-43-003C
Date: February 21, 2011
Subject: Windshield Wiper Performance, Cleaning Instructions and Maintenance
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2010 and Prior Isuzu Medium Duty Trucks 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 and 2012 model year. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 06-08-43-003B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Wiper Concerns
Most concerns about windshield wiper performance are the result of dirty wiper blades, damaged
wiper blades, or worn out blades that are continuing to be used beyond their useful life. Depending
on environmental conditions, wiper blades can have dramatic differences in lifespan. Here are
some tips and guidelines to maximize wiper performance to avoid damage to the blades, and to
avoid unnecessary replacements.
Many wiper blades are being replaced under warranty with reviews showing there is nothing wrong
with the returned blades other than a build-up of dirt. Additionally, advise the customer to review
the information in their Owner Manual.
Inspection and Cleaning
Scheduled Maintenance
- Inspect your wipers rubber blades every 4-6 months or 12,000 km (7,500 mi) for wear, cracking or
contamination.
- Clean the windshield and the rubber wiper blades (using the procedure below) if the blades are
not clearing the glass satisfactorily. If this does not correct the problem, then replace the rubber
elements.
Cleaning Procedure
Important Avoid getting windshield washer fluid on your hands. Wear rubber gloves or avoid direct
contact with washer fluid.
Important Do not use gasoline, kerosene, or petroleum based products to clean wiper blades.
- Clean the rubber blades using a lint free cloth or paper towel soaked with windshield washer fluid
or a mild detergent. You should see significant amounts of dirt being removed on the cloth.
- Be sure to wash the windshield thoroughly when you clean the blades. Bugs, road grime, sap and
a buildup of car wash/wax treatments may additionally cause wiper streaking.
Tip For a larger scale buildup on the windshield, use a non-abrasive cleaner such as Bon-Ami*
(www.faultless.com) cleanser with a wet sponge, being sure to use plenty of water to avoid
scratching the glass. Flush the surface and body panels completely.
Tip For day-to-day exterior glass cleaning and to maintain a streak free appearance, suggest
Vehicle Care Glass Cleaner, P/N 88862560 (in Canada, 992727). This product is an easy to use
foaming cleaner that quickly removes dirt and grime from glass surfaces.
Tip Interior glass should be cleaned with plain, clean water to eliminate any film or haze on the
window and help prevent fogging, a major customer dissatisfier. Refer to Corporate Bulletin
Number 03-00-89-006D for more information. The New Vehicle Pre-Delivery Inspection form also
recommends using plain water to clean interior glass.
*"We believe this material to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such material.
General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any responsibility for the
products or equipment from these firms or any such items which may be available from other
sources.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Other Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 06-08-43-003C > Feb > 11 > Glass/Body - Windshield Wiper Performance >
Page 10517
Avoiding Wiper Damage
The following are major contributors to wiper damage. Some of these you can control and others
are environmental concerns.
- Extremely dusty areas (such as driving on dirt roads) may cause the wipers rubber edge to wear
quickly and unevenly.
- Sand and salt used on roads for increasing winter traction and ice control will cause the wiper
blades to wear quicker. Areas with significant snowfall require more frequent blade replacements.
- Heat and time may cause the rubber blades to take a "permanent set" resulting in the rubber not
flexing and turning over uniformly. This condition may result in streaking and/or unwiped areas.
- Rubber blades are easily cut or torn when using ice scrapers. Likewise pulling blades up off a
frozen windshield can tear the rubber. Exercise caution when clearing ice and snow.
- Using your wipers to "wear through" frost and ice, instead of allowing the defrosters to melt the
ice, can dull, nick or tear the rubber blades.
- Banging wipers on the glass to remove ice and snow may cause the blade to bend, dislodging the
rubber and causing potential scratching of the windshield.
- Ice can form in the pin joints of the wipers, which can cause streaking and unwiped areas. To
remove ice from pin joints, compress the blade and rubber edge with your hand to loosen the
frozen joints. Consider using Winter Blades that have a rubber cover to avoid this condition.
Note
GM does not recommend the use of any spray on/wipe on windshield treatments or washer fluid
additives. The variation in friction that results on the glass from the use of these products causes
wipers to chatter and have premature wear.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Other Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 00-08-48-005D > Sep > 10 > Body - Vehicle Glass Distortion Information
Windshield: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Vehicle Glass Distortion Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-08-48-005D
Date: September 10, 2010
Subject: Distortion in Outer Surface of Vehicle Glass
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X 2010 and Prior Saturn
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-08-48-005C (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Distortion in the outer surface of the windshield glass, door glass or backlite glass may appear after
the vehicle has:
- Accumulated some mileage.
- Been frequently washed in automatic car washes, particularly "touchless" car washes.
This distortion may look like a subtle orange peel pattern, or may look like a drip or sag etched into
the surface of the glass.
Some car wash solutions contain a buffered solution of hydrofluoric acid which is used to clean the
glass. This should not cause a problem if used in the correct concentration. However, if not used
correctly, hydrofluoric acid will attack the glass, and over time, will cause visual distortion in the
outer surface of the glass which cannot be removed by scraping or polishing.
If this condition is suspected, look at the area of the windshield under the wipers or below the belt
seal on the side glass. The area of the glass below the wipers or belt seal will not be affected and
what looks like a drip or sag may be apparent at the edge of the wiper or belt seal. You may also
see a line on the glass where the wiper blade or the belt seal contacts the glass.
Important The repair will require replacing the affected glass and is not a result of a defect in
material or workmanship. Therefore, is not covered by New Vehicle Warranty.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 10522
Windshield: Service and Repair
Windshield Replacement
Tools Required
* J 24402-A Glass Sealant (Cold Knife) Remover
* J 39032 Stationary Glass Removal Tool
* Urethane Adhesive Kit GM P/N 12346392 or Equivalent
* Isopropyl Alcohol or Equivalent
* Cartridge-type Caulking Gun
* Commercial-type Utility Knife
* Razor Blade Scraper
* Suction Cups
* Plastic Paddle
Removal Procedure
Important: Before cutting out a stationary window, apply a double layer of masking tape around the
perimeter of the painted surfaces and the interior trim.
1. Remove the windshield wiper arms. Refer to Wiper Arm Replacement in Wipers/Washer
Systems. 2. Remove the antenna if necessary. Refer to Fixed Antenna Replacement in
Entertainment. 3. Open the hood. 4. Remove the air inlet grille. Refer to Air Inlet Grille Panel
Replacement (See: Body and Frame/Cowl/Cowl Moulding / Trim/Service and Repair)
in Body Front End.
5. Remove the inside rearview mirror. Refer to Rearview Mirror Replacement (See: Body and
Frame/Mirrors/Service and Repair/Rearview Mirror
Replacement) .
Caution: If broken glass falls into the defroster outlets, it can be blown into the passenger
compartment and cause personal injury.
6. Cover to protect the following parts from broken glass:
1. Upper dash pad 2. Defroster outlets and A/C outlets 3. Seats and carpeting
7. Remove the door sealing weatherstrip from the upper pinchweld flange.
Caution: When working with any type of glass or sheet metal with exposed or rough edges, wear
approved safety glasses and gloves in order to reduce the chance of personal injury.
8. Remove the 2 screws that retain the windshield frame filler panels. 9. Remove the frame filler
panels.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 10523
Important: The windshield reveal molding fills the cavities between the body and windshield and
can not be reused if stretched or damaged.
10. The windshield reveal molding is a one piece molding.
Caution: When working with any type of glass or sheet metal with exposed or rough edges, wear
approved safety glasses and gloves in order to reduce the chance of personal injury.
11. Grasp the lower corner of the windshield reveal molding by hand and slowly pull the reveal
molding away from the windshield.
If the windshield reveal molding will not release, use a utility knife in order to cut around the
windshield in order to remove the windshield reveal molding.
12. Remove the windshield reveal molding.
13. Remove the lower windshield supports (1) from the cowl panel, if equipped.
Important: Keep the cutting edge of the tool against the quarter window.
14. This will allow the urethane adhesive to be separated from the quarter window.
* Leave a base of urethane on the pinchweld flange.
* The only suitable lubrication is clear water.
* Use J 24402-A , J 39032 or equivalent in order to remove the quarter window.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 10524
15. Remove the windshield (1) from the vehicle with the aid of an assistant (2).
Installation Procedure
1. Install the quarter window into the opening. Refer to Urethane Adhesive Installation of Stationary
Windows (See: Windows/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Urethane Adhesive Installation of Stationary Windows) .
Notice: Refer to Fastener Notice in Cautions and Notices.
2. Install the windshield side reveal molding screws.
Tighten the windshield side reveal screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
3. Install the windshield frame filler panel with 2 screws.
Tighten the windshield frame filler panel screws to 2 N.m (18 lb in).
4. Install the door sealing weatherstrip to the upper pinchweld flange. 5. Install the inside rearview
mirror. Refer to Rearview Mirror Replacement (See: Body and Frame/Mirrors/Service and
Repair/Rearview Mirror
Replacement) .
6. Install the air inlet grille. Refer to Air Inlet Grille Panel Replacement (See: Body and
Frame/Cowl/Cowl Moulding / Trim/Service and Repair) in
Body Front End.
7. Close the hood. 8. Install the antenna, if necessary. Refer to Fixed Antenna Replacement in
Entertainment.
Install the windshield wiper arms. Refer to Wiper Arm Replacement in Wipers/Washer Systems.
9. Remove the double layer of masking tape around the perimeter of the painted surfaces and the
interior trim.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Wiper Control Module: Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 10530
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems >
Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
Rear Window Wiper Washer Switch
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Windshield Washer Hose: Service and Repair
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the washer solvent container. 2. Remove the washer hose from the rear washer pump
to the rear washer check valve. 3. Remove the rear washer check valve. 4. Remove the washer
hose from the front washer pump to the front washer check valve. 5. Remove the front washer
check valve.
6. Remove the front washer hose and strap.
7. Remove the washer hose connector from the plenum clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 10541
8. Remove the RH washer nozzle hose and hose clip.
9. Remove the LH washer nozzle hose from the 2 plenum clips.
10. Remove the LH washer nozzle hose and hose clip.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the LH washer nozzle hose with the hose clip. 2. Install the LH washer nozzle hose in the
2 plenum clips.
3. Install the RH washer nozzle hose with the hose clip. 4. Install the washer hose connector in the
plenum clip.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 10542
5. Install the front washer hose and strap.
6. Install the front washer check valve. 7. Install the washer hose from the front washer pump to the
front washer check valve. 8. Install the rear washer check valve. 9. Install the washer hose from the
rear washer pump to the rear washer check valve.
10. Install the washer solvent container.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Pump > Component Information >
Locations
Windshield Washer Pump: Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Pump > Component Information >
Locations > Page 10546
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Pump > Component Information >
Locations > Page 10547
Windshield Washer Pump: Diagrams
Rear Window Washer Fluid Pump
Windshield Washer Fluid Pump
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Pump > Component Information >
Locations > Page 10548
Windshield Washer Pump: Service and Repair
WASHER PUMP REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the washer solvent container. 2. Disconnect the washer hose(s). 3. Remove the washer
pump(s) from the washer solvent container.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the washer pump(s) in the washer solvent container. 2. Connect the washer hose(s). 3.
Install the washer solvent container.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information >
Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Arm Blade Replacement - Rear
Wiper Arm: Service and Repair Wiper Arm Blade Replacement - Rear
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Insert a narrow-bladed screwdriver into the slot over the wiper blade retainer spring. 2. Pivot the
screwdriver so that the blade tip presses downward on the retainer spring and releases the wiper
blade from the pin of the wiper arm. 3. Remove the wiper blade from the wiper arm.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the wiper blade on the wiper arm pin. 2. Snap the wiper blade into place.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Arm Blade Replacement - Rear > Page 10556
Wiper Arm: Service and Repair Wiper Arm Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the washer hose from the wiper arm.
IMPORTANT: Before removing one or both of the arm and blade assemblies, use a suitable
marker on the windshield to indicate the proper part position and to aid in reinstallation.
2. Lift the wiper arm assembly from the windshield, then pull the retaining latch. 3. Remove the arm
assembly from the transmission drive shaft.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Position the wiper arm assembly on the drive shaft and press in the retaining latch so that the
wiper blade aligns with the mark made before the
removal.
2. Install the washer hose.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Arm Blade Replacement - Rear > Page 10557
Wiper Arm: Service and Repair Wiper Arm Replacement - Rear
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: Mark the position of the wiper blade on the liftgate with a suitable marker or a piece
of masking tape.
1. Pull the washer hose through the liftgate grommet. 2. Disconnect the washer hose from the
washer harness connector. 3. Lift the wiper arm off the liftgate. 4. Push out the wiper arm retaining
clip with a small screwdriver. 5. Remove the wiper arm from the wiper motor drive shaft.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Position the wiper arm onto the wiper motor drive shaft so that the tip of the blade aligns with the
mark made at removal. 2. Install the wiper arm onto the drive shaft. 3. Press in the retaining clip. 4.
Connect the washer hose onto the washer harness connector. 5. Insert the hose into the liftgate
grommet. 6. Operate the rear wiper and inspect for proper operation.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Glass/Body - Windshield Wiper Performance
Wiper Blade: Technical Service Bulletins Glass/Body - Windshield Wiper Performance
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 06-08-43-003C
Date: February 21, 2011
Subject: Windshield Wiper Performance, Cleaning Instructions and Maintenance
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2010 and Prior Isuzu Medium Duty Trucks 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 and 2012 model year. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 06-08-43-003B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Wiper Concerns
Most concerns about windshield wiper performance are the result of dirty wiper blades, damaged
wiper blades, or worn out blades that are continuing to be used beyond their useful life. Depending
on environmental conditions, wiper blades can have dramatic differences in lifespan. Here are
some tips and guidelines to maximize wiper performance to avoid damage to the blades, and to
avoid unnecessary replacements.
Many wiper blades are being replaced under warranty with reviews showing there is nothing wrong
with the returned blades other than a build-up of dirt. Additionally, advise the customer to review
the information in their Owner Manual.
Inspection and Cleaning
Scheduled Maintenance
- Inspect your wipers rubber blades every 4-6 months or 12,000 km (7,500 mi) for wear, cracking or
contamination.
- Clean the windshield and the rubber wiper blades (using the procedure below) if the blades are
not clearing the glass satisfactorily. If this does not correct the problem, then replace the rubber
elements.
Cleaning Procedure
Important Avoid getting windshield washer fluid on your hands. Wear rubber gloves or avoid direct
contact with washer fluid.
Important Do not use gasoline, kerosene, or petroleum based products to clean wiper blades.
- Clean the rubber blades using a lint free cloth or paper towel soaked with windshield washer fluid
or a mild detergent. You should see significant amounts of dirt being removed on the cloth.
- Be sure to wash the windshield thoroughly when you clean the blades. Bugs, road grime, sap and
a buildup of car wash/wax treatments may additionally cause wiper streaking.
Tip For a larger scale buildup on the windshield, use a non-abrasive cleaner such as Bon-Ami*
(www.faultless.com) cleanser with a wet sponge, being sure to use plenty of water to avoid
scratching the glass. Flush the surface and body panels completely.
Tip For day-to-day exterior glass cleaning and to maintain a streak free appearance, suggest
Vehicle Care Glass Cleaner, P/N 88862560 (in Canada, 992727). This product is an easy to use
foaming cleaner that quickly removes dirt and grime from glass surfaces.
Tip Interior glass should be cleaned with plain, clean water to eliminate any film or haze on the
window and help prevent fogging, a major customer dissatisfier. Refer to Corporate Bulletin
Number 03-00-89-006D for more information. The New Vehicle Pre-Delivery Inspection form also
recommends using plain water to clean interior glass.
*"We believe this material to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such material.
General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any responsibility for the
products or equipment from these firms or any such items which may be available from other
sources.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Glass/Body - Windshield Wiper Performance > Page 10562
Avoiding Wiper Damage
The following are major contributors to wiper damage. Some of these you can control and others
are environmental concerns.
- Extremely dusty areas (such as driving on dirt roads) may cause the wipers rubber edge to wear
quickly and unevenly.
- Sand and salt used on roads for increasing winter traction and ice control will cause the wiper
blades to wear quicker. Areas with significant snowfall require more frequent blade replacements.
- Heat and time may cause the rubber blades to take a "permanent set" resulting in the rubber not
flexing and turning over uniformly. This condition may result in streaking and/or unwiped areas.
- Rubber blades are easily cut or torn when using ice scrapers. Likewise pulling blades up off a
frozen windshield can tear the rubber. Exercise caution when clearing ice and snow.
- Using your wipers to "wear through" frost and ice, instead of allowing the defrosters to melt the
ice, can dull, nick or tear the rubber blades.
- Banging wipers on the glass to remove ice and snow may cause the blade to bend, dislodging the
rubber and causing potential scratching of the windshield.
- Ice can form in the pin joints of the wipers, which can cause streaking and unwiped areas. To
remove ice from pin joints, compress the blade and rubber edge with your hand to loosen the
frozen joints. Consider using Winter Blades that have a rubber cover to avoid this condition.
Note
GM does not recommend the use of any spray on/wipe on windshield treatments or washer fluid
additives. The variation in friction that results on the glass from the use of these products causes
wipers to chatter and have premature wear.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Wiper Blade Element Replacement
Wiper Blade: Service and Repair Wiper Blade Element Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: Replace the wiper blade element if it is removed from the wiper blade.
1. Remove the wiper blade from the wiper arm. 2. Squeeze the wiper blade element tabs together.
3. Pull the wiper blade element out through the wiper blade claws.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Slide the wiper blade element through the bottom claw of the wiper blade. 2. Guide the wiper
blade element through the wiper blade claws until both of the locking tabs engage the bottom claw
set. 3. Install the wiper blade on the wiper arm.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Wiper Blade Element Replacement > Page 10565
Wiper Blade: Service and Repair Blade Element Cleaning
Lift each blade assembly off of the windshield and clean the element with a cloth saturated with full
strength washer solvent. Then rinse the blade assemblies with clear water.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Wiper Blade Element Replacement > Page 10566
Wiper Blade: Service and Repair Blade Element Replacement - Rear
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
IMPORTANT: Replace the wiper blade element if it is removed from the wiper blade.
1. Remove the wiper blade from the wiper arm. 2. Squeeze the wiper blade element tabs together.
3. Pull the wiper blade element out through the wiper blade claws.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Slide the wiper blade element through the bottom claw of the wiper blade. 2. Guide the wiper
blade element through the wiper blade claws until both of the locking tabs engage the bottom claw
set. 3. Install the wiper blade on the wiper arm.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Wiper Control Module: Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control Module > Component Information > Locations
> Page 10570
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Gear Box > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Wiper Gear Box: Service and Repair
WIPER TRANSMISSION REPLACEMENT
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 39232 Wiper Transmission Separator
^ J 39529 Wiper Transmission Installer
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the wiper arms. 2. Remove the air inlet grille panel. 3. Disconnect the transmission
drive link from the wiper motor crank arm with the J 39232.
4. Remove the transmission to cowl nuts. 5. Remove the wiper transmission from the vehicle
through the access openings in the top of the cowl.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Gear Box > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 10574
1. Install the wiper transmission on the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the transmission to cowl nuts.
Tighten Tighten the transmission nuts to 14 N.m (10 lb ft).
IMPORTANT: Assemble the wiper transmission to the crank arm past the second detent so that the
seal is compressed to a maximum height of 25.5 mm (1.0 in). Lubricate the inside of the socket
with a lithium-based grease (GM P/N 1050109, 1052196 or equivalent).
3. Connect the transmission drive link to the wiper motor crank arm using the J 39529. 4. Install the
air inlet grille panel. 5. Install the wiper arms.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Locations
Wiper Motor: Locations
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Locations > Page
10578
Locations View
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Locations > Page
10579
Wiper Motor: Diagrams
Rear Window Wiper Motor
Windshield Wiper Motor And Module
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Wiper Motor Replacement
Wiper Motor: Service and Repair Wiper Motor Replacement
TOOLS REQUIRED
^ J 39232 Wiper Transmission Separator
^ J 39529 Wiper Transmission Installer
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the wiper arms. 2. Remove the air inlet grille panel. 3. Disconnect the transmission
drive link from the wiper motor crank arm using the J 39232.
4. Remove the wiper motor electrical connector. 5. Remove the three bolts. 6. Remove the wiper
motor from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Wiper Motor Replacement > Page 10582
1. Install the wiper motor on the vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the 3 bolts.
Tighten Tighten the 3 bolts to 7.0 N.m (62 lb in).
3. Connect the wiper motor electrical connector.
IMPORTANT: Assemble the wiper transmission to the crank arm past the second detent so that the
seal is compressed to a maximum height of 25.5 mm (1.0 in).
Lubricate the inside of the socket with a lithium-based grease (GM P/N 1050109, 1052196 or
equivalent).
4. Connect the transmission drive link to the crank arm using the J 39529. 5. Install the air inlet
grille panel. 6. Install the wiper arms.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Wiper Motor Replacement > Page 10583
Wiper Motor: Service and Repair Wiper Motor Module Replacement
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the wiper motor electrical connector. 2. Remove the cover screws. 3. Remove the
cover. 4. Remove the circuit board and terminal module by lifting up on the terminal.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1. Install the circuit board and terminal module.
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
2. Install the cover and 3 screws.
Tighten Tighten the screws to 2.6 N.m (23 lb in).
3. Install the wiper motor electrical connector.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Wiper Motor Replacement > Page 10584
Wiper Motor: Service and Repair Wiper Motor Replacement - Lift Gate
REMOVAL PROCEDURE
1. Remove the liftgate garnish molding. 2. Disconnect the wiper motor electrical connector. 3.
Remove the wiper arm from the wiper motor. 4. Remove the nut, the spacer, and the seal. 5.
Remove the 2 bolts and the wiper motor from the liftgate.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
NOTE: Refer to Fastener Notice in Service Precautions.
1. Install the wiper motor to the liftgate with the 2 bolts.
Tighten Tighten the bolts to 7.0 N.m (62 lb in).
2. Install the seal, the spacer, and the nut.
Tighten Tighten the nut to 6.0 N.m (53 lb in).
3. Install the wiper arm and blade. 4. Connect the wiper motor electrical connector. 5. Install the
liftgate garnish molding.
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
Rear Window Wiper Washer Switch